Factory Workshop Manual
Make
Ford
Model
Edge Fwd
Engine and year
V6-3.5L (2007)
Please navigate through the PDF using the options
provided by OnlyManuals.com on the sidebar.
This manual was submitted by
Anonymous
Date
1st January 2018
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory
Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory
Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 8
Accessory Delay Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory
Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 9
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna
Control Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-8 (behind Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 13
C2086
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 17
C4014
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 18
Parking Assist Control Module: Service and Repair
PARKING AID MODULE
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to electrical charges. If exposed to these charges,
damage may result.
1. Remove the LH rear quarter trim panel. 2. Remove the 2 nuts and the parking aid module.
- Disconnect the parking aid module electrical connectors.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Heated Mirror Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Heated Mirror Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 23
Heated Mirror Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Heated Mirror Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 24
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-18 (Driver Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 28
Memory Positioning Module: Diagrams
C3299A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 29
C3299B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 30
C3299C
C3299D
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Power Seat Control Module: Description and Operation
DRIVER SEAT MODULE - MEMORY SEAT
The power driver seat, power outside rear view mirrors and power adjustable pedals are controlled
by the driver seat module (DSM) only when the vehicle is equipped with the programmable/recall
memory option. The DSM is located on the driver seat track.
This system allows automatic positioning of the driver seat to 2 programmable positions.
- A power driver seat position can be stored at any time. The driver must move the seat to the
desired position using the driver seat switch assembly. The driver must then depress the memory
SET switch which activates the memory SET switch light emitting diode (LED). Within 5 seconds
(before the LED goes out), the driver must select a memory position. Memory 1 is selected by
depressing memory switch 1. Memory 2 is selected by depressing memory switch 2.
- If no memory switch input is received within the 5-second time limit, the operation is aborted and
the memory seat position switch (set switch) LED is turned OFF. This also occurs if one of the
following inputs is received during the 5-second programming limit: Driver seat control switch
- Memory seat position switch (set switch)
- Power adjustable pedal switch
A programmed seat position can only be recalled when the transmission selector is in PARK or
NEUTRAL with the ignition switch in the RUN position. A position may be programmed at any time.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 37
Power Seat Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 38
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module: > 08-14-5 > Jul > 08 > Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC B117B
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Customer Interest Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC
B117B
TSB 08-14-5
07/21/08
POWER LIFT GATE INOPERATIVE - ALL FUNCTIONAL SWITCHES, REMOTE KEYLESS
ENTRY, WITH POWER LIFT GATE TRUNK MODULE DTC B117B
FORD: 2008 Taurus X 2007-2008 Edge, Expedition
Ford: 2009 Flex
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition, Navigator Edge, MKX, 2008 Taurus X and 2009 Flex may
exhibit an inoperative power lift gate from remote keyless entry, inside switches or the outside lift
gate handle with a power lift gate/trunk module (LTM) with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B117B
and PID UCH_OUT set to Active.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check power lift gate operation from all buttons.
2. If the power lift gate is inoperative, then check the LTM for DTC B117B and for PID UCH_Out
set to "Active".
NOTE
THE PID UCH_OUT IS SET TO "INACTIVE" OR ANY OTHER DTC ARE RETRIEVED, DO NOT
CONTINUE WITH THIS PROCEDURE, PERFORM NORMAL DIAGNOSTICS PER THE WORK
SHOP MANUAL SECTION 501-03.
3. If both the DTC B117B and the PID UCH_Out equal "Active" are present, then clear the LTM
memory and proceed to Step 4.
4. Reprogram the LTM module to the latest calibration using IDS release 55.13 Patch 28 and
higher or 56.1 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2008.7 DVD. Calibration
files may also be obtained at the website.
5. Initialize LTM per Work Shop Manual Section 501-03.
6. Check the operation of the power lift gate. Check for any DTCs. If lift gate operation passes from
all switches and there are NO DTCs in the LTM, return the vehicle to the customer.
7. If any DTCs are present after retesting or lift gate is inoperative, from any switches, perform
Work Shop Manual diagnosis per Section 501-03.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081405A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator, Edge, MKX, 2008 Taurus X, 2009 Flex: Reprogram The LTM, Includes Time To Check
DTCs And, Lift Gate Operation, Authorization Decal Not Required (Do Not Use With 12650D,
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module: > 08-14-5 > Jul > 08 > Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC B117B > Page 47
12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Trunk / Liftgate
Control Module: > 08-14-5 > Jul > 08 > Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC B117B
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Power Liftgate
Inoperative/DTC B117B
TSB 08-14-5
07/21/08
POWER LIFT GATE INOPERATIVE - ALL FUNCTIONAL SWITCHES, REMOTE KEYLESS
ENTRY, WITH POWER LIFT GATE TRUNK MODULE DTC B117B
FORD: 2008 Taurus X 2007-2008 Edge, Expedition
Ford: 2009 Flex
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition, Navigator Edge, MKX, 2008 Taurus X and 2009 Flex may
exhibit an inoperative power lift gate from remote keyless entry, inside switches or the outside lift
gate handle with a power lift gate/trunk module (LTM) with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B117B
and PID UCH_OUT set to Active.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check power lift gate operation from all buttons.
2. If the power lift gate is inoperative, then check the LTM for DTC B117B and for PID UCH_Out
set to "Active".
NOTE
THE PID UCH_OUT IS SET TO "INACTIVE" OR ANY OTHER DTC ARE RETRIEVED, DO NOT
CONTINUE WITH THIS PROCEDURE, PERFORM NORMAL DIAGNOSTICS PER THE WORK
SHOP MANUAL SECTION 501-03.
3. If both the DTC B117B and the PID UCH_Out equal "Active" are present, then clear the LTM
memory and proceed to Step 4.
4. Reprogram the LTM module to the latest calibration using IDS release 55.13 Patch 28 and
higher or 56.1 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2008.7 DVD. Calibration
files may also be obtained at the website.
5. Initialize LTM per Work Shop Manual Section 501-03.
6. Check the operation of the power lift gate. Check for any DTCs. If lift gate operation passes from
all switches and there are NO DTCs in the LTM, return the vehicle to the customer.
7. If any DTCs are present after retesting or lift gate is inoperative, from any switches, perform
Work Shop Manual diagnosis per Section 501-03.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081405A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator, Edge, MKX, 2008 Taurus X, 2009 Flex: Reprogram The LTM, Includes Time To Check
DTCs And, Lift Gate Operation, Authorization Decal Not Required (Do Not Use With 12650D,
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Trunk / Liftgate
Control Module: > 08-14-5 > Jul > 08 > Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC B117B > Page 53
12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 54
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 55
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Diagrams
C4174A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 56
C4174B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 57
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Service and Repair
POWER LIFTGATE MODULE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the power liftgate motor assembly.
2. Remove the power liftgate module.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors and remove the 3 bolts. To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Heated Seat Module
Seat Heater Control Module: Locations Heated Seat Module
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Heated Seat Module > Page 62
View 151-20 (Rear Seats)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Heated Seat Module > Page 63
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Heated Seat Module > Page 64
Seat Heater Control Module: Locations Climate Controlled Seat Backrest Module
View 151-18 (Driver Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Heated Seat Module > Page 65
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Heated Seat Module > Page 66
Seat Heater Control Module: Locations Climate Controlled Seat Cushion Module
View 151-18 (Driver Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Heated Seat Module > Page 67
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Seat Module
Seat Heater Control Module: Diagrams Heated Seat Module
C329
C3162
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Seat Module > Page 70
Seat Heater Control Module: Diagrams Climate Controlled Seat Module, Passenger Side
C3036A
C3036B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Seat Module > Page 71
C3036C
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Seat Module > Page 72
Seat Heater Control Module: Diagrams Climate Controlled Seat Backrest Module
C3322
C3326
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Seat Module > Page 73
Seat Heater Control Module: Diagrams Climate Controlled Seat Cushion Module
C3327
C3328
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Climate Controlled Seat Module
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair Climate Controlled Seat Module
CLIMATE CONTROLLED SEAT MODULE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an airbag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- When installing a new climate control seat module (CCSM), it is necessary to carry out
programmable module installation (PMI).
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Before removing the climate control seat module (CCSM), carry out the appropriate steps in the
programmable module installation (PMI)
procedure.
2. Position the front passenger seat to access all the seat track-to-floor bolts and the safety belt
retractor belt anchor nut. 3. Depower the SRS. 4. Remove the front passenger seat. 5. Remove the
CCSM.
- Disconnect the 3 electrical connectors.
- Remove the 2 screws.
- Remove the CCSM.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 7. Install the front passenger seat and repower the
SRS. Do not prove out the SRS at this time. 8. Carry out the Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS)
System Zero Seat Weight Test and prove out the SRS. 9. Install the CCSM software data. Carry
out the appropriate steps in the PMI procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Climate Controlled Seat Module > Page 76
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair Heated Seat Module
Front
HEATED SEAT MODULE - FRONT
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an airbag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Position the front passenger seat to access the heated seat module. 2. Depower the SRS. 3.
From under the front of the front passenger seat, remove the heated seat module.
- Vehicles with power seat track, remove the 2 screws and lower the bracket (if equipped).
- Disconnect the heated seat module electrical connector.
- Remove the screw and heated seat module.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 5. Repower the SRS. Do not prove out the SRS at this
time. 6. Carry out the Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Zero Seat Weight Test and
prove out the SRS.
Rear
HEATED SEAT MODULE - REAR SEAT
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the second row 60 percent seat front riser-to-floor nut and bolt.
- To install, tighten to 70 Nm (52 lb-ft).
2. Pivot the front of the 60 percent seat cushion upward. 3. Remove the screw, disconnect the
electrical connector and remove the heated seat module. 4. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 81
C135
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 82
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to electrical charges. The ABS module can be
damaged if exposed to these charges.
CAUTION: Do not allow any brake fluid or foreign material to enter the mating side of the ABS
module or damage to the solenoids can occur.
1. Remove the hydraulic control unit (HCU). 2. Remove the 4 ABS module screws and the ABS
module.
^ To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
3. NOTE: Visually inspect the ABS module terminals for damage before installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Control
Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 87
C1554
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 92
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 93
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 97
Compressor Clutch Relay: Description and Operation
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) CLUTCH RELAY (A/CCR)
NOTE: The PCM PIDs WAC and wide open throttle air conditioning cutoff fault (WACF) are used to
monitor the A/CCR output.
The A/CCR is wired normally open. There is no direct electrical connection between the A/C switch
or electronic automatic temperature control (EATC) module and the A/C clutch. The PCM receives
a signal indicating that A/C is requested. For some applications, this message is sent through the
communications network. When A/C is requested, the PCM checks other A/C related inputs that
are available, such as A/C pressure switch and A/C cycling switch. If these inputs indicate A/C
operation is OK, and the engine conditions are OK (coolant temperature, engine RPM, throttle
position), the PCM grounds the A/CCR output, closing the relay contacts and sending voltage to
the A/CCR.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 98
Compressor Clutch Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 99
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module > Page 104
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module
C228A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module > Page 107
C228B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module > Page 108
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams Manual Climate Control Module
C2357A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module > Page 109
C2357B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 110
Control Module HVAC: Service and Repair
CLIMATE CONTROL MODULE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the center instrument panel finish panel. 2. Remove the 4 climate control module
screws. 3. Remove the climate control module.
4. NOTE: Be sure the climate control module spacers are correctly positioned before installing the
climate control module.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 115
Backup Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 116
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Headlamp Control Module: Service and Repair
ADAPTIVE FRONT LIGHTING MODULE
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the 2 screws and position the fender splash shield aside. 3. Remove the 3 screws and
the adaptive front lighting module.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay > Page 124
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay > Page 125
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay > Page 128
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay > Page 129
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Right Stop/Turn Lamp Relay
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay > Page 130
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay > Page 131
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Park Lamp Relay
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay > Page 132
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Micro ISO
Micro ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection Relay - Micro ISO
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Micro ISO > Page 138
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Micro ISO > Page 139
Micro ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection Relay - Ultra Micro ISO
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Micro ISO > Page 140
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Mini ISO Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Mini ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Mini ISO Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 144
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair
SMART JUNCTION BOX (SJB)
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
NOTE:
- Prior to the replacement of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to the appropriate scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new module
after installation.
- The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) functionality has been integrated into the SJB.
- The steps included in the SJB removal and installation procedure are critical to restoring the
vehicle security and tire pressure monitoring systems to normal operation. A new SJB is delivered
in a manufacturing mode with 7 pre-set DTCs related to the TPMS. To clear the DTCs, successful
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 148
configuration of the SJB must occur, followed by successful TPMS sensor training, and a
successful self-test, including clearing of the DTCs. The DTCs are as follows: B2477 (Module Configuration Failure)
- B106D (Tire Pressure Monitor System [TPMS] Initiators Not Configured)
- B2868 (Left Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2869 (Right Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2870 (Right Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2871 (Left Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- C2780 (ECU in Manufacturer Sub-State)
1. NOTE: This step is necessary only if the SJB is being replaced.
Upload the module configuration information from the SJB into the scan tool.
2. Remove the driver door scuff plate. 3. Disconnect the 6 electrical connectors. 4. Remove the
harness pushpin from the SJB. 5. Remove the nut. 6. Lower the SJB (release the SJB from the 2
alignment holes). 7. Push the red lock upward and press the 2 black tangs inward to release the B+
connector from the SJB. 8. Remove the SJB.
Installation
1. Install the B+ connector onto the SJB and push the red lock tab downward. 2. Position the 2 SJB
alignment tabs into the 2 holes and install the nut.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. Install the harness pushpin into the SJB. 4. Connect the 6 electrical connectors.
5. NOTE: If the SJB was not replaced, this is the last step that is necessary.
Install the driver door scuff plate.
6. NOTE:
- When successful, this step provides the calibration necessary for the SJB operation and clears
DTCs B106D and B2477. The clearing of these DTCs indicates the calibration data has been
successfully downloaded to the new SJB.
- If the programmable module installation (PMI) procedure was not followed when a new SJB was
installed, the remote keyless entry (RKE) function (from the integrated keyhead transmitter [IKT]) of
the SJB must be programmed, or the IKT RKE functions will be inoperative. IKTs can be
programmed to the new SJB by cycling each IKT key to the ON position for a minimum of 6
seconds. If a new instrument cluster was installed, the IKT keys must be programmed to the new
instrument cluster in order to program both the RKE and passive anti-theft system (PATS)
functions.
Download the SJB configuration information from the scan tool to the new SJB.
7. NOTE: When successful, this step clears DTCs B2868, B2869, B2870 and B2871. The clearing
of these DTCs indicates the SJB has recognized
the tire pressure sensors during the training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensors.
8. NOTE: DTC C2780 will not clear if any other DTCs are present in the SJB.
Carry out the SJB on-demand self-test, clear DTCs, and then retrieve all DTCs to confirm all DTCs
have been cleared.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Relay Box: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 153
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 154
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 155
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 156
Relay Box: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 157
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 158
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 159
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Relay Box: Diagrams Battery Junction Box (BJB)
C1035A
C1035B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 162
Relay Box: Diagrams Smart Junction Box (SJB)
C2280A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 163
C2280B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 164
C2280C
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 165
C2280D
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 166
C2280E
C2280F
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 167
C2280G
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Relay Box: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 170
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 171
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 172
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 173
Relay Box: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 174
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 175
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 176
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Specifications
Torque Specifications
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driver Seat
Module (DSM)
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Driver Seat Module (DSM)
DRIVER SEAT MODULE (DSM)
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driver Seat
Module (DSM) > Page 184
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
NOTE: Prior to the replacement of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to the appropriate scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new module
after installation.
1. NOTE: This step is necessary only if the DSM is being replaced.
Upload the module configuration information from the DSM into the scan tool.
2. NOTE: If the driver seat can be moved to a high enough position, the DSM screws can be
removed without removing the driver seat.
If necessary, remove the driver seat.
3. Remove the 2 screws. 4. Disconnect the 4 electrical connectors and remove the DSM.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driver Seat
Module (DSM) > Page 185
5. NOTE: Make sure to download the DSM configuration information from the scan tool into the
new DSM.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driver Seat
Module (DSM) > Page 186
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Programmable Module Installation
PROGRAMMABLE MODULE INSTALLATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) Using the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) When the
Original Module is Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure be
carried out. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal
and installation procedures.
1. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle as normal. 2. From the Toolbox icon, select Module
Programming and press the check mark. 3. Select Programmable Module Installation. 4. Select the
module that is being replaced. 5. Follow the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the OFF
position, and press the check mark. 6. Install the new module and press the check mark. 7. Follow
the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the ON position, and press the check mark. 8.
The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration Complete. 9.
Test module for correct operation.
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) Using the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) When the
Original Module is NOT Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure be
carried out. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal
and installation procedures.
1. Install the new module. 2. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle as normal. 3. From the
Toolbox icon, select Module Programming and press the check mark. 4. Select Programmable
Module Installation. 5. Select the module that was replaced. 6. Follow the on-screen instructions,
turn the ignition key to the OFF position, and press the check mark. 7. Follow the on-screen
instructions, turn the ignition key to the ON position, and press the check mark. 8. If the data is not
available, the IDS displays a screen stating to contact the As-Built Data Center. Retrieve the data
from the technician service
publication website at this time and press the check mark.
9. Enter the module data and press the check mark.
10. The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration
Complete. 11. Test module for correct operation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Electronic Throttle Control Module: Description and Operation
TORQUE BASED ELECTRONIC THROTTLE CONTROL (ETC)
Overview
The torque based ETC is a hardware and software strategy that delivers an engine output torque
(via throttle angle) based on driver demand (pedal position). It uses an electronic throttle body, the
powertrain control module (PCM), and an accelerator pedal assembly to control the throttle
opening and engine torque. The ETC system replaces the standard cable operated accelerator
pedal, idle air control (IAC) valve, 3-wire throttle position (TP) sensor, and mechanical throttle body.
Torque based ETC enables aggressive automatic transmission shift schedules (earlier upshifts and
later downshifts). This is possible by adjusting the throttle angle to achieve the same wheel torque
during shifts, and by calculating this desired torque, the system prevents engine lugging (low RPM
and low manifold vacuum) while still delivering the performance and torque requested by the driver.
It also enables many fuel economy/emission improvement technologies such as variable camshaft
timing (VCT) (deliver same torque during transitions).
Torque based ETC also results in less intrusive vehicle and engine speed limiting, along with
smoother traction control.
Other benefits of ETC are: eliminate cruise control actuators
- eliminate idle air control (IAC) valve
- better airflow range
- packaging (no cable)
- more responsive powertrain at altitude and improved shift quality
It should be noted that the ETC system illuminates a powertrain malfunction indicator (wrench) on
the instrument cluster when a concern is present. Concerns are accompanied by diagnostic trouble
codes (DTCs) and may also illuminate the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL).
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB)
The ETB has the following characteristics: 1. The throttle actuator control (TAC) motor is a DC
motor controlled by the PCM (requires 2-wires). The gear ratio from the motor to the throttle
plate shaft is 17:1.
2. There are 2 designs: parallel and in-series. The parallel design has the motor under the bore
parallel to the plate shaft. The motor housing is
integrated into the main housing. The in-series design has a separate motor housing.
3. Two springs are used: one is used to close the throttle (main spring) and the other is in a plunger
assembly that results in a default angle when no
power is applied. This is for limp home reasons (the force of the plunger spring is 2 times stronger
than the main spring). The default angle is usually set to result in a top vehicle speed of 48 km/h
(30 mph). Typically this throttle angle is 7 to 8 degrees from the hard-stop angle.
4. The closed throttle plate hard stop is used to prevent the throttle from binding in the bore (~0.75
degree). This hard stop setting is not adjustable
and is set to result in less airflow than the minimum engine airflow required at idle.
5. Unlike cable operated throttle bodies, the intent for the ETB is not to have a hole in the throttle
plate or to use plate sealant. The hole is not
required in the ETB because the required idle airflow is provided by the plate angle in the throttle
body assembly. This plate angle controls idle, idle quality, and eliminates the need for an IAC
valve.
6. The TP sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant throttle position
signals are required for increased monitoring
reasons. The first TP signal (TP1) has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and
the second signal (TP2) has a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal
operation the negative slope TP signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of
throttle position. The TP sensor assembly requires 4 circuits. 5-volt reference voltage
- Signal return (ground)
- TP1 voltage with negative voltage slope (5-0 volts)
- TP2 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensors
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 190
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) And Accelerator Pedal Assembly
The ETC strategy uses pedal position sensors as an input to determine the driver demand. 1.
There are 3 pedal position signals required for system monitoring. APP1 has a negative slope
(increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and APP2 and
APP3 both have a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation
APP1 is used as the indication of pedal position by the strategy.
2. There are 2 VREF circuits, 2 signal return circuits, and 3 signal circuits (a total of 7 circuits and
pins) between the PCM and the APP sensor
assembly. 2 reference voltage circuits (5 volts)
- 2 signal return (ground) circuits
- APP1 voltage with negative voltage slope (5-0 volts)
- APP2 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
- APP3 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
3. The pedal position signal is convened to pedal travel degrees (rotary angle) by the PCM. The
software then converts these degrees to counts,
which is the input to the torque based strategy.
4. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a
concern. The PCM determines if a signal is
incorrect by calculating where it should be, inferred from the other signals. A value is substituted for
an incorrect signal if 2 of the 3 signals are incorrect.
Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) System Strategy
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 191
ETC System
The torque based ETC strategy was developed to improve fuel economy and to accommodate
variable camshaft timing (VCT). This is possible by not coupling the throttle angle to the driver
pedal position. Uncoupling the throttle angle (produce engine torque) from the pedal position (driver
demand) allows the powertrain control strategy to optimize fuel control and transmission shift
schedules while delivering the requested wheel torque.
The ETC monitor system is distributed across 2 processors within the PCM: the main powertrain
control processor unit (CPU) and a monitoring processor called an enhanced-quizzer (E-Quizzer)
processor. The primary monitoring function is carried out by the independent plausibility check
(IPC) software, which resides on the main processor. It is responsible for determining the
driver-demanded torque and comparing it to an estimate of the actual torque delivered. If the
generated torque exceeds driver demand by a specified amount, the IPC takes appropriate
corrective action.
ETC System Failure Mode And Effects Management (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 192
ETC System Failure Mode And Effects Management (Part 2)
Since the IPC and the main controller share the same processor, they are subject to a number of
potential common failure modes. The E-Quizzer processor was added to redundantly monitor
selected PCM inputs and to act as an intelligent watchdog and monitor the performance of the IPC
and the main processor. If it determines that the IPC function is impaired in any way, it takes
appropriate failure mode and effects management (FMEM) actions.
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation:
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 193
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation (Part 2)
Accelerator and Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Inputs
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Check:
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Check
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Check:
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Check
Throttle Plate Position Controller (TPPC) Outputs
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 194
Throttle Plate Controller Check Operation
The purpose of the TPPC is to maintain the throttle position at the desired throttle angle. It is a
separate chip embedded in the PCM. The desired angle is communicated from the main CPU via a
312.5 Hz duty cycle (DC) signal. The TPPC interprets the duty cycle signal as follows: Less than 4% - Out of range, limp home default position.
- Greater than or equal to 4% but less than 6% - Commanded default position, closed.
- Greater than or equal to 6% but less than 7% - Commanded default position. Used for key ON,
engine OFF.
- Greater than or equal to 7% but less than 8% - Enable ice breaker mode. Used to clear potential
ice buildup in the throttle body.
- Greater than or equal to 8% but less than 10% - Closed against hard-stop. Used to learn zero
throttle angle position (hard stop) after key-up.
- Greater than or equal to 10% but less than or equal to 92% - Normal operation, between 0
degrees (hard stop) and 82 degrees, 10% duty cycle equals 0 degrees throttle angle, 92% duty
cycle equals 82 degrees throttle angle.
- Greater than 92% but less than or equal to 96% - Wide open throttle, 82 to 86 degrees throttle
angle.
- Greater than 96% but less than or equal to 100% - Out of range, limp home default position.
The desired angle is relative to the hard-stop angle. The hard stop angle is learned during each
key-up process before the main CPU requests the throttle plate be closed against the hard stop.
The output of the TPPC is a voltage request to the H driver (also in PCM). The H driver is capable
of positive or negative voltage to the electronic throttle body motor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 09-11-15 > Jun > 09 > Engine Controls - Rough/Rolling Idle/Idle Speed
Drop
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls - Rough/Rolling Idle/Idle Speed Drop
TSB 09-11-15
06/15/09
ROUGH / ROLLING IDLE / IDLE SPEED DROPS BELOW SPECIFICATION / LIGHT THROTTLE
WITH CRUISE ENGAGED / LOW SPEED TIP IN CLUNK
FORD: 2008-2009 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2009 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKX
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 8-23-5 to update the vehicle lines and Action statement.
ISSUE Some 2008-2009 Taurus, Taurus-X, Sable and 2007-2009 Edge and MKX vehicles may
exhibit a rough, rolling idle, or the idle speed dropping below specification. This condition typically
occurs most often in hot ambient temperatures with the A/C on when idling for extended periods.
Vehicles may also exhibit idle speed dropping below specification on light throttle application with
vehicle cruise control engaged and traveling down a hill or a low speed tip in clunk.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) to the latest calibration using IDS
release 61.05 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration
files may also be obtained at the website.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091115A 2008-2009 Taurus, Sable, 0.3 Hr.
Taurus X. 2007-2009 Edge, MKX: Reprogram The PCM, Authorization Decal Not Required. (Do
Not Use With 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 07-19-5 > Oct > 07 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0451
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0451
TSB 07-19-5
10/01/07
MIL ON DTC P0451
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles may exhibit a malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) on with
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0451 which may be caused by electromagnetic compatibility
(EMC) interference.
ACTION If normal Workshop Manual Diagnostics are unable to resolve the concern, install a
Capacitor/Jumper Harness Kit following the installation instruction sheet included with the kit.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071905A 2007 Edge/MKX: Install A 0.7 Hr.
Capacitor Jumper Harness Kit (Do Not Use With 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9C052 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 09-11-15 > Jun > 09 > Engine Controls - Rough/Rolling Idle/Idle
Speed Drop
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Rough/Rolling Idle/Idle
Speed Drop
TSB 09-11-15
06/15/09
ROUGH / ROLLING IDLE / IDLE SPEED DROPS BELOW SPECIFICATION / LIGHT THROTTLE
WITH CRUISE ENGAGED / LOW SPEED TIP IN CLUNK
FORD: 2008-2009 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2009 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKX
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 8-23-5 to update the vehicle lines and Action statement.
ISSUE Some 2008-2009 Taurus, Taurus-X, Sable and 2007-2009 Edge and MKX vehicles may
exhibit a rough, rolling idle, or the idle speed dropping below specification. This condition typically
occurs most often in hot ambient temperatures with the A/C on when idling for extended periods.
Vehicles may also exhibit idle speed dropping below specification on light throttle application with
vehicle cruise control engaged and traveling down a hill or a low speed tip in clunk.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) to the latest calibration using IDS
release 61.05 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration
files may also be obtained at the website.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091115A 2008-2009 Taurus, Sable, 0.3 Hr.
Taurus X. 2007-2009 Edge, MKX: Reprogram The PCM, Authorization Decal Not Required. (Do
Not Use With 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 07-19-5 > Oct > 07 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0451
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0451
TSB 07-19-5
10/01/07
MIL ON DTC P0451
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles may exhibit a malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) on with
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0451 which may be caused by electromagnetic compatibility
(EMC) interference.
ACTION If normal Workshop Manual Diagnostics are unable to resolve the concern, install a
Capacitor/Jumper Harness Kit following the installation instruction sheet included with the kit.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071905A 2007 Edge/MKX: Install A 0.7 Hr.
Capacitor Jumper Harness Kit (Do Not Use With 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9C052 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
216
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 219
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 220
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 221
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 222
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 223
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 224
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 225
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 226
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 227
Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 228
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 229
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 230
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 231
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 232
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 233
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 234
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 235
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 236
Engine Control Module: Connector Views
C175B (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 237
C175B (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 238
C175E (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 239
C175E (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 240
C175T (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 241
C175T (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Powertrain
Control Module (PCM)
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
Removal
1. NOTE: PCM replacement DOES NOT require new keys or programming of keys.
Retrieve the module configuration. Carry out the module configuration retrieval steps of the
Programmable Module Installation procedure.
2. Disconnect the 3 powertrain control module (PCM) electrical connectors. 3. Remove the 2 nuts
and the PCM.
- Remove the gasket.
Installation
1. Install the gasket and the PCM. 2. Install the 2 PCM nuts.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. Connect the 3 PCM electrical connectors. 4. Restore the module configuration. Carry out the
module configuration restore steps of the Programmable Module Installation procedure. 5.
Reprogram the passive anti-theft system (PATS). Carry out the Parameter Reset procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Powertrain
Control Module (PCM) > Page 244
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only
Memory (EEPROM)
FLASH ELECTRICALLY ERASABLE PROGRAMMABLE READ ONLY MEMORY (EEPROM)
Description
The EEPROM is contained in an integrated circuit (IC) internal to the powertrain control module
(PCM). The EEPROM contains the vehicle strategy including calibration information specific to the
vehicle, and is capable of being programmed or flashed repeatedly.
As part of the calibration there is an area referred to as the vehicle identification (VID) block. The
VID block is programmed when installing a new PCM as described under Programming the VID
Block for a Replacement PCM. Failure to carry out this procedure may generate DTCs P1635 or
P1639. The VID block in an existing PCM can also be tailored to accommodate various hardware
or parameter changes made to the vehicle since production. Failure to carry out this procedure
properly may generate DTC P1635, Tire/Axle Ratio out of Acceptable Range. An incorrect tire/axle
ratio is one of the main causes for DTC P1639. This is described under Making Changes to the VID
Block and also under Making Changes to the PCM Calibration. The VID block contains many items
used by the strategy for a variety of functions. Some of these items include the vehicle identification
number (VIN), octane adjust, fuel octane, fuel type, vehicle speed limit, tire size, axle ratio, the
presence of speed control, and 4-wheel drive electronic shift-on-the-fly (ESOF) versus manual
shift-on-the-fly (MSOF). Only items applicable to the vehicle hardware and supported by the VID
block is displayed on the scan tool.
When changing items in the VID block, the strategy places range limits on certain items such as
tire and axle ratio. The number of times the VID block may be reconfigured is limited. When this
limit is reached, the scan tool displays a message indicating the need to flash the PCM again to
reset the VID block.
Programming can be carried out by a local Ford dealer or any non-Ford facility. Refer to the scan
tool manufacturer's instruction manual for details.
Programming the VID Block for a Replacement PCM
A new PCM contains the latest strategy and calibration level for a particular vehicle. However, the
VID block is blank and needs programming. There are 2 procedures available. The first is an
automatic data transfer from the old PCM to the new PCM, and the second is manual data entry
into the new PCM.
Automatic data transfer is carried out if the old PCM is capable of communicating. This is done by
using a scan tool to retrieve data from the old PCM before removing it from the vehicle. The stored
data can then be downloaded to the new PCM after it has been installed.
Carry out manual data entry if the old module is damaged or incapable of communicating. Remove
and install a new PCM. Using a compatible scan tool, select and carry out the module/parameter
programming, referring to the scan tool manufacturer's instruction manual. Make certain that all
parameters are included. Failure to properly program tire size in revolutions per mile, (rev/mile
equals 63,360 divided by the tire circumference in inches), axle ratio, 4x4/4x2, and/or MSOF/ESOF
may result in DTCs P1635 and P1639. You may be instructed to contact the As-Built Data Center
for the information needed to manually update the VID block with the scan tool. Contact the center
only if the old PCM cannot be used or the data is corrupt. For Ford and Lincoln Mercury
technicians, contact your National Hotline or the Professional Technician Society (PTS) website for
As-Built data listed under the Service Publications Index. Non-Ford technicians use the
Motorcraft(R) website at www.motorcraft.com. From the Motorcraft(R) homepage, use the search
function to find the Module Programming or As-Built Data.
For Ford and Lincoln Mercury technicians, check the Programmable Module Installation link on the
PTS website for quick Programmable Module data information by vehicle.
Making Changes to the VID Block
A PCM which is programmed may require changes to be made to certain VID information to
accommodate the vehicle hardware. Refer to Module Reprogramming on the scan tool.
Making Changes to the PCM Calibration
At certain times, the entire EEPROM needs to be completely reprogrammed. This is due to
changes made to the strategy or calibration after production, or the need to reset the VID block
because it has reached its limit. Refer to Module Reprogramming on the scan tool.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 248
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 249
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 254
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 255
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 259
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 260
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Ignition Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Ignition Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 265
Ignition Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Ignition Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 266
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations
Air Bag Control Module: Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 271
View 151-13 (Right Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 272
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams
C310A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 273
C310B (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 274
C310B (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 275
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair
RESTRAINTS CONTROL MODULE (RCM)
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- The restraints control module (RCM) orientation is critical for correct air bag supplemental
restraint system (SRS) operation. If a vehicle equipped with an SRS system has been involved in a
collision in which the center tunnel area has been damaged, inspect the mounting and bracket for
deformation. If damaged, a new RCM must be installed whether or not the air bags have deployed.
In addition, make sure the area of the RCM is restored to its original condition. Failure to follow this
procedure may result in serious personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices. Failure to follow this
procedure may result in serious
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 276
personal injury.
CAUTION:
- Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these charges, damage
may result.
- When installing a new restraints control module (RCM), it is necessary to carry out programmable
module installation (PMI). See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Information Bus/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- When installing a new restraints control module (RCM), always make sure the correct RCM is
being installed. If an incorrect RCM is installed, erroneous DTCs will result.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
1. If installing a new restraints control module (RCM), carry out the steps necessary to prepare for
programmable module installation (PMI). 2. Depower the system. 3. Remove the floor console.
4. Disconnect the selector lever cable from the ball stud located on the shifter and remove the
cable from the retaining clips. 5. Remove the 4 bolts (2 each side) from the inner floor console
support bracket. 6. Remove the bolts from the inner floor console bracket support-to-instrument
panel. 7. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the front inner floor console support bracket. 8.
Remove the inner floor console support bracket.
9. Press to release the locking tab and disconnect the small RCM electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 277
10. Disconnect the large RCM electrical connector.
1. Pinch the thumb tab and pivot the connector position assurance lever all the way back until it
stops. 2. Pull out and disconnect the RCM electrical connector.
11. Remove the 3 bolts and the RCM.
Installation
1. WARNING: The tightening torque of the air bag RCM retaining bolts is critical for correct system
operation. Failure to follow this
procedure may result in serious personal injury.
Install the restraints control module (RCM) and the 3 bolts. Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
2. Make sure the large RCM connector position assurance lever is in the full release position before
attempting to connect the connector.
3. CAUTION: Placing the large restraints control module (RCM) electrical wiring connector into the
RCM on an angle, may cause bad
electrical connections and damaged components.
Position the large RCM electrical connector into the RCM.
- CAUTION: Do not push the connector to the point where the lever pivots and seats itself. Light
pressure is needed to get the connector into position on the restraints control module (RCM),
before using the lever to fully seat the connector. Failure to follow these instructions may cause
component or connector damage.
With the large RCM electrical connector uniformly aligned to the RCM, lightly push in until a subtle
audible click is heard and slight resistance is felt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 278
4. Connect the large RCM electrical connector.
- Using the connector position assurance lever, pivot it toward the RCM, drawing the connector into
the RCM. Make sure the thumb tab is engaged to the retainer on the RCM and locked in place.
5. Connect the small RCM electrical connector. 6. Install the inner floor console support bracket. 7.
Install the 4 bolts (2 each side) to the inner floor console support bracket.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
8. Install the screws to the inner floor console bracket support-to-floor instrument panel.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
9. Install the selector lever cable in the selector lever housing.
10. NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable, make sure that the selector lever cable locking
tabs are locked in place and the cable end is
snapped onto the ball stud. Press the selector lever cable into the bracket and listen for the cable
to click in place. Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is locked into the bracket.
Also make sure that the selector lever cable end is correctly installed onto the ball stud. Pull back
on the selector lever cable end to make sure that the cable end is correctly installed.
Connect the selector lever cable end to the floor shifter.
11. Attach the electrical connectors to the front inner floor console support bracket. 12. Install the
floor console. 13. Repower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Do not prove out the SRS at
this time. 14. When installing a new RCM, carry out the steps necessary to complete
programmable module installation (PMI). 15. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition switch from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the ignition switch back to ON
and visually monitor the air bag indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag warning
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn OFF. If an air bag SRS
fault is present, the air bag indicator will: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash at a 5 Hz rate (RCM not configured).
The air bag warning indicator might not light until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch
has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault exists, a
chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning indicator and
any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 279
Clear all continuous diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) from the RCM and occupant classification
sensor (OCS) module using a scan tool.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Classification
Module - Air Bag > Component Information > Locations
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Classification
Module - Air Bag > Component Information > Locations > Page 283
C3159
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Classification
Module - Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Module - Manual Seat Track
Seat Occupant Classification Module - Air Bag: Service and Repair Occupant Classification Module
- Manual Seat Track
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION MODULE - MANUAL SEAT TRACK
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
CAUTION: Use care when handling the seat and track assembly. Dropping the assembly or sitting
on a seat not secured in the vehicle may result in damaged components.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
1. Depower the system. 2. Disconnect the occupant classification sensor (OCS) module electrical
connector. 3. Remove the 2 screws and the OCS module. 4. To install, reverse the removal
procedure. 5. Install the passenger seat and repower the supplemental restraints system (SRS).
Do not prove out the SRS at this time. 6. Carry out the appropriate procedure after installation of an
OCS system component.
- If installing the original OCS system component, carry out the Zero Seat Weight Test and prove
out the SRS. See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Classification
Module - Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Module - Manual Seat Track >
Page 286
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics
- If installing a new OCS system component, carry out the System Reset procedure and prove out
the SRS. See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag Systems/Service and Repair/Occupant Classification
Sensor (OCS) System Reset
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Classification
Module - Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Module - Manual Seat Track >
Page 287
Seat Occupant Classification Module - Air Bag: Service and Repair Occupant Classification Module
- Power Seat Track
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION MODULE - POWER SEAT TRACK
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
CAUTION: Use care when handling the seat and track assembly. Dropping the assembly or sitting
on a seat not secured in the vehicle may result in damaged components.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a restraints
control module (RCM) fault.
- The restraints control module (RCM) must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing
the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
1. Center and raise the front passenger seat to its highest position. 2. Depower the supplemental
restraint system (SRS). 3. Remove the front passenger seat. 4. Disconnect the occupant
classification sensor (OCS) module electrical connector. 5. Remove the 2 screws and the OCS
module. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 7. Install the front passenger seat. Do not
prove out the SRS at this time.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Classification
Module - Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Module - Manual Seat Track >
Page 288
8. Repower the supplemental restraints system (SRS). Do not prove out the SRS at this time. 9.
Carry out the appropriate procedure after installation of an OCS system component.
- If installing the original OCS system component, carry out the Zero Seat Weight Test. See:
Restraint Systems/Air Bag Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics
- If installing a new OCS system component, carry out the System Reset procedure. See: Restraint
Systems/Air Bag Systems/Service and Repair/Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System
Reset
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Starter Relay
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Starter Relay > Page 294
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Run/Start Relay
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection Run/Start Relay
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Run/Start Relay > Page 297
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Run/Start Relay > Page 298
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection Starter Relay
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Run/Start Relay > Page 299
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 304
Heated Glass Element Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 305
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 310
C1552
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Diagrams
C127
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-16 (Rear End - Edge)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor, Outer Left
C4009
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor, Outer Left > Page 321
C4011
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor, Outer Left > Page 322
C4010
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor, Outer Left > Page 323
C4012
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 324
Parking Assist Distance Sensor: Service and Repair
PARKING AID SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear bumper cover. 2. Disconnect the parking aid sensor(s) electrical connector(s).
3. Press the retaining tabs and remove the parking aid sensor(s). 4. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor >
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Diagrams
C127
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Driver Side
View 151-21 (Driver Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Driver Side > Page 334
View 151-22 (Passenger Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Side
C505
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Side > Page 337
C605
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 338
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 339
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 340
Power Door Lock Switch: Service and Repair
DOOR LOCK CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Open the cover, remove the screw and position the interior front door handle finish panel aside.
2. Disconnect the door lock control switch electrical connector. 3. Release the locking clips and
remove the door lock control switch. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-21 (Driver Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 344
C527
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 345
Power Mirror Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 346
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 347
Power Mirror Switch: Service and Repair
EXTERIOR MIRROR CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front door control switch bezel.
2. Remove the exterior mirror control switch.
- Depress the 2 locking tabs.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Power Seat Release Switch, Rear
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Power Seat Release Switch, Rear > Page 352
Power Seat Switch: Locations Power Seat Switch
View 151-18 (Driver Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Power Seat Release Switch, Rear > Page 353
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Power Seat Release Switch, Rear
C4351
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Power Seat Release Switch, Rear > Page 356
Power Seat Switch: Diagrams Power Seat Switch
C352
C3016
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Power Seat Release Switch, Rear > Page 357
C355
C3026
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat > Page 360
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat > Page 361
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, 8- or 10-Way Power Seats
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat > Page 362
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Memory Set Switch
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Memory Set Switch
MEMORY SET SWITCH
Memory SET Switch Edge
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Memory Set Switch > Page 365
Memory SET Switch, MKX
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the driver door trim panel.
Edge vehicles
2. Disconnect the electrical connector, release the 4 tabs and remove the memory SET switch
through the front of the door trim panel.
MK-vehicles
3. Disconnect the electrical connector, release the 4 tabs and remove the memory SET switch
through the back of the door trim panel.
All vehicles
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Memory Set Switch > Page 366
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Seat Control Switch-Front
Seat Control Switch - Front
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
Warning: To reduce the risk of accidental deployment, do not use any memory saver devices.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
NOTE: The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the
customer.
ALL SEATS
1. If possible, position the seat all the way up and center the seat in the front door opening.
2. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Air
Bag(s) Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair
3. Separate the safety belt retractor belt anchor from the seat in the following sequence.
1. Carefully pull up and out to remove the safety belt retractor belt anchor nut cover from the
cushion side shield. 2. Remove the safety belt anchor nut. To install, tighten to 47 Nm (35 lb-ft). 3.
Separate the safety belt retractor belt anchor from the seat.
4. Remove the seat control switch in the following sequence.
1. Pull out and remove the seat control switch knob(s). 2. If equipped with manual recline, release
the clip and remove the manual recline handle. 3. If equipped with manual lumbar, pull and remove
the manual lumbar handle. 4. Remove the cushion side shield screw(s). 5. Slide the cushion side
shield up in the rear to release the retailer. 6. Slide the cushion side shield forward to disengage
the retainer. 7. Release the cushion side shield clips and separate the seat control switch. 8.
Disconnect the seat control switch electrical connector and remove the switch.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
6. Repower the SRS. If a passenger seat has been serviced, do not prove out the SRS at this time.
Refer to See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming/Service and
Repair
PASSENGER SEAT
7. Carry out the Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Zero Seat Weight Test and prove
out the SRS. Refer to See: Relays and
Modules/Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems/Seat Occupant Classification Module - Air Bag
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate
Hazard Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Trunk / Liftgate Hazard Sensor: Service and Repair
PINCH STRIP SWITCH
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Left side shown, right side similar.
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel.
2. Disconnect the pinch strip electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate
Hazard Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 370
3. Remove the pinch strip.
- Remove the pin-type retainers.
- Remove the grommet and route the harness out of the vehicle.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Left Rear
View 151-23 (Left Rear Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Left Rear > Page 375
View 151-24 (Right Rear Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear
C722
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Rear > Page 378
C822
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat Control Switch
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Seat Control Switch
Front
SEAT CONTROL SWITCH - FRONT
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an airbag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All seats
1. If possible, position the seat all the way up and center the seat in the front door opening. 2.
Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). 3. Remove the seat control switch in the
following sequence.
1. Remove the safety belt retractor belt anchor nut cover. 2. If equipped with manual recline,
release the clip and remove the manual recline handle. 3. If equipped with manual lumbar, pull and
remove the manual lumbar handle. 4. Remove the cushion side shield screw(s). 5. Slide the
cushion side shield up in the rear to release the retainer. 6. Slide the cushion side shield forward to
disengage the retainer. 7. Release the cushion side shield clips and separate the seat control
switch. 8. Disconnect the seat control switch electrical connector and remove the switch.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 5. Repower the SRS. If a passenger seat has been
serviced, do not prove out the SRS at this time.
Passenger seat
6. Carry out the Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Zero Seat Weight Test and prove
out the SRS.
Rear
SEAT CONTROL SWITCH - REAR SEAT
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat Control Switch > Page 381
Seat Control Switch Without Power Liftgate
Seat Control Switch With Power Liftgate
Removal and Installation
Vehicles without power liftgate
1. Remove the quarter trim panel.
Vehicles with power liftgate
2. Pull out and remove the power liftgate strut cover in the quarter trim panel.
All vehicles
3. Remove the seat control switch.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
- Squeeze the tab at the top and bottom of the seat control switch and remove from the quarter trim
panel.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat Control Switch > Page 382
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Heated Seat Switch - Rear Seat
HEATED SEAT SWITCH - REAR SEAT
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door handle bezel on the side of the affected switch in the following sequence.
1. Remove the rear door handle bezel screw cover. 2. Remove the rear door handle bezel screw.
3. Separate the rear door handle bezel from the door trim panel.
2. Disconnect the electrical connector, release the clips and remove the heated seat switch from
the back side of the rear door handle bezel. 3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Memory Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-21 (Driver Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Memory Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 386
C503
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch
> Component Information > Locations
View 151-28 (Roof - With Panoramic Vista Roof)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 390
C912
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 391
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Service and Repair
ROOF OPENING PANEL CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the overhead console. 2. Disengage the clips and remove the switch from the overhead
console. 3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > License Lamps/Liftgate Release Switch
View 151-25 (Liftgate - Edge)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > License Lamps/Liftgate Release Switch > Page 396
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > License Lamps/Liftgate Release Switch > Page 397
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > License Lamps/Liftgate Release Switch
C4353
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > License Lamps/Liftgate Release Switch > Page 400
C4333
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > License Lamps/Liftgate Release Switch > Page 401
C4216
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > License Lamps/Liftgate Release Switch > Page 402
C2269
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Release Switch - Manual
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Service and Repair Liftgate Release Switch - Manual
LIFTGATE RELEASE SWITCH - MANUAL
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel. 2. Disconnect the liftgate release switch electrical connector. 3.
Remove the 5 liftgate release switch moulding nuts.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
4. Depress the tabs and remove the liftgate release switch. 5. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Release Switch - Manual > Page 405
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Service and Repair Liftgate Release Switch - Power
LIFTGATE RELEASE SWITCH - POWER
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel. 2. Disconnect the liftgate release switch electrical connector. 3.
Remove the 2 liftgate release switch moulding bolts.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
4. Depress the tabs and remove the liftgate release switch. 5. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS Sensor
Block > Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (Right Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS Sensor
Block > Component Information > Locations > Page 410
C3037
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS Sensor
Block > Component Information > Locations > Page 411
ABS Sensor Block: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
NOTE: When installing a new stability control sensor cluster, the sensor cluster must be calibrated.
Follow the scan tool directions for the calibration procedures.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
2. NOTE: The sensor is located on the RH side of the vehicle, under the rear seat.
Remove the rear seat. For additional information, refer to Seats.
3. Disconnect the stability control sensor cluster electrical connector. 4. Remove the 2 stability
control sensor cluster nuts and the stability control sensor cluster.
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 415
C124
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Service and Repair
Lateral Accelerometer: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
NOTE: When installing a new stability control sensor cluster, the sensor cluster must be calibrated.
Follow the scan tool directions for the calibration procedures.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
2. NOTE: The sensor is located on the RH side of the vehicle, under the rear seat.
Remove the rear seat. For additional information, refer to Seats.
3. Disconnect the stability control sensor cluster electrical connector. 4. Remove the 2 stability
control sensor cluster nuts and the stability control sensor cluster.
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Left Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 422
C2015
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 423
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Service and Repair
Parking Brake Warning Indicator Switch
Parking Brake Warning Indicator Switch
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the parking brake warning indicator switch electrical connector. 2. Remove the
parking brake warning indicator switch screw and the switch. 3. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Service and Repair
Steering Angle Sensor: Service and Repair
Steering Wheel Rotation Sensor
Special Tool(s)
Removal
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 427
1. Remove the clockspring. For additional information, refer to Air Bag Systems. 2. Remove the 2
steering wheel rotation sensor bolts. 3. Disconnect the steering wheel rotation sensor electrical
connector and remove the steering wheel rotation sensor.
Installation
1. If the arrow on the steering wheel rotation sensor ring and the arrow on the sensor housing are
misaligned and/or the straight ahead position of the
sensor is not known, follow these steps to align the sensor prior to installing the sensor: 1
Orient the front wheels in the straight-ahead position.
2 Connect the steering wheel rotation sensor electrical connector.
3 Connect the battery negative cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
4 Carefully rotate the sensor clockwise until it stops.
5 Rotate the sensor counterclockwise 2-1/2 turns.
6 Using the scan tool, read the steering wheel rotation sensor position PID (SWA POS). The PID
should read approximately 0 degrees. If not, repeat the procedure.
7 Disconnect the battery negative cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
8 Disconnect the steering wheel rotation sensor electrical connector.
2. NOTE: Slight rotation of the steering wheel rotation sensor ring is allowed to align the 2 arrows.
Make sure the sensor ring arrow is lined up with the steering wheel rotation sensor housing arrow
as shown and position the sensor into the multi-function switch housing.
3. Connect the steering wheel rotation sensor electrical connector. 4. Remove the 2 steering wheel
rotation sensor bolts.
^ Tighten to 1 Nm (9 inch lbs).
5. Install the clockspring. For additional information, refer to Air Bag Systems.
^ If the steering wheel rotation sensor was aligned using the scan tool, diagnostic trouble codes
(DTCs) will be present in the restrains control module (RCM). Using the scan tool, clear the DTCs
in the RCM.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction Control
Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction Control
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 431
C2355
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction Control
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 432
Traction Control Switch: Service and Repair
Stability/Traction Control Switch
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery. 2. Position the
instrument panel center finish panel away from the instrument panel. 3. Disconnect the
stability/traction control switch electrical connector. 4. Depress the 4 tabs and remove the
stability/traction control switch from the instrument panel center finish panel.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor: > 07-17-2 >
Sep > 07 > ABS/TCS - ABS/ESC Lamps ON/DTC's C1165/C1175/C1235/C1236
Wheel Speed Sensor: Customer Interest ABS/TCS - ABS/ESC Lamps ON/DTC's
C1165/C1175/C1235/C1236
TSB 07-17-2
09/03/07
ABS LAMP ON C1165/C1175 AND/OR C1235/C1236
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge/MKX vehicles built before 6/1/2007 (FWD only) may exhibit an Anti-Lock
Brake System (ABS) warning lamp and/or a Electronic Stability Control (ESC) warning lamp
illuminated with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) C1165/C1175 and/or C1235/C1236. This may be
due to a faulty rear wheel speed sensor.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Verify DTCs C1235/C1236 and/or C1165/C1175 are present. If so, continue on to Step 2. For all
other codes follow normal Workshop Manual diagnostics.
2. With the ignition off, proceed with the replacement of the faulted wheel speed sensor. Refer to
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 206-09.
NOTE
IT IS NOT NECESSARY TO REMOVE THE HARNESS ROUTING BRACKETS WHEN
PERFORMING THE REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE.
3. With a new wheel speed sensor installed, make sure to torque the retaining bolt to 7 N.m (62
lb-in).
4. Clear continuous DTCs.
NOTE
THE ABS SYSTEM CONFIRMS REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL INPUT BASED ON
SEVERAL WHEEL REVOLUTIONS ABOVE 24 KM/H (15 MPH). DRIVE VEHICLE FOR AT LEAST
75 FEET AT OR ABOVE 15 MPH. IF WHEEL SPEED SIGNAL INPUT IS MISSING THE ABS
LIGHT WILL ILLUMINATE.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071702A 2007 Edge/MKX Built 0.5 Hr.
Before 6/1/2007: Check Diagnostic Trouble Codes and Replace One Rear Wheel Speed Sensor
(Do Not Use With 12650D, 2219D, 2219D5)
071702B 2007 Edge/MKX Built 0.7 Hr.
Before 6/1/2007: Check Diagnostic Trouble Codes and Replace Both Rear
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor: > 07-17-2 >
Sep > 07 > ABS/TCS - ABS/ESC Lamps ON/DTC's C1165/C1175/C1235/C1236 > Page 441
Wheel Speed Sensors (Do Not Use With 12650D, 2219D, 2219D5)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C216 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
07-17-2 > Sep > 07 > ABS/TCS - ABS/ESC Lamps ON/DTC's C1165/C1175/C1235/C1236
Wheel Speed Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS/TCS - ABS/ESC Lamps ON/DTC's
C1165/C1175/C1235/C1236
TSB 07-17-2
09/03/07
ABS LAMP ON C1165/C1175 AND/OR C1235/C1236
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge/MKX vehicles built before 6/1/2007 (FWD only) may exhibit an Anti-Lock
Brake System (ABS) warning lamp and/or a Electronic Stability Control (ESC) warning lamp
illuminated with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) C1165/C1175 and/or C1235/C1236. This may be
due to a faulty rear wheel speed sensor.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Verify DTCs C1235/C1236 and/or C1165/C1175 are present. If so, continue on to Step 2. For all
other codes follow normal Workshop Manual diagnostics.
2. With the ignition off, proceed with the replacement of the faulted wheel speed sensor. Refer to
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 206-09.
NOTE
IT IS NOT NECESSARY TO REMOVE THE HARNESS ROUTING BRACKETS WHEN
PERFORMING THE REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE.
3. With a new wheel speed sensor installed, make sure to torque the retaining bolt to 7 N.m (62
lb-in).
4. Clear continuous DTCs.
NOTE
THE ABS SYSTEM CONFIRMS REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL INPUT BASED ON
SEVERAL WHEEL REVOLUTIONS ABOVE 24 KM/H (15 MPH). DRIVE VEHICLE FOR AT LEAST
75 FEET AT OR ABOVE 15 MPH. IF WHEEL SPEED SIGNAL INPUT IS MISSING THE ABS
LIGHT WILL ILLUMINATE.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071702A 2007 Edge/MKX Built 0.5 Hr.
Before 6/1/2007: Check Diagnostic Trouble Codes and Replace One Rear Wheel Speed Sensor
(Do Not Use With 12650D, 2219D, 2219D5)
071702B 2007 Edge/MKX Built 0.7 Hr.
Before 6/1/2007: Check Diagnostic Trouble Codes and Replace Both Rear
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
07-17-2 > Sep > 07 > ABS/TCS - ABS/ESC Lamps ON/DTC's C1165/C1175/C1235/C1236 > Page 447
Wheel Speed Sensors (Do Not Use With 12650D, 2219D, 2219D5)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C216 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left Rear
View 151-15 (Right Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left Rear > Page 450
View 151-15 (Right Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left Rear > Page 451
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front
C150
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 454
C440
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 455
C160
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 456
C426
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly. 2. Remove the retainers and position the fender splash
shield aside. 3. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector. 4. Disconnect the 6
pushpin fasteners. 5. Remove the front wheel speed sensor bolt and the wheel speed sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front > Page 459
^ To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 inch lbs).
6. CAUTION: The wheel speed sensor harness must be routed as shown or damage to the
harness during vehicle jounce and rebound can
occur.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front > Page 460
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery. 2. Remove the
wheel and tire assembly. 3. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector.
4. NOTE: It is not necessary to remove the harness routing brackets.
Disconnect the wheel speed sensor harness from the brackets.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front > Page 461
5. Disconnect the pushpin fasteners. 6. Remove the wheel speed sensor bolt and the wheel speed
sensor.
^ To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 inch lbs).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
Yaw Rate Sensor: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
NOTE: When installing a new stability control sensor cluster, the sensor cluster must be calibrated.
Follow the scan tool directions for the calibration procedures.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
2. NOTE: The sensor is located on the RH side of the vehicle, under the rear seat.
Remove the rear seat. For additional information, refer to Seats.
3. Disconnect the stability control sensor cluster electrical connector. 4. Remove the 2 stability
control sensor cluster nuts and the stability control sensor cluster.
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Radiator Cooling Fan Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
FAN SPEED SENSOR (FSS)
Cooling Fan Clutch With (FSS)
The FSS is a Hall-effect sensor that measures the cooling fan clutch speed by generating a
waveform with a frequency proportional to the fan speed. If the cooling fan clutch is moving at a
relatively low speed, the sensor produces a signal with a low frequency. As the cooling fan clutch
speed increases, the sensor generates a signal with a higher frequency. The powertrain control
module (PCM) uses the frequency signal generated by the FSS as a feedback for closed loop
control of the cooling fan clutch.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR
Typical Thread Type ECT Sensor
The ECT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The ECT measures the temperature of the engine coolant. The PCM uses the ECT input for fuel
control and for cooling fan control. There are 3 types of ECT sensors, threaded, push-in, and
twist-lock. The ECT sensor is located in an engine coolant passage.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 476
C107
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 477
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Typical CHT Sensor
The CHT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with the temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as temperature increases., and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
The CHT sensor is installed in the cylinder head and measures the metal temperature. The CHT
sensor can provide complete engine temperature information and can be used to infer coolant
temperature. If the CHT sensor conveys an overheating condition to the PCM, the PCM initiates a
fail-safe cooling strategy based on information from the CHT sensor. A cooling system concern
such as low coolant or coolant loss could cause an overheating condition. As a result, damage to
major engine components could occur. Using both the CHT sensor and fail-safe cooling strategy,
the PCM prevents damage by allowing air cooling of the engine and limp home capability.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 478
Engine Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the lower intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the cylinder head temperature (CHT) sensor
electrical connector. 3. Remove and discard the CHT sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Do not reuse the CHT sensor, install a new sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control)
> Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control)
> Component Information > Locations > Page 483
C2064
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control)
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal to the
PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control)
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch > Page 486
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Brake Pedal Switch (BPS) Brake
Deactivator Switch
BRAKE PEDAL SWITCH (BPS) BRAKE DEACTIVATOR SWITCH
The BPS, also called the brake deactivator switch, is for vehicle speed control deactivation. A
normally closed switch supplies battery positive voltage (B+) to the PCM when the brake pedal is
not applied. When the brake pedal is applied, the normally closed switch opens and power is
removed from the PCM.
On some applications the normally closed BPS, along with the normally open BPP switch, are used
for a brake rationality test within the PCM. The PCM misfire monitor profile learn function may be
disabled if a brake switch concern occurs. If one or both brake pedal inputs to the PCM is not
changing states when they were expected to, a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) is set by the PCM
strategy.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise Control
> Component Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION (CPP) SWITCH
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
The CPP switch is an input to the PCM indicating the clutch pedal position. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the CPP circuit. When the CPP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The CPP input to the PCM is used to detect a reduction in engine
load. The PCM uses the load information for mass air flow and fuel calculations.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair
SPEED CONTROL SWITCH
Edge
MKX
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 493
Removal and Installation
MKX
1. Remove the driver air bag module. 2. Remove the 4 screws and the steering wheel control
bezel.
All vehicles
3. Remove the speed control switch by pulling the switch toward the rear of the vehicle.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 498
C103
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 499
Oil Pressure Sender: Service and Repair
Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) Switch
Material
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove the cooling fan assembly. For additional information,
refer to Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories. 3. Disconnect the engine oil pressure
(EOP) switch electrical connector. 4. Remove the EOP switch.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Apply thread sealant with PTFE to the EOP switch threads prior to installation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Temperature Sensor/Switch,
Engine > Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Temperature Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
ENGINE OIL TEMPERATURE (EOT) SENSOR
Typical EOT Sensor
The EOT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The EOT sensor measures the temperature of the engine oil. The sensor is typically threaded into
the engine oil lubrication system. The PCM can use the EOT sensor input to determine the
following:
- On variable camshaft timing (VCT) applications the EOT input is used to adjust the VCT control
gains and logic for camshaft timing.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input in conjunction with other PCM inputs to determine oil
degradation.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input to initiate a soft engine shutdown. To prevent engine
damage from occurring as a result of high oil temperatures, the PCM has the ability to initiate a soft
engine shutdown. Whenever engine RPM exceeds a calibrated level for a certain period of time,
the PCM begins reducing power by disabling engine cylinders.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch
HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Service and Repair
AMBIENT AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front bumper cover. 2. Disconnect the ambient air temperature sensor electrical
connector and remove the ambient air temperature sensor. 3. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-8 (behind Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 510
C271
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 511
Blower Motor Switch: Description and Operation
BLOWER MOTOR SWITCH
The blower motor switch is mounted in the EMTC module and controls blower motor speed by
adding or bypassing resistors in the blower motor resistor in all modes except OFF. The blower
motor switch knob is removable and can be separately replaced.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Blower Motor Speed Control
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair Blower Motor Speed Control
BLOWER MOTOR SPEED CONTROL
Removal and Installation
1. Detach the glove compartment damper from the glove compartment. 2. Remove the glove
compartment. 3. Disconnect the blower motor speed control electrical connector. 4. Remove the 2
blower motor speed control screws. 5. Remove the blower motor speed control. 6. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Blower Motor Speed Control > Page 514
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair Blower Motor Switch
BLOWER MOTOR SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the climate control module. 2. Pull to remove the blower motor switch knob.
3. Remove the blower motor switch nut.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Blower Motor Speed Control > Page 515
4. Release the 2 retaining tabs with the index finger on each hand, while depressing the blower
motor switch shaft with the thumbs to remove the
blower motor switch.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 519
C233
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 520
Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
IN-VEHICLE TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the 2 lower steering column opening cover bolts. 2. Detach the lower steering column
opening cover. 3. Disconnect the in-vehicle temperature sensor aspirator hose. 4. Disconnect the
in-vehicle temperature sensor electrical connector. 5. Release the 2 in-vehicle temperature sensor
clips and remove the in-vehicle temperature sensor.
6. NOTE: The in-vehicle temperature sensor hose and venturi assembly can be accessed from
below the driver side of the instrument panel.
Remove the in-vehicle temperature sensor hose and venturi assembly.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-29 (Front HVAC)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 524
C296
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Evaporator Temperature Sensor
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Evaporator Temperature
Sensor
EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The evaporator temperature sensor contains a thermistor which receives a reference voltage from
the dual-zone EATC or EMTC module. The thermistor then varies the resistance to the reference
voltage based on the evaporator fin temperature. The resulting voltage is returned to the dual-zone
EATC or EMTC module where it is interpreted as an evaporator fin temperature reading.
The dual-zone EATC module or EMTC module maintains evaporator core temperature and
prevents icing of the evaporator core. It does this by switching off the A/C request signal to the
instrument cluster when the evaporator temperature sensor reading falls below acceptable levels,
and by switching on the A/C request when the evaporator temperature rises above acceptable
levels.
The evaporator temperature sensor electrical connector is located outside of the heater core and
evaporator core housing near the accelerator pedal, with the sensor pigtail leading into the housing
to the sensor probe which is inserted between the evaporator core fins.
The evaporator temperature sensor is not available as a separate component. To install a new
evaporator temperature sensor, a new heater core and evaporator core housing must be installed.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Evaporator Temperature Sensor > Page 527
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning Evaporator
Temperature (ACET) Sensor
AIR CONDITIONING EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE (ACET) SENSOR
A/C Evaporator Temperature (ACET) Sensor Voltage And Resistance
The ACET sensor measures the evaporator air discharge temperature. The ACET sensor is a
thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of a
thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance increases as the
temperature decreases. The PCM sources a low current 5 volts on the ACET circuit. With SIG RTN
also connected to the ACET sensor, the varying resistance changes the voltage drop across the
sensor terminals. As A/C evaporator air temperature changes, the varying resistance of the ACET
sensor changes the voltage the PCM detects.
The ACET sensor is used to more accurately control A/C clutch cycling, improve defrost/demist
performance, and reduce A/C clutch cycling.
NOTE: These values can vary 15% due to sensor and VREF variations. Voltage values were
calculated for VREF equals 5.0 volts.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch,
HVAC > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch,
HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 531
C1260
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch,
HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > A/C Pressure Transducer
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation A/C Pressure Transducer
A/C PRESSURE TRANSDUCER
The A/C pressure transducer monitors the compressor discharge pressure and communicates with
the PCM. The PCM will interrupt A/C compressor operation in the event that the A/C pressure
transducer indicates high system discharge pressures. It is also used to sense low charge
conditions. If the pressure is below a predetermined value for a given ambient temperature, the
PCM will not allow the clutch to engage. It is not necessary to recover the refrigerant before
removing the A/C pressure transducer.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch,
HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > A/C Pressure Transducer > Page 534
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning (A/C) Cycling
Switch
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) CYCLING SWITCH
The A/C cycling switch may be wired to either the ACCS or ACPSW PCM input. When the A/C
cycling switch opens, the PCM turns off the A/C clutch. For information on the specific function of
the A/C cycling switch, refer to Heating and Air Conditioning, Climate Control System. Also, refer to
the applicable Vehicle/Diagrams for vehicle specific wiring.
If the ACCS signal is not received by the PCM, the PCM circuit will not allow the A/C to operate.
Some applications do not have a dedicated (separate) input to the PCM indicating that A/C is
requested. This information is received by the PCM through the communication link.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch,
HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > A/C Pressure Transducer > Page 535
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning (A/C) High
Pressure Switch
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) HIGH PRESSURE SWITCH
The A/C high pressure switch is used for additional A/C system pressure control. The A/C high
pressure switch is either dual function for multiple speed, relay controlled electric fan applications,
or single function for all others.
For refrigerant containment control, the normally closed high pressure contacts open at a
predetermined A/C pressure. This results in the A/C turning off, preventing the A/C pressure from
rising to a level that would open the A/C high pressure relief valve.
For fan control, the normally open medium pressure contacts close at a predetermined A/C
pressure. This grounds the ACPSW circuit input to the PCM. The PCM then turns on the high
speed fan to help reduce the pressure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch,
HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > A/C Pressure Transducer > Page 536
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning Pressure (ACP)
Transducer Sensor
AIR CONDITIONING PRESSURE (ACP) TRANSDUCER SENSOR
A/C Pressure Transducer Sensor Output Voltage
Typical ACP Transducer Sensor
The ACP transducer sensor is located in the high pressure (discharge) side of the A/C system. The
ACP transducer sensor provides a voltage signal to the PCM that is proportional to the A/C
pressure. The PCM uses this information for A/C clutch control, fan control and idle speed control.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair
INSTRUMENT PANEL DIMMER SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument panel side finish panel.
2. NOTE: The switch is removed by pushing from behind.
Release the tabs and remove the headlamp switch assembly. Disconnect the electrical connectors.
3. Release the 4 tabs and remove the instrument panel dimmer switch. 4. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-25 (Liftgate - Edge)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 544
C479
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-1-7 > Jan > 08 >
Instruments - Inaccurate Fuel Gauge
Fuel Gauge Sender: Customer Interest Instruments - Inaccurate Fuel Gauge
TSB 08-1-7
01/21/08
INACCURATE FUEL GAUGE INDICATOR - VEHICLE BUILT BEFORE 11/1/2007
FORD: 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Edge and MKX vehicles built before 11/1/2007, may experience an
inaccurate low fuel gauge indicator. This condition may be caused by a stuck float arm on the fuel
delivery module. The fuel delivery module float arm could get hung up on the fuel tank baffle plate.
This failure mode will only occur when the fuel tank is at or near empty fuel level. When the fuel
tank is refilled to a full level, the fuel gauge will continue to read a low fuel fill level. For all other fuel
gauge related concerns, refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 413-01.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. To make this repair it will be necessary to remove the fuel pump module from the fuel tank.
Follow WSM, Section 310-01.
2. Once the fuel delivery module is removed from the fuel tank, access the fuel tank baffle through
the fuel tank fuel delivery opening. (Figure 1)
3. Move the baffle plate with a wooden object or by hand towards the front of the vehicle to prevent
interference between the baffle and the float arm. The fuel tank baffle plate is a metal plate that is
easy to move by hand or using a tool with no consequent damage to the baffle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-1-7 > Jan > 08 >
Instruments - Inaccurate Fuel Gauge > Page 553
4. The fuel delivery module float arm should have a clearance of 1 5/32" (29.63 mm) in the empty
tank position (bottom) and 13/16" (20.73 mm) in the full tank position (up). (Figure 2)
5. Install the fuel delivery module following WSM, Section 310-01.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
080107A 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.7 Hrs.
Reposition the Fuel Tank Baffle Plate. Includes Time to Remove Rear Seat and Fuel Delivery
Module. (Do Not Use With 9350E, 63100B,63100B, 9275A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9002 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-1-7 >
Jan > 08 > Instruments - Inaccurate Fuel Gauge
Fuel Gauge Sender: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Inaccurate Fuel Gauge
TSB 08-1-7
01/21/08
INACCURATE FUEL GAUGE INDICATOR - VEHICLE BUILT BEFORE 11/1/2007
FORD: 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Edge and MKX vehicles built before 11/1/2007, may experience an
inaccurate low fuel gauge indicator. This condition may be caused by a stuck float arm on the fuel
delivery module. The fuel delivery module float arm could get hung up on the fuel tank baffle plate.
This failure mode will only occur when the fuel tank is at or near empty fuel level. When the fuel
tank is refilled to a full level, the fuel gauge will continue to read a low fuel fill level. For all other fuel
gauge related concerns, refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 413-01.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. To make this repair it will be necessary to remove the fuel pump module from the fuel tank.
Follow WSM, Section 310-01.
2. Once the fuel delivery module is removed from the fuel tank, access the fuel tank baffle through
the fuel tank fuel delivery opening. (Figure 1)
3. Move the baffle plate with a wooden object or by hand towards the front of the vehicle to prevent
interference between the baffle and the float arm. The fuel tank baffle plate is a metal plate that is
easy to move by hand or using a tool with no consequent damage to the baffle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-1-7 >
Jan > 08 > Instruments - Inaccurate Fuel Gauge > Page 559
4. The fuel delivery module float arm should have a clearance of 1 5/32" (29.63 mm) in the empty
tank position (bottom) and 13/16" (20.73 mm) in the full tank position (up). (Figure 2)
5. Install the fuel delivery module following WSM, Section 310-01.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
080107A 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.7 Hrs.
Reposition the Fuel Tank Baffle Plate. Includes Time to Remove Rear Seat and Fuel Delivery
Module. (Do Not Use With 9350E, 63100B,63100B, 9275A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9002 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 562
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Module
C463
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Module > Page 565
C434
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 566
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation
FUEL PUMP (FP) MODULE
Typical Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 567
Typical Mechanical Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
The FP module is a device that contains the fuel pump and sender assembly. The fuel pump is
located inside the FP module reservoir and supplies fuel through the FP module manifold to the
engine and FP module jet pump. The jet pump continuously refills the reservoir with fuel, and a
check valve located in the manifold outlet maintains system pressure when the fuel pump is not
energized. A flapper valve located in the bottom of the reservoir allows fuel to enter the reservoir
and prime the fuel pump during the initial fill.
FUEL PUMP (FP) MODULE AND RESERVOIR
The FP module is mounted inside the fuel tank in a reservoir. The pump has a discharge check
valve that maintains the system pressure after the key has been turned off to minimize starting
concerns. The reservoir prevents fuel flow interruptions during extreme vehicle maneuvers with low
tank fill levels.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module
FUEL PUMP MODULE
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 570
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 571
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 572
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
repairing or disconnecting any of the fuel system components, the fuel system pressure must be
relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel causing personal injury or a fire hazard.
All vehicles
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 573
1. Release the fuel system pressure. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3. Release the fuel
tank filler cap and position aside.
4. Insert a suitable fuel drain tube into the fuel tank filler pipe until it reaches the fuel tank inlet
spout. 5. Attach the fuel storage tanker to the fuel drain tube and remove any residual fuel
remaining in the fuel tank filler pipe. 6. Remove the rear seat. 7. Position the carpet and/or any
insulation covering the fuel pump (FP) module access cover aside.
8. Remove the 4 screws and the FP module access cover.
9. Disconnect the FP module electrical connector.
10. Disconnect the fuel tank supply tube-to-FP module quick connect coupling.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 574
11. CAUTION: Place absorbent pads on the floor pan in the immediate area in case of fuel spills.
Carefully remove the fuel pump (FP)
module from the vehicle to avoid fuel spillage inside the vehicle.
Using the special tool, remove the FP module lock ring retainer.
All wheel drive (AWD) vehicles
12. CAUTION: The fuel pump (FP) module must be handled carefully to avoid damage to the FP
module and/or float arm.
Carefully lift the FP module out of the fuel tank enough to access and disconnect the fuel tank
crossover tube-to-FP module quick connect coupling.
All vehicles
13. CAUTION: The fuel pump (FP) module will have residual fuel remaining internally, drain into a
suitable container.
Completely remove the FP module from the fuel tank.
14. CAUTION:
- Inspect the mating surfaces of the fuel pump (FP) module flange and the fuel tank O-ring seal
contact surfaces. Do not polish or adjust the O-ring seal contact area of the fuel tank flange or the
fuel tank. Install a new FP module or fuel tank if the O-ring seal contact area is bent, scratched or
corroded.
- Make sure to install a new fuel pump (FP) module O-ring seal. Install a new lock ring if it is bent,
damaged or corroded.
NOTE: To install, apply clean engine oil to the O-ring seal.
Remove the FP module O-ring seal.
15. NOTE: Make sure the alignment tab on the fuel pump (FP) module and the fuel tank meet
before tightening the FP module lock ring.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 575
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Fuel Level Sensor
FUEL LEVEL SENSOR
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 576
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 577
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 578
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- This procedure involves fuel handling. Be prepared for spillage at all times and always observe
fuel handling precautions. Failure to follow these instructions can result in personal injury.
1. Release the fuel system pressure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 579
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3. Release the fuel tank filler cap and position aside.
4. Insert a suitable fuel drain tube into the fuel tank filler pipe until it reaches the fuel tank inlet
spout.
5. CAUTION: The fuel pump (FP) module and fuel level sensor will be below the fuel level in the
tank when the tank is full. Make sure to
drain 1/8 of the fuel capacity through the filler pipe prior to removing the fuel level sensor or fuel
spillage will occur.
Attach the fuel storage tanker to the fuel drain tube and remove any residual fuel remaining in the
fuel tank filler pipe.
6. Remove the rear seat. 7. Position the carpet and/or any insulation covering the fuel level sensor
access cover aside.
8. Remove the 4 screws and the fuel level sensor access cover.
9. Disconnect the fuel level sensor electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 580
10. CAUTION: Place absorbant pads in the general work area in case of fuel spillage.
Release the lock tab, rotate the fuel level sensor counterclockwise approximately 1/4 turn and lift
upward.
11. CAUTION:
- The fuel level sensor must be handled carefully to avoid damage to the float arm.
- Carefully remove the fuel level sensor from the fuel tank to avoid fuel spillage inside the vehicle.
Carefully lift and remove the fuel level sensor from the fuel tank.
12. CAUTION: Inspect the mating surfaces of the fuel level sensor flange and the fuel tank O-ring
seal contact surfaces. Do not polish or
adjust the O-ring seal contact area of the fuel tank flange or the fuel tank. Install a new fuel level
sensor or fuel tank if the O-ring seal contact area is bent, scratched or corroded.
NOTE: To install, apply clean engine oil to the O-ring seal.
- Upon installation, properly seat and press down firmly on the fuel level sensor, rotate it clockwise
until the lock arrow on the sensor aligns with the notch on the tank. Torque should not exceed 15
Nm (11 lb-ft).
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Outside Temperature
Display Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Outside Temperature
Display Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 584
C198
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Left Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 588
C2015
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 589
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Service and Repair
Parking Brake Warning Indicator Switch
Parking Brake Warning Indicator Switch
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the parking brake warning indicator switch electrical connector. 2. Remove the
parking brake warning indicator switch screw and the switch. 3. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-8 (behind Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 594
Ambient Light Sensor: Diagrams
C286
C287
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 595
Ambient Light Sensor: Service and Repair
LIGHT SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Using a suitable tool, remove the light sensor.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
2. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Brake Light Switch: > 07-11-9 > Jun > 07 >
Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging
Brake Light Switch: Customer Interest Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging
TSB 07-11-9
06/11/07
BRAKE DRAG
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some Edge/MKX vehicles may exhibit brake drag from the rear wheels or all wheels.
Customers may notice an odor and/or reduced powertrain performance. In some cases, the driver
may also note an integral vehicle dynamics (IVD) light after driving a given distance due to
pressure noted in the module without a change in brake on/off (BOO) state.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure to resolve brake drag concerns.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Raise the vehicle on a hoist, with engine running, and vehicle in park. Rotate all of the wheels by
hand to verify excessive force is necessary to turn wheels.
^ To resolve the brake drag concern from all wheels - Replacement of the BOO switch is
necessary.
^ To resolve the brake drag concern from the rear wheels only - Adjustment of the park brake
cables are necessary.
BOO Switch Replacement (All Brakes Drag) Removal
1. With the vehicle shut off and in park, remove the stop lamp switch by rotating the stop lamp
switch in the clockwise direction.
2. If the brake pedal moves up during the removal of the switch, the pedal was being inadvertently
held down by the stop lamp switch thus keeping the hydraulic circuits pressurized. Refer to
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 417-01.
3. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the switch and discard the switch.
Installation
NOTE
INSTALLATION OF THE NEW STOP LAMP SWITCH MUST BE DONE WITH THE BRAKE
PEDAL AT ITS NORMALLY INSTALLED AND RESTING POSITION. DO NOT PULL UP OR
PUSH DOWN ON THE BRAKE PEDAL DURING STOP LAMP SWITCH INSTALLATION. REFER
TO WSM, Section 417-01.
1. With the brake pedal at its rest position, insert the new stop lamp switch into the keyed hole on
the brake pedal and rotate the switch 45 degrees counter-clockwise to seat the switch. You may
hear a click sound during this step, this is normal.
2. Plug the wire harness connector to the new stop lamp switch.
3. Verify that the brake lamps are functioning properly and that the brakes are no longer dragging.
Park Cable Adjustment (Rear Brakes Drag)
Brake drag noted on rear wheels only likely caused by over adjusted park brake equalizer
adjustment (or all 3 cable lengths built at the minimum levels).
1. With vehicle on Hoist and shut off, verify rear brake pads are positioned properly per WSM,
Section 206-04: Rear Disc Brake.
2. With a fully released parking brake pedal, back off the adjustment until the wheels spin freely.
NOTE
DISTANCE BETWEEN THE NUT AND END OF THE STUD SHOULD BE 7/8" (22 mm)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Brake Light Switch: > 07-11-9 > Jun > 07 >
Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging > Page 604
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071109A 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.4 Hr.
Diagnose, Replace BOO Switch (Do Not Use With 13480A)
071109B 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.4 Hr.
Diagnose, Adjust Park Brake (Do Not Use With 2780B)
071109C 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.5 Hr.
Diagnose, Replace BOO Switch, And Adjust Park Brake (Do Not Use With 13480A, 2780B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
13480 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 07-11-9 >
Jun > 07 > Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging
Brake Light Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging
TSB 07-11-9
06/11/07
BRAKE DRAG
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some Edge/MKX vehicles may exhibit brake drag from the rear wheels or all wheels.
Customers may notice an odor and/or reduced powertrain performance. In some cases, the driver
may also note an integral vehicle dynamics (IVD) light after driving a given distance due to
pressure noted in the module without a change in brake on/off (BOO) state.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure to resolve brake drag concerns.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Raise the vehicle on a hoist, with engine running, and vehicle in park. Rotate all of the wheels by
hand to verify excessive force is necessary to turn wheels.
^ To resolve the brake drag concern from all wheels - Replacement of the BOO switch is
necessary.
^ To resolve the brake drag concern from the rear wheels only - Adjustment of the park brake
cables are necessary.
BOO Switch Replacement (All Brakes Drag) Removal
1. With the vehicle shut off and in park, remove the stop lamp switch by rotating the stop lamp
switch in the clockwise direction.
2. If the brake pedal moves up during the removal of the switch, the pedal was being inadvertently
held down by the stop lamp switch thus keeping the hydraulic circuits pressurized. Refer to
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 417-01.
3. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the switch and discard the switch.
Installation
NOTE
INSTALLATION OF THE NEW STOP LAMP SWITCH MUST BE DONE WITH THE BRAKE
PEDAL AT ITS NORMALLY INSTALLED AND RESTING POSITION. DO NOT PULL UP OR
PUSH DOWN ON THE BRAKE PEDAL DURING STOP LAMP SWITCH INSTALLATION. REFER
TO WSM, Section 417-01.
1. With the brake pedal at its rest position, insert the new stop lamp switch into the keyed hole on
the brake pedal and rotate the switch 45 degrees counter-clockwise to seat the switch. You may
hear a click sound during this step, this is normal.
2. Plug the wire harness connector to the new stop lamp switch.
3. Verify that the brake lamps are functioning properly and that the brakes are no longer dragging.
Park Cable Adjustment (Rear Brakes Drag)
Brake drag noted on rear wheels only likely caused by over adjusted park brake equalizer
adjustment (or all 3 cable lengths built at the minimum levels).
1. With vehicle on Hoist and shut off, verify rear brake pads are positioned properly per WSM,
Section 206-04: Rear Disc Brake.
2. With a fully released parking brake pedal, back off the adjustment until the wheels spin freely.
NOTE
DISTANCE BETWEEN THE NUT AND END OF THE STUD SHOULD BE 7/8" (22 mm)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 07-11-9 >
Jun > 07 > Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging > Page 610
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071109A 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.4 Hr.
Diagnose, Replace BOO Switch (Do Not Use With 13480A)
071109B 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.4 Hr.
Diagnose, Adjust Park Brake (Do Not Use With 2780B)
071109C 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.5 Hr.
Diagnose, Replace BOO Switch, And Adjust Park Brake (Do Not Use With 13480A, 2780B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
13480 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 611
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 612
C2064
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 613
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal to the
PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 614
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
STOPLAMP SWITCH
Removal
1. Disconnect the stoplamp switch electrical connector.
2. NOTE: The stoplamp switch will be difficult to remove if the switch plunger is not depressed. A
slight rearward force should be adequate to
depress the plunger.
With a light force (approximately 1-4 N [1-3 lb]), pull rearward on the brake pedal, rotate the
stoplamp switch 45 degrees clockwise and remove the stoplamp switch.
Installation
CAUTION: It is very important to not press, pull or touch the brake pedal assembly during the
installation of the stoplamp switch. Failure to follow these instructions may damage the stoplamp
switch.
1. Without movement to the brake pedal assembly, install the stoplamp switch and rotate 45
degrees counterclockwise. 2. Connect the stoplamp switch electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-25 (Liftgate - Edge)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 618
C479
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 622
C2355
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Illumination Dimmer Switch
View 151-8 (behind Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Illumination Dimmer Switch > Page 627
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Multifunction Switch
C202
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Multifunction Switch > Page 630
C2298
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion > Page 633
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion > Page 634
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Testing and Inspection Illumination Dimmer Switch
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion > Page 635
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 636
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Release the upper steering column shroud by pressing inward on the sides of the shroud
and lifting upwards.
Remove the upper steering column shroud.
2. Release the tilt lever, remove the 3 screws and then remove the lower steering column shroud.
3. Disconnect the multi-function switch electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 637
4. Remove the 2 multi-function switch screws and remove the switch. 5. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 641
C205
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 642
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 643
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 644
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
HEADLAMP SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument panel side finish panel.
2. NOTE: The headlamp switch is removed by pushing from behind.
Release the tabs and remove the headlamp switch. Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Left
View 151-10 (Steering Wheel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Left > Page 649
View 151-10 (Steering Wheel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left
C2996
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left > Page 652
C2997
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 656
C202
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 657
Turn Signal Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 658
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 659
Turn Signal Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Release the upper steering column shroud by pressing inward on the sides of the shroud
and lifting upwards.
Remove the upper steering column shroud.
2. Release the tilt lever, remove the 3 screws and then remove the lower steering column shroud.
3. Disconnect the multi-function switch electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 660
4. Remove the 2 multi-function switch screws and remove the switch. 5. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 666
C2040
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 667
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION (APP) SENSOR
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
torque demand. There are 3 pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APPS1, has a negative
slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APPS2 and APPS3, both have a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APPS1 is used as
the indication of pedal position by the strategy. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There are 2 reference voltage circuits and 2
signal return circuits for the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 671
C128
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 672
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Diagram Of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot And Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 673
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. The current required to
maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow. The MAF sensor then
outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air mass. The PCM
calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired air/fuel ratio. This
input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC), shift and torque
converter clutch scheduling.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly. Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology with an integrated intake air
temperature (IAT) sensor. The hot wire electronic sensing element must be replaced as an
assembly. Replacing only the element may change the air flow calibration.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 674
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 2. Remove the 2 screws and
the MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft
Position Sensor 1
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft
Position Sensor 1 > Page 679
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft
Position Sensor
C1366
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft
Position Sensor > Page 682
C1367
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 683
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Typical Synchronizer Hall-Effect CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston
number 1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing
the sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil-on-plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP
signal to select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with 2 CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). They use the
second sensor to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2 as an input to the PCM.
There are 2 types of CMP sensors: the 3-pin connector Hall-effect type sensor and the 2-pin
connector variable reluctance type sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 684
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
RH sensor
1. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe.
LH sensor
2. Remove the air cleaner assembly.
Both sensors
3. Disconnect the camshaft position sensor (CMP) electrical connector. 4. Remove the bolt and the
CMP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
5. NOTE: Lubricate the CMP O-ring seal with clean engine oil.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Clutch Switch, ECM > Component Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION (CPP) SWITCH
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
The CPP switch is an input to the PCM indicating the clutch pedal position. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the CPP circuit. When the CPP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The CPP input to the PCM is used to detect a reduction in engine
load. The PCM uses the load information for mass air flow and fuel calculations.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR
Typical Thread Type ECT Sensor
The ECT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The ECT measures the temperature of the engine coolant. The PCM uses the ECT input for fuel
control and for cooling fan control. There are 3 types of ECT sensors, threaded, push-in, and
twist-lock. The ECT sensor is located in an engine coolant passage.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
694
C101
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
695
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid deceleration between teeth.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
696
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the LH catalytic converter. 3.
Remove the bolt, nut and the heat shield.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
4. Remove the rubber grommet cover. 5. Disconnect the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor
electrical connector. 6. Remove the bolt and the CKP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
700
C107
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
701
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Typical CHT Sensor
The CHT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with the temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as temperature increases., and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
The CHT sensor is installed in the cylinder head and measures the metal temperature. The CHT
sensor can provide complete engine temperature information and can be used to infer coolant
temperature. If the CHT sensor conveys an overheating condition to the PCM, the PCM initiates a
fail-safe cooling strategy based on information from the CHT sensor. A cooling system concern
such as low coolant or coolant loss could cause an overheating condition. As a result, damage to
major engine components could occur. Using both the CHT sensor and fail-safe cooling strategy,
the PCM prevents damage by allowing air cooling of the engine and limp home capability.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
702
Engine Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the lower intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the cylinder head temperature (CHT) sensor
electrical connector. 3. Remove and discard the CHT sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Do not reuse the CHT sensor, install a new sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL LEVEL INPUT (FLI)
The FLI is a communications network message. Most vehicle applications use a potentiometer type
FLI sensor connected to a float in the FP module to determine fuel level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Level Sensor
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Level Sensor
FUEL LEVEL SENSOR
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Level Sensor > Page 708
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Level Sensor > Page 709
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Level Sensor > Page 710
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- This procedure involves fuel handling. Be prepared for spillage at all times and always observe
fuel handling precautions. Failure to follow these instructions can result in personal injury.
1. Release the fuel system pressure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Level Sensor > Page 711
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3. Release the fuel tank filler cap and position aside.
4. Insert a suitable fuel drain tube into the fuel tank filler pipe until it reaches the fuel tank inlet
spout.
5. CAUTION: The fuel pump (FP) module and fuel level sensor will be below the fuel level in the
tank when the tank is full. Make sure to
drain 1/8 of the fuel capacity through the filler pipe prior to removing the fuel level sensor or fuel
spillage will occur.
Attach the fuel storage tanker to the fuel drain tube and remove any residual fuel remaining in the
fuel tank filler pipe.
6. Remove the rear seat. 7. Position the carpet and/or any insulation covering the fuel level sensor
access cover aside.
8. Remove the 4 screws and the fuel level sensor access cover.
9. Disconnect the fuel level sensor electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Level Sensor > Page 712
10. CAUTION: Place absorbant pads in the general work area in case of fuel spillage.
Release the lock tab, rotate the fuel level sensor counterclockwise approximately 1/4 turn and lift
upward.
11. CAUTION:
- The fuel level sensor must be handled carefully to avoid damage to the float arm.
- Carefully remove the fuel level sensor from the fuel tank to avoid fuel spillage inside the vehicle.
Carefully lift and remove the fuel level sensor from the fuel tank.
12. CAUTION: Inspect the mating surfaces of the fuel level sensor flange and the fuel tank O-ring
seal contact surfaces. Do not polish or
adjust the O-ring seal contact area of the fuel tank flange or the fuel tank. Install a new fuel level
sensor or fuel tank if the O-ring seal contact area is bent, scratched or corroded.
NOTE: To install, apply clean engine oil to the O-ring seal.
- Upon installation, properly seat and press down firmly on the fuel level sensor, rotate it clockwise
until the lock arrow on the sensor aligns with the notch on the tank. Torque should not exceed 15
Nm (11 lb-ft).
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Level Sensor > Page 713
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module
FUEL PUMP MODULE
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Level Sensor > Page 714
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Level Sensor > Page 715
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Level Sensor > Page 716
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
repairing or disconnecting any of the fuel system components, the fuel system pressure must be
relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel causing personal injury or a fire hazard.
All vehicles
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Level Sensor > Page 717
1. Release the fuel system pressure. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3. Release the fuel
tank filler cap and position aside.
4. Insert a suitable fuel drain tube into the fuel tank filler pipe until it reaches the fuel tank inlet
spout. 5. Attach the fuel storage tanker to the fuel drain tube and remove any residual fuel
remaining in the fuel tank filler pipe. 6. Remove the rear seat. 7. Position the carpet and/or any
insulation covering the fuel pump (FP) module access cover aside.
8. Remove the 4 screws and the FP module access cover.
9. Disconnect the FP module electrical connector.
10. Disconnect the fuel tank supply tube-to-FP module quick connect coupling.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Level Sensor > Page 718
11. CAUTION: Place absorbent pads on the floor pan in the immediate area in case of fuel spills.
Carefully remove the fuel pump (FP)
module from the vehicle to avoid fuel spillage inside the vehicle.
Using the special tool, remove the FP module lock ring retainer.
All wheel drive (AWD) vehicles
12. CAUTION: The fuel pump (FP) module must be handled carefully to avoid damage to the FP
module and/or float arm.
Carefully lift the FP module out of the fuel tank enough to access and disconnect the fuel tank
crossover tube-to-FP module quick connect coupling.
All vehicles
13. CAUTION: The fuel pump (FP) module will have residual fuel remaining internally, drain into a
suitable container.
Completely remove the FP module from the fuel tank.
14. CAUTION:
- Inspect the mating surfaces of the fuel pump (FP) module flange and the fuel tank O-ring seal
contact surfaces. Do not polish or adjust the O-ring seal contact area of the fuel tank flange or the
fuel tank. Install a new FP module or fuel tank if the O-ring seal contact area is bent, scratched or
corroded.
- Make sure to install a new fuel pump (FP) module O-ring seal. Install a new lock ring if it is bent,
damaged or corroded.
NOTE: To install, apply clean engine oil to the O-ring seal.
Remove the FP module O-ring seal.
15. NOTE: Make sure the alignment tab on the fuel pump (FP) module and the fuel tank meet
before tightening the FP module lock ring.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
722
C435
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
723
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL TANK PRESSURE (FTP) SENSOR
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
In-Line Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
The FTP sensor or in-line FTP sensor is used to measure the fuel tank pressure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
727
C128
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
728
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (IAT) SENSOR
Typical Stand-Alone/Non-Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensors
Typical Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Incorporated Into A Drop-in Or Flange-type
MAF Sensor
The IAT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The electrical
resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance increases
as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the sensor
terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The IAT provides air temperature information to the PCM. The PCM uses the air temperature
information as a correction factor in the calculation of fuel, spark, and air flow.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
729
The IAT sensor provides a quicker temperature change response time than the ECT or CHT
sensor.
Currently there are 2 design types of IAT sensors used, a stand-alone/non-integrated type and a
integrated type. Both types function the same, however the integrated type is incorporated into the
mass air flow (MAF) sensor instead of being a stand alone sensor.
Supercharged vehicles use 2 IAT sensors. Both sensors are thermistor type devices and operate
as described. One is located before the supercharger at the air cleaner for standard OBD/cold
weather input, while a second sensor (IAT2) is located after the supercharger in the intake
manifold. The IAT2 sensor located after the supercharger provides air temperature information to
the PCM to control spark and to help determine charge air cooler (CAC) efficiency.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 733
C109
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 734
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Two Types Of Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 735
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the thermostat housing. 2. Remove the lower intake manifold. 3. Remove the coolant
tube.
- Discard the O-ring.
4. Disconnect the knock sensor (KS) electrical connector. 5. Remove the 2 bolts and the KS.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Lubricate the new O-ring with clean engine coolant.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE (MAP) SENSOR
Typical Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
The MAP sensor measures intake manifold absolute pressure. The PCM uses information from the
MAP sensor to measure how much exhaust gas is introduced into the intake manifold.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM: Description and Operation
ENGINE OIL TEMPERATURE (EOT) SENSOR
Typical EOT Sensor
The EOT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The EOT sensor measures the temperature of the engine oil. The sensor is typically threaded into
the engine oil lubrication system. The PCM can use the EOT sensor input to determine the
following:
- On variable camshaft timing (VCT) applications the EOT input is used to adjust the VCT control
gains and logic for camshaft timing.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input in conjunction with other PCM inputs to determine oil
degradation.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input to initiate a soft engine shutdown. To prevent engine
damage from occurring as a result of high oil temperatures, the PCM has the ability to initiate a soft
engine shutdown. Whenever engine RPM exceeds a calibrated level for a certain period of time,
the PCM begins reducing power by disabling engine cylinders.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 746
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 747
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 748
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22
C141
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 751
C142
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 752
C171
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 753
C172
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 754
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HO2S)
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
The HO2S detects the presence of oxygen in the exhaust and produces a variable voltage
according to the amount of oxygen detected. A high concentration of oxygen (lean air/fuel ratio) in
the exhaust produces a voltage signal less than 0.4 volt. A low concentration of oxygen (rich
air/fuel ratio) produces a voltage signal greater than 0.6 volt. The HO2S provides feedback to the
PCM indicating air/fuel ratio in order to achieve a near stoichiometric air/fuel ratio of 14.7:1 during
closed loop engine operation. The HO2S generates a voltage between 0.0 and 1.1 volts.
Embedded with the sensing element is the HO2S heater. The heating element heats the sensor to
a temperature of 800°C (1,472°F). At approximately 300°C (572°F) the engine can enter closed
loop operation. The VPWR circuit supplies voltage to the heater. The PCM turns the heater on by
providing the ground when the correct conditions occur. The heater allows the engine to enter
closed loop operation sooner. The use of this heater requires the HO2S heater control to be duty
cycled, to prevent damage to the heater.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HO2S)
RH Sensors
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 757
LH Sensors
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
RH sensor
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
Both sensors
2. Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 758
3. NOTE: If necessary, lubricate the sensor threads with penetrating and lock lubricant to assist in
removal.
Using the special tool, remove the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S). To install, tighten to 48 Nm (35 lb-ft).
4. NOTE: Apply a light coat of anti-seize lubricant to the threads of the heated oxygen sensor
(HO2S).
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 759
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Catalyst Monitor Sensor
CATALYST MONITOR SENSOR
RH Sensors
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 760
LH Sensors
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the catalyst monitor sensor
electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 761
3. NOTE: If necessary, lubricate the sensor threads with penetrating and lock lubricant to assist in
removal.
Using the special tool, remove the catalyst monitor sensor. To install, tighten to 48 Nm (35 lb-ft).
4. NOTE: Apply a light coat of anti-seize lubricant to the threads of the catalyst monitor sensor.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 765
C1121
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Switch
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SWITCH
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
The PSP switch monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP switch
is a normally closed switch that opens as the hydraulic pressure increases. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the PSP circuit. When the PSP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The PCM uses the input signal from the PSP switch to compensate
for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the idle RPM and preventing engine stall during
parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP switch signals the PCM to adjust the transmission electronic
pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased engine load, for example during parking
maneuvers
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch > Page 768
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Sensor
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SENSOR
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
The PSP sensor monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP
sensor voltage input to the PCM changes as the hydraulic pressure changes. The PCM uses the
input signal from the PSP sensor to compensate for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the
idle RPM and preventing engine stall during parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP sensor signals the
PCM to adjust the transmission electronic pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased
engine load, for example, during parking maneuvers.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer
that monitors the differential pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly.
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as
the downstream pressure hose (REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI
and REF hose connections are marked on the differential pressure feedback EGR sensor housing
for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger diameter hose). The differential pressure
feedback EGR sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the metering
orifice and supplies it to the PCM as EGR flow rate feedback.
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR TUBE MOUNTED
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 772
The tube mounted differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is identical in operation as the large
plastic differential pressure feedback EGR sensors and uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF
hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE BODY (ETB) POSITION SENSOR
The ETB position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant ETB
position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB position sensor signal (TP1)
has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation the negative slope
ETB position sensor signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of throttle
position. The 2 ETB position sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1
signal has a concern. There is 1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor > Page 777
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Typical TP Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases the corrosion resistance on the
terminals and increases the connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body.
As the TP sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, 4 operating conditions are determined by the PCM
from the TP. The operating conditions are:
- closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration)
- part throttle (includes cruise or moderate acceleration)
- wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on crank)
- throttle angle rate
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 782
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 783
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 784
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 785
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 786
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 787
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 788
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 789
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 790
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 791
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 792
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 793
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 794
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 795
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 796
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 797
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 798
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 799
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 800
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 801
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
12. Disconnect the selector lever cable end from the manual lever.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 802
13. Remove the nut and the manual lever.
14. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
15. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
16. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 803
17. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
18. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
19. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle side cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 804
20. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
21. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
22. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 805
23. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when removing the solenoid body filter.
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
24. Remove the 10 bolts, the TR sensor detent spring and the main control valve body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 806
25. Using a suitable tool, remove and discard the TR sensor locking pin.
26. NOTE: TR sensor removed for clarity.
Make sure that the park pawl actuator rod does not become disengaged from the park pawl and
the abutment by keeping the end of the park pawl actuator rod behind the machined valve body
mating surface of the transaxle case. If the park pawl actuator rod becomes disengaged from the
park pawl and the abutment, transaxle removal and disassembly is required to reinstall the actuator
rod.
27. CAUTION: Make sure that the park pawl actuator rod does not become disengaged from the
park pawl and the abutment or transaxle
removal and disassembly is required to reinstall the actuator rod.
Remove the TR sensor. 1
Slide the TR sensor down until the manual shaft is out of the transaxle case.
2 Rotate the TR sensor detent plate counterclockwise, as viewed from below until the plate rests
against the transaxle case, remove the park
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 807
pawl actuating rod from the TR sensor and remove the TR sensor.
Installation
1. Install the TR sensor.
1 Position the park pawl actuating rod in the TR sensor.
2 Install the TR sensor in the transaxle case.
2. Using the special tool, install a new TR sensor locking pin.
3. NOTE: Make sure that the manual lever pin (part of the TR sensor) is correctly installed in the
manual valve.
Position the TSS, OSS and TR sensor wiring harnesses aside and install the main control valve
body, the TR sensor detent spring and the 10 bolts. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown. ^
Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 808
4. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
5. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4
95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 809
6. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
7. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 810
8. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
9. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
10. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
11. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on
the inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 811
12. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
13. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 812
14. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
15. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
16. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
17. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 813
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
18. Install the manual lever and the nut.
^ Tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs).
19. Connect the selector lever cable end to the manual lever.
20. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
21. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 814
22. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
23. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
24. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
25. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 815
26. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
27. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
28. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
OUTPUT SHAFT SPEED (OSS) SENSOR
The OSS sensor provides the PCM with information about the rotational speed of an output shaft.
The PCM uses the information to control and diagnose powertrain behavior. In some applications,
the sensor is also used as the source of vehicle speed. The sensor may be physically located in
different places on the vehicle, depending upon the specific application. The design of each speed
sensor is unique and depends on which powertrain control feature uses the information that is
generated.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor > Page 820
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR (VSS)
Typical Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
The VSS is a variable reluctance or hall-effect sensor that generates a waveform with a frequency
that is proportional to the speed of the vehicle. If the vehicle is moving at a relatively low velocity,
the sensor produces a signal with a low frequency. As the vehicle velocity increases, the sensor
generates a signal with a higher frequency. The PCM uses the frequency signal generated by the
VSS (and other inputs) to control such parameters as fuel injection, ignition control,
transmission/transaxle shift scheduling, and torque converter clutch scheduling.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer
that monitors the differential pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly.
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as
the downstream pressure hose (REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI
and REF hose connections are marked on the differential pressure feedback EGR sensor housing
for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger diameter hose). The differential pressure
feedback EGR sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the metering
orifice and supplies it to the PCM as EGR flow rate feedback.
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR TUBE MOUNTED
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 825
The tube mounted differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is identical in operation as the large
plastic differential pressure feedback EGR sensors and uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF
hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 830
C2040
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 831
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION (APP) SENSOR
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
torque demand. There are 3 pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APPS1, has a negative
slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APPS2 and APPS3, both have a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APPS1 is used as
the indication of pedal position by the strategy. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There are 2 reference voltage circuits and 2
signal return circuits for the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 835
C128
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 836
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Diagram Of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot And Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 837
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. The current required to
maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow. The MAF sensor then
outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air mass. The PCM
calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired air/fuel ratio. This
input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC), shift and torque
converter clutch scheduling.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly. Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology with an integrated intake air
temperature (IAT) sensor. The hot wire electronic sensing element must be replaced as an
assembly. Replacing only the element may change the air flow calibration.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 838
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 2. Remove the 2 screws and
the MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE (FRP) SENSOR
Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
The FRP sensor is a diaphragm strain gauge device in which resistance changes with pressure.
The electrical resistance of a strain gauge increases as pressure increases, and the resistance
decreases as the pressure decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the
sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to pressure.
Strain gauge type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The FRP sensor measures the pressure of the fuel near the fuel injectors. This signal is used by
the PCM to adjust the fuel injector pulse width and meter fuel to each engine combustion cylinder.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor > Page 843
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT)
Sensor
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail.
The temperature sensing portion of the FRPT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance
changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor decreases as the temperature
increases, and the resistance increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance
changes the voltage drop across the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM
corresponding to temperature.
Both the pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the fuel pump. The
speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid state. The
dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which allows the
injector pulse width to decrease.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Fuel Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail.
The temperature sensing portion of the FRPT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance
changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor decreases as the temperature
increases, and the resistance increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance
changes the voltage drop across the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM
corresponding to temperature.
Both the pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the fuel pump. The
speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid state. The
dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which allows the
injector pulse width to decrease.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 850
C4168
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 851
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Description and Operation
INERTIA FUEL SHUTOFF (IFS) SWITCH
Typical Inertia Fuel Shutoff (IFS) Switch
The IFS switch is used in conjunction with the electric fuel pump. The purpose of the IFS switch is
to shutoff the fuel pump if a collision occurs. It consists of a steel ball held in place by a magnet.
When a sharp impact occurs, the ball breaks loose from the magnet, rolls up a conical ramp and
strikes a target plate which opens the electrical contacts of the switch and shuts off the electric fuel
pump. Once the switch is open, it must be manually reset before restarting the vehicle. Refer to the
Owner's Literature for the location of the IFS.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 852
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Service and Repair
INERTIA FUEL SHUTOFF (IFS) SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the LH rear quarter trim panel. 2. Disconnect the inertia fuel shutoff (IFS) switch
electrical connector. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the IFS switch.
- To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE BODY (ETB) POSITION SENSOR
The ETB position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant ETB
position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB position sensor signal (TP1)
has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation the negative slope
ETB position sensor signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of throttle
position. The 2 ETB position sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1
signal has a concern. There is 1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor > Page 857
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Typical TP Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases the corrosion resistance on the
terminals and increases the connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body.
As the TP sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, 4 operating conditions are determined by the PCM
from the TP. The operating conditions are:
- closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration)
- part throttle (includes cruise or moderate acceleration)
- wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on crank)
- throttle angle rate
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor
1
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor
1 > Page 863
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor
C1366
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor
> Page 866
C1367
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 867
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Typical Synchronizer Hall-Effect CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston
number 1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing
the sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil-on-plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP
signal to select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with 2 CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). They use the
second sensor to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2 as an input to the PCM.
There are 2 types of CMP sensors: the 3-pin connector Hall-effect type sensor and the 2-pin
connector variable reluctance type sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 868
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
RH sensor
1. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe.
LH sensor
2. Remove the air cleaner assembly.
Both sensors
3. Disconnect the camshaft position sensor (CMP) electrical connector. 4. Remove the bolt and the
CMP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
5. NOTE: Lubricate the CMP O-ring seal with clean engine oil.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 872
C101
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 873
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid deceleration between teeth.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 874
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the LH catalytic converter. 3.
Remove the bolt, nut and the heat shield.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
4. Remove the rubber grommet cover. 5. Disconnect the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor
electrical connector. 6. Remove the bolt and the CKP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
IGNITION LOCK CYLINDER
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the passive anti-theft system (PATS) transceiver. 2. Turn the ignition key to the ON
position. 3. Using a suitable tool, press the ignition lock cylinder release button and remove the
ignition lock cylinder. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 882
C109
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 883
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Two Types Of Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 884
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the thermostat housing. 2. Remove the lower intake manifold. 3. Remove the coolant
tube.
- Discard the O-ring.
4. Disconnect the knock sensor (KS) electrical connector. 5. Remove the 2 bolts and the KS.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Lubricate the new O-ring with clean engine coolant.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 889
C2355
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Front Impact Sensor
Impact Sensor: Locations Front Impact Sensor
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Front Impact Sensor > Page 894
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Front Impact Sensor > Page 895
Impact Sensor: Locations Side Impact Sensor
View 151-12 (Left Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Front Impact Sensor > Page 896
View 151-13 (Right Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Front Impact Sensor > Page 897
View 151-15 (Right Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Front Impact Sensor > Page 898
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Front Impact Sensor
Impact Sensor: Diagrams Front Impact Sensor
C1465
C1466
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Front Impact Sensor > Page 901
Impact Sensor: Diagrams Side Impact Sensor
C3209
C3211
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Front Impact Sensor > Page 902
C3248
C3249
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Front Impact Severity Sensor
FRONT IMPACT SEVERITY SENSOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting
bracket and wiring pigtail for deformation. Install and correctly position the sensor or any other
damaged SRS components whether or not the air bag is deployed. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in serious personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
1. Depower the system. 2. Remove the front bumper cover. 3. Disconnect the front impact severity
sensor electrical connector.
4. WARNING: The tightening torque of the front impact severity sensor retaining nuts is critical for
correct system operation. Failure to
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 905
follow tightening instructions may result in serious personal injury.
NOTE: Make sure the hood latch bracket and front impact severity sensor mating surfaces are clean and
free of foreign material.
- Note position of the 2 locator tabs on sensor for installation.
Remove the bolt and the front impact severity sensor. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 6. Repower the system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 906
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Side Impact Sensor - B-Pillar
SIDE IMPACT SENSOR - B-PILLAR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting
bracket and wiring pigtail for deformation. Install and correctly position the sensor or any other
damaged supplemental restraint system (SRS) components whether or not the air bag is deployed.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
1. Position the front seat forward.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 907
2. Depower the system. 3. Remove the front door scuff plate.
- Pull up to release the 5 retaining clips.
4. Remove the rear door scuff plate.
- Pull up to release the 2 retaining clips.
5. Detach the 2 retainers and remove the lower B-Pillar trim panel. 6. Disconnect the side impact
sensor electrical connector.
7. WARNING: The tightening torque of the air bag side impact sensor retaining bolt is critical for
correct system operation. Failure to
follow tightening instruction may result in serious personal injury.
NOTE: Make sure the B-pillar and side impact sensor mating surfaces are clean and free of foreign
material.
- Note the position of the side impact sensor locating tabs for installation.
Remove the bolt and the side impact sensor. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 9. Repower the system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 908
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Side Impact Sensor - C-Pillar
SIDE IMPACT SENSOR - C-PILLAR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting
bracket and wiring pigtail for deformation. Install and correctly position the sensor or any other
damaged supplemental restraint system (SRS) components whether or not the air bag is deployed.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a SRS fault.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
1. Fold down the rear seat backrest. 2. Depower the system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 909
3. Position aside the quarter trim panel.
- Pull out on the quarter trim panel at the C-pillar to release the retaining clip to access the C-pillar
side impact sensor.
4. Disconnect the side impact sensor electrical connector.
5. WARNING: The tightening torque of the air bag side impact sensor retaining bolt is critical for
correct system operation. Failure to
follow tightening instructions may result in serious personal injury.
NOTE: Note the position of the 2 side impact sensor locating tabs for installation.
- Make sure the C-pillar and side impact sensor mating surfaces are clean and free of foreign
material.
Remove the bolt and the side impact sensor. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 7. Repower the system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Passenger
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Passenger > Page 914
View 151-18 (Driver Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Driver
C3065
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Driver > Page 917
C3066
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS)1
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS)1 > Page 922
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS)1 > Page 923
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS)1 > Page 924
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) 1
C3324
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) 1 > Page 927
C3325
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) 1 > Page 928
C3330
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) 1 > Page 929
C3331
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 930
Seat Occupant Sensor: Description and Operation
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SENSOR (OCS) SYSTEM
The occupant classification sensor (OCS) system is standard equipment on all front passenger
seats. For diagnosing or servicing the OCS system, refer to Air Bag Systems.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track
Seat Occupant Sensor: Service and Repair Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SENSOR - MANUAL SEAT TRACK
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
CAUTION: Use care when handling the seat and track assembly. Dropping the assembly or sitting
on a seat not secured in the vehicle may result in damaged components.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
All occupant classification sensor (OCS) weight sensor bolt(s) 1. Position the seat to access all the
seat track-to-floor bolts and the safety belt anchor. 2. Depower the Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS). 3. Remove the front passenger seat. 4. Remove the manual seat track.
5. NOTE: After marking the seat track rails, do not change the position of the seat track.
Mark the position of both seat track rails.
Inboard OCS weight sensor bolt(s)
6. Remove the nut and the safety belt buckle pretensioner.
All OCS weight sensor bolt(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 933
7. NOTE: Outboard front cross brace screws shown, inboard similar.
On the side with the affected OCS I-bolt(s), remove the 2 front cross brace screws.
8. On the side with the affected OCS weight sensor bolt(s), disengage the seat adjuster handle
spring and position it aside.
9. Separate the seat adjuster handle from the affected side of the seat track rail with the OCS
weight sensor bolt(s).
10. NOTE: Outboard rear cross brace screws shown, inboard similar.
On the side with the affected OCS weight sensor bolt(s), remove the 2 rear cross brace screws.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 934
11. Remove and discard the 2 OCS weight sensor bolt nuts from the affected side of the seat track
rail with the OCS weight sensor bolt(s).
12. Remove the side plate with the OCS weight sensor bolt(s) from the seat track rail.
13. CAUTION: Do not overtighten the side plate with the occupant classification sensor (OCS)
weight sensor bolts to the bench or table.
Tighten only enough to compress the spring washer. Overtightening may damage the side plate or
OCS weight sensor bolts.
Using a suitable tool, clamp the side plate to a bench or table to compress the spring washer on
the affected OCS weight sensor bolt as shown.
14. NOTE: Note the position of the OCS weight sensor bolt, spring washer and retaining clip for
installation.
Remove and discard the retaining clip from the affected OCS weight sensor bolt.
15. Release the clamp and remove the OCS weight sensor bolt and spring washer from the side
plate. sensor bolt and spring washer from the side
plate.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 935
Installation
All OCS weight sensor bolt(s)
1. CAUTION: Do not overtighten the side plate with the occupant classification sensor (OCS)
weight sensor bolts to the bench or table.
Tighten only enough to compress the spring washer. Overtightening may damage the side plate or
OCS weight sensor bolts.
Position the spring washer and OCS weight sensor bolt in the side plate. Then clamp the side plate
to a bench or table to compress the OCS weight sensor bolt spring washer.
2. NOTE: Make sure the occupant classification sensor (OCS) weight sensor bolt retaining clip is
seated fully in the OCS weight sensor bolt groove
underneath the OCS weight sensor O-ring seal.
Install the 2 new OCS weight sensor bolt retaining clips in the OCS weight sensor groove
underneath the O-ring seal.
3. Unclamp the side plate with the installed OCS weight sensor bolt from the bench or table.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 936
4. NOTE: Slight rotational adjustment of the OCS weight sensors bolts may be necessary to install
the OCS weight sensor bolts and side plate to the
seat track rail.
Install the side plate and OCS weight sensor bolts to the seat track rail.
5. NOTE: When installing the side plate to the seat track rail, 2 new OCS weight sensor nuts must
be installed.
Install the 2 new OCS weight sensor bolt nuts to the seat track rail. Tighten to 33 Nm (24 lb-ft).
6. Install the seat adjuster handle to the seat track rail.
7. Engage the seat adjuster handle spring.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 937
8. Install the 2 rear cross brace screws.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
9. Install the 2 front cross brace screws.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
Inboard OCS weight sensor bolt(s)
10. Install the nut and the safety belt buckle pretensioner.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
All OCS weight sensor bolt(s) 11. Install the manual seat track. 12. Install the passenger seat and
repower the supplemental restraints system (SRS). Do not prove out the SRS at this time. 13.
Carry out the appropriate procedure after installation of an OCS system component.
- If installing the original OCS system component, carry out the Zero Seat Weight Test and prove
out the SRS. See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests
and General Diagnostics
- If installing a new OCS system component, carry out the System Reset procedure and prove out
the SRS. See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag Systems/Service and Repair/Occupant Classification
Sensor (OCS) System Reset
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 938
Seat Occupant Sensor: Service and Repair Occupant Classification Sensor - Power Seat Track
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SENSOR - POWER SEAT TRACK
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 939
Part 2
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
CAUTION: Use care when handling the seat and track assembly. Dropping the assembly or sitting
on a seat not secured in the vehicle may result in damaged components.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- If any occupant classification sensor (OCS) weight sensor bolt nuts are removed, new OCS
weight sensor bolt nuts must be installed.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
All occupant classification sensor (OCS) weight sensor bolt(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 940
1. Position the seat to access all the seat track-to-floor bolts and the safety belt anchor. 2. Depower
the supplemental restraint system (SRS). 3. Remove the passenger front seat. 4. Remove the
power seat track.
5. NOTE:
- Inboard seat track rail shown, outboard similar.
- After marking the seat track rails, do not change the position of the seat track.
Mark the position of both seat track rails.
Inboard OCS weight sensor bolt(s) 6. Remove the nut and the safety belt buckle pretensioner.
Outboard OCS weight sensor bolt(s) 7. Remove the front retainer and the outboard seat track riser
cover shield. 8. Remove the 2 retainers and the OCS weight sensor bolt protection bracket.
All OCS weight sensor bolt(s) 9. On the side with the affected OCS weight sensor bolt(s), remove
the nut from the seat track front cross brace.
10. Remove and discard the 2 OCS weight sensor bolt nuts from the affected side of the seat track
rail with the OCS weight sensor(s).
11. NOTE: Outboard side shown, inboard similar.
Separate the front seat track motor cable from the affected seat track rail. Then remove the side
plate with the OCS weight sensor bolts from the seat track rail.
12. CAUTION: Do not overtighten the side plate with the OCS weight sensor bolts to the bench or
table. Tighten only enough to compress
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 941
the spring washer. Overtightening may damage the side plate or OCS weight sensor bolts.
Using a suitable tool, clamp the side plate to a bench or table to compress the spring washer on
the affected OCS weight sensor bolt as shown.
13. NOTE: Note the position of the OCS weight sensor bolt, spring washer and retaining clip for
installation.
Remove and discard the retaining clip from the affected OCS weight sensor bolt.
14. Release the clamp and remove the OCS weight sensor bolt and spring washer from the side
plate.
Installation
All OCS weight sensor bolt(s)
1. CAUTION: Do not overtighten the side plate with the occupant classification sensor (OCS)
weight sensor bolts to the bench or table.
Tighten only enough to compress the spring washer. Overtightening may damage the side plate or
OCS weight sensor bolts.
Position the spring washer and OCS weight sensor bolt in the side plate. Then clamp the side plate
to a bench or table to compress the OCS weight sensor bolt spring washer.
2. NOTE: Make sure the OCS weight sensor bolt retaining clip is seated fully in the OCS weight
sensor bolt groove underneath the OCS weight
sensor O-ring seal.
Install the OCS weight sensor bolt retaining clip.
3. Remove the clamp and the side plate from the bench or table.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 942
4. NOTE: Slight rotational adjustment of the front seat track motor cable and OCS weight sensor
bolts may be necessary to install the OCS weight
sensor bolts and side plate to the seat track rail.
Install the front seat track motor cable to the seat track rail. Then install the side plate with the OCS
weight sensor bolts to the seat track rail.
5. NOTE: When installing the side plate to the seat track rail, 2 new OCS weight sensor nuts must
be installed.
Install the 2 new OCS weight sensor bolt nuts to the seat track rail. Tighten to 33 Nm (24 lb-ft).
6. NOTE: Outboard side shown, inboard similar.
Install the nut to the seat track front cross brace. Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
Outboard OCS weight sensor bolt(s) 7. Install the 2 retainers and the OCS weight sensor bolt
protection bracket. 8. Install the front retainer and the outboard seat track riser cover shield.
Inboard OCS weight sensor bolt(s) 9. Install the nut and the safety belt buckle pretensioner.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
All OCS weight sensor bolt(s) 10. Install the power seat track. 11. Install the passenger seat and
repower the supplemental restraints system (SRS). Do not prove out the SRS at this time. 12.
Carry out the appropriate procedure after installation of an OCS system component.
- If installing the original OCS system component, carry out the Zero Seat Weight Test and prove
out the SRS. See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests
and General Diagnostics
- If installing a new OCS system component, carry out the System Reset procedure and prove out
the SRS. See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag Systems/Service and Repair/Occupant Classification
Sensor (OCS) System Reset
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Seat Position Sensor: Service and Repair
SEAT POSITION SENSOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
All seats
1. Raise the driver seat and then position it to the middle of the track. 2. Depower the system. 3.
Remove the driver seat. 4. Disconnect the seat position sensor electrical connector.
Power seats
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 946
5. Detach the wire harness routing pin-type retainer from the seat position sensor bracket.
All seats
6. Push apart then inward to release the seat position sensor locking clip. 7. Slide the seat position
sensor rearward to release the 2 hooks from the bracket. Then remove the seat position sensor. 8.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. 9. Repower the system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-18 (Driver Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 950
C356
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
IGNITION LOCK CYLINDER
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the passive anti-theft system (PATS) transceiver. 2. Turn the ignition key to the ON
position. 3. Using a suitable tool, press the ignition lock cylinder release button and remove the
ignition lock cylinder. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 961
C1121
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Power
Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Switch
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SWITCH
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
The PSP switch monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP switch
is a normally closed switch that opens as the hydraulic pressure increases. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the PSP circuit. When the PSP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The PCM uses the input signal from the PSP switch to compensate
for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the idle RPM and preventing engine stall during
parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP switch signals the PCM to adjust the transmission electronic
pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased engine load, for example during parking
maneuvers
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Power
Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch > Page 964
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Sensor
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SENSOR
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
The PSP sensor monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP
sensor voltage input to the PCM changes as the hydraulic pressure changes. The PCM uses the
input signal from the PSP sensor to compensate for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the
idle RPM and preventing engine stall during parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP sensor signals the
PCM to adjust the transmission electronic pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased
engine load, for example, during parking maneuvers.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 968
C222
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 973
C222
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training
Special Tool(s)
NOTE: If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, the sensors will go into a "sleep
mode" to conserve battery power. It will be necessary to wake them up so they will transmit the
latest tire pressure information to the Smart Junction Box (SJB).
NOTE: The tire pressure sensor training procedure must be done on a single vehicle, in an area
without radio frequency noise and at least 1 m (3 ft) away from other vehicles equipped with a Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS).
Radio frequency noise is generated by electrical motors and appliance operation, cellular
telephones, remote transmitters, power inverters and portable entertainment equipment.
NOTE: If a sensor does not respond to the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool, attempt to
activate the same sensor with the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. If the sensor still does not
respond, move the vehicle to rotate the wheels at least one-fourth of a turn and attempt to activate
the same sensor again.
NOTE: The SJB has a 2-minute time limit between sensor responses. If the SJB does not
recognize any 1 of the 4 tire pressure sensors during this time limit, the horn will sound twice and
the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE NOT TRAINED REPEAT and the entire
procedure must be repeated.
NOTE: For vehicles with different front and rear tire pressures (such as the E-Series and certain
F-Series), the tire pressure sensors must be trained following a tire rotation. Failure to train the
sensors will cause the TPMS indicator to illuminate. For vehicles with the same tire pressure for
front and rear tires, tire rotation will not affect the system.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position, then press and release the brake pedal. 2. Cycle the
ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position. 3.
Press and release the brake pedal. 4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position. 5. Turn the
ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position.
- The horn will sound once and the TPMS indicator will flash if the training mode has been entered
successfully. If equipped, the message center will display TRAIN LF TIRE.
NOTE: It may take up to 6 seconds to activate a tire pressure sensor. During this time, the Tire
Pressure Monitor Activation Tool must remain in place 180 degrees from the valve stem.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 978
6. Place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the LF tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees)
from the valve stem. Press and release the test
button on the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. The horn will sound briefly to indicate that the
tire pressure sensor has been recognized by the SJB.
7. Within 2 minutes of the horn sounding, place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the RF
tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees) from the
valve stem and press and release the test button to train the RF tire pressure sensor.
NOTE: Do not wait more than 2 minutes between training each sensor or the SJB will time out and
the entire procedure must be repeated.
8. Repeat Step 7 for the RR and LR tires.
The procedure is completed after the last tire has been trained. When the training procedure is
complete, the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE TRAINING COMPLETE. For vehicles
not equipped with a message center, successful completion of the training procedure will be
verified by turning the ignition switch to the OFF position without the horn sounding. If the horn
sounds twice when the switch is turned to the OFF position, the training procedure was not
successful.
9. Using the scan tool, locate the updated TPMS sensor identifiers trained to the SJB and
document them on the applicable warranty claim.
NOTE: This step is required to clear DTC C2780, cause the SJB to exit the manufacturing mode
and to make sure there are no other concerns with a newly programmed SJB.
10. If the sensors are being trained due to the installation of a new SJB, clear any DTCs and carry
out the SJB On-Demand Self Test.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Disassembly
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application.
When installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color
of the sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor can be removed and installed without removing the strap or the cradle.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
1. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Dismount the tire only as
instructed.
Remove the tire from the wheel.
2. CAUTION: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to
the sensor locking clip can occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the sensor locking clip.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 981
3. CAUTION: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to
the sensor can occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver or similar tool, detach the sensor from the cradle.
4. Remove the sensor.
Assembly
1. CAUTION: Damage to the sensor can occur if excessive force is applied during sensor
installation.
NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the cradle. The sensor will make a "click" noise
when correctly seated.
Position the sensor into the cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end of the
cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. NOTE: The locking clip can only be fully seated when installed in the correct orientation. If the
sensor locking clip cannot be fully inserted, then
the sensor may not be fully seated on the cradle or the locking clip may be inserted backward.
Insert a new locking clip into the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 982
3. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel.
4. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 983
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and
Cradle
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and Cradle
Material
Disassembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 984
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application.
When installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color
of the sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor is available separately, the cradle and strap are available as a strap kit. There
are several different strap kits available based on wheel diameter but all strap kits share the same
base part number.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
1. Remove the tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor.
2. WARNING: The TPMS band is under tension. Always use safety goggles or a face shield and
gloves when removing the TPMS
band/strap. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
Remove a factory installed strap in this sequence: 1
Locate the strap buckle and secure the strap to the wheel using duct tape or a similar item, on both
sides of the buckle approximately 25 mm (0.98 inch) from the buckle.
2 Using a large screwdriver and a twisting motion, unbuckle the strap.
3 Discard the strap.
3. To remove a dealer installed strap, turn the worm gear screw until the strap is fully released from
the worm gear.
^ Discard the strap.
4. NOTE: To aid assembly, mark the location of the cradle prior to disassembly.
Using a screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the cradle by inserting the screwdriver under the cradle
and prying up.
Assembly
1. NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the new cradle. The sensor will make a "click"
noise when fully seated.
Position the sensor into the new cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end
of the cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. CAUTION: Metal scrapers can damage the wheel. Use only plastic or non-metallic scrapers to
remove the cradle adhesive strip residue.
NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be installed in the drop well of the wheel, 180 degrees from the
valve stem.
Clean the area where the sensor and cradle are to be installed.
3. NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be positioned with the hinge side of the sensor on the RH
side when viewed from the curb side (beauty side)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 985
of the wheel.
NOTE: The sensor has raised markings indicating how to position the sensor.
Remove the adhesive tape liner from the cradle and position the sensor and cradle into the wheel
drop well 180 degrees from the valve stem.
4. Install the tapered end of the strap through the opening of the cradle on the hinge side of the
sensor. This will position the worm gear on the
locking clip side of the sensor.
5. CAUTION: Steel wheels have a "high spot" along their circumference. Make sure the strap is
positioned in the lowest spot possible for
correct sensor and cradle retention.
NOTE: Keep the strap parallel with the wheel flange while tightening the worm gear.
Position the worm gear 13-26 mm (0.5-1.0 inch) away from the sensor and tighten the worm gear.
^
Tighten to 3 Nm (27 inch lbs).
6. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel.
7. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
992
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
993
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
994
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
995
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
996
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
997
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
998
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
999
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
1000
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
1001
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
1002
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
1003
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
1004
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
1005
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
1006
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
1007
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
1008
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1009
Brake Switch - TCC: Description and Operation
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal to the
PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Overdrive Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1014
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1015
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1016
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1017
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1018
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1019
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1020
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1021
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1022
Overdrive Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1023
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1024
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1025
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1026
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1027
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1028
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1029
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1030
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1035
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1036
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1037
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1038
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1039
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1040
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1041
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1042
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1043
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1044
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1045
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1046
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1047
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1048
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1049
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1050
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1051
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1056
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1057
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1058
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1059
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1060
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1061
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1062
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1063
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1064
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1065
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1066
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1067
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1068
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1069
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1070
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1071
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1072
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1073
Transmission Mode Switch: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL SWITCH (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
The TCS signals the PCM with VPWR whenever the TCS is pressed. On vehicles with this feature,
the transmission control indicator lamp (TCIL) illuminates when the TCS is cycled to disengage
overdrive.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1078
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1079
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1080
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1081
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1082
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1083
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1084
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1085
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1086
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1087
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1088
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1089
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1090
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1091
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1092
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1093
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1094
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1095
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1096
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1097
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
12. Disconnect the selector lever cable end from the manual lever.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1098
13. Remove the nut and the manual lever.
14. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
15. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
16. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1099
17. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
18. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
19. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle side cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1100
20. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
21. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
22. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1101
23. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when removing the solenoid body filter.
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
24. Remove the 10 bolts, the TR sensor detent spring and the main control valve body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1102
25. Using a suitable tool, remove and discard the TR sensor locking pin.
26. NOTE: TR sensor removed for clarity.
Make sure that the park pawl actuator rod does not become disengaged from the park pawl and
the abutment by keeping the end of the park pawl actuator rod behind the machined valve body
mating surface of the transaxle case. If the park pawl actuator rod becomes disengaged from the
park pawl and the abutment, transaxle removal and disassembly is required to reinstall the actuator
rod.
27. CAUTION: Make sure that the park pawl actuator rod does not become disengaged from the
park pawl and the abutment or transaxle
removal and disassembly is required to reinstall the actuator rod.
Remove the TR sensor. 1
Slide the TR sensor down until the manual shaft is out of the transaxle case.
2 Rotate the TR sensor detent plate counterclockwise, as viewed from below until the plate rests
against the transaxle case, remove the park
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1103
pawl actuating rod from the TR sensor and remove the TR sensor.
Installation
1. Install the TR sensor.
1 Position the park pawl actuating rod in the TR sensor.
2 Install the TR sensor in the transaxle case.
2. Using the special tool, install a new TR sensor locking pin.
3. NOTE: Make sure that the manual lever pin (part of the TR sensor) is correctly installed in the
manual valve.
Position the TSS, OSS and TR sensor wiring harnesses aside and install the main control valve
body, the TR sensor detent spring and the 10 bolts. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown. ^
Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1104
4. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
5. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4
95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1105
6. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
7. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1106
8. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
9. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
10. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
11. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on
the inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1107
12. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
13. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1108
14. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
15. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
16. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
17. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1109
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
18. Install the manual lever and the nut.
^ Tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs).
19. Connect the selector lever cable end to the manual lever.
20. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
21. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1110
22. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
23. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
24. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
25. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1111
26. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
27. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
28. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's
Transmission Speed Sensor: Customer Interest A/T - Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's
TSB 07-21-11
10/29/07
6F50 TRANSAXLES BUILT PRIOR TO 10/21/2007 - DTC P0715, P0717, P0718, P0720, P0721,
P0722 AND/OR HARSH ENGAGEMENT, NO UPSHIFT, FIFTH GEAR ONLY
FORD: 2008 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2008Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
MERCURY: 2008 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 07-3-11 to update the transaxle built date coverage and Part List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Edge and MKX, 2008 Taurus Taurus X, and Sable vehicles equipped with
a 6F50 transaxle with a build date prior to 10/21/2007, with any Output Shaft Speed (OSS) sensor
or Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) sensor diagnostic trouble code(s) (DTCs) P0715, P0717, P0718,
P0720, P0721, P0722 and/or harsh engagements, no upshift, fifth gear only, could have an
intermittent short in the OSS or TSS sensor.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. If any DTCs related to OSS or TSS are present, check the transaxle build date following
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
a. If the build date is before 10/21/2007 go to Step 2.
b. If vehicle transaxle is built on or after 10/21/2007 do not continue with this TSB and follow
normal WSM, Section 307-01 Automatic Transaxle/Transmission-6F50 Diagnosis and Testing.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's > Page 1120
2. To repair an OSS or TSS DTC refer to WSM, Section 307-01, follow pin point test (PPT) C. The
TSS sensor is located in the end cover assembly (Figure 1). The OSS sensor is located inside the
transaxle under the main Control (Figure 2). Both sensor connectors are plugged into the solenoid
body. Both sensor connectors look the same but are wired differently (Figure 3).
3. If you work through PPT C and get to Step C9 before finding the cause of the concern, replace
the sensor (DO NOT REPLACE THE POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) AT THIS TIME).
Reassemble as needed and verify the concern is fixed.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT:
Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits are
determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's > Page 1121
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT072111 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING BASIC PART NO.
CONDITION
7M101 CODE
42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's
Transmission Speed Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Harsh Engagement/No
Shift/Multiple DTC's
TSB 07-21-11
10/29/07
6F50 TRANSAXLES BUILT PRIOR TO 10/21/2007 - DTC P0715, P0717, P0718, P0720, P0721,
P0722 AND/OR HARSH ENGAGEMENT, NO UPSHIFT, FIFTH GEAR ONLY
FORD: 2008 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2008Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
MERCURY: 2008 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 07-3-11 to update the transaxle built date coverage and Part List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Edge and MKX, 2008 Taurus Taurus X, and Sable vehicles equipped with
a 6F50 transaxle with a build date prior to 10/21/2007, with any Output Shaft Speed (OSS) sensor
or Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) sensor diagnostic trouble code(s) (DTCs) P0715, P0717, P0718,
P0720, P0721, P0722 and/or harsh engagements, no upshift, fifth gear only, could have an
intermittent short in the OSS or TSS sensor.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. If any DTCs related to OSS or TSS are present, check the transaxle build date following
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
a. If the build date is before 10/21/2007 go to Step 2.
b. If vehicle transaxle is built on or after 10/21/2007 do not continue with this TSB and follow
normal WSM, Section 307-01 Automatic Transaxle/Transmission-6F50 Diagnosis and Testing.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's > Page 1127
2. To repair an OSS or TSS DTC refer to WSM, Section 307-01, follow pin point test (PPT) C. The
TSS sensor is located in the end cover assembly (Figure 1). The OSS sensor is located inside the
transaxle under the main Control (Figure 2). Both sensor connectors are plugged into the solenoid
body. Both sensor connectors look the same but are wired differently (Figure 3).
3. If you work through PPT C and get to Step C9 before finding the cause of the concern, replace
the sensor (DO NOT REPLACE THE POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) AT THIS TIME).
Reassemble as needed and verify the concern is fixed.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT:
Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits are
determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's > Page 1128
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT072111 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING BASIC PART NO.
CONDITION
7M101 CODE
42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Transmission Speed Sensor: > 07-11-9 > Jun > 07 > Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging
Brake Light Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging
TSB 07-11-9
06/11/07
BRAKE DRAG
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some Edge/MKX vehicles may exhibit brake drag from the rear wheels or all wheels.
Customers may notice an odor and/or reduced powertrain performance. In some cases, the driver
may also note an integral vehicle dynamics (IVD) light after driving a given distance due to
pressure noted in the module without a change in brake on/off (BOO) state.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure to resolve brake drag concerns.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Raise the vehicle on a hoist, with engine running, and vehicle in park. Rotate all of the wheels by
hand to verify excessive force is necessary to turn wheels.
^ To resolve the brake drag concern from all wheels - Replacement of the BOO switch is
necessary.
^ To resolve the brake drag concern from the rear wheels only - Adjustment of the park brake
cables are necessary.
BOO Switch Replacement (All Brakes Drag) Removal
1. With the vehicle shut off and in park, remove the stop lamp switch by rotating the stop lamp
switch in the clockwise direction.
2. If the brake pedal moves up during the removal of the switch, the pedal was being inadvertently
held down by the stop lamp switch thus keeping the hydraulic circuits pressurized. Refer to
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 417-01.
3. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the switch and discard the switch.
Installation
NOTE
INSTALLATION OF THE NEW STOP LAMP SWITCH MUST BE DONE WITH THE BRAKE
PEDAL AT ITS NORMALLY INSTALLED AND RESTING POSITION. DO NOT PULL UP OR
PUSH DOWN ON THE BRAKE PEDAL DURING STOP LAMP SWITCH INSTALLATION. REFER
TO WSM, Section 417-01.
1. With the brake pedal at its rest position, insert the new stop lamp switch into the keyed hole on
the brake pedal and rotate the switch 45 degrees counter-clockwise to seat the switch. You may
hear a click sound during this step, this is normal.
2. Plug the wire harness connector to the new stop lamp switch.
3. Verify that the brake lamps are functioning properly and that the brakes are no longer dragging.
Park Cable Adjustment (Rear Brakes Drag)
Brake drag noted on rear wheels only likely caused by over adjusted park brake equalizer
adjustment (or all 3 cable lengths built at the minimum levels).
1. With vehicle on Hoist and shut off, verify rear brake pads are positioned properly per WSM,
Section 206-04: Rear Disc Brake.
2. With a fully released parking brake pedal, back off the adjustment until the wheels spin freely.
NOTE
DISTANCE BETWEEN THE NUT AND END OF THE STUD SHOULD BE 7/8" (22 mm)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Transmission Speed Sensor: > 07-11-9 > Jun > 07 > Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging > Page
1134
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071109A 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.4 Hr.
Diagnose, Replace BOO Switch (Do Not Use With 13480A)
071109B 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.4 Hr.
Diagnose, Adjust Park Brake (Do Not Use With 2780B)
071109C 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.5 Hr.
Diagnose, Replace BOO Switch, And Adjust Park Brake (Do Not Use With 13480A, 2780B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
13480 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Transmission Speed Sensor: > 07-11-9 > Jun > 07 > Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging > Page
1140
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071109A 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.4 Hr.
Diagnose, Replace BOO Switch (Do Not Use With 13480A)
071109B 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.4 Hr.
Diagnose, Adjust Park Brake (Do Not Use With 2780B)
071109C 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.5 Hr.
Diagnose, Replace BOO Switch, And Adjust Park Brake (Do Not Use With 13480A, 2780B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
13480 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1143
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1144
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1145
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1146
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1147
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1148
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1149
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1150
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1151
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1152
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1153
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1154
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1155
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1156
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1157
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1158
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1159
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor
Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1162
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1163
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1164
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle side cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1165
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1166
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
22. Remove the 10 bolts, the detent spring and the main control valve body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1167
23. Remove the bolt and the TSS sensor.
Installation
1. Route the TSS sensor wiring harness through the cover and the transaxle case.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1168
2. Install the TSS sensor in the cover and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
3. NOTE: Make sure that the manual lever pin (part of the TR sensor) is correctly installed in the
manual valve.
Position the TSS, OSS and TR sensor wiring harnesses aside and install the main control valve
body, the TR sensor detent spring and the 10 bolts. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown. ^
Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1169
4. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
5. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3
80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1170
6. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
7. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1171
8. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
9. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
10. Inspect the transaxle side cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
11. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on
the inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle side cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1172
12. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
13. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1173
14. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
15. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
16. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1174
17. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
18. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
19. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
20. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
21. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1175
22. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
23. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
24. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
25. Connect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness
fastener.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1176
26. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1177
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1178
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1179
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1180
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle side cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1181
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1182
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when removing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
22. Remove the 10 bolts, the TR sensor detent spring and the main control valve body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1183
23. Remove the bolt and the OSS sensor.
Installation
1. Install the OSS sensor and the bolt.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
2. NOTE: Make sure that the manual lever pin (part of the TR sensor) is correctly installed in the
manual valve.
Position the TSS, OSS and TR sensor wiring harnesses aside and install the main control valve
body, the TR sensor detent spring and the 10 bolts. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown. ^
Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1184
3. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
4. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1185
5. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
6. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1186
7. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
8. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
9. Inspect the transaxle side cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
10. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on
the inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle side cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1187
11. Tighten the main control valve body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
12. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1188
13. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
14. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
15. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
16. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1189
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
17. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
18. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
19. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
20. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1190
21. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
22. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
23. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
24. Connect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness
fastener.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed
(TSS) Sensor > Page 1191
25. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1196
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1197
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1198
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1199
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1200
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1201
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1202
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1203
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1204
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1205
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1206
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1207
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1208
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1209
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1210
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1211
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1212
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Locations Window Adjust Switch
View 151-24 (Right Rear Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Window Adjust Switch > Page 1218
View 151-23 (Left Rear Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Window Adjust Switch > Page 1219
View 151-21 (Driver Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Window Adjust Switch > Page 1220
View 151-22 (Passenger Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Master Window Adjust Switch
C504A
C504B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1223
C535A
C535B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1224
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Window Adjust Switch
C701
C801
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1225
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Power Window Switch, RH Side Front
C624
C648
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Master Window Adjust Switch
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1228
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1229
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Window Adjust Switches
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1230
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1231
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1232
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1233
Power Window Switch: Service and Repair
WINDOW CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
Edge only
1. Pull the switch bezel straight up to unclip it from the door trim panel.
MKX only
2. NOTE: LH front shown, all others similar.
Pull up on the front edge of the switch bezel and pull forward to unhook it from the door trim panel.
All vehicles
3. Disconnect the electrical connector(s). 4. Unclip the window control switch from the switch bezel.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1238
C138
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1242
C202
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Front
Windshield Washer Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion Front
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Front >
Page 1245
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Front >
Page 1246
Windshield Washer Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion Rear
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Front >
Page 1247
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1248
Windshield Washer Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Release the upper steering column shroud by pressing inward on the sides of the shroud
and lifting upwards.
Remove the upper steering column shroud.
2. Release the tilt lever, remove the 3 screws and then remove the lower steering column shroud.
3. Disconnect the multi-function switch electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1249
4. Remove the 2 multi-function switch screws and remove the switch. 5. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1253
C202
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Front
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Front
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Front > Page 1256
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Front > Page 1257
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Rear
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Front > Page 1258
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1259
Wiper Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Release the upper steering column shroud by pressing inward on the sides of the shroud
and lifting upwards.
Remove the upper steering column shroud.
2. Release the tilt lever, remove the 3 screws and then remove the lower steering column shroud.
3. Disconnect the multi-function switch electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1260
4. Remove the 2 multi-function switch screws and remove the switch. 5. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest: > 08-7-3 > Apr > 08 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pull or Drift Condition
Alignment: Customer Interest Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pull or Drift Condition
TSB 08-7-3
04/14/08
PULL/DRIFT
FORD: 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 07-7-6 to update the original TSB to add model years. No other
changes made.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Ford Edge and Lincoln MKX vehicles may exhibit a drift/pull concern that
occurs even though the tire pressures and wheel alignment are within specifications, and the
concern is not corrected by rotating the front tires left to right.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Verify that drift/pull is not being caused by concerns listed in Workshop Manual (WSM), Section
204-00 drift/pull diagnostics. If normal drift/pull WSM diagnostics/procedures do not resolve the
concern then refer to the following service steps.
NOTE
THIS SERVICE PROCEDURE MAY CAUSE THE FRONT CROSS CAMBER (TOTAL/SPLIT)
ALIGNMENT VALUE TO EXCEED THE SERVICE MANUAL SPECIFICATION OF 0.00 +/- 0.75
DEGREES. DO NOT EXCEED +/- 1.2 DEGREES OF CROSS CAMBER.
For a Right Drift/Pull
1. Inspect the left strut upper plate to verify which direction the arrow is pointing. (Figure 1)
NOTE
IF THE NOTCH IS VISIBLE IN THE ACCESS HOLE IN THE STRUT TOWER, THE PLATE HAS
ALREADY BEEN ROTATED A POSITIVE 0.5 DEGREE.
2. If the arrow is pointing inboard as seen through the access hole in Figure 1, no rotation is
necessary (positive 0.5 degree camber already there).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest: > 08-7-3 > Apr > 08 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pull or Drift Condition > Page 1270
Continue with Step 4.
3. If the arrow is pointing outboard, increase positive camber approximately 0.5 degrees on the left
front wheel by rotating the upper strut plate 180 degrees. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Camber
Adjustment - Front.
NOTE
DISCONNECT THE FRONT STABILIZER BAR LINK AT THE LOWER CONTROL ARM SO THAT
ENOUGH CLEARANCE CAN BE OBTAINED TO ROTATE THE UPPER STRUT MOUNT.
REPLACE THE STABILIZER BAR LINK NUT ON REASSEMBLY.
NOTE
REPLACE THE FOUR (4) UPPER STRUT MOUNT NUTS.
4. Place vehicle on alignment rack. Remove and replace the two (2) right front shock absorber
(strut) to wheel knuckle lower flag bolts and nuts but do not tighten. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
5. With full vehicle weight on the wheels allow the right wheel to increase negative camber and
tighten both lower flag bolts and nuts to 166 lb-ft (225 N.m). The camber shift may vary between
vehicles, but will typically be between a negative 0.2 and negative 0.6 degrees of camber change.
Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
6. Reset front toe adjustment to proper specifications. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Toe
Adjustment - Front.
For a Left Drift/Pull
1. Inspect the right strut upper plate to verify which direction the arrow is pointing. (Figure 1)
NOTE
IF THE NOTCH IS VISIBLE IN THE ACCESS HOLE IN THE STRUT TOWER, THE PLATE HAS
ALREADY BEEN ROTATED A POSITIVE 0.5 DEGREE.
2. If the arrow is pointing inboard, as seen through the access hole in Figure 1, no rotation is
necessary (positive 0.5 degree camber already there). Continue with Step 4.
3. If the arrow is pointing outboard, increase positive camber approximately 0.5 degrees on the
right front wheel by rotating the upper strut plate 180 degrees. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00,
Camber Adjustment - Front.
NOTE
DISCONNECT THE FRONT STABILIZER BAR LINK AT THE LOWER CONTROL ARM SO THAT
ENOUGH CLEARANCE CAN BE OBTAINED TO ROTATE THE UPPER STRUT MOUNT.
REPLACE THE STABILIZER BAR LINK NUT ON REASSEMBLY.
NOTE
REPLACE THE FOUR (4) UPPER STRUT MOUNT NUTS.
4. Place vehicle on alignment rack. Remove and replace the two (2) left front shock absorber (strut)
to wheel knuckle lower flag bolts and nuts but do not tighten. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
5. With full vehicle weight on the wheels allow the left wheel to increase negative camber and
tighten both lower flag bolts and nuts to 166 lb-ft (225 N.m). The camber shift may vary between
vehicles, but will typically be between a negative 0.2 and a negative 0.6 degrees of camber
change. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
6. Reset front toe adjustment to proper specifications. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Toe
Adjustment - Front.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest: > 08-7-3 > Apr > 08 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pull or Drift Condition > Page 1271
080703A 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.4 Hrs.
Increase Positive Camber Following Service Procedure. Includes Inspect Upper Strut Plate. (Do
Not Use With 3001A, 3001A1)
080703B 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.8 Hrs.
Increase Positive Camber Following Service Procedure. Includes Inspect and Rotate Upper Strut
Plate. (Do Not Use With 3001A, 3001A1)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
FRONT W6
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 08-7-3 > Apr > 08 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pull or Drift Condition
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pull or Drift Condition
TSB 08-7-3
04/14/08
PULL/DRIFT
FORD: 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 07-7-6 to update the original TSB to add model years. No other
changes made.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Ford Edge and Lincoln MKX vehicles may exhibit a drift/pull concern that
occurs even though the tire pressures and wheel alignment are within specifications, and the
concern is not corrected by rotating the front tires left to right.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Verify that drift/pull is not being caused by concerns listed in Workshop Manual (WSM), Section
204-00 drift/pull diagnostics. If normal drift/pull WSM diagnostics/procedures do not resolve the
concern then refer to the following service steps.
NOTE
THIS SERVICE PROCEDURE MAY CAUSE THE FRONT CROSS CAMBER (TOTAL/SPLIT)
ALIGNMENT VALUE TO EXCEED THE SERVICE MANUAL SPECIFICATION OF 0.00 +/- 0.75
DEGREES. DO NOT EXCEED +/- 1.2 DEGREES OF CROSS CAMBER.
For a Right Drift/Pull
1. Inspect the left strut upper plate to verify which direction the arrow is pointing. (Figure 1)
NOTE
IF THE NOTCH IS VISIBLE IN THE ACCESS HOLE IN THE STRUT TOWER, THE PLATE HAS
ALREADY BEEN ROTATED A POSITIVE 0.5 DEGREE.
2. If the arrow is pointing inboard as seen through the access hole in Figure 1, no rotation is
necessary (positive 0.5 degree camber already there).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 08-7-3 > Apr > 08 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pull or Drift Condition > Page 1277
Continue with Step 4.
3. If the arrow is pointing outboard, increase positive camber approximately 0.5 degrees on the left
front wheel by rotating the upper strut plate 180 degrees. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Camber
Adjustment - Front.
NOTE
DISCONNECT THE FRONT STABILIZER BAR LINK AT THE LOWER CONTROL ARM SO THAT
ENOUGH CLEARANCE CAN BE OBTAINED TO ROTATE THE UPPER STRUT MOUNT.
REPLACE THE STABILIZER BAR LINK NUT ON REASSEMBLY.
NOTE
REPLACE THE FOUR (4) UPPER STRUT MOUNT NUTS.
4. Place vehicle on alignment rack. Remove and replace the two (2) right front shock absorber
(strut) to wheel knuckle lower flag bolts and nuts but do not tighten. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
5. With full vehicle weight on the wheels allow the right wheel to increase negative camber and
tighten both lower flag bolts and nuts to 166 lb-ft (225 N.m). The camber shift may vary between
vehicles, but will typically be between a negative 0.2 and negative 0.6 degrees of camber change.
Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
6. Reset front toe adjustment to proper specifications. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Toe
Adjustment - Front.
For a Left Drift/Pull
1. Inspect the right strut upper plate to verify which direction the arrow is pointing. (Figure 1)
NOTE
IF THE NOTCH IS VISIBLE IN THE ACCESS HOLE IN THE STRUT TOWER, THE PLATE HAS
ALREADY BEEN ROTATED A POSITIVE 0.5 DEGREE.
2. If the arrow is pointing inboard, as seen through the access hole in Figure 1, no rotation is
necessary (positive 0.5 degree camber already there). Continue with Step 4.
3. If the arrow is pointing outboard, increase positive camber approximately 0.5 degrees on the
right front wheel by rotating the upper strut plate 180 degrees. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00,
Camber Adjustment - Front.
NOTE
DISCONNECT THE FRONT STABILIZER BAR LINK AT THE LOWER CONTROL ARM SO THAT
ENOUGH CLEARANCE CAN BE OBTAINED TO ROTATE THE UPPER STRUT MOUNT.
REPLACE THE STABILIZER BAR LINK NUT ON REASSEMBLY.
NOTE
REPLACE THE FOUR (4) UPPER STRUT MOUNT NUTS.
4. Place vehicle on alignment rack. Remove and replace the two (2) left front shock absorber (strut)
to wheel knuckle lower flag bolts and nuts but do not tighten. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
5. With full vehicle weight on the wheels allow the left wheel to increase negative camber and
tighten both lower flag bolts and nuts to 166 lb-ft (225 N.m). The camber shift may vary between
vehicles, but will typically be between a negative 0.2 and a negative 0.6 degrees of camber
change. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
6. Reset front toe adjustment to proper specifications. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Toe
Adjustment - Front.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 08-7-3 > Apr > 08 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pull or Drift Condition > Page 1278
080703A 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.4 Hrs.
Increase Positive Camber Following Service Procedure. Includes Inspect Upper Strut Plate. (Do
Not Use With 3001A, 3001A1)
080703B 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.8 Hrs.
Increase Positive Camber Following Service Procedure. Includes Inspect and Rotate Upper Strut
Plate. (Do Not Use With 3001A, 3001A1)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
FRONT W6
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Alignment: > 08-1-7 > Jan > 08 > Instruments - Inaccurate Fuel Gauge
Fuel Gauge Sender: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Inaccurate Fuel Gauge
TSB 08-1-7
01/21/08
INACCURATE FUEL GAUGE INDICATOR - VEHICLE BUILT BEFORE 11/1/2007
FORD: 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Edge and MKX vehicles built before 11/1/2007, may experience an
inaccurate low fuel gauge indicator. This condition may be caused by a stuck float arm on the fuel
delivery module. The fuel delivery module float arm could get hung up on the fuel tank baffle plate.
This failure mode will only occur when the fuel tank is at or near empty fuel level. When the fuel
tank is refilled to a full level, the fuel gauge will continue to read a low fuel fill level. For all other fuel
gauge related concerns, refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 413-01.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. To make this repair it will be necessary to remove the fuel pump module from the fuel tank.
Follow WSM, Section 310-01.
2. Once the fuel delivery module is removed from the fuel tank, access the fuel tank baffle through
the fuel tank fuel delivery opening. (Figure 1)
3. Move the baffle plate with a wooden object or by hand towards the front of the vehicle to prevent
interference between the baffle and the float arm. The fuel tank baffle plate is a metal plate that is
easy to move by hand or using a tool with no consequent damage to the baffle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Alignment: > 08-1-7 > Jan > 08 > Instruments - Inaccurate Fuel Gauge > Page 1284
4. The fuel delivery module float arm should have a clearance of 1 5/32" (29.63 mm) in the empty
tank position (bottom) and 13/16" (20.73 mm) in the full tank position (up). (Figure 2)
5. Install the fuel delivery module following WSM, Section 310-01.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
080107A 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.7 Hrs.
Reposition the Fuel Tank Baffle Plate. Includes Time to Remove Rear Seat and Fuel Delivery
Module. (Do Not Use With 9350E, 63100B,63100B, 9275A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9002 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 1285
Alignment: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 08-7-3 Date: 080414
Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pull or Drift Condition
TSB 08-7-3
04/14/08
PULL/DRIFT
FORD: 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 07-7-6 to update the original TSB to add model years. No other
changes made.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Ford Edge and Lincoln MKX vehicles may exhibit a drift/pull concern that
occurs even though the tire pressures and wheel alignment are within specifications, and the
concern is not corrected by rotating the front tires left to right.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Verify that drift/pull is not being caused by concerns listed in Workshop Manual (WSM), Section
204-00 drift/pull diagnostics. If normal drift/pull WSM diagnostics/procedures do not resolve the
concern then refer to the following service steps.
NOTE
THIS SERVICE PROCEDURE MAY CAUSE THE FRONT CROSS CAMBER (TOTAL/SPLIT)
ALIGNMENT VALUE TO EXCEED THE SERVICE MANUAL SPECIFICATION OF 0.00 +/- 0.75
DEGREES. DO NOT EXCEED +/- 1.2 DEGREES OF CROSS CAMBER.
For a Right Drift/Pull
1. Inspect the left strut upper plate to verify which direction the arrow is pointing. (Figure 1)
NOTE
IF THE NOTCH IS VISIBLE IN THE ACCESS HOLE IN THE STRUT TOWER, THE PLATE HAS
ALREADY BEEN ROTATED A POSITIVE
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 1286
0.5 DEGREE.
2. If the arrow is pointing inboard as seen through the access hole in Figure 1, no rotation is
necessary (positive 0.5 degree camber already there). Continue with Step 4.
3. If the arrow is pointing outboard, increase positive camber approximately 0.5 degrees on the left
front wheel by rotating the upper strut plate 180 degrees. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Camber
Adjustment - Front.
NOTE
DISCONNECT THE FRONT STABILIZER BAR LINK AT THE LOWER CONTROL ARM SO THAT
ENOUGH CLEARANCE CAN BE OBTAINED TO ROTATE THE UPPER STRUT MOUNT.
REPLACE THE STABILIZER BAR LINK NUT ON REASSEMBLY.
NOTE
REPLACE THE FOUR (4) UPPER STRUT MOUNT NUTS.
4. Place vehicle on alignment rack. Remove and replace the two (2) right front shock absorber
(strut) to wheel knuckle lower flag bolts and nuts but do not tighten. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
5. With full vehicle weight on the wheels allow the right wheel to increase negative camber and
tighten both lower flag bolts and nuts to 166 lb-ft (225 N.m). The camber shift may vary between
vehicles, but will typically be between a negative 0.2 and negative 0.6 degrees of camber change.
Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
6. Reset front toe adjustment to proper specifications. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Toe
Adjustment - Front.
For a Left Drift/Pull
1. Inspect the right strut upper plate to verify which direction the arrow is pointing. (Figure 1)
NOTE
IF THE NOTCH IS VISIBLE IN THE ACCESS HOLE IN THE STRUT TOWER, THE PLATE HAS
ALREADY BEEN ROTATED A POSITIVE 0.5 DEGREE.
2. If the arrow is pointing inboard, as seen through the access hole in Figure 1, no rotation is
necessary (positive 0.5 degree camber already there). Continue with Step 4.
3. If the arrow is pointing outboard, increase positive camber approximately 0.5 degrees on the
right front wheel by rotating the upper strut plate 180 degrees. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00,
Camber Adjustment - Front.
NOTE
DISCONNECT THE FRONT STABILIZER BAR LINK AT THE LOWER CONTROL ARM SO THAT
ENOUGH CLEARANCE CAN BE OBTAINED TO ROTATE THE UPPER STRUT MOUNT.
REPLACE THE STABILIZER BAR LINK NUT ON REASSEMBLY.
NOTE
REPLACE THE FOUR (4) UPPER STRUT MOUNT NUTS.
4. Place vehicle on alignment rack. Remove and replace the two (2) left front shock absorber (strut)
to wheel knuckle lower flag bolts and nuts but do not tighten. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
5. With full vehicle weight on the wheels allow the left wheel to increase negative camber and
tighten both lower flag bolts and nuts to 166 lb-ft (225 N.m). The camber shift may vary between
vehicles, but will typically be between a negative 0.2 and a negative 0.6 degrees of camber
change. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
6. Reset front toe adjustment to proper specifications. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Toe
Adjustment - Front.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 1287
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
080703A 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.4 Hrs.
Increase Positive Camber Following Service Procedure. Includes Inspect Upper Strut Plate. (Do
Not Use With 3001A, 3001A1)
080703B 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.8 Hrs.
Increase Positive Camber Following Service Procedure. Includes Inspect and Rotate Upper Strut
Plate. (Do Not Use With 3001A, 3001A1)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
FRONT W6
Disclaimer
Technical Service Bulletin # 08-7-3 Date: 080414
Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pull or Drift Condition
TSB 08-7-3
04/14/08
PULL/DRIFT
FORD: 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 07-7-6 to update the original TSB to add model years. No other
changes made.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Ford Edge and Lincoln MKX vehicles may exhibit a drift/pull concern that
occurs even though the tire pressures and wheel alignment are within specifications, and the
concern is not corrected by rotating the front tires left to right.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Verify that drift/pull is not being caused by concerns listed in Workshop Manual (WSM), Section
204-00 drift/pull diagnostics. If normal drift/pull WSM diagnostics/procedures do not resolve the
concern then refer to the following service steps.
NOTE
THIS SERVICE PROCEDURE MAY CAUSE THE FRONT CROSS CAMBER (TOTAL/SPLIT)
ALIGNMENT VALUE TO EXCEED THE SERVICE MANUAL SPECIFICATION OF 0.00 +/- 0.75
DEGREES. DO NOT EXCEED +/- 1.2 DEGREES OF CROSS CAMBER.
For a Right Drift/Pull
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 1288
1. Inspect the left strut upper plate to verify which direction the arrow is pointing. (Figure 1)
NOTE
IF THE NOTCH IS VISIBLE IN THE ACCESS HOLE IN THE STRUT TOWER, THE PLATE HAS
ALREADY BEEN ROTATED A POSITIVE 0.5 DEGREE.
2. If the arrow is pointing inboard as seen through the access hole in Figure 1, no rotation is
necessary (positive 0.5 degree camber already there). Continue with Step 4.
3. If the arrow is pointing outboard, increase positive camber approximately 0.5 degrees on the left
front wheel by rotating the upper strut plate 180 degrees. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Camber
Adjustment - Front.
NOTE
DISCONNECT THE FRONT STABILIZER BAR LINK AT THE LOWER CONTROL ARM SO THAT
ENOUGH CLEARANCE CAN BE OBTAINED TO ROTATE THE UPPER STRUT MOUNT.
REPLACE THE STABILIZER BAR LINK NUT ON REASSEMBLY.
NOTE
REPLACE THE FOUR (4) UPPER STRUT MOUNT NUTS.
4. Place vehicle on alignment rack. Remove and replace the two (2) right front shock absorber
(strut) to wheel knuckle lower flag bolts and nuts but do not tighten. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
5. With full vehicle weight on the wheels allow the right wheel to increase negative camber and
tighten both lower flag bolts and nuts to 166 lb-ft (225 N.m). The camber shift may vary between
vehicles, but will typically be between a negative 0.2 and negative 0.6 degrees of camber change.
Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
6. Reset front toe adjustment to proper specifications. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Toe
Adjustment - Front.
For a Left Drift/Pull
1. Inspect the right strut upper plate to verify which direction the arrow is pointing. (Figure 1)
NOTE
IF THE NOTCH IS VISIBLE IN THE ACCESS HOLE IN THE STRUT TOWER, THE PLATE HAS
ALREADY BEEN ROTATED A POSITIVE 0.5 DEGREE.
2. If the arrow is pointing inboard, as seen through the access hole in Figure 1, no rotation is
necessary (positive 0.5 degree camber already there). Continue with Step 4.
3. If the arrow is pointing outboard, increase positive camber approximately 0.5 degrees on the
right front wheel by rotating the upper strut plate 180 degrees. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00,
Camber Adjustment - Front.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 1289
NOTE
DISCONNECT THE FRONT STABILIZER BAR LINK AT THE LOWER CONTROL ARM SO THAT
ENOUGH CLEARANCE CAN BE OBTAINED TO ROTATE THE UPPER STRUT MOUNT.
REPLACE THE STABILIZER BAR LINK NUT ON REASSEMBLY.
NOTE
REPLACE THE FOUR (4) UPPER STRUT MOUNT NUTS.
4. Place vehicle on alignment rack. Remove and replace the two (2) left front shock absorber (strut)
to wheel knuckle lower flag bolts and nuts but do not tighten. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
5. With full vehicle weight on the wheels allow the left wheel to increase negative camber and
tighten both lower flag bolts and nuts to 166 lb-ft (225 N.m). The camber shift may vary between
vehicles, but will typically be between a negative 0.2 and a negative 0.6 degrees of camber
change. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
6. Reset front toe adjustment to proper specifications. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Toe
Adjustment - Front.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
080703A 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.4 Hrs.
Increase Positive Camber Following Service Procedure. Includes Inspect Upper Strut Plate. (Do
Not Use With 3001A, 3001A1)
080703B 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.8 Hrs.
Increase Positive Camber Following Service Procedure. Includes Inspect and Rotate Upper Strut
Plate. (Do Not Use With 3001A, 3001A1)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
FRONT W6
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications >
Page 1292
Ride Height
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications >
Page 1293
Bushing Fastener Tightening Height
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications >
Page 1294
Alignment: Specifications General Specifications
General Specifications
Ride Height
Bushing Fastener Tightening Height
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications >
Page 1295
Alignment: Specifications
Ride Height
Bushing Fastener Tightening Height
General Specifications
General Specifications
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications >
Page 1296
Ride Height
Bushing Fastener Tightening Height
Ball Joint Deflection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 1297
Alignment: Description and Operation
Wheel Alignment Angles
NOTE: When making rear alignment adjustments, it is important to know that when adjustments
are made to the rear toe, the rear camber will also be adjusted (in the same direction as the toe
adjustment). When making adjustments to the rear camber, the rear toe will also be adjusted (in
the opposite direction of the camber adjustment). It will be necessary to check the rear camber
whenever rear toe adjustments are made and to check the rear toe whenever rear camber
adjustments are made.
Front toe is adjusted through the use of adjustable tie-rod ends. Front camber is adjusted through
the use of the upper strut plate. Rotating the upper strut plate 180 degrees will change the camber
+0.5 degrees. Front caster is not adjustable on the vehicle. Rear toe is adjusted through the use of
adjustable toe link cams. Rear camber is adjusted through the use of a cam bolt that attaches the
rear lower control arm to the rear subframe.
Camber
Negative and Positive Camber
Camber is the vertical tilt of the wheel when viewed from the front. Camber can be positive or
negative and has a direct affect on tire wear.
Caster
Caster
Caster is the deviation from vertical of an imaginary line drawn through the ball joints when viewed
from the side. The caster specifications will give the vehicle the best directional stability
characteristics when loaded and driven. The caster setting is not related to tire wear.
Toe
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 1298
Positive Toe (Toe In)
Negative Toe (Toe Out)
The vehicle toe setting affects tire wear and directional stability.
Ride Height If there is a ride height concern, such as the front or rear of the vehicle being higher or
lower than normal or an apparent lean, it should be corrected before aligning the vehicle. Any
heavy items such as tool boxes, sample cases or any other items should be removed.
If no unusual load is present, check for damaged components or nonstandard replacement
suspension components.
To measure ride height, the vehicle must be in a level, static ground position with full fluids and a
full fuel tank.
Front Ride Height (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 1299
Front Ride Height (Part 2)
Rear Ride Height Measurement
Wander Wander is the tendency of the vehicle to require frequent, random left and right steering
wheel corrections to maintain a straight path down a level road.
Shimmy Shimmy, as observed by the driver, is large, consistent, rotational oscillations of the
steering wheel resulting from large, side-to-side (lateral) tire/wheel movements.
Shimmy is usually experienced near 64 km/h (40 mph), and can begin or be amplified when the tire
contacts pot holes or irregularities in the road surface. Nibble Sometimes confused with shimmy,
nibble is a condition resulting from tire interaction with various road surfaces and observed by the
driver as small rotational oscillations of the steering wheel.
Poor Returnability/Sticky Steering Poor returnability and sticky steering is used to describe poor
return of the steering wheel to center after a turn or steering correction.
Drift/Pull Pull is a tugging sensation, felt by the hands on the steering wheel, that must be
overcome to keep the vehicle going straight.
Drift describes what a vehicle with this condition does with hands off the steering wheel.
^ A vehicle-related drift/pull, on a flat road, will cause a consistent deviation from the straight-ahead
path and require constant steering input in the opposite direction to counteract the effect.
^ Drift/pull may be induced by conditions external to the vehicle (for example, wind, road crown).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 1300
Poor Groove Feel Poor groove feel is characterized by little or no buildup of turning effort felt in the
steering wheel as the wheel is rocked slowly left and right within very small around center or
straight-ahead (under 20 degrees of steering wheel turn). Efforts may be said to be "flat on center."
^ Under 20 degrees of turn, most of the turning effort that builds up comes from the mesh of gear
teeth in the steering gear. In this range, the steering wheel is not yet turned enough to feel the
effort from the self-aligning forces at the road wheel or tire patch.
^ In the diagnosis of a roadability problem, it is important to understand the difference between
wander and poor groove feel.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber Adjustment Front
Alignment: Service and Repair Camber Adjustment - Front
Camber Adjustment - Front
NOTE: Front camber is adjusted through the use of the upper strut plate. Rotating the upper strut
plate 180 degrees will change the camber +0.5 degrees.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturer's instructions, measure the camber. 2.
Remove the 4 strut upper mounting plate nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs).
3. Using a suitable jack, raise the vehicle body enough to allow the front strut upper plate mounting
studs to clear the frame.
4. NOTE: Rotating the upper strut plate 180 degrees will change the camber +0.5 degrees.
Rotate the upper mounting plate 180 degrees.
5. Recheck the front camber settings. 6. Check and, if necessary, adjust the front toe.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber Adjustment Front > Page 1303
Alignment: Service and Repair Toe Adjustment - Front
Toe Adjustment - Front
1. Start the engine and center the steering wheel. 2. Turn the engine OFF and, using a suitable
steering wheel holding device, lock the steering wheel in the straight ahead position. 3. Using
alignment equipment and the manufacturer's instructions, measure the front toe. 4. Remove the
steering gear bellows clamps.
5. Loosen the tie-rod jam nuts.
6. NOTE: Do not allow the steering gear bellows to twist when the tie rod is rotated.
Rotate the tie rods until the toe setting is within specifications.
7. Tighten the jam nuts to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs). 8. Install the steering gear bellows clamps.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber Adjustment Front > Page 1304
Alignment: Service and Repair Toe Adjustment - Rear
Toe Adjustment - Rear
NOTE: When making rear alignment adjustments, it is important to know that when adjustments
are made to the rear toe, the rear camber will also be adjusted (in the same direction as the toe
adjustment). When making adjustments to the rear camber, the rear toe will also be adjusted (in
the opposite direction of the camber adjustment). It will be necessary to check the rear camber
whenever rear toe adjustments are made and to check the rear toe whenever rear camber
adjustments are made.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturer's instructions, measure the rear toe. 2. Loosen
the toe link inboard bolt. 3. Rotate the toe link adjuster cam until the toe setting is within
specifications.
4. CAUTION: Before tightening any suspension bushing fasteners, the suspension must be at the
bushing fastener tightening position.
NOTE: Do not allow the toe link adjuster can to rotate while tightening the bolt.
Tighten the toe link inboard bolt to 200 Nm (148 ft. lbs).
5. Recheck the rear toe and camber.
^ Adjust as necessary.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber Adjustment Front > Page 1305
Alignment: Service and Repair Camber Adjustment - Rear
Camber Adjustment - Rear
CAUTION: Before tightening any suspension bushing fasteners, the suspension must be at the
bushing fastener tightening position.
NOTE: When making rear alignment adjustments, it is important to know that when adjustments
are made to the rear camber the rear toe will also be affected. Also when adjusting the rear toe, the
rear camber will be affected. It will be necessary to check the rear toe whenever rear camber
adjustments are made and to check the rear camber whenever rear toe adjustments are made.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturer's instructions, measure the rear camber. 2.
Loosen the lower arm cam bolt. 3. Rotate the camber adjustment bolt until the camber setting is
within specifications.
4. CAUTION: Before tightening any suspension bushing fasteners, the weight of the vehicle must
be resting on the wheels and tires or
incorrect clamp load and bushing damage may occure..
NOTE: Do not allow the camber cam adjuster to rotate while tightening the bolt.
Tighten the lower arm cam bolt to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs).
5. Recheck the rear camber and toe.
^ Adjust as necessary.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System Information
> Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Fuel Pressure
3.5 L engine running fuel pressure.......................................................................................................
...........................................................450 kPa (65 psi)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System Information >
Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Typical Diagnostic Reference Value
Measured/PID Values 600 RPM ..........................................................................................................
..................................................................................................... Hot Idle
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Air Cleaner Housing: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER
Part 1
Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 1316
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 2. Loosen the clamp and
disconnect the air cleaner outlet pipe from the air cleaner.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. Remove the air cleaner bolt.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
4. NOTE: No tools are needed to remove the air cleaner assembly. Removal should be carried out
using hands only.
Separate the 2 air cleaner feet from the rubber grommets and remove the air cleaner assembly.
5. NOTE:
- Make sure that the 2 air cleaner feet are seated into the rubber grommets under the air cleaner
assembly.
- The air cleaner outlet pipe should be securely sealed to prevent unmetered air from entering the
engine.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure Release
> System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELEASE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
WARNING:
- Do not carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any fuel-related
components. Highly flammable vapors are always present and can ignite. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, which may cause personal injury
or a fire hazard.
1. Remove the Schrader valve cap.
2. NOTE: This step will drain some fuel out of the system. Place the fuel in a suitable container.
Install the special tool and slowly open the manual valve to relieve the fuel system pressure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order > Component
Information > Specifications > Firing Order
Firing Order: Specifications Firing Order
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Firing order...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................1-4-2-5-3-6
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order > Component
Information > Specifications > Firing Order > Page 1325
Firing Order: Specifications Engine Cylinder Identification
Engine
Engine Cylinder Identification
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing > Number One
Cylinder > Component Information > Locations
Number One Cylinder: Locations
Engine
Engine Cylinder Identification
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Specifications > General Specifications
Spark Plug: Specifications General Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Spark plug gap.....................................................................................................................................
....................................1.29-1.45 mm (0.051-0.057 in)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Specifications > General Specifications > Page 1334
Torque Specifications
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1335
Spark Plug: Application and ID
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Spark plug............................................................................................................................................
................................................................AYFS-22FM
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1336
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection
Spark Plug Inspection
1. Inspect the spark plug for a bridged gap.
^ Check for deposit build-up closing the gap between the electrodes. Deposits are caused by oil or
carbon fouling.
^ Clean the spark plug.
2. Check for oil fouling.
^ Check for wet, black deposits on the insulator shell bore electrodes, caused by excessive oil
entering the combustion chamber through worn rings and pistons, excessive valve-to-guide
clearance or worn or loose bearings.
^ Correct the oil leak concern.
^ Install a new spark plug.
3. Inspect for carbon fouling. Look for black, dry, fluffy carbon deposits on the insulator tips,
exposed shell surfaces and electrodes, caused by a
spark plug with an incorrect heat range, dirty air cleaner, too rich a fuel mixture or excessive idling.
^
Install new spark plugs.
4. Inspect for normal burning.
^ Check for light tan or gray deposits on the firing tip.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1337
5. Inspect for pre-ignition, identified by melted electrodes and a possibly damaged insulator.
Metallic deposits on the insulator indicate engine
damage. This may be caused by incorrect ignition timing, wrong type of fuel or the unauthorized
installation of a Heli-coil insert in place of the spark plug threads. ^
Install a new spark plug.
6. Inspect for overheating, identified by white or light gray spots and with a bluish-burnt appearance
of electrodes. This is caused by engine
overheating, wrong type of fuel, loose spark plugs, spark plugs with an incorrect heat range, low
fuel pump pressure or incorrect ignition timing. ^
Install a new spark plug.
7. Inspect for fused deposits, identified by melted or spotty deposits resembling bubbles or blisters.
These are caused by sudden acceleration.
^ Install new spark plugs.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1338
Spark Plug: Service and Repair
SPARK PLUGS
Exploded View
Removal
LH side 1. Disconnect the crankcase vent tube quick connect coupling from the valve cover fitting
and position aside.
RH side
2. NOTE: The upper intake manifold must be removed to access the RH spark plugs only.
Remove the upper intake manifold.
Both sides 3. Disconnect the 6 ignition coil-on-plug electrical connectors.
4. NOTE: When removing the ignition coil-on-plugs, a slight twisting motion will break the seal and
ease removal.
Remove the 6 bolts and the 6 ignition coil-on-plugs.
5. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when removing or installing the spark plugs or damage can
occur to the cylinder head or spark plug.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1339
NOTE: Use compressed air to remove any foreign material in the spark plug well before removing
the spark plugs.
Remove the 6 spark plugs.
Installation
Both sides
1. Inspect the 6 spark plugs.
2. Adjust the spark plug gap as necessary.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1340
3. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when removing or installing the spark plugs, or damage can
occur to the cylinder head or spark plug.
Install the 6 spark plugs. Tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
4. NOTE: Apply a small amount of dielectric grease to the inside of the ignition coil-on-plug boots
before attaching to the spark plugs.
Install the 6 ignition coil-on-plugs and the 6 bolts. Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
5. Connect the 6 ignition coil-on-plug electrical connectors.
RH side 6. Install the upper intake manifold.
LH side 7. Position and connect the crankcase vent tube quick connect coupling to the valve cover
fitting.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check > System
Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Compression Test - Test Results
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75% of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit Chart.
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check > System
Information > Specifications > Page 1344
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
Compression Test
1. Make sure the oil in the crankcase is of the correct viscosity and at the correct level and that the
battery is correctly charged. Operate the vehicle
until the engine is at normal operating temperature. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position,
then remove all the spark plugs.
2. Set the throttle plates in the wide-open position. 3. Install a compression gauge such as the
Compression Tester in the No. 1 cylinder. 4. Install an auxiliary starter switch in the starting circuit.
With the ignition switch in the OFF position, and using the auxiliary starter switch, crank
the engine a minimum of 5 compression strokes and record the highest reading. Note the
approximate number of compression strokes necessary to obtain the highest reading.
5. Repeat the test on each cylinder, cranking the engine approximately the same number of
compression strokes.
Compression Test - Test Results
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75% of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit Chart.
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
If one or more cylinders reads low, squirt approximately one tablespoon of engine oil meeting Ford
specification on top of the pistons in the low-reading cylinders. Repeat the compression pressure
check on these cylinders.
Compression Test - Interpreting Compression Readings
1. If compression improves considerably, piston rings are worn or damaged. 2. If compression does
not improve, valves are sticking or not seating correctly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check > System
Information > Specifications > Page 1345
3. If 2 adjacent cylinders indicate low compression pressures and squirting oil on each piston does
not increase compression, the head gasket may be
leaking between cylinders. Engine oil or coolant in cylinders could result from this condition.
Use the Compression Pressure Limit Chart when checking cylinder compression so that the lowest
reading is within 75% of the highest reading.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance > System
Information > Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
Valve Clearance
A midrange clearance is the most desirable.
Intake ...................................................................................................................................................
....................... 0.15 - 0.25 mm (0.006 - 0.01 inch) Exhaust
..............................................................................................................................................................
0.300 - 0.400 mm (0.0118 - 0.0157 inch)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance > System
Information > Specifications > Page 1349
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
Valve Clearance Check
1. Remove the valve covers.
2. NOTE: The valve clearance must be measured with the camshaft at base circle. The engine will
have to be rotated with the crankshaft pulley bolt
to bring each valve to base circle.
Use a feeler gauge to measure the clearance of each valve and record its location. A midrange
clearance is the most desirable: ^
Intake: 0.15 - 0.25 mm (0.006 - 0.01 inch)
^ Exhaust: 0.300 - 0.400 mm (0.0118 - 0.0157 inch)
3. NOTE: The number on the valve tappet reflects the thickness of the valve tappet. For example, a
tappet with the number 3.310 has the thickness
of 3.31 mm (0.13 inch).
If any of the valve clearances are out of specification, select new tappets using this formula: tappet
thickness = measured clearance + the base tappet thickness - most desirable thickness. Select the
tappets and mark the installation location.
4. If required, install the new selected valve tappets in the marked locations.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest: > 07-23-18 > Nov > 07 > Steering - Power Steering Belt Chirp/Squeal When Cold
Drive Belt: Customer Interest Steering - Power Steering Belt Chirp/Squeal When Cold
TSB 07-23-18
11/26/07
POWER STEERING BELT CHIRP/SQUEAL - COLD
FORD: 2007 Edge, Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX, MKX
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles, equipped with a 3.5L engine and built between
6/20/2007 - 6/29/2007 and 8/13/2007 - 8/24/2007 may exhibit a power steering belt chirp or squeal
noise when cold. Turning the steering wheel to the stop position may also cause the slip and
squeal. This may be caused by an incorrect power steering belt being installed.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Inspect power steering belt label.
2. If a white label Motorcraft(R) belt Part Number 7T4E-6C301-AB is present, then the vehicle has
the correct belt and this TSB does not apply. Follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM), Section
100-4 diagnostics.
3. If a blue label Motorcraft® belt Part Number 7T4E-6C301 -BB is present, then the vehicle has
the incorrect belt and it must be replaced.
4. Cut the old belt off and follow WSM, Section 303-05 for power steering belt installation.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072318A 2007 Edge, MKX 3.5L: 0.6 Hr.
Replace The Power Steering Belt (Do Not Use with 8620C)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
6C301 38
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins: > 07-23-18 > Nov > 07 > Steering - Power Steering Belt Chirp/Squeal When Cold
Drive Belt: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Power Steering Belt Chirp/Squeal When Cold
TSB 07-23-18
11/26/07
POWER STEERING BELT CHIRP/SQUEAL - COLD
FORD: 2007 Edge, Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX, MKX
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles, equipped with a 3.5L engine and built between
6/20/2007 - 6/29/2007 and 8/13/2007 - 8/24/2007 may exhibit a power steering belt chirp or squeal
noise when cold. Turning the steering wheel to the stop position may also cause the slip and
squeal. This may be caused by an incorrect power steering belt being installed.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Inspect power steering belt label.
2. If a white label Motorcraft(R) belt Part Number 7T4E-6C301-AB is present, then the vehicle has
the correct belt and this TSB does not apply. Follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM), Section
100-4 diagnostics.
3. If a blue label Motorcraft® belt Part Number 7T4E-6C301 -BB is present, then the vehicle has
the incorrect belt and it must be replaced.
4. Cut the old belt off and follow WSM, Section 303-05 for power steering belt installation.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072318A 2007 Edge, MKX 3.5L: 0.6 Hr.
Replace The Power Steering Belt (Do Not Use with 8620C)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
6C301 38
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Drive Belt: > 07-11-9 > Jun > 07 > Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging
Brake Light Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging
TSB 07-11-9
06/11/07
BRAKE DRAG
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some Edge/MKX vehicles may exhibit brake drag from the rear wheels or all wheels.
Customers may notice an odor and/or reduced powertrain performance. In some cases, the driver
may also note an integral vehicle dynamics (IVD) light after driving a given distance due to
pressure noted in the module without a change in brake on/off (BOO) state.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure to resolve brake drag concerns.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Raise the vehicle on a hoist, with engine running, and vehicle in park. Rotate all of the wheels by
hand to verify excessive force is necessary to turn wheels.
^ To resolve the brake drag concern from all wheels - Replacement of the BOO switch is
necessary.
^ To resolve the brake drag concern from the rear wheels only - Adjustment of the park brake
cables are necessary.
BOO Switch Replacement (All Brakes Drag) Removal
1. With the vehicle shut off and in park, remove the stop lamp switch by rotating the stop lamp
switch in the clockwise direction.
2. If the brake pedal moves up during the removal of the switch, the pedal was being inadvertently
held down by the stop lamp switch thus keeping the hydraulic circuits pressurized. Refer to
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 417-01.
3. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the switch and discard the switch.
Installation
NOTE
INSTALLATION OF THE NEW STOP LAMP SWITCH MUST BE DONE WITH THE BRAKE
PEDAL AT ITS NORMALLY INSTALLED AND RESTING POSITION. DO NOT PULL UP OR
PUSH DOWN ON THE BRAKE PEDAL DURING STOP LAMP SWITCH INSTALLATION. REFER
TO WSM, Section 417-01.
1. With the brake pedal at its rest position, insert the new stop lamp switch into the keyed hole on
the brake pedal and rotate the switch 45 degrees counter-clockwise to seat the switch. You may
hear a click sound during this step, this is normal.
2. Plug the wire harness connector to the new stop lamp switch.
3. Verify that the brake lamps are functioning properly and that the brakes are no longer dragging.
Park Cable Adjustment (Rear Brakes Drag)
Brake drag noted on rear wheels only likely caused by over adjusted park brake equalizer
adjustment (or all 3 cable lengths built at the minimum levels).
1. With vehicle on Hoist and shut off, verify rear brake pads are positioned properly per WSM,
Section 206-04: Rear Disc Brake.
2. With a fully released parking brake pedal, back off the adjustment until the wheels spin freely.
NOTE
DISTANCE BETWEEN THE NUT AND END OF THE STUD SHOULD BE 7/8" (22 mm)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Drive Belt: > 07-11-9 > Jun > 07 > Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging > Page 1368
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071109A 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.4 Hr.
Diagnose, Replace BOO Switch (Do Not Use With 13480A)
071109B 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.4 Hr.
Diagnose, Adjust Park Brake (Do Not Use With 2780B)
071109C 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.5 Hr.
Diagnose, Replace BOO Switch, And Adjust Park Brake (Do Not Use With 13480A, 2780B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
13480 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Drive Belt: > 07-11-9 > Jun > 07 > Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging > Page 1374
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071109A 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.4 Hr.
Diagnose, Replace BOO Switch (Do Not Use With 13480A)
071109B 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.4 Hr.
Diagnose, Adjust Park Brake (Do Not Use With 2780B)
071109C 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.5 Hr.
Diagnose, Replace BOO Switch, And Adjust Park Brake (Do Not Use With 13480A, 2780B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
13480 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Diagrams > Exploded Views
Drive Belt: Exploded Views
Front End Accessory Drive (FEAD) - Exploded View
Front End Accessory Drive (FEAD) - Exploded View
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Diagrams > Exploded Views > Page 1377
Drive Belt: Mechanical Diagrams
Front Engine Accessory Drive
Front Engine Accessory Drive
Power Steering Pump Belt
Power Steering Pump Belt (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Diagrams > Exploded Views > Page 1378
Power Steering Pump Belt (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection
and Diagnostic Overview
Drive Belt: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Inspection and Verification
CAUTION: Under no circumstances should the accessory drive belt, tensioner or pulleys be
lubricated as potential damage to the belt material and tensioner damping mechanism will occur.
Do not apply any fluids or belt dressing to the accessory drive belt or pulleys.
1. Verify the customer concern by operating the system. 2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of
mechanical damage.
Visual Inspection Chart
Visual Inspection Chart
3. Eliminate all other non-belt related noises that could cause belt misdiagnosis, such as A/C
compressor engagement chirp, power steering
cavitations at low temperatures, variable camshaft timing (VCT) tick or generator whine.
4. If a concern is found, correct the condition before proceeding to the next step.
V-Ribbed Serpentine Drive Belt With Cracks Across Ribs
5. NOTE: Up to 15 cracks in a rib over a distance of 100 mm (4.0 inch) can be considered
acceptable. If damage exceeds the acceptable limit or
any chunks are found to be missing from the ribs, a new belt must be installed.
Check the belt for cracks. Up to 15 cracks in a rib over a distance of 100 mm (4.0 inch) can be
considered acceptable. If cracks exceed this standard, install a new belt.
6. The condition of the V-ribbed drive belt should be compared against the illustration and
appropriate action taken.
1 Small scattered deposits of rubber material. This is not a concern, therefore, installation of a new
belt is not required.
2 Longer deposit areas building up to 50% of the rib height. This is not considered a concern but it
can result in excessive noise. If noise is apparent, install a new belt.
3 Heavy deposits building up along the grooves resulting in a possible noise and belt stability
concern. If heavy deposits are apparent, install a new belt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection
and Diagnostic Overview > Page 1381
V-Ribbed Serpentine Belt With Piling
7. There should be no chunks missing from the belt ribs. If the belt shows any evidence of this,
install a new accessory drive belt.
V-Ribbed Serpentine Belt With Chunks of Rib Missing
8. If the concern is not visually evident, verify the symptom and GO to Symptom Chart. See:
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection
and Diagnostic Overview > Page 1382
Drive Belt: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Symptom Chart
Symptom Chart (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection
and Diagnostic Overview > Page 1383
Symptom Chart (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection
and Diagnostic Overview > Page 1384
Drive Belt: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Drive Belt - Noise/Flutter
Drive belt chirp occurs due to pulley misalignment or excessive pulley runout. It can be the result of
a damaged or incorrectly aligned grooved pulley.
To correct, determine the area where the noise comes from. Check each of the pulleys in that area
with a straightedge to the crankshaft pulley. Look for accessory pulleys out of position in the fore/aft
direction or at an angle to the straightedge.
CAUTION: Do not apply any fluids or belt dressing to the accessory drive belt or pulleys.
Drive belt squeal may be an intermittent or constant noise that occurs when the drive belt slips on
an accessory pulley under certain conditions.
A short intermittent squeal may occur during engine start-up and shut down or during very rapid
engine acceleration and decelerations, such as: ^
wide open throttle 1-2 and 2-3 shifts or 2-3 and 3-4 back out shifts on automatic transmissions.
^ wide open throttle 1-2 and 2-3 shifts and any combination of rapid downshifting on manual
transmissions.
These special short-term transient events are expected, and are due to the higher system inertias
required to meet the electrical and cooling demands on today's vehicle systems. Constant or
reoccurring drive belt squeal can occur: ^
if the A/C discharge pressure goes above specifications: - the A/C system is overcharged. - the A/C
condenser core airflow is blocked.
^ if the A/C off equalized pressure (the common discharged and suction pressure that occurs after
several minutes) exceeds specifications.
^ if any of the accessories are damaged or have a worn or damaged bearing. All accessories
should be rotatable by hand in the unloaded condition. If not, inspect the accessory.
^ if there is evidence of fluid contamination on the accessory drive belt. When the drive belt has
been exposed to fluid contamination during vehicle operation, such as leaks from the power
steering system, A/C system or cooling system, clean all pulleys with soap and water, rinse with
clean water and install a new accessory drive belt. If the drive belt has been exposed to fluids in a
localized area during routine vehicle service, such as replacement of hoses or fluids, the drive belt
and pulleys should be washed with soap and water immediately (prior to starting the engine), and
rinsed with clean water.
^ if the accessory drive belt is too long. A drive belt that is too long will allow the accessory drive
belt tensioner arm to go all the way to the arm travel stop under certain load conditions, which will
release tension to the drive belt. If the accessory drive belt tensioner indicator is outside the normal
installation wear range window, install a new accessory drive belt.
^ NOTE: The accessory drive belt tensioner arm should rotate freely without binding.
Install a new accessory drive belt tensioner if the drive belt tensioner is worn or damaged.
Drive Belt - Incorrect Installation
CAUTION: Incorrect accessory drive belt installation will cause excessive drive belt wear and can
cause the drive belt to come off the pulleys.
Non-standard accessory drive belts can track differently or incorrectly. If an accessory drive belt
tracks incorrectly, install a new accessory drive belt to avoid performance failure or loss of the drive
belt.
Incorrect Installation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection
and Diagnostic Overview > Page 1385
Correct Installation
With the engine running, check accessory drive belt tracking on all pulleys. If the edge of the
accessory drive belt rides beyond the edge of the pulleys, noise and premature wear will occur.
Make sure the accessory drive belt rides correctly on the pulley. If an accessory drive belt tracking
condition exists: ^
Visually check the accessory drive belt tensioner for damage, especially the mounting pad surface.
If the accessory drive belt tensioner is not installed correctly, the mounting surface pad will be out
of position. This will result in chirp and squeal noises.
^ With the engine running, visually observe the grooves in the pulleys (not the pulley flanges or the
pulley forward faces) for excessive wobble. Install new components as necessary.
^ Check all accessories, mounting brackets and the accessory drive belt tensioner for any
interference that would prevent the component from mounting correctly. Correct any interference
condition and recheck the accessory drive belt tracking.
^ Tighten all accessories, mounting brackets and accessory drive belt tensioner retaining hardware
to specification. Recheck the accessory drive belt tracking.
Belt Tensioner - Mechanical
The only mechanical check that needs to be made is a check for tensioner stick, grab or bind. 1.
With the engine off, check routing of the accessory drive belt.
2. NOTE: The accessory drive belt tensioner spring is very strong and requires substantial force to
release.
Using a suitable, commercially available serpentine belt tensioner release tool, release the tension
on the belt and detach the accessory drive belt in the area of the tensioner.
3. Using a suitable, commercially available serpentine belt tensioner release tool, move the
tensioner from its relaxed position, through its full stroke
and back to the relaxed position to make sure there is no stick, grab or bind, and to make sure that
there is tension on the tensioner spring.
4. Rotate the tensioner pulley by hand and check for a binding, contaminated or seized condition.
Install a new accessory drive belt tensioner if
necessary.
5. Inspect the area surrounding the accessory drive belt tensioner for oil leaks or contamination
and repair any leaks. Install a new accessory drive
belt tensioner as necessary.
6. If the accessory drive belt tensioner meets the above criteria, proceed to testing the tensioner
dynamically. If the accessory drive belt tensioner
does not meet the above criteria, install a new tensioner.
Belt Tensioner - Dynamics
The accessory drive belt tensioner can be checked dynamically as follows: 1. With the engine
running, observe the accessory drive belt tensioner movement. The accessory drive tensioner
should move (respond) when the air
conditioning clutch cycles (if equipped), or when the engine is accelerated rapidly. If the accessory
drive belt tensioner movement is excessive without air conditioning clutch cycling or engine
acceleration, check belt rideout. Excessive belt rideout (uneven depth of grooves in the belt) can
cause excessive accessory drive belt tensioner movement. Check rideout condition by installing a
new belt. If excessive accessory drive belt tensioner movement still exists, install a new accessory
drive belt tensioner.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Accessory Drive Belt
Drive Belt: Service and Repair Accessory Drive Belt
Accessory Drive Belt
Removal
CAUTION: Under no circumstances should the accessory drive belt, tensioner or pulleys be
lubricated as potential damage to the belt material and tensioner damping mechanism will occur.
Do not apply any fluids or belt dressing to the accessory drive belt or pulleys.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Working from the top of the vehicle, using a suitable belt
tensioner release tool, rotate the accessory drive belt tensioner clockwise and remove the
accessory drive belt from the generator pulley.
3. Remove the RH inner fender splash shield. 4. Working from under the vehicle, remove the
accessory drive belt.
Installation
1. Working from under the vehicle, position the accessory drive belt on all pulleys, with the
exception of the generator pulley.
2. CAUTION: Make sure the belt is correctly seated on all pulleys.
Working from the top of the vehicle, position the accessory drive belt on the generator pulley. Using
a suitable belt tensioner release tool, rotate the accessory drive belt tensioner clockwise and install
the accessory drive belt on the generator pulley.
3. Install the RH inner fender splash shield.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Accessory Drive Belt
> Page 1388
Drive Belt: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump Belt
Power Steering Pump Belt
Special Tool(s)
Removal
CAUTION: Under no circumstances should the accessory drive belt, tensioner or pulleys be
lubricated as potential damage to the belt material and tensioner damping mechanism will occur.
Do not apply any fluids or belt dressing to the accessory drive belt or pulleys.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Working from the top of the vehicle, using a suitable belt
tensioner release tool, rotate the accessory drive belt tensioner clockwise and remove the
accessory drive belt from the generator pulley.
3. Remove the RH inner fender splash shield. 4. Position the accessory drive belt off the crankshaft
pulley. 5. Install the Power Steering Belt Removal Tool between the power steering pump belt and
pulley, turning the crankshaft bolt clockwise to remove
the power steering belt.
Installation
1. Install the power steering belt on the crankshaft pulley.
2. CAUTION: After installation, make sure the belt is correctly seated on the crankshaft and power
steering pulleys.
Position the power steering belt around the Power Steering Installation Tool and the power steering
pulley. Make sure that the belt is engaged with the power steering pulley and rotate the crankshaft
clockwise to install the power steering belt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Accessory Drive Belt
> Page 1389
3. Position the accessory drive belt on the crankshaft pulley.
4. CAUTION: Make sure the belt is correctly seated on all pulleys.
Working from the top of the vehicle, position the accessory drive belt on the generator pulley. Using
a suitable belt tensioner release tool, rotate the accessory drive belt tensioner clockwise and install
the accessory drive belt on the generator pulley.
5. Install the RH inner fender splash shield.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Cleaner Housing: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER
Part 1
Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Page 1394
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 2. Loosen the clamp and
disconnect the air cleaner outlet pipe from the air cleaner.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. Remove the air cleaner bolt.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
4. NOTE: No tools are needed to remove the air cleaner assembly. Removal should be carried out
using hands only.
Separate the 2 air cleaner feet from the rubber grommets and remove the air cleaner assembly.
5. NOTE:
- Make sure that the 2 air cleaner feet are seated into the rubber grommets under the air cleaner
assembly.
- The air cleaner outlet pipe should be securely sealed to prevent unmetered air from entering the
engine.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Cabin Air Filter > Component Information > Locations
Cabin Air Filter: Locations
Air Inlet Duct
Cabin Air Filter
A cabin air filter is available as standard equipment on dual-zone EATC vehicles.EMTC vehicles
are not equipped from the factory with a cabin air filter, but are equipped with a screen in place of
the filter to prevent any large foreign material from entering the heater core and evaporator core
housing. The cabin air filter or screen can be accessed by removing the glove compartment and
removing the cabin air filter access cover. A cabin air filter can be installed as a dealer accessory
on vehicles not originally equipped with a filter, but only a screen or a filter should be used, never
both.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Cabin Air Filter > Component Information > Locations > Page 1398
Cabin Air Filter: Description and Operation
Air Distribution
There are 2 sources of air available to the air distribution system. Outside air
- Recirculated air
Recirculated air is always used when the climate control assembly is set to the MAX A/C mode on
vehicles equipped with Electronic Manual Temperature Control (EMTC) and can be selected in any
mode except DEFROST. Vehicles equipped with dual-zone Electronic Automatic Temperature
Control (EATC) use recirculated air only when the RECIRC function is selected in any mode other
than DEFROST, or when required by the HVAC module in the AUTOMATIC mode.
RECIRC is a timed function when selected while operating in FLOOR or FLOOR/DEFROST mode,
and will automatically default back to fresh air inlet in 5 minutes if operating with A/C ON at an
ambient temperature below (50°F). When operating with A/C OFF, the RECIRC function will always
default back to fresh air inlet in5minutes regardless of ambient temperature.
Air distribution within the vehicle is determined by the airftow mode selected, or by the dual-zone
RAYC system in the AUTOMATIC mode. The air distribution mode on vehicles equipped with
dual-zone ~ATC can be ovemdden by the driver if desired. Airflow mode control doors are used to
direct airflow within the heater core and evaporator core housing. Electric mode door actuators are
used to position these airaow mode doors.
Vehicles equipped with dual-zone EA.TQ use 2 separate temperature blend doors. This allows
individual temperature settings to be selected for the RH and LH air outlets. The airfow mode doors
are not partitioned for separate RH and LH airflow positions. Therefore, the airflow mode will
always remain similar for the RH and LH sides of the vehicle regardless of the temperatures
selected.
Air enters the passenger compartment from the following outlets: Instrument panel registers
- Floor duct outlets
- Windshield defroster
- Side window demisters
- Rear footwell duct
- Center console registers
Passenger compartment air is exhausted from the vehicle through open windows or body air vents.
Cabin Air Filter
A cabin air filter is available as standard equipment on dual-zone EATC vehicles.EMTC vehicles
are not equipped from the factory with a cabin air filter, but are equipped with a screen in place of
the filter to prevent any large foreign material from entering the heater core and evaporator core
housing. The cabin air filter or screen can be accessed by removing the glove compartment and
removing the cabin air filter access cover. A cabin air filter can be installed as a dealer accessory
on vehicles not originally equipped with a filter, but only a screen or a filter should be used, never
both.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Cabin Air Filter > Component Information > Locations > Page 1399
Cabin Air Filter: Service and Repair
Cabin Air Filter
A cabin air filter is available as standard equipment on dual-zone EATC vehicles.EMTC vehicles
are not equipped from the factory with a cabin air filter, but are equipped with a screen in place of
the filter to prevent any large foreign material from entering the heater core and evaporator core
housing. The cabin air filter or screen can be accessed by removing the glove compartment and
removing the cabin air filter access cover. A cabin air filter can be installed as a dealer accessory
on vehicles not originally equipped with a filter, but only a screen or a filter should be used, never
both.
Air Inlet Duct
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the heater core and evaporator core housing. For additional information, 2. Disconnect
the air inlet mode door actuator electrical connector. 3. Remove the cabin air filter cover and the
cabin air filter (if equipped) or air inlet screen (if equipped) 4. Remove the 5 fresh air inlet duct
screws. 5. Detach the 4 fresh air inlet duct clips and remove the fresh air inlet duct. 6. Remove the
7 air inlet duct screws. 7. Remove the air inlet duct. 8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Evaporative Canister Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Evaporative Canister Filter: Service and Repair
DUST SEPARATOR
Removal and Installation
1. The dust separator is serviced as part of the evaporative emission (EVAP) canister vent
solenoid.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure Release > System Information > Service and
Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELEASE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
WARNING:
- Do not carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any fuel-related
components. Highly flammable vapors are always present and can ignite. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, which may cause personal injury
or a fire hazard.
1. Remove the Schrader valve cap.
2. NOTE: This step will drain some fuel out of the system. Place the fuel in a suitable container.
Install the special tool and slowly open the manual valve to relieve the fuel system pressure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor to Condenser Discharge Line
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Compressor to Condenser Discharge Line
COMPRESSOR TO CONDENSER DISCHARGE LINE
Removal and Installation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor to Condenser Discharge Line > Page 1412
NOTE:
- The O-ring seals used on this vehicle are not interchangeable with all similarly sized O-ring seals
used on other Ford products. Use only the O-ring seals specified for this vehicle in the Ford master
parts catalog.
- Installation of a new receiver/drier desiccant bag is not required when repairing the A/C system
except when there is physical evidence of system contamination from a failed A/C compressor or
damage to the receiver/drier desiccant bag.
- The compressor-to-condenser discharge line consists of 2 separately serviceable lines. If only
one line is to be removed, only carry out the steps qualified for that line.
Both compressor-to-condenser discharge lines
1. Recover the refrigerant. 2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 3. Remove the
compressor-to-condenser discharge line fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
Condenser side compressor-to-condenser discharge line
4. Remove the front bumper cover. 5. Drain the engine coolant. 6. Release the upper radiator hose
clamp and disconnect the upper radiator hose from the radiator. 7. Remove the engine cooling fan.
8. Remove the compressor-to-condenser discharge line bracket bolt.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
9. Disconnect the A/C pressure transducer electrical connector.
10. Detach the 2 radiator brackets from the core support and position the radiator rearward. 11.
Remove the condenser inlet fitting bolt and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
12. Detach the compressor-to-condenser discharge line-to-radiator clip. 13. Remove the condenser
side compressor-to-condenser discharge line.
Compressor side compressor-to-condenser discharge line
14. Remove the drive belt from the A/C compressor pulley. 15. Disconnect the clutch field coil
electrical connector. 16. Remove the compressor-to-condenser discharge line bracket nut. 17.
Remove the A/C compressor discharge fitting bolt and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
18. Remove the compressor-to-condenser discharge line.
Both compressor-to-condenser discharge lines
19. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new O-ring seals lubricated in clean PAG oil.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
20. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor to Condenser Discharge Line > Page 1413
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Condenser to Evaporator Line
CONDENSER TO EVAPORATOR LINE
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor to Condenser Discharge Line > Page 1414
Removal and Installation
NOTE:
- The O-ring seals used on this vehicle are not interchangeable with all similarly sized O-ring seals
used on other Ford products. Use only the O-ring seals specified for this vehicle in the Ford master
parts catalog.
- Installation of a new receiver/drier desiccant bag is not required when repairing the A/C system
except when there is physical evidence of system contamination from a failed A/C compressor or
damage to the receiver/drier desiccant bag.
- The condenser-to-evaporator line consists of 2 separately serviceable lines. If only one line is to
be removed, only carry out the steps qualified for that line.
Both condenser-to-evaporator lines
1. Recover the refrigerant. 2. Disconnect the condenser-to-evaporator line spring lock coupling.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
Condenser-side condenser-to-evaporator line
3. Remove the front bumper cover. 4. Drain the engine coolant. 5. Release the upper radiator hose
clamp at the radiator and disconnect the hose. 6. Remove the engine cooling fan. 7. Remove the
condenser-to-evaporator line bracket bolt.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
8. Release the 2 radiator bracket clips from the radiator support and position the radiator rearward.
9. Remove the condenser outlet fitting bolt and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
10. Detach the condenser-to-evaporator line radiator clip.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor to Condenser Discharge Line > Page 1415
11. Remove the condenser-side condenser-to-evaporator line.
Evaporator-side condenser-to-evaporator line
12. Remove evaporator outlet line.
13. Remove the 3 coolant reservoir bolts and position the coolant reservoir aside.
14. Remove the 2 power steering reservoir nuts and position the reservoir aside.
15. Detach the 2 wire harness retainers at the RH shock tower.
16. Remove the ground bolt at the RH shock tower.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor to Condenser Discharge Line > Page 1416
17. Disconnect the RH front wheel speed sensor electrical connector. 18. Detach the 2
condenser-to-evaporator line clips. 19. Remove the evaporator-side condenser-to-evaporator line.
Both condenser-to-evaporator lines
20. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new O-ring seals lubricated in clean PAG oil.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
21. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor to Condenser Discharge Line > Page 1417
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Evaporator Outlet Line
EVAPORATOR OUTLET LINE
Removal and Installation
NOTE:
- The O-ring seals used on this vehicle are not interchangeable with all similarly sized O-ring seals
used on other Ford products. Use only the O-ring seals specified for this vehicle in the Ford master
parts catalog.
- Installation of a new receiver/drier desiccant bag is not required when repairing the A/C system
except when there is physical evidence of system contamination from a failed A/C compressor or
damage to the receiver/drier desiccant bag.
1. Recover the refrigerant. 2. Remove the ground strap nut at the RH shock tower. 3. Remove the
evaporator outlet line bracket stud bolt.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
4. Disconnect the evaporator outlet line spring lock coupling.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
5. Remove the thermostatic expansion valve (TXV) fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
6. Remove the evaporator outlet line. 7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new O-ring seals lubricated in clean PAG oil.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Compressor to Condenser Discharge Line > Page 1418
8. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 07-25-14 > Dec > 07 > Steering - Leaks From
Steering Rack/Pump Areas
Power Steering Line/Hose: Customer Interest Steering - Leaks From Steering Rack/Pump Areas
TSB 07-25-14
12/24/07
POWER STEERING FLUID LEAKS FROM STEERING RACK AND PUMP ATTACHMENT
JOINTS
FORD: 2006-2008 Fusion 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2006 Zephyr 2007-2008 MKZ, MKX
MERCURY: 2006-2008 Milan
This article supersedes TSB 07-1-3 to update vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some 2006-2008 Fusion and Milan, 2006 Zephyr, 2007-2008 MKZ and 2007-2008 Edge
and MKX vehicles may exhibit a small power steering fluid leak at the line attachment areas of the
rack or the pump.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Replace the banjo bolt and the two (2) sealing washers following Workshop Manual, Section
211-02 using the service kit.
2. One (1) kit is used for one (1) joint (either pump or gear).
3. Joint must be torqued with a hand torque wrench to:
a. Fusion, Milan, Zephyr, and MKZ:
(1) Pump 35 lb-ft (47 N.m).
(2) Gear 41 lb-ft (55 N.m).
b. Edge and MKX:
(1) Pump 35 lb-ft (47 N.m).
(2) Gear 35 lb-ft (47 N.m).
NOTE
THIS NEW BANJO BOLT HAS A HIGHER TORQUE RATING TO ACHIEVE A HIGHER CLAMP
LOAD.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072514A 2006 Fusion, Milan, 0.6 Hr.
Zephyr, 2007-2008 Fusion
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 07-25-14 > Dec > 07 > Steering - Leaks From
Steering Rack/Pump Areas > Page 1427
Milan 2.3L: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear Or Power
Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
3674A5)
072514B 2006 Fusion, Milan, 0.7 Hr.
Zephyr, 2007-2008 Fusion Milan 2.3L: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH
Steering Gear And The Power Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System
(Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514C 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan 0.6 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Power Steering Pump. Includes
Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514D 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan 0.8 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear. Includes Time To
Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514E 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan, 0.9 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH Steering Gear And The Power
Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
3674A5)
072514F 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.5 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers on The Power Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill
And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514G 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.6 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear. Includes Time To Fill And
Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 07-25-14 > Dec > 07 > Steering - Leaks From
Steering Rack/Pump Areas > Page 1428
3674A5)
072514H 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.7 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH Steering Gear And The Power Steering
Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A 3674A5)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3A705 24
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 07-25-14 > Dec > 07 > Steering - Leaks
From Steering Rack/Pump Areas
Power Steering Line/Hose: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Leaks From Steering
Rack/Pump Areas
TSB 07-25-14
12/24/07
POWER STEERING FLUID LEAKS FROM STEERING RACK AND PUMP ATTACHMENT
JOINTS
FORD: 2006-2008 Fusion 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2006 Zephyr 2007-2008 MKZ, MKX
MERCURY: 2006-2008 Milan
This article supersedes TSB 07-1-3 to update vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some 2006-2008 Fusion and Milan, 2006 Zephyr, 2007-2008 MKZ and 2007-2008 Edge
and MKX vehicles may exhibit a small power steering fluid leak at the line attachment areas of the
rack or the pump.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Replace the banjo bolt and the two (2) sealing washers following Workshop Manual, Section
211-02 using the service kit.
2. One (1) kit is used for one (1) joint (either pump or gear).
3. Joint must be torqued with a hand torque wrench to:
a. Fusion, Milan, Zephyr, and MKZ:
(1) Pump 35 lb-ft (47 N.m).
(2) Gear 41 lb-ft (55 N.m).
b. Edge and MKX:
(1) Pump 35 lb-ft (47 N.m).
(2) Gear 35 lb-ft (47 N.m).
NOTE
THIS NEW BANJO BOLT HAS A HIGHER TORQUE RATING TO ACHIEVE A HIGHER CLAMP
LOAD.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072514A 2006 Fusion, Milan, 0.6 Hr.
Zephyr, 2007-2008 Fusion
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 07-25-14 > Dec > 07 > Steering - Leaks
From Steering Rack/Pump Areas > Page 1434
Milan 2.3L: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear Or Power
Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
3674A5)
072514B 2006 Fusion, Milan, 0.7 Hr.
Zephyr, 2007-2008 Fusion Milan 2.3L: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH
Steering Gear And The Power Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System
(Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514C 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan 0.6 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Power Steering Pump. Includes
Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514D 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan 0.8 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear. Includes Time To
Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514E 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan, 0.9 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH Steering Gear And The Power
Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
3674A5)
072514F 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.5 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers on The Power Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill
And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514G 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.6 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear. Includes Time To Fill And
Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 07-25-14 > Dec > 07 > Steering - Leaks
From Steering Rack/Pump Areas > Page 1435
3674A5)
072514H 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.7 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH Steering Gear And The Power Steering
Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A 3674A5)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3A705 24
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose
Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose
Material
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
contaminants or premature failure of the power steering components can result.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Using a suitable suction device, siphon the power steering
fluid from the power steering fluid reservoir. 3. Remove the 4 pushpin retainers and the RH splash
shield.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose > Page 1438
4. Release the clamp and disconnect the power steering fluid cooler hose from the return line. 5.
Release the clamp and disconnect the return hose from the return line at the steering gear. 6.
Remove the 2 power steering return hose bracket-to-subframe bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Fill the power steering system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose > Page 1439
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure
Line
Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure Line
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose > Page 1440
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: When repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
contaminants or premature failure of the power steering components can result.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Using a suitable suction device, siphon the power steering
fluid from the power steering fluid reservoir. 3. Remove the power steering pressure line banjo bolt
and disconnect the line from the power steering gear.
^ Discard the 2 seals.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (44 ft. lbs).
4. Release the clamp and disconnect the return hose from the steering gear. 5. Release the clamp
and disconnect the return hose from the return line. 6. Remove the 3 power steering line
bracket-to-steering gear bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
7. Remove the power steering pressure line banjo bolt and disconnect the line from the power
steering pump.
^ Discard the 2 seals.
^ To install, tighten to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs).
8. To install, reverse removal procedure.
^ Fill the power steering system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Specifications
Brake Fluid: Specifications
BRAKE FLUID
Motorcraft High Performance DOT 3 Motor Vehicle Brake Fluid
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
................................................................... PM-1-C Ford Specification ..............................................
.......................................................................................................................................
WSS-M6C62-A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion
Technical Service Bulletin # 09M04S1 Date: 100331
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page 1453
Attachment I - Administrative Information
OASIS ACTIVATED?
Yes, OASIS will be activated on November 10, 2009.
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED? No
STOCK VEHICLES
Do not perform this program unless the affected vehicle exhibits the covered condition.
SOLD VEHICLES
Only owners with affected vehicles that exhibit the covered condition will be directed to dealers for
repairs.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition, call the
Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page 1454
NOTE:
Heater core replacement should not be necessary if the flush is performed properly. Prior approval
is required to replace the heater core.
ADDITIONAL LABOR TIME
^ If a condition exists that requires additional labor to complete the repair, call the Special Service
Support Center to request approval prior to performing any additional labor. Requests for approval
after completion of the repair will not be granted.
^ If you encounter aftermarket equipment or modifications to the vehicle which might prevent the
repair of the covered condition, call the Special Service Support Center.
OWNER REFUNDS
^ Ford Motor Company will only refund owner-paid repairs covered by this program if the repair
was performed prior to the date of the Customer Notification Letter (or after the date of the letter if
an emergency repair was made away from the servicing dealer). Non-covered repairs, or those
judged by Ford to be excessive, will not be reimbursed.
^ Refunds will only be provided for the cost associated with the diagnosis and replacement of the
heater core and/or cooling system flush related to reduced heater performance.
^ Vehicles that have had a heater core replacement or cooling system flush and are experiencing
reduced heater performance will need to have this service performed, beginning with the heater
performance evaluation.
^ Multiple refunds should be submitted on one repair line and the invoice details for each repair
should be detailed in the comments section of the claim. If a repair is performed on the same visit,
the repair and refunds should be submitted on separate repair lines.
^ The refund period for repairs performed prior to the date of the Customer Notification Letter will
expire on May 31 2010.
^ Refund Claiming Information (submit on separate repair line).
- Program Code: 09M04 - Misc. Expense: ADMIN - 0.2 Hrs.
- Misc. Expense: REFUND
RENTAL VEHICLES
The use of rental vehicles is not authorized for this program.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Refund or related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line
on which the FSA is claimed. Related damage requires prior approval from the Special Service
Support Center.
^ "MT" labor should be submitted on a separate repair line with the related damage flag checked.
"MT" labor requires prior approval from the Special Service Support Center.
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
^ Claiming information for 5 gallons of distilled water up to $1 .25 per gallon (submit as Misc.
Expense code "OTHER" on the same repair line as the repair).
^ Program Code: 09M04
Misc. Expense: OTHER for actual cost, not to exceed $6.25 maximum
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page 1455
LABOR ALLOWANCES
PARTS REQUIREMENTS / ORDERING INFORMATION
Order your parts requirements through normal order processing channels.
The DOR/COR number for this program is 50410.
Questions regarding parts should be directed to the Special Service Support Center or E-mailed.
DEALER PRICE
For latest prices, refer to DOES II.
PARTS RETENTION AND RETURN
Affected water pump inlet tubes and heater cores are subject to random selection for return to the
Ford Warranty Parts Analysis Center (WPAC). Refer to your daily PEARS (Parts Entry and Return
System) register for part disposition and return instructions.
Follow the provisions of the Warranty and Policy Manual for "Parts Retention and Return
Procedures."
Overview
OVERVIEW
In some of the affected vehicles, cooling system corrosion may lead to contamination of the heater
core. This contamination may, over time, lead to reduced heater performance.
This service procedure is very extensive and detailed. Listed below are the sections of the service
procedure along with highlights of important information.
VERIFICATION
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page 1456
^ Measure temperature difference in the center vents
^ If greater than 15° F (8° C), proceed to the service procedure
^ If less than 15° F (8° C), follow normal WSM diagnosis
EQUIPMENT LIST
^ Rotunda Tool Kit # 303-1525
^ Additional equipment needed
WATER PUMP INLET TUBE
^ Replace the water pump inlet tube if the engine build date is on or before 4/1/2008
^ Do NOT replace the water pump inlet tube, if the engine build date is on or after 4/2/2008
PRE-RINSE
^ Removes old coolant from the cooling system
^ Coolant MUST NOT mix with the VC-11 flush chemical
VC-11 FLUSH
^ Removes contamination from the cooling system
^ VC-11 flush chemical temperature has to be between 135° F (57° C) and 150° F (65° C) for
optimum cleaning performance
POST-RINSE AND FILL
^ Removes VC-11 from the cooling system
^ VC-11 flush chemical MUST NOT mix with the new coolant
Necessary to use 5 gallons of distilled water for the final system fill
Verification
VERIFY THE CUSTOMER CONCERN BY PERFORMING THE FOLLOWING HEATER
PERFORMANCE EVALUATION
1. Idle the engine at shop ambient temperature of 60° F (15° C) or higher, until the engine is fully
warmed up.
2. Set the front climate temperature control to the hottest setting.
3. Set the mode to panel/vent (with all vents OPEN) and make sure the A/C is switched to the OFF
position. Do NOT set the temperature control to the
recirculation mode.
4. Set the blower to the highest speed.
5. Idle the engine for 5 minutes with the hood closed.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page 1457
6. Measure the difference in the discharge air temperature between the left-center vent and the
right center vent as shown. The difference should be less
than 15° F (8° C) to meet the performance requirement.
If the temperature DIFFERENCE IS LESS than 15° F (8° C), continue with normal Workshop
Manual (WSM) diagnostic procedures. Do NOT proceed with this Service Procedure.
If the temperature DIFFERENCE IS MORE than 15° F (8° C), continue to the Service Procedure.
Service Procedure
NOTICE:
ALL STEPS OF THIS SERVICE PROCEDURE MUST BE COMPLETED IN ORDER TO
PROPERLY CLEAN THE COOLING SYSTEM. FAILURE TO FOLLOW THESE STEPS WILL
COPROMISE COOLANT PROTECTION CAPABILITY.
NOTE:
This procedure must be performed at an ambient temperature between 60°F (15° C) and 90° F
(32° C) for proper utilization of the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11.
NOTE:
Dispose of Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture in the same way as
coolant in accordance with local, state and federal laws.
EQUIPMENT LIST
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page 1458
NOTE:
Before starting this service procedure make sure that you have the equipment listed.
NOTE:
The dealer bulletin contains the parts list for this service procedure (see Attachment II)
Necessary equipment for the cooling system flush:
1. Rotunda Tool Kit #303-1525
2. Two large radiator hose pinch-off pliers (not supplied with the tool kit)
3. One clean 5 gallon bucket (not supplied with the tool kit)
4. An infrared thermometer or equivalent (not supplied with the tool kit)
5. Safety equipment (eye protection and chemical gloves, not supplied with the tool kit)
6. AirLift Cooling Tester UVU-550000 (not shown, formerly Radkit Plus)
7. Shop water supply hose (not shown)
8. Radiator drain pan (not shown)
WATER PUMP INLET TUBE
NOTE:
Dispose of old coolant in accordance with local state and federal laws.
NOTE:
On some of the affected vehicles the water pump inlet tube is painted on the inside surface. The
flushing chemicals will remove the paint and contaminate the cooling system and components.
1. Place a drain pan under the radiator drain valve and completely drain the cooling system through
the radiator drain (degas bottle cap should be loose
for proper draining).
2. Remove the air cleaner as an assembly.
^ Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector.
^ Loosen the clamp and disconnect the air cleaner assembly outlet pipe from the air cleaner
assembly.
^ Remove the air cleaner assembly bolts.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page 1459
^ Separate the 2 air cleaner assembly feet from the rubber grommets.
3. NOTE: The engine build date is on the engine code label, located on the RH cam cover or the
front cover The date is positioned in the center of the
label in a date/month/year sequence
Locate and check the engine build date See Figure 1.
If the engine build date is ON or AFTER 4/2/2008, the water pump inlet tube does NOT need to be
replaced Proceed to Step 11.
If the engine build date is ON or BEFORE 4/1/2008, it will be necessary to replace the water pump
inlet tube Proceed to Step 4.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page 1460
4. Remove the coolant hoses from the thermostat housing. See Figure 2.
5. Remove the 3 thermostat housing bolts.
6. Separate the thermostat housing from the water pump inlet tube.
7. NOTE: The water pump inlet tube orientation can be determined by the length of the radius at
the ends of the tube The longer radius end is Inserted
Into the water pump housing. See Figure 3.
Remove the water pump inlet tube from the water pump housing using a slight twisting motion The
inlet tube must be replaced with a new inlet tube without paint on the interior surface of the tube.
8. Lubricate the new water pump inlet tube O-ring with clean engine coolant.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page 1461
9. Install the new water pump inlet tube into the water pump housing.
10. Install the thermostat housing.
^ Lubricate the thermostat housing 0-ring with clean engine coolant.
^ Install the thermostat housing and 3 housing bolts. Tighten the bolts to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
^ Install the coolant hoses to the thermostat housing EXCEPT for the heater core inlet and outlet
hoses See Figure 2.
PRE-RINSE
NOTE:
The pinch-off pliers are used to control the direction of fluids in certain areas of the cooling system
They are also used for optimum cleaning and to prevent air from entering Into the cooling system.
11. If the water pump inlet tube was NOT replaced disconnect both the heater core inlet and outlet
hoses from the thermostat housing. See Figure 4.
12. Remove the 2 thermostat housing cover bolts and remove the thermostat.
13.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page 1462
Position the flush tool kit plug into the thermostat housing to control the flow and thermostat
housing cover, and bolts Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in). See Figure 6.
14. NOTICE:
With the heater core inlet and outlet hoses off from step 11:
^ Connect the heater core inlet hose (1B - lower hose) to the heater return port (upper port) on the
thermostat housing.
^ Connect the flush tool kit drain hose to the heater core inlet port on the thermostat housing.
^ Connect the flush tool kit hose-to-pump to the heater core outlet hose (OB) for the reverse
flushing.
15. Route the flush tool kit drain and fill hoses under the thermostat housing and out of the engine
compartment Make sure that the hoses are NOT
kinked.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page 1463
16.NOTICE: To prevent any damage to the flush tool kit drain and fill hoses place shop towels
between the radiator shroud and the hoses.
Position several shop towels between the hoses and the radiator shroud See Figure 8.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page 1464
17. Place the flush tool kit pump onto a tool cart in front of the vehicle. Connect the fill hose from
the heater core outlet to the pump. See Figure 9.
18. Position the flush tool kit 5 gallon bucket onto the tool cart along side the pump. See Figure 9.
19. Reinstall the air cleaner assembly and connect the MAF electrical connector. It is NOT
necessary to secure the air cleaner assembly at this time.
20. NOTE: For measuring purposes it is recommended to use a clean 5 gallon shop bucket. Place
a separate empty 5 gallon shop bucket on the floor in
front of the vehicle. See Figure 9.
21. Place the flush tool kit drain hose from the heater core inlet port on the thermostat housing into
the empty bucket on the floor. See Figure 9.
22. Install the tool kit water valve onto the shop fresh water supply hose. Completely fill the cooling
system through the degas bottle with fresh water
until the water flows from the radiator drain.
(NEW!) 23. Allow the radiator to completely drain. Close the radiator drain and install the degas
bottle cap.
24. NOTE: The pinch-off pliers are used to control the direction of fluids in certain areas of the
cooling system. They are also used for optimum
cleaning and to prevent air from entering into the cooling system.
NOTE:
If the vehicle is being lifted to install and remove the lower radiator hose pinch-off pliers the flush
tool kit pump must be secured onto the radiator shroud while lifting.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page 1465
Position and clamp the pinchoff pliers onto the upper radiator hose (see Figure 10) and the lower
radiator hose (see Figure 11) as close to the radiator as possible.
25. Place the flush tool kit suction hose from the pump into one of the small holes in the lid of the
flush tool kit bucket that is along side of the pump.
The hose MUST be kept a minimum of 2 inches from the bottom of the tool kit bucket.
26. Using the shop fresh water supply, fill the flush tool kit bucket with fresh water. Use the tool kit
valve attached to the shop fresh water supply hose
to maintain the water level in the tool kit bucket.
27. Connect a shop air supply to the pump, with the fresh water supply on, and maintain the water
level in the tool kit bucket.
28. NOTE: Do NOT allow the tool kit supply bucket to become low or empty. This will introduce air
into the cooling system and cause an overheating
condition
With the fresh water supply on, monitor and maintain the water level in the tool kit bucket.
29. NOTE: Dispose of old coolant and flushing water contaminated with antifreeze in accordance
with local, state and federal laws.
Allow a minimum of 10 gallons of water to flush through the engine and out the drain hose into the
shop bucket on the floor. It will be necessary to disconnect the shop air supply from the pump to
eliminate the water flow from the drain hose while emptying the shop bucket.
30. After a minimum of 10 gallons of water has flushed through the engine, disconnect the shop air
from the pump and turn off the fresh water supply.
31. Remove the tool kit bucket lid and empty the bucket.
VC-11 FLUSH
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page 1466
32. NOTE: Both the suction and drain hoses MUST be kept a minimum of 2 inches from the bottom
of the tool kit bucket. This will prevent any air
from entering into the cooling system and causing an overheating condition.
Reposition the drain hose from the 5 gallon bucket on the floor into one of the small holes in the lid
of the flush tool kit bucket on the tool cart. See Figure 12.
33. Remove the pinchoff pliers from upper and lower radiator hoses.
34. Install the pinchoff pliers onto the flush tool kit drain and suction hose closest to the flush tool kit
bucket lid. See Figure 13.
35. WARNING: THE USE OF SAFETY EQUIPMENT SUCH AS EYE PROTECTION AND
CHEMICAL GLOVES IS REQUIRED FAILURE TO
FOLLOW THESE INSTRUCTIONS MAY RESULT IN SERIOUS PERSONAL INJURY.
NOTICE: Bring the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11 to room temperature of
68° F (20° C) and shake well Follow all of the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC1 1
instructions and Precautions.
Add 2 gallons of Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11 to the flush tool kit bucket
that is on the tool cart Do not dilute the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11 in the
flush tool kit bucket
(NEW!) 36. NOTICE: It is necessary to use the AirLift Cooling Tester UVU-550000 (formerly Radkit
Plus) to remove any air from the cooling system.
If air remains in the cooling system, the air will inhibit the circulation of the Motorcraft(R) Engine
Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture and will cause an overheating condition and possible
damage to the engine.
Rinse the shop bucket and fill with fresh water Place the shop bucket so that the fill hose from the
AirLift Cooling Tester UVU-550000 (formerly Radkit Plus) will siphon the fresh water out of the
bucket. Install the AirLift Cooling Tester UVU-550000 onto the degas bottle.
37. Remove the AirLift Cooling Tester UVU-550000 from the degas bottle and install the degas
bottle cap Make sure that the degas bottle is filled to 1
inch (25 mm) above the COLD FILL LEVEL.
38. Remove the pinch-off pliers from both hoses at the flush tool kit bucket.
39. Position one of the pinch-off pliers onto the upper radiator hose closest to the radiator.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page 1467
40. Connect shop air supply to the tool kit pump. The pump will start to siphon the Motorcraft(R)
Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11 from the
bucket into the engine.
41. NOTICE:
With the heater in the OFF position start the engine and idle until the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling
System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture temperature reaches 140° F (60° C) Monitor the
Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture temperature using an infrared
thermometer or equivalent in the flush tool kit bucket.
42. When the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture temperature
reaches 140° F (60° C) remove the pinch-off pliers
from the upper radiator hose.
43. Disconnect the A/C high pressure cut-off switch electrical connector This will activate the
engine cooling fans. It may take a few seconds until the
cooling fans come on See Figure 14.
44.
NOTICE:
Make sure that the radiator is NOT obstructed for maximum air flow Any deflection of air may
cause an overheating condition.
NOTICE:
The Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC11/water mixture temperature MUST NOT
EXCEED 15° F (65° C) or damage to the
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page 1468
engine may occur. If the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture
temperature EXCEEDS 150° F (65° C), the heater blower motor can be turned ON to reduce the
mixtures temperature If the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture
temperature STILL EXCEEDS 150° F (65° C), the engine MUST be turned OFF and the key left
ON. The key MUST remain on for the operation of the heater blower motor to allow the engine to
cool down.
Continue the flush using the flush tool kit pump, circulating the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling
System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture through the cooling system.
NOTICE:
Do NOT allow the degas bottle to run low or empty This will allow air to enter the cooling system
and will cause an overheating condition and prevent the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System
Cleaner VC-11/water mixture from circulating through the entire engine and cooling system.
(NEW!) NOTE:
Allow the engine to idle for a MINIMUM of 2 hours The Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System
Cleaner VC11/water mixture temperature MUST remain between 135° F (57° C) to 150° F (65° C)
NOTE:
To control any odor from the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture
during the flush install a shop exhaust hose into the lid of the tool kit bucket.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page 1469
To control any odor from the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture it
is recommended to install a shop exhaust hose into the lid of the tool kit bucket. See Figure 16.
45. EVERY half hour monitor the degas bottle for the correct level and measure the temperature in
the tool kit bucket. DO NOT allow the
Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture to get below the COLD FILL
LEVEL. If necessary, release cooling system pressure by loosening the degas bottle cap slowly
allowing air to escape and the degas bottle to fill to 1 inch (25 mm) above the COLD FILL LEVEL.
46. After the engine has idled for a MINIMUM of 2 hours, turn the engine OFF and leave the key in
the ON position. Turn the heater blower motor ON
and select the highest blower speed.
47. Continue flushing until the cooling system cleaner/water mixture reaches 120° F (49° C) with
the heater blower motor on high. The temperature can
be identified using an infrared thermometer or equivalent to monitor the mixture temperature in the
flush tool kit bucket.
48. Disconnect shop air from the flush tool kit pump.
49. Turn the ignition key OFF.
50. Connect the A/C High Pressure switch and the cooling fan motor electrical connector (if
disconnected).
POST-RINSE AND FILL
WARNING:
THE USE OF SAFETY EQUIPMENT SUCH AS EYE PROTECTION AND CHEMICAL GLOVES IS
REQUIRED FAILURE TO FOLLOW THESE INSTRUCTIONS MAY RESULT IN SERIOUS
PERSONAL INJURY
51. NOTE: Dispose of Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture in the
same way as coolant in accordance with local, state
and federal laws.
Empty and rinse the flush tool kit bucket, and then fill with fresh water.
52. Using caution, slowly open and remove the degas bottle cap.
53. Using caution, open the radiator drain.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page 1470
54. NOTE: Dispose of Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture in the
same way as coolant in accordance with local, state
and federal laws.
Allow the radiator to drain completely (degas bottle cap should be OFF).
55. Fill the degas bottle completely with fresh water and allow the radiator to drain.
(NEW!) 56. Close the radiator drain and install the degas bottle cap.
57. Place an empty 5 gallon bucket on the floor in front of the vehicle.
58. Remove the flush tool kit drain hose from the flush tool kit bucket and place the drain hose into
the empty shop bucket.
59. Install pinch-off pliers on the upper and lower radiator hoses as close to the radiator outlets as
possible. See Figure 10 and Figure 11.
60. NOTICE: Do NOT allow the flush tool kit bucket to run low or empty during the post-rinse and
fill procedure. This will allow air to enter into the
cooling system and cause an overheating condition.
Keep the fresh water hose in the tool kit bucket and monitor the water level. Do not allow the
bucket to run low or empty.
61. Connect air supply to the pump.
62. Allow a minimum of 10 gallons of water to flush through the engine and out the drain hose into
the shop bucket on the floor. It will be necessary to
disconnect the shop air supply from the pump to eliminate the water flow from the drain hose while
emptying the shop bucket.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page 1471
63. NOTE: Remove ONLY the pinch-off pliers from the lower radiator hose in this step. Remove the
pinch-off pliers from the lower radiator hose.
64. NOTICE: Distilled water must be used for the final 5 gallon flush and fill.
After flushing the system with a minimum of 10 gallons of fresh shop water, continue the flush
using an additional 5 gallons of distilled water.
65. Remove the pinch-off pliers from the upper radiator hose.
66. Remove air supply from flush tool kit pump.
67. Disconnect the flush tool kit suction hose from the pump and remove the drain hose from the
shop bucket. Move the tool cart with the bucket and
pump aside.
68. Remove the degas bottle cap.
69. NOTE: Dispose of Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture in the
same way as coolant in accordance with local, state
and federal laws.
Open the radiator drain and completely drain the radiator.
70. Close the radiator drain.
71. Remove the Air Cleaner Assembly.
72. NOTE: A black residue may be evident after the flushing procedure. This is a normal condition
and requires NO action.
Remove the heater core inlet hose from the heater return port on the thermostat housing.
73. Remove the drain hose from the heater core inlet port on the thermostat housing.
74. Remove the thermostat housing cover and remove the flush tool kit plug.
75. Install the thermostat and housing cover. Tighten the bolts to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
76. Install the heater core inlet and outlet hoses onto the thermostat housing See Figure 17.
77. Install the Air Cleaner Assembly
^ Install the air cleaner assembly into the rubber grommets
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page 1472
^ Install the air cleaner assembly bolt and tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
^ Connect the air cleaner assembly outlet pipe and tighten the clamp to 5 Nm (44 lb-in)
^ Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector
78. NOTICE:
Using the AirLift Cooling Tester UVU-550000 (formerly Radkit Plus), add 5.8 qts (5.5 L) for base
models and 6.3 qts (6.0 L) for trailer tow models (vehicles equipped with an oil cooler) of 100%
pure concentrated coolant. Use concentrated coolant, Motorcraft(R) Specialty Green Engine
Coolant VC-10-A2 (US) or CVC-10-A (Canada) to the cooling system. Continue with the purge of
air from the system until the coolant reaches 1 inch (25 mm) above the COLD FILL LEVEL.
The recommended coolant concentration is 50/50 or -34° F (-36° C) using Motorcraft(R) Specialty
Green Engine Coolant VC-10-A2 (US) or CVC-10-A (Canada) to distilled water, as measured with
a hydrometer or equivalent.
^ Maximum coolant concentration is 60/40, -60° F (-51° C) for cold weather areas.
^ Minimum coolant concentration is 40/60, -20° F (-29° C) for warm weather areas.
79. Turn the heater to OFF.
WARNING:
ALWAYS ALLOW THE ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE OPENING THE COOLING SYSTEM DO
NOT UNSCREW THE COOLANT PRESSURE RELIEF CAP WHEN THE ENGINE IS
OPERATING OR THE COOLING SYSTEM IS HOT THE COOLING SYSTEM MAY BE UNDER
PRESSURE; STEAM AND HOT LIQUID CAN COME OUT FORCEFULLY WHEN THE CAP IS
LOOSENED SLIGHTLY FAILURE TO FOLLOW THESE INSTRUCTIONS MAY RESULT IN
SERIOUS PERSONAL INJURY.
(NEW!) 80. Start the engine and increase the engine speed to rpm and hold for 30 seconds.
81. Turn the engine OFF and wait for 1 minute to purge any large air pockets from the cooling
system.
82. NOTE: Add concentrated coolant, Motorcraft(R) Specialty Green Engine Coolant VC-10-A2
(US) or CVC-10-A (Canada) to 1 inch (25 mm)
above the top of the COLD FILL LEVEL of the degas bottle.
Check the engine coolant level in the degas bottle and if necessary, fill to 1 inch (25 mm) above the
top of the COLD FILL LEVEL when warm or to the top of the COLD FILL LEVEL when cold using
concentrated coolant, Motorcraft(R) Specialty Green Engine Coolant VC-10-A2 (US) OR CVC-10-A
(Canada).
83. Start the engine and let idle until the engine reaches normal operating temperature and the
thermostat is fully open. A fully open thermostat can be
verified by the radiator cooling fan cycling on at least once.
84. With the engine ON, thermostat open and the cooling fans cycled at least once, increase the
engine speed to 3,500 rpm and hold for 30 seconds.
Then allow the engine to idle for 30 seconds.
85. Turn the engine OFF and wait for 1 minute.
86. Repeat Steps 84 and 85 a total of 5 TIMES to remove any remaining air trapped in the system.
87. NOTE: Add concentrated coolant, Motorcraft(R) Specialty Green Engine Coolant VC-10-A2
(US) or CVC-10-A (Canada) to 1 inch (25 mm)
above the top of the COLD FILL RANGE of the degas bottle.
Check the engine coolant level in the degas bottle, and if necessary, fill to 1 inch (25 mm) above
the top of the COLD FILL LEVEL with the engine warm or to the top of the COLD FILL LEVEL with
the engine cold using concentrated coolant, Motorcraft(R) Specialty Green Engine Coolant
VC-10-A2 (US) or CVC-10-A (Canada).
88. Make sure the degas bottle cap is installed to at least one audible "click."
89. Overlay the new cooling system label onto the degas bottle cap that has been provided by
service management.
90. Using the IDS, clear any codes that may have been set during the flush procedure.
91. Service management will provide the Customer Information Sheet to the customer for insertion
into vehicle's Owner Guide. This Customer
Information Sheet will remind the customer that a revised type of coolant has been installed in their
vehicle and will need to be used from this point forward.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page 1473
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page 1474
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page 1475
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page 1476
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion
Technical Service Bulletin # 09M04S1 Date: 100331
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
1482
Attachment I - Administrative Information
OASIS ACTIVATED?
Yes, OASIS will be activated on November 10, 2009.
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED? No
STOCK VEHICLES
Do not perform this program unless the affected vehicle exhibits the covered condition.
SOLD VEHICLES
Only owners with affected vehicles that exhibit the covered condition will be directed to dealers for
repairs.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition, call the
Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
1483
NOTE:
Heater core replacement should not be necessary if the flush is performed properly. Prior approval
is required to replace the heater core.
ADDITIONAL LABOR TIME
^ If a condition exists that requires additional labor to complete the repair, call the Special Service
Support Center to request approval prior to performing any additional labor. Requests for approval
after completion of the repair will not be granted.
^ If you encounter aftermarket equipment or modifications to the vehicle which might prevent the
repair of the covered condition, call the Special Service Support Center.
OWNER REFUNDS
^ Ford Motor Company will only refund owner-paid repairs covered by this program if the repair
was performed prior to the date of the Customer Notification Letter (or after the date of the letter if
an emergency repair was made away from the servicing dealer). Non-covered repairs, or those
judged by Ford to be excessive, will not be reimbursed.
^ Refunds will only be provided for the cost associated with the diagnosis and replacement of the
heater core and/or cooling system flush related to reduced heater performance.
^ Vehicles that have had a heater core replacement or cooling system flush and are experiencing
reduced heater performance will need to have this service performed, beginning with the heater
performance evaluation.
^ Multiple refunds should be submitted on one repair line and the invoice details for each repair
should be detailed in the comments section of the claim. If a repair is performed on the same visit,
the repair and refunds should be submitted on separate repair lines.
^ The refund period for repairs performed prior to the date of the Customer Notification Letter will
expire on May 31 2010.
^ Refund Claiming Information (submit on separate repair line).
- Program Code: 09M04 - Misc. Expense: ADMIN - 0.2 Hrs.
- Misc. Expense: REFUND
RENTAL VEHICLES
The use of rental vehicles is not authorized for this program.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Refund or related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line
on which the FSA is claimed. Related damage requires prior approval from the Special Service
Support Center.
^ "MT" labor should be submitted on a separate repair line with the related damage flag checked.
"MT" labor requires prior approval from the Special Service Support Center.
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
^ Claiming information for 5 gallons of distilled water up to $1 .25 per gallon (submit as Misc.
Expense code "OTHER" on the same repair line as the repair).
^ Program Code: 09M04
Misc. Expense: OTHER for actual cost, not to exceed $6.25 maximum
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
1484
LABOR ALLOWANCES
PARTS REQUIREMENTS / ORDERING INFORMATION
Order your parts requirements through normal order processing channels.
The DOR/COR number for this program is 50410.
Questions regarding parts should be directed to the Special Service Support Center or E-mailed.
DEALER PRICE
For latest prices, refer to DOES II.
PARTS RETENTION AND RETURN
Affected water pump inlet tubes and heater cores are subject to random selection for return to the
Ford Warranty Parts Analysis Center (WPAC). Refer to your daily PEARS (Parts Entry and Return
System) register for part disposition and return instructions.
Follow the provisions of the Warranty and Policy Manual for "Parts Retention and Return
Procedures."
Overview
OVERVIEW
In some of the affected vehicles, cooling system corrosion may lead to contamination of the heater
core. This contamination may, over time, lead to reduced heater performance.
This service procedure is very extensive and detailed. Listed below are the sections of the service
procedure along with highlights of important information.
VERIFICATION
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
1485
^ Measure temperature difference in the center vents
^ If greater than 15° F (8° C), proceed to the service procedure
^ If less than 15° F (8° C), follow normal WSM diagnosis
EQUIPMENT LIST
^ Rotunda Tool Kit # 303-1525
^ Additional equipment needed
WATER PUMP INLET TUBE
^ Replace the water pump inlet tube if the engine build date is on or before 4/1/2008
^ Do NOT replace the water pump inlet tube, if the engine build date is on or after 4/2/2008
PRE-RINSE
^ Removes old coolant from the cooling system
^ Coolant MUST NOT mix with the VC-11 flush chemical
VC-11 FLUSH
^ Removes contamination from the cooling system
^ VC-11 flush chemical temperature has to be between 135° F (57° C) and 150° F (65° C) for
optimum cleaning performance
POST-RINSE AND FILL
^ Removes VC-11 from the cooling system
^ VC-11 flush chemical MUST NOT mix with the new coolant
Necessary to use 5 gallons of distilled water for the final system fill
Verification
VERIFY THE CUSTOMER CONCERN BY PERFORMING THE FOLLOWING HEATER
PERFORMANCE EVALUATION
1. Idle the engine at shop ambient temperature of 60° F (15° C) or higher, until the engine is fully
warmed up.
2. Set the front climate temperature control to the hottest setting.
3. Set the mode to panel/vent (with all vents OPEN) and make sure the A/C is switched to the OFF
position. Do NOT set the temperature control to the
recirculation mode.
4. Set the blower to the highest speed.
5. Idle the engine for 5 minutes with the hood closed.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
1486
6. Measure the difference in the discharge air temperature between the left-center vent and the
right center vent as shown. The difference should be less
than 15° F (8° C) to meet the performance requirement.
If the temperature DIFFERENCE IS LESS than 15° F (8° C), continue with normal Workshop
Manual (WSM) diagnostic procedures. Do NOT proceed with this Service Procedure.
If the temperature DIFFERENCE IS MORE than 15° F (8° C), continue to the Service Procedure.
Service Procedure
NOTICE:
ALL STEPS OF THIS SERVICE PROCEDURE MUST BE COMPLETED IN ORDER TO
PROPERLY CLEAN THE COOLING SYSTEM. FAILURE TO FOLLOW THESE STEPS WILL
COPROMISE COOLANT PROTECTION CAPABILITY.
NOTE:
This procedure must be performed at an ambient temperature between 60°F (15° C) and 90° F
(32° C) for proper utilization of the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11.
NOTE:
Dispose of Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture in the same way as
coolant in accordance with local, state and federal laws.
EQUIPMENT LIST
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
1487
NOTE:
Before starting this service procedure make sure that you have the equipment listed.
NOTE:
The dealer bulletin contains the parts list for this service procedure (see Attachment II)
Necessary equipment for the cooling system flush:
1. Rotunda Tool Kit #303-1525
2. Two large radiator hose pinch-off pliers (not supplied with the tool kit)
3. One clean 5 gallon bucket (not supplied with the tool kit)
4. An infrared thermometer or equivalent (not supplied with the tool kit)
5. Safety equipment (eye protection and chemical gloves, not supplied with the tool kit)
6. AirLift Cooling Tester UVU-550000 (not shown, formerly Radkit Plus)
7. Shop water supply hose (not shown)
8. Radiator drain pan (not shown)
WATER PUMP INLET TUBE
NOTE:
Dispose of old coolant in accordance with local state and federal laws.
NOTE:
On some of the affected vehicles the water pump inlet tube is painted on the inside surface. The
flushing chemicals will remove the paint and contaminate the cooling system and components.
1. Place a drain pan under the radiator drain valve and completely drain the cooling system through
the radiator drain (degas bottle cap should be loose
for proper draining).
2. Remove the air cleaner as an assembly.
^ Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector.
^ Loosen the clamp and disconnect the air cleaner assembly outlet pipe from the air cleaner
assembly.
^ Remove the air cleaner assembly bolts.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
1488
^ Separate the 2 air cleaner assembly feet from the rubber grommets.
3. NOTE: The engine build date is on the engine code label, located on the RH cam cover or the
front cover The date is positioned in the center of the
label in a date/month/year sequence
Locate and check the engine build date See Figure 1.
If the engine build date is ON or AFTER 4/2/2008, the water pump inlet tube does NOT need to be
replaced Proceed to Step 11.
If the engine build date is ON or BEFORE 4/1/2008, it will be necessary to replace the water pump
inlet tube Proceed to Step 4.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
1489
4. Remove the coolant hoses from the thermostat housing. See Figure 2.
5. Remove the 3 thermostat housing bolts.
6. Separate the thermostat housing from the water pump inlet tube.
7. NOTE: The water pump inlet tube orientation can be determined by the length of the radius at
the ends of the tube The longer radius end is Inserted
Into the water pump housing. See Figure 3.
Remove the water pump inlet tube from the water pump housing using a slight twisting motion The
inlet tube must be replaced with a new inlet tube without paint on the interior surface of the tube.
8. Lubricate the new water pump inlet tube O-ring with clean engine coolant.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
1490
9. Install the new water pump inlet tube into the water pump housing.
10. Install the thermostat housing.
^ Lubricate the thermostat housing 0-ring with clean engine coolant.
^ Install the thermostat housing and 3 housing bolts. Tighten the bolts to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
^ Install the coolant hoses to the thermostat housing EXCEPT for the heater core inlet and outlet
hoses See Figure 2.
PRE-RINSE
NOTE:
The pinch-off pliers are used to control the direction of fluids in certain areas of the cooling system
They are also used for optimum cleaning and to prevent air from entering Into the cooling system.
11. If the water pump inlet tube was NOT replaced disconnect both the heater core inlet and outlet
hoses from the thermostat housing. See Figure 4.
12. Remove the 2 thermostat housing cover bolts and remove the thermostat.
13.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
1491
Position the flush tool kit plug into the thermostat housing to control the flow and thermostat
housing cover, and bolts Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in). See Figure 6.
14. NOTICE:
With the heater core inlet and outlet hoses off from step 11:
^ Connect the heater core inlet hose (1B - lower hose) to the heater return port (upper port) on the
thermostat housing.
^ Connect the flush tool kit drain hose to the heater core inlet port on the thermostat housing.
^ Connect the flush tool kit hose-to-pump to the heater core outlet hose (OB) for the reverse
flushing.
15. Route the flush tool kit drain and fill hoses under the thermostat housing and out of the engine
compartment Make sure that the hoses are NOT
kinked.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
1492
16.NOTICE: To prevent any damage to the flush tool kit drain and fill hoses place shop towels
between the radiator shroud and the hoses.
Position several shop towels between the hoses and the radiator shroud See Figure 8.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
1493
17. Place the flush tool kit pump onto a tool cart in front of the vehicle. Connect the fill hose from
the heater core outlet to the pump. See Figure 9.
18. Position the flush tool kit 5 gallon bucket onto the tool cart along side the pump. See Figure 9.
19. Reinstall the air cleaner assembly and connect the MAF electrical connector. It is NOT
necessary to secure the air cleaner assembly at this time.
20. NOTE: For measuring purposes it is recommended to use a clean 5 gallon shop bucket. Place
a separate empty 5 gallon shop bucket on the floor in
front of the vehicle. See Figure 9.
21. Place the flush tool kit drain hose from the heater core inlet port on the thermostat housing into
the empty bucket on the floor. See Figure 9.
22. Install the tool kit water valve onto the shop fresh water supply hose. Completely fill the cooling
system through the degas bottle with fresh water
until the water flows from the radiator drain.
(NEW!) 23. Allow the radiator to completely drain. Close the radiator drain and install the degas
bottle cap.
24. NOTE: The pinch-off pliers are used to control the direction of fluids in certain areas of the
cooling system. They are also used for optimum
cleaning and to prevent air from entering into the cooling system.
NOTE:
If the vehicle is being lifted to install and remove the lower radiator hose pinch-off pliers the flush
tool kit pump must be secured onto the radiator shroud while lifting.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
1494
Position and clamp the pinchoff pliers onto the upper radiator hose (see Figure 10) and the lower
radiator hose (see Figure 11) as close to the radiator as possible.
25. Place the flush tool kit suction hose from the pump into one of the small holes in the lid of the
flush tool kit bucket that is along side of the pump.
The hose MUST be kept a minimum of 2 inches from the bottom of the tool kit bucket.
26. Using the shop fresh water supply, fill the flush tool kit bucket with fresh water. Use the tool kit
valve attached to the shop fresh water supply hose
to maintain the water level in the tool kit bucket.
27. Connect a shop air supply to the pump, with the fresh water supply on, and maintain the water
level in the tool kit bucket.
28. NOTE: Do NOT allow the tool kit supply bucket to become low or empty. This will introduce air
into the cooling system and cause an overheating
condition
With the fresh water supply on, monitor and maintain the water level in the tool kit bucket.
29. NOTE: Dispose of old coolant and flushing water contaminated with antifreeze in accordance
with local, state and federal laws.
Allow a minimum of 10 gallons of water to flush through the engine and out the drain hose into the
shop bucket on the floor. It will be necessary to disconnect the shop air supply from the pump to
eliminate the water flow from the drain hose while emptying the shop bucket.
30. After a minimum of 10 gallons of water has flushed through the engine, disconnect the shop air
from the pump and turn off the fresh water supply.
31. Remove the tool kit bucket lid and empty the bucket.
VC-11 FLUSH
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
1495
32. NOTE: Both the suction and drain hoses MUST be kept a minimum of 2 inches from the bottom
of the tool kit bucket. This will prevent any air
from entering into the cooling system and causing an overheating condition.
Reposition the drain hose from the 5 gallon bucket on the floor into one of the small holes in the lid
of the flush tool kit bucket on the tool cart. See Figure 12.
33. Remove the pinchoff pliers from upper and lower radiator hoses.
34. Install the pinchoff pliers onto the flush tool kit drain and suction hose closest to the flush tool kit
bucket lid. See Figure 13.
35. WARNING: THE USE OF SAFETY EQUIPMENT SUCH AS EYE PROTECTION AND
CHEMICAL GLOVES IS REQUIRED FAILURE TO
FOLLOW THESE INSTRUCTIONS MAY RESULT IN SERIOUS PERSONAL INJURY.
NOTICE: Bring the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11 to room temperature of
68° F (20° C) and shake well Follow all of the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC1 1
instructions and Precautions.
Add 2 gallons of Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11 to the flush tool kit bucket
that is on the tool cart Do not dilute the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11 in the
flush tool kit bucket
(NEW!) 36. NOTICE: It is necessary to use the AirLift Cooling Tester UVU-550000 (formerly Radkit
Plus) to remove any air from the cooling system.
If air remains in the cooling system, the air will inhibit the circulation of the Motorcraft(R) Engine
Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture and will cause an overheating condition and possible
damage to the engine.
Rinse the shop bucket and fill with fresh water Place the shop bucket so that the fill hose from the
AirLift Cooling Tester UVU-550000 (formerly Radkit Plus) will siphon the fresh water out of the
bucket. Install the AirLift Cooling Tester UVU-550000 onto the degas bottle.
37. Remove the AirLift Cooling Tester UVU-550000 from the degas bottle and install the degas
bottle cap Make sure that the degas bottle is filled to 1
inch (25 mm) above the COLD FILL LEVEL.
38. Remove the pinch-off pliers from both hoses at the flush tool kit bucket.
39. Position one of the pinch-off pliers onto the upper radiator hose closest to the radiator.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
1496
40. Connect shop air supply to the tool kit pump. The pump will start to siphon the Motorcraft(R)
Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11 from the
bucket into the engine.
41. NOTICE:
With the heater in the OFF position start the engine and idle until the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling
System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture temperature reaches 140° F (60° C) Monitor the
Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture temperature using an infrared
thermometer or equivalent in the flush tool kit bucket.
42. When the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture temperature
reaches 140° F (60° C) remove the pinch-off pliers
from the upper radiator hose.
43. Disconnect the A/C high pressure cut-off switch electrical connector This will activate the
engine cooling fans. It may take a few seconds until the
cooling fans come on See Figure 14.
44.
NOTICE:
Make sure that the radiator is NOT obstructed for maximum air flow Any deflection of air may
cause an overheating condition.
NOTICE:
The Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC11/water mixture temperature MUST NOT
EXCEED 15° F (65° C) or damage to the
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
1497
engine may occur. If the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture
temperature EXCEEDS 150° F (65° C), the heater blower motor can be turned ON to reduce the
mixtures temperature If the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture
temperature STILL EXCEEDS 150° F (65° C), the engine MUST be turned OFF and the key left
ON. The key MUST remain on for the operation of the heater blower motor to allow the engine to
cool down.
Continue the flush using the flush tool kit pump, circulating the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling
System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture through the cooling system.
NOTICE:
Do NOT allow the degas bottle to run low or empty This will allow air to enter the cooling system
and will cause an overheating condition and prevent the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System
Cleaner VC-11/water mixture from circulating through the entire engine and cooling system.
(NEW!) NOTE:
Allow the engine to idle for a MINIMUM of 2 hours The Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System
Cleaner VC11/water mixture temperature MUST remain between 135° F (57° C) to 150° F (65° C)
NOTE:
To control any odor from the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture
during the flush install a shop exhaust hose into the lid of the tool kit bucket.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
1498
To control any odor from the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture it
is recommended to install a shop exhaust hose into the lid of the tool kit bucket. See Figure 16.
45. EVERY half hour monitor the degas bottle for the correct level and measure the temperature in
the tool kit bucket. DO NOT allow the
Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture to get below the COLD FILL
LEVEL. If necessary, release cooling system pressure by loosening the degas bottle cap slowly
allowing air to escape and the degas bottle to fill to 1 inch (25 mm) above the COLD FILL LEVEL.
46. After the engine has idled for a MINIMUM of 2 hours, turn the engine OFF and leave the key in
the ON position. Turn the heater blower motor ON
and select the highest blower speed.
47. Continue flushing until the cooling system cleaner/water mixture reaches 120° F (49° C) with
the heater blower motor on high. The temperature can
be identified using an infrared thermometer or equivalent to monitor the mixture temperature in the
flush tool kit bucket.
48. Disconnect shop air from the flush tool kit pump.
49. Turn the ignition key OFF.
50. Connect the A/C High Pressure switch and the cooling fan motor electrical connector (if
disconnected).
POST-RINSE AND FILL
WARNING:
THE USE OF SAFETY EQUIPMENT SUCH AS EYE PROTECTION AND CHEMICAL GLOVES IS
REQUIRED FAILURE TO FOLLOW THESE INSTRUCTIONS MAY RESULT IN SERIOUS
PERSONAL INJURY
51. NOTE: Dispose of Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture in the
same way as coolant in accordance with local, state
and federal laws.
Empty and rinse the flush tool kit bucket, and then fill with fresh water.
52. Using caution, slowly open and remove the degas bottle cap.
53. Using caution, open the radiator drain.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
1499
54. NOTE: Dispose of Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture in the
same way as coolant in accordance with local, state
and federal laws.
Allow the radiator to drain completely (degas bottle cap should be OFF).
55. Fill the degas bottle completely with fresh water and allow the radiator to drain.
(NEW!) 56. Close the radiator drain and install the degas bottle cap.
57. Place an empty 5 gallon bucket on the floor in front of the vehicle.
58. Remove the flush tool kit drain hose from the flush tool kit bucket and place the drain hose into
the empty shop bucket.
59. Install pinch-off pliers on the upper and lower radiator hoses as close to the radiator outlets as
possible. See Figure 10 and Figure 11.
60. NOTICE: Do NOT allow the flush tool kit bucket to run low or empty during the post-rinse and
fill procedure. This will allow air to enter into the
cooling system and cause an overheating condition.
Keep the fresh water hose in the tool kit bucket and monitor the water level. Do not allow the
bucket to run low or empty.
61. Connect air supply to the pump.
62. Allow a minimum of 10 gallons of water to flush through the engine and out the drain hose into
the shop bucket on the floor. It will be necessary to
disconnect the shop air supply from the pump to eliminate the water flow from the drain hose while
emptying the shop bucket.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
1500
63. NOTE: Remove ONLY the pinch-off pliers from the lower radiator hose in this step. Remove the
pinch-off pliers from the lower radiator hose.
64. NOTICE: Distilled water must be used for the final 5 gallon flush and fill.
After flushing the system with a minimum of 10 gallons of fresh shop water, continue the flush
using an additional 5 gallons of distilled water.
65. Remove the pinch-off pliers from the upper radiator hose.
66. Remove air supply from flush tool kit pump.
67. Disconnect the flush tool kit suction hose from the pump and remove the drain hose from the
shop bucket. Move the tool cart with the bucket and
pump aside.
68. Remove the degas bottle cap.
69. NOTE: Dispose of Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture in the
same way as coolant in accordance with local, state
and federal laws.
Open the radiator drain and completely drain the radiator.
70. Close the radiator drain.
71. Remove the Air Cleaner Assembly.
72. NOTE: A black residue may be evident after the flushing procedure. This is a normal condition
and requires NO action.
Remove the heater core inlet hose from the heater return port on the thermostat housing.
73. Remove the drain hose from the heater core inlet port on the thermostat housing.
74. Remove the thermostat housing cover and remove the flush tool kit plug.
75. Install the thermostat and housing cover. Tighten the bolts to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
76. Install the heater core inlet and outlet hoses onto the thermostat housing See Figure 17.
77. Install the Air Cleaner Assembly
^ Install the air cleaner assembly into the rubber grommets
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
1501
^ Install the air cleaner assembly bolt and tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
^ Connect the air cleaner assembly outlet pipe and tighten the clamp to 5 Nm (44 lb-in)
^ Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector
78. NOTICE:
Using the AirLift Cooling Tester UVU-550000 (formerly Radkit Plus), add 5.8 qts (5.5 L) for base
models and 6.3 qts (6.0 L) for trailer tow models (vehicles equipped with an oil cooler) of 100%
pure concentrated coolant. Use concentrated coolant, Motorcraft(R) Specialty Green Engine
Coolant VC-10-A2 (US) or CVC-10-A (Canada) to the cooling system. Continue with the purge of
air from the system until the coolant reaches 1 inch (25 mm) above the COLD FILL LEVEL.
The recommended coolant concentration is 50/50 or -34° F (-36° C) using Motorcraft(R) Specialty
Green Engine Coolant VC-10-A2 (US) or CVC-10-A (Canada) to distilled water, as measured with
a hydrometer or equivalent.
^ Maximum coolant concentration is 60/40, -60° F (-51° C) for cold weather areas.
^ Minimum coolant concentration is 40/60, -20° F (-29° C) for warm weather areas.
79. Turn the heater to OFF.
WARNING:
ALWAYS ALLOW THE ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE OPENING THE COOLING SYSTEM DO
NOT UNSCREW THE COOLANT PRESSURE RELIEF CAP WHEN THE ENGINE IS
OPERATING OR THE COOLING SYSTEM IS HOT THE COOLING SYSTEM MAY BE UNDER
PRESSURE; STEAM AND HOT LIQUID CAN COME OUT FORCEFULLY WHEN THE CAP IS
LOOSENED SLIGHTLY FAILURE TO FOLLOW THESE INSTRUCTIONS MAY RESULT IN
SERIOUS PERSONAL INJURY.
(NEW!) 80. Start the engine and increase the engine speed to rpm and hold for 30 seconds.
81. Turn the engine OFF and wait for 1 minute to purge any large air pockets from the cooling
system.
82. NOTE: Add concentrated coolant, Motorcraft(R) Specialty Green Engine Coolant VC-10-A2
(US) or CVC-10-A (Canada) to 1 inch (25 mm)
above the top of the COLD FILL LEVEL of the degas bottle.
Check the engine coolant level in the degas bottle and if necessary, fill to 1 inch (25 mm) above the
top of the COLD FILL LEVEL when warm or to the top of the COLD FILL LEVEL when cold using
concentrated coolant, Motorcraft(R) Specialty Green Engine Coolant VC-10-A2 (US) OR CVC-10-A
(Canada).
83. Start the engine and let idle until the engine reaches normal operating temperature and the
thermostat is fully open. A fully open thermostat can be
verified by the radiator cooling fan cycling on at least once.
84. With the engine ON, thermostat open and the cooling fans cycled at least once, increase the
engine speed to 3,500 rpm and hold for 30 seconds.
Then allow the engine to idle for 30 seconds.
85. Turn the engine OFF and wait for 1 minute.
86. Repeat Steps 84 and 85 a total of 5 TIMES to remove any remaining air trapped in the system.
87. NOTE: Add concentrated coolant, Motorcraft(R) Specialty Green Engine Coolant VC-10-A2
(US) or CVC-10-A (Canada) to 1 inch (25 mm)
above the top of the COLD FILL RANGE of the degas bottle.
Check the engine coolant level in the degas bottle, and if necessary, fill to 1 inch (25 mm) above
the top of the COLD FILL LEVEL with the engine warm or to the top of the COLD FILL LEVEL with
the engine cold using concentrated coolant, Motorcraft(R) Specialty Green Engine Coolant
VC-10-A2 (US) or CVC-10-A (Canada).
88. Make sure the degas bottle cap is installed to at least one audible "click."
89. Overlay the new cooling system label onto the degas bottle cap that has been provided by
service management.
90. Using the IDS, clear any codes that may have been set during the flush procedure.
91. Service management will provide the Customer Information Sheet to the customer for insertion
into vehicle's Owner Guide. This Customer
Information Sheet will remind the customer that a revised type of coolant has been installed in their
vehicle and will need to be used from this point forward.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
1502
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
1503
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
1504
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
1505
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Coolant: Capacity Specifications
Cooling System ...................................................................................................................................
.......................................... 11.7 quarts (11.09 liters)
With Trailer Tow Package ...................................................................................................................
.................................................... 12.83 qts (12.14L)
NOTE: Add the coolant type originally equipped in your vehicle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1508
Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications
ENGINE COOLANT
Motorcraft Premium Gold Engine Coolant with bittering agent (yellow-colored)
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
.................................................................. VC-7-B
Ford Specification ................................................................................................................................
................................................ WSS-M97B51-A1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
Transmission Fluid ..............................................................................................................................
............................................... 10.0 quarts (9.5 liters)
Note: Indicates only approximate dry-fill capacity. Some applications mat vary based on cooler size
and if equipped with an in-tank cooler. The amount of transmission fluid and fluid level should be
set by the indication on the dipstick's normal operating range.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1513
Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Transmission Fluid Type
Type .....................................................................................................................................................
............................................ MERCON V XT-5-QM
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1514
Fluid - A/T: Testing and Inspection
Check Fluid Level and Condition (All vehicles)
CAUTION: The vehicle should not be driven if the fluid level indicator shows the fluid below the
minimum fluid level mark or internal failure could result.
If the vehicle has been operated for an extended period of time, at highway speeds, in city traffic, in
hot weather or while pulling a trailer, the fluid needs to cool down to obtain an accurate reading.
The fluid level reading on the fluid level indicator will differ depending on operating and ambient
temperatures. The correct reading should be within the normal operating temperature range.
Fluid Level Check
NOTE: The transmission fluid should be checked at normal operating temperature 80°C-93°C
(175°F-200°F) on a level surface. Normal operating temperature can be reached after
approximately 32 km (20 miles) of driving and can be checked using the scan tool.
Under normal circumstances the fluid level should be checked during normal maintenance. If the
transaxle starts to slip, shifts slowly or shows signs of fluid leaking, the fluid level should be
checked.
1. With the transaxle in PARK, the engine at idle, foot pressed on the brake, move the selector
lever through each gear and allow engagement of each
gear. Place the selector lever in the PARK position.
2. Wipe the fluid level indicator cap and remove the fluid level indicator. 3. Wipe the fluid level
indicator with a clean cloth. 4. Install the fluid level indicator back in the fluid indicator tube until it is
fully seated, then remove the indicator. The fluid level should be within the
normal operating range.
High Fluid Level A fluid level that is too high may cause the fluid to become aerated due to the
churning action of the rotating internal parts. This will cause erratic control pressure, foaming, loss
of fluid from the vent tube and possible transaxle malfunction and/or damage.
Low Fluid Level A low fluid level could result in poor transaxle engagement, slipping, malfunction
and/or damage. This could also indicate a leak in one of the transaxle seals or gaskets.
Adding Fluid
CAUTION: MERCON(R) V, MERCON(R) SP, Motorcraft Premium Automatic Transmission Fluid,
Motorcraft Continuously Variable Chain Type Transmission Fluid and FNR5 automatic transmission
fluid are not interchangeable transmission fluids. The use of any fluid other than what is
recommended for this transmission will cause transmission damage.
If fluid needs to be added, add fluid in 0.25L (1/2 pt) increments through the indicator tube. Do not
overfill the fluid.
Fluid Condition Check
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1515
1. Check the fluid level. 2. Observe the color and the odor. The color under normal circumstances
should be a dark red color, not brown or black or have a burnt odor. 3. Hold the fluid level indicator
over a white facial tissue and allow the fluid to drip onto the facial tissue and examine the stain. 4. If
evidence of solid material is found, the transmission fluid pan should be removed for further
inspection. 5. If fluid contamination or transaxle failure is confirmed by the sediment in the bottom
of the fluid pan, repair the transaxle and clean the fluid
cooler tubes and fluid cooler.
6. If the transaxle is to be overhauled or if installing a new transaxle, the fluid cooler must be
backflushed.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1516
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill
Material
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
2. NOTE: If an internal problem is suspected, drain the transmission fluid through a paper filter. A
small amount of metal or friction particles may be
found from normal wear. If an excessive amount of metal or friction material is present, the
transaxle will need to be overhauled.
Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
3. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
4. Fill the transaxle with clean automatic transmission fluid.
5. Start the engine, run through all the gears, check the fluid level and run the engine for 5 minutes.
Repeat steps 2, 3 and 4.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1517
6. Start the engine, run through all the gears and check the fluid level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil
With Filter ............................................................................................................................................
............................................................. 5.2L (5.5 Qt)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1522
Engine Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Engine Oil
U.S. ........................................................................................................................................
Motorcraft SAE 5W-20 Premium Synthetic Blend Motor Oil Canada
...................................................................................................................................................
Motorcraft SAE 5W-20 Super Premium Motor Oil
Ford Part Number:
................................................................................................................................ XO-5W20-QSP
(US), CXO-5W20LSP12 (Canada) Ford Specification:
..................................................................................................................................................
WSS-M2C930-A and API Certification
NOTE: Use of synthetic or synthetic blend motor oil is not mandatory. Engine oil need only meet
the requirements of Ford specification WSS-M2C930-A and the API Certification mark.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Specifications
Power Steering Fluid: Specifications
POWER STEERING FLUID
Motorcraft MERCON ATF
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
............................................................ XT-2-QDX Ford Specification .................................................
............................................................................................................................................ MERCON
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Specifications > Page
1526
Power Steering Fluid: Testing and Inspection
Power Steering Fluid Leak Test
NOTE: This test should only be carried out if a leak in the system has not been detected during a
thorough visual inspection. Refer to Inspection and Verification. See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Testing and Inspection/Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview/Inspection
and Verification
1. Check the power steering fluid level. If necessary, add the specified power steering fluid. 2.
Remove the power steering pump reservoir cap and tightly install the evacuation cap to the power
steering pump reservoir. 3. Install the hose from the fill adapter manifold tee to the evacuation cap
on the power steering pump reservoir. 4. Install the vacuum pump to the evacuation cap. 5. Using
the vacuum pump, apply 68-85 kPa (20-25 in-Hg) of vacuum to the power steering system. 6.
Observe the vacuum gauge for 30 seconds. If the vacuum gauge reading drops more than 3 kPa
(0.88 in-Hg) a leak is present. 7. Remove the vacuum pump.
8. CAUTION: Do not hold the steering wheel at the stops for more than 3-5 seconds. Damage to
the power steering pump can occur.
Start the engine. With the engine at idle, raise the power steering fluid temperature to 74-80°C
(165-176°F) by rotating the steering wheel fully to the left and right several times.
9. Visually inspect the system for leaks. If a leak is evident, repair as necessary. If a leak is not
evident, add the specified UV fluorescent tracer dye
to the power steering fluid. Use 14.78 mL (1/2 oz) of dye solution for every 1.89 L (2 qt) of power
steering fluid.
10. CAUTION: Do not hold the steering wheel at the stops for more than 3-5 seconds. Damage to
the power steering pump can occur.
Start the engine. With the engine at idle, raise the power steering fluid temperature to 74-80°C
(165-176°F) by rotating the steering wheel fully to the left and right several times.
11. NOTE: On vehicles with rack and pinion steering gear, it may be necessary to remove the
bellows boot clamp from the steering gear bellows
boots to inspect for internal steering gear leaks.
Using the special tool (UV lamp), inspect the system for traces of UV dye. Repair as necessary.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Refrigerant: Capacity Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Refrigerant and Capacity
Capacity................................................................................................................................................
............................................................0.55 kg (19 oz)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1531
Refrigerant: Fluid Type Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Refrigerant and Capacity
R-134a Refrigerant YN-19 (US); CYN-16-P or CYN-16-R
(Canada).........................................................................................................WSH-M17B19-A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1532
Refrigerant: Description and Operation
REFRIGERANT SYSTEM DYE
A fluorescent refrigerant system dye "wafer" is added to the receiver/drier desiccant bag to assist in
refrigerant system leak diagnosis using a Rotunda approved ultraviolet blacklight. This fluorescent
dye "wafer" will dissolve after about 30 minutes of continued A/C operation. It is not necessary to
add additional dye to the refrigerant system before diagnosing leaks, even if a significant amount of
refrigerant has been removed from the system. Additional refrigerant system dye should only be
added if more than 50% of the refrigerant system lubricant capacity has been lost due to a fitting
separation, hose rupture, etc.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Refrigerant Oil: Capacity Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Refrigerant Lubricant and Capacity
Capacity................................................................................................................................................
...............................................................118 ml (4 oz)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1537
Refrigerant Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Refrigerant Lubricant and Capacity
PAG Refrigerant Compressor Oil (R-134a Systems)
YN-12-D....................................................................................................................WSH-M1C231-B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Master Cylinder
Master Cylinder
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied, or
partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent air from getting into the system.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
1. NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied,
or partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent
air from getting into the system.
Disconnect the brake master cylinder outlet tubes.
2. Install short brake tubes with ends submerged in the brake master cylinder reservoir and fill the
brake master cylinder reservoir with clean,
specified brake fluid.
3. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal until clear fluid flows from both brake tubes without air
bubbles. 4. Remove the short brake tubes and install the brake outlet tubes. 5. Bleed each brake
tube at the brake master cylinder as follows:
1 Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal.
2 Loosen the rearmost brake tube fittings until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have an assistant
maintain pressure on the brake pedal while tightening the brake tube fitting.
3 Repeat this operation until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder >
Page 1542
4 Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary. Repeat the bleeding operation at the front
brake tube.
6. While the assistant maintains pressure on the brake pedal, tighten the brake tubes.
^ Tighten to 28 Nm (21 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder >
Page 1543
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Brake System Bleeding
Brake System Bleeding
Special Tool(s)
Material
Brake System Bleeding
Pressure
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: This procedure must be carried out if a new anti-lock brake system (ABS) hydraulic control
unit (HCU) has been installed.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or installation of a
new component, air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires
bleeding of the hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can
be bled manually or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: Carrying out the chassis brake bleeding procedure drives trapped air from the otherwise
inaccessible lower section of the HCU valves into the upper sections (accessible by bleeding the
brakes). Subsequent bleeding removes the air from the system.
NOTE: Bleed the longest brake tube or hose first. Be sure the bleeder tank contains enough
specified brake fluid to complete the bleeding operation.
NOTE: Add clean, specified brake fluid as necessary throughout the procedure.
1. If the vehicle is equipped with an ABS, connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) and
scan tool into the vehicle data link connector
(DLC) under the dash and carry out the chassis brake bleeding procedure.
2. Clean all dirt from the master cylinder filler cap, then remove the cap and fill the brake master
cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder >
Page 1544
3. NOTE: Master cylinder pressure bleeder adapter tools are available from various manufacturers
of pressure bleeding equipment. Follow the
manufacturer's instructions when installing the adapter.
Install the bleeder adapter to the brake master cylinder reservoir and attach the bleeder tank hose
to the fitting on the adapter.
4. Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber hose
to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and
submerge the free end of the hose in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake fluid.
5. Open the valve on the bleeder tank. 6. Loosen the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Leave
the bleeder screw open until clear, bubble-free brake fluid flows into the container, then
tighten the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and remove the rubber hose. ^
Tighten to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs).
7. Continue bleeding the rest of the system, going in order from the LH rear disc brake caliper to
the RH front disc brake caliper, ending with the LH
front disc brake caliper.
8. Close the bleeder tank valve and remove the tank hose from the adapter and remove the
adapter. 9. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid and install the
cap.
Manual
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder >
Page 1545
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: This procedure must be carried out if a new anti-lock brake system (ABS) hydraulic control
unit (HCU) has been installed.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or installation of a
new component, air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires
bleeding of the hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can
be bled manually or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: Carrying out the chassis brake bleeding procedure drives trapped air from the otherwise
inaccessible lower section of the HCU valves into the upper sections (accessible by bleeding the
brakes). Subsequent bleeding removes the air from the system.
NOTE: Add clean, specified brake fluid as necessary throughout the procedure.
1. Clean all dirt from the master cylinder filler cap, then remove the cap and fill the brake master
cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid.
^ Install the master cylinder filler cap.
2. If the vehicle is equipped with an ABS, connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) and
scan tool into the vehicle data link connector
(DLC) under the dash and carry out the chassis brake bleeding procedure.
3. Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber hose
to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and
submerge the free end of the hose in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake fluid.
4. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 5.
Loosen the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
6. Tighten the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs).
7. Repeat Steps 2 through 5 for the LH rear disc brake caliper. 8. Place a box-end wrench on the
RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber hose to the RH front disc brake caliper
bleeder screw
and submerge the free end of the hose in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake
fluid.
9. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal.
10. Loosen the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out.
Have an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
11. Tighten the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder >
Page 1546
12. Repeat Steps 7 through 10 for the LH front disc brake caliper.
Gravity
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or installation of a
new component, air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires
bleeding of the hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can
be bled manually or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: Performing the chassis brake bleeding procedure drives trapped air from the otherwise
inaccessible lower section of the HCU valves into the upper sections (accessible by bleeding the
brakes). Subsequent bleeding removes the air from the system.
NOTE: Add clean, specified brake fluid as necessary throughout the procedure.
1. Clean all dirt from the master cylinder filler cap, then remove the cap and fill the brake master
cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid. 2. If the vehicle is equipped with an ABS,
connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) and scan tool into the vehicle data link
connector
(DLC) under the dash and carry out the chassis brake bleeding procedure.
3. Bleed the rear disc brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber hose to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the free end
of the hose in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows into the
container. Repeat for the LH rear disc brake caliper.
4. Tighten the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screws to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs). 5. Bleed the front disc
brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber hose to the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the free end
of the hose in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows. Repeat for the LH front disc brake caliper.
6. Tighten the front disc brake caliper bleeder screws to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEPOWERING AND REPOWERING
Depowering Procedure
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Failure to follow this instruction may result in
air bag deployment, which may result in serious personal injury.
- Never probe the electrical connector on a side air curtain module. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in side air curtain module deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraints system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraints system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the smart power
distribution junction box (SPDJB), located in the LH lower kick panel, remove the lower kick panel
fuse cover and the
restraints control module (RCM) fuse 46 (7.5A) from the (SPDJB).
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30 seconds.
The air bag warning indicator will remain lit
continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or installing any new front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and
before servicing, installing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors,
such as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches. Failure to
follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
The front impact severity sensors are located on the radiator support under the front bumper cover.
The first row side impact sensors are located at or near the base of the B-pillars.
The second row side impact sensors are located on the C-pillars.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
Repowering Procedure
1. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 2. Install RCM fuse 46 (7.5A) to the SPDJB and install
the lower kick panel fuse cover.
3. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in front
of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal
injury.
Connect the battery ground cable.
4. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition switch from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the ignition switch back to ON
and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag
warning indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn OFF. If an air
bag SRS fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash at a 5 Hz rate (RCM not configured).
The air bag warning indicator might not light until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch
has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1551
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator and any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) from the RCM and occupant classification
sensor (OCS) module using a scan tool.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1552
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Deactivation and Reactivation
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEACTIVATION AND REACTIVATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Deactivation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of serious personal injury in
the event of an accidental deployment.
- Carry a live air bag module with the air bag and trim cover pointed away from your body. This will
reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live air bag module down with the trim cover face down. This will reduce the risk of
serious personal injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Failure to follow this instruction may result in
air bag deployment, which may result in personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the safety canopy module. Failure to follow this instruction may
result in safety canopy deployment, which may result in personal injury.
- The safety belt pretensioners are pyrotechnic devices. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in pretensioner or air bag deployment which may result in serious personal
injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraints system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraints system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All vehicles 1. Turn all vehicle accessories off. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the smart
power distribution junction box (SPDJB), located in the LH lower kick panel, remove the lower kick
panel fuse cover and the
restraints control module (RCM) fuse 46 (7.5A) from the SPDJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30 seconds.
The air bag warning indicator will remain lit
continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or installing any new front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and
before servicing, installing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors,
such as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensors are located on the radiator support under the front bumper cover.
The first row side impact sensors are located at or near the base of the B-pillars.
The second row side impact sensors are located on the C-pillars.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1553
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
7. NOTE: Repeat this step for both locking pins.
Using a 3-mm Allen wrench or a suitable tool through the access hole on the backside of the
steering wheel, position the tool against the spring clip and push in, disengaging the clip from the
locking pin. With the spring clip disengaged from the locking pin, gently pull back on that side of the
driver air bag module to release it from the steering wheel.
8. CAUTION: Do not pull the driver air bag module electrical connectors out by the locking buttons.
Damage to the locking buttons may
occur.
Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking buttons on the driver air bag
module electrical connectors. With the locking buttons released, remove the electrical connectors
and the driver air bag module.
9. Open and lower the glove compartment door. Then unhook the glove compartment door from
the instrument panel (I/P).
- If equipped, detach the glove compartment door dampener.
Edge
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1554
10. Remove the 2 passenger air bag module bolts from the cross vehicle beam bracket.
11. CAUTION: Do not handle the passenger air bag module by grabbing the edges of the
deployment doors. Damage to the air bag module
may occur.
Through the glove compartment opening, release the 4 LH side deployment door clips. Then
release the forward-most 5 clips and separate the deployment door and passenger air bag module
from the I/P.
12. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the RH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
13. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the RH locking button released, remove the RH electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1555
14. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the LH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
15. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the LH locking button released, remove the LH electrical connector and remove the
passenger air bag module.
MKX
16. Pull straight out to release the 5 retaining clips and remove the RH I/P finish panel.
17. Remove the screw for the LH duct assembly bracket from the front of the I/P.
18. Through the glove compartment opening, remove the screw and the LH duct assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1556
19. Through the glove compartment opening, remove the screw and the RH duct assembly.
20. Remove the 4 bolts and the passenger air bag module support bracket.
21. Remove the 3 nuts from the passenger air bag module.
22. CAUTION: Do not allow the passenger air bag module to hang from the wiring harness.
Damage to the wiring harness and connectors
may occur.
Lower the rear of the passenger air bag module off the 3 mounting studs. Move the passenger air
bag module rearward to release the 7 hooks from the I/P and rest the module on the cross vehicle
beam.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1557
23. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the LH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
24. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the LH locking button released, remove the LH electrical connector from the passenger air
bag module.
25. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the RH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
26. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the RH locking button released, remove the RH electrical connector. Remove the passenger
air bag module from the glove compartment opening.
All vehicles
27. From under the rear of the front passenger seat, slide and disengage the passenger seat side
air bag module electrical connector locking clip, and
then release the tab and disconnect the passenger seat side air bag module electrical connector.
28. Remove the passenger side D-pillar trim panel.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1558
29. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger safety canopy module electrical connector out by the
locking button. Damage to the locking button
may occur.
With the locking button released, remove the electrical connector from the passenger safety
canopy module.
30. Remove the driver side D-pillar trim panel.
31. CAUTION: Do not pull the driver safety canopy module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button
may occur.
With the locking button released, remove the electrical connector from the driver safety canopy
module.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1559
32. From under the rear of the driver seat, detach the driver seat side air bag module electrical
connector from the seat cushion frame. Then slide and
disengage the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector locking clip, and then release
the tab and disconnect the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector.
33. Install RCM fuse 46 (7.5A) to the SPDJB. 34. Connect the battery ground cable.
Reactivation
All vehicles 1. Remove RCM fuse 46 (7.5A) from the SPDJB. 2. Disconnect the battery ground
cable and wait at least one minute.
3. Connect the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector and then slide and engage the
seat side air bag electrical connector locking clip.
Then attach the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector to the seat cushion frame.
4. CAUTION:
- Do not install the safety canopy module electrical connector by the locking button. Damage to the
locking button may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector locking button must be in the released position
when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector is unique and cannot be reversed when connected
to the safety canopy module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the safety canopy
module. Do not force the electrical connector into the safety canopy module. Damage to the
connector or component may occur.
With the locking button released, install the driver safety canopy module electrical connector fully
into the driver safety canopy module and seat the locking button.
5. Install the driver side D-pillar trim panel.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1560
6. CAUTION:
- Do not install the safety canopy module electrical connector by the locking button. Damage to the
locking button may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector locking button must be in the released position
when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector is unique and cannot be reversed when connected
to the safety canopy module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the safety canopy
module. Do not force the electrical connector into the safety canopy module. Damage to the
connector or component may occur.
With the locking button released, install the passenger safety canopy module electrical connector
fully into the passenger safety canopy module and seat the locking button.
7. Install the passenger side D-pillar trim panel.
8. Connect the passenger seat side air bag module electrical connector and then slide and engage
the seat side air bag electrical connector locking
clip.
MKX
9. CAUTION:
- Do not install the passenger air bag module electrical connectors by the locking buttons. Damage
to the locking buttons may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connector locking buttons must be in the released
position when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the passenger air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in
the passenger air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the passenger air bag
module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1561
Position the passenger air bag module on the cross vehicle beam. With the locking buttons
released, install the 2 passenger air bag module electrical connectors fully into the passenger air
bag module and seat the locking buttons.
10. NOTE: During the passenger air bag module installation, make sure all 7 of the hooks are fully
seated in the I/P.
Install the passenger air bag module 7 hooks into the I/P. Raise the rear of the passenger air bag
module onto the 3 mounting studs.
11. Install the 3 passenger air bag module nuts.
- Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
12. NOTE: To avoid a squeak or rattle condition, install the passenger air bag module bracket and
passenger air bag module bolts in this order.
Install the passenger air bag module support bracket and the 4 bolts. 1. Install the passenger air
bag module support bracket and 2 bolts to the cross vehicle beam.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
2. Install the inboard passenger air bag module support bracket-to-passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
3. Install the outboard passenger air bag module support bracket-to-passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1562
13. Install the screw and the RH duct assembly.
14. Install the screw and the LH duct assembly.
15. Install the screw for the LH duct assembly bracket in the front of the I/P.
16. NOTE: Make sure the RH I/P finish panel 5 retaining clips are fully seated in the I/P.
Install the RH I/P finish panel.
Edge
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1563
17. CAUTION:
- Do not install the passenger air bag module electrical connectors by the locking buttons. Damage
to the locking buttons may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connector locking buttons must be in the released
position when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the passenger air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in
the passenger air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the passenger air bag
module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
With the locking buttons released, install the 2 passenger air bag module electrical connectors fully
into the passenger air bag module and seat the locking buttons.
18. CAUTION: Do not handle the passenger air bag module by grabbing the edges of the
deployment doors. Damage to the air bag module
may occur.
NOTE: During air bag module installation, make sure all the deployment door clips are fully seated
in the I/P.
Install the passenger air bag module deployment door rear-most clips into the I/P first. Then install
the side deployment door clips working around to the forward-most clips seating each of them fully
into the I/P.
19. NOTE: To avoid a squeak or rattle condition, install the 2 passenger air bag module bolts in this
order.
Install the passenger air bag module 2 bolts. 1. Install the inboard passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
2. Install the outboard passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
All vehicles 20. Hook the glove compartment door to the I/P. Close the glove compartment door.
- If equipped, attach the glove compartment door dampener.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1564
21. CAUTION:
- Do not install the driver air bag module electrical connectors by the locking buttons. Damage to
the locking buttons may occur.
- The driver air bag module electrical connector locking buttons must be in the released position
when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the passenger air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in
the passenger air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the passenger air bag
module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
With the locking buttons released, install the driver air bag module electrical connectors fully into
the driver air bag module and seat the locking buttons.
22. NOTE: Audible clicks will be heard when both wire clips are seated in the driver air bag module.
Align the driver air bag module locking pins to the steering wheel and, while pushing inward, seat
the 2 driver air bag module locking pins to the steering wheel wire clips. When the 2 locking pins are seated in place, there should be an even gap between the driver air
bag module trim cover and the steering wheel.
23. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 24. Install RCM fuse 46 (7.5A) to the SPDJB and
install the lower kick panel fuse cover.
25. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in
front of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected. Failure to follow this instructions may result in serious personal
injury.
Connect the battery ground cable.
26. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag warning
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag SRS
fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will either: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash at a 5 Hz rate (RCM not configured).
The air bag warning indicator may not illuminate until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator will need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Clear all continuous DTCs from the restraints control module using a scan tool.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Fuse: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1570
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1571
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1572
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1573
Fuse: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1574
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1575
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1576
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuse: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1579
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1580
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1581
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1582
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1583
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1584
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1585
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1586
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1587
Fuse: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1588
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1589
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1590
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1591
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1592
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1593
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1594
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1595
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Fuse: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1598
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1599
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1600
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1601
Fuse: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1602
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1603
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1604
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's
Set
Fuse Block: Customer Interest Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set
TSB 10-1-8
02/01/10
PCM - BATTERY JUNCTION BOX (BJB) - POSSIBLE MIL ON WITH MULTIPLE DTCS, NO
CRANK/NO START, DRIVABILITY SYMPTOMS
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 7-16-5 to remove the production build date and TSB 7-17-9 to update
the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles may exhibit concerns that results in no crank/start,
buck/jerk, lack/loss of power and/or malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) with one or more diagnostic
trouble codes (DTCs) present. This could be caused by a poor fuse terminal fit, loose or unseated
wire terminal connection at the Battery Junction Box (BJB) located near the battery under the hood.
ACTION If loose and/or unseated wiring terminals for fuses and relays are found in the BJB, follow
the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the vehicle battery.
2. Open the BJB top cover. (Figure 1)
3. Check for loose fuse connections in the BJB at fuse positions 30, 31, 32, 33, and 34. If poor
terminal fit is present, note those fuse cavities for Step 6.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's
Set > Page 1613
4. Remove all the mini fuses, relays and diodes (suggest taking a picture of the layout so install is
easier). (Figure 2)
a. Do not remove the cartridge fuses from the BJB.
5. Remove the light gray retainer that the devices were plugged through. This will expose the
terminals within the plastic housing. (Figure 3)
6. Locate the terminal cavities identified in procedure Step 3 that require repair. The tuning forks
will be off center in relation to the plastic cavities or
open.
7. Insert a small flat blade screw driver/pick tool into the suspect tuning fork slot. The flat blade
screw driver/pick tool width should be a maximum of
0.05" (1.25 mm) to provide access into the cavity. Tip dimensions were 0.04" x 0.04" (1 mm x 1
mm) with a 45 degree taper).
8. The small flat blade screw driver/pick tool should be inserted to the outside of the tuning fork leg
between the tuning fork leg and the plastic wall of
the housing cavity. (Figure 4)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's
Set > Page 1614
9. Pry the screw driver/pick tool against the plastic cavity wall and against the side of the tuning
fork leg. This will move the tuning fork legs together,
tuning fork legs should be close to touching. (Figure 5)
10. Next remove the BJB from the splash shield. (Figure 6)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's
Set > Page 1615
a. Tug on the underside wires to determine the unseated terminal location. (Figures 7 and 8)
NOTE
THIS MAY REQUIRE SOME LEVEL OF HARNESS REMOVAL FROM THE VEHICLE MOUNTING
LOCATIONS TO ADEQUATELY ACCESS THE LEADS ON THE UNDERSIDE OF THE BJB
BLOCK.
11. Any circuits that do not offer any resistance during the tugging operation should be reseated
using the Push-Click-Tug method.
a. Push the terminal back into the cavity.
b. Listen for an audible click to assure lock engagement.
c. Tug on the lead to insure a proper seat occurred.
12. Once all the BJB circuits have been verified as seated, proceed to the next steps.
13. Install and lock the BJB block back into the splash shield.
14. Install the light gray retainer.
15. Reinstall all the mini fuses, relays and diodes back into their specific locations.
a. Make sure all the relays are replaced in the proper orientation.
16. Close the BJB cover.
17. Reconnect the vehicle battery cable.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100108A 2007 Edge, MKX: Follow 0.6 Hr.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's
Set > Page 1616
The Service Procedure To Check For And Repair Loose/Unseated Wiring Terminals (Do Not Use
With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14290 X2
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No
Start/DTC's Set
Fuse Block: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set
TSB 10-1-8
02/01/10
PCM - BATTERY JUNCTION BOX (BJB) - POSSIBLE MIL ON WITH MULTIPLE DTCS, NO
CRANK/NO START, DRIVABILITY SYMPTOMS
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 7-16-5 to remove the production build date and TSB 7-17-9 to update
the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles may exhibit concerns that results in no crank/start,
buck/jerk, lack/loss of power and/or malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) with one or more diagnostic
trouble codes (DTCs) present. This could be caused by a poor fuse terminal fit, loose or unseated
wire terminal connection at the Battery Junction Box (BJB) located near the battery under the hood.
ACTION If loose and/or unseated wiring terminals for fuses and relays are found in the BJB, follow
the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the vehicle battery.
2. Open the BJB top cover. (Figure 1)
3. Check for loose fuse connections in the BJB at fuse positions 30, 31, 32, 33, and 34. If poor
terminal fit is present, note those fuse cavities for Step 6.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No
Start/DTC's Set > Page 1622
4. Remove all the mini fuses, relays and diodes (suggest taking a picture of the layout so install is
easier). (Figure 2)
a. Do not remove the cartridge fuses from the BJB.
5. Remove the light gray retainer that the devices were plugged through. This will expose the
terminals within the plastic housing. (Figure 3)
6. Locate the terminal cavities identified in procedure Step 3 that require repair. The tuning forks
will be off center in relation to the plastic cavities or
open.
7. Insert a small flat blade screw driver/pick tool into the suspect tuning fork slot. The flat blade
screw driver/pick tool width should be a maximum of
0.05" (1.25 mm) to provide access into the cavity. Tip dimensions were 0.04" x 0.04" (1 mm x 1
mm) with a 45 degree taper).
8. The small flat blade screw driver/pick tool should be inserted to the outside of the tuning fork leg
between the tuning fork leg and the plastic wall of
the housing cavity. (Figure 4)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No
Start/DTC's Set > Page 1623
9. Pry the screw driver/pick tool against the plastic cavity wall and against the side of the tuning
fork leg. This will move the tuning fork legs together,
tuning fork legs should be close to touching. (Figure 5)
10. Next remove the BJB from the splash shield. (Figure 6)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No
Start/DTC's Set > Page 1624
a. Tug on the underside wires to determine the unseated terminal location. (Figures 7 and 8)
NOTE
THIS MAY REQUIRE SOME LEVEL OF HARNESS REMOVAL FROM THE VEHICLE MOUNTING
LOCATIONS TO ADEQUATELY ACCESS THE LEADS ON THE UNDERSIDE OF THE BJB
BLOCK.
11. Any circuits that do not offer any resistance during the tugging operation should be reseated
using the Push-Click-Tug method.
a. Push the terminal back into the cavity.
b. Listen for an audible click to assure lock engagement.
c. Tug on the lead to insure a proper seat occurred.
12. Once all the BJB circuits have been verified as seated, proceed to the next steps.
13. Install and lock the BJB block back into the splash shield.
14. Install the light gray retainer.
15. Reinstall all the mini fuses, relays and diodes back into their specific locations.
a. Make sure all the relays are replaced in the proper orientation.
16. Close the BJB cover.
17. Reconnect the vehicle battery cable.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100108A 2007 Edge, MKX: Follow 0.6 Hr.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No
Start/DTC's Set > Page 1625
The Service Procedure To Check For And Repair Loose/Unseated Wiring Terminals (Do Not Use
With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14290 X2
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Fuse Block: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1628
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1629
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1630
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1631
Fuse Block: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1632
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1633
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1634
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuse Block: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1637
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1638
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1639
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1640
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1641
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1642
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1643
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1644
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1645
Fuse Block: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1646
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1647
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1648
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1649
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1650
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1651
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1652
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1653
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1654
Fuse Block: Connector Views
C1035A
C1035B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1655
C2280A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1656
C2280B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1657
C2280C
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1658
C2280D
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1659
C2280E
C2280F
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1660
C2280G
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Fuse Block: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1663
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1664
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1665
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1666
Fuse Block: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1667
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1668
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1669
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Relay Box: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1674
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1675
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1676
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1677
Relay Box: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1678
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1679
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1680
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams >
Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Relay Box: Diagrams Battery Junction Box (BJB)
C1035A
C1035B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 1683
Relay Box: Diagrams Smart Junction Box (SJB)
C2280A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 1684
C2280B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 1685
C2280C
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 1686
C2280D
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 1687
C2280E
C2280F
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 1688
C2280G
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Relay Box: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1691
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1692
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1693
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1694
Relay Box: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1695
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1696
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 1697
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Low Tire Pressure Indicator > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection
Low Tire Pressure Indicator: Testing and Inspection
TPMS Indicator and Message Center Messages The TPMS indicator and vehicle message center
(if equipped) sometimes displays faults that cannot be resolved by the customer. Treat these
messages as TPMS faults that must be serviced.
TPMS Indicator Illuminates Continuously
NOTE: If the spare tire is in use, the damaged road tire must be repaired and installed on the
vehicle to restore complete TPMS functionality before carrying out any diagnosis.
1. The TPMS indicator remains on continuously for this condition:
^ Low Tire Pressure - The TPMS indicator is illuminated solid and the message center displays
LOW TIRE PRESSURE (if equipped). This is displayed when any of the tire pressures are low.
When this condition exists, the tire pressure must be adjusted to the recommended cold pressure
as indicated on the vehicle certification label.
2. NOTE: The TPMS sensors do not transmit when the vehicle is stationary. If the vehicle has been
stationary for more than 30 minutes, it will be
necessary to wake up the sensors so they will transmit the latest tire pressure information to the
SJB.
If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, perform this procedure to wake up the
TPMS sensors. 1
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
2 Adjust the air pressure in the LF tire (as necessary).
3 Activate the LF TPMS sensor, at least 2 times, using the tire pressure monitor activation tool.
4 Repeat Steps 2 and 3 for the remaining tires.
5 If the TPMS indicator remains illuminated after adjusting and activating each sensor, GO to
Symptom Chart. See: Wheels and Tires/Tire Monitoring System/Testing and Inspection/Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures
TPMS Indicator Flashes The TPMS indicator flashes for 70 seconds, then remains ON solid when
the ignition switch is turned to the ON position, for these conditions:
1. Tire Pressure Sensor Fault - If equipped, the message center will display TIRE SENSOR FAULT
when a tire pressure sensor is malfunctioning.
GO to Symptom Chart. See: Wheels and Tires/Tire Monitoring System/Testing and
Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
2. No communication with the SJB (TPMS is integral to the SJB) - The TPMS indicator is
illuminated when the instrument cluster has received no
signals from the SJB for more than 5 seconds. If equipped, the message center displays TIRE
MONITOR FAULT. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Wheels and Tires/Tire Monitoring System/Testing
and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
3. Tire Pressure Monitor Fault - If equipped, the message center will display TIRE MONITOR
FAULT when the tire pressure monitoring system is
malfunctioning or communication with the instrument cluster has been lost. GO to Symptom Chart.
See: Wheels and Tires/Tire Monitoring System/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator: Service and Repair
Ford provides no information related to a Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator for this vehicle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP (MIL)
CHECK ENGINE, SERVICE ENGINE SOON, Or ISO Standard Engine Symbol
The MIL notifies the driver that the powertrain control module (PCM) has detected an on board
diagnostic (OBD) emission-related component or system concern. When this occurs, an OBD
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) sets.
- The MIL is located in the instrument cluster and is labeled CHECK ENGINE, SERVICE ENGINE
SOON or the international standards organization (ISO) standard engine symbol.
- The MIL is illuminated during the instrument cluster prove out for approximately 4 seconds.
- The MIL remains illuminated after instrument cluster prove out if: an emission-related concern and DTC exists.
- the PCM does not send a control message to the instrument cluster (applications with the MIL
controlled through the communication link).
- the PCM is operating in the hardware limited operation strategy (HLOS).
- The MIL remains off during the instrument cluster prove out if an indicator or instrument cluster
concern is present.
- To turn off the MIL after a repair, a reset command from the scan tool must be sent, or 3
consecutive drive cycles must be completed without a concern.
- For all MIL concerns, go to Symptom Charts. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
- If the MIL flashes at a steady rate, a severe misfire condition may exist.
- If the MIL flashes erratically, the PCM can reset while cranking if the battery voltage is low.
- The MIL flashes after a period of time with the key in the RUN position (engine not running) if
DTC P1000 is set.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Oil Change Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Oil Change Reminder Lamp: Service and Repair
Ford provides no information related to an Oil Change Reminder Lamp.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Vehicle Lifting: Description and Operation
JACKING
WARNING:
- Do not run the engine when jacking the vehicle. The wheels contacting the ground could cause
the vehicle to move. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Make sure the jack and jack stands are correctly located to prevent the vehicle from falling.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Wheel chocks should be used to prevent the vehicle from rolling and falling off the jack. Failure to
follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: The service jack provided with the vehicle is only intended to be used in an emergency
for changing a deflated tire. Never use the service jack to hoist the vehicle for any other service.
Refer to the Owner Guide when using the jack supplied with the vehicle.
Jacking Points - Front
1. The front jacking points are identified by an upside down triangle on the rocker panel moulding
just behind the front wheels. Position the jack so
its lift area fits on the frame underneath the triangle.
Jacking Points - Rear
1. The rear jacking points are identified by an upside down triangle on the rocker panel moulding
just in front of the rear wheels. Position the jack so
its lift area fits on the frame underneath the triangle.
LIFTING
Lifting Points
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 1715
CAUTION: Under no circumstances should the vehicle be lifted by the front control arms, front cross braces or
rear control arms. Severe damage to the vehicle could result.
- Do not allow the lift adapters to contact the steering linkage, suspension arms, front cross braces,
stabilizer bar, or to compress the lower suspension arm stabilizer bar insulator. Damage to the
suspension, exhaust and steering linkage components may occur if care is not exercised when
positioning the lift adapters prior to lifting the vehicle.
1. CAUTION: Damage to the suspension, exhaust or steering linkage components may occur if
care is not exercised when positioning the
hoist adapters prior to lifting the vehicle.
The lifting points are part of the uni-body structure.
2. The front lifting points are identified by an upside down triangle on the rocker panel moulding just
behind the front wheels. Position the hoist
adapters directly under the frame rail with the triangle centered.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 1716
3. The rear lifting points are identified by an upside down triangle on the rocker panel moulding just
in front of the rear wheels. Position the hoist
adapters directly under the frame rail with the triangle centered.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training
Special Tool(s)
NOTE: If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, the sensors will go into a "sleep
mode" to conserve battery power. It will be necessary to wake them up so they will transmit the
latest tire pressure information to the Smart Junction Box (SJB).
NOTE: The tire pressure sensor training procedure must be done on a single vehicle, in an area
without radio frequency noise and at least 1 m (3 ft) away from other vehicles equipped with a Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS).
Radio frequency noise is generated by electrical motors and appliance operation, cellular
telephones, remote transmitters, power inverters and portable entertainment equipment.
NOTE: If a sensor does not respond to the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool, attempt to
activate the same sensor with the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. If the sensor still does not
respond, move the vehicle to rotate the wheels at least one-fourth of a turn and attempt to activate
the same sensor again.
NOTE: The SJB has a 2-minute time limit between sensor responses. If the SJB does not
recognize any 1 of the 4 tire pressure sensors during this time limit, the horn will sound twice and
the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE NOT TRAINED REPEAT and the entire
procedure must be repeated.
NOTE: For vehicles with different front and rear tire pressures (such as the E-Series and certain
F-Series), the tire pressure sensors must be trained following a tire rotation. Failure to train the
sensors will cause the TPMS indicator to illuminate. For vehicles with the same tire pressure for
front and rear tires, tire rotation will not affect the system.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position, then press and release the brake pedal. 2. Cycle the
ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position. 3.
Press and release the brake pedal. 4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position. 5. Turn the
ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position.
- The horn will sound once and the TPMS indicator will flash if the training mode has been entered
successfully. If equipped, the message center will display TRAIN LF TIRE.
NOTE: It may take up to 6 seconds to activate a tire pressure sensor. During this time, the Tire
Pressure Monitor Activation Tool must remain in place 180 degrees from the valve stem.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1721
6. Place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the LF tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees)
from the valve stem. Press and release the test
button on the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. The horn will sound briefly to indicate that the
tire pressure sensor has been recognized by the SJB.
7. Within 2 minutes of the horn sounding, place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the RF
tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees) from the
valve stem and press and release the test button to train the RF tire pressure sensor.
NOTE: Do not wait more than 2 minutes between training each sensor or the SJB will time out and
the entire procedure must be repeated.
8. Repeat Step 7 for the RR and LR tires.
The procedure is completed after the last tire has been trained. When the training procedure is
complete, the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE TRAINING COMPLETE. For vehicles
not equipped with a message center, successful completion of the training procedure will be
verified by turning the ignition switch to the OFF position without the horn sounding. If the horn
sounds twice when the switch is turned to the OFF position, the training procedure was not
successful.
9. Using the scan tool, locate the updated TPMS sensor identifiers trained to the SJB and
document them on the applicable warranty claim.
NOTE: This step is required to clear DTC C2780, cause the SJB to exit the manufacturing mode
and to make sure there are no other concerns with a newly programmed SJB.
10. If the sensors are being trained due to the installation of a new SJB, clear any DTCs and carry
out the SJB On-Demand Self Test.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Disassembly
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application.
When installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color
of the sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor can be removed and installed without removing the strap or the cradle.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
1. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Dismount the tire only as
instructed.
Remove the tire from the wheel.
2. CAUTION: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to
the sensor locking clip can occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the sensor locking clip.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1724
3. CAUTION: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to
the sensor can occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver or similar tool, detach the sensor from the cradle.
4. Remove the sensor.
Assembly
1. CAUTION: Damage to the sensor can occur if excessive force is applied during sensor
installation.
NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the cradle. The sensor will make a "click" noise
when correctly seated.
Position the sensor into the cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end of the
cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. NOTE: The locking clip can only be fully seated when installed in the correct orientation. If the
sensor locking clip cannot be fully inserted, then
the sensor may not be fully seated on the cradle or the locking clip may be inserted backward.
Insert a new locking clip into the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1725
3. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel.
4. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1726
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and
Cradle
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and Cradle
Material
Disassembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1727
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application.
When installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color
of the sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor is available separately, the cradle and strap are available as a strap kit. There
are several different strap kits available based on wheel diameter but all strap kits share the same
base part number.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
1. Remove the tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor.
2. WARNING: The TPMS band is under tension. Always use safety goggles or a face shield and
gloves when removing the TPMS
band/strap. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
Remove a factory installed strap in this sequence: 1
Locate the strap buckle and secure the strap to the wheel using duct tape or a similar item, on both
sides of the buckle approximately 25 mm (0.98 inch) from the buckle.
2 Using a large screwdriver and a twisting motion, unbuckle the strap.
3 Discard the strap.
3. To remove a dealer installed strap, turn the worm gear screw until the strap is fully released from
the worm gear.
^ Discard the strap.
4. NOTE: To aid assembly, mark the location of the cradle prior to disassembly.
Using a screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the cradle by inserting the screwdriver under the cradle
and prying up.
Assembly
1. NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the new cradle. The sensor will make a "click"
noise when fully seated.
Position the sensor into the new cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end
of the cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. CAUTION: Metal scrapers can damage the wheel. Use only plastic or non-metallic scrapers to
remove the cradle adhesive strip residue.
NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be installed in the drop well of the wheel, 180 degrees from the
valve stem.
Clean the area where the sensor and cradle are to be installed.
3. NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be positioned with the hinge side of the sensor on the RH
side when viewed from the curb side (beauty side)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1728
of the wheel.
NOTE: The sensor has raised markings indicating how to position the sensor.
Remove the adhesive tape liner from the cradle and position the sensor and cradle into the wheel
drop well 180 degrees from the valve stem.
4. Install the tapered end of the strap through the opening of the cradle on the hinge side of the
sensor. This will position the worm gear on the
locking clip side of the sensor.
5. CAUTION: Steel wheels have a "high spot" along their circumference. Make sure the strap is
positioned in the lowest spot possible for
correct sensor and cradle retention.
NOTE: Keep the strap parallel with the wheel flange while tightening the worm gear.
Position the worm gear 13-26 mm (0.5-1.0 inch) away from the sensor and tighten the worm gear.
^
Tighten to 3 Nm (27 inch lbs).
6. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel.
7. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Low Tire Pressure Indicator >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Low Tire Pressure Indicator: Testing and Inspection
TPMS Indicator and Message Center Messages The TPMS indicator and vehicle message center
(if equipped) sometimes displays faults that cannot be resolved by the customer. Treat these
messages as TPMS faults that must be serviced.
TPMS Indicator Illuminates Continuously
NOTE: If the spare tire is in use, the damaged road tire must be repaired and installed on the
vehicle to restore complete TPMS functionality before carrying out any diagnosis.
1. The TPMS indicator remains on continuously for this condition:
^ Low Tire Pressure - The TPMS indicator is illuminated solid and the message center displays
LOW TIRE PRESSURE (if equipped). This is displayed when any of the tire pressures are low.
When this condition exists, the tire pressure must be adjusted to the recommended cold pressure
as indicated on the vehicle certification label.
2. NOTE: The TPMS sensors do not transmit when the vehicle is stationary. If the vehicle has been
stationary for more than 30 minutes, it will be
necessary to wake up the sensors so they will transmit the latest tire pressure information to the
SJB.
If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, perform this procedure to wake up the
TPMS sensors. 1
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
2 Adjust the air pressure in the LF tire (as necessary).
3 Activate the LF TPMS sensor, at least 2 times, using the tire pressure monitor activation tool.
4 Repeat Steps 2 and 3 for the remaining tires.
5 If the TPMS indicator remains illuminated after adjusting and activating each sensor, GO to
Symptom Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
TPMS Indicator Flashes The TPMS indicator flashes for 70 seconds, then remains ON solid when
the ignition switch is turned to the ON position, for these conditions:
1. Tire Pressure Sensor Fault - If equipped, the message center will display TIRE SENSOR FAULT
when a tire pressure sensor is malfunctioning.
GO to Symptom Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
2. No communication with the SJB (TPMS is integral to the SJB) - The TPMS indicator is
illuminated when the instrument cluster has received no
signals from the SJB for more than 5 seconds. If equipped, the message center displays TIRE
MONITOR FAULT. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
3. Tire Pressure Monitor Fault - If equipped, the message center will display TIRE MONITOR
FAULT when the tire pressure monitoring system is
malfunctioning or communication with the instrument cluster has been lost. GO to Symptom Chart.
See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training
Special Tool(s)
NOTE: If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, the sensors will go into a "sleep
mode" to conserve battery power. It will be necessary to wake them up so they will transmit the
latest tire pressure information to the Smart Junction Box (SJB).
NOTE: The tire pressure sensor training procedure must be done on a single vehicle, in an area
without radio frequency noise and at least 1 m (3 ft) away from other vehicles equipped with a Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS).
Radio frequency noise is generated by electrical motors and appliance operation, cellular
telephones, remote transmitters, power inverters and portable entertainment equipment.
NOTE: If a sensor does not respond to the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool, attempt to
activate the same sensor with the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. If the sensor still does not
respond, move the vehicle to rotate the wheels at least one-fourth of a turn and attempt to activate
the same sensor again.
NOTE: The SJB has a 2-minute time limit between sensor responses. If the SJB does not
recognize any 1 of the 4 tire pressure sensors during this time limit, the horn will sound twice and
the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE NOT TRAINED REPEAT and the entire
procedure must be repeated.
NOTE: For vehicles with different front and rear tire pressures (such as the E-Series and certain
F-Series), the tire pressure sensors must be trained following a tire rotation. Failure to train the
sensors will cause the TPMS indicator to illuminate. For vehicles with the same tire pressure for
front and rear tires, tire rotation will not affect the system.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position, then press and release the brake pedal. 2. Cycle the
ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position. 3.
Press and release the brake pedal. 4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position. 5. Turn the
ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position.
- The horn will sound once and the TPMS indicator will flash if the training mode has been entered
successfully. If equipped, the message center will display TRAIN LF TIRE.
NOTE: It may take up to 6 seconds to activate a tire pressure sensor. During this time, the Tire
Pressure Monitor Activation Tool must remain in place 180 degrees from the valve stem.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1736
6. Place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the LF tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees)
from the valve stem. Press and release the test
button on the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. The horn will sound briefly to indicate that the
tire pressure sensor has been recognized by the SJB.
7. Within 2 minutes of the horn sounding, place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the RF
tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees) from the
valve stem and press and release the test button to train the RF tire pressure sensor.
NOTE: Do not wait more than 2 minutes between training each sensor or the SJB will time out and
the entire procedure must be repeated.
8. Repeat Step 7 for the RR and LR tires.
The procedure is completed after the last tire has been trained. When the training procedure is
complete, the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE TRAINING COMPLETE. For vehicles
not equipped with a message center, successful completion of the training procedure will be
verified by turning the ignition switch to the OFF position without the horn sounding. If the horn
sounds twice when the switch is turned to the OFF position, the training procedure was not
successful.
9. Using the scan tool, locate the updated TPMS sensor identifiers trained to the SJB and
document them on the applicable warranty claim.
NOTE: This step is required to clear DTC C2780, cause the SJB to exit the manufacturing mode
and to make sure there are no other concerns with a newly programmed SJB.
10. If the sensors are being trained due to the installation of a new SJB, clear any DTCs and carry
out the SJB On-Demand Self Test.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Disassembly
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application.
When installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color
of the sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor can be removed and installed without removing the strap or the cradle.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
1. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Dismount the tire only as
instructed.
Remove the tire from the wheel.
2. CAUTION: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to
the sensor locking clip can occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the sensor locking clip.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1739
3. CAUTION: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to
the sensor can occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver or similar tool, detach the sensor from the cradle.
4. Remove the sensor.
Assembly
1. CAUTION: Damage to the sensor can occur if excessive force is applied during sensor
installation.
NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the cradle. The sensor will make a "click" noise
when correctly seated.
Position the sensor into the cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end of the
cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. NOTE: The locking clip can only be fully seated when installed in the correct orientation. If the
sensor locking clip cannot be fully inserted, then
the sensor may not be fully seated on the cradle or the locking clip may be inserted backward.
Insert a new locking clip into the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1740
3. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel.
4. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1741
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and
Cradle
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and Cradle
Material
Disassembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1742
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application.
When installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color
of the sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor is available separately, the cradle and strap are available as a strap kit. There
are several different strap kits available based on wheel diameter but all strap kits share the same
base part number.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
1. Remove the tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor.
2. WARNING: The TPMS band is under tension. Always use safety goggles or a face shield and
gloves when removing the TPMS
band/strap. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
Remove a factory installed strap in this sequence: 1
Locate the strap buckle and secure the strap to the wheel using duct tape or a similar item, on both
sides of the buckle approximately 25 mm (0.98 inch) from the buckle.
2 Using a large screwdriver and a twisting motion, unbuckle the strap.
3 Discard the strap.
3. To remove a dealer installed strap, turn the worm gear screw until the strap is fully released from
the worm gear.
^ Discard the strap.
4. NOTE: To aid assembly, mark the location of the cradle prior to disassembly.
Using a screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the cradle by inserting the screwdriver under the cradle
and prying up.
Assembly
1. NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the new cradle. The sensor will make a "click"
noise when fully seated.
Position the sensor into the new cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end
of the cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. CAUTION: Metal scrapers can damage the wheel. Use only plastic or non-metallic scrapers to
remove the cradle adhesive strip residue.
NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be installed in the drop well of the wheel, 180 degrees from the
valve stem.
Clean the area where the sensor and cradle are to be installed.
3. NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be positioned with the hinge side of the sensor on the RH
side when viewed from the curb side (beauty side)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1743
of the wheel.
NOTE: The sensor has raised markings indicating how to position the sensor.
Remove the adhesive tape liner from the cradle and position the sensor and cradle into the wheel
drop well 180 degrees from the valve stem.
4. Install the tapered end of the strap through the opening of the cradle on the hinge side of the
sensor. This will position the worm gear on the
locking clip side of the sensor.
5. CAUTION: Steel wheels have a "high spot" along their circumference. Make sure the strap is
positioned in the lowest spot possible for
correct sensor and cradle retention.
NOTE: Keep the strap parallel with the wheel flange while tightening the worm gear.
Position the worm gear 13-26 mm (0.5-1.0 inch) away from the sensor and tighten the worm gear.
^
Tighten to 3 Nm (27 inch lbs).
6. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel.
7. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheels: > 09-11-2 > Jun > 09 > Wheels/Tires - Popping/Snapping Noise At Low Speeds
Wheels: Customer Interest Wheels/Tires - Popping/Snapping Noise At Low Speeds
TSB 09-11-2
06/15/09
POPPING/SNAPPING NOISE - FRONT OR REAR 18 INCH WHEELS - TURNING AT SLOW
SPEED BELOW 10 MPH (16 KM/H)
FORD: 2007-2008 Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
MERCURY: 2007-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 09-4-3 to update the vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Explorer, Sport Trac, and Mountaineer vehicles built prior to 1/28/2008
and 2007-2008 Edge and MKX vehicles built prior to 8/18/2008 and equipped with 18 inch wheels
may exhibit a noise coming from the front or rear wheel(s) while turning the steering wheel at
speeds lower than 10 MPH (16 Km/h). The noise may be coming from the chrome cladding that
attaches to the rim.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IF THE SOURCE OF NOISE IS NOT FROM THE WHEEL, FOLLOW NORMAL WORKSHOP
MANUAL PROCEDURES.
1. Verify the noise is coming from the wheel(s).
2. Replace the wheel(s) that have the noise with updated service parts. Refer to Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 204-04.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheels: > 09-11-2 > Jun > 09 > Wheels/Tires - Popping/Snapping Noise At Low Speeds >
Page 1752
3. Lubricate the remaining wheels at the outboard wheel flange, between the cladding and the
wheel inter[ace. Use Motorcraft(R) Silicone Spray
Lubricant with an extension nozzle. (Figures 1 and 2)
4. Clean any excess lubricant off the wheel with a soft cloth.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091102A 2007-2008 Explorer, 0.9 Hr.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge, MKX:
Replace One Wheel
and Lubricate Remaining Three Wheels. Includes Test Drive, Transfer Tire Pressure Monitor
Sensor (TPMS), And Balance Wheel Assembly (Do Not Use With 1007A, 1007A1)
091102B 2007-2008 Explorer, 1.1 Hrs.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge, MKX:
Replace Two
Wheels and Lubricate Remaining Two Wheels. Includes Test Drive, Transfer Tire Pressure Monitor
Sensor (TPMS), And Balance Wheel Assemblies (Do Not Use With 1007A, 1007A1)
091102C 2007-2008 Explorer, 1.4 Hrs.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge,
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheels: > 09-11-2 > Jun > 09 > Wheels/Tires - Popping/Snapping Noise At Low Speeds >
Page 1753
MKX: Replace Three Wheels and Lubricate Remaining Wheel. Includes Test Drive, Transfer Tire
Pressure Monitor Sensor (TPMS), Balance And Balance Wheel Assemblies (Do Not Use With
1007A, 1007A1)
091102D 2007-2008 Explorer, 1.6 Hrs.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge, MKX: Replace Four Wheels. Includes Test Drive,
Transfer Tire Pressure Monitor Sensor (TPMS), And Balance Wheel Assemblies (Do Not Use With
1007A, 1007A1)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
1007 68
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheels: > 07-23-4 > Nov > 07 > Wheels/Tires - Popping Noise From Wheels When
Turning
Wheels: Customer Interest Wheels/Tires - Popping Noise From Wheels When Turning
TSB 07-23-4
11/26/07
POPPING/SNAPPING NOISE - FRONT OR REAR 18 INCH WHEELS - TURNING AT SLOW
SPEEDS BELOW 10 MPH (16KM/H)
FORD: 2007 Edge 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer
MERCURY: 2007-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 07-19-6 to update the vehicle lines.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Explorer, Explorer Sport Trac and Mountaineer vehicles built prior to
8/17/2007 and 2007 Edge vehicles built prior to 8/24/2007 and equipped with 18" wheels may
exhibit noise coming from the front or rear wheel(s) while turning the steering wheel at speeds
lower than 10 MPH (16 Km/h). The noise may be coming from the chrome cladding that attaches to
the rim.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IF THE SOURCE OF NOISE IS NOT FROM THE WHEEL, FOLLOW NORMAL WORKSHOP
MANUAL PROCEDURES.
1. Verify the noise is coming from the wheel(s).
2. Replace wheel(s) with updated service parts for 18" Chrome (Bright) Clad Cast Aluminum wheel
and Satin Clad Cast Aluminum wheel(s). Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 204-04.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheels: > 07-23-4 > Nov > 07 > Wheels/Tires - Popping Noise From Wheels When
Turning > Page 1758
3. Lubricate the remaining wheels at the outboard wheel flange, between the cladding and the
wheel inter[ace. Use Motorcraft Silicone Spray Lubricant and spray lubricant with an extension
nozzle. (Figures 1 and 2)
NOTE
NEW WHEELS WILL NOT REQUIRE LUBRICATION.
4. Clean any excess lubricate off the wheel with a soft cloth.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072304A 2007-2008 Explorer, 0.9 Hr.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge: Replace One Wheel and Lubricate Remaining
Three Wheels. Includes Test Drive, Transfer Tire Pressure Monitor Sensor (TPMS), And Balance
Wheel Assembly (Do Not Use With 1007A, 1007A1)
072304B 2007-2008 Explorer, 1.1 Hrs.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge: Replace Two Wheels and Lubricate Remaining Two
Wheels. Includes Test Drive, Transfer TPMS, And Balance Wheel Assemblies (Do Not Use With
1007A, 1007A1)
072304C 2007-2008 Explorer, 1.4 Hrs.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge:
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheels: > 07-23-4 > Nov > 07 > Wheels/Tires - Popping Noise From Wheels When
Turning > Page 1759
Replace Three Wheels and Lubricate Remaining Wheel. Includes Test Drive, Transfer TPMS,
Balance And Balance Wheel Assemblies (Do Not Use With 1007A, 1007A1)
072304D 2007-2008 Explorer, 1.6 Hrs.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge: Replace Four Wheels. Includes Test Drive, Transfer
TPMS, And Balance Wheel Assemblies (Do Not Use With 1007A, 1007A1)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
1007 68
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 09-11-2 > Jun > 09 > Wheels/Tires - Popping/Snapping Noise At
Low Speeds
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Popping/Snapping Noise At Low Speeds
TSB 09-11-2
06/15/09
POPPING/SNAPPING NOISE - FRONT OR REAR 18 INCH WHEELS - TURNING AT SLOW
SPEED BELOW 10 MPH (16 KM/H)
FORD: 2007-2008 Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
MERCURY: 2007-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 09-4-3 to update the vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Explorer, Sport Trac, and Mountaineer vehicles built prior to 1/28/2008
and 2007-2008 Edge and MKX vehicles built prior to 8/18/2008 and equipped with 18 inch wheels
may exhibit a noise coming from the front or rear wheel(s) while turning the steering wheel at
speeds lower than 10 MPH (16 Km/h). The noise may be coming from the chrome cladding that
attaches to the rim.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IF THE SOURCE OF NOISE IS NOT FROM THE WHEEL, FOLLOW NORMAL WORKSHOP
MANUAL PROCEDURES.
1. Verify the noise is coming from the wheel(s).
2. Replace the wheel(s) that have the noise with updated service parts. Refer to Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 204-04.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 09-11-2 > Jun > 09 > Wheels/Tires - Popping/Snapping Noise At
Low Speeds > Page 1765
3. Lubricate the remaining wheels at the outboard wheel flange, between the cladding and the
wheel inter[ace. Use Motorcraft(R) Silicone Spray
Lubricant with an extension nozzle. (Figures 1 and 2)
4. Clean any excess lubricant off the wheel with a soft cloth.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091102A 2007-2008 Explorer, 0.9 Hr.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge, MKX:
Replace One Wheel
and Lubricate Remaining Three Wheels. Includes Test Drive, Transfer Tire Pressure Monitor
Sensor (TPMS), And Balance Wheel Assembly (Do Not Use With 1007A, 1007A1)
091102B 2007-2008 Explorer, 1.1 Hrs.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge, MKX:
Replace Two
Wheels and Lubricate Remaining Two Wheels. Includes Test Drive, Transfer Tire Pressure Monitor
Sensor (TPMS), And Balance Wheel Assemblies (Do Not Use With 1007A, 1007A1)
091102C 2007-2008 Explorer, 1.4 Hrs.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge,
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 09-11-2 > Jun > 09 > Wheels/Tires - Popping/Snapping Noise At
Low Speeds > Page 1766
MKX: Replace Three Wheels and Lubricate Remaining Wheel. Includes Test Drive, Transfer Tire
Pressure Monitor Sensor (TPMS), Balance And Balance Wheel Assemblies (Do Not Use With
1007A, 1007A1)
091102D 2007-2008 Explorer, 1.6 Hrs.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge, MKX: Replace Four Wheels. Includes Test Drive,
Transfer Tire Pressure Monitor Sensor (TPMS), And Balance Wheel Assemblies (Do Not Use With
1007A, 1007A1)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
1007 68
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 07-23-4 > Nov > 07 > Wheels/Tires - Popping Noise From Wheels
When Turning
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Popping Noise From Wheels When Turning
TSB 07-23-4
11/26/07
POPPING/SNAPPING NOISE - FRONT OR REAR 18 INCH WHEELS - TURNING AT SLOW
SPEEDS BELOW 10 MPH (16KM/H)
FORD: 2007 Edge 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer
MERCURY: 2007-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 07-19-6 to update the vehicle lines.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Explorer, Explorer Sport Trac and Mountaineer vehicles built prior to
8/17/2007 and 2007 Edge vehicles built prior to 8/24/2007 and equipped with 18" wheels may
exhibit noise coming from the front or rear wheel(s) while turning the steering wheel at speeds
lower than 10 MPH (16 Km/h). The noise may be coming from the chrome cladding that attaches to
the rim.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IF THE SOURCE OF NOISE IS NOT FROM THE WHEEL, FOLLOW NORMAL WORKSHOP
MANUAL PROCEDURES.
1. Verify the noise is coming from the wheel(s).
2. Replace wheel(s) with updated service parts for 18" Chrome (Bright) Clad Cast Aluminum wheel
and Satin Clad Cast Aluminum wheel(s). Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 204-04.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 07-23-4 > Nov > 07 > Wheels/Tires - Popping Noise From Wheels
When Turning > Page 1771
3. Lubricate the remaining wheels at the outboard wheel flange, between the cladding and the
wheel inter[ace. Use Motorcraft Silicone Spray Lubricant and spray lubricant with an extension
nozzle. (Figures 1 and 2)
NOTE
NEW WHEELS WILL NOT REQUIRE LUBRICATION.
4. Clean any excess lubricate off the wheel with a soft cloth.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072304A 2007-2008 Explorer, 0.9 Hr.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge: Replace One Wheel and Lubricate Remaining
Three Wheels. Includes Test Drive, Transfer Tire Pressure Monitor Sensor (TPMS), And Balance
Wheel Assembly (Do Not Use With 1007A, 1007A1)
072304B 2007-2008 Explorer, 1.1 Hrs.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge: Replace Two Wheels and Lubricate Remaining Two
Wheels. Includes Test Drive, Transfer TPMS, And Balance Wheel Assemblies (Do Not Use With
1007A, 1007A1)
072304C 2007-2008 Explorer, 1.4 Hrs.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge:
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 07-23-4 > Nov > 07 > Wheels/Tires - Popping Noise From Wheels
When Turning > Page 1772
Replace Three Wheels and Lubricate Remaining Wheel. Includes Test Drive, Transfer TPMS,
Balance And Balance Wheel Assemblies (Do Not Use With 1007A, 1007A1)
072304D 2007-2008 Explorer, 1.6 Hrs.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge: Replace Four Wheels. Includes Test Drive, Transfer
TPMS, And Balance Wheel Assemblies (Do Not Use With 1007A, 1007A1)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
1007 68
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front
Wheel Bearing and Wheel Hub
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 1777
Removal
NOTE: If removing the wheel hub, the wheel bearing must be replaced.
1. Remove the wheel knuckle. 2. Using the special tool, press the wheel hub from the wheel
bearing.
3. NOTE: This step may not be necessary if the inner wheel bearing race remains in the wheel
knuckle after removing the wheel hub.
Using the special tool, press the inner wheel bearing race from the wheel hub.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 1778
4. Remove the snap ring. 5. Using the special tool, press the outer wheel bearing race from the
wheel knuckle.
Installation
1. Using the special tool, press the wheel bearing into the wheel knuckle.
2. Install the snap ring. 3. Using the special tools, press the wheel hub into the wheel bearing.
4. Install the wheel knuckle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 1779
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear
Wheel Bearing and Wheel Hub
Special Tool(s)
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicles
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 1780
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicles
Removal
All vehicles
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly.
2. CAUTION: Do not allow the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly to hang from the brake
hose or damage to the hose can occur.
Remove the 2 anchor plate bolts and position the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly aside. ^
Support the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly using mechanic's wire.
3. Remove the brake disc.
All wheel drive (AWD) vehicles 4. Remove and discard the halfshaft nut. 5. Using the special tool,
separate the halfshaft from the hub and bearing assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 1781
All vehicles 6. Remove the 4 bolts and the wheel bearing and wheel hub.
^ Discard the bolts.
Installation
All vehicles
1. Install the wheel bearing and new wheel hub bolts.
^ Tighten to 133 Nm (98 ft. lbs).
2. Position the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly and install the 2 bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs).
3. Install the brake disc.
AWD vehicles 4. Using a suitable installation tool, install the halfshaft into the wheel bearing and
wheel hub. 5. Install the halfshaft hub nut.
^ Tighten to 275 Nm (203 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
Front Wheel Hub Nut ...........................................................................................................................
.............................................. 350 Nm (258 ft. lbs).
Install a new front wheel hub nut.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Dust Cover, Wheel Hub > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Dust Cover: > 10-2-9 > Feb > 10 > Drivetrain - Growl/Howl
From Rear Hub Area
Dust Cover: Customer Interest Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area
TSB 10-2-9
02/15/10
NOISE FROM REAR WHEEL HUB BEARING - BUILT ON OR BEFORE 12/4/2008
FORD: 2007-2009 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 09-26-5 to update the Parts List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Edge and MKX vehicles built on or before 12/4/2008 may exhibit a growl
or howl type noise coming from the left and/or right rear wheel area. This could be the result of a
faulty rear wheel hub bearing assembly.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. If Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics identify a faulty rear wheel hub bearing, it will be
necessary to replace the rear suspension trailing
arm/knuckle assembly along with a new rear wheel hub bearing assembly.
2. Refer to WSM, Section 204-02, for rear wheel hub bearing and trailing arm/knuckle replacement.
Only replace the rear suspension trailing
arm/knuckle assembly and rear bearing hub on the side with the concern. Failing to install a new
rear suspension trailing arm/knuckle assembly when installing a new rear bearing hub assembly
will result in premature bearing noise/wear.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100209A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 1.3 Hrs.
FWD: Replace ONE Rear Wheel Hub Bearing And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assembly
100209A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 1.5 Hrs.
AWD: Replace ONE Rear Wheel Hub Bearing And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assembly
100209B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 2.4 Hrs.
FWD: Replace BOTH Rear
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Dust Cover, Wheel Hub > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Dust Cover: > 10-2-9 > Feb > 10 > Drivetrain - Growl/Howl
From Rear Hub Area > Page 1794
Wheel Hub Bearings And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assemblies
100209B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 2.8 Hrs.
AWD: Replace BOTH Rear Wheel Hub Bearings And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assemblies
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
1104 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Dust Cover, Wheel Hub > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Dust Cover: > 10-2-9 > Feb > 10 > Drivetrain Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area
Dust Cover: All Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area
TSB 10-2-9
02/15/10
NOISE FROM REAR WHEEL HUB BEARING - BUILT ON OR BEFORE 12/4/2008
FORD: 2007-2009 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 09-26-5 to update the Parts List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Edge and MKX vehicles built on or before 12/4/2008 may exhibit a growl
or howl type noise coming from the left and/or right rear wheel area. This could be the result of a
faulty rear wheel hub bearing assembly.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. If Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics identify a faulty rear wheel hub bearing, it will be
necessary to replace the rear suspension trailing
arm/knuckle assembly along with a new rear wheel hub bearing assembly.
2. Refer to WSM, Section 204-02, for rear wheel hub bearing and trailing arm/knuckle replacement.
Only replace the rear suspension trailing
arm/knuckle assembly and rear bearing hub on the side with the concern. Failing to install a new
rear suspension trailing arm/knuckle assembly when installing a new rear bearing hub assembly
will result in premature bearing noise/wear.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100209A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 1.3 Hrs.
FWD: Replace ONE Rear Wheel Hub Bearing And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assembly
100209A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 1.5 Hrs.
AWD: Replace ONE Rear Wheel Hub Bearing And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assembly
100209B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 2.4 Hrs.
FWD: Replace BOTH Rear
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Dust Cover, Wheel Hub > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Dust Cover: > 10-2-9 > Feb > 10 > Drivetrain Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area > Page 1800
Wheel Hub Bearings And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assemblies
100209B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 2.8 Hrs.
AWD: Replace BOTH Rear Wheel Hub Bearings And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assemblies
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
1104 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Specifications
Wheel Fastener: Specifications
Wheel lug nuts
.............................................................................................................................................................
135 Nm (100 ft. lbs) in a star pattern
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair Front
Wheel Studs
Wheel Studs
Removal
1. Remove the wheel hub. 2. Using a press, remove the wheel stud from the wheel bearing and
hub assembly.
Installation
1. Position the new wheel stud in the wheel hub, aligning the serrations in the wheel hub flange
made by the original wheel stud. 2. Using a press, install a new wheel stud. 3. Install the wheel
hub.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 1806
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair Rear
Wheel Studs
Wheel Studs
Removal
1. Remove the wheel bearing and wheel hub. 2. Using a suitable press, remove the wheel stud
from the wheel hub.
^ Discard the wheel stud.
Installation
1. Position the new wheel stud in the wheel hub, aligning the serrations in the wheel hub flange
made by the original wheel stud. 2. Using a suitable press, install the wheel stud. 3. Install the
wheel bearing and wheel hub.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Description and Operation
Vehicle Lifting: Description and Operation
JACKING
WARNING:
- Do not run the engine when jacking the vehicle. The wheels contacting the ground could cause
the vehicle to move. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Make sure the jack and jack stands are correctly located to prevent the vehicle from falling.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Wheel chocks should be used to prevent the vehicle from rolling and falling off the jack. Failure to
follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: The service jack provided with the vehicle is only intended to be used in an emergency
for changing a deflated tire. Never use the service jack to hoist the vehicle for any other service.
Refer to the Owner Guide when using the jack supplied with the vehicle.
Jacking Points - Front
1. The front jacking points are identified by an upside down triangle on the rocker panel moulding
just behind the front wheels. Position the jack so
its lift area fits on the frame underneath the triangle.
Jacking Points - Rear
1. The rear jacking points are identified by an upside down triangle on the rocker panel moulding
just in front of the rear wheels. Position the jack so
its lift area fits on the frame underneath the triangle.
LIFTING
Lifting Points
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
1810
CAUTION: Under no circumstances should the vehicle be lifted by the front control arms, front cross braces or
rear control arms. Severe damage to the vehicle could result.
- Do not allow the lift adapters to contact the steering linkage, suspension arms, front cross braces,
stabilizer bar, or to compress the lower suspension arm stabilizer bar insulator. Damage to the
suspension, exhaust and steering linkage components may occur if care is not exercised when
positioning the lift adapters prior to lifting the vehicle.
1. CAUTION: Damage to the suspension, exhaust or steering linkage components may occur if
care is not exercised when positioning the
hoist adapters prior to lifting the vehicle.
The lifting points are part of the uni-body structure.
2. The front lifting points are identified by an upside down triangle on the rocker panel moulding just
behind the front wheels. Position the hoist
adapters directly under the frame rail with the triangle centered.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
1811
3. The rear lifting points are identified by an upside down triangle on the rocker panel moulding just
in front of the rear wheels. Position the hoist
adapters directly under the frame rail with the triangle centered.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Variable Valve Timing
Actuator: > 10-16-1 > Aug > 10 > Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser DTC's Set
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Customer Interest Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser DTC's Set
TSB 10-16-1
08/30/10
3.5L / 3.7L ENGINE - VCT CODES P0011, P0012, P0021, P0022 - RUNS ROUGH OR MISSES VEHICLES BUILT ON OR BEFORE 12/15/2008
FORD: 2008-2009 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2009 Edge 2009 Flex
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2007-2009 MKX
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 09-13-10 to update Service Procedure and Part List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Edge, MKX, MKZ, 2008-2009 Taurus, Taurus X, Sable, 2009 Flex and
MKS vehicles equipped with a 3.5L or 3.7L engine and vehicle build date on or before 12/15/2008
may exhibit a malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) on and one or more diagnostic trouble codes
(DTCs) P0011, P0012, P0016, P0018, P0021, P0022. Vehicle may also exhibit rough idle or
misses.
ACTION Follow the service procedure steps to correct this condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Using IDS, verify DTCs are present.
2. Verify vehicle build date on or before 12/15/2008.
a. If the vehicle was built after 12/15/2008, this procedure does not apply, refer to the Powertrain
Controls/Emissions Diagnosis (PC/ED) manual
for further diagnosis.
b. If the vehicle was built on or before 12/15/2008 and has any Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT)
DTCs P0011, P0012, P0016, P0018, P0021,
P0022 proceed to Step 3.
3. Remove both cam covers. Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 303-01.
4. Inspect the part number on the front of the camshaft phaser. You may need to rotate the engine
crank to move the phasers in position. The left cam
phaser should be 7T4E-6C524-EC and the right cam phaser should be 8T4E-6C524-AC.
a. If either one or both don't match the updated part numbers replace the phaser(s). Refer to WSM,
Section 303-01.
b. If both camshaft phasers have the updated part numbers, this procedure does not apply and
refer to the PC/ED manual for further diagnosis.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Variable Valve Timing
Actuator: > 10-16-1 > Aug > 10 > Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser DTC's Set > Page 1823
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101601A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 7.5 Hrs.
3.5L DOHC: Check DTCs, Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer
(Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101601A 2007-2009 MKZ FWD 3.5L 10.0
DOHC: Check DTCs, Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101601A 2007-2009 MKZ AWD 3.5L 10.3
DOHC: Check DTCs Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101601A 2008-2009 Taurus, Sable, 6.9 Hrs.
Taurus X 3.5L DOHC 2009 MKS 3.7L: Check DTCs, Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace
The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101601A 2009 Flex: Check DTCs, 7.0 Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101601B 2009 Flex: Check DTCs, 7.2 Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any
Other Labor Operations)
101601B 2008-2009 Taurus, Sable, 7.0 Hrs.
Taurus X 3.5L DOHC 2009 MKS 3.7L: Check DTCs Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace
Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101601B 2007-2009 MKZ AWD 3.5L 10.4
DOHC: Check DTCs, Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any
Other Labor Operations)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Variable Valve Timing
Actuator: > 10-16-1 > Aug > 10 > Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser DTC's Set > Page 1824
101601B 2007-2009 MKZ FWD 3.5L 10.2
DOHC:Check DTCs, Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any
Other Labor Operations)
101601B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 7.7 Hrs.
3.5L DOHC: Check DTCs, Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left
Phazers (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
6A257 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Variable Valve
Timing Actuator: > 10-16-1 > Aug > 10 > Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser DTC's Set
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser
DTC's Set
TSB 10-16-1
08/30/10
3.5L / 3.7L ENGINE - VCT CODES P0011, P0012, P0021, P0022 - RUNS ROUGH OR MISSES VEHICLES BUILT ON OR BEFORE 12/15/2008
FORD: 2008-2009 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2009 Edge 2009 Flex
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2007-2009 MKX
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 09-13-10 to update Service Procedure and Part List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Edge, MKX, MKZ, 2008-2009 Taurus, Taurus X, Sable, 2009 Flex and
MKS vehicles equipped with a 3.5L or 3.7L engine and vehicle build date on or before 12/15/2008
may exhibit a malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) on and one or more diagnostic trouble codes
(DTCs) P0011, P0012, P0016, P0018, P0021, P0022. Vehicle may also exhibit rough idle or
misses.
ACTION Follow the service procedure steps to correct this condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Using IDS, verify DTCs are present.
2. Verify vehicle build date on or before 12/15/2008.
a. If the vehicle was built after 12/15/2008, this procedure does not apply, refer to the Powertrain
Controls/Emissions Diagnosis (PC/ED) manual
for further diagnosis.
b. If the vehicle was built on or before 12/15/2008 and has any Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT)
DTCs P0011, P0012, P0016, P0018, P0021,
P0022 proceed to Step 3.
3. Remove both cam covers. Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 303-01.
4. Inspect the part number on the front of the camshaft phaser. You may need to rotate the engine
crank to move the phasers in position. The left cam
phaser should be 7T4E-6C524-EC and the right cam phaser should be 8T4E-6C524-AC.
a. If either one or both don't match the updated part numbers replace the phaser(s). Refer to WSM,
Section 303-01.
b. If both camshaft phasers have the updated part numbers, this procedure does not apply and
refer to the PC/ED manual for further diagnosis.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Variable Valve
Timing Actuator: > 10-16-1 > Aug > 10 > Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser DTC's Set > Page 1830
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101601A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 7.5 Hrs.
3.5L DOHC: Check DTCs, Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer
(Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101601A 2007-2009 MKZ FWD 3.5L 10.0
DOHC: Check DTCs, Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101601A 2007-2009 MKZ AWD 3.5L 10.3
DOHC: Check DTCs Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101601A 2008-2009 Taurus, Sable, 6.9 Hrs.
Taurus X 3.5L DOHC 2009 MKS 3.7L: Check DTCs, Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace
The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101601A 2009 Flex: Check DTCs, 7.0 Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101601B 2009 Flex: Check DTCs, 7.2 Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any
Other Labor Operations)
101601B 2008-2009 Taurus, Sable, 7.0 Hrs.
Taurus X 3.5L DOHC 2009 MKS 3.7L: Check DTCs Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace
Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101601B 2007-2009 MKZ AWD 3.5L 10.4
DOHC: Check DTCs, Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any
Other Labor Operations)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Variable Valve
Timing Actuator: > 10-16-1 > Aug > 10 > Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser DTC's Set > Page 1831
101601B 2007-2009 MKZ FWD 3.5L 10.2
DOHC:Check DTCs, Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any
Other Labor Operations)
101601B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 7.7 Hrs.
3.5L DOHC: Check DTCs, Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left
Phazers (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
6A257 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Valve 1
C1451
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Valve 1 > Page 1834
C1452
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1835
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Description and Operation
VARIABLE CAMSHAFT TIMING (VCT) SYSTEM
Overview
The VCT enables rotation of the camshaft(s) relative to the crankshaft rotation as a function of
engine operating conditions. There are 4 types of VCT systems. Exhaust phase shifting (EPS) system - the exhaust cam is the active cam being retarded.
- Intake phase shifting (IPS) system - the intake cam is the active cam being advanced.
- Dual equal phase shifting (DEPS) system - both intake and exhaust cams are phase shifted and
equally advanced or retarded.
- Dual independent phase shifting (DIPS) system - where both the intake and exhaust cams are
shifted independently.
All systems have 4 operational modes: idle, part throttle, wide open throttle (WOT), and default
mode. At idle and low engine speeds with closed throttle, the powertrain control module (PCM)
determines the phase angle based on air flow, engine oil temperature and engine coolant
temperature. At part and wide open throttle the PCM determines the phase angle based on engine
RPM, load, and throttle position. VCT systems provide reduced emissions and enhanced engine
power, fuel economy and idle quality. IPS systems also have the added benefit of improved torque.
In addition, some VCT system applications can eliminate the need for an external exhaust gas
recirculation (EGR) system. The elimination of the EGR system is accomplished by controlling the
overlap time between the intake valve opening and exhaust valve closing. Currently, both the IPS
and DEPS systems are used.
Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) System
VCT System
The VCT system consists of an electric hydraulic positioning control solenoid, a camshaft position
(CMP) sensor, and a trigger wheel. The CMP trigger wheel has a number of equally spaced teeth
equal to the number (n) of cylinders on a bank plus one extra tooth (n+1). Four cylinder and V8
engines use a CMP 4+1 tooth trigger wheel. V6 engines use a CMP 3+1 tooth trigger wheel. The
extra tooth placed between the equally spaced teeth represents the CMP signal for that bank. A
crankshaft position sensor (CKP) provides the PCM with crankshaft positioning information in 10
degree increments. 1. The PCM receives input signals from the intake air temperature (IAT)
sensor, engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor, engine oil temperature
(EOT) sensor, CMP, throttle position (TP) sensor, mass air flow (MAF) sensor, and CKP to
determine the operating conditions of the engine. At idle and low engine speeds with closed
throttle, the PCM controls the camshaft position based on ECT, EOT, IAT, and MAF. During part
and wide open throttle, the camshaft position is determined by engine RPM, load and throttle
position. The VCT system does not operate until the engine is at normal operating temperature.
2. The VCT system is enabled by the PCM when the correct conditions are met. 3. The CKP signal
is used as a reference for CMP positioning. 4. The VCT solenoid valve is an integral part of the
VCT system. The solenoid valve controls the flow of engine oil in the VCT actuator assembly.
As the PCM controls the duty cycle of the solenoid valve, oil pressure/flow advances or retards the
cam timing. Duty cycles near 0% or 100% represent rapid movement of the camshaft. Retaining a
fixed camshaft position is accomplished by dithering (oscillating) the solenoid valve duty cycle.
The PCM calculates and determines the desired camshaft position. It continually updates the VCT
solenoid duty cycle until the desired position is achieved. A difference between the desired and
actual camshaft position represents a position error in the PCM VCT control loop. The PCM
disables the VCT and places the camshaft in a default position if a concern is detected. A related
DTC is also set when the concern is detected.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1836
5. When the VCT solenoid is energized, engine oil is allowed to flow to the VCT actuator assembly
which advances or retards the camshaft timing.
One half of the VCT actuator is coupled to the camshaft and the other half is connected to the
timing chain. Oil chambers between the 2 halves couple the camshaft to the timing chain. When
the flow of oil is shifted from one side of the chamber to the other, the differential change in oil
pressure forces the camshaft to rotate in either an advance or retard position depending on the oil
flow.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid: Service and Repair
VARIABLE CAMSHAFT TIMING (VCT) OIL CONTROL SOLENOID
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the LH or RH valve cover. 2. Remove the bolt and the variable camshaft timing (VCT)
oil control solenoid.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Compression Check > System Information >
Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Compression Test - Test Results
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75% of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit Chart.
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Compression Check > System Information >
Specifications > Page 1843
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
Compression Test
1. Make sure the oil in the crankcase is of the correct viscosity and at the correct level and that the
battery is correctly charged. Operate the vehicle
until the engine is at normal operating temperature. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position,
then remove all the spark plugs.
2. Set the throttle plates in the wide-open position. 3. Install a compression gauge such as the
Compression Tester in the No. 1 cylinder. 4. Install an auxiliary starter switch in the starting circuit.
With the ignition switch in the OFF position, and using the auxiliary starter switch, crank
the engine a minimum of 5 compression strokes and record the highest reading. Note the
approximate number of compression strokes necessary to obtain the highest reading.
5. Repeat the test on each cylinder, cranking the engine approximately the same number of
compression strokes.
Compression Test - Test Results
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75% of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit Chart.
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
If one or more cylinders reads low, squirt approximately one tablespoon of engine oil meeting Ford
specification on top of the pistons in the low-reading cylinders. Repeat the compression pressure
check on these cylinders.
Compression Test - Interpreting Compression Readings
1. If compression improves considerably, piston rings are worn or damaged. 2. If compression does
not improve, valves are sticking or not seating correctly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Compression Check > System Information >
Specifications > Page 1844
3. If 2 adjacent cylinders indicate low compression pressures and squirting oil on each piston does
not increase compression, the head gasket may be
leaking between cylinders. Engine oil or coolant in cylinders could result from this condition.
Use the Compression Pressure Limit Chart when checking cylinder compression so that the lowest
reading is within 75% of the highest reading.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications
Camshaft Bearing: Specifications
Camshaft bearing cap bolts .................................................................................................................
.................................................. 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Camshaft: Procedures
Camshaft Bearing Journal Diameter
1. Measure each camshaft journal diameter in 2 directions.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Camshaft End Play - OHC Engines
Special Tool(s)
1. Use a Dial Indicator Gauge with Holding Fixture to measure camshaft end play. 2. Position the
camshaft to the rear of the cylinder head. 3. Zero the indicator. 4. Move the camshaft to the front of
the cylinder head. Note and record the camshaft end play.
^ If camshaft end play exceeds specifications, install new camshaft and recheck end play.
^ If camshaft end play exceeds specification after camshaft installation, install a new cylinder head.
Camshaft Surface Inspection
1. Inspect camshaft lobes for pitting or damage in the contact area. Minor pitting is acceptable
outside the contact area.
^ If excessive pitting or damage is present, install new components as necessary.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1853
Camshaft Lobe Lift
Special Tool(s)
1. Use a Dial Indicator Gauge with Holding Fixture to measure camshaft intake/exhaust lobe lift.
^ Rotate the camshaft and subtract the lowest indicator reading from the highest indicator reading
to figure the camshaft lobe lift.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Camshaft Runout
Special Tool(s)
1. NOTE: Camshaft journals must be within specifications before checking runout.
Using the special tool, measure the camshaft runout. ^
Rotate the camshaft and subtract the lowest indicator reading from the highest indicator reading.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1854
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1855
Camshaft: Removal and Replacement
Part 1
Camshaft
Special Tool(s) (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1856
Special Tool(s) (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1857
Special Tool(s) (Part 3)
Material
Removal (Steps 1-40)
WARNING: Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or
near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: During engine repair procedures, cleanliness is extremely important. Any foreign
material, including any material created while cleaning gasket surfaces that enters the oil
passages, coolant passages or the oil pan, can cause engine failure.
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Recover the air conditioning system. For additional
information, refer to Heating and Air Conditioning. 3. Release the fuel system pressure. For
additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery and Air Induction. 4. Drain the engine cooling system.
For additional information, refer to Cooling System. 5. Remove the accessory drive belt and the
power steering belt. For additional information, refer to Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and
Accessories. 6. Disconnect the power steering cooler hose and drain the power steering fluid into a
suitable drain pan.
7. Remove the degas bottle. For additional information, refer to Cooling System. 8. Remove the
engine air cleaner and air cleaner outlet pipe. For additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery and
Air Induction. 9. Remove the battery tray. For additional information, refer to Battery.
10. Disconnect the battery harness electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1858
11. Remove the nut and disconnect the power feed from the battery terminal.
12. Remove the bolt and the ground wire.
^ Detach the 2 wiring harness retainers from the cowl.
13. Disconnect the vacuum hose from the upper intake manifold.
14. Disconnect the upper evaporative emissions (EVAP) tube quick connect coupling from the
purge valve. For additional information, refer to Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1859
15. Disconnect the upper radiator hose, lower radiator hose and 2 heater hoses from the
thermostat housing.
16. Detach the wiring harness retainer from the transaxle control cable bracket.
17. Disconnect the transaxle control cable from the control lever.
^ Detach the control cable from the bracket.
18. Disconnect the transaxle control electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1860
19. If equipped, detach the engine block heater harness retainers from the radiator support and the
A/C suction tube.
20. Remove the nut and disconnect the A/C pressure tube fitting.
^ Discard the O-ring seal.
21. Remove the safety clip from the A/C fitting.
^ Disconnect the A/C suction tube fitting.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1861
22. Disconnect the hose from the power steering reservoir.
23. Disconnect the fuel supply tube. For additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery and Air
Induction.
24. Disconnect the fuel hose routing clip from the transaxle stud and position the fuel hose aside.
25. Disconnect the 2 engine wiring harness electrical connectors.
^ Detach the electrical connector from the LH valve cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1862
26. Remove the oil level indicator.
27. Detach the wiring harness retainer from the RH valve cover stud bolt.
28. Remove the bolt and the ground wire from the engine front cover.
29. Remove the nut, the ground wire and the radio interference capacitor wire from the engine front
cover stud.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1863
30. Loosen the exhaust flexible pipe clamp and disconnect the 2 exhaust hangers.
31. Remove the 4 nuts and the exhaust flexible pipe and Y-pipe as an assembly.
^ Discard the nuts and the gasket.
32. Remove the 3 pin-type retainers, the 7 screws and the radiator splash shield.
33. Remove the LH inner splash shield. 34. Remove the 2 secondary latches from the transmission
fluid cooler tubes.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1864
35. Using the special tool, disconnect the transaxle cooling tubes.
36. Remove the drain plug and drain the engine oil.
^ Install the drain plug and tighten to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs).
37. Remove and discard the engine oil filter.
38. Remove the power steering cooler bracket bolt from the RH side of the subframe.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1865
All wheel drive (AWD) vehicles
39. NOTE: Index-mark the driveshaft for installation.
Remove the 4 bolts and support the driveshaft with a length of mechanic's wire.
All vehicles
40. Remove and discard the RH front halfshaft nut.
Part 2
Camshaft
Removal (Steps 41-80)
41. Remove the 2 nuts and the roll restrictor heat shield.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1866
42. Remove the engine roll restrictor-to-subframe through bolt.
43. Remove and discard the power steering pressure (PSP) tube-to-pump banjo bolt and the 2
seals.
44. CAUTION: Do not allow the intermediate shaft to rotate while it is disconnected from the gear
or damage to the clockspring can occur. If
there is evidence that the intermediate shaft has rotated, the clockspring must be removed and
recentered. For additional information, refer to Air Bag Systems.
Remove and discard the steering intermediate shaft bolt. ^
Separate the steering intermediate shaft from the steering gear.
45. NOTE: RH shown, LH similar.
Remove and discard the cotter pins and tie-rod end nuts. ^
Using the special tool, separate the tie-rod ends from the wheel knuckles.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1867
46. NOTE: RH shown, LH similar.
Remove the 2 stabilizer link-to-lower control arm nuts and separate the stabilizer bar links from the
lower control arms.
47. NOTE: RH shown, LH similar.
Remove the lower control arm-to-knuckle pinch bolts and separate the lower control arms from the
knuckles.
48. Remove the 3 RH subframe-to-lower bumper nuts.
49. Remove the 3 LH subframe-to-lower bumper nuts and separate the lower bumper from the
subframe.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1868
50. Position the special tool under the subframe assembly.
51. Remove the 2 nuts, 4 bolts and the subframe support brackets.
52. Remove the 2 front subframe nuts.
53. Remove the 2 middle subframe nuts.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1869
54. Using the special tool, lower the subframe assembly from the vehicle.
55. If equipped, disconnect the oil cooler coolant hoses.
56. Using the special tools, separate the LH halfshaft from the transaxle and support the halfshaft
with a length of mechanic's wire.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1870
57. Using the special tool, separate the RH halfshaft from the hub.
Front wheel drive (FWD) vehicles
58. Remove the 2 RH catalytic converter support bracket bolts.
59. Remove the bolt, the nut and the RH catalytic converter support bracket.
60. Remove the 2 stud bolts and the RH halfshaft/intermediate shaft assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1871
AWD vehicles
61. Remove the 2 RH halfshaft bearing support bracket bolts and the RH halfshaft/intermediate
shaft assembly.
All vehicles
62. NOTE: Position a block of wood under the transaxle.
Install the special tools.
63. Remove the transaxle support insulator through bolt and nut.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1872
64. Remove the 3 nuts, the bolt and the transaxle support insulator bracket.
65. Remove the nut, bolt and engine mount brace.
66. Remove the 4 engine mount nuts.
67. Remove the 3 bolts and the engine mount.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1873
68. Lower the engine and transaxle assembly from the vehicle. 69. If equipped, detach the engine
block heater wiring harness retainers and position the harness aside. 70. Disconnect the positive
crankcase ventilation (PCV) fitting electrical connector.
71. Disconnect the PCV hose from the PCV valve.
72. Disconnect the throttle body electrical connector.
73. Detach the wiring harness retainers from the upper intake manifold.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1874
74. Remove the upper intake manifold support bracket bolt.
75. Remove the upper intake manifold support bracket bolt.
76. Remove the 6 bolts and the upper intake manifold.
^ Discard the gaskets.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1875
77. Disconnect the RH catalyst monitor electrical connector.
78. Disconnect the PSP switch electrical connector.
79. Disconnect the RH variable camshaft timing (VCT) solenoid electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1876
80. Disconnect the 3 RH coil-on-plug electrical connectors.
Part 3
Camshaft
Removal (Steps 81-119)
81. Disconnect the heated PCV valve electrical connector.
82. Detach all of the wiring harness retainers from the RH valve cover and stud bolts. 83.
Disconnect the LH VCT solenoid electrical connector.
84. Disconnect the 3 LH coil-on-plug electrical connectors.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1877
85. Detach all of the wiring harness retainers from the LH valve cover and stud bolts.
86. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Remove the 6 bolts and the 6 coil-on-plugs.
87. Remove the 11 stud bolts and the LH valve cover.
^ Discard the gasket.
88. Remove the bolt, the 10 stud bolts and the RH valve cover.
^ Discard the gasket.
89. NOTE: VCT solenoid seal removal shown, spark plug tube seal removal similar.
Inspect the VCT solenoid seals and the spark plug tube seals. Install new seals if damaged.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1878
^ Using the special tools, remove the seal(s).
90. Remove the 3 bolts and the power steering pump.
91. Remove the 3 bolts and the accessory drive belt tensioner.
92. Using the special tool, remove the crankshaft bolt and washer.
^ Discard the bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1879
93. Using the special tool, remove the crankshaft pulley.
94. Using the special tool, remove and discard the crankshaft front seal.
95. Remove the 2 engine mount studs.
96. Remove the 3 bolts and the engine mount bracket.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1880
97. Remove the 22 engine front cover bolts.
98. Install 4 of the engine front cover bolts (finger tight) into the 4 threaded holes in the engine front
cover.
1 Tighten the bolts one turn at a time in a criss-cross pattern until the engine front cover-to-cylinder
block seal is released.
2 Remove the engine front cover.
99. CAUTION: Place clean, lint free shop towels over exposed engine cavities. Carefully remove
the towels so foreign material is not dropped
into the engine.
CAUTION: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive means
to clean the sealing surfaces. These tools cause scratches and gouges that make leak paths. Use
a plastic scraping tool to remove all traces of sealant.
CAUTION: Observe all warnings or cautions and follow all application directions contained on the
packaging of the silicone gasket remover and the metal surface prep.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1881
Clean all engine sealing surfaces, including the engine front cover and cylinder block. 1
Remove any large deposits of silicone or gasket material with a plastic scraper.
2 Apply silicone gasket remover, following package directions, and allow to set for several minutes.
3 Remove the silicone gasket remover with a plastic scraper. A second application of silicone
gasket remover may be required if residual traces of silicone or gasket material remain.
4 Apply metal surface prep, following package directions, to remove any remaining traces of oil or
coolant and to prepare the surfaces to bond. Do not attempt to make the metal shiny. Some
staining of the metal surfaces is normal.
100. Rotate the crankshaft clockwise and align the timing marks on the variable camshaft timing
(VCT) assemblies as shown.
101. NOTE: The special tool will hold the camshafts in the top dead center position.
Install the special tool onto the flats of the LH camshafts.
102. NOTE: The special tool will hold the camshafts in the top dead center position.
Install the special tool onto the flats of the RH camshafts.
103. Remove the 3 bolts and the RH VCT housing.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1882
104. Remove the 3 bolts and the LH VCT housing.
105. Remove and discard the VCT housing seals.
106. Remove the 2 bolts and the primary timing chain tensioner.
107. Remove the primary timing chain tensioner arm.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1883
108. Remove the 2 bolts and the lower LH primary timing chain guide.
109. Remove the primary timing chain.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1884
LH camshafts 110. Compress the LH secondary timing chain tensioner and install a suitable
lockpin to retain the tensioner in the collapsed position.
111. NOTE: The VCT bolt and the exhaust camshaft bolt must be discarded and new ones
installed. However, the exhaust camshaft washer is reusable.
Remove and discard the LH VCT assembly bolt and the LH exhaust camshaft sprocket bolt. ^
Remove the LH VCT assembly, secondary timing chain and the LH exhaust camshaft sprocket as
an assembly.
112. NOTE: When the special tool is removed, valve spring pressure will rotate the LH camshafts
approximately 3 degrees to a neutral position.
Remove the special tool from the LH camshafts.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1885
113. CAUTION: The camshafts must remain in the neutral position during removal.
Verify the LH camshafts are in the neutral position.
114. CAUTION: Cylinder head camshaft bearing caps are numbered to verify that they are
assembled in their original positions.
Remove the bolts and the LH camshaft bearing caps. ^
Remove the LH camshafts.
RH camshafts 115. Compress the RH secondary timing chain tensioner and install a suitable
lockpin to retain the tensioner in the collapsed position.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1886
116. NOTE: The VCT bolt and the exhaust camshaft bolt must be discarded and new ones
installed. However, the exhaust camshaft washer is reusable.
Remove and discard the RH VCT assembly bolt and the RH exhaust camshaft sprocket bolt. ^
Remove the RH VCT assembly, secondary timing chain and the RH exhaust camshaft sprocket as
an assembly.
117. Remove the special tool from the RH camshafts.
118. CAUTION: The camshafts must remain in the neutral position during removal.
Rotate the RH camshafts counterclockwise to the neutral position.
119. CAUTION: Cylinder head camshaft bearing caps are numbered to verify that they are
assembled in their original positions.
Remove the bolts and the RH camshaft bearing caps. ^
Remove the RH camshafts.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1887
Part 1
Camshaft
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1888
Special Tool(s) (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1889
Special Tool(s) (Part 2)
Material
Installation (Steps 1-43)
WARNING: Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or
near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: During engine repair procedures, cleanliness is extremely important. Any foreign
material, including any material created while cleaning gasket surfaces that enters the oil
passages, coolant passages or the oil pan, can cause engine failure.
All camshafts
1. CAUTION: The crankshaft must remain in the freewheeling position (crankshaft dowel pin at 9
o'clock) until after the camshafts are
installed and the valve clearance is checked/adjusted. Do not turn the crankshaft until instructed to
do so. Failure to follow this process will result in severe engine damage.
Rotate the crankshaft counterclockwise until the crankshaft dowel pin is in the 9 o'clock position.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1890
LH camshafts
2. CAUTION: The camshafts must remain in the neutral position during installation.
NOTE: Coat the camshafts with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Position the camshafts onto the LH cylinder head in the neutral position as shown.
3. CAUTION: Cylinder head camshaft bearing caps are numbered to verify that they are assembled
in their original positions.
Install the 8 camshaft caps and the 16 bolts. ^
Tighten in the sequence shown to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1891
RH camshafts
4. CAUTION: The camshafts must remain in the neutral position during installation.
NOTE: Coat the camshafts with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Position the camshafts onto the RH cylinder head in the neutral position as shown.
5. CAUTION: Cylinder head camshaft bearing caps are numbered to verify that they are assembled
in their original positions.
Install the 8 camshaft caps and the 16 bolts. ^
Tighten in the sequence shown to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
All camshafts
6. CAUTION: If any components are installed new, the engine valve clearance must be
checked/adjusted or engine damage can occur.
NOTE: Use a camshaft sprocket bolt to turn the camshafts.
Using a feeler gauge, confirm that the valve tappet clearances are within specification. If valve
tappet clearances are not within specification, the clearance must be adjusted by installing new
valve tappet(s) of the correct size.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1892
LH camshafts
7. NOTE: Use a camshaft sprocket bolt to turn the camshafts.
Rotate the LH camshafts to the top dead center position and install the special tool on the flats of
the camshafts.
8. Assemble the LH variable camshaft timing (VCT) assembly, the LH exhaust camshaft sprocket
and the LH secondary timing chain.
^ Align the colored links with the timing marks.
9. Position the LH secondary timing assembly onto the camshafts.
10. Install 2 new bolts and the original washer. Tighten in 4 stages.
^ Stage 1: Tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
^ Stage 2: Loosen one full turn.
^ Stage 3: Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
^ Stage 4: Tighten 90 degrees.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1893
11. Remove the lockpin from the LH secondary timing chain tensioner.
RH camshafts
12. NOTE: Use a camshaft sprocket bolt to turn the camshafts.
Rotate the RH camshafts to the top dead center position and install the special tool on the flats of
the camshafts.
13. Assemble the RH VCT assembly, the RH exhaust camshaft sprocket and the RH secondary
timing chain.
^ Align the colored links with the timing marks.
14. Position the RH secondary timing assembly onto the camshafts.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1894
15. Install 2 new bolts and the original washer. Tighten in 4 stages.
^ Stage 1: Tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
^ Stage 2: Loosen one full turn.
^ Stage 3: Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
^ Stage 4: Tighten 90 degrees.
16. Remove the lockpin from the RH secondary timing chain tensioner.
All camshafts
17. Rotate the crankshaft clockwise 60 degrees to the top dead center position (crankshaft dowel
pin at 11 o'clock.)
18. Install the primary timing chain with the colored links aligned with the timing marks on the VCT
assemblies and the crankshaft sprocket.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1895
19. Install the lower LH primary timing chain guide and the 2 bolts.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
20. Install the primary timing chain tensioner arm.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1896
21. Reset the primary timing chain tensioner.
^ Rotate the lever counterclockwise.
^ Using a soft-jawed vise, compress the plunger.
^ Align the hole in the lever with the hole in the tensioner housing.
^ Install a suitable lockpin.
22. NOTE: It may be necessary to rotate the crankshaft slightly to remove slack from the timing
chain and install the tensioner.
Install the primary tensioner and the 2 bolts. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
^ Remove the lockpin.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1897
23. As a post-check, verify correct alignment of all timing marks.
24. Install new VCT housing seals.
25. CAUTION: Make sure the dowels on the VCT housing are fully engaged in the cylinder head
prior to tightening the bolts.
Install the LH VCT housing and the 3 bolts. ^
Tighten in the sequence shown to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1898
26. CAUTION: Make sure the dowels on the VCT housing are fully engaged in the cylinder head
prior to tightening the bolts.
Install the RH VCT housing and the 3 bolts. ^
Tighten in the sequence shown to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
27. Install the special tools.
28. NOTE: If the engine front cover, engine mount bracket and bolts 7, 8, 17, 18, 19, 20, 23, 24 and
25 are not installed and tightened within 10
minutes, the sealant must be removed and the sealing area cleaned. To clean the sealing area,
use silicone gasket remover and metal surface prep. Follow the directions on the packaging.
Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil leakage.
Apply a 3.0 mm (0.11 inch) bead of silicone gasket and sealant to the engine front cover sealing
surfaces including the 3 engine mount bracket bosses. ^
Apply a 5.5 mm (0.21 inch) bead of silicone gasket and sealant to the oil pan-to-cylinder block joint
and the cylinder head-to-cylinder block joint areas of the engine front cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1899
29. Install the engine front cover and bolts 7, 8, 17, 18, 19 and 20.
^ Tighten in sequence to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
30. Install the engine mount bracket and the 3 bolts.
^ Tighten in the sequence shown to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1900
31. Tighten the bolts in this sequence.
^ Tighten bolts 7, 8, 17, 18, 19 and 20 to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
^ Tighten bolts 23, 24 and 25 to 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs).
32. Remove the special tools (alignment pins).
33. NOTE: The remainder of the engine front cover bolts (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15,
16, 21 and 22) must be installed and tightened
within 60 minutes of the initial sealant application.
Install bolts 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 21 and 22 and tighten in the sequence
shown in 2 stages: ^
Stage 1: Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
^ Stage 2: Tighten to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1901
34. Install the 2 engine mount studs.
^ Tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs).
35. NOTE: Apply clean engine oil to the crankshaft front seal bore in the engine front cover.
Using the special tools, install a new crankshaft front seal.
36. NOTE: Lubricate the outside diameter sealing surfaces with clean engine oil.
Using the special tools, install the crankshaft pulley.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1902
37. Using the special tool, install the crankshaft pulley washer and new bolt and tighten in 4 stages.
^ Stage 1: Tighten to 120 Nm (89 ft. lbs).
^ Stage 2: Loosen one full turn.
^ Stage 3: Tighten to 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs).
^ Stage 4: Tighten an additional 90 degrees.
38. Install the accessory drive belt tensioner and the 3 bolts.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
39. Install the power steering pump and the 3 bolts.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
40. NOTE: Installation of new seals is only required if damaged seals were removed during
disassembly of the engine.
NOTE: Spark plug tube seal installation shown, variable camshaft timing (VCT) seal installation
similar.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1903
Using the special tools, install new VCT solenoid and/or spark plug tube seals.
41. NOTE: If the valve cover is not installed and the fasteners tightened within 5 minutes, the
sealant must be removed and the sealing area
cleaned. To clean the sealing area, use silicone gasket remover and metal surface prep. Follow the
directions on the packaging. Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil leakage.
Apply a 8 mm (0.31 inch) bead of silicone gasket and sealant to the engine front cover-to-RH
cylinder head joints.
42. Using a new gasket, install the RH valve cover, bolt and the 10 stud bolts.
^ Tighten in the sequence shown to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
43. NOTE: If the valve cover is not installed and the fasteners tightened within 5 minutes, the
sealant must be removed and the sealing area
cleaned. To clean the sealing area, use silicone gasket remover and metal surface prep. Follow the
directions on the packaging. Failure to follow
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1904
this procedure can cause future oil leakage.
Apply a 8 mm (0.31 inch) bead of silicone gasket and sealant to the engine front cover-to-LH
cylinder head joints.
Part 2
Camshaft
Installation (Steps 44-86)
44. Using a new gasket, install the LH valve cover and 11 stud bolts.
^ Tighten in the sequence shown to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
45. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Install the 6 coil-on-plug assemblies and the 6 bolts. ^
Tighten to 7 Nm (62 inch lbs).
46. Attach all of the wiring harness retainers to the LH valve cover and stud bolts. 47. Connect the
3 LH coil-on-plug electrical connectors.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1905
48. Connect the LH camshaft VCT solenoid electrical connector.
49. Attach all of the wiring harness retainers to the RH valve cover and stud bolts. 50. Connect the
heated positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) valve electrical connector.
51. Connect the 3 RH coil-on-plug electrical connectors.
52. Connect the RH VCT solenoid electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1906
53. Connect the power steering pressure (PSP) switch electrical connector.
54. Connect the RH catalyst monitor sensor electrical connector.
55. Using new gaskets, install the upper intake manifold and the 6 bolts.
^ Tighten in the sequence shown to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1907
56. Install the upper intake manifold support bracket bolt.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
57. Install the upper intake manifold support bracket bolt.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
58. Attach the wiring harness retainers to the upper intake manifold.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1908
59. Connect the throttle body electrical connector.
60. Connect the PCV hose to the PCV valve.
61. Connect the PCV fitting electrical connector.
62. If equipped, attach the engine block heater wiring harness retainers. 63. Raise the engine and
transaxle assembly into the vehicle. 64. Install the engine mount and the 3 bolts.
^ Tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1909
65. Install the 4 engine mount nuts.
^ Tighten to 63 Nm (46 ft. lbs).
66. Install the engine mount brace, the nut and the bolt.
^ Tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs).
67. Install the transaxle support insulator bracket, the 3 nuts and the bolt.
^ Tighten the nuts to 63 Nm (46 ft. lbs).
^ Tighten the bolt to 70 Nm (52 ft. lbs).
68. Install the transaxle support insulator through bolt and nut.
^ Tighten to 175 Nm (129 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1910
All wheel drive (AWD) vehicles
69. CAUTION: A new powertrain transfer unit (PTU) seal must be installed whenever the
intermediate shaft is removed.
Install a new powertrain transfer unit (PTU) seal.
70. NOTE: Prior to installation of the halfshaft, inspect the halfshaft sealing surface for wear or
damage and install new, if necessary.
Position the RH halfshaft/intermediate shaft assembly in the PTU and in the steering knuckle and
install the 2 bolts. ^
Tighten to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs).
Front wheel drive (FWD) vehicles
71. NOTE: Prior to installation of the halfshaft, inspect the halfshaft sealing surface for wear or
damage and install new if necessary.
Position the RH halfshaft/intermediate shaft assembly in the transaxle and in the steering knuckle
and install the 2 stud bolts. ^
Tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs).
72. NOTE: Do not tighten the 2 catalytic converter support bracket bolts at this time.
Install the converter support bracket and the 2 bolts.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1911
73. Install the catalytic converter bracket bolt and the nut.
1 Tighten the nut to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
2 Tighten the bolt to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs).
74. Tighten the 2 RH catalytic converter support bracket bolts to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs).
All vehicles
75. NOTE: Prior to installation of the halfshaft, inspect the halfshaft sealing surface for wear or
damage and install new, if necessary.
Install the LH halfshaft into the transaxle.
76. If equipped, connect the oil cooler coolant hoses.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1912
77. Using the special tool, raise the subframe into the installed position.
78. Install the 2 middle subframe nuts.
^ Tighten to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs).
79. Install the 2 front subframe nuts.
^ Tighten to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1913
80. Position the subframe support brackets in place and loosely install the 4 bolts.
81. Install the 2 rear subframe bracket nuts.
^ Tighten to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs).
82. Tighten the 4 subframe support bracket bolts.
^ Tighten to 103 Nm (76 ft. lbs).
83. Position the lower bumper on the subframe and install the 3 LH nuts.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1914
84. Install the 3 RH lower bumper-to-subframe nuts.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
85. NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
Install the ball joints in the steering knuckles and install the pinch bolts. ^
Tighten to 63 Nm (46 ft. lbs).
86. NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
Position the stabilizer bar links in the lower control arms and install the nuts. ^
Tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs).
Part 3
Camshaft
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1915
Installation (Steps 87-130)
87. NOTE: RH shown, LH similar.
Install the tie-rod ends and nuts. ^
Tighten to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs).
^ Install new cotter pins.
88. CAUTION: Do not allow the intermediate shaft to rotate while it is disconnected from the gear
or damage to the clockspring can occur. If
there is evidence that the intermediate shaft has rotated, the clockspring must be removed and
recentered. For additional information, refer to Air Bag Systems.
Install the intermediate shaft onto the steering gear and install a new bolt. ^
Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
89. Using a new banjo bolt and 2 new seals, install the PSP tube.
^ Tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs).
90. Install the engine roll restrictor-to-subframe through bolt.
^ Tighten to 103 Nm (76 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1916
91. Install the roll restrictor heat shield and the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
92. NOTE: Apply the brake to keep the halfshaft from rotating.
Install a new RH front halfshaft nut. ^
Tighten to 350 Nm (258 ft. lbs).
AWD vehicles
93. Line up the index marks on the rear driveshaft to the index marks on the PTU flange made
during removal and install the 4 bolts.
^ Tighten to 70 Nm (52 ft. lbs).
All vehicles
94. Install the power steering cooler bracket bolt to the RH side of the subframe.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1917
95. Connect the power steering cooler hose.
96. NOTE: Lubricate the engine oil filter gasket with clean engine oil prior to installing the oil filter.
Install a new engine oil filter. ^
Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs) and then rotate an additional 180 degrees.
97. Connect the 2 transmission fluid cooler tubes.
98. Install the 2 secondary latches onto the transmission fluid cooler tubes.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1918
99. Install the LH inner splash shield.
100. Install the radiator splash shield, the 3 pin-type retainers and the 7 screws.
101. Using a new gasket, install the Y-pipe and exhaust flexible pipe assembly and 4 new nuts.
^ Tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
102. Install the 2 exhaust hangers and tighten the exhaust clamp.
^ Tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
103. Install the ground wire, the radio interference capacitor wire and the nut to the engine front
cover stud.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1919
104. Install the ground wire and bolt to the engine front cover.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
105. Attach the wiring harness retainer to the RH valve cover stud bolt.
106. Install the oil level indicator.
107. Connect the 2 engine wiring harness electrical connectors.
^ Attach the electrical connector to the LH valve cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1920
108. Connect the fuel hose routing clip to the transaxle stud.
109. Connect the fuel supply tube. For additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery and Air
Induction.
110. Connect the hose to the power steering reservoir.
111. Connect the A/C suction tube fitting.
^ Install the safety clip onto the A/C fitting.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1921
112. Using a new O-ring seal, connect the A/C pressure tube fitting and install the nut.
^ Tighten to 6 Nm (53 inch lbs).
113. If equipped, attach the engine block heater harness retainers from to the radiator support and
the A/C suction tube.
114. Connect the transaxle control electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1922
115. Attach the control cable to the bracket.
^ Connect the transaxle control cable to the control lever.
116. Attach the wiring harness retainer to the transaxle control cable bracket.
117. Connect the upper radiator hose, lower radiator hose and 2 heater hoses to the thermostat
housing.
118. Connect the upper evaporative emissions (EVAP) tube quick connect coupling. to the purge
valve.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1923
119. Connect the vacuum hose to the upper intake manifold.
120. Install the ground wire and the bolt.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
^ Attach the 2 wiring harness retainers to the cowl.
121. Connect the power feed to the battery terminal and install the nut.
^ Tighten to 6 Nm (53 inch lbs).
122. Connect the battery harness electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1924
123. Install the battery tray. For additional information, refer to Battery. 124. Install the engine air
cleaner and the air cleaner outlet pipe. 125. Install the degas bottle. 126. Install the accessory drive
belt and the power steering belt. 127. Fill the engine with clean engine oil. 128. Fill and bleed the
cooling system. 129. Fill the power steering system. 130. Recharge the air conditioning system. For
additional information, refer to Heating and Air Conditioning.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Lifter / Lash Adjuster: Testing and Inspection
Valve Tappet Inspection
OHC engines
1. Inspect the valve tappet for damage, especially in the indicated areas. If any damage is evident,
inspect the camshaft lobes and valves for damage.
Replace components as necessary.
Push rod engines
Push rod engines
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Lifter / Lash Adjuster: Service and Repair Removal
Valve Tappets
CAUTION: During engine repair procedures, cleanliness is extremely important. Any foreign
material, including any material created while cleaning gasket surfaces that enters the oil
passages, coolant passages or the oil pan, can cause engine failure.
1. Depending on the valve tappets being serviced, remove the LH and/or the RH camshafts.
2. CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for installation
into their original locations.
Remove the valve tappets from the cylinder head.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 1930
Lifter / Lash Adjuster: Service and Repair Installation
Valve Tappets
Material
CAUTION: During engine repair procedures, cleanliness is extremely important. Any foreign
material, including any material created while cleaning gasket surfaces that enters the oil
passages, coolant passages or the oil pan, can cause engine failure.
1. CAUTION: The valve tappets must be installed in their original positions.
NOTE: Coat the valve tappets with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Install the valve tappets.
2. Depending on the valve tappets being serviced, install the LH and/or the RH camshafts.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 10-16-1 > Aug > 10 >
Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser DTC's Set
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Customer Interest Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser DTC's Set
TSB 10-16-1
08/30/10
3.5L / 3.7L ENGINE - VCT CODES P0011, P0012, P0021, P0022 - RUNS ROUGH OR MISSES VEHICLES BUILT ON OR BEFORE 12/15/2008
FORD: 2008-2009 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2009 Edge 2009 Flex
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2007-2009 MKX
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 09-13-10 to update Service Procedure and Part List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Edge, MKX, MKZ, 2008-2009 Taurus, Taurus X, Sable, 2009 Flex and
MKS vehicles equipped with a 3.5L or 3.7L engine and vehicle build date on or before 12/15/2008
may exhibit a malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) on and one or more diagnostic trouble codes
(DTCs) P0011, P0012, P0016, P0018, P0021, P0022. Vehicle may also exhibit rough idle or
misses.
ACTION Follow the service procedure steps to correct this condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Using IDS, verify DTCs are present.
2. Verify vehicle build date on or before 12/15/2008.
a. If the vehicle was built after 12/15/2008, this procedure does not apply, refer to the Powertrain
Controls/Emissions Diagnosis (PC/ED) manual
for further diagnosis.
b. If the vehicle was built on or before 12/15/2008 and has any Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT)
DTCs P0011, P0012, P0016, P0018, P0021,
P0022 proceed to Step 3.
3. Remove both cam covers. Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 303-01.
4. Inspect the part number on the front of the camshaft phaser. You may need to rotate the engine
crank to move the phasers in position. The left cam
phaser should be 7T4E-6C524-EC and the right cam phaser should be 8T4E-6C524-AC.
a. If either one or both don't match the updated part numbers replace the phaser(s). Refer to WSM,
Section 303-01.
b. If both camshaft phasers have the updated part numbers, this procedure does not apply and
refer to the PC/ED manual for further diagnosis.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 10-16-1 > Aug > 10 >
Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser DTC's Set > Page 1939
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101601A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 7.5 Hrs.
3.5L DOHC: Check DTCs, Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer
(Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101601A 2007-2009 MKZ FWD 3.5L 10.0
DOHC: Check DTCs, Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101601A 2007-2009 MKZ AWD 3.5L 10.3
DOHC: Check DTCs Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101601A 2008-2009 Taurus, Sable, 6.9 Hrs.
Taurus X 3.5L DOHC 2009 MKS 3.7L: Check DTCs, Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace
The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101601A 2009 Flex: Check DTCs, 7.0 Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101601B 2009 Flex: Check DTCs, 7.2 Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any
Other Labor Operations)
101601B 2008-2009 Taurus, Sable, 7.0 Hrs.
Taurus X 3.5L DOHC 2009 MKS 3.7L: Check DTCs Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace
Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101601B 2007-2009 MKZ AWD 3.5L 10.4
DOHC: Check DTCs, Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any
Other Labor Operations)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 10-16-1 > Aug > 10 >
Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser DTC's Set > Page 1940
101601B 2007-2009 MKZ FWD 3.5L 10.2
DOHC:Check DTCs, Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any
Other Labor Operations)
101601B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 7.7 Hrs.
3.5L DOHC: Check DTCs, Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left
Phazers (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
6A257 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 10-16-1 > Aug >
10 > Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser DTC's Set
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser
DTC's Set
TSB 10-16-1
08/30/10
3.5L / 3.7L ENGINE - VCT CODES P0011, P0012, P0021, P0022 - RUNS ROUGH OR MISSES VEHICLES BUILT ON OR BEFORE 12/15/2008
FORD: 2008-2009 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2009 Edge 2009 Flex
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2007-2009 MKX
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 09-13-10 to update Service Procedure and Part List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Edge, MKX, MKZ, 2008-2009 Taurus, Taurus X, Sable, 2009 Flex and
MKS vehicles equipped with a 3.5L or 3.7L engine and vehicle build date on or before 12/15/2008
may exhibit a malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) on and one or more diagnostic trouble codes
(DTCs) P0011, P0012, P0016, P0018, P0021, P0022. Vehicle may also exhibit rough idle or
misses.
ACTION Follow the service procedure steps to correct this condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Using IDS, verify DTCs are present.
2. Verify vehicle build date on or before 12/15/2008.
a. If the vehicle was built after 12/15/2008, this procedure does not apply, refer to the Powertrain
Controls/Emissions Diagnosis (PC/ED) manual
for further diagnosis.
b. If the vehicle was built on or before 12/15/2008 and has any Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT)
DTCs P0011, P0012, P0016, P0018, P0021,
P0022 proceed to Step 3.
3. Remove both cam covers. Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 303-01.
4. Inspect the part number on the front of the camshaft phaser. You may need to rotate the engine
crank to move the phasers in position. The left cam
phaser should be 7T4E-6C524-EC and the right cam phaser should be 8T4E-6C524-AC.
a. If either one or both don't match the updated part numbers replace the phaser(s). Refer to WSM,
Section 303-01.
b. If both camshaft phasers have the updated part numbers, this procedure does not apply and
refer to the PC/ED manual for further diagnosis.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 10-16-1 > Aug >
10 > Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser DTC's Set > Page 1946
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101601A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 7.5 Hrs.
3.5L DOHC: Check DTCs, Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer
(Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101601A 2007-2009 MKZ FWD 3.5L 10.0
DOHC: Check DTCs, Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101601A 2007-2009 MKZ AWD 3.5L 10.3
DOHC: Check DTCs Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101601A 2008-2009 Taurus, Sable, 6.9 Hrs.
Taurus X 3.5L DOHC 2009 MKS 3.7L: Check DTCs, Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace
The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101601A 2009 Flex: Check DTCs, 7.0 Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101601B 2009 Flex: Check DTCs, 7.2 Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any
Other Labor Operations)
101601B 2008-2009 Taurus, Sable, 7.0 Hrs.
Taurus X 3.5L DOHC 2009 MKS 3.7L: Check DTCs Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace
Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101601B 2007-2009 MKZ AWD 3.5L 10.4
DOHC: Check DTCs, Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any
Other Labor Operations)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 10-16-1 > Aug >
10 > Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser DTC's Set > Page 1947
101601B 2007-2009 MKZ FWD 3.5L 10.2
DOHC:Check DTCs, Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any
Other Labor Operations)
101601B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 7.7 Hrs.
3.5L DOHC: Check DTCs, Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left
Phazers (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
6A257 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Variable Valve
Timing Actuator: > 07-11-9 > Jun > 07 > Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging
Parking Brake Cable: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging
TSB 07-11-9
06/11/07
BRAKE DRAG
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some Edge/MKX vehicles may exhibit brake drag from the rear wheels or all wheels.
Customers may notice an odor and/or reduced powertrain performance. In some cases, the driver
may also note an integral vehicle dynamics (IVD) light after driving a given distance due to
pressure noted in the module without a change in brake on/off (BOO) state.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure to resolve brake drag concerns.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Raise the vehicle on a hoist, with engine running, and vehicle in park. Rotate all of the wheels by
hand to verify excessive force is necessary to turn wheels.
^ To resolve the brake drag concern from all wheels - Replacement of the BOO switch is
necessary.
^ To resolve the brake drag concern from the rear wheels only - Adjustment of the park brake
cables are necessary.
BOO Switch Replacement (All Brakes Drag) Removal
1. With the vehicle shut off and in park, remove the stop lamp switch by rotating the stop lamp
switch in the clockwise direction.
2. If the brake pedal moves up during the removal of the switch, the pedal was being inadvertently
held down by the stop lamp switch thus keeping the hydraulic circuits pressurized. Refer to
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 417-01.
3. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the switch and discard the switch.
Installation
NOTE
INSTALLATION OF THE NEW STOP LAMP SWITCH MUST BE DONE WITH THE BRAKE
PEDAL AT ITS NORMALLY INSTALLED AND RESTING POSITION. DO NOT PULL UP OR
PUSH DOWN ON THE BRAKE PEDAL DURING STOP LAMP SWITCH INSTALLATION. REFER
TO WSM, Section 417-01.
1. With the brake pedal at its rest position, insert the new stop lamp switch into the keyed hole on
the brake pedal and rotate the switch 45 degrees counter-clockwise to seat the switch. You may
hear a click sound during this step, this is normal.
2. Plug the wire harness connector to the new stop lamp switch.
3. Verify that the brake lamps are functioning properly and that the brakes are no longer dragging.
Park Cable Adjustment (Rear Brakes Drag)
Brake drag noted on rear wheels only likely caused by over adjusted park brake equalizer
adjustment (or all 3 cable lengths built at the minimum levels).
1. With vehicle on Hoist and shut off, verify rear brake pads are positioned properly per WSM,
Section 206-04: Rear Disc Brake.
2. With a fully released parking brake pedal, back off the adjustment until the wheels spin freely.
NOTE
DISTANCE BETWEEN THE NUT AND END OF THE STUD SHOULD BE 7/8" (22 mm)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Variable Valve
Timing Actuator: > 07-11-9 > Jun > 07 > Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging > Page 1953
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071109A 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.4 Hr.
Diagnose, Replace BOO Switch (Do Not Use With 13480A)
071109B 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.4 Hr.
Diagnose, Adjust Park Brake (Do Not Use With 2780B)
071109C 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.5 Hr.
Diagnose, Replace BOO Switch, And Adjust Park Brake (Do Not Use With 13480A, 2780B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
13480 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Variable Valve
Timing Actuator: > 07-11-9 > Jun > 07 > Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging > Page 1959
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071109A 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.4 Hr.
Diagnose, Replace BOO Switch (Do Not Use With 13480A)
071109B 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.4 Hr.
Diagnose, Adjust Park Brake (Do Not Use With 2780B)
071109C 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.5 Hr.
Diagnose, Replace BOO Switch, And Adjust Park Brake (Do Not Use With 13480A, 2780B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
13480 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Valve 1
C1451
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Valve 1 > Page 1962
C1452
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1963
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Description and Operation
VARIABLE CAMSHAFT TIMING (VCT) SYSTEM
Overview
The VCT enables rotation of the camshaft(s) relative to the crankshaft rotation as a function of
engine operating conditions. There are 4 types of VCT systems. Exhaust phase shifting (EPS) system - the exhaust cam is the active cam being retarded.
- Intake phase shifting (IPS) system - the intake cam is the active cam being advanced.
- Dual equal phase shifting (DEPS) system - both intake and exhaust cams are phase shifted and
equally advanced or retarded.
- Dual independent phase shifting (DIPS) system - where both the intake and exhaust cams are
shifted independently.
All systems have 4 operational modes: idle, part throttle, wide open throttle (WOT), and default
mode. At idle and low engine speeds with closed throttle, the powertrain control module (PCM)
determines the phase angle based on air flow, engine oil temperature and engine coolant
temperature. At part and wide open throttle the PCM determines the phase angle based on engine
RPM, load, and throttle position. VCT systems provide reduced emissions and enhanced engine
power, fuel economy and idle quality. IPS systems also have the added benefit of improved torque.
In addition, some VCT system applications can eliminate the need for an external exhaust gas
recirculation (EGR) system. The elimination of the EGR system is accomplished by controlling the
overlap time between the intake valve opening and exhaust valve closing. Currently, both the IPS
and DEPS systems are used.
Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) System
VCT System
The VCT system consists of an electric hydraulic positioning control solenoid, a camshaft position
(CMP) sensor, and a trigger wheel. The CMP trigger wheel has a number of equally spaced teeth
equal to the number (n) of cylinders on a bank plus one extra tooth (n+1). Four cylinder and V8
engines use a CMP 4+1 tooth trigger wheel. V6 engines use a CMP 3+1 tooth trigger wheel. The
extra tooth placed between the equally spaced teeth represents the CMP signal for that bank. A
crankshaft position sensor (CKP) provides the PCM with crankshaft positioning information in 10
degree increments. 1. The PCM receives input signals from the intake air temperature (IAT)
sensor, engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor, engine oil temperature
(EOT) sensor, CMP, throttle position (TP) sensor, mass air flow (MAF) sensor, and CKP to
determine the operating conditions of the engine. At idle and low engine speeds with closed
throttle, the PCM controls the camshaft position based on ECT, EOT, IAT, and MAF. During part
and wide open throttle, the camshaft position is determined by engine RPM, load and throttle
position. The VCT system does not operate until the engine is at normal operating temperature.
2. The VCT system is enabled by the PCM when the correct conditions are met. 3. The CKP signal
is used as a reference for CMP positioning. 4. The VCT solenoid valve is an integral part of the
VCT system. The solenoid valve controls the flow of engine oil in the VCT actuator assembly.
As the PCM controls the duty cycle of the solenoid valve, oil pressure/flow advances or retards the
cam timing. Duty cycles near 0% or 100% represent rapid movement of the camshaft. Retaining a
fixed camshaft position is accomplished by dithering (oscillating) the solenoid valve duty cycle.
The PCM calculates and determines the desired camshaft position. It continually updates the VCT
solenoid duty cycle until the desired position is achieved. A difference between the desired and
actual camshaft position represents a position error in the PCM VCT control loop. The PCM
disables the VCT and places the camshaft in a default position if a concern is detected. A related
DTC is also set when the concern is detected.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1964
5. When the VCT solenoid is energized, engine oil is allowed to flow to the VCT actuator assembly
which advances or retards the camshaft timing.
One half of the VCT actuator is coupled to the camshaft and the other half is connected to the
timing chain. Oil chambers between the 2 halves couple the camshaft to the timing chain. When
the flow of oil is shifted from one side of the chamber to the other, the differential change in oil
pressure forces the camshaft to rotate in either an advance or retard position depending on the oil
flow.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications
Connecting Rod Bearing: Specifications
Connecting Rod Bearing
Bore diameter
Grade
1..........................................................................................................................................................
59.866-59.872 mm (2.3569-2.3571 inch) Grade
2..........................................................................................................................................................
59.873-59.879 mm (2.3572-2.3574 inch) Grade
3..........................................................................................................................................................
59.880-59.886 mm (2.3574-2.3577 inch)
Bearing-to-crankshaft clearance...........................................................................................................
............................................................................... -
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Connecting Rod: Specifications
Connecting Rod
Piston-to-connecting rod clearance......................................................................................................
.................................................... 2.7 mm (0.1 inch) Rod-to-pin clearance
Standard...............................................................................................................................................
............. 0.007-0.021 mm (0.0002-0.0008 inch) Service limit...............................................................
................................................................................................................................................... Pin bore diameter.................................................................................................................................
................... 23.007-23.019 mm (0.905-0.906 inch) Rod length (center-to-center)..............................
............................................................................................................................. 152.68 mm (6.01
inch) Rod maximum allowed bend.......................................................................................................
.................................................. 0.038 mm (0.0014 inch) Rod maximum allowed twist.......................
................................................................................................................................... 0.050 mm
(0.0019 inch) Rod bearing
Bore diameter
Grade
1....................................................................................................................................................
59.866-59.872 mm (2.3569-2.3571 inch) Grade
2....................................................................................................................................................
59.873-59.879 mm (2.3572-2.3574 inch) Grade
3....................................................................................................................................................
59.880-59.886 mm (2.3574-2.3577 inch)
Bearing-to-crankshaft clearance...........................................................................................................
......................................................................... Rod side clearance (assembled to crank)
Standard...............................................................................................................................................
............. 0.175-0.425 mm (0.0068-0.0167 inch) Service limit...............................................................
................................................................................................................................................... -
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Gear/Sprocket >
Component Information > Specifications
Crankshaft Gear/Sprocket: Specifications
Crankshaft Pulley Bolt
Discard the bolt.
First pass .............................................................................................................................................
................................................ 120 Nm (89 ft. lbs). Second pass .......................................................
................................................................................................................................. Loosen one full
turn Third pass .....................................................................................................................................
........................................................ 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs). Final pass ......................................................
...................................................................................................................................................
Tighten 90°
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Specifications
Crankshaft
Main bearing journal
Diameter...............................................................................................................................................
....................................... 67.5 mm (2.657 inch) Maximum taper..........................................................
............................................................................................................ 0.004 mm (0.00015 inch)
Maximum out-of-round.........................................................................................................................
................................. 0.006 mm (0.00023 inch) Journal-to-cylinder block clearance...........................
................................................................................................................................................... Main bearing bore inside
diameter...................................................................................................................... 72.400-72.424
mm (2.8503-2.8513 inch)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Crankshaft: Specifications
Crankshaft
Main bearing journal
Diameter...............................................................................................................................................
....................................... 67.5 mm (2.657 inch) Maximum taper..........................................................
............................................................................................................ 0.004 mm (0.00015 inch)
Maximum out-of-round.........................................................................................................................
................................. 0.006 mm (0.00023 inch) Journal-to-cylinder block clearance...........................
................................................................................................................................................... Connecting rod journal
Diameter...............................................................................................................................................
............. 55.983-56.003 mm (2.204-2.205 inch) Maximum taper.........................................................
............................................................................................................. 0.004 mm (0.00015 inch)
Maximum out-of-round.........................................................................................................................
................................. 0.006 mm (0.00023 inch)
Maximum end
play..................................................................................................................................................
0.101-0.291 mm (0.0039-0.0114 inch) Main bearing bore inside
diameter...................................................................................................................... 72.400-72.424
mm (2.8503-2.8513 inch)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1981
Crankshaft: Service and Repair
Crankshaft End Play
Special Tool(s)
1. Measure the crankshaft end play. Use a Dial Indicator Gauge with Holding Fixture to measure
crankshaft end play. 2. Position the crankshaft to the rear of the cylinder block. 3. Zero the
indicator. 4. Move the crankshaft to the front of the cylinder block. Note and record the crankshaft
end play.
^ If crankshaft end play exceeds specifications, install a new crankshaft thrust washer or crankshaft
thrust main bearing.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Engine Block Heater >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Engine Block Heater: Service and Repair
Block Heater
Block Heater
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Drain the cooling system. 3. Remove the RH catalytic
converter. For additional information, refer to Catalytic Converter. 4. Remove the block heater
cover.
5. CAUTION: Make sure that the block heater wiring is routed and secured away from rotating or
hot components, or damage to the
wiring can occur.
Disconnect the block heater electrical connector.
6. Remove the block heater.
^ To install, tighten to 41 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 8. Fill and bleed the cooling system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications
Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Specifications
Crankshaft Pulley Bolt
Discard the bolt.
First pass .............................................................................................................................................
................................................ 120 Nm (89 ft. lbs). Second pass .......................................................
................................................................................................................................. Loosen one full
turn Third pass .....................................................................................................................................
........................................................ 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs). Final pass ......................................................
...................................................................................................................................................
Tighten 90°
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1988
Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Diagrams
Lower End Components - Exploded View, Crankshaft Pulley and Crankshaft Front Seal
Lower End Components - Exploded View, Crankshaft Pulley and Crankshaft Front Seal
Lower End Components - Exploded View, Flexplate and Crankshaft Rear Seal
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1989
Lower End Components - Exploded View, Flexplate and Crankshaft Rear Seal
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1990
Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Pulley
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove the accessory drive belt and the power steering belt.
For additional information, refer to Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories. 3. Using the
special tool, remove the crankshaft bolt and washer.
^ Discard the bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1991
4. Using the special tool, remove the crankshaft pulley.
Installation
1. Lubricate the crankshaft front seal inner lip with clean engine oil.
2. NOTE: Lubricate the outside diameter sealing surfaces with clean engine oil.
Using the special tools, install the crankshaft pulley.
3. Using the special tool, install the crankshaft pulley washer and new bolt and tighten in 4 stages.
^ Stage 1: Tighten to 120 Nm (89 ft. lbs).
^ Stage 2: Loosen one full turn.
^ Stage 3: Tighten to 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs).
^ Stage 4: Tighten an additional 90 degrees.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1992
4. Install the accessory drive belt and the power steering belt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Piston: Specifications
Piston
Diameter - single
grade.......................................................................................................................................
92.476-92.490 mm (3.6407-3.6413 inch) Piston-to-cylinder bore
clearance........................................................................................................................ 0.010 to
0.044 mm (0.0003-0.0017 inch) Ring end gap
Compression (top, gauge
diameter)....................................................................................................................... 0.15-0.25 mm
(0.0059-0.0098 inch) Compression (bottom, gauge
diameter)................................................................................................................. 0.30-0.55 mm
(0.0118-0.0216 inch) Oil ring (steel rail, gauge
diameter)....................................................................................................................... 0.15-0.45 mm
(0.0059-0.0177 inch)
Ring groove width
Compression
(top)...............................................................................................................................................
1.230-1.25 mm (0.0484-0.0492 inch) Compression
(bottom).........................................................................................................................................
1.530-1.55 mm (0.0602-0.0610 inch) Oil ring.......................................................................................
........................................................................... 2.53-2.55 mm (0.0996-0.1003 inch)
Ring width
Upper comp
ring...................................................................................................................................................
1.17-1.19 mm (0.0460-0.0468 inch) Lower comp
ring...................................................................................................................................................
1.47-1.49 mm (0.0578-0.0586 inch)
Ring-to-groove clearance (upper and lower compression
rings)............................................................................. 0.040-0.080 mm (0.0015-0.0031 inch)
Piston Pin
Bore
diameter................................................................................................................................................
23.002-23.006 mm (0.9055-0.9057 inch) Pin diameter........................................................................
.......................................................................... 22.998-23.000 mm (0.9054-0.9055 inch) Pin length.
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................. 55.975 mm (2.203 inch) Pin-to-piston
fit........................................................................................................................................... 0.002 to
0.008 mm (0.00007-0.0003 inch)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Piston Ring: Specifications
Piston Rings
Ring end gap
Compression (top, gauge
diameter)....................................................................................................................... 0.15-0.25 mm
(0.0059-0.0098 inch) Compression (bottom, gauge
diameter)................................................................................................................. 0.30-0.55 mm
(0.0118-0.0216 inch) Oil ring (steel rail, gauge
diameter)....................................................................................................................... 0.15-0.45 mm
(0.0059-0.0177 inch)
Ring groove width
Compression
(top)...............................................................................................................................................
1.230-1.25 mm (0.0484-0.0492 inch) Compression
(bottom).........................................................................................................................................
1.530-1.55 mm (0.0602-0.0610 inch) Oil ring.......................................................................................
........................................................................... 2.53-2.55 mm (0.0996-0.1003 inch)
Ring width
Upper comp
ring...................................................................................................................................................
1.17-1.19 mm (0.0460-0.0468 inch) Lower comp
ring...................................................................................................................................................
1.47-1.49 mm (0.0578-0.0586 inch)
Ring-to-groove clearance (upper and lower compression
rings)............................................................................. 0.040-0.080 mm (0.0015-0.0031 inch)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Clearance > System
Information > Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
Valve Clearance
A midrange clearance is the most desirable.
Intake ...................................................................................................................................................
....................... 0.15 - 0.25 mm (0.006 - 0.01 inch) Exhaust
..............................................................................................................................................................
0.300 - 0.400 mm (0.0118 - 0.0157 inch)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Clearance > System
Information > Specifications > Page 2003
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
Valve Clearance Check
1. Remove the valve covers.
2. NOTE: The valve clearance must be measured with the camshaft at base circle. The engine will
have to be rotated with the crankshaft pulley bolt
to bring each valve to base circle.
Use a feeler gauge to measure the clearance of each valve and record its location. A midrange
clearance is the most desirable: ^
Intake: 0.15 - 0.25 mm (0.006 - 0.01 inch)
^ Exhaust: 0.300 - 0.400 mm (0.0118 - 0.0157 inch)
3. NOTE: The number on the valve tappet reflects the thickness of the valve tappet. For example, a
tappet with the number 3.310 has the thickness
of 3.31 mm (0.13 inch).
If any of the valve clearances are out of specification, select new tappets using this formula: tappet
thickness = measured clearance + the base tappet thickness - most desirable thickness. Select the
tappets and mark the installation location.
4. If required, install the new selected valve tappets in the marked locations.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Fuel Pressure Release >
System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELEASE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
WARNING:
- Do not carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any fuel-related
components. Highly flammable vapors are always present and can ignite. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, which may cause personal injury
or a fire hazard.
1. Remove the Schrader valve cap.
2. NOTE: This step will drain some fuel out of the system. Place the fuel in a suitable container.
Install the special tool and slowly open the manual valve to relieve the fuel system pressure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH
Valve Cover: Service and Repair Valve Cover - LH
Valve Cover - LH
Special Tool(s)
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 2011
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 2012
Removal
CAUTION: During engine repair procedures, cleanliness is extremely important. Any foreign
material, including any material created while cleaning gasket surfaces that enters the oil
passages, coolant passages or the oil pan, can cause engine failure.
1. Remove the crankcase vent tube. 2. Remove the LH ignition coils. For additional information,
refer to Ignition System. 3. Remove the oil level indicator. 4. Disconnect the LH variable camshaft
timing (VCT) solenoid electrical connector. 5. Detach all of the wiring harness retainers from the
valve cover and the stud bolts. 6. Remove the 11 stud bolts and the LH valve cover.
^ Discard the gasket.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 2013
7. NOTE: VCT solenoid seal removal shown, spark plug tube seal removal similar.
Inspect the VCT solenoid seals and the spark plug tube seals. Remove any damaged seals. ^
Using the special tools, remove the seal(s).
8. Clean the valve cover, cylinder head and engine front cover sealing surfaces with metal surface
cleaner.
Installation
1. NOTE: Installation of new seals is only required if damaged seals were removed during
disassembly of the engine.
NOTE: Spark plug tube seal installation shown, VCT seal installation similar.
Using the special tools, install new VCT solenoid and/or spark plug tube seals.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 2014
2. NOTE: If the valve cover is not installed and the fasteners tightened within 5 minutes, the sealant
must be removed and the sealing area
cleaned. To clean the sealing area, use silicone gasket remover and metal surface prep. Follow the
directions on the packaging. Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil leakage.
Apply a 8 mm (0.31 inch) bead of silicone gasket and sealant to the engine front cover-to-LH
cylinder head joints.
3. Using a new gasket, install the LH valve cover and 11 stud bolts.
^ Tighten in the sequence shown to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
4. Attach all of the wiring harness retainers to the valve cover and the stud bolts. 5. Connect the LH
VCT solenoid electrical connector. 6. Install the oil level indicator. 7. Install the LH ignition coils. 8.
Install the crankcase vent tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 2015
Valve Cover: Service and Repair Valve Cover - RH
Valve Cover - RH
Special Tool(s)
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 2016
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 2017
Removal
CAUTION: During engine repair procedures, cleanliness is extremely important. Any foreign
material, including any material created while cleaning gasket surfaces that enters the oil
passages, coolant passages or the oil pan, can cause engine failure.
1. Remove the RH ignition coils. For additional information, refer to Ignition System. 2. Disconnect
the power steering pressure (PSP) switch electrical connector. 3. Disconnect the RH catalyst
monitor sensor electrical connector and pin-type retainer. 4. Disconnect the RH heated oxygen
sensor (HO2S) electrical connector. 5. Disconnect the RH variable camshaft timing (VCT) electrical
connector. 6. Disconnect the 3 RH fuel injector electrical connectors. 7. Disconnect the heated
positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) valve electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 2018
8. Detach all of the wiring harness retainers from the RH valve cover and the stud bolts. 9. Remove
the bolt, the 10 stud bolts and the RH valve cover.
^ Discard the gasket.
10. NOTE: VCT solenoid seal removal shown, spark plug tube seal removal similar.
Inspect the VCT solenoid seals and the spark plug tube seals. Remove any damaged seals. ^
Using the special tools, remove the seal(s).
11. Clean the valve cover, cylinder head and engine front cover sealing surfaces with metal surface
cleaner.
Installation
1. NOTE: Installation of new seals is only required if damaged seals were removed during
disassembly of the engine.
NOTE: Spark plug tube seal installation shown, VCT seal installation similar.
Using the special tools, install new VCT solenoid and/or spark plug tube seals.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 2019
2. NOTE: If the valve cover is not installed and the fasteners tightened within 5 minutes, the sealant
must be removed and the sealing area
cleaned. To clean the sealing area, use silicone gasket remover and metal surface prep. Follow the
directions on the packaging. Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil leakage.
Apply a 8 mm (0.31 inch) bead of silicone gasket and sealant to the engine front cover-to-RH
cylinder head joints.
3. Using a new gasket, install the RH valve cover, bolt and the 10 stud bolts.
^ Tighten in the sequence shown to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
4. Attach all of the wiring harness retainers to the valve cover and the stud bolts. 5. Connect the
heated PCV valve electrical connector. 6. Connect the 3 RH fuel injector electrical connectors. 7.
Connect the RH VCT electrical connector. 8. Connect the RH HO2S electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 2020
9. Connect the RH catalyst monitor sensor electrical connector and pin-type retainer.
10. Connect the PSP switch electrical connector. 11. Install the RH ignition coils.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Guide > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Valve Guide: Service and Repair
Valve Guide Inner Diameter
1. NOTE: Valve guides tend to wear in an hourglass pattern. The ball gauge can be inserted into
the combustion chamber side of the valve guide if
necessary.
Use a ball gauge to determine the inner diameter of the valve guides in 2 directions at the top,
middle and bottom of the valve guide.
2. Measure the ball gauge with a micrometer.
3. If the valve guide is not within specifications, ream the valve guide and install a valve with an
oversize stem or remove the valve guide and install
a new valve guide.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Seat > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Valve Seat: Service and Repair
Valve Seat Inspection
Valve and Seat Refacing Measurements
CAUTION: After grinding valves or valve seats, check valve clearance.
1. Check the valve head and seat.
^ Check valve angles.
^ Check margin width.
^ Be sure margin width is within specification.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
2. Inspect for abnormalities on the valve face and seat. Install a new cylinder head assembly if
abnormalities are found.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Valve Spring: Procedures
Valve Spring Free Length
1. Measure the free length of each valve spring.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Valve Spring Squareness
1. Measure the out-of-square on each valve spring.
^ Turn the valve spring and observe the space between the top of the valve spring and the square.
Install a new valve spring if out of square.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Valve Spring Strength
Special Tool(s)
1. Use a Valve/Clutch Spring Pressure Gauge to check the valve spring for correct strength at the
specified valve spring length.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2031
Valve Spring: Removal and Replacement
Removal
Valve Spring, Retainer and Seal
Special Tool(s)
CAUTION: During engine repair procedures, cleanliness is extremely important. Any foreign
material, including any material created while cleaning gasket surfaces that enters the oil
passages, coolant passages or the oil pan, can cause engine failure.
1. Remove all of the camshafts. 2. Rotate the crankshaft until the piston for the valve being
serviced is at the top of its stroke.
3. CAUTION: If air pressure has forced the piston to the bottom of the cylinder, any loss of air
pressure will allow the valve to fall into the
cylinder. If air pressure must be removed, support the valve prior to removal.
CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in their original positions.
Mark the components for installation into their original locations.
NOTE: If a valve drops into the cylinder, remove the cylinder head.
Pressurize the cylinder using compressed air.
4. Using the special tool, remove the keys, retainer and spring.
5. Remove and discard the valve stem seal.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2032
Installation
Valve Spring, Retainer and Seal
Special Tool(s)
Material
1. NOTE: Lubricate the valve stem seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2033
Using the special tool, install a new valve stem seal.
2. Using the special tools, install the valve spring, retainer and key.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Valve: Testing and Inspection
Valve Inspection
1. Inspect these valve areas:
1 The end of the stem for grooves or scoring.
2 The valve face and the edge for pits, grooves or scores.
3 The valve head for signs of burning, erosion, warpage and cracking.
4 The valve margin for wear.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2037
Valve: Service and Repair
Valve Stem Diameter
1. Measure the diameter of each intake and exhaust valve stem at the points shown. Verify the
diameter is within specification.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-23-18 > Nov > 07 > Steering - Power
Steering Belt Chirp/Squeal When Cold
Drive Belt: Customer Interest Steering - Power Steering Belt Chirp/Squeal When Cold
TSB 07-23-18
11/26/07
POWER STEERING BELT CHIRP/SQUEAL - COLD
FORD: 2007 Edge, Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX, MKX
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles, equipped with a 3.5L engine and built between
6/20/2007 - 6/29/2007 and 8/13/2007 - 8/24/2007 may exhibit a power steering belt chirp or squeal
noise when cold. Turning the steering wheel to the stop position may also cause the slip and
squeal. This may be caused by an incorrect power steering belt being installed.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Inspect power steering belt label.
2. If a white label Motorcraft(R) belt Part Number 7T4E-6C301-AB is present, then the vehicle has
the correct belt and this TSB does not apply. Follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM), Section
100-4 diagnostics.
3. If a blue label Motorcraft® belt Part Number 7T4E-6C301 -BB is present, then the vehicle has
the incorrect belt and it must be replaced.
4. Cut the old belt off and follow WSM, Section 303-05 for power steering belt installation.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072318A 2007 Edge, MKX 3.5L: 0.6 Hr.
Replace The Power Steering Belt (Do Not Use with 8620C)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
6C301 38
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 07-23-18 > Nov > 07 >
Steering - Power Steering Belt Chirp/Squeal When Cold
Drive Belt: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Power Steering Belt Chirp/Squeal When Cold
TSB 07-23-18
11/26/07
POWER STEERING BELT CHIRP/SQUEAL - COLD
FORD: 2007 Edge, Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX, MKX
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles, equipped with a 3.5L engine and built between
6/20/2007 - 6/29/2007 and 8/13/2007 - 8/24/2007 may exhibit a power steering belt chirp or squeal
noise when cold. Turning the steering wheel to the stop position may also cause the slip and
squeal. This may be caused by an incorrect power steering belt being installed.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Inspect power steering belt label.
2. If a white label Motorcraft(R) belt Part Number 7T4E-6C301-AB is present, then the vehicle has
the correct belt and this TSB does not apply. Follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM), Section
100-4 diagnostics.
3. If a blue label Motorcraft® belt Part Number 7T4E-6C301 -BB is present, then the vehicle has
the incorrect belt and it must be replaced.
4. Cut the old belt off and follow WSM, Section 303-05 for power steering belt installation.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072318A 2007 Edge, MKX 3.5L: 0.6 Hr.
Replace The Power Steering Belt (Do Not Use with 8620C)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
6C301 38
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Drive Belt: > 07-17-2 > Sep >
07 > ABS/TCS - ABS/ESC Lamps ON/DTC's C1165/C1175/C1235/C1236
Wheel Speed Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS/TCS - ABS/ESC Lamps ON/DTC's
C1165/C1175/C1235/C1236
TSB 07-17-2
09/03/07
ABS LAMP ON C1165/C1175 AND/OR C1235/C1236
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge/MKX vehicles built before 6/1/2007 (FWD only) may exhibit an Anti-Lock
Brake System (ABS) warning lamp and/or a Electronic Stability Control (ESC) warning lamp
illuminated with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) C1165/C1175 and/or C1235/C1236. This may be
due to a faulty rear wheel speed sensor.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Verify DTCs C1235/C1236 and/or C1165/C1175 are present. If so, continue on to Step 2. For all
other codes follow normal Workshop Manual diagnostics.
2. With the ignition off, proceed with the replacement of the faulted wheel speed sensor. Refer to
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 206-09.
NOTE
IT IS NOT NECESSARY TO REMOVE THE HARNESS ROUTING BRACKETS WHEN
PERFORMING THE REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE.
3. With a new wheel speed sensor installed, make sure to torque the retaining bolt to 7 N.m (62
lb-in).
4. Clear continuous DTCs.
NOTE
THE ABS SYSTEM CONFIRMS REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL INPUT BASED ON
SEVERAL WHEEL REVOLUTIONS ABOVE 24 KM/H (15 MPH). DRIVE VEHICLE FOR AT LEAST
75 FEET AT OR ABOVE 15 MPH. IF WHEEL SPEED SIGNAL INPUT IS MISSING THE ABS
LIGHT WILL ILLUMINATE.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071702A 2007 Edge/MKX Built 0.5 Hr.
Before 6/1/2007: Check Diagnostic Trouble Codes and Replace One Rear Wheel Speed Sensor
(Do Not Use With 12650D, 2219D, 2219D5)
071702B 2007 Edge/MKX Built 0.7 Hr.
Before 6/1/2007: Check Diagnostic Trouble Codes and Replace Both Rear
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Drive Belt: > 07-17-2 > Sep >
07 > ABS/TCS - ABS/ESC Lamps ON/DTC's C1165/C1175/C1235/C1236 > Page 2057
Wheel Speed Sensors (Do Not Use With 12650D, 2219D, 2219D5)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C216 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Drive Belt: > 07-17-2 > Sep >
07 > ABS/TCS - ABS/ESC Lamps ON/DTC's C1165/C1175/C1235/C1236 > Page 2063
Wheel Speed Sensors (Do Not Use With 12650D, 2219D, 2219D5)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C216 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Diagrams > Exploded Views
Drive Belt: Exploded Views
Front End Accessory Drive (FEAD) - Exploded View
Front End Accessory Drive (FEAD) - Exploded View
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Diagrams > Exploded Views > Page 2066
Drive Belt: Mechanical Diagrams
Front Engine Accessory Drive
Front Engine Accessory Drive
Power Steering Pump Belt
Power Steering Pump Belt (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Diagrams > Exploded Views > Page 2067
Power Steering Pump Belt (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Drive Belt: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Inspection and Verification
CAUTION: Under no circumstances should the accessory drive belt, tensioner or pulleys be
lubricated as potential damage to the belt material and tensioner damping mechanism will occur.
Do not apply any fluids or belt dressing to the accessory drive belt or pulleys.
1. Verify the customer concern by operating the system. 2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of
mechanical damage.
Visual Inspection Chart
Visual Inspection Chart
3. Eliminate all other non-belt related noises that could cause belt misdiagnosis, such as A/C
compressor engagement chirp, power steering
cavitations at low temperatures, variable camshaft timing (VCT) tick or generator whine.
4. If a concern is found, correct the condition before proceeding to the next step.
V-Ribbed Serpentine Drive Belt With Cracks Across Ribs
5. NOTE: Up to 15 cracks in a rib over a distance of 100 mm (4.0 inch) can be considered
acceptable. If damage exceeds the acceptable limit or
any chunks are found to be missing from the ribs, a new belt must be installed.
Check the belt for cracks. Up to 15 cracks in a rib over a distance of 100 mm (4.0 inch) can be
considered acceptable. If cracks exceed this standard, install a new belt.
6. The condition of the V-ribbed drive belt should be compared against the illustration and
appropriate action taken.
1 Small scattered deposits of rubber material. This is not a concern, therefore, installation of a new
belt is not required.
2 Longer deposit areas building up to 50% of the rib height. This is not considered a concern but it
can result in excessive noise. If noise is apparent, install a new belt.
3 Heavy deposits building up along the grooves resulting in a possible noise and belt stability
concern. If heavy deposits are apparent, install a new belt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2070
V-Ribbed Serpentine Belt With Piling
7. There should be no chunks missing from the belt ribs. If the belt shows any evidence of this,
install a new accessory drive belt.
V-Ribbed Serpentine Belt With Chunks of Rib Missing
8. If the concern is not visually evident, verify the symptom and GO to Symptom Chart. See:
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2071
Drive Belt: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Symptom Chart
Symptom Chart (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2072
Symptom Chart (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2073
Drive Belt: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Drive Belt - Noise/Flutter
Drive belt chirp occurs due to pulley misalignment or excessive pulley runout. It can be the result of
a damaged or incorrectly aligned grooved pulley.
To correct, determine the area where the noise comes from. Check each of the pulleys in that area
with a straightedge to the crankshaft pulley. Look for accessory pulleys out of position in the fore/aft
direction or at an angle to the straightedge.
CAUTION: Do not apply any fluids or belt dressing to the accessory drive belt or pulleys.
Drive belt squeal may be an intermittent or constant noise that occurs when the drive belt slips on
an accessory pulley under certain conditions.
A short intermittent squeal may occur during engine start-up and shut down or during very rapid
engine acceleration and decelerations, such as: ^
wide open throttle 1-2 and 2-3 shifts or 2-3 and 3-4 back out shifts on automatic transmissions.
^ wide open throttle 1-2 and 2-3 shifts and any combination of rapid downshifting on manual
transmissions.
These special short-term transient events are expected, and are due to the higher system inertias
required to meet the electrical and cooling demands on today's vehicle systems. Constant or
reoccurring drive belt squeal can occur: ^
if the A/C discharge pressure goes above specifications: - the A/C system is overcharged. - the A/C
condenser core airflow is blocked.
^ if the A/C off equalized pressure (the common discharged and suction pressure that occurs after
several minutes) exceeds specifications.
^ if any of the accessories are damaged or have a worn or damaged bearing. All accessories
should be rotatable by hand in the unloaded condition. If not, inspect the accessory.
^ if there is evidence of fluid contamination on the accessory drive belt. When the drive belt has
been exposed to fluid contamination during vehicle operation, such as leaks from the power
steering system, A/C system or cooling system, clean all pulleys with soap and water, rinse with
clean water and install a new accessory drive belt. If the drive belt has been exposed to fluids in a
localized area during routine vehicle service, such as replacement of hoses or fluids, the drive belt
and pulleys should be washed with soap and water immediately (prior to starting the engine), and
rinsed with clean water.
^ if the accessory drive belt is too long. A drive belt that is too long will allow the accessory drive
belt tensioner arm to go all the way to the arm travel stop under certain load conditions, which will
release tension to the drive belt. If the accessory drive belt tensioner indicator is outside the normal
installation wear range window, install a new accessory drive belt.
^ NOTE: The accessory drive belt tensioner arm should rotate freely without binding.
Install a new accessory drive belt tensioner if the drive belt tensioner is worn or damaged.
Drive Belt - Incorrect Installation
CAUTION: Incorrect accessory drive belt installation will cause excessive drive belt wear and can
cause the drive belt to come off the pulleys.
Non-standard accessory drive belts can track differently or incorrectly. If an accessory drive belt
tracks incorrectly, install a new accessory drive belt to avoid performance failure or loss of the drive
belt.
Incorrect Installation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2074
Correct Installation
With the engine running, check accessory drive belt tracking on all pulleys. If the edge of the
accessory drive belt rides beyond the edge of the pulleys, noise and premature wear will occur.
Make sure the accessory drive belt rides correctly on the pulley. If an accessory drive belt tracking
condition exists: ^
Visually check the accessory drive belt tensioner for damage, especially the mounting pad surface.
If the accessory drive belt tensioner is not installed correctly, the mounting surface pad will be out
of position. This will result in chirp and squeal noises.
^ With the engine running, visually observe the grooves in the pulleys (not the pulley flanges or the
pulley forward faces) for excessive wobble. Install new components as necessary.
^ Check all accessories, mounting brackets and the accessory drive belt tensioner for any
interference that would prevent the component from mounting correctly. Correct any interference
condition and recheck the accessory drive belt tracking.
^ Tighten all accessories, mounting brackets and accessory drive belt tensioner retaining hardware
to specification. Recheck the accessory drive belt tracking.
Belt Tensioner - Mechanical
The only mechanical check that needs to be made is a check for tensioner stick, grab or bind. 1.
With the engine off, check routing of the accessory drive belt.
2. NOTE: The accessory drive belt tensioner spring is very strong and requires substantial force to
release.
Using a suitable, commercially available serpentine belt tensioner release tool, release the tension
on the belt and detach the accessory drive belt in the area of the tensioner.
3. Using a suitable, commercially available serpentine belt tensioner release tool, move the
tensioner from its relaxed position, through its full stroke
and back to the relaxed position to make sure there is no stick, grab or bind, and to make sure that
there is tension on the tensioner spring.
4. Rotate the tensioner pulley by hand and check for a binding, contaminated or seized condition.
Install a new accessory drive belt tensioner if
necessary.
5. Inspect the area surrounding the accessory drive belt tensioner for oil leaks or contamination
and repair any leaks. Install a new accessory drive
belt tensioner as necessary.
6. If the accessory drive belt tensioner meets the above criteria, proceed to testing the tensioner
dynamically. If the accessory drive belt tensioner
does not meet the above criteria, install a new tensioner.
Belt Tensioner - Dynamics
The accessory drive belt tensioner can be checked dynamically as follows: 1. With the engine
running, observe the accessory drive belt tensioner movement. The accessory drive tensioner
should move (respond) when the air
conditioning clutch cycles (if equipped), or when the engine is accelerated rapidly. If the accessory
drive belt tensioner movement is excessive without air conditioning clutch cycling or engine
acceleration, check belt rideout. Excessive belt rideout (uneven depth of grooves in the belt) can
cause excessive accessory drive belt tensioner movement. Check rideout condition by installing a
new belt. If excessive accessory drive belt tensioner movement still exists, install a new accessory
drive belt tensioner.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Accessory Drive Belt
Drive Belt: Service and Repair Accessory Drive Belt
Accessory Drive Belt
Removal
CAUTION: Under no circumstances should the accessory drive belt, tensioner or pulleys be
lubricated as potential damage to the belt material and tensioner damping mechanism will occur.
Do not apply any fluids or belt dressing to the accessory drive belt or pulleys.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Working from the top of the vehicle, using a suitable belt
tensioner release tool, rotate the accessory drive belt tensioner clockwise and remove the
accessory drive belt from the generator pulley.
3. Remove the RH inner fender splash shield. 4. Working from under the vehicle, remove the
accessory drive belt.
Installation
1. Working from under the vehicle, position the accessory drive belt on all pulleys, with the
exception of the generator pulley.
2. CAUTION: Make sure the belt is correctly seated on all pulleys.
Working from the top of the vehicle, position the accessory drive belt on the generator pulley. Using
a suitable belt tensioner release tool, rotate the accessory drive belt tensioner clockwise and install
the accessory drive belt on the generator pulley.
3. Install the RH inner fender splash shield.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Accessory Drive Belt > Page 2077
Drive Belt: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump Belt
Power Steering Pump Belt
Special Tool(s)
Removal
CAUTION: Under no circumstances should the accessory drive belt, tensioner or pulleys be
lubricated as potential damage to the belt material and tensioner damping mechanism will occur.
Do not apply any fluids or belt dressing to the accessory drive belt or pulleys.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Working from the top of the vehicle, using a suitable belt
tensioner release tool, rotate the accessory drive belt tensioner clockwise and remove the
accessory drive belt from the generator pulley.
3. Remove the RH inner fender splash shield. 4. Position the accessory drive belt off the crankshaft
pulley. 5. Install the Power Steering Belt Removal Tool between the power steering pump belt and
pulley, turning the crankshaft bolt clockwise to remove
the power steering belt.
Installation
1. Install the power steering belt on the crankshaft pulley.
2. CAUTION: After installation, make sure the belt is correctly seated on the crankshaft and power
steering pulleys.
Position the power steering belt around the Power Steering Installation Tool and the power steering
pulley. Make sure that the belt is engaged with the power steering pulley and rotate the crankshaft
clockwise to install the power steering belt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Accessory Drive Belt > Page 2078
3. Position the accessory drive belt on the crankshaft pulley.
4. CAUTION: Make sure the belt is correctly seated on all pulleys.
Working from the top of the vehicle, position the accessory drive belt on the generator pulley. Using
a suitable belt tensioner release tool, rotate the accessory drive belt tensioner clockwise and install
the accessory drive belt on the generator pulley.
5. Install the RH inner fender splash shield.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt Tensioner > Component Information > Diagrams
Drive Belt Tensioner: Diagrams
Front End Accessory Drive (FEAD) - Exploded View
Front End Accessory Drive (FEAD) - Exploded View
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt Tensioner > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2082
Drive Belt Tensioner: Description and Operation
Belt Tensioner
Automatic tensioners are calibrated to provide the correct amount of tension to the belt for a given
accessory drive system. Unless a spring or damping band within the tensioner assembly breaks or
some other mechanical part of the tensioner fails, there is no need to check the tensioner for
correct tension.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt Tensioner > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2083
Drive Belt Tensioner: Service and Repair
Accessory Drive Belt Tensioner
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Working from the top of the vehicle, using a suitable belt
tensioner release tool, rotate the accessory drive belt tensioner clockwise and remove the
accessory drive belt from the generator pulley.
3. Remove the RH inner fender splash shield. 4. Remove the 3 bolts and the accessory drive belt
tensioner.
Installation
1. Install the accessory drive belt tensioner and the 3 bolts.
Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
2. CAUTION: Make sure the belt is correctly seated on all pulleys.
Working from the top of the vehicle, using a suitable belt tensioner release tool, rotate the
accessory drive belt tensioner clockwise and install the accessory drive belt on the generator
pulley.
3. Install the RH inner fender splash shield.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair
Engine Mount: Service and Repair
Engine Mount
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2087
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Loosen the exhaust flexible pipe clamp and disconnect the 2
exhaust hangers.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
3. Remove the 4 nuts, the exhaust flexible pipe and the Y-pipe as an assembly.
^ Discard the nuts and the gasket.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
4. Remove the 2 nuts and the roll restrictor heat shield.
^ To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2088
5. Loosen the roll restrictor-to-subframe through bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 103 Nm (76 ft. lbs).
6. Remove the roll restrictor through bolt and the 2 roll restrictor-to-transaxle bracket plate bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs).
7. Remove the 3 bolts and the transaxle bracket.
^ To install, tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs).
8. CAUTION: The special tool must be carefully aligned to the mounting bosses on the oil pan.
Failure to follow these instructions may
result in damage to the oil pan.
Position a floor jack and the special tool under the oil pan.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2089
9. Remove the 3 bolts and position the engine coolant degas bottle aside.
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
10. Remove the nut, bolt and engine mount brace.
^ To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs).
11. Remove the 4 engine mount nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 63 Nm (46 ft. lbs).
12. Remove the 3 bolts and the engine mount.
^ To install, tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2090
13. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Pressure >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Engine Oil Pressure: Testing and Inspection
Oil Pressure Test
1. Disconnect and remove the oil pressure sensor from the engine. 2. Connect the Engine Oil
Pressure Gauge to the oil pressure sender oil galley port. 3. Run the engine until normal operating
temperature is reached. 4. Run the engine at the specified rpm and record the gauge reading. 5.
The oil pressure should be within specifications. 6. If the pressure is not within specification, check
these possible sources:
^ Insufficient oil
^ Oil leakage
^ Worn or damaged oil pump
^ Oil pump screen cover and tube
^ Excessive main bearing clearance
^ Excessive connecting rod bearing clearance
^ Chain tensioner leak
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil
With Filter ............................................................................................................................................
............................................................. 5.2L (5.5 Qt)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 2099
Engine Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Engine Oil
U.S. ........................................................................................................................................
Motorcraft SAE 5W-20 Premium Synthetic Blend Motor Oil Canada
...................................................................................................................................................
Motorcraft SAE 5W-20 Super Premium Motor Oil
Ford Part Number:
................................................................................................................................ XO-5W20-QSP
(US), CXO-5W20LSP12 (Canada) Ford Specification:
..................................................................................................................................................
WSS-M2C930-A and API Certification
NOTE: Use of synthetic or synthetic blend motor oil is not mandatory. Engine oil need only meet
the requirements of Ford specification WSS-M2C930-A and the API Certification mark.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Cooler, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Oil Cooler: Service and Repair
Oil Cooler
Oil Cooler
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Drain the cooling system. For additional information, refer to
Cooling System. 3. Remove the LH catalytic converter. For additional information, refer to Catalytic
Converter. 4. Disconnect the 2 coolant hoses from the oil cooler.
5. CAUTION: If metal or aluminum material is present in the oil cooler, mechanical concerns exist.
Remove the 6 bolts and the oil cooler. ^
Discard the gaskets.
^ Inspect the oil cooler.
^ Clean and inspect all sealing surfaces.
Installation
1. Using new gaskets, install the oil cooler and the 6 bolts.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
2. Connect the 2 coolant hoses to the oil cooler. 3. Install the LH catalytic converter. For additional
information, refer to Catalytic Converter. 4. Fill and bleed the cooling system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Cooler, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 2103
Oil Cooler: Tools and Equipment
1/2" Oil Cooler Line Rem.
AST tool# 8023
Used to disconnect 1/2" transmission oil cooler lines.
- Used for R and R of Transmission Oil Cooler Lines
- Orange-Anodized Aluminum Construction
- Quick line removal
- Included in the #8110 Line Disconnect Set
- Fits 2009 Escape with 6F Trans
- Fits Ford Edge
Contact AST for pricing.
Assenmacher Specialty Tools 1-800-525-2943
This Tool is also available in the following kits:
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Cooler, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 2104
8110 - 10-Pc. Line Disconnect Set
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter Adapter > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Oil Filter Adapter: Service and Repair
Oil Filter Adapter
Material
Engine With Oil Cooler
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter Adapter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 2108
Engine Without Oil Cooler
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove and discard the engine oil filter. 3. If equipped,
remove the engine oil cooler. 4. Remove the 2 bolts and the oil filter adapter.
^ Discard the gasket and O-ring seal.
^ Clean and inspect all sealing surfaces.
Installation
1. Using a new gasket and O-ring seal, install the oil filter adapter.
^ Tighten the large bolt to 57 Nm (42 ft. lbs).
^ Tighten the small bolt to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
2. NOTE: Lubricate the engine oil filter gasket with clean engine oil prior to installing the oil filter.
Install a new engine oil filter. ^
Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs) and then rotate an additional 180 degrees.
3. If equipped, install the engine oil cooler.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Oil Pan: Service and Repair Removal
Oil Pan
Special Tool(s)
Material
CAUTION: During engine repair procedures, cleanliness is extremely important. Any foreign
material, including any material created while cleaning gasket surfaces that enters the oil
passages, coolant passages or the oil pan, can cause engine failure.
All vehicles
1. Remove the engine from the vehicle. 2. Remove the 8 bolts and the flexplate.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2113
3. Remove the crankshaft sensor ring.
4. CAUTION: Install the engine stand bolts into the cylinder block only. Do not install the bolts into
the oil pan.
Mount the engine on a suitable engine stand.
5. If equipped, remove the heat shield and disconnect the block heater electrical connector.
^ Detach all of the engine block heater harness retainers and remove the harness.
6. Disconnect the positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) fitting electrical connector.
7. Disconnect the PCV hose from the PCV valve.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2114
8. Disconnect the throttle body electrical connector.
9. Detach the wiring harness retainers from the upper intake manifold.
10. Remove the upper intake manifold support bracket bolt.
11. Remove the upper intake manifold support bracket bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2115
12. Remove the 6 bolts and the upper intake manifold.
^ Discard the gaskets.
13. Disconnect the power steering pressure (PSP) switch electrical connector.
Front wheel drive (FWD) vehicles
14. Disconnect the RH catalyst monitor sensor electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2116
All vehicles
15. Disconnect the RH variable camshaft timing (VCT) solenoid electrical connector.
16. Disconnect the 3 RH coil-on-plug electrical connectors.
17. Disconnect the heated PCV valve electrical connector.
18. Detach all of the wiring harness retainers from the RH valve cover and stud bolts. 19.
Disconnect the LH catalyst monitor sensor electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2117
20. Disconnect the LH VCT solenoid electrical connector.
21. Disconnect the 3 LH coil-on-plug electrical connectors.
22. Detach all of the wiring harness retainers from the LH valve cover and stud bolts.
23. NOTE: The A/C compressor must remain bolted to the engine block prior to installing the oil
pan.
Remove the A/C compressor nut and stud.
24. Remove the 3 bolts and the power steering pump.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2118
25. Remove the 3 bolts and the accessory drive belt tensioner.
26. Remove the 4 nuts (3 shown) and the LH catalytic converter.
^ Discard the nuts and the gasket.
FWD vehicles
27. Remove the 4 nuts and the RH catalytic converter.
^ Discard the nuts and the gasket.
All vehicles
28. Remove the RH cylinder block drain plug or, if equipped, the block heater.
^ Allow coolant to drain from the cylinder block.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2119
29. Remove the LH cylinder block drain plug.
^ Allow coolant to drain from the cylinder block.
30. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar. Remove the 6 bolts and the 6 coil-on-plugs.
31. Remove the 11 stud bolts and the LH valve cover.
^ Discard the gasket.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2120
32. Remove the bolt, the 10 stud bolts and the RH valve cover.
^ Discard the gasket.
33. NOTE: VCT solenoid seal removal shown, spark plug tube seal removal similar.
Inspect the VCT solenoid seals and the spark plug tube seals. Remove any damaged seals. ^
Using the special tools, remove the seal(s).
34. Using the special tool, remove the crankshaft bolt and washer.
^ Discard the bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2121
35. Using the special tool, remove the crankshaft pulley.
36. Using the special tool, remove and discard the crankshaft front seal.
37. Remove the 2 engine mount studs.
38. Remove the 3 bolts and the engine mount bracket.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2122
39. Remove the 22 engine front cover bolts.
40. Install 4 of the engine front cover bolts (finger tight) into the 4 threaded holes in the engine front
cover.
1 Tighten the bolts one turn at a time in a criss-cross pattern until the engine front cover-to-cylinder
block seal is released.
2 Remove the engine front cover.
41. Remove the 16 oil pan bolts.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2123
42. Install 2 of the oil pan bolts (finger tight) into the 2 threaded holes in the oil pan.
1 Alternately tighten the 2 bolts one turn at a time until the oil pan-to-cylinder block seal is released.
2 Remove the oil pan.
43. CAUTION: Place clean, lint free shop towels over exposed engine cavities. Carefully remove
the towels so foreign material is not dropped
into the engine.
CAUTION: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive means
to clean the sealing surfaces. These tools cause scratches and gouges that make leak paths. Use
a plastic scraping tool to remove all traces of sealant.
CAUTION: Observe all warnings or cautions and follow all application directions contained on the
packaging of the silicone gasket remover and the metal surface prep.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2124
Clean all engine sealing surfaces, including the engine front cover, oil pan and cylinder block. 1
Remove any large deposits of silicone or gasket material with a plastic scraper.
2 Apply silicone gasket remover, following package directions, and allow to set for several minutes.
3 Remove the silicone gasket remover with a plastic scraper. A second application of silicone
gasket remover may be required if residual traces of silicone or gasket material remain.
4 Apply metal surface prep, following package directions, to remove any remaining traces of oil or
coolant and to prepare the surfaces to bond. Do not attempt to make the metal shiny. Some
staining of the metal surfaces is normal.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2125
Oil Pan: Service and Repair Installation
Oil Pan
Special Tool(s) (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2126
Special Tool(s) (Part 2)
Material
CAUTION: During engine repair procedures, cleanliness is extremely important. Any foreign
material, including any material created while cleaning gasket surfaces that enters the oil
passages, coolant passages or the oil pan, can cause engine failure.
All vehicles
1. NOTE: The oil pan and bolts must be installed and the oil pan aligned to the cylinder block and
A/C compressor within 5 minutes of sealant
application. Final tightening of the oil pan bolts must be carried out within 60 minutes of sealant
application.
Apply a 3 mm (0.11 inch) bead of silicone gasket sealant to the sealing surface of the oil pan. ^
Apply a 5.5 mm (0.21 inch) bead of silicone gasket sealant to the 2 crankshaft seal retainer
plate-to-cylinder block joint areas on the sealing surface of the oil pan.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2127
2. Install the oil pan and the 16 bolts.
^ Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown to 3 Nm (27 inch lbs).
^ Loosen the bolts 180 degrees.
3. Align the oil pan to the cylinder block and the A/C compressor.
^ Position the oil pan so the mounting boss is against the A/C compressor and using a
straightedge, align the oil pan flush with the rear of the cylinder block at the 2 areas shown.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2128
4. Tighten the oil pan bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten the large bolts (1-14) to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs).
^ Tighten the small bolts (15 and 16) to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
5. Install the A/C compressor mounting stud and nut.
^ Tighten the stud to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs) and the nut to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2129
6. Install the special tools.
7. NOTE: If the engine front cover, engine mount bracket and bolts 7, 8, 17, 18, 19, 20, 23, 24 and
25 are not installed and tightened within 10
minutes, the sealant must be removed and the sealing area cleaned. To clean the sealing area,
use silicone gasket remover and metal surface prep. Follow the directions on the packaging.
Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil leakage.
Apply a 3.0 mm (0.11 inch) bead of silicone gasket and sealant to the engine front cover sealing
surfaces including the 3 engine mount bracket bosses. ^
Apply a 5.5 mm (0.21 inch) bead of silicone gasket and sealant to the oil pan-to-cylinder block joint
and the cylinder head-to-cylinder block joint areas of the engine front cover.
8. Install the engine front cover and bolts 7, 8, 17, 18, 19 and 20.
^ Tighten in sequence to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2130
9. Install the engine mount bracket and the 3 bolts.
^ Tighten in the sequence shown to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs).
10. Tighten the bolts in this sequence.
^ Tighten bolts 7, 8, 17, 18, 19 and 20 to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
^ Tighten bolts 23, 24 and 25 to 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2131
11. Remove the special tools (alignment pins).
12. NOTE: The remainder of the engine front cover bolts (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15,
16, 21 and 22) must be installed and tightened
within 60 minutes of the initial sealant application.
Install bolts 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 21 and 22 and tighten in the sequence
shown in 2 stages: ^
Stage 1: Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
^ Stage 2: Tighten to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
13. Install the 2 engine mount studs.
^ Tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2132
14. NOTE: Apply clean engine oil to the crankshaft front seal bore in the engine front cover.
Using the special tools, install a new crankshaft front seal.
15. NOTE: Lubricate the outside diameter sealing surfaces with clean engine oil.
Using the special tools, install the crankshaft pulley.
16. Using the special tool, install the crankshaft pulley washer and new bolt and tighten in 4 stages.
^ Stage 1: Tighten to 120 Nm (89 ft. lbs).
^ Stage 2: Loosen one full turn.
^ Stage 3: Tighten to 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs).
^ Stage 4: Tighten an additional 90 degrees.
17. NOTE: Installation of new seals is only required if damaged seals were removed during
disassembly of the engine.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2133
NOTE: Spark plug tube seal installation shown, variable camshaft timing (VCT) seal installation
similar.
Using the special tools, install new VCT solenoid and/or spark plug tube seals.
18. NOTE: If the valve cover is not installed and the fasteners tightened within 5 minutes, the
sealant must be removed and the sealing area
cleaned. To clean the sealing area, use silicone gasket remover and metal surface prep. Follow the
directions on the packaging. Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil leakage.
Apply a 8 mm (0.31 inch) bead of silicone gasket and sealant to the engine front cover-to-RH
cylinder head joints.
19. Using a new gasket, install the RH valve cover, bolt and the 10 stud bolts.
^ Tighten in the sequence shown to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2134
20. NOTE: If the valve cover is not installed and the fasteners tightened within 5 minutes, the
sealant must be removed and the sealing area
cleaned. To clean the sealing area, use silicone gasket remover and metal surface prep. Follow the
directions on the packaging. Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil leakage.
Apply a 8 mm (0.31 inch) bead of silicone gasket and sealant to the engine front cover-to-LH
cylinder head joints.
21. Using a new gasket, install the LH valve cover and 11 stud bolts.
^ Tighten in the sequence shown to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
22. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Install the 6 coil-on-plug assemblies and the 6 bolts. ^
Tighten to 7 Nm (62 inch lbs).
23. Install the LH cylinder block drain plug.
^ Tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs) plus an additional 180 degrees.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2135
24. Install the RH cylinder block drain plug or, if equipped, the block heater.
^ Tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
Front wheel drive (FWD) vehicles
25. Using a new gasket, install the RH catalytic converter and 4 new nuts.
^ Tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
All vehicles
26. Using a new gasket, install the LH catalytic converter and 4 new nuts (3 shown).
^ Tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2136
27. Install the accessory drive belt tensioner and the 3 bolts.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
28. Install the power steering pump and the 3 bolts.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
29. Attach all of the wiring harness retainers to the LH valve cover and stud bolts. 30. Connect the
3 LH coil-on-plug electrical connectors.
31. Connect the LH camshaft VCT solenoid electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2137
32. Connect the LH catalyst monitor sensor electrical connector.
33. Attach all of the wiring harness retainers to the RH valve cover and stud bolts. 34. Connect the
heated positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) valve electrical connector.
35. Connect the 3 RH coil-on-plug electrical connectors.
36. Connect the RH VCT solenoid electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2138
FWD vehicles
37. Connect the RH catalyst monitor sensor electrical connector.
All vehicles
38. Connect the power steering pressure (PSP) switch electrical connector.
39. Using new gaskets, install the upper intake manifold and the 6 bolts.
^ Tighten in the sequence shown to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2139
40. Install the upper intake manifold support bracket bolt.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
41. Install the upper intake manifold support bracket bolt.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
42. Attach the wiring harness retainers to the upper intake manifold.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2140
43. Connect the throttle body electrical connector.
44. Connect the PCV hose to the PCV valve.
45. Connect the PCV fitting electrical connector.
46. If equipped, position the engine block heater harness on the engine and attach all of the
harness retainers.
^ Connect the engine block heater electrical connector and install the heat shield.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2141
47. Using the special tools, remove the engine from the stand.
48. Install the crankshaft sensor ring.
49. Install the flexplate and the 8 bolts.
^ Tighten to 80 Nm (59 ft. lbs).
50. Install the engine in the vehicle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2145
C103
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2146
Oil Pressure Sender: Service and Repair
Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) Switch
Material
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove the cooling fan assembly. For additional information,
refer to Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories. 3. Disconnect the engine oil pressure
(EOP) switch electrical connector. 4. Remove the EOP switch.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Apply thread sealant with PTFE to the EOP switch threads prior to installation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pick Up/Strainer > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Oil Pick Up/Strainer: Service and Repair Removal
Oil Pump Screen and Pickup Tube
CAUTION: During engine repair procedures, cleanliness is extremely important. Any foreign
material, including any material created while cleaning gasket surfaces that enters the oil
passages, coolant passages or the oil pan, can cause engine failure.
1. Remove the oil pan. 2. Remove the 3 bolts and the oil pump screen and pickup tube.
^ Discard the O-ring seal.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pick Up/Strainer > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2151
Oil Pick Up/Strainer: Service and Repair Installation
Oil Pump Screen and Pickup Tube
CAUTION: During engine repair procedures, cleanliness is extremely important. Any foreign
material, including any material created while cleaning gasket surfaces that enters the oil
passages, coolant passages or the oil pan, can cause engine failure.
1. Using a new O-ring seal, install the oil pump screen and pickup tube and the 3 bolts.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
2. Install the oil pan.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pump, Engine > Engine Oil
Pressure > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Engine Oil Pressure: Testing and Inspection
Oil Pressure Test
1. Disconnect and remove the oil pressure sensor from the engine. 2. Connect the Engine Oil
Pressure Gauge to the oil pressure sender oil galley port. 3. Run the engine until normal operating
temperature is reached. 4. Run the engine at the specified rpm and record the gauge reading. 5.
The oil pressure should be within specifications. 6. If the pressure is not within specification, check
these possible sources:
^ Insufficient oil
^ Oil leakage
^ Worn or damaged oil pump
^ Oil pump screen cover and tube
^ Excessive main bearing clearance
^ Excessive connecting rod bearing clearance
^ Chain tensioner leak
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Temperature Sensor/Switch,
Engine > Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Temperature Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
ENGINE OIL TEMPERATURE (EOT) SENSOR
Typical EOT Sensor
The EOT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The EOT sensor measures the temperature of the engine oil. The sensor is typically threaded into
the engine oil lubrication system. The PCM can use the EOT sensor input to determine the
following:
- On variable camshaft timing (VCT) applications the EOT input is used to adjust the VCT control
gains and logic for camshaft timing.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input in conjunction with other PCM inputs to determine oil
degradation.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input to initiate a soft engine shutdown. To prevent engine
damage from occurring as a result of high oil temperatures, the PCM has the ability to initiate a soft
engine shutdown. Whenever engine RPM exceeds a calibrated level for a certain period of time,
the PCM begins reducing power by disabling engine cylinders.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications
Intake Manifold: Specifications
Upper intake manifold bolts .................................................................................................................
................................................. 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
Lower intake manifold bolts .................................................................................................................
................................................. 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Upper Intake Manifold
Intake Manifold: Service and Repair Upper Intake Manifold
Upper Intake Manifold
Upper Intake Manifold (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Upper Intake Manifold > Page 2164
Upper Intake Manifold (Part 2)
Upper Intake Manifold (Part 3)
Removal
1. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe. For additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery and Air
Induction. 2. Disconnect the throttle body electrical connector. 3. Disconnect the evaporative
emissions (EVAP) tube from the intake manifold. 4. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose
from the intake manifold. 5. Disconnect the positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) tube from the PCV
valve. 6. Disconnect the PCV fitting electrical connector. 7. Detach the wiring harness retainers
from the upper intake manifold. 8. Remove the 2 upper intake manifold support bracket bolts. 9.
Remove the 6 bolts and remove the upper intake manifold.
^ Remove and discard the gaskets.
^ Clean and inspect all of the sealing surfaces of the upper and lower intake manifold.
Installation
1. Using new gaskets, install the upper intake manifold and the 6 bolts.
^ Tighten in the sequence shown to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Upper Intake Manifold > Page 2165
2. Install the 2 upper intake manifold support bracket bolts.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
3. Attach the wiring harness retainers to the upper intake manifold. 4. Connect the PCV fitting
electrical connector. 5. Connect the PCV tube to the PCV valve. 6. Connect the brake booster
vacuum hose to the intake manifold. 7. Connect the EVAP tube to the intake manifold. 8. Connect
the throttle body electrical connector. 9. Install the air cleaner outlet pipe.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Upper Intake Manifold > Page 2166
Intake Manifold: Service and Repair Lower Intake Manifold
Lower Intake Manifold
Lower Intake Manifold
Removal
CAUTION: During engine repair procedures, cleanliness is extremely important. Any foreign
material, including any material created while cleaning gasket surfaces that enters the oil
passages, coolant passages or the oil pan, can cause engine failure.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Drain the cooling system. For additional information, refer to
Cooling System. 3. Remove the fuel rail. For additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery and Air
Induction. 4. Remove the 3 thermostat housing-to-lower intake manifold bolts. 5. Remove the 10
bolts and the lower intake manifold.
^ Remove and discard the intake manifold and thermostat housing gaskets.
^ Clean and inspect all sealing surfaces.
Installation
1. Using new intake manifold and thermostat housing gaskets, install the lower intake manifold and
the 10 bolts.
^ Tighten in the sequence shown to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Upper Intake Manifold > Page 2167
2. Install the 3 thermostat housing-to-lower intake manifold bolts.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
3. Install the fuel rail. 4. Fill and bleed the cooling system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: Procedures
Crankshaft Rear Seal
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove the flexplate. 3. Remove the crankshaft sensor ring.
4. Using the special tools, remove and discard the crankshaft rear seal.
^ Clean all sealing surfaces with metal surface cleaner.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2173
Installation
1. NOTE: Lubricate the seal lips and bore with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Position the special tool onto the end of the crankshaft and slide a new crankshaft rear seal onto
the tool.
2. Using the special tools, install the new crankshaft rear seal.
3. Install the crankshaft sensor ring. 4. Install the flexplate.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2174
Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: Removal and Replacement
Removal
Crankshaft Rear Seal with Retainer Plate
Special Tool(s)
Material
CAUTION: During engine repair procedures, cleanliness is extremely important. Any foreign
material, including any material created while cleaning gasket surfaces that enters the oil
passages, coolant passages or the oil pan, can cause engine failure.
NOTE: This procedure is for removal of the crankshaft rear seal and retainer plate and requires
removal of the oil pan. If you are only removing the crankshaft rear seal, refer to Crankshaft Rear
Seal.
1. Remove the oil pan. 2. Using the special tools, remove the engine from the stand.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2175
3. Disconnect the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor electrical connector.
4. Remove the bolt and the CKP sensor.
5. Using the special tools, remove and discard the rear crankshaft seal.
6. Remove the 8 crankshaft rear seal retainer bolts.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2176
7. Install the 2 M6 oil pan bolts (finger tight) into the 2 threaded holes in the crankshaft rear seal
retainer.
1 Alternately tighten the 2 bolts one turn at a time until the crankshaft rear seal retainer-to-cylinder
block seal is released.
2 Remove the crankshaft rear seal retainer.
8. CAUTION: Place clean, lint free shop towels over exposed engine cavities. Carefully remove the
towels so foreign material is not dropped
into the engine.
CAUTION: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive means
to clean the sealing surfaces. These tools cause scratches and gouges that make leak paths. Use
a plastic scraping tool to remove all traces of the gasket.
CAUTION: Observe all warnings or cautions and follow all application directions contained on the
packaging of the silicone gasket remover and the metal surface prep.
Clean sealing surfaces of the crankshaft rear seal retainer and cylinder block. 1
Remove any large deposits of silicone or gasket material with a plastic scraper.
2 Apply silicone gasket remover, following package directions, and allow to set for several minutes.
3 Remove the silicone gasket remover with a plastic scraper. A second application of silicone
gasket remover may be required if residual traces of silicone or gasket material remain.
4 Apply metal surface prep, following package directions, to remove any remaining traces of oil or
coolant and to prepare the surfaces to bond. Do not attempt to make the metal shiny. Some
staining of the metal surfaces is normal.
Installation
Crankshaft Rear Seal with Retainer Plate
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2177
Special Tool(s)
Material
CAUTION: During engine repair procedures, cleanliness is extremely important. Any foreign
material, including any material created while cleaning gasket surfaces that enters the oil
passages, coolant passages or the oil pan, can cause engine failure.
1. NOTE: The crankshaft rear seal retainer must be installed and the bolts tightened within 5
minutes of sealant application.
Apply a 3 mm (0.11 inch) bead of silicone gasket sealant to the sealing surface of the crankshaft
rear seal retainer.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2178
2. Install the rear seal retainer and the 8 bolts.
^ Tighten in the sequence shown to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
3. NOTE: Lubricate the seal lips and bore with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Position the special tool onto the end of the crankshaft and slide a new crankshaft rear seal onto
the tool.
4. Using the special tools, install the new crankshaft rear seal.
5. Install the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2179
6. Connect the CKP sensor electrical connector.
7. Using the special tools, install the engine onto the stand.
8. Install the oil pan.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal >
Component Information > Diagrams
Front Crankshaft Seal: Diagrams
Lower End Components - Exploded View, Crankshaft Pulley and Crankshaft Front Seal
Lower End Components - Exploded View, Crankshaft Pulley and Crankshaft Front Seal
Lower End Components - Exploded View, Flexplate and Crankshaft Rear Seal
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2183
Lower End Components - Exploded View, Flexplate and Crankshaft Rear Seal
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2184
Front Crankshaft Seal: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Front Seal
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove the crankshaft pulley. 3. Using the special tool,
remove and discard the crankshaft front seal.
^ Clean all sealing surfaces with metal surface cleaner.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2185
Installation
1. NOTE: Apply clean engine oil to the crankshaft front seal bore in the engine front cover.
Using the special tools, install a new crankshaft front seal.
2. Install the crankshaft pulley.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender
> Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender
> Component Information > Locations > Page 2190
C103
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender
> Component Information > Locations > Page 2191
Oil Pressure Sender: Service and Repair
Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) Switch
Material
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove the cooling fan assembly. For additional information,
refer to Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories. 3. Disconnect the engine oil pressure
(EOP) switch electrical connector. 4. Remove the EOP switch.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Apply thread sealant with PTFE to the EOP switch threads prior to installation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Temperature
Sensor/Switch, Engine > Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Temperature Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
ENGINE OIL TEMPERATURE (EOT) SENSOR
Typical EOT Sensor
The EOT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The EOT sensor measures the temperature of the engine oil. The sensor is typically threaded into
the engine oil lubrication system. The PCM can use the EOT sensor input to determine the
following:
- On variable camshaft timing (VCT) applications the EOT input is used to adjust the VCT control
gains and logic for camshaft timing.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input in conjunction with other PCM inputs to determine oil
degradation.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input to initiate a soft engine shutdown. To prevent engine
damage from occurring as a result of high oil temperatures, the PCM has the ability to initiate a soft
engine shutdown. Whenever engine RPM exceeds a calibrated level for a certain period of time,
the PCM begins reducing power by disabling engine cylinders.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Crankshaft Gear/Sprocket >
Component Information > Specifications
Crankshaft Gear/Sprocket: Specifications
Crankshaft Pulley Bolt
Discard the bolt.
First pass .............................................................................................................................................
................................................ 120 Nm (89 ft. lbs). Second pass .......................................................
................................................................................................................................. Loosen one full
turn Third pass .....................................................................................................................................
........................................................ 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs). Final pass ......................................................
...................................................................................................................................................
Tighten 90°
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications
Timing Chain Tensioner: Specifications
Timing chain tensioner bolts ................................................................................................................
................................................. 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2202
Timing Chain Tensioner: Service and Repair
Timing Drive Components
Special Tool(s)
Removal
CAUTION: During engine repair procedures, cleanliness is extremely important. Any foreign
material, including any material created while cleaning gasket surfaces, that enters the oil
passages, coolant passages or the oil pan can cause engine failure.
1. Remove the engine front cover. 2. Rotate the crankshaft clockwise and align the timing marks on
the variable camshaft timing (VCT) assemblies as shown.
3. NOTE: The special tool will hold the camshafts in the top dead center position.
Install the special tool onto the flats of the LH camshafts.
4. NOTE: The special tool will hold the camshafts in the top dead center position.
Install the special tool onto the flats of the RH camshafts.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2203
5. Remove the 3 bolts and the RH VCT housing.
6. Remove the 3 bolts and the LH VCT housing.
7. Remove and discard the VCT housing seals.
8. Remove the 2 bolts and the primary timing chain tensioner.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2204
9. Remove the primary timing chain tensioner arm.
10. Remove the 2 bolts and the lower LH primary timing chain guide.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2205
11. Remove the primary timing chain.
12. Remove the crankshaft timing chain sprocket.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2206
13. Remove the 2 bolts and the upper LH primary timing chain guide.
14. Compress the LH secondary timing chain tensioner and install a suitable lockpin to retain the
tensioner in the collapsed position.
15. NOTE: The VCT bolt and the exhaust camshaft bolt must be discarded and new ones installed.
However, the exhaust camshaft washer is reusable.
Remove and discard the LH VCT assembly bolt and the LH exhaust camshaft sprocket bolt. ^
Remove the LH VCT assembly, secondary timing chain and the LH exhaust camshaft sprocket as
an assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2207
16. NOTE: It is necessary to tilt the special tool toward the rear of the engine to access the
rearmost secondary timing chain tensioner bolt.
Remove the 2 bolts and the LH secondary timing chain tensioner.
17. Compress the RH secondary timing chain tensioner and install a suitable lockpin to retain the
tensioner in the collapsed position.
18. NOTE: The VCT bolt and the exhaust camshaft bolt must be discarded and new ones installed.
However, the exhaust camshaft washer is reusable.
Remove and discard the RH VCT assembly bolt and the RH exhaust camshaft sprocket bolt. ^
Remove the RH VCT assembly, secondary timing chain and the RH exhaust camshaft sprocket as
an assembly.
19. NOTE: It is necessary to tilt the special tool toward the rear of the engine to access the
rearmost secondary timing chain tensioner bolt.
Remove the 2 bolts and the RH secondary timing chain tensioner.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2208
20. Remove the 2 bolts and the RH primary timing chain guide.
Installation
1. Install the RH primary timing chain guide and the 2 bolts.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2209
2. NOTE: It is necessary to tilt the special tool toward the rear of the engine to access the rearmost
secondary timing chain tensioner bolt.
Install the RH secondary timing chain tensioner and the 2 bolts. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
3. Assemble the RH variable camshaft timing (VCT) assembly, the RH exhaust camshaft sprocket
and the RH secondary timing chain.
^ Align the colored links with the timing marks.
4. Position the RH secondary timing assembly onto the camshafts.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2210
5. Install 2 new bolts and the original washer. Tighten in 4 stages.
^ Stage 1: Tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
^ Stage 2: Loosen one full turn.
^ Stage 3: Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
^ Stage 4: Tighten 90 degrees.
6. Remove the lockpin from the RH secondary timing chain tensioner.
7. NOTE: It is necessary to tilt the special tool toward the rear of the engine to access the rearmost
secondary timing chain tensioner bolt.
Install the LH secondary timing chain tensioner and the 2 bolts. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
8. Assemble the LH VCT assembly, the LH exhaust camshaft sprocket and the LH secondary
timing chain.
^ Align the colored links with the timing marks.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2211
9. Position the LH secondary timing assembly onto the camshafts.
10. Install 2 new bolts and the original washer. Tighten in 4 stages.
^ Stage 1: Tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
^ Stage 2: Loosen one full turn.
^ Stage 3: Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
^ Stage 4: Tighten 90 degrees.
11. Remove the lockpin from the LH secondary timing chain tensioner.
12. Install the crankshaft timing chain sprocket.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2212
13. Install the primary timing chain with the colored links aligned with the timing marks on the VCT
assemblies and the crankshaft sprocket.
14. Install the upper LH primary timing chain guide and the 2 bolts.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2213
15. Install the lower LH primary timing chain guide and the 2 bolts.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
16. Install the primary timing chain tensioner arm.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2214
17. Reset the primary timing chain tensioner.
^ Rotate the lever counterclockwise.
^ Using a soft-jawed vise, compress the plunger.
^ Align the hole in the lever with the hole in the tensioner housing.
^ Install a suitable lockpin.
18. NOTE: It may be necessary to rotate the crankshaft slightly to remove slack from the timing
chain and install the tensioner.
Install the primary tensioner and the 2 bolts. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
^ Remove the lockpin.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2215
19. As a post-check, verify correct alignment of all timing marks.
20. Install new VCT housing seals.
21. CAUTION: Make sure the dowels on the VCT housing are fully engaged in the cylinder head
prior to tightening the bolts.
Install the LH VCT housing and the 3 bolts. ^
Tighten in the sequence shown to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2216
22. CAUTION: Make sure the dowels on the VCT housing are fully engaged in the cylinder head
prior to tightening the bolts.
Install the RH VCT housing and the 3 bolts. ^
Tighten in the sequence shown to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
23. Install the engine front cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation
Timing Cover: Service and Repair Installation
Engine Front Cover
Installation
1. Raise the engine to the installed position.
2. CAUTION: Place clean, lint free shop towels over exposed engine cavities. Carefully remove the
towels so foreign material is not dropped
into the engine.
CAUTION: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive means
to clean the sealing surfaces. These tools cause scratches and gouges that make leak paths. Use
a plastic scraping tool to remove all traces of sealant, including any sealant from the inner surface
of the cylinder block, cylinder head and engine front cover.
CAUTION: Observe all warnings or cautions and follow all application directions contained on the
packaging of the silicone gasket remover and the metal surface prep.
Clean the sealing surfaces of the engine front cover and the mating surfaces on the cylinder heads,
the cylinder block and the oil pan. ^
Remove any large deposits of silicone or gasket material with a plastic scraper.
^ Apply silicone gasket remover, following package directions and allow to set for several minutes.
^ Remove the silicone gasket remover with a plastic scraper. A second application of silicone
gasket remover may be required if residual traces of silicone or gasket material remain.
^ Apply metal surface prep, following package directions, to remove any remaining traces of oil or
coolant and to prepare the surfaces to bond. Do not attempt to make the metal shiny. Some
staining of the metal surfaces is normal.
3. Install the special tools.
4. NOTE: If the engine front cover, engine mount bracket and bolts 7, 8, 17, 18, 19, 20, 23, 24 and
25 are not installed and tightened within
10 minutes, the sealant must be removed and the sealing area cleaned. To clean the sealing area,
use silicone gasket remover and metal surface prep. Follow the directions on the packaging.
Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil leakage.
Apply a 3.0 mm (0.11 inch) bead of silicone gasket and sealant to the engine front cover sealing
surfaces including the 3 engine mount bracket bosses. ^
Apply a 5.5 mm (0.21 inch) bead of silicone gasket and sealant to the oil pan-to-cylinder block joint
and the cylinder head-to-cylinder block joint areas of the engine front cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 2221
5. Install the engine front cover and bolts 7, 8, 17, 18, 19 and 20.
^ Tighten in sequence to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
6. NOTE: Do not tighten the bolt at this time.
Lower the engine to allow installation of the engine mount bracket and lower bolt. ^
Install the engine mount bracket and lower bolt as an assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 2222
7. Raise the engine to the installed position.
^ Install the 2 upper engine mount bracket bolts.
8. Tighten bolts in sequence to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs).
9. Tighten the bolts in this sequence.
^ Tighten bolts 7, 8, 17, 18, 19 and 20 to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
^ Tighten bolts 23, 24 and 25 to 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 2223
10. Remove the special tools (alignment pins).
11. NOTE: The remainder of the engine front cover bolts (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15,
16, 21 and 22) must be installed and tightened
within 60 minutes of the initial sealant application.
Install bolts 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 21 and 22 and tighten in the sequence
shown in 2 stages: ^
Stage 1: Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
^ Stage 2: Tighten to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
12. Install the 2 engine mount studs.
^ Tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 2224
13. Install the engine mount and the 3 bolts.
^ Tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs).
14. Install the 4 engine mount nuts.
^ Tighten to 63 Nm (46 ft. lbs).
15. Install the engine mount brace, nut and bolt.
^ Tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs).
16. Tighten the transaxle mount through bolt to 175 Nm (129 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 2225
17. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Install the LH and RH VCT solenoids and bolts. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
18. Install the power steering pump and the 3 bolts.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
19. Install the power steering reservoir and the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs).
20. Install the degas bottle and the 3 bolts.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 2226
21. Connect the 3 PCM electrical connectors.
22. Connect the purge valve electrical connector.
23. Install the radio interference capacitor, the ground wire and the nut to the cowl stud.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
24. Install the radio interference capacitor wire, the ground wire and the nut to the engine front
cover stud.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 2227
25. Install the ground wire and bolt on the engine front cover.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
26. Connect the 2 engine wiring harness connectors.
27. Using a new O-ring seal, connect the A/C pressure tube fitting and install the nut.
^ Tighten to 6 Nm (53 inch lbs).
28. Install the A/C pressure tube bracket and bolt.
^ Tighten to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 2228
29. Connect the A/C suction tube fitting.
^ Install the safety clip onto the fitting.
30. Install the LH and RH valve covers. 31. Install the engine air cleaner and air cleaner outlet pipe.
32. If equipped, attach the engine block heater harness to the radiator support, the A/C suction
tube and the engine wiring harness.
33. Align the RH halfshaft splines with the intermediate shaft and push the halfshaft on until the
circlip locks the shafts together.
^ Pull the inboard halfshaft outward to make sure the circlip is locked.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 2229
34. NOTE: Do not tighten the halfshaft nut at this time.
Install the RH halfshaft into the hub and install a new halfshaft nut.
35. Install the RH lower ball joint into the steering knuckle and install the pinch bolt.
^ Tighten to 63 Nm (46 ft. lbs).
36. Install the RH stabilizer bar link into the lower control arm and install the nut.
^ Tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs).
37. NOTE: Apply the brake to keep the halfshaft from rotating.
Tighten the RH halfshaft nut to 350 Nm (258 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 2230
38. Install and the transaxle bracket and the 3 bolts.
^ Tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs).
39. Position the roll restrictor and transaxle bracket plate and install the 3 bolts.
^ Tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs).
40. Tighten the engine roll restrictor-to-subframe through bolt to 103 Nm (76 ft. lbs).
41. Install the roll restrictor heat shield and the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 2231
42. Position the Y-pipe assembly in place and install the 4 nuts.
^ Tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
43. Install the 2 exhaust hangers and tighten the exhaust clamp.
^ Tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
44. NOTE: Apply clean engine oil to the crankshaft front seal bore in the engine front cover.
Using the special tools, install a new crankshaft front seal.
45. NOTE: Lubricate the outside diameter sealing surfaces with clean engine oil.
Using the special tools, install the crankshaft pulley.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 2232
46. Using the special tool, install the crankshaft pulley washer and new bolt and tighten in 4 stages.
^ Stage 1: Tighten to 120 Nm (89 ft. lbs).
^ Stage 2: Loosen one full turn.
^ Stage 3: Tighten to 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs).
^ Stage 4: Tighten an additional 90 degrees.
47. Install the accessory drive belt, tensioner and the power steering belt. 48. Fill the engine with
clean engine oil. 49. Connect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
50. Evacuate and recharge the air conditioning system. For additional information, refer to Heating
and Air Conditioning.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 2233
Timing Cover: Service and Repair Removal
Engine Front Cover
Special Tool(s) (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 2234
Special Tool(s) (Part 2)
Material (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 2235
Material (Part 2)
Removal
CAUTION: During engine repair procedures, cleanliness is extremely important. Any foreign
material, including any material created while cleaning gasket surfaces that enters the oil
passages, coolant passages or the oil pan, can cause engine failure.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Recover the air conditioning system. For additional
information, refer to Heating and Air Conditioning. 3. Disconnect the battery ground cable. For
additional information, refer to Battery. 4. Remove the accessory drive belt, tensioner and the
power steering belt. For additional information, refer to Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and
Accessories.
5. Using the special tool, remove the crankshaft bolt and washer.
^ Discard the bolt.
6. Using the special tool, remove the crankshaft pulley.
7. Using the special tool, remove and discard the crankshaft front seal.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 2236
8. Loosen the exhaust flexible pipe clamp and disconnect the 2 exhaust hangers.
9. Remove the 4 nuts, the exhaust flexible pipe and the Y-pipe as an assembly.
^ Discard the nuts and the gasket.
10. Remove the 2 nuts and the roll restrictor heat shield.
11. Remove the roll restrictor through bolt and the 2 roll restrictor-to-transaxle bracket plate bolts.
12. Loosen the roll restrictor-to-subframe through bolt.
^ Position the roll restrictor and transaxle bracket plate aside.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 2237
13. Remove the 3 bolts and the transaxle bracket.
14. Remove and discard the RH front halfshaft nut.
15. Remove the RH stabilizer link-to-lower control arm nut.
16. Remove the RH lower control arm-to-knuckle pinch bolt.
^ Separate the lower control arm from the knuckle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 2238
17. Using the special tool, separate the RH halfshaft from the hub.
18. Using the special tools, separate the RH halfshaft from the intermediate shaft.
^ Remove the RH halfshaft.
19. Remove the drain plug and drain the engine oil.
^ Install the drain plug and tighten to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs).
20. If equipped, detach the engine block heater harness from the radiator support, the A/C suction
tube and the engine wiring harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 2239
21. Remove the engine air cleaner and air cleaner outlet pipe. For additional information, refer to
Fuel Delivery and Air Induction. 22. Remove the LH and RH valve covers. 23. Remove the safety
clip from the A/C suction tube fitting.
^ Disconnect the A/C suction tube fitting and position the tube aside.
24. Remove the A/C pressure tube bracket bolt.
25. Remove the nut and disconnect the A/C pressure tube fitting.
^ Discard the O-ring seal.
^ Position the A/C pressure tube aside.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 2240
26. Disconnect the 2 engine wiring harness connectors.
27. Remove the bolt and the ground wire from the engine front cover.
28. Remove the nut, the ground wire and the radio interference capacitor wire from the engine front
cover stud.
29. Remove the nut, the ground wire and the radio interference capacitor from the cowl stud.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 2241
30. Disconnect the purge valve electrical connector.
31. Disconnect the 3 powertrain control module (PCM) electrical connectors and position the wiring
harness aside.
32. Remove the 3 bolts and position the degas bottle aside.
33. NOTE: The area between the front of the engine and the body of the vehicle must be
unobstructed in order to properly remove and install the
engine front cover.
Remove the 2 power steering reservoir nuts. ^
Support the power steering reservoir and hose away from the front of the engine with a length of
mechanic's wire.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 2242
34. Remove the 3 power steering pump bolts.
^ Support the power steering pump and hose away from the front of the engine with a length of
mechanic's wire.
35. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Remove the bolts, the LH and the RH VCT solenoids.
36. CAUTION: The special tool must be carefully aligned to the mounting bosses on the oil pan.
Failure to follow these instructions may
result in damage to the oil pan.
NOTE: The special tool and floor jack are used to raise and lower the engine to access the engine
front cover and engine mount bracket fasteners.
Position a floor jack and the special tool under the oil pan.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 2243
37. CAUTION: The transaxle through bolt must be loosened prior to removing the engine mount
and lowering the front of the engine.
Failure to follow these instructions may cause internal damage to the hydraulic transaxle mount
and possible fluid leakage.
Loosen the transaxle mount through bolt.
38. Remove the nut, bolt and engine mount brace.
39. Remove the 4 engine mount nuts.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 2244
40. Remove the 3 bolts and the engine mount.
41. Remove the 2 engine mount studs.
42. Remove the 2 upper engine mount bracket bolts.
43. Lower the engine to access the lower engine mount bracket bolt. 44. Loosen the lower engine
mount bracket bolt and remove the engine mount bracket and bolt as an assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 2245
45. Remove the 22 engine front cover bolts. 46. Install 4 of the engine front cover bolts (finger tight)
into the 4 threaded holes in the engine front cover.
1 Tighten the bolts one turn at a time in a criss-cross pattern until the engine front cover-to-cylinder
block seal is released.
2 Remove the engine front cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Variable
Valve Timing Actuator: > 10-16-1 > Aug > 10 > Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser DTC's Set
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Customer Interest Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser DTC's Set
TSB 10-16-1
08/30/10
3.5L / 3.7L ENGINE - VCT CODES P0011, P0012, P0021, P0022 - RUNS ROUGH OR MISSES VEHICLES BUILT ON OR BEFORE 12/15/2008
FORD: 2008-2009 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2009 Edge 2009 Flex
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2007-2009 MKX
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 09-13-10 to update Service Procedure and Part List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Edge, MKX, MKZ, 2008-2009 Taurus, Taurus X, Sable, 2009 Flex and
MKS vehicles equipped with a 3.5L or 3.7L engine and vehicle build date on or before 12/15/2008
may exhibit a malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) on and one or more diagnostic trouble codes
(DTCs) P0011, P0012, P0016, P0018, P0021, P0022. Vehicle may also exhibit rough idle or
misses.
ACTION Follow the service procedure steps to correct this condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Using IDS, verify DTCs are present.
2. Verify vehicle build date on or before 12/15/2008.
a. If the vehicle was built after 12/15/2008, this procedure does not apply, refer to the Powertrain
Controls/Emissions Diagnosis (PC/ED) manual
for further diagnosis.
b. If the vehicle was built on or before 12/15/2008 and has any Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT)
DTCs P0011, P0012, P0016, P0018, P0021,
P0022 proceed to Step 3.
3. Remove both cam covers. Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 303-01.
4. Inspect the part number on the front of the camshaft phaser. You may need to rotate the engine
crank to move the phasers in position. The left cam
phaser should be 7T4E-6C524-EC and the right cam phaser should be 8T4E-6C524-AC.
a. If either one or both don't match the updated part numbers replace the phaser(s). Refer to WSM,
Section 303-01.
b. If both camshaft phasers have the updated part numbers, this procedure does not apply and
refer to the PC/ED manual for further diagnosis.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Variable
Valve Timing Actuator: > 10-16-1 > Aug > 10 > Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser DTC's Set > Page 2255
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101601A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 7.5 Hrs.
3.5L DOHC: Check DTCs, Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer
(Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101601A 2007-2009 MKZ FWD 3.5L 10.0
DOHC: Check DTCs, Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101601A 2007-2009 MKZ AWD 3.5L 10.3
DOHC: Check DTCs Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101601A 2008-2009 Taurus, Sable, 6.9 Hrs.
Taurus X 3.5L DOHC 2009 MKS 3.7L: Check DTCs, Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace
The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101601A 2009 Flex: Check DTCs, 7.0 Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101601B 2009 Flex: Check DTCs, 7.2 Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any
Other Labor Operations)
101601B 2008-2009 Taurus, Sable, 7.0 Hrs.
Taurus X 3.5L DOHC 2009 MKS 3.7L: Check DTCs Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace
Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101601B 2007-2009 MKZ AWD 3.5L 10.4
DOHC: Check DTCs, Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any
Other Labor Operations)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Variable
Valve Timing Actuator: > 10-16-1 > Aug > 10 > Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser DTC's Set > Page 2256
101601B 2007-2009 MKZ FWD 3.5L 10.2
DOHC:Check DTCs, Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any
Other Labor Operations)
101601B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 7.7 Hrs.
3.5L DOHC: Check DTCs, Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left
Phazers (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
6A257 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: > 10-16-1 > Aug > 10 > Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser DTC's Set
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser
DTC's Set
TSB 10-16-1
08/30/10
3.5L / 3.7L ENGINE - VCT CODES P0011, P0012, P0021, P0022 - RUNS ROUGH OR MISSES VEHICLES BUILT ON OR BEFORE 12/15/2008
FORD: 2008-2009 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2009 Edge 2009 Flex
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2007-2009 MKX
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 09-13-10 to update Service Procedure and Part List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Edge, MKX, MKZ, 2008-2009 Taurus, Taurus X, Sable, 2009 Flex and
MKS vehicles equipped with a 3.5L or 3.7L engine and vehicle build date on or before 12/15/2008
may exhibit a malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) on and one or more diagnostic trouble codes
(DTCs) P0011, P0012, P0016, P0018, P0021, P0022. Vehicle may also exhibit rough idle or
misses.
ACTION Follow the service procedure steps to correct this condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Using IDS, verify DTCs are present.
2. Verify vehicle build date on or before 12/15/2008.
a. If the vehicle was built after 12/15/2008, this procedure does not apply, refer to the Powertrain
Controls/Emissions Diagnosis (PC/ED) manual
for further diagnosis.
b. If the vehicle was built on or before 12/15/2008 and has any Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT)
DTCs P0011, P0012, P0016, P0018, P0021,
P0022 proceed to Step 3.
3. Remove both cam covers. Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 303-01.
4. Inspect the part number on the front of the camshaft phaser. You may need to rotate the engine
crank to move the phasers in position. The left cam
phaser should be 7T4E-6C524-EC and the right cam phaser should be 8T4E-6C524-AC.
a. If either one or both don't match the updated part numbers replace the phaser(s). Refer to WSM,
Section 303-01.
b. If both camshaft phasers have the updated part numbers, this procedure does not apply and
refer to the PC/ED manual for further diagnosis.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: > 10-16-1 > Aug > 10 > Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser DTC's Set > Page 2262
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101601A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 7.5 Hrs.
3.5L DOHC: Check DTCs, Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer
(Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101601A 2007-2009 MKZ FWD 3.5L 10.0
DOHC: Check DTCs, Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101601A 2007-2009 MKZ AWD 3.5L 10.3
DOHC: Check DTCs Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101601A 2008-2009 Taurus, Sable, 6.9 Hrs.
Taurus X 3.5L DOHC 2009 MKS 3.7L: Check DTCs, Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace
The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101601A 2009 Flex: Check DTCs, 7.0 Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101601B 2009 Flex: Check DTCs, 7.2 Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any
Other Labor Operations)
101601B 2008-2009 Taurus, Sable, 7.0 Hrs.
Taurus X 3.5L DOHC 2009 MKS 3.7L: Check DTCs Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace
Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101601B 2007-2009 MKZ AWD 3.5L 10.4
DOHC: Check DTCs, Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any
Other Labor Operations)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: > 10-16-1 > Aug > 10 > Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser DTC's Set > Page 2263
101601B 2007-2009 MKZ FWD 3.5L 10.2
DOHC:Check DTCs, Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any
Other Labor Operations)
101601B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 7.7 Hrs.
3.5L DOHC: Check DTCs, Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left
Phazers (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
6A257 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Valve 1
C1451
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Valve 1 > Page
2266
C1452
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2267
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Description and Operation
VARIABLE CAMSHAFT TIMING (VCT) SYSTEM
Overview
The VCT enables rotation of the camshaft(s) relative to the crankshaft rotation as a function of
engine operating conditions. There are 4 types of VCT systems. Exhaust phase shifting (EPS) system - the exhaust cam is the active cam being retarded.
- Intake phase shifting (IPS) system - the intake cam is the active cam being advanced.
- Dual equal phase shifting (DEPS) system - both intake and exhaust cams are phase shifted and
equally advanced or retarded.
- Dual independent phase shifting (DIPS) system - where both the intake and exhaust cams are
shifted independently.
All systems have 4 operational modes: idle, part throttle, wide open throttle (WOT), and default
mode. At idle and low engine speeds with closed throttle, the powertrain control module (PCM)
determines the phase angle based on air flow, engine oil temperature and engine coolant
temperature. At part and wide open throttle the PCM determines the phase angle based on engine
RPM, load, and throttle position. VCT systems provide reduced emissions and enhanced engine
power, fuel economy and idle quality. IPS systems also have the added benefit of improved torque.
In addition, some VCT system applications can eliminate the need for an external exhaust gas
recirculation (EGR) system. The elimination of the EGR system is accomplished by controlling the
overlap time between the intake valve opening and exhaust valve closing. Currently, both the IPS
and DEPS systems are used.
Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) System
VCT System
The VCT system consists of an electric hydraulic positioning control solenoid, a camshaft position
(CMP) sensor, and a trigger wheel. The CMP trigger wheel has a number of equally spaced teeth
equal to the number (n) of cylinders on a bank plus one extra tooth (n+1). Four cylinder and V8
engines use a CMP 4+1 tooth trigger wheel. V6 engines use a CMP 3+1 tooth trigger wheel. The
extra tooth placed between the equally spaced teeth represents the CMP signal for that bank. A
crankshaft position sensor (CKP) provides the PCM with crankshaft positioning information in 10
degree increments. 1. The PCM receives input signals from the intake air temperature (IAT)
sensor, engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor, engine oil temperature
(EOT) sensor, CMP, throttle position (TP) sensor, mass air flow (MAF) sensor, and CKP to
determine the operating conditions of the engine. At idle and low engine speeds with closed
throttle, the PCM controls the camshaft position based on ECT, EOT, IAT, and MAF. During part
and wide open throttle, the camshaft position is determined by engine RPM, load and throttle
position. The VCT system does not operate until the engine is at normal operating temperature.
2. The VCT system is enabled by the PCM when the correct conditions are met. 3. The CKP signal
is used as a reference for CMP positioning. 4. The VCT solenoid valve is an integral part of the
VCT system. The solenoid valve controls the flow of engine oil in the VCT actuator assembly.
As the PCM controls the duty cycle of the solenoid valve, oil pressure/flow advances or retards the
cam timing. Duty cycles near 0% or 100% represent rapid movement of the camshaft. Retaining a
fixed camshaft position is accomplished by dithering (oscillating) the solenoid valve duty cycle.
The PCM calculates and determines the desired camshaft position. It continually updates the VCT
solenoid duty cycle until the desired position is achieved. A difference between the desired and
actual camshaft position represents a position error in the PCM VCT control loop. The PCM
disables the VCT and places the camshaft in a default position if a concern is detected. A related
DTC is also set when the concern is detected.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2268
5. When the VCT solenoid is energized, engine oil is allowed to flow to the VCT actuator assembly
which advances or retards the camshaft timing.
One half of the VCT actuator is coupled to the camshaft and the other half is connected to the
timing chain. Oil chambers between the 2 halves couple the camshaft to the timing chain. When
the flow of oil is shifted from one side of the chamber to the other, the differential change in oil
pressure forces the camshaft to rotate in either an advance or retard position depending on the oil
flow.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid: Service and Repair
VARIABLE CAMSHAFT TIMING (VCT) OIL CONTROL SOLENOID
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the LH or RH valve cover. 2. Remove the bolt and the variable camshaft timing (VCT)
oil control solenoid.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Fuel Pressure
3.5 L engine running fuel pressure.......................................................................................................
...........................................................450 kPa (65 psi)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle
Speed > System Information > Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Typical Diagnostic Reference Value
Measured/PID Values 600 RPM ..........................................................................................................
..................................................................................................... Hot Idle
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Cleaner Housing: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER
Part 1
Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2282
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 2. Loosen the clamp and
disconnect the air cleaner outlet pipe from the air cleaner.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. Remove the air cleaner bolt.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
4. NOTE: No tools are needed to remove the air cleaner assembly. Removal should be carried out
using hands only.
Separate the 2 air cleaner feet from the rubber grommets and remove the air cleaner assembly.
5. NOTE:
- Make sure that the 2 air cleaner feet are seated into the rubber grommets under the air cleaner
assembly.
- The air cleaner outlet pipe should be securely sealed to prevent unmetered air from entering the
engine.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter
> Fuel Pressure Release > System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELEASE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
WARNING:
- Do not carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any fuel-related
components. Highly flammable vapors are always present and can ignite. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, which may cause personal injury
or a fire hazard.
1. Remove the Schrader valve cap.
2. NOTE: This step will drain some fuel out of the system. Place the fuel in a suitable container.
Install the special tool and slowly open the manual valve to relieve the fuel system pressure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing
Order > Component Information > Specifications > Firing Order
Firing Order: Specifications Firing Order
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Firing order...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................1-4-2-5-3-6
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing
Order > Component Information > Specifications > Firing Order > Page 2291
Firing Order: Specifications Engine Cylinder Identification
Engine
Engine Cylinder Identification
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Timing > Number One Cylinder > Component Information > Locations
Number One Cylinder: Locations
Engine
Engine Cylinder Identification
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Specifications > General Specifications
Spark Plug: Specifications General Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Spark plug gap.....................................................................................................................................
....................................1.29-1.45 mm (0.051-0.057 in)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Specifications > General Specifications > Page 2300
Torque Specifications
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2301
Spark Plug: Application and ID
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Spark plug............................................................................................................................................
................................................................AYFS-22FM
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2302
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection
Spark Plug Inspection
1. Inspect the spark plug for a bridged gap.
^ Check for deposit build-up closing the gap between the electrodes. Deposits are caused by oil or
carbon fouling.
^ Clean the spark plug.
2. Check for oil fouling.
^ Check for wet, black deposits on the insulator shell bore electrodes, caused by excessive oil
entering the combustion chamber through worn rings and pistons, excessive valve-to-guide
clearance or worn or loose bearings.
^ Correct the oil leak concern.
^ Install a new spark plug.
3. Inspect for carbon fouling. Look for black, dry, fluffy carbon deposits on the insulator tips,
exposed shell surfaces and electrodes, caused by a
spark plug with an incorrect heat range, dirty air cleaner, too rich a fuel mixture or excessive idling.
^
Install new spark plugs.
4. Inspect for normal burning.
^ Check for light tan or gray deposits on the firing tip.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2303
5. Inspect for pre-ignition, identified by melted electrodes and a possibly damaged insulator.
Metallic deposits on the insulator indicate engine
damage. This may be caused by incorrect ignition timing, wrong type of fuel or the unauthorized
installation of a Heli-coil insert in place of the spark plug threads. ^
Install a new spark plug.
6. Inspect for overheating, identified by white or light gray spots and with a bluish-burnt appearance
of electrodes. This is caused by engine
overheating, wrong type of fuel, loose spark plugs, spark plugs with an incorrect heat range, low
fuel pump pressure or incorrect ignition timing. ^
Install a new spark plug.
7. Inspect for fused deposits, identified by melted or spotty deposits resembling bubbles or blisters.
These are caused by sudden acceleration.
^ Install new spark plugs.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2304
Spark Plug: Service and Repair
SPARK PLUGS
Exploded View
Removal
LH side 1. Disconnect the crankcase vent tube quick connect coupling from the valve cover fitting
and position aside.
RH side
2. NOTE: The upper intake manifold must be removed to access the RH spark plugs only.
Remove the upper intake manifold.
Both sides 3. Disconnect the 6 ignition coil-on-plug electrical connectors.
4. NOTE: When removing the ignition coil-on-plugs, a slight twisting motion will break the seal and
ease removal.
Remove the 6 bolts and the 6 ignition coil-on-plugs.
5. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when removing or installing the spark plugs or damage can
occur to the cylinder head or spark plug.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2305
NOTE: Use compressed air to remove any foreign material in the spark plug well before removing
the spark plugs.
Remove the 6 spark plugs.
Installation
Both sides
1. Inspect the 6 spark plugs.
2. Adjust the spark plug gap as necessary.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2306
3. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when removing or installing the spark plugs, or damage can
occur to the cylinder head or spark plug.
Install the 6 spark plugs. Tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
4. NOTE: Apply a small amount of dielectric grease to the inside of the ignition coil-on-plug boots
before attaching to the spark plugs.
Install the 6 ignition coil-on-plugs and the 6 bolts. Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
5. Connect the 6 ignition coil-on-plug electrical connectors.
RH side 6. Install the upper intake manifold.
LH side 7. Position and connect the crankcase vent tube quick connect coupling to the valve cover
fitting.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Compression Check > System Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Compression Test - Test Results
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75% of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit Chart.
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Compression Check > System Information > Specifications > Page 2310
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
Compression Test
1. Make sure the oil in the crankcase is of the correct viscosity and at the correct level and that the
battery is correctly charged. Operate the vehicle
until the engine is at normal operating temperature. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position,
then remove all the spark plugs.
2. Set the throttle plates in the wide-open position. 3. Install a compression gauge such as the
Compression Tester in the No. 1 cylinder. 4. Install an auxiliary starter switch in the starting circuit.
With the ignition switch in the OFF position, and using the auxiliary starter switch, crank
the engine a minimum of 5 compression strokes and record the highest reading. Note the
approximate number of compression strokes necessary to obtain the highest reading.
5. Repeat the test on each cylinder, cranking the engine approximately the same number of
compression strokes.
Compression Test - Test Results
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75% of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit Chart.
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
If one or more cylinders reads low, squirt approximately one tablespoon of engine oil meeting Ford
specification on top of the pistons in the low-reading cylinders. Repeat the compression pressure
check on these cylinders.
Compression Test - Interpreting Compression Readings
1. If compression improves considerably, piston rings are worn or damaged. 2. If compression does
not improve, valves are sticking or not seating correctly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Compression Check > System Information > Specifications > Page 2311
3. If 2 adjacent cylinders indicate low compression pressures and squirting oil on each piston does
not increase compression, the head gasket may be
leaking between cylinders. Engine oil or coolant in cylinders could result from this condition.
Use the Compression Pressure Limit Chart when checking cylinder compression so that the lowest
reading is within 75% of the highest reading.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve
Clearance > System Information > Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
Valve Clearance
A midrange clearance is the most desirable.
Intake ...................................................................................................................................................
....................... 0.15 - 0.25 mm (0.006 - 0.01 inch) Exhaust
..............................................................................................................................................................
0.300 - 0.400 mm (0.0118 - 0.0157 inch)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve
Clearance > System Information > Specifications > Page 2315
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
Valve Clearance Check
1. Remove the valve covers.
2. NOTE: The valve clearance must be measured with the camshaft at base circle. The engine will
have to be rotated with the crankshaft pulley bolt
to bring each valve to base circle.
Use a feeler gauge to measure the clearance of each valve and record its location. A midrange
clearance is the most desirable: ^
Intake: 0.15 - 0.25 mm (0.006 - 0.01 inch)
^ Exhaust: 0.300 - 0.400 mm (0.0118 - 0.0157 inch)
3. NOTE: The number on the valve tappet reflects the thickness of the valve tappet. For example, a
tappet with the number 3.310 has the thickness
of 3.31 mm (0.13 inch).
If any of the valve clearances are out of specification, select new tappets using this formula: tappet
thickness = measured clearance + the base tappet thickness - most desirable thickness. Select the
tappets and mark the installation location.
4. If required, install the new selected valve tappets in the marked locations.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Specifications
Water Pump: Specifications
Coolant pump bolts ..............................................................................................................................
................................................. 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 2319
Water Pump: Service and Repair
Coolant Pump
Removal
CAUTION: During engine repair procedures, cleanliness is extremely important. Any foreign
material, including any material created while cleaning gasket surfaces, that enters the oil
passages, coolant passages or the oil pan can cause engine failure.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Drain the cooling system. For additional information, refer to
Cooling System. 3. Loosen the exhaust flexible pipe clamp and disconnect the 2 exhaust hangers.
4. Remove the 4 nuts, the exhaust flexible pipe and the Y-pipe as an assembly.
^ Discard the nuts and the gasket.
5. Remove the LH and RH catalytic converters. For additional information, refer to Catalytic
Converter. 6. If equipped, remove the heat shield and disconnect the block heater electrical
connector.
7. Remove the RH cylinder block drain plug or, if equipped, the block heater.
^ Allow coolant to drain from the cylinder block.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 2320
8. Remove the LH cylinder block drain plug.
^ Allow coolant to drain from the cylinder block.
9. Remove the engine front cover.
10. Rotate the crankshaft clockwise and align the timing marks on the variable camshaft timing
(VCT) assemblies as shown.
11. NOTE: The special tool will hold the camshafts in the top dead center (TDC) position.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 2321
Install the special tool onto the flats of the LH camshafts.
12. NOTE: The special tool will hold the camshafts in the TDC position.
Install the special tool onto the flats of the RH camshafts.
13. Remove the 3 bolts and the RH VCT housing.
14. Remove the 3 bolts and the LH VCT housing.
15. Remove and discard the VCT housing seals.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 2322
16. Remove the 2 bolts and the primary timing chain tensioner.
17. Remove the primary timing chain tensioner arm.
18. Remove the 2 bolts and the lower LH primary timing chain guide.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 2323
19. Remove the primary timing chain.
20. Remove the 2 bolts and the upper LH primary timing chain guide.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 2324
21. Remove the RH primary timing chain guide lower bolt.
22. NOTE: The RH primary timing chain guide must be repositioned to allow the coolant pump to
be removed.
Loosen the RH primary timing chain guide upper bolt. ^
Rotate the guide and tighten the bolt.
23. Remove the 8 bolts and the coolant pump.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 2325
Installation
1. NOTE: Clean and inspect all sealing surfaces.
Install the coolant pump and the 8 bolts. ^
Tighten in the sequence shown to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
2. Loosen the RH primary timing chain guide upper bolt.
^ Position the RH primary timing chain guide and install the lower bolt.
^ Tighten the 2 bolts to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
3. Install the primary timing chain with the colored links aligned with the timing marks on the VCT
assemblies and the crankshaft sprocket.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 2326
4. Install the upper LH primary timing chain guide and the 2 bolts.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
5. Install the lower LH primary timing chain guide and the 2 bolts.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 2327
6. Install the primary timing chain tensioner arm.
7. Reset the primary timing chain tensioner.
^ Rotate the lever counterclockwise.
^ Using a soft-jawed vise, compress the plunger.
^ Align the hole in the lever with the hole in the tensioner housing.
^ Install a suitable lock pin.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 2328
8. NOTE: It may be necessary to rotate the crankshaft slightly to remove slack from the timing
chain and install the tensioner.
Install the primary tensioner and the 2 bolts. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
^ Remove the lock pin.
9. As a post check, verify correct alignment of all timing marks.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 2329
10. Install new VCT housing seals.
11. CAUTION: Make sure the dowels on the VCT housing are fully engaged in the cylinder head
prior to tightening the bolts.
Install the LH VCT housing and the 3 bolts. ^
Tighten in the sequence shown to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
12. CAUTION: Make sure the dowels on the VCT housing are fully engaged in the cylinder head
prior to tightening the bolts.
Install the RH VCT housing and the 3 bolts. ^
Tighten in the sequence shown to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 2330
13. Install the engine front cover. 14. Install the RH cylinder block drain plug or, if equipped, the
block heater.
^ Tighten the cylinder block drain plug to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs).
^ Tighten the block heater to 41 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
15. NOTE: Make sure that the block heater wiring is routed and secured away from rotating or hot
components, or damage to the wiring can occur.
If equipped, connect the block heater electrical connector and install the heat shield.
16. Install the LH cylinder block drain plug.
^ Tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs) plus an additional 180 degrees.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 2331
17. Install the LH and RH catalytic converters. For additional information, refer to Catalytic
Converter. 18. Position the Y-pipe assembly in place and install the 4 nuts.
^ Tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
19. Install the 2 exhaust hangers and tighten the exhaust clamp.
^ Tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
20. Fill the engine with clean engine oil. 21. Fill and bleed the cooling system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion
Technical Service Bulletin # 09M04S1 Date: 100331
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
2341
Attachment I - Administrative Information
OASIS ACTIVATED?
Yes, OASIS will be activated on November 10, 2009.
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED? No
STOCK VEHICLES
Do not perform this program unless the affected vehicle exhibits the covered condition.
SOLD VEHICLES
Only owners with affected vehicles that exhibit the covered condition will be directed to dealers for
repairs.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition, call the
Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
2342
NOTE:
Heater core replacement should not be necessary if the flush is performed properly. Prior approval
is required to replace the heater core.
ADDITIONAL LABOR TIME
^ If a condition exists that requires additional labor to complete the repair, call the Special Service
Support Center to request approval prior to performing any additional labor. Requests for approval
after completion of the repair will not be granted.
^ If you encounter aftermarket equipment or modifications to the vehicle which might prevent the
repair of the covered condition, call the Special Service Support Center.
OWNER REFUNDS
^ Ford Motor Company will only refund owner-paid repairs covered by this program if the repair
was performed prior to the date of the Customer Notification Letter (or after the date of the letter if
an emergency repair was made away from the servicing dealer). Non-covered repairs, or those
judged by Ford to be excessive, will not be reimbursed.
^ Refunds will only be provided for the cost associated with the diagnosis and replacement of the
heater core and/or cooling system flush related to reduced heater performance.
^ Vehicles that have had a heater core replacement or cooling system flush and are experiencing
reduced heater performance will need to have this service performed, beginning with the heater
performance evaluation.
^ Multiple refunds should be submitted on one repair line and the invoice details for each repair
should be detailed in the comments section of the claim. If a repair is performed on the same visit,
the repair and refunds should be submitted on separate repair lines.
^ The refund period for repairs performed prior to the date of the Customer Notification Letter will
expire on May 31 2010.
^ Refund Claiming Information (submit on separate repair line).
- Program Code: 09M04 - Misc. Expense: ADMIN - 0.2 Hrs.
- Misc. Expense: REFUND
RENTAL VEHICLES
The use of rental vehicles is not authorized for this program.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Refund or related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line
on which the FSA is claimed. Related damage requires prior approval from the Special Service
Support Center.
^ "MT" labor should be submitted on a separate repair line with the related damage flag checked.
"MT" labor requires prior approval from the Special Service Support Center.
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
^ Claiming information for 5 gallons of distilled water up to $1 .25 per gallon (submit as Misc.
Expense code "OTHER" on the same repair line as the repair).
^ Program Code: 09M04
Misc. Expense: OTHER for actual cost, not to exceed $6.25 maximum
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
2343
LABOR ALLOWANCES
PARTS REQUIREMENTS / ORDERING INFORMATION
Order your parts requirements through normal order processing channels.
The DOR/COR number for this program is 50410.
Questions regarding parts should be directed to the Special Service Support Center or E-mailed.
DEALER PRICE
For latest prices, refer to DOES II.
PARTS RETENTION AND RETURN
Affected water pump inlet tubes and heater cores are subject to random selection for return to the
Ford Warranty Parts Analysis Center (WPAC). Refer to your daily PEARS (Parts Entry and Return
System) register for part disposition and return instructions.
Follow the provisions of the Warranty and Policy Manual for "Parts Retention and Return
Procedures."
Overview
OVERVIEW
In some of the affected vehicles, cooling system corrosion may lead to contamination of the heater
core. This contamination may, over time, lead to reduced heater performance.
This service procedure is very extensive and detailed. Listed below are the sections of the service
procedure along with highlights of important information.
VERIFICATION
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
2344
^ Measure temperature difference in the center vents
^ If greater than 15° F (8° C), proceed to the service procedure
^ If less than 15° F (8° C), follow normal WSM diagnosis
EQUIPMENT LIST
^ Rotunda Tool Kit # 303-1525
^ Additional equipment needed
WATER PUMP INLET TUBE
^ Replace the water pump inlet tube if the engine build date is on or before 4/1/2008
^ Do NOT replace the water pump inlet tube, if the engine build date is on or after 4/2/2008
PRE-RINSE
^ Removes old coolant from the cooling system
^ Coolant MUST NOT mix with the VC-11 flush chemical
VC-11 FLUSH
^ Removes contamination from the cooling system
^ VC-11 flush chemical temperature has to be between 135° F (57° C) and 150° F (65° C) for
optimum cleaning performance
POST-RINSE AND FILL
^ Removes VC-11 from the cooling system
^ VC-11 flush chemical MUST NOT mix with the new coolant
Necessary to use 5 gallons of distilled water for the final system fill
Verification
VERIFY THE CUSTOMER CONCERN BY PERFORMING THE FOLLOWING HEATER
PERFORMANCE EVALUATION
1. Idle the engine at shop ambient temperature of 60° F (15° C) or higher, until the engine is fully
warmed up.
2. Set the front climate temperature control to the hottest setting.
3. Set the mode to panel/vent (with all vents OPEN) and make sure the A/C is switched to the OFF
position. Do NOT set the temperature control to the
recirculation mode.
4. Set the blower to the highest speed.
5. Idle the engine for 5 minutes with the hood closed.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
2345
6. Measure the difference in the discharge air temperature between the left-center vent and the
right center vent as shown. The difference should be less
than 15° F (8° C) to meet the performance requirement.
If the temperature DIFFERENCE IS LESS than 15° F (8° C), continue with normal Workshop
Manual (WSM) diagnostic procedures. Do NOT proceed with this Service Procedure.
If the temperature DIFFERENCE IS MORE than 15° F (8° C), continue to the Service Procedure.
Service Procedure
NOTICE:
ALL STEPS OF THIS SERVICE PROCEDURE MUST BE COMPLETED IN ORDER TO
PROPERLY CLEAN THE COOLING SYSTEM. FAILURE TO FOLLOW THESE STEPS WILL
COPROMISE COOLANT PROTECTION CAPABILITY.
NOTE:
This procedure must be performed at an ambient temperature between 60°F (15° C) and 90° F
(32° C) for proper utilization of the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11.
NOTE:
Dispose of Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture in the same way as
coolant in accordance with local, state and federal laws.
EQUIPMENT LIST
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
2346
NOTE:
Before starting this service procedure make sure that you have the equipment listed.
NOTE:
The dealer bulletin contains the parts list for this service procedure (see Attachment II)
Necessary equipment for the cooling system flush:
1. Rotunda Tool Kit #303-1525
2. Two large radiator hose pinch-off pliers (not supplied with the tool kit)
3. One clean 5 gallon bucket (not supplied with the tool kit)
4. An infrared thermometer or equivalent (not supplied with the tool kit)
5. Safety equipment (eye protection and chemical gloves, not supplied with the tool kit)
6. AirLift Cooling Tester UVU-550000 (not shown, formerly Radkit Plus)
7. Shop water supply hose (not shown)
8. Radiator drain pan (not shown)
WATER PUMP INLET TUBE
NOTE:
Dispose of old coolant in accordance with local state and federal laws.
NOTE:
On some of the affected vehicles the water pump inlet tube is painted on the inside surface. The
flushing chemicals will remove the paint and contaminate the cooling system and components.
1. Place a drain pan under the radiator drain valve and completely drain the cooling system through
the radiator drain (degas bottle cap should be loose
for proper draining).
2. Remove the air cleaner as an assembly.
^ Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector.
^ Loosen the clamp and disconnect the air cleaner assembly outlet pipe from the air cleaner
assembly.
^ Remove the air cleaner assembly bolts.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
2347
^ Separate the 2 air cleaner assembly feet from the rubber grommets.
3. NOTE: The engine build date is on the engine code label, located on the RH cam cover or the
front cover The date is positioned in the center of the
label in a date/month/year sequence
Locate and check the engine build date See Figure 1.
If the engine build date is ON or AFTER 4/2/2008, the water pump inlet tube does NOT need to be
replaced Proceed to Step 11.
If the engine build date is ON or BEFORE 4/1/2008, it will be necessary to replace the water pump
inlet tube Proceed to Step 4.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
2348
4. Remove the coolant hoses from the thermostat housing. See Figure 2.
5. Remove the 3 thermostat housing bolts.
6. Separate the thermostat housing from the water pump inlet tube.
7. NOTE: The water pump inlet tube orientation can be determined by the length of the radius at
the ends of the tube The longer radius end is Inserted
Into the water pump housing. See Figure 3.
Remove the water pump inlet tube from the water pump housing using a slight twisting motion The
inlet tube must be replaced with a new inlet tube without paint on the interior surface of the tube.
8. Lubricate the new water pump inlet tube O-ring with clean engine coolant.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
2349
9. Install the new water pump inlet tube into the water pump housing.
10. Install the thermostat housing.
^ Lubricate the thermostat housing 0-ring with clean engine coolant.
^ Install the thermostat housing and 3 housing bolts. Tighten the bolts to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
^ Install the coolant hoses to the thermostat housing EXCEPT for the heater core inlet and outlet
hoses See Figure 2.
PRE-RINSE
NOTE:
The pinch-off pliers are used to control the direction of fluids in certain areas of the cooling system
They are also used for optimum cleaning and to prevent air from entering Into the cooling system.
11. If the water pump inlet tube was NOT replaced disconnect both the heater core inlet and outlet
hoses from the thermostat housing. See Figure 4.
12. Remove the 2 thermostat housing cover bolts and remove the thermostat.
13.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
2350
Position the flush tool kit plug into the thermostat housing to control the flow and thermostat
housing cover, and bolts Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in). See Figure 6.
14. NOTICE:
With the heater core inlet and outlet hoses off from step 11:
^ Connect the heater core inlet hose (1B - lower hose) to the heater return port (upper port) on the
thermostat housing.
^ Connect the flush tool kit drain hose to the heater core inlet port on the thermostat housing.
^ Connect the flush tool kit hose-to-pump to the heater core outlet hose (OB) for the reverse
flushing.
15. Route the flush tool kit drain and fill hoses under the thermostat housing and out of the engine
compartment Make sure that the hoses are NOT
kinked.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
2351
16.NOTICE: To prevent any damage to the flush tool kit drain and fill hoses place shop towels
between the radiator shroud and the hoses.
Position several shop towels between the hoses and the radiator shroud See Figure 8.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
2352
17. Place the flush tool kit pump onto a tool cart in front of the vehicle. Connect the fill hose from
the heater core outlet to the pump. See Figure 9.
18. Position the flush tool kit 5 gallon bucket onto the tool cart along side the pump. See Figure 9.
19. Reinstall the air cleaner assembly and connect the MAF electrical connector. It is NOT
necessary to secure the air cleaner assembly at this time.
20. NOTE: For measuring purposes it is recommended to use a clean 5 gallon shop bucket. Place
a separate empty 5 gallon shop bucket on the floor in
front of the vehicle. See Figure 9.
21. Place the flush tool kit drain hose from the heater core inlet port on the thermostat housing into
the empty bucket on the floor. See Figure 9.
22. Install the tool kit water valve onto the shop fresh water supply hose. Completely fill the cooling
system through the degas bottle with fresh water
until the water flows from the radiator drain.
(NEW!) 23. Allow the radiator to completely drain. Close the radiator drain and install the degas
bottle cap.
24. NOTE: The pinch-off pliers are used to control the direction of fluids in certain areas of the
cooling system. They are also used for optimum
cleaning and to prevent air from entering into the cooling system.
NOTE:
If the vehicle is being lifted to install and remove the lower radiator hose pinch-off pliers the flush
tool kit pump must be secured onto the radiator shroud while lifting.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
2353
Position and clamp the pinchoff pliers onto the upper radiator hose (see Figure 10) and the lower
radiator hose (see Figure 11) as close to the radiator as possible.
25. Place the flush tool kit suction hose from the pump into one of the small holes in the lid of the
flush tool kit bucket that is along side of the pump.
The hose MUST be kept a minimum of 2 inches from the bottom of the tool kit bucket.
26. Using the shop fresh water supply, fill the flush tool kit bucket with fresh water. Use the tool kit
valve attached to the shop fresh water supply hose
to maintain the water level in the tool kit bucket.
27. Connect a shop air supply to the pump, with the fresh water supply on, and maintain the water
level in the tool kit bucket.
28. NOTE: Do NOT allow the tool kit supply bucket to become low or empty. This will introduce air
into the cooling system and cause an overheating
condition
With the fresh water supply on, monitor and maintain the water level in the tool kit bucket.
29. NOTE: Dispose of old coolant and flushing water contaminated with antifreeze in accordance
with local, state and federal laws.
Allow a minimum of 10 gallons of water to flush through the engine and out the drain hose into the
shop bucket on the floor. It will be necessary to disconnect the shop air supply from the pump to
eliminate the water flow from the drain hose while emptying the shop bucket.
30. After a minimum of 10 gallons of water has flushed through the engine, disconnect the shop air
from the pump and turn off the fresh water supply.
31. Remove the tool kit bucket lid and empty the bucket.
VC-11 FLUSH
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
2354
32. NOTE: Both the suction and drain hoses MUST be kept a minimum of 2 inches from the bottom
of the tool kit bucket. This will prevent any air
from entering into the cooling system and causing an overheating condition.
Reposition the drain hose from the 5 gallon bucket on the floor into one of the small holes in the lid
of the flush tool kit bucket on the tool cart. See Figure 12.
33. Remove the pinchoff pliers from upper and lower radiator hoses.
34. Install the pinchoff pliers onto the flush tool kit drain and suction hose closest to the flush tool kit
bucket lid. See Figure 13.
35. WARNING: THE USE OF SAFETY EQUIPMENT SUCH AS EYE PROTECTION AND
CHEMICAL GLOVES IS REQUIRED FAILURE TO
FOLLOW THESE INSTRUCTIONS MAY RESULT IN SERIOUS PERSONAL INJURY.
NOTICE: Bring the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11 to room temperature of
68° F (20° C) and shake well Follow all of the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC1 1
instructions and Precautions.
Add 2 gallons of Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11 to the flush tool kit bucket
that is on the tool cart Do not dilute the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11 in the
flush tool kit bucket
(NEW!) 36. NOTICE: It is necessary to use the AirLift Cooling Tester UVU-550000 (formerly Radkit
Plus) to remove any air from the cooling system.
If air remains in the cooling system, the air will inhibit the circulation of the Motorcraft(R) Engine
Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture and will cause an overheating condition and possible
damage to the engine.
Rinse the shop bucket and fill with fresh water Place the shop bucket so that the fill hose from the
AirLift Cooling Tester UVU-550000 (formerly Radkit Plus) will siphon the fresh water out of the
bucket. Install the AirLift Cooling Tester UVU-550000 onto the degas bottle.
37. Remove the AirLift Cooling Tester UVU-550000 from the degas bottle and install the degas
bottle cap Make sure that the degas bottle is filled to 1
inch (25 mm) above the COLD FILL LEVEL.
38. Remove the pinch-off pliers from both hoses at the flush tool kit bucket.
39. Position one of the pinch-off pliers onto the upper radiator hose closest to the radiator.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
2355
40. Connect shop air supply to the tool kit pump. The pump will start to siphon the Motorcraft(R)
Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11 from the
bucket into the engine.
41. NOTICE:
With the heater in the OFF position start the engine and idle until the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling
System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture temperature reaches 140° F (60° C) Monitor the
Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture temperature using an infrared
thermometer or equivalent in the flush tool kit bucket.
42. When the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture temperature
reaches 140° F (60° C) remove the pinch-off pliers
from the upper radiator hose.
43. Disconnect the A/C high pressure cut-off switch electrical connector This will activate the
engine cooling fans. It may take a few seconds until the
cooling fans come on See Figure 14.
44.
NOTICE:
Make sure that the radiator is NOT obstructed for maximum air flow Any deflection of air may
cause an overheating condition.
NOTICE:
The Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC11/water mixture temperature MUST NOT
EXCEED 15° F (65° C) or damage to the
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
2356
engine may occur. If the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture
temperature EXCEEDS 150° F (65° C), the heater blower motor can be turned ON to reduce the
mixtures temperature If the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture
temperature STILL EXCEEDS 150° F (65° C), the engine MUST be turned OFF and the key left
ON. The key MUST remain on for the operation of the heater blower motor to allow the engine to
cool down.
Continue the flush using the flush tool kit pump, circulating the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling
System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture through the cooling system.
NOTICE:
Do NOT allow the degas bottle to run low or empty This will allow air to enter the cooling system
and will cause an overheating condition and prevent the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System
Cleaner VC-11/water mixture from circulating through the entire engine and cooling system.
(NEW!) NOTE:
Allow the engine to idle for a MINIMUM of 2 hours The Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System
Cleaner VC11/water mixture temperature MUST remain between 135° F (57° C) to 150° F (65° C)
NOTE:
To control any odor from the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture
during the flush install a shop exhaust hose into the lid of the tool kit bucket.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
2357
To control any odor from the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture it
is recommended to install a shop exhaust hose into the lid of the tool kit bucket. See Figure 16.
45. EVERY half hour monitor the degas bottle for the correct level and measure the temperature in
the tool kit bucket. DO NOT allow the
Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture to get below the COLD FILL
LEVEL. If necessary, release cooling system pressure by loosening the degas bottle cap slowly
allowing air to escape and the degas bottle to fill to 1 inch (25 mm) above the COLD FILL LEVEL.
46. After the engine has idled for a MINIMUM of 2 hours, turn the engine OFF and leave the key in
the ON position. Turn the heater blower motor ON
and select the highest blower speed.
47. Continue flushing until the cooling system cleaner/water mixture reaches 120° F (49° C) with
the heater blower motor on high. The temperature can
be identified using an infrared thermometer or equivalent to monitor the mixture temperature in the
flush tool kit bucket.
48. Disconnect shop air from the flush tool kit pump.
49. Turn the ignition key OFF.
50. Connect the A/C High Pressure switch and the cooling fan motor electrical connector (if
disconnected).
POST-RINSE AND FILL
WARNING:
THE USE OF SAFETY EQUIPMENT SUCH AS EYE PROTECTION AND CHEMICAL GLOVES IS
REQUIRED FAILURE TO FOLLOW THESE INSTRUCTIONS MAY RESULT IN SERIOUS
PERSONAL INJURY
51. NOTE: Dispose of Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture in the
same way as coolant in accordance with local, state
and federal laws.
Empty and rinse the flush tool kit bucket, and then fill with fresh water.
52. Using caution, slowly open and remove the degas bottle cap.
53. Using caution, open the radiator drain.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
2358
54. NOTE: Dispose of Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture in the
same way as coolant in accordance with local, state
and federal laws.
Allow the radiator to drain completely (degas bottle cap should be OFF).
55. Fill the degas bottle completely with fresh water and allow the radiator to drain.
(NEW!) 56. Close the radiator drain and install the degas bottle cap.
57. Place an empty 5 gallon bucket on the floor in front of the vehicle.
58. Remove the flush tool kit drain hose from the flush tool kit bucket and place the drain hose into
the empty shop bucket.
59. Install pinch-off pliers on the upper and lower radiator hoses as close to the radiator outlets as
possible. See Figure 10 and Figure 11.
60. NOTICE: Do NOT allow the flush tool kit bucket to run low or empty during the post-rinse and
fill procedure. This will allow air to enter into the
cooling system and cause an overheating condition.
Keep the fresh water hose in the tool kit bucket and monitor the water level. Do not allow the
bucket to run low or empty.
61. Connect air supply to the pump.
62. Allow a minimum of 10 gallons of water to flush through the engine and out the drain hose into
the shop bucket on the floor. It will be necessary to
disconnect the shop air supply from the pump to eliminate the water flow from the drain hose while
emptying the shop bucket.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
2359
63. NOTE: Remove ONLY the pinch-off pliers from the lower radiator hose in this step. Remove the
pinch-off pliers from the lower radiator hose.
64. NOTICE: Distilled water must be used for the final 5 gallon flush and fill.
After flushing the system with a minimum of 10 gallons of fresh shop water, continue the flush
using an additional 5 gallons of distilled water.
65. Remove the pinch-off pliers from the upper radiator hose.
66. Remove air supply from flush tool kit pump.
67. Disconnect the flush tool kit suction hose from the pump and remove the drain hose from the
shop bucket. Move the tool cart with the bucket and
pump aside.
68. Remove the degas bottle cap.
69. NOTE: Dispose of Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture in the
same way as coolant in accordance with local, state
and federal laws.
Open the radiator drain and completely drain the radiator.
70. Close the radiator drain.
71. Remove the Air Cleaner Assembly.
72. NOTE: A black residue may be evident after the flushing procedure. This is a normal condition
and requires NO action.
Remove the heater core inlet hose from the heater return port on the thermostat housing.
73. Remove the drain hose from the heater core inlet port on the thermostat housing.
74. Remove the thermostat housing cover and remove the flush tool kit plug.
75. Install the thermostat and housing cover. Tighten the bolts to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
76. Install the heater core inlet and outlet hoses onto the thermostat housing See Figure 17.
77. Install the Air Cleaner Assembly
^ Install the air cleaner assembly into the rubber grommets
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
2360
^ Install the air cleaner assembly bolt and tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
^ Connect the air cleaner assembly outlet pipe and tighten the clamp to 5 Nm (44 lb-in)
^ Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector
78. NOTICE:
Using the AirLift Cooling Tester UVU-550000 (formerly Radkit Plus), add 5.8 qts (5.5 L) for base
models and 6.3 qts (6.0 L) for trailer tow models (vehicles equipped with an oil cooler) of 100%
pure concentrated coolant. Use concentrated coolant, Motorcraft(R) Specialty Green Engine
Coolant VC-10-A2 (US) or CVC-10-A (Canada) to the cooling system. Continue with the purge of
air from the system until the coolant reaches 1 inch (25 mm) above the COLD FILL LEVEL.
The recommended coolant concentration is 50/50 or -34° F (-36° C) using Motorcraft(R) Specialty
Green Engine Coolant VC-10-A2 (US) or CVC-10-A (Canada) to distilled water, as measured with
a hydrometer or equivalent.
^ Maximum coolant concentration is 60/40, -60° F (-51° C) for cold weather areas.
^ Minimum coolant concentration is 40/60, -20° F (-29° C) for warm weather areas.
79. Turn the heater to OFF.
WARNING:
ALWAYS ALLOW THE ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE OPENING THE COOLING SYSTEM DO
NOT UNSCREW THE COOLANT PRESSURE RELIEF CAP WHEN THE ENGINE IS
OPERATING OR THE COOLING SYSTEM IS HOT THE COOLING SYSTEM MAY BE UNDER
PRESSURE; STEAM AND HOT LIQUID CAN COME OUT FORCEFULLY WHEN THE CAP IS
LOOSENED SLIGHTLY FAILURE TO FOLLOW THESE INSTRUCTIONS MAY RESULT IN
SERIOUS PERSONAL INJURY.
(NEW!) 80. Start the engine and increase the engine speed to rpm and hold for 30 seconds.
81. Turn the engine OFF and wait for 1 minute to purge any large air pockets from the cooling
system.
82. NOTE: Add concentrated coolant, Motorcraft(R) Specialty Green Engine Coolant VC-10-A2
(US) or CVC-10-A (Canada) to 1 inch (25 mm)
above the top of the COLD FILL LEVEL of the degas bottle.
Check the engine coolant level in the degas bottle and if necessary, fill to 1 inch (25 mm) above the
top of the COLD FILL LEVEL when warm or to the top of the COLD FILL LEVEL when cold using
concentrated coolant, Motorcraft(R) Specialty Green Engine Coolant VC-10-A2 (US) OR CVC-10-A
(Canada).
83. Start the engine and let idle until the engine reaches normal operating temperature and the
thermostat is fully open. A fully open thermostat can be
verified by the radiator cooling fan cycling on at least once.
84. With the engine ON, thermostat open and the cooling fans cycled at least once, increase the
engine speed to 3,500 rpm and hold for 30 seconds.
Then allow the engine to idle for 30 seconds.
85. Turn the engine OFF and wait for 1 minute.
86. Repeat Steps 84 and 85 a total of 5 TIMES to remove any remaining air trapped in the system.
87. NOTE: Add concentrated coolant, Motorcraft(R) Specialty Green Engine Coolant VC-10-A2
(US) or CVC-10-A (Canada) to 1 inch (25 mm)
above the top of the COLD FILL RANGE of the degas bottle.
Check the engine coolant level in the degas bottle, and if necessary, fill to 1 inch (25 mm) above
the top of the COLD FILL LEVEL with the engine warm or to the top of the COLD FILL LEVEL with
the engine cold using concentrated coolant, Motorcraft(R) Specialty Green Engine Coolant
VC-10-A2 (US) or CVC-10-A (Canada).
88. Make sure the degas bottle cap is installed to at least one audible "click."
89. Overlay the new cooling system label onto the degas bottle cap that has been provided by
service management.
90. Using the IDS, clear any codes that may have been set during the flush procedure.
91. Service management will provide the Customer Information Sheet to the customer for insertion
into vehicle's Owner Guide. This Customer
Information Sheet will remind the customer that a revised type of coolant has been installed in their
vehicle and will need to be used from this point forward.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
2361
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
2362
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
2363
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling System Corrosion > Page
2364
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling
System Corrosion
Technical Service Bulletin # 09M04S1 Date: 100331
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling
System Corrosion > Page 2370
Attachment I - Administrative Information
OASIS ACTIVATED?
Yes, OASIS will be activated on November 10, 2009.
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED? No
STOCK VEHICLES
Do not perform this program unless the affected vehicle exhibits the covered condition.
SOLD VEHICLES
Only owners with affected vehicles that exhibit the covered condition will be directed to dealers for
repairs.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition, call the
Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling
System Corrosion > Page 2371
NOTE:
Heater core replacement should not be necessary if the flush is performed properly. Prior approval
is required to replace the heater core.
ADDITIONAL LABOR TIME
^ If a condition exists that requires additional labor to complete the repair, call the Special Service
Support Center to request approval prior to performing any additional labor. Requests for approval
after completion of the repair will not be granted.
^ If you encounter aftermarket equipment or modifications to the vehicle which might prevent the
repair of the covered condition, call the Special Service Support Center.
OWNER REFUNDS
^ Ford Motor Company will only refund owner-paid repairs covered by this program if the repair
was performed prior to the date of the Customer Notification Letter (or after the date of the letter if
an emergency repair was made away from the servicing dealer). Non-covered repairs, or those
judged by Ford to be excessive, will not be reimbursed.
^ Refunds will only be provided for the cost associated with the diagnosis and replacement of the
heater core and/or cooling system flush related to reduced heater performance.
^ Vehicles that have had a heater core replacement or cooling system flush and are experiencing
reduced heater performance will need to have this service performed, beginning with the heater
performance evaluation.
^ Multiple refunds should be submitted on one repair line and the invoice details for each repair
should be detailed in the comments section of the claim. If a repair is performed on the same visit,
the repair and refunds should be submitted on separate repair lines.
^ The refund period for repairs performed prior to the date of the Customer Notification Letter will
expire on May 31 2010.
^ Refund Claiming Information (submit on separate repair line).
- Program Code: 09M04 - Misc. Expense: ADMIN - 0.2 Hrs.
- Misc. Expense: REFUND
RENTAL VEHICLES
The use of rental vehicles is not authorized for this program.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Refund or related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line
on which the FSA is claimed. Related damage requires prior approval from the Special Service
Support Center.
^ "MT" labor should be submitted on a separate repair line with the related damage flag checked.
"MT" labor requires prior approval from the Special Service Support Center.
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
^ Claiming information for 5 gallons of distilled water up to $1 .25 per gallon (submit as Misc.
Expense code "OTHER" on the same repair line as the repair).
^ Program Code: 09M04
Misc. Expense: OTHER for actual cost, not to exceed $6.25 maximum
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling
System Corrosion > Page 2372
LABOR ALLOWANCES
PARTS REQUIREMENTS / ORDERING INFORMATION
Order your parts requirements through normal order processing channels.
The DOR/COR number for this program is 50410.
Questions regarding parts should be directed to the Special Service Support Center or E-mailed.
DEALER PRICE
For latest prices, refer to DOES II.
PARTS RETENTION AND RETURN
Affected water pump inlet tubes and heater cores are subject to random selection for return to the
Ford Warranty Parts Analysis Center (WPAC). Refer to your daily PEARS (Parts Entry and Return
System) register for part disposition and return instructions.
Follow the provisions of the Warranty and Policy Manual for "Parts Retention and Return
Procedures."
Overview
OVERVIEW
In some of the affected vehicles, cooling system corrosion may lead to contamination of the heater
core. This contamination may, over time, lead to reduced heater performance.
This service procedure is very extensive and detailed. Listed below are the sections of the service
procedure along with highlights of important information.
VERIFICATION
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling
System Corrosion > Page 2373
^ Measure temperature difference in the center vents
^ If greater than 15° F (8° C), proceed to the service procedure
^ If less than 15° F (8° C), follow normal WSM diagnosis
EQUIPMENT LIST
^ Rotunda Tool Kit # 303-1525
^ Additional equipment needed
WATER PUMP INLET TUBE
^ Replace the water pump inlet tube if the engine build date is on or before 4/1/2008
^ Do NOT replace the water pump inlet tube, if the engine build date is on or after 4/2/2008
PRE-RINSE
^ Removes old coolant from the cooling system
^ Coolant MUST NOT mix with the VC-11 flush chemical
VC-11 FLUSH
^ Removes contamination from the cooling system
^ VC-11 flush chemical temperature has to be between 135° F (57° C) and 150° F (65° C) for
optimum cleaning performance
POST-RINSE AND FILL
^ Removes VC-11 from the cooling system
^ VC-11 flush chemical MUST NOT mix with the new coolant
Necessary to use 5 gallons of distilled water for the final system fill
Verification
VERIFY THE CUSTOMER CONCERN BY PERFORMING THE FOLLOWING HEATER
PERFORMANCE EVALUATION
1. Idle the engine at shop ambient temperature of 60° F (15° C) or higher, until the engine is fully
warmed up.
2. Set the front climate temperature control to the hottest setting.
3. Set the mode to panel/vent (with all vents OPEN) and make sure the A/C is switched to the OFF
position. Do NOT set the temperature control to the
recirculation mode.
4. Set the blower to the highest speed.
5. Idle the engine for 5 minutes with the hood closed.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling
System Corrosion > Page 2374
6. Measure the difference in the discharge air temperature between the left-center vent and the
right center vent as shown. The difference should be less
than 15° F (8° C) to meet the performance requirement.
If the temperature DIFFERENCE IS LESS than 15° F (8° C), continue with normal Workshop
Manual (WSM) diagnostic procedures. Do NOT proceed with this Service Procedure.
If the temperature DIFFERENCE IS MORE than 15° F (8° C), continue to the Service Procedure.
Service Procedure
NOTICE:
ALL STEPS OF THIS SERVICE PROCEDURE MUST BE COMPLETED IN ORDER TO
PROPERLY CLEAN THE COOLING SYSTEM. FAILURE TO FOLLOW THESE STEPS WILL
COPROMISE COOLANT PROTECTION CAPABILITY.
NOTE:
This procedure must be performed at an ambient temperature between 60°F (15° C) and 90° F
(32° C) for proper utilization of the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11.
NOTE:
Dispose of Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture in the same way as
coolant in accordance with local, state and federal laws.
EQUIPMENT LIST
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling
System Corrosion > Page 2375
NOTE:
Before starting this service procedure make sure that you have the equipment listed.
NOTE:
The dealer bulletin contains the parts list for this service procedure (see Attachment II)
Necessary equipment for the cooling system flush:
1. Rotunda Tool Kit #303-1525
2. Two large radiator hose pinch-off pliers (not supplied with the tool kit)
3. One clean 5 gallon bucket (not supplied with the tool kit)
4. An infrared thermometer or equivalent (not supplied with the tool kit)
5. Safety equipment (eye protection and chemical gloves, not supplied with the tool kit)
6. AirLift Cooling Tester UVU-550000 (not shown, formerly Radkit Plus)
7. Shop water supply hose (not shown)
8. Radiator drain pan (not shown)
WATER PUMP INLET TUBE
NOTE:
Dispose of old coolant in accordance with local state and federal laws.
NOTE:
On some of the affected vehicles the water pump inlet tube is painted on the inside surface. The
flushing chemicals will remove the paint and contaminate the cooling system and components.
1. Place a drain pan under the radiator drain valve and completely drain the cooling system through
the radiator drain (degas bottle cap should be loose
for proper draining).
2. Remove the air cleaner as an assembly.
^ Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector.
^ Loosen the clamp and disconnect the air cleaner assembly outlet pipe from the air cleaner
assembly.
^ Remove the air cleaner assembly bolts.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling
System Corrosion > Page 2376
^ Separate the 2 air cleaner assembly feet from the rubber grommets.
3. NOTE: The engine build date is on the engine code label, located on the RH cam cover or the
front cover The date is positioned in the center of the
label in a date/month/year sequence
Locate and check the engine build date See Figure 1.
If the engine build date is ON or AFTER 4/2/2008, the water pump inlet tube does NOT need to be
replaced Proceed to Step 11.
If the engine build date is ON or BEFORE 4/1/2008, it will be necessary to replace the water pump
inlet tube Proceed to Step 4.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling
System Corrosion > Page 2377
4. Remove the coolant hoses from the thermostat housing. See Figure 2.
5. Remove the 3 thermostat housing bolts.
6. Separate the thermostat housing from the water pump inlet tube.
7. NOTE: The water pump inlet tube orientation can be determined by the length of the radius at
the ends of the tube The longer radius end is Inserted
Into the water pump housing. See Figure 3.
Remove the water pump inlet tube from the water pump housing using a slight twisting motion The
inlet tube must be replaced with a new inlet tube without paint on the interior surface of the tube.
8. Lubricate the new water pump inlet tube O-ring with clean engine coolant.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling
System Corrosion > Page 2378
9. Install the new water pump inlet tube into the water pump housing.
10. Install the thermostat housing.
^ Lubricate the thermostat housing 0-ring with clean engine coolant.
^ Install the thermostat housing and 3 housing bolts. Tighten the bolts to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
^ Install the coolant hoses to the thermostat housing EXCEPT for the heater core inlet and outlet
hoses See Figure 2.
PRE-RINSE
NOTE:
The pinch-off pliers are used to control the direction of fluids in certain areas of the cooling system
They are also used for optimum cleaning and to prevent air from entering Into the cooling system.
11. If the water pump inlet tube was NOT replaced disconnect both the heater core inlet and outlet
hoses from the thermostat housing. See Figure 4.
12. Remove the 2 thermostat housing cover bolts and remove the thermostat.
13.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling
System Corrosion > Page 2379
Position the flush tool kit plug into the thermostat housing to control the flow and thermostat
housing cover, and bolts Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in). See Figure 6.
14. NOTICE:
With the heater core inlet and outlet hoses off from step 11:
^ Connect the heater core inlet hose (1B - lower hose) to the heater return port (upper port) on the
thermostat housing.
^ Connect the flush tool kit drain hose to the heater core inlet port on the thermostat housing.
^ Connect the flush tool kit hose-to-pump to the heater core outlet hose (OB) for the reverse
flushing.
15. Route the flush tool kit drain and fill hoses under the thermostat housing and out of the engine
compartment Make sure that the hoses are NOT
kinked.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling
System Corrosion > Page 2380
16.NOTICE: To prevent any damage to the flush tool kit drain and fill hoses place shop towels
between the radiator shroud and the hoses.
Position several shop towels between the hoses and the radiator shroud See Figure 8.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling
System Corrosion > Page 2381
17. Place the flush tool kit pump onto a tool cart in front of the vehicle. Connect the fill hose from
the heater core outlet to the pump. See Figure 9.
18. Position the flush tool kit 5 gallon bucket onto the tool cart along side the pump. See Figure 9.
19. Reinstall the air cleaner assembly and connect the MAF electrical connector. It is NOT
necessary to secure the air cleaner assembly at this time.
20. NOTE: For measuring purposes it is recommended to use a clean 5 gallon shop bucket. Place
a separate empty 5 gallon shop bucket on the floor in
front of the vehicle. See Figure 9.
21. Place the flush tool kit drain hose from the heater core inlet port on the thermostat housing into
the empty bucket on the floor. See Figure 9.
22. Install the tool kit water valve onto the shop fresh water supply hose. Completely fill the cooling
system through the degas bottle with fresh water
until the water flows from the radiator drain.
(NEW!) 23. Allow the radiator to completely drain. Close the radiator drain and install the degas
bottle cap.
24. NOTE: The pinch-off pliers are used to control the direction of fluids in certain areas of the
cooling system. They are also used for optimum
cleaning and to prevent air from entering into the cooling system.
NOTE:
If the vehicle is being lifted to install and remove the lower radiator hose pinch-off pliers the flush
tool kit pump must be secured onto the radiator shroud while lifting.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling
System Corrosion > Page 2382
Position and clamp the pinchoff pliers onto the upper radiator hose (see Figure 10) and the lower
radiator hose (see Figure 11) as close to the radiator as possible.
25. Place the flush tool kit suction hose from the pump into one of the small holes in the lid of the
flush tool kit bucket that is along side of the pump.
The hose MUST be kept a minimum of 2 inches from the bottom of the tool kit bucket.
26. Using the shop fresh water supply, fill the flush tool kit bucket with fresh water. Use the tool kit
valve attached to the shop fresh water supply hose
to maintain the water level in the tool kit bucket.
27. Connect a shop air supply to the pump, with the fresh water supply on, and maintain the water
level in the tool kit bucket.
28. NOTE: Do NOT allow the tool kit supply bucket to become low or empty. This will introduce air
into the cooling system and cause an overheating
condition
With the fresh water supply on, monitor and maintain the water level in the tool kit bucket.
29. NOTE: Dispose of old coolant and flushing water contaminated with antifreeze in accordance
with local, state and federal laws.
Allow a minimum of 10 gallons of water to flush through the engine and out the drain hose into the
shop bucket on the floor. It will be necessary to disconnect the shop air supply from the pump to
eliminate the water flow from the drain hose while emptying the shop bucket.
30. After a minimum of 10 gallons of water has flushed through the engine, disconnect the shop air
from the pump and turn off the fresh water supply.
31. Remove the tool kit bucket lid and empty the bucket.
VC-11 FLUSH
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling
System Corrosion > Page 2383
32. NOTE: Both the suction and drain hoses MUST be kept a minimum of 2 inches from the bottom
of the tool kit bucket. This will prevent any air
from entering into the cooling system and causing an overheating condition.
Reposition the drain hose from the 5 gallon bucket on the floor into one of the small holes in the lid
of the flush tool kit bucket on the tool cart. See Figure 12.
33. Remove the pinchoff pliers from upper and lower radiator hoses.
34. Install the pinchoff pliers onto the flush tool kit drain and suction hose closest to the flush tool kit
bucket lid. See Figure 13.
35. WARNING: THE USE OF SAFETY EQUIPMENT SUCH AS EYE PROTECTION AND
CHEMICAL GLOVES IS REQUIRED FAILURE TO
FOLLOW THESE INSTRUCTIONS MAY RESULT IN SERIOUS PERSONAL INJURY.
NOTICE: Bring the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11 to room temperature of
68° F (20° C) and shake well Follow all of the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC1 1
instructions and Precautions.
Add 2 gallons of Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11 to the flush tool kit bucket
that is on the tool cart Do not dilute the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11 in the
flush tool kit bucket
(NEW!) 36. NOTICE: It is necessary to use the AirLift Cooling Tester UVU-550000 (formerly Radkit
Plus) to remove any air from the cooling system.
If air remains in the cooling system, the air will inhibit the circulation of the Motorcraft(R) Engine
Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture and will cause an overheating condition and possible
damage to the engine.
Rinse the shop bucket and fill with fresh water Place the shop bucket so that the fill hose from the
AirLift Cooling Tester UVU-550000 (formerly Radkit Plus) will siphon the fresh water out of the
bucket. Install the AirLift Cooling Tester UVU-550000 onto the degas bottle.
37. Remove the AirLift Cooling Tester UVU-550000 from the degas bottle and install the degas
bottle cap Make sure that the degas bottle is filled to 1
inch (25 mm) above the COLD FILL LEVEL.
38. Remove the pinch-off pliers from both hoses at the flush tool kit bucket.
39. Position one of the pinch-off pliers onto the upper radiator hose closest to the radiator.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling
System Corrosion > Page 2384
40. Connect shop air supply to the tool kit pump. The pump will start to siphon the Motorcraft(R)
Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11 from the
bucket into the engine.
41. NOTICE:
With the heater in the OFF position start the engine and idle until the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling
System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture temperature reaches 140° F (60° C) Monitor the
Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture temperature using an infrared
thermometer or equivalent in the flush tool kit bucket.
42. When the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture temperature
reaches 140° F (60° C) remove the pinch-off pliers
from the upper radiator hose.
43. Disconnect the A/C high pressure cut-off switch electrical connector This will activate the
engine cooling fans. It may take a few seconds until the
cooling fans come on See Figure 14.
44.
NOTICE:
Make sure that the radiator is NOT obstructed for maximum air flow Any deflection of air may
cause an overheating condition.
NOTICE:
The Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC11/water mixture temperature MUST NOT
EXCEED 15° F (65° C) or damage to the
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling
System Corrosion > Page 2385
engine may occur. If the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture
temperature EXCEEDS 150° F (65° C), the heater blower motor can be turned ON to reduce the
mixtures temperature If the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture
temperature STILL EXCEEDS 150° F (65° C), the engine MUST be turned OFF and the key left
ON. The key MUST remain on for the operation of the heater blower motor to allow the engine to
cool down.
Continue the flush using the flush tool kit pump, circulating the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling
System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture through the cooling system.
NOTICE:
Do NOT allow the degas bottle to run low or empty This will allow air to enter the cooling system
and will cause an overheating condition and prevent the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System
Cleaner VC-11/water mixture from circulating through the entire engine and cooling system.
(NEW!) NOTE:
Allow the engine to idle for a MINIMUM of 2 hours The Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System
Cleaner VC11/water mixture temperature MUST remain between 135° F (57° C) to 150° F (65° C)
NOTE:
To control any odor from the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture
during the flush install a shop exhaust hose into the lid of the tool kit bucket.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling
System Corrosion > Page 2386
To control any odor from the Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture it
is recommended to install a shop exhaust hose into the lid of the tool kit bucket. See Figure 16.
45. EVERY half hour monitor the degas bottle for the correct level and measure the temperature in
the tool kit bucket. DO NOT allow the
Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture to get below the COLD FILL
LEVEL. If necessary, release cooling system pressure by loosening the degas bottle cap slowly
allowing air to escape and the degas bottle to fill to 1 inch (25 mm) above the COLD FILL LEVEL.
46. After the engine has idled for a MINIMUM of 2 hours, turn the engine OFF and leave the key in
the ON position. Turn the heater blower motor ON
and select the highest blower speed.
47. Continue flushing until the cooling system cleaner/water mixture reaches 120° F (49° C) with
the heater blower motor on high. The temperature can
be identified using an infrared thermometer or equivalent to monitor the mixture temperature in the
flush tool kit bucket.
48. Disconnect shop air from the flush tool kit pump.
49. Turn the ignition key OFF.
50. Connect the A/C High Pressure switch and the cooling fan motor electrical connector (if
disconnected).
POST-RINSE AND FILL
WARNING:
THE USE OF SAFETY EQUIPMENT SUCH AS EYE PROTECTION AND CHEMICAL GLOVES IS
REQUIRED FAILURE TO FOLLOW THESE INSTRUCTIONS MAY RESULT IN SERIOUS
PERSONAL INJURY
51. NOTE: Dispose of Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture in the
same way as coolant in accordance with local, state
and federal laws.
Empty and rinse the flush tool kit bucket, and then fill with fresh water.
52. Using caution, slowly open and remove the degas bottle cap.
53. Using caution, open the radiator drain.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling
System Corrosion > Page 2387
54. NOTE: Dispose of Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture in the
same way as coolant in accordance with local, state
and federal laws.
Allow the radiator to drain completely (degas bottle cap should be OFF).
55. Fill the degas bottle completely with fresh water and allow the radiator to drain.
(NEW!) 56. Close the radiator drain and install the degas bottle cap.
57. Place an empty 5 gallon bucket on the floor in front of the vehicle.
58. Remove the flush tool kit drain hose from the flush tool kit bucket and place the drain hose into
the empty shop bucket.
59. Install pinch-off pliers on the upper and lower radiator hoses as close to the radiator outlets as
possible. See Figure 10 and Figure 11.
60. NOTICE: Do NOT allow the flush tool kit bucket to run low or empty during the post-rinse and
fill procedure. This will allow air to enter into the
cooling system and cause an overheating condition.
Keep the fresh water hose in the tool kit bucket and monitor the water level. Do not allow the
bucket to run low or empty.
61. Connect air supply to the pump.
62. Allow a minimum of 10 gallons of water to flush through the engine and out the drain hose into
the shop bucket on the floor. It will be necessary to
disconnect the shop air supply from the pump to eliminate the water flow from the drain hose while
emptying the shop bucket.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling
System Corrosion > Page 2388
63. NOTE: Remove ONLY the pinch-off pliers from the lower radiator hose in this step. Remove the
pinch-off pliers from the lower radiator hose.
64. NOTICE: Distilled water must be used for the final 5 gallon flush and fill.
After flushing the system with a minimum of 10 gallons of fresh shop water, continue the flush
using an additional 5 gallons of distilled water.
65. Remove the pinch-off pliers from the upper radiator hose.
66. Remove air supply from flush tool kit pump.
67. Disconnect the flush tool kit suction hose from the pump and remove the drain hose from the
shop bucket. Move the tool cart with the bucket and
pump aside.
68. Remove the degas bottle cap.
69. NOTE: Dispose of Motorcraft(R) Engine Cooling System Cleaner VC-11/water mixture in the
same way as coolant in accordance with local, state
and federal laws.
Open the radiator drain and completely drain the radiator.
70. Close the radiator drain.
71. Remove the Air Cleaner Assembly.
72. NOTE: A black residue may be evident after the flushing procedure. This is a normal condition
and requires NO action.
Remove the heater core inlet hose from the heater return port on the thermostat housing.
73. Remove the drain hose from the heater core inlet port on the thermostat housing.
74. Remove the thermostat housing cover and remove the flush tool kit plug.
75. Install the thermostat and housing cover. Tighten the bolts to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
76. Install the heater core inlet and outlet hoses onto the thermostat housing See Figure 17.
77. Install the Air Cleaner Assembly
^ Install the air cleaner assembly into the rubber grommets
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling
System Corrosion > Page 2389
^ Install the air cleaner assembly bolt and tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
^ Connect the air cleaner assembly outlet pipe and tighten the clamp to 5 Nm (44 lb-in)
^ Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector
78. NOTICE:
Using the AirLift Cooling Tester UVU-550000 (formerly Radkit Plus), add 5.8 qts (5.5 L) for base
models and 6.3 qts (6.0 L) for trailer tow models (vehicles equipped with an oil cooler) of 100%
pure concentrated coolant. Use concentrated coolant, Motorcraft(R) Specialty Green Engine
Coolant VC-10-A2 (US) or CVC-10-A (Canada) to the cooling system. Continue with the purge of
air from the system until the coolant reaches 1 inch (25 mm) above the COLD FILL LEVEL.
The recommended coolant concentration is 50/50 or -34° F (-36° C) using Motorcraft(R) Specialty
Green Engine Coolant VC-10-A2 (US) or CVC-10-A (Canada) to distilled water, as measured with
a hydrometer or equivalent.
^ Maximum coolant concentration is 60/40, -60° F (-51° C) for cold weather areas.
^ Minimum coolant concentration is 40/60, -20° F (-29° C) for warm weather areas.
79. Turn the heater to OFF.
WARNING:
ALWAYS ALLOW THE ENGINE TO COOL BEFORE OPENING THE COOLING SYSTEM DO
NOT UNSCREW THE COOLANT PRESSURE RELIEF CAP WHEN THE ENGINE IS
OPERATING OR THE COOLING SYSTEM IS HOT THE COOLING SYSTEM MAY BE UNDER
PRESSURE; STEAM AND HOT LIQUID CAN COME OUT FORCEFULLY WHEN THE CAP IS
LOOSENED SLIGHTLY FAILURE TO FOLLOW THESE INSTRUCTIONS MAY RESULT IN
SERIOUS PERSONAL INJURY.
(NEW!) 80. Start the engine and increase the engine speed to rpm and hold for 30 seconds.
81. Turn the engine OFF and wait for 1 minute to purge any large air pockets from the cooling
system.
82. NOTE: Add concentrated coolant, Motorcraft(R) Specialty Green Engine Coolant VC-10-A2
(US) or CVC-10-A (Canada) to 1 inch (25 mm)
above the top of the COLD FILL LEVEL of the degas bottle.
Check the engine coolant level in the degas bottle and if necessary, fill to 1 inch (25 mm) above the
top of the COLD FILL LEVEL when warm or to the top of the COLD FILL LEVEL when cold using
concentrated coolant, Motorcraft(R) Specialty Green Engine Coolant VC-10-A2 (US) OR CVC-10-A
(Canada).
83. Start the engine and let idle until the engine reaches normal operating temperature and the
thermostat is fully open. A fully open thermostat can be
verified by the radiator cooling fan cycling on at least once.
84. With the engine ON, thermostat open and the cooling fans cycled at least once, increase the
engine speed to 3,500 rpm and hold for 30 seconds.
Then allow the engine to idle for 30 seconds.
85. Turn the engine OFF and wait for 1 minute.
86. Repeat Steps 84 and 85 a total of 5 TIMES to remove any remaining air trapped in the system.
87. NOTE: Add concentrated coolant, Motorcraft(R) Specialty Green Engine Coolant VC-10-A2
(US) or CVC-10-A (Canada) to 1 inch (25 mm)
above the top of the COLD FILL RANGE of the degas bottle.
Check the engine coolant level in the degas bottle, and if necessary, fill to 1 inch (25 mm) above
the top of the COLD FILL LEVEL with the engine warm or to the top of the COLD FILL LEVEL with
the engine cold using concentrated coolant, Motorcraft(R) Specialty Green Engine Coolant
VC-10-A2 (US) or CVC-10-A (Canada).
88. Make sure the degas bottle cap is installed to at least one audible "click."
89. Overlay the new cooling system label onto the degas bottle cap that has been provided by
service management.
90. Using the IDS, clear any codes that may have been set during the flush procedure.
91. Service management will provide the Customer Information Sheet to the customer for insertion
into vehicle's Owner Guide. This Customer
Information Sheet will remind the customer that a revised type of coolant has been installed in their
vehicle and will need to be used from this point forward.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling
System Corrosion > Page 2390
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling
System Corrosion > Page 2391
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling
System Corrosion > Page 2392
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant: > 09M04S1 > Mar > 10 > Campaign - Potential Cooling
System Corrosion > Page 2393
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Coolant: Capacity Specifications
Cooling System ...................................................................................................................................
.......................................... 11.7 quarts (11.09 liters)
With Trailer Tow Package ...................................................................................................................
.................................................... 12.83 qts (12.14L)
NOTE: Add the coolant type originally equipped in your vehicle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 2396
Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications
ENGINE COOLANT
Motorcraft Premium Gold Engine Coolant with bittering agent (yellow-colored)
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
.................................................................. VC-7-B
Ford Specification ................................................................................................................................
................................................ WSS-M97B51-A1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Reservoir > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Coolant Reservoir: Service and Repair
Degas Bottle
Degas Bottle
Removal and Installation
1. WARNING: To avoid personal injury, do not unscrew the coolant pressure relief cap while the
engine is operating or hot. The cooling
system is under pressure; steam and hot liquid can come out forcefully when the cap is loosened
slightly. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
Release the pressure in the cooling system by slowly turning the pressure relief cap one half turn
counterclockwise. When the pressure is released, remove the pressure relief cap.
2. Using hose clamp pliers, clamp the lower degas bottle hose. 3. Using a suitable suction device,
siphon the coolant from the degas bottle. 4. Disconnect the upper degas bottle hose and position it
aside. 5. Disconnect the lower degas bottle hose and position it aside. 6. Remove the degas
bottle-to-washer bottle screw. 7. Remove the 2 bolts and the degas bottle.
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 9. Fill the degas bottle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Control Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 2404
C1554
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2409
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2410
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2411
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2412
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2413
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2414
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2415
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2416
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2417
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2418
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2419
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2420
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2421
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2422
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2423
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2424
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2425
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2426
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Description and Operation
FAN CONTROL
The PCM monitors certain parameters (such as engine coolant temperature, vehicle speed, A/C
on/off status, A/C pressure) to determine engine cooling fan needs.
For variable speed electric fan(s):
Edge/MKX, Five Hundred/Freestyle/Montego, Fusion/Milan/MKZ, Crown Victoria/Grand Marquis,
Town Car: FCV Duty Cycle Output From PCM (Negative Duty Cycle)
The PCM controls the fan speed and operation using a duty cycle output on the fan control variable
(FCV) circuit. The fan controller (located at or integral to the engine cooling fan assembly) receives
the FCV command and operates the cooling fan at the speed requested (by varying the power
applied to the fan motor).
For relay controlled fans:
2.0L Focus (with A/C) And Taurus: PCM FC Output State For Cooling Fan Speeds
2.3L Escape: PCM FC Output State For Cooling Fan Speeds
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2427
Freestar, Monterey: PCM FC Output State For Cooling Fan Speeds
The PCM controls the fan operation through the fan control (FC) (single speed fan applications),
low fan control (LFC), medium fan control (MFC), and/or high fan control (HFC) outputs. Some
applications will have the xFC circuit wired to 2 separate relays.
For 3-speed fans, although the PCM output circuits are called low, medium, and high fan control
(FC), cooling fan speed is controlled by a combination of these outputs. Refer to the table.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Radiator Cooling Fan Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
FAN SPEED SENSOR (FSS)
Cooling Fan Clutch With (FSS)
The FSS is a Hall-effect sensor that measures the cooling fan clutch speed by generating a
waveform with a frequency proportional to the fan speed. If the cooling fan clutch is moving at a
relatively low speed, the sensor produces a signal with a low frequency. As the cooling fan clutch
speed increases, the sensor generates a signal with a higher frequency. The powertrain control
module (PCM) uses the frequency signal generated by the FSS as a feedback for closed loop
control of the cooling fan clutch.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fan Clutch: Description and Operation
COOLING FAN CLUTCH
Cooling Fan Clutch With Fan Speed Sensor (FSS)
The cooling fan clutch is an electrically actuated viscous clutch that consists of 3 main elements:
- a working chamber
- a reservoir chamber
- a cooling fan clutch actuator valve and a fan speed sensor (FSS)
The cooling fan clutch actuator valve controls the fluid flow from the reservoir into the working
chamber. Once viscous fluid is in the working chamber, shearing of the fluid results in fan rotation.
The cooling fan clutch actuator valve is activated with a pulse width modulated (PWM) output
signal from the PCM. By opening and closing the fluid port valve, the PCM can control the cooling
fan clutch speed. The cooling fan clutch speed is measured by a Hall-effect sensor and is
monitored by the PCM during closed loop operation.
The PCM optimizes fan speed based on engine coolant temperature (ECT), engine oil temperature
(EOT), transmission fluid temperature (TFT), intake air temperature (IAT), or air conditioning
requirements. When an increased demand for fan speed is requested for vehicle cooling, the PCM
monitors the fan speed through the Hall-effect sensor. If a fan speed increase is required, the PCM
outputs the PWM signal to the fluid port, providing the required fan speed increase.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 2434
Fan Clutch: Tools and Equipment
Fan Clutch Holding Tool AST tool# 8005
Allows the technician to hold the water pump pulleuy in place while loosening the radiator fan.
2009 Suggested user price: $41.20
Assenmacher Specialty Tools 1 800 525 2943
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch
> Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Description and Operation
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR
Typical Thread Type ECT Sensor
The ECT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The ECT measures the temperature of the engine coolant. The PCM uses the ECT input for fuel
control and for cooling fan control. There are 3 types of ECT sensors, threaded, push-in, and
twist-lock. The ECT sensor is located in an engine coolant passage.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch
> Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch
> Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2442
C107
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch
> Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2443
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Typical CHT Sensor
The CHT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with the temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as temperature increases., and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
The CHT sensor is installed in the cylinder head and measures the metal temperature. The CHT
sensor can provide complete engine temperature information and can be used to infer coolant
temperature. If the CHT sensor conveys an overheating condition to the PCM, the PCM initiates a
fail-safe cooling strategy based on information from the CHT sensor. A cooling system concern
such as low coolant or coolant loss could cause an overheating condition. As a result, damage to
major engine components could occur. Using both the CHT sensor and fail-safe cooling strategy,
the PCM prevents damage by allowing air cooling of the engine and limp home capability.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch
> Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2444
Engine Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the lower intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the cylinder head temperature (CHT) sensor
electrical connector. 3. Remove and discard the CHT sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Do not reuse the CHT sensor, install a new sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Fan Shroud > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Fan Shroud: Service and Repair
Cooling Fan Motor and Shroud
Cooling Fan Motor and Shroud
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery. 2. Remove the
air cleaner assembly. For additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery and Air Induction. 3. If
equipped, detach the 2 block heater wiring clips from the radiator support.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Fan Shroud > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 2448
4. Detach the 5 wiring harness retainers and position the harness aside. 5. Position aside the upper
radiator hose from the cooling fan motor and shroud. 6. Disconnect the cooling fan motor and
shroud electrical connector. 7. If equipped, remove the bolt and position aside the oil cooler
bracket.
^ To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 inch lbs).
8. Remove the 2 bolts and the cooling fan motor and shroud.
^ To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 inch lbs).
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Heater Core: Service and Repair
HEATER CORE
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 2452
Removal and Installation
NOTE: If a heater core leak is suspected, the heater core must be pressure leak tested before it is
removed from the vehicle.
1. Remove the heater core and evaporator core housing. 2. Remove the 6 floor duct screws and
the floor duct. 3. Remove the heater core tube dash panel seal. 4. Remove the heater tube bracket
screw and the heater tube bracket. 5. Remove the 5 fresh air inlet duct screws and the fresh air
inlet duct. 6. Disconnect the wire harness from the plenum chamber. 7. Remove the 7 lower facing
plenum chamber screws. 8. Orient the heater core and evaporator core housing with the plenum
chamber upright. 9. Remove the upper facing plenum chamber screw.
10. Remove the 2 plenum chamber clips and remove the plenum chamber being careful not to
allow the evaporator core to become dislodged from the
installed position.
11. CAUTION: Do not handle the heater core by the inlet and/or outlet tube to remove. Handling
the heater core by the tubes may damage
the joints and lead to failure of the heater core.
Remove the heater core. 1
Grasp the heater core by the core-side of the heater tube connections and partially remove it from
the plenum chamber.
2 Grasp the heater core by the top of the core and remove it from the plenum chamber.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 2453
12. NOTE: It is not necessary to carry out this step if the evaporator core has not become
dislodged from the installed position during this procedure.
If the evaporator core has been moved at any point during heater core removal, remove the
evaporator core, verify that the drain seal is installed in the correct position and install the
evaporator core in the correct position.
13. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Radiator: Service and Repair
Radiator
Radiator (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Page 2457
Radiator (Part 2)
Removal and Installation
1. Drain the cooling system. 2. Remove the cooling fan motor and shroud. 3. Remove the front
bumper cover. 4. Disconnect the upper radiator hose and lower degas bottle hose from the
radiator. 5. Disconnect the lower radiator hose from the radiator. 6. Lift and remove the tabs from
the radiator support and position the radiator towards the engine. 7. Remove the 2 A/C condenser
bolts from the radiator and separate the condenser from the radiator.
^ To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
8. Remove the radiator. 9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
10. Fill and bleed the cooling system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Control Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 2462
C1554
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Radiator Cooling Fan Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
FAN SPEED SENSOR (FSS)
Cooling Fan Clutch With (FSS)
The FSS is a Hall-effect sensor that measures the cooling fan clutch speed by generating a
waveform with a frequency proportional to the fan speed. If the cooling fan clutch is moving at a
relatively low speed, the sensor produces a signal with a low frequency. As the cooling fan clutch
speed increases, the sensor generates a signal with a higher frequency. The powertrain control
module (PCM) uses the frequency signal generated by the FSS as a feedback for closed loop
control of the cooling fan clutch.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR
Typical Thread Type ECT Sensor
The ECT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The ECT measures the temperature of the engine coolant. The PCM uses the ECT input for fuel
control and for cooling fan control. There are 3 types of ECT sensors, threaded, push-in, and
twist-lock. The ECT sensor is located in an engine coolant passage.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2474
C107
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2475
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Typical CHT Sensor
The CHT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with the temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as temperature increases., and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
The CHT sensor is installed in the cylinder head and measures the metal temperature. The CHT
sensor can provide complete engine temperature information and can be used to infer coolant
temperature. If the CHT sensor conveys an overheating condition to the PCM, the PCM initiates a
fail-safe cooling strategy based on information from the CHT sensor. A cooling system concern
such as low coolant or coolant loss could cause an overheating condition. As a result, damage to
major engine components could occur. Using both the CHT sensor and fail-safe cooling strategy,
the PCM prevents damage by allowing air cooling of the engine and limp home capability.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2476
Engine Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the lower intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the cylinder head temperature (CHT) sensor
electrical connector. 3. Remove and discard the CHT sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Do not reuse the CHT sensor, install a new sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Specifications
Thermostat: Specifications
Thermostat Opening Temperatures
Starts to open.......................................................................................................................................
........................................................... 86°C (187°F) Fully open...........................................................
............................................................................................................................................ 96°C
(205°F)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2480
Thermostat: Service and Repair
Thermostat
Material
Removal and Installation
1. Drain the cooling system. 2. Remove the air cleaner assembly and outlet pipe. For additional
information, refer to Fuel Delivery and Air Induction. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and position aside the
thermostat housing cover.
^ To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
4. Remove the O-ring seal and thermostat.
^ Clean and inspect the O-ring seal. Install a new seal if necessary.
5. NOTE: Lubricate the thermostat O-ring seal with clean engine coolant.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
6. Fill and bleed the cooling system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat Housing, Engine Cooling >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Thermostat Housing: Service and Repair
Thermostat Housing
Material
Removal and Installation
1. Drain the cooling system. 2. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe. For additional information, refer
to Fuel Delivery and Air Induction. 3. Disconnect the 5 coolant hoses from the thermostat housing
and position them aside. 4. Remove the 3 thermostat housing bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
5. CAUTION: Do not pull the other end of the coolant tube out of the engine block when separating
the thermostat housing.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat Housing, Engine Cooling >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2484
Separate the thermostat housing from the coolant tube and remove the thermostat housing. ^
Remove and discard the O-ring seals.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Lubricate the new O-ring seals with clean engine coolant.
7. Fill and bleed the cooling system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications
Water Pump: Specifications
Coolant pump bolts ..............................................................................................................................
................................................. 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2488
Water Pump: Service and Repair
Coolant Pump
Removal
CAUTION: During engine repair procedures, cleanliness is extremely important. Any foreign
material, including any material created while cleaning gasket surfaces, that enters the oil
passages, coolant passages or the oil pan can cause engine failure.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Drain the cooling system. For additional information, refer to
Cooling System. 3. Loosen the exhaust flexible pipe clamp and disconnect the 2 exhaust hangers.
4. Remove the 4 nuts, the exhaust flexible pipe and the Y-pipe as an assembly.
^ Discard the nuts and the gasket.
5. Remove the LH and RH catalytic converters. For additional information, refer to Catalytic
Converter. 6. If equipped, remove the heat shield and disconnect the block heater electrical
connector.
7. Remove the RH cylinder block drain plug or, if equipped, the block heater.
^ Allow coolant to drain from the cylinder block.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2489
8. Remove the LH cylinder block drain plug.
^ Allow coolant to drain from the cylinder block.
9. Remove the engine front cover.
10. Rotate the crankshaft clockwise and align the timing marks on the variable camshaft timing
(VCT) assemblies as shown.
11. NOTE: The special tool will hold the camshafts in the top dead center (TDC) position.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2490
Install the special tool onto the flats of the LH camshafts.
12. NOTE: The special tool will hold the camshafts in the TDC position.
Install the special tool onto the flats of the RH camshafts.
13. Remove the 3 bolts and the RH VCT housing.
14. Remove the 3 bolts and the LH VCT housing.
15. Remove and discard the VCT housing seals.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2491
16. Remove the 2 bolts and the primary timing chain tensioner.
17. Remove the primary timing chain tensioner arm.
18. Remove the 2 bolts and the lower LH primary timing chain guide.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2492
19. Remove the primary timing chain.
20. Remove the 2 bolts and the upper LH primary timing chain guide.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2493
21. Remove the RH primary timing chain guide lower bolt.
22. NOTE: The RH primary timing chain guide must be repositioned to allow the coolant pump to
be removed.
Loosen the RH primary timing chain guide upper bolt. ^
Rotate the guide and tighten the bolt.
23. Remove the 8 bolts and the coolant pump.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2494
Installation
1. NOTE: Clean and inspect all sealing surfaces.
Install the coolant pump and the 8 bolts. ^
Tighten in the sequence shown to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
2. Loosen the RH primary timing chain guide upper bolt.
^ Position the RH primary timing chain guide and install the lower bolt.
^ Tighten the 2 bolts to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
3. Install the primary timing chain with the colored links aligned with the timing marks on the VCT
assemblies and the crankshaft sprocket.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2495
4. Install the upper LH primary timing chain guide and the 2 bolts.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
5. Install the lower LH primary timing chain guide and the 2 bolts.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2496
6. Install the primary timing chain tensioner arm.
7. Reset the primary timing chain tensioner.
^ Rotate the lever counterclockwise.
^ Using a soft-jawed vise, compress the plunger.
^ Align the hole in the lever with the hole in the tensioner housing.
^ Install a suitable lock pin.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2497
8. NOTE: It may be necessary to rotate the crankshaft slightly to remove slack from the timing
chain and install the tensioner.
Install the primary tensioner and the 2 bolts. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
^ Remove the lock pin.
9. As a post check, verify correct alignment of all timing marks.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2498
10. Install new VCT housing seals.
11. CAUTION: Make sure the dowels on the VCT housing are fully engaged in the cylinder head
prior to tightening the bolts.
Install the LH VCT housing and the 3 bolts. ^
Tighten in the sequence shown to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
12. CAUTION: Make sure the dowels on the VCT housing are fully engaged in the cylinder head
prior to tightening the bolts.
Install the RH VCT housing and the 3 bolts. ^
Tighten in the sequence shown to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2499
13. Install the engine front cover. 14. Install the RH cylinder block drain plug or, if equipped, the
block heater.
^ Tighten the cylinder block drain plug to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs).
^ Tighten the block heater to 41 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
15. NOTE: Make sure that the block heater wiring is routed and secured away from rotating or hot
components, or damage to the wiring can occur.
If equipped, connect the block heater electrical connector and install the heat shield.
16. Install the LH cylinder block drain plug.
^ Tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs) plus an additional 180 degrees.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2500
17. Install the LH and RH catalytic converters. For additional information, refer to Catalytic
Converter. 18. Position the Y-pipe assembly in place and install the 4 nuts.
^ Tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
19. Install the 2 exhaust hangers and tighten the exhaust clamp.
^ Tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
20. Fill the engine with clean engine oil. 21. Fill and bleed the cooling system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component Information
> Description and Operation
Catalytic Converter: Description and Operation
CATALYST AND EXHAUST SYSTEMS
Overview
V-Engines
In-Line Engines
The catalytic converter and exhaust Systems work together to control the release of harmful engine
exhaust emissions into the atmosphere. The engine exhaust gas consists mainly of nitrogen (N),
carbon dioxide (CO2) and water vapor (H2O) However, it also contains carbon monoxide (CO),
oxides of nitrogen (NOx), hydrogen (H), and various unburned hydrocarbons (HCs). The major air
pollutants of CO, NOx, and HCs, and their emission into the atmosphere must be controlled.
The exhaust system generally consists of an exhaust manifold, front exhaust pipe, front heated
oxygen sensor (HO2S), rear exhaust pipe, catalyst HO2S, a muffler, and an exhaust tailpipe. The
catalytic converter is typically installed between the front and rear exhaust pipes. On some vehicle
applications, more than one catalyst is used between the front and rear exhaust pipes. Catalytic
converter efficiency is monitored by the on board diagnostic (OBD) system strategy in the PCM.
For information on the OBD catalyst monitor, refer to the description for the Catalyst Efficiency
Monitor. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Monitors, Trips, Drive Cycles and Readiness Codes/Monitors/Catalyst Efficiency Monitor
The number of HO2Ss used in the exhaust stream and the location of these sensors depend on the
vehicle emission certification level (LEV, LEV-II, ULEV, PZEV). On most vehicles only 2 HO2Ss are
used in an exhaust stream. The front sensors (HO2S11/HO2S21) before the catalyst are used for
primary fuel control while the ones after the catalyst (HO2S12/HO2S22) are used to monitor
catalyst efficiency. However, some partial zero emission vehicles (PZEV) use 3 HO2Ss for each
engine bank. The stream 1 sensors (HO2S11/HO2S21) located before the catalyst are used for
primary fuel control, the stream 2 sensors (HO2S12/HO2S22) are used to monitor the light-off
catalyst, and the stream 3 sensors (HO2S13/HO2S23) located after the catalyst are used for long
term fuel trim control to optimize catalyst efficiency (fore aft oxygen sensor control). Current PZEV
vehicles use only a 4-cylinder engine, so only the bank 1 HO2Ss are used.
Catalytic Converter
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Page 2505
A catalyst is a material that remains unchanged when it initiates and increases the speed of a
chemical reaction. A catalyst also enables a chemical reaction to occur at a lower temperature. The
concentration of exhaust gas products released to the atmosphere must be controlled. The
catalytic converter assists in this task. It contains a catalyst in the form of a specially treated
ceramic honeycomb structure saturated with catalytically active precious metals. As the exhaust
gases come in contact with the catalyst, they are changed into mostly harmless products. The
catalyst initiates and speeds up heat producing chemical reactions of the exhaust gas components
so they are used up as much as possible.
Light Off Catalyst
As the catalyst heats up, converter efficiency rises rapidly. The point at which conversion efficiency
exceeds 50% is called catalyst light off. For most catalysts this point occurs at 246°C to 302°C
(475°F to 575°F). A fast light catalyst is a 3-way catalyst (TWC) that is located as close to the
exhaust manifold as possible. Because the light off catalyst is located close to the exhaust manifold
it lights off faster and reduces emissions more quickly than the catalyst located under the body.
Once the catalyst lights off, the catalyst quickly reaches the maximum conversion efficiency for that
catalyst.
Three-Way Catalyst (TWC) Conversion Efficiency
TWC Conversion Efficiency Chart
A TWC requires a stoichiometric fuel ratio, 14.7 pounds of air to 1 pound of fuel (14.7:1), for high
conversion efficiency. In order to achieve these high efficiencies, the air/fuel ratio must be tightly
controlled with a narrow window of stoichiometry. Deviations outside of this window greatly
decrease the conversion efficiency. For example a rich mixture decreases the HC and CO
conversion efficiency while a lean mixture decreases the NOx conversion efficiency.
Exhaust System
Typical Bank 1 Catalyst 2 HO2S Configuration
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Page 2506
Typical Bank 1 Catalyst 3 HO2S Configuration
The purpose of the exhaust system is to convey engine emissions from the exhaust manifold to the
atmosphere. Engine exhaust emissions are directed from the engine exhaust manifold to the
catalytic converter through the front exhaust pipe. A HO2S is mounted on the front exhaust pipe
before the catalyst. The catalytic converter reduces the concentration of CO, unburned HCs, and
NOx in the exhaust emissions to an acceptable level. The reduced exhaust emissions are directed
from the catalytic converter past another HO2S mounted in the rear exhaust pipe and then on into
the muffler. Finally, the exhaust emissions are directed to the atmosphere through an exhaust
tailpipe.
On some PZEV, there is a total of 3 HO2S in the exhaust stream. One near the exhaust manifold
(stream 1), one in the middle of the light-off catalyst (stream 2), and the third (stream 3) is mounted
after the light-off catalyst.
Underbody Catalyst
The underbody catalyst is located after the light off catalyst. The underbody catalyst may be in line
with the light off catalyst, or the underbody catalyst may be common to 2 light off catalysts, forming
a Y pipe configuration. For an exact configuration of the catalyst and exhaust system for a specific
vehicle, refer to Catalytic Converter, Exhaust System.
Three-Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter
The TWC converter contains either platinum (Pt) and rhodium (Rh) or palladium (Pd) and rhodium
(Rh). The TWC converter catalyzes the oxidation reactions of unburned HCs and CO and the
reduction reaction of NOx. The 3-way conversion can be best accomplished by always operating
the engine air fuel/ratio at or close to stoichiometry.
Exhaust Manifold Runners
The exhaust manifold runners collect exhaust gases from engine cylinders. The number of exhaust
manifolds and exhaust manifold runners depends on the engine configuration and number of
cylinders.
Exhaust Pipes
Exhaust pipes are usually treated during manufacturing with an anti-corrosive coating agent to
increase the life of the product. The pipes serve as guides for the flow of exhaust gases from the
engine exhaust manifold through the catalytic converter and the muffler.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
The HO2Ss provide the powertrain control module (PCM) with voltage and frequency information
related to the oxygen content of the exhaust gas.
Muffler
Mufflers are usually treated during manufacturing with an anti-corrosive coating agent to increase.
the life of the product. The muffler reduces the level of noise produced by the engine, and also
reduces the noise produced by exhaust gases as they travel from the catalytic converter to the
atmosphere.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Catalytic Converter - LH
Catalytic Converter: Service and Repair Catalytic Converter - LH
Catalytic Converter - LH
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: If necessary, the catalytic converter heat shield can be serviced separately.
NOTE: Always install new fasteners and gaskets. Clean flange faces prior to new gasket
installation to make sure of correct sealing.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
2. Disconnect the catalyst monitor sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the exhaust Y-pipe. 4.
Remove the 2 catalytic converter support bracket-to-transmission bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs).
5. Remove the 4 nuts and the LH catalytic converter.
^ Discard the 4 LH catalytic converter nuts and gasket.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Install a new gasket and nuts.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Catalytic Converter - LH > Page 2509
Catalytic Converter: Service and Repair Catalytic Converter - RH
Catalytic Converter - RH
All vehicles
1. NOTE: If necessary, the catalytic converter heat shield can be serviced separately.
NOTE: Always install new fasteners and gaskets. Clean flange faces prior to new gasket
installation to make sure of correct sealing.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
2. Remove the catalyst monitor sensor. For additional information, refer to Computers and Control
Systems. 3. Remove the exhaust Y-pipe.
All wheel drive (AWD)
4. Remove and discard the 4 universal joint (U-joint) flange bolts and separate the front driveshaft
and secure it with a length of mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 70 Nm (52 ft. lbs).
5. Remove the RH halfshaft assembly. 6. Remove the 2 catalytic converter support
bracket-to-engine block bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
Front wheel drive (FWD)
7. Remove the 2 bolts and the power steering rack shield.
^ To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs).
8. Remove the catalytic converter support bracket-to-engine block bolt and nut.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
All vehicles
9. Remove the 2 nuts and the roll restrictor shield.
^ To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Catalytic Converter - LH > Page 2510
10. Remove the roll restrictor bolt and rotate the engine forward.
^ To install, tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs).
11. Remove the 2 bracket-to-RH catalytic converter bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs).
12. Remove the 4 nuts and the RH catalytic converter.
^ Discard the 4 RH catalytic converter nuts and gasket.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
13. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Install a new gasket and nuts.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications
Exhaust Manifold: Specifications
Exhaust Manifold
Discard the nuts and studs.
Studs ...................................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs). Nuts .....................................................................
................................................................................................................................. 20 Nm (15 ft.
lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2514
Exhaust Manifold: Testing and Inspection
Exhaust Manifold Cleaning and Inspection
Special Tool(s)
1. Clean the exhaust manifold using a suitable solvent. Use a plastic scraping tool to clean the
gasket sealing surfaces.
2. NOTE: New exhaust manifold gaskets, studs, nuts and/or bolts must be installed when an
exhaust manifold is serviced.
Using the special tool (or a precision straight edge) and a feeler gauge, check the exhaust manifold
sealing surface for warpage. If the warpage is greater than 0.76 mm (0.0299 inch), install a new
exhaust manifold.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Exhaust Manifold - LH
Exhaust Manifold: Service and Repair Exhaust Manifold - LH
Exhaust Manifold - LH
Material
Removal
1. Remove the LH catalytic converter. For additional information, refer to Catalytic Converter. 2.
Remove the LH heated oxygen sensor (HO2S). For additional information, refer to Computers and
Control Systems. 3. Remove the 3 bolts and the LH exhaust manifold heat shield. 4. Remove the 6
nuts and the LH exhaust manifold.
^ Discard the nuts and gasket.
5. Clean and inspect the LH exhaust manifold. 6. Remove and discard the 6 LH exhaust manifold
studs.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Exhaust Manifold - LH > Page 2517
7. CAUTION: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These
may cause scratches and gouges resulting in leak paths. Use a plastic scraper to clean the sealing
surfaces.
Clean the exhaust manifold mating surface of the cylinder head with metal surface prep. Follow the
directions on the packaging.
Installation
1. Install 6 new LH exhaust manifold studs.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
2. Using a new gasket, install the LH exhaust manifold and 6 new nuts.
^ Tighten in the sequence shown to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs).
3. Install the LH exhaust manifold heat shield and the 3 bolts.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
4. Install the LH HO2S. 5. Install the LH catalytic converter. For additional information, refer to
Catalytic Converter.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Exhaust Manifold - LH > Page 2518
Exhaust Manifold: Service and Repair Exhaust Manifold - RH
Exhaust Manifold - RH
Material
Removal
1. Remove the RH catalytic converter. For additional information, refer to Catalytic Converter. 2.
Disconnect the RH heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) electrical connector. 3. Remove the 6 nuts and
the RH exhaust manifold.
^ Discard the nuts and gasket.
4. Clean and inspect the RH exhaust manifold. 5. Remove and discard the 6 RH exhaust manifold
studs.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Exhaust Manifold - LH > Page 2519
6. CAUTION: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These
may cause scratches and gouges resulting in leak paths. Use a plastic scraper to clean the sealing
surfaces.
Clean the exhaust manifold mating surface of the cylinder head with metal surface prep. Follow the
directions on the packaging.
Installation
1. Install 6 new RH exhaust manifold studs.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
2. Using a new gasket, install the RH exhaust manifold and 6 new nuts.
^ Tighten in the sequence shown to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs).
3. Connect the RH HO2S electrical connector. 4. Install the RH catalytic converter. For additional
information, refer to Catalytic Converter.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Exhaust Flexible Pipe
Exhaust Pipe: Service and Repair Exhaust Flexible Pipe
Exhaust Flexible Pipe
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Do not excessively bend, twist or allow the exhaust to hang from the flexible pipe.
1. NOTE: Always install new fasteners and gaskets. Clean flange faces prior to new gasket
installation to make sure of correct sealing.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
2. Remove and discard the 2 exhaust flexible pipe-to-exhaust Y-pipe nuts.
^ Discard the gasket.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
3. Remove the Torca(R) clamp. 4. Separate the 2 exhaust flexible pipe isolators and remove the
exhaust flexible pipe. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Install a new gasket and nuts.
6. Start the engine and check for exhaust leaks.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Exhaust Flexible Pipe > Page 2524
Exhaust Pipe: Service and Repair Exhaust Y-Pipe
Exhaust Y-Pipe
Removal and Installation
1. CAUTION: Do not excessively bend, twist or allow the exhaust to hang from the flexible pipe.
NOTE: Always install new fasteners and gaskets. Clean flange faces prior to new gasket
installation to make sure of correct sealing.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
2. Remove and discard the 4 exhaust Y-pipe-to-LH and RH catalytic converter nuts.
^ Discard the gaskets.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
3. Remove and discard the exhaust Y-pipe-to-exhaust flexible pipe nuts and remove the exhaust
Y-pipe.
^ Discard the gasket.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Install new gaskets and nuts.
5. Start the engine and check for exhaust leaks.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Muffler: Service and Repair
Muffler and Tailpipe
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Do not use oil or grease-based lubricants on the isolators. They may cause deterioration of
the rubber.
NOTE: Oil or grease-based lubricants on the isolators may cause the exhaust hanger isolator to
separate from the exhaust hanger bracket during vehicle operation.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Support the muffler and tailpipe with a suitable jackstand.
3. Remove the Torca(R) clamp.
4. CAUTION: Do not damage or tear the isolators during removal.
Using soapy water, separate the 4 muffler and tailpipe isolators from the vehicle.
5. Separate the muffler and tailpipe from the exhaust flexible pipe and remove the muffler and
tailpipe. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Inspect and replace any isolators damaged or torn during the removal process.
7. Start the engine and check for exhaust leaks.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Specifications
Torque Specifications
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driver
Seat Module (DSM)
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Driver Seat Module (DSM)
DRIVER SEAT MODULE (DSM)
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driver
Seat Module (DSM) > Page 2536
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
NOTE: Prior to the replacement of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to the appropriate scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new module
after installation.
1. NOTE: This step is necessary only if the DSM is being replaced.
Upload the module configuration information from the DSM into the scan tool.
2. NOTE: If the driver seat can be moved to a high enough position, the DSM screws can be
removed without removing the driver seat.
If necessary, remove the driver seat.
3. Remove the 2 screws. 4. Disconnect the 4 electrical connectors and remove the DSM.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driver
Seat Module (DSM) > Page 2537
5. NOTE: Make sure to download the DSM configuration information from the scan tool into the
new DSM.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driver
Seat Module (DSM) > Page 2538
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Programmable Module Installation
PROGRAMMABLE MODULE INSTALLATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) Using the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) When the
Original Module is Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure be
carried out. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal
and installation procedures.
1. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle as normal. 2. From the Toolbox icon, select Module
Programming and press the check mark. 3. Select Programmable Module Installation. 4. Select the
module that is being replaced. 5. Follow the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the OFF
position, and press the check mark. 6. Install the new module and press the check mark. 7. Follow
the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the ON position, and press the check mark. 8.
The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration Complete. 9.
Test module for correct operation.
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) Using the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) When the
Original Module is NOT Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure be
carried out. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal
and installation procedures.
1. Install the new module. 2. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle as normal. 3. From the
Toolbox icon, select Module Programming and press the check mark. 4. Select Programmable
Module Installation. 5. Select the module that was replaced. 6. Follow the on-screen instructions,
turn the ignition key to the OFF position, and press the check mark. 7. Follow the on-screen
instructions, turn the ignition key to the ON position, and press the check mark. 8. If the data is not
available, the IDS displays a screen stating to contact the As-Built Data Center. Retrieve the data
from the technician service
publication website at this time and press the check mark.
9. Enter the module data and press the check mark.
10. The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration
Complete. 11. Test module for correct operation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Electronic Throttle Control Module: Description and Operation
TORQUE BASED ELECTRONIC THROTTLE CONTROL (ETC)
Overview
The torque based ETC is a hardware and software strategy that delivers an engine output torque
(via throttle angle) based on driver demand (pedal position). It uses an electronic throttle body, the
powertrain control module (PCM), and an accelerator pedal assembly to control the throttle
opening and engine torque. The ETC system replaces the standard cable operated accelerator
pedal, idle air control (IAC) valve, 3-wire throttle position (TP) sensor, and mechanical throttle body.
Torque based ETC enables aggressive automatic transmission shift schedules (earlier upshifts and
later downshifts). This is possible by adjusting the throttle angle to achieve the same wheel torque
during shifts, and by calculating this desired torque, the system prevents engine lugging (low RPM
and low manifold vacuum) while still delivering the performance and torque requested by the driver.
It also enables many fuel economy/emission improvement technologies such as variable camshaft
timing (VCT) (deliver same torque during transitions).
Torque based ETC also results in less intrusive vehicle and engine speed limiting, along with
smoother traction control.
Other benefits of ETC are: eliminate cruise control actuators
- eliminate idle air control (IAC) valve
- better airflow range
- packaging (no cable)
- more responsive powertrain at altitude and improved shift quality
It should be noted that the ETC system illuminates a powertrain malfunction indicator (wrench) on
the instrument cluster when a concern is present. Concerns are accompanied by diagnostic trouble
codes (DTCs) and may also illuminate the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL).
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB)
The ETB has the following characteristics: 1. The throttle actuator control (TAC) motor is a DC
motor controlled by the PCM (requires 2-wires). The gear ratio from the motor to the throttle
plate shaft is 17:1.
2. There are 2 designs: parallel and in-series. The parallel design has the motor under the bore
parallel to the plate shaft. The motor housing is
integrated into the main housing. The in-series design has a separate motor housing.
3. Two springs are used: one is used to close the throttle (main spring) and the other is in a plunger
assembly that results in a default angle when no
power is applied. This is for limp home reasons (the force of the plunger spring is 2 times stronger
than the main spring). The default angle is usually set to result in a top vehicle speed of 48 km/h
(30 mph). Typically this throttle angle is 7 to 8 degrees from the hard-stop angle.
4. The closed throttle plate hard stop is used to prevent the throttle from binding in the bore (~0.75
degree). This hard stop setting is not adjustable
and is set to result in less airflow than the minimum engine airflow required at idle.
5. Unlike cable operated throttle bodies, the intent for the ETB is not to have a hole in the throttle
plate or to use plate sealant. The hole is not
required in the ETB because the required idle airflow is provided by the plate angle in the throttle
body assembly. This plate angle controls idle, idle quality, and eliminates the need for an IAC
valve.
6. The TP sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant throttle position
signals are required for increased monitoring
reasons. The first TP signal (TP1) has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and
the second signal (TP2) has a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal
operation the negative slope TP signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of
throttle position. The TP sensor assembly requires 4 circuits. 5-volt reference voltage
- Signal return (ground)
- TP1 voltage with negative voltage slope (5-0 volts)
- TP2 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensors
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 2542
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) And Accelerator Pedal Assembly
The ETC strategy uses pedal position sensors as an input to determine the driver demand. 1.
There are 3 pedal position signals required for system monitoring. APP1 has a negative slope
(increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and APP2 and
APP3 both have a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation
APP1 is used as the indication of pedal position by the strategy.
2. There are 2 VREF circuits, 2 signal return circuits, and 3 signal circuits (a total of 7 circuits and
pins) between the PCM and the APP sensor
assembly. 2 reference voltage circuits (5 volts)
- 2 signal return (ground) circuits
- APP1 voltage with negative voltage slope (5-0 volts)
- APP2 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
- APP3 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
3. The pedal position signal is convened to pedal travel degrees (rotary angle) by the PCM. The
software then converts these degrees to counts,
which is the input to the torque based strategy.
4. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a
concern. The PCM determines if a signal is
incorrect by calculating where it should be, inferred from the other signals. A value is substituted for
an incorrect signal if 2 of the 3 signals are incorrect.
Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) System Strategy
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 2543
ETC System
The torque based ETC strategy was developed to improve fuel economy and to accommodate
variable camshaft timing (VCT). This is possible by not coupling the throttle angle to the driver
pedal position. Uncoupling the throttle angle (produce engine torque) from the pedal position (driver
demand) allows the powertrain control strategy to optimize fuel control and transmission shift
schedules while delivering the requested wheel torque.
The ETC monitor system is distributed across 2 processors within the PCM: the main powertrain
control processor unit (CPU) and a monitoring processor called an enhanced-quizzer (E-Quizzer)
processor. The primary monitoring function is carried out by the independent plausibility check
(IPC) software, which resides on the main processor. It is responsible for determining the
driver-demanded torque and comparing it to an estimate of the actual torque delivered. If the
generated torque exceeds driver demand by a specified amount, the IPC takes appropriate
corrective action.
ETC System Failure Mode And Effects Management (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 2544
ETC System Failure Mode And Effects Management (Part 2)
Since the IPC and the main controller share the same processor, they are subject to a number of
potential common failure modes. The E-Quizzer processor was added to redundantly monitor
selected PCM inputs and to act as an intelligent watchdog and monitor the performance of the IPC
and the main processor. If it determines that the IPC function is impaired in any way, it takes
appropriate failure mode and effects management (FMEM) actions.
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation:
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 2545
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation (Part 2)
Accelerator and Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Inputs
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Check:
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Check
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Check:
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Check
Throttle Plate Position Controller (TPPC) Outputs
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 2546
Throttle Plate Controller Check Operation
The purpose of the TPPC is to maintain the throttle position at the desired throttle angle. It is a
separate chip embedded in the PCM. The desired angle is communicated from the main CPU via a
312.5 Hz duty cycle (DC) signal. The TPPC interprets the duty cycle signal as follows: Less than 4% - Out of range, limp home default position.
- Greater than or equal to 4% but less than 6% - Commanded default position, closed.
- Greater than or equal to 6% but less than 7% - Commanded default position. Used for key ON,
engine OFF.
- Greater than or equal to 7% but less than 8% - Enable ice breaker mode. Used to clear potential
ice buildup in the throttle body.
- Greater than or equal to 8% but less than 10% - Closed against hard-stop. Used to learn zero
throttle angle position (hard stop) after key-up.
- Greater than or equal to 10% but less than or equal to 92% - Normal operation, between 0
degrees (hard stop) and 82 degrees, 10% duty cycle equals 0 degrees throttle angle, 92% duty
cycle equals 82 degrees throttle angle.
- Greater than 92% but less than or equal to 96% - Wide open throttle, 82 to 86 degrees throttle
angle.
- Greater than 96% but less than or equal to 100% - Out of range, limp home default position.
The desired angle is relative to the hard-stop angle. The hard stop angle is learned during each
key-up process before the main CPU requests the throttle plate be closed against the hard stop.
The output of the TPPC is a voltage request to the H driver (also in PCM). The H driver is capable
of positive or negative voltage to the electronic throttle body motor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-11-15 > Jun > 09 > Engine Controls - Rough/Rolling Idle/Idle Speed Drop
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls - Rough/Rolling Idle/Idle Speed Drop
TSB 09-11-15
06/15/09
ROUGH / ROLLING IDLE / IDLE SPEED DROPS BELOW SPECIFICATION / LIGHT THROTTLE
WITH CRUISE ENGAGED / LOW SPEED TIP IN CLUNK
FORD: 2008-2009 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2009 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKX
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 8-23-5 to update the vehicle lines and Action statement.
ISSUE Some 2008-2009 Taurus, Taurus-X, Sable and 2007-2009 Edge and MKX vehicles may
exhibit a rough, rolling idle, or the idle speed dropping below specification. This condition typically
occurs most often in hot ambient temperatures with the A/C on when idling for extended periods.
Vehicles may also exhibit idle speed dropping below specification on light throttle application with
vehicle cruise control engaged and traveling down a hill or a low speed tip in clunk.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) to the latest calibration using IDS
release 61.05 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration
files may also be obtained at the website.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091115A 2008-2009 Taurus, Sable, 0.3 Hr.
Taurus X. 2007-2009 Edge, MKX: Reprogram The PCM, Authorization Decal Not Required. (Do
Not Use With 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-19-5 > Oct > 07 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0451
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0451
TSB 07-19-5
10/01/07
MIL ON DTC P0451
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles may exhibit a malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) on with
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0451 which may be caused by electromagnetic compatibility
(EMC) interference.
ACTION If normal Workshop Manual Diagnostics are unable to resolve the concern, install a
Capacitor/Jumper Harness Kit following the installation instruction sheet included with the kit.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071905A 2007 Edge/MKX: Install A 0.7 Hr.
Capacitor Jumper Harness Kit (Do Not Use With 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9C052 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-11-15 > Jun > 09 > Engine Controls - Rough/Rolling Idle/Idle Speed Drop
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Rough/Rolling Idle/Idle
Speed Drop
TSB 09-11-15
06/15/09
ROUGH / ROLLING IDLE / IDLE SPEED DROPS BELOW SPECIFICATION / LIGHT THROTTLE
WITH CRUISE ENGAGED / LOW SPEED TIP IN CLUNK
FORD: 2008-2009 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2009 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKX
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 8-23-5 to update the vehicle lines and Action statement.
ISSUE Some 2008-2009 Taurus, Taurus-X, Sable and 2007-2009 Edge and MKX vehicles may
exhibit a rough, rolling idle, or the idle speed dropping below specification. This condition typically
occurs most often in hot ambient temperatures with the A/C on when idling for extended periods.
Vehicles may also exhibit idle speed dropping below specification on light throttle application with
vehicle cruise control engaged and traveling down a hill or a low speed tip in clunk.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) to the latest calibration using IDS
release 61.05 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration
files may also be obtained at the website.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091115A 2008-2009 Taurus, Sable, 0.3 Hr.
Taurus X. 2007-2009 Edge, MKX: Reprogram The PCM, Authorization Decal Not Required. (Do
Not Use With 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 07-19-5 > Oct > 07 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0451
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0451
TSB 07-19-5
10/01/07
MIL ON DTC P0451
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles may exhibit a malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) on with
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0451 which may be caused by electromagnetic compatibility
(EMC) interference.
ACTION If normal Workshop Manual Diagnostics are unable to resolve the concern, install a
Capacitor/Jumper Harness Kit following the installation instruction sheet included with the kit.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071905A 2007 Edge/MKX: Install A 0.7 Hr.
Capacitor Jumper Harness Kit (Do Not Use With 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9C052 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-2-9 > Feb > 10 > Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From Rear
Hub Area
Rear Knuckle: All Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area
TSB 10-2-9
02/15/10
NOISE FROM REAR WHEEL HUB BEARING - BUILT ON OR BEFORE 12/4/2008
FORD: 2007-2009 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 09-26-5 to update the Parts List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Edge and MKX vehicles built on or before 12/4/2008 may exhibit a growl
or howl type noise coming from the left and/or right rear wheel area. This could be the result of a
faulty rear wheel hub bearing assembly.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. If Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics identify a faulty rear wheel hub bearing, it will be
necessary to replace the rear suspension trailing
arm/knuckle assembly along with a new rear wheel hub bearing assembly.
2. Refer to WSM, Section 204-02, for rear wheel hub bearing and trailing arm/knuckle replacement.
Only replace the rear suspension trailing
arm/knuckle assembly and rear bearing hub on the side with the concern. Failing to install a new
rear suspension trailing arm/knuckle assembly when installing a new rear bearing hub assembly
will result in premature bearing noise/wear.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100209A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 1.3 Hrs.
FWD: Replace ONE Rear Wheel Hub Bearing And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assembly
100209A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 1.5 Hrs.
AWD: Replace ONE Rear Wheel Hub Bearing And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assembly
100209B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 2.4 Hrs.
FWD: Replace BOTH Rear
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-2-9 > Feb > 10 > Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From Rear
Hub Area > Page 2573
Wheel Hub Bearings And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assemblies
100209B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 2.8 Hrs.
AWD: Replace BOTH Rear Wheel Hub Bearings And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assemblies
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
1104 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-2-9 > Feb > 10 > Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From Rear
Hub Area > Page 2579
Wheel Hub Bearings And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assemblies
100209B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 2.8 Hrs.
AWD: Replace BOTH Rear Wheel Hub Bearings And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assemblies
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
1104 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 2580
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2583
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2584
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2585
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2586
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2587
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2588
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2589
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2590
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2591
Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2592
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2593
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2594
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2595
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2596
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2597
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2598
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2599
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2600
Engine Control Module: Connector Views
C175B (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2601
C175B (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2602
C175E (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2603
C175E (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2604
C175T (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2605
C175T (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
Removal
1. NOTE: PCM replacement DOES NOT require new keys or programming of keys.
Retrieve the module configuration. Carry out the module configuration retrieval steps of the
Programmable Module Installation procedure.
2. Disconnect the 3 powertrain control module (PCM) electrical connectors. 3. Remove the 2 nuts
and the PCM.
- Remove the gasket.
Installation
1. Install the gasket and the PCM. 2. Install the 2 PCM nuts.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. Connect the 3 PCM electrical connectors. 4. Restore the module configuration. Carry out the
module configuration restore steps of the Programmable Module Installation procedure. 5.
Reprogram the passive anti-theft system (PATS). Carry out the Parameter Reset procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) > Page 2608
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only
Memory (EEPROM)
FLASH ELECTRICALLY ERASABLE PROGRAMMABLE READ ONLY MEMORY (EEPROM)
Description
The EEPROM is contained in an integrated circuit (IC) internal to the powertrain control module
(PCM). The EEPROM contains the vehicle strategy including calibration information specific to the
vehicle, and is capable of being programmed or flashed repeatedly.
As part of the calibration there is an area referred to as the vehicle identification (VID) block. The
VID block is programmed when installing a new PCM as described under Programming the VID
Block for a Replacement PCM. Failure to carry out this procedure may generate DTCs P1635 or
P1639. The VID block in an existing PCM can also be tailored to accommodate various hardware
or parameter changes made to the vehicle since production. Failure to carry out this procedure
properly may generate DTC P1635, Tire/Axle Ratio out of Acceptable Range. An incorrect tire/axle
ratio is one of the main causes for DTC P1639. This is described under Making Changes to the VID
Block and also under Making Changes to the PCM Calibration. The VID block contains many items
used by the strategy for a variety of functions. Some of these items include the vehicle identification
number (VIN), octane adjust, fuel octane, fuel type, vehicle speed limit, tire size, axle ratio, the
presence of speed control, and 4-wheel drive electronic shift-on-the-fly (ESOF) versus manual
shift-on-the-fly (MSOF). Only items applicable to the vehicle hardware and supported by the VID
block is displayed on the scan tool.
When changing items in the VID block, the strategy places range limits on certain items such as
tire and axle ratio. The number of times the VID block may be reconfigured is limited. When this
limit is reached, the scan tool displays a message indicating the need to flash the PCM again to
reset the VID block.
Programming can be carried out by a local Ford dealer or any non-Ford facility. Refer to the scan
tool manufacturer's instruction manual for details.
Programming the VID Block for a Replacement PCM
A new PCM contains the latest strategy and calibration level for a particular vehicle. However, the
VID block is blank and needs programming. There are 2 procedures available. The first is an
automatic data transfer from the old PCM to the new PCM, and the second is manual data entry
into the new PCM.
Automatic data transfer is carried out if the old PCM is capable of communicating. This is done by
using a scan tool to retrieve data from the old PCM before removing it from the vehicle. The stored
data can then be downloaded to the new PCM after it has been installed.
Carry out manual data entry if the old module is damaged or incapable of communicating. Remove
and install a new PCM. Using a compatible scan tool, select and carry out the module/parameter
programming, referring to the scan tool manufacturer's instruction manual. Make certain that all
parameters are included. Failure to properly program tire size in revolutions per mile, (rev/mile
equals 63,360 divided by the tire circumference in inches), axle ratio, 4x4/4x2, and/or MSOF/ESOF
may result in DTCs P1635 and P1639. You may be instructed to contact the As-Built Data Center
for the information needed to manually update the VID block with the scan tool. Contact the center
only if the old PCM cannot be used or the data is corrupt. For Ford and Lincoln Mercury
technicians, contact your National Hotline or the Professional Technician Society (PTS) website for
As-Built data listed under the Service Publications Index. Non-Ford technicians use the
Motorcraft(R) website at www.motorcraft.com. From the Motorcraft(R) homepage, use the search
function to find the Module Programming or As-Built Data.
For Ford and Lincoln Mercury technicians, check the Programmable Module Installation link on the
PTS website for quick Programmable Module data information by vehicle.
Making Changes to the VID Block
A PCM which is programmed may require changes to be made to certain VID information to
accommodate the vehicle hardware. Refer to Module Reprogramming on the scan tool.
Making Changes to the PCM Calibration
At certain times, the entire EEPROM needs to be completely reprogrammed. This is due to
changes made to the strategy or calibration after production, or the need to reset the VID block
because it has reached its limit. Refer to Module Reprogramming on the scan tool.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2612
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2613
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 2618
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 2619
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2623
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2624
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 2629
Ignition Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 2630
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2636
C2040
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2637
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION (APP) SENSOR
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
torque demand. There are 3 pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APPS1, has a negative
slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APPS2 and APPS3, both have a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APPS1 is used as
the indication of pedal position by the strategy. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There are 2 reference voltage circuits and 2
signal return circuits for the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2641
C128
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2642
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Diagram Of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot And Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2643
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. The current required to
maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow. The MAF sensor then
outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air mass. The PCM
calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired air/fuel ratio. This
input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC), shift and torque
converter clutch scheduling.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly. Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology with an integrated intake air
temperature (IAT) sensor. The hot wire electronic sensing element must be replaced as an
assembly. Replacing only the element may change the air flow calibration.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2644
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 2. Remove the 2 screws and
the MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft
Position Sensor 1
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft
Position Sensor 1 > Page 2649
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft
Position Sensor
C1366
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft
Position Sensor > Page 2652
C1367
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
2653
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Typical Synchronizer Hall-Effect CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston
number 1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing
the sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil-on-plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP
signal to select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with 2 CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). They use the
second sensor to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2 as an input to the PCM.
There are 2 types of CMP sensors: the 3-pin connector Hall-effect type sensor and the 2-pin
connector variable reluctance type sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
2654
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
RH sensor
1. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe.
LH sensor
2. Remove the air cleaner assembly.
Both sensors
3. Disconnect the camshaft position sensor (CMP) electrical connector. 4. Remove the bolt and the
CMP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
5. NOTE: Lubricate the CMP O-ring seal with clean engine oil.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Clutch Switch, ECM > Component Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION (CPP) SWITCH
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
The CPP switch is an input to the PCM indicating the clutch pedal position. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the CPP circuit. When the CPP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The CPP input to the PCM is used to detect a reduction in engine
load. The PCM uses the load information for mass air flow and fuel calculations.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR
Typical Thread Type ECT Sensor
The ECT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The ECT measures the temperature of the engine coolant. The PCM uses the ECT input for fuel
control and for cooling fan control. There are 3 types of ECT sensors, threaded, push-in, and
twist-lock. The ECT sensor is located in an engine coolant passage.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2664
C101
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2665
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid deceleration between teeth.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2666
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the LH catalytic converter. 3.
Remove the bolt, nut and the heat shield.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
4. Remove the rubber grommet cover. 5. Disconnect the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor
electrical connector. 6. Remove the bolt and the CKP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2670
C107
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2671
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Typical CHT Sensor
The CHT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with the temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as temperature increases., and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
The CHT sensor is installed in the cylinder head and measures the metal temperature. The CHT
sensor can provide complete engine temperature information and can be used to infer coolant
temperature. If the CHT sensor conveys an overheating condition to the PCM, the PCM initiates a
fail-safe cooling strategy based on information from the CHT sensor. A cooling system concern
such as low coolant or coolant loss could cause an overheating condition. As a result, damage to
major engine components could occur. Using both the CHT sensor and fail-safe cooling strategy,
the PCM prevents damage by allowing air cooling of the engine and limp home capability.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2672
Engine Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the lower intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the cylinder head temperature (CHT) sensor
electrical connector. 3. Remove and discard the CHT sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Do not reuse the CHT sensor, install a new sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL LEVEL INPUT (FLI)
The FLI is a communications network message. Most vehicle applications use a potentiometer type
FLI sensor connected to a float in the FP module to determine fuel level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Level Sensor
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Level Sensor
FUEL LEVEL SENSOR
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Level Sensor > Page 2678
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Level Sensor > Page 2679
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Level Sensor > Page 2680
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- This procedure involves fuel handling. Be prepared for spillage at all times and always observe
fuel handling precautions. Failure to follow these instructions can result in personal injury.
1. Release the fuel system pressure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Level Sensor > Page 2681
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3. Release the fuel tank filler cap and position aside.
4. Insert a suitable fuel drain tube into the fuel tank filler pipe until it reaches the fuel tank inlet
spout.
5. CAUTION: The fuel pump (FP) module and fuel level sensor will be below the fuel level in the
tank when the tank is full. Make sure to
drain 1/8 of the fuel capacity through the filler pipe prior to removing the fuel level sensor or fuel
spillage will occur.
Attach the fuel storage tanker to the fuel drain tube and remove any residual fuel remaining in the
fuel tank filler pipe.
6. Remove the rear seat. 7. Position the carpet and/or any insulation covering the fuel level sensor
access cover aside.
8. Remove the 4 screws and the fuel level sensor access cover.
9. Disconnect the fuel level sensor electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Level Sensor > Page 2682
10. CAUTION: Place absorbant pads in the general work area in case of fuel spillage.
Release the lock tab, rotate the fuel level sensor counterclockwise approximately 1/4 turn and lift
upward.
11. CAUTION:
- The fuel level sensor must be handled carefully to avoid damage to the float arm.
- Carefully remove the fuel level sensor from the fuel tank to avoid fuel spillage inside the vehicle.
Carefully lift and remove the fuel level sensor from the fuel tank.
12. CAUTION: Inspect the mating surfaces of the fuel level sensor flange and the fuel tank O-ring
seal contact surfaces. Do not polish or
adjust the O-ring seal contact area of the fuel tank flange or the fuel tank. Install a new fuel level
sensor or fuel tank if the O-ring seal contact area is bent, scratched or corroded.
NOTE: To install, apply clean engine oil to the O-ring seal.
- Upon installation, properly seat and press down firmly on the fuel level sensor, rotate it clockwise
until the lock arrow on the sensor aligns with the notch on the tank. Torque should not exceed 15
Nm (11 lb-ft).
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Level Sensor > Page 2683
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module
FUEL PUMP MODULE
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Level Sensor > Page 2684
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Level Sensor > Page 2685
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Level Sensor > Page 2686
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
repairing or disconnecting any of the fuel system components, the fuel system pressure must be
relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel causing personal injury or a fire hazard.
All vehicles
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Level Sensor > Page 2687
1. Release the fuel system pressure. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3. Release the fuel
tank filler cap and position aside.
4. Insert a suitable fuel drain tube into the fuel tank filler pipe until it reaches the fuel tank inlet
spout. 5. Attach the fuel storage tanker to the fuel drain tube and remove any residual fuel
remaining in the fuel tank filler pipe. 6. Remove the rear seat. 7. Position the carpet and/or any
insulation covering the fuel pump (FP) module access cover aside.
8. Remove the 4 screws and the FP module access cover.
9. Disconnect the FP module electrical connector.
10. Disconnect the fuel tank supply tube-to-FP module quick connect coupling.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Level Sensor > Page 2688
11. CAUTION: Place absorbent pads on the floor pan in the immediate area in case of fuel spills.
Carefully remove the fuel pump (FP)
module from the vehicle to avoid fuel spillage inside the vehicle.
Using the special tool, remove the FP module lock ring retainer.
All wheel drive (AWD) vehicles
12. CAUTION: The fuel pump (FP) module must be handled carefully to avoid damage to the FP
module and/or float arm.
Carefully lift the FP module out of the fuel tank enough to access and disconnect the fuel tank
crossover tube-to-FP module quick connect coupling.
All vehicles
13. CAUTION: The fuel pump (FP) module will have residual fuel remaining internally, drain into a
suitable container.
Completely remove the FP module from the fuel tank.
14. CAUTION:
- Inspect the mating surfaces of the fuel pump (FP) module flange and the fuel tank O-ring seal
contact surfaces. Do not polish or adjust the O-ring seal contact area of the fuel tank flange or the
fuel tank. Install a new FP module or fuel tank if the O-ring seal contact area is bent, scratched or
corroded.
- Make sure to install a new fuel pump (FP) module O-ring seal. Install a new lock ring if it is bent,
damaged or corroded.
NOTE: To install, apply clean engine oil to the O-ring seal.
Remove the FP module O-ring seal.
15. NOTE: Make sure the alignment tab on the fuel pump (FP) module and the fuel tank meet
before tightening the FP module lock ring.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2692
C435
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2693
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL TANK PRESSURE (FTP) SENSOR
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
In-Line Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
The FTP sensor or in-line FTP sensor is used to measure the fuel tank pressure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2697
C128
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2698
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (IAT) SENSOR
Typical Stand-Alone/Non-Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensors
Typical Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Incorporated Into A Drop-in Or Flange-type
MAF Sensor
The IAT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The electrical
resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance increases
as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the sensor
terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The IAT provides air temperature information to the PCM. The PCM uses the air temperature
information as a correction factor in the calculation of fuel, spark, and air flow.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2699
The IAT sensor provides a quicker temperature change response time than the ECT or CHT
sensor.
Currently there are 2 design types of IAT sensors used, a stand-alone/non-integrated type and a
integrated type. Both types function the same, however the integrated type is incorporated into the
mass air flow (MAF) sensor instead of being a stand alone sensor.
Supercharged vehicles use 2 IAT sensors. Both sensors are thermistor type devices and operate
as described. One is located before the supercharger at the air cleaner for standard OBD/cold
weather input, while a second sensor (IAT2) is located after the supercharger in the intake
manifold. The IAT2 sensor located after the supercharger provides air temperature information to
the PCM to control spark and to help determine charge air cooler (CAC) efficiency.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2703
C109
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2704
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Two Types Of Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2705
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the thermostat housing. 2. Remove the lower intake manifold. 3. Remove the coolant
tube.
- Discard the O-ring.
4. Disconnect the knock sensor (KS) electrical connector. 5. Remove the 2 bolts and the KS.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Lubricate the new O-ring with clean engine coolant.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE (MAP) SENSOR
Typical Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
The MAP sensor measures intake manifold absolute pressure. The PCM uses information from the
MAP sensor to measure how much exhaust gas is introduced into the intake manifold.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM: Description and Operation
ENGINE OIL TEMPERATURE (EOT) SENSOR
Typical EOT Sensor
The EOT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The EOT sensor measures the temperature of the engine oil. The sensor is typically threaded into
the engine oil lubrication system. The PCM can use the EOT sensor input to determine the
following:
- On variable camshaft timing (VCT) applications the EOT input is used to adjust the VCT control
gains and logic for camshaft timing.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input in conjunction with other PCM inputs to determine oil
degradation.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input to initiate a soft engine shutdown. To prevent engine
damage from occurring as a result of high oil temperatures, the PCM has the ability to initiate a soft
engine shutdown. Whenever engine RPM exceeds a calibrated level for a certain period of time,
the PCM begins reducing power by disabling engine cylinders.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 2716
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 2717
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 2718
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22
C141
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 2721
C142
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 2722
C171
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 2723
C172
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2724
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HO2S)
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
The HO2S detects the presence of oxygen in the exhaust and produces a variable voltage
according to the amount of oxygen detected. A high concentration of oxygen (lean air/fuel ratio) in
the exhaust produces a voltage signal less than 0.4 volt. A low concentration of oxygen (rich
air/fuel ratio) produces a voltage signal greater than 0.6 volt. The HO2S provides feedback to the
PCM indicating air/fuel ratio in order to achieve a near stoichiometric air/fuel ratio of 14.7:1 during
closed loop engine operation. The HO2S generates a voltage between 0.0 and 1.1 volts.
Embedded with the sensing element is the HO2S heater. The heating element heats the sensor to
a temperature of 800°C (1,472°F). At approximately 300°C (572°F) the engine can enter closed
loop operation. The VPWR circuit supplies voltage to the heater. The PCM turns the heater on by
providing the ground when the correct conditions occur. The heater allows the engine to enter
closed loop operation sooner. The use of this heater requires the HO2S heater control to be duty
cycled, to prevent damage to the heater.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HO2S)
RH Sensors
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 2727
LH Sensors
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
RH sensor
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
Both sensors
2. Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 2728
3. NOTE: If necessary, lubricate the sensor threads with penetrating and lock lubricant to assist in
removal.
Using the special tool, remove the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S). To install, tighten to 48 Nm (35 lb-ft).
4. NOTE: Apply a light coat of anti-seize lubricant to the threads of the heated oxygen sensor
(HO2S).
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 2729
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Catalyst Monitor Sensor
CATALYST MONITOR SENSOR
RH Sensors
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 2730
LH Sensors
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the catalyst monitor sensor
electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 2731
3. NOTE: If necessary, lubricate the sensor threads with penetrating and lock lubricant to assist in
removal.
Using the special tool, remove the catalyst monitor sensor. To install, tighten to 48 Nm (35 lb-ft).
4. NOTE: Apply a light coat of anti-seize lubricant to the threads of the catalyst monitor sensor.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2735
C1121
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Switch
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SWITCH
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
The PSP switch monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP switch
is a normally closed switch that opens as the hydraulic pressure increases. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the PSP circuit. When the PSP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The PCM uses the input signal from the PSP switch to compensate
for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the idle RPM and preventing engine stall during
parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP switch signals the PCM to adjust the transmission electronic
pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased engine load, for example during parking
maneuvers
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch > Page 2738
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Sensor
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SENSOR
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
The PSP sensor monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP
sensor voltage input to the PCM changes as the hydraulic pressure changes. The PCM uses the
input signal from the PSP sensor to compensate for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the
idle RPM and preventing engine stall during parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP sensor signals the
PCM to adjust the transmission electronic pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased
engine load, for example, during parking maneuvers.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer
that monitors the differential pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly.
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as
the downstream pressure hose (REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI
and REF hose connections are marked on the differential pressure feedback EGR sensor housing
for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger diameter hose). The differential pressure
feedback EGR sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the metering
orifice and supplies it to the PCM as EGR flow rate feedback.
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR TUBE MOUNTED
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 2742
The tube mounted differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is identical in operation as the large
plastic differential pressure feedback EGR sensors and uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF
hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE BODY (ETB) POSITION SENSOR
The ETB position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant ETB
position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB position sensor signal (TP1)
has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation the negative slope
ETB position sensor signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of throttle
position. The 2 ETB position sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1
signal has a concern. There is 1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor > Page 2747
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Typical TP Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases the corrosion resistance on the
terminals and increases the connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body.
As the TP sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, 4 operating conditions are determined by the PCM
from the TP. The operating conditions are:
- closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration)
- part throttle (includes cruise or moderate acceleration)
- wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on crank)
- throttle angle rate
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2752
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2753
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2754
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2755
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2756
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2757
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2758
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2759
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2760
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2761
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2762
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2763
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2764
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2765
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2766
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2767
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2768
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2769
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2770
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2771
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
12. Disconnect the selector lever cable end from the manual lever.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2772
13. Remove the nut and the manual lever.
14. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
15. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
16. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2773
17. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
18. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
19. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle side cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2774
20. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
21. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
22. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2775
23. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when removing the solenoid body filter.
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
24. Remove the 10 bolts, the TR sensor detent spring and the main control valve body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2776
25. Using a suitable tool, remove and discard the TR sensor locking pin.
26. NOTE: TR sensor removed for clarity.
Make sure that the park pawl actuator rod does not become disengaged from the park pawl and
the abutment by keeping the end of the park pawl actuator rod behind the machined valve body
mating surface of the transaxle case. If the park pawl actuator rod becomes disengaged from the
park pawl and the abutment, transaxle removal and disassembly is required to reinstall the actuator
rod.
27. CAUTION: Make sure that the park pawl actuator rod does not become disengaged from the
park pawl and the abutment or transaxle
removal and disassembly is required to reinstall the actuator rod.
Remove the TR sensor. 1
Slide the TR sensor down until the manual shaft is out of the transaxle case.
2 Rotate the TR sensor detent plate counterclockwise, as viewed from below until the plate rests
against the transaxle case, remove the park
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2777
pawl actuating rod from the TR sensor and remove the TR sensor.
Installation
1. Install the TR sensor.
1 Position the park pawl actuating rod in the TR sensor.
2 Install the TR sensor in the transaxle case.
2. Using the special tool, install a new TR sensor locking pin.
3. NOTE: Make sure that the manual lever pin (part of the TR sensor) is correctly installed in the
manual valve.
Position the TSS, OSS and TR sensor wiring harnesses aside and install the main control valve
body, the TR sensor detent spring and the 10 bolts. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown. ^
Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2778
4. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
5. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4
95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2779
6. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
7. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2780
8. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
9. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
10. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
11. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on
the inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2781
12. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
13. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2782
14. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
15. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
16. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
17. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2783
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
18. Install the manual lever and the nut.
^ Tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs).
19. Connect the selector lever cable end to the manual lever.
20. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
21. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2784
22. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
23. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
24. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
25. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2785
26. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
27. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
28. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
OUTPUT SHAFT SPEED (OSS) SENSOR
The OSS sensor provides the PCM with information about the rotational speed of an output shaft.
The PCM uses the information to control and diagnose powertrain behavior. In some applications,
the sensor is also used as the source of vehicle speed. The sensor may be physically located in
different places on the vehicle, depending upon the specific application. The design of each speed
sensor is unique and depends on which powertrain control feature uses the information that is
generated.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor > Page 2790
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR (VSS)
Typical Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
The VSS is a variable reluctance or hall-effect sensor that generates a waveform with a frequency
that is proportional to the speed of the vehicle. If the vehicle is moving at a relatively low velocity,
the sensor produces a signal with a low frequency. As the vehicle velocity increases, the sensor
generates a signal with a higher frequency. The PCM uses the frequency signal generated by the
VSS (and other inputs) to control such parameters as fuel injection, ignition control,
transmission/transaxle shift scheduling, and torque converter clutch scheduling.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer
that monitors the differential pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly.
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as
the downstream pressure hose (REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI
and REF hose connections are marked on the differential pressure feedback EGR sensor housing
for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger diameter hose). The differential pressure
feedback EGR sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the metering
orifice and supplies it to the PCM as EGR flow rate feedback.
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR TUBE MOUNTED
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 2795
The tube mounted differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is identical in operation as the large
plastic differential pressure feedback EGR sensors and uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF
hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2800
C2040
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2801
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION (APP) SENSOR
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
torque demand. There are 3 pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APPS1, has a negative
slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APPS2 and APPS3, both have a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APPS1 is used as
the indication of pedal position by the strategy. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There are 2 reference voltage circuits and 2
signal return circuits for the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2805
C128
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2806
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Diagram Of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot And Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2807
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. The current required to
maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow. The MAF sensor then
outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air mass. The PCM
calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired air/fuel ratio. This
input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC), shift and torque
converter clutch scheduling.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly. Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology with an integrated intake air
temperature (IAT) sensor. The hot wire electronic sensing element must be replaced as an
assembly. Replacing only the element may change the air flow calibration.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2808
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 2. Remove the 2 screws and
the MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE (FRP) SENSOR
Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
The FRP sensor is a diaphragm strain gauge device in which resistance changes with pressure.
The electrical resistance of a strain gauge increases as pressure increases, and the resistance
decreases as the pressure decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the
sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to pressure.
Strain gauge type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The FRP sensor measures the pressure of the fuel near the fuel injectors. This signal is used by
the PCM to adjust the fuel injector pulse width and meter fuel to each engine combustion cylinder.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor > Page 2813
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT)
Sensor
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail.
The temperature sensing portion of the FRPT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance
changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor decreases as the temperature
increases, and the resistance increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance
changes the voltage drop across the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM
corresponding to temperature.
Both the pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the fuel pump. The
speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid state. The
dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which allows the
injector pulse width to decrease.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Fuel Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail.
The temperature sensing portion of the FRPT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance
changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor decreases as the temperature
increases, and the resistance increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance
changes the voltage drop across the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM
corresponding to temperature.
Both the pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the fuel pump. The
speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid state. The
dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which allows the
injector pulse width to decrease.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2820
C4168
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2821
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Description and Operation
INERTIA FUEL SHUTOFF (IFS) SWITCH
Typical Inertia Fuel Shutoff (IFS) Switch
The IFS switch is used in conjunction with the electric fuel pump. The purpose of the IFS switch is
to shutoff the fuel pump if a collision occurs. It consists of a steel ball held in place by a magnet.
When a sharp impact occurs, the ball breaks loose from the magnet, rolls up a conical ramp and
strikes a target plate which opens the electrical contacts of the switch and shuts off the electric fuel
pump. Once the switch is open, it must be manually reset before restarting the vehicle. Refer to the
Owner's Literature for the location of the IFS.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2822
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Service and Repair
INERTIA FUEL SHUTOFF (IFS) SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the LH rear quarter trim panel. 2. Disconnect the inertia fuel shutoff (IFS) switch
electrical connector. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the IFS switch.
- To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE BODY (ETB) POSITION SENSOR
The ETB position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant ETB
position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB position sensor signal (TP1)
has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation the negative slope
ETB position sensor signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of throttle
position. The 2 ETB position sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1
signal has a concern. There is 1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor > Page 2827
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Typical TP Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases the corrosion resistance on the
terminals and increases the connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body.
As the TP sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, 4 operating conditions are determined by the PCM
from the TP. The operating conditions are:
- closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration)
- part throttle (includes cruise or moderate acceleration)
- wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on crank)
- throttle angle rate
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor
1
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor
1 > Page 2833
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor
C1366
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor
> Page 2836
C1367
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2837
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Typical Synchronizer Hall-Effect CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston
number 1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing
the sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil-on-plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP
signal to select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with 2 CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). They use the
second sensor to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2 as an input to the PCM.
There are 2 types of CMP sensors: the 3-pin connector Hall-effect type sensor and the 2-pin
connector variable reluctance type sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2838
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
RH sensor
1. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe.
LH sensor
2. Remove the air cleaner assembly.
Both sensors
3. Disconnect the camshaft position sensor (CMP) electrical connector. 4. Remove the bolt and the
CMP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
5. NOTE: Lubricate the CMP O-ring seal with clean engine oil.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2842
C101
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2843
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid deceleration between teeth.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2844
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the LH catalytic converter. 3.
Remove the bolt, nut and the heat shield.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
4. Remove the rubber grommet cover. 5. Disconnect the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor
electrical connector. 6. Remove the bolt and the CKP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
IGNITION LOCK CYLINDER
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the passive anti-theft system (PATS) transceiver. 2. Turn the ignition key to the ON
position. 3. Using a suitable tool, press the ignition lock cylinder release button and remove the
ignition lock cylinder. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2852
C109
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2853
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Two Types Of Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2854
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the thermostat housing. 2. Remove the lower intake manifold. 3. Remove the coolant
tube.
- Discard the O-ring.
4. Disconnect the knock sensor (KS) electrical connector. 5. Remove the 2 bolts and the KS.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Lubricate the new O-ring with clean engine coolant.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Fuel Pressure
3.5 L engine running fuel pressure.......................................................................................................
...........................................................450 kPa (65 psi)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System
Information > Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Typical Diagnostic Reference Value
Measured/PID Values 600 RPM ..........................................................................................................
..................................................................................................... Hot Idle
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Cleaner Housing: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER
Part 1
Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2865
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 2. Loosen the clamp and
disconnect the air cleaner outlet pipe from the air cleaner.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. Remove the air cleaner bolt.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
4. NOTE: No tools are needed to remove the air cleaner assembly. Removal should be carried out
using hands only.
Separate the 2 air cleaner feet from the rubber grommets and remove the air cleaner assembly.
5. NOTE:
- Make sure that the 2 air cleaner feet are seated into the rubber grommets under the air cleaner
assembly.
- The air cleaner outlet pipe should be securely sealed to prevent unmetered air from entering the
engine.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel
Pressure Release > System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELEASE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
WARNING:
- Do not carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any fuel-related
components. Highly flammable vapors are always present and can ignite. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, which may cause personal injury
or a fire hazard.
1. Remove the Schrader valve cap.
2. NOTE: This step will drain some fuel out of the system. Place the fuel in a suitable container.
Install the special tool and slowly open the manual valve to relieve the fuel system pressure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order >
Component Information > Specifications > Firing Order
Firing Order: Specifications Firing Order
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Firing order...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................1-4-2-5-3-6
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order >
Component Information > Specifications > Firing Order > Page 2874
Firing Order: Specifications Engine Cylinder Identification
Engine
Engine Cylinder Identification
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing >
Number One Cylinder > Component Information > Locations
Number One Cylinder: Locations
Engine
Engine Cylinder Identification
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Specifications > General Specifications
Spark Plug: Specifications General Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Spark plug gap.....................................................................................................................................
....................................1.29-1.45 mm (0.051-0.057 in)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Specifications > General Specifications > Page 2883
Torque Specifications
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2884
Spark Plug: Application and ID
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Spark plug............................................................................................................................................
................................................................AYFS-22FM
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2885
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection
Spark Plug Inspection
1. Inspect the spark plug for a bridged gap.
^ Check for deposit build-up closing the gap between the electrodes. Deposits are caused by oil or
carbon fouling.
^ Clean the spark plug.
2. Check for oil fouling.
^ Check for wet, black deposits on the insulator shell bore electrodes, caused by excessive oil
entering the combustion chamber through worn rings and pistons, excessive valve-to-guide
clearance or worn or loose bearings.
^ Correct the oil leak concern.
^ Install a new spark plug.
3. Inspect for carbon fouling. Look for black, dry, fluffy carbon deposits on the insulator tips,
exposed shell surfaces and electrodes, caused by a
spark plug with an incorrect heat range, dirty air cleaner, too rich a fuel mixture or excessive idling.
^
Install new spark plugs.
4. Inspect for normal burning.
^ Check for light tan or gray deposits on the firing tip.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2886
5. Inspect for pre-ignition, identified by melted electrodes and a possibly damaged insulator.
Metallic deposits on the insulator indicate engine
damage. This may be caused by incorrect ignition timing, wrong type of fuel or the unauthorized
installation of a Heli-coil insert in place of the spark plug threads. ^
Install a new spark plug.
6. Inspect for overheating, identified by white or light gray spots and with a bluish-burnt appearance
of electrodes. This is caused by engine
overheating, wrong type of fuel, loose spark plugs, spark plugs with an incorrect heat range, low
fuel pump pressure or incorrect ignition timing. ^
Install a new spark plug.
7. Inspect for fused deposits, identified by melted or spotty deposits resembling bubbles or blisters.
These are caused by sudden acceleration.
^ Install new spark plugs.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2887
Spark Plug: Service and Repair
SPARK PLUGS
Exploded View
Removal
LH side 1. Disconnect the crankcase vent tube quick connect coupling from the valve cover fitting
and position aside.
RH side
2. NOTE: The upper intake manifold must be removed to access the RH spark plugs only.
Remove the upper intake manifold.
Both sides 3. Disconnect the 6 ignition coil-on-plug electrical connectors.
4. NOTE: When removing the ignition coil-on-plugs, a slight twisting motion will break the seal and
ease removal.
Remove the 6 bolts and the 6 ignition coil-on-plugs.
5. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when removing or installing the spark plugs or damage can
occur to the cylinder head or spark plug.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2888
NOTE: Use compressed air to remove any foreign material in the spark plug well before removing
the spark plugs.
Remove the 6 spark plugs.
Installation
Both sides
1. Inspect the 6 spark plugs.
2. Adjust the spark plug gap as necessary.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2889
3. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when removing or installing the spark plugs, or damage can
occur to the cylinder head or spark plug.
Install the 6 spark plugs. Tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
4. NOTE: Apply a small amount of dielectric grease to the inside of the ignition coil-on-plug boots
before attaching to the spark plugs.
Install the 6 ignition coil-on-plugs and the 6 bolts. Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
5. Connect the 6 ignition coil-on-plug electrical connectors.
RH side 6. Install the upper intake manifold.
LH side 7. Position and connect the crankcase vent tube quick connect coupling to the valve cover
fitting.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check >
System Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Compression Test - Test Results
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75% of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit Chart.
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check >
System Information > Specifications > Page 2893
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
Compression Test
1. Make sure the oil in the crankcase is of the correct viscosity and at the correct level and that the
battery is correctly charged. Operate the vehicle
until the engine is at normal operating temperature. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position,
then remove all the spark plugs.
2. Set the throttle plates in the wide-open position. 3. Install a compression gauge such as the
Compression Tester in the No. 1 cylinder. 4. Install an auxiliary starter switch in the starting circuit.
With the ignition switch in the OFF position, and using the auxiliary starter switch, crank
the engine a minimum of 5 compression strokes and record the highest reading. Note the
approximate number of compression strokes necessary to obtain the highest reading.
5. Repeat the test on each cylinder, cranking the engine approximately the same number of
compression strokes.
Compression Test - Test Results
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75% of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit Chart.
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
If one or more cylinders reads low, squirt approximately one tablespoon of engine oil meeting Ford
specification on top of the pistons in the low-reading cylinders. Repeat the compression pressure
check on these cylinders.
Compression Test - Interpreting Compression Readings
1. If compression improves considerably, piston rings are worn or damaged. 2. If compression does
not improve, valves are sticking or not seating correctly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check >
System Information > Specifications > Page 2894
3. If 2 adjacent cylinders indicate low compression pressures and squirting oil on each piston does
not increase compression, the head gasket may be
leaking between cylinders. Engine oil or coolant in cylinders could result from this condition.
Use the Compression Pressure Limit Chart when checking cylinder compression so that the lowest
reading is within 75% of the highest reading.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
Valve Clearance
A midrange clearance is the most desirable.
Intake ...................................................................................................................................................
....................... 0.15 - 0.25 mm (0.006 - 0.01 inch) Exhaust
..............................................................................................................................................................
0.300 - 0.400 mm (0.0118 - 0.0157 inch)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications > Page 2898
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
Valve Clearance Check
1. Remove the valve covers.
2. NOTE: The valve clearance must be measured with the camshaft at base circle. The engine will
have to be rotated with the crankshaft pulley bolt
to bring each valve to base circle.
Use a feeler gauge to measure the clearance of each valve and record its location. A midrange
clearance is the most desirable: ^
Intake: 0.15 - 0.25 mm (0.006 - 0.01 inch)
^ Exhaust: 0.300 - 0.400 mm (0.0118 - 0.0157 inch)
3. NOTE: The number on the valve tappet reflects the thickness of the valve tappet. For example, a
tappet with the number 3.310 has the thickness
of 3.31 mm (0.13 inch).
If any of the valve clearances are out of specification, select new tappets using this formula: tappet
thickness = measured clearance + the base tappet thickness - most desirable thickness. Select the
tappets and mark the installation location.
4. If required, install the new selected valve tappets in the marked locations.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
> Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Page 2903
C2040
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Page 2904
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION (APP) SENSOR
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
torque demand. There are 3 pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APPS1, has a negative
slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APPS2 and APPS3, both have a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APPS1 is used as
the indication of pedal position by the strategy. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There are 2 reference voltage circuits and 2
signal return circuits for the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2908
C128
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2909
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Diagram Of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot And Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2910
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. The current required to
maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow. The MAF sensor then
outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air mass. The PCM
calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired air/fuel ratio. This
input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC), shift and torque
converter clutch scheduling.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly. Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology with an integrated intake air
temperature (IAT) sensor. The hot wire electronic sensing element must be replaced as an
assembly. Replacing only the element may change the air flow calibration.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2911
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 2. Remove the 2 screws and
the MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2915
C128
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2916
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (IAT) SENSOR
Typical Stand-Alone/Non-Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensors
Typical Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Incorporated Into A Drop-in Or Flange-type
MAF Sensor
The IAT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The electrical
resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance increases
as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the sensor
terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The IAT provides air temperature information to the PCM. The PCM uses the air temperature
information as a correction factor in the calculation of fuel, spark, and air flow.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2917
The IAT sensor provides a quicker temperature change response time than the ECT or CHT
sensor.
Currently there are 2 design types of IAT sensors used, a stand-alone/non-integrated type and a
integrated type. Both types function the same, however the integrated type is incorporated into the
mass air flow (MAF) sensor instead of being a stand alone sensor.
Supercharged vehicles use 2 IAT sensors. Both sensors are thermistor type devices and operate
as described. One is located before the supercharger at the air cleaner for standard OBD/cold
weather input, while a second sensor (IAT2) is located after the supercharger in the intake
manifold. The IAT2 sensor located after the supercharger provides air temperature information to
the PCM to control spark and to help determine charge air cooler (CAC) efficiency.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Specifications
Torque Specifications
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Driver Seat Module (DSM)
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Driver Seat Module (DSM)
DRIVER SEAT MODULE (DSM)
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Driver Seat Module (DSM) > Page 2923
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
NOTE: Prior to the replacement of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to the appropriate scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new module
after installation.
1. NOTE: This step is necessary only if the DSM is being replaced.
Upload the module configuration information from the DSM into the scan tool.
2. NOTE: If the driver seat can be moved to a high enough position, the DSM screws can be
removed without removing the driver seat.
If necessary, remove the driver seat.
3. Remove the 2 screws. 4. Disconnect the 4 electrical connectors and remove the DSM.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Driver Seat Module (DSM) > Page 2924
5. NOTE: Make sure to download the DSM configuration information from the scan tool into the
new DSM.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Driver Seat Module (DSM) > Page 2925
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Programmable Module Installation
PROGRAMMABLE MODULE INSTALLATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) Using the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) When the
Original Module is Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure be
carried out. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal
and installation procedures.
1. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle as normal. 2. From the Toolbox icon, select Module
Programming and press the check mark. 3. Select Programmable Module Installation. 4. Select the
module that is being replaced. 5. Follow the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the OFF
position, and press the check mark. 6. Install the new module and press the check mark. 7. Follow
the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the ON position, and press the check mark. 8.
The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration Complete. 9.
Test module for correct operation.
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) Using the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) When the
Original Module is NOT Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure be
carried out. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal
and installation procedures.
1. Install the new module. 2. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle as normal. 3. From the
Toolbox icon, select Module Programming and press the check mark. 4. Select Programmable
Module Installation. 5. Select the module that was replaced. 6. Follow the on-screen instructions,
turn the ignition key to the OFF position, and press the check mark. 7. Follow the on-screen
instructions, turn the ignition key to the ON position, and press the check mark. 8. If the data is not
available, the IDS displays a screen stating to contact the As-Built Data Center. Retrieve the data
from the technician service
publication website at this time and press the check mark.
9. Enter the module data and press the check mark.
10. The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration
Complete. 11. Test module for correct operation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Brake Signal > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Brake Signal > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2929
C2064
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Brake Signal > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
Brake Signal: Description and Operation Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal to the
PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Brake Signal > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch > Page 2932
Brake Signal: Description and Operation Brake Pedal Switch (BPS) Brake Deactivator Switch
BRAKE PEDAL SWITCH (BPS) BRAKE DEACTIVATOR SWITCH
The BPS, also called the brake deactivator switch, is for vehicle speed control deactivation. A
normally closed switch supplies battery positive voltage (B+) to the PCM when the brake pedal is
not applied. When the brake pedal is applied, the normally closed switch opens and power is
removed from the PCM.
On some applications the normally closed BPS, along with the normally open BPP switch, are used
for a brake rationality test within the PCM. The PCM misfire monitor profile learn function may be
disabled if a brake switch concern occurs. If one or both brake pedal inputs to the PCM is not
changing states when they were expected to, a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) is set by the PCM
strategy.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor 1
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor 1 > Page 2937
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor
C1366
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor > Page 2940
C1367
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2941
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Typical Synchronizer Hall-Effect CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston
number 1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing
the sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil-on-plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP
signal to select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with 2 CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). They use the
second sensor to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2 as an input to the PCM.
There are 2 types of CMP sensors: the 3-pin connector Hall-effect type sensor and the 2-pin
connector variable reluctance type sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2942
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
RH sensor
1. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe.
LH sensor
2. Remove the air cleaner assembly.
Both sensors
3. Disconnect the camshaft position sensor (CMP) electrical connector. 4. Remove the bolt and the
CMP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
5. NOTE: Lubricate the CMP O-ring seal with clean engine oil.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Clutch Switch, ECM > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION (CPP) SWITCH
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
The CPP switch is an input to the PCM indicating the clutch pedal position. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the CPP circuit. When the CPP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The CPP input to the PCM is used to detect a reduction in engine
load. The PCM uses the load information for mass air flow and fuel calculations.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Description and Operation
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR
Typical Thread Type ECT Sensor
The ECT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The ECT measures the temperature of the engine coolant. The PCM uses the ECT input for fuel
control and for cooling fan control. There are 3 types of ECT sensors, threaded, push-in, and
twist-lock. The ECT sensor is located in an engine coolant passage.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2952
C101
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2953
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid deceleration between teeth.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2954
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the LH catalytic converter. 3.
Remove the bolt, nut and the heat shield.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
4. Remove the rubber grommet cover. 5. Disconnect the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor
electrical connector. 6. Remove the bolt and the CKP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Data Link Connector: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2960
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2961
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2962
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2963
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2964
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2965
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2966
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2967
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2968
Data Link Connector: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2969
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2970
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2971
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2972
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2973
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2974
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2975
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2976
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2977
C251
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Actuator >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Actuator >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2981
C1368
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Actuator >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2982
Electronic Throttle Actuator: Description and Operation
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE ACTUATOR CONTROL (TAC)
The electronic TAC is a DC motor controlled by the PCM (requires 2 wires). The gear ratio from the
motor to the throttle plate shaft is 17:1. There are 2 designs for the TAC, parallel and in-series. The
parallel design has the motor under the bore parallel to the plate shaft. The motor housing is
integrated into the main housing. The in-series design has a separate motor housing. Two springs
are used; one is used to close the throttle (main spring) and the other is in a plunger assembly that
results in a default angle when no power is applied. The force of the plunger spring is 2 times
stronger than the main spring. The default angle is usually set to result in a top vehicle speed of 48
km/h (30 mph). Typically this throttle angle is 7 to 8 degree from the hard stop angle. The closed
throttle plate hard stop is used to prevent the throttle from binding in the bore (~ 0.75 degree). This
hard stop setting is not adjustable and is set to result in less airflow than the minimum engine
airflow required at idle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module
> Component Information > Description and Operation
Electronic Throttle Control Module: Description and Operation
TORQUE BASED ELECTRONIC THROTTLE CONTROL (ETC)
Overview
The torque based ETC is a hardware and software strategy that delivers an engine output torque
(via throttle angle) based on driver demand (pedal position). It uses an electronic throttle body, the
powertrain control module (PCM), and an accelerator pedal assembly to control the throttle
opening and engine torque. The ETC system replaces the standard cable operated accelerator
pedal, idle air control (IAC) valve, 3-wire throttle position (TP) sensor, and mechanical throttle body.
Torque based ETC enables aggressive automatic transmission shift schedules (earlier upshifts and
later downshifts). This is possible by adjusting the throttle angle to achieve the same wheel torque
during shifts, and by calculating this desired torque, the system prevents engine lugging (low RPM
and low manifold vacuum) while still delivering the performance and torque requested by the driver.
It also enables many fuel economy/emission improvement technologies such as variable camshaft
timing (VCT) (deliver same torque during transitions).
Torque based ETC also results in less intrusive vehicle and engine speed limiting, along with
smoother traction control.
Other benefits of ETC are: eliminate cruise control actuators
- eliminate idle air control (IAC) valve
- better airflow range
- packaging (no cable)
- more responsive powertrain at altitude and improved shift quality
It should be noted that the ETC system illuminates a powertrain malfunction indicator (wrench) on
the instrument cluster when a concern is present. Concerns are accompanied by diagnostic trouble
codes (DTCs) and may also illuminate the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL).
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB)
The ETB has the following characteristics: 1. The throttle actuator control (TAC) motor is a DC
motor controlled by the PCM (requires 2-wires). The gear ratio from the motor to the throttle
plate shaft is 17:1.
2. There are 2 designs: parallel and in-series. The parallel design has the motor under the bore
parallel to the plate shaft. The motor housing is
integrated into the main housing. The in-series design has a separate motor housing.
3. Two springs are used: one is used to close the throttle (main spring) and the other is in a plunger
assembly that results in a default angle when no
power is applied. This is for limp home reasons (the force of the plunger spring is 2 times stronger
than the main spring). The default angle is usually set to result in a top vehicle speed of 48 km/h
(30 mph). Typically this throttle angle is 7 to 8 degrees from the hard-stop angle.
4. The closed throttle plate hard stop is used to prevent the throttle from binding in the bore (~0.75
degree). This hard stop setting is not adjustable
and is set to result in less airflow than the minimum engine airflow required at idle.
5. Unlike cable operated throttle bodies, the intent for the ETB is not to have a hole in the throttle
plate or to use plate sealant. The hole is not
required in the ETB because the required idle airflow is provided by the plate angle in the throttle
body assembly. This plate angle controls idle, idle quality, and eliminates the need for an IAC
valve.
6. The TP sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant throttle position
signals are required for increased monitoring
reasons. The first TP signal (TP1) has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and
the second signal (TP2) has a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal
operation the negative slope TP signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of
throttle position. The TP sensor assembly requires 4 circuits. 5-volt reference voltage
- Signal return (ground)
- TP1 voltage with negative voltage slope (5-0 volts)
- TP2 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensors
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 2986
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) And Accelerator Pedal Assembly
The ETC strategy uses pedal position sensors as an input to determine the driver demand. 1.
There are 3 pedal position signals required for system monitoring. APP1 has a negative slope
(increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and APP2 and
APP3 both have a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation
APP1 is used as the indication of pedal position by the strategy.
2. There are 2 VREF circuits, 2 signal return circuits, and 3 signal circuits (a total of 7 circuits and
pins) between the PCM and the APP sensor
assembly. 2 reference voltage circuits (5 volts)
- 2 signal return (ground) circuits
- APP1 voltage with negative voltage slope (5-0 volts)
- APP2 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
- APP3 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
3. The pedal position signal is convened to pedal travel degrees (rotary angle) by the PCM. The
software then converts these degrees to counts,
which is the input to the torque based strategy.
4. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a
concern. The PCM determines if a signal is
incorrect by calculating where it should be, inferred from the other signals. A value is substituted for
an incorrect signal if 2 of the 3 signals are incorrect.
Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) System Strategy
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 2987
ETC System
The torque based ETC strategy was developed to improve fuel economy and to accommodate
variable camshaft timing (VCT). This is possible by not coupling the throttle angle to the driver
pedal position. Uncoupling the throttle angle (produce engine torque) from the pedal position (driver
demand) allows the powertrain control strategy to optimize fuel control and transmission shift
schedules while delivering the requested wheel torque.
The ETC monitor system is distributed across 2 processors within the PCM: the main powertrain
control processor unit (CPU) and a monitoring processor called an enhanced-quizzer (E-Quizzer)
processor. The primary monitoring function is carried out by the independent plausibility check
(IPC) software, which resides on the main processor. It is responsible for determining the
driver-demanded torque and comparing it to an estimate of the actual torque delivered. If the
generated torque exceeds driver demand by a specified amount, the IPC takes appropriate
corrective action.
ETC System Failure Mode And Effects Management (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 2988
ETC System Failure Mode And Effects Management (Part 2)
Since the IPC and the main controller share the same processor, they are subject to a number of
potential common failure modes. The E-Quizzer processor was added to redundantly monitor
selected PCM inputs and to act as an intelligent watchdog and monitor the performance of the IPC
and the main processor. If it determines that the IPC function is impaired in any way, it takes
appropriate failure mode and effects management (FMEM) actions.
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation:
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 2989
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation (Part 2)
Accelerator and Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Inputs
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Check:
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Check
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Check:
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Check
Throttle Plate Position Controller (TPPC) Outputs
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 2990
Throttle Plate Controller Check Operation
The purpose of the TPPC is to maintain the throttle position at the desired throttle angle. It is a
separate chip embedded in the PCM. The desired angle is communicated from the main CPU via a
312.5 Hz duty cycle (DC) signal. The TPPC interprets the duty cycle signal as follows: Less than 4% - Out of range, limp home default position.
- Greater than or equal to 4% but less than 6% - Commanded default position, closed.
- Greater than or equal to 6% but less than 7% - Commanded default position. Used for key ON,
engine OFF.
- Greater than or equal to 7% but less than 8% - Enable ice breaker mode. Used to clear potential
ice buildup in the throttle body.
- Greater than or equal to 8% but less than 10% - Closed against hard-stop. Used to learn zero
throttle angle position (hard stop) after key-up.
- Greater than or equal to 10% but less than or equal to 92% - Normal operation, between 0
degrees (hard stop) and 82 degrees, 10% duty cycle equals 0 degrees throttle angle, 92% duty
cycle equals 82 degrees throttle angle.
- Greater than 92% but less than or equal to 96% - Wide open throttle, 82 to 86 degrees throttle
angle.
- Greater than 96% but less than or equal to 100% - Out of range, limp home default position.
The desired angle is relative to the hard-stop angle. The hard stop angle is learned during each
key-up process before the main CPU requests the throttle plate be closed against the hard stop.
The output of the TPPC is a voltage request to the H driver (also in PCM). The H driver is capable
of positive or negative voltage to the electronic throttle body motor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-11-15 > Jun > 09 > Engine Controls Rough/Rolling Idle/Idle Speed Drop
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls - Rough/Rolling Idle/Idle Speed Drop
TSB 09-11-15
06/15/09
ROUGH / ROLLING IDLE / IDLE SPEED DROPS BELOW SPECIFICATION / LIGHT THROTTLE
WITH CRUISE ENGAGED / LOW SPEED TIP IN CLUNK
FORD: 2008-2009 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2009 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKX
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 8-23-5 to update the vehicle lines and Action statement.
ISSUE Some 2008-2009 Taurus, Taurus-X, Sable and 2007-2009 Edge and MKX vehicles may
exhibit a rough, rolling idle, or the idle speed dropping below specification. This condition typically
occurs most often in hot ambient temperatures with the A/C on when idling for extended periods.
Vehicles may also exhibit idle speed dropping below specification on light throttle application with
vehicle cruise control engaged and traveling down a hill or a low speed tip in clunk.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) to the latest calibration using IDS
release 61.05 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration
files may also be obtained at the website.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091115A 2008-2009 Taurus, Sable, 0.3 Hr.
Taurus X. 2007-2009 Edge, MKX: Reprogram The PCM, Authorization Decal Not Required. (Do
Not Use With 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-19-5 > Oct > 07 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0451
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0451
TSB 07-19-5
10/01/07
MIL ON DTC P0451
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles may exhibit a malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) on with
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0451 which may be caused by electromagnetic compatibility
(EMC) interference.
ACTION If normal Workshop Manual Diagnostics are unable to resolve the concern, install a
Capacitor/Jumper Harness Kit following the installation instruction sheet included with the kit.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071905A 2007 Edge/MKX: Install A 0.7 Hr.
Capacitor Jumper Harness Kit (Do Not Use With 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9C052 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-11-15 > Jun > 09 > Engine
Controls - Rough/Rolling Idle/Idle Speed Drop
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Rough/Rolling Idle/Idle
Speed Drop
TSB 09-11-15
06/15/09
ROUGH / ROLLING IDLE / IDLE SPEED DROPS BELOW SPECIFICATION / LIGHT THROTTLE
WITH CRUISE ENGAGED / LOW SPEED TIP IN CLUNK
FORD: 2008-2009 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2009 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKX
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 8-23-5 to update the vehicle lines and Action statement.
ISSUE Some 2008-2009 Taurus, Taurus-X, Sable and 2007-2009 Edge and MKX vehicles may
exhibit a rough, rolling idle, or the idle speed dropping below specification. This condition typically
occurs most often in hot ambient temperatures with the A/C on when idling for extended periods.
Vehicles may also exhibit idle speed dropping below specification on light throttle application with
vehicle cruise control engaged and traveling down a hill or a low speed tip in clunk.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) to the latest calibration using IDS
release 61.05 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration
files may also be obtained at the website.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091115A 2008-2009 Taurus, Sable, 0.3 Hr.
Taurus X. 2007-2009 Edge, MKX: Reprogram The PCM, Authorization Decal Not Required. (Do
Not Use With 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 07-19-5 > Oct > 07 > Engine
Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0451
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0451
TSB 07-19-5
10/01/07
MIL ON DTC P0451
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles may exhibit a malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) on with
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0451 which may be caused by electromagnetic compatibility
(EMC) interference.
ACTION If normal Workshop Manual Diagnostics are unable to resolve the concern, install a
Capacitor/Jumper Harness Kit following the installation instruction sheet included with the kit.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071905A 2007 Edge/MKX: Install A 0.7 Hr.
Capacitor Jumper Harness Kit (Do Not Use With 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9C052 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-1-8 >
Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set
Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set
TSB 10-1-8
02/01/10
PCM - BATTERY JUNCTION BOX (BJB) - POSSIBLE MIL ON WITH MULTIPLE DTCS, NO
CRANK/NO START, DRIVABILITY SYMPTOMS
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 7-16-5 to remove the production build date and TSB 7-17-9 to update
the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles may exhibit concerns that results in no crank/start,
buck/jerk, lack/loss of power and/or malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) with one or more diagnostic
trouble codes (DTCs) present. This could be caused by a poor fuse terminal fit, loose or unseated
wire terminal connection at the Battery Junction Box (BJB) located near the battery under the hood.
ACTION If loose and/or unseated wiring terminals for fuses and relays are found in the BJB, follow
the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the vehicle battery.
2. Open the BJB top cover. (Figure 1)
3. Check for loose fuse connections in the BJB at fuse positions 30, 31, 32, 33, and 34. If poor
terminal fit is present, note those fuse cavities for Step 6.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-1-8 >
Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set > Page 3017
4. Remove all the mini fuses, relays and diodes (suggest taking a picture of the layout so install is
easier). (Figure 2)
a. Do not remove the cartridge fuses from the BJB.
5. Remove the light gray retainer that the devices were plugged through. This will expose the
terminals within the plastic housing. (Figure 3)
6. Locate the terminal cavities identified in procedure Step 3 that require repair. The tuning forks
will be off center in relation to the plastic cavities or
open.
7. Insert a small flat blade screw driver/pick tool into the suspect tuning fork slot. The flat blade
screw driver/pick tool width should be a maximum of
0.05" (1.25 mm) to provide access into the cavity. Tip dimensions were 0.04" x 0.04" (1 mm x 1
mm) with a 45 degree taper).
8. The small flat blade screw driver/pick tool should be inserted to the outside of the tuning fork leg
between the tuning fork leg and the plastic wall of
the housing cavity. (Figure 4)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-1-8 >
Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set > Page 3018
9. Pry the screw driver/pick tool against the plastic cavity wall and against the side of the tuning
fork leg. This will move the tuning fork legs together,
tuning fork legs should be close to touching. (Figure 5)
10. Next remove the BJB from the splash shield. (Figure 6)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-1-8 >
Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set > Page 3019
a. Tug on the underside wires to determine the unseated terminal location. (Figures 7 and 8)
NOTE
THIS MAY REQUIRE SOME LEVEL OF HARNESS REMOVAL FROM THE VEHICLE MOUNTING
LOCATIONS TO ADEQUATELY ACCESS THE LEADS ON THE UNDERSIDE OF THE BJB
BLOCK.
11. Any circuits that do not offer any resistance during the tugging operation should be reseated
using the Push-Click-Tug method.
a. Push the terminal back into the cavity.
b. Listen for an audible click to assure lock engagement.
c. Tug on the lead to insure a proper seat occurred.
12. Once all the BJB circuits have been verified as seated, proceed to the next steps.
13. Install and lock the BJB block back into the splash shield.
14. Install the light gray retainer.
15. Reinstall all the mini fuses, relays and diodes back into their specific locations.
a. Make sure all the relays are replaced in the proper orientation.
16. Close the BJB cover.
17. Reconnect the vehicle battery cable.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100108A 2007 Edge, MKX: Follow 0.6 Hr.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-1-8 >
Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set > Page 3020
The Service Procedure To Check For And Repair Loose/Unseated Wiring Terminals (Do Not Use
With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14290 X2
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-1-8 >
Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set > Page 3026
4. Remove all the mini fuses, relays and diodes (suggest taking a picture of the layout so install is
easier). (Figure 2)
a. Do not remove the cartridge fuses from the BJB.
5. Remove the light gray retainer that the devices were plugged through. This will expose the
terminals within the plastic housing. (Figure 3)
6. Locate the terminal cavities identified in procedure Step 3 that require repair. The tuning forks
will be off center in relation to the plastic cavities or
open.
7. Insert a small flat blade screw driver/pick tool into the suspect tuning fork slot. The flat blade
screw driver/pick tool width should be a maximum of
0.05" (1.25 mm) to provide access into the cavity. Tip dimensions were 0.04" x 0.04" (1 mm x 1
mm) with a 45 degree taper).
8. The small flat blade screw driver/pick tool should be inserted to the outside of the tuning fork leg
between the tuning fork leg and the plastic wall of
the housing cavity. (Figure 4)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-1-8 >
Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set > Page 3027
9. Pry the screw driver/pick tool against the plastic cavity wall and against the side of the tuning
fork leg. This will move the tuning fork legs together,
tuning fork legs should be close to touching. (Figure 5)
10. Next remove the BJB from the splash shield. (Figure 6)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-1-8 >
Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set > Page 3028
a. Tug on the underside wires to determine the unseated terminal location. (Figures 7 and 8)
NOTE
THIS MAY REQUIRE SOME LEVEL OF HARNESS REMOVAL FROM THE VEHICLE MOUNTING
LOCATIONS TO ADEQUATELY ACCESS THE LEADS ON THE UNDERSIDE OF THE BJB
BLOCK.
11. Any circuits that do not offer any resistance during the tugging operation should be reseated
using the Push-Click-Tug method.
a. Push the terminal back into the cavity.
b. Listen for an audible click to assure lock engagement.
c. Tug on the lead to insure a proper seat occurred.
12. Once all the BJB circuits have been verified as seated, proceed to the next steps.
13. Install and lock the BJB block back into the splash shield.
14. Install the light gray retainer.
15. Reinstall all the mini fuses, relays and diodes back into their specific locations.
a. Make sure all the relays are replaced in the proper orientation.
16. Close the BJB cover.
17. Reconnect the vehicle battery cable.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100108A 2007 Edge, MKX: Follow 0.6 Hr.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-1-8 >
Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set > Page 3029
The Service Procedure To Check For And Repair Loose/Unseated Wiring Terminals (Do Not Use
With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14290 X2
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3030
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3033
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3034
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3035
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3036
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3037
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3038
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3039
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3040
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3041
Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3042
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3043
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3044
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3045
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3046
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3047
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3048
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3049
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3050
Engine Control Module: Connector Views
C175B (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3051
C175B (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3052
C175E (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3053
C175E (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3054
C175T (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3055
C175T (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
Removal
1. NOTE: PCM replacement DOES NOT require new keys or programming of keys.
Retrieve the module configuration. Carry out the module configuration retrieval steps of the
Programmable Module Installation procedure.
2. Disconnect the 3 powertrain control module (PCM) electrical connectors. 3. Remove the 2 nuts
and the PCM.
- Remove the gasket.
Installation
1. Install the gasket and the PCM. 2. Install the 2 PCM nuts.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. Connect the 3 PCM electrical connectors. 4. Restore the module configuration. Carry out the
module configuration restore steps of the Programmable Module Installation procedure. 5.
Reprogram the passive anti-theft system (PATS). Carry out the Parameter Reset procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Powertrain Control Module (PCM) > Page 3058
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only
Memory (EEPROM)
FLASH ELECTRICALLY ERASABLE PROGRAMMABLE READ ONLY MEMORY (EEPROM)
Description
The EEPROM is contained in an integrated circuit (IC) internal to the powertrain control module
(PCM). The EEPROM contains the vehicle strategy including calibration information specific to the
vehicle, and is capable of being programmed or flashed repeatedly.
As part of the calibration there is an area referred to as the vehicle identification (VID) block. The
VID block is programmed when installing a new PCM as described under Programming the VID
Block for a Replacement PCM. Failure to carry out this procedure may generate DTCs P1635 or
P1639. The VID block in an existing PCM can also be tailored to accommodate various hardware
or parameter changes made to the vehicle since production. Failure to carry out this procedure
properly may generate DTC P1635, Tire/Axle Ratio out of Acceptable Range. An incorrect tire/axle
ratio is one of the main causes for DTC P1639. This is described under Making Changes to the VID
Block and also under Making Changes to the PCM Calibration. The VID block contains many items
used by the strategy for a variety of functions. Some of these items include the vehicle identification
number (VIN), octane adjust, fuel octane, fuel type, vehicle speed limit, tire size, axle ratio, the
presence of speed control, and 4-wheel drive electronic shift-on-the-fly (ESOF) versus manual
shift-on-the-fly (MSOF). Only items applicable to the vehicle hardware and supported by the VID
block is displayed on the scan tool.
When changing items in the VID block, the strategy places range limits on certain items such as
tire and axle ratio. The number of times the VID block may be reconfigured is limited. When this
limit is reached, the scan tool displays a message indicating the need to flash the PCM again to
reset the VID block.
Programming can be carried out by a local Ford dealer or any non-Ford facility. Refer to the scan
tool manufacturer's instruction manual for details.
Programming the VID Block for a Replacement PCM
A new PCM contains the latest strategy and calibration level for a particular vehicle. However, the
VID block is blank and needs programming. There are 2 procedures available. The first is an
automatic data transfer from the old PCM to the new PCM, and the second is manual data entry
into the new PCM.
Automatic data transfer is carried out if the old PCM is capable of communicating. This is done by
using a scan tool to retrieve data from the old PCM before removing it from the vehicle. The stored
data can then be downloaded to the new PCM after it has been installed.
Carry out manual data entry if the old module is damaged or incapable of communicating. Remove
and install a new PCM. Using a compatible scan tool, select and carry out the module/parameter
programming, referring to the scan tool manufacturer's instruction manual. Make certain that all
parameters are included. Failure to properly program tire size in revolutions per mile, (rev/mile
equals 63,360 divided by the tire circumference in inches), axle ratio, 4x4/4x2, and/or MSOF/ESOF
may result in DTCs P1635 and P1639. You may be instructed to contact the As-Built Data Center
for the information needed to manually update the VID block with the scan tool. Contact the center
only if the old PCM cannot be used or the data is corrupt. For Ford and Lincoln Mercury
technicians, contact your National Hotline or the Professional Technician Society (PTS) website for
As-Built data listed under the Service Publications Index. Non-Ford technicians use the
Motorcraft(R) website at www.motorcraft.com. From the Motorcraft(R) homepage, use the search
function to find the Module Programming or As-Built Data.
For Ford and Lincoln Mercury technicians, check the Programmable Module Installation link on the
PTS website for quick Programmable Module data information by vehicle.
Making Changes to the VID Block
A PCM which is programmed may require changes to be made to certain VID information to
accommodate the vehicle hardware. Refer to Module Reprogramming on the scan tool.
Making Changes to the PCM Calibration
At certain times, the entire EEPROM needs to be completely reprogrammed. This is due to
changes made to the strategy or calibration after production, or the need to reset the VID block
because it has reached its limit. Refer to Module Reprogramming on the scan tool.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3062
C107
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3063
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Typical CHT Sensor
The CHT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with the temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as temperature increases., and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
The CHT sensor is installed in the cylinder head and measures the metal temperature. The CHT
sensor can provide complete engine temperature information and can be used to infer coolant
temperature. If the CHT sensor conveys an overheating condition to the PCM, the PCM initiates a
fail-safe cooling strategy based on information from the CHT sensor. A cooling system concern
such as low coolant or coolant loss could cause an overheating condition. As a result, damage to
major engine components could occur. Using both the CHT sensor and fail-safe cooling strategy,
the PCM prevents damage by allowing air cooling of the engine and limp home capability.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3064
Engine Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the lower intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the cylinder head temperature (CHT) sensor
electrical connector. 3. Remove and discard the CHT sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Do not reuse the CHT sensor, install a new sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL LEVEL INPUT (FLI)
The FLI is a communications network message. Most vehicle applications use a potentiometer type
FLI sensor connected to a float in the FP module to determine fuel level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Level Sensor
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Level Sensor
FUEL LEVEL SENSOR
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Level Sensor > Page 3070
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Level Sensor > Page 3071
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Level Sensor > Page 3072
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- This procedure involves fuel handling. Be prepared for spillage at all times and always observe
fuel handling precautions. Failure to follow these instructions can result in personal injury.
1. Release the fuel system pressure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Level Sensor > Page 3073
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3. Release the fuel tank filler cap and position aside.
4. Insert a suitable fuel drain tube into the fuel tank filler pipe until it reaches the fuel tank inlet
spout.
5. CAUTION: The fuel pump (FP) module and fuel level sensor will be below the fuel level in the
tank when the tank is full. Make sure to
drain 1/8 of the fuel capacity through the filler pipe prior to removing the fuel level sensor or fuel
spillage will occur.
Attach the fuel storage tanker to the fuel drain tube and remove any residual fuel remaining in the
fuel tank filler pipe.
6. Remove the rear seat. 7. Position the carpet and/or any insulation covering the fuel level sensor
access cover aside.
8. Remove the 4 screws and the fuel level sensor access cover.
9. Disconnect the fuel level sensor electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Level Sensor > Page 3074
10. CAUTION: Place absorbant pads in the general work area in case of fuel spillage.
Release the lock tab, rotate the fuel level sensor counterclockwise approximately 1/4 turn and lift
upward.
11. CAUTION:
- The fuel level sensor must be handled carefully to avoid damage to the float arm.
- Carefully remove the fuel level sensor from the fuel tank to avoid fuel spillage inside the vehicle.
Carefully lift and remove the fuel level sensor from the fuel tank.
12. CAUTION: Inspect the mating surfaces of the fuel level sensor flange and the fuel tank O-ring
seal contact surfaces. Do not polish or
adjust the O-ring seal contact area of the fuel tank flange or the fuel tank. Install a new fuel level
sensor or fuel tank if the O-ring seal contact area is bent, scratched or corroded.
NOTE: To install, apply clean engine oil to the O-ring seal.
- Upon installation, properly seat and press down firmly on the fuel level sensor, rotate it clockwise
until the lock arrow on the sensor aligns with the notch on the tank. Torque should not exceed 15
Nm (11 lb-ft).
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Level Sensor > Page 3075
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module
FUEL PUMP MODULE
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Level Sensor > Page 3076
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Level Sensor > Page 3077
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Level Sensor > Page 3078
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
repairing or disconnecting any of the fuel system components, the fuel system pressure must be
relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel causing personal injury or a fire hazard.
All vehicles
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Level Sensor > Page 3079
1. Release the fuel system pressure. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3. Release the fuel
tank filler cap and position aside.
4. Insert a suitable fuel drain tube into the fuel tank filler pipe until it reaches the fuel tank inlet
spout. 5. Attach the fuel storage tanker to the fuel drain tube and remove any residual fuel
remaining in the fuel tank filler pipe. 6. Remove the rear seat. 7. Position the carpet and/or any
insulation covering the fuel pump (FP) module access cover aside.
8. Remove the 4 screws and the FP module access cover.
9. Disconnect the FP module electrical connector.
10. Disconnect the fuel tank supply tube-to-FP module quick connect coupling.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Level Sensor > Page 3080
11. CAUTION: Place absorbent pads on the floor pan in the immediate area in case of fuel spills.
Carefully remove the fuel pump (FP)
module from the vehicle to avoid fuel spillage inside the vehicle.
Using the special tool, remove the FP module lock ring retainer.
All wheel drive (AWD) vehicles
12. CAUTION: The fuel pump (FP) module must be handled carefully to avoid damage to the FP
module and/or float arm.
Carefully lift the FP module out of the fuel tank enough to access and disconnect the fuel tank
crossover tube-to-FP module quick connect coupling.
All vehicles
13. CAUTION: The fuel pump (FP) module will have residual fuel remaining internally, drain into a
suitable container.
Completely remove the FP module from the fuel tank.
14. CAUTION:
- Inspect the mating surfaces of the fuel pump (FP) module flange and the fuel tank O-ring seal
contact surfaces. Do not polish or adjust the O-ring seal contact area of the fuel tank flange or the
fuel tank. Install a new FP module or fuel tank if the O-ring seal contact area is bent, scratched or
corroded.
- Make sure to install a new fuel pump (FP) module O-ring seal. Install a new lock ring if it is bent,
damaged or corroded.
NOTE: To install, apply clean engine oil to the O-ring seal.
Remove the FP module O-ring seal.
15. NOTE: Make sure the alignment tab on the fuel pump (FP) module and the fuel tank meet
before tightening the FP module lock ring.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3084
C435
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3085
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL TANK PRESSURE (FTP) SENSOR
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
In-Line Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
The FTP sensor or in-line FTP sensor is used to measure the fuel tank pressure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Description and Operation
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Description and Operation
IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE
NOTE: The IAC valve assembly is not adjustable and cannot be cleaned, also some IAC valves are
normally open and others are normally closed. Some IAC valves require engine vacuum to
operate.
The IAC valve assembly controls the engine idle speed and provides a dashpot function. The IAC
valve assembly meters intake air around the throttle plate through a bypass within the IAC valve
assembly and throttle body. The PCM determines the desired idle speed or bypass air and signals
the IAC valve assembly through a specified duty cycle. The IAC valve responds by positioning the
IAC valve to control the amount of bypassed air. The PCM monitors engine RPM and increases or
decreases the IAC duty cycle in order to achieve the desired RPM.
The PCM uses the IAC valve assembly to control:
- no touch start
- cold engine fast idle for rapid warm-up
- idle (corrects for engine load)
- stumble or stalling on deceleration (provides a dashpot function)
- over-temperature idle boost
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Information Bus: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3093
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3094
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3095
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3096
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3097
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3098
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3099
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3100
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3101
Information Bus: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3102
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3103
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3104
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3105
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3106
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3107
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3108
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3109
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3110
Information Bus: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
14-1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3111
14-2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3112
14-3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3113
14-4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3114
14-5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3115
14-6
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3116
Information Bus: Description and Operation
COMMUNICATIONS NETWORK
Vehicle communication utilizes both medium and high speed controller area network (CAN)
communications. CAN is used for many modules to communicate with each other on a common
network. CAN in-vehicle networking, is a method for transferring data among distributed electronic
modules via a serial data bus. Without serial networking, intermodule communication requires
dedicated, point to point wiring resulting in bulky, expensive, complex, and difficult to install wiring
harnesses. Applying a serial data network reduces the number of wires combining the signals on a
single network. Information is sent to the individual control modules that control each function.
The vehicle has 2 module communication networks:
- Medium speed (MS) CAN
- High speed (HS) CAN
Both networks are connected to the data link connector (DLC). This makes diagnosis and testing of
these systems easier by allowing one scan tool to be able to diagnose and control any module on
both networks from one connector. The DLC can be found under the instrument panel between the
steering column and the audio unit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3117
Network Topology
MS-CAN Network Operation
The MS-CAN network communicates using bussed messages. The MS-CAN has an unshielded
twisted pair cable, data bus (+) and data bus (-) circuits. In addition to scan tool communication,
this network allows sharing of information between all modules on the network.
The MS-CAN is a medium speed communication network used for the following modules:
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3118
- SJB
- Audio unit
- Instrument cluster
- DSM (if equipped)
- DVD player (if equipped)
- EATC module (if equipped)
- SDARS module (if equipped)
- Parking aid module (if equipped)
- Power liftgate module (if equipped)
- THX(R) amplifier (if equipped)
- Climate controlled seat module (if equipped)
HS-CAN Network Operation
The HS-CAN network communicates using bussed messages. The HS-CAN network uses an
unshielded twisted pair cable, data bus (+) and data bus (-) circuits. In addition to scan tool
communication, this network allows sharing of information between all modules on the network.
The HS-CAN is a high speed communication network used for the following modules: PCM
- RCM
- ABS module
- Instrument cluster
- Occupant classification sensor module
- 4WD control module (if equipped)
- Steering angle sensor module (if equipped)
- Adaptive front lighting module (if equipped)
Network Termination
The CAN network uses a network termination circuit to improve communication reliability. The
network termination of the CAN bus takes place inside the termination modules by termination
resistors. Termination modules are located at either end of the bus network. As network messages
are broadcast in the form of voltage signals, the network voltage signals are stabilized by the
termination resistors. Each termination module has a 120 ohm resistor across the positive and
negative bus connection in the termination module. With 2 termination modules on each network,
and the 120 ohm resistors located in a parallel circuit configuration, the total network impedance, or
total resistance is 60 ohms.
Network termination improves bus message reliability by: stabilizing bus voltage.
- eliminating electrical interference.
Gateway Module
The instrument cluster is the gateway module, translating HS-CAN to MS-CAN and vice versa. This
information allows a message to be distributed throughout both networks. The instrument cluster is
the only module on this vehicle that has this ability.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Information Bus: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Inspection and Verification
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
1. Verify the customer concern. 2. Visually inspect the following for obvious signs of electrical
damage.
VISUAL INSPECTION CHART
Electrical Battery junction box (BJB) fuse(s): 15 (40A) (no communication with ABS module)
- 16 (30A) (no communication with climate controlled seat module)
- 50 (10A) (no communication with ABS module)
- 51 (5A) (no communication with adaptive front lighting module)
- 57 (40A) (no communication with ABS module)
- 59 (30A) (no communication with power liftgate module)
- 60 (30A) (no communication with driver seat module [DSM])
- Smart junction box (SJB) fuse(s): 3 (15A) (no communication with digital versatile disc [DVD] player)
- 5 (10A) (no communication with SJB)
- 11 (10A) (no communication with four wheel drive [4WD] control module)
- 12 (7.5A) (no communication with DSM)
- 13 (7.5A) (no communication with satellite radio receiver)
- 14 (10A) (no communication with power liftgate module)
- 15 (10A) (no communication with electronic automatic temperature control [EATC] module)
- 18 (20A) (no communication with THX(R) amplifier)
- 20 (15A) (no power to scan tool)
- 26 (10A) (no communication with instrument cluster)
- 28 (5A) (no communication with audio unit)
- 29 (5A) (no communication with instrument cluster)
- 34 (5A) (no communication with steering angle sensor module)
- 35 (10A) (no communication with parking aid module, 4WD control module)
- 37 (10A) (no communication with EATC module)
- 38 (20A) (no communication with THX(R) amplifier)
- 39 (20A) (no communication with audio unit)
- 41 (15A) (no communication with audio unit)
- 46 (7.5A) (no communication with restraints control module [RCM], occupant classification sensor
module)
- Data link connector (DLC)
- Wiring harness
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
3. If an obvious cause for an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible)
before proceeding to the next step.
4. NOTE: Make sure to use the latest scan tool software release.
If the cause is not visually evident, connect the scan tool to the DLC.
NOTE: The vehicle communication module (VCM) LED prove-out confirms power and ground from
the DLC are provided to the VCM.
If the scan tool does not communicate with the VCM: Check the VCM connection to the vehicle.
- Check the scan tool connection to the VCM.
- GO to Pinpoint Test U, to diagnose no power to the scan tool. See: Pinpoint Tests/Test U: No
Power To The Scan Tool
5. NOTE: During the network test, the scan tool will first attempt to communicate with the PCM,
after establishing communication with the PCM,
the scan tool will then attempt to communicate with all other modules on the vehicle.
Carry out the network test. If the network test passes, retrieve and record the continuous memory DTCs and proceed to Step
6.
- If the network test fails, GO to Symptom Chart to continue diagnosis for the module not
communicating. See: Symptom Related Diagnostic
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3121
Procedures
6. If the DTCs retrieved are related to the concern, go to the Communication Network DTC Chart.
For all other DTCs, refer to Body Control
Systems (Multifunction Electronic Control Module). See: Diagnostic Trouble Code
Descriptions/Module Communications Network
NOTE: Follow the non-network DTC diagnostics (B-codes, C-codes, P-codes) prior to the network
DTC (U-codes) diagnostics.
7. If no DTCs related to the concern are retrieved, GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Principles of Operation
PRINCIPLES OF OPERATION
Vehicle communication utilizes both medium and high speed controller area network (CAN)
communications. CAN is a method for transferring data among distributed electronic modules via a
serial data bus.
The vehicle is equipped with 2 module communication networks:
- High speed (HS) CAN
- Medium speed (MS) CAN
HS-CAN and MS-CAN
CAN is a communication network that uses an unshielded twisted pair cable of data (+) and data (-)
circuits. The data (+) and the data (-) circuits are each regulated to approximately 2.5 volts during
neutral or rested network traffic. As bus messages are sent on the data (+) circuit, voltage is
increased by approximately 1.0 volt. Inversely, the data (-) circuit is reduced by approximately 1.0
volt when a bus message is sent. Multiple bus messages can be sent over the network CAN
circuits allowing multiple modules to communicate with each other.
The MS-CAN network operates at a maximum data transfer speed of 125 Kbps for bus messages
and is designed for general information transfer. The HS-CAN network operates at a maximum
data transfer speed of 500 Kbps and is designed for real time information transfer and control.
Certain network faults may cause inconsistent message communication. The CAN network may
remain operational with only 1 of the 2 termination resistors present.
CAN Network Communication Fault Chart
The fault chart describes the specific CAN network failures and their resulting symptom.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3122
CAN Network Module Communication Message Chart (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3123
CAN Network Module Communication Message Chart (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3124
CAN Network Module Communication Message Chart (Part 3)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3125
CAN Network Module Communication Message Chart (Part 4)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3126
CAN Network Module Communication Message Chart (Part 5)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3127
CAN Network Module Communication Message Chart (Part 6)
NOTE: Some HS-CAN faults may result in a no-start condition.
Inspection and Verification
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
This provides step-by-step module configuration procedures. Carry out the programmable module
installation (PMI) procedure when another Vehicle System directs to carry out configuration or
when DTCs from the below list are present. See: Body Control Module/Service and Repair
Principles of Operation
PRINCIPLES OF OPERATION
Configurable modules accommodate a variety of vehicle options, eliminating the need for many
unique modules for one vehicle line. These modules must be configured when replaced as part of a
repair procedure.
Configurable modules should not be exchanged between vehicles since the settings are unique to
each vehicle. Failure to configure a new module may result in improper operation and/or any of the
following DTCs setting:
- B2477 and/or B2141 - sets when a body/chassis module is not configured.
- B2900 - sets when there is a VIN mismatch between the module with the B2900 and the PCM.
Either the PCM or the body module stored VIN may be incorrect.
- P0602, P0605 and/or P1639 - sets when the PCM vehicle identification (VID) block is not
configured or is configured incorrectly.
- U0300 and/or U0301 - sets when the configuration between 2 or more modules do not match.
- U2050 and/or U2051 - sets when a valid strategy/calibration is not present.
The following are the 3 different methods of configuration:
- Programmable module installation (PMI)
- Module reprogramming ("flashing")
- Programmable parameters
Some modules do not support all 3 methods.
Definition of Terms
The following are definitions of configuration terms:
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) PMI is a scan tool process which configures settings in a
new module. Data used for the PMI process is automatically downloaded from the original module
and stored when a scan tool session is started. If this data cannot be retrieved from the module
being replaced, the scan tool may prompt for As-Built data entry or display a list of parameter
values that need to be manually selected. Some modules are reprogrammed during PMI when a
strategy/calibration update is available.
NOTE: A module must be able to communicate with the scan tool in order to carry out PMI. It is
important that the scan tool identifies the vehicle and obtains configuration data prior to removing
any modules.
To carry out PMI, refer to Programmable Module Installation. See: Body Control Module/Service
and Repair
Module Reprogramming Module reprogramming (also referred to as "flashing") is a scan tool
process which updates the strategy/calibration in a module. Module reprogramming is
automatically carried out during PMI when a later strategy/calibration is available. Reprogramming
a module with the same level of software will not improve module operation or repair a hardware
failure.
NOTE: Module reprogramming should be limited to circumstances where a published Technical Service
Bulletin (TSB) procedure recommends doing so.
- A module cannot communicate with other modules on the communication network while being
reprogrammed. Clear any network communication DTCs which may have been set in other
modules during reprogramming.
Programmable Parameters Programmable parameters are customer preference items that may be
modified by the dealer via scan tool or in some cases modified by the customer following a
procedure listed in the vehicle Owner's Literature. While many configuration options may exist for a
module, only a few of these options are programmable parameters.
Adaptive Learning and Calibration
Some modules require a separate learning procedure be carried out if replaced as part of a repair
procedure. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal
and installation procedures.
Vehicle Identification (VID) Block
Some PCMs contain a memory area called a vehicle identification (VID) block. The PCM VID block
commonly stores powertrain configuration items
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3128
such as VIN, tire size, axle ratio, and whether or not the vehicle is equipped with speed control.
As-Built Data
As-Built data is a VIN specific module configuration record. During vehicle build, the configuration
from all modules is downloaded and stored in the As-Built database. As Built data will not reflect
customer preference items that have been changed from the default state. These items will need to
be changed using programmable parameters after the module is configured.
NOTE: It is not necessary to obtain As-Built data unless directed to do so by the scan tool. This
data may be accessed from the technician service publication website.
Body/Chassis Module Addresses For As-Built Entry
The chart lists body/chassis module As-Built data addresses.
Module Configuration And Parameter Index (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3129
Module Configuration And Parameter Index (Part 2)
The chart describes specific module programming information.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3130
Information Bus: Diagnostic Trouble Code Descriptions
U0002-U0102
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3131
U0115-U0155
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3132
U0155-U0197
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3133
U0208-U2023
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3134
U2023-U2511
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3135
B2477-B2900 / P0602-P1639 / U0300-U2050
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3136
U2051
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3137
Information Bus: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Symptom Chart (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3138
Symptom Chart (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3139
Symptom Chart (Part 3)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3140
Information Bus: Pinpoint Tests
Test A: The PCM Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST A: THE PCM DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
A1-A2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3141
A2-A3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3142
A4
Normal Operation
The PCM communicates with the scan tool through the high speed controller area network
(HS-CAN). Circuits VDB04 (WH/BU) (HS-CAN +) and VDB05 (WH) (HS-CAN -) provide the
network connection to the PCM. The PCM shares the HS-CAN network with the ABS module, the
restraints control module (RCM), the occupant classification sensor module, the four wheel drive
(4WD) control module (if equipped), the adaptive front lighting module (if equipped), the steering
angle sensor module (if equipped) and the instrument cluster.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- PCM
Test B: The ABS Module Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST B: THE ABS MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
B1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3143
B1-B3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3144
B4
Normal Operation
The ABS module communicates with the scan tool through the high speed controller area network
(HS-CAN). Circuits VDB04 (WH/BU) (HS-CAN +) and VDB05 (WH) (HS-CAN -) provide the
network connection to the ABS module. The ABS module shares the HS-CAN network with the
PCM, the restraints control module (RCM), the occupant classification sensor module, the four
wheel drive (4WD) control module (if equipped), the adaptive front lighting module (if equipped),
the steering angle sensor module (if equipped) and the instrument cluster. Voltage for the ABS
module is provided by circuits CBB50 (YE/OG), SBB57 (RD) and SBB15 (WH/RD). Ground is
provided by circuit GD121 (BK/YE).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- ABS module
Test C: The Restraints Control Module (RCM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST C: THE RESTRAINTS CONTROL MODULE (RCM) DOES NOT RESPOND TO
THE SCAN TOOL
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3145
C1-C3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3146
C4-C5
Normal Operation
The RCM communicates with the scan tool through the high speed controller area network
(HS-CAN). Circuits VDB04 (WH/BU) (HS-CAN +) and VDB05 (WH) (HS-CAN -) provide the
network connection to the RCM. The RCM shares the HS-CAN network with the PCM, the ABS
module, the occupant classification sensor module, the four wheel drive (4WD) control module (if
equipped), the adaptive front lighting module (if equipped), the steering angle sensor module (if
equipped) and the instrument cluster. Voltage for the RCM is provided by circuit CBP46 (WH/BU),
and the RCM is case grounded.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Case ground open
- RCM
Test E: The Occupant Classification Sensor Module Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST E: THE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SENSOR MODULE DOES NOT
RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3147
E1-E2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3148
E2-E3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3149
E4
Normal Operation
The occupant classification sensor module communicates with the scan tool through the high
speed controller area network (HS-CAN). Circuits VDB04 (WH/BU) (HS-CAN +) and VDB05 (WH)
(HS-CAN -) provide the network connection to the occupant classification sensor module. The
occupant classification sensor module shares the HS-CAN network with the PCM, the ABS
module, the four wheel drive (4WD) control module (if equipped), the restraints control module
(RCM), the adaptive front lighting module (if equipped), the steering angle sensor module (if
equipped) and the instrument cluster. Voltage to the occupant classification sensor module is
supplied by circuit CBP46 (WH/BU). Ground is supplied by circuit GD143 (BK/VT).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Occupant classification sensor module
Test F: The Adaptive Front Lighting Module Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST F: THE ADAPTIVE FRONT LIGHTING MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND TO
THE SCAN TOOL
F1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3150
F1-F2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3151
F3-F4
Normal Operation
The adaptive front lighting module communicates with the scan tool through the high speed
controller area network (HS-CAN). Circuits VDB04 (WH/BU) (HS-CAN +) and VDB05 (WH)
(HS-CAN -) provide the network connection to the adaptive front lighting module. The adaptive
front lighting module shares the HS-CAN network with the PCM, the ABS module, the four wheel
drive (4WD) control module (if equipped), the restraints control module (RCM), the occupant
classification sensor module, the steering angle sensor module (if equipped) and the instrument
cluster. Voltage to the adaptive front lighting module is supplied by circuit CBB51 (BN). Ground is
supplied by circuit GD120 (BK/GN).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Adaptive front lighting module
Test G: The Steering Angle Sensor Module Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST G: THE STEERING ANGLE SENSOR MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND TO
THE SCAN TOOL
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3152
G1-G2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3153
G2-G3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3154
G4
Normal Operation
The steering angle sensor module communicates with the scan tool through the high speed
controller area network (HS-CAN). Circuits VDB04 (WH/BU) (HS-CAN +) and VDB05 (WH)
(HS-CAN -) provide the network connection to the steering angle sensor module. The steering
angle sensor module shares the HS-CAN network with the PCM, the ABS module, the four wheel
drive (4WD) control module (if equipped), the restraints control module (RCM), the occupant
classification sensor module, the adaptive front lighting module (if equipped) and the instrument
cluster. Voltage to the steering angle sensor module is supplied by circuit CBP34 (VT/BN). Ground
is supplied by circuit GD115 (BK/GY).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Steering angle sensor module
Test H: The Instrument Cluster Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST H: THE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3155
H1-H3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3156
H4-H5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3157
H5-H6
Normal Operation
The instrument cluster communicates with the scan tool through the high speed controller area
network (HS-CAN). Circuits VDB04 (WH/BU) (HS-CAN +) and VDB05 (WH) (HS-CAN -) provide
the HS-CAN network connection to the instrument cluster and circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN
+) and VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -) provide the MS-CAN network connection to the instrument
cluster. The instrument cluster shares the HS-CAN network with the PCM, the ABS module, the
four wheel drive (4WD) control module (if equipped), the restraints control module (RCM), the
occupant classification sensor module, the adaptive front lighting module (if equipped) and the
steering angle sensor module (if equipped). The instrument cluster shares the MS-CAN network
with the smart junction box (SJB), the electronic automatic temperature control (EATC) module (if
equipped), the audio unit, the THX(R) amplifier (if equipped), the satellite radio receiver (if
equipped), the driver seat module (DSM) (if equipped), the climate controlled seat module (if
equipped), the power liftgate module (if equipped), the parking aid module (if equipped), and the
digital versatile disc (DVD) player (if equipped). Voltage for the instrument cluster is provided by
circuits CBP29 (WH/VT) and SBP26 (YE/RD). Circuit GD115 (BK/GY) provides ground.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Instrument cluster
Test I: The Smart Junction Box (SJB) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST I: THE SMART JUNCTION BOX (SJB) DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN
TOOL
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3158
I1-I2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3159
I3-I4
Normal Operation
The SJB communicates with the scan tool through the medium speed controller area network
(MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -) provide the
network connection to the SJB. The SJB shares the MS-CAN network with the instrument cluster,
the electronic automatic temperature control (EATC) module (if equipped), the audio unit, the
THX(R) amplifier (if equipped), the satellite radio receiver (if equipped), the driver seat module
(DSM) (if equipped), the climate controlled seat module (if equipped), the power liftgate module (if
equipped), the parking aid module (if equipped) and the digital versatile disc (DVD) player (if
equipped). Voltage for the SJB is provided by circuit CDC33 (VT/GN). Circuit GD133 (BK) provides
ground.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- SJB
Test J: The Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module Does Not Respond To The
Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST J: THE ELECTRONIC AUTOMATIC TEMPERATURE CONTROL (EATC)
MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3160
J1-J2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3161
J2-J3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3162
J4
Normal Operation
The EATC module communicates with the scan tool through the medium speed controller area
network (MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -)
provide the network connection to the EATC module. The EATC module shares the MS-CAN
network with the instrument cluster, the smart junction box (SJB), the audio unit, the THX(R)
amplifier (if equipped), the satellite radio receiver (if equipped), the digital versatile disc (DVD)
player, the driver seat module (DSM) (if equipped), the parking aid module (if equipped), the power
liftgate module and the climate controlled seat module (if equipped). Voltage for the EATC module
is provided by circuits CBP37 (WH) and SBP15 (WH/RD). Circuit GD115 (BK/GY) provides ground.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- EATC module
Test K: The Audio Unit Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST K: THE AUDIO UNIT DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
K1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3163
K1-K3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3164
K3-K4
Normal Operation
The audio unit communicates with the scan tool through the medium speed controller area network
(MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -) provide the
network connection to the audio unit. The audio unit shares the MS-CAN network with the
instrument cluster, the smart junction box (SJB), the electronic automatic temperature control
(EATC) module (if equipped), the THX(R) amplifier (if equipped), the satellite radio receiver (if
equipped), the digital versatile disc (DVD) player, the driver seat module (DSM) (if equipped), the
parking aid module (if equipped), the power liftgate module and the climate controlled seat module
(if equipped). Voltage for the audio unit is provided by circuits CBP28 (GY/VT), CBP41 (BU) and
SBP39 (WH/RD). Circuit GD114 (BK/BU) provides ground.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Audio unit
Test L: The THX(R) Amplifier Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST L: THE THX(R) AMPLIFIER DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3165
L1-L3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3166
L3-L4
Normal Operation
The THX(R) amplifier communicates with the scan tool through the medium speed controller area
network (MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -)
provide the network connection to the THX(R) amplifier. The THX(R) amplifier shares the MS-CAN
network with the instrument cluster, the smart junction box (SJB), the electronic automatic
temperature control (EATC) module (if equipped), the audio unit, the satellite radio receiver (if
equipped), the digital versatile disc (DVD) player, the driver seat module (DSM) (if equipped), the
power running board module (if equipped), the parking aid module (if equipped), the power liftgate
module (if equipped) and the climate controlled seat module (if equipped). Voltage for the THX(R)
amplifier is provided by circuits SBP38 (BN/RD) and SBP18 (YE/RD). Three circuits GD148
(BK/YE) provide ground.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- THX(R) amplifier
Test M: The Satellite Radio Receiver Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST M: THE SATELLITE RADIO RECEIVER DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN
TOOL
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3167
M1-M2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3168
M2-M3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3169
M4
Normal Operation
The satellite radio receiver communicates with the scan tool through the medium speed controller
area network (MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -)
provide the network connection to the satellite radio receiver. The satellite radio receiver shares the
MS-CAN network with the instrument cluster, the smart junction box (SJB), the electronic automatic
temperature control (EATC) module (if equipped), the audio unit, the THX(R) amplifier (if
equipped), the digital versatile disc (DVD) player (if equipped), the driver seat module (DSM) (if
equipped), the parking aid module (if equipped), the power liftgate module (if equipped) and the
climate controlled seat module (if equipped). Voltage for the satellite radio receiver is provided by
circuit CBP13 (GY/BN). Circuit GD148 (BK/YE) provides ground.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Satellite radio receiver
Test N: The Digital Versatile Disc (DVD) Player Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST N: THE DIGITAL VERSATILE DISC (DVD) PLAYER DOES NOT RESPOND TO
THE SCAN TOOL
N1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3170
N1-N3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3171
N3-N4
Normal Operation
The DVD player communicates with the scan tool through the medium speed controller area
network (MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -)
provide the network connection to the DVD player. The DVD player shares the MS-CAN network
with the instrument cluster, the smart junction box (SJB), the electronic automatic temperature
control (EATC) module (if equipped), the audio unit, the THX(R) amplifier (if equipped), the satellite
radio receiver (if equipped), the driver seat module (DSM) (if equipped), the parking aid module (if
equipped), the power liftgate module (if equipped) and the climate controlled seat module (if
equipped). Voltage for the DVD player is provided by circuit SBP03 (BU/RD). Circuit GD114
(BK/BU) provides ground.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- DVD player
Test O: The Driver Seat Module (DSM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST O: THE DRIVER SEAT MODULE (DSM) DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN
TOOL
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3172
O1-O3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3173
O3-O4
Normal Operation
The DSM communicates with the scan tool through the medium speed controller area network
(MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -) provide the
network connection to the DSM. The DSM shares the MS-CAN network with the instrument cluster,
the smart junction box (SJB), the electronic automatic temperature control (EATC) module (if
equipped), the audio unit, the THX(R) amplifier (if equipped), the satellite radio receiver (if
equipped), the parking aid module (if equipped), the power liftgate module (if equipped), the digital
versatile disc (DVD) player (if equipped) and the climate controlled seat module (if equipped).
Voltage for the DSM is provided by circuits SBP12 (GN/RD) and SBB60 (GN/RD). Circuits GD133
(BK) and GD145 (BK/BU) provide ground.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- DSM
Test P: The Climate Controlled Seat Module Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST P: THE CLIMATE CONTROLLED SEAT MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND TO
THE SCAN TOOL
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3174
P1-P2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3175
P3-P4
Normal Operation
The climate controlled seat module communicates with the scan tool through the medium speed
controller area network (MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG)
(MS-CAN -) provide the network connection to the climate controlled seat module. The climate
controlled seat module shares the MS-CAN network with the instrument cluster, the smart junction
box (SJB), the electronic automatic temperature control (EATC) module (if equipped), the audio
unit, the THX(R) amplifier (if equipped), the satellite radio receiver (if equipped), the parking aid
module (if equipped), the digital versatile disc (DVD) player (if equipped), the driver seat module
(DSM) (if equipped), and the power liftgate module (if equipped). Voltage for the climate controlled
seat module is provided by circuit SBB16 (VT/RD). Circuit GD145 (BK/BU) provides ground.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Climate controlled seat module
Test Q: The Parking Aid Module Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST Q: THE PARKING AID MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3176
Q1-Q2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3177
Q2-Q3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3178
Q4
Normal Operation
The parking aid module communicates with the scan tool through the medium speed controller
area network (MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -)
provide the network connection to the parking aid module. The parking aid module shares the
MS-CAN network with the instrument cluster, the smart junction box (SJB), the electronic automatic
temperature control (EATC) module (if equipped), the audio unit, the THX(R) amplifier (if
equipped), the satellite radio receiver (if equipped), the digital versatile disc (DVD) player (if
equipped), the driver seat module (DSM) (if equipped), the power liftgate module (if equipped) and
the climate controlled seat module (if equipped). Voltage for the parking aid module is provided by
circuit CBP35 (YE/GY). Circuit GD133 (BK) provides ground.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Parking aid module
Test R: The Power Liftgate Module Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST R: THE POWER LIFTGATE MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN
TOOL
R1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3179
R1-R3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3180
R3-R4
Normal Operation
The power liftgate module communicates with the scan tool through the medium speed controller
area network (MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -)
provide the network connection to the power liftgate module. The power liftgate module shares the
MS-CAN network with the instrument cluster, the smart junction box (SJB), the electronic automatic
temperature control (EATC) module (if equipped), the audio unit, the THX(R) amplifier (if
equipped), the satellite radio receiver (if equipped), the parking aid module (if equipped), the digital
versatile disc (DVD) player (if equipped), the driver seat module (DSM) (if equipped), and the
climate controlled seat module (if equipped). Voltage for the power liftgate module is provided by
circuits SBP14 (BN/RD) and SBB59 (BU/RD). Circuit GD149 (BK/GY) provides ground.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Power liftgate module
Test S: No Medium Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN) Communication, All Modules Are
Not Responding
PINPOINT TEST S: NO MEDIUM SPEED CONTROLLER AREA NETWORK (MS-CAN)
COMMUNICATION, ALL MODULES ARE
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3181
NOT RESPONDING
S1-S2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3182
S2-S4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3183
S5-S7
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3184
S7-S8
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3185
S9-S12
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3186
S12-S16
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3187
S16-S20
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3188
S20-S24
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3189
S24-S27
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3190
S27-S29
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3191
S29-S33
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3192
S33-S37
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3193
S37-S41
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3194
S41-S44
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3195
S45-S48
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3196
S49-S53
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3197
S54-S56
Normal Operation
The MS-CAN network uses an unshielded twisted pair cable, circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) and VDB07
(VT/OG) provide the network connection to all modules on the network. The smart junction box
(SJB), the instrument cluster, the electronic automatic temperature control (EATC) module (if
equipped), the audio unit, the THX(R) amplifier (if equipped), the satellite radio receiver (if
equipped), the digital versatile disc (DVD) (if equipped), the parking aid module (if equipped), the
power liftgate module (if equipped), the driver seat module (if equipped), and the climate controlled
seat module (if equipped) all communicate with the scan tool using the MS-CAN network.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- SJB
- Instrument cluster
- Audio unit
- DVD player (if equipped)
- EATC module (if equipped)
- Parking aid module (if equipped)
- Power liftgate module (if equipped)
- Satellite radio receiver (if equipped)
- THX(R) amplifier (if equipped)
- Driver seat module (DSM) (if equipped)
- Climate controlled seat module (if equipped)
Test T: No High Speed Controller Area Network (HS-CAN) Communication, All Modules Are Not
Responding
PINPOINT TEST T: NO HIGH SPEED CONTROLLER AREA NETWORK (HS-CAN)
COMMUNICATION, ALL MODULES ARE NOT RESPONDING
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3198
T1-T2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3199
T3-T4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3200
T5-T6
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3201
T7-T8
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3202
T8-T9
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3203
T10-T11
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3204
T12-T14
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3205
T14-T17
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3206
T17-T20
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3207
T21-T23
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3208
T23-T25
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3209
T25-T28
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3210
T28-T31
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3211
T32-T34
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3212
T35-T38
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3213
T39-T40
Normal Operation
The HS-CAN uses an unshielded twisted pair cable, circuits VDB04 (WH/BU) and VDB05 (WH).
The PCM, the ABS module, the restraints control module (RCM), the occupant classification sensor
module, the four wheel drive (4WD) control module (if equipped), the steering angle sensor module
(if equipped), the adaptive front lighting module (if equipped) and the instrument cluster all
communicate with the scan tool using the HS-CAN.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- PCM
- RCM
- ABS module
- Instrument cluster
- Occupant classification sensor
- 4WD control module (if equipped)
- Steering angle sensor module (if equipped)
- Adaptive front lighting module (if equipped)
Test U: No Power To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST U: NO POWER TO THE SCAN TOOL
U1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3214
U1-U3
Normal Operation
The scan tool is connected to the data link connector (DLC) to communicate with the high speed
controller area network (HS-CAN) and the medium speed controller area network (MS-CAN)
communications network. Voltage for the scan tool is provided by circuit SBP20 (GN/RD). Ground
is provided by circuits GD115 (BK/GY) and GD116 (BK/VT).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Scan tool
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3215
Information Bus: Programming and Relearning
PROGRAMMABLE MODULE INSTALLATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) Using The Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) When The
Original Module Is Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure be
carried out. For instructions, refer to the specific module removal and installation procedures.
1. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle as normal. 2. From the Toolbox icon, select Module
Programming and press the check mark. 3. Select Programmable Module Installation. 4. Select the
module that is being replaced. 5. Follow the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the OFF
position, and press the check mark. 6. Install the new module and press the check mark. 7. Follow
the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the ON position, and press the check mark. 8.
The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration Complete. 9.
Test module for correct operation.
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) Using The Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) When The
Original Module Is Not Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure be
carried out. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal
and installation procedures.
1. Install the new module. 2. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle as normal. 3. From the
Toolbox icon, select Module Programming and press the check mark. 4. Select Programmable
Module Installation. 5. Select the module that was replaced. 6. Follow the on-screen instructions,
turn the ignition key to the OFF position, and press the check mark. 7. Follow the on-screen
instructions, turn the ignition key to the ON position, and press the check mark. 8. If the data is not
available, the IDS displays a screen stating to contact the As-Built Data Center. Retrieve the data
from the technician service
publication website at this time and press the check mark.
9. Enter the module data and press the check mark.
10. The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration
Complete. 11. Test module for correct operation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 3216
Information Bus: Service and Repair
PROGRAMMABLE MODULE INSTALLATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) Using The Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) When The
Original Module Is Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure be
carried out. For instructions, refer to the specific module removal and installation procedures.
1. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle as normal. 2. From the Toolbox icon, select Module
Programming and press the check mark. 3. Select Programmable Module Installation. 4. Select the
module that is being replaced. 5. Follow the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the OFF
position, and press the check mark. 6. Install the new module and press the check mark. 7. Follow
the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the ON position, and press the check mark. 8.
The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration Complete. 9.
Test module for correct operation.
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) Using The Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) When The
Original Module Is Not Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure be
carried out. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal
and installation procedures.
1. Install the new module. 2. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle as normal. 3. From the
Toolbox icon, select Module Programming and press the check mark. 4. Select Programmable
Module Installation. 5. Select the module that was replaced. 6. Follow the on-screen instructions,
turn the ignition key to the OFF position, and press the check mark. 7. Follow the on-screen
instructions, turn the ignition key to the ON position, and press the check mark. 8. If the data is not
available, the IDS displays a screen stating to contact the As-Built Data Center. Retrieve the data
from the technician service
publication website at this time and press the check mark.
9. Enter the module data and press the check mark.
10. The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration
Complete. 11. Test module for correct operation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Tools and Equipment > Module Communications Network
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Tools and Equipment > Module Communications Network > Page 3219
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3223
C109
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3224
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Two Types Of Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3225
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the thermostat housing. 2. Remove the lower intake manifold. 3. Remove the coolant
tube.
- Discard the O-ring.
4. Disconnect the knock sensor (KS) electrical connector. 5. Remove the 2 bolts and the KS.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Lubricate the new O-ring with clean engine coolant.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 3229
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 3230
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP (MIL)
CHECK ENGINE, SERVICE ENGINE SOON, Or ISO Standard Engine Symbol
The MIL notifies the driver that the powertrain control module (PCM) has detected an on board
diagnostic (OBD) emission-related component or system concern. When this occurs, an OBD
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) sets.
- The MIL is located in the instrument cluster and is labeled CHECK ENGINE, SERVICE ENGINE
SOON or the international standards organization (ISO) standard engine symbol.
- The MIL is illuminated during the instrument cluster prove out for approximately 4 seconds.
- The MIL remains illuminated after instrument cluster prove out if: an emission-related concern and DTC exists.
- the PCM does not send a control message to the instrument cluster (applications with the MIL
controlled through the communication link).
- the PCM is operating in the hardware limited operation strategy (HLOS).
- The MIL remains off during the instrument cluster prove out if an indicator or instrument cluster
concern is present.
- To turn off the MIL after a repair, a reset command from the scan tool must be sent, or 3
consecutive drive cycles must be completed without a concern.
- For all MIL concerns, go to Symptom Charts. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
- If the MIL flashes at a steady rate, a severe misfire condition may exist.
- If the MIL flashes erratically, the PCM can reset while cranking if the battery voltage is low.
- The MIL flashes after a period of time with the key in the RUN position (engine not running) if
DTC P1000 is set.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE (MAP) SENSOR
Typical Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
The MAP sensor measures intake manifold absolute pressure. The PCM uses information from the
MAP sensor to measure how much exhaust gas is introduced into the intake manifold.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM
> Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM: Description and Operation
ENGINE OIL TEMPERATURE (EOT) SENSOR
Typical EOT Sensor
The EOT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The EOT sensor measures the temperature of the engine oil. The sensor is typically threaded into
the engine oil lubrication system. The PCM can use the EOT sensor input to determine the
following:
- On variable camshaft timing (VCT) applications the EOT input is used to adjust the VCT control
gains and logic for camshaft timing.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input in conjunction with other PCM inputs to determine oil
degradation.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input to initiate a soft engine shutdown. To prevent engine
damage from occurring as a result of high oil temperatures, the PCM has the ability to initiate a soft
engine shutdown. Whenever engine RPM exceeds a calibrated level for a certain period of time,
the PCM begins reducing power by disabling engine cylinders.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #11
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 3244
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 3245
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 3246
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #22
C141
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 3249
C142
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 3250
C171
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 3251
C172
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3252
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HO2S)
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
The HO2S detects the presence of oxygen in the exhaust and produces a variable voltage
according to the amount of oxygen detected. A high concentration of oxygen (lean air/fuel ratio) in
the exhaust produces a voltage signal less than 0.4 volt. A low concentration of oxygen (rich
air/fuel ratio) produces a voltage signal greater than 0.6 volt. The HO2S provides feedback to the
PCM indicating air/fuel ratio in order to achieve a near stoichiometric air/fuel ratio of 14.7:1 during
closed loop engine operation. The HO2S generates a voltage between 0.0 and 1.1 volts.
Embedded with the sensing element is the HO2S heater. The heating element heats the sensor to
a temperature of 800°C (1,472°F). At approximately 300°C (572°F) the engine can enter closed
loop operation. The VPWR circuit supplies voltage to the heater. The PCM turns the heater on by
providing the ground when the correct conditions occur. The heater allows the engine to enter
closed loop operation sooner. The use of this heater requires the HO2S heater control to be duty
cycled, to prevent damage to the heater.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HO2S)
RH Sensors
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 3255
LH Sensors
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
RH sensor
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
Both sensors
2. Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 3256
3. NOTE: If necessary, lubricate the sensor threads with penetrating and lock lubricant to assist in
removal.
Using the special tool, remove the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S). To install, tighten to 48 Nm (35 lb-ft).
4. NOTE: Apply a light coat of anti-seize lubricant to the threads of the heated oxygen sensor
(HO2S).
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 3257
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Catalyst Monitor Sensor
CATALYST MONITOR SENSOR
RH Sensors
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 3258
LH Sensors
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the catalyst monitor sensor
electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 3259
3. NOTE: If necessary, lubricate the sensor threads with penetrating and lock lubricant to assist in
removal.
Using the special tool, remove the catalyst monitor sensor. To install, tighten to 48 Nm (35 lb-ft).
4. NOTE: Apply a light coat of anti-seize lubricant to the threads of the catalyst monitor sensor.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3263
C1121
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Switch
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SWITCH
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
The PSP switch monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP switch
is a normally closed switch that opens as the hydraulic pressure increases. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the PSP circuit. When the PSP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The PCM uses the input signal from the PSP switch to compensate
for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the idle RPM and preventing engine stall during
parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP switch signals the PCM to adjust the transmission electronic
pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased engine load, for example during parking
maneuvers
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch > Page 3266
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Sensor
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SENSOR
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
The PSP sensor monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP
sensor voltage input to the PCM changes as the hydraulic pressure changes. The PCM uses the
input signal from the PSP sensor to compensate for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the
idle RPM and preventing engine stall during parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP sensor signals the
PCM to adjust the transmission electronic pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased
engine load, for example, during parking maneuvers.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust
Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description and Operation
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer
that monitors the differential pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly.
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as
the downstream pressure hose (REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI
and REF hose connections are marked on the differential pressure feedback EGR sensor housing
for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger diameter hose). The differential pressure
feedback EGR sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the metering
orifice and supplies it to the PCM as EGR flow rate feedback.
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR TUBE MOUNTED
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust
Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3270
The tube mounted differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is identical in operation as the large
plastic differential pressure feedback EGR sensors and uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF
hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Specifications
Torque Specifications
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driver Seat Module (DSM)
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Driver Seat Module (DSM)
DRIVER SEAT MODULE (DSM)
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driver Seat Module (DSM) >
Page 3277
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
NOTE: Prior to the replacement of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to the appropriate scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new module
after installation.
1. NOTE: This step is necessary only if the DSM is being replaced.
Upload the module configuration information from the DSM into the scan tool.
2. NOTE: If the driver seat can be moved to a high enough position, the DSM screws can be
removed without removing the driver seat.
If necessary, remove the driver seat.
3. Remove the 2 screws. 4. Disconnect the 4 electrical connectors and remove the DSM.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driver Seat Module (DSM) >
Page 3278
5. NOTE: Make sure to download the DSM configuration information from the scan tool into the
new DSM.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driver Seat Module (DSM) >
Page 3279
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Programmable Module Installation
PROGRAMMABLE MODULE INSTALLATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) Using the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) When the
Original Module is Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure be
carried out. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal
and installation procedures.
1. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle as normal. 2. From the Toolbox icon, select Module
Programming and press the check mark. 3. Select Programmable Module Installation. 4. Select the
module that is being replaced. 5. Follow the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the OFF
position, and press the check mark. 6. Install the new module and press the check mark. 7. Follow
the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the ON position, and press the check mark. 8.
The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration Complete. 9.
Test module for correct operation.
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) Using the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) When the
Original Module is NOT Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure be
carried out. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal
and installation procedures.
1. Install the new module. 2. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle as normal. 3. From the
Toolbox icon, select Module Programming and press the check mark. 4. Select Programmable
Module Installation. 5. Select the module that was replaced. 6. Follow the on-screen instructions,
turn the ignition key to the OFF position, and press the check mark. 7. Follow the on-screen
instructions, turn the ignition key to the ON position, and press the check mark. 8. If the data is not
available, the IDS displays a screen stating to contact the As-Built Data Center. Retrieve the data
from the technician service
publication website at this time and press the check mark.
9. Enter the module data and press the check mark.
10. The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration
Complete. 11. Test module for correct operation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
Electronic Throttle Control Module: Description and Operation
TORQUE BASED ELECTRONIC THROTTLE CONTROL (ETC)
Overview
The torque based ETC is a hardware and software strategy that delivers an engine output torque
(via throttle angle) based on driver demand (pedal position). It uses an electronic throttle body, the
powertrain control module (PCM), and an accelerator pedal assembly to control the throttle
opening and engine torque. The ETC system replaces the standard cable operated accelerator
pedal, idle air control (IAC) valve, 3-wire throttle position (TP) sensor, and mechanical throttle body.
Torque based ETC enables aggressive automatic transmission shift schedules (earlier upshifts and
later downshifts). This is possible by adjusting the throttle angle to achieve the same wheel torque
during shifts, and by calculating this desired torque, the system prevents engine lugging (low RPM
and low manifold vacuum) while still delivering the performance and torque requested by the driver.
It also enables many fuel economy/emission improvement technologies such as variable camshaft
timing (VCT) (deliver same torque during transitions).
Torque based ETC also results in less intrusive vehicle and engine speed limiting, along with
smoother traction control.
Other benefits of ETC are: eliminate cruise control actuators
- eliminate idle air control (IAC) valve
- better airflow range
- packaging (no cable)
- more responsive powertrain at altitude and improved shift quality
It should be noted that the ETC system illuminates a powertrain malfunction indicator (wrench) on
the instrument cluster when a concern is present. Concerns are accompanied by diagnostic trouble
codes (DTCs) and may also illuminate the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL).
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB)
The ETB has the following characteristics: 1. The throttle actuator control (TAC) motor is a DC
motor controlled by the PCM (requires 2-wires). The gear ratio from the motor to the throttle
plate shaft is 17:1.
2. There are 2 designs: parallel and in-series. The parallel design has the motor under the bore
parallel to the plate shaft. The motor housing is
integrated into the main housing. The in-series design has a separate motor housing.
3. Two springs are used: one is used to close the throttle (main spring) and the other is in a plunger
assembly that results in a default angle when no
power is applied. This is for limp home reasons (the force of the plunger spring is 2 times stronger
than the main spring). The default angle is usually set to result in a top vehicle speed of 48 km/h
(30 mph). Typically this throttle angle is 7 to 8 degrees from the hard-stop angle.
4. The closed throttle plate hard stop is used to prevent the throttle from binding in the bore (~0.75
degree). This hard stop setting is not adjustable
and is set to result in less airflow than the minimum engine airflow required at idle.
5. Unlike cable operated throttle bodies, the intent for the ETB is not to have a hole in the throttle
plate or to use plate sealant. The hole is not
required in the ETB because the required idle airflow is provided by the plate angle in the throttle
body assembly. This plate angle controls idle, idle quality, and eliminates the need for an IAC
valve.
6. The TP sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant throttle position
signals are required for increased monitoring
reasons. The first TP signal (TP1) has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and
the second signal (TP2) has a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal
operation the negative slope TP signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of
throttle position. The TP sensor assembly requires 4 circuits. 5-volt reference voltage
- Signal return (ground)
- TP1 voltage with negative voltage slope (5-0 volts)
- TP2 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensors
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
3283
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) And Accelerator Pedal Assembly
The ETC strategy uses pedal position sensors as an input to determine the driver demand. 1.
There are 3 pedal position signals required for system monitoring. APP1 has a negative slope
(increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and APP2 and
APP3 both have a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation
APP1 is used as the indication of pedal position by the strategy.
2. There are 2 VREF circuits, 2 signal return circuits, and 3 signal circuits (a total of 7 circuits and
pins) between the PCM and the APP sensor
assembly. 2 reference voltage circuits (5 volts)
- 2 signal return (ground) circuits
- APP1 voltage with negative voltage slope (5-0 volts)
- APP2 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
- APP3 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
3. The pedal position signal is convened to pedal travel degrees (rotary angle) by the PCM. The
software then converts these degrees to counts,
which is the input to the torque based strategy.
4. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a
concern. The PCM determines if a signal is
incorrect by calculating where it should be, inferred from the other signals. A value is substituted for
an incorrect signal if 2 of the 3 signals are incorrect.
Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) System Strategy
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
3284
ETC System
The torque based ETC strategy was developed to improve fuel economy and to accommodate
variable camshaft timing (VCT). This is possible by not coupling the throttle angle to the driver
pedal position. Uncoupling the throttle angle (produce engine torque) from the pedal position (driver
demand) allows the powertrain control strategy to optimize fuel control and transmission shift
schedules while delivering the requested wheel torque.
The ETC monitor system is distributed across 2 processors within the PCM: the main powertrain
control processor unit (CPU) and a monitoring processor called an enhanced-quizzer (E-Quizzer)
processor. The primary monitoring function is carried out by the independent plausibility check
(IPC) software, which resides on the main processor. It is responsible for determining the
driver-demanded torque and comparing it to an estimate of the actual torque delivered. If the
generated torque exceeds driver demand by a specified amount, the IPC takes appropriate
corrective action.
ETC System Failure Mode And Effects Management (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
3285
ETC System Failure Mode And Effects Management (Part 2)
Since the IPC and the main controller share the same processor, they are subject to a number of
potential common failure modes. The E-Quizzer processor was added to redundantly monitor
selected PCM inputs and to act as an intelligent watchdog and monitor the performance of the IPC
and the main processor. If it determines that the IPC function is impaired in any way, it takes
appropriate failure mode and effects management (FMEM) actions.
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation:
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
3286
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation (Part 2)
Accelerator and Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Inputs
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Check:
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Check
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Check:
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Check
Throttle Plate Position Controller (TPPC) Outputs
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
3287
Throttle Plate Controller Check Operation
The purpose of the TPPC is to maintain the throttle position at the desired throttle angle. It is a
separate chip embedded in the PCM. The desired angle is communicated from the main CPU via a
312.5 Hz duty cycle (DC) signal. The TPPC interprets the duty cycle signal as follows: Less than 4% - Out of range, limp home default position.
- Greater than or equal to 4% but less than 6% - Commanded default position, closed.
- Greater than or equal to 6% but less than 7% - Commanded default position. Used for key ON,
engine OFF.
- Greater than or equal to 7% but less than 8% - Enable ice breaker mode. Used to clear potential
ice buildup in the throttle body.
- Greater than or equal to 8% but less than 10% - Closed against hard-stop. Used to learn zero
throttle angle position (hard stop) after key-up.
- Greater than or equal to 10% but less than or equal to 92% - Normal operation, between 0
degrees (hard stop) and 82 degrees, 10% duty cycle equals 0 degrees throttle angle, 92% duty
cycle equals 82 degrees throttle angle.
- Greater than 92% but less than or equal to 96% - Wide open throttle, 82 to 86 degrees throttle
angle.
- Greater than 96% but less than or equal to 100% - Out of range, limp home default position.
The desired angle is relative to the hard-stop angle. The hard stop angle is learned during each
key-up process before the main CPU requests the throttle plate be closed against the hard stop.
The output of the TPPC is a voltage request to the H driver (also in PCM). The H driver is capable
of positive or negative voltage to the electronic throttle body motor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest
for Engine Control Module: > 09-11-15 > Jun > 09 > Engine Controls - Rough/Rolling Idle/Idle Speed Drop
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls - Rough/Rolling Idle/Idle Speed Drop
TSB 09-11-15
06/15/09
ROUGH / ROLLING IDLE / IDLE SPEED DROPS BELOW SPECIFICATION / LIGHT THROTTLE
WITH CRUISE ENGAGED / LOW SPEED TIP IN CLUNK
FORD: 2008-2009 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2009 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKX
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 8-23-5 to update the vehicle lines and Action statement.
ISSUE Some 2008-2009 Taurus, Taurus-X, Sable and 2007-2009 Edge and MKX vehicles may
exhibit a rough, rolling idle, or the idle speed dropping below specification. This condition typically
occurs most often in hot ambient temperatures with the A/C on when idling for extended periods.
Vehicles may also exhibit idle speed dropping below specification on light throttle application with
vehicle cruise control engaged and traveling down a hill or a low speed tip in clunk.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) to the latest calibration using IDS
release 61.05 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration
files may also be obtained at the website.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091115A 2008-2009 Taurus, Sable, 0.3 Hr.
Taurus X. 2007-2009 Edge, MKX: Reprogram The PCM, Authorization Decal Not Required. (Do
Not Use With 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest
for Engine Control Module: > 07-19-5 > Oct > 07 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0451
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0451
TSB 07-19-5
10/01/07
MIL ON DTC P0451
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles may exhibit a malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) on with
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0451 which may be caused by electromagnetic compatibility
(EMC) interference.
ACTION If normal Workshop Manual Diagnostics are unable to resolve the concern, install a
Capacitor/Jumper Harness Kit following the installation instruction sheet included with the kit.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071905A 2007 Edge/MKX: Install A 0.7 Hr.
Capacitor Jumper Harness Kit (Do Not Use With 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9C052 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 09-11-15 > Jun > 09 > Engine Controls - Rough/Rolling Idle/Idle Speed Drop
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Rough/Rolling Idle/Idle
Speed Drop
TSB 09-11-15
06/15/09
ROUGH / ROLLING IDLE / IDLE SPEED DROPS BELOW SPECIFICATION / LIGHT THROTTLE
WITH CRUISE ENGAGED / LOW SPEED TIP IN CLUNK
FORD: 2008-2009 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2009 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKX
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 8-23-5 to update the vehicle lines and Action statement.
ISSUE Some 2008-2009 Taurus, Taurus-X, Sable and 2007-2009 Edge and MKX vehicles may
exhibit a rough, rolling idle, or the idle speed dropping below specification. This condition typically
occurs most often in hot ambient temperatures with the A/C on when idling for extended periods.
Vehicles may also exhibit idle speed dropping below specification on light throttle application with
vehicle cruise control engaged and traveling down a hill or a low speed tip in clunk.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) to the latest calibration using IDS
release 61.05 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration
files may also be obtained at the website.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091115A 2008-2009 Taurus, Sable, 0.3 Hr.
Taurus X. 2007-2009 Edge, MKX: Reprogram The PCM, Authorization Decal Not Required. (Do
Not Use With 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 07-19-5 > Oct > 07 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0451
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0451
TSB 07-19-5
10/01/07
MIL ON DTC P0451
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles may exhibit a malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) on with
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0451 which may be caused by electromagnetic compatibility
(EMC) interference.
ACTION If normal Workshop Manual Diagnostics are unable to resolve the concern, install a
Capacitor/Jumper Harness Kit following the installation instruction sheet included with the kit.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071905A 2007 Edge/MKX: Install A 0.7 Hr.
Capacitor Jumper Harness Kit (Do Not Use With 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9C052 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3309
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3312
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3313
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3314
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3315
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3316
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3317
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3318
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3319
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3320
Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3321
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3322
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3323
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3324
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3325
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3326
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3327
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3328
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3329
Engine Control Module: Connector Views
C175B (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3330
C175B (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3331
C175E (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3332
C175E (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3333
C175T (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3334
C175T (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Powertrain Control Module
(PCM)
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
Removal
1. NOTE: PCM replacement DOES NOT require new keys or programming of keys.
Retrieve the module configuration. Carry out the module configuration retrieval steps of the
Programmable Module Installation procedure.
2. Disconnect the 3 powertrain control module (PCM) electrical connectors. 3. Remove the 2 nuts
and the PCM.
- Remove the gasket.
Installation
1. Install the gasket and the PCM. 2. Install the 2 PCM nuts.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. Connect the 3 PCM electrical connectors. 4. Restore the module configuration. Carry out the
module configuration restore steps of the Programmable Module Installation procedure. 5.
Reprogram the passive anti-theft system (PATS). Carry out the Parameter Reset procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Powertrain Control Module
(PCM) > Page 3337
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only
Memory (EEPROM)
FLASH ELECTRICALLY ERASABLE PROGRAMMABLE READ ONLY MEMORY (EEPROM)
Description
The EEPROM is contained in an integrated circuit (IC) internal to the powertrain control module
(PCM). The EEPROM contains the vehicle strategy including calibration information specific to the
vehicle, and is capable of being programmed or flashed repeatedly.
As part of the calibration there is an area referred to as the vehicle identification (VID) block. The
VID block is programmed when installing a new PCM as described under Programming the VID
Block for a Replacement PCM. Failure to carry out this procedure may generate DTCs P1635 or
P1639. The VID block in an existing PCM can also be tailored to accommodate various hardware
or parameter changes made to the vehicle since production. Failure to carry out this procedure
properly may generate DTC P1635, Tire/Axle Ratio out of Acceptable Range. An incorrect tire/axle
ratio is one of the main causes for DTC P1639. This is described under Making Changes to the VID
Block and also under Making Changes to the PCM Calibration. The VID block contains many items
used by the strategy for a variety of functions. Some of these items include the vehicle identification
number (VIN), octane adjust, fuel octane, fuel type, vehicle speed limit, tire size, axle ratio, the
presence of speed control, and 4-wheel drive electronic shift-on-the-fly (ESOF) versus manual
shift-on-the-fly (MSOF). Only items applicable to the vehicle hardware and supported by the VID
block is displayed on the scan tool.
When changing items in the VID block, the strategy places range limits on certain items such as
tire and axle ratio. The number of times the VID block may be reconfigured is limited. When this
limit is reached, the scan tool displays a message indicating the need to flash the PCM again to
reset the VID block.
Programming can be carried out by a local Ford dealer or any non-Ford facility. Refer to the scan
tool manufacturer's instruction manual for details.
Programming the VID Block for a Replacement PCM
A new PCM contains the latest strategy and calibration level for a particular vehicle. However, the
VID block is blank and needs programming. There are 2 procedures available. The first is an
automatic data transfer from the old PCM to the new PCM, and the second is manual data entry
into the new PCM.
Automatic data transfer is carried out if the old PCM is capable of communicating. This is done by
using a scan tool to retrieve data from the old PCM before removing it from the vehicle. The stored
data can then be downloaded to the new PCM after it has been installed.
Carry out manual data entry if the old module is damaged or incapable of communicating. Remove
and install a new PCM. Using a compatible scan tool, select and carry out the module/parameter
programming, referring to the scan tool manufacturer's instruction manual. Make certain that all
parameters are included. Failure to properly program tire size in revolutions per mile, (rev/mile
equals 63,360 divided by the tire circumference in inches), axle ratio, 4x4/4x2, and/or MSOF/ESOF
may result in DTCs P1635 and P1639. You may be instructed to contact the As-Built Data Center
for the information needed to manually update the VID block with the scan tool. Contact the center
only if the old PCM cannot be used or the data is corrupt. For Ford and Lincoln Mercury
technicians, contact your National Hotline or the Professional Technician Society (PTS) website for
As-Built data listed under the Service Publications Index. Non-Ford technicians use the
Motorcraft(R) website at www.motorcraft.com. From the Motorcraft(R) homepage, use the search
function to find the Module Programming or As-Built Data.
For Ford and Lincoln Mercury technicians, check the Programmable Module Installation link on the
PTS website for quick Programmable Module data information by vehicle.
Making Changes to the VID Block
A PCM which is programmed may require changes to be made to certain VID information to
accommodate the vehicle hardware. Refer to Module Reprogramming on the scan tool.
Making Changes to the PCM Calibration
At certain times, the entire EEPROM needs to be completely reprogrammed. This is due to
changes made to the strategy or calibration after production, or the need to reset the VID block
because it has reached its limit. Refer to Module Reprogramming on the scan tool.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 3341
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 3342
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3347
C2040
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3348
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION (APP) SENSOR
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
torque demand. There are 3 pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APPS1, has a negative
slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APPS2 and APPS3, both have a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APPS1 is used as
the indication of pedal position by the strategy. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There are 2 reference voltage circuits and 2
signal return circuits for the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3352
C128
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3353
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Diagram Of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot And Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3354
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. The current required to
maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow. The MAF sensor then
outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air mass. The PCM
calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired air/fuel ratio. This
input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC), shift and torque
converter clutch scheduling.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly. Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology with an integrated intake air
temperature (IAT) sensor. The hot wire electronic sensing element must be replaced as an
assembly. Replacing only the element may change the air flow calibration.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3355
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 2. Remove the 2 screws and
the MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position
Sensor 1
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position
Sensor 1 > Page 3360
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position
Sensor
C1366
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position
Sensor > Page 3363
C1367
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3364
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Typical Synchronizer Hall-Effect CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston
number 1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing
the sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil-on-plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP
signal to select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with 2 CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). They use the
second sensor to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2 as an input to the PCM.
There are 2 types of CMP sensors: the 3-pin connector Hall-effect type sensor and the 2-pin
connector variable reluctance type sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3365
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
RH sensor
1. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe.
LH sensor
2. Remove the air cleaner assembly.
Both sensors
3. Disconnect the camshaft position sensor (CMP) electrical connector. 4. Remove the bolt and the
CMP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
5. NOTE: Lubricate the CMP O-ring seal with clean engine oil.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Clutch Switch, ECM > Component Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION (CPP) SWITCH
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
The CPP switch is an input to the PCM indicating the clutch pedal position. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the CPP circuit. When the CPP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The CPP input to the PCM is used to detect a reduction in engine
load. The PCM uses the load information for mass air flow and fuel calculations.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR
Typical Thread Type ECT Sensor
The ECT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The ECT measures the temperature of the engine coolant. The PCM uses the ECT input for fuel
control and for cooling fan control. There are 3 types of ECT sensors, threaded, push-in, and
twist-lock. The ECT sensor is located in an engine coolant passage.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3375
C101
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3376
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid deceleration between teeth.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3377
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the LH catalytic converter. 3.
Remove the bolt, nut and the heat shield.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
4. Remove the rubber grommet cover. 5. Disconnect the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor
electrical connector. 6. Remove the bolt and the CKP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3381
C107
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3382
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Typical CHT Sensor
The CHT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with the temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as temperature increases., and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
The CHT sensor is installed in the cylinder head and measures the metal temperature. The CHT
sensor can provide complete engine temperature information and can be used to infer coolant
temperature. If the CHT sensor conveys an overheating condition to the PCM, the PCM initiates a
fail-safe cooling strategy based on information from the CHT sensor. A cooling system concern
such as low coolant or coolant loss could cause an overheating condition. As a result, damage to
major engine components could occur. Using both the CHT sensor and fail-safe cooling strategy,
the PCM prevents damage by allowing air cooling of the engine and limp home capability.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3383
Engine Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the lower intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the cylinder head temperature (CHT) sensor
electrical connector. 3. Remove and discard the CHT sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Do not reuse the CHT sensor, install a new sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL LEVEL INPUT (FLI)
The FLI is a communications network message. Most vehicle applications use a potentiometer type
FLI sensor connected to a float in the FP module to determine fuel level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Level Sensor
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Level Sensor
FUEL LEVEL SENSOR
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Level Sensor
> Page 3389
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Level Sensor
> Page 3390
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Level Sensor
> Page 3391
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- This procedure involves fuel handling. Be prepared for spillage at all times and always observe
fuel handling precautions. Failure to follow these instructions can result in personal injury.
1. Release the fuel system pressure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Level Sensor
> Page 3392
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3. Release the fuel tank filler cap and position aside.
4. Insert a suitable fuel drain tube into the fuel tank filler pipe until it reaches the fuel tank inlet
spout.
5. CAUTION: The fuel pump (FP) module and fuel level sensor will be below the fuel level in the
tank when the tank is full. Make sure to
drain 1/8 of the fuel capacity through the filler pipe prior to removing the fuel level sensor or fuel
spillage will occur.
Attach the fuel storage tanker to the fuel drain tube and remove any residual fuel remaining in the
fuel tank filler pipe.
6. Remove the rear seat. 7. Position the carpet and/or any insulation covering the fuel level sensor
access cover aside.
8. Remove the 4 screws and the fuel level sensor access cover.
9. Disconnect the fuel level sensor electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Level Sensor
> Page 3393
10. CAUTION: Place absorbant pads in the general work area in case of fuel spillage.
Release the lock tab, rotate the fuel level sensor counterclockwise approximately 1/4 turn and lift
upward.
11. CAUTION:
- The fuel level sensor must be handled carefully to avoid damage to the float arm.
- Carefully remove the fuel level sensor from the fuel tank to avoid fuel spillage inside the vehicle.
Carefully lift and remove the fuel level sensor from the fuel tank.
12. CAUTION: Inspect the mating surfaces of the fuel level sensor flange and the fuel tank O-ring
seal contact surfaces. Do not polish or
adjust the O-ring seal contact area of the fuel tank flange or the fuel tank. Install a new fuel level
sensor or fuel tank if the O-ring seal contact area is bent, scratched or corroded.
NOTE: To install, apply clean engine oil to the O-ring seal.
- Upon installation, properly seat and press down firmly on the fuel level sensor, rotate it clockwise
until the lock arrow on the sensor aligns with the notch on the tank. Torque should not exceed 15
Nm (11 lb-ft).
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Level Sensor
> Page 3394
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module
FUEL PUMP MODULE
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Level Sensor
> Page 3395
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Level Sensor
> Page 3396
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Level Sensor
> Page 3397
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
repairing or disconnecting any of the fuel system components, the fuel system pressure must be
relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel causing personal injury or a fire hazard.
All vehicles
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Level Sensor
> Page 3398
1. Release the fuel system pressure. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3. Release the fuel
tank filler cap and position aside.
4. Insert a suitable fuel drain tube into the fuel tank filler pipe until it reaches the fuel tank inlet
spout. 5. Attach the fuel storage tanker to the fuel drain tube and remove any residual fuel
remaining in the fuel tank filler pipe. 6. Remove the rear seat. 7. Position the carpet and/or any
insulation covering the fuel pump (FP) module access cover aside.
8. Remove the 4 screws and the FP module access cover.
9. Disconnect the FP module electrical connector.
10. Disconnect the fuel tank supply tube-to-FP module quick connect coupling.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Level Sensor
> Page 3399
11. CAUTION: Place absorbent pads on the floor pan in the immediate area in case of fuel spills.
Carefully remove the fuel pump (FP)
module from the vehicle to avoid fuel spillage inside the vehicle.
Using the special tool, remove the FP module lock ring retainer.
All wheel drive (AWD) vehicles
12. CAUTION: The fuel pump (FP) module must be handled carefully to avoid damage to the FP
module and/or float arm.
Carefully lift the FP module out of the fuel tank enough to access and disconnect the fuel tank
crossover tube-to-FP module quick connect coupling.
All vehicles
13. CAUTION: The fuel pump (FP) module will have residual fuel remaining internally, drain into a
suitable container.
Completely remove the FP module from the fuel tank.
14. CAUTION:
- Inspect the mating surfaces of the fuel pump (FP) module flange and the fuel tank O-ring seal
contact surfaces. Do not polish or adjust the O-ring seal contact area of the fuel tank flange or the
fuel tank. Install a new FP module or fuel tank if the O-ring seal contact area is bent, scratched or
corroded.
- Make sure to install a new fuel pump (FP) module O-ring seal. Install a new lock ring if it is bent,
damaged or corroded.
NOTE: To install, apply clean engine oil to the O-ring seal.
Remove the FP module O-ring seal.
15. NOTE: Make sure the alignment tab on the fuel pump (FP) module and the fuel tank meet
before tightening the FP module lock ring.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3403
C435
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3404
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL TANK PRESSURE (FTP) SENSOR
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
In-Line Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
The FTP sensor or in-line FTP sensor is used to measure the fuel tank pressure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3408
C128
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3409
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (IAT) SENSOR
Typical Stand-Alone/Non-Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensors
Typical Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Incorporated Into A Drop-in Or Flange-type
MAF Sensor
The IAT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The electrical
resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance increases
as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the sensor
terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The IAT provides air temperature information to the PCM. The PCM uses the air temperature
information as a correction factor in the calculation of fuel, spark, and air flow.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3410
The IAT sensor provides a quicker temperature change response time than the ECT or CHT
sensor.
Currently there are 2 design types of IAT sensors used, a stand-alone/non-integrated type and a
integrated type. Both types function the same, however the integrated type is incorporated into the
mass air flow (MAF) sensor instead of being a stand alone sensor.
Supercharged vehicles use 2 IAT sensors. Both sensors are thermistor type devices and operate
as described. One is located before the supercharger at the air cleaner for standard OBD/cold
weather input, while a second sensor (IAT2) is located after the supercharger in the intake
manifold. The IAT2 sensor located after the supercharger provides air temperature information to
the PCM to control spark and to help determine charge air cooler (CAC) efficiency.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3414
C109
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3415
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Two Types Of Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3416
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the thermostat housing. 2. Remove the lower intake manifold. 3. Remove the coolant
tube.
- Discard the O-ring.
4. Disconnect the knock sensor (KS) electrical connector. 5. Remove the 2 bolts and the KS.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Lubricate the new O-ring with clean engine coolant.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE (MAP) SENSOR
Typical Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
The MAP sensor measures intake manifold absolute pressure. The PCM uses information from the
MAP sensor to measure how much exhaust gas is introduced into the intake manifold.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM > Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM: Description and Operation
ENGINE OIL TEMPERATURE (EOT) SENSOR
Typical EOT Sensor
The EOT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The EOT sensor measures the temperature of the engine oil. The sensor is typically threaded into
the engine oil lubrication system. The PCM can use the EOT sensor input to determine the
following:
- On variable camshaft timing (VCT) applications the EOT input is used to adjust the VCT control
gains and logic for camshaft timing.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input in conjunction with other PCM inputs to determine oil
degradation.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input to initiate a soft engine shutdown. To prevent engine
damage from occurring as a result of high oil temperatures, the PCM has the ability to initiate a soft
engine shutdown. Whenever engine RPM exceeds a calibrated level for a certain period of time,
the PCM begins reducing power by disabling engine cylinders.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#11
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#11 > Page 3427
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#11 > Page 3428
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#11 > Page 3429
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#22
C141
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#22 > Page 3432
C142
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#22 > Page 3433
C171
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#22 > Page 3434
C172
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3435
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HO2S)
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
The HO2S detects the presence of oxygen in the exhaust and produces a variable voltage
according to the amount of oxygen detected. A high concentration of oxygen (lean air/fuel ratio) in
the exhaust produces a voltage signal less than 0.4 volt. A low concentration of oxygen (rich
air/fuel ratio) produces a voltage signal greater than 0.6 volt. The HO2S provides feedback to the
PCM indicating air/fuel ratio in order to achieve a near stoichiometric air/fuel ratio of 14.7:1 during
closed loop engine operation. The HO2S generates a voltage between 0.0 and 1.1 volts.
Embedded with the sensing element is the HO2S heater. The heating element heats the sensor to
a temperature of 800°C (1,472°F). At approximately 300°C (572°F) the engine can enter closed
loop operation. The VPWR circuit supplies voltage to the heater. The PCM turns the heater on by
providing the ground when the correct conditions occur. The heater allows the engine to enter
closed loop operation sooner. The use of this heater requires the HO2S heater control to be duty
cycled, to prevent damage to the heater.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S)
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HO2S)
RH Sensors
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) > Page 3438
LH Sensors
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
RH sensor
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
Both sensors
2. Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) > Page 3439
3. NOTE: If necessary, lubricate the sensor threads with penetrating and lock lubricant to assist in
removal.
Using the special tool, remove the heated oxygen sensor (HO2S). To install, tighten to 48 Nm (35 lb-ft).
4. NOTE: Apply a light coat of anti-seize lubricant to the threads of the heated oxygen sensor
(HO2S).
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) > Page 3440
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Catalyst Monitor Sensor
CATALYST MONITOR SENSOR
RH Sensors
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) > Page 3441
LH Sensors
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the catalyst monitor sensor
electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) > Page 3442
3. NOTE: If necessary, lubricate the sensor threads with penetrating and lock lubricant to assist in
removal.
Using the special tool, remove the catalyst monitor sensor. To install, tighten to 48 Nm (35 lb-ft).
4. NOTE: Apply a light coat of anti-seize lubricant to the threads of the catalyst monitor sensor.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3446
C1121
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Switch
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SWITCH
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
The PSP switch monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP switch
is a normally closed switch that opens as the hydraulic pressure increases. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the PSP circuit. When the PSP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The PCM uses the input signal from the PSP switch to compensate
for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the idle RPM and preventing engine stall during
parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP switch signals the PCM to adjust the transmission electronic
pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased engine load, for example during parking
maneuvers
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch > Page 3449
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Sensor
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SENSOR
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
The PSP sensor monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP
sensor voltage input to the PCM changes as the hydraulic pressure changes. The PCM uses the
input signal from the PSP sensor to compensate for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the
idle RPM and preventing engine stall during parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP sensor signals the
PCM to adjust the transmission electronic pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased
engine load, for example, during parking maneuvers.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer
that monitors the differential pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly.
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as
the downstream pressure hose (REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI
and REF hose connections are marked on the differential pressure feedback EGR sensor housing
for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger diameter hose). The differential pressure
feedback EGR sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the metering
orifice and supplies it to the PCM as EGR flow rate feedback.
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR TUBE MOUNTED
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 3453
The tube mounted differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is identical in operation as the large
plastic differential pressure feedback EGR sensors and uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF
hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE BODY (ETB) POSITION SENSOR
The ETB position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant ETB
position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB position sensor signal (TP1)
has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation the negative slope
ETB position sensor signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of throttle
position. The 2 ETB position sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1
signal has a concern. There is 1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor > Page 3458
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Typical TP Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases the corrosion resistance on the
terminals and increases the connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body.
As the TP sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, 4 operating conditions are determined by the PCM
from the TP. The operating conditions are:
- closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration)
- part throttle (includes cruise or moderate acceleration)
- wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on crank)
- throttle angle rate
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3463
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3464
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3465
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3466
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3467
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3468
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3469
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3470
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3471
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3472
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3473
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3474
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3475
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3476
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3477
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3478
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3479
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
3480
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
3481
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
3482
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
12. Disconnect the selector lever cable end from the manual lever.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
3483
13. Remove the nut and the manual lever.
14. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
15. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
16. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
3484
17. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
18. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
19. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle side cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
3485
20. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
21. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
22. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
3486
23. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when removing the solenoid body filter.
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
24. Remove the 10 bolts, the TR sensor detent spring and the main control valve body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
3487
25. Using a suitable tool, remove and discard the TR sensor locking pin.
26. NOTE: TR sensor removed for clarity.
Make sure that the park pawl actuator rod does not become disengaged from the park pawl and
the abutment by keeping the end of the park pawl actuator rod behind the machined valve body
mating surface of the transaxle case. If the park pawl actuator rod becomes disengaged from the
park pawl and the abutment, transaxle removal and disassembly is required to reinstall the actuator
rod.
27. CAUTION: Make sure that the park pawl actuator rod does not become disengaged from the
park pawl and the abutment or transaxle
removal and disassembly is required to reinstall the actuator rod.
Remove the TR sensor. 1
Slide the TR sensor down until the manual shaft is out of the transaxle case.
2 Rotate the TR sensor detent plate counterclockwise, as viewed from below until the plate rests
against the transaxle case, remove the park
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
3488
pawl actuating rod from the TR sensor and remove the TR sensor.
Installation
1. Install the TR sensor.
1 Position the park pawl actuating rod in the TR sensor.
2 Install the TR sensor in the transaxle case.
2. Using the special tool, install a new TR sensor locking pin.
3. NOTE: Make sure that the manual lever pin (part of the TR sensor) is correctly installed in the
manual valve.
Position the TSS, OSS and TR sensor wiring harnesses aside and install the main control valve
body, the TR sensor detent spring and the 10 bolts. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown. ^
Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
3489
4. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
5. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4
95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
3490
6. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
7. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
3491
8. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
9. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
10. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
11. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on
the inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
3492
12. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
13. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
3493
14. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
15. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
16. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
17. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
3494
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
18. Install the manual lever and the nut.
^ Tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs).
19. Connect the selector lever cable end to the manual lever.
20. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
21. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
3495
22. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
23. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
24. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
25. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
3496
26. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
27. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
28. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output
Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
OUTPUT SHAFT SPEED (OSS) SENSOR
The OSS sensor provides the PCM with information about the rotational speed of an output shaft.
The PCM uses the information to control and diagnose powertrain behavior. In some applications,
the sensor is also used as the source of vehicle speed. The sensor may be physically located in
different places on the vehicle, depending upon the specific application. The design of each speed
sensor is unique and depends on which powertrain control feature uses the information that is
generated.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output
Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor > Page 3501
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR (VSS)
Typical Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
The VSS is a variable reluctance or hall-effect sensor that generates a waveform with a frequency
that is proportional to the speed of the vehicle. If the vehicle is moving at a relatively low velocity,
the sensor produces a signal with a low frequency. As the vehicle velocity increases, the sensor
generates a signal with a higher frequency. The PCM uses the frequency signal generated by the
VSS (and other inputs) to control such parameters as fuel injection, ignition control,
transmission/transaxle shift scheduling, and torque converter clutch scheduling.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE BODY (ETB) POSITION SENSOR
The ETB position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant ETB
position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB position sensor signal (TP1)
has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation the negative slope
ETB position sensor signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of throttle
position. The 2 ETB position sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1
signal has a concern. There is 1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor > Page 3506
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Typical TP Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases the corrosion resistance on the
terminals and increases the connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body.
As the TP sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, 4 operating conditions are determined by the PCM
from the TP. The operating conditions are:
- closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration)
- part throttle (includes cruise or moderate acceleration)
- wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on crank)
- throttle angle rate
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3511
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3512
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3513
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3514
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3515
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3516
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3517
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3518
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3519
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3520
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3521
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3522
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3523
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3524
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3525
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3526
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3527
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3528
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3529
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3530
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
12. Disconnect the selector lever cable end from the manual lever.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3531
13. Remove the nut and the manual lever.
14. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
15. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
16. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3532
17. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
18. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
19. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle side cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3533
20. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
21. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
22. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3534
23. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when removing the solenoid body filter.
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
24. Remove the 10 bolts, the TR sensor detent spring and the main control valve body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3535
25. Using a suitable tool, remove and discard the TR sensor locking pin.
26. NOTE: TR sensor removed for clarity.
Make sure that the park pawl actuator rod does not become disengaged from the park pawl and
the abutment by keeping the end of the park pawl actuator rod behind the machined valve body
mating surface of the transaxle case. If the park pawl actuator rod becomes disengaged from the
park pawl and the abutment, transaxle removal and disassembly is required to reinstall the actuator
rod.
27. CAUTION: Make sure that the park pawl actuator rod does not become disengaged from the
park pawl and the abutment or transaxle
removal and disassembly is required to reinstall the actuator rod.
Remove the TR sensor. 1
Slide the TR sensor down until the manual shaft is out of the transaxle case.
2 Rotate the TR sensor detent plate counterclockwise, as viewed from below until the plate rests
against the transaxle case, remove the park
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3536
pawl actuating rod from the TR sensor and remove the TR sensor.
Installation
1. Install the TR sensor.
1 Position the park pawl actuating rod in the TR sensor.
2 Install the TR sensor in the transaxle case.
2. Using the special tool, install a new TR sensor locking pin.
3. NOTE: Make sure that the manual lever pin (part of the TR sensor) is correctly installed in the
manual valve.
Position the TSS, OSS and TR sensor wiring harnesses aside and install the main control valve
body, the TR sensor detent spring and the 10 bolts. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown. ^
Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3537
4. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
5. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4
95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3538
6. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
7. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3539
8. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
9. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
10. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
11. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on
the inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3540
12. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
13. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3541
14. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
15. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
16. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
17. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3542
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
18. Install the manual lever and the nut.
^ Tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs).
19. Connect the selector lever cable end to the manual lever.
20. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
21. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3543
22. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
23. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
24. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
25. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3544
26. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
27. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
28. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Variable Valve Timing Actuator: > 10-16-1 >
Aug > 10 > Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser DTC's Set
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Customer Interest Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser DTC's Set
TSB 10-16-1
08/30/10
3.5L / 3.7L ENGINE - VCT CODES P0011, P0012, P0021, P0022 - RUNS ROUGH OR MISSES VEHICLES BUILT ON OR BEFORE 12/15/2008
FORD: 2008-2009 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2009 Edge 2009 Flex
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2007-2009 MKX
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 09-13-10 to update Service Procedure and Part List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Edge, MKX, MKZ, 2008-2009 Taurus, Taurus X, Sable, 2009 Flex and
MKS vehicles equipped with a 3.5L or 3.7L engine and vehicle build date on or before 12/15/2008
may exhibit a malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) on and one or more diagnostic trouble codes
(DTCs) P0011, P0012, P0016, P0018, P0021, P0022. Vehicle may also exhibit rough idle or
misses.
ACTION Follow the service procedure steps to correct this condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Using IDS, verify DTCs are present.
2. Verify vehicle build date on or before 12/15/2008.
a. If the vehicle was built after 12/15/2008, this procedure does not apply, refer to the Powertrain
Controls/Emissions Diagnosis (PC/ED) manual
for further diagnosis.
b. If the vehicle was built on or before 12/15/2008 and has any Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT)
DTCs P0011, P0012, P0016, P0018, P0021,
P0022 proceed to Step 3.
3. Remove both cam covers. Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 303-01.
4. Inspect the part number on the front of the camshaft phaser. You may need to rotate the engine
crank to move the phasers in position. The left cam
phaser should be 7T4E-6C524-EC and the right cam phaser should be 8T4E-6C524-AC.
a. If either one or both don't match the updated part numbers replace the phaser(s). Refer to WSM,
Section 303-01.
b. If both camshaft phasers have the updated part numbers, this procedure does not apply and
refer to the PC/ED manual for further diagnosis.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Variable Valve Timing Actuator: > 10-16-1 >
Aug > 10 > Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser DTC's Set > Page 3553
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101601A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 7.5 Hrs.
3.5L DOHC: Check DTCs, Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer
(Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101601A 2007-2009 MKZ FWD 3.5L 10.0
DOHC: Check DTCs, Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101601A 2007-2009 MKZ AWD 3.5L 10.3
DOHC: Check DTCs Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101601A 2008-2009 Taurus, Sable, 6.9 Hrs.
Taurus X 3.5L DOHC 2009 MKS 3.7L: Check DTCs, Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace
The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101601A 2009 Flex: Check DTCs, 7.0 Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101601B 2009 Flex: Check DTCs, 7.2 Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any
Other Labor Operations)
101601B 2008-2009 Taurus, Sable, 7.0 Hrs.
Taurus X 3.5L DOHC 2009 MKS 3.7L: Check DTCs Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace
Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101601B 2007-2009 MKZ AWD 3.5L 10.4
DOHC: Check DTCs, Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any
Other Labor Operations)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Variable Valve Timing Actuator: > 10-16-1 >
Aug > 10 > Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser DTC's Set > Page 3554
101601B 2007-2009 MKZ FWD 3.5L 10.2
DOHC:Check DTCs, Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any
Other Labor Operations)
101601B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 7.7 Hrs.
3.5L DOHC: Check DTCs, Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left
Phazers (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
6A257 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Variable Valve Timing Actuator: >
10-16-1 > Aug > 10 > Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser DTC's Set
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser
DTC's Set
TSB 10-16-1
08/30/10
3.5L / 3.7L ENGINE - VCT CODES P0011, P0012, P0021, P0022 - RUNS ROUGH OR MISSES VEHICLES BUILT ON OR BEFORE 12/15/2008
FORD: 2008-2009 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2009 Edge 2009 Flex
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2007-2009 MKX
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 09-13-10 to update Service Procedure and Part List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Edge, MKX, MKZ, 2008-2009 Taurus, Taurus X, Sable, 2009 Flex and
MKS vehicles equipped with a 3.5L or 3.7L engine and vehicle build date on or before 12/15/2008
may exhibit a malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) on and one or more diagnostic trouble codes
(DTCs) P0011, P0012, P0016, P0018, P0021, P0022. Vehicle may also exhibit rough idle or
misses.
ACTION Follow the service procedure steps to correct this condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Using IDS, verify DTCs are present.
2. Verify vehicle build date on or before 12/15/2008.
a. If the vehicle was built after 12/15/2008, this procedure does not apply, refer to the Powertrain
Controls/Emissions Diagnosis (PC/ED) manual
for further diagnosis.
b. If the vehicle was built on or before 12/15/2008 and has any Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT)
DTCs P0011, P0012, P0016, P0018, P0021,
P0022 proceed to Step 3.
3. Remove both cam covers. Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 303-01.
4. Inspect the part number on the front of the camshaft phaser. You may need to rotate the engine
crank to move the phasers in position. The left cam
phaser should be 7T4E-6C524-EC and the right cam phaser should be 8T4E-6C524-AC.
a. If either one or both don't match the updated part numbers replace the phaser(s). Refer to WSM,
Section 303-01.
b. If both camshaft phasers have the updated part numbers, this procedure does not apply and
refer to the PC/ED manual for further diagnosis.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Variable Valve Timing Actuator: >
10-16-1 > Aug > 10 > Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser DTC's Set > Page 3560
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101601A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 7.5 Hrs.
3.5L DOHC: Check DTCs, Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer
(Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101601A 2007-2009 MKZ FWD 3.5L 10.0
DOHC: Check DTCs, Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101601A 2007-2009 MKZ AWD 3.5L 10.3
DOHC: Check DTCs Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101601A 2008-2009 Taurus, Sable, 6.9 Hrs.
Taurus X 3.5L DOHC 2009 MKS 3.7L: Check DTCs, Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace
The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101601A 2009 Flex: Check DTCs, 7.0 Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace The Right Or Left Phazer (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101601B 2009 Flex: Check DTCs, 7.2 Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any
Other Labor Operations)
101601B 2008-2009 Taurus, Sable, 7.0 Hrs.
Taurus X 3.5L DOHC 2009 MKS 3.7L: Check DTCs Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace
Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101601B 2007-2009 MKZ AWD 3.5L 10.4
DOHC: Check DTCs, Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any
Other Labor Operations)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Variable Valve Timing Actuator: >
10-16-1 > Aug > 10 > Engine - MIL ON/Camshaft Phaser DTC's Set > Page 3561
101601B 2007-2009 MKZ FWD 3.5L 10.2
DOHC:Check DTCs, Hrs.
Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left Phazers (Do Not Use With Any
Other Labor Operations)
101601B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 7.7 Hrs.
3.5L DOHC: Check DTCs, Inspect Both Phaser Part Numbers, Replace Both Right And Left
Phazers (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
6A257 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Valve 1
C1451
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Valve 1 > Page 3564
C1452
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3565
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Description and Operation
VARIABLE CAMSHAFT TIMING (VCT) SYSTEM
Overview
The VCT enables rotation of the camshaft(s) relative to the crankshaft rotation as a function of
engine operating conditions. There are 4 types of VCT systems. Exhaust phase shifting (EPS) system - the exhaust cam is the active cam being retarded.
- Intake phase shifting (IPS) system - the intake cam is the active cam being advanced.
- Dual equal phase shifting (DEPS) system - both intake and exhaust cams are phase shifted and
equally advanced or retarded.
- Dual independent phase shifting (DIPS) system - where both the intake and exhaust cams are
shifted independently.
All systems have 4 operational modes: idle, part throttle, wide open throttle (WOT), and default
mode. At idle and low engine speeds with closed throttle, the powertrain control module (PCM)
determines the phase angle based on air flow, engine oil temperature and engine coolant
temperature. At part and wide open throttle the PCM determines the phase angle based on engine
RPM, load, and throttle position. VCT systems provide reduced emissions and enhanced engine
power, fuel economy and idle quality. IPS systems also have the added benefit of improved torque.
In addition, some VCT system applications can eliminate the need for an external exhaust gas
recirculation (EGR) system. The elimination of the EGR system is accomplished by controlling the
overlap time between the intake valve opening and exhaust valve closing. Currently, both the IPS
and DEPS systems are used.
Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) System
VCT System
The VCT system consists of an electric hydraulic positioning control solenoid, a camshaft position
(CMP) sensor, and a trigger wheel. The CMP trigger wheel has a number of equally spaced teeth
equal to the number (n) of cylinders on a bank plus one extra tooth (n+1). Four cylinder and V8
engines use a CMP 4+1 tooth trigger wheel. V6 engines use a CMP 3+1 tooth trigger wheel. The
extra tooth placed between the equally spaced teeth represents the CMP signal for that bank. A
crankshaft position sensor (CKP) provides the PCM with crankshaft positioning information in 10
degree increments. 1. The PCM receives input signals from the intake air temperature (IAT)
sensor, engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor, engine oil temperature
(EOT) sensor, CMP, throttle position (TP) sensor, mass air flow (MAF) sensor, and CKP to
determine the operating conditions of the engine. At idle and low engine speeds with closed
throttle, the PCM controls the camshaft position based on ECT, EOT, IAT, and MAF. During part
and wide open throttle, the camshaft position is determined by engine RPM, load and throttle
position. The VCT system does not operate until the engine is at normal operating temperature.
2. The VCT system is enabled by the PCM when the correct conditions are met. 3. The CKP signal
is used as a reference for CMP positioning. 4. The VCT solenoid valve is an integral part of the
VCT system. The solenoid valve controls the flow of engine oil in the VCT actuator assembly.
As the PCM controls the duty cycle of the solenoid valve, oil pressure/flow advances or retards the
cam timing. Duty cycles near 0% or 100% represent rapid movement of the camshaft. Retaining a
fixed camshaft position is accomplished by dithering (oscillating) the solenoid valve duty cycle.
The PCM calculates and determines the desired camshaft position. It continually updates the VCT
solenoid duty cycle until the desired position is achieved. A difference between the desired and
actual camshaft position represents a position error in the PCM VCT control loop. The PCM
disables the VCT and places the camshaft in a default position if a concern is detected. A related
DTC is also set when the concern is detected.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3566
5. When the VCT solenoid is energized, engine oil is allowed to flow to the VCT actuator assembly
which advances or retards the camshaft timing.
One half of the VCT actuator is coupled to the camshaft and the other half is connected to the
timing chain. Oil chambers between the 2 halves couple the camshaft to the timing chain. When
the flow of oil is shifted from one side of the chamber to the other, the differential change in oil
pressure forces the camshaft to rotate in either an advance or retard position depending on the oil
flow.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Solenoid >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid: Service and Repair
VARIABLE CAMSHAFT TIMING (VCT) OIL CONTROL SOLENOID
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the LH or RH valve cover. 2. Remove the bolt and the variable camshaft timing (VCT)
oil control solenoid.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
OUTPUT SHAFT SPEED (OSS) SENSOR
The OSS sensor provides the PCM with information about the rotational speed of an output shaft.
The PCM uses the information to control and diagnose powertrain behavior. In some applications,
the sensor is also used as the source of vehicle speed. The sensor may be physically located in
different places on the vehicle, depending upon the specific application. The design of each speed
sensor is unique and depends on which powertrain control feature uses the information that is
generated.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor > Page 3574
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR (VSS)
Typical Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
The VSS is a variable reluctance or hall-effect sensor that generates a waveform with a frequency
that is proportional to the speed of the vehicle. If the vehicle is moving at a relatively low velocity,
the sensor produces a signal with a low frequency. As the vehicle velocity increases, the sensor
generates a signal with a higher frequency. The PCM uses the frequency signal generated by the
VSS (and other inputs) to control such parameters as fuel injection, ignition control,
transmission/transaxle shift scheduling, and torque converter clutch scheduling.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Diverter Solenoid >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Air Diverter Solenoid: Description and Operation
SECONDARY AIR INJECTION (AIR) BYPASS SOLENOID
Secondary AIR Bypass Solenoid
The secondary AIR bypass solenoid is used by the PCM to control vacuum to the secondary air
injection diverter (AIR diverter) valve. The secondary AIR bypass solenoid is a normally closed
solenoid. The secondary AIR bypass solenoid also has a filtered vent feature to permit vacuum
release.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Diverter Valve >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Air Diverter Valve: Description and Operation
SECONDARY AIR DIVERTER VALVE
Secondary AIR Diverter Valve
The secondary AIR diverter valve is used with the secondary AIR pump to provide on/off control of
air to the exhaust manifold and catalytic converter. When the secondary AIR pump is on and
vacuum is supplied to the AIR diverter valve, air passes the integral check valve disk. When the
secondary AIR pump is off, and vacuum is removed from the AIR diverter valve, the integral check
valve disk is held on the seat and stops air from being drawn into the exhaust system and prevents
the back flow of the exhaust into the secondary AIR system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Injection Pump >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Air Injection Pump: Description and Operation
SECONDARY AIR PUMP
Secondary Air Pump
The secondary AIR pump provides pressurized air to the secondary AIR system. The secondary
AIR pump functions independently of RPM and is controlled by the PCM. The secondary AIR pump
is only used for short periods of time. Delivery of air is dependent on the amount of system
backpressure and system voltage. The secondary AIR pump draws dry filtered air from the intake
air system downstream of the MAF/IAT sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Catalytic Converter: Description and Operation
CATALYST AND EXHAUST SYSTEMS
Overview
V-Engines
In-Line Engines
The catalytic converter and exhaust Systems work together to control the release of harmful engine
exhaust emissions into the atmosphere. The engine exhaust gas consists mainly of nitrogen (N),
carbon dioxide (CO2) and water vapor (H2O) However, it also contains carbon monoxide (CO),
oxides of nitrogen (NOx), hydrogen (H), and various unburned hydrocarbons (HCs). The major air
pollutants of CO, NOx, and HCs, and their emission into the atmosphere must be controlled.
The exhaust system generally consists of an exhaust manifold, front exhaust pipe, front heated
oxygen sensor (HO2S), rear exhaust pipe, catalyst HO2S, a muffler, and an exhaust tailpipe. The
catalytic converter is typically installed between the front and rear exhaust pipes. On some vehicle
applications, more than one catalyst is used between the front and rear exhaust pipes. Catalytic
converter efficiency is monitored by the on board diagnostic (OBD) system strategy in the PCM.
For information on the OBD catalyst monitor, refer to the description for the Catalyst Efficiency
Monitor. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Monitors, Trips, Drive
Cycles and Readiness Codes/Monitors/Catalyst Efficiency Monitor
The number of HO2Ss used in the exhaust stream and the location of these sensors depend on the
vehicle emission certification level (LEV, LEV-II, ULEV, PZEV). On most vehicles only 2 HO2Ss are
used in an exhaust stream. The front sensors (HO2S11/HO2S21) before the catalyst are used for
primary fuel control while the ones after the catalyst (HO2S12/HO2S22) are used to monitor
catalyst efficiency. However, some partial zero emission vehicles (PZEV) use 3 HO2Ss for each
engine bank. The stream 1 sensors (HO2S11/HO2S21) located before the catalyst are used for
primary fuel control, the stream 2 sensors (HO2S12/HO2S22) are used to monitor the light-off
catalyst, and the stream 3 sensors (HO2S13/HO2S23) located after the catalyst are used for long
term fuel trim control to optimize catalyst efficiency (fore aft oxygen sensor control). Current PZEV
vehicles use only a 4-cylinder engine, so only the bank 1 HO2Ss are used.
Catalytic Converter
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3589
A catalyst is a material that remains unchanged when it initiates and increases the speed of a
chemical reaction. A catalyst also enables a chemical reaction to occur at a lower temperature. The
concentration of exhaust gas products released to the atmosphere must be controlled. The
catalytic converter assists in this task. It contains a catalyst in the form of a specially treated
ceramic honeycomb structure saturated with catalytically active precious metals. As the exhaust
gases come in contact with the catalyst, they are changed into mostly harmless products. The
catalyst initiates and speeds up heat producing chemical reactions of the exhaust gas components
so they are used up as much as possible.
Light Off Catalyst
As the catalyst heats up, converter efficiency rises rapidly. The point at which conversion efficiency
exceeds 50% is called catalyst light off. For most catalysts this point occurs at 246°C to 302°C
(475°F to 575°F). A fast light catalyst is a 3-way catalyst (TWC) that is located as close to the
exhaust manifold as possible. Because the light off catalyst is located close to the exhaust manifold
it lights off faster and reduces emissions more quickly than the catalyst located under the body.
Once the catalyst lights off, the catalyst quickly reaches the maximum conversion efficiency for that
catalyst.
Three-Way Catalyst (TWC) Conversion Efficiency
TWC Conversion Efficiency Chart
A TWC requires a stoichiometric fuel ratio, 14.7 pounds of air to 1 pound of fuel (14.7:1), for high
conversion efficiency. In order to achieve these high efficiencies, the air/fuel ratio must be tightly
controlled with a narrow window of stoichiometry. Deviations outside of this window greatly
decrease the conversion efficiency. For example a rich mixture decreases the HC and CO
conversion efficiency while a lean mixture decreases the NOx conversion efficiency.
Exhaust System
Typical Bank 1 Catalyst 2 HO2S Configuration
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3590
Typical Bank 1 Catalyst 3 HO2S Configuration
The purpose of the exhaust system is to convey engine emissions from the exhaust manifold to the
atmosphere. Engine exhaust emissions are directed from the engine exhaust manifold to the
catalytic converter through the front exhaust pipe. A HO2S is mounted on the front exhaust pipe
before the catalyst. The catalytic converter reduces the concentration of CO, unburned HCs, and
NOx in the exhaust emissions to an acceptable level. The reduced exhaust emissions are directed
from the catalytic converter past another HO2S mounted in the rear exhaust pipe and then on into
the muffler. Finally, the exhaust emissions are directed to the atmosphere through an exhaust
tailpipe.
On some PZEV, there is a total of 3 HO2S in the exhaust stream. One near the exhaust manifold
(stream 1), one in the middle of the light-off catalyst (stream 2), and the third (stream 3) is mounted
after the light-off catalyst.
Underbody Catalyst
The underbody catalyst is located after the light off catalyst. The underbody catalyst may be in line
with the light off catalyst, or the underbody catalyst may be common to 2 light off catalysts, forming
a Y pipe configuration. For an exact configuration of the catalyst and exhaust system for a specific
vehicle, refer to Catalytic Converter, Exhaust System.
Three-Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter
The TWC converter contains either platinum (Pt) and rhodium (Rh) or palladium (Pd) and rhodium
(Rh). The TWC converter catalyzes the oxidation reactions of unburned HCs and CO and the
reduction reaction of NOx. The 3-way conversion can be best accomplished by always operating
the engine air fuel/ratio at or close to stoichiometry.
Exhaust Manifold Runners
The exhaust manifold runners collect exhaust gases from engine cylinders. The number of exhaust
manifolds and exhaust manifold runners depends on the engine configuration and number of
cylinders.
Exhaust Pipes
Exhaust pipes are usually treated during manufacturing with an anti-corrosive coating agent to
increase the life of the product. The pipes serve as guides for the flow of exhaust gases from the
engine exhaust manifold through the catalytic converter and the muffler.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
The HO2Ss provide the powertrain control module (PCM) with voltage and frequency information
related to the oxygen content of the exhaust gas.
Muffler
Mufflers are usually treated during manufacturing with an anti-corrosive coating agent to increase.
the life of the product. The muffler reduces the level of noise produced by the engine, and also
reduces the noise produced by exhaust gases as they travel from the catalytic converter to the
atmosphere.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Catalytic Converter - LH
Catalytic Converter: Service and Repair Catalytic Converter - LH
Catalytic Converter - LH
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: If necessary, the catalytic converter heat shield can be serviced separately.
NOTE: Always install new fasteners and gaskets. Clean flange faces prior to new gasket
installation to make sure of correct sealing.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
2. Disconnect the catalyst monitor sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the exhaust Y-pipe. 4.
Remove the 2 catalytic converter support bracket-to-transmission bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs).
5. Remove the 4 nuts and the LH catalytic converter.
^ Discard the 4 LH catalytic converter nuts and gasket.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Install a new gasket and nuts.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Catalytic Converter - LH > Page 3593
Catalytic Converter: Service and Repair Catalytic Converter - RH
Catalytic Converter - RH
All vehicles
1. NOTE: If necessary, the catalytic converter heat shield can be serviced separately.
NOTE: Always install new fasteners and gaskets. Clean flange faces prior to new gasket
installation to make sure of correct sealing.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
2. Remove the catalyst monitor sensor. For additional information, refer to Computers and Control
Systems. 3. Remove the exhaust Y-pipe.
All wheel drive (AWD)
4. Remove and discard the 4 universal joint (U-joint) flange bolts and separate the front driveshaft
and secure it with a length of mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 70 Nm (52 ft. lbs).
5. Remove the RH halfshaft assembly. 6. Remove the 2 catalytic converter support
bracket-to-engine block bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
Front wheel drive (FWD)
7. Remove the 2 bolts and the power steering rack shield.
^ To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs).
8. Remove the catalytic converter support bracket-to-engine block bolt and nut.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
All vehicles
9. Remove the 2 nuts and the roll restrictor shield.
^ To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Catalytic Converter - LH > Page 3594
10. Remove the roll restrictor bolt and rotate the engine forward.
^ To install, tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs).
11. Remove the 2 bracket-to-RH catalytic converter bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs).
12. Remove the 4 nuts and the RH catalytic converter.
^ Discard the 4 RH catalytic converter nuts and gasket.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
13. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Install a new gasket and nuts.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Diagrams
C1195
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3599
Canister Purge Control Valve: Description and Operation
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) CANISTER PURGE VALVE
Typical EVAP Canister Purge Valve
NOTE: The EVAP canister purge valve may also be referred to as a vapor management valve
(VMV).
The EVAP canister purge valve is part of the enhanced EVAP system that is controlled by the
PCM. This valve controls the flow of vapors (purging) from the EVAP canister to the intake manifold
during various engine operating modes. The EVAP canister purge valve is a normally closed valve.
The EVAP canister purge valve controls the flow of vapors by way of a solenoid, eliminating the
need for an electronic vacuum regulator and vacuum diaphragm. The PCM outputs a signal
between 0 mA and 1,000 mA to control the EVAP canister purge valve.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3600
Canister Purge Control Valve: Service and Repair
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CANISTER PURGE VALVE
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The evaporative emission system contains fuel vapor and condensed fuel vapor. Although not
present in large quantities, it still presents the danger of explosion or fire. Disconnect the battery
ground cable from the battery to minimize the possibility of an electrical spark occurring, which can
cause a fire or explosion if fuel vapor or liquefied fuel are present in the area. Failure to follow
these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Disconnect the evaporative emission (EVAP) canister purge valve electrical connector. 2.
Disconnect the 2 EVAP canister purge valve vapor tube quick connect couplings.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3601
3. Depress the tab and remove the EVAP canister purge valve from the bracket. 4. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
- Carry out a leak test. See: Testing and Inspection
- Carry out the evaporative emission repair verification drive cycle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Canister Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair
Evaporative Canister Filter: Service and Repair
DUST SEPARATOR
Removal and Installation
1. The dust separator is serviced as part of the evaporative emission (EVAP) canister vent
solenoid.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Service and Repair
Evaporative Emission Control Canister: Service and Repair
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CANISTER
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3608
Part 2
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The evaporative emission system contains fuel vapor and condensed fuel vapor. Although not
present in large quantities, it still presents the danger of explosion or fire. Disconnect the battery
ground cable from the battery to minimize the possibility of an electrical spark occurring, which can
cause a fire or explosion if fuel vapor or liquefied fuel are present in the area. Failure to follow
these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. NOTE: Correct placement of the hoist arm to the frame lifting point is essential for the removal
and installation of the evaporative emission
(EVAP) canister assembly.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the 3 bolts, pushpin retainer and the evaporative emission (EVAP) shield.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. Disconnect the EVAP canister vent solenoid electrical connector. 4. Disconnect the 2 quick
connect couplings from the EVAP canister assembly. 5. Disconnect the EVAP vapor tube from the
EVAP dust separator. 6. Remove the 3 EVAP canister assembly bracket bolts.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
7. Release the EVAP canister assembly pushpin retainer and remove the EVAP canister assembly.
8. NOTE: When installing the EVAP canister assembly, insert the alignment tab into the body first,
then install the pushpin and 3 bolts.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. Carry out a leak test. See: Testing and Inspection
- Carry out the evaporative emission repair verification drive cycle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emissions Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair
Evaporative Emissions Hose: Service and Repair
FUEL VAPOR TUBE ASSEMBLY
WARNING:
- The evaporative emission system contains fuel vapor and condensed fuel vapor. Although not
present in large quantities, it still presents the danger of explosion or fire. Disconnect the battery
ground cable from the battery to minimize the possibility of an electrical spark occurring, which can
cause a fire or explosion if fuel vapor or liquefied fuel are present in the area. Failure to follow
these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emissions Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3612
result in personal injury.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the 3 bolts, pushpin retainer and the evaporative emission (EVAP) shield.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. Disconnect the fuel vapor tube assembly-to-EVAP canister quick connect coupling.
4. Remove the fuel vapor tube assembly from the 2 front retainer clips.
5. Disconnect the fuel tank pressure transducer (FTPT) electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emissions Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3613
6. Disconnect the fuel vapor tube assembly quick connect coupling from the fuel tank. 7. Position a
suitable lifting device under the fuel tank.
8. Remove the 2 fuel tank bracket bolts and the 4 fuel tank mounting bolts. Partially lower the fuel
tank enough to access the 2 rear fuel vapor tube
assembly retainer clips. To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
9. Remove the fuel vapor tube assembly from the 2 rear retainer clips.
10. Remove the fuel vapor tube assembly. 11. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Carry out a leak test. See: Testing and Inspection
- Carry out the evaporative emission repair verification drive cycle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Valve, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Left Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Valve, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 3617
C377
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Valve, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 3618
Leak Detection Valve: Description and Operation
CANISTER VENT (CV) SOLENOID
Typical Canister Vent (CV) Solenoid
During the evaporative emissions (EVAP) leak check monitor, the CV solenoid seals the EVAP
canister from the atmospheric pressure. This allows the EVAP canister purge valve to obtain the
target vacuum in the fuel tank during the EVAP leak check monitor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Valve, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 3619
Leak Detection Valve: Service and Repair
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CANISTER VENT SOLENOID
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The evaporative emission system contains fuel vapor and condensed fuel vapor. Although not
present in large quantities, it still presents the danger of explosion or fire. Disconnect the battery
ground cable from the battery to minimize the possibility of an electrical spark occurring, which can
cause a fire or explosion if fuel vapor or liquefied fuel are present in the area. Failure to follow
these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Valve, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 3620
result in personal injury.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the 3 bolts, pushpin retainer and the evaporative emission (EVAP) shield.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. Disconnect the EVAP canister vent solenoid electrical connector.
4. Disconnect the 2 EVAP vapor tubes from the EVAP canister vent solenoid and dust separator
assembly. 5. Depress the tab and remove the EVAP canister vent solenoid and dust separator
assembly from the EVAP canister assembly bracket. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Carry out a leak test. See: Testing and Inspection
- Carry out the evaporative emission repair verification drive cycle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Electronic Vacuum Regulator Solenoid > Component Information > Description and Operation
EGR Electronic Vacuum Regulator Solenoid: Description and Operation
EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) VACUUM REGULATOR SOLENOID
EGR Vacuum Regulator Solenoid
Vacuum Output (IN-HG)
EGR Vacuum Regulator Solenoid Data
The EGR vacuum regulator solenoid is an electromagnetic device used to regulate the vacuum
supply to the EGR valve. The solenoid contains a coil which magnetically controls the position of a
disc to regulate the vacuum. As the duty cycle to the coil increases, the vacuum signal passed
through the solenoid to the EGR valve also increases. Vacuum not directed to the EGR valve is
vented through the solenoid vent to atmosphere. Note that at 0% duty cycle (no electrical signal
applied), the EGR vacuum regulator solenoid allows some vacuum to pass, but not enough to open
the EGR valve.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR Tube
> Component Information > Description and Operation
EGR Tube: Description and Operation
EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) ORIFICE TUBE ASSEMBLY
EGR Orifice Tube Assembly
The orifice tube assembly is a section of tubing connecting the exhaust system to the intake
manifold. The assembly provides the flow path for the EGR to the intake manifold and also
contains the metering orifice and 2 pressure pick-up tubes. The internal metering orifice creates a
measurable pressure drop across it as the EGR valve opens and closes. This pressure differential
across the orifice is picked up by the differential pressure feedback EGR sensor which provides
feedback to the PCM.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR Valve
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EEGR) Valve
EGR Valve: Description and Operation Electric Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EEGR) Valve
ELECTRIC EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EEGR) VALVE
EEGR Motor/Valve Assembly
Depending on the application, the EEGR valve is a water cooled or an air cooled motor/valve
assembly. The motor is commanded to move in 52 discrete steps as it acts directly on the EEGR
valve. The position of the valve determines the rate of EGR. The built-in spring works to close the
valve (against the motor opening force).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR Valve
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EEGR) Valve > Page 3632
EGR Valve: Description and Operation Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) System Module (ESM)
EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SYSTEM MODULE (ESM)
ESM
The ESM is an integrated differential pressure feedback EGR system that functions in the same
manner as a conventional differential pressure feedback EGR system. The various system
components have been integrated into a single component called the ESM. The flange of the valve
portion of the ESM bolts directly to the intake manifold with a metal gasket that forms the metering
orifice. This arrangement increases system reliability, response time, and system precision. By
relocating the EGR orifice from the exhaust to the intake side of the EGR valve, the downstream
pressure signal measures manifold absolute pressure (MAP). This MAP signal is used for EGR
correction and inferred barometric pressure (BARO) at key on. The system provides the powertrain
control module (PCM) with a differential pressure feedback EGR signal, identical to a traditional
differential pressure feedback EGR system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR Valve
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EEGR) Valve > Page 3633
EGR Valve: Description and Operation Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Valve
EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) VALVE
Typical EGR Valve
EGR Flowrate
The EGR valve in the differential pressure feedback EGR system is a conventional,
vacuum-actuated. The valve increases or decreases the flow of EGR. As vacuum applied to the
EGR valve diaphragm overcomes the spring force, the valve begins to open. As the vacuum signal
weakens, at 5.4 kPa (1.6 in-Hg) or less, the spring force closes the valve. The EGR valve is fully
open at about 15 kPa (4.5 in-Hg).
Since EGR flow requirement varies greatly, providing repair specifications on flow rate is
impractical. The on board diagnostic (OBD) system monitors the EGR valve function and triggers a
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) if the test criteria is not met. The EGR valve flow rate is not
measured directly as part of the diagnostic procedures.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > Pressure
Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description and Operation
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer
that monitors the differential pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly.
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as
the downstream pressure hose (REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI
and REF hose connections are marked on the differential pressure feedback EGR sensor housing
for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger diameter hose). The differential pressure
feedback EGR sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the metering
orifice and supplies it to the PCM as EGR flow rate feedback.
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR TUBE MOUNTED
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > Pressure
Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3637
The tube mounted differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is identical in operation as the large
plastic differential pressure feedback EGR sensors and uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF
hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation > PCV
Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair
PCV Heater: Service and Repair
POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION (PCV) HEATER ELEMENT
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) heater element electrical connector. 2.
Release the spring tension clamp and remove the PCV hose from the PCV heater element.
3. NOTE: The intake manifold is manufactured with an optional set of mounting holes for the PCV
heater element self-tapping retaining screws that
may be used if necessary.
Remove the 2 PCV heater element retainer screws. To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
4. Remove the PCV heater element from the intake manifold
5. NOTE:
- To install, apply clean engine oil to the O-ring seal.
- Upon installation, make sure the PCV heater element electrical connector is in the correct position
to allow the wiring harness to be connected.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Positive Crankcase Ventilation (PCV)
Valve
C190
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Positive Crankcase Ventilation (PCV)
Valve > Page 3646
C1556
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3647
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve: Service and Repair
POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION (PCV) VALVE
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) valve electrical connector. 2. Disconnect the
PCV hose from the PCV valve.
3. CAUTION: A new PCV valve must be installed if removed from the valve cover. Upon removal,
damage will occur to the locking
mechanism on the PCV valve.
NOTE: To install, apply clean engine oil to the O-ring seal.
- Upon installation, make sure the PCV valve electrical connector is pointing in the correct position
to allow the wiring harness to be connected. Incorrect installation would require removal and
installation of a new valve.
Rotate the PCV valve counterclockwise and remove from the valve cover. Discard the PCV valve.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description and Operation
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer
that monitors the differential pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly.
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as
the downstream pressure hose (REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI
and REF hose connections are marked on the differential pressure feedback EGR sensor housing
for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger diameter hose). The differential pressure
feedback EGR sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the metering
orifice and supplies it to the PCM as EGR flow rate feedback.
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR TUBE MOUNTED
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 3652
The tube mounted differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is identical in operation as the large
plastic differential pressure feedback EGR sensors and uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF
hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System Information
> Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Fuel Pressure
3.5 L engine running fuel pressure.......................................................................................................
...........................................................450 kPa (65 psi)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Release > System
Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELEASE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
WARNING:
- Do not carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any fuel-related
components. Highly flammable vapors are always present and can ignite. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, which may cause personal injury
or a fire hazard.
1. Remove the Schrader valve cap.
2. NOTE: This step will drain some fuel out of the system. Place the fuel in a suitable container.
Install the special tool and slowly open the manual valve to relieve the fuel system pressure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed > System Information >
Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Typical Diagnostic Reference Value
Measured/PID Values 600 RPM ..........................................................................................................
..................................................................................................... Hot Idle
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal > Component
Information > Specifications
Torque Specifications
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3666
Accelerator Pedal: Service and Repair
ACCELERATOR PEDAL AND BRACKET
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Release the safety lock tab mechanism on the accelerator pedal sensor electrical
connector prior to disconnecting.
Disconnect the accelerator pedal sensor electrical connector.
2. Remove the 3 nuts and the accelerator pedal and bracket.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3670
C2040
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3671
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION (APP) SENSOR
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
torque demand. There are 3 pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APPS1, has a negative
slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APPS2 and APPS3, both have a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APPS1 is used as
the indication of pedal position by the strategy. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There are 2 reference voltage circuits and 2
signal return circuits for the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Air Cleaner Housing: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER
Part 1
Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3675
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 2. Loosen the clamp and
disconnect the air cleaner outlet pipe from the air cleaner.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. Remove the air cleaner bolt.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
4. NOTE: No tools are needed to remove the air cleaner assembly. Removal should be carried out
using hands only.
Separate the 2 air cleaner feet from the rubber grommets and remove the air cleaner assembly.
5. NOTE:
- Make sure that the 2 air cleaner feet are seated into the rubber grommets under the air cleaner
assembly.
- The air cleaner outlet pipe should be securely sealed to prevent unmetered air from entering the
engine.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3679
C128
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3680
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Diagram Of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot And Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3681
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. The current required to
maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow. The MAF sensor then
outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air mass. The PCM
calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired air/fuel ratio. This
input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC), shift and torque
converter clutch scheduling.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly. Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology with an integrated intake air
temperature (IAT) sensor. The hot wire electronic sensing element must be replaced as an
assembly. Replacing only the element may change the air flow calibration.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3682
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 2. Remove the 2 screws and
the MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filler Cap Warning Indicator >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Filler Cap Warning Indicator: Description and Operation
CHECK FUEL CAP INDICATOR
The check fuel cap indicator is a communications network message sent by the PCM. The PCM
sends the message to illuminate the lamp when the strategy determines that there is a failure in the
vapor management system due to the fuel filler cap not being sealed correctly. This would be
detected by the inability to pull vacuum in the fuel tank, after a fueling event.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure Release
> System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELEASE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
WARNING:
- Do not carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any fuel-related
components. Highly flammable vapors are always present and can ignite. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, which may cause personal injury
or a fire hazard.
1. Remove the Schrader valve cap.
2. NOTE: This step will drain some fuel out of the system. Place the fuel in a suitable container.
Install the special tool and slowly open the manual valve to relieve the fuel system pressure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Fuel Injector: Electrical Specifications
Fuel Injector Resistance ......................................................................................................................
............................................................. 11 - 18 Ohms
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1
C181
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 3696
C182
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 3697
C183
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 3698
C184
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 3699
Fuel Injector: Diagrams
C181
C182
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 3700
C183
C184
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 3701
C185
C186
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3702
Fuel Injector: Description and Operation
FUEL INJECTORS
Typical Fuel Injector
CAUTION: Do not apply battery positive voltage (B+) directly to the fuel injector electrical connector
terminals. The solenoids may be damaged internally in a matter of seconds.
The fuel injector is a solenoid-operated valve that meters fuel flow to the engine. The fuel injector is
opened and closed a constant number of times per crankshaft revolution. The amount of fuel is
controlled by the length of time the fuel injector is held open.
The fuel injector is normally closed, and is operated by a 12-volt source from either the electronic
engine control (EEC) power relay or fuel pump relay. The ground signal is controlled by the PCM.
The injector is the deposit resistant injector (DRI) type and does not have to be cleaned. However,
it can be flow checked and, if found outside of specification, a new fuel injector should be installed.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3703
Fuel Injector: Service and Repair
FUEL RAIL
Exploded View
Removal
WARNING: Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
working on or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved. Failure to follow these instructions can result in personal injury.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3704
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Release the fuel system pressure. 3. Remove the upper
intake manifold. 4. Disconnect the fuel tube-to-fuel rail quick connect coupling. 5. Disconnect the 6
fuel injector electrical connectors. 6. Remove the 4 fuel rail bolts. 7. Remove the fuel rail and
injectors as an assembly. 8. Remove the 6 fuel injector clips and the 6 fuel injectors.
- Remove and discard the 12 fuel injector O-ring seals.
Installation
1. CAUTION:
- Use O-ring seals that are made of special fuel-resistant material. The use of ordinary O-rings can
cause the fuel system to leak. Do not reuse the O-ring seals.
- The upper and lower O-ring seals are not interchangeable.
NOTE: Install new fuel injector O-ring seals and lubricate them with clean engine oil.
Install the 6 fuel injectors and the 6 fuel injector clips into the fuel rail.
2. Install the fuel rail and fuel injectors as an assembly. 3. Install the 4 fuel rail bolts.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
4. Connect the 6 fuel injector electrical connectors. 5. Connect the fuel tube-to-fuel rail quick
connect coupling. 6. Install the upper intake manifold. 7. Connect the battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Line Coupler: Service and Repair
QUICK CONNECT COUPLING
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Disconnect - Type I
WARNING:
- Do not carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any fuel-related
components. Highly flammable vapors are always present and can ignite. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION:
- If the liquid or vapor tube is damaged (torn, holes or delaminated), a new tube assembly must be
installed. Do not use aftermarket sleeving. Do not re-adhere loose sleeving material.
- When reusing liquid or vapor tube quick connect couplings, make sure to use compressed air to
remove any foreign material from the connector locking tab area before separating the quick
connect coupling from the tube. Apply clean engine oil to the end of the tube before inserting the
quick connect coupling onto the tube.
- Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances. It is
therefore essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components.
Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
1. If servicing a liquid fuel tube quick connect coupling, release the fuel system pressure.
2. Depress the locking tab and release the quick connect coupling from the tube.
Connect - Type I
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3708
1. CAUTION: Make sure the fuel tube clicks into place when installing the quick connect coupling
onto the tube.
Install the quick connect coupling onto the tube until it is fully seated.
2. Pull on the quick connect coupling and the tube to make sure it is securely fastened.
Disconnect - Type II
WARNING:
- Do not carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any fuel-related
components. Highly flammable vapors are always present and can ignite. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION:
- If the liquid or vapor tube is damaged (torn, holes or delaminated), a new tube assembly must be
installed. Do not use aftermarket sleeving. Do not re-adhere loose sleeving material.
- When reusing liquid or vapor tube quick connect couplings, make sure to use compressed air to
remove any foreign material from the connector locking tab area before separating the quick
connect coupling from the tube. Apply clean engine oil to the end of the tube before inserting the
quick connect coupling onto the tube.
- Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances. It is
therefore essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components.
Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
1. If servicing a liquid fuel tube quick connect coupling, release the fuel system pressure.
2. Release the quick connect coupling primary locking tab.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3709
3. Rotate the primary locking tab to the fully opened position and squeeze the secondary locking
tabs to release the locking mechanism.
4. Push the locking mechanism outward and release the tube.
5. Remove the quick connect coupling from the tube.
Connect - Type II
1. Install the quick connect coupling onto the tube until it is fully seated.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3710
2. CAUTION: Make sure the retainer clip clicks into place when installing.
Depress the locking mechanism until it is flush with the quick connect coupling housing and is fully
seated onto the tube.
3. Rotate the primary locking tab on the retainer clip to the closed position. 4. Pull on the quick
connect coupling and the tube to make sure it is securely fastened.
Disconnect - Type III
WARNING:
- Do not carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any fuel-related
components. Highly flammable vapors are always present and can ignite. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION:
- If the liquid or vapor tube is damaged (torn, holes or delaminated), a new tube assembly must be
installed. Do not use aftermarket sleeving. Do not re-adhere loose sleeving material.
- When reusing liquid or vapor tube quick connect couplings, make sure to use compressed air to
remove any foreign material from the connector locking tab area before separating the quick
connect coupling from the tube. Apply clean engine oil to the end of the tube before inserting the
quick connect coupling onto the tube.
- Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances. It is
therefore essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components.
Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
1. If servicing a liquid fuel tube quick connect coupling, release the fuel system pressure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3711
2. Squeeze the quick connect coupling retainer locking tabs to release the locking mechanism.
3. Push the locking mechanism outward to release the tube.
4. Remove the quick connect coupling from the tube.
Connect - Type III
1. CAUTION: Make sure that the tube clicks into place when installing the quick connect coupling.
Install the quick connect coupling onto the tube.
2. Depress the quick connect coupling locking mechanism into the locked position.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3712
3. Visually inspect and verify that the locking mechanism is flush with the quick connect coupling
housing and that the locking tabs are securely
fastened.
4. Pull on the quick connect coupling and the tube to make sure it is securely fastened.
Disconnect - Type IV
WARNING:
- Do not carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any fuel-related
components. Highly flammable vapors are always present and can ignite. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION:
- If the liquid or vapor tube is damaged (torn, holes or delaminated), a new tube assembly must be
installed. Do not use aftermarket sleeving. Do not re-adhere loose sleeving material.
- When reusing liquid or vapor tube quick connect couplings, make sure to use compressed air to
remove any foreign material from the connector locking tab area before separating the quick
connect coupling from the tube. Apply clean engine oil to the end of the tube before inserting the
quick connect coupling onto the tube.
- Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances. It is
therefore essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components.
Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
1. Install the special tool on the tube and push into the quick connect coupling locking clip to
release the locking tabs.
2. Remove the quick connect coupling from the tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3713
Connect - Type IV
1. CAUTION: Make sure the fuel tube clicks into place when installing the tube.
Install the quick connect coupling onto the tube until it is fully seated.
2. Pull on the quick connect coupling and the tube to make sure it is securely fastened.
Disconnect - Type V
WARNING:
- Do not carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any fuel-related
components. Highly flammable vapors are always present and can ignite. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION:
- If the liquid or vapor tube is damaged (torn, holes or delaminated), a new tube assembly must be
installed. Do not use aftermarket sleeving. Do not re-adhere loose sleeving material.
- When reusing liquid or vapor tube quick connect couplings, make sure to use compressed air to
remove any foreign material from the connector locking tab area before separating the quick
connect coupling from the tube. Apply clean engine oil to the end of the tube before inserting the
quick connect coupling onto the tube.
1. Squeeze the outer edges of the quick connect coupling to release the locking tabs.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3714
2. Remove the quick connect coupling from the tube.
Connect - Type V
1. CAUTION: Make sure the quick connect coupling locking tabs click into place when installing
onto the tube.
Install the quick connect coupling onto the tube until it is fully seated.
2. Pull on the quick connect coupling and the tube to make sure it is securely fastened.
Disconnect - Type VI
WARNING:
- Do not carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any fuel-related
components. Highly flammable vapors are always present and can ignite. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION:
- If the liquid or vapor tube is damaged (torn, holes or delaminated), a new tube assembly must be
installed. Do not use aftermarket sleeving. Do not re-adhere loose sleeving material.
- When reusing liquid or vapor tube quick connect couplings, make sure to use compressed air to
remove any foreign material from the connector locking tab area before separating the quick
connect coupling from the tube. Apply clean engine oil to the end of the tube before inserting the
quick connect coupling onto the tube.
- Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances. It is
therefore essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components.
Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
1. Release the lock tab on the quick connect coupling.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3715
2. Separate the quick connect coupling from the fitting.
Connect - Type VI
1. Release the lock tab and install the quick connect coupling onto the fitting.
2. Apply the lock tab into the latched position. 3. Pull on the quick connect coupling to make sure it
is securely fastened.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE (FRP) SENSOR
Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
The FRP sensor is a diaphragm strain gauge device in which resistance changes with pressure.
The electrical resistance of a strain gauge increases as pressure increases, and the resistance
decreases as the pressure decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the
sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to pressure.
Strain gauge type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The FRP sensor measures the pressure of the fuel near the fuel injectors. This signal is used by
the PCM to adjust the fuel injector pulse width and meter fuel to each engine combustion cylinder.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor > Page 3720
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT)
Sensor
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail.
The temperature sensing portion of the FRPT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance
changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor decreases as the temperature
increases, and the resistance increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance
changes the voltage drop across the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM
corresponding to temperature.
Both the pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the fuel pump. The
speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid state. The
dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which allows the
injector pulse width to decrease.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Pulsation Damper >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Pressure Pulsation Damper: Description and Operation
FUEL RAIL PULSE DAMPER
Typical Fuel Rail Pulse Damper
The fuel rail pulse damper is located on the fuel rail and reduces the fuel system noise caused by
the pulsing of the fuel injectors. The vacuum port located on the damper is connected to manifold
vacuum to avoid fuel spillage if the pulse damper diaphragm ruptures. The fuel rail pulse damper
should not be confused with a fuel pressure regulator; it does not regulate the fuel rail pressure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Fuel Pressure
3.5 L engine running fuel pressure.......................................................................................................
...........................................................450 kPa (65 psi)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3731
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3732
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component Information
> Service and Repair
Fuel Rail: Service and Repair
FUEL RAIL
Exploded View
Removal
WARNING: Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
working on or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved. Failure to follow these instructions can result in personal injury.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Page 3736
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Release the fuel system pressure. 3. Remove the upper
intake manifold. 4. Disconnect the fuel tube-to-fuel rail quick connect coupling. 5. Disconnect the 6
fuel injector electrical connectors. 6. Remove the 4 fuel rail bolts. 7. Remove the fuel rail and
injectors as an assembly. 8. Remove the 6 fuel injector clips and the 6 fuel injectors.
- Remove and discard the 12 fuel injector O-ring seals.
Installation
1. CAUTION:
- Use O-ring seals that are made of special fuel-resistant material. The use of ordinary O-rings can
cause the fuel system to leak. Do not reuse the O-ring seals.
- The upper and lower O-ring seals are not interchangeable.
NOTE: Install new fuel injector O-ring seals and lubricate them with clean engine oil.
Install the 6 fuel injectors and the 6 fuel injector clips into the fuel rail.
2. Install the fuel rail and fuel injectors as an assembly. 3. Install the 4 fuel rail bolts.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
4. Connect the 6 fuel injector electrical connectors. 5. Connect the fuel tube-to-fuel rail quick
connect coupling. 6. Install the upper intake manifold. 7. Connect the battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Supply Line: Service and Repair
FUEL LINES
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3740
Part 2
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- The evaporative emissions system contains fuel vapor and condensed fuel vapor. Although not
present in large quantities, it still presents the danger of explosion or fire. Disconnect the battery
ground cable from the battery to minimize the possibility of an electrical spark occurring, and
possibly causing a fire or explosion if fuel vapor or liquid fuel are present in the area. Failure to
follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Before
repairing or disconnecting any of the fuel system components, the fuel system pressure must be
relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, causing personal injury or a fire hazard.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Release the fuel system pressure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3741
3. Disconnect the evaporative emission (EVAP) outlet tube-to-EVAP purge valve quick connect
coupling.
4. Disconnect the fresh air tube-to-vent hose quick connect coupling.
5. Disconnect the fuel tank supply tube-to-fuel supply tube quick connect coupling.
6. Remove the 3 bolts, pushpin retainer and the EVAP shield.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3742
7. Disconnect the EVAP purge valve outlet tube-to-EVAP canister quick connect coupling.
8. Disconnect the EVAP vapor-to-dust separator tube.
9. Disconnect the fuel supply tube-to-fuel tank jumper tube quick connect coupling.
10. Release the EVAP and fuel supply tubes from the bundle retainer clips and remove the tubes
the from the vehicle. 11. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Filler Hose: Service and Repair
FUEL TANK FILLER PIPE
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3747
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3748
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- The fuel in the tank may be pressurized. Remove the fuel tank cap slowly. If a hissing sound is
heard, wait until the condition stops before removing the fuel tank filler cap. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
- This procedure involves fuel handling. Be prepared for spillage at all times and always observe
fuel handling precautions. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Release the fuel tank filler cap and
position aside.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3749
3. Insert a suitable fuel drain tube into the fuel tank filler pipe until it reaches the fuel tank inlet
spout. 4. Attach the fuel storage tanker to the fuel drain tube and remove any residual fuel
remaining the fuel tank filler pipe.
5. Remove the 3 fuel tank filler pipe flange retaining screws.
- To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
6. Remove the LH rear wheel splash shield.
7. CAUTION: The fuel pump (FP) module, fuel level sensor (if equipped) and the fuel tank inlet
spout are below the fuel level when the fuel
tank is completely full. Make sure to drain any residual fuel from the fuel tank filler pipe prior to
removing the fuel tank filler pipe clamp and hose.
NOTE: The fuel tank filler pipe may have some residual fuel remaining in it after draining. Upon
disconnecting the fuel tank filler pipe hose, carefully drain the residual fuel into a suitable container.
Release the clamp and disconnect the fuel tank filler pipe-to-fuel tank hose. To install, tighten to 4 Nm (35 lb-in).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3750
8. Remove the 2 fuel tank filler pipe bracket bolts.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
9. Remove the fuel tank filler pipe assembly from the vehicle.
10. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-1-7 > Jan > 08 >
Instruments - Inaccurate Fuel Gauge
Fuel Gauge Sender: Customer Interest Instruments - Inaccurate Fuel Gauge
TSB 08-1-7
01/21/08
INACCURATE FUEL GAUGE INDICATOR - VEHICLE BUILT BEFORE 11/1/2007
FORD: 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Edge and MKX vehicles built before 11/1/2007, may experience an
inaccurate low fuel gauge indicator. This condition may be caused by a stuck float arm on the fuel
delivery module. The fuel delivery module float arm could get hung up on the fuel tank baffle plate.
This failure mode will only occur when the fuel tank is at or near empty fuel level. When the fuel
tank is refilled to a full level, the fuel gauge will continue to read a low fuel fill level. For all other fuel
gauge related concerns, refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 413-01.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. To make this repair it will be necessary to remove the fuel pump module from the fuel tank.
Follow WSM, Section 310-01.
2. Once the fuel delivery module is removed from the fuel tank, access the fuel tank baffle through
the fuel tank fuel delivery opening. (Figure 1)
3. Move the baffle plate with a wooden object or by hand towards the front of the vehicle to prevent
interference between the baffle and the float arm. The fuel tank baffle plate is a metal plate that is
easy to move by hand or using a tool with no consequent damage to the baffle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-1-7 > Jan > 08 >
Instruments - Inaccurate Fuel Gauge > Page 3759
4. The fuel delivery module float arm should have a clearance of 1 5/32" (29.63 mm) in the empty
tank position (bottom) and 13/16" (20.73 mm) in the full tank position (up). (Figure 2)
5. Install the fuel delivery module following WSM, Section 310-01.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
080107A 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.7 Hrs.
Reposition the Fuel Tank Baffle Plate. Includes Time to Remove Rear Seat and Fuel Delivery
Module. (Do Not Use With 9350E, 63100B,63100B, 9275A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9002 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-1-7 >
Jan > 08 > Instruments - Inaccurate Fuel Gauge
Fuel Gauge Sender: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Inaccurate Fuel Gauge
TSB 08-1-7
01/21/08
INACCURATE FUEL GAUGE INDICATOR - VEHICLE BUILT BEFORE 11/1/2007
FORD: 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Edge and MKX vehicles built before 11/1/2007, may experience an
inaccurate low fuel gauge indicator. This condition may be caused by a stuck float arm on the fuel
delivery module. The fuel delivery module float arm could get hung up on the fuel tank baffle plate.
This failure mode will only occur when the fuel tank is at or near empty fuel level. When the fuel
tank is refilled to a full level, the fuel gauge will continue to read a low fuel fill level. For all other fuel
gauge related concerns, refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 413-01.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. To make this repair it will be necessary to remove the fuel pump module from the fuel tank.
Follow WSM, Section 310-01.
2. Once the fuel delivery module is removed from the fuel tank, access the fuel tank baffle through
the fuel tank fuel delivery opening. (Figure 1)
3. Move the baffle plate with a wooden object or by hand towards the front of the vehicle to prevent
interference between the baffle and the float arm. The fuel tank baffle plate is a metal plate that is
easy to move by hand or using a tool with no consequent damage to the baffle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-1-7 >
Jan > 08 > Instruments - Inaccurate Fuel Gauge > Page 3765
4. The fuel delivery module float arm should have a clearance of 1 5/32" (29.63 mm) in the empty
tank position (bottom) and 13/16" (20.73 mm) in the full tank position (up). (Figure 2)
5. Install the fuel delivery module following WSM, Section 310-01.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
080107A 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.7 Hrs.
Reposition the Fuel Tank Baffle Plate. Includes Time to Remove Rear Seat and Fuel Delivery
Module. (Do Not Use With 9350E, 63100B,63100B, 9275A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9002 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 3768
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Module
C463
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Module > Page 3771
C434
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3772
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation
FUEL PUMP (FP) MODULE
Typical Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3773
Typical Mechanical Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
The FP module is a device that contains the fuel pump and sender assembly. The fuel pump is
located inside the FP module reservoir and supplies fuel through the FP module manifold to the
engine and FP module jet pump. The jet pump continuously refills the reservoir with fuel, and a
check valve located in the manifold outlet maintains system pressure when the fuel pump is not
energized. A flapper valve located in the bottom of the reservoir allows fuel to enter the reservoir
and prime the fuel pump during the initial fill.
FUEL PUMP (FP) MODULE AND RESERVOIR
The FP module is mounted inside the fuel tank in a reservoir. The pump has a discharge check
valve that maintains the system pressure after the key has been turned off to minimize starting
concerns. The reservoir prevents fuel flow interruptions during extreme vehicle maneuvers with low
tank fill levels.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module
FUEL PUMP MODULE
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 3776
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 3777
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 3778
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
repairing or disconnecting any of the fuel system components, the fuel system pressure must be
relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel causing personal injury or a fire hazard.
All vehicles
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 3779
1. Release the fuel system pressure. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3. Release the fuel
tank filler cap and position aside.
4. Insert a suitable fuel drain tube into the fuel tank filler pipe until it reaches the fuel tank inlet
spout. 5. Attach the fuel storage tanker to the fuel drain tube and remove any residual fuel
remaining in the fuel tank filler pipe. 6. Remove the rear seat. 7. Position the carpet and/or any
insulation covering the fuel pump (FP) module access cover aside.
8. Remove the 4 screws and the FP module access cover.
9. Disconnect the FP module electrical connector.
10. Disconnect the fuel tank supply tube-to-FP module quick connect coupling.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 3780
11. CAUTION: Place absorbent pads on the floor pan in the immediate area in case of fuel spills.
Carefully remove the fuel pump (FP)
module from the vehicle to avoid fuel spillage inside the vehicle.
Using the special tool, remove the FP module lock ring retainer.
All wheel drive (AWD) vehicles
12. CAUTION: The fuel pump (FP) module must be handled carefully to avoid damage to the FP
module and/or float arm.
Carefully lift the FP module out of the fuel tank enough to access and disconnect the fuel tank
crossover tube-to-FP module quick connect coupling.
All vehicles
13. CAUTION: The fuel pump (FP) module will have residual fuel remaining internally, drain into a
suitable container.
Completely remove the FP module from the fuel tank.
14. CAUTION:
- Inspect the mating surfaces of the fuel pump (FP) module flange and the fuel tank O-ring seal
contact surfaces. Do not polish or adjust the O-ring seal contact area of the fuel tank flange or the
fuel tank. Install a new FP module or fuel tank if the O-ring seal contact area is bent, scratched or
corroded.
- Make sure to install a new fuel pump (FP) module O-ring seal. Install a new lock ring if it is bent,
damaged or corroded.
NOTE: To install, apply clean engine oil to the O-ring seal.
Remove the FP module O-ring seal.
15. NOTE: Make sure the alignment tab on the fuel pump (FP) module and the fuel tank meet
before tightening the FP module lock ring.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 3781
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Fuel Level Sensor
FUEL LEVEL SENSOR
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 3782
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 3783
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 3784
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- This procedure involves fuel handling. Be prepared for spillage at all times and always observe
fuel handling precautions. Failure to follow these instructions can result in personal injury.
1. Release the fuel system pressure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 3785
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3. Release the fuel tank filler cap and position aside.
4. Insert a suitable fuel drain tube into the fuel tank filler pipe until it reaches the fuel tank inlet
spout.
5. CAUTION: The fuel pump (FP) module and fuel level sensor will be below the fuel level in the
tank when the tank is full. Make sure to
drain 1/8 of the fuel capacity through the filler pipe prior to removing the fuel level sensor or fuel
spillage will occur.
Attach the fuel storage tanker to the fuel drain tube and remove any residual fuel remaining in the
fuel tank filler pipe.
6. Remove the rear seat. 7. Position the carpet and/or any insulation covering the fuel level sensor
access cover aside.
8. Remove the 4 screws and the fuel level sensor access cover.
9. Disconnect the fuel level sensor electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 3786
10. CAUTION: Place absorbant pads in the general work area in case of fuel spillage.
Release the lock tab, rotate the fuel level sensor counterclockwise approximately 1/4 turn and lift
upward.
11. CAUTION:
- The fuel level sensor must be handled carefully to avoid damage to the float arm.
- Carefully remove the fuel level sensor from the fuel tank to avoid fuel spillage inside the vehicle.
Carefully lift and remove the fuel level sensor from the fuel tank.
12. CAUTION: Inspect the mating surfaces of the fuel level sensor flange and the fuel tank O-ring
seal contact surfaces. Do not polish or
adjust the O-ring seal contact area of the fuel tank flange or the fuel tank. Install a new fuel level
sensor or fuel tank if the O-ring seal contact area is bent, scratched or corroded.
NOTE: To install, apply clean engine oil to the O-ring seal.
- Upon installation, properly seat and press down firmly on the fuel level sensor, rotate it clockwise
until the lock arrow on the sensor aligns with the notch on the tank. Torque should not exceed 15
Nm (11 lb-ft).
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3790
C463
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3791
Fuel Tank Unit: Description and Operation
FUEL PUMP (FP) MODULE
Typical Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3792
Typical Mechanical Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
The FP module is a device that contains the fuel pump and sender assembly. The fuel pump is
located inside the FP module reservoir and supplies fuel through the FP module manifold to the
engine and FP module jet pump. The jet pump continuously refills the reservoir with fuel, and a
check valve located in the manifold outlet maintains system pressure when the fuel pump is not
energized. A flapper valve located in the bottom of the reservoir allows fuel to enter the reservoir
and prime the fuel pump during the initial fill.
FUEL PUMP (FP) MODULE AND RESERVOIR
The FP module is mounted inside the fuel tank in a reservoir. The pump has a discharge check
valve that maintains the system pressure after the key has been turned off to minimize starting
concerns. The reservoir prevents fuel flow interruptions during extreme vehicle maneuvers with low
tank fill levels.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail.
The temperature sensing portion of the FRPT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance
changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor decreases as the temperature
increases, and the resistance increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance
changes the voltage drop across the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM
corresponding to temperature.
Both the pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the fuel pump. The
speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid state. The
dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which allows the
injector pulse width to decrease.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Description and Operation
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Description and Operation
IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE
NOTE: The IAC valve assembly is not adjustable and cannot be cleaned, also some IAC valves are
normally open and others are normally closed. Some IAC valves require engine vacuum to
operate.
The IAC valve assembly controls the engine idle speed and provides a dashpot function. The IAC
valve assembly meters intake air around the throttle plate through a bypass within the IAC valve
assembly and throttle body. The PCM determines the desired idle speed or bypass air and signals
the IAC valve assembly through a specified duty cycle. The IAC valve responds by positioning the
IAC valve to control the amount of bypassed air. The PCM monitors engine RPM and increases or
decreases the IAC duty cycle in order to achieve the desired RPM.
The PCM uses the IAC valve assembly to control:
- no touch start
- cold engine fast idle for rapid warm-up
- idle (corrects for engine load)
- stumble or stalling on deceleration (provides a dashpot function)
- over-temperature idle boost
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3802
C4168
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3803
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Description and Operation
INERTIA FUEL SHUTOFF (IFS) SWITCH
Typical Inertia Fuel Shutoff (IFS) Switch
The IFS switch is used in conjunction with the electric fuel pump. The purpose of the IFS switch is
to shutoff the fuel pump if a collision occurs. It consists of a steel ball held in place by a magnet.
When a sharp impact occurs, the ball breaks loose from the magnet, rolls up a conical ramp and
strikes a target plate which opens the electrical contacts of the switch and shuts off the electric fuel
pump. Once the switch is open, it must be manually reset before restarting the vehicle. Refer to the
Owner's Literature for the location of the IFS.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3804
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Service and Repair
INERTIA FUEL SHUTOFF (IFS) SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the LH rear quarter trim panel. 2. Disconnect the inertia fuel shutoff (IFS) switch
electrical connector. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the IFS switch.
- To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Duct > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Intake Air Duct: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER OUTLET PIPE
Part 1
Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Duct > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3808
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the crankcase vent tube and vacuum tube from the air cleaner outlet pipe. 2. Loosen
the air cleaner outlet pipe-to-air cleaner cover clamp.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe-to-throttle body clamp.
- Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
4. NOTE: The air cleaner outlet pipe should be securely sealed to prevent unmetered air from
entering the engine.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 3812
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 3813
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 3818
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 3819
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 3823
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 3824
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3829
C2040
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3830
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION (APP) SENSOR
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
torque demand. There are 3 pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APPS1, has a negative
slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APPS2 and APPS3, both have a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APPS1 is used as
the indication of pedal position by the strategy. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There are 2 reference voltage circuits and 2
signal return circuits for the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3834
C128
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3835
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Diagram Of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot And Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3836
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. The current required to
maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow. The MAF sensor then
outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air mass. The PCM
calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired air/fuel ratio. This
input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC), shift and torque
converter clutch scheduling.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly. Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology with an integrated intake air
temperature (IAT) sensor. The hot wire electronic sensing element must be replaced as an
assembly. Replacing only the element may change the air flow calibration.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3837
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 2. Remove the 2 screws and
the MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Rail
Pressure (FRP) Sensor
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE (FRP) SENSOR
Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
The FRP sensor is a diaphragm strain gauge device in which resistance changes with pressure.
The electrical resistance of a strain gauge increases as pressure increases, and the resistance
decreases as the pressure decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the
sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to pressure.
Strain gauge type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The FRP sensor measures the pressure of the fuel near the fuel injectors. This signal is used by
the PCM to adjust the fuel injector pulse width and meter fuel to each engine combustion cylinder.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Rail
Pressure (FRP) Sensor > Page 3842
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT)
Sensor
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail.
The temperature sensing portion of the FRPT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance
changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor decreases as the temperature
increases, and the resistance increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance
changes the voltage drop across the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM
corresponding to temperature.
Both the pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the fuel pump. The
speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid state. The
dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which allows the
injector pulse width to decrease.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail.
The temperature sensing portion of the FRPT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance
changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor decreases as the temperature
increases, and the resistance increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance
changes the voltage drop across the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM
corresponding to temperature.
Both the pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the fuel pump. The
speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid state. The
dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which allows the
injector pulse width to decrease.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3849
C4168
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3850
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Description and Operation
INERTIA FUEL SHUTOFF (IFS) SWITCH
Typical Inertia Fuel Shutoff (IFS) Switch
The IFS switch is used in conjunction with the electric fuel pump. The purpose of the IFS switch is
to shutoff the fuel pump if a collision occurs. It consists of a steel ball held in place by a magnet.
When a sharp impact occurs, the ball breaks loose from the magnet, rolls up a conical ramp and
strikes a target plate which opens the electrical contacts of the switch and shuts off the electric fuel
pump. Once the switch is open, it must be manually reset before restarting the vehicle. Refer to the
Owner's Literature for the location of the IFS.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3851
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Service and Repair
INERTIA FUEL SHUTOFF (IFS) SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the LH rear quarter trim panel. 2. Disconnect the inertia fuel shutoff (IFS) switch
electrical connector. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the IFS switch.
- To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic
Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE BODY (ETB) POSITION SENSOR
The ETB position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant ETB
position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB position sensor signal (TP1)
has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation the negative slope
ETB position sensor signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of throttle
position. The 2 ETB position sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1
signal has a concern. There is 1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic
Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor > Page 3856
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Typical TP Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases the corrosion resistance on the
terminals and increases the connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body.
As the TP sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, 4 operating conditions are determined by the PCM
from the TP. The operating conditions are:
- closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration)
- part throttle (includes cruise or moderate acceleration)
- wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on crank)
- throttle angle rate
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Throttle Body: Service and Repair
THROTTLE BODY
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: The throttle body must be removed from the vehicle to be cleaned. Do not hold the
throttle plate open with any object that could scratch the bore or plate while servicing or cleaning
the throttle body.
1. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe. 2. Disconnect the electronic throttle control electrical
connector. 3. Remove the 4 bolts and the throttle body (TB).
- Discard the TB gasket.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
4. NOTE: Install a new TB gasket.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE BODY (ETB) POSITION SENSOR
The ETB position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant ETB
position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB position sensor signal (TP1)
has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation the negative slope
ETB position sensor signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of throttle
position. The 2 ETB position sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1
signal has a concern. There is 1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor > Page 3864
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Typical TP Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases the corrosion resistance on the
terminals and increases the connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body.
As the TP sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, 4 operating conditions are determined by the PCM
from the TP. The operating conditions are:
- closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration)
- part throttle (includes cruise or moderate acceleration)
- wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on crank)
- throttle angle rate
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction System >
Variable Induction Control Actuator > Component Information > Description and Operation
Variable Induction Control Actuator: Description and Operation
INTAKE MANIFOLD TUNING VALVE (IMTV)
WARNING: Substantial opening and closing torque is applied by this system. To prevent injury, be
careful to keep fingers away from lever mechanisms when actuated.
The IMTV is a motorized actuated unit mounted directly to the intake manifold. The IMTV actuator
controls a shutter device attached to the actuator shaft. There is no monitor input to the PCM with
this system to indicate shutter position.
The motorized IMTV unit is not energized below approximately 2,600 RPM. The shutter is in the
closed position not allowing airflow blend to occur in the intake manifold. The motorized unit is
energized above approximately 2,600 RPM. The motorized unit is commanded on by the PCM
initially at a 100 percent duty cycle to move the shutter to the open position, and then falling to
approximately 50 percent to continue to hold the shutter open.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Firing Order > Component Information >
Specifications > Firing Order
Firing Order: Specifications Firing Order
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Firing order...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................1-4-2-5-3-6
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Firing Order > Component Information >
Specifications > Firing Order > Page 3874
Firing Order: Specifications Engine Cylinder Identification
Engine
Engine Cylinder Identification
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Timing > Number One Cylinder >
Component Information > Locations
Number One Cylinder: Locations
Engine
Engine Cylinder Identification
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor 1
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor 1 > Page 3883
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor
C1366
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor > Page 3886
C1367
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3887
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Typical Synchronizer Hall-Effect CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston
number 1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing
the sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil-on-plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP
signal to select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with 2 CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). They use the
second sensor to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2 as an input to the PCM.
There are 2 types of CMP sensors: the 3-pin connector Hall-effect type sensor and the 2-pin
connector variable reluctance type sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3888
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
RH sensor
1. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe.
LH sensor
2. Remove the air cleaner assembly.
Both sensors
3. Disconnect the camshaft position sensor (CMP) electrical connector. 4. Remove the bolt and the
CMP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
5. NOTE: Lubricate the CMP O-ring seal with clean engine oil.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3892
C101
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3893
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid deceleration between teeth.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3894
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the LH catalytic converter. 3.
Remove the bolt, nut and the heat shield.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
4. Remove the rubber grommet cover. 5. Disconnect the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor
electrical connector. 6. Remove the bolt and the CKP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil On Plug (COP) 1
C111
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil On Plug (COP) 1 > Page 3900
C112
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil On Plug (COP) 1 > Page 3901
C113
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil On Plug (COP) 1 > Page 3902
C114
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil On Plug (COP) 1 > Page 3903
Ignition Coil: Diagrams
C111
C112
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil On Plug (COP) 1 > Page 3904
C113
C114
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil On Plug (COP) 1 > Page 3905
C115
C116
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil On Plug (COP) 1 > Page 3906
C174
C194
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Page 3907
Ignition Coil: Description and Operation
COIL ON PLUG (COP)
Typical Coil On Plug (COP)
The COP ignition operates similar to a standard coil pack ignition except each plug has one coil per
plug. The COP has 3 different modes of operation: engine crank, engine running, and CMP failure
mode effects management (FMEM).
COIL PACK
Typical Four-Tower Coil Pack
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Page 3908
Typical Six-Tower Coil Pack
The PCM provides a grounding switch for the coil primary circuit. When the switch is closed,
voltage is applied to the coil primary circuit. This creates a magnetic field around the primary coil.
The PCM opens the switch, causing the magnetic field to collapse, inducing the high voltage in the
secondary coil windings and firing the spark plug. The spark plugs are paired so that as one spark
plug fires on the compression stroke, the other spark plug fires on the exhaust stroke. The next
time the coil is fired the order is reversed. The next pair of spark plugs fire according to the engine
firing order.
Coil packs come in 4-tower, 6-tower horizontal and series 5 6-tower models. Two adjacent coil
towers share a common coil and are called a matched pair. For 6-tower coil pack (6 cylinder)
applications, the matched pairs are 1 and 5, 2 and 6, and 3 and 4. For 4-tower coil pack (4 cylinder)
applications, the matched pairs are 1 and 4, and 2 and 3.
When the coil is fired by the PCM, spark is delivered through the matched pair towers to their
respective spark plugs. The spark plugs are fired simultaneously and are paired so that as one fires
on the compression stroke, the other spark plug fires on the exhaust stroke. The next time the coil
is fired, the situation is reversed. The next pair of spark plugs fire according to the engine firing
order.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Page 3909
Ignition Coil: Service and Repair
IGNITION COIL-ON-PLUG
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
LH side
1. Disconnect the crankcase vent tube quick connect coupling from the valve cover fitting and
position aside.
RH side
2. NOTE: The upper intake manifold must be removed to access the RH ignition coil-on-plugs.
Remove the upper intake manifold.
Both sides
3. Disconnect the 6 ignition coil-on-plug electrical connectors.
4. NOTE: When removing the ignition coil-on-plugs, a slight twisting motion will break the seal and
ease removal.
Remove the 6 bolts and the 6 ignition coil-on-plugs. To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Page 3910
- Apply a small amount of dielectric grease to the inside of the ignition coil-on-plug boots before
attaching to the spark plugs.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Relay > Component Information >
Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Relay > Component Information >
Locations > Page 3914
Ignition Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Relay > Component Information >
Locations > Page 3915
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 3919
C109
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 3920
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Two Types Of Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 3921
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the thermostat housing. 2. Remove the lower intake manifold. 3. Remove the coolant
tube.
- Discard the O-ring.
4. Disconnect the knock sensor (KS) electrical connector. 5. Remove the 2 bolts and the KS.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Lubricate the new O-ring with clean engine coolant.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Ignition
Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Ignition
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 3926
Ignition Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Ignition
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 3927
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor 1
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor 1 > Page 3933
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor
C1366
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor > Page 3936
C1367
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3937
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Typical Synchronizer Hall-Effect CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston
number 1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing
the sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil-on-plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP
signal to select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with 2 CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). They use the
second sensor to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2 as an input to the PCM.
There are 2 types of CMP sensors: the 3-pin connector Hall-effect type sensor and the 2-pin
connector variable reluctance type sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3938
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
RH sensor
1. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe.
LH sensor
2. Remove the air cleaner assembly.
Both sensors
3. Disconnect the camshaft position sensor (CMP) electrical connector. 4. Remove the bolt and the
CMP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
5. NOTE: Lubricate the CMP O-ring seal with clean engine oil.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3942
C101
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3943
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid deceleration between teeth.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3944
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the LH catalytic converter. 3.
Remove the bolt, nut and the heat shield.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
4. Remove the rubber grommet cover. 5. Disconnect the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor
electrical connector. 6. Remove the bolt and the CKP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
IGNITION LOCK CYLINDER
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the passive anti-theft system (PATS) transceiver. 2. Turn the ignition key to the ON
position. 3. Using a suitable tool, press the ignition lock cylinder release button and remove the
ignition lock cylinder. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3952
C109
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3953
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Two Types Of Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3954
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the thermostat housing. 2. Remove the lower intake manifold. 3. Remove the coolant
tube.
- Discard the O-ring.
4. Disconnect the knock sensor (KS) electrical connector. 5. Remove the 2 bolts and the KS.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Lubricate the new O-ring with clean engine coolant.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Specifications > General Specifications
Spark Plug: Specifications General Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Spark plug gap.....................................................................................................................................
....................................1.29-1.45 mm (0.051-0.057 in)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Specifications > General Specifications > Page 3959
Torque Specifications
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3960
Spark Plug: Application and ID
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Spark plug............................................................................................................................................
................................................................AYFS-22FM
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3961
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection
Spark Plug Inspection
1. Inspect the spark plug for a bridged gap.
^ Check for deposit build-up closing the gap between the electrodes. Deposits are caused by oil or
carbon fouling.
^ Clean the spark plug.
2. Check for oil fouling.
^ Check for wet, black deposits on the insulator shell bore electrodes, caused by excessive oil
entering the combustion chamber through worn rings and pistons, excessive valve-to-guide
clearance or worn or loose bearings.
^ Correct the oil leak concern.
^ Install a new spark plug.
3. Inspect for carbon fouling. Look for black, dry, fluffy carbon deposits on the insulator tips,
exposed shell surfaces and electrodes, caused by a
spark plug with an incorrect heat range, dirty air cleaner, too rich a fuel mixture or excessive idling.
^
Install new spark plugs.
4. Inspect for normal burning.
^ Check for light tan or gray deposits on the firing tip.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3962
5. Inspect for pre-ignition, identified by melted electrodes and a possibly damaged insulator.
Metallic deposits on the insulator indicate engine
damage. This may be caused by incorrect ignition timing, wrong type of fuel or the unauthorized
installation of a Heli-coil insert in place of the spark plug threads. ^
Install a new spark plug.
6. Inspect for overheating, identified by white or light gray spots and with a bluish-burnt appearance
of electrodes. This is caused by engine
overheating, wrong type of fuel, loose spark plugs, spark plugs with an incorrect heat range, low
fuel pump pressure or incorrect ignition timing. ^
Install a new spark plug.
7. Inspect for fused deposits, identified by melted or spotty deposits resembling bubbles or blisters.
These are caused by sudden acceleration.
^ Install new spark plugs.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3963
Spark Plug: Service and Repair
SPARK PLUGS
Exploded View
Removal
LH side 1. Disconnect the crankcase vent tube quick connect coupling from the valve cover fitting
and position aside.
RH side
2. NOTE: The upper intake manifold must be removed to access the RH spark plugs only.
Remove the upper intake manifold.
Both sides 3. Disconnect the 6 ignition coil-on-plug electrical connectors.
4. NOTE: When removing the ignition coil-on-plugs, a slight twisting motion will break the seal and
ease removal.
Remove the 6 bolts and the 6 ignition coil-on-plugs.
5. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when removing or installing the spark plugs or damage can
occur to the cylinder head or spark plug.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3964
NOTE: Use compressed air to remove any foreign material in the spark plug well before removing
the spark plugs.
Remove the 6 spark plugs.
Installation
Both sides
1. Inspect the 6 spark plugs.
2. Adjust the spark plug gap as necessary.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3965
3. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when removing or installing the spark plugs, or damage can
occur to the cylinder head or spark plug.
Install the 6 spark plugs. Tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
4. NOTE: Apply a small amount of dielectric grease to the inside of the ignition coil-on-plug boots
before attaching to the spark plugs.
Install the 6 ignition coil-on-plugs and the 6 bolts. Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
5. Connect the 6 ignition coil-on-plug electrical connectors.
RH side 6. Install the upper intake manifold.
LH side 7. Position and connect the crankcase vent tube quick connect coupling to the valve cover
fitting.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Specifications
Solenoid Operation Chart
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3974
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3975
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3976
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3977
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3978
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3979
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3980
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3981
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3982
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3983
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3984
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3985
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3986
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3987
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3988
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3989
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3990
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3991
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
Pinpoint Tests - OSC Equipped Vehicle
Special Tool(s)
Any time an electrical connector or solenoid body is disconnected, inspect the connector for
terminal condition, corrosion and contamination. Also inspect the connector seal for damage.
Clean, repair or install new components as required.
Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor Diagnosis Chart
A. "In Between" reading could be caused by a shift cable or digital TR sensor misaligned or a
digital TR sensor circuit failure of TR1, TR2, TR3 or TR4. B. TRD: 1= Open digital TR switch, 0=
Closed digital TR switch. C. VCM Readings: Taken from PCM signal pins for TR1, TR2, TR3 and
TR4 to signal return.
Wiggle Test Information for Open/Shorts A. Check TR1, TR2, TR3 and TR4 circuits for an
intermittent open with the TR sensor positioned so that suspect circuit is in the closed position and
monitor the TR_D with the scan tool. B. Check TR1, TR2, TR3 and TR4 circuits for an intermittent
short with the TR sensor positioned so that suspect circuit is in the open position and monitor the
TRD with the scan tool. To determine the shorted components while observing TRD, unplug the TR
and determine if the short goes away. If the short is still present unplug the transaxle harness and
determine if the short goes away. If the short is still present, then the short is in the powertrain
control module (PCM) or vehicle harness. Remove the suspect circuit(s) wire terminal from the
PCM connector. If the short is still present, then the PCM has an internal failure. Otherwise, the
failure is in the vehicle harness.
Shift Solenoid Pre-Diagnosis Use this shift solenoid operation information when carrying out
Pinpoint Test A.
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3992
Solenoid Operation Chart
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Failed ON" or "Failed OFF" Failed ON/OFF due to powertrain
control module and/or vehicle wiring concerns, and/or solenoid electrically, mechanically or
hydraulically stuck on/off.
SSA
SSB
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3993
SSC
SSD
SSE
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3994
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair
Solenoid Body Assembly
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3995
Removal
NOTE: The PCM must be updated with a new solenoid body strategy data file and solenoid body
ID anytime a new solenoid body is installed. A new solenoid body service tag must be installed
over the current solenoid body service tag on top of the transaxle case.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3996
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3997
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3998
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3999
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle main control cover.
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4000
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4001
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
Installation
1. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
2. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4002
3. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
4. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4003
5. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
6. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
7. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
8. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on the
inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4004
9. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
10. Wipe the surface of the existing solenoid body strategy tag on top of the transaxle case clean
and install the new solenoid body strategy tag
(supplied with the solenoid body service kit) over it.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4005
11. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
12. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
13. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4006
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
15. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
16. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
17. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
18. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4007
19. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
20. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
21. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
22. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4008
23. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
24. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level. 25. Download a new solenoid
body strategy to the PCM.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications
Shift Solenoid: Specifications
Solenoid Operation Chart
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Shift Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4014
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4015
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4016
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4017
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4018
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4019
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4020
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4021
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4022
Shift Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4023
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4024
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4025
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4026
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4027
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4028
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4029
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4030
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 4031
Shift Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
Pinpoint Tests - OSC Equipped Vehicle
Special Tool(s)
Any time an electrical connector or solenoid body is disconnected, inspect the connector for
terminal condition, corrosion and contamination. Also inspect the connector seal for damage.
Clean, repair or install new components as required.
Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor Diagnosis Chart
A. "In Between" reading could be caused by a shift cable or digital TR sensor misaligned or a
digital TR sensor circuit failure of TR1, TR2, TR3 or TR4. B. TRD: 1= Open digital TR switch, 0=
Closed digital TR switch. C. VCM Readings: Taken from PCM signal pins for TR1, TR2, TR3 and
TR4 to signal return.
Wiggle Test Information for Open/Shorts A. Check TR1, TR2, TR3 and TR4 circuits for an
intermittent open with the TR sensor positioned so that suspect circuit is in the closed position and
monitor the TR_D with the scan tool. B. Check TR1, TR2, TR3 and TR4 circuits for an intermittent
short with the TR sensor positioned so that suspect circuit is in the open position and monitor the
TRD with the scan tool. To determine the shorted components while observing TRD, unplug the TR
and determine if the short goes away. If the short is still present unplug the transaxle harness and
determine if the short goes away. If the short is still present, then the short is in the powertrain
control module (PCM) or vehicle harness. Remove the suspect circuit(s) wire terminal from the
PCM connector. If the short is still present, then the PCM has an internal failure. Otherwise, the
failure is in the vehicle harness.
Shift Solenoid Pre-Diagnosis Use this shift solenoid operation information when carrying out
Pinpoint Test A.
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 4032
Solenoid Operation Chart
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Failed ON" or "Failed OFF" Failed ON/OFF due to powertrain
control module and/or vehicle wiring concerns, and/or solenoid electrically, mechanically or
hydraulically stuck on/off.
SSA
SSB
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 4033
SSC
SSD
SSE
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 4034
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair
Solenoid Body Assembly
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 4035
Removal
NOTE: The PCM must be updated with a new solenoid body strategy data file and solenoid body
ID anytime a new solenoid body is installed. A new solenoid body service tag must be installed
over the current solenoid body service tag on top of the transaxle case.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 4036
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 4037
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 4038
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 4039
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle main control cover.
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 4040
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 4041
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
Installation
1. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
2. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 4042
3. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
4. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 4043
5. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
6. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
7. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
8. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on the
inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 4044
9. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
10. Wipe the surface of the existing solenoid body strategy tag on top of the transaxle case clean
and install the new solenoid body strategy tag
(supplied with the solenoid body service kit) over it.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 4045
11. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
12. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
13. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 4046
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
15. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
16. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
17. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
18. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 4047
19. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
20. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
21. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
22. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 4048
23. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
24. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level. 25. Download a new solenoid
body strategy to the PCM.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Specifications
Solenoid Operation Chart
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4054
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4055
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4056
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4057
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4058
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4059
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4060
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4061
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4062
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4063
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4064
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4065
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4066
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4067
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4068
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4069
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4070
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4071
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Service and Repair
Solenoid Body Assembly
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4072
Removal
NOTE: The PCM must be updated with a new solenoid body strategy data file and solenoid body
ID anytime a new solenoid body is installed. A new solenoid body service tag must be installed
over the current solenoid body service tag on top of the transaxle case.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4073
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4074
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4075
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4076
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle main control cover.
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4077
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4078
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
Installation
1. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
2. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4079
3. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
4. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4080
5. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
6. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
7. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
8. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on the
inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4081
9. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
10. Wipe the surface of the existing solenoid body strategy tag on top of the transaxle case clean
and install the new solenoid body strategy tag
(supplied with the solenoid body service kit) over it.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4082
11. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
12. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
13. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4083
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
15. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
16. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
17. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
18. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4084
19. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
20. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
21. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
22. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4085
23. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
24. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level. 25. Download a new solenoid
body strategy to the PCM.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL INDICATOR LAMP (TCIL)
The TCIL is an output signal from the PCM that controls the lamp on/off function depending on the
engagement or disengagement of overdrive.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4097
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4098
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4099
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4100
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4101
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4102
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4103
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4104
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4105
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4106
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4107
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4108
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4109
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4110
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4111
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4112
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4113
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 4114
Brake Switch - TCC: Description and Operation
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal to the
PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Overdrive Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4119
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4120
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4121
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4122
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4123
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4124
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4125
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4126
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4127
Overdrive Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4128
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4129
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4130
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4131
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4132
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4133
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4134
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4135
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4140
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4141
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4142
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4143
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4144
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4145
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4146
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4147
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4148
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4149
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4150
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4151
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4152
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4153
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4154
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4155
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4156
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4161
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4162
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4163
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4164
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4165
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4166
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4167
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4168
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4169
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4170
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4171
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4172
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4173
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4174
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4175
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4176
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4177
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 4178
Transmission Mode Switch: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL SWITCH (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
The TCS signals the PCM with VPWR whenever the TCS is pressed. On vehicles with this feature,
the transmission control indicator lamp (TCIL) illuminates when the TCS is cycled to disengage
overdrive.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4183
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4184
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4185
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4186
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4187
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4188
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4189
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4190
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4191
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4192
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4193
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4194
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4195
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4196
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4197
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4198
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4199
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4200
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4201
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4202
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
12. Disconnect the selector lever cable end from the manual lever.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4203
13. Remove the nut and the manual lever.
14. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
15. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
16. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4204
17. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
18. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
19. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle side cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4205
20. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
21. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
22. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4206
23. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when removing the solenoid body filter.
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
24. Remove the 10 bolts, the TR sensor detent spring and the main control valve body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4207
25. Using a suitable tool, remove and discard the TR sensor locking pin.
26. NOTE: TR sensor removed for clarity.
Make sure that the park pawl actuator rod does not become disengaged from the park pawl and
the abutment by keeping the end of the park pawl actuator rod behind the machined valve body
mating surface of the transaxle case. If the park pawl actuator rod becomes disengaged from the
park pawl and the abutment, transaxle removal and disassembly is required to reinstall the actuator
rod.
27. CAUTION: Make sure that the park pawl actuator rod does not become disengaged from the
park pawl and the abutment or transaxle
removal and disassembly is required to reinstall the actuator rod.
Remove the TR sensor. 1
Slide the TR sensor down until the manual shaft is out of the transaxle case.
2 Rotate the TR sensor detent plate counterclockwise, as viewed from below until the plate rests
against the transaxle case, remove the park
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4208
pawl actuating rod from the TR sensor and remove the TR sensor.
Installation
1. Install the TR sensor.
1 Position the park pawl actuating rod in the TR sensor.
2 Install the TR sensor in the transaxle case.
2. Using the special tool, install a new TR sensor locking pin.
3. NOTE: Make sure that the manual lever pin (part of the TR sensor) is correctly installed in the
manual valve.
Position the TSS, OSS and TR sensor wiring harnesses aside and install the main control valve
body, the TR sensor detent spring and the 10 bolts. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown. ^
Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4209
4. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
5. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4
95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4210
6. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
7. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4211
8. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
9. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
10. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
11. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on
the inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4212
12. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
13. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4213
14. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
15. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
16. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
17. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4214
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
18. Install the manual lever and the nut.
^ Tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs).
19. Connect the selector lever cable end to the manual lever.
20. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
21. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4215
22. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
23. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
24. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
25. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4216
26. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
27. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
28. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Transmission Speed Sensor: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh
Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's
Transmission Speed Sensor: Customer Interest A/T - Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's
TSB 07-21-11
10/29/07
6F50 TRANSAXLES BUILT PRIOR TO 10/21/2007 - DTC P0715, P0717, P0718, P0720, P0721,
P0722 AND/OR HARSH ENGAGEMENT, NO UPSHIFT, FIFTH GEAR ONLY
FORD: 2008 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2008Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
MERCURY: 2008 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 07-3-11 to update the transaxle built date coverage and Part List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Edge and MKX, 2008 Taurus Taurus X, and Sable vehicles equipped with
a 6F50 transaxle with a build date prior to 10/21/2007, with any Output Shaft Speed (OSS) sensor
or Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) sensor diagnostic trouble code(s) (DTCs) P0715, P0717, P0718,
P0720, P0721, P0722 and/or harsh engagements, no upshift, fifth gear only, could have an
intermittent short in the OSS or TSS sensor.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. If any DTCs related to OSS or TSS are present, check the transaxle build date following
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
a. If the build date is before 10/21/2007 go to Step 2.
b. If vehicle transaxle is built on or after 10/21/2007 do not continue with this TSB and follow
normal WSM, Section 307-01 Automatic Transaxle/Transmission-6F50 Diagnosis and Testing.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Transmission Speed Sensor: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh
Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's > Page 4225
2. To repair an OSS or TSS DTC refer to WSM, Section 307-01, follow pin point test (PPT) C. The
TSS sensor is located in the end cover assembly (Figure 1). The OSS sensor is located inside the
transaxle under the main Control (Figure 2). Both sensor connectors are plugged into the solenoid
body. Both sensor connectors look the same but are wired differently (Figure 3).
3. If you work through PPT C and get to Step C9 before finding the cause of the concern, replace
the sensor (DO NOT REPLACE THE POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) AT THIS TIME).
Reassemble as needed and verify the concern is fixed.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT:
Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits are
determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Transmission Speed Sensor: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh
Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's > Page 4226
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT072111 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING BASIC PART NO.
CONDITION
7M101 CODE
42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Transmission Speed Sensor: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's
Transmission Speed Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Harsh Engagement/No
Shift/Multiple DTC's
TSB 07-21-11
10/29/07
6F50 TRANSAXLES BUILT PRIOR TO 10/21/2007 - DTC P0715, P0717, P0718, P0720, P0721,
P0722 AND/OR HARSH ENGAGEMENT, NO UPSHIFT, FIFTH GEAR ONLY
FORD: 2008 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2008Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
MERCURY: 2008 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 07-3-11 to update the transaxle built date coverage and Part List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Edge and MKX, 2008 Taurus Taurus X, and Sable vehicles equipped with
a 6F50 transaxle with a build date prior to 10/21/2007, with any Output Shaft Speed (OSS) sensor
or Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) sensor diagnostic trouble code(s) (DTCs) P0715, P0717, P0718,
P0720, P0721, P0722 and/or harsh engagements, no upshift, fifth gear only, could have an
intermittent short in the OSS or TSS sensor.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. If any DTCs related to OSS or TSS are present, check the transaxle build date following
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
a. If the build date is before 10/21/2007 go to Step 2.
b. If vehicle transaxle is built on or after 10/21/2007 do not continue with this TSB and follow
normal WSM, Section 307-01 Automatic Transaxle/Transmission-6F50 Diagnosis and Testing.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Transmission Speed Sensor: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's > Page 4232
2. To repair an OSS or TSS DTC refer to WSM, Section 307-01, follow pin point test (PPT) C. The
TSS sensor is located in the end cover assembly (Figure 1). The OSS sensor is located inside the
transaxle under the main Control (Figure 2). Both sensor connectors are plugged into the solenoid
body. Both sensor connectors look the same but are wired differently (Figure 3).
3. If you work through PPT C and get to Step C9 before finding the cause of the concern, replace
the sensor (DO NOT REPLACE THE POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) AT THIS TIME).
Reassemble as needed and verify the concern is fixed.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT:
Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits are
determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Transmission Speed Sensor: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's > Page 4233
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT072111 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING BASIC PART NO.
CONDITION
7M101 CODE
42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4236
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4237
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4238
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4239
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4240
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4241
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4242
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4243
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4244
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4245
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4246
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4247
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4248
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4249
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4250
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4251
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4252
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor
Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4255
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4256
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4257
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle side cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4258
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4259
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
22. Remove the 10 bolts, the detent spring and the main control valve body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4260
23. Remove the bolt and the TSS sensor.
Installation
1. Route the TSS sensor wiring harness through the cover and the transaxle case.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4261
2. Install the TSS sensor in the cover and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
3. NOTE: Make sure that the manual lever pin (part of the TR sensor) is correctly installed in the
manual valve.
Position the TSS, OSS and TR sensor wiring harnesses aside and install the main control valve
body, the TR sensor detent spring and the 10 bolts. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown. ^
Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4262
4. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
5. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3
80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4263
6. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
7. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4264
8. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
9. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
10. Inspect the transaxle side cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
11. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on
the inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle side cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4265
12. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
13. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4266
14. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
15. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
16. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4267
17. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
18. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
19. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
20. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
21. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4268
22. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
23. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
24. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
25. Connect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness
fastener.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4269
26. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4270
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4271
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4272
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4273
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle side cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4274
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4275
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when removing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
22. Remove the 10 bolts, the TR sensor detent spring and the main control valve body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4276
23. Remove the bolt and the OSS sensor.
Installation
1. Install the OSS sensor and the bolt.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
2. NOTE: Make sure that the manual lever pin (part of the TR sensor) is correctly installed in the
manual valve.
Position the TSS, OSS and TR sensor wiring harnesses aside and install the main control valve
body, the TR sensor detent spring and the 10 bolts. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown. ^
Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4277
3. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
4. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4278
5. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
6. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4279
7. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
8. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
9. Inspect the transaxle side cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
10. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on
the inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle side cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4280
11. Tighten the main control valve body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
12. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4281
13. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
14. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
15. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
16. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4282
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
17. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
18. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
19. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
20. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4283
21. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
22. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
23. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
24. Connect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness
fastener.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 4284
25. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4289
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4290
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4291
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4292
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4293
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4294
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4295
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4296
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4297
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4298
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4299
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4300
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4301
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4302
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4303
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4304
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4305
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: > 09-11-15 >
Jun > 09 > Engine Controls - Rough/Rolling Idle/Idle Speed Drop
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest Engine Controls - Rough/Rolling
Idle/Idle Speed Drop
TSB 09-11-15
06/15/09
ROUGH / ROLLING IDLE / IDLE SPEED DROPS BELOW SPECIFICATION / LIGHT THROTTLE
WITH CRUISE ENGAGED / LOW SPEED TIP IN CLUNK
FORD: 2008-2009 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2009 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKX
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 8-23-5 to update the vehicle lines and Action statement.
ISSUE Some 2008-2009 Taurus, Taurus-X, Sable and 2007-2009 Edge and MKX vehicles may
exhibit a rough, rolling idle, or the idle speed dropping below specification. This condition typically
occurs most often in hot ambient temperatures with the A/C on when idling for extended periods.
Vehicles may also exhibit idle speed dropping below specification on light throttle application with
vehicle cruise control engaged and traveling down a hill or a low speed tip in clunk.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) to the latest calibration using IDS
release 61.05 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration
files may also be obtained at the website.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091115A 2008-2009 Taurus, Sable, 0.3 Hr.
Taurus X. 2007-2009 Edge, MKX: Reprogram The PCM, Authorization Decal Not Required. (Do
Not Use With 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: > 08-26-8 >
Jan > 09 > Engine Controls - Harsh Low Speed Driveline Clunk
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest Engine Controls - Harsh Low
Speed Driveline Clunk
TSB 08-26-8
01/05/09
HARSH DRIVELINE CLUNK / LOW SPEED BELOW 10 MPH (16 KM/H) ON TIP-IN OR VEHICLE
ROLLS ON INCLINE WHILE STOPPED WITHOUT BRAKE APPLIED-IN DRIVE OR REVERSE
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 08-25-2 to update the calibration information.
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles may exhibit a harsh driveline clunk at low speed, below
10 MPH (16 Km/h) during stop and go driving on tip in while touching the accelerator pedal (could
be perceived as a harsh 1-2 upshift or 2-1 downshift) may be due to a Powertrain Control Module
(PCM) calibration. There is a new calibration that will improve the low speed stop and go driving
feel.
ACTION Reprogram the PCM to the latest calibration using IDS release 57.14 and higher or 58.5
and higher.
This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2008.9 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained
at the website.
NOTE
AUTHORIZATION DECAL NOT REQUIRED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082608A 2007 Edge, MKX: Check 0.3 Hr.
For DTCs And Reprogram The PCM. Authorization Decal Not Required (Do Not Use With 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
09-11-15 > Jun > 09 > Engine Controls - Rough/Rolling Idle/Idle Speed Drop
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls Rough/Rolling Idle/Idle Speed Drop
TSB 09-11-15
06/15/09
ROUGH / ROLLING IDLE / IDLE SPEED DROPS BELOW SPECIFICATION / LIGHT THROTTLE
WITH CRUISE ENGAGED / LOW SPEED TIP IN CLUNK
FORD: 2008-2009 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2009 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKX
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 8-23-5 to update the vehicle lines and Action statement.
ISSUE Some 2008-2009 Taurus, Taurus-X, Sable and 2007-2009 Edge and MKX vehicles may
exhibit a rough, rolling idle, or the idle speed dropping below specification. This condition typically
occurs most often in hot ambient temperatures with the A/C on when idling for extended periods.
Vehicles may also exhibit idle speed dropping below specification on light throttle application with
vehicle cruise control engaged and traveling down a hill or a low speed tip in clunk.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) to the latest calibration using IDS
release 61.05 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration
files may also be obtained at the website.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091115A 2008-2009 Taurus, Sable, 0.3 Hr.
Taurus X. 2007-2009 Edge, MKX: Reprogram The PCM, Authorization Decal Not Required. (Do
Not Use With 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
08-26-8 > Jan > 09 > Engine Controls - Harsh Low Speed Driveline Clunk
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls Harsh Low Speed Driveline Clunk
TSB 08-26-8
01/05/09
HARSH DRIVELINE CLUNK / LOW SPEED BELOW 10 MPH (16 KM/H) ON TIP-IN OR VEHICLE
ROLLS ON INCLINE WHILE STOPPED WITHOUT BRAKE APPLIED-IN DRIVE OR REVERSE
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 08-25-2 to update the calibration information.
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles may exhibit a harsh driveline clunk at low speed, below
10 MPH (16 Km/h) during stop and go driving on tip in while touching the accelerator pedal (could
be perceived as a harsh 1-2 upshift or 2-1 downshift) may be due to a Powertrain Control Module
(PCM) calibration. There is a new calibration that will improve the low speed stop and go driving
feel.
ACTION Reprogram the PCM to the latest calibration using IDS release 57.14 and higher or 58.5
and higher.
This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2008.9 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained
at the website.
NOTE
AUTHORIZATION DECAL NOT REQUIRED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082608A 2007 Edge, MKX: Check 0.3 Hr.
For DTCs And Reprogram The PCM. Authorization Decal Not Required (Do Not Use With 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Specifications
Solenoid Operation Chart
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4335
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4336
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4337
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4338
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4339
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4340
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4341
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4342
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4343
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4344
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4345
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4346
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4347
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4348
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4349
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4350
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4351
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4352
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
Pinpoint Tests - OSC Equipped Vehicle
Special Tool(s)
Any time an electrical connector or solenoid body is disconnected, inspect the connector for
terminal condition, corrosion and contamination. Also inspect the connector seal for damage.
Clean, repair or install new components as required.
Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor Diagnosis Chart
A. "In Between" reading could be caused by a shift cable or digital TR sensor misaligned or a
digital TR sensor circuit failure of TR1, TR2, TR3 or TR4. B. TRD: 1= Open digital TR switch, 0=
Closed digital TR switch. C. VCM Readings: Taken from PCM signal pins for TR1, TR2, TR3 and
TR4 to signal return.
Wiggle Test Information for Open/Shorts A. Check TR1, TR2, TR3 and TR4 circuits for an
intermittent open with the TR sensor positioned so that suspect circuit is in the closed position and
monitor the TR_D with the scan tool. B. Check TR1, TR2, TR3 and TR4 circuits for an intermittent
short with the TR sensor positioned so that suspect circuit is in the open position and monitor the
TRD with the scan tool. To determine the shorted components while observing TRD, unplug the TR
and determine if the short goes away. If the short is still present unplug the transaxle harness and
determine if the short goes away. If the short is still present, then the short is in the powertrain
control module (PCM) or vehicle harness. Remove the suspect circuit(s) wire terminal from the
PCM connector. If the short is still present, then the PCM has an internal failure. Otherwise, the
failure is in the vehicle harness.
Shift Solenoid Pre-Diagnosis Use this shift solenoid operation information when carrying out
Pinpoint Test A.
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4353
Solenoid Operation Chart
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Failed ON" or "Failed OFF" Failed ON/OFF due to powertrain
control module and/or vehicle wiring concerns, and/or solenoid electrically, mechanically or
hydraulically stuck on/off.
SSA
SSB
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4354
SSC
SSD
SSE
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4355
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair
Solenoid Body Assembly
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4356
Removal
NOTE: The PCM must be updated with a new solenoid body strategy data file and solenoid body
ID anytime a new solenoid body is installed. A new solenoid body service tag must be installed
over the current solenoid body service tag on top of the transaxle case.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4357
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4358
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4359
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4360
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle main control cover.
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4361
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4362
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
Installation
1. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
2. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4363
3. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
4. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4364
5. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
6. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
7. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
8. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on the
inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4365
9. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
10. Wipe the surface of the existing solenoid body strategy tag on top of the transaxle case clean
and install the new solenoid body strategy tag
(supplied with the solenoid body service kit) over it.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4366
11. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
12. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
13. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4367
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
15. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
16. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
17. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
18. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4368
19. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
20. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
21. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
22. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4369
23. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
24. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level. 25. Download a new solenoid
body strategy to the PCM.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Shift Solenoid: Specifications
Solenoid Operation Chart
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Shift Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4375
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4376
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4377
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4378
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4379
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4380
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4381
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4382
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4383
Shift Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4384
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4385
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4386
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4387
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4388
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4389
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4390
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4391
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4392
Shift Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
Pinpoint Tests - OSC Equipped Vehicle
Special Tool(s)
Any time an electrical connector or solenoid body is disconnected, inspect the connector for
terminal condition, corrosion and contamination. Also inspect the connector seal for damage.
Clean, repair or install new components as required.
Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor Diagnosis Chart
A. "In Between" reading could be caused by a shift cable or digital TR sensor misaligned or a
digital TR sensor circuit failure of TR1, TR2, TR3 or TR4. B. TRD: 1= Open digital TR switch, 0=
Closed digital TR switch. C. VCM Readings: Taken from PCM signal pins for TR1, TR2, TR3 and
TR4 to signal return.
Wiggle Test Information for Open/Shorts A. Check TR1, TR2, TR3 and TR4 circuits for an
intermittent open with the TR sensor positioned so that suspect circuit is in the closed position and
monitor the TR_D with the scan tool. B. Check TR1, TR2, TR3 and TR4 circuits for an intermittent
short with the TR sensor positioned so that suspect circuit is in the open position and monitor the
TRD with the scan tool. To determine the shorted components while observing TRD, unplug the TR
and determine if the short goes away. If the short is still present unplug the transaxle harness and
determine if the short goes away. If the short is still present, then the short is in the powertrain
control module (PCM) or vehicle harness. Remove the suspect circuit(s) wire terminal from the
PCM connector. If the short is still present, then the PCM has an internal failure. Otherwise, the
failure is in the vehicle harness.
Shift Solenoid Pre-Diagnosis Use this shift solenoid operation information when carrying out
Pinpoint Test A.
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4393
Solenoid Operation Chart
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Failed ON" or "Failed OFF" Failed ON/OFF due to powertrain
control module and/or vehicle wiring concerns, and/or solenoid electrically, mechanically or
hydraulically stuck on/off.
SSA
SSB
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4394
SSC
SSD
SSE
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4395
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair
Solenoid Body Assembly
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4396
Removal
NOTE: The PCM must be updated with a new solenoid body strategy data file and solenoid body
ID anytime a new solenoid body is installed. A new solenoid body service tag must be installed
over the current solenoid body service tag on top of the transaxle case.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4397
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4398
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4399
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4400
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle main control cover.
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4401
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4402
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
Installation
1. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
2. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4403
3. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
4. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4404
5. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
6. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
7. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
8. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on the
inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4405
9. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
10. Wipe the surface of the existing solenoid body strategy tag on top of the transaxle case clean
and install the new solenoid body strategy tag
(supplied with the solenoid body service kit) over it.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4406
11. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
12. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
13. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4407
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
15. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
16. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
17. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
18. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4408
19. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
20. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
21. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
22. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4409
23. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
24. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level. 25. Download a new solenoid
body strategy to the PCM.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Specifications
Solenoid Operation Chart
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4415
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4416
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4417
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4418
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4419
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4420
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4421
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4422
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4423
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4424
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4425
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4426
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4427
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4428
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4429
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4430
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4431
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4432
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Service and Repair
Solenoid Body Assembly
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4433
Removal
NOTE: The PCM must be updated with a new solenoid body strategy data file and solenoid body
ID anytime a new solenoid body is installed. A new solenoid body service tag must be installed
over the current solenoid body service tag on top of the transaxle case.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4434
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4435
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4436
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4437
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle main control cover.
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4438
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4439
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
Installation
1. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
2. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4440
3. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
4. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4441
5. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
6. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
7. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
8. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on the
inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4442
9. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
10. Wipe the surface of the existing solenoid body strategy tag on top of the transaxle case clean
and install the new solenoid body strategy tag
(supplied with the solenoid body service kit) over it.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4443
11. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
12. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
13. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4444
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
15. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
16. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
17. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
18. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4445
19. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
20. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
21. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
22. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4446
23. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
24. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level. 25. Download a new solenoid
body strategy to the PCM.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Specifications
Solenoid Operation Chart
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4454
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4455
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4456
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4457
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4458
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4459
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4460
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4461
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4462
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4463
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4464
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4465
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4466
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4467
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4468
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4469
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4470
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4471
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
Pinpoint Tests - OSC Equipped Vehicle
Special Tool(s)
Any time an electrical connector or solenoid body is disconnected, inspect the connector for
terminal condition, corrosion and contamination. Also inspect the connector seal for damage.
Clean, repair or install new components as required.
Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor Diagnosis Chart
A. "In Between" reading could be caused by a shift cable or digital TR sensor misaligned or a
digital TR sensor circuit failure of TR1, TR2, TR3 or TR4. B. TRD: 1= Open digital TR switch, 0=
Closed digital TR switch. C. VCM Readings: Taken from PCM signal pins for TR1, TR2, TR3 and
TR4 to signal return.
Wiggle Test Information for Open/Shorts A. Check TR1, TR2, TR3 and TR4 circuits for an
intermittent open with the TR sensor positioned so that suspect circuit is in the closed position and
monitor the TR_D with the scan tool. B. Check TR1, TR2, TR3 and TR4 circuits for an intermittent
short with the TR sensor positioned so that suspect circuit is in the open position and monitor the
TRD with the scan tool. To determine the shorted components while observing TRD, unplug the TR
and determine if the short goes away. If the short is still present unplug the transaxle harness and
determine if the short goes away. If the short is still present, then the short is in the powertrain
control module (PCM) or vehicle harness. Remove the suspect circuit(s) wire terminal from the
PCM connector. If the short is still present, then the PCM has an internal failure. Otherwise, the
failure is in the vehicle harness.
Shift Solenoid Pre-Diagnosis Use this shift solenoid operation information when carrying out
Pinpoint Test A.
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4472
Solenoid Operation Chart
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Failed ON" or "Failed OFF" Failed ON/OFF due to powertrain
control module and/or vehicle wiring concerns, and/or solenoid electrically, mechanically or
hydraulically stuck on/off.
SSA
SSB
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4473
SSC
SSD
SSE
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4474
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair
Solenoid Body Assembly
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4475
Removal
NOTE: The PCM must be updated with a new solenoid body strategy data file and solenoid body
ID anytime a new solenoid body is installed. A new solenoid body service tag must be installed
over the current solenoid body service tag on top of the transaxle case.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4476
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4477
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4478
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4479
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle main control cover.
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4480
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4481
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
Installation
1. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
2. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4482
3. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
4. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4483
5. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
6. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
7. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
8. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on the
inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4484
9. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
10. Wipe the surface of the existing solenoid body strategy tag on top of the transaxle case clean
and install the new solenoid body strategy tag
(supplied with the solenoid body service kit) over it.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4485
11. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
12. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
13. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4486
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
15. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
16. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
17. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
18. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4487
19. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
20. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
21. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
22. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4488
23. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
24. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level. 25. Download a new solenoid
body strategy to the PCM.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Shift Solenoid: Specifications
Solenoid Operation Chart
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Shift Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4494
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4495
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4496
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4497
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4498
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4499
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4500
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4501
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4502
Shift Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4503
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4504
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4505
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4506
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4507
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4508
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4509
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4510
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4511
Shift Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
Pinpoint Tests - OSC Equipped Vehicle
Special Tool(s)
Any time an electrical connector or solenoid body is disconnected, inspect the connector for
terminal condition, corrosion and contamination. Also inspect the connector seal for damage.
Clean, repair or install new components as required.
Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor Diagnosis Chart
A. "In Between" reading could be caused by a shift cable or digital TR sensor misaligned or a
digital TR sensor circuit failure of TR1, TR2, TR3 or TR4. B. TRD: 1= Open digital TR switch, 0=
Closed digital TR switch. C. VCM Readings: Taken from PCM signal pins for TR1, TR2, TR3 and
TR4 to signal return.
Wiggle Test Information for Open/Shorts A. Check TR1, TR2, TR3 and TR4 circuits for an
intermittent open with the TR sensor positioned so that suspect circuit is in the closed position and
monitor the TR_D with the scan tool. B. Check TR1, TR2, TR3 and TR4 circuits for an intermittent
short with the TR sensor positioned so that suspect circuit is in the open position and monitor the
TRD with the scan tool. To determine the shorted components while observing TRD, unplug the TR
and determine if the short goes away. If the short is still present unplug the transaxle harness and
determine if the short goes away. If the short is still present, then the short is in the powertrain
control module (PCM) or vehicle harness. Remove the suspect circuit(s) wire terminal from the
PCM connector. If the short is still present, then the PCM has an internal failure. Otherwise, the
failure is in the vehicle harness.
Shift Solenoid Pre-Diagnosis Use this shift solenoid operation information when carrying out
Pinpoint Test A.
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4512
Solenoid Operation Chart
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Failed ON" or "Failed OFF" Failed ON/OFF due to powertrain
control module and/or vehicle wiring concerns, and/or solenoid electrically, mechanically or
hydraulically stuck on/off.
SSA
SSB
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4513
SSC
SSD
SSE
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4514
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair
Solenoid Body Assembly
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4515
Removal
NOTE: The PCM must be updated with a new solenoid body strategy data file and solenoid body
ID anytime a new solenoid body is installed. A new solenoid body service tag must be installed
over the current solenoid body service tag on top of the transaxle case.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4516
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4517
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4518
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4519
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle main control cover.
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4520
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4521
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
Installation
1. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
2. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4522
3. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
4. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4523
5. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
6. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
7. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
8. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on the
inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4524
9. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
10. Wipe the surface of the existing solenoid body strategy tag on top of the transaxle case clean
and install the new solenoid body strategy tag
(supplied with the solenoid body service kit) over it.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4525
11. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
12. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
13. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4526
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
15. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
16. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
17. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
18. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4527
19. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
20. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
21. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
22. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4528
23. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
24. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level. 25. Download a new solenoid
body strategy to the PCM.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Specifications
Solenoid Operation Chart
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4534
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4535
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4536
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4537
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4538
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4539
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4540
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4541
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4542
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4543
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4544
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4545
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4546
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4547
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4548
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4549
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4550
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4551
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Service and Repair
Solenoid Body Assembly
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4552
Removal
NOTE: The PCM must be updated with a new solenoid body strategy data file and solenoid body
ID anytime a new solenoid body is installed. A new solenoid body service tag must be installed
over the current solenoid body service tag on top of the transaxle case.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4553
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4554
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4555
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4556
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle main control cover.
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4557
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4558
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
Installation
1. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
2. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4559
3. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
4. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4560
5. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
6. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
7. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
8. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on the
inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4561
9. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
10. Wipe the surface of the existing solenoid body strategy tag on top of the transaxle case clean
and install the new solenoid body strategy tag
(supplied with the solenoid body service kit) over it.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4562
11. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
12. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
13. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4563
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
15. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
16. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
17. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
18. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4564
19. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
20. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
21. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
22. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4565
23. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
24. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level. 25. Download a new solenoid
body strategy to the PCM.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4570
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4571
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4572
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4573
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4574
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4575
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4576
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4577
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4578
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4579
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4580
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4581
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4582
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4583
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4584
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4585
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4586
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4587
Brake Switch - TCC: Description and Operation
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal to the
PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Clutch: Specifications
Clutch Application Chart
Clutch Application Chart (Part 1)
Clutch Application Chart (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
Transmission Fluid ..............................................................................................................................
............................................... 10.0 quarts (9.5 liters)
Note: Indicates only approximate dry-fill capacity. Some applications mat vary based on cooler size
and if equipped with an in-tank cooler. The amount of transmission fluid and fluid level should be
set by the indication on the dipstick's normal operating range.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 4595
Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Transmission Fluid Type
Type .....................................................................................................................................................
............................................ MERCON V XT-5-QM
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4596
Fluid - A/T: Testing and Inspection
Check Fluid Level and Condition (All vehicles)
CAUTION: The vehicle should not be driven if the fluid level indicator shows the fluid below the
minimum fluid level mark or internal failure could result.
If the vehicle has been operated for an extended period of time, at highway speeds, in city traffic, in
hot weather or while pulling a trailer, the fluid needs to cool down to obtain an accurate reading.
The fluid level reading on the fluid level indicator will differ depending on operating and ambient
temperatures. The correct reading should be within the normal operating temperature range.
Fluid Level Check
NOTE: The transmission fluid should be checked at normal operating temperature 80°C-93°C
(175°F-200°F) on a level surface. Normal operating temperature can be reached after
approximately 32 km (20 miles) of driving and can be checked using the scan tool.
Under normal circumstances the fluid level should be checked during normal maintenance. If the
transaxle starts to slip, shifts slowly or shows signs of fluid leaking, the fluid level should be
checked.
1. With the transaxle in PARK, the engine at idle, foot pressed on the brake, move the selector
lever through each gear and allow engagement of each
gear. Place the selector lever in the PARK position.
2. Wipe the fluid level indicator cap and remove the fluid level indicator. 3. Wipe the fluid level
indicator with a clean cloth. 4. Install the fluid level indicator back in the fluid indicator tube until it is
fully seated, then remove the indicator. The fluid level should be within the
normal operating range.
High Fluid Level A fluid level that is too high may cause the fluid to become aerated due to the
churning action of the rotating internal parts. This will cause erratic control pressure, foaming, loss
of fluid from the vent tube and possible transaxle malfunction and/or damage.
Low Fluid Level A low fluid level could result in poor transaxle engagement, slipping, malfunction
and/or damage. This could also indicate a leak in one of the transaxle seals or gaskets.
Adding Fluid
CAUTION: MERCON(R) V, MERCON(R) SP, Motorcraft Premium Automatic Transmission Fluid,
Motorcraft Continuously Variable Chain Type Transmission Fluid and FNR5 automatic transmission
fluid are not interchangeable transmission fluids. The use of any fluid other than what is
recommended for this transmission will cause transmission damage.
If fluid needs to be added, add fluid in 0.25L (1/2 pt) increments through the indicator tube. Do not
overfill the fluid.
Fluid Condition Check
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4597
1. Check the fluid level. 2. Observe the color and the odor. The color under normal circumstances
should be a dark red color, not brown or black or have a burnt odor. 3. Hold the fluid level indicator
over a white facial tissue and allow the fluid to drip onto the facial tissue and examine the stain. 4. If
evidence of solid material is found, the transmission fluid pan should be removed for further
inspection. 5. If fluid contamination or transaxle failure is confirmed by the sediment in the bottom
of the fluid pan, repair the transaxle and clean the fluid
cooler tubes and fluid cooler.
6. If the transaxle is to be overhauled or if installing a new transaxle, the fluid cooler must be
backflushed.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4598
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill
Material
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
2. NOTE: If an internal problem is suspected, drain the transmission fluid through a paper filter. A
small amount of metal or friction particles may be
found from normal wear. If an excessive amount of metal or friction material is present, the
transaxle will need to be overhauled.
Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
3. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
4. Fill the transaxle with clean automatic transmission fluid.
5. Start the engine, run through all the gears, check the fluid level and run the engine for 5 minutes.
Repeat steps 2, 3 and 4.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4599
6. Start the engine, run through all the gears and check the fluid level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Fluid Line/Hose: Service and Repair
Transmission Fluid Cooler Tubes
Special Tool(s)
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4603
Transmission Fluid Cooler Tubes (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4604
Transmission Fluid Cooler Tubes (Part 2)
Removal
CAUTION: MERCON(R) V, MERCON(R) SP, Motorcraft Premium Automatic Transmission Fluid,
Motorcraft Continuously Variable Chain Type Transmission Fluid and FNR5 Automatic
Transmission Fluid are not interchangeable transmission fluids. The use of any fluid other than
what is recommended for this transmission will cause transmission damage.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove the front bumper cover. 3. Disconnect the mass air
flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner
assembly.
4. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4605
5. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
6. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
7. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
8. Remove the battery. For additional information, refer to Battery. 9. Remove the battery tray.
1 Disconnect the wiring harness fasteners.
2 Remove the 3 bolts and the battery tray.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4606
10. Disconnect the transmission fluid cooler tube fasteners from the radiator support.
11. Remove the secondary latches from the transmission fluid cooler.
12. Using the special tool, disconnect the transmission fluid cooler tubes from the transmission fluid
cooler.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4607
13. Remove the 2 secondary latches from the transmission fluid cooler tubes at the transmission
fluid cooler thermal bypass valve.
14. Using the special tool, disconnect the transmission fluid cooler tubes from the transmission fluid
cooler thermal bypass valve.
15. NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
Pull up on the tabs on both sides of the radiator support, position the radiator back and remove the
transmission fluid cooler tubes from the cooling module.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4608
16. Remove the 2 transmission fluid cooler tube bolts.
17. Inspect the transaxle case to be sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seals and backing
rings were removed with the transmission fluid cooler
tubes and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seals or backing
rings are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seals and backing rings.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4609
18. Loosen the 2 fluid cooler tube fittings and remove the 2 fluid cooler tubes from the thermal
bypass valve and the transaxle.
19. Remove the 2 nuts and the thermal bypass valve.
Installation
1. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4610
2. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing rings and seals for damage and install new
backing rings or seals if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seals with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
rings and seals on the transmission fluid cooler tubes.
3. Position the 2 fluid cooler tubes on the transaxle and tighten the 2 fluid cooler tube fittings.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
4. Install the 2 transmission fluid cooler tube bolts.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4611
5. NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
Route the transmission fluid cooler tubes through the cooling module and fasten the upper radiator
brackets to the radiator support through the cooling module.
6. Install the transmission fluid cooler tubes in the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve.
7. Install the 2 secondary latches on the transmission fluid cooler tubes at the transmission fluid
cooler thermal bypass valve.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4612
8. Connect the transmission fluid cooler tubes to the transmission fluid cooler.
9. Install the secondary latches on the transmission fluid cooler.
10. Connect the transmission fluid cooler tube fasteners to the radiator support.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4613
11. Install the battery tray.
1 Install the 3 bolts. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
2 Connect the wiring harness fasteners to the battery tray.
12. Install the battery. For additional information, refer to Battery. 13. Position the air cleaner
assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
14. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
15. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4614
16. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
17. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
18. Install the front bumper cover. 19. Check the transmission fluid level and add automatic
transmission fluid as necessary.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Fluid Pan: Specifications
Main control cover bolts .......................................................................................................................
...................................................... 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4618
Fluid Pan: Service and Repair
Main Control Cover
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4619
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4620
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4621
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4622
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4623
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle main control cover.
Installation
1. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
2. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on the
inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4624
3. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
4. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4625
5. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
6. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
7. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
8. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4626
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
9. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
10. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
12. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4627
13. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
14. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
15. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
16. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4628
17. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators - A/T
> Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL INDICATOR LAMP (TCIL)
The TCIL is an output signal from the PCM that controls the lamp on/off function depending on the
engagement or disengagement of overdrive.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Overdrive Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4637
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4638
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4639
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4640
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4641
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4642
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4643
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4644
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4645
Overdrive Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4646
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4647
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4648
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4649
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4650
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4651
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4652
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4653
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Specifications
Solenoid Operation Chart
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4659
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4660
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4661
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4662
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4663
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4664
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4665
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4666
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4667
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4668
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4669
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4670
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4671
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4672
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4673
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4674
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4675
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4676
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
Pinpoint Tests - OSC Equipped Vehicle
Special Tool(s)
Any time an electrical connector or solenoid body is disconnected, inspect the connector for
terminal condition, corrosion and contamination. Also inspect the connector seal for damage.
Clean, repair or install new components as required.
Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor Diagnosis Chart
A. "In Between" reading could be caused by a shift cable or digital TR sensor misaligned or a
digital TR sensor circuit failure of TR1, TR2, TR3 or TR4. B. TRD: 1= Open digital TR switch, 0=
Closed digital TR switch. C. VCM Readings: Taken from PCM signal pins for TR1, TR2, TR3 and
TR4 to signal return.
Wiggle Test Information for Open/Shorts A. Check TR1, TR2, TR3 and TR4 circuits for an
intermittent open with the TR sensor positioned so that suspect circuit is in the closed position and
monitor the TR_D with the scan tool. B. Check TR1, TR2, TR3 and TR4 circuits for an intermittent
short with the TR sensor positioned so that suspect circuit is in the open position and monitor the
TRD with the scan tool. To determine the shorted components while observing TRD, unplug the TR
and determine if the short goes away. If the short is still present unplug the transaxle harness and
determine if the short goes away. If the short is still present, then the short is in the powertrain
control module (PCM) or vehicle harness. Remove the suspect circuit(s) wire terminal from the
PCM connector. If the short is still present, then the PCM has an internal failure. Otherwise, the
failure is in the vehicle harness.
Shift Solenoid Pre-Diagnosis Use this shift solenoid operation information when carrying out
Pinpoint Test A.
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4677
Solenoid Operation Chart
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Failed ON" or "Failed OFF" Failed ON/OFF due to powertrain
control module and/or vehicle wiring concerns, and/or solenoid electrically, mechanically or
hydraulically stuck on/off.
SSA
SSB
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4678
SSC
SSD
SSE
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4679
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair
Solenoid Body Assembly
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4680
Removal
NOTE: The PCM must be updated with a new solenoid body strategy data file and solenoid body
ID anytime a new solenoid body is installed. A new solenoid body service tag must be installed
over the current solenoid body service tag on top of the transaxle case.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4681
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4682
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4683
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4684
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle main control cover.
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4685
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4686
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
Installation
1. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
2. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4687
3. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
4. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4688
5. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
6. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
7. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
8. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on the
inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4689
9. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
10. Wipe the surface of the existing solenoid body strategy tag on top of the transaxle case clean
and install the new solenoid body strategy tag
(supplied with the solenoid body service kit) over it.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4690
11. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
12. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
13. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4691
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
15. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
16. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
17. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
18. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4692
19. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
20. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
21. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
22. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4693
23. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
24. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level. 25. Download a new solenoid
body strategy to the PCM.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Halfshaft Seal - RH
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Halfshaft Seal - RH
Halfshaft Seal - RH, Front Wheel Drive (FWD)
Special Tool(s)
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Halfshaft Seal - RH > Page 4698
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove the halfshaft nut.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Halfshaft Seal - RH > Page 4699
3. Remove the lower control arm-to-knuckle pinch bolt and separate the lower control arm from the
knuckle.
4. Using the special tool, separate the halfshaft from the wheel hub.
5. Remove the 2 catalytic converter support bracket bolts.
6. Remove the bolt, the nut and the catalytic converter support bracket.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Halfshaft Seal - RH > Page 4700
7. Remove the 2 bolts and the RH halfshaft.
8. Inspect the halfshaft hub for wear or damage and install a new halfshaft if necessary.
1 Inspect the differential seal surface.
2 Inspect the halfshaft bushing surface. If this surface is damaged, inspect the halfshaft bushing for
damage.
3 Inspect the differential side gear splines.
9. Using a suitable awl, poke a small hole in the halfshaft seal.
10. Using a suitable dent puller, remove the halfshaft seal.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Halfshaft Seal - RH > Page 4701
Installation
1. Install a new halfshaft seal on the special tool.
2. Using the special tool, install the RH halfshaft seal.
3. Position the RH halfshaft and intermediate shaft support bracket in the transaxle and in the
steering knuckle. Install the 1 stud bolt and 1 bolt.
^ Tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs).
4. Position the catalytic converter support bracket in place and install the bolt and the nut.
1 Tighten the nut to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
2 Tighten the bolt to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Halfshaft Seal - RH > Page 4702
5. Install the 2 RH catalytic converter support bracket bolts.
^ Tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs).
6. Install the ball joint in the steering knuckle and install the pinch bolt.
^ Tighten to 115 Nm (85 ft. lbs).
7. Install the halfshaft nut.
^ Tighten to 350 Nm (258 ft. lbs).
8. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Halfshaft Seal - RH > Page 4703
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Halfshaft Seal - LH
Halfshaft Seal - LH
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove the front LH halfshaft. 3. Inspect the halfshaft hub for
wear or damage and install a new halfshaft if necessary.
1 Inspect the differential seal surface.
2 Inspect the halfshaft bushing surface. If this surface is damaged, inspect the halfshaft bushing for
damage.
3 Inspect the differential side gear splines.
4. Using a suitable awl, poke a small hole in the halfshaft seal.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Halfshaft Seal - RH > Page 4704
5. Using a suitable dent puller, remove the halfshaft seal.
Installation
1. Install a new halfshaft seal on the special tool.
2. Using the special tool, install the LH halfshaft seal.
3. Install the front LH halfshaft. 4. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Halfshaft Seal - RH > Page 4705
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Manual Control Lever Shaft Seal
Manual Control Lever Shaft Seal
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Halfshaft Seal - RH > Page 4706
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Halfshaft Seal - RH > Page 4707
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Halfshaft Seal - RH > Page 4708
12. Disconnect the selector lever cable end from the manual lever.
13. Remove the nut and the manual lever.
14. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
15. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Halfshaft Seal - RH > Page 4709
16. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
17. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
18. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
19. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle main control cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Halfshaft Seal - RH > Page 4710
20. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
21. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
22. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Halfshaft Seal - RH > Page 4711
23. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
24. Remove the 10 bolts, the TR sensor detent spring and the main control valve body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Halfshaft Seal - RH > Page 4712
25. Using a suitable tool, remove and discard the TR sensor locking pin.
26. NOTE: TR sensor removed for clarity.
Make sure that the park pawl actuator rod does not become disengaged from the park pawl and
the abutment by keeping the end of the park pawl actuator rod behind the machined valve body
mating surface of the transaxle case. If the park pawl actuator rod becomes disengaged from the
park pawl and the abutment, transaxle removal and disassembly is required to reinstall the actuator
rod.
27. CAUTION: Make sure that the park pawl actuator rod does not become disengaged from the
park pawl and the abutment or transaxle
removal and disassembly is required to reinstall the actuator rod.
Remove the TR sensor. 1
Slide the TR sensor down until the manual shaft is out of the transaxle case.
2 Rotate the TR sensor detent plate counterclockwise, as viewed from below until the plate rests
against the transaxle case, remove the park pawl
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Halfshaft Seal - RH > Page 4713
actuating rod from the TR sensor and remove the TR sensor.
28. Using a suitable tool, remove the manual lever shaft seal.
Installation
1. Using the special tool, install a new manual lever shaft seal.
2. Install the TR sensor.
1 Position the park pawl actuating rod in the TR sensor.
2 Install the TR sensor in the transaxle case.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Halfshaft Seal - RH > Page 4714
3. Using the special tool, install a new TR sensor locking pin.
4. NOTE: Make sure that the manual lever pin (part of the TR sensor) is correctly installed in the
manual valve.
Position the TSS, OSS and TR sensor wiring harnesses aside and install the main control valve
body, the TR sensor detent spring and the 10 bolts. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown. ^
Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
5. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Halfshaft Seal - RH > Page 4715
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
6. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
7. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Halfshaft Seal - RH > Page 4716
8. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
9. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
10. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Halfshaft Seal - RH > Page 4717
11. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
12. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on
the inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
13. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Halfshaft Seal - RH > Page 4718
14. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
15. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
16. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Halfshaft Seal - RH > Page 4719
17. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
18. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
19. Install the manual lever and the nut.
^ Tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs).
20. Connect the selector lever cable end to the manual lever.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Halfshaft Seal - RH > Page 4720
21. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
22. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
23. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
24. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Halfshaft Seal - RH > Page 4721
25. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
26. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
27. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
28. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Halfshaft Seal - RH > Page 4722
29. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4728
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4729
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4730
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4731
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4732
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4733
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4734
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4735
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4736
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4737
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4738
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4739
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4740
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4741
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4742
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4743
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4744
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4745
Brake Switch - TCC: Description and Operation
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal to the
PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Overdrive Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4750
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4751
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4752
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4753
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4754
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4755
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4756
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4757
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4758
Overdrive Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4759
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4760
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4761
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4762
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4763
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4764
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4765
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4766
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4771
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4772
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4773
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4774
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4775
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4776
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4777
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4778
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4779
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4780
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4781
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4782
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4783
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4784
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4785
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4786
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4787
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4792
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4793
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4794
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4795
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4796
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4797
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4798
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4799
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4800
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4801
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4802
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4803
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4804
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4805
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4806
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4807
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4808
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4809
Transmission Mode Switch: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL SWITCH (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
The TCS signals the PCM with VPWR whenever the TCS is pressed. On vehicles with this feature,
the transmission control indicator lamp (TCIL) illuminates when the TCS is cycled to disengage
overdrive.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4814
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4815
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4816
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4817
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4818
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4819
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4820
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4821
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4822
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4823
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4824
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4825
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4826
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4827
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4828
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4829
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4830
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4831
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4832
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4833
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
12. Disconnect the selector lever cable end from the manual lever.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4834
13. Remove the nut and the manual lever.
14. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
15. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
16. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4835
17. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
18. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
19. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle side cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4836
20. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
21. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
22. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4837
23. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when removing the solenoid body filter.
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
24. Remove the 10 bolts, the TR sensor detent spring and the main control valve body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4838
25. Using a suitable tool, remove and discard the TR sensor locking pin.
26. NOTE: TR sensor removed for clarity.
Make sure that the park pawl actuator rod does not become disengaged from the park pawl and
the abutment by keeping the end of the park pawl actuator rod behind the machined valve body
mating surface of the transaxle case. If the park pawl actuator rod becomes disengaged from the
park pawl and the abutment, transaxle removal and disassembly is required to reinstall the actuator
rod.
27. CAUTION: Make sure that the park pawl actuator rod does not become disengaged from the
park pawl and the abutment or transaxle
removal and disassembly is required to reinstall the actuator rod.
Remove the TR sensor. 1
Slide the TR sensor down until the manual shaft is out of the transaxle case.
2 Rotate the TR sensor detent plate counterclockwise, as viewed from below until the plate rests
against the transaxle case, remove the park
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4839
pawl actuating rod from the TR sensor and remove the TR sensor.
Installation
1. Install the TR sensor.
1 Position the park pawl actuating rod in the TR sensor.
2 Install the TR sensor in the transaxle case.
2. Using the special tool, install a new TR sensor locking pin.
3. NOTE: Make sure that the manual lever pin (part of the TR sensor) is correctly installed in the
manual valve.
Position the TSS, OSS and TR sensor wiring harnesses aside and install the main control valve
body, the TR sensor detent spring and the 10 bolts. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown. ^
Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4840
4. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
5. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4
95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4841
6. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
7. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4842
8. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
9. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
10. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
11. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on
the inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4843
12. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
13. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4844
14. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
15. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
16. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
17. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4845
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
18. Install the manual lever and the nut.
^ Tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs).
19. Connect the selector lever cable end to the manual lever.
20. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
21. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4846
22. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
23. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
24. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
25. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4847
26. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
27. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
28. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Transmission Speed Sensor: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's
Transmission Speed Sensor: Customer Interest A/T - Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's
TSB 07-21-11
10/29/07
6F50 TRANSAXLES BUILT PRIOR TO 10/21/2007 - DTC P0715, P0717, P0718, P0720, P0721,
P0722 AND/OR HARSH ENGAGEMENT, NO UPSHIFT, FIFTH GEAR ONLY
FORD: 2008 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2008Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
MERCURY: 2008 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 07-3-11 to update the transaxle built date coverage and Part List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Edge and MKX, 2008 Taurus Taurus X, and Sable vehicles equipped with
a 6F50 transaxle with a build date prior to 10/21/2007, with any Output Shaft Speed (OSS) sensor
or Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) sensor diagnostic trouble code(s) (DTCs) P0715, P0717, P0718,
P0720, P0721, P0722 and/or harsh engagements, no upshift, fifth gear only, could have an
intermittent short in the OSS or TSS sensor.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. If any DTCs related to OSS or TSS are present, check the transaxle build date following
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
a. If the build date is before 10/21/2007 go to Step 2.
b. If vehicle transaxle is built on or after 10/21/2007 do not continue with this TSB and follow
normal WSM, Section 307-01 Automatic Transaxle/Transmission-6F50 Diagnosis and Testing.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Transmission Speed Sensor: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's > Page 4856
2. To repair an OSS or TSS DTC refer to WSM, Section 307-01, follow pin point test (PPT) C. The
TSS sensor is located in the end cover assembly (Figure 1). The OSS sensor is located inside the
transaxle under the main Control (Figure 2). Both sensor connectors are plugged into the solenoid
body. Both sensor connectors look the same but are wired differently (Figure 3).
3. If you work through PPT C and get to Step C9 before finding the cause of the concern, replace
the sensor (DO NOT REPLACE THE POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) AT THIS TIME).
Reassemble as needed and verify the concern is fixed.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT:
Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits are
determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Transmission Speed Sensor: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's > Page 4857
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT072111 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING BASIC PART NO.
CONDITION
7M101 CODE
42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Transmission Speed Sensor: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's
Transmission Speed Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Harsh Engagement/No
Shift/Multiple DTC's
TSB 07-21-11
10/29/07
6F50 TRANSAXLES BUILT PRIOR TO 10/21/2007 - DTC P0715, P0717, P0718, P0720, P0721,
P0722 AND/OR HARSH ENGAGEMENT, NO UPSHIFT, FIFTH GEAR ONLY
FORD: 2008 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2008Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
MERCURY: 2008 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 07-3-11 to update the transaxle built date coverage and Part List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Edge and MKX, 2008 Taurus Taurus X, and Sable vehicles equipped with
a 6F50 transaxle with a build date prior to 10/21/2007, with any Output Shaft Speed (OSS) sensor
or Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) sensor diagnostic trouble code(s) (DTCs) P0715, P0717, P0718,
P0720, P0721, P0722 and/or harsh engagements, no upshift, fifth gear only, could have an
intermittent short in the OSS or TSS sensor.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. If any DTCs related to OSS or TSS are present, check the transaxle build date following
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
a. If the build date is before 10/21/2007 go to Step 2.
b. If vehicle transaxle is built on or after 10/21/2007 do not continue with this TSB and follow
normal WSM, Section 307-01 Automatic Transaxle/Transmission-6F50 Diagnosis and Testing.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Transmission Speed Sensor: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's > Page 4863
2. To repair an OSS or TSS DTC refer to WSM, Section 307-01, follow pin point test (PPT) C. The
TSS sensor is located in the end cover assembly (Figure 1). The OSS sensor is located inside the
transaxle under the main Control (Figure 2). Both sensor connectors are plugged into the solenoid
body. Both sensor connectors look the same but are wired differently (Figure 3).
3. If you work through PPT C and get to Step C9 before finding the cause of the concern, replace
the sensor (DO NOT REPLACE THE POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) AT THIS TIME).
Reassemble as needed and verify the concern is fixed.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT:
Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits are
determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Transmission Speed Sensor: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's > Page 4864
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT072111 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING BASIC PART NO.
CONDITION
7M101 CODE
42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4867
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4868
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4869
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4870
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4871
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4872
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4873
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4874
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4875
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4876
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4877
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4878
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4879
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4880
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4881
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4882
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
4883
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor
Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4886
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4887
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4888
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle side cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4889
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4890
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
22. Remove the 10 bolts, the detent spring and the main control valve body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4891
23. Remove the bolt and the TSS sensor.
Installation
1. Route the TSS sensor wiring harness through the cover and the transaxle case.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4892
2. Install the TSS sensor in the cover and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
3. NOTE: Make sure that the manual lever pin (part of the TR sensor) is correctly installed in the
manual valve.
Position the TSS, OSS and TR sensor wiring harnesses aside and install the main control valve
body, the TR sensor detent spring and the 10 bolts. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown. ^
Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4893
4. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
5. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3
80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4894
6. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
7. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4895
8. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
9. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
10. Inspect the transaxle side cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
11. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on
the inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle side cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4896
12. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
13. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4897
14. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
15. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
16. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4898
17. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
18. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
19. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
20. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
21. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4899
22. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
23. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
24. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
25. Connect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness
fastener.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4900
26. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4901
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4902
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4903
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4904
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle side cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4905
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4906
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when removing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
22. Remove the 10 bolts, the TR sensor detent spring and the main control valve body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4907
23. Remove the bolt and the OSS sensor.
Installation
1. Install the OSS sensor and the bolt.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
2. NOTE: Make sure that the manual lever pin (part of the TR sensor) is correctly installed in the
manual valve.
Position the TSS, OSS and TR sensor wiring harnesses aside and install the main control valve
body, the TR sensor detent spring and the 10 bolts. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown. ^
Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4908
3. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
4. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4909
5. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
6. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4910
7. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
8. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
9. Inspect the transaxle side cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
10. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on
the inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle side cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4911
11. Tighten the main control valve body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
12. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4912
13. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
14. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
15. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
16. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4913
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
17. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
18. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
19. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
20. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4914
21. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
22. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
23. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
24. Connect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness
fastener.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor >
Page 4915
25. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4920
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4921
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4922
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4923
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4924
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4925
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4926
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4927
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4928
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4929
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4930
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4931
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4932
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4933
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4934
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4935
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4936
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Shift Interlock: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4941
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4942
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4943
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4944
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4945
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4946
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4947
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4948
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4949
Shift Interlock: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4950
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4951
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4952
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4953
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4954
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4955
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4956
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4957
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4958
Shift Interlock: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
37-1
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See:
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4959
Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Shift Solenoid: Specifications
Solenoid Operation Chart
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Shift Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4965
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4966
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4967
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4968
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4969
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4970
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4971
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4972
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4973
Shift Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4974
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4975
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4976
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4977
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4978
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4979
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4980
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4981
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4982
Shift Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
Pinpoint Tests - OSC Equipped Vehicle
Special Tool(s)
Any time an electrical connector or solenoid body is disconnected, inspect the connector for
terminal condition, corrosion and contamination. Also inspect the connector seal for damage.
Clean, repair or install new components as required.
Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor Diagnosis Chart
A. "In Between" reading could be caused by a shift cable or digital TR sensor misaligned or a
digital TR sensor circuit failure of TR1, TR2, TR3 or TR4. B. TRD: 1= Open digital TR switch, 0=
Closed digital TR switch. C. VCM Readings: Taken from PCM signal pins for TR1, TR2, TR3 and
TR4 to signal return.
Wiggle Test Information for Open/Shorts A. Check TR1, TR2, TR3 and TR4 circuits for an
intermittent open with the TR sensor positioned so that suspect circuit is in the closed position and
monitor the TR_D with the scan tool. B. Check TR1, TR2, TR3 and TR4 circuits for an intermittent
short with the TR sensor positioned so that suspect circuit is in the open position and monitor the
TRD with the scan tool. To determine the shorted components while observing TRD, unplug the TR
and determine if the short goes away. If the short is still present unplug the transaxle harness and
determine if the short goes away. If the short is still present, then the short is in the powertrain
control module (PCM) or vehicle harness. Remove the suspect circuit(s) wire terminal from the
PCM connector. If the short is still present, then the PCM has an internal failure. Otherwise, the
failure is in the vehicle harness.
Shift Solenoid Pre-Diagnosis Use this shift solenoid operation information when carrying out
Pinpoint Test A.
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4983
Solenoid Operation Chart
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Failed ON" or "Failed OFF" Failed ON/OFF due to powertrain
control module and/or vehicle wiring concerns, and/or solenoid electrically, mechanically or
hydraulically stuck on/off.
SSA
SSB
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4984
SSC
SSD
SSE
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4985
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair
Solenoid Body Assembly
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4986
Removal
NOTE: The PCM must be updated with a new solenoid body strategy data file and solenoid body
ID anytime a new solenoid body is installed. A new solenoid body service tag must be installed
over the current solenoid body service tag on top of the transaxle case.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4987
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4988
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4989
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4990
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle main control cover.
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4991
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4992
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
Installation
1. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
2. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4993
3. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
4. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4994
5. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
6. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
7. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
8. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on the
inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4995
9. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
10. Wipe the surface of the existing solenoid body strategy tag on top of the transaxle case clean
and install the new solenoid body strategy tag
(supplied with the solenoid body service kit) over it.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4996
11. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
12. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
13. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4997
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
15. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
16. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
17. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
18. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4998
19. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
20. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
21. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
22. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4999
23. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
24. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level. 25. Download a new solenoid
body strategy to the PCM.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams
C3245
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever
Shifter A/T: Service and Repair Selector Lever
Selector Lever
Selector Lever
Removal
MKX
1. Using a suitable tool, remove the selector lever trim ring.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever > Page 5005
All vehicles 2. Lift the armrest. Using a suitable tool, remove the center console trim cover.
3. Remove the 2 fasteners and position aside the power outlet trim cover.
4. Remove the selector lever cable end from the selector lever.
5. Release the 2 tabs and remove the selector lever cable from the selector lever housing.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever > Page 5006
6. Disconnect the selector lever electrical connector.
7. Remove the bolts and the selector lever.
Installation
All vehicles 1. Install the selector lever and the bolts.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
2. Connect the selector lever electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever > Page 5007
3. Install the selector lever cable in the selector lever housing.
4. Place the selector lever in REVERSE.
5. Disconnect the selector lever cable end from the manual lever.
6. Install the selector lever cable end on the selector lever.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever > Page 5008
7. Place the selector lever in DRIVE.
8. Position the power outlet trim cover in place and install the 2 fasteners.
9. Install the center console trim cover.
10. Install the selector lever trim ring.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever > Page 5009
All vehicles 11. Place the manual lever in DRIVE.
1 Rotate the manual lever clockwise until it stops.
2 Rotate the manual lever counterclockwise one detent.
12. Unlock the adjuster by sliding the locking tab over.
13. Slide the cable end forward or backward to align it with the manual lever.
14. With the adjuster locking tab released, connect the selector lever cable end to the manual
lever.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever > Page 5010
15. Slide the release tab back to lock the adjuster.
16. Verify that the vehicle starts in PARK and NEUTRAL only and that the reverse lamps illuminate
in REVERSE.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever > Page 5011
Shifter A/T: Service and Repair Selector Lever Knob
Selector Lever Knob
Selector Lever Knob
Removal
MKX
1. Using a suitable tool, remove the selector lever trim ring.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever > Page 5012
All vehicles 2. Lift the armrest. Using a suitable tool, remove the center console trim cover.
3. NOTE: Center console side trim cover removed for clarity.
Disconnect the transmission control (TC) switch electrical connector.
4. Remove and discard the selector lever knob trim covers by carefully prying out on the bottom
front corners and then pry out on the top front
corner and remove the covers.
5. NOTE: Inspect the knob body for damage. Install a new knob body if necessary.
Remove and discard the 2 selector lever knob screws and remove the selector lever knob while
routing the TC switch electrical connector harness out of the selector lever.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever > Page 5013
Installation
All vehicles
1. Route the TC switch electrical connector harness through the selector lever and install the shift
knob and 2 new screws. Loosely install both screws
before tightening. ^
Tighten to 2 Nm (18 inch lbs).
2. NOTE: Be sure that the shift knob bezel is correctly installed on the shift knob.
Install new selector lever knob trim covers.
3. NOTE: Center console side trim cover removed for clarity.
Connect the transmission control (TC) switch electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever > Page 5014
4. Install the center console trim cover.
MKX 5. Install the selector lever trim ring.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair
Shift Cable: Service and Repair
Selector Lever Cable
Selector Lever Cable (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5019
Selector Lever Cable (Part 2)
Removal
All vehicles
1. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector and the wiring harness fastener
from the air cleaner assembly.
2. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
3. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
4. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5020
5. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
6. Disconnect the selector lever cable end from the manual lever.
7. Release the 2 tabs and remove the selector lever cable from the bracket.
8. Using a suitable tool, remove the selector lever trim ring.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5021
All vehicles 9. Lift the armrest. Using a suitable tool, remove the center console trim cover.
10. Remove the 2 fasteners and position aside the power outlet trim cover.
11. Remove the selector lever cable end from the selector lever.
12. Release the 2 tabs and remove the selector lever cable from the selector lever housing.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5022
13. Remove the center console side cover.
14. Remove the 2 nuts from the grommet and remove the selector lever cable.
Installation
All vehicles
1. Install the selector lever cable, position the grommet in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
2. Install the center console side cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5023
3. Install the selector lever cable in the selector lever housing.
4. Place the selector lever in REVERSE.
5. Install the selector lever cable end on the selector lever.
6. Place the selector lever in DRIVE.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5024
7. Position the power outlet trim cover in place and install the 2 fasteners.
8. Install the center console trim cover.
9. Install the selector lever trim ring.
All vehicles 10. Install the selector lever cable in the bracket.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5025
11. Place the manual lever in DRIVE.
1 Rotate the manual lever clockwise until it stops.
2 Rotate the manual lever counterclockwise one detent.
12. Unlock the adjuster by sliding the locking tab over.
13. Slide the cable end forward or backward to align it with the manual lever.
14. With the adjuster locking tab released, connect the selector lever cable end to the manual
lever.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5026
15. Slide the release tab back to lock the adjuster.
16. Connect the selector lever cable on the manual lever.
17. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
18. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5027
19. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
20. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
21. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
22. Verify that the vehicle starts in PARK and NEUTRAL only and that the reverse lamps illuminate
in REVERSE.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sun Gear > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sun Gear: > 08-9-4 > May > 08 > A/T - No Reverse/3rd or
5th Gears/MIL ON/DTC's Set
Sun Gear: Customer Interest A/T - No Reverse/3rd or 5th Gears/MIL ON/DTC's Set
TSB 08-9-4
05/12/08
6F50 TRANSAXLE BUILT ON OR BEFORE 3/15/2008 - NO REVERSE ENGAGEMENT, NO 3RD
OR 5TH GEAR - DTC P0733, P0735, P0756
FORD: 2008 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
MERCURY: 2008 Sable
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Edge, MKX, 2008 Taurus, Sable, and Taurus X vehicles equipped with a
6F50 transaxle and built on or before 3/15/2008 may experience no reverse engagement, no 3rd
and 5th gears with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) P0733, P0735, P0756 and a malfunction
indicator lamp (MIL) on.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove the transaxle following Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Replace the intermediate shell/sun gear assembly and the number 3 bearing next to the sun
gear with revised parts following WSM, Section 307-03.
3. Install the transaxle following WSM, Section 307-01.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
080904A 2008 Taurus, Sable, 13.7
Taurus X AWD Built before Hrs. 3/15/2008: Replace The Intermediate Shell/Sun Gear Assembly
And The Number 3 Bearing, Includes Time To Check For DTCs, Remove And Install Transmission
(This Labor Operation Is All Inclusive Do Not Claim With Any Other Labor Operations)
080904A 2008 Taurus, Sable, 12.7
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sun Gear > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sun Gear: > 08-9-4 > May > 08 > A/T - No Reverse/3rd or
5th Gears/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page 5036
Taurus X FWD Built before Hrs.
3/15/2008: Replace The Intermediate Shell/Sun Gear Assembly And The Number 3 Bearing,
Includes Time To Check For DTCs, Remove And Install Transmission (This Labor Operation Is All
Inclusive Do Not Claim With Any Other Labor Operations)
080904A 2007-2008 Edge, MKX 13.8
FWD Built before Hrs.
3/15/2008: Replace The Intermediate Shell/Sun Gear Assembly And The Number 3 Bearing,
Includes Time To Check For DTCs, Remove And Install Transmission (This Labor Operation Is All
Inclusive Do Not Claim With Any Other Labor Operations)
080904A 2007-2008 Edge, MKX 13.9
AWD Built before Hrs.
3/15/2008: Replace The Intermediate Shell/Sun Gear Assembly And The Number 3 Bearing,
Includes Time To Check For DTCs, Remove And Install Transmission (This Labor Operation Is All
Inclusive Do Not Claim With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7A019 01
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sun Gear > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sun Gear: > 08-9-4 > May > 08 > A/T - No
Reverse/3rd or 5th Gears/MIL ON/DTC's Set
Sun Gear: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - No Reverse/3rd or 5th Gears/MIL ON/DTC's Set
TSB 08-9-4
05/12/08
6F50 TRANSAXLE BUILT ON OR BEFORE 3/15/2008 - NO REVERSE ENGAGEMENT, NO 3RD
OR 5TH GEAR - DTC P0733, P0735, P0756
FORD: 2008 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
MERCURY: 2008 Sable
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Edge, MKX, 2008 Taurus, Sable, and Taurus X vehicles equipped with a
6F50 transaxle and built on or before 3/15/2008 may experience no reverse engagement, no 3rd
and 5th gears with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) P0733, P0735, P0756 and a malfunction
indicator lamp (MIL) on.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove the transaxle following Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Replace the intermediate shell/sun gear assembly and the number 3 bearing next to the sun
gear with revised parts following WSM, Section 307-03.
3. Install the transaxle following WSM, Section 307-01.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
080904A 2008 Taurus, Sable, 13.7
Taurus X AWD Built before Hrs. 3/15/2008: Replace The Intermediate Shell/Sun Gear Assembly
And The Number 3 Bearing, Includes Time To Check For DTCs, Remove And Install Transmission
(This Labor Operation Is All Inclusive Do Not Claim With Any Other Labor Operations)
080904A 2008 Taurus, Sable, 12.7
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sun Gear > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sun Gear: > 08-9-4 > May > 08 > A/T - No
Reverse/3rd or 5th Gears/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page 5042
Taurus X FWD Built before Hrs.
3/15/2008: Replace The Intermediate Shell/Sun Gear Assembly And The Number 3 Bearing,
Includes Time To Check For DTCs, Remove And Install Transmission (This Labor Operation Is All
Inclusive Do Not Claim With Any Other Labor Operations)
080904A 2007-2008 Edge, MKX 13.8
FWD Built before Hrs.
3/15/2008: Replace The Intermediate Shell/Sun Gear Assembly And The Number 3 Bearing,
Includes Time To Check For DTCs, Remove And Install Transmission (This Labor Operation Is All
Inclusive Do Not Claim With Any Other Labor Operations)
080904A 2007-2008 Edge, MKX 13.9
AWD Built before Hrs.
3/15/2008: Replace The Intermediate Shell/Sun Gear Assembly And The Number 3 Bearing,
Includes Time To Check For DTCs, Remove And Install Transmission (This Labor Operation Is All
Inclusive Do Not Claim With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7A019 01
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5047
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5048
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5049
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5050
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5051
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5052
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5053
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5054
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5055
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5056
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5057
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5058
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5059
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5060
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5061
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5062
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5063
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Specifications
Torque Converter: Specifications
Stall Speed Chart
Stall Speed Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 5067
Torque Converter: Description and Operation
Torque Converter The torque converter transmits and multiplies torque. The torque converter is a
4-element device:
^ Impeller assembly
^ Turbine assembly
^ Reactor assembly
^ Clutch and damper assembly
The standard torque converter components operate as follows:
^ Rotation of the converter housing and impeller set the fluid in motion.
^ The turbine reacts to the fluid motion from the impeller, transferring rotation to the geartrain
through the input shaft.
^ The reactor redirects fluid going back into the impeller, providing for torque multiplication.
^ The clutch and damper assembly dampens powertrain torsional vibration and provides a direct
mechanical connection for improved efficiency.
^ Power is transmitted from the torque converter to the planetary gearsets and other components
through the input shaft.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Torque Converter Diagnosis
Torque Converter: Testing and Inspection Torque Converter Diagnosis
Torque Converter Diagnosis Prior to torque converter installation, all diagnostic procedures must
be followed. This is to prevent the unnecessary installation of new or remanufactured torque
converters. Only after a complete diagnostic evaluation can the decision be made to install a new
or remanufactured torque converter.
Begin with the normal diagnostic procedures as follows:
1. Preliminary Inspection 2. Know and Understand the Customer's Concern 3. Verify the Concern carry out the torque converter operation test. 4. Carry out Diagnostic Procedures:
^ Run on-board diagnostics. Repair all non-transmission related DTCs first.
- Repair all transmission DTCs.
- Rerun On-Board Diagnostic to verify repair.
- Carry out Line Pressure Test. See: Transmission Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/Line Pressure Test
- Carry out Stall Speed Test. See: Transmission Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/Stall Speed Test
- Carry out diagnostic routines. See: Transmission Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/Diagnostic Routines
- Use the index to locate the appropriate routine that best describes the symptom(s). The routine
will list all possible components that may cause or contribute to the symptom. Check each
component listed, diagnose and repair as required, before installing a new torque converter .
Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Operation Test This test verifies that the TCC control system and
the torque converter are operating correctly.
1. Carry out Quick Test, refer to the tester manual. Check for DTCs. 2. Connect a tachometer to
the engine. 3. Bring the engine to normal operating temperature by driving the vehicle at highway
speeds for approximately 15 minutes in (D) position. 4. If the vehicle stalls in (D) at idle with vehicle
at a stop, move the selector lever to manual L position. If the vehicle stalls, refer to torque
converter
operation concerns. Repair as required. If the vehicle does not stall in (D), refer to Diagnosis By
Symptom. See: Transmission Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures/Diagnostic Routines/Torque Converter Operation Concerns
250/350-252/352 See: Transmission Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures/Diagnosis By Symptom
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Torque Converter Diagnosis > Page 5070
Torque Converter: Testing and Inspection Torque Converter
Torque Converter
1. A new or remanufactured torque converter must be installed if one or more of these statements
is true:
^ A torque converter malfunction has been determined based on complete diagnostic procedures.
^ Converter bolt holes, impeller hub or bushing are damaged.
^ Discoloration (due to overheating).
^ Evidence of transmission assembly or fluid contamination due to these transmission or converter
failure modes: Major metallic failure.
- Multiple clutches or clutch plate failures.
- Sufficient component wear which results in metallic contamination.
- Internal torque converter contamination present. For additional information, refer to Torque
Converter Contamination Inspection. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics/Torque Converter Contamination Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Torque Converter Diagnosis > Page 5071
Torque Converter: Testing and Inspection Torque Converter Contamination Inspection
Torque Converter Contamination Inspection
Material
CAUTION: Do not use water-based cleaners or mineral spirits to clean or flush the torque converter
or transmission damage will occur. Use only clean automatic transmission fluid designated for the
transmission and converter being serviced.
1. If a new or remanufactured torque converter is not being installed, these steps must be
completed. 2. With the torque converter on a bench, pour a small amount of transmission fluid from
the torque converter onto an absorbent white tissue or
through a paper filter and examine the fluid.
3. Observe the color and odor of the fluid. The fluid should be red, not brown or black. Odor may
indicate an overheating condition such as clutch
disc or band failure.
4. Examine the stain on the tissue for evidence of particles (spec of any kind). If particles are
present in the fluid, a new torque converter must be
installed.
5. If there are no particles or contamination present, drain the remainder of the transmission fluid
from the torque converter. 6. Add 1.9L (2 qt) of clean automatic transmission fluid into the converter
and agitate by hand. 7. Thoroughly drain the fluid.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Specifications
Solenoid Operation Chart
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5077
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5078
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5079
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5080
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5081
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5082
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5083
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5084
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5085
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5086
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5087
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5088
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5089
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5090
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5091
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5092
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5093
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5094
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Service and Repair
Solenoid Body Assembly
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5095
Removal
NOTE: The PCM must be updated with a new solenoid body strategy data file and solenoid body
ID anytime a new solenoid body is installed. A new solenoid body service tag must be installed
over the current solenoid body service tag on top of the transaxle case.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5096
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5097
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5098
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5099
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle main control cover.
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5100
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5101
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
Installation
1. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
2. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5102
3. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
4. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5103
5. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
6. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
7. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
8. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on the
inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5104
9. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
10. Wipe the surface of the existing solenoid body strategy tag on top of the transaxle case clean
and install the new solenoid body strategy tag
(supplied with the solenoid body service kit) over it.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5105
11. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
12. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
13. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5106
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
15. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
16. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
17. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
18. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5107
19. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
20. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
21. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
22. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5108
23. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
24. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level. 25. Download a new solenoid
body strategy to the PCM.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Mechanical Specifications
Transmission Cooler: Mechanical Specifications
General Specifications
General Specifications
General Specifications
Torque Specifications
Torque Specifications
Torque Specifications
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Mechanical Specifications > Page 5113
Transmission Cooler: Fluid Type Specifications
General Specifications
General Specifications
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 5114
Transmission Cooler: Locations
Transaxle Cooling
Transaxle Cooling (Part 1)
Transaxle Cooling (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Transmission Cooler: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Inspection and Verification
1. Verify the customer concern by operating the vehicle to duplicate the condition. 2. If the
inspection reveals obvious concern(s) that can be readily identified, repair as necessary. 3. Install
new components if a fluid leak is found in any of the transaxle cooling components. 4. If the
concern(s) remains after the inspection, determine the symptom(s). GO to Symptom Chart. See:
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 5117
Transmission Cooler: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Symptom Chart
Symptom Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 5118
Transmission Cooler: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Transmission Fluid Cooler
CAUTION: Whenever a transaxle has been disassembled to install new parts or because the main
control valve body sticks from foreign material, the main control valve body, transaxle fluid cooler
and fluid cooler inlet tube and fluid cooler tube must be cleaned and flushed using Torque
Converter/Oil Cooler Cleaner. Under no circumstances should an attempt be made to clean the
torque converter by hand agitation with solvent.
When internal wear or damage has occurred in the transaxle, metal particles, clutch plate material
or band material may have been carried into the torque converter and transaxle fluid cooler. These
contaminants are a major cause of recurring transaxle troubles and must be removed from the
system before the transaxle is put back into use.
Transmission Fluid Cooler Flow Test
NOTE: The transaxle linkage/cable adjustment, fluid level and line pressure must be within
specification before carrying out this test. Refer to Special Testing Procedures for line pressure
test. See: Transmission Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics/Line Pressure Test
1. Remove fluid level indicator from fluid filler tube. 2. Place funnel in fluid filler tube. 3. With the
vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. Refer to Maintenance/Service and Repair. 4. Remove
the cooler return line (lower fitting) from the fitting on the transaxle case. 5. Connect one end of a
hose to the cooler return line and route other end of the hose up to a point where it can be inserted
into the funnel at the fluid
filler tube.
6. Remove the safety stands and lower the vehicle. Insert end of hose into the funnel. 7. Start the
engine and run it at idle with the transmission in NEUTRAL position. 8. When fluid flowing from
hose is in a steady stream, a liberal amount of fluid should be observed. "Liberal" is described as
about 1L (1 qt)
delivered in 30 seconds. If a liberal flow is observed, the test is complete.
9. If the flow is not liberal, stop the engine. Disconnect the hose from the cooler return line and
connect it to the converter outline fitting (upper
fitting) on the transmission case.
10. Repeat Steps 7 and 8. If flow is now approximately 1L (1 qt) in 30 seconds, refer to
Transmission Fluid Cooler - Backflushing and Cleaning. If
the flow is still not approximately 1L (1 qt) in 30 seconds, repair the pump and/or the torque
converter.
If new fluid cooler tubes need to be installed, refer to Fluid Line/Hose, A/T.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Transmission Cooler: Procedures
Transmission Fluid Cooler - Backflushing and Cleaning
Special Tool(s)
Material
NOTE: Transmission fluid cooler backflushing will be carried out using the special tool. Follow the
manufacturer's instructions included with the machine. Test the equipment to make sure that a
vigorous fluid flow is present before proceeding.
1. Check and top off fluid level of the special tool tank with transmission fluid. 2. Allow the fluid in
the flusher 15-30 minutes to heat up to 60°C (140°F) before using. 3. Install the line adapters into
the transmission cooler lines.
4. NOTE: The FRONT transaxle cooler line on the thermal bypass valve is the cooler pressure line.
Attach the flusher's red line to the transmission fluid cooler pressure line quick disconnect fitting.
5. Attach the flusher's blue line to the transmission fluid cooler return line quick disconnect fitting. 6.
Follow the equipment instructions to purge the cooler lines and cooler prior to starting the flushing
procedure. 7. Allow the cooling system to backflush for 10-15 minutes, then flush the cooler in a
normal flow direction for an additional 10-15 minutes. 8. Clean the transaxle mounted fluid cooler
tubes and the thermal bypass valve by hand.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5121
Transmission Cooler: Removal and Replacement
Transmission Fluid Cooler
Special Tool(s)
Material
Transmission Fluid Cooler (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5122
Transmission Fluid Cooler (Part 2)
Removal
CAUTION: MERCON(R) V, MERCON(R) SP, Motorcraft Premium Automatic Transmission Fluid,
Motorcraft Continuously Variable Chain Type Transmission Fluid and FNR5 Automatic
Transmission Fluid are not interchangeable transmission fluids. The use of any fluid other than
what is recommended for this transmission will cause transmission damage.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove the front bumper cover. 3. Disconnect the 2
transmission fluid cooler tube fasteners from the radiator support.
4. Remove the secondary latches from the transmission fluid cooler.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5123
5. Using the special tool, disconnect the transmission fluid cooler tubes from the transmission fluid
cooler.
6. Remove the 2 bolts and the 2 transmission fluid cooler support brackets.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5124
7. Remove the transmission fluid cooler.
Installation
1. Position the transmission fluid cooler in place. 2. Install the 2 transmission fluid cooler support
brackets and the 2 bolts.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
3. Connect the transmission fluid cooler tubes to the transmission fluid cooler.
4. Install the secondary latches on the transmission fluid cooler.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5125
5. Connect the transmission fluid cooler tube fasteners to the radiator support.
6. Install the front bumper cover. 7. Check the transmission fluid level and add automatic
transmission fluid as necessary.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Tools and Equipment > Special Tools Used With Diagnosis and Testing
Transmission Cooler: Tools and Equipment Special Tools Used With Diagnosis and Testing
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Tools and Equipment > Special Tools Used With Diagnosis and Testing > Page 5128
Transmission Cooler: Tools and Equipment Material Used With Diagnosis and Testing
Material
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode
Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL INDICATOR LAMP (TCIL)
The TCIL is an output signal from the PCM that controls the lamp on/off function depending on the
engagement or disengagement of overdrive.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5136
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5137
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5138
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5139
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5140
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5141
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5142
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5143
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5144
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5145
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5146
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5147
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5148
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5149
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5150
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5151
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5152
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5153
Transmission Mode Switch: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL SWITCH (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
The TCS signals the PCM with VPWR whenever the TCS is pressed. On vehicles with this feature,
the transmission control indicator lamp (TCIL) illuminates when the TCS is cycled to disengage
overdrive.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mount, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Transmission Mount: Service and Repair
Transaxle Support Insulator
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mount, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5157
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Loosen the exhaust flexible pipe clamp and disconnect the 2
exhaust hangers.
3. Remove the 4 nuts and the exhaust flexible pipe and Y-pipe as an assembly.
^ Discard the nuts and the gasket.
4. Remove the 2 nuts and the roll restrictor heat shield.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mount, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5158
5. Loosen the engine roll restrictor-to-subframe through bolt.
6. Remove the 3 bolts from the roll restrictor bracket.
7. Remove the 3 bolts and the roll restrictor bracket.
8. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector and the wiring harness fastener
from the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mount, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5159
9. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
10. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
11. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
12. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mount, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5160
13. Remove the battery. For additional information, refer to Battery. 14. Remove the battery tray.
1 Disconnect the wiring harness fasteners.
2 Remove the 3 bolts and the battery tray.
15. CAUTION: The special tool must be carefully aligned to the mounting bosses on the oil pan.
Failure to follow these instructions may
result in damage to the oil pan.
NOTE: The special tool and floor jack are used to raise and lower the engine to access the engine
front cover and engine mount bracket fasteners.
Position a floor jack and the special tool under the oil pan and raise the floor jack high enough to
release the pressure on the transaxle support insulator.
16. Remove the transaxle support insulator through bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mount, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5161
17. Remove the 3 nuts, the bolt and the transaxle support insulator bracket.
18. Lower the jack until the transmission fluid cooler tube clears the lower transmission support
insulator bolts. 19. Loosen the battery tray support bracket bolts.
20. Remove the top transaxle support insulator bolts.
21. Remove the bottom transaxle support insulator bolts.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mount, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5162
Installation
1. Install the bottom transaxle support insulator bolts.
^ Tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs).
2. Install the top transaxle support insulator bolts.
^ Tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs).
3. Tighten the battery tray support bracket bolts.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
4. Using the jack, lift the transaxle into place. 5. Install the transaxle support insulator bracket,
install the bolt and the 3 nuts.
^ Tighten to 63 Nm (46 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mount, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5163
6. Install the transaxle support insulator through bolt.
^ Tighten to 175 Nm (129 ft. lbs).
7. Install the battery tray.
1 Install the 3 bolts. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
2 Connect the wiring harness fasteners to the battery tray.
8. Install the battery. For additional information, refer to Battery. 9. Position the air cleaner
assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
10. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mount, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5164
11. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
12. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
13. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
14. Check the transmission fluid level and fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct
level. 15. Position the roll restrictor bracket on the transaxle and install the 3 bolts.
^ Tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mount, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5165
16. Position the roll restrictor in place, install the bracket and the 3 bolts.
^ Tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs).
17. Install the engine roll restrictor-to-subframe through bolt.
^ Tighten to 103 Nm (76 ft. lbs).
18. Install the roll restrictor heat shield and the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
19. Position the exhaust Y-pipe assembly in place and install the 4 nuts.
^ Tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mount, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5166
20. Install the 2 exhaust hangers and tighten the exhaust clamp.
^ Tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5171
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5172
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5173
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5174
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5175
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5176
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5177
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5178
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5179
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5180
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5181
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5182
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5183
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5184
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5185
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5186
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5187
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5188
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5189
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5190
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
12. Disconnect the selector lever cable end from the manual lever.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5191
13. Remove the nut and the manual lever.
14. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
15. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
16. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5192
17. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
18. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
19. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle side cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5193
20. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
21. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
22. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5194
23. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when removing the solenoid body filter.
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
24. Remove the 10 bolts, the TR sensor detent spring and the main control valve body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5195
25. Using a suitable tool, remove and discard the TR sensor locking pin.
26. NOTE: TR sensor removed for clarity.
Make sure that the park pawl actuator rod does not become disengaged from the park pawl and
the abutment by keeping the end of the park pawl actuator rod behind the machined valve body
mating surface of the transaxle case. If the park pawl actuator rod becomes disengaged from the
park pawl and the abutment, transaxle removal and disassembly is required to reinstall the actuator
rod.
27. CAUTION: Make sure that the park pawl actuator rod does not become disengaged from the
park pawl and the abutment or transaxle
removal and disassembly is required to reinstall the actuator rod.
Remove the TR sensor. 1
Slide the TR sensor down until the manual shaft is out of the transaxle case.
2 Rotate the TR sensor detent plate counterclockwise, as viewed from below until the plate rests
against the transaxle case, remove the park
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5196
pawl actuating rod from the TR sensor and remove the TR sensor.
Installation
1. Install the TR sensor.
1 Position the park pawl actuating rod in the TR sensor.
2 Install the TR sensor in the transaxle case.
2. Using the special tool, install a new TR sensor locking pin.
3. NOTE: Make sure that the manual lever pin (part of the TR sensor) is correctly installed in the
manual valve.
Position the TSS, OSS and TR sensor wiring harnesses aside and install the main control valve
body, the TR sensor detent spring and the 10 bolts. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown. ^
Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5197
4. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
5. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4
95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5198
6. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
7. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5199
8. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
9. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
10. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
11. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on
the inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5200
12. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
13. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5201
14. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
15. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
16. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
17. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5202
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
18. Install the manual lever and the nut.
^ Tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs).
19. Connect the selector lever cable end to the manual lever.
20. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
21. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5203
22. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
23. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
24. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
25. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5204
26. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
27. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
28. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Transmission Speed Sensor: >
07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's
Transmission Speed Sensor: Customer Interest A/T - Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's
TSB 07-21-11
10/29/07
6F50 TRANSAXLES BUILT PRIOR TO 10/21/2007 - DTC P0715, P0717, P0718, P0720, P0721,
P0722 AND/OR HARSH ENGAGEMENT, NO UPSHIFT, FIFTH GEAR ONLY
FORD: 2008 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2008Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
MERCURY: 2008 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 07-3-11 to update the transaxle built date coverage and Part List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Edge and MKX, 2008 Taurus Taurus X, and Sable vehicles equipped with
a 6F50 transaxle with a build date prior to 10/21/2007, with any Output Shaft Speed (OSS) sensor
or Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) sensor diagnostic trouble code(s) (DTCs) P0715, P0717, P0718,
P0720, P0721, P0722 and/or harsh engagements, no upshift, fifth gear only, could have an
intermittent short in the OSS or TSS sensor.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. If any DTCs related to OSS or TSS are present, check the transaxle build date following
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
a. If the build date is before 10/21/2007 go to Step 2.
b. If vehicle transaxle is built on or after 10/21/2007 do not continue with this TSB and follow
normal WSM, Section 307-01 Automatic Transaxle/Transmission-6F50 Diagnosis and Testing.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Transmission Speed Sensor: >
07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's > Page 5213
2. To repair an OSS or TSS DTC refer to WSM, Section 307-01, follow pin point test (PPT) C. The
TSS sensor is located in the end cover assembly (Figure 1). The OSS sensor is located inside the
transaxle under the main Control (Figure 2). Both sensor connectors are plugged into the solenoid
body. Both sensor connectors look the same but are wired differently (Figure 3).
3. If you work through PPT C and get to Step C9 before finding the cause of the concern, replace
the sensor (DO NOT REPLACE THE POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) AT THIS TIME).
Reassemble as needed and verify the concern is fixed.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT:
Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits are
determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Transmission Speed Sensor: >
07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's > Page 5214
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT072111 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING BASIC PART NO.
CONDITION
7M101 CODE
42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Transmission
Speed Sensor: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's
Transmission Speed Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Harsh Engagement/No
Shift/Multiple DTC's
TSB 07-21-11
10/29/07
6F50 TRANSAXLES BUILT PRIOR TO 10/21/2007 - DTC P0715, P0717, P0718, P0720, P0721,
P0722 AND/OR HARSH ENGAGEMENT, NO UPSHIFT, FIFTH GEAR ONLY
FORD: 2008 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2008Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
MERCURY: 2008 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 07-3-11 to update the transaxle built date coverage and Part List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Edge and MKX, 2008 Taurus Taurus X, and Sable vehicles equipped with
a 6F50 transaxle with a build date prior to 10/21/2007, with any Output Shaft Speed (OSS) sensor
or Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) sensor diagnostic trouble code(s) (DTCs) P0715, P0717, P0718,
P0720, P0721, P0722 and/or harsh engagements, no upshift, fifth gear only, could have an
intermittent short in the OSS or TSS sensor.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. If any DTCs related to OSS or TSS are present, check the transaxle build date following
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
a. If the build date is before 10/21/2007 go to Step 2.
b. If vehicle transaxle is built on or after 10/21/2007 do not continue with this TSB and follow
normal WSM, Section 307-01 Automatic Transaxle/Transmission-6F50 Diagnosis and Testing.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Transmission
Speed Sensor: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's > Page 5220
2. To repair an OSS or TSS DTC refer to WSM, Section 307-01, follow pin point test (PPT) C. The
TSS sensor is located in the end cover assembly (Figure 1). The OSS sensor is located inside the
transaxle under the main Control (Figure 2). Both sensor connectors are plugged into the solenoid
body. Both sensor connectors look the same but are wired differently (Figure 3).
3. If you work through PPT C and get to Step C9 before finding the cause of the concern, replace
the sensor (DO NOT REPLACE THE POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) AT THIS TIME).
Reassemble as needed and verify the concern is fixed.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT:
Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits are
determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Transmission
Speed Sensor: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's > Page 5221
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT072111 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING BASIC PART NO.
CONDITION
7M101 CODE
42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5224
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5225
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5226
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5227
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5228
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5229
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5230
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5231
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5232
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5233
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5234
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5235
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5236
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5237
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5238
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5239
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5240
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor
Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5243
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5244
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5245
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle side cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5246
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5247
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
22. Remove the 10 bolts, the detent spring and the main control valve body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5248
23. Remove the bolt and the TSS sensor.
Installation
1. Route the TSS sensor wiring harness through the cover and the transaxle case.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5249
2. Install the TSS sensor in the cover and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
3. NOTE: Make sure that the manual lever pin (part of the TR sensor) is correctly installed in the
manual valve.
Position the TSS, OSS and TR sensor wiring harnesses aside and install the main control valve
body, the TR sensor detent spring and the 10 bolts. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown. ^
Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5250
4. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
5. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3
80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5251
6. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
7. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5252
8. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
9. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
10. Inspect the transaxle side cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
11. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on
the inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle side cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5253
12. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
13. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5254
14. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
15. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
16. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5255
17. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
18. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
19. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
20. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
21. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5256
22. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
23. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
24. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
25. Connect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness
fastener.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5257
26. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5258
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5259
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5260
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5261
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle side cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5262
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5263
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when removing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
22. Remove the 10 bolts, the TR sensor detent spring and the main control valve body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5264
23. Remove the bolt and the OSS sensor.
Installation
1. Install the OSS sensor and the bolt.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
2. NOTE: Make sure that the manual lever pin (part of the TR sensor) is correctly installed in the
manual valve.
Position the TSS, OSS and TR sensor wiring harnesses aside and install the main control valve
body, the TR sensor detent spring and the 10 bolts. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown. ^
Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5265
3. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
4. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5266
5. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
6. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5267
7. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
8. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
9. Inspect the transaxle side cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
10. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on
the inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle side cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5268
11. Tighten the main control valve body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
12. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5269
13. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
14. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
15. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
16. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5270
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
17. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
18. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
19. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
20. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5271
21. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
22. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
23. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
24. Connect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness
fastener.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5272
25. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5277
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5278
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5279
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5280
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5281
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5282
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5283
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5284
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5285
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5286
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5287
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5288
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5289
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5290
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5291
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5292
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5293
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Locations
Valve Body: Locations
Check Ball Locations
fm07edge_30701-323d
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5297
Valve Body: Diagrams
Main Control Assembly - Exploded Views
Main Control Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5298
Lower Valve Body (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5299
Lower Valve Body (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement
Valve Body: Removal and Replacement
Main Control
Main Control
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5302
Removal
NOTE: If cleaning of the main control assembly or inspecting the valves, refer to Main Control
Assembly. If installing a new main control assembly continue with this procedure.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5303
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5304
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5305
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5306
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle main control cover.
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5307
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5308
22. Remove the 10 bolts, the TR sensor detent spring and the main control valve body.
Installation
1. NOTE: Make sure that the manual lever pin (part of the TR sensor) is correctly installed in the
manual valve.
Position the TSS, OSS and TR sensor wiring harnesses aside and install the main control valve
body, the TR sensor detent spring and the 10 bolts. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown. ^
Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5309
2. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
3. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5310
4. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
5. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5311
6. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
7. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
8. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
9. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on the
inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5312
2 Studbolt location
10. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
11. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5313
12. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
13. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5314
15. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
16. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
17. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
18. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
19. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5315
20. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
21. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
22. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
23. Connect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness
fastener.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5316
24. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level.
Solenoid Body Assembly
Solenoid Body Assembly
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5317
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5318
Removal
NOTE: The PCM must be updated with a new solenoid body strategy data file and solenoid body
ID anytime a new solenoid body is installed. A new solenoid body service tag must be installed
over the current solenoid body service tag on top of the transaxle case.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5319
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5320
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5321
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5322
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle main control cover.
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5323
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5324
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
Installation
1. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
2. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5325
3. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
4. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5326
5. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
6. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
7. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
8. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on the
inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5327
9. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
10. Wipe the surface of the existing solenoid body strategy tag on top of the transaxle case clean
and install the new solenoid body strategy tag
(supplied with the solenoid body service kit) over it.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5328
11. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
12. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
13. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5329
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
15. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
16. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
17. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
18. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5330
19. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
20. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
21. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
22. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5331
23. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
24. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level. 25. Download a new solenoid
body strategy to the PCM.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5332
Valve Body: Overhaul
Main Control Assembly
Main Control Assembly
Main Control Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5333
Lower Valve Body (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5334
Lower Valve Body (Part 2)
Disassembly
1. NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolt for assembly.
Remove the 6 bolts and the cover assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5335
2. NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 5 bolts and the transfer plate assembly.
3. Remove and discard the valve body separator plate.
4. NOTE: Note the location of the check balls for assembly.
Remove the 7 check balls from the valve body.
Check Ball Locations
5. Remove the lower valve body assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5336
6. Remove and discard the lower valve body separator plate and gasket.
7. Remove the manual valve from the valve body.
8. CAUTION: Remove the valves by tapping the valve body on the palm of the hand to slide the
valves out of the bores. It may be necessary
to remove the valves and springs using a pick. If it is necessary to use a pick, use extreme caution
to prevent damaging the valves or valve bores. If necessary, disassemble parts of the main control
valve body in small groups. Take special care when handling the main control components, since
they are the most precise and delicate parts of the transaxle. Neatly arrange the parts as they are
removed to avoid mixing similar pieces.
CAUTION: Do not stone or polish any valves. If the valves do not move freely, install a new
assembly.
Remove the individual valves and springs from the main control valve body and lower valve body
by removing the retaining clips. See the main control valve body assembly illustration for valve and
spring locations. Clean valves, springs, main control valve body and lower valve body.
Assembly
1. CAUTION: Do not stone or polish any valves. If the valves do not move freely during assembly,
replacement of install a new valve body.
Install the valve body valves, springs, and retaining clips in the main control valve body and lower
valve body. See the main control valve body assembly illustration for valve and spring locations.
2. Install the manual valve in the valve body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5337
3. Position a new lower valve body separator plate and gasket on the main control valve body.
4. Position the lower valve body on the main control valve body.
5. NOTE: Install the check balls in the correct location as noted during disassembly.
Install the 7 check balls.
6. Install a new valve body separator plate and gasket.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5338
7. NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the correct location as noted during disassembly.
Install the transfer plate assembly and hand tighten the 5 bolts. 1
63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
2 35 mm (1.37 inch) bolts
8. Tighten the 5 bolts.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
9. NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the correct location as noted during disassembly.
Install the cover assembly and hand tighten the 6 bolts. 1
63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
2 35 mm (1.37 inch) bolts
10. Tighten the 6 bolts.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5339
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Solenoid Body Assembly
Solenoid Body Assembly
Solenoid Body Assembly
Disassembly
1. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the solenoid
body filter or damage to the solenoid body can occur.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5340
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
2. Remove and discard the solenoid body assembly electrical connector seal.
3. Clean and inspect the solenoid body assembly for damage and replace if necessary.
Assembly
1. Install a new solenoid body assembly electrical connector seal.
2. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5341
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Differential Cover: Service and Repair
Differential Housing Cover
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove the rear axle assembly. 3. Remove the 10 bolts and
the rear differential cover.
^ Drain the differential fluid from the housing.
Installation
1. CAUTION: Make sure the machined surfaces on the rear axle housing and the differential
housing cover are clean and free of oil before
installing the new silicone sealant. The inside of the rear axle must be covered when cleaning the
machined surface to prevent contamination.
NOTE: Make sure the differential vent located on the rear cover is free of obstruction.
Clean the gasket mating surfaces of the differential housing and the differential housing cover.
2. NOTE: The differential housing cover must be installed within 15 minutes of application of the
silicone, or new sealant must be applied. If
possible, allow one hour before filling with lubricant to make sure the silicone sealant has correctly
cured.
Apply a new continuous bead of clear silicone rubber as shown in the illustration.
3. Install the differential housing cover and the 10 bolts.
^ Tighten to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs).
4. Fill the rear axle with 1.15L (2.43 pt) of rear axle lubricant, 3-5 mm (0.118-0.196 inch) below the
bottom of the filler hole and install the filler
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 5346
plug. ^
Tighten to 29 Nm (21 ft. lbs).
5. Install the axle assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Output Shaft, Differential > Differential
Output Shaft Bearing > Component Information > Service and Repair
Differential Output Shaft Bearing: Service and Repair
Stub Shaft Pilot Bearing and Seal
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. Remove the halfshaft assembly. 2. To remove the seal, use the special tool to remove the stub
shaft seal. The stub shaft pilot bearing is not serviced.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Output Shaft, Differential > Differential
Output Shaft Bearing > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5351
Installation
1. NOTE: Lubricate the new stub shaft pilot bearing housing seal with grease.
Using the special tools, install the stub shaft pilot bearing housing seal.
2. CAUTION: Inspect the inboard CV joint seal journal for rust or nicks/scratches prior to installing
the halfshaft. If necessary, polish the
seal journal with fine crocus cloth.
Install the halfshaft assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Flange, Differential > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Pinion Flange: Service and Repair
Drive Pinion Seal
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove and discard the 4 rear driveshaft universal joint flange
bolts.
^ Support the driveshaft.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Flange, Differential > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 5355
3. NOTE: Discard the nut after removing it. Install a new nut during installation.
Using the special tool, hold the pinion flange while removing the nut. ^
Remove the nut.
4. Index-mark the location of the pinion to the yoke.
5. Using the special tool, remove the pinion flange.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Flange, Differential > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 5356
6. Using the special tools, remove the seal.
Installation
1. NOTE: Make sure that the mating surface is clean before installing the new seal.
Using the special tool, install the seal.
2. NOTE: Lubricate the pinion flange with premium long-life grease.
Line up the index marks and position the pinion flange.
3. Using the special tool, install the pinion nut.
^ Tighten to 244 Nm (180 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Flange, Differential > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 5357
4. Line up the index marks and install the rear driveshaft universal joint flange.
^ Tighten the bolts to 70 Nm (52 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Stub Shaft Pilot Bearing and Seal
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Stub Shaft Pilot Bearing and Seal
Stub Shaft Pilot Bearing and Seal
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. Remove the halfshaft assembly. 2. To remove the seal, use the special tool to remove the stub
shaft seal. The stub shaft pilot bearing is not serviced.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Stub Shaft Pilot Bearing and Seal > Page 5362
Installation
1. NOTE: Lubricate the new stub shaft pilot bearing housing seal with grease.
Using the special tools, install the stub shaft pilot bearing housing seal.
2. CAUTION: Inspect the inboard CV joint seal journal for rust or nicks/scratches prior to installing
the halfshaft. If necessary, polish the
seal journal with fine crocus cloth.
Install the halfshaft assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Stub Shaft Pilot Bearing and Seal > Page 5363
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Drive Pinion Seal
Drive Pinion Seal
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove and discard the 4 rear driveshaft universal joint flange
bolts.
^ Support the driveshaft.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Stub Shaft Pilot Bearing and Seal > Page 5364
3. NOTE: Discard the nut after removing it. Install a new nut during installation.
Using the special tool, hold the pinion flange while removing the nut. ^
Remove the nut.
4. Index-mark the location of the pinion to the yoke.
5. Using the special tool, remove the pinion flange.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Stub Shaft Pilot Bearing and Seal > Page 5365
6. Using the special tools, remove the seal.
Installation
1. NOTE: Make sure that the mating surface is clean before installing the new seal.
Using the special tool, install the seal.
2. NOTE: Lubricate the pinion flange with premium long-life grease.
Line up the index marks and position the pinion flange.
3. Using the special tool, install the pinion nut.
^ Tighten to 244 Nm (180 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Stub Shaft Pilot Bearing and Seal > Page 5366
4. Line up the index marks and install the rear driveshaft universal joint flange.
^ Tighten the bolts to 70 Nm (52 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-25-8 > Dec > 07 >
Drivetrain - Front Axle Clicking/Creaking Noises
Constant Velocity Joint: Customer Interest Drivetrain - Front Axle Clicking/Creaking Noises
TSB 07-25-8
12/24/07
NOISE COLD - FRONT HALF SHAFTS - RATCHETING/CLICKING/CREAKING - COLD AMBIENT
TEMPERATURES - BELOW 15 DEGREES F (-9 C) BUILT BEFORE 5/1/2007
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 07-11-14 to update the Service Procedure and add a production fix
date.
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles built before 5/1/2007 may exhibit a ratcheting, clicking,
and creaking noise from the front half shafts in cold ambient temperatures after a vehicle cold
soaks. The noise occurs on medium to heavy acceleration when turning but goes away quickly.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Replace the grease in both front halfshaft outer constant velocity (CV) joints. The inner CV joints do
not require grease replacement. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 205-04 for the constant
velocity (CV) joint boot removal and replacement procedure.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072508A 2007 Edge/MKX FWD: 2.2 Hrs
Replace The CV Joint Boots And Grease. Includes Time To Remove And Install Halfshaft: Both
Halfshafts (Do Not Use With 3329A, 3329A1)
072508A 2007 Edge/MKX AWD: 2.7 Hrs.
Replace The CV Joint Boots And Grease. Includes Time To Remove And Install Halfshaft: Both
Front Halfshafts Sides (Do Not Use With 4462A, 4462A1)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3A331 42
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-25-8 > Dec > 07 >
Drivetrain - Front Axle Clicking/Creaking Noises > Page 5377
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 07-25-8
> Dec > 07 > Drivetrain - Front Axle Clicking/Creaking Noises
Constant Velocity Joint: All Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Front Axle Clicking/Creaking
Noises
TSB 07-25-8
12/24/07
NOISE COLD - FRONT HALF SHAFTS - RATCHETING/CLICKING/CREAKING - COLD AMBIENT
TEMPERATURES - BELOW 15 DEGREES F (-9 C) BUILT BEFORE 5/1/2007
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 07-11-14 to update the Service Procedure and add a production fix
date.
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles built before 5/1/2007 may exhibit a ratcheting, clicking,
and creaking noise from the front half shafts in cold ambient temperatures after a vehicle cold
soaks. The noise occurs on medium to heavy acceleration when turning but goes away quickly.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Replace the grease in both front halfshaft outer constant velocity (CV) joints. The inner CV joints do
not require grease replacement. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 205-04 for the constant
velocity (CV) joint boot removal and replacement procedure.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072508A 2007 Edge/MKX FWD: 2.2 Hrs
Replace The CV Joint Boots And Grease. Includes Time To Remove And Install Halfshaft: Both
Halfshafts (Do Not Use With 3329A, 3329A1)
072508A 2007 Edge/MKX AWD: 2.7 Hrs.
Replace The CV Joint Boots And Grease. Includes Time To Remove And Install Halfshaft: Both
Front Halfshafts Sides (Do Not Use With 4462A, 4462A1)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3A331 42
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 07-25-8
> Dec > 07 > Drivetrain - Front Axle Clicking/Creaking Noises > Page 5383
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Constant
Velocity Joint: > 07-25-14 > Dec > 07 > Steering - Leaks From Steering Rack/Pump Areas
Steering Gear: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Leaks From Steering Rack/Pump Areas
TSB 07-25-14
12/24/07
POWER STEERING FLUID LEAKS FROM STEERING RACK AND PUMP ATTACHMENT
JOINTS
FORD: 2006-2008 Fusion 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2006 Zephyr 2007-2008 MKZ, MKX
MERCURY: 2006-2008 Milan
This article supersedes TSB 07-1-3 to update vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some 2006-2008 Fusion and Milan, 2006 Zephyr, 2007-2008 MKZ and 2007-2008 Edge
and MKX vehicles may exhibit a small power steering fluid leak at the line attachment areas of the
rack or the pump.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Replace the banjo bolt and the two (2) sealing washers following Workshop Manual, Section
211-02 using the service kit.
2. One (1) kit is used for one (1) joint (either pump or gear).
3. Joint must be torqued with a hand torque wrench to:
a. Fusion, Milan, Zephyr, and MKZ:
(1) Pump 35 lb-ft (47 N.m).
(2) Gear 41 lb-ft (55 N.m).
b. Edge and MKX:
(1) Pump 35 lb-ft (47 N.m).
(2) Gear 35 lb-ft (47 N.m).
NOTE
THIS NEW BANJO BOLT HAS A HIGHER TORQUE RATING TO ACHIEVE A HIGHER CLAMP
LOAD.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072514A 2006 Fusion, Milan, 0.6 Hr.
Zephyr, 2007-2008 Fusion
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Constant
Velocity Joint: > 07-25-14 > Dec > 07 > Steering - Leaks From Steering Rack/Pump Areas > Page 5389
Milan 2.3L: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear Or Power
Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
3674A5)
072514B 2006 Fusion, Milan, 0.7 Hr.
Zephyr, 2007-2008 Fusion Milan 2.3L: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH
Steering Gear And The Power Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System
(Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514C 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan 0.6 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Power Steering Pump. Includes
Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514D 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan 0.8 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear. Includes Time To
Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514E 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan, 0.9 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH Steering Gear And The Power
Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
3674A5)
072514F 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.5 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers on The Power Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill
And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514G 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.6 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear. Includes Time To Fill And
Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Constant
Velocity Joint: > 07-25-14 > Dec > 07 > Steering - Leaks From Steering Rack/Pump Areas > Page 5390
3674A5)
072514H 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.7 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH Steering Gear And The Power Steering
Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A 3674A5)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3A705 24
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Constant
Velocity Joint: > 07-25-14 > Dec > 07 > Steering - Leaks From Steering Rack/Pump Areas > Page 5396
Milan 2.3L: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear Or Power
Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
3674A5)
072514B 2006 Fusion, Milan, 0.7 Hr.
Zephyr, 2007-2008 Fusion Milan 2.3L: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH
Steering Gear And The Power Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System
(Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514C 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan 0.6 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Power Steering Pump. Includes
Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514D 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan 0.8 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear. Includes Time To
Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514E 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan, 0.9 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH Steering Gear And The Power
Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
3674A5)
072514F 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.5 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers on The Power Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill
And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514G 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.6 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear. Includes Time To Fill And
Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Constant
Velocity Joint: > 07-25-14 > Dec > 07 > Steering - Leaks From Steering Rack/Pump Areas > Page 5397
3674A5)
072514H 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.7 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH Steering Gear And The Power Steering
Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A 3674A5)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3A705 24
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Drive Halfshafts
Constant Velocity Joint Boot: Service and Repair Front Drive Halfshafts
Constant Velocity (CV) Joint Boot
Special Tool(s)
Disassembly
1. Remove the halfshaft assembly. 2. For the inboard CV joint, remove and discard the boot
clamps. 3. Remove the inboard CV joint retaining ring.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Drive Halfshafts > Page 5402
4. CAUTION: Do not let the roller bearings fall.
For the inboard CV joint: ^
Remove and discard the retainer circlip.
^ Slide the boot away from the CV joint.
5. Using a suitable 3-jaw puller, remove the CV joint.
6. Remove and discard the inner CV boot.
7. NOTE: The outboard CV joint is not removable from the halfshaft. The boot must be removed or
installed from the inboard CV joint side of the
shaft.
For the outboard CV joint: 1
Remove and discard the boot clamps.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Drive Halfshafts > Page 5403
2 Remove and discard the boot.
8. If necessary, press the anti-lock brake sensor indicator ring from the outer CV joint.
Assembly
1. NOTE: Do not mix the boot clamps.
If removed, install a new anti-lock brake sensor indicator ring on the outer CV joint.
2. Lubricate the outboard CV joint.
1 Pack the outboard CV joint with grease from the kit. ^
One-third of the grease must be installed in the joint with the remainder placed in the boot.
2 Spread the remaining grease evenly inside the boot.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Drive Halfshafts > Page 5404
3. Position the boot so the rib on the boot is located in the groove of the shaft.
4. Position the outboard halfshaft boot and the outboard boot clamps.
1 Position the boot.
2 Position the boot clamps.
5. Install the outboard CV boot clamps.
6. Position the inboard clamp and boot.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Drive Halfshafts > Page 5405
7. Install the CV joint and snap ring on the halfshaft.
8. Fill the inboard CV joint housing with grease from the kit.
^ One-half of the grease must be installed in the joint and the remainder placed in the boot.
9. CAUTION: Do not let the roller bearings fall.
Position the CV housing on the CV joint.
10. Install the retaining ring.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Drive Halfshafts > Page 5406
11. Position the inboard halfshaft boot and clamps.
^ Position the boot in the housing groove.
^ Position the boot clamps.
12. Set the halfshaft assembled length to specifications.
1 Measure the entire assembly length.
2 Push in or pull out on the inner joint as necessary to adjust the halfshaft assembled length.
3 Hold the inner joint to prevent the assembled length from changing, and insert a small flat-blade
screwdriver between the boot and the joint to equalize the pressure.
13. Install the boot clamps.
^ Lever arm to the closed position and use a soft-faced hammer to close the tabs.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Drive Halfshafts > Page 5407
14. Install the halfshaft assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Drive Halfshafts > Page 5408
Constant Velocity Joint Boot: Service and Repair Rear Drive Halfshafts
Constant Velocity (CV) Joint Boot
Special Tool(s)
Disassembly
1. Remove the halfshaft assembly. 2. Remove and discard the inboard constant velocity (CV) joint
boot clamps.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Drive Halfshafts > Page 5409
3. With the inboard CV joint boot removed from the housing, remove the retaining ring.
4. Remove the 8 balls and outer race.
5. Remove the CV joint housing snap ring.
6. Remove and discard the boot.
7. NOTE: The outboard CV joint is not removable from the halfshaft. The boot must be removed or
installed from the inboard CV joint side of the
shaft.
For the outboard CV joint boot, carry out the following: 1
Remove and discard the boot clamps.
2 Remove and discard the boot.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Drive Halfshafts > Page 5410
Assembly
1. For the outboard CV joint, carry out the following:
1 Slide the boot on the interconnecting shaft.
2 Pack the outboard CV joint with 80 g (2.82 oz) of grease.
3 Spread any remaining grease evenly inside the boot.
4 Install the boot by seating it in the groove in the CV joint housing.
2. Using the special tool, install the 79.6 mm (3.13 inch) boot clamps on the large end of the boot.
3. Install the small clamp on the small end of the boot.
4. CAUTION: Install a new circlip every time the halfshaft is removed from the axle.
CAUTION: Start one end of the circlip in the groove and work the circlip over the halfshaft and into
the groove to prevent the circlip from overexpanding.
Install a new retainer circlip.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Drive Halfshafts > Page 5411
5. Position the small clamp on the interconnecting shaft before installing the boot. 6. Position the
boot on the interconnecting shaft. 7. Install the inner race and the retainer snap ring.
8. Install the outer race with 8 balls.
9. Insert the assembly in the housing.
10. Install the retaining ring.
11. For the inboard CV joint, carry out the following:
1 Pack the inboard CV joint housing with 108 g (3.80 oz) of grease.
2 Spread any remaining grease evenly inside the boot and CV joint.
3 Install the inboard CV joint housing, seating the boot in the groove in the housing.
12. Set the halfshaft assembled length to specifications.
1 Measure the entire assembly length.
2 Push in or pull out on the inner joint as necessary to adjust the halfshaft assembled length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Drive Halfshafts > Page 5412
3 Hold the inner joint to prevent the assembled length from changing and insert a soft, flat tool
between the boot and the joint to equalize the pressure.
13. Using the special tool, install the 77.5 mm (3.05 inch) boot clamps on the large end of the boot.
14. Install the smaller boot clamp. 15. Install the halfshaft assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front
Wheel Bearing and Wheel Hub
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5417
Removal
NOTE: If removing the wheel hub, the wheel bearing must be replaced.
1. Remove the wheel knuckle. 2. Using the special tool, press the wheel hub from the wheel
bearing.
3. NOTE: This step may not be necessary if the inner wheel bearing race remains in the wheel
knuckle after removing the wheel hub.
Using the special tool, press the inner wheel bearing race from the wheel hub.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5418
4. Remove the snap ring. 5. Using the special tool, press the outer wheel bearing race from the
wheel knuckle.
Installation
1. Using the special tool, press the wheel bearing into the wheel knuckle.
2. Install the snap ring. 3. Using the special tools, press the wheel hub into the wheel bearing.
4. Install the wheel knuckle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5419
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear
Wheel Bearing and Wheel Hub
Special Tool(s)
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicles
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5420
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicles
Removal
All vehicles
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly.
2. CAUTION: Do not allow the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly to hang from the brake
hose or damage to the hose can occur.
Remove the 2 anchor plate bolts and position the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly aside. ^
Support the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly using mechanic's wire.
3. Remove the brake disc.
All wheel drive (AWD) vehicles 4. Remove and discard the halfshaft nut. 5. Using the special tool,
separate the halfshaft from the hub and bearing assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5421
All vehicles 6. Remove the 4 bolts and the wheel bearing and wheel hub.
^ Discard the bolts.
Installation
All vehicles
1. Install the wheel bearing and new wheel hub bolts.
^ Tighten to 133 Nm (98 ft. lbs).
2. Position the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly and install the 2 bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs).
3. Install the brake disc.
AWD vehicles 4. Using a suitable installation tool, install the halfshaft into the wheel bearing and
wheel hub. 5. Install the halfshaft hub nut.
^ Tighten to 275 Nm (203 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut >
Component Information > Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
Front Wheel Hub Nut ...........................................................................................................................
.............................................. 350 Nm (258 ft. lbs).
Install a new front wheel hub nut.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Dust Cover,
Wheel Hub > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Dust Cover: > 10-2-9 > Feb > 10
> Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area
Dust Cover: Customer Interest Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area
TSB 10-2-9
02/15/10
NOISE FROM REAR WHEEL HUB BEARING - BUILT ON OR BEFORE 12/4/2008
FORD: 2007-2009 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 09-26-5 to update the Parts List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Edge and MKX vehicles built on or before 12/4/2008 may exhibit a growl
or howl type noise coming from the left and/or right rear wheel area. This could be the result of a
faulty rear wheel hub bearing assembly.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. If Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics identify a faulty rear wheel hub bearing, it will be
necessary to replace the rear suspension trailing
arm/knuckle assembly along with a new rear wheel hub bearing assembly.
2. Refer to WSM, Section 204-02, for rear wheel hub bearing and trailing arm/knuckle replacement.
Only replace the rear suspension trailing
arm/knuckle assembly and rear bearing hub on the side with the concern. Failing to install a new
rear suspension trailing arm/knuckle assembly when installing a new rear bearing hub assembly
will result in premature bearing noise/wear.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100209A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 1.3 Hrs.
FWD: Replace ONE Rear Wheel Hub Bearing And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assembly
100209A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 1.5 Hrs.
AWD: Replace ONE Rear Wheel Hub Bearing And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assembly
100209B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 2.4 Hrs.
FWD: Replace BOTH Rear
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Dust Cover,
Wheel Hub > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Dust Cover: > 10-2-9 > Feb > 10
> Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area > Page 5434
Wheel Hub Bearings And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assemblies
100209B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 2.8 Hrs.
AWD: Replace BOTH Rear Wheel Hub Bearings And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assemblies
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
1104 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Dust Cover,
Wheel Hub > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Dust Cover: >
10-2-9 > Feb > 10 > Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area
Dust Cover: All Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area
TSB 10-2-9
02/15/10
NOISE FROM REAR WHEEL HUB BEARING - BUILT ON OR BEFORE 12/4/2008
FORD: 2007-2009 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 09-26-5 to update the Parts List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Edge and MKX vehicles built on or before 12/4/2008 may exhibit a growl
or howl type noise coming from the left and/or right rear wheel area. This could be the result of a
faulty rear wheel hub bearing assembly.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. If Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics identify a faulty rear wheel hub bearing, it will be
necessary to replace the rear suspension trailing
arm/knuckle assembly along with a new rear wheel hub bearing assembly.
2. Refer to WSM, Section 204-02, for rear wheel hub bearing and trailing arm/knuckle replacement.
Only replace the rear suspension trailing
arm/knuckle assembly and rear bearing hub on the side with the concern. Failing to install a new
rear suspension trailing arm/knuckle assembly when installing a new rear bearing hub assembly
will result in premature bearing noise/wear.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100209A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 1.3 Hrs.
FWD: Replace ONE Rear Wheel Hub Bearing And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assembly
100209A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 1.5 Hrs.
AWD: Replace ONE Rear Wheel Hub Bearing And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assembly
100209B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 2.4 Hrs.
FWD: Replace BOTH Rear
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Dust Cover,
Wheel Hub > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Dust Cover: >
10-2-9 > Feb > 10 > Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area > Page 5440
Wheel Hub Bearings And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assemblies
100209B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 2.8 Hrs.
AWD: Replace BOTH Rear Wheel Hub Bearings And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assemblies
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
1104 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Service and Repair
Driveshaft
Driveshaft
Removal and Installation
WARNING: The normal operating temperature of the exhaust system is very high. Never attempt to
remove any part of the system until it has cooled. Be especially careful when working around the
catalytic converters. The temperature of the converter rises to a high level after only a few minutes
of engine operation. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Index-mark both the driveshaft flanges.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
2. CAUTION: Do not reuse the CV joint bolts. Install new bolts or damage to the vehicle may occur.
Remove and discard the 4 front driveshaft-to-transfer case bolts. ^
To install, tighten to 70 Nm (52 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5445
3. Remove and discard the 4 universal joint flange bolts and remove the front driveshaft.
^ To install, tighten to 70 Nm (52 ft. lbs).
4. CAUTION: Do not reuse the bolts for the rear U-joint flange. Install new bolts.
Remove and discard the 4 universal joint flange bolts. ^
To install, tighten to 70 Nm (52 ft. lbs).
5. With the help of an assistant, remove the 4 center bearing support nuts and the driveshaft.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
6. NOTE: If a driveshaft is installed and driveshaft vibration is encountered after installation, index
the driveshaft.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Description and Operation
Universal Joint: Description and Operation
Universal Joints The center and rear joints are:
^ a lubed-for-life design that requires no periodic lubrication.
^ equipped with nylon thrust washers, located at the base of each bearing cup, which control end
play, position the needle bearings and improve grease movement.
^ staked in place and not serviced individually. If worn or damaged, install a new driveshaft
assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flex Plate > Component Information > Specifications
Flex Plate: Specifications
Flexplate bolts .....................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 80 Nm (59 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flex Plate > Component Information > Specifications > Page
5452
Flex Plate: Diagrams
Lower End Components - Exploded View, Crankshaft Pulley and Crankshaft Front Seal
Lower End Components - Exploded View, Crankshaft Pulley and Crankshaft Front Seal
Lower End Components - Exploded View, Flexplate and Crankshaft Rear Seal
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flex Plate > Component Information > Specifications > Page
5453
Lower End Components - Exploded View, Flexplate and Crankshaft Rear Seal
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flex Plate > Component Information > Specifications > Page
5454
Flex Plate: Service and Repair
Flexplate
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove the transaxle.
3. NOTE: One of the 8 flexplate holes are offset so the flexplate can only be installed in one
position.
Remove the bolts and the flexplate. ^
To install, tighten to 80 Nm (59 ft. lbs).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and
Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL INDICATOR LAMP (TCIL)
The TCIL is an output signal from the PCM that controls the lamp on/off function depending on the
engagement or disengagement of overdrive.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Power Take-Off > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Power Take-Off: Description and Operation
POWER TAKE-OFF (PTO) SWITCH AND CIRCUITS
The PTO circuit is used by the PCM to disable some of the on board diagnostics (OBD) monitors
during PTO operation. The PTO switch is normally open. When the PTO unit is activated, the PTO
switch is closed and battery voltage is supplied to the PTO input circuit. This indicates to the PCM
that an additional load is being applied to the engine. The PTO indicator lamp illuminates when the
PTO system is functioning correctly and flashes when the PTO system is damaged
When the PTO unit is activated, the PCM disables some OBD monitors, which may not function
reliably during PTO operation. Without the PTO circuit information to the PCM, false DTCs may be
set during PTO operation. Prior to an Inspection/Maintenance test, operate the vehicle with the
PTO disengaged long enough to successfully complete the OBD Monitors.
PTO Circuits Description
The 3 PTO input circuits are PTO mode, PTO engage, and PTO RPM.
The PTO engage circuit is used when the operator is requesting the PCM to check the needed
inputs required to initiate the PTO engagement.
The PTO RPM circuit is used for the operator to request additional engine RPM for PTO operation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5469
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5470
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5471
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5472
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5473
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5474
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5475
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5476
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5477
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5478
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5479
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5480
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5481
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5482
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5483
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5484
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5485
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5486
Brake Switch - TCC: Description and Operation
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal to the
PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Overdrive Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5491
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5492
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5493
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5494
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5495
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5496
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5497
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5498
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5499
Overdrive Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5500
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5501
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5502
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5503
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5504
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5505
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5506
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5507
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5512
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5513
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5514
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5515
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5516
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5517
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5518
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5519
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5520
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5521
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5522
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5523
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5524
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5525
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5526
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5527
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5528
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5533
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5534
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5535
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5536
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5537
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5538
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5539
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5540
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5541
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5542
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5543
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5544
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5545
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5546
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5547
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5548
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5549
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5550
Transmission Mode Switch: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL SWITCH (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
The TCS signals the PCM with VPWR whenever the TCS is pressed. On vehicles with this feature,
the transmission control indicator lamp (TCIL) illuminates when the TCS is cycled to disengage
overdrive.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5555
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5556
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5557
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5558
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5559
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5560
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5561
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5562
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5563
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5564
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5565
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5566
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5567
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5568
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5569
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5570
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5571
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5572
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5573
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5574
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
12. Disconnect the selector lever cable end from the manual lever.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5575
13. Remove the nut and the manual lever.
14. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
15. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
16. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5576
17. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
18. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
19. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle side cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5577
20. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
21. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
22. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5578
23. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when removing the solenoid body filter.
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
24. Remove the 10 bolts, the TR sensor detent spring and the main control valve body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5579
25. Using a suitable tool, remove and discard the TR sensor locking pin.
26. NOTE: TR sensor removed for clarity.
Make sure that the park pawl actuator rod does not become disengaged from the park pawl and
the abutment by keeping the end of the park pawl actuator rod behind the machined valve body
mating surface of the transaxle case. If the park pawl actuator rod becomes disengaged from the
park pawl and the abutment, transaxle removal and disassembly is required to reinstall the actuator
rod.
27. CAUTION: Make sure that the park pawl actuator rod does not become disengaged from the
park pawl and the abutment or transaxle
removal and disassembly is required to reinstall the actuator rod.
Remove the TR sensor. 1
Slide the TR sensor down until the manual shaft is out of the transaxle case.
2 Rotate the TR sensor detent plate counterclockwise, as viewed from below until the plate rests
against the transaxle case, remove the park
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5580
pawl actuating rod from the TR sensor and remove the TR sensor.
Installation
1. Install the TR sensor.
1 Position the park pawl actuating rod in the TR sensor.
2 Install the TR sensor in the transaxle case.
2. Using the special tool, install a new TR sensor locking pin.
3. NOTE: Make sure that the manual lever pin (part of the TR sensor) is correctly installed in the
manual valve.
Position the TSS, OSS and TR sensor wiring harnesses aside and install the main control valve
body, the TR sensor detent spring and the 10 bolts. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown. ^
Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5581
4. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
5. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4
95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5582
6. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
7. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5583
8. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
9. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
10. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
11. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on
the inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5584
12. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
13. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5585
14. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
15. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
16. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
17. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5586
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
18. Install the manual lever and the nut.
^ Tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs).
19. Connect the selector lever cable end to the manual lever.
20. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
21. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5587
22. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
23. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
24. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
25. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5588
26. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
27. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
28. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Transmission Speed Sensor: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's
Transmission Speed Sensor: Customer Interest A/T - Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's
TSB 07-21-11
10/29/07
6F50 TRANSAXLES BUILT PRIOR TO 10/21/2007 - DTC P0715, P0717, P0718, P0720, P0721,
P0722 AND/OR HARSH ENGAGEMENT, NO UPSHIFT, FIFTH GEAR ONLY
FORD: 2008 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2008Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
MERCURY: 2008 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 07-3-11 to update the transaxle built date coverage and Part List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Edge and MKX, 2008 Taurus Taurus X, and Sable vehicles equipped with
a 6F50 transaxle with a build date prior to 10/21/2007, with any Output Shaft Speed (OSS) sensor
or Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) sensor diagnostic trouble code(s) (DTCs) P0715, P0717, P0718,
P0720, P0721, P0722 and/or harsh engagements, no upshift, fifth gear only, could have an
intermittent short in the OSS or TSS sensor.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. If any DTCs related to OSS or TSS are present, check the transaxle build date following
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
a. If the build date is before 10/21/2007 go to Step 2.
b. If vehicle transaxle is built on or after 10/21/2007 do not continue with this TSB and follow
normal WSM, Section 307-01 Automatic Transaxle/Transmission-6F50 Diagnosis and Testing.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Transmission Speed Sensor: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's > Page
5597
2. To repair an OSS or TSS DTC refer to WSM, Section 307-01, follow pin point test (PPT) C. The
TSS sensor is located in the end cover assembly (Figure 1). The OSS sensor is located inside the
transaxle under the main Control (Figure 2). Both sensor connectors are plugged into the solenoid
body. Both sensor connectors look the same but are wired differently (Figure 3).
3. If you work through PPT C and get to Step C9 before finding the cause of the concern, replace
the sensor (DO NOT REPLACE THE POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) AT THIS TIME).
Reassemble as needed and verify the concern is fixed.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT:
Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits are
determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Transmission Speed Sensor: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's > Page
5598
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT072111 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING BASIC PART NO.
CONDITION
7M101 CODE
42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Transmission Speed Sensor: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh Engagement/No
Shift/Multiple DTC's
Transmission Speed Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Harsh Engagement/No
Shift/Multiple DTC's
TSB 07-21-11
10/29/07
6F50 TRANSAXLES BUILT PRIOR TO 10/21/2007 - DTC P0715, P0717, P0718, P0720, P0721,
P0722 AND/OR HARSH ENGAGEMENT, NO UPSHIFT, FIFTH GEAR ONLY
FORD: 2008 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2008Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
MERCURY: 2008 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 07-3-11 to update the transaxle built date coverage and Part List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Edge and MKX, 2008 Taurus Taurus X, and Sable vehicles equipped with
a 6F50 transaxle with a build date prior to 10/21/2007, with any Output Shaft Speed (OSS) sensor
or Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) sensor diagnostic trouble code(s) (DTCs) P0715, P0717, P0718,
P0720, P0721, P0722 and/or harsh engagements, no upshift, fifth gear only, could have an
intermittent short in the OSS or TSS sensor.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. If any DTCs related to OSS or TSS are present, check the transaxle build date following
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
a. If the build date is before 10/21/2007 go to Step 2.
b. If vehicle transaxle is built on or after 10/21/2007 do not continue with this TSB and follow
normal WSM, Section 307-01 Automatic Transaxle/Transmission-6F50 Diagnosis and Testing.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Transmission Speed Sensor: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh Engagement/No
Shift/Multiple DTC's > Page 5604
2. To repair an OSS or TSS DTC refer to WSM, Section 307-01, follow pin point test (PPT) C. The
TSS sensor is located in the end cover assembly (Figure 1). The OSS sensor is located inside the
transaxle under the main Control (Figure 2). Both sensor connectors are plugged into the solenoid
body. Both sensor connectors look the same but are wired differently (Figure 3).
3. If you work through PPT C and get to Step C9 before finding the cause of the concern, replace
the sensor (DO NOT REPLACE THE POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) AT THIS TIME).
Reassemble as needed and verify the concern is fixed.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT:
Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits are
determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Transmission Speed Sensor: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh Engagement/No
Shift/Multiple DTC's > Page 5605
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT072111 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING BASIC PART NO.
CONDITION
7M101 CODE
42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5608
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5609
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5610
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5611
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5612
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5613
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5614
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5615
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5616
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5617
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5618
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5619
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5620
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5621
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5622
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5623
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5624
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor
Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5627
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5628
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5629
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle side cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5630
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5631
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
22. Remove the 10 bolts, the detent spring and the main control valve body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5632
23. Remove the bolt and the TSS sensor.
Installation
1. Route the TSS sensor wiring harness through the cover and the transaxle case.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5633
2. Install the TSS sensor in the cover and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
3. NOTE: Make sure that the manual lever pin (part of the TR sensor) is correctly installed in the
manual valve.
Position the TSS, OSS and TR sensor wiring harnesses aside and install the main control valve
body, the TR sensor detent spring and the 10 bolts. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown. ^
Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5634
4. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
5. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3
80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5635
6. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
7. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5636
8. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
9. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
10. Inspect the transaxle side cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
11. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on
the inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle side cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5637
12. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
13. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5638
14. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
15. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
16. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5639
17. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
18. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
19. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
20. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
21. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5640
22. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
23. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
24. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
25. Connect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness
fastener.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5641
26. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5642
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5643
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5644
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5645
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle side cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5646
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5647
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when removing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
22. Remove the 10 bolts, the TR sensor detent spring and the main control valve body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5648
23. Remove the bolt and the OSS sensor.
Installation
1. Install the OSS sensor and the bolt.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
2. NOTE: Make sure that the manual lever pin (part of the TR sensor) is correctly installed in the
manual valve.
Position the TSS, OSS and TR sensor wiring harnesses aside and install the main control valve
body, the TR sensor detent spring and the 10 bolts. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown. ^
Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5649
3. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
4. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5650
5. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
6. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5651
7. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
8. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
9. Inspect the transaxle side cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
10. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on
the inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle side cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5652
11. Tighten the main control valve body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
12. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5653
13. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
14. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
15. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
16. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5654
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
17. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
18. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
19. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
20. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5655
21. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
22. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
23. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
24. Connect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness
fastener.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft
Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5656
25. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5661
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5662
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5663
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5664
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5665
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5666
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5667
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5668
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5669
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5670
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5671
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5672
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5673
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5674
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5675
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5676
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5677
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Specifications
Solenoid Operation Chart
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5686
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5687
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5688
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5689
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5690
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5691
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5692
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5693
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5694
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5695
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5696
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5697
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5698
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5699
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5700
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5701
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5702
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5703
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
Pinpoint Tests - OSC Equipped Vehicle
Special Tool(s)
Any time an electrical connector or solenoid body is disconnected, inspect the connector for
terminal condition, corrosion and contamination. Also inspect the connector seal for damage.
Clean, repair or install new components as required.
Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor Diagnosis Chart
A. "In Between" reading could be caused by a shift cable or digital TR sensor misaligned or a
digital TR sensor circuit failure of TR1, TR2, TR3 or TR4. B. TRD: 1= Open digital TR switch, 0=
Closed digital TR switch. C. VCM Readings: Taken from PCM signal pins for TR1, TR2, TR3 and
TR4 to signal return.
Wiggle Test Information for Open/Shorts A. Check TR1, TR2, TR3 and TR4 circuits for an
intermittent open with the TR sensor positioned so that suspect circuit is in the closed position and
monitor the TR_D with the scan tool. B. Check TR1, TR2, TR3 and TR4 circuits for an intermittent
short with the TR sensor positioned so that suspect circuit is in the open position and monitor the
TRD with the scan tool. To determine the shorted components while observing TRD, unplug the TR
and determine if the short goes away. If the short is still present unplug the transaxle harness and
determine if the short goes away. If the short is still present, then the short is in the powertrain
control module (PCM) or vehicle harness. Remove the suspect circuit(s) wire terminal from the
PCM connector. If the short is still present, then the PCM has an internal failure. Otherwise, the
failure is in the vehicle harness.
Shift Solenoid Pre-Diagnosis Use this shift solenoid operation information when carrying out
Pinpoint Test A.
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5704
Solenoid Operation Chart
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Failed ON" or "Failed OFF" Failed ON/OFF due to powertrain
control module and/or vehicle wiring concerns, and/or solenoid electrically, mechanically or
hydraulically stuck on/off.
SSA
SSB
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5705
SSC
SSD
SSE
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5706
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair
Solenoid Body Assembly
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5707
Removal
NOTE: The PCM must be updated with a new solenoid body strategy data file and solenoid body
ID anytime a new solenoid body is installed. A new solenoid body service tag must be installed
over the current solenoid body service tag on top of the transaxle case.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5708
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5709
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5710
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5711
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle main control cover.
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5712
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5713
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
Installation
1. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
2. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5714
3. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
4. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5715
5. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
6. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
7. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
8. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on the
inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5716
9. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
10. Wipe the surface of the existing solenoid body strategy tag on top of the transaxle case clean
and install the new solenoid body strategy tag
(supplied with the solenoid body service kit) over it.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5717
11. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
12. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
13. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5718
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
15. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
16. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
17. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
18. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5719
19. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
20. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
21. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
22. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5720
23. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
24. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level. 25. Download a new solenoid
body strategy to the PCM.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications
Shift Solenoid: Specifications
Solenoid Operation Chart
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Shift Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5726
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5727
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5728
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5729
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5730
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5731
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5732
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5733
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5734
Shift Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5735
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5736
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5737
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5738
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5739
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5740
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5741
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5742
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5743
Shift Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
Pinpoint Tests - OSC Equipped Vehicle
Special Tool(s)
Any time an electrical connector or solenoid body is disconnected, inspect the connector for
terminal condition, corrosion and contamination. Also inspect the connector seal for damage.
Clean, repair or install new components as required.
Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor Diagnosis Chart
A. "In Between" reading could be caused by a shift cable or digital TR sensor misaligned or a
digital TR sensor circuit failure of TR1, TR2, TR3 or TR4. B. TRD: 1= Open digital TR switch, 0=
Closed digital TR switch. C. VCM Readings: Taken from PCM signal pins for TR1, TR2, TR3 and
TR4 to signal return.
Wiggle Test Information for Open/Shorts A. Check TR1, TR2, TR3 and TR4 circuits for an
intermittent open with the TR sensor positioned so that suspect circuit is in the closed position and
monitor the TR_D with the scan tool. B. Check TR1, TR2, TR3 and TR4 circuits for an intermittent
short with the TR sensor positioned so that suspect circuit is in the open position and monitor the
TRD with the scan tool. To determine the shorted components while observing TRD, unplug the TR
and determine if the short goes away. If the short is still present unplug the transaxle harness and
determine if the short goes away. If the short is still present, then the short is in the powertrain
control module (PCM) or vehicle harness. Remove the suspect circuit(s) wire terminal from the
PCM connector. If the short is still present, then the PCM has an internal failure. Otherwise, the
failure is in the vehicle harness.
Shift Solenoid Pre-Diagnosis Use this shift solenoid operation information when carrying out
Pinpoint Test A.
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5744
Solenoid Operation Chart
Shift Solenoid Failure Mode Chart "Failed ON" or "Failed OFF" Failed ON/OFF due to powertrain
control module and/or vehicle wiring concerns, and/or solenoid electrically, mechanically or
hydraulically stuck on/off.
SSA
SSB
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5745
SSC
SSD
SSE
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5746
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair
Solenoid Body Assembly
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5747
Removal
NOTE: The PCM must be updated with a new solenoid body strategy data file and solenoid body
ID anytime a new solenoid body is installed. A new solenoid body service tag must be installed
over the current solenoid body service tag on top of the transaxle case.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5748
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5749
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5750
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5751
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle main control cover.
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5752
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5753
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
Installation
1. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
2. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5754
3. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
4. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5755
5. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
6. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
7. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
8. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on the
inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5756
9. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
10. Wipe the surface of the existing solenoid body strategy tag on top of the transaxle case clean
and install the new solenoid body strategy tag
(supplied with the solenoid body service kit) over it.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5757
11. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
12. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
13. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5758
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
15. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
16. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
17. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
18. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5759
19. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
20. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
21. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
22. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5760
23. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
24. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level. 25. Download a new solenoid
body strategy to the PCM.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Specifications
Solenoid Operation Chart
Solenoid Operation Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5766
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5767
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5768
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5769
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5770
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5771
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5772
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5773
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5774
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5775
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5776
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5777
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5778
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5779
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5780
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5781
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5782
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5783
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Service and Repair
Solenoid Body Assembly
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5784
Removal
NOTE: The PCM must be updated with a new solenoid body strategy data file and solenoid body
ID anytime a new solenoid body is installed. A new solenoid body service tag must be installed
over the current solenoid body service tag on top of the transaxle case.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5785
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5786
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5787
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5788
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle main control cover.
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5789
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5790
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
Installation
1. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
2. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5791
3. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
4. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5792
5. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
6. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
7. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
8. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on the
inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5793
9. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
10. Wipe the surface of the existing solenoid body strategy tag on top of the transaxle case clean
and install the new solenoid body strategy tag
(supplied with the solenoid body service kit) over it.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5794
11. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
12. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
13. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
14. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5795
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
15. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
16. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
17. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
18. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5796
19. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
20. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
21. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
22. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5797
23. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
24. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level. 25. Download a new solenoid
body strategy to the PCM.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL INDICATOR LAMP (TCIL)
The TCIL is an output signal from the PCM that controls the lamp on/off function depending on the
engagement or disengagement of overdrive.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5809
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5810
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5811
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5812
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5813
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5814
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5815
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5816
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5817
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5818
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5819
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5820
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5821
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5822
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5823
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5824
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5825
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5826
Brake Switch - TCC: Description and Operation
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal to the
PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Overdrive Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5831
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5832
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5833
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5834
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5835
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5836
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5837
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5838
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5839
Overdrive Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5840
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5841
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5842
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5843
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5844
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5845
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5846
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5847
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5852
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5853
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5854
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5855
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5856
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5857
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5858
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5859
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5860
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5861
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5862
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5863
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5864
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5865
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5866
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5867
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5868
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5873
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5874
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5875
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5876
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5877
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5878
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5879
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5880
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5881
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5882
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5883
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5884
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5885
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5886
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5887
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5888
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5889
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 5890
Transmission Mode Switch: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL SWITCH (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
The TCS signals the PCM with VPWR whenever the TCS is pressed. On vehicles with this feature,
the transmission control indicator lamp (TCIL) illuminates when the TCS is cycled to disengage
overdrive.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5895
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5896
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5897
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5898
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5899
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5900
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5901
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5902
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5903
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5904
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5905
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5906
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5907
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5908
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5909
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5910
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5911
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5912
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
Digital Transmission Range (TR) Sensor
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5913
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5914
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
12. Disconnect the selector lever cable end from the manual lever.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5915
13. Remove the nut and the manual lever.
14. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
15. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
16. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5916
17. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
18. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
19. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle side cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5917
20. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
21. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
22. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5918
23. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when removing the solenoid body filter.
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
24. Remove the 10 bolts, the TR sensor detent spring and the main control valve body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5919
25. Using a suitable tool, remove and discard the TR sensor locking pin.
26. NOTE: TR sensor removed for clarity.
Make sure that the park pawl actuator rod does not become disengaged from the park pawl and
the abutment by keeping the end of the park pawl actuator rod behind the machined valve body
mating surface of the transaxle case. If the park pawl actuator rod becomes disengaged from the
park pawl and the abutment, transaxle removal and disassembly is required to reinstall the actuator
rod.
27. CAUTION: Make sure that the park pawl actuator rod does not become disengaged from the
park pawl and the abutment or transaxle
removal and disassembly is required to reinstall the actuator rod.
Remove the TR sensor. 1
Slide the TR sensor down until the manual shaft is out of the transaxle case.
2 Rotate the TR sensor detent plate counterclockwise, as viewed from below until the plate rests
against the transaxle case, remove the park
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5920
pawl actuating rod from the TR sensor and remove the TR sensor.
Installation
1. Install the TR sensor.
1 Position the park pawl actuating rod in the TR sensor.
2 Install the TR sensor in the transaxle case.
2. Using the special tool, install a new TR sensor locking pin.
3. NOTE: Make sure that the manual lever pin (part of the TR sensor) is correctly installed in the
manual valve.
Position the TSS, OSS and TR sensor wiring harnesses aside and install the main control valve
body, the TR sensor detent spring and the 10 bolts. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown. ^
Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5921
4. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
5. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4
95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5922
6. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
7. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5923
8. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
9. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
10. Inspect the transaxle main control cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
11. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on
the inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle main control cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5924
12. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
13. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5925
14. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
15. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
16. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
17. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5926
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
18. Install the manual lever and the nut.
^ Tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs).
19. Connect the selector lever cable end to the manual lever.
20. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
21. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5927
22. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
23. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
24. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
25. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5928
26. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
27. Connect the MAF sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness fastener.
28. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Transmission Speed Sensor: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh
Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's
Transmission Speed Sensor: Customer Interest A/T - Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's
TSB 07-21-11
10/29/07
6F50 TRANSAXLES BUILT PRIOR TO 10/21/2007 - DTC P0715, P0717, P0718, P0720, P0721,
P0722 AND/OR HARSH ENGAGEMENT, NO UPSHIFT, FIFTH GEAR ONLY
FORD: 2008 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2008Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
MERCURY: 2008 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 07-3-11 to update the transaxle built date coverage and Part List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Edge and MKX, 2008 Taurus Taurus X, and Sable vehicles equipped with
a 6F50 transaxle with a build date prior to 10/21/2007, with any Output Shaft Speed (OSS) sensor
or Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) sensor diagnostic trouble code(s) (DTCs) P0715, P0717, P0718,
P0720, P0721, P0722 and/or harsh engagements, no upshift, fifth gear only, could have an
intermittent short in the OSS or TSS sensor.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. If any DTCs related to OSS or TSS are present, check the transaxle build date following
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
a. If the build date is before 10/21/2007 go to Step 2.
b. If vehicle transaxle is built on or after 10/21/2007 do not continue with this TSB and follow
normal WSM, Section 307-01 Automatic Transaxle/Transmission-6F50 Diagnosis and Testing.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Transmission Speed Sensor: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh
Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's > Page 5937
2. To repair an OSS or TSS DTC refer to WSM, Section 307-01, follow pin point test (PPT) C. The
TSS sensor is located in the end cover assembly (Figure 1). The OSS sensor is located inside the
transaxle under the main Control (Figure 2). Both sensor connectors are plugged into the solenoid
body. Both sensor connectors look the same but are wired differently (Figure 3).
3. If you work through PPT C and get to Step C9 before finding the cause of the concern, replace
the sensor (DO NOT REPLACE THE POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) AT THIS TIME).
Reassemble as needed and verify the concern is fixed.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT:
Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits are
determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Transmission Speed Sensor: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T - Harsh
Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's > Page 5938
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT072111 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING BASIC PART NO.
CONDITION
7M101 CODE
42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Transmission Speed Sensor: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's
Transmission Speed Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Harsh Engagement/No
Shift/Multiple DTC's
TSB 07-21-11
10/29/07
6F50 TRANSAXLES BUILT PRIOR TO 10/21/2007 - DTC P0715, P0717, P0718, P0720, P0721,
P0722 AND/OR HARSH ENGAGEMENT, NO UPSHIFT, FIFTH GEAR ONLY
FORD: 2008 Taurus X, Taurus 2007-2008Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
MERCURY: 2008 Sable
This article supersedes TSB 07-3-11 to update the transaxle built date coverage and Part List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Edge and MKX, 2008 Taurus Taurus X, and Sable vehicles equipped with
a 6F50 transaxle with a build date prior to 10/21/2007, with any Output Shaft Speed (OSS) sensor
or Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) sensor diagnostic trouble code(s) (DTCs) P0715, P0717, P0718,
P0720, P0721, P0722 and/or harsh engagements, no upshift, fifth gear only, could have an
intermittent short in the OSS or TSS sensor.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. If any DTCs related to OSS or TSS are present, check the transaxle build date following
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
a. If the build date is before 10/21/2007 go to Step 2.
b. If vehicle transaxle is built on or after 10/21/2007 do not continue with this TSB and follow
normal WSM, Section 307-01 Automatic Transaxle/Transmission-6F50 Diagnosis and Testing.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Transmission Speed Sensor: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's > Page 5944
2. To repair an OSS or TSS DTC refer to WSM, Section 307-01, follow pin point test (PPT) C. The
TSS sensor is located in the end cover assembly (Figure 1). The OSS sensor is located inside the
transaxle under the main Control (Figure 2). Both sensor connectors are plugged into the solenoid
body. Both sensor connectors look the same but are wired differently (Figure 3).
3. If you work through PPT C and get to Step C9 before finding the cause of the concern, replace
the sensor (DO NOT REPLACE THE POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) AT THIS TIME).
Reassemble as needed and verify the concern is fixed.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT:
Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits are
determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Transmission Speed Sensor: > 07-21-11 > Oct > 07 > A/T Harsh Engagement/No Shift/Multiple DTC's > Page 5945
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT072111 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING BASIC PART NO.
CONDITION
7M101 CODE
42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5948
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5949
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5950
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5951
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5952
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5953
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5954
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5955
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5956
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5957
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5958
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5959
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5960
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5961
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5962
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5963
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5964
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor
Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5967
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5968
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5969
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle side cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5970
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5971
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
22. Remove the 10 bolts, the detent spring and the main control valve body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5972
23. Remove the bolt and the TSS sensor.
Installation
1. Route the TSS sensor wiring harness through the cover and the transaxle case.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5973
2. Install the TSS sensor in the cover and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
3. NOTE: Make sure that the manual lever pin (part of the TR sensor) is correctly installed in the
manual valve.
Position the TSS, OSS and TR sensor wiring harnesses aside and install the main control valve
body, the TR sensor detent spring and the 10 bolts. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown. ^
Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5974
4. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
5. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3
80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5975
6. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
7. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5976
8. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
9. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
10. Inspect the transaxle side cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
11. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on
the inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle side cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5977
12. Tighten the main control cover bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
13. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5978
14. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
15. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
16. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5979
17. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
18. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
19. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
20. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
21. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5980
22. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
23. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
24. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
25. Connect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness
fastener.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5981
26. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5982
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical
connector and the wiring harness fastener from the air cleaner assembly.
3. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the air cleaner outlet pipe.
4. Disconnect the engine breather from the air cleaner assembly.
5. Remove the air cleaner assembly bracket bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5983
6. Loosen the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body and remove the air cleaner and air
cleaner outlet pipe assembly.
7. Remove the transmission fluid drain plug and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
8. Install the transmission fluid drain plug.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
9. NOTE: The coolant hoses do not need to be removed from the engine.
Remove the coolant hoses from the transmission fluid filler tube and position aside.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5984
10. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the transmission fluid level indicator.
11. NOTE: The coolant hoses have been removed for clarity.
Remove the nut, rotate the transmission fluid filler tube counterclockwise 90 degrees and remove
the transmission fluid filler tube.
12. Loosen the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting from the thermal bypass valve.
13. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bolt and the transmission fluid cooler tube.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5985
14. Inspect the transaxle case to make sure that the transmission fluid cooler tube seal and
backing ring were removed with the transmission fluid
cooler tube and are not stuck in the transaxle case. If the transmission fluid cooler tube seal or
backing ring are stuck in the transaxle case, remove the seal and backing ring.
15. Disconnect the transaxle electrical connector.
16. Remove the 2 nuts, pull the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve straight up and
position it aside.
17. NOTE: Note the location of the of the stud bolts for assembly.
Remove the 14 bolts and the transaxle side cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5986
18. Disconnect the transmission range (TR) sensor electrical connector.
1 Slide the lock over.
2 Press the tab and disconnect the connector.
19. Disconnect the turbine shaft speed (TSS) and output shaft speed (OSS) sensor electrical
connectors.
20. CAUTION: The solenoid body should be handled with care, damage to the solenoid body may
occur.
NOTE: Note the location of the different length bolts for assembly.
Remove the 11 bolts and the solenoid body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5987
21. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when removing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
Remove the solenoid body filter assembly by pulling it straight up from the alignment tabs. Discard
the filter.
22. Remove the 10 bolts, the TR sensor detent spring and the main control valve body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5988
23. Remove the bolt and the OSS sensor.
Installation
1. Install the OSS sensor and the bolt.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
2. NOTE: Make sure that the manual lever pin (part of the TR sensor) is correctly installed in the
manual valve.
Position the TSS, OSS and TR sensor wiring harnesses aside and install the main control valve
body, the TR sensor detent spring and the 10 bolts. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown. ^
Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5989
3. CAUTION: Do not handle the solenoid body in the leadframe area or by the screens of the
solenoid body filter or damage to the solenoid
body can occur.
CAUTION: Use care not to break the alignment tabs when installing the solenoid body filter.
Damage to the transaxle will occur if the solenoid body is not correctly aligned.
CAUTION: Make sure that the filter passage areas are clean of foreign material before installing
the filter. Damage to the transaxle will occur if the filter passages are not clean.
Install a new solenoid body filter assembly by pushing it straight down on to the alignment tabs.
4. CAUTION: Make sure not to pinch the TSS, OSS or TR sensor wiring harnesses when installing
the solenoid body. Damage to the wiring
harness will occur.
NOTE: Install the different length bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the solenoid body and the 11 bolts. 1
42 mm (1.65 inch) bolt
2 63 mm (2.48 inch) bolts
3 80 mm (3.14 inch) bolts
4 95 mm (3.74 inch) bolts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5990
5. Tighten the solenoid body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
6. Route the OSS sensor wiring harness and connect the electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5991
7. Connect the TR sensor electrical connector.
1 Connect the electrical connector.
2 Slide the locking tab over.
8. Connect the TSS sensor electrical connector.
9. Inspect the transaxle side cover seal for damage and install new if necessary.
10. CAUTION: Inspect the 20 pin solenoid body connector seal to make sure that the seals is on
the inside of the main control cover.
Transmission fluid leak will occur.
NOTE: Install the stud bolts in the locations noted during disassembly.
Install the transaxle side cover and install the 14 bolts. 1
Bolt location
2 Studbolt location
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5992
11. Tighten the main control valve body bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs).
12. Position the transmission fluid cooler thermal bypass valve and transmission fluid cooler tube
assembly in place and install the 2 nuts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5993
13. Connect the transaxle electrical connector.
14. Inspect the transmission fluid cooler tube backing ring and seal for damage and install a new
backing ring or seal if necessary. Lubricate the
transmission fluid cooler tube seal with clean automatic transmission fluid and install the backing
ring and seal on the transmission fluid cooler tube.
15. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
16. Tighten the transmission fluid cooler tube fitting.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5994
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
17. Install the fluid filler tube and the nut.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
18. Install the transmission fluid level indicator.
19. Route the coolant hoses in the transmission fluid filler tube.
20. Position the air cleaner assembly in place and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5995
21. Tighten the air cleaner outlet pipe clamp at the throttle body.
^ Tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
22. Connect the engine breather to the air cleaner assembly.
23. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the air cleaner assembly.
24. Connect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector and connect the electrical harness
fastener.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Turbine Shaft Speed (TSS) Sensor > Page 5996
25. Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid to the correct level.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6001
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6002
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6003
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6004
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6005
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6006
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6007
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6008
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6009
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6010
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6011
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6012
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6013
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6014
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6015
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6016
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6017
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Sensor Block >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (Right Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Sensor Block >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6023
C3037
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Sensor Block >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6024
ABS Sensor Block: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
NOTE: When installing a new stability control sensor cluster, the sensor cluster must be calibrated.
Follow the scan tool directions for the calibration procedures.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
2. NOTE: The sensor is located on the RH side of the vehicle, under the rear seat.
Remove the rear seat. For additional information, refer to Seats.
3. Disconnect the stability control sensor cluster electrical connector. 4. Remove the 2 stability
control sensor cluster nuts and the stability control sensor cluster.
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6028
C135
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6029
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to electrical charges. The ABS module can be
damaged if exposed to these charges.
CAUTION: Do not allow any brake fluid or foreign material to enter the mating side of the ABS
module or damage to the solenoids can occur.
1. Remove the hydraulic control unit (HCU). 2. Remove the 4 ABS module screws and the ABS
module.
^ To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
3. NOTE: Visually inspect the ABS module terminals for damage before installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Service and Repair
Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU)
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 6033
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. Remove the air cleaner outlet tube and the air cleaner assembly. For additional information, refer
to Fuel Delivery and Air Induction. 2. Remove the battery and battery tray. For additional
information, refer to Battery. 3. Disconnect the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module electrical
connector. 4. Disconnect the 6 brake tube fittings.
^ To install, tighten the brake master cylinder tubes to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs).
^ To install, tighten the remaining tubes to 22 Nm (16 ft. lbs).
5. Remove the hydraulic control unit (HCU) bracket.
^ To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs).
6. Remove the 3 HCU bracket-to-frame bolts and the HCU.
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
7. Remove the 3 HCU bracket-to-HCU bolts and separate the HCU from the bracket.
^ To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs).
8. NOTE: Make sure the HCU and ABS module are clean and free of any brake fluid or foreign
material before separating the components.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. ^
Bleed the brake system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Service and Repair
Lateral Accelerometer: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
NOTE: When installing a new stability control sensor cluster, the sensor cluster must be calibrated.
Follow the scan tool directions for the calibration procedures.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
2. NOTE: The sensor is located on the RH side of the vehicle, under the rear seat.
Remove the rear seat. For additional information, refer to Seats.
3. Disconnect the stability control sensor cluster electrical connector. 4. Remove the 2 stability
control sensor cluster nuts and the stability control sensor cluster.
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Service and Repair
Steering Angle Sensor: Service and Repair
Steering Wheel Rotation Sensor
Special Tool(s)
Removal
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 6040
1. Remove the clockspring. For additional information, refer to Air Bag Systems. 2. Remove the 2
steering wheel rotation sensor bolts. 3. Disconnect the steering wheel rotation sensor electrical
connector and remove the steering wheel rotation sensor.
Installation
1. If the arrow on the steering wheel rotation sensor ring and the arrow on the sensor housing are
misaligned and/or the straight ahead position of the
sensor is not known, follow these steps to align the sensor prior to installing the sensor: 1
Orient the front wheels in the straight-ahead position.
2 Connect the steering wheel rotation sensor electrical connector.
3 Connect the battery negative cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
4 Carefully rotate the sensor clockwise until it stops.
5 Rotate the sensor counterclockwise 2-1/2 turns.
6 Using the scan tool, read the steering wheel rotation sensor position PID (SWA POS). The PID
should read approximately 0 degrees. If not, repeat the procedure.
7 Disconnect the battery negative cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
8 Disconnect the steering wheel rotation sensor electrical connector.
2. NOTE: Slight rotation of the steering wheel rotation sensor ring is allowed to align the 2 arrows.
Make sure the sensor ring arrow is lined up with the steering wheel rotation sensor housing arrow
as shown and position the sensor into the multi-function switch housing.
3. Connect the steering wheel rotation sensor electrical connector. 4. Remove the 2 steering wheel
rotation sensor bolts.
^ Tighten to 1 Nm (9 inch lbs).
5. Install the clockspring. For additional information, refer to Air Bag Systems.
^ If the steering wheel rotation sensor was aligned using the scan tool, diagnostic trouble codes
(DTCs) will be present in the restrains control module (RCM). Using the scan tool, clear the DTCs
in the RCM.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Traction Control
Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Traction Control
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6044
C2355
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Traction Control
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6045
Traction Control Switch: Service and Repair
Stability/Traction Control Switch
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery. 2. Position the
instrument panel center finish panel away from the instrument panel. 3. Disconnect the
stability/traction control switch electrical connector. 4. Depress the 4 tabs and remove the
stability/traction control switch from the instrument panel center finish panel.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor: > 07-17-2 >
Sep > 07 > ABS/TCS - ABS/ESC Lamps ON/DTC's C1165/C1175/C1235/C1236
Wheel Speed Sensor: Customer Interest ABS/TCS - ABS/ESC Lamps ON/DTC's
C1165/C1175/C1235/C1236
TSB 07-17-2
09/03/07
ABS LAMP ON C1165/C1175 AND/OR C1235/C1236
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge/MKX vehicles built before 6/1/2007 (FWD only) may exhibit an Anti-Lock
Brake System (ABS) warning lamp and/or a Electronic Stability Control (ESC) warning lamp
illuminated with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) C1165/C1175 and/or C1235/C1236. This may be
due to a faulty rear wheel speed sensor.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Verify DTCs C1235/C1236 and/or C1165/C1175 are present. If so, continue on to Step 2. For all
other codes follow normal Workshop Manual diagnostics.
2. With the ignition off, proceed with the replacement of the faulted wheel speed sensor. Refer to
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 206-09.
NOTE
IT IS NOT NECESSARY TO REMOVE THE HARNESS ROUTING BRACKETS WHEN
PERFORMING THE REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE.
3. With a new wheel speed sensor installed, make sure to torque the retaining bolt to 7 N.m (62
lb-in).
4. Clear continuous DTCs.
NOTE
THE ABS SYSTEM CONFIRMS REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL INPUT BASED ON
SEVERAL WHEEL REVOLUTIONS ABOVE 24 KM/H (15 MPH). DRIVE VEHICLE FOR AT LEAST
75 FEET AT OR ABOVE 15 MPH. IF WHEEL SPEED SIGNAL INPUT IS MISSING THE ABS
LIGHT WILL ILLUMINATE.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071702A 2007 Edge/MKX Built 0.5 Hr.
Before 6/1/2007: Check Diagnostic Trouble Codes and Replace One Rear Wheel Speed Sensor
(Do Not Use With 12650D, 2219D, 2219D5)
071702B 2007 Edge/MKX Built 0.7 Hr.
Before 6/1/2007: Check Diagnostic Trouble Codes and Replace Both Rear
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor: > 07-17-2 >
Sep > 07 > ABS/TCS - ABS/ESC Lamps ON/DTC's C1165/C1175/C1235/C1236 > Page 6054
Wheel Speed Sensors (Do Not Use With 12650D, 2219D, 2219D5)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C216 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
07-17-2 > Sep > 07 > ABS/TCS - ABS/ESC Lamps ON/DTC's C1165/C1175/C1235/C1236
Wheel Speed Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS/TCS - ABS/ESC Lamps ON/DTC's
C1165/C1175/C1235/C1236
TSB 07-17-2
09/03/07
ABS LAMP ON C1165/C1175 AND/OR C1235/C1236
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge/MKX vehicles built before 6/1/2007 (FWD only) may exhibit an Anti-Lock
Brake System (ABS) warning lamp and/or a Electronic Stability Control (ESC) warning lamp
illuminated with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) C1165/C1175 and/or C1235/C1236. This may be
due to a faulty rear wheel speed sensor.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Verify DTCs C1235/C1236 and/or C1165/C1175 are present. If so, continue on to Step 2. For all
other codes follow normal Workshop Manual diagnostics.
2. With the ignition off, proceed with the replacement of the faulted wheel speed sensor. Refer to
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 206-09.
NOTE
IT IS NOT NECESSARY TO REMOVE THE HARNESS ROUTING BRACKETS WHEN
PERFORMING THE REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE.
3. With a new wheel speed sensor installed, make sure to torque the retaining bolt to 7 N.m (62
lb-in).
4. Clear continuous DTCs.
NOTE
THE ABS SYSTEM CONFIRMS REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL INPUT BASED ON
SEVERAL WHEEL REVOLUTIONS ABOVE 24 KM/H (15 MPH). DRIVE VEHICLE FOR AT LEAST
75 FEET AT OR ABOVE 15 MPH. IF WHEEL SPEED SIGNAL INPUT IS MISSING THE ABS
LIGHT WILL ILLUMINATE.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071702A 2007 Edge/MKX Built 0.5 Hr.
Before 6/1/2007: Check Diagnostic Trouble Codes and Replace One Rear Wheel Speed Sensor
(Do Not Use With 12650D, 2219D, 2219D5)
071702B 2007 Edge/MKX Built 0.7 Hr.
Before 6/1/2007: Check Diagnostic Trouble Codes and Replace Both Rear
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
07-17-2 > Sep > 07 > ABS/TCS - ABS/ESC Lamps ON/DTC's C1165/C1175/C1235/C1236 > Page 6060
Wheel Speed Sensors (Do Not Use With 12650D, 2219D, 2219D5)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C216 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left Rear
View 151-15 (Right Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left Rear > Page 6063
View 151-15 (Right Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left Rear > Page 6064
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front
C150
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 6067
C440
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 6068
C160
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 6069
C426
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly. 2. Remove the retainers and position the fender splash
shield aside. 3. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector. 4. Disconnect the 6
pushpin fasteners. 5. Remove the front wheel speed sensor bolt and the wheel speed sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front > Page 6072
^ To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 inch lbs).
6. CAUTION: The wheel speed sensor harness must be routed as shown or damage to the
harness during vehicle jounce and rebound can
occur.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front > Page 6073
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery. 2. Remove the
wheel and tire assembly. 3. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector.
4. NOTE: It is not necessary to remove the harness routing brackets.
Disconnect the wheel speed sensor harness from the brackets.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front > Page 6074
5. Disconnect the pushpin fasteners. 6. Remove the wheel speed sensor bolt and the wheel speed
sensor.
^ To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 inch lbs).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Yaw Rate Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Yaw Rate Sensor: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
NOTE: When installing a new stability control sensor cluster, the sensor cluster must be calibrated.
Follow the scan tool directions for the calibration procedures.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
2. NOTE: The sensor is located on the RH side of the vehicle, under the rear seat.
Remove the rear seat. For additional information, refer to Seats.
3. Disconnect the stability control sensor cluster electrical connector. 4. Remove the 2 stability
control sensor cluster nuts and the stability control sensor cluster.
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Master Cylinder
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Master Cylinder
Master Cylinder
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied, or
partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent air from getting into the system.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
1. NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied,
or partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent
air from getting into the system.
Disconnect the brake master cylinder outlet tubes.
2. Install short brake tubes with ends submerged in the brake master cylinder reservoir and fill the
brake master cylinder reservoir with clean,
specified brake fluid.
3. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal until clear fluid flows from both brake tubes without air
bubbles. 4. Remove the short brake tubes and install the brake outlet tubes. 5. Bleed each brake
tube at the brake master cylinder as follows:
1 Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal.
2 Loosen the rearmost brake tube fittings until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have an assistant
maintain pressure on the brake pedal while tightening the brake tube fitting.
3 Repeat this operation until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Master Cylinder > Page 6082
4 Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary. Repeat the bleeding operation at the front
brake tube.
6. While the assistant maintains pressure on the brake pedal, tighten the brake tubes.
^ Tighten to 28 Nm (21 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Master Cylinder > Page 6083
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Brake System Bleeding
Brake System Bleeding
Special Tool(s)
Material
Brake System Bleeding
Pressure
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: This procedure must be carried out if a new anti-lock brake system (ABS) hydraulic control
unit (HCU) has been installed.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or installation of a
new component, air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires
bleeding of the hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can
be bled manually or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: Carrying out the chassis brake bleeding procedure drives trapped air from the otherwise
inaccessible lower section of the HCU valves into the upper sections (accessible by bleeding the
brakes). Subsequent bleeding removes the air from the system.
NOTE: Bleed the longest brake tube or hose first. Be sure the bleeder tank contains enough
specified brake fluid to complete the bleeding operation.
NOTE: Add clean, specified brake fluid as necessary throughout the procedure.
1. If the vehicle is equipped with an ABS, connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) and
scan tool into the vehicle data link connector
(DLC) under the dash and carry out the chassis brake bleeding procedure.
2. Clean all dirt from the master cylinder filler cap, then remove the cap and fill the brake master
cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Master Cylinder > Page 6084
3. NOTE: Master cylinder pressure bleeder adapter tools are available from various manufacturers
of pressure bleeding equipment. Follow the
manufacturer's instructions when installing the adapter.
Install the bleeder adapter to the brake master cylinder reservoir and attach the bleeder tank hose
to the fitting on the adapter.
4. Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber hose
to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and
submerge the free end of the hose in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake fluid.
5. Open the valve on the bleeder tank. 6. Loosen the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Leave
the bleeder screw open until clear, bubble-free brake fluid flows into the container, then
tighten the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and remove the rubber hose. ^
Tighten to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs).
7. Continue bleeding the rest of the system, going in order from the LH rear disc brake caliper to
the RH front disc brake caliper, ending with the LH
front disc brake caliper.
8. Close the bleeder tank valve and remove the tank hose from the adapter and remove the
adapter. 9. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid and install the
cap.
Manual
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Master Cylinder > Page 6085
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: This procedure must be carried out if a new anti-lock brake system (ABS) hydraulic control
unit (HCU) has been installed.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or installation of a
new component, air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires
bleeding of the hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can
be bled manually or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: Carrying out the chassis brake bleeding procedure drives trapped air from the otherwise
inaccessible lower section of the HCU valves into the upper sections (accessible by bleeding the
brakes). Subsequent bleeding removes the air from the system.
NOTE: Add clean, specified brake fluid as necessary throughout the procedure.
1. Clean all dirt from the master cylinder filler cap, then remove the cap and fill the brake master
cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid.
^ Install the master cylinder filler cap.
2. If the vehicle is equipped with an ABS, connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) and
scan tool into the vehicle data link connector
(DLC) under the dash and carry out the chassis brake bleeding procedure.
3. Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber hose
to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and
submerge the free end of the hose in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake fluid.
4. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 5.
Loosen the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
6. Tighten the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs).
7. Repeat Steps 2 through 5 for the LH rear disc brake caliper. 8. Place a box-end wrench on the
RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber hose to the RH front disc brake caliper
bleeder screw
and submerge the free end of the hose in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake
fluid.
9. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal.
10. Loosen the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out.
Have an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
11. Tighten the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Master Cylinder > Page 6086
12. Repeat Steps 7 through 10 for the LH front disc brake caliper.
Gravity
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or installation of a
new component, air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires
bleeding of the hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can
be bled manually or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: Performing the chassis brake bleeding procedure drives trapped air from the otherwise
inaccessible lower section of the HCU valves into the upper sections (accessible by bleeding the
brakes). Subsequent bleeding removes the air from the system.
NOTE: Add clean, specified brake fluid as necessary throughout the procedure.
1. Clean all dirt from the master cylinder filler cap, then remove the cap and fill the brake master
cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid. 2. If the vehicle is equipped with an ABS,
connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) and scan tool into the vehicle data link
connector
(DLC) under the dash and carry out the chassis brake bleeding procedure.
3. Bleed the rear disc brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber hose to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the free end
of the hose in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows into the
container. Repeat for the LH rear disc brake caliper.
4. Tighten the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screws to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs). 5. Bleed the front disc
brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber hose to the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the free end
of the hose in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows. Repeat for the LH front disc brake caliper.
6. Tighten the front disc brake caliper bleeder screws to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Service and Repair
Brake Pedal Assy: Service and Repair
Brake Pedal and Bracket
Brake Pedal and Bracket
CAUTION: Do not remove or loosen the fasteners that hold the 2 brake pedal bracket halves
together. Failure to follow these instructions may result in damage to the brake pedal bracket.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Page 6090
Removal and Installation
1. CAUTION: Always remove the stoplamp switch with the brake pedal secured to the brake
booster push rod and with the brake pedal in
the at-rest position. Do not press or pull on the brake pedal when removing the switch or damage
to switch can occur.
CAUTION: The stoplamp switch must be removed prior to removing the brake pedal and bracket,
brake booster and associated mounting fasteners or damage to the switches can occur.
Remove the stoplamp switch.
2. Remove the instrument panel. For additional information, refer to Dash Board. 3. Remove the
brake booster push rod pin clip and pin, then disconnect the push rod from the brake pedal arm. 4.
Remove the 4 brake pedal bracket nuts.
To install, tighten to 22 Nm (16 ft. lbs).
5. Lift the brake pedal and bracket off of the hangers and remove the brake pedal and bracket.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Caliper Removal and Installation, Front
Brake Caliper
Material
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly. 2. Remove the brake caliper flow bolt and position the
hose aside.
^ Discard the 2 copper washers.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6096
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
3. NOTE: The guide pin bolts are different sizes. The longer/bigger bolt is the upper guide pin bolt.
Remove the 2 brake caliper guide pin bolts. ^
To install, tighten to 88 Nm (65 ft. lbs).
4. Remove the brake caliper.
5. NOTE: During installation, make sure that the brake caliper hose is not twisted.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. ^
Bleed the brake system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6097
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Caliper Removal and Installation, Rear
Brake Caliper
Material
Removal
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly. 2. Remove the brake caliper flow bolt and position the
brake hose aside.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6098
^ Discard the 2 copper washers.
3. Remove the 2 brake caliper guide bolts and the brake caliper.
^ If a leaking or damaged caliper piston boot is found, install a new disc brake caliper.
Installation
1. CAUTION: Make sure that the caliper guide pin boots are fully seated or damage to the caliper
guide pin boots can occur.
NOTE: Make sure that the brake caliper hose is not twisted during caliper installation.
Position the brake caliper onto the anchor plate and brake pads.
2. Install the 2 brake caliper guide pin bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 26 Nm (19 ft. lbs).
3. Using 2 new copper washers, position the brake hose and install the brake caliper flow bolt.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
4. Install the wheel and tire assembly. 5. Bleed the brake system. 6. Test the brakes for normal
operation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6099
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Brake Caliper Anchor Plate, Front
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate
Removal and Installation
1. Check the brake fluid level in the brake master cylinder reservoir.
^ If required, remove the fluid until the brake master cylinder reservoir is 1/2 full.
2. Remove the wheel and tire assembly.
3. CAUTION: Do not pry in the caliper sight hole to retract the pistons as this can damage the
pistons and boots.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
occur.
Remove the 2 brake caliper guide pin bolts and position the caliper aside. ^
Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 88 Nm (65 ft. lbs).
4. Remove the brake pads, brake pad shims and stainless steel shims. 5. Remove the brake pad
slides. 6. Remove the 2 brake caliper anchor plate bolts and the anchor plate.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6100
^ To install, tighten to 133 Nm (98 ft. lbs).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6101
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Brake Caliper Anchor Plate, Rear
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly.
2. CAUTION: Do not pry in the caliper sight hole to retract the pistons, as this can damage the
pistons and boots.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
occur.
Remove the 2 brake caliper guide pin bolts and position the caliper aside. ^
Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 26 Nm (19 ft. lbs).
3. Remove the 2 brake pads, shims and slide clips. Inspect the brake pads for wear or
contamination. 4. Remove the 2 brake caliper anchor plate bolts and the anchor plate.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs).
5. NOTE: Make sure that the brake caliper hose is not twisted during caliper installation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6102
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
6. Test the brakes for normal operation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6103
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Brake Caliper Support Plate
Brake Caliper Support Plate
Brake Caliper Support Plate
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the brake disc shield. 2. Remove the 2 parking brake cable-to-support plate bolts,
disconnect the parking brake cable from the lever and position the cable aside.
^ To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs).
3. Remove the 2 dust boot shield bolts and the dust shield.
^ To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
4. Remove the dust boot. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Specifications
Brake Pad: Specifications
Front Brake Pads
Minimum thickness...............................................................................................................................
............................................... 3.0 mm (0.118 inch) Maximum thickness variation
(pad-to-pad).........................................................................................................................................
2.0 mm (0.079 inch) Maximum taper wear (in any
direction)...............................................................................................................................................
3.0 mm (0.118 inch)
Rear Brake Pads
Minimum thickness...............................................................................................................................
............................................... 3.0 mm (0.118 inch) Maximum thickness variation
(pad-to-pad).........................................................................................................................................
2.0 mm (0.079 inch) Maximum taper wear (in any
direction)...............................................................................................................................................
3.0 mm (0.118 inch)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front
Brake Pad: Service and Repair Front
Brake Pads
Material
Removal
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 brake fluid will cause permanent damage to
brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these instructions may
result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. Check the brake fluid level in the brake master cylinder reservoir.
^ If required, remove the fluid until the brake master cylinder reservoir is 1/2 full.
2. Remove the wheel and tire assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 6109
3. CAUTION: Do not pry in the caliper sight hole to retract the pistons as this can damage the
pistons and boots.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
occur.
Remove the 2 brake caliper guide pin bolts and position the caliper aside. ^
Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
4. Remove the brake pads, brake pad shims and stainless steel shims.
^ Inspect the brake pads and shims for wear or contamination.
5. Remove the brake pad slides.
Installation
1. CAUTION: Protect the caliper piston and boots when pushing the caliper piston into the bores.
CAUTION: Make sure that the caliper guide pin boots are fully seated or damage to the caliper
guide pin boots can occur.
If installing new brake pads, using a suitable tool and a worn brake, compress the disc brake
caliper pistons into the caliper.
2. Install the brake pad slides. 3. Apply a thin coating of the supplied grease to the shims and the
shim contact area of the brake pads. 4. Install the stainless steel shims to the brake pads.
5. NOTE: The guide pin bolts are different sizes. The longer/bigger bolt is the upper guide pin bolt.
Position the brake caliper and install the 2 guide pin bolts. ^
Tighten to 88 Nm (65 ft. lbs).
6. Install the wheel and tire assembly. 7. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with clean,
specified brake fluid. 8. Test the brakes for normal operation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 6110
Brake Pad: Service and Repair Rear
Brake Pads
Material
Removal
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 brake fluid will cause permanent damage to
brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these instructions may
result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. Check the brake fluid level in the brake master cylinder reservoir.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 6111
^ If required, remove the fluid until the brake master cylinder reservoir is 1/2 full.
2. Remove the wheel and tire assembly.
3. CAUTION: Do not pry in the caliper sight hole to retract the pistons, as this can damage the
pistons and boots.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
occur.
Remove the 2 brake caliper guide pin bolts and position the caliper aside. ^
Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
4. CAUTION: Install new brake pads if they are worn past the specified thickness above the metal
backing plates. Install new brake pads in
complete axle sets.
Remove the 2 brake pads, shims and slide clips. Inspect the brake pads and shims for wear,
damage or contamination. ^
Discard the slide clips.
Installation
1. CAUTION: Protect the caliper piston and boots when pushing the caliper piston into the bores.
NOTE: Make sure the caliper piston boot is clean and free of foreign material.
If installing new brake pads, using a suitable tool and a worn brake pad, compress the disc brake
caliper pistons into the caliper.
2. Install the 2 brake pads, shims and new slide clips to the brake caliper anchor plate.
3. CAUTION: Make sure that the caliper guide pin boots are fully seated or damage to the caliper
guide pin boots can occur.
NOTE: Make sure that the brake caliper hose is not twisted during caliper installation.
Position the brake caliper on the anchor plate and install the 2 guide pin bolts. ^
Tighten to 26 Nm (19 ft. lbs).
4. Install the wheel and tire assembly. 5. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with clean,
specified brake fluid. 6. Test the brakes for normal operation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Specifications
Brake Rotor/Disc: Specifications
Front Brake Disc
New disc thickness...............................................................................................................................
................................................... 28 mm (1.10 inch) Minimum thickness.............................................
.................................................................................................................................... 26 mm (1.02
inch) Minimum thickness to machine....................................................................................................
....................................................... 27.1 mm (1.07 inch)
Rear Brake Disc
New disc thickness...............................................................................................................................
................................................... 18 mm (0.70 inch) Minimum thickness.............................................
.................................................................................................................................... 16 mm (0.63
inch) Minimum thickness to machine....................................................................................................
....................................................... 17.1 mm (0.67 inch)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures
Brake Rotor/Disc: Procedures
Brake Disc Machining
Material
NOTE: Do not use a bench lathe to machine the brake discs.
NOTE: Read the entire operating manual and view the video shipped with the lathe before
installing, operating or repairing the lathe.
NOTE: If the thickness of the brake disc is less than the minimum thickness to machine
specification, install a new brake disc. This will make sure that the brake disc will be above
minimum thickness after machining.
NOTE: Do not machine new brake discs.
NOTE: Lateral runout and disc thickness variation measurements are not required because correct
adjustment of the on-vehicle brake lathe will make sure that these dimensions are within
specifications.
1. NOTE: It is not necessary to disconnect the brake tube from the brake caliper.
Position the brake caliper and brake caliper anchor bracket aside.
2. For vehicles with a 2-piece brake disc and hub assembly:
1 Mark the brake disc and the wheel stud for correct indexing during re-assembly.
2 Remove the brake disc from the hub.
3 CAUTION: Do not use an abrasive sanding disc since it will remove paint or other protective
finishes from the wheel or metal from the mounting surfaces, adversely affecting corrosion
protection and brake disc lateral runout.
Remove corrosion from the wheel mounting surface, both disc mounting surfaces and hub
mounting surface.
4 Align the match marks and install the brake disc on the hub.
3. Machine the brake disc using an on-vehicle brake lathe.
1 Install the hub adapter and silencer belt if necessary.
2 Install the cutting lathe.
3 If the lathe is not self adjusting, adjust the lathe oscillation using a dial indicator. Total indicated
reading (TIR) target is 0.000 mm (0.000 inch), maximum is 0.08 mm (0.003 inch).
4 Center the cutting head, adjust the cutting bits and install the chip deflector.
5 NOTE: The depth of cut should be between 0.10 and 0.20 mm (0.004 and 0.008 inch). Lighter
cuts will cause the bit to heat up and wear faster. Heavier cuts will cause poor brake disc surface
finish.
Machine the brake disc.
6 Remove the lathe and, if installed, the silencer belt.
7 Remove the hub adapter.
4. Remove the metal shavings. 5. For vehicles with a 2-piece brake disc and hub assembly:
1 Remove the brake disc from the hub.
2 Remove metal shavings from the hub, the brake disc mounting surfaces and from the ABS
sensors.
3 Apply anti-seize lubricant to the hub mounting surface to prevent corrosion.
4 Align the match marks and install the brake disc on the hub.
6. NOTE: It is not required to install new brake pads if friction material properties are within
guidelines.
Install the brake caliper and brake caliper anchor bracket.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6117
Brake Rotor/Disc: Removal and Replacement
Disc Removal and Installation, Front
Brake Disc
Material
Removal
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly.
2. CAUTION: Do not allow the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly to hang from the brake
hose or damage to the hose can occur.
Remove the brake caliper anchor plate bolts and position the brake caliper and anchor plate
assembly aside. ^
Support the caliper and anchor plate assembly using mechanic's wire.
3. Remove the brake disc.
Installation
1. Clean and dry the brake disc-to-wheel hub mounting surface and apply a thin coat of anti-seize
where indicated.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6118
2. NOTE: Make sure the brake disc is clean and free of any foreign material.
Install the brake disc.
3. Position the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly and install the brake caliper anchor plate
bolts.
^ Tighten to 133 Nm (98 ft. lbs).
4. Install the wheel and tire assembly.
Disc Removal and Installation, Rear
Brake Disc
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6119
Removal
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly.
2. CAUTION: Do not allow the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly to hang from the brake
hose or damage to the hose can occur.
Remove the 2 brake caliper anchor plate bolts and position the brake caliper and anchor plate
assembly aside. ^
Support the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly using mechanic's wire.
3. Remove the brake disc.
Installation
1. Clean and dry the brake disc-to-hub mounting surface and apply a thin coat of anti-seize
lubricant where indicated.
2. Install the brake disc onto the wheel hub. 3. Position the brake caliper and anchor plate
assembly and install the 2 brake caliper anchor plate bolts.
^ Tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs).
4. Install the wheel and tire assembly. 5. Test the brakes for normal operation.
Shield Removal and Installation, Front
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6120
Brake Disc Shield
Brake Disc Shield
Removal
1. Remove the wheel bearing and wheel hub. 2. Index-mark the brake disc shield to the wheel
knuckle, then align the new brake disc shield to the existing shield and transfer the index mark.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6121
3. Cut the brake disc shield and remove it from the wheel knuckle.
Installation
1. Position the brake disc shield onto the wheel knuckle. 2. Align the index marks and install the
brake disc shield onto the wheel knuckle. 3. Install the wheel bearing and wheel hub.
Shield Removal and Installation, Rear
Brake Disc Shield
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6122
Brake Disc Shield
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the wheel hub. 2. Remove the parking brake shoe return spring bracket bolt and
bracket.
^ To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
3. Remove the brake disc shield. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Master Cylinder
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Master Cylinder
Master Cylinder
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied, or
partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent air from getting into the system.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
1. NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied,
or partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent
air from getting into the system.
Disconnect the brake master cylinder outlet tubes.
2. Install short brake tubes with ends submerged in the brake master cylinder reservoir and fill the
brake master cylinder reservoir with clean,
specified brake fluid.
3. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal until clear fluid flows from both brake tubes without air
bubbles. 4. Remove the short brake tubes and install the brake outlet tubes. 5. Bleed each brake
tube at the brake master cylinder as follows:
1 Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal.
2 Loosen the rearmost brake tube fittings until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have an assistant
maintain pressure on the brake pedal while tightening the brake tube fitting.
3 Repeat this operation until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Master Cylinder > Page 6128
4 Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary. Repeat the bleeding operation at the front
brake tube.
6. While the assistant maintains pressure on the brake pedal, tighten the brake tubes.
^ Tighten to 28 Nm (21 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Master Cylinder > Page 6129
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Brake System Bleeding
Brake System Bleeding
Special Tool(s)
Material
Brake System Bleeding
Pressure
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: This procedure must be carried out if a new anti-lock brake system (ABS) hydraulic control
unit (HCU) has been installed.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or installation of a
new component, air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires
bleeding of the hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can
be bled manually or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: Carrying out the chassis brake bleeding procedure drives trapped air from the otherwise
inaccessible lower section of the HCU valves into the upper sections (accessible by bleeding the
brakes). Subsequent bleeding removes the air from the system.
NOTE: Bleed the longest brake tube or hose first. Be sure the bleeder tank contains enough
specified brake fluid to complete the bleeding operation.
NOTE: Add clean, specified brake fluid as necessary throughout the procedure.
1. If the vehicle is equipped with an ABS, connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) and
scan tool into the vehicle data link connector
(DLC) under the dash and carry out the chassis brake bleeding procedure.
2. Clean all dirt from the master cylinder filler cap, then remove the cap and fill the brake master
cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Master Cylinder > Page 6130
3. NOTE: Master cylinder pressure bleeder adapter tools are available from various manufacturers
of pressure bleeding equipment. Follow the
manufacturer's instructions when installing the adapter.
Install the bleeder adapter to the brake master cylinder reservoir and attach the bleeder tank hose
to the fitting on the adapter.
4. Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber hose
to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and
submerge the free end of the hose in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake fluid.
5. Open the valve on the bleeder tank. 6. Loosen the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Leave
the bleeder screw open until clear, bubble-free brake fluid flows into the container, then
tighten the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and remove the rubber hose. ^
Tighten to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs).
7. Continue bleeding the rest of the system, going in order from the LH rear disc brake caliper to
the RH front disc brake caliper, ending with the LH
front disc brake caliper.
8. Close the bleeder tank valve and remove the tank hose from the adapter and remove the
adapter. 9. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid and install the
cap.
Manual
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Master Cylinder > Page 6131
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: This procedure must be carried out if a new anti-lock brake system (ABS) hydraulic control
unit (HCU) has been installed.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or installation of a
new component, air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires
bleeding of the hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can
be bled manually or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: Carrying out the chassis brake bleeding procedure drives trapped air from the otherwise
inaccessible lower section of the HCU valves into the upper sections (accessible by bleeding the
brakes). Subsequent bleeding removes the air from the system.
NOTE: Add clean, specified brake fluid as necessary throughout the procedure.
1. Clean all dirt from the master cylinder filler cap, then remove the cap and fill the brake master
cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid.
^ Install the master cylinder filler cap.
2. If the vehicle is equipped with an ABS, connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) and
scan tool into the vehicle data link connector
(DLC) under the dash and carry out the chassis brake bleeding procedure.
3. Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber hose
to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and
submerge the free end of the hose in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake fluid.
4. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 5.
Loosen the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
6. Tighten the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs).
7. Repeat Steps 2 through 5 for the LH rear disc brake caliper. 8. Place a box-end wrench on the
RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber hose to the RH front disc brake caliper
bleeder screw
and submerge the free end of the hose in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake
fluid.
9. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal.
10. Loosen the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out.
Have an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
11. Tighten the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Master Cylinder > Page 6132
12. Repeat Steps 7 through 10 for the LH front disc brake caliper.
Gravity
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or installation of a
new component, air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires
bleeding of the hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can
be bled manually or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: Performing the chassis brake bleeding procedure drives trapped air from the otherwise
inaccessible lower section of the HCU valves into the upper sections (accessible by bleeding the
brakes). Subsequent bleeding removes the air from the system.
NOTE: Add clean, specified brake fluid as necessary throughout the procedure.
1. Clean all dirt from the master cylinder filler cap, then remove the cap and fill the brake master
cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid. 2. If the vehicle is equipped with an ABS,
connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) and scan tool into the vehicle data link
connector
(DLC) under the dash and carry out the chassis brake bleeding procedure.
3. Bleed the rear disc brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber hose to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the free end
of the hose in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows into the
container. Repeat for the LH rear disc brake caliper.
4. Tighten the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screws to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs). 5. Bleed the front disc
brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber hose to the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the free end
of the hose in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows. Repeat for the LH front disc brake caliper.
6. Tighten the front disc brake caliper bleeder screws to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Caliper Removal and Installation, Front
Brake Caliper
Material
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly. 2. Remove the brake caliper flow bolt and position the
hose aside.
^ Discard the 2 copper washers.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6137
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
3. NOTE: The guide pin bolts are different sizes. The longer/bigger bolt is the upper guide pin bolt.
Remove the 2 brake caliper guide pin bolts. ^
To install, tighten to 88 Nm (65 ft. lbs).
4. Remove the brake caliper.
5. NOTE: During installation, make sure that the brake caliper hose is not twisted.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. ^
Bleed the brake system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6138
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Caliper Removal and Installation, Rear
Brake Caliper
Material
Removal
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly. 2. Remove the brake caliper flow bolt and position the
brake hose aside.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6139
^ Discard the 2 copper washers.
3. Remove the 2 brake caliper guide bolts and the brake caliper.
^ If a leaking or damaged caliper piston boot is found, install a new disc brake caliper.
Installation
1. CAUTION: Make sure that the caliper guide pin boots are fully seated or damage to the caliper
guide pin boots can occur.
NOTE: Make sure that the brake caliper hose is not twisted during caliper installation.
Position the brake caliper onto the anchor plate and brake pads.
2. Install the 2 brake caliper guide pin bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 26 Nm (19 ft. lbs).
3. Using 2 new copper washers, position the brake hose and install the brake caliper flow bolt.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
4. Install the wheel and tire assembly. 5. Bleed the brake system. 6. Test the brakes for normal
operation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6140
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Brake Caliper Anchor Plate, Front
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate
Removal and Installation
1. Check the brake fluid level in the brake master cylinder reservoir.
^ If required, remove the fluid until the brake master cylinder reservoir is 1/2 full.
2. Remove the wheel and tire assembly.
3. CAUTION: Do not pry in the caliper sight hole to retract the pistons as this can damage the
pistons and boots.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
occur.
Remove the 2 brake caliper guide pin bolts and position the caliper aside. ^
Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 88 Nm (65 ft. lbs).
4. Remove the brake pads, brake pad shims and stainless steel shims. 5. Remove the brake pad
slides. 6. Remove the 2 brake caliper anchor plate bolts and the anchor plate.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6141
^ To install, tighten to 133 Nm (98 ft. lbs).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6142
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Brake Caliper Anchor Plate, Rear
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly.
2. CAUTION: Do not pry in the caliper sight hole to retract the pistons, as this can damage the
pistons and boots.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
occur.
Remove the 2 brake caliper guide pin bolts and position the caliper aside. ^
Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 26 Nm (19 ft. lbs).
3. Remove the 2 brake pads, shims and slide clips. Inspect the brake pads for wear or
contamination. 4. Remove the 2 brake caliper anchor plate bolts and the anchor plate.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs).
5. NOTE: Make sure that the brake caliper hose is not twisted during caliper installation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6143
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
6. Test the brakes for normal operation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6144
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Brake Caliper Support Plate
Brake Caliper Support Plate
Brake Caliper Support Plate
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the brake disc shield. 2. Remove the 2 parking brake cable-to-support plate bolts,
disconnect the parking brake cable from the lever and position the cable aside.
^ To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs).
3. Remove the 2 dust boot shield bolts and the dust shield.
^ To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs).
4. Remove the dust boot. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid > Component Information
> Specifications
Brake Fluid: Specifications
BRAKE FLUID
Motorcraft High Performance DOT 3 Motor Vehicle Brake Fluid
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
................................................................... PM-1-C Ford Specification ..............................................
.......................................................................................................................................
WSS-M6C62-A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6151
C124
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock
Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Service and Repair
Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU)
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock
Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 6155
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. Remove the air cleaner outlet tube and the air cleaner assembly. For additional information, refer
to Fuel Delivery and Air Induction. 2. Remove the battery and battery tray. For additional
information, refer to Battery. 3. Disconnect the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module electrical
connector. 4. Disconnect the 6 brake tube fittings.
^ To install, tighten the brake master cylinder tubes to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs).
^ To install, tighten the remaining tubes to 22 Nm (16 ft. lbs).
5. Remove the hydraulic control unit (HCU) bracket.
^ To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs).
6. Remove the 3 HCU bracket-to-frame bolts and the HCU.
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
7. Remove the 3 HCU bracket-to-HCU bolts and separate the HCU from the bracket.
^ To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs).
8. NOTE: Make sure the HCU and ABS module are clean and free of any brake fluid or foreign
material before separating the components.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. ^
Bleed the brake system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection
Brake Master Cylinder: Testing and Inspection
Brake Master Cylinder Tests
Bypass Condition
1. Check the brake hydraulic system for leaks or insufficient brake fluid. Repair as necessary. 2.
Observe the brake fluid level in the brake master cylinder reservoir while the brake pedal is slowly
applied and released. If the brake fluid level
drops when the brake pedal is applied and rises when the brake pedal is released, but the net
brake fluid level remains unchanged, the brake master cylinder is bypassing. Repair or install a
new brake master cylinder.
Non-Pressure External Leaks
A low brake fluid level in the brake master cylinder reservoir may be caused by these non-pressure
external leaks:
Type 1: An external leak may exist at the brake master cylinder filler cap due to incorrect position of
the cap, cap gasket or cap gasket deterioration. Repair or install new components as necessary.
Type 2: An external leak may exist at the brake master cylinder mounting flange due to internal
seal failure. Repair or install a new brake master cylinder.
Type 3: An external leak may exist at the base of the brake master cylinder reservoir due to
deteriorated reservoir mounting seals. Repair or install a new brake master cylinder.
Compensator Port
The purpose of the compensator ports in the brake master cylinder is to: ^
supply additional brake fluid from the brake master cylinder reservoir needed by the brake system
due to brake lining wear.
^ allow brake fluid to return to the brake master cylinder reservoir when the brakes are released.
The returning brake fluid creates a slight turbulence in the brake master cylinder reservoir. This is a
normal condition and indicates that the compensator ports are not clogged.
Clogged compensator ports may cause the brakes to hang up or not fully release. If clogged
compensator ports are suspected, proceed as follows: 1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it
on a hoist. Refer to Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. With the brakes released, attempt to rotate
each wheel. If an excessive amount of brake drag exists, continue with the test. If an excessive
amount
of brake drag exists at only one wheel, it indicates a possible seized brake disc caliper or parking
brake component. Repair or install new components as necessary.
3. Check the brake stoplamp switch adjustment and the brake pedal free play to verify that the
brake pedal is not partially applied. 4. Loosen the nuts attaching the brake master cylinder to the
power brake booster and pull the brake master cylinder away from the power brake
booster.
5. Repeat Steps 1 and 2. If the brake drag disappears, the power brake booster is binding and a
new one must be installed. If the brake drag
continues, the brake master cylinder is binding and a new one must be installed.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Brake Master Cylinder: Procedures
Master Cylinder
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied, or
partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent air from getting into the system.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
1. NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied,
or partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent
air from getting into the system.
Disconnect the brake master cylinder outlet tubes.
2. Install short brake tubes with ends submerged in the brake master cylinder reservoir and fill the
brake master cylinder reservoir with clean,
specified brake fluid.
3. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal until clear fluid flows from both brake tubes without air
bubbles. 4. Remove the short brake tubes and install the brake outlet tubes. 5. Bleed each brake
tube at the brake master cylinder as follows:
1 Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal.
2 Loosen the rearmost brake tube fittings until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have an assistant
maintain pressure on the brake pedal while tightening the brake tube fitting.
3 Repeat this operation until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
4 Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary. Repeat the bleeding operation at the front
brake tube.
6. While the assistant maintains pressure on the brake pedal, tighten the brake tubes.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6161
^ Tighten to 28 Nm (21 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6162
Brake Master Cylinder: Removal and Replacement
Brake Master Cylinder
Material
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. Remove the air cleaner and air cleaner outlet tube. For additional information, refer to Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction. 2. Remove the battery and battery tray. For additional information, refer
to Battery. 3. Disconnect the brake fluid level switch electrical connector. 4. Using a suitable
suction device, remove the brake fluid from the brake master cylinder reservoir.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6163
5. Disconnect the master cylinder brake tube fittings, plug the brake tubes and the brake master
cylinder ports.
^ To install, tighten to 28 Nm (21 ft. lbs).
6. Remove the 2 brake master cylinder nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
7. Remove the brake master cylinder and reservoir. 8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Bleed the master cylinder and brake system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Parking Brake Cable: > 07-11-9 > Jun > 07 > Brakes - IVD
Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging
Parking Brake Cable: Customer Interest Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging
TSB 07-11-9
06/11/07
BRAKE DRAG
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some Edge/MKX vehicles may exhibit brake drag from the rear wheels or all wheels.
Customers may notice an odor and/or reduced powertrain performance. In some cases, the driver
may also note an integral vehicle dynamics (IVD) light after driving a given distance due to
pressure noted in the module without a change in brake on/off (BOO) state.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure to resolve brake drag concerns.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Raise the vehicle on a hoist, with engine running, and vehicle in park. Rotate all of the wheels by
hand to verify excessive force is necessary to turn wheels.
^ To resolve the brake drag concern from all wheels - Replacement of the BOO switch is
necessary.
^ To resolve the brake drag concern from the rear wheels only - Adjustment of the park brake
cables are necessary.
BOO Switch Replacement (All Brakes Drag) Removal
1. With the vehicle shut off and in park, remove the stop lamp switch by rotating the stop lamp
switch in the clockwise direction.
2. If the brake pedal moves up during the removal of the switch, the pedal was being inadvertently
held down by the stop lamp switch thus keeping the hydraulic circuits pressurized. Refer to
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 417-01.
3. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the switch and discard the switch.
Installation
NOTE
INSTALLATION OF THE NEW STOP LAMP SWITCH MUST BE DONE WITH THE BRAKE
PEDAL AT ITS NORMALLY INSTALLED AND RESTING POSITION. DO NOT PULL UP OR
PUSH DOWN ON THE BRAKE PEDAL DURING STOP LAMP SWITCH INSTALLATION. REFER
TO WSM, Section 417-01.
1. With the brake pedal at its rest position, insert the new stop lamp switch into the keyed hole on
the brake pedal and rotate the switch 45 degrees counter-clockwise to seat the switch. You may
hear a click sound during this step, this is normal.
2. Plug the wire harness connector to the new stop lamp switch.
3. Verify that the brake lamps are functioning properly and that the brakes are no longer dragging.
Park Cable Adjustment (Rear Brakes Drag)
Brake drag noted on rear wheels only likely caused by over adjusted park brake equalizer
adjustment (or all 3 cable lengths built at the minimum levels).
1. With vehicle on Hoist and shut off, verify rear brake pads are positioned properly per WSM,
Section 206-04: Rear Disc Brake.
2. With a fully released parking brake pedal, back off the adjustment until the wheels spin freely.
NOTE
DISTANCE BETWEEN THE NUT AND END OF THE STUD SHOULD BE 7/8" (22 mm)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Parking Brake Cable: > 07-11-9 > Jun > 07 > Brakes - IVD
Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging > Page 6173
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071109A 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.4 Hr.
Diagnose, Replace BOO Switch (Do Not Use With 13480A)
071109B 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.4 Hr.
Diagnose, Adjust Park Brake (Do Not Use With 2780B)
071109C 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.5 Hr.
Diagnose, Replace BOO Switch, And Adjust Park Brake (Do Not Use With 13480A, 2780B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
13480 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Parking Brake Cable: > 07-11-9 > Jun > 07 >
Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging
Parking Brake Cable: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging
TSB 07-11-9
06/11/07
BRAKE DRAG
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some Edge/MKX vehicles may exhibit brake drag from the rear wheels or all wheels.
Customers may notice an odor and/or reduced powertrain performance. In some cases, the driver
may also note an integral vehicle dynamics (IVD) light after driving a given distance due to
pressure noted in the module without a change in brake on/off (BOO) state.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure to resolve brake drag concerns.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Raise the vehicle on a hoist, with engine running, and vehicle in park. Rotate all of the wheels by
hand to verify excessive force is necessary to turn wheels.
^ To resolve the brake drag concern from all wheels - Replacement of the BOO switch is
necessary.
^ To resolve the brake drag concern from the rear wheels only - Adjustment of the park brake
cables are necessary.
BOO Switch Replacement (All Brakes Drag) Removal
1. With the vehicle shut off and in park, remove the stop lamp switch by rotating the stop lamp
switch in the clockwise direction.
2. If the brake pedal moves up during the removal of the switch, the pedal was being inadvertently
held down by the stop lamp switch thus keeping the hydraulic circuits pressurized. Refer to
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 417-01.
3. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the switch and discard the switch.
Installation
NOTE
INSTALLATION OF THE NEW STOP LAMP SWITCH MUST BE DONE WITH THE BRAKE
PEDAL AT ITS NORMALLY INSTALLED AND RESTING POSITION. DO NOT PULL UP OR
PUSH DOWN ON THE BRAKE PEDAL DURING STOP LAMP SWITCH INSTALLATION. REFER
TO WSM, Section 417-01.
1. With the brake pedal at its rest position, insert the new stop lamp switch into the keyed hole on
the brake pedal and rotate the switch 45 degrees counter-clockwise to seat the switch. You may
hear a click sound during this step, this is normal.
2. Plug the wire harness connector to the new stop lamp switch.
3. Verify that the brake lamps are functioning properly and that the brakes are no longer dragging.
Park Cable Adjustment (Rear Brakes Drag)
Brake drag noted on rear wheels only likely caused by over adjusted park brake equalizer
adjustment (or all 3 cable lengths built at the minimum levels).
1. With vehicle on Hoist and shut off, verify rear brake pads are positioned properly per WSM,
Section 206-04: Rear Disc Brake.
2. With a fully released parking brake pedal, back off the adjustment until the wheels spin freely.
NOTE
DISTANCE BETWEEN THE NUT AND END OF THE STUD SHOULD BE 7/8" (22 mm)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Parking Brake Cable: > 07-11-9 > Jun > 07 >
Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging > Page 6179
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071109A 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.4 Hr.
Diagnose, Replace BOO Switch (Do Not Use With 13480A)
071109B 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.4 Hr.
Diagnose, Adjust Park Brake (Do Not Use With 2780B)
071109C 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.5 Hr.
Diagnose, Replace BOO Switch, And Adjust Park Brake (Do Not Use With 13480A, 2780B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
13480 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6180
Parking Brake Cable: Adjustments
Parking Brake Cable Adjustment
NOTE: Cable tension is adjusted in 2 locations, the first location is at the parking brake control, the
second location is at the parking brake cable equalizer. The tension must be adjusted equally at
both locations.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
2. NOTE: The dimension will vary depending on the amount of cable stretch. New cables require
cycling the parking brake control 5-10 times to
remove the cable slack.
Adjust the parking brake control adjustment nut as shown.
3. Adjust the parking brake cable equalizer adjustment nut as shown.
4. Fully apply the parking brake pedal 3 times to verify correct operation of the parking brake
system.
^ With the parking brake cable in the fully released position, brake drag should not be present.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Cable - Rear, LH
Parking Brake Cable: Service and Repair Parking Brake Cable - Rear, LH
Parking Brake Cable - Rear, LH
Parking Brake Cable - Rear, LH (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Cable - Rear, LH > Page 6183
Parking Brake Cable - Rear, LH (Part 2)
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Relieve the tension in the parking brake cable by loosening
the equalizer adjustment nut.
3. Disconnect the LH parking brake cable from the equalizer. 4. Squeeze the tabs and disconnect
the LH parking brake cable from the bracket.
All wheel drive (AWD) vehicles
5. Remove the wheel speed sensor bolt and position the wheel speed sensor aside.
^ To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 inch lbs).
All vehicles
6. Remove the 2 parking brake cable-to-support plate bolts and disconnect the cable from the
lever.
^ To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs).
7. Remove the stabilizer bar link nut and position the stabilizer bar link aside.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs).
8. Remove the parking brake cable front bracket bolt, middle bracket bolt and the parking brake
cable.
^ To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs).
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Adjust the parking brake cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Cable - Rear, LH > Page 6184
Parking Brake Cable: Service and Repair Parking Brake Cable - Rear, RH
Parking Brake Cable - Rear, RH
Parking Brake Cable - Rear, RH (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Cable - Rear, LH > Page 6185
Parking Brake Cable - Rear, RH (Part 2)
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Relieve the tension in the parking brake cable by loosening
the equalizer adjustment nut.
3. Disconnect the RH parking brake cable from the equalizer. 4. Squeeze the tabs and disconnect
the RH parking brake cable from the bracket.
All wheel drive (AWD) vehicles
5. Remove the wheel speed sensor bolt and position the wheel speed sensor aside.
^ To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 inch lbs).
All vehicles
6. Remove the 2 parking brake cable-to-support plate bolts and disconnect the cable from the
lever.
^ To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs).
7. Remove the stabilizer bar link nut and position the stabilizer bar link aside.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs).
8. Remove the 4 parking brake cable bracket bolts and the parking brake cable.
^ To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs).
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Adjust the parking brake cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Cable - Rear, LH > Page 6186
Parking Brake Cable: Service and Repair Parking Brake Cable - Front
Parking Brake Cable - Front
Parking Brake Cable - Front
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove the parking brake cable equalizer adjustment nut and
disconnect the front cable from the equalizer. 3. Remove the LH rear footwell duct. For additional
information, refer to Heating and Air Conditioning. 4. Remove the parking brake control adjustment
nut.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Cable - Rear, LH > Page 6187
5. Remove the front parking brake cable-to-control nut and remove the front parking brake cable
from the control.
^ To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs).
6. Remove the front parking brake cable bracket bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs).
7. Remove the 2 front parking brake cable floor plate bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs).
8. Remove the front parking brake cable. 9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Adjust the parking brake cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Control > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Parking Brake Control: Service and Repair
Parking Brake Control
Parking Brake Control
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the parking brake switch electrical connector. 2. Remove the parking brake control
adjustment nut. 3. Remove the front parking brake cable-to-control nut and position the front cable
aside.
^ To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs).
4. Remove the 3 parking brake control nuts and the parking brake control.
^ To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Adjust the parking brake cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Shoe > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Parking Brake Shoe: Service and Repair
Parking Brake Shoes
Parking Brake Shoes
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear brake disc. 2. Remove the parking brake shoe return spring. 3. Remove the
parking brake shoe. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Check the parking brake for normal operation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Left Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6197
C2015
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6198
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Service and Repair
Parking Brake Warning Indicator Switch
Parking Brake Warning Indicator Switch
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the parking brake warning indicator switch electrical connector. 2. Remove the
parking brake warning indicator switch screw and the switch. 3. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Specifications
Vacuum Brake Booster: Specifications
Torque Specifications
Torque Specifications
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6203
Vacuum Brake Booster: Description and Operation
Brake Booster
The power brake actuation system includes a vacuum assisted brake booster, vacuum check
valve, vacuum hose and aspirator. The vacuum hose delivers engine vacuum to the vacuum check
valve. The vacuum check valve is a one-way valve that allows engine supplied vacuum to the
booster, and closes when engine vacuum is removed. The brake booster utilizes engine vacuum to
reduce the amount of effort required at the brake pedal to actuate the foundation brakes.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6204
Vacuum Brake Booster: Testing and Inspection
Brake Booster
1. Inspect all vacuum hoses and connections. All unused vacuum connections must be capped.
Hoses and their connections must be correctly secured
and in good condition with no holes, cracks or collapsed areas.
2. Check the brake hydraulic system for leaks or insufficient brake fluid. Repair as necessary. 3.
With the engine OFF, place the transaxle in PARK (A/T) or NEUTRAL (M/T) and apply the parking
brake.
4. NOTE: If the power brake booster is noisy when the brakes are applied, a new component must
be installed.
Apply and hold the brake pedal several times to exhaust all of the vacuum reserve from the
system.
5. Apply and hold the brake pedal. 6. Start the engine. If the vacuum system is operating, the brake
pedal will move downward slightly under constant foot pressure. If no movement
occurs, the power brake booster system is not functioning. Turn the engine OFF.
7. Remove the vacuum hose from the power brake booster. 8. Place the transaxle in PARK (A/T)
or NEUTRAL (M/T) and apply the parking brake. Start the engine. Manifold vacuum should be
available from
the vacuum booster hose. If manifold vacuum is not available, inspect all of the hoses and hose
connections. Repair as necessary.
9. Connect the vacuum booster hose and run the engine at fast idle for 10 seconds.
10. Turn OFF the engine and let the vehicle stand for 10 minutes. 11. Apply the brake pedal with
approximately 89 Nm (66 ft. lbs) of force. The brake pedal feel should be the same as normal
power-assisted brake
operation for at least one brake pedal application. If the brake pedal feel is normal, the power brake
booster is OK. If the brake pedal feels hard, continue with the test.
12. Remove the vacuum booster hose from the power brake booster. Apply 57.3 kPa (17 in-Hg) of
vacuum to the vacuum booster hose. If the vacuum
does not leak off after 10 minutes, install a new power brake booster. If the vacuum does leak off,
install a new check valve and/or new vacuum booster hoses.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6205
Vacuum Brake Booster: Service and Repair
Brake Booster
Brake Booster
Removal and Installation
1. CAUTION: Always remove the stop lamp switch with the brake pedal secured to the brake
booster push rod and with the brake pedal in
the at-rest position. Do not press or pull on the brake pedal when removing the switch or damage
to switch can occur.
CAUTION: The stop lamp switch must be removed prior to removing the brake pedal and bracket,
brake booster and associated mounting fasteners or damage to the switch can occur.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6206
Remove the stop lamp switch.
2. CAUTION: The brake booster check valve must be disconnected from the brake booster (prior to
removing the master cylinder) or the
master cylinder seal may be drawn into the brake booster.
Disconnect the brake booster check valve from the brake booster to deplete the residual vacuum in
the brake booster.
3. Remove the brake master cylinder.
4. CAUTION: Make sure that the vacuum hose assembly is routed correctly so it does not make
contact with surrounding components.
Disconnect the manifold vacuum hose assembly from the brake booster.
5. Disconnect the vacuum hose and wire harness from the studs and position aside.
6. Remove the 2 pushpin fasteners and the lower instrument panel cover. 7. Remove the brake
booster push rod pin and clip and disconnect the push rod from the brake pedal. 8. Remove the 4
brake booster nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs).
9. Remove the brake booster.
10. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 11. Check the brake booster for correct operation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster Check Valve >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Vacuum Brake Booster Check Valve: Testing and Inspection
Check Valve
1. Remove the vacuum booster hose from the power brake booster. 2. Apply 57.3 kPa (17 in-Hg) of
vacuum to the vacuum booster hose. If the vacuum does not leak off after 10 minutes, the check
valve is OK.
Otherwise, install a new check valve.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6214
C135
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6215
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to electrical charges. The ABS module can be
damaged if exposed to these charges.
CAUTION: Do not allow any brake fluid or foreign material to enter the mating side of the ABS
module or damage to the solenoids can occur.
1. Remove the hydraulic control unit (HCU). 2. Remove the 4 ABS module screws and the ABS
module.
^ To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 inch lbs).
3. NOTE: Visually inspect the ABS module terminals for damage before installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS
Sensor Block > Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (Right Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS
Sensor Block > Component Information > Locations > Page 6220
C3037
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS
Sensor Block > Component Information > Locations > Page 6221
ABS Sensor Block: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
NOTE: When installing a new stability control sensor cluster, the sensor cluster must be calibrated.
Follow the scan tool directions for the calibration procedures.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
2. NOTE: The sensor is located on the RH side of the vehicle, under the rear seat.
Remove the rear seat. For additional information, refer to Seats.
3. Disconnect the stability control sensor cluster electrical connector. 4. Remove the 2 stability
control sensor cluster nuts and the stability control sensor cluster.
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6225
C124
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Service and Repair
Lateral Accelerometer: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
NOTE: When installing a new stability control sensor cluster, the sensor cluster must be calibrated.
Follow the scan tool directions for the calibration procedures.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
2. NOTE: The sensor is located on the RH side of the vehicle, under the rear seat.
Remove the rear seat. For additional information, refer to Seats.
3. Disconnect the stability control sensor cluster electrical connector. 4. Remove the 2 stability
control sensor cluster nuts and the stability control sensor cluster.
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Left Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6232
C2015
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6233
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Service and Repair
Parking Brake Warning Indicator Switch
Parking Brake Warning Indicator Switch
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the parking brake warning indicator switch electrical connector. 2. Remove the
parking brake warning indicator switch screw and the switch. 3. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering
Angle Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Service and Repair
Steering Angle Sensor: Service and Repair
Steering Wheel Rotation Sensor
Special Tool(s)
Removal
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering
Angle Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 6237
1. Remove the clockspring. For additional information, refer to Air Bag Systems. 2. Remove the 2
steering wheel rotation sensor bolts. 3. Disconnect the steering wheel rotation sensor electrical
connector and remove the steering wheel rotation sensor.
Installation
1. If the arrow on the steering wheel rotation sensor ring and the arrow on the sensor housing are
misaligned and/or the straight ahead position of the
sensor is not known, follow these steps to align the sensor prior to installing the sensor: 1
Orient the front wheels in the straight-ahead position.
2 Connect the steering wheel rotation sensor electrical connector.
3 Connect the battery negative cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
4 Carefully rotate the sensor clockwise until it stops.
5 Rotate the sensor counterclockwise 2-1/2 turns.
6 Using the scan tool, read the steering wheel rotation sensor position PID (SWA POS). The PID
should read approximately 0 degrees. If not, repeat the procedure.
7 Disconnect the battery negative cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
8 Disconnect the steering wheel rotation sensor electrical connector.
2. NOTE: Slight rotation of the steering wheel rotation sensor ring is allowed to align the 2 arrows.
Make sure the sensor ring arrow is lined up with the steering wheel rotation sensor housing arrow
as shown and position the sensor into the multi-function switch housing.
3. Connect the steering wheel rotation sensor electrical connector. 4. Remove the 2 steering wheel
rotation sensor bolts.
^ Tighten to 1 Nm (9 inch lbs).
5. Install the clockspring. For additional information, refer to Air Bag Systems.
^ If the steering wheel rotation sensor was aligned using the scan tool, diagnostic trouble codes
(DTCs) will be present in the restrains control module (RCM). Using the scan tool, clear the DTCs
in the RCM.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction
Control Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction
Control Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6241
C2355
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction
Control Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6242
Traction Control Switch: Service and Repair
Stability/Traction Control Switch
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery. 2. Position the
instrument panel center finish panel away from the instrument panel. 3. Disconnect the
stability/traction control switch electrical connector. 4. Depress the 4 tabs and remove the
stability/traction control switch from the instrument panel center finish panel.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
07-17-2 > Sep > 07 > ABS/TCS - ABS/ESC Lamps ON/DTC's C1165/C1175/C1235/C1236
Wheel Speed Sensor: Customer Interest ABS/TCS - ABS/ESC Lamps ON/DTC's
C1165/C1175/C1235/C1236
TSB 07-17-2
09/03/07
ABS LAMP ON C1165/C1175 AND/OR C1235/C1236
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge/MKX vehicles built before 6/1/2007 (FWD only) may exhibit an Anti-Lock
Brake System (ABS) warning lamp and/or a Electronic Stability Control (ESC) warning lamp
illuminated with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) C1165/C1175 and/or C1235/C1236. This may be
due to a faulty rear wheel speed sensor.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Verify DTCs C1235/C1236 and/or C1165/C1175 are present. If so, continue on to Step 2. For all
other codes follow normal Workshop Manual diagnostics.
2. With the ignition off, proceed with the replacement of the faulted wheel speed sensor. Refer to
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 206-09.
NOTE
IT IS NOT NECESSARY TO REMOVE THE HARNESS ROUTING BRACKETS WHEN
PERFORMING THE REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE.
3. With a new wheel speed sensor installed, make sure to torque the retaining bolt to 7 N.m (62
lb-in).
4. Clear continuous DTCs.
NOTE
THE ABS SYSTEM CONFIRMS REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL INPUT BASED ON
SEVERAL WHEEL REVOLUTIONS ABOVE 24 KM/H (15 MPH). DRIVE VEHICLE FOR AT LEAST
75 FEET AT OR ABOVE 15 MPH. IF WHEEL SPEED SIGNAL INPUT IS MISSING THE ABS
LIGHT WILL ILLUMINATE.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071702A 2007 Edge/MKX Built 0.5 Hr.
Before 6/1/2007: Check Diagnostic Trouble Codes and Replace One Rear Wheel Speed Sensor
(Do Not Use With 12650D, 2219D, 2219D5)
071702B 2007 Edge/MKX Built 0.7 Hr.
Before 6/1/2007: Check Diagnostic Trouble Codes and Replace Both Rear
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
07-17-2 > Sep > 07 > ABS/TCS - ABS/ESC Lamps ON/DTC's C1165/C1175/C1235/C1236 > Page 6251
Wheel Speed Sensors (Do Not Use With 12650D, 2219D, 2219D5)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C216 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed
Sensor: > 07-17-2 > Sep > 07 > ABS/TCS - ABS/ESC Lamps ON/DTC's C1165/C1175/C1235/C1236
Wheel Speed Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS/TCS - ABS/ESC Lamps ON/DTC's
C1165/C1175/C1235/C1236
TSB 07-17-2
09/03/07
ABS LAMP ON C1165/C1175 AND/OR C1235/C1236
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge/MKX vehicles built before 6/1/2007 (FWD only) may exhibit an Anti-Lock
Brake System (ABS) warning lamp and/or a Electronic Stability Control (ESC) warning lamp
illuminated with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) C1165/C1175 and/or C1235/C1236. This may be
due to a faulty rear wheel speed sensor.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Verify DTCs C1235/C1236 and/or C1165/C1175 are present. If so, continue on to Step 2. For all
other codes follow normal Workshop Manual diagnostics.
2. With the ignition off, proceed with the replacement of the faulted wheel speed sensor. Refer to
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 206-09.
NOTE
IT IS NOT NECESSARY TO REMOVE THE HARNESS ROUTING BRACKETS WHEN
PERFORMING THE REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE.
3. With a new wheel speed sensor installed, make sure to torque the retaining bolt to 7 N.m (62
lb-in).
4. Clear continuous DTCs.
NOTE
THE ABS SYSTEM CONFIRMS REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL INPUT BASED ON
SEVERAL WHEEL REVOLUTIONS ABOVE 24 KM/H (15 MPH). DRIVE VEHICLE FOR AT LEAST
75 FEET AT OR ABOVE 15 MPH. IF WHEEL SPEED SIGNAL INPUT IS MISSING THE ABS
LIGHT WILL ILLUMINATE.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071702A 2007 Edge/MKX Built 0.5 Hr.
Before 6/1/2007: Check Diagnostic Trouble Codes and Replace One Rear Wheel Speed Sensor
(Do Not Use With 12650D, 2219D, 2219D5)
071702B 2007 Edge/MKX Built 0.7 Hr.
Before 6/1/2007: Check Diagnostic Trouble Codes and Replace Both Rear
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed
Sensor: > 07-17-2 > Sep > 07 > ABS/TCS - ABS/ESC Lamps ON/DTC's C1165/C1175/C1235/C1236 > Page 6257
Wheel Speed Sensors (Do Not Use With 12650D, 2219D, 2219D5)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C216 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left Rear
View 151-15 (Right Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left Rear > Page 6260
View 151-15 (Right Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left Rear > Page 6261
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front
C150
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 6264
C440
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 6265
C160
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 6266
C426
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly. 2. Remove the retainers and position the fender splash
shield aside. 3. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector. 4. Disconnect the 6
pushpin fasteners. 5. Remove the front wheel speed sensor bolt and the wheel speed sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front > Page 6269
^ To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 inch lbs).
6. CAUTION: The wheel speed sensor harness must be routed as shown or damage to the
harness during vehicle jounce and rebound can
occur.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front > Page 6270
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery. 2. Remove the
wheel and tire assembly. 3. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector.
4. NOTE: It is not necessary to remove the harness routing brackets.
Disconnect the wheel speed sensor harness from the brackets.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front > Page 6271
5. Disconnect the pushpin fasteners. 6. Remove the wheel speed sensor bolt and the wheel speed
sensor.
^ To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 inch lbs).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
Yaw Rate Sensor: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
NOTE: When installing a new stability control sensor cluster, the sensor cluster must be calibrated.
Follow the scan tool directions for the calibration procedures.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
2. NOTE: The sensor is located on the RH side of the vehicle, under the rear seat.
Remove the rear seat. For additional information, refer to Seats.
3. Disconnect the stability control sensor cluster electrical connector. 4. Remove the 2 stability
control sensor cluster nuts and the stability control sensor cluster.
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
IGNITION LOCK CYLINDER
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the passive anti-theft system (PATS) transceiver. 2. Turn the ignition key to the ON
position. 3. Using a suitable tool, press the ignition lock cylinder release button and remove the
ignition lock cylinder. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Starter Relay
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Starter Relay > Page 6286
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Run/Start Relay
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection Run/Start Relay
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Run/Start Relay > Page 6289
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Run/Start Relay > Page 6290
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection Starter Relay
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Run/Start Relay > Page 6291
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Service and Repair
Battery Cable: Service and Repair
BATTERY CABLES
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Page 6296
Part 2
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the battery tray. 2. Remove the bolt and position the battery cable body ground terminal
aside.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
3. Remove the nut and position the BJB cable terminal aside.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
4. Remove the starter solenoid terminal cover. 5. Remove the nut and position the battery cable
starter solenoid terminal aside.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
6. Remove the nut and position the battery cable starter motor terminal aside.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
7. Release the battery cable locator from the engine. 8. Remove the bolt and position the battery
cable engine ground terminal aside.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
9. Release the battery cable from the top of the intake manifold.
10. Release the 3 battery cable locators from the LH valve cover. 11. Position the generator
protective cover aside, remove the nut and position the generator B+ terminal aside.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
12. Remove the battery cables. 13. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Alternator: Electrical Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Generator
Voltage.................................................................................................................................................
..........................................................................12Volt
Rating...................................................................................................................78/143 amp (max)
@ 620-2500 engine rpm @ normal engine temperature
Generator
Load at 2,000 rpm................................................................................................................................
....................................................................90 amps No Load at 2,000 rpm........................................
.......................................................................................................................between 13.2 and 15.5
volts
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 6302
Torque Specifications
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Alternator: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6305
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6306
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6307
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6308
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6309
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6310
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6311
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6312
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6313
Alternator: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6314
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6315
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6316
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6317
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6318
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6319
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6320
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6321
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6322
Alternator: Connector Views
C102A
C102B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 6323
Alternator: Application and ID
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Rating...................................................................................................................78/143 amp (max)
@ 620-2500 engine rpm @ normal engine temperature Generator pulley ratio..................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.....2.66:1 Voltage regulator type..........................................................................................................
................................................Electronic internal with generator
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 6324
Alternator: Description and Operation
GENERATOR
The generator is belt-driven by the engine accessory drive system. The generator has an internal
voltage regulator that is not replaced separately. The generator and voltage regulator are repaired
as an assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 6325
Alternator: Service and Repair
GENERATOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Remove the cooling fan. 3. Rotate the accessory drive belt tensioner
counterclockwise and position the accessory drive belt aside. 4. Position the generator protective
cover aside, remove the nut and position the generator B+ terminal aside.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
5. Disconnect the generator electrical connector.
- Detach the pin-type retainer and wiring harness.
6. Remove the generator stud nut.
- To install, tighten to 47 Nm (35 lb-ft).
7. Remove the generator stud.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
8. Remove the generator bolt and the generator. 9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
IGNITION LOCK CYLINDER
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the passive anti-theft system (PATS) transceiver. 2. Turn the ignition key to the ON
position. 3. Using a suitable tool, press the ignition lock cylinder release button and remove the
ignition lock cylinder. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6334
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6335
Starter Motor: Diagrams
C197A
C197B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6336
Starter Motor: Service and Repair
STARTER MOTOR
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6337
Removal and Installation
WARNING: When carrying out maintenance on the starting system, be aware that heavy gauge
leads are connected directly to the battery. Make sure protective caps are in place when
maintenance is completed.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Remove the air cleaner. 3. Disconnect the transmission
shift cable and adjustment lock from the transmission manual control lever. 4. Disconnect the
transmission shift cable rotating slide snap and position aside the transmission cable. 5. Remove
the nut and the transmission manual control lever.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 lb-ft).
6. Remove the starter motor terminal cover. 7. Remove the starter motor solenoid battery cable
nut.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
8. Remove the starter motor solenoid wire nut.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6338
9. Disconnect the wiring harness retainer from the starter motor stud bolt and position the wiring
harness aside.
10. Remove the starter motor stud bolt, bolt and the starter.
- To install, tighten to 27 Nm (20 lb-ft).
11. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Starter Relay
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Starter Relay > Page 6343
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Run/Start Relay
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection Run/Start Relay
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Run/Start Relay > Page 6346
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Run/Start Relay > Page 6347
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection Starter Relay
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Run/Start Relay > Page 6348
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Power Point, Cargo Area
C474
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Power Point, Cargo Area > Page 6354
C2033
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Power Point, Cargo Area > Page 6355
C3063
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Power Point, Cargo Area > Page 6356
C3064
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Power Point, Cargo Area > Page 6357
C3323
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Electronic Noise Suppressor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Ignition Transformer Capacitor 1
C174
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Electronic Noise Suppressor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Ignition Transformer Capacitor 1 > Page 6362
C194
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Fuse: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6367
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6368
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6369
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6370
Fuse: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6371
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6372
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6373
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuse: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6376
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6377
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6378
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6379
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6380
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6381
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6382
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6383
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6384
Fuse: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6385
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6386
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6387
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6388
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6389
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6390
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6391
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6392
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Fuse: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6395
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6396
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6397
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6398
Fuse: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6399
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6400
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6401
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No
Start/DTC's Set
Fuse Block: Customer Interest Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set
TSB 10-1-8
02/01/10
PCM - BATTERY JUNCTION BOX (BJB) - POSSIBLE MIL ON WITH MULTIPLE DTCS, NO
CRANK/NO START, DRIVABILITY SYMPTOMS
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 7-16-5 to remove the production build date and TSB 7-17-9 to update
the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles may exhibit concerns that results in no crank/start,
buck/jerk, lack/loss of power and/or malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) with one or more diagnostic
trouble codes (DTCs) present. This could be caused by a poor fuse terminal fit, loose or unseated
wire terminal connection at the Battery Junction Box (BJB) located near the battery under the hood.
ACTION If loose and/or unseated wiring terminals for fuses and relays are found in the BJB, follow
the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the vehicle battery.
2. Open the BJB top cover. (Figure 1)
3. Check for loose fuse connections in the BJB at fuse positions 30, 31, 32, 33, and 34. If poor
terminal fit is present, note those fuse cavities for Step 6.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No
Start/DTC's Set > Page 6410
4. Remove all the mini fuses, relays and diodes (suggest taking a picture of the layout so install is
easier). (Figure 2)
a. Do not remove the cartridge fuses from the BJB.
5. Remove the light gray retainer that the devices were plugged through. This will expose the
terminals within the plastic housing. (Figure 3)
6. Locate the terminal cavities identified in procedure Step 3 that require repair. The tuning forks
will be off center in relation to the plastic cavities or
open.
7. Insert a small flat blade screw driver/pick tool into the suspect tuning fork slot. The flat blade
screw driver/pick tool width should be a maximum of
0.05" (1.25 mm) to provide access into the cavity. Tip dimensions were 0.04" x 0.04" (1 mm x 1
mm) with a 45 degree taper).
8. The small flat blade screw driver/pick tool should be inserted to the outside of the tuning fork leg
between the tuning fork leg and the plastic wall of
the housing cavity. (Figure 4)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No
Start/DTC's Set > Page 6411
9. Pry the screw driver/pick tool against the plastic cavity wall and against the side of the tuning
fork leg. This will move the tuning fork legs together,
tuning fork legs should be close to touching. (Figure 5)
10. Next remove the BJB from the splash shield. (Figure 6)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No
Start/DTC's Set > Page 6412
a. Tug on the underside wires to determine the unseated terminal location. (Figures 7 and 8)
NOTE
THIS MAY REQUIRE SOME LEVEL OF HARNESS REMOVAL FROM THE VEHICLE MOUNTING
LOCATIONS TO ADEQUATELY ACCESS THE LEADS ON THE UNDERSIDE OF THE BJB
BLOCK.
11. Any circuits that do not offer any resistance during the tugging operation should be reseated
using the Push-Click-Tug method.
a. Push the terminal back into the cavity.
b. Listen for an audible click to assure lock engagement.
c. Tug on the lead to insure a proper seat occurred.
12. Once all the BJB circuits have been verified as seated, proceed to the next steps.
13. Install and lock the BJB block back into the splash shield.
14. Install the light gray retainer.
15. Reinstall all the mini fuses, relays and diodes back into their specific locations.
a. Make sure all the relays are replaced in the proper orientation.
16. Close the BJB cover.
17. Reconnect the vehicle battery cable.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100108A 2007 Edge, MKX: Follow 0.6 Hr.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No
Start/DTC's Set > Page 6413
The Service Procedure To Check For And Repair Loose/Unseated Wiring Terminals (Do Not Use
With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14290 X2
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No
Crank/No Start/DTC's Set
Fuse Block: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set
TSB 10-1-8
02/01/10
PCM - BATTERY JUNCTION BOX (BJB) - POSSIBLE MIL ON WITH MULTIPLE DTCS, NO
CRANK/NO START, DRIVABILITY SYMPTOMS
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 7-16-5 to remove the production build date and TSB 7-17-9 to update
the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles may exhibit concerns that results in no crank/start,
buck/jerk, lack/loss of power and/or malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) with one or more diagnostic
trouble codes (DTCs) present. This could be caused by a poor fuse terminal fit, loose or unseated
wire terminal connection at the Battery Junction Box (BJB) located near the battery under the hood.
ACTION If loose and/or unseated wiring terminals for fuses and relays are found in the BJB, follow
the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the vehicle battery.
2. Open the BJB top cover. (Figure 1)
3. Check for loose fuse connections in the BJB at fuse positions 30, 31, 32, 33, and 34. If poor
terminal fit is present, note those fuse cavities for Step 6.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No
Crank/No Start/DTC's Set > Page 6419
4. Remove all the mini fuses, relays and diodes (suggest taking a picture of the layout so install is
easier). (Figure 2)
a. Do not remove the cartridge fuses from the BJB.
5. Remove the light gray retainer that the devices were plugged through. This will expose the
terminals within the plastic housing. (Figure 3)
6. Locate the terminal cavities identified in procedure Step 3 that require repair. The tuning forks
will be off center in relation to the plastic cavities or
open.
7. Insert a small flat blade screw driver/pick tool into the suspect tuning fork slot. The flat blade
screw driver/pick tool width should be a maximum of
0.05" (1.25 mm) to provide access into the cavity. Tip dimensions were 0.04" x 0.04" (1 mm x 1
mm) with a 45 degree taper).
8. The small flat blade screw driver/pick tool should be inserted to the outside of the tuning fork leg
between the tuning fork leg and the plastic wall of
the housing cavity. (Figure 4)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No
Crank/No Start/DTC's Set > Page 6420
9. Pry the screw driver/pick tool against the plastic cavity wall and against the side of the tuning
fork leg. This will move the tuning fork legs together,
tuning fork legs should be close to touching. (Figure 5)
10. Next remove the BJB from the splash shield. (Figure 6)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No
Crank/No Start/DTC's Set > Page 6421
a. Tug on the underside wires to determine the unseated terminal location. (Figures 7 and 8)
NOTE
THIS MAY REQUIRE SOME LEVEL OF HARNESS REMOVAL FROM THE VEHICLE MOUNTING
LOCATIONS TO ADEQUATELY ACCESS THE LEADS ON THE UNDERSIDE OF THE BJB
BLOCK.
11. Any circuits that do not offer any resistance during the tugging operation should be reseated
using the Push-Click-Tug method.
a. Push the terminal back into the cavity.
b. Listen for an audible click to assure lock engagement.
c. Tug on the lead to insure a proper seat occurred.
12. Once all the BJB circuits have been verified as seated, proceed to the next steps.
13. Install and lock the BJB block back into the splash shield.
14. Install the light gray retainer.
15. Reinstall all the mini fuses, relays and diodes back into their specific locations.
a. Make sure all the relays are replaced in the proper orientation.
16. Close the BJB cover.
17. Reconnect the vehicle battery cable.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100108A 2007 Edge, MKX: Follow 0.6 Hr.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No
Crank/No Start/DTC's Set > Page 6422
The Service Procedure To Check For And Repair Loose/Unseated Wiring Terminals (Do Not Use
With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14290 X2
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Fuse Block: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6425
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6426
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6427
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6428
Fuse Block: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6429
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6430
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6431
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuse Block: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6434
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6435
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6436
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6437
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6438
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6439
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6440
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6441
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6442
Fuse Block: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6443
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6444
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6445
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6446
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6447
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6448
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6449
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6450
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6451
Fuse Block: Connector Views
C1035A
C1035B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6452
C2280A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6453
C2280B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6454
C2280C
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6455
C2280D
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6456
C2280E
C2280F
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6457
C2280G
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Fuse Block: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6460
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6461
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6462
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6463
Fuse Block: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6464
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6465
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6466
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Micro ISO
Micro ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection Relay - Micro ISO
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Micro ISO > Page 6471
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Micro ISO > Page 6472
Micro ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection Relay - Ultra Micro ISO
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Micro ISO > Page 6473
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Mini ISO Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection
Mini ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Mini ISO Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 6477
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934
Multiple Junction Connector: Diagrams C110-C934
C110
C126
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6482
C134
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6483
C139 (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6484
C139 (Part 2)
C140
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6485
C192
C210
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6486
C211
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6487
C212 (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6488
C212 (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6489
C213 (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6490
C213 (Part 2)
C214
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6491
C215 (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6492
C215 (Part 2)
C260
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6493
C263
C264
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6494
C265
C300
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6495
C311 (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6496
C311 (Part 2)
C312
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6497
C313
C314
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6498
C315
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6499
C316
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6500
C327
C328
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6501
C405
C406
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6502
C510 (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6503
C510 (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6504
C610 (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6505
C610 (Part 2)
C700
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6506
C800
C913
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6507
C919
C922
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6508
C925
C934
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6509
C4345
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6510
C4346
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6511
C224
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6512
Multiple Junction Connector: Diagrams
C110
C126
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6513
C134
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6514
C139 (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6515
C139 (Part 2)
C140
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6516
C192
C210
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6517
C211
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6518
C212 (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6519
C212 (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6520
C213 (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6521
C213 (Part 2)
C214
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6522
C215 (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6523
C215 (Part 2)
C260
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6524
C263
C264
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6525
C265
C300
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6526
C311 (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6527
C311 (Part 2)
C312
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6528
C313
C314
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6529
C315
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6530
C316
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6531
C327
C328
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6532
C405
C406
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6533
C510 (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6534
C510 (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6535
C610 (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6536
C610 (Part 2)
C700
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6537
C800
C913
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6538
C919
C922
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6539
C925
C934
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6540
C4345
C4346
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6541
C224
C223
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6542
C2199
C2365
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6543
C2200
C4133
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6544
C3337
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair
SMART JUNCTION BOX (SJB)
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
NOTE:
- Prior to the replacement of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to the appropriate scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new module
after installation.
- The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) functionality has been integrated into the SJB.
- The steps included in the SJB removal and installation procedure are critical to restoring the
vehicle security and tire pressure monitoring systems to normal operation. A new SJB is delivered
in a manufacturing mode with 7 pre-set DTCs related to the TPMS. To clear the DTCs, successful
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 6548
configuration of the SJB must occur, followed by successful TPMS sensor training, and a
successful self-test, including clearing of the DTCs. The DTCs are as follows: B2477 (Module Configuration Failure)
- B106D (Tire Pressure Monitor System [TPMS] Initiators Not Configured)
- B2868 (Left Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2869 (Right Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2870 (Right Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2871 (Left Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- C2780 (ECU in Manufacturer Sub-State)
1. NOTE: This step is necessary only if the SJB is being replaced.
Upload the module configuration information from the SJB into the scan tool.
2. Remove the driver door scuff plate. 3. Disconnect the 6 electrical connectors. 4. Remove the
harness pushpin from the SJB. 5. Remove the nut. 6. Lower the SJB (release the SJB from the 2
alignment holes). 7. Push the red lock upward and press the 2 black tangs inward to release the B+
connector from the SJB. 8. Remove the SJB.
Installation
1. Install the B+ connector onto the SJB and push the red lock tab downward. 2. Position the 2 SJB
alignment tabs into the 2 holes and install the nut.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. Install the harness pushpin into the SJB. 4. Connect the 6 electrical connectors.
5. NOTE: If the SJB was not replaced, this is the last step that is necessary.
Install the driver door scuff plate.
6. NOTE:
- When successful, this step provides the calibration necessary for the SJB operation and clears
DTCs B106D and B2477. The clearing of these DTCs indicates the calibration data has been
successfully downloaded to the new SJB.
- If the programmable module installation (PMI) procedure was not followed when a new SJB was
installed, the remote keyless entry (RKE) function (from the integrated keyhead transmitter [IKT]) of
the SJB must be programmed, or the IKT RKE functions will be inoperative. IKTs can be
programmed to the new SJB by cycling each IKT key to the ON position for a minimum of 6
seconds. If a new instrument cluster was installed, the IKT keys must be programmed to the new
instrument cluster in order to program both the RKE and passive anti-theft system (PATS)
functions.
Download the SJB configuration information from the scan tool to the new SJB.
7. NOTE: When successful, this step clears DTCs B2868, B2869, B2870 and B2871. The clearing
of these DTCs indicates the SJB has recognized
the tire pressure sensors during the training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensors.
8. NOTE: DTC C2780 will not clear if any other DTCs are present in the SJB.
Carry out the SJB on-demand self-test, clear DTCs, and then retrieve all DTCs to confirm all DTCs
have been cleared.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Micro ISO
Micro ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection Relay - Micro ISO
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Micro ISO > Page 6554
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Micro ISO > Page 6555
Micro ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection Relay - Ultra Micro ISO
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Micro ISO > Page 6556
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Mini ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Mini ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Mini ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 6560
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair
SMART JUNCTION BOX (SJB)
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
NOTE:
- Prior to the replacement of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to the appropriate scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new module
after installation.
- The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) functionality has been integrated into the SJB.
- The steps included in the SJB removal and installation procedure are critical to restoring the
vehicle security and tire pressure monitoring systems to normal operation. A new SJB is delivered
in a manufacturing mode with 7 pre-set DTCs related to the TPMS. To clear the DTCs, successful
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 6564
configuration of the SJB must occur, followed by successful TPMS sensor training, and a
successful self-test, including clearing of the DTCs. The DTCs are as follows: B2477 (Module Configuration Failure)
- B106D (Tire Pressure Monitor System [TPMS] Initiators Not Configured)
- B2868 (Left Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2869 (Right Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2870 (Right Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2871 (Left Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- C2780 (ECU in Manufacturer Sub-State)
1. NOTE: This step is necessary only if the SJB is being replaced.
Upload the module configuration information from the SJB into the scan tool.
2. Remove the driver door scuff plate. 3. Disconnect the 6 electrical connectors. 4. Remove the
harness pushpin from the SJB. 5. Remove the nut. 6. Lower the SJB (release the SJB from the 2
alignment holes). 7. Push the red lock upward and press the 2 black tangs inward to release the B+
connector from the SJB. 8. Remove the SJB.
Installation
1. Install the B+ connector onto the SJB and push the red lock tab downward. 2. Position the 2 SJB
alignment tabs into the 2 holes and install the nut.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. Install the harness pushpin into the SJB. 4. Connect the 6 electrical connectors.
5. NOTE: If the SJB was not replaced, this is the last step that is necessary.
Install the driver door scuff plate.
6. NOTE:
- When successful, this step provides the calibration necessary for the SJB operation and clears
DTCs B106D and B2477. The clearing of these DTCs indicates the calibration data has been
successfully downloaded to the new SJB.
- If the programmable module installation (PMI) procedure was not followed when a new SJB was
installed, the remote keyless entry (RKE) function (from the integrated keyhead transmitter [IKT]) of
the SJB must be programmed, or the IKT RKE functions will be inoperative. IKTs can be
programmed to the new SJB by cycling each IKT key to the ON position for a minimum of 6
seconds. If a new instrument cluster was installed, the IKT keys must be programmed to the new
instrument cluster in order to program both the RKE and passive anti-theft system (PATS)
functions.
Download the SJB configuration information from the scan tool to the new SJB.
7. NOTE: When successful, this step clears DTCs B2868, B2869, B2870 and B2871. The clearing
of these DTCs indicates the SJB has recognized
the tire pressure sensors during the training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensors.
8. NOTE: DTC C2780 will not clear if any other DTCs are present in the SJB.
Carry out the SJB on-demand self-test, clear DTCs, and then retrieve all DTCs to confirm all DTCs
have been cleared.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution
Box
Relay Box: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution
Box > Page 6569
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution
Box > Page 6570
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution
Box > Page 6571
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution
Box > Page 6572
Relay Box: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution
Box > Page 6573
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution
Box > Page 6574
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution
Box > Page 6575
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Relay Box: Diagrams Battery Junction Box (BJB)
C1035A
C1035B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 6578
Relay Box: Diagrams Smart Junction Box (SJB)
C2280A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 6579
C2280B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 6580
C2280C
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 6581
C2280D
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 6582
C2280E
C2280F
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 6583
C2280G
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power
Distribution Box
Relay Box: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power
Distribution Box > Page 6586
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power
Distribution Box > Page 6587
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power
Distribution Box > Page 6588
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power
Distribution Box > Page 6589
Relay Box: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power
Distribution Box > Page 6590
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power
Distribution Box > Page 6591
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power
Distribution Box > Page 6592
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Relay Box: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6597
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6598
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6599
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6600
Relay Box: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6601
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6602
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6603
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Relay Box: Diagrams Battery Junction Box (BJB)
C1035A
C1035B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 6606
Relay Box: Diagrams Smart Junction Box (SJB)
C2280A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 6607
C2280B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 6608
C2280C
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 6609
C2280D
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 6610
C2280E
C2280F
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 6611
C2280G
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Relay Box: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6614
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6615
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6616
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6617
Relay Box: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6618
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6619
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6620
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wiring Harness: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL
ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set
Wiring Harness: Customer Interest Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set
TSB 10-1-8
02/01/10
PCM - BATTERY JUNCTION BOX (BJB) - POSSIBLE MIL ON WITH MULTIPLE DTCS, NO
CRANK/NO START, DRIVABILITY SYMPTOMS
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 7-16-5 to remove the production build date and TSB 7-17-9 to update
the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles may exhibit concerns that results in no crank/start,
buck/jerk, lack/loss of power and/or malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) with one or more diagnostic
trouble codes (DTCs) present. This could be caused by a poor fuse terminal fit, loose or unseated
wire terminal connection at the Battery Junction Box (BJB) located near the battery under the hood.
ACTION If loose and/or unseated wiring terminals for fuses and relays are found in the BJB, follow
the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the vehicle battery.
2. Open the BJB top cover. (Figure 1)
3. Check for loose fuse connections in the BJB at fuse positions 30, 31, 32, 33, and 34. If poor
terminal fit is present, note those fuse cavities for Step 6.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wiring Harness: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL
ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set > Page 6629
4. Remove all the mini fuses, relays and diodes (suggest taking a picture of the layout so install is
easier). (Figure 2)
a. Do not remove the cartridge fuses from the BJB.
5. Remove the light gray retainer that the devices were plugged through. This will expose the
terminals within the plastic housing. (Figure 3)
6. Locate the terminal cavities identified in procedure Step 3 that require repair. The tuning forks
will be off center in relation to the plastic cavities or
open.
7. Insert a small flat blade screw driver/pick tool into the suspect tuning fork slot. The flat blade
screw driver/pick tool width should be a maximum of
0.05" (1.25 mm) to provide access into the cavity. Tip dimensions were 0.04" x 0.04" (1 mm x 1
mm) with a 45 degree taper).
8. The small flat blade screw driver/pick tool should be inserted to the outside of the tuning fork leg
between the tuning fork leg and the plastic wall of
the housing cavity. (Figure 4)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wiring Harness: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL
ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set > Page 6630
9. Pry the screw driver/pick tool against the plastic cavity wall and against the side of the tuning
fork leg. This will move the tuning fork legs together,
tuning fork legs should be close to touching. (Figure 5)
10. Next remove the BJB from the splash shield. (Figure 6)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wiring Harness: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL
ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set > Page 6631
a. Tug on the underside wires to determine the unseated terminal location. (Figures 7 and 8)
NOTE
THIS MAY REQUIRE SOME LEVEL OF HARNESS REMOVAL FROM THE VEHICLE MOUNTING
LOCATIONS TO ADEQUATELY ACCESS THE LEADS ON THE UNDERSIDE OF THE BJB
BLOCK.
11. Any circuits that do not offer any resistance during the tugging operation should be reseated
using the Push-Click-Tug method.
a. Push the terminal back into the cavity.
b. Listen for an audible click to assure lock engagement.
c. Tug on the lead to insure a proper seat occurred.
12. Once all the BJB circuits have been verified as seated, proceed to the next steps.
13. Install and lock the BJB block back into the splash shield.
14. Install the light gray retainer.
15. Reinstall all the mini fuses, relays and diodes back into their specific locations.
a. Make sure all the relays are replaced in the proper orientation.
16. Close the BJB cover.
17. Reconnect the vehicle battery cable.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100108A 2007 Edge, MKX: Follow 0.6 Hr.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wiring Harness: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL
ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set > Page 6632
The Service Procedure To Check For And Repair Loose/Unseated Wiring Terminals (Do Not Use
With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14290 X2
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 >
Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set
Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set
TSB 10-1-8
02/01/10
PCM - BATTERY JUNCTION BOX (BJB) - POSSIBLE MIL ON WITH MULTIPLE DTCS, NO
CRANK/NO START, DRIVABILITY SYMPTOMS
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 7-16-5 to remove the production build date and TSB 7-17-9 to update
the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles may exhibit concerns that results in no crank/start,
buck/jerk, lack/loss of power and/or malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) with one or more diagnostic
trouble codes (DTCs) present. This could be caused by a poor fuse terminal fit, loose or unseated
wire terminal connection at the Battery Junction Box (BJB) located near the battery under the hood.
ACTION If loose and/or unseated wiring terminals for fuses and relays are found in the BJB, follow
the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the vehicle battery.
2. Open the BJB top cover. (Figure 1)
3. Check for loose fuse connections in the BJB at fuse positions 30, 31, 32, 33, and 34. If poor
terminal fit is present, note those fuse cavities for Step 6.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 >
Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set > Page 6638
4. Remove all the mini fuses, relays and diodes (suggest taking a picture of the layout so install is
easier). (Figure 2)
a. Do not remove the cartridge fuses from the BJB.
5. Remove the light gray retainer that the devices were plugged through. This will expose the
terminals within the plastic housing. (Figure 3)
6. Locate the terminal cavities identified in procedure Step 3 that require repair. The tuning forks
will be off center in relation to the plastic cavities or
open.
7. Insert a small flat blade screw driver/pick tool into the suspect tuning fork slot. The flat blade
screw driver/pick tool width should be a maximum of
0.05" (1.25 mm) to provide access into the cavity. Tip dimensions were 0.04" x 0.04" (1 mm x 1
mm) with a 45 degree taper).
8. The small flat blade screw driver/pick tool should be inserted to the outside of the tuning fork leg
between the tuning fork leg and the plastic wall of
the housing cavity. (Figure 4)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 >
Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set > Page 6639
9. Pry the screw driver/pick tool against the plastic cavity wall and against the side of the tuning
fork leg. This will move the tuning fork legs together,
tuning fork legs should be close to touching. (Figure 5)
10. Next remove the BJB from the splash shield. (Figure 6)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 >
Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set > Page 6640
a. Tug on the underside wires to determine the unseated terminal location. (Figures 7 and 8)
NOTE
THIS MAY REQUIRE SOME LEVEL OF HARNESS REMOVAL FROM THE VEHICLE MOUNTING
LOCATIONS TO ADEQUATELY ACCESS THE LEADS ON THE UNDERSIDE OF THE BJB
BLOCK.
11. Any circuits that do not offer any resistance during the tugging operation should be reseated
using the Push-Click-Tug method.
a. Push the terminal back into the cavity.
b. Listen for an audible click to assure lock engagement.
c. Tug on the lead to insure a proper seat occurred.
12. Once all the BJB circuits have been verified as seated, proceed to the next steps.
13. Install and lock the BJB block back into the splash shield.
14. Install the light gray retainer.
15. Reinstall all the mini fuses, relays and diodes back into their specific locations.
a. Make sure all the relays are replaced in the proper orientation.
16. Close the BJB cover.
17. Reconnect the vehicle battery cable.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100108A 2007 Edge, MKX: Follow 0.6 Hr.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 >
Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set > Page 6641
The Service Procedure To Check For And Repair Loose/Unseated Wiring Terminals (Do Not Use
With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14290 X2
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams >
Power Point, Cargo Area
C474
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams >
Power Point, Cargo Area > Page 6647
C2033
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams >
Power Point, Cargo Area > Page 6648
C3063
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams >
Power Point, Cargo Area > Page 6649
C3064
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams >
Power Point, Cargo Area > Page 6650
C3323
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Electronic Noise Suppressor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Ignition Transformer Capacitor 1
C174
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Electronic Noise Suppressor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Ignition Transformer Capacitor 1 > Page 6655
C194
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction
Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Fuse: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction
Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6660
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction
Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6661
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction
Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6662
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction
Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6663
Fuse: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction
Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6664
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction
Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6665
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction
Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6666
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Fuse: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6669
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6670
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6671
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6672
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6673
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6674
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6675
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6676
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6677
Fuse: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6678
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6679
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6680
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6681
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6682
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6683
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6684
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6685
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Fuse: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6688
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6689
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6690
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6691
Fuse: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6692
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6693
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6694
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set
Fuse Block: Customer Interest Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set
TSB 10-1-8
02/01/10
PCM - BATTERY JUNCTION BOX (BJB) - POSSIBLE MIL ON WITH MULTIPLE DTCS, NO
CRANK/NO START, DRIVABILITY SYMPTOMS
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 7-16-5 to remove the production build date and TSB 7-17-9 to update
the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles may exhibit concerns that results in no crank/start,
buck/jerk, lack/loss of power and/or malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) with one or more diagnostic
trouble codes (DTCs) present. This could be caused by a poor fuse terminal fit, loose or unseated
wire terminal connection at the Battery Junction Box (BJB) located near the battery under the hood.
ACTION If loose and/or unseated wiring terminals for fuses and relays are found in the BJB, follow
the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the vehicle battery.
2. Open the BJB top cover. (Figure 1)
3. Check for loose fuse connections in the BJB at fuse positions 30, 31, 32, 33, and 34. If poor
terminal fit is present, note those fuse cavities for Step 6.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set >
Page 6703
4. Remove all the mini fuses, relays and diodes (suggest taking a picture of the layout so install is
easier). (Figure 2)
a. Do not remove the cartridge fuses from the BJB.
5. Remove the light gray retainer that the devices were plugged through. This will expose the
terminals within the plastic housing. (Figure 3)
6. Locate the terminal cavities identified in procedure Step 3 that require repair. The tuning forks
will be off center in relation to the plastic cavities or
open.
7. Insert a small flat blade screw driver/pick tool into the suspect tuning fork slot. The flat blade
screw driver/pick tool width should be a maximum of
0.05" (1.25 mm) to provide access into the cavity. Tip dimensions were 0.04" x 0.04" (1 mm x 1
mm) with a 45 degree taper).
8. The small flat blade screw driver/pick tool should be inserted to the outside of the tuning fork leg
between the tuning fork leg and the plastic wall of
the housing cavity. (Figure 4)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set >
Page 6704
9. Pry the screw driver/pick tool against the plastic cavity wall and against the side of the tuning
fork leg. This will move the tuning fork legs together,
tuning fork legs should be close to touching. (Figure 5)
10. Next remove the BJB from the splash shield. (Figure 6)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set >
Page 6705
a. Tug on the underside wires to determine the unseated terminal location. (Figures 7 and 8)
NOTE
THIS MAY REQUIRE SOME LEVEL OF HARNESS REMOVAL FROM THE VEHICLE MOUNTING
LOCATIONS TO ADEQUATELY ACCESS THE LEADS ON THE UNDERSIDE OF THE BJB
BLOCK.
11. Any circuits that do not offer any resistance during the tugging operation should be reseated
using the Push-Click-Tug method.
a. Push the terminal back into the cavity.
b. Listen for an audible click to assure lock engagement.
c. Tug on the lead to insure a proper seat occurred.
12. Once all the BJB circuits have been verified as seated, proceed to the next steps.
13. Install and lock the BJB block back into the splash shield.
14. Install the light gray retainer.
15. Reinstall all the mini fuses, relays and diodes back into their specific locations.
a. Make sure all the relays are replaced in the proper orientation.
16. Close the BJB cover.
17. Reconnect the vehicle battery cable.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100108A 2007 Edge, MKX: Follow 0.6 Hr.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set >
Page 6706
The Service Procedure To Check For And Repair Loose/Unseated Wiring Terminals (Do Not Use
With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14290 X2
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No
Start/DTC's Set
Fuse Block: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set
TSB 10-1-8
02/01/10
PCM - BATTERY JUNCTION BOX (BJB) - POSSIBLE MIL ON WITH MULTIPLE DTCS, NO
CRANK/NO START, DRIVABILITY SYMPTOMS
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 7-16-5 to remove the production build date and TSB 7-17-9 to update
the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles may exhibit concerns that results in no crank/start,
buck/jerk, lack/loss of power and/or malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) with one or more diagnostic
trouble codes (DTCs) present. This could be caused by a poor fuse terminal fit, loose or unseated
wire terminal connection at the Battery Junction Box (BJB) located near the battery under the hood.
ACTION If loose and/or unseated wiring terminals for fuses and relays are found in the BJB, follow
the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the vehicle battery.
2. Open the BJB top cover. (Figure 1)
3. Check for loose fuse connections in the BJB at fuse positions 30, 31, 32, 33, and 34. If poor
terminal fit is present, note those fuse cavities for Step 6.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No
Start/DTC's Set > Page 6712
4. Remove all the mini fuses, relays and diodes (suggest taking a picture of the layout so install is
easier). (Figure 2)
a. Do not remove the cartridge fuses from the BJB.
5. Remove the light gray retainer that the devices were plugged through. This will expose the
terminals within the plastic housing. (Figure 3)
6. Locate the terminal cavities identified in procedure Step 3 that require repair. The tuning forks
will be off center in relation to the plastic cavities or
open.
7. Insert a small flat blade screw driver/pick tool into the suspect tuning fork slot. The flat blade
screw driver/pick tool width should be a maximum of
0.05" (1.25 mm) to provide access into the cavity. Tip dimensions were 0.04" x 0.04" (1 mm x 1
mm) with a 45 degree taper).
8. The small flat blade screw driver/pick tool should be inserted to the outside of the tuning fork leg
between the tuning fork leg and the plastic wall of
the housing cavity. (Figure 4)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No
Start/DTC's Set > Page 6713
9. Pry the screw driver/pick tool against the plastic cavity wall and against the side of the tuning
fork leg. This will move the tuning fork legs together,
tuning fork legs should be close to touching. (Figure 5)
10. Next remove the BJB from the splash shield. (Figure 6)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No
Start/DTC's Set > Page 6714
a. Tug on the underside wires to determine the unseated terminal location. (Figures 7 and 8)
NOTE
THIS MAY REQUIRE SOME LEVEL OF HARNESS REMOVAL FROM THE VEHICLE MOUNTING
LOCATIONS TO ADEQUATELY ACCESS THE LEADS ON THE UNDERSIDE OF THE BJB
BLOCK.
11. Any circuits that do not offer any resistance during the tugging operation should be reseated
using the Push-Click-Tug method.
a. Push the terminal back into the cavity.
b. Listen for an audible click to assure lock engagement.
c. Tug on the lead to insure a proper seat occurred.
12. Once all the BJB circuits have been verified as seated, proceed to the next steps.
13. Install and lock the BJB block back into the splash shield.
14. Install the light gray retainer.
15. Reinstall all the mini fuses, relays and diodes back into their specific locations.
a. Make sure all the relays are replaced in the proper orientation.
16. Close the BJB cover.
17. Reconnect the vehicle battery cable.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100108A 2007 Edge, MKX: Follow 0.6 Hr.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuse Block: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No
Start/DTC's Set > Page 6715
The Service Procedure To Check For And Repair Loose/Unseated Wiring Terminals (Do Not Use
With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14290 X2
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Fuse Block: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6718
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6719
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6720
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6721
Fuse Block: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6722
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6723
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6724
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Fuse Block: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6727
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6728
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6729
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6730
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6731
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6732
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6733
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6734
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6735
Fuse Block: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6736
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6737
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6738
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6739
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6740
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6741
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6742
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6743
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6744
Fuse Block: Connector Views
C1035A
C1035B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6745
C2280A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6746
C2280B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6747
C2280C
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6748
C2280D
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6749
C2280E
C2280F
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6750
C2280G
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Fuse Block: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6753
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6754
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6755
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6756
Fuse Block: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6757
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6758
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6759
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Relay - Micro ISO
Micro ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection Relay - Micro ISO
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Relay - Micro ISO > Page 6764
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Relay - Micro ISO > Page 6765
Micro ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection Relay - Ultra Micro ISO
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Relay - Micro ISO > Page 6766
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Mini ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection
Mini ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Mini ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 6770
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934
Multiple Junction Connector: Diagrams C110-C934
C110
C126
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6775
C134
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6776
C139 (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6777
C139 (Part 2)
C140
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6778
C192
C210
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6779
C211
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6780
C212 (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6781
C212 (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6782
C213 (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6783
C213 (Part 2)
C214
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6784
C215 (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6785
C215 (Part 2)
C260
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6786
C263
C264
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6787
C265
C300
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6788
C311 (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6789
C311 (Part 2)
C312
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6790
C313
C314
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6791
C315
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6792
C316
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6793
C327
C328
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6794
C405
C406
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6795
C510 (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6796
C510 (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6797
C610 (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6798
C610 (Part 2)
C700
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6799
C800
C913
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6800
C919
C922
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6801
C925
C934
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6802
C4345
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6803
C4346
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6804
C224
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6805
Multiple Junction Connector: Diagrams
C110
C126
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6806
C134
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6807
C139 (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6808
C139 (Part 2)
C140
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6809
C192
C210
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6810
C211
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6811
C212 (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6812
C212 (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6813
C213 (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6814
C213 (Part 2)
C214
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6815
C215 (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6816
C215 (Part 2)
C260
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6817
C263
C264
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6818
C265
C300
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6819
C311 (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6820
C311 (Part 2)
C312
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6821
C313
C314
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6822
C315
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6823
C316
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6824
C327
C328
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6825
C405
C406
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6826
C510 (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6827
C510 (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6828
C610 (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6829
C610 (Part 2)
C700
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6830
C800
C913
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6831
C919
C922
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6832
C925
C934
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6833
C4345
C4346
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6834
C224
C223
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6835
C2199
C2365
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6836
C2200
C4133
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C934 > Page 6837
C3337
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair
SMART JUNCTION BOX (SJB)
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
NOTE:
- Prior to the replacement of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to the appropriate scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new module
after installation.
- The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) functionality has been integrated into the SJB.
- The steps included in the SJB removal and installation procedure are critical to restoring the
vehicle security and tire pressure monitoring systems to normal operation. A new SJB is delivered
in a manufacturing mode with 7 pre-set DTCs related to the TPMS. To clear the DTCs, successful
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Page 6841
configuration of the SJB must occur, followed by successful TPMS sensor training, and a
successful self-test, including clearing of the DTCs. The DTCs are as follows: B2477 (Module Configuration Failure)
- B106D (Tire Pressure Monitor System [TPMS] Initiators Not Configured)
- B2868 (Left Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2869 (Right Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2870 (Right Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2871 (Left Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- C2780 (ECU in Manufacturer Sub-State)
1. NOTE: This step is necessary only if the SJB is being replaced.
Upload the module configuration information from the SJB into the scan tool.
2. Remove the driver door scuff plate. 3. Disconnect the 6 electrical connectors. 4. Remove the
harness pushpin from the SJB. 5. Remove the nut. 6. Lower the SJB (release the SJB from the 2
alignment holes). 7. Push the red lock upward and press the 2 black tangs inward to release the B+
connector from the SJB. 8. Remove the SJB.
Installation
1. Install the B+ connector onto the SJB and push the red lock tab downward. 2. Position the 2 SJB
alignment tabs into the 2 holes and install the nut.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. Install the harness pushpin into the SJB. 4. Connect the 6 electrical connectors.
5. NOTE: If the SJB was not replaced, this is the last step that is necessary.
Install the driver door scuff plate.
6. NOTE:
- When successful, this step provides the calibration necessary for the SJB operation and clears
DTCs B106D and B2477. The clearing of these DTCs indicates the calibration data has been
successfully downloaded to the new SJB.
- If the programmable module installation (PMI) procedure was not followed when a new SJB was
installed, the remote keyless entry (RKE) function (from the integrated keyhead transmitter [IKT]) of
the SJB must be programmed, or the IKT RKE functions will be inoperative. IKTs can be
programmed to the new SJB by cycling each IKT key to the ON position for a minimum of 6
seconds. If a new instrument cluster was installed, the IKT keys must be programmed to the new
instrument cluster in order to program both the RKE and passive anti-theft system (PATS)
functions.
Download the SJB configuration information from the scan tool to the new SJB.
7. NOTE: When successful, this step clears DTCs B2868, B2869, B2870 and B2871. The clearing
of these DTCs indicates the SJB has recognized
the tire pressure sensors during the training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensors.
8. NOTE: DTC C2780 will not clear if any other DTCs are present in the SJB.
Carry out the SJB on-demand self-test, clear DTCs, and then retrieve all DTCs to confirm all DTCs
have been cleared.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Micro
ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Micro ISO
Micro ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection Relay - Micro ISO
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Micro
ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Micro ISO > Page 6847
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Micro
ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Micro ISO > Page 6848
Micro ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection Relay - Ultra Micro ISO
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Micro
ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Micro ISO > Page 6849
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Mini
ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Mini ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Mini
ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 6853
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair
SMART JUNCTION BOX (SJB)
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
NOTE:
- Prior to the replacement of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to the appropriate scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new module
after installation.
- The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) functionality has been integrated into the SJB.
- The steps included in the SJB removal and installation procedure are critical to restoring the
vehicle security and tire pressure monitoring systems to normal operation. A new SJB is delivered
in a manufacturing mode with 7 pre-set DTCs related to the TPMS. To clear the DTCs, successful
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 6857
configuration of the SJB must occur, followed by successful TPMS sensor training, and a
successful self-test, including clearing of the DTCs. The DTCs are as follows: B2477 (Module Configuration Failure)
- B106D (Tire Pressure Monitor System [TPMS] Initiators Not Configured)
- B2868 (Left Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2869 (Right Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2870 (Right Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2871 (Left Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- C2780 (ECU in Manufacturer Sub-State)
1. NOTE: This step is necessary only if the SJB is being replaced.
Upload the module configuration information from the SJB into the scan tool.
2. Remove the driver door scuff plate. 3. Disconnect the 6 electrical connectors. 4. Remove the
harness pushpin from the SJB. 5. Remove the nut. 6. Lower the SJB (release the SJB from the 2
alignment holes). 7. Push the red lock upward and press the 2 black tangs inward to release the B+
connector from the SJB. 8. Remove the SJB.
Installation
1. Install the B+ connector onto the SJB and push the red lock tab downward. 2. Position the 2 SJB
alignment tabs into the 2 holes and install the nut.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. Install the harness pushpin into the SJB. 4. Connect the 6 electrical connectors.
5. NOTE: If the SJB was not replaced, this is the last step that is necessary.
Install the driver door scuff plate.
6. NOTE:
- When successful, this step provides the calibration necessary for the SJB operation and clears
DTCs B106D and B2477. The clearing of these DTCs indicates the calibration data has been
successfully downloaded to the new SJB.
- If the programmable module installation (PMI) procedure was not followed when a new SJB was
installed, the remote keyless entry (RKE) function (from the integrated keyhead transmitter [IKT]) of
the SJB must be programmed, or the IKT RKE functions will be inoperative. IKTs can be
programmed to the new SJB by cycling each IKT key to the ON position for a minimum of 6
seconds. If a new instrument cluster was installed, the IKT keys must be programmed to the new
instrument cluster in order to program both the RKE and passive anti-theft system (PATS)
functions.
Download the SJB configuration information from the scan tool to the new SJB.
7. NOTE: When successful, this step clears DTCs B2868, B2869, B2870 and B2871. The clearing
of these DTCs indicates the SJB has recognized
the tire pressure sensors during the training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensors.
8. NOTE: DTC C2780 will not clear if any other DTCs are present in the SJB.
Carry out the SJB on-demand self-test, clear DTCs, and then retrieve all DTCs to confirm all DTCs
have been cleared.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Relay Box: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6862
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6863
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6864
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6865
Relay Box: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6866
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6867
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6868
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Relay Box: Diagrams Battery Junction Box (BJB)
C1035A
C1035B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 6871
Relay Box: Diagrams Smart Junction Box (SJB)
C2280A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 6872
C2280B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 6873
C2280C
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 6874
C2280D
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 6875
C2280E
C2280F
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 6876
C2280G
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Relay Box: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6879
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6880
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6881
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6882
Relay Box: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6883
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6884
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6885
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Relay Box: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6890
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6891
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6892
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6893
Relay Box: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6894
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6895
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6896
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery
Junction Box (BJB)
Relay Box: Diagrams Battery Junction Box (BJB)
C1035A
C1035B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) > Page 6899
Relay Box: Diagrams Smart Junction Box (SJB)
C2280A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) > Page 6900
C2280B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) > Page 6901
C2280C
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) > Page 6902
C2280D
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) > Page 6903
C2280E
C2280F
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) > Page 6904
C2280G
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Relay Box: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6907
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6908
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6909
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6910
Relay Box: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6911
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6912
Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) / Power Distribution Box > Page 6913
Smart Junction Box (SJB) / Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wiring Harness: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set
Wiring Harness: Customer Interest Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set
TSB 10-1-8
02/01/10
PCM - BATTERY JUNCTION BOX (BJB) - POSSIBLE MIL ON WITH MULTIPLE DTCS, NO
CRANK/NO START, DRIVABILITY SYMPTOMS
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 7-16-5 to remove the production build date and TSB 7-17-9 to update
the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles may exhibit concerns that results in no crank/start,
buck/jerk, lack/loss of power and/or malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) with one or more diagnostic
trouble codes (DTCs) present. This could be caused by a poor fuse terminal fit, loose or unseated
wire terminal connection at the Battery Junction Box (BJB) located near the battery under the hood.
ACTION If loose and/or unseated wiring terminals for fuses and relays are found in the BJB, follow
the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the vehicle battery.
2. Open the BJB top cover. (Figure 1)
3. Check for loose fuse connections in the BJB at fuse positions 30, 31, 32, 33, and 34. If poor
terminal fit is present, note those fuse cavities for Step 6.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wiring Harness: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set >
Page 6922
4. Remove all the mini fuses, relays and diodes (suggest taking a picture of the layout so install is
easier). (Figure 2)
a. Do not remove the cartridge fuses from the BJB.
5. Remove the light gray retainer that the devices were plugged through. This will expose the
terminals within the plastic housing. (Figure 3)
6. Locate the terminal cavities identified in procedure Step 3 that require repair. The tuning forks
will be off center in relation to the plastic cavities or
open.
7. Insert a small flat blade screw driver/pick tool into the suspect tuning fork slot. The flat blade
screw driver/pick tool width should be a maximum of
0.05" (1.25 mm) to provide access into the cavity. Tip dimensions were 0.04" x 0.04" (1 mm x 1
mm) with a 45 degree taper).
8. The small flat blade screw driver/pick tool should be inserted to the outside of the tuning fork leg
between the tuning fork leg and the plastic wall of
the housing cavity. (Figure 4)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wiring Harness: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set >
Page 6923
9. Pry the screw driver/pick tool against the plastic cavity wall and against the side of the tuning
fork leg. This will move the tuning fork legs together,
tuning fork legs should be close to touching. (Figure 5)
10. Next remove the BJB from the splash shield. (Figure 6)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wiring Harness: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set >
Page 6924
a. Tug on the underside wires to determine the unseated terminal location. (Figures 7 and 8)
NOTE
THIS MAY REQUIRE SOME LEVEL OF HARNESS REMOVAL FROM THE VEHICLE MOUNTING
LOCATIONS TO ADEQUATELY ACCESS THE LEADS ON THE UNDERSIDE OF THE BJB
BLOCK.
11. Any circuits that do not offer any resistance during the tugging operation should be reseated
using the Push-Click-Tug method.
a. Push the terminal back into the cavity.
b. Listen for an audible click to assure lock engagement.
c. Tug on the lead to insure a proper seat occurred.
12. Once all the BJB circuits have been verified as seated, proceed to the next steps.
13. Install and lock the BJB block back into the splash shield.
14. Install the light gray retainer.
15. Reinstall all the mini fuses, relays and diodes back into their specific locations.
a. Make sure all the relays are replaced in the proper orientation.
16. Close the BJB cover.
17. Reconnect the vehicle battery cable.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100108A 2007 Edge, MKX: Follow 0.6 Hr.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wiring Harness: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set >
Page 6925
The Service Procedure To Check For And Repair Loose/Unseated Wiring Terminals (Do Not Use
With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14290 X2
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No
Start/DTC's Set
Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No Start/DTC's Set
TSB 10-1-8
02/01/10
PCM - BATTERY JUNCTION BOX (BJB) - POSSIBLE MIL ON WITH MULTIPLE DTCS, NO
CRANK/NO START, DRIVABILITY SYMPTOMS
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 7-16-5 to remove the production build date and TSB 7-17-9 to update
the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles may exhibit concerns that results in no crank/start,
buck/jerk, lack/loss of power and/or malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) with one or more diagnostic
trouble codes (DTCs) present. This could be caused by a poor fuse terminal fit, loose or unseated
wire terminal connection at the Battery Junction Box (BJB) located near the battery under the hood.
ACTION If loose and/or unseated wiring terminals for fuses and relays are found in the BJB, follow
the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the vehicle battery.
2. Open the BJB top cover. (Figure 1)
3. Check for loose fuse connections in the BJB at fuse positions 30, 31, 32, 33, and 34. If poor
terminal fit is present, note those fuse cavities for Step 6.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No
Start/DTC's Set > Page 6931
4. Remove all the mini fuses, relays and diodes (suggest taking a picture of the layout so install is
easier). (Figure 2)
a. Do not remove the cartridge fuses from the BJB.
5. Remove the light gray retainer that the devices were plugged through. This will expose the
terminals within the plastic housing. (Figure 3)
6. Locate the terminal cavities identified in procedure Step 3 that require repair. The tuning forks
will be off center in relation to the plastic cavities or
open.
7. Insert a small flat blade screw driver/pick tool into the suspect tuning fork slot. The flat blade
screw driver/pick tool width should be a maximum of
0.05" (1.25 mm) to provide access into the cavity. Tip dimensions were 0.04" x 0.04" (1 mm x 1
mm) with a 45 degree taper).
8. The small flat blade screw driver/pick tool should be inserted to the outside of the tuning fork leg
between the tuning fork leg and the plastic wall of
the housing cavity. (Figure 4)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No
Start/DTC's Set > Page 6932
9. Pry the screw driver/pick tool against the plastic cavity wall and against the side of the tuning
fork leg. This will move the tuning fork legs together,
tuning fork legs should be close to touching. (Figure 5)
10. Next remove the BJB from the splash shield. (Figure 6)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No
Start/DTC's Set > Page 6933
a. Tug on the underside wires to determine the unseated terminal location. (Figures 7 and 8)
NOTE
THIS MAY REQUIRE SOME LEVEL OF HARNESS REMOVAL FROM THE VEHICLE MOUNTING
LOCATIONS TO ADEQUATELY ACCESS THE LEADS ON THE UNDERSIDE OF THE BJB
BLOCK.
11. Any circuits that do not offer any resistance during the tugging operation should be reseated
using the Push-Click-Tug method.
a. Push the terminal back into the cavity.
b. Listen for an audible click to assure lock engagement.
c. Tug on the lead to insure a proper seat occurred.
12. Once all the BJB circuits have been verified as seated, proceed to the next steps.
13. Install and lock the BJB block back into the splash shield.
14. Install the light gray retainer.
15. Reinstall all the mini fuses, relays and diodes back into their specific locations.
a. Make sure all the relays are replaced in the proper orientation.
16. Close the BJB cover.
17. Reconnect the vehicle battery cable.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100108A 2007 Edge, MKX: Follow 0.6 Hr.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-1-8 > Feb > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/No Crank/No
Start/DTC's Set > Page 6934
The Service Procedure To Check For And Repair Loose/Unseated Wiring Terminals (Do Not Use
With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14290 X2
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Alignment: > 08-7-3 > Apr > 08 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pull or Drift Condition
Alignment: Customer Interest Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pull or Drift Condition
TSB 08-7-3
04/14/08
PULL/DRIFT
FORD: 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 07-7-6 to update the original TSB to add model years. No other
changes made.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Ford Edge and Lincoln MKX vehicles may exhibit a drift/pull concern that
occurs even though the tire pressures and wheel alignment are within specifications, and the
concern is not corrected by rotating the front tires left to right.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Verify that drift/pull is not being caused by concerns listed in Workshop Manual (WSM), Section
204-00 drift/pull diagnostics. If normal drift/pull WSM diagnostics/procedures do not resolve the
concern then refer to the following service steps.
NOTE
THIS SERVICE PROCEDURE MAY CAUSE THE FRONT CROSS CAMBER (TOTAL/SPLIT)
ALIGNMENT VALUE TO EXCEED THE SERVICE MANUAL SPECIFICATION OF 0.00 +/- 0.75
DEGREES. DO NOT EXCEED +/- 1.2 DEGREES OF CROSS CAMBER.
For a Right Drift/Pull
1. Inspect the left strut upper plate to verify which direction the arrow is pointing. (Figure 1)
NOTE
IF THE NOTCH IS VISIBLE IN THE ACCESS HOLE IN THE STRUT TOWER, THE PLATE HAS
ALREADY BEEN ROTATED A POSITIVE 0.5 DEGREE.
2. If the arrow is pointing inboard as seen through the access hole in Figure 1, no rotation is
necessary (positive 0.5 degree camber already there).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Alignment: > 08-7-3 > Apr > 08 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pull or Drift Condition > Page 6944
Continue with Step 4.
3. If the arrow is pointing outboard, increase positive camber approximately 0.5 degrees on the left
front wheel by rotating the upper strut plate 180 degrees. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Camber
Adjustment - Front.
NOTE
DISCONNECT THE FRONT STABILIZER BAR LINK AT THE LOWER CONTROL ARM SO THAT
ENOUGH CLEARANCE CAN BE OBTAINED TO ROTATE THE UPPER STRUT MOUNT.
REPLACE THE STABILIZER BAR LINK NUT ON REASSEMBLY.
NOTE
REPLACE THE FOUR (4) UPPER STRUT MOUNT NUTS.
4. Place vehicle on alignment rack. Remove and replace the two (2) right front shock absorber
(strut) to wheel knuckle lower flag bolts and nuts but do not tighten. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
5. With full vehicle weight on the wheels allow the right wheel to increase negative camber and
tighten both lower flag bolts and nuts to 166 lb-ft (225 N.m). The camber shift may vary between
vehicles, but will typically be between a negative 0.2 and negative 0.6 degrees of camber change.
Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
6. Reset front toe adjustment to proper specifications. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Toe
Adjustment - Front.
For a Left Drift/Pull
1. Inspect the right strut upper plate to verify which direction the arrow is pointing. (Figure 1)
NOTE
IF THE NOTCH IS VISIBLE IN THE ACCESS HOLE IN THE STRUT TOWER, THE PLATE HAS
ALREADY BEEN ROTATED A POSITIVE 0.5 DEGREE.
2. If the arrow is pointing inboard, as seen through the access hole in Figure 1, no rotation is
necessary (positive 0.5 degree camber already there). Continue with Step 4.
3. If the arrow is pointing outboard, increase positive camber approximately 0.5 degrees on the
right front wheel by rotating the upper strut plate 180 degrees. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00,
Camber Adjustment - Front.
NOTE
DISCONNECT THE FRONT STABILIZER BAR LINK AT THE LOWER CONTROL ARM SO THAT
ENOUGH CLEARANCE CAN BE OBTAINED TO ROTATE THE UPPER STRUT MOUNT.
REPLACE THE STABILIZER BAR LINK NUT ON REASSEMBLY.
NOTE
REPLACE THE FOUR (4) UPPER STRUT MOUNT NUTS.
4. Place vehicle on alignment rack. Remove and replace the two (2) left front shock absorber (strut)
to wheel knuckle lower flag bolts and nuts but do not tighten. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
5. With full vehicle weight on the wheels allow the left wheel to increase negative camber and
tighten both lower flag bolts and nuts to 166 lb-ft (225 N.m). The camber shift may vary between
vehicles, but will typically be between a negative 0.2 and a negative 0.6 degrees of camber
change. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
6. Reset front toe adjustment to proper specifications. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Toe
Adjustment - Front.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Alignment: > 08-7-3 > Apr > 08 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pull or Drift Condition > Page 6945
080703A 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.4 Hrs.
Increase Positive Camber Following Service Procedure. Includes Inspect Upper Strut Plate. (Do
Not Use With 3001A, 3001A1)
080703B 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.8 Hrs.
Increase Positive Camber Following Service Procedure. Includes Inspect and Rotate Upper Strut
Plate. (Do Not Use With 3001A, 3001A1)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
FRONT W6
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 08-7-3 > Apr > 08 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pull or Drift Condition
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pull or Drift Condition
TSB 08-7-3
04/14/08
PULL/DRIFT
FORD: 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 07-7-6 to update the original TSB to add model years. No other
changes made.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Ford Edge and Lincoln MKX vehicles may exhibit a drift/pull concern that
occurs even though the tire pressures and wheel alignment are within specifications, and the
concern is not corrected by rotating the front tires left to right.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Verify that drift/pull is not being caused by concerns listed in Workshop Manual (WSM), Section
204-00 drift/pull diagnostics. If normal drift/pull WSM diagnostics/procedures do not resolve the
concern then refer to the following service steps.
NOTE
THIS SERVICE PROCEDURE MAY CAUSE THE FRONT CROSS CAMBER (TOTAL/SPLIT)
ALIGNMENT VALUE TO EXCEED THE SERVICE MANUAL SPECIFICATION OF 0.00 +/- 0.75
DEGREES. DO NOT EXCEED +/- 1.2 DEGREES OF CROSS CAMBER.
For a Right Drift/Pull
1. Inspect the left strut upper plate to verify which direction the arrow is pointing. (Figure 1)
NOTE
IF THE NOTCH IS VISIBLE IN THE ACCESS HOLE IN THE STRUT TOWER, THE PLATE HAS
ALREADY BEEN ROTATED A POSITIVE 0.5 DEGREE.
2. If the arrow is pointing inboard as seen through the access hole in Figure 1, no rotation is
necessary (positive 0.5 degree camber already there).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 08-7-3 > Apr > 08 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pull or Drift Condition >
Page 6951
Continue with Step 4.
3. If the arrow is pointing outboard, increase positive camber approximately 0.5 degrees on the left
front wheel by rotating the upper strut plate 180 degrees. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Camber
Adjustment - Front.
NOTE
DISCONNECT THE FRONT STABILIZER BAR LINK AT THE LOWER CONTROL ARM SO THAT
ENOUGH CLEARANCE CAN BE OBTAINED TO ROTATE THE UPPER STRUT MOUNT.
REPLACE THE STABILIZER BAR LINK NUT ON REASSEMBLY.
NOTE
REPLACE THE FOUR (4) UPPER STRUT MOUNT NUTS.
4. Place vehicle on alignment rack. Remove and replace the two (2) right front shock absorber
(strut) to wheel knuckle lower flag bolts and nuts but do not tighten. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
5. With full vehicle weight on the wheels allow the right wheel to increase negative camber and
tighten both lower flag bolts and nuts to 166 lb-ft (225 N.m). The camber shift may vary between
vehicles, but will typically be between a negative 0.2 and negative 0.6 degrees of camber change.
Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
6. Reset front toe adjustment to proper specifications. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Toe
Adjustment - Front.
For a Left Drift/Pull
1. Inspect the right strut upper plate to verify which direction the arrow is pointing. (Figure 1)
NOTE
IF THE NOTCH IS VISIBLE IN THE ACCESS HOLE IN THE STRUT TOWER, THE PLATE HAS
ALREADY BEEN ROTATED A POSITIVE 0.5 DEGREE.
2. If the arrow is pointing inboard, as seen through the access hole in Figure 1, no rotation is
necessary (positive 0.5 degree camber already there). Continue with Step 4.
3. If the arrow is pointing outboard, increase positive camber approximately 0.5 degrees on the
right front wheel by rotating the upper strut plate 180 degrees. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00,
Camber Adjustment - Front.
NOTE
DISCONNECT THE FRONT STABILIZER BAR LINK AT THE LOWER CONTROL ARM SO THAT
ENOUGH CLEARANCE CAN BE OBTAINED TO ROTATE THE UPPER STRUT MOUNT.
REPLACE THE STABILIZER BAR LINK NUT ON REASSEMBLY.
NOTE
REPLACE THE FOUR (4) UPPER STRUT MOUNT NUTS.
4. Place vehicle on alignment rack. Remove and replace the two (2) left front shock absorber (strut)
to wheel knuckle lower flag bolts and nuts but do not tighten. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
5. With full vehicle weight on the wheels allow the left wheel to increase negative camber and
tighten both lower flag bolts and nuts to 166 lb-ft (225 N.m). The camber shift may vary between
vehicles, but will typically be between a negative 0.2 and a negative 0.6 degrees of camber
change. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
6. Reset front toe adjustment to proper specifications. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Toe
Adjustment - Front.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 08-7-3 > Apr > 08 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pull or Drift Condition >
Page 6952
080703A 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.4 Hrs.
Increase Positive Camber Following Service Procedure. Includes Inspect Upper Strut Plate. (Do
Not Use With 3001A, 3001A1)
080703B 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.8 Hrs.
Increase Positive Camber Following Service Procedure. Includes Inspect and Rotate Upper Strut
Plate. (Do Not Use With 3001A, 3001A1)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
FRONT W6
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 6953
Alignment: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 08-7-3 Date: 080414
Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pull or Drift Condition
TSB 08-7-3
04/14/08
PULL/DRIFT
FORD: 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 07-7-6 to update the original TSB to add model years. No other
changes made.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Ford Edge and Lincoln MKX vehicles may exhibit a drift/pull concern that
occurs even though the tire pressures and wheel alignment are within specifications, and the
concern is not corrected by rotating the front tires left to right.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Verify that drift/pull is not being caused by concerns listed in Workshop Manual (WSM), Section
204-00 drift/pull diagnostics. If normal drift/pull WSM diagnostics/procedures do not resolve the
concern then refer to the following service steps.
NOTE
THIS SERVICE PROCEDURE MAY CAUSE THE FRONT CROSS CAMBER (TOTAL/SPLIT)
ALIGNMENT VALUE TO EXCEED THE SERVICE MANUAL SPECIFICATION OF 0.00 +/- 0.75
DEGREES. DO NOT EXCEED +/- 1.2 DEGREES OF CROSS CAMBER.
For a Right Drift/Pull
1. Inspect the left strut upper plate to verify which direction the arrow is pointing. (Figure 1)
NOTE
IF THE NOTCH IS VISIBLE IN THE ACCESS HOLE IN THE STRUT TOWER, THE PLATE HAS
ALREADY BEEN ROTATED A POSITIVE
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 6954
0.5 DEGREE.
2. If the arrow is pointing inboard as seen through the access hole in Figure 1, no rotation is
necessary (positive 0.5 degree camber already there). Continue with Step 4.
3. If the arrow is pointing outboard, increase positive camber approximately 0.5 degrees on the left
front wheel by rotating the upper strut plate 180 degrees. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Camber
Adjustment - Front.
NOTE
DISCONNECT THE FRONT STABILIZER BAR LINK AT THE LOWER CONTROL ARM SO THAT
ENOUGH CLEARANCE CAN BE OBTAINED TO ROTATE THE UPPER STRUT MOUNT.
REPLACE THE STABILIZER BAR LINK NUT ON REASSEMBLY.
NOTE
REPLACE THE FOUR (4) UPPER STRUT MOUNT NUTS.
4. Place vehicle on alignment rack. Remove and replace the two (2) right front shock absorber
(strut) to wheel knuckle lower flag bolts and nuts but do not tighten. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
5. With full vehicle weight on the wheels allow the right wheel to increase negative camber and
tighten both lower flag bolts and nuts to 166 lb-ft (225 N.m). The camber shift may vary between
vehicles, but will typically be between a negative 0.2 and negative 0.6 degrees of camber change.
Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
6. Reset front toe adjustment to proper specifications. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Toe
Adjustment - Front.
For a Left Drift/Pull
1. Inspect the right strut upper plate to verify which direction the arrow is pointing. (Figure 1)
NOTE
IF THE NOTCH IS VISIBLE IN THE ACCESS HOLE IN THE STRUT TOWER, THE PLATE HAS
ALREADY BEEN ROTATED A POSITIVE 0.5 DEGREE.
2. If the arrow is pointing inboard, as seen through the access hole in Figure 1, no rotation is
necessary (positive 0.5 degree camber already there). Continue with Step 4.
3. If the arrow is pointing outboard, increase positive camber approximately 0.5 degrees on the
right front wheel by rotating the upper strut plate 180 degrees. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00,
Camber Adjustment - Front.
NOTE
DISCONNECT THE FRONT STABILIZER BAR LINK AT THE LOWER CONTROL ARM SO THAT
ENOUGH CLEARANCE CAN BE OBTAINED TO ROTATE THE UPPER STRUT MOUNT.
REPLACE THE STABILIZER BAR LINK NUT ON REASSEMBLY.
NOTE
REPLACE THE FOUR (4) UPPER STRUT MOUNT NUTS.
4. Place vehicle on alignment rack. Remove and replace the two (2) left front shock absorber (strut)
to wheel knuckle lower flag bolts and nuts but do not tighten. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
5. With full vehicle weight on the wheels allow the left wheel to increase negative camber and
tighten both lower flag bolts and nuts to 166 lb-ft (225 N.m). The camber shift may vary between
vehicles, but will typically be between a negative 0.2 and a negative 0.6 degrees of camber
change. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
6. Reset front toe adjustment to proper specifications. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Toe
Adjustment - Front.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 6955
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
080703A 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.4 Hrs.
Increase Positive Camber Following Service Procedure. Includes Inspect Upper Strut Plate. (Do
Not Use With 3001A, 3001A1)
080703B 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.8 Hrs.
Increase Positive Camber Following Service Procedure. Includes Inspect and Rotate Upper Strut
Plate. (Do Not Use With 3001A, 3001A1)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
FRONT W6
Disclaimer
Technical Service Bulletin # 08-7-3 Date: 080414
Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pull or Drift Condition
TSB 08-7-3
04/14/08
PULL/DRIFT
FORD: 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 07-7-6 to update the original TSB to add model years. No other
changes made.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Ford Edge and Lincoln MKX vehicles may exhibit a drift/pull concern that
occurs even though the tire pressures and wheel alignment are within specifications, and the
concern is not corrected by rotating the front tires left to right.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Verify that drift/pull is not being caused by concerns listed in Workshop Manual (WSM), Section
204-00 drift/pull diagnostics. If normal drift/pull WSM diagnostics/procedures do not resolve the
concern then refer to the following service steps.
NOTE
THIS SERVICE PROCEDURE MAY CAUSE THE FRONT CROSS CAMBER (TOTAL/SPLIT)
ALIGNMENT VALUE TO EXCEED THE SERVICE MANUAL SPECIFICATION OF 0.00 +/- 0.75
DEGREES. DO NOT EXCEED +/- 1.2 DEGREES OF CROSS CAMBER.
For a Right Drift/Pull
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 6956
1. Inspect the left strut upper plate to verify which direction the arrow is pointing. (Figure 1)
NOTE
IF THE NOTCH IS VISIBLE IN THE ACCESS HOLE IN THE STRUT TOWER, THE PLATE HAS
ALREADY BEEN ROTATED A POSITIVE 0.5 DEGREE.
2. If the arrow is pointing inboard as seen through the access hole in Figure 1, no rotation is
necessary (positive 0.5 degree camber already there). Continue with Step 4.
3. If the arrow is pointing outboard, increase positive camber approximately 0.5 degrees on the left
front wheel by rotating the upper strut plate 180 degrees. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Camber
Adjustment - Front.
NOTE
DISCONNECT THE FRONT STABILIZER BAR LINK AT THE LOWER CONTROL ARM SO THAT
ENOUGH CLEARANCE CAN BE OBTAINED TO ROTATE THE UPPER STRUT MOUNT.
REPLACE THE STABILIZER BAR LINK NUT ON REASSEMBLY.
NOTE
REPLACE THE FOUR (4) UPPER STRUT MOUNT NUTS.
4. Place vehicle on alignment rack. Remove and replace the two (2) right front shock absorber
(strut) to wheel knuckle lower flag bolts and nuts but do not tighten. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
5. With full vehicle weight on the wheels allow the right wheel to increase negative camber and
tighten both lower flag bolts and nuts to 166 lb-ft (225 N.m). The camber shift may vary between
vehicles, but will typically be between a negative 0.2 and negative 0.6 degrees of camber change.
Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
6. Reset front toe adjustment to proper specifications. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Toe
Adjustment - Front.
For a Left Drift/Pull
1. Inspect the right strut upper plate to verify which direction the arrow is pointing. (Figure 1)
NOTE
IF THE NOTCH IS VISIBLE IN THE ACCESS HOLE IN THE STRUT TOWER, THE PLATE HAS
ALREADY BEEN ROTATED A POSITIVE 0.5 DEGREE.
2. If the arrow is pointing inboard, as seen through the access hole in Figure 1, no rotation is
necessary (positive 0.5 degree camber already there). Continue with Step 4.
3. If the arrow is pointing outboard, increase positive camber approximately 0.5 degrees on the
right front wheel by rotating the upper strut plate 180 degrees. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00,
Camber Adjustment - Front.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 6957
NOTE
DISCONNECT THE FRONT STABILIZER BAR LINK AT THE LOWER CONTROL ARM SO THAT
ENOUGH CLEARANCE CAN BE OBTAINED TO ROTATE THE UPPER STRUT MOUNT.
REPLACE THE STABILIZER BAR LINK NUT ON REASSEMBLY.
NOTE
REPLACE THE FOUR (4) UPPER STRUT MOUNT NUTS.
4. Place vehicle on alignment rack. Remove and replace the two (2) left front shock absorber (strut)
to wheel knuckle lower flag bolts and nuts but do not tighten. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
5. With full vehicle weight on the wheels allow the left wheel to increase negative camber and
tighten both lower flag bolts and nuts to 166 lb-ft (225 N.m). The camber shift may vary between
vehicles, but will typically be between a negative 0.2 and a negative 0.6 degrees of camber
change. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
6. Reset front toe adjustment to proper specifications. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Toe
Adjustment - Front.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
080703A 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.4 Hrs.
Increase Positive Camber Following Service Procedure. Includes Inspect Upper Strut Plate. (Do
Not Use With 3001A, 3001A1)
080703B 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.8 Hrs.
Increase Positive Camber Following Service Procedure. Includes Inspect and Rotate Upper Strut
Plate. (Do Not Use With 3001A, 3001A1)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
FRONT W6
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications > Page 6960
Ride Height
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications > Page 6961
Bushing Fastener Tightening Height
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications > Page 6962
Alignment: Specifications General Specifications
General Specifications
Ride Height
Bushing Fastener Tightening Height
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications > Page 6963
Alignment: Specifications
Ride Height
Bushing Fastener Tightening Height
General Specifications
General Specifications
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications > Page 6964
Ride Height
Bushing Fastener Tightening Height
Ball Joint Deflection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 6965
Alignment: Description and Operation
Wheel Alignment Angles
NOTE: When making rear alignment adjustments, it is important to know that when adjustments
are made to the rear toe, the rear camber will also be adjusted (in the same direction as the toe
adjustment). When making adjustments to the rear camber, the rear toe will also be adjusted (in
the opposite direction of the camber adjustment). It will be necessary to check the rear camber
whenever rear toe adjustments are made and to check the rear toe whenever rear camber
adjustments are made.
Front toe is adjusted through the use of adjustable tie-rod ends. Front camber is adjusted through
the use of the upper strut plate. Rotating the upper strut plate 180 degrees will change the camber
+0.5 degrees. Front caster is not adjustable on the vehicle. Rear toe is adjusted through the use of
adjustable toe link cams. Rear camber is adjusted through the use of a cam bolt that attaches the
rear lower control arm to the rear subframe.
Camber
Negative and Positive Camber
Camber is the vertical tilt of the wheel when viewed from the front. Camber can be positive or
negative and has a direct affect on tire wear.
Caster
Caster
Caster is the deviation from vertical of an imaginary line drawn through the ball joints when viewed
from the side. The caster specifications will give the vehicle the best directional stability
characteristics when loaded and driven. The caster setting is not related to tire wear.
Toe
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 6966
Positive Toe (Toe In)
Negative Toe (Toe Out)
The vehicle toe setting affects tire wear and directional stability.
Ride Height If there is a ride height concern, such as the front or rear of the vehicle being higher or
lower than normal or an apparent lean, it should be corrected before aligning the vehicle. Any
heavy items such as tool boxes, sample cases or any other items should be removed.
If no unusual load is present, check for damaged components or nonstandard replacement
suspension components.
To measure ride height, the vehicle must be in a level, static ground position with full fluids and a
full fuel tank.
Front Ride Height (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 6967
Front Ride Height (Part 2)
Rear Ride Height Measurement
Wander Wander is the tendency of the vehicle to require frequent, random left and right steering
wheel corrections to maintain a straight path down a level road.
Shimmy Shimmy, as observed by the driver, is large, consistent, rotational oscillations of the
steering wheel resulting from large, side-to-side (lateral) tire/wheel movements.
Shimmy is usually experienced near 64 km/h (40 mph), and can begin or be amplified when the tire
contacts pot holes or irregularities in the road surface. Nibble Sometimes confused with shimmy,
nibble is a condition resulting from tire interaction with various road surfaces and observed by the
driver as small rotational oscillations of the steering wheel.
Poor Returnability/Sticky Steering Poor returnability and sticky steering is used to describe poor
return of the steering wheel to center after a turn or steering correction.
Drift/Pull Pull is a tugging sensation, felt by the hands on the steering wheel, that must be
overcome to keep the vehicle going straight.
Drift describes what a vehicle with this condition does with hands off the steering wheel.
^ A vehicle-related drift/pull, on a flat road, will cause a consistent deviation from the straight-ahead
path and require constant steering input in the opposite direction to counteract the effect.
^ Drift/pull may be induced by conditions external to the vehicle (for example, wind, road crown).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 6968
Poor Groove Feel Poor groove feel is characterized by little or no buildup of turning effort felt in the
steering wheel as the wheel is rocked slowly left and right within very small around center or
straight-ahead (under 20 degrees of steering wheel turn). Efforts may be said to be "flat on center."
^ Under 20 degrees of turn, most of the turning effort that builds up comes from the mesh of gear
teeth in the steering gear. In this range, the steering wheel is not yet turned enough to feel the
effort from the self-aligning forces at the road wheel or tire patch.
^ In the diagnosis of a roadability problem, it is important to understand the difference between
wander and poor groove feel.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber
Adjustment - Front
Alignment: Service and Repair Camber Adjustment - Front
Camber Adjustment - Front
NOTE: Front camber is adjusted through the use of the upper strut plate. Rotating the upper strut
plate 180 degrees will change the camber +0.5 degrees.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturer's instructions, measure the camber. 2.
Remove the 4 strut upper mounting plate nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs).
3. Using a suitable jack, raise the vehicle body enough to allow the front strut upper plate mounting
studs to clear the frame.
4. NOTE: Rotating the upper strut plate 180 degrees will change the camber +0.5 degrees.
Rotate the upper mounting plate 180 degrees.
5. Recheck the front camber settings. 6. Check and, if necessary, adjust the front toe.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber
Adjustment - Front > Page 6971
Alignment: Service and Repair Toe Adjustment - Front
Toe Adjustment - Front
1. Start the engine and center the steering wheel. 2. Turn the engine OFF and, using a suitable
steering wheel holding device, lock the steering wheel in the straight ahead position. 3. Using
alignment equipment and the manufacturer's instructions, measure the front toe. 4. Remove the
steering gear bellows clamps.
5. Loosen the tie-rod jam nuts.
6. NOTE: Do not allow the steering gear bellows to twist when the tie rod is rotated.
Rotate the tie rods until the toe setting is within specifications.
7. Tighten the jam nuts to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs). 8. Install the steering gear bellows clamps.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber
Adjustment - Front > Page 6972
Alignment: Service and Repair Toe Adjustment - Rear
Toe Adjustment - Rear
NOTE: When making rear alignment adjustments, it is important to know that when adjustments
are made to the rear toe, the rear camber will also be adjusted (in the same direction as the toe
adjustment). When making adjustments to the rear camber, the rear toe will also be adjusted (in
the opposite direction of the camber adjustment). It will be necessary to check the rear camber
whenever rear toe adjustments are made and to check the rear toe whenever rear camber
adjustments are made.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturer's instructions, measure the rear toe. 2. Loosen
the toe link inboard bolt. 3. Rotate the toe link adjuster cam until the toe setting is within
specifications.
4. CAUTION: Before tightening any suspension bushing fasteners, the suspension must be at the
bushing fastener tightening position.
NOTE: Do not allow the toe link adjuster can to rotate while tightening the bolt.
Tighten the toe link inboard bolt to 200 Nm (148 ft. lbs).
5. Recheck the rear toe and camber.
^ Adjust as necessary.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber
Adjustment - Front > Page 6973
Alignment: Service and Repair Camber Adjustment - Rear
Camber Adjustment - Rear
CAUTION: Before tightening any suspension bushing fasteners, the suspension must be at the
bushing fastener tightening position.
NOTE: When making rear alignment adjustments, it is important to know that when adjustments
are made to the rear camber the rear toe will also be affected. Also when adjusting the rear toe, the
rear camber will be affected. It will be necessary to check the rear toe whenever rear camber
adjustments are made and to check the rear camber whenever rear toe adjustments are made.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturer's instructions, measure the rear camber. 2.
Loosen the lower arm cam bolt. 3. Rotate the camber adjustment bolt until the camber setting is
within specifications.
4. CAUTION: Before tightening any suspension bushing fasteners, the weight of the vehicle must
be resting on the wheels and tires or
incorrect clamp load and bushing damage may occure..
NOTE: Do not allow the camber cam adjuster to rotate while tightening the bolt.
Tighten the lower arm cam bolt to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs).
5. Recheck the rear camber and toe.
^ Adjust as necessary.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6979
C1121
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Power
Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Switch
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SWITCH
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
The PSP switch monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP switch
is a normally closed switch that opens as the hydraulic pressure increases. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the PSP circuit. When the PSP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The PCM uses the input signal from the PSP switch to compensate
for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the idle RPM and preventing engine stall during
parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP switch signals the PCM to adjust the transmission electronic
pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased engine load, for example during parking
maneuvers
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Power
Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch > Page 6982
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Sensor
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SENSOR
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
The PSP sensor monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP
sensor voltage input to the PCM changes as the hydraulic pressure changes. The PCM uses the
input signal from the PSP sensor to compensate for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the
idle RPM and preventing engine stall during parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP sensor signals the
PCM to adjust the transmission electronic pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased
engine load, for example, during parking maneuvers.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6986
C222
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6991
C222
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training
Special Tool(s)
NOTE: If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, the sensors will go into a "sleep
mode" to conserve battery power. It will be necessary to wake them up so they will transmit the
latest tire pressure information to the Smart Junction Box (SJB).
NOTE: The tire pressure sensor training procedure must be done on a single vehicle, in an area
without radio frequency noise and at least 1 m (3 ft) away from other vehicles equipped with a Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS).
Radio frequency noise is generated by electrical motors and appliance operation, cellular
telephones, remote transmitters, power inverters and portable entertainment equipment.
NOTE: If a sensor does not respond to the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool, attempt to
activate the same sensor with the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. If the sensor still does not
respond, move the vehicle to rotate the wheels at least one-fourth of a turn and attempt to activate
the same sensor again.
NOTE: The SJB has a 2-minute time limit between sensor responses. If the SJB does not
recognize any 1 of the 4 tire pressure sensors during this time limit, the horn will sound twice and
the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE NOT TRAINED REPEAT and the entire
procedure must be repeated.
NOTE: For vehicles with different front and rear tire pressures (such as the E-Series and certain
F-Series), the tire pressure sensors must be trained following a tire rotation. Failure to train the
sensors will cause the TPMS indicator to illuminate. For vehicles with the same tire pressure for
front and rear tires, tire rotation will not affect the system.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position, then press and release the brake pedal. 2. Cycle the
ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position. 3.
Press and release the brake pedal. 4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position. 5. Turn the
ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position.
- The horn will sound once and the TPMS indicator will flash if the training mode has been entered
successfully. If equipped, the message center will display TRAIN LF TIRE.
NOTE: It may take up to 6 seconds to activate a tire pressure sensor. During this time, the Tire
Pressure Monitor Activation Tool must remain in place 180 degrees from the valve stem.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 6996
6. Place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the LF tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees)
from the valve stem. Press and release the test
button on the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. The horn will sound briefly to indicate that the
tire pressure sensor has been recognized by the SJB.
7. Within 2 minutes of the horn sounding, place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the RF
tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees) from the
valve stem and press and release the test button to train the RF tire pressure sensor.
NOTE: Do not wait more than 2 minutes between training each sensor or the SJB will time out and
the entire procedure must be repeated.
8. Repeat Step 7 for the RR and LR tires.
The procedure is completed after the last tire has been trained. When the training procedure is
complete, the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE TRAINING COMPLETE. For vehicles
not equipped with a message center, successful completion of the training procedure will be
verified by turning the ignition switch to the OFF position without the horn sounding. If the horn
sounds twice when the switch is turned to the OFF position, the training procedure was not
successful.
9. Using the scan tool, locate the updated TPMS sensor identifiers trained to the SJB and
document them on the applicable warranty claim.
NOTE: This step is required to clear DTC C2780, cause the SJB to exit the manufacturing mode
and to make sure there are no other concerns with a newly programmed SJB.
10. If the sensors are being trained due to the installation of a new SJB, clear any DTCs and carry
out the SJB On-Demand Self Test.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Disassembly
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application.
When installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color
of the sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor can be removed and installed without removing the strap or the cradle.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
1. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Dismount the tire only as
instructed.
Remove the tire from the wheel.
2. CAUTION: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to
the sensor locking clip can occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the sensor locking clip.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 6999
3. CAUTION: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to
the sensor can occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver or similar tool, detach the sensor from the cradle.
4. Remove the sensor.
Assembly
1. CAUTION: Damage to the sensor can occur if excessive force is applied during sensor
installation.
NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the cradle. The sensor will make a "click" noise
when correctly seated.
Position the sensor into the cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end of the
cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. NOTE: The locking clip can only be fully seated when installed in the correct orientation. If the
sensor locking clip cannot be fully inserted, then
the sensor may not be fully seated on the cradle or the locking clip may be inserted backward.
Insert a new locking clip into the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 7000
3. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel.
4. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 7001
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and
Cradle
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and Cradle
Material
Disassembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 7002
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application.
When installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color
of the sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor is available separately, the cradle and strap are available as a strap kit. There
are several different strap kits available based on wheel diameter but all strap kits share the same
base part number.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
1. Remove the tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor.
2. WARNING: The TPMS band is under tension. Always use safety goggles or a face shield and
gloves when removing the TPMS
band/strap. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
Remove a factory installed strap in this sequence: 1
Locate the strap buckle and secure the strap to the wheel using duct tape or a similar item, on both
sides of the buckle approximately 25 mm (0.98 inch) from the buckle.
2 Using a large screwdriver and a twisting motion, unbuckle the strap.
3 Discard the strap.
3. To remove a dealer installed strap, turn the worm gear screw until the strap is fully released from
the worm gear.
^ Discard the strap.
4. NOTE: To aid assembly, mark the location of the cradle prior to disassembly.
Using a screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the cradle by inserting the screwdriver under the cradle
and prying up.
Assembly
1. NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the new cradle. The sensor will make a "click"
noise when fully seated.
Position the sensor into the new cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end
of the cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. CAUTION: Metal scrapers can damage the wheel. Use only plastic or non-metallic scrapers to
remove the cradle adhesive strip residue.
NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be installed in the drop well of the wheel, 180 degrees from the
valve stem.
Clean the area where the sensor and cradle are to be installed.
3. NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be positioned with the hinge side of the sensor on the RH
side when viewed from the curb side (beauty side)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 7003
of the wheel.
NOTE: The sensor has raised markings indicating how to position the sensor.
Remove the adhesive tape liner from the cradle and position the sensor and cradle into the wheel
drop well 180 degrees from the valve stem.
4. Install the tapered end of the strap through the opening of the cradle on the hinge side of the
sensor. This will position the worm gear on the
locking clip side of the sensor.
5. CAUTION: Steel wheels have a "high spot" along their circumference. Make sure the strap is
positioned in the lowest spot possible for
correct sensor and cradle retention.
NOTE: Keep the strap parallel with the wheel flange while tightening the worm gear.
Position the worm gear 13-26 mm (0.5-1.0 inch) away from the sensor and tighten the worm gear.
^
Tighten to 3 Nm (27 inch lbs).
6. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel.
7. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Front Steering Knuckle: Service and Repair
Wheel Knuckle
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 7008
Removal
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 7009
parts.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly.
2. NOTE: Apply the brake to keep the halfshaft from rotating.
Remove the halfshaft nut, halfshaft hub seal and halfshaft washer. ^
Discard the nut, seal and washer.
3. Remove the wheel speed sensor bolt and position the wheel speed sensor aside.
4. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper and anchor plate assembly to hang from the brake hose or
damage to the hose can occur.
Remove the 2 bolts and position the caliper and anchor plate assembly aside. ^
Support the caliper and anchor plate assembly using mechanic's wire.
5. Remove the brake disc. 6. Using the special tool, separate the halfshaft from the wheel hub.
7. Remove and discard the tie-rod end cotter pin and nut.
8. CAUTION: Do not use a hammer to separate the tie-rod end from the wheel knuckle or damage
to the wheel knuckle can result.
Using the special tool, separate the tie-rod end from the wheel knuckle.
9. Remove the shock absorber lower nuts and flag bolts.
^ Discard the nuts and flag bolts.
10. Remove the lower ball joint bolt, nut and the wheel knuckle.
^ Discard the bolt and nut.
Installation
1. Position the wheel knuckle and install the lower ball joint bolt and nut.
^ Tighten the nut to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs).
2. Install the shock absorber lower nuts and flag bolts.
^ Tighten to 225 Nm (166 ft. lbs).
3. Position the tie-rod end and install the nut and cotter pin.
^ Tighten to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs).
4. Position the wheel speed sensor and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 7 Nm (62 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 7010
5. Install the brake disc. 6. Position the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly and install the 2
bolts.
^ Tighten to 133 Nm (98 ft. lbs).
7. Using a suitable installation tool, install the halfshaft into the wheel hub.
8. CAUTION: Do not tighten the halfshaft nut with the vehicle on the ground. The nut must be
tightened to specification before the vehicle
is lowered onto the wheels. Wheel bearing damage will occur if the wheel bearing is loaded with
the weight of the vehicle applied.
NOTE: Apply the brake to keep the halfshaft from rotating.
Install the halfshaft hub seal, washer and nut. ^
Tighten to 225 Nm (185 ft. lbs).
9. Install the wheel and tire assembly.
10. Check and if necessary, adjust the alignment.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair
Power Steering Bleeding: Service and Repair
Power Steering System Purging
Special Tool(s)
Material
CAUTION: If the air is not purged from the power steering system correctly, premature power
steering pump failure can result. The condition can occur on pre-delivery vehicles with evidence of
aerated fluid or on vehicles that have had steering component repairs.
1. NOTE: A whine heard from the power steering pump can be caused by air in the system. The
power steering purge procedure must be carried out
prior to any component repair for which power steering noise complaints are accompanied by
evidence of aerated fluid.
Remove the power steering pump reservoir cap. Check the fluid.
2. Raise the front wheels off the floor. 3. Tightly insert the stopper of the vacuum pump into the
reservoir. 4. Start the engine. 5. Install the vacuum pump, apply vacuum and maintain the
maximum vacuum of 68-85 kPa (20-25 in-Hg). 6. If equipped with Hydro-Boost(R), apply the brake
pedal twice.
7. CAUTION: Do not hold the steering wheel against the stops for more than 3 to 5 seconds at a
time. Damage to the power steering pump
can occur.
Cycle the steering wheel fully from stop-to-stop 10 times.
8. Stop the engine. 9. Release the vacuum and remove the vacuum pump.
10. CAUTION: Do not overfill the reservoir.
Fill the reservoir. ^
Use approved transmission fluid.
11. Start the engine. 12. Install the vacuum pump. Apply and maintain the maximum vacuum of
68-85 kPa (20-25 in-Hg).
13. CAUTION: Do not hold the steering wheel against the stops for more than 3 to 5 seconds at a
time. Damage to the power steering pump
can occur.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 7015
Cycle the steering wheel fully from stop-to-stop 10 times.
14. Stop the engine, release the vacuum and remove the vacuum pump.
15. CAUTION: Do not overfill the reservoir.
Fill the reservoir as needed and install the reservoir cap.
16. Visually inspect the power steering system for leaks.
17. CAUTION: Do not overfill the reservoir.
Fill the reservoir as needed and visually inspect the power steering system for leaks.
18. Install the reservoir cap.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Specifications
Power Steering Fluid: Specifications
POWER STEERING FLUID
Motorcraft MERCON ATF
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
............................................................ XT-2-QDX Ford Specification .................................................
............................................................................................................................................ MERCON
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 7019
Power Steering Fluid: Testing and Inspection
Power Steering Fluid Leak Test
NOTE: This test should only be carried out if a leak in the system has not been detected during a
thorough visual inspection. Refer to Inspection and Verification. See: Testing and Inspection/Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview/Inspection and Verification
1. Check the power steering fluid level. If necessary, add the specified power steering fluid. 2.
Remove the power steering pump reservoir cap and tightly install the evacuation cap to the power
steering pump reservoir. 3. Install the hose from the fill adapter manifold tee to the evacuation cap
on the power steering pump reservoir. 4. Install the vacuum pump to the evacuation cap. 5. Using
the vacuum pump, apply 68-85 kPa (20-25 in-Hg) of vacuum to the power steering system. 6.
Observe the vacuum gauge for 30 seconds. If the vacuum gauge reading drops more than 3 kPa
(0.88 in-Hg) a leak is present. 7. Remove the vacuum pump.
8. CAUTION: Do not hold the steering wheel at the stops for more than 3-5 seconds. Damage to
the power steering pump can occur.
Start the engine. With the engine at idle, raise the power steering fluid temperature to 74-80°C
(165-176°F) by rotating the steering wheel fully to the left and right several times.
9. Visually inspect the system for leaks. If a leak is evident, repair as necessary. If a leak is not
evident, add the specified UV fluorescent tracer dye
to the power steering fluid. Use 14.78 mL (1/2 oz) of dye solution for every 1.89 L (2 qt) of power
steering fluid.
10. CAUTION: Do not hold the steering wheel at the stops for more than 3-5 seconds. Damage to
the power steering pump can occur.
Start the engine. With the engine at idle, raise the power steering fluid temperature to 74-80°C
(165-176°F) by rotating the steering wheel fully to the left and right several times.
11. NOTE: On vehicles with rack and pinion steering gear, it may be necessary to remove the
bellows boot clamp from the steering gear bellows
boots to inspect for internal steering gear leaks.
Using the special tool (UV lamp), inspect the system for traces of UV dye. Repair as necessary.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Cooler >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Steering Fluid Cooler: Service and Repair
Power Steering Fluid Cooler
Material
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
contaminants or premature failure of the power steering components can result.
1. Using a suitable suction device, siphon the power steering fluid from the power steering
reservoir. 2. Remove the front bumper cover. 3. Release the clamps and disconnect the power
steering hoses from the power steering fluid cooler.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Cooler >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 7023
4. Remove the power steering fluid cooler-to-subframe bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
5. Remove the 2 power steering fluid cooler nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 inch lbs).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Fill the power steering system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Reservoir >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Steering Fluid Reservoir: Service and Repair
Power Steering Fluid Reservoir
Material
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
contaminants or premature failure of the power steering components can result.
1. Using a suitable suction device, siphon the power steering fluid from the power steering fluid
reservoir. 2. Remove the 2 power steering fluid reservoir nuts and lift the reservoir from the
mounting studs.
^ To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs).
3. Release the clamp and disconnect the power steering return hose from the power steering fluid
reservoir. 4. Release the clamp and disconnect the power steering reservoir supply hose from the
power steering pump.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Reservoir >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 7027
^ Remove the reservoir.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Fill the power steering system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 07-25-14 > Dec
> 07 > Steering - Leaks From Steering Rack/Pump Areas
Power Steering Line/Hose: Customer Interest Steering - Leaks From Steering Rack/Pump Areas
TSB 07-25-14
12/24/07
POWER STEERING FLUID LEAKS FROM STEERING RACK AND PUMP ATTACHMENT
JOINTS
FORD: 2006-2008 Fusion 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2006 Zephyr 2007-2008 MKZ, MKX
MERCURY: 2006-2008 Milan
This article supersedes TSB 07-1-3 to update vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some 2006-2008 Fusion and Milan, 2006 Zephyr, 2007-2008 MKZ and 2007-2008 Edge
and MKX vehicles may exhibit a small power steering fluid leak at the line attachment areas of the
rack or the pump.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Replace the banjo bolt and the two (2) sealing washers following Workshop Manual, Section
211-02 using the service kit.
2. One (1) kit is used for one (1) joint (either pump or gear).
3. Joint must be torqued with a hand torque wrench to:
a. Fusion, Milan, Zephyr, and MKZ:
(1) Pump 35 lb-ft (47 N.m).
(2) Gear 41 lb-ft (55 N.m).
b. Edge and MKX:
(1) Pump 35 lb-ft (47 N.m).
(2) Gear 35 lb-ft (47 N.m).
NOTE
THIS NEW BANJO BOLT HAS A HIGHER TORQUE RATING TO ACHIEVE A HIGHER CLAMP
LOAD.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072514A 2006 Fusion, Milan, 0.6 Hr.
Zephyr, 2007-2008 Fusion
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 07-25-14 > Dec
> 07 > Steering - Leaks From Steering Rack/Pump Areas > Page 7036
Milan 2.3L: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear Or Power
Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
3674A5)
072514B 2006 Fusion, Milan, 0.7 Hr.
Zephyr, 2007-2008 Fusion Milan 2.3L: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH
Steering Gear And The Power Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System
(Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514C 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan 0.6 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Power Steering Pump. Includes
Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514D 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan 0.8 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear. Includes Time To
Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514E 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan, 0.9 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH Steering Gear And The Power
Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
3674A5)
072514F 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.5 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers on The Power Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill
And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514G 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.6 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear. Includes Time To Fill And
Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 07-25-14 > Dec
> 07 > Steering - Leaks From Steering Rack/Pump Areas > Page 7037
3674A5)
072514H 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.7 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH Steering Gear And The Power Steering
Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A 3674A5)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3A705 24
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Line/Hose: >
07-25-14 > Dec > 07 > Steering - Leaks From Steering Rack/Pump Areas
Power Steering Line/Hose: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Leaks From Steering
Rack/Pump Areas
TSB 07-25-14
12/24/07
POWER STEERING FLUID LEAKS FROM STEERING RACK AND PUMP ATTACHMENT
JOINTS
FORD: 2006-2008 Fusion 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2006 Zephyr 2007-2008 MKZ, MKX
MERCURY: 2006-2008 Milan
This article supersedes TSB 07-1-3 to update vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some 2006-2008 Fusion and Milan, 2006 Zephyr, 2007-2008 MKZ and 2007-2008 Edge
and MKX vehicles may exhibit a small power steering fluid leak at the line attachment areas of the
rack or the pump.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Replace the banjo bolt and the two (2) sealing washers following Workshop Manual, Section
211-02 using the service kit.
2. One (1) kit is used for one (1) joint (either pump or gear).
3. Joint must be torqued with a hand torque wrench to:
a. Fusion, Milan, Zephyr, and MKZ:
(1) Pump 35 lb-ft (47 N.m).
(2) Gear 41 lb-ft (55 N.m).
b. Edge and MKX:
(1) Pump 35 lb-ft (47 N.m).
(2) Gear 35 lb-ft (47 N.m).
NOTE
THIS NEW BANJO BOLT HAS A HIGHER TORQUE RATING TO ACHIEVE A HIGHER CLAMP
LOAD.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072514A 2006 Fusion, Milan, 0.6 Hr.
Zephyr, 2007-2008 Fusion
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Line/Hose: >
07-25-14 > Dec > 07 > Steering - Leaks From Steering Rack/Pump Areas > Page 7043
Milan 2.3L: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear Or Power
Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
3674A5)
072514B 2006 Fusion, Milan, 0.7 Hr.
Zephyr, 2007-2008 Fusion Milan 2.3L: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH
Steering Gear And The Power Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System
(Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514C 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan 0.6 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Power Steering Pump. Includes
Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514D 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan 0.8 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear. Includes Time To
Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514E 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan, 0.9 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH Steering Gear And The Power
Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
3674A5)
072514F 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.5 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers on The Power Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill
And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514G 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.6 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear. Includes Time To Fill And
Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Line/Hose: >
07-25-14 > Dec > 07 > Steering - Leaks From Steering Rack/Pump Areas > Page 7044
3674A5)
072514H 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.7 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH Steering Gear And The Power Steering
Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A 3674A5)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3A705 24
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose
Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose
Material
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
contaminants or premature failure of the power steering components can result.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Using a suitable suction device, siphon the power steering
fluid from the power steering fluid reservoir. 3. Remove the 4 pushpin retainers and the RH splash
shield.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose > Page 7047
4. Release the clamp and disconnect the power steering fluid cooler hose from the return line. 5.
Release the clamp and disconnect the return hose from the return line at the steering gear. 6.
Remove the 2 power steering return hose bracket-to-subframe bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Fill the power steering system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose > Page 7048
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure
Line
Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure Line
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose > Page 7049
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: When repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
contaminants or premature failure of the power steering components can result.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Using a suitable suction device, siphon the power steering
fluid from the power steering fluid reservoir. 3. Remove the power steering pressure line banjo bolt
and disconnect the line from the power steering gear.
^ Discard the 2 seals.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (44 ft. lbs).
4. Release the clamp and disconnect the return hose from the steering gear. 5. Release the clamp
and disconnect the return hose from the return line. 6. Remove the 3 power steering line
bracket-to-steering gear bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
7. Remove the power steering pressure line banjo bolt and disconnect the line from the power
steering pump.
^ Discard the 2 seals.
^ To install, tighten to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs).
8. To install, reverse removal procedure.
^ Fill the power steering system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Steering Pump: > 07-25-14 > Dec > 07 > Steering Leaks From Steering Rack/Pump Areas
Power Steering Pump: Customer Interest Steering - Leaks From Steering Rack/Pump Areas
TSB 07-25-14
12/24/07
POWER STEERING FLUID LEAKS FROM STEERING RACK AND PUMP ATTACHMENT
JOINTS
FORD: 2006-2008 Fusion 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2006 Zephyr 2007-2008 MKZ, MKX
MERCURY: 2006-2008 Milan
This article supersedes TSB 07-1-3 to update vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some 2006-2008 Fusion and Milan, 2006 Zephyr, 2007-2008 MKZ and 2007-2008 Edge
and MKX vehicles may exhibit a small power steering fluid leak at the line attachment areas of the
rack or the pump.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Replace the banjo bolt and the two (2) sealing washers following Workshop Manual, Section
211-02 using the service kit.
2. One (1) kit is used for one (1) joint (either pump or gear).
3. Joint must be torqued with a hand torque wrench to:
a. Fusion, Milan, Zephyr, and MKZ:
(1) Pump 35 lb-ft (47 N.m).
(2) Gear 41 lb-ft (55 N.m).
b. Edge and MKX:
(1) Pump 35 lb-ft (47 N.m).
(2) Gear 35 lb-ft (47 N.m).
NOTE
THIS NEW BANJO BOLT HAS A HIGHER TORQUE RATING TO ACHIEVE A HIGHER CLAMP
LOAD.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072514A 2006 Fusion, Milan, 0.6 Hr.
Zephyr, 2007-2008 Fusion
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Steering Pump: > 07-25-14 > Dec > 07 > Steering Leaks From Steering Rack/Pump Areas > Page 7058
Milan 2.3L: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear Or Power
Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
3674A5)
072514B 2006 Fusion, Milan, 0.7 Hr.
Zephyr, 2007-2008 Fusion Milan 2.3L: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH
Steering Gear And The Power Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System
(Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514C 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan 0.6 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Power Steering Pump. Includes
Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514D 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan 0.8 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear. Includes Time To
Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514E 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan, 0.9 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH Steering Gear And The Power
Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
3674A5)
072514F 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.5 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers on The Power Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill
And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514G 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.6 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear. Includes Time To Fill And
Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Steering Pump: > 07-25-14 > Dec > 07 > Steering Leaks From Steering Rack/Pump Areas > Page 7059
3674A5)
072514H 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.7 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH Steering Gear And The Power Steering
Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A 3674A5)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3A705 24
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Pump: > 07-25-14 > Dec > 07
> Steering - Leaks From Steering Rack/Pump Areas
Power Steering Pump: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Leaks From Steering Rack/Pump
Areas
TSB 07-25-14
12/24/07
POWER STEERING FLUID LEAKS FROM STEERING RACK AND PUMP ATTACHMENT
JOINTS
FORD: 2006-2008 Fusion 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2006 Zephyr 2007-2008 MKZ, MKX
MERCURY: 2006-2008 Milan
This article supersedes TSB 07-1-3 to update vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some 2006-2008 Fusion and Milan, 2006 Zephyr, 2007-2008 MKZ and 2007-2008 Edge
and MKX vehicles may exhibit a small power steering fluid leak at the line attachment areas of the
rack or the pump.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Replace the banjo bolt and the two (2) sealing washers following Workshop Manual, Section
211-02 using the service kit.
2. One (1) kit is used for one (1) joint (either pump or gear).
3. Joint must be torqued with a hand torque wrench to:
a. Fusion, Milan, Zephyr, and MKZ:
(1) Pump 35 lb-ft (47 N.m).
(2) Gear 41 lb-ft (55 N.m).
b. Edge and MKX:
(1) Pump 35 lb-ft (47 N.m).
(2) Gear 35 lb-ft (47 N.m).
NOTE
THIS NEW BANJO BOLT HAS A HIGHER TORQUE RATING TO ACHIEVE A HIGHER CLAMP
LOAD.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072514A 2006 Fusion, Milan, 0.6 Hr.
Zephyr, 2007-2008 Fusion
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Pump: > 07-25-14 > Dec > 07
> Steering - Leaks From Steering Rack/Pump Areas > Page 7065
Milan 2.3L: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear Or Power
Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
3674A5)
072514B 2006 Fusion, Milan, 0.7 Hr.
Zephyr, 2007-2008 Fusion Milan 2.3L: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH
Steering Gear And The Power Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System
(Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514C 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan 0.6 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Power Steering Pump. Includes
Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514D 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan 0.8 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear. Includes Time To
Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514E 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan, 0.9 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH Steering Gear And The Power
Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
3674A5)
072514F 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.5 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers on The Power Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill
And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514G 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.6 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear. Includes Time To Fill And
Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Pump: > 07-25-14 > Dec > 07
> Steering - Leaks From Steering Rack/Pump Areas > Page 7066
3674A5)
072514H 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.7 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH Steering Gear And The Power Steering
Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A 3674A5)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3A705 24
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7067
Power Steering Pump: Service and Repair
Power Steering Pump
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7068
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
contaminants or premature failure of the power steering components can result.
1. Using a suitable suction device, siphon the power steering fluid from the power steering fluid
reservoir. 2. Remove the accessory drive belt. For additional information, refer to Drive Belts,
Mounts, Brackets and Accessories. 3. Release the clamp and disconnect the power steering
supply hose from the power steering pump. 4. Disconnect the power steering pressure switch
electrical connector. 5. Remove the power steering pressure line fitting banjo bolt and disconnect
the line from the power steering pump.
^ Discard the 2 seals.
^ To install, tighten to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs).
6. Remove the 3 power steering pump bolts and the power steering pump.
^ To install, tighten to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
7. CAUTION: New seals must be installed any time the power steering pressure line is
disconnected from the power steering pump.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
8. Fill the power steering system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7073
C1121
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Switch
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SWITCH
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
The PSP switch monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP switch
is a normally closed switch that opens as the hydraulic pressure increases. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the PSP circuit. When the PSP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The PCM uses the input signal from the PSP switch to compensate
for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the idle RPM and preventing engine stall during
parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP switch signals the PCM to adjust the transmission electronic
pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased engine load, for example during parking
maneuvers
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch > Page
7076
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Sensor
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SENSOR
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
The PSP sensor monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP
sensor voltage input to the PCM changes as the hydraulic pressure changes. The PCM uses the
input signal from the PSP sensor to compensate for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the
idle RPM and preventing engine stall during parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP sensor signals the
PCM to adjust the transmission electronic pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased
engine load, for example, during parking maneuvers.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Steering Angle Sensor
> Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Steering Angle Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Page 7080
C222
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information >
Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7084
C222
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEPOWERING AND REPOWERING
Depowering Procedure
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Failure to follow this instruction may result in
air bag deployment, which may result in serious personal injury.
- Never probe the electrical connector on a side air curtain module. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in side air curtain module deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraints system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraints system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the smart power
distribution junction box (SPDJB), located in the LH lower kick panel, remove the lower kick panel
fuse cover and the
restraints control module (RCM) fuse 46 (7.5A) from the (SPDJB).
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30 seconds.
The air bag warning indicator will remain lit
continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or installing any new front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and
before servicing, installing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors,
such as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches. Failure to
follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
The front impact severity sensors are located on the radiator support under the front bumper cover.
The first row side impact sensors are located at or near the base of the B-pillars.
The second row side impact sensors are located on the C-pillars.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
Repowering Procedure
1. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 2. Install RCM fuse 46 (7.5A) to the SPDJB and install
the lower kick panel fuse cover.
3. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in front
of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal
injury.
Connect the battery ground cable.
4. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition switch from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the ignition switch back to ON
and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag
warning indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn OFF. If an air
bag SRS fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash at a 5 Hz rate (RCM not configured).
The air bag warning indicator might not light until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch
has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
7090
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator and any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) from the RCM and occupant classification
sensor (OCS) module using a scan tool.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
7091
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Deactivation and Reactivation
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEACTIVATION AND REACTIVATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Deactivation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of serious personal injury in
the event of an accidental deployment.
- Carry a live air bag module with the air bag and trim cover pointed away from your body. This will
reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live air bag module down with the trim cover face down. This will reduce the risk of
serious personal injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Failure to follow this instruction may result in
air bag deployment, which may result in personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the safety canopy module. Failure to follow this instruction may
result in safety canopy deployment, which may result in personal injury.
- The safety belt pretensioners are pyrotechnic devices. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in pretensioner or air bag deployment which may result in serious personal
injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraints system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraints system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All vehicles 1. Turn all vehicle accessories off. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the smart
power distribution junction box (SPDJB), located in the LH lower kick panel, remove the lower kick
panel fuse cover and the
restraints control module (RCM) fuse 46 (7.5A) from the SPDJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30 seconds.
The air bag warning indicator will remain lit
continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or installing any new front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and
before servicing, installing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors,
such as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensors are located on the radiator support under the front bumper cover.
The first row side impact sensors are located at or near the base of the B-pillars.
The second row side impact sensors are located on the C-pillars.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
7092
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
7. NOTE: Repeat this step for both locking pins.
Using a 3-mm Allen wrench or a suitable tool through the access hole on the backside of the
steering wheel, position the tool against the spring clip and push in, disengaging the clip from the
locking pin. With the spring clip disengaged from the locking pin, gently pull back on that side of the
driver air bag module to release it from the steering wheel.
8. CAUTION: Do not pull the driver air bag module electrical connectors out by the locking buttons.
Damage to the locking buttons may
occur.
Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking buttons on the driver air bag
module electrical connectors. With the locking buttons released, remove the electrical connectors
and the driver air bag module.
9. Open and lower the glove compartment door. Then unhook the glove compartment door from
the instrument panel (I/P).
- If equipped, detach the glove compartment door dampener.
Edge
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
7093
10. Remove the 2 passenger air bag module bolts from the cross vehicle beam bracket.
11. CAUTION: Do not handle the passenger air bag module by grabbing the edges of the
deployment doors. Damage to the air bag module
may occur.
Through the glove compartment opening, release the 4 LH side deployment door clips. Then
release the forward-most 5 clips and separate the deployment door and passenger air bag module
from the I/P.
12. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the RH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
13. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the RH locking button released, remove the RH electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
7094
14. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the LH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
15. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the LH locking button released, remove the LH electrical connector and remove the
passenger air bag module.
MKX
16. Pull straight out to release the 5 retaining clips and remove the RH I/P finish panel.
17. Remove the screw for the LH duct assembly bracket from the front of the I/P.
18. Through the glove compartment opening, remove the screw and the LH duct assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
7095
19. Through the glove compartment opening, remove the screw and the RH duct assembly.
20. Remove the 4 bolts and the passenger air bag module support bracket.
21. Remove the 3 nuts from the passenger air bag module.
22. CAUTION: Do not allow the passenger air bag module to hang from the wiring harness.
Damage to the wiring harness and connectors
may occur.
Lower the rear of the passenger air bag module off the 3 mounting studs. Move the passenger air
bag module rearward to release the 7 hooks from the I/P and rest the module on the cross vehicle
beam.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
7096
23. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the LH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
24. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the LH locking button released, remove the LH electrical connector from the passenger air
bag module.
25. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the RH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
26. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the RH locking button released, remove the RH electrical connector. Remove the passenger
air bag module from the glove compartment opening.
All vehicles
27. From under the rear of the front passenger seat, slide and disengage the passenger seat side
air bag module electrical connector locking clip, and
then release the tab and disconnect the passenger seat side air bag module electrical connector.
28. Remove the passenger side D-pillar trim panel.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
7097
29. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger safety canopy module electrical connector out by the
locking button. Damage to the locking button
may occur.
With the locking button released, remove the electrical connector from the passenger safety
canopy module.
30. Remove the driver side D-pillar trim panel.
31. CAUTION: Do not pull the driver safety canopy module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button
may occur.
With the locking button released, remove the electrical connector from the driver safety canopy
module.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
7098
32. From under the rear of the driver seat, detach the driver seat side air bag module electrical
connector from the seat cushion frame. Then slide and
disengage the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector locking clip, and then release
the tab and disconnect the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector.
33. Install RCM fuse 46 (7.5A) to the SPDJB. 34. Connect the battery ground cable.
Reactivation
All vehicles 1. Remove RCM fuse 46 (7.5A) from the SPDJB. 2. Disconnect the battery ground
cable and wait at least one minute.
3. Connect the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector and then slide and engage the
seat side air bag electrical connector locking clip.
Then attach the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector to the seat cushion frame.
4. CAUTION:
- Do not install the safety canopy module electrical connector by the locking button. Damage to the
locking button may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector locking button must be in the released position
when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector is unique and cannot be reversed when connected
to the safety canopy module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the safety canopy
module. Do not force the electrical connector into the safety canopy module. Damage to the
connector or component may occur.
With the locking button released, install the driver safety canopy module electrical connector fully
into the driver safety canopy module and seat the locking button.
5. Install the driver side D-pillar trim panel.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
7099
6. CAUTION:
- Do not install the safety canopy module electrical connector by the locking button. Damage to the
locking button may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector locking button must be in the released position
when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector is unique and cannot be reversed when connected
to the safety canopy module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the safety canopy
module. Do not force the electrical connector into the safety canopy module. Damage to the
connector or component may occur.
With the locking button released, install the passenger safety canopy module electrical connector
fully into the passenger safety canopy module and seat the locking button.
7. Install the passenger side D-pillar trim panel.
8. Connect the passenger seat side air bag module electrical connector and then slide and engage
the seat side air bag electrical connector locking
clip.
MKX
9. CAUTION:
- Do not install the passenger air bag module electrical connectors by the locking buttons. Damage
to the locking buttons may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connector locking buttons must be in the released
position when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the passenger air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in
the passenger air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the passenger air bag
module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
7100
Position the passenger air bag module on the cross vehicle beam. With the locking buttons
released, install the 2 passenger air bag module electrical connectors fully into the passenger air
bag module and seat the locking buttons.
10. NOTE: During the passenger air bag module installation, make sure all 7 of the hooks are fully
seated in the I/P.
Install the passenger air bag module 7 hooks into the I/P. Raise the rear of the passenger air bag
module onto the 3 mounting studs.
11. Install the 3 passenger air bag module nuts.
- Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
12. NOTE: To avoid a squeak or rattle condition, install the passenger air bag module bracket and
passenger air bag module bolts in this order.
Install the passenger air bag module support bracket and the 4 bolts. 1. Install the passenger air
bag module support bracket and 2 bolts to the cross vehicle beam.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
2. Install the inboard passenger air bag module support bracket-to-passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
3. Install the outboard passenger air bag module support bracket-to-passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
7101
13. Install the screw and the RH duct assembly.
14. Install the screw and the LH duct assembly.
15. Install the screw for the LH duct assembly bracket in the front of the I/P.
16. NOTE: Make sure the RH I/P finish panel 5 retaining clips are fully seated in the I/P.
Install the RH I/P finish panel.
Edge
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
7102
17. CAUTION:
- Do not install the passenger air bag module electrical connectors by the locking buttons. Damage
to the locking buttons may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connector locking buttons must be in the released
position when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the passenger air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in
the passenger air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the passenger air bag
module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
With the locking buttons released, install the 2 passenger air bag module electrical connectors fully
into the passenger air bag module and seat the locking buttons.
18. CAUTION: Do not handle the passenger air bag module by grabbing the edges of the
deployment doors. Damage to the air bag module
may occur.
NOTE: During air bag module installation, make sure all the deployment door clips are fully seated
in the I/P.
Install the passenger air bag module deployment door rear-most clips into the I/P first. Then install
the side deployment door clips working around to the forward-most clips seating each of them fully
into the I/P.
19. NOTE: To avoid a squeak or rattle condition, install the 2 passenger air bag module bolts in this
order.
Install the passenger air bag module 2 bolts. 1. Install the inboard passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
2. Install the outboard passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
All vehicles 20. Hook the glove compartment door to the I/P. Close the glove compartment door.
- If equipped, attach the glove compartment door dampener.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
7103
21. CAUTION:
- Do not install the driver air bag module electrical connectors by the locking buttons. Damage to
the locking buttons may occur.
- The driver air bag module electrical connector locking buttons must be in the released position
when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the passenger air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in
the passenger air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the passenger air bag
module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
With the locking buttons released, install the driver air bag module electrical connectors fully into
the driver air bag module and seat the locking buttons.
22. NOTE: Audible clicks will be heard when both wire clips are seated in the driver air bag module.
Align the driver air bag module locking pins to the steering wheel and, while pushing inward, seat
the 2 driver air bag module locking pins to the steering wheel wire clips. When the 2 locking pins are seated in place, there should be an even gap between the driver air
bag module trim cover and the steering wheel.
23. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 24. Install RCM fuse 46 (7.5A) to the SPDJB and
install the lower kick panel fuse cover.
25. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in
front of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected. Failure to follow this instructions may result in serious personal
injury.
Connect the battery ground cable.
26. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag warning
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag SRS
fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will either: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash at a 5 Hz rate (RCM not configured).
The air bag warning indicator may not illuminate until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator will need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Clear all continuous DTCs from the restraints control module using a scan tool.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Lock > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Steering Column Lock: Service and Repair
Steering Column Lock Module
Steering Column Lock Module
1. Depower the supplemental restraints system (SRS). For additional information, refer to Air Bag
Systems.
2. NOTE: Release the upper steering column shroud by pressing inward on the sides of the shroud
and lifting upwards.
Remove the upper steering column shroud.
3. Release the tilt lever, remove the 3 screws and then remove the lower steering column shroud.
4. NOTE: The top of the instrument panel steering column cover is held in place by tabs that clip to
the instrument panel.
Remove the 2 instrument panel steering column cover screws. ^
Detach the instrument panel steering column cover by pulling straight outward.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Lock > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 7107
5. If equipped, disconnect the electrical connector and hose from the temperature sensor.
^ Remove the instrument panel steering column cover.
6. Disconnect the multi-function switch electrical connector. 7. Disconnect the passive anti-theft
system (PATS) and ignition switch connectors.
8. NOTE: After cutting slots in the steering lock module bolts, clean all metal shavings and foreign
material from the steering column.
Using a suitable tool, cut slots into the heads of the 2 steering lock module bolts.
9. NOTE: The steering lock module bolts are designed to sheer off when tightened.
Remove the 2 steering lock module bolts using a screwdriver. ^
Discard the steering lock module bolts.
^ To install, tighten the steering lock module bolts until the heads of the bolts shear off.
10. Remove the steering lock module clamp and the steering lock module assembly from the
steering column.
11. NOTE: Align the locating tab on the steering lock module with the window of the steering
column tube. Verify that the lock module operates
correctly.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
12. Repower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Air Bag Systems.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Gear: > 07-25-14 > Dec > 07 > Steering - Leaks From Steering
Rack/Pump Areas
Steering Gear: Customer Interest Steering - Leaks From Steering Rack/Pump Areas
TSB 07-25-14
12/24/07
POWER STEERING FLUID LEAKS FROM STEERING RACK AND PUMP ATTACHMENT
JOINTS
FORD: 2006-2008 Fusion 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2006 Zephyr 2007-2008 MKZ, MKX
MERCURY: 2006-2008 Milan
This article supersedes TSB 07-1-3 to update vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some 2006-2008 Fusion and Milan, 2006 Zephyr, 2007-2008 MKZ and 2007-2008 Edge
and MKX vehicles may exhibit a small power steering fluid leak at the line attachment areas of the
rack or the pump.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Replace the banjo bolt and the two (2) sealing washers following Workshop Manual, Section
211-02 using the service kit.
2. One (1) kit is used for one (1) joint (either pump or gear).
3. Joint must be torqued with a hand torque wrench to:
a. Fusion, Milan, Zephyr, and MKZ:
(1) Pump 35 lb-ft (47 N.m).
(2) Gear 41 lb-ft (55 N.m).
b. Edge and MKX:
(1) Pump 35 lb-ft (47 N.m).
(2) Gear 35 lb-ft (47 N.m).
NOTE
THIS NEW BANJO BOLT HAS A HIGHER TORQUE RATING TO ACHIEVE A HIGHER CLAMP
LOAD.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072514A 2006 Fusion, Milan, 0.6 Hr.
Zephyr, 2007-2008 Fusion
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Gear: > 07-25-14 > Dec > 07 > Steering - Leaks From Steering
Rack/Pump Areas > Page 7116
Milan 2.3L: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear Or Power
Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
3674A5)
072514B 2006 Fusion, Milan, 0.7 Hr.
Zephyr, 2007-2008 Fusion Milan 2.3L: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH
Steering Gear And The Power Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System
(Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514C 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan 0.6 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Power Steering Pump. Includes
Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514D 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan 0.8 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear. Includes Time To
Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514E 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan, 0.9 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH Steering Gear And The Power
Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
3674A5)
072514F 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.5 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers on The Power Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill
And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514G 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.6 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear. Includes Time To Fill And
Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Gear: > 07-25-14 > Dec > 07 > Steering - Leaks From Steering
Rack/Pump Areas > Page 7117
3674A5)
072514H 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.7 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH Steering Gear And The Power Steering
Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A 3674A5)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3A705 24
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Gear: > 07-25-14 > Dec > 07 > Steering - Leaks From
Steering Rack/Pump Areas
Steering Gear: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Leaks From Steering Rack/Pump Areas
TSB 07-25-14
12/24/07
POWER STEERING FLUID LEAKS FROM STEERING RACK AND PUMP ATTACHMENT
JOINTS
FORD: 2006-2008 Fusion 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2006 Zephyr 2007-2008 MKZ, MKX
MERCURY: 2006-2008 Milan
This article supersedes TSB 07-1-3 to update vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some 2006-2008 Fusion and Milan, 2006 Zephyr, 2007-2008 MKZ and 2007-2008 Edge
and MKX vehicles may exhibit a small power steering fluid leak at the line attachment areas of the
rack or the pump.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Replace the banjo bolt and the two (2) sealing washers following Workshop Manual, Section
211-02 using the service kit.
2. One (1) kit is used for one (1) joint (either pump or gear).
3. Joint must be torqued with a hand torque wrench to:
a. Fusion, Milan, Zephyr, and MKZ:
(1) Pump 35 lb-ft (47 N.m).
(2) Gear 41 lb-ft (55 N.m).
b. Edge and MKX:
(1) Pump 35 lb-ft (47 N.m).
(2) Gear 35 lb-ft (47 N.m).
NOTE
THIS NEW BANJO BOLT HAS A HIGHER TORQUE RATING TO ACHIEVE A HIGHER CLAMP
LOAD.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072514A 2006 Fusion, Milan, 0.6 Hr.
Zephyr, 2007-2008 Fusion
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Gear: > 07-25-14 > Dec > 07 > Steering - Leaks From
Steering Rack/Pump Areas > Page 7123
Milan 2.3L: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear Or Power
Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
3674A5)
072514B 2006 Fusion, Milan, 0.7 Hr.
Zephyr, 2007-2008 Fusion Milan 2.3L: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH
Steering Gear And The Power Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System
(Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514C 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan 0.6 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Power Steering Pump. Includes
Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514D 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan 0.8 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear. Includes Time To
Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514E 2007-2008 Fusion, Milan, 0.9 Hr.
3.0L, MKZ: Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH Steering Gear And The Power
Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
3674A5)
072514F 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.5 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers on The Power Steering Pump, Includes Time To Fill
And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A, 3674A5)
072514G 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.6 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On The Steering Gear. Includes Time To Fill And
Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A,
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Gear: > 07-25-14 > Dec > 07 > Steering - Leaks From
Steering Rack/Pump Areas > Page 7124
3674A5)
072514H 2007-2008 Edge, MKX: 0.7 Hr.
Replace The Banjo Bolt And Sealing Washers On BOTH Steering Gear And The Power Steering
Pump, Includes Time To Fill And Purge The P/S System (Do Not Use With 3719A 3674A5)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3A705 24
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 7125
Steering Gear: Testing and Inspection
Steering Gear Grunt/Shudder Test
1. Start and run the vehicle to operating temperature. 2. Set engine idle speed to 1200 rpm.
3. CAUTION: Do not hold the steering wheel against the stops for more than 3 to 5 seconds at a
time. Damage to the power steering pump
will occur.
Rotate the steering wheel to the RH stop, then turn the steering wheel 90 degrees back from that
position. Slowly turn the steering wheel back and forth approximately 1/12 of a full turn.
4. Turn the steering wheel another 90 degrees. Slowly turn the steering wheel back and forth
approximately 1/12 of a full turn. 5. Repeat the test with the power steering fluid at different
temperatures. 6. If a light grunt is heard or a low (50-200 Hz) shudder is present, this is a normal
steering system condition. 7. If a loud grunt is heard, or a strong shudder is felt, purge the power
steering system. If a loud grunt or strong shudder still exists, check the power
steering lines/hoses for restrictions or damage and repair as necessary. If the lines/hoses are OK,
install a new steering gear.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 7126
Steering Gear: Service and Repair
Steering Gear
Special Tool(s)
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 7127
Removal
CAUTION: When repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
contaminants or premature failure of the power steering components can result.
1. Remove the stabilizer bar. 2. Remove the power steering pressure line-to-steering gear banjo
bolt.
^ Discard the 2 seals.
3. Release the clamp and disconnect the return hose from the steering gear. 4. Remove the 2 bolts
and the steering gear heat shield. 5. Remove the 3 power steering pressure line-to-steering gear
bracket bolts. 6. Remove and discard the 4 steering gear bolts.
^ Remove the steering gear.
Installation
1. Position the steering gear and tighten the 4 steering gear bolts to 103 Nm (76 ft. lbs) in the
sequence shown.
2. CAUTION: New seals must be installed any time the power steering pressure line is
disconnected from the power steering pump and/or
the steering gear.
Install the power steering pressure line-to-steering gear banjo bolt. ^
Tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs).
3. Install the 3 power steering pressure line-to-steering gear bracket bolts.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
4. Release the clamp and connect the return hose to the steering gear. 5. When installing a new
steering gear, install a new steering gear turn tube heat wrap. 6. Install the steering gear heat
shield and the 2 bolts.
^ Tighten to 6 Nm (53 inch lbs).
7. Install the stabilizer bar. 8. Fill the power steering system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Wheel: > 07-4-3 > Mar > 07 > Interior - Leather Wrapping On Steering
Wheel Is Loose
Steering Wheel: Customer Interest Interior - Leather Wrapping On Steering Wheel Is Loose
TSB 07-4-3
03/05/07
LEATHER - WRAPPED STEERING WHEEL - LEATHER COMING LOOSE
FORD: 2000-2005 Thunderbird 2000-2007 Crown Victoria, Focus, Mustang, Taurus 2005-2007
Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1999-2003 Windstar 1999-2008 F-Super Duty
2000-2005 Excursion 2000-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, Ranger 2001-2003 Explorer Sport
2001-2007 Explorer Sport Trac 2001-2008 Escape 2004-2007 F-150, Freestar 2005-2008 Escape
Hybrid 2007 Edge 2004-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 2000-2002 Continental 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2000-2007 Town Car 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 2000-2007 Navigator 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT 2007 MKX
MERCURY: 2000-2005 Sable 2000-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007 Montego 2006-2007 Milan
2000-2007 Mountaineer 2004-2007 Monterey 2005-2008 Mariner 2006-2008 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 04-24-3 to update the vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some vehicles equipped with leather-wrapped steering wheels may exhibit the leather
coming loose from the spoke area.
ACTION Apply Motorcraft Instant Gel Adhesive to re-adhere the loose leather to the wheel spoke.
Refer to the following Service Procedure.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IF RE-ADHERING LEATHER TO THE FRONT SIDE OF THE STEERING WHEEL ONLY, OMIT
STEPS 1 AND 6. STEERING WHEEL/AIR BAG ASSEMBLY REMOVAL IS NECESSARY ONLY
WHEN REPAIRING LOOSE LEATHER ON THE BACKSIDE OF THE STEERING WHEEL.
CAUTION
AVOID SKIN CONTACT WITH MOTORCRAFT INSTANT GEL ADHESIVE.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Wheel: > 07-4-3 > Mar > 07 > Interior - Leather Wrapping On Steering
Wheel Is Loose > Page 7136
1. Remove the steering wheel (ONLY NECESSARY TO REPAIR BACKSIDE OF STEERING
WHEEL). Refer to Workshop Manual Sections 211-04 and 501-20B.
2. Fold loose leather out of the way.
3. Apply Motorcraft Instant Gel Adhesive evenly over the wheel spoke.
4. Fold the leather back into its original position.
5. Smooth the leather tuck in for neat appearance, and apply pressure until the leather is bonded to
the wheel spoke (apply pressure for at least 30 seconds).
NOTE
THE ADHESIVE SHOULD BE COMPLETELY SET AFTER 5 MINUTES. DO NOT PULL ON THE
REPAIR AREA.
6. Reinstall steering wheel.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT070403 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3600 33
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Wheel: > 07-4-3 > Mar > 07 > Interior - Leather Wrapping On
Steering Wheel Is Loose
Steering Wheel: All Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Leather Wrapping On Steering Wheel Is
Loose
TSB 07-4-3
03/05/07
LEATHER - WRAPPED STEERING WHEEL - LEATHER COMING LOOSE
FORD: 2000-2005 Thunderbird 2000-2007 Crown Victoria, Focus, Mustang, Taurus 2005-2007
Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1999-2003 Windstar 1999-2008 F-Super Duty
2000-2005 Excursion 2000-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, Ranger 2001-2003 Explorer Sport
2001-2007 Explorer Sport Trac 2001-2008 Escape 2004-2007 F-150, Freestar 2005-2008 Escape
Hybrid 2007 Edge 2004-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 2000-2002 Continental 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2000-2007 Town Car 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 2000-2007 Navigator 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT 2007 MKX
MERCURY: 2000-2005 Sable 2000-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007 Montego 2006-2007 Milan
2000-2007 Mountaineer 2004-2007 Monterey 2005-2008 Mariner 2006-2008 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 04-24-3 to update the vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some vehicles equipped with leather-wrapped steering wheels may exhibit the leather
coming loose from the spoke area.
ACTION Apply Motorcraft Instant Gel Adhesive to re-adhere the loose leather to the wheel spoke.
Refer to the following Service Procedure.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IF RE-ADHERING LEATHER TO THE FRONT SIDE OF THE STEERING WHEEL ONLY, OMIT
STEPS 1 AND 6. STEERING WHEEL/AIR BAG ASSEMBLY REMOVAL IS NECESSARY ONLY
WHEN REPAIRING LOOSE LEATHER ON THE BACKSIDE OF THE STEERING WHEEL.
CAUTION
AVOID SKIN CONTACT WITH MOTORCRAFT INSTANT GEL ADHESIVE.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Wheel: > 07-4-3 > Mar > 07 > Interior - Leather Wrapping On
Steering Wheel Is Loose > Page 7142
1. Remove the steering wheel (ONLY NECESSARY TO REPAIR BACKSIDE OF STEERING
WHEEL). Refer to Workshop Manual Sections 211-04 and 501-20B.
2. Fold loose leather out of the way.
3. Apply Motorcraft Instant Gel Adhesive evenly over the wheel spoke.
4. Fold the leather back into its original position.
5. Smooth the leather tuck in for neat appearance, and apply pressure until the leather is bonded to
the wheel spoke (apply pressure for at least 30 seconds).
NOTE
THE ADHESIVE SHOULD BE COMPLETELY SET AFTER 5 MINUTES. DO NOT PULL ON THE
REPAIR AREA.
6. Reinstall steering wheel.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT070403 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3600 33
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Locations >
Steering Wheel Switch, Left
View 151-10 (Steering Wheel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Locations >
Steering Wheel Switch, Left > Page 7145
View 151-10 (Steering Wheel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Diagrams >
Steering Wheel Switch, Left
C2998
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Diagrams >
Steering Wheel Switch, Left > Page 7148
C2999
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 7149
Steering Wheel: Service and Repair
Steering Wheel
Steering Wheel
Removal and Installation
1. Position the steering wheel in the straight-ahead position and turn the ignition switch to the OFF
position.
^ Remove the key.
2. Remove the driver air bag module. For additional information, refer to Air Bag Systems.
3. NOTE: Mark the steering wheel and column shaft for reference during installation.
Remove the steering wheel nut. ^
To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs).
4. Disconnect the steering wheel switches electrical connector.
5. CAUTION: Do not remove the steering wheel by hitting the shaft with a hammer. Damage to the
column can occur.
Using a suitable puller, remove the steering wheel.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 7150
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Align the steering wheel using the reference mark.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Component Information > Service and Repair
Tie Rod: Service and Repair
Tie Rod - Inner
NOTE: Left side shown, right side similar.
Tie Rod - Inner
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the steering gear. 2. Mark the pinion shaft and the steering gear housing for correct
reference during installation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Page 7154
3. CAUTION: Position the steering gear in a soft-jaw vise or damage to the steering gear can
occur.
Loosen the tie-rod end jam nut and remove the outer tie-rod end. ^
To install, tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs).
4. NOTE: It is necessary to remove both bellows boots when removing the RH inner tie-rod end.
Remove the 4 bellow clamps and the 2 steering gear bellows boots.
5. Using a suitable wrench, hold the piston shaft. 6. Using a suitable wrench, remove the inner
tie-rod end.
^ To install, tighten to 103 Nm (76 ft. lbs).
7. NOTE: Using a suitable wrench, hold the piston shaft while tightening the inner tie rod.
NOTE: The new lock washer must be crimped after tightening the inner tie rod end.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Specifications
Ball Joint: Specifications
Ball Joint Deflection
Lower ...................................................................................................................................................
......................................... 0-0.2 mm (0-0.08 inch) Upper ...................................................................
....................................................................................................................... 0-0.2 mm (0-0.008
inch)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 7159
Ball Joint: Testing and Inspection
Ball Joint Inspection
1. Prior to inspecting the ball joints for wear, inspect the wheel bearings. Refer to Vehicle/Testing
and Inspection. 2. Raise and support the vehicle by the frame to allow the wheels to hang in the
rebound position. 3. Inspect the ball joint and ball joint boot for damage.
^ If the ball joint or ball joint boot is damaged, install a new ball joint.
NOTE: Carry out Steps 4-6 to inspect the lower ball joints.
4. CAUTION: Do not use any tools or equipment to move the wheel and tire assembly or
suspension components, while checking for relative
movement. Suspension damage can occur. The use of tools or equipment will also create relative
movement that may not exist when using hand force. Relative movement must be measured using
hand force only.
NOTE: To avoid lateral movement of the steering linkage and steering components, make sure to
apply hand force only at the 12 o'clock and 6 o'clock positions of the wheel and tire assembly.
Inspect the ball joints for relative movement by alternately pulling outward and pushing inward on
the wheel and tire assembly, at the 12 o'clock and 6 o'clock positions, by hand. Note any relative
movement between the wheel knuckle and both lower arms at the lower ball joints. ^
If relative movement is not felt or seen, the ball joints are OK. Do not install new ball joints.
^ If relative movement is found, continue with Step 5.
5. NOTE: In order to obtain an accurate measurement, the dial indicator should be aligned as close
as possible with the center line of the lower ball
joint.
To measure ball joint deflection, attach a suitable dial indicator with a flexible arm between the
lower arm and the wheel knuckle at the lower ball joint.
6. Measure the ball joint deflection while an assistant alternately pulls outward and pushes inward
on the wheel and tire assembly, at the 12 o'clock
and 6 o'clock positions, by hand. ^
If the deflection exceeds the specification, install a new lower ball joint.
^ If the deflection meets the specification, continue with the procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front
Control Arm: Service and Repair Front
Lower Arm
Lower Arm
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 7164
parts.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly. 2. Remove and discard the stabilizer bar link lower nut.
^ To install, tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs).
3. Remove and discard the lower ball joint nut and bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs).
4. CAUTION: Do not tighten any suspension bushing fasteners until the installation procedure is
complete and the weight of the vehicle is
resting on the wheel and tire assemblies.
Remove the lower arm-to-frame forward bolt and spacer. ^
Discard the bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs).
5. Remove the 2 lower arm-to-frame rearward bolts and remove the lower arm.
^ Discard the bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 80 Nm (59 ft. lbs).
6. CAUTION: Do not tighten any suspension bushing fasteners until the installation procedure is
complete and the weight of the vehicle is
resting on the wheel and tire assemblies.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
7. Check and if necessary, adjust the alignment.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 7165
Control Arm: Service and Repair Rear
Upper Arm
Upper Arm
Upper Arm
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
CAUTION: Suspension bushing fasteners must be tightened with the weight of the vehicle resting
on the wheel and tires.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly. 2. Position a suitable jackstand under the lower arm. 3.
Remove and discard the upper arm outboard bolt and nut.
^ To install, tighten to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs).
4. Carefully lower the lower arm and remove the jack. 5. Position the jackstand under the
subframe.
6. NOTE: The upper arm inboard bolt cannot be removed without first lowering the subframe.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 7166
Remove and discard the 2 subframe bushing brace-to-body bolts. ^
To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
7. Remove the subframe forward mounting nut.
^ To install, tighten the bolts to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs).
8. NOTE: The upper arm inboard bolt cannot be removed without first lowering the subframe.
NOTE: The rear springs are under pressure. The jack must be lowered slowly while relieving the
spring pressure.
Remove the subframe rearward mounting nut and lower the jack. ^
To install, tighten the bolts to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs).
9. Remove and discard the upper arm inboard bolt and nut.
^ Remove the upper arm.
^ To install, tighten to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs).
10. CAUTION: Suspension bushing fasteners must be tightened with the weight of the vehicle
resting on the wheel and tires.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Lower Arm
Lower Arm
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 7167
Lower Arm
1. Remove the spring. 2. Remove the cam adjuster nut, cam adjuster and cam bolt.
^ Discard the cam bolt and nut.
^ To install, tighten to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Front Steering Knuckle: Service and Repair
Wheel Knuckle
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 7171
Removal
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 7172
parts.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly.
2. NOTE: Apply the brake to keep the halfshaft from rotating.
Remove the halfshaft nut, halfshaft hub seal and halfshaft washer. ^
Discard the nut, seal and washer.
3. Remove the wheel speed sensor bolt and position the wheel speed sensor aside.
4. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper and anchor plate assembly to hang from the brake hose or
damage to the hose can occur.
Remove the 2 bolts and position the caliper and anchor plate assembly aside. ^
Support the caliper and anchor plate assembly using mechanic's wire.
5. Remove the brake disc. 6. Using the special tool, separate the halfshaft from the wheel hub.
7. Remove and discard the tie-rod end cotter pin and nut.
8. CAUTION: Do not use a hammer to separate the tie-rod end from the wheel knuckle or damage
to the wheel knuckle can result.
Using the special tool, separate the tie-rod end from the wheel knuckle.
9. Remove the shock absorber lower nuts and flag bolts.
^ Discard the nuts and flag bolts.
10. Remove the lower ball joint bolt, nut and the wheel knuckle.
^ Discard the bolt and nut.
Installation
1. Position the wheel knuckle and install the lower ball joint bolt and nut.
^ Tighten the nut to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs).
2. Install the shock absorber lower nuts and flag bolts.
^ Tighten to 225 Nm (166 ft. lbs).
3. Position the tie-rod end and install the nut and cotter pin.
^ Tighten to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs).
4. Position the wheel speed sensor and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 7 Nm (62 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 7173
5. Install the brake disc. 6. Position the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly and install the 2
bolts.
^ Tighten to 133 Nm (98 ft. lbs).
7. Using a suitable installation tool, install the halfshaft into the wheel hub.
8. CAUTION: Do not tighten the halfshaft nut with the vehicle on the ground. The nut must be
tightened to specification before the vehicle
is lowered onto the wheels. Wheel bearing damage will occur if the wheel bearing is loaded with
the weight of the vehicle applied.
NOTE: Apply the brake to keep the halfshaft from rotating.
Install the halfshaft hub seal, washer and nut. ^
Tighten to 225 Nm (185 ft. lbs).
9. Install the wheel and tire assembly.
10. Check and if necessary, adjust the alignment.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Rear Knuckle: > 10-2-9 > Feb > 10 > Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area
Rear Knuckle: Customer Interest Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area
TSB 10-2-9
02/15/10
NOISE FROM REAR WHEEL HUB BEARING - BUILT ON OR BEFORE 12/4/2008
FORD: 2007-2009 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 09-26-5 to update the Parts List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Edge and MKX vehicles built on or before 12/4/2008 may exhibit a growl
or howl type noise coming from the left and/or right rear wheel area. This could be the result of a
faulty rear wheel hub bearing assembly.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. If Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics identify a faulty rear wheel hub bearing, it will be
necessary to replace the rear suspension trailing
arm/knuckle assembly along with a new rear wheel hub bearing assembly.
2. Refer to WSM, Section 204-02, for rear wheel hub bearing and trailing arm/knuckle replacement.
Only replace the rear suspension trailing
arm/knuckle assembly and rear bearing hub on the side with the concern. Failing to install a new
rear suspension trailing arm/knuckle assembly when installing a new rear bearing hub assembly
will result in premature bearing noise/wear.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100209A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 1.3 Hrs.
FWD: Replace ONE Rear Wheel Hub Bearing And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assembly
100209A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 1.5 Hrs.
AWD: Replace ONE Rear Wheel Hub Bearing And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assembly
100209B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 2.4 Hrs.
FWD: Replace BOTH Rear
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Rear Knuckle: > 10-2-9 > Feb > 10 > Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area
> Page 7182
Wheel Hub Bearings And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assemblies
100209B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 2.8 Hrs.
AWD: Replace BOTH Rear Wheel Hub Bearings And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assemblies
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
1104 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Knuckle: > 10-2-9 > Feb > 10 > Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From
Rear Hub Area
Rear Knuckle: All Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area
TSB 10-2-9
02/15/10
NOISE FROM REAR WHEEL HUB BEARING - BUILT ON OR BEFORE 12/4/2008
FORD: 2007-2009 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 09-26-5 to update the Parts List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Edge and MKX vehicles built on or before 12/4/2008 may exhibit a growl
or howl type noise coming from the left and/or right rear wheel area. This could be the result of a
faulty rear wheel hub bearing assembly.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. If Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics identify a faulty rear wheel hub bearing, it will be
necessary to replace the rear suspension trailing
arm/knuckle assembly along with a new rear wheel hub bearing assembly.
2. Refer to WSM, Section 204-02, for rear wheel hub bearing and trailing arm/knuckle replacement.
Only replace the rear suspension trailing
arm/knuckle assembly and rear bearing hub on the side with the concern. Failing to install a new
rear suspension trailing arm/knuckle assembly when installing a new rear bearing hub assembly
will result in premature bearing noise/wear.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100209A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 1.3 Hrs.
FWD: Replace ONE Rear Wheel Hub Bearing And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assembly
100209A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 1.5 Hrs.
AWD: Replace ONE Rear Wheel Hub Bearing And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assembly
100209B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 2.4 Hrs.
FWD: Replace BOTH Rear
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Knuckle: > 10-2-9 > Feb > 10 > Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From
Rear Hub Area > Page 7188
Wheel Hub Bearings And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assemblies
100209B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 2.8 Hrs.
AWD: Replace BOTH Rear Wheel Hub Bearings And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assemblies
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
1104 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 7189
Rear Knuckle: Service and Repair
Wheel Knuckle
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 7190
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 7191
Removal
All vehicles
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
CAUTION: Suspension bushing fasteners must be tightened with the weight of the vehicle resting
on the wheel and tires.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly.
2. CAUTION: Do not allow the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly to hang from the brake
hose or damage to the hose can occur.
Remove the 2 anchor plate bolts and position the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly aside. ^
Support the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly using mechanic's wire.
3. Remove the brake disc. 4. Disconnect the parking brake shoe retaining spring and remove the
spring and brake shoe assembly. 5. Remove the 2 bolts and disconnect the parking brake cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 7192
6. Remove the nut and disconnect the stabilizer bar link and parking brake cable bracket from the
wheel knuckle.
^ Discard the nut.
7. Remove the bolt, unclip the 2 retainers and position aside the wheel speed sensor.
8. Remove the brake hose bracket bolt.
All wheel drive (AWD) vehicles 9. Remove and discard the halfshaft nut.
10. Using the special tool, separate the halfshaft from the wheel bearing and wheel hub.
All vehicles 11. Position a suitable jackstand under the lower arm.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 7193
12. Remove and discard the lower shock bolt and nut. 13. Remove and discard the upper arm
outboard bolt and nut. 14. Remove and discard the lower are outboard bolt and nut. 15. Remove
and discard the toe link outboard bolt and nut.
AWD vehicles 16. Position the halfshaft through the wheel knuckle opening and secure the
halfshaft aside.
All vehicles 17. Remove the 5 wheel knuckle bracket-to-frame bolts and the wheel knuckle.
^ Discard the bolts.
Installation
All vehicles
CAUTION: Suspension bushing fasteners must be tightened with the weight of the vehicle resting
on the wheel and tires.
1. Position the wheel knuckle and install the 5 wheel knuckle bracket-to-frame bolts.
^ Tighten the bolts to 47 Nm (35 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 7194
AWD vehicles 2. Position the halfshaft into the wheel bearing and hub.
All vehicles 3. Position the wheel knuckle onto the toe link and lower arm.
4. NOTE: Do not tighten the lower arm forward bolt at this time.
Loosely install the lower arm forward bolt.
5. NOTE: Do not tighten the toe link forward bolt at this time.
Loosely install the toe link forward bolt.
6. NOTE: Do not tighten the shock absorber lower bolt at this time.
Loosely install the shock absorber lower bolt.
7. Using the jack, raise the suspension and install the upper arm outboard bolt and nut.
^ Tighten to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs).
8. If installing a new wheel knuckle, tighten the lower arm outboard bolt to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs).
^ Loosen the bolt 180 degrees.
^ Tighten the bolt to 80 Nm (59 ft. lbs).
^ Tighten the bolt an additional 90 degrees.
9. If installing the original wheel knuckle, tighten the lower arm outboard bolt to 80 Nm (59 ft. lbs).
^ Tighten the bolt an additional 90 degrees.
10. Tighten the toe link outboard bolt to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs). 11. Tighten the shock absorber lower
nut to 80 Nm (59 ft. lbs).
AWD vehicles 12. Using a suitable installation tool, install the halfshaft into the wheel hub. 13.
Install the halfshaft nut.
^ Tighten to 225 Nm (166 ft. lbs).
All vehicles 14. Install the brake hose bracket bolt.
^ Tighten to 7 Nm (62 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 7195
15. Position the wheel speed sensor, clip the 2 retainers to the upper arm and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 7 Nm (62 inch lbs).
16. NOTE: The parking brake cable bracket is fastened to the wheel knuckle with the same bolt as
the stabilizer bar link.
Install the parking brake cable bracket and the stabilizer bar link to the wheel knuckle. ^
Tighten the bolt to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs).
17. Connect the parking brake cable and install the 2 bolts.
^ Tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs).
18. Install the parking brake shoe and retaining spring. 19. Install the brake disc. 20. Position the
brake caliper and anchor plate assembly and install the anchor plate bolts.
^ Tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs).
21. Install the wheel and tire assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle Alignment Link > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Rear Knuckle Alignment Link: Service and Repair
Toe Link
Toe Link
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly. 2. Remove and discard the toe link inboard nut, cam
adjuster and cam bolt.
^ To install, tighten the nut to 200 Nm (148 ft. lbs).
3. Remove and discard the toe link outboard bolt and nut then remove the toe link.
^ To install, tighten to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs).
4. CAUTION: Suspension bushing fasteners must be tightened with the weight of the vehicle
resting on the wheel and tires.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
5. Check and, if necessary, adjust the rear toe.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Suspension > Steering Angle
Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Suspension > Steering Angle
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7203
C222
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Spindle > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spindle: > 10-2-9 > Feb > 10 > Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area
Spindle: All Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area
TSB 10-2-9
02/15/10
NOISE FROM REAR WHEEL HUB BEARING - BUILT ON OR BEFORE 12/4/2008
FORD: 2007-2009 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 09-26-5 to update the Parts List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Edge and MKX vehicles built on or before 12/4/2008 may exhibit a growl
or howl type noise coming from the left and/or right rear wheel area. This could be the result of a
faulty rear wheel hub bearing assembly.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. If Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics identify a faulty rear wheel hub bearing, it will be
necessary to replace the rear suspension trailing
arm/knuckle assembly along with a new rear wheel hub bearing assembly.
2. Refer to WSM, Section 204-02, for rear wheel hub bearing and trailing arm/knuckle replacement.
Only replace the rear suspension trailing
arm/knuckle assembly and rear bearing hub on the side with the concern. Failing to install a new
rear suspension trailing arm/knuckle assembly when installing a new rear bearing hub assembly
will result in premature bearing noise/wear.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100209A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 1.3 Hrs.
FWD: Replace ONE Rear Wheel Hub Bearing And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assembly
100209A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 1.5 Hrs.
AWD: Replace ONE Rear Wheel Hub Bearing And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assembly
100209B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 2.4 Hrs.
FWD: Replace BOTH Rear
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Spindle > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spindle: > 10-2-9 > Feb > 10 > Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area >
Page 7212
Wheel Hub Bearings And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assemblies
100209B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 2.8 Hrs.
AWD: Replace BOTH Rear Wheel Hub Bearings And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assemblies
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
1104 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Spindle > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Spindle: > 10-2-9 > Feb > 10 > Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area
Spindle: Customer Interest Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area
TSB 10-2-9
02/15/10
NOISE FROM REAR WHEEL HUB BEARING - BUILT ON OR BEFORE 12/4/2008
FORD: 2007-2009 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 09-26-5 to update the Parts List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Edge and MKX vehicles built on or before 12/4/2008 may exhibit a growl
or howl type noise coming from the left and/or right rear wheel area. This could be the result of a
faulty rear wheel hub bearing assembly.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. If Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics identify a faulty rear wheel hub bearing, it will be
necessary to replace the rear suspension trailing
arm/knuckle assembly along with a new rear wheel hub bearing assembly.
2. Refer to WSM, Section 204-02, for rear wheel hub bearing and trailing arm/knuckle replacement.
Only replace the rear suspension trailing
arm/knuckle assembly and rear bearing hub on the side with the concern. Failing to install a new
rear suspension trailing arm/knuckle assembly when installing a new rear bearing hub assembly
will result in premature bearing noise/wear.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100209A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 1.3 Hrs.
FWD: Replace ONE Rear Wheel Hub Bearing And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assembly
100209A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 1.5 Hrs.
AWD: Replace ONE Rear Wheel Hub Bearing And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assembly
100209B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 2.4 Hrs.
FWD: Replace BOTH Rear
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Spindle > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Spindle: > 10-2-9 > Feb > 10 > Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area > Page 7218
Wheel Hub Bearings And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assemblies
100209B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 2.8 Hrs.
AWD: Replace BOTH Rear Wheel Hub Bearings And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assemblies
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
1104 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Link >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Stabilizer Link: Service and Repair Front
Stabilizer Bar and Link
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Link >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 7224
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Link >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 7225
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Suspension and subframe fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance
of vital parts and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the
same part number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement
part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during
reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these parts.
NOTE: If replacing only the stabilizer bar bushings, proceed to Step 23 of this procedure.
All vehicles
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly. 2. Remove the lower steering shaft coupler bolt and
disconnect the coupler from the steering gear.
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
3. Index-mark the relationship of the front subframe to the underbody at the mounting locations. 4.
Remove the RH fender splash shield. 5. Remove the 3 pushpin fasteners, the 7 screws and the
front splash shield.
6. Remove the 3 RH front lower bumper-to-subframe nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
7. Remove the 3 LH front lower bumper-to-subframe nuts and separate the lower bumper from the
subframe.
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
8. Remove the power steering cooler hose bracket bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Link >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 7226
9. Loosen the Y-pipe clamp and disconnect the 2 exhaust hangers.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
10. Remove the 2 nuts and separate the flex pipe from the Y-pipe assembly.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs).
All wheel drive (AWD) vehicles 11. Index-mark the driveshaft, remove the 4 bolts and position the
driveshaft aside.
^ To install, tighten to 70 Nm (52 ft. lbs).
All vehicles
12. NOTE: Use the holding feature to prevent the ball stud from turning while removing or installing
the stabilizer bar link nuts.
Remove the stabilizer link upper and lower nuts and the stabilizer links. ^
Discard the nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs).
13. Remove the 2 outer tie-rod end nuts (1 each side).
^ To install, tighten to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Link >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 7227
14. Using the special tool, separate the outer tie-rod ends from the wheel knuckles.
15. NOTE: RH shown, LH similar.
Remove the 2 lower ball joint bolts and nuts and separate the lower ball joints from the wheel
knuckles. ^
Discard the bolts and nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs).
16. Remove the nut and the engine roll restrictor heat shield.
^ To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs).
17. Remove the engine roll restrictor-to-subframe bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs).
18. Using a suitable jack, support the subframe.
^ Support the subframe in the center rear area of the subframe.
19. NOTE: During installation, the subframe brackets are loosely installed with the support bracket
bolts. Align the index marks made in Step 2, then
tighten the rear subframe nuts prior to tightening the support bracket bolts.
Remove the 2 nuts, 4 bolts and the subframe support brackets. ^
Discard the nuts and bolts.
^ To install, tighten the nuts to 133 Nm (98 ft. lbs).
^ To install, tighten the bolts to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs).
20. Remove and discard the 4 front subframe nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 133 Nm (98 ft. lbs).
21. Using the jack, lower the subframe approximately 76.2 mm (3 inch). 22. Remove the 4 bolts, 2
stabilizer bar brackets and bushings.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Link >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 7228
^ Discard the bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 63 Nm (46 ft. lbs).
23. Remove the stabilizer bar. 24. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 25. Check, and if
necessary, adjust the alignment.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Link >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 7229
Stabilizer Link: Service and Repair Rear
Stabilizer Bar and Link
Stabilizer Bar and Link
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove and discard the stabilizer bar link upper nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs).
3. Remove and discard the stabilizer bar link lower nuts and remove the stabilizer bar links.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs).
4. Remove and discard the stabilizer bar bracket nuts and remove the stabilizer bar brackets and
the stabilizer bar.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Link >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 7230
5. Inspect the stabilizer bar bushings and install a new bushing(s) if necessary. 6. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Subframe > Front Subframe > System Information >
Description and Operation
Front Subframe: Description and Operation
FRAME ASSEMBLY
Front Subframe
The front subframe is bolted to the body and is used to: aid in structural support.
- provide mounting surfaces for the front suspension control arms.
- provide the mounting surface for the steering gear.
- provide the mounting surface for the sway bar.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Subframe > Front Subframe > System Information >
Description and Operation > Page 7235
Front Subframe: Service and Repair
Subframe - Front
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Subframe > Front Subframe > System Information >
Description and Operation > Page 7236
Subframe - Front (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Subframe > Front Subframe > System Information >
Description and Operation > Page 7237
Subframe - Front (Part 2)
CAUTION: Suspension and subframe fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance
of vital parts and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. A new part with the
same part number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement
part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during
reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. With a wax pencil, mark the relationship of the front subframe to the underbody at the mounting
locations.
2. Remove the RH splash shield.
3. Remove the 3 pushpin fasteners, the 7 screws and the front splash shield.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Subframe > Front Subframe > System Information >
Description and Operation > Page 7238
4. Remove the 3 RH subframe-to-lower bumper nuts.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
5. Remove the 3 LH subframe-to-lower bumper nuts and separate the lower bumper from the
subframe.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
6. Remove the 3 power steering tube bracket bolts from the RH side of the subframe and position
the power steering tube aside.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Subframe > Front Subframe > System Information >
Description and Operation > Page 7239
7. NOTE:
- Use the holding feature to prevent the ball stud from turning while removing or installing the
stabilizer bar link nut.
- RH side shown, LH side similar.
Remove the 2 stabilizer bar link-to-control arm nuts (1 each side) and separate the stabilizer bar
links from the lower control arms. Discard the nuts
- To install, tighten to 90 Nm (66 lb-ft).
8. NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
Remove the lower control arm-to-knuckle pinch bolts and separate the lower control arms from the
knuckles. Discard the bolts.
- To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
9. Loosen the Y-pipe clamp and disconnect the 2 exhaust hangers.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Subframe > Front Subframe > System Information >
Description and Operation > Page 7240
10. Remove the 4 nuts and the Y-pipe assembly.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
11. NOTE: The steering gear is not removed with the front subframe and must be positioned aside.
Position the steering gear aside using mechanic's wire.
Remove the 4 bolts and position the steering rack aside using a suitable length of mechanic's wire.
Discard the bolts.
- To install, tighten the steering gear bolts in the sequence shown. To install, tighten to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
12. Remove the 4 bolts and position the stabilizer bar aside using a suitable length of mechanic's
wire.
- Discard the bolts.
- To install, tighten to 63 Nm (46 lb-ft).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Subframe > Front Subframe > System Information >
Description and Operation > Page 7241
13. Remove the nuts and the roll restrictor heat shield.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
14. Remove the 3 bolts from the roll restrictor bracket.
- To install, tighten to 90 Nm (66 lb-ft).
15. Position the lift table under the subframe.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Subframe > Front Subframe > System Information >
Description and Operation > Page 7242
16. NOTE:
- Align the front subframe index marks to the body index marks made during removal.
- During installation, the subframe brackets are loosely installed with the support bracket bolts.
Tighten the rear subframe nuts prior to tightening the support bracket bolts.
Remove the 2 nuts, 4 bolts and the subframe support brackets. Discard the nuts and bolts.
- To install, tighten the nuts to 133 Nm (98 lb-ft).
- To install, tighten the bolts to 90 Nm (66 lb-ft).
17. Remove the 2 front subframe nuts.
- Discard the nuts.
- To install, tighten to 133 Nm (98 lb-ft).
18. Remove the 2 middle subframe nuts and remove the subframe.
- Discard the nuts.
- To install, tighten to 133 Nm (98 lb-ft).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Subframe > Front Subframe > System Information >
Description and Operation > Page 7243
19. Transfer the components as necessary. 20. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Subframe > Rear Subframe > System Information >
Description and Operation
Rear Subframe: Description and Operation
FRAME ASSEMBLY
Rear Subframe
The rear subframe is bolted to the body and is used to: aid in structural support.
- provide mounting surfaces for the rear suspension control arms.
- provide a mounting point for the rear differential, if equipped.
- provide a mounting surface for the sway bar.
Underbody misalignment can affect front and rear wheel alignment, the operation of the
suspension parts and drivetrain operation. Window glass cracks, door and window opening
concerns and air or water leaks at the doors are often caused by incorrectly tightened bolts and
body misalignment.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Subframe > Rear Subframe > System Information >
Service and Repair > Subframe - Rear
Rear Subframe: Service and Repair Subframe - Rear
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Subframe - Rear
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Subframe > Rear Subframe > System Information >
Service and Repair > Subframe - Rear > Page 7249
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Rear Subframe
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Subframe > Rear Subframe > System Information >
Service and Repair > Subframe - Rear > Page 7250
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Rear Subframe (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Subframe > Rear Subframe > System Information >
Service and Repair > Subframe - Rear > Page 7251
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Rear Subframe (Part 2)
CAUTION: Suspension and subframe fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance
of vital parts and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. A new part with the
same part number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement
part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during
reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the rear wheels. 2. If equipped, remove the bolts from the drive shaft-to-rear drive unit
flange.
- To install, tighten to 70 Nm (52 lb-ft).
3. With a wax pencil, mark the relationship of the rear subframe to the underbody at the mounting
locations.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Subframe > Rear Subframe > System Information >
Service and Repair > Subframe - Rear > Page 7252
4. Remove the muffler and tailpipe assembly. 5. Disconnect the LH and RH wheel speed sensor
connectors.
6. NOTE: All wheel drive (AWD) shown, front wheel drive (FWD) similar.
Remove the connector from the front of the subframe and position aside.
7. CAUTION: Do not allow the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly to hang from the brake
hose or damage to the hose may occur.
Remove the 4 bolts (2 each side) from the rear hub spindle-to-brake caliper. To install, tighten to 70 Nm (52 lb-ft).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Subframe > Rear Subframe > System Information >
Service and Repair > Subframe - Rear > Page 7253
8. Remove the 2 bolts (1 each side) from the brake hose bracket.
9. Position the brake calipers aside using mechanic's wire. It is not necessary to disconnect the
hydraulic brake lines.
10. Remove the 2 nuts (1 each side) from the parking brake cable bracket and upper stabilizer
shaft.
- Discard the nuts.
- To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
11. Remove the 4 bolts (2 each side) from the parking brake cable-to-backing plate.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Subframe > Rear Subframe > System Information >
Service and Repair > Subframe - Rear > Page 7254
- To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 lb-ft).
12. Remove the rear shock-to-trailing link lower nuts and flag bolts.
- Discard the nuts and flag bolts.
- To install, tighten to 80 Nm (59 lb-ft).
13. CAUTION:
- The rear subframe must be secured to the lifting table. The rear subframe may become unstable
and fall from the lifting table.
- Position a jackstand under the front of the vehicle to keep the vehicle from becoming unstable on
the hoist.
Position the lifting table under the rear subframe.
14. Remove the 4 front (2 each side) bushing brace-to-body bolts.
- Discard the bolts.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Subframe > Rear Subframe > System Information >
Service and Repair > Subframe - Rear > Page 7255
15. Remove the 2 front (1 each side) mounting nuts from the rear subframe.
- Discard the nuts.
- To install, tighten to 90 Nm (66 lb-ft).
16. NOTE: The bolts are 2 different sizes, note the location of the bolts to make sure of correct
installation.
Remove the 10 bolts (5 each side) from the trailing links-to-vehicle body. Discard the bolts.
- To install, tighten to 47 Nm (35 lb-ft).
17. NOTE: The rear springs are under pressure. The lifting table must be lowered slowly to relieve
the spring pressure.
Remove the 2 rear mounting nuts. Discard the nuts.
- To install, tighten to 90 Nm (66 lb-ft).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Subframe > Rear Subframe > System Information >
Service and Repair > Subframe - Rear > Page 7256
18. Remove the rear subframe. 19. Transfer the components as necessary. 20. To install, reverse
the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Subframe > Rear Subframe > System Information >
Service and Repair > Subframe - Rear > Page 7257
Rear Subframe: Service and Repair Subframe Bushings - Rear Differential, Rear
Subframe Bushings - Differential, Rear
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Subframe > Rear Subframe > System Information >
Service and Repair > Subframe - Rear > Page 7258
Removal
NOTE: There are 2 rear drive unit (RDU) bushings in the rear subframe, this procedure shows how
to remove one bushing. The procedure for the remaining RDU bushing is identical.
1. Remove the rear drive unit.
2. NOTE:
- Make sure the 204-617/2 is positioned with the larger opening toward the bushing to act as the
receiver cup.
- Make sure the arrow on the special tool is pointed toward the rear subframe when removing the
bushing.
Assemble the special tools to the rear subframe and press out the bushing.
Installation
NOTE: There are 2 RDU bushings in the subframe, this procedure shows how to install one
bushing. The procedure for the remaining RDU bushing is identical.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Subframe > Rear Subframe > System Information >
Service and Repair > Subframe - Rear > Page 7259
1. NOTE: Make sure the alignment marks on the special tool are aligned with the anti-rotation tabs
on the RDU bushing.
Install the RDU bushing into the special tool.
2. NOTE: Make sure the alignment marks are correctly aligned on both special tools and the
anti-rotation tabs are correctly seated in the special
tool.
Install the special tool onto the RDU bushing.
3. NOTE:
- Make sure the arrow on the special tool is visible on the bottom and facing away from the
subframe. The arrow must remain straight so that the bushings are correctly indexed into the
subframe.
- When installing the RDU bushing, 204-617/2 will fall away as the RDU bushing is installed into the
subframe. The special tool does not control the depth of the bushing, continue to tighten the nut
until the RDU bushing is fully seated into the subframe.
Install the RDU bushing into the subframe.
4. Install the RDU.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement
Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): Removal and Replacement
Spring
Spring (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7264
Spring (Part 2)
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
CAUTION: Suspension bushing fasteners must be tightened with the weight of the vehicle resting
on the wheel and tires.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly.
2. CAUTION: Do not allow the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly to hang from the brake
hose or damage to the hose can occur.
Remove the 2 anchor plate bolts and position the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly aside. ^
Support the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly using mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs).
3. Remove the brake disc. 4. Remove the nut and disconnect the stabilizer bar link and parking
brake cable bracket from the wheel knuckle.
^ Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs).
5. Remove the bolt, unclip the 2 retainers from the upper arm and position aside the wheel speed
sensor.
^ To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 inch lbs).
6. Remove the brake hose bracket bolt and position the hose aside.
^ To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 inch lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7265
All wheel drive (AWD) vehicles 7. Remove and discard the halfshaft nut.
^ To install, tighten to 275 (203 ft. lbs).
8. Using the special tool, separate the halfshaft from the hub and bearing.
All vehicles 9. Position a suitable jackstand under the lower arm.
10. Remove and discard the lower shock nut and flag bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 80 Nm (59 ft. lbs).
11. Remove and discard the upper arm outboard bolt and nut.
^ To install, tighten to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs).
12. Remove and discard the toe link outboard bolt and nut.
^ To install, tighten to 150 Nm (111 ft. lbs).
13. Lower and remove the jackstand.
AWD vehicles 14. Position the halfshaft through the wheel knuckle opening and secure the
halfshaft aside.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7266
All vehicles
15. WARNING: The spring is under extreme compression, care must be taken at all times. Failure
to follow this instruction may result in
personal injury.
Position the jackstand under the lower arm.
16. Remove and discard the lower arm outboard bolt and nut.
^ To install, tighten to 80 Nm (59 ft. lbs).
^ Tighten an additional 90 degrees.
17. WARNING: The spring is under extreme compression, care must be taken at all times. Failure
to follow this instruction may result in
personal injury.
Pull outward on the wheel knuckle while lowering the jack stand and remove the spring. ^
Inspect the spring upper and lower seats, install new seats as necessary.
18. CAUTION: Before tightening any suspension bushing fasteners the weight of the vehicle
resting on the wheel and tires.
NOTE: Use a suitable installation tool when installing the halfshaft into the wheel hub.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
19. If removed, position the spring lower seat into the lower arm aligning the recess in the seat with
the projection on the lower arm.
20. On installation, position the spring onto the lower arm with the end of the spring 0-10 mm
(0-0.39 inch) from the step on the spring seat.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7267
21. Check, and if necessary, align the vehicle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7268
Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): Overhaul
Shock Absorber and Spring Assembly
Shock Absorber and Spring Assembly
Disassembly
WARNING: All vehicles are equipped with gas-pressurized shock absorbers which will extend
unassisted. Do not apply heat or flame to the shock absorbers during removal or component
servicing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: The spring is under extreme compression, care must be taken at all times. Failure to
follow this instruction may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: The coil spring is coated with long-term corrosion protective paint. Do not damage the
paint during component servicing.
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the shock absorber and spring assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7269
2. WARNING: Always wear safety goggles when using a spring compressor. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal
injury.
Position the shock and spring assembly in a suitable spring compressor.
3. Compress the spring enough to relieve the tension on the shock and spring assembly.
4. CAUTION: Do not use an impact wrench on the shock absorber rod nut.
NOTE: Use the holding feature to prevent the shock absorber rod from turning while removing the
nut.
While holding the shock absorber rod, remove and discard the rod nut.
5. Remove the shock absorber assembly and spring lower seat. 6. Remove the dust boot and
jounce bumper. 7. Remove the shock absorber upper mount and spring upper seat. 8. Carefully
release the tension on the spring compressor and remove the spring.
Assembly
1. Install the lower spring seat, jounce bumper and dust boot onto the shock absorber.
2. WARNING: Always wear safety goggles when using a spring compressor. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal
injury.
Position the shock and spring assembly in a suitable spring compressor.
3. Install the spring, shock absorber upper mount and spring upper seat. 4. Align the arrow on the
upper mount perpendicular to the center of the shock absorber lower mount.
5. Compress the spring enough to relieve the tension on the shock and spring assembly. 6.
Position the end of spring within 0-10 mm (0-0.39 inch) of the upper spring mount.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7270
7. NOTE: Before tightening the shock absorber rod nut, position the end of the spring within 0-10
mm (0-0.39 inch) of the step on the lower spring
mount.
NOTE: Use the holding feature to prevent the shock absorber rod from turning while installing the
nut.
Install the shock absorber rod nut. ^
Tighten to 115 Nm (85 ft. lbs).
8. Release the tension on the shock and spring assembly. 9. Install the shock absorber and spring
assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 08-7-3 > Apr > 08 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pull or
Drift Condition
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Customer Interest Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pull or Drift
Condition
TSB 08-7-3
04/14/08
PULL/DRIFT
FORD: 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 07-7-6 to update the original TSB to add model years. No other
changes made.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Ford Edge and Lincoln MKX vehicles may exhibit a drift/pull concern that
occurs even though the tire pressures and wheel alignment are within specifications, and the
concern is not corrected by rotating the front tires left to right.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Verify that drift/pull is not being caused by concerns listed in Workshop Manual (WSM), Section
204-00 drift/pull diagnostics. If normal drift/pull WSM diagnostics/procedures do not resolve the
concern then refer to the following service steps.
NOTE
THIS SERVICE PROCEDURE MAY CAUSE THE FRONT CROSS CAMBER (TOTAL/SPLIT)
ALIGNMENT VALUE TO EXCEED THE SERVICE MANUAL SPECIFICATION OF 0.00 +/- 0.75
DEGREES. DO NOT EXCEED +/- 1.2 DEGREES OF CROSS CAMBER.
For a Right Drift/Pull
1. Inspect the left strut upper plate to verify which direction the arrow is pointing. (Figure 1)
NOTE
IF THE NOTCH IS VISIBLE IN THE ACCESS HOLE IN THE STRUT TOWER, THE PLATE HAS
ALREADY BEEN ROTATED A POSITIVE 0.5 DEGREE.
2. If the arrow is pointing inboard as seen through the access hole in Figure 1, no rotation is
necessary (positive 0.5 degree camber already there).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 08-7-3 > Apr > 08 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pull or
Drift Condition > Page 7279
Continue with Step 4.
3. If the arrow is pointing outboard, increase positive camber approximately 0.5 degrees on the left
front wheel by rotating the upper strut plate 180 degrees. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Camber
Adjustment - Front.
NOTE
DISCONNECT THE FRONT STABILIZER BAR LINK AT THE LOWER CONTROL ARM SO THAT
ENOUGH CLEARANCE CAN BE OBTAINED TO ROTATE THE UPPER STRUT MOUNT.
REPLACE THE STABILIZER BAR LINK NUT ON REASSEMBLY.
NOTE
REPLACE THE FOUR (4) UPPER STRUT MOUNT NUTS.
4. Place vehicle on alignment rack. Remove and replace the two (2) right front shock absorber
(strut) to wheel knuckle lower flag bolts and nuts but do not tighten. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
5. With full vehicle weight on the wheels allow the right wheel to increase negative camber and
tighten both lower flag bolts and nuts to 166 lb-ft (225 N.m). The camber shift may vary between
vehicles, but will typically be between a negative 0.2 and negative 0.6 degrees of camber change.
Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
6. Reset front toe adjustment to proper specifications. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Toe
Adjustment - Front.
For a Left Drift/Pull
1. Inspect the right strut upper plate to verify which direction the arrow is pointing. (Figure 1)
NOTE
IF THE NOTCH IS VISIBLE IN THE ACCESS HOLE IN THE STRUT TOWER, THE PLATE HAS
ALREADY BEEN ROTATED A POSITIVE 0.5 DEGREE.
2. If the arrow is pointing inboard, as seen through the access hole in Figure 1, no rotation is
necessary (positive 0.5 degree camber already there). Continue with Step 4.
3. If the arrow is pointing outboard, increase positive camber approximately 0.5 degrees on the
right front wheel by rotating the upper strut plate 180 degrees. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00,
Camber Adjustment - Front.
NOTE
DISCONNECT THE FRONT STABILIZER BAR LINK AT THE LOWER CONTROL ARM SO THAT
ENOUGH CLEARANCE CAN BE OBTAINED TO ROTATE THE UPPER STRUT MOUNT.
REPLACE THE STABILIZER BAR LINK NUT ON REASSEMBLY.
NOTE
REPLACE THE FOUR (4) UPPER STRUT MOUNT NUTS.
4. Place vehicle on alignment rack. Remove and replace the two (2) left front shock absorber (strut)
to wheel knuckle lower flag bolts and nuts but do not tighten. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
5. With full vehicle weight on the wheels allow the left wheel to increase negative camber and
tighten both lower flag bolts and nuts to 166 lb-ft (225 N.m). The camber shift may vary between
vehicles, but will typically be between a negative 0.2 and a negative 0.6 degrees of camber
change. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
6. Reset front toe adjustment to proper specifications. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Toe
Adjustment - Front.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 08-7-3 > Apr > 08 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pull or
Drift Condition > Page 7280
080703A 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.4 Hrs.
Increase Positive Camber Following Service Procedure. Includes Inspect Upper Strut Plate. (Do
Not Use With 3001A, 3001A1)
080703B 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.8 Hrs.
Increase Positive Camber Following Service Procedure. Includes Inspect and Rotate Upper Strut
Plate. (Do Not Use With 3001A, 3001A1)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
FRONT W6
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 08-7-3 > Apr > 08 > Steering/Suspension Vehicle Pull or Drift Condition
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering/Suspension - Vehicle
Pull or Drift Condition
TSB 08-7-3
04/14/08
PULL/DRIFT
FORD: 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 07-7-6 to update the original TSB to add model years. No other
changes made.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Ford Edge and Lincoln MKX vehicles may exhibit a drift/pull concern that
occurs even though the tire pressures and wheel alignment are within specifications, and the
concern is not corrected by rotating the front tires left to right.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Verify that drift/pull is not being caused by concerns listed in Workshop Manual (WSM), Section
204-00 drift/pull diagnostics. If normal drift/pull WSM diagnostics/procedures do not resolve the
concern then refer to the following service steps.
NOTE
THIS SERVICE PROCEDURE MAY CAUSE THE FRONT CROSS CAMBER (TOTAL/SPLIT)
ALIGNMENT VALUE TO EXCEED THE SERVICE MANUAL SPECIFICATION OF 0.00 +/- 0.75
DEGREES. DO NOT EXCEED +/- 1.2 DEGREES OF CROSS CAMBER.
For a Right Drift/Pull
1. Inspect the left strut upper plate to verify which direction the arrow is pointing. (Figure 1)
NOTE
IF THE NOTCH IS VISIBLE IN THE ACCESS HOLE IN THE STRUT TOWER, THE PLATE HAS
ALREADY BEEN ROTATED A POSITIVE 0.5 DEGREE.
2. If the arrow is pointing inboard as seen through the access hole in Figure 1, no rotation is
necessary (positive 0.5 degree camber already there).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 08-7-3 > Apr > 08 > Steering/Suspension Vehicle Pull or Drift Condition > Page 7286
Continue with Step 4.
3. If the arrow is pointing outboard, increase positive camber approximately 0.5 degrees on the left
front wheel by rotating the upper strut plate 180 degrees. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Camber
Adjustment - Front.
NOTE
DISCONNECT THE FRONT STABILIZER BAR LINK AT THE LOWER CONTROL ARM SO THAT
ENOUGH CLEARANCE CAN BE OBTAINED TO ROTATE THE UPPER STRUT MOUNT.
REPLACE THE STABILIZER BAR LINK NUT ON REASSEMBLY.
NOTE
REPLACE THE FOUR (4) UPPER STRUT MOUNT NUTS.
4. Place vehicle on alignment rack. Remove and replace the two (2) right front shock absorber
(strut) to wheel knuckle lower flag bolts and nuts but do not tighten. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
5. With full vehicle weight on the wheels allow the right wheel to increase negative camber and
tighten both lower flag bolts and nuts to 166 lb-ft (225 N.m). The camber shift may vary between
vehicles, but will typically be between a negative 0.2 and negative 0.6 degrees of camber change.
Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
6. Reset front toe adjustment to proper specifications. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Toe
Adjustment - Front.
For a Left Drift/Pull
1. Inspect the right strut upper plate to verify which direction the arrow is pointing. (Figure 1)
NOTE
IF THE NOTCH IS VISIBLE IN THE ACCESS HOLE IN THE STRUT TOWER, THE PLATE HAS
ALREADY BEEN ROTATED A POSITIVE 0.5 DEGREE.
2. If the arrow is pointing inboard, as seen through the access hole in Figure 1, no rotation is
necessary (positive 0.5 degree camber already there). Continue with Step 4.
3. If the arrow is pointing outboard, increase positive camber approximately 0.5 degrees on the
right front wheel by rotating the upper strut plate 180 degrees. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00,
Camber Adjustment - Front.
NOTE
DISCONNECT THE FRONT STABILIZER BAR LINK AT THE LOWER CONTROL ARM SO THAT
ENOUGH CLEARANCE CAN BE OBTAINED TO ROTATE THE UPPER STRUT MOUNT.
REPLACE THE STABILIZER BAR LINK NUT ON REASSEMBLY.
NOTE
REPLACE THE FOUR (4) UPPER STRUT MOUNT NUTS.
4. Place vehicle on alignment rack. Remove and replace the two (2) left front shock absorber (strut)
to wheel knuckle lower flag bolts and nuts but do not tighten. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
5. With full vehicle weight on the wheels allow the left wheel to increase negative camber and
tighten both lower flag bolts and nuts to 166 lb-ft (225 N.m). The camber shift may vary between
vehicles, but will typically be between a negative 0.2 and a negative 0.6 degrees of camber
change. Refer to WSM, Section 204-01.
6. Reset front toe adjustment to proper specifications. Refer to WSM, Section 204-00, Toe
Adjustment - Front.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 08-7-3 > Apr > 08 > Steering/Suspension Vehicle Pull or Drift Condition > Page 7287
080703A 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.4 Hrs.
Increase Positive Camber Following Service Procedure. Includes Inspect Upper Strut Plate. (Do
Not Use With 3001A, 3001A1)
080703B 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.8 Hrs.
Increase Positive Camber Following Service Procedure. Includes Inspect and Rotate Upper Strut
Plate. (Do Not Use With 3001A, 3001A1)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
FRONT W6
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: > 07-25-4 >
Dec > 07 > Body - Sunroof Slow Operation/Sticking/Binding
Sunroof / Moonroof Track: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Sunroof Slow
Operation/Sticking/Binding
TSB 07-25-4
12/24/07
ROOF OPENING PANEL SLOW OR STICKING/BINDING OPERATION
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles equipped with a roof opening panel and built before
8/1/2007 may experience a roof opening panel operating slow or sticking. This may be caused by
the roof opening panel guide tracks being out of specification.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove roof opening panel guide track mechanism following Workshop Manual (WSM), Section
501-17.
2. Remove both ditch moldings and clip strips. (Figure 1)
3. Remove both side panel end caps. (Figure 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: > 07-25-4 >
Dec > 07 > Body - Sunroof Slow Operation/Sticking/Binding > Page 7293
4. Tape painted roof area next to panels to prevent damage to paint. (Figure 3)
5. Remove and discard both roof opening panel trims.
CAUTION
MAKE SURE THE CUTTING BLADES ARE CHANGED WHERE THE CUTTING DEPTH
CHANGES TO AVOID DAMAGE TO THE BODY OR GLASS.
NOTE
LUBRICATE THE URETHANE ADHESIVE WITH WATER TO AID THE SPECIAL TOOL WHEN
CUTTING THE URETHANE ADHESIVE.
a. Cut the urethane adhesive with a pneumatic knife and remove. (Figure 4)
6. Carefully mark the location of both idler tracks in 3 places before removing any fasteners. The
new idler tracks must be installed in exactly the same position. Left hand shown, right hand similar.
7. Remove the six (6) rear idler track-to-housing screws. (Figure 5) There is a special Replacement
Screw available if a screw hole becomes stripped
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: > 07-25-4 >
Dec > 07 > Body - Sunroof Slow Operation/Sticking/Binding > Page 7294
during installation. For additional information, WSM, Section 501-17.
8. Completely loosen the two (2) center rear idler track-to-housing screws. The screws will be
captured inside the track rail. In some cases it may be necessary to lift rails to completely remove
screws from roof threads to allow idler track removal. (Figure 6)
9. Slide idler track rearward to disengage the idler track from the front clip.
10. Remove the idler track.
11. Remove the two (2) center screws from the idler track and install back into the roof opening
module. Hand tighten the two (2) center screws.
12. Repeat Steps 6 through 10 for the opposite side idler track.
13. Trim urethane adhesive to 0.01" (0.5 mm) base of original equipment urethane along the roof
opening module surface.
14. Using a soft brush or vacuum, remove any dirt or foreign material from the roof opening module
surface.
15. Touch up scratches on roof opening module from cutting old panels off. Refer to WSM, Section
501-35 Restoring Corrosion Protection Following Repair.
16. Modify new idler tracks prior to installation. (Figure 7)
a. Locate the screw head access in the new idler tracks.
b. Measure and mark at the screw head access, 2 clearance slots on the inside edge of each new
idler track, 1/2" (13 mm) wide and 3/16" (5 mm) deep.
c. Cut slots using a small die grinder or equivalent. View shows after modification of a new idler
track. (Figure 7)
17. Install the new idler tracks.
a. Using slots, position new idler track into module.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: > 07-25-4 >
Dec > 07 > Body - Sunroof Slow Operation/Sticking/Binding > Page 7295
18. Loosen the two (2) center rear idler track-to-housing screws and slide new idler track into
proper position. Loosen screws only to allow idler track to slide, do not remove.
19. Install and tighten remaining six (6) rear idler track-to-housing screws to 35 lb-in (4 N.m).
20. Tighten the two (2) center rear idler track to housing screws to 35 lb-in (4 N.m).
21. Repeat Steps 16 through 19 for the opposite side idler track.
22. Install roof opening panel guide track mechanism following WSM, Section 501-17.
NOTE
DO NOT INSTALL ROOF OPENING PANEL TRIMS AT THIS TIME.
23. Test operation of roof opening panel and adjust as necessary.
CAUTION
WHEN INSTALLING URETHANE-INSTALLED PARTS, THE VEHICLE MUST NOT BE DRIVEN
UNTIL THE URETHANE HAS CURED. ADEQUATE CURE TIME IS SPECIFIED ON THE DRIVE
AWAY CHART FOR EACH URETHANE PRODUCT AS THE TEMPERATURES AND HUMIDITY
VARY. INADEQUATE OR INCORRECT CURING CAN ADVERSELY AFFECT THE RETENTION
OF THE TRIM PANEL .
NOTE
BE SURE TO USE THE SAME BRAND OF CURE-RATE PRODUCTS FOR THE ADHESIVE AND
PRIMER. DO NOT MIX DIFFERENT BRANDS OF URETHANE AND PRIMER. REFER TO WSM,
SECTION 501-17.
24. Cut the urethane adhesive applicator tip to the specification. (Figure 8)
NOTE
USE EITHER A HIGH-RATIO, ELECTRIC OR BATTERY-OPERATED CAULK GUN THAT WILL
APPLY THE URETHANE WITH LESS EFFORT AND A CONTINUOUS BEAD.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: > 07-25-4 >
Dec > 07 > Body - Sunroof Slow Operation/Sticking/Binding > Page 7296
25. Apply a smooth continuous bead of urethane adhesive on top of the existing trimmed urethane
adhesive bead. Make sure that all gaps in the urethane adhesive are smoothed into one
continuous bead. (Figure 9)
26. Insert the front of the trim panel into the front trim seal then rotate the rear of the side trim panel
down to engage. Apply the side trim panel assembly to the roof module. (Figure 10)
27. Install both side panel end caps.
28. Install the clip strip and ditch moldings.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072504A 2007 Edge AWD, FWD, 6.0 Hrs.
2007 MKX AWD, FWD: Replace Roof Opening Panel Idler Tracks, Includes Time to Cut Slots in
New Idler Tracks and Replace Roof Opening Panel Side Trim. Remove and Install ditch molding,
Headliner, Pillar and Quarter Trim Panels, Roof Opening Panel Glass, Shade and Motor, Adjust
Roof Panel Glass and Re-initialize Motor. (Do Not Use With 50282B, 51902A, 15790A, 04104A,
51916B, 31012A, 15790A, 14056D, 51916A, 50222A)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: > 07-25-4 >
Dec > 07 > Body - Sunroof Slow Operation/Sticking/Binding > Page 7297
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7851070 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: > 07-25-4 >
Dec > 07 > Body - Sunroof Slow Operation/Sticking/Binding > Page 7303
4. Tape painted roof area next to panels to prevent damage to paint. (Figure 3)
5. Remove and discard both roof opening panel trims.
CAUTION
MAKE SURE THE CUTTING BLADES ARE CHANGED WHERE THE CUTTING DEPTH
CHANGES TO AVOID DAMAGE TO THE BODY OR GLASS.
NOTE
LUBRICATE THE URETHANE ADHESIVE WITH WATER TO AID THE SPECIAL TOOL WHEN
CUTTING THE URETHANE ADHESIVE.
a. Cut the urethane adhesive with a pneumatic knife and remove. (Figure 4)
6. Carefully mark the location of both idler tracks in 3 places before removing any fasteners. The
new idler tracks must be installed in exactly the same position. Left hand shown, right hand similar.
7. Remove the six (6) rear idler track-to-housing screws. (Figure 5) There is a special Replacement
Screw available if a screw hole becomes stripped
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: > 07-25-4 >
Dec > 07 > Body - Sunroof Slow Operation/Sticking/Binding > Page 7304
during installation. For additional information, WSM, Section 501-17.
8. Completely loosen the two (2) center rear idler track-to-housing screws. The screws will be
captured inside the track rail. In some cases it may be necessary to lift rails to completely remove
screws from roof threads to allow idler track removal. (Figure 6)
9. Slide idler track rearward to disengage the idler track from the front clip.
10. Remove the idler track.
11. Remove the two (2) center screws from the idler track and install back into the roof opening
module. Hand tighten the two (2) center screws.
12. Repeat Steps 6 through 10 for the opposite side idler track.
13. Trim urethane adhesive to 0.01" (0.5 mm) base of original equipment urethane along the roof
opening module surface.
14. Using a soft brush or vacuum, remove any dirt or foreign material from the roof opening module
surface.
15. Touch up scratches on roof opening module from cutting old panels off. Refer to WSM, Section
501-35 Restoring Corrosion Protection Following Repair.
16. Modify new idler tracks prior to installation. (Figure 7)
a. Locate the screw head access in the new idler tracks.
b. Measure and mark at the screw head access, 2 clearance slots on the inside edge of each new
idler track, 1/2" (13 mm) wide and 3/16" (5 mm) deep.
c. Cut slots using a small die grinder or equivalent. View shows after modification of a new idler
track. (Figure 7)
17. Install the new idler tracks.
a. Using slots, position new idler track into module.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: > 07-25-4 >
Dec > 07 > Body - Sunroof Slow Operation/Sticking/Binding > Page 7305
18. Loosen the two (2) center rear idler track-to-housing screws and slide new idler track into
proper position. Loosen screws only to allow idler track to slide, do not remove.
19. Install and tighten remaining six (6) rear idler track-to-housing screws to 35 lb-in (4 N.m).
20. Tighten the two (2) center rear idler track to housing screws to 35 lb-in (4 N.m).
21. Repeat Steps 16 through 19 for the opposite side idler track.
22. Install roof opening panel guide track mechanism following WSM, Section 501-17.
NOTE
DO NOT INSTALL ROOF OPENING PANEL TRIMS AT THIS TIME.
23. Test operation of roof opening panel and adjust as necessary.
CAUTION
WHEN INSTALLING URETHANE-INSTALLED PARTS, THE VEHICLE MUST NOT BE DRIVEN
UNTIL THE URETHANE HAS CURED. ADEQUATE CURE TIME IS SPECIFIED ON THE DRIVE
AWAY CHART FOR EACH URETHANE PRODUCT AS THE TEMPERATURES AND HUMIDITY
VARY. INADEQUATE OR INCORRECT CURING CAN ADVERSELY AFFECT THE RETENTION
OF THE TRIM PANEL .
NOTE
BE SURE TO USE THE SAME BRAND OF CURE-RATE PRODUCTS FOR THE ADHESIVE AND
PRIMER. DO NOT MIX DIFFERENT BRANDS OF URETHANE AND PRIMER. REFER TO WSM,
SECTION 501-17.
24. Cut the urethane adhesive applicator tip to the specification. (Figure 8)
NOTE
USE EITHER A HIGH-RATIO, ELECTRIC OR BATTERY-OPERATED CAULK GUN THAT WILL
APPLY THE URETHANE WITH LESS EFFORT AND A CONTINUOUS BEAD.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: > 07-25-4 >
Dec > 07 > Body - Sunroof Slow Operation/Sticking/Binding > Page 7306
25. Apply a smooth continuous bead of urethane adhesive on top of the existing trimmed urethane
adhesive bead. Make sure that all gaps in the urethane adhesive are smoothed into one
continuous bead. (Figure 9)
26. Insert the front of the trim panel into the front trim seal then rotate the rear of the side trim panel
down to engage. Apply the side trim panel assembly to the roof module. (Figure 10)
27. Install both side panel end caps.
28. Install the clip strip and ditch moldings.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072504A 2007 Edge AWD, FWD, 6.0 Hrs.
2007 MKX AWD, FWD: Replace Roof Opening Panel Idler Tracks, Includes Time to Cut Slots in
New Idler Tracks and Replace Roof Opening Panel Side Trim. Remove and Install ditch molding,
Headliner, Pillar and Quarter Trim Panels, Roof Opening Panel Glass, Shade and Motor, Adjust
Roof Panel Glass and Re-initialize Motor. (Do Not Use With 50282B, 51902A, 15790A, 04104A,
51916B, 31012A, 15790A, 14056D, 51916A, 50222A)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: > 07-25-4 >
Dec > 07 > Body - Sunroof Slow Operation/Sticking/Binding > Page 7307
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7851070 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Removal and Replacement
Front Suspension
Shock Absorber and Spring Assembly
Shock Absorber and Spring Assembly
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7310
major service expense. A new part with the same part number must be installed if installation
becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque
values must be used as specified during reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these
parts.
1. Remove and discard the 4 shock absorber upper mount nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs).
2. Remove the wheel and tire assembly. 3. Remove the shock absorber lower nuts, flag bolts and
the shock absorber and spring assembly.
^ Discard the nuts and flag bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 225 Nm (166 ft. lbs).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 5. Check and if necessary, adjust the alignment.
Rear Suspension
Shock Absorber
Removal and Installation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7311
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
NOTE: The new shock absorber is shipped with a strap securing it in the compressed position.
1. Remove the quarter trim panel. For additional information, refer to Trim Panel. 2. Remove and
discard the shock absorber upper nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs).
3. Remove the wheel and tire assembly. 4. Position a suitable jackstand under the lower arm. 5.
Remove the shock absorber lower bolt, flagnut and shock absorber.
^ Discard the bolt and flagnut.
^ To install, tighten to 80 Nm (59 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7312
6. CAUTION: Suspension bushing fasteners must be tightened with the weight of the vehicle
resting on the wheel and tires.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7313
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Overhaul
Shock Absorber and Spring Assembly
Shock Absorber and Spring Assembly
Disassembly
WARNING: All vehicles are equipped with gas-pressurized shock absorbers which will extend
unassisted. Do not apply heat or flame to the shock absorbers during removal or component
servicing. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: The spring is under extreme compression, care must be taken at all times. Failure to
follow this instruction may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: The coil spring is coated with long-term corrosion protective paint. Do not damage the
paint during component servicing.
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the shock absorber and spring assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7314
2. WARNING: Always wear safety goggles when using a spring compressor. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal
injury.
Position the shock and spring assembly in a suitable spring compressor.
3. Compress the spring enough to relieve the tension on the shock and spring assembly.
4. CAUTION: Do not use an impact wrench on the shock absorber rod nut.
NOTE: Use the holding feature to prevent the shock absorber rod from turning while removing the
nut.
While holding the shock absorber rod, remove and discard the rod nut.
5. Remove the shock absorber assembly and spring lower seat. 6. Remove the dust boot and
jounce bumper. 7. Remove the shock absorber upper mount and spring upper seat. 8. Carefully
release the tension on the spring compressor and remove the spring.
Assembly
1. Install the lower spring seat, jounce bumper and dust boot onto the shock absorber.
2. WARNING: Always wear safety goggles when using a spring compressor. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal
injury.
Position the shock and spring assembly in a suitable spring compressor.
3. Install the spring, shock absorber upper mount and spring upper seat. 4. Align the arrow on the
upper mount perpendicular to the center of the shock absorber lower mount.
5. Compress the spring enough to relieve the tension on the shock and spring assembly. 6.
Position the end of spring within 0-10 mm (0-0.39 inch) of the upper spring mount.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7315
7. NOTE: Before tightening the shock absorber rod nut, position the end of the spring within 0-10
mm (0-0.39 inch) of the step on the lower spring
mount.
NOTE: Use the holding feature to prevent the shock absorber rod from turning while installing the
nut.
Install the shock absorber rod nut. ^
Tighten to 115 Nm (85 ft. lbs).
8. Release the tension on the shock and spring assembly. 9. Install the shock absorber and spring
assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front
Wheel Bearing and Wheel Hub
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front > Page 7320
Removal
NOTE: If removing the wheel hub, the wheel bearing must be replaced.
1. Remove the wheel knuckle. 2. Using the special tool, press the wheel hub from the wheel
bearing.
3. NOTE: This step may not be necessary if the inner wheel bearing race remains in the wheel
knuckle after removing the wheel hub.
Using the special tool, press the inner wheel bearing race from the wheel hub.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front > Page 7321
4. Remove the snap ring. 5. Using the special tool, press the outer wheel bearing race from the
wheel knuckle.
Installation
1. Using the special tool, press the wheel bearing into the wheel knuckle.
2. Install the snap ring. 3. Using the special tools, press the wheel hub into the wheel bearing.
4. Install the wheel knuckle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front > Page 7322
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear
Wheel Bearing and Wheel Hub
Special Tool(s)
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicles
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front > Page 7323
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicles
Removal
All vehicles
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly.
2. CAUTION: Do not allow the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly to hang from the brake
hose or damage to the hose can occur.
Remove the 2 anchor plate bolts and position the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly aside. ^
Support the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly using mechanic's wire.
3. Remove the brake disc.
All wheel drive (AWD) vehicles 4. Remove and discard the halfshaft nut. 5. Using the special tool,
separate the halfshaft from the hub and bearing assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front > Page 7324
All vehicles 6. Remove the 4 bolts and the wheel bearing and wheel hub.
^ Discard the bolts.
Installation
All vehicles
1. Install the wheel bearing and new wheel hub bolts.
^ Tighten to 133 Nm (98 ft. lbs).
2. Position the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly and install the 2 bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs).
3. Install the brake disc.
AWD vehicles 4. Using a suitable installation tool, install the halfshaft into the wheel bearing and
wheel hub. 5. Install the halfshaft hub nut.
^ Tighten to 275 Nm (203 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
Front Wheel Hub Nut ...........................................................................................................................
.............................................. 350 Nm (258 ft. lbs).
Install a new front wheel hub nut.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub > Dust Cover, Wheel Hub > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Dust Cover: > 10-2-9 > Feb > 10 > Drivetrain - Growl/Howl
From Rear Hub Area
Dust Cover: Customer Interest Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area
TSB 10-2-9
02/15/10
NOISE FROM REAR WHEEL HUB BEARING - BUILT ON OR BEFORE 12/4/2008
FORD: 2007-2009 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 09-26-5 to update the Parts List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Edge and MKX vehicles built on or before 12/4/2008 may exhibit a growl
or howl type noise coming from the left and/or right rear wheel area. This could be the result of a
faulty rear wheel hub bearing assembly.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. If Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics identify a faulty rear wheel hub bearing, it will be
necessary to replace the rear suspension trailing
arm/knuckle assembly along with a new rear wheel hub bearing assembly.
2. Refer to WSM, Section 204-02, for rear wheel hub bearing and trailing arm/knuckle replacement.
Only replace the rear suspension trailing
arm/knuckle assembly and rear bearing hub on the side with the concern. Failing to install a new
rear suspension trailing arm/knuckle assembly when installing a new rear bearing hub assembly
will result in premature bearing noise/wear.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100209A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 1.3 Hrs.
FWD: Replace ONE Rear Wheel Hub Bearing And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assembly
100209A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 1.5 Hrs.
AWD: Replace ONE Rear Wheel Hub Bearing And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assembly
100209B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 2.4 Hrs.
FWD: Replace BOTH Rear
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub > Dust Cover, Wheel Hub > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Dust Cover: > 10-2-9 > Feb > 10 > Drivetrain - Growl/Howl
From Rear Hub Area > Page 7337
Wheel Hub Bearings And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assemblies
100209B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 2.8 Hrs.
AWD: Replace BOTH Rear Wheel Hub Bearings And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assemblies
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
1104 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub > Dust Cover, Wheel Hub > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Dust Cover: > 10-2-9 > Feb > 10 > Drivetrain Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area
Dust Cover: All Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area
TSB 10-2-9
02/15/10
NOISE FROM REAR WHEEL HUB BEARING - BUILT ON OR BEFORE 12/4/2008
FORD: 2007-2009 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 09-26-5 to update the Parts List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Edge and MKX vehicles built on or before 12/4/2008 may exhibit a growl
or howl type noise coming from the left and/or right rear wheel area. This could be the result of a
faulty rear wheel hub bearing assembly.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. If Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics identify a faulty rear wheel hub bearing, it will be
necessary to replace the rear suspension trailing
arm/knuckle assembly along with a new rear wheel hub bearing assembly.
2. Refer to WSM, Section 204-02, for rear wheel hub bearing and trailing arm/knuckle replacement.
Only replace the rear suspension trailing
arm/knuckle assembly and rear bearing hub on the side with the concern. Failing to install a new
rear suspension trailing arm/knuckle assembly when installing a new rear bearing hub assembly
will result in premature bearing noise/wear.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100209A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 1.3 Hrs.
FWD: Replace ONE Rear Wheel Hub Bearing And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assembly
100209A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 1.5 Hrs.
AWD: Replace ONE Rear Wheel Hub Bearing And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assembly
100209B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 2.4 Hrs.
FWD: Replace BOTH Rear
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub > Dust Cover, Wheel Hub > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Dust Cover: > 10-2-9 > Feb > 10 > Drivetrain Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area > Page 7343
Wheel Hub Bearings And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assemblies
100209B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 2.8 Hrs.
AWD: Replace BOTH Rear Wheel Hub Bearings And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assemblies
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
1104 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Vehicle Lifting: Description and Operation
JACKING
WARNING:
- Do not run the engine when jacking the vehicle. The wheels contacting the ground could cause
the vehicle to move. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Make sure the jack and jack stands are correctly located to prevent the vehicle from falling.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Wheel chocks should be used to prevent the vehicle from rolling and falling off the jack. Failure to
follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: The service jack provided with the vehicle is only intended to be used in an emergency
for changing a deflated tire. Never use the service jack to hoist the vehicle for any other service.
Refer to the Owner Guide when using the jack supplied with the vehicle.
Jacking Points - Front
1. The front jacking points are identified by an upside down triangle on the rocker panel moulding
just behind the front wheels. Position the jack so
its lift area fits on the frame underneath the triangle.
Jacking Points - Rear
1. The rear jacking points are identified by an upside down triangle on the rocker panel moulding
just in front of the rear wheels. Position the jack so
its lift area fits on the frame underneath the triangle.
LIFTING
Lifting Points
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 7348
CAUTION: Under no circumstances should the vehicle be lifted by the front control arms, front cross braces or
rear control arms. Severe damage to the vehicle could result.
- Do not allow the lift adapters to contact the steering linkage, suspension arms, front cross braces,
stabilizer bar, or to compress the lower suspension arm stabilizer bar insulator. Damage to the
suspension, exhaust and steering linkage components may occur if care is not exercised when
positioning the lift adapters prior to lifting the vehicle.
1. CAUTION: Damage to the suspension, exhaust or steering linkage components may occur if
care is not exercised when positioning the
hoist adapters prior to lifting the vehicle.
The lifting points are part of the uni-body structure.
2. The front lifting points are identified by an upside down triangle on the rocker panel moulding just
behind the front wheels. Position the hoist
adapters directly under the frame rail with the triangle centered.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 7349
3. The rear lifting points are identified by an upside down triangle on the rocker panel moulding just
in front of the rear wheels. Position the hoist
adapters directly under the frame rail with the triangle centered.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training
Special Tool(s)
NOTE: If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, the sensors will go into a "sleep
mode" to conserve battery power. It will be necessary to wake them up so they will transmit the
latest tire pressure information to the Smart Junction Box (SJB).
NOTE: The tire pressure sensor training procedure must be done on a single vehicle, in an area
without radio frequency noise and at least 1 m (3 ft) away from other vehicles equipped with a Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS).
Radio frequency noise is generated by electrical motors and appliance operation, cellular
telephones, remote transmitters, power inverters and portable entertainment equipment.
NOTE: If a sensor does not respond to the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool, attempt to
activate the same sensor with the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. If the sensor still does not
respond, move the vehicle to rotate the wheels at least one-fourth of a turn and attempt to activate
the same sensor again.
NOTE: The SJB has a 2-minute time limit between sensor responses. If the SJB does not
recognize any 1 of the 4 tire pressure sensors during this time limit, the horn will sound twice and
the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE NOT TRAINED REPEAT and the entire
procedure must be repeated.
NOTE: For vehicles with different front and rear tire pressures (such as the E-Series and certain
F-Series), the tire pressure sensors must be trained following a tire rotation. Failure to train the
sensors will cause the TPMS indicator to illuminate. For vehicles with the same tire pressure for
front and rear tires, tire rotation will not affect the system.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position, then press and release the brake pedal. 2. Cycle the
ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position. 3.
Press and release the brake pedal. 4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position. 5. Turn the
ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position.
- The horn will sound once and the TPMS indicator will flash if the training mode has been entered
successfully. If equipped, the message center will display TRAIN LF TIRE.
NOTE: It may take up to 6 seconds to activate a tire pressure sensor. During this time, the Tire
Pressure Monitor Activation Tool must remain in place 180 degrees from the valve stem.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 7354
6. Place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the LF tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees)
from the valve stem. Press and release the test
button on the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. The horn will sound briefly to indicate that the
tire pressure sensor has been recognized by the SJB.
7. Within 2 minutes of the horn sounding, place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the RF
tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees) from the
valve stem and press and release the test button to train the RF tire pressure sensor.
NOTE: Do not wait more than 2 minutes between training each sensor or the SJB will time out and
the entire procedure must be repeated.
8. Repeat Step 7 for the RR and LR tires.
The procedure is completed after the last tire has been trained. When the training procedure is
complete, the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE TRAINING COMPLETE. For vehicles
not equipped with a message center, successful completion of the training procedure will be
verified by turning the ignition switch to the OFF position without the horn sounding. If the horn
sounds twice when the switch is turned to the OFF position, the training procedure was not
successful.
9. Using the scan tool, locate the updated TPMS sensor identifiers trained to the SJB and
document them on the applicable warranty claim.
NOTE: This step is required to clear DTC C2780, cause the SJB to exit the manufacturing mode
and to make sure there are no other concerns with a newly programmed SJB.
10. If the sensors are being trained due to the installation of a new SJB, clear any DTCs and carry
out the SJB On-Demand Self Test.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Disassembly
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application.
When installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color
of the sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor can be removed and installed without removing the strap or the cradle.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
1. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Dismount the tire only as
instructed.
Remove the tire from the wheel.
2. CAUTION: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to
the sensor locking clip can occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the sensor locking clip.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor >
Page 7357
3. CAUTION: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to
the sensor can occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver or similar tool, detach the sensor from the cradle.
4. Remove the sensor.
Assembly
1. CAUTION: Damage to the sensor can occur if excessive force is applied during sensor
installation.
NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the cradle. The sensor will make a "click" noise
when correctly seated.
Position the sensor into the cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end of the
cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. NOTE: The locking clip can only be fully seated when installed in the correct orientation. If the
sensor locking clip cannot be fully inserted, then
the sensor may not be fully seated on the cradle or the locking clip may be inserted backward.
Insert a new locking clip into the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor >
Page 7358
3. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel.
4. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor >
Page 7359
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and
Cradle
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and Cradle
Material
Disassembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor >
Page 7360
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application.
When installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color
of the sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor is available separately, the cradle and strap are available as a strap kit. There
are several different strap kits available based on wheel diameter but all strap kits share the same
base part number.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
1. Remove the tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor.
2. WARNING: The TPMS band is under tension. Always use safety goggles or a face shield and
gloves when removing the TPMS
band/strap. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
Remove a factory installed strap in this sequence: 1
Locate the strap buckle and secure the strap to the wheel using duct tape or a similar item, on both
sides of the buckle approximately 25 mm (0.98 inch) from the buckle.
2 Using a large screwdriver and a twisting motion, unbuckle the strap.
3 Discard the strap.
3. To remove a dealer installed strap, turn the worm gear screw until the strap is fully released from
the worm gear.
^ Discard the strap.
4. NOTE: To aid assembly, mark the location of the cradle prior to disassembly.
Using a screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the cradle by inserting the screwdriver under the cradle
and prying up.
Assembly
1. NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the new cradle. The sensor will make a "click"
noise when fully seated.
Position the sensor into the new cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end
of the cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. CAUTION: Metal scrapers can damage the wheel. Use only plastic or non-metallic scrapers to
remove the cradle adhesive strip residue.
NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be installed in the drop well of the wheel, 180 degrees from the
valve stem.
Clean the area where the sensor and cradle are to be installed.
3. NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be positioned with the hinge side of the sensor on the RH
side when viewed from the curb side (beauty side)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor >
Page 7361
of the wheel.
NOTE: The sensor has raised markings indicating how to position the sensor.
Remove the adhesive tape liner from the cradle and position the sensor and cradle into the wheel
drop well 180 degrees from the valve stem.
4. Install the tapered end of the strap through the opening of the cradle on the hinge side of the
sensor. This will position the worm gear on the
locking clip side of the sensor.
5. CAUTION: Steel wheels have a "high spot" along their circumference. Make sure the strap is
positioned in the lowest spot possible for
correct sensor and cradle retention.
NOTE: Keep the strap parallel with the wheel flange while tightening the worm gear.
Position the worm gear 13-26 mm (0.5-1.0 inch) away from the sensor and tighten the worm gear.
^
Tighten to 3 Nm (27 inch lbs).
6. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel.
7. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Low Tire Pressure
Indicator > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Low Tire Pressure Indicator: Testing and Inspection
TPMS Indicator and Message Center Messages The TPMS indicator and vehicle message center
(if equipped) sometimes displays faults that cannot be resolved by the customer. Treat these
messages as TPMS faults that must be serviced.
TPMS Indicator Illuminates Continuously
NOTE: If the spare tire is in use, the damaged road tire must be repaired and installed on the
vehicle to restore complete TPMS functionality before carrying out any diagnosis.
1. The TPMS indicator remains on continuously for this condition:
^ Low Tire Pressure - The TPMS indicator is illuminated solid and the message center displays
LOW TIRE PRESSURE (if equipped). This is displayed when any of the tire pressures are low.
When this condition exists, the tire pressure must be adjusted to the recommended cold pressure
as indicated on the vehicle certification label.
2. NOTE: The TPMS sensors do not transmit when the vehicle is stationary. If the vehicle has been
stationary for more than 30 minutes, it will be
necessary to wake up the sensors so they will transmit the latest tire pressure information to the
SJB.
If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, perform this procedure to wake up the
TPMS sensors. 1
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
2 Adjust the air pressure in the LF tire (as necessary).
3 Activate the LF TPMS sensor, at least 2 times, using the tire pressure monitor activation tool.
4 Repeat Steps 2 and 3 for the remaining tires.
5 If the TPMS indicator remains illuminated after adjusting and activating each sensor, GO to
Symptom Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
TPMS Indicator Flashes The TPMS indicator flashes for 70 seconds, then remains ON solid when
the ignition switch is turned to the ON position, for these conditions:
1. Tire Pressure Sensor Fault - If equipped, the message center will display TIRE SENSOR FAULT
when a tire pressure sensor is malfunctioning.
GO to Symptom Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
2. No communication with the SJB (TPMS is integral to the SJB) - The TPMS indicator is
illuminated when the instrument cluster has received no
signals from the SJB for more than 5 seconds. If equipped, the message center displays TIRE
MONITOR FAULT. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
3. Tire Pressure Monitor Fault - If equipped, the message center will display TIRE MONITOR
FAULT when the tire pressure monitoring system is
malfunctioning or communication with the instrument cluster has been lost. GO to Symptom Chart.
See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training
Special Tool(s)
NOTE: If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, the sensors will go into a "sleep
mode" to conserve battery power. It will be necessary to wake them up so they will transmit the
latest tire pressure information to the Smart Junction Box (SJB).
NOTE: The tire pressure sensor training procedure must be done on a single vehicle, in an area
without radio frequency noise and at least 1 m (3 ft) away from other vehicles equipped with a Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS).
Radio frequency noise is generated by electrical motors and appliance operation, cellular
telephones, remote transmitters, power inverters and portable entertainment equipment.
NOTE: If a sensor does not respond to the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool, attempt to
activate the same sensor with the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. If the sensor still does not
respond, move the vehicle to rotate the wheels at least one-fourth of a turn and attempt to activate
the same sensor again.
NOTE: The SJB has a 2-minute time limit between sensor responses. If the SJB does not
recognize any 1 of the 4 tire pressure sensors during this time limit, the horn will sound twice and
the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE NOT TRAINED REPEAT and the entire
procedure must be repeated.
NOTE: For vehicles with different front and rear tire pressures (such as the E-Series and certain
F-Series), the tire pressure sensors must be trained following a tire rotation. Failure to train the
sensors will cause the TPMS indicator to illuminate. For vehicles with the same tire pressure for
front and rear tires, tire rotation will not affect the system.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position, then press and release the brake pedal. 2. Cycle the
ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position. 3.
Press and release the brake pedal. 4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position. 5. Turn the
ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position.
- The horn will sound once and the TPMS indicator will flash if the training mode has been entered
successfully. If equipped, the message center will display TRAIN LF TIRE.
NOTE: It may take up to 6 seconds to activate a tire pressure sensor. During this time, the Tire
Pressure Monitor Activation Tool must remain in place 180 degrees from the valve stem.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 7369
6. Place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the LF tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees)
from the valve stem. Press and release the test
button on the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. The horn will sound briefly to indicate that the
tire pressure sensor has been recognized by the SJB.
7. Within 2 minutes of the horn sounding, place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the RF
tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees) from the
valve stem and press and release the test button to train the RF tire pressure sensor.
NOTE: Do not wait more than 2 minutes between training each sensor or the SJB will time out and
the entire procedure must be repeated.
8. Repeat Step 7 for the RR and LR tires.
The procedure is completed after the last tire has been trained. When the training procedure is
complete, the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE TRAINING COMPLETE. For vehicles
not equipped with a message center, successful completion of the training procedure will be
verified by turning the ignition switch to the OFF position without the horn sounding. If the horn
sounds twice when the switch is turned to the OFF position, the training procedure was not
successful.
9. Using the scan tool, locate the updated TPMS sensor identifiers trained to the SJB and
document them on the applicable warranty claim.
NOTE: This step is required to clear DTC C2780, cause the SJB to exit the manufacturing mode
and to make sure there are no other concerns with a newly programmed SJB.
10. If the sensors are being trained due to the installation of a new SJB, clear any DTCs and carry
out the SJB On-Demand Self Test.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Disassembly
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application.
When installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color
of the sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor can be removed and installed without removing the strap or the cradle.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
1. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Dismount the tire only as
instructed.
Remove the tire from the wheel.
2. CAUTION: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to
the sensor locking clip can occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the sensor locking clip.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 7372
3. CAUTION: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to
the sensor can occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver or similar tool, detach the sensor from the cradle.
4. Remove the sensor.
Assembly
1. CAUTION: Damage to the sensor can occur if excessive force is applied during sensor
installation.
NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the cradle. The sensor will make a "click" noise
when correctly seated.
Position the sensor into the cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end of the
cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. NOTE: The locking clip can only be fully seated when installed in the correct orientation. If the
sensor locking clip cannot be fully inserted, then
the sensor may not be fully seated on the cradle or the locking clip may be inserted backward.
Insert a new locking clip into the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 7373
3. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel.
4. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 7374
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and
Cradle
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and Cradle
Material
Disassembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 7375
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application.
When installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color
of the sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor is available separately, the cradle and strap are available as a strap kit. There
are several different strap kits available based on wheel diameter but all strap kits share the same
base part number.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
1. Remove the tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor.
2. WARNING: The TPMS band is under tension. Always use safety goggles or a face shield and
gloves when removing the TPMS
band/strap. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
Remove a factory installed strap in this sequence: 1
Locate the strap buckle and secure the strap to the wheel using duct tape or a similar item, on both
sides of the buckle approximately 25 mm (0.98 inch) from the buckle.
2 Using a large screwdriver and a twisting motion, unbuckle the strap.
3 Discard the strap.
3. To remove a dealer installed strap, turn the worm gear screw until the strap is fully released from
the worm gear.
^ Discard the strap.
4. NOTE: To aid assembly, mark the location of the cradle prior to disassembly.
Using a screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the cradle by inserting the screwdriver under the cradle
and prying up.
Assembly
1. NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the new cradle. The sensor will make a "click"
noise when fully seated.
Position the sensor into the new cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end
of the cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. CAUTION: Metal scrapers can damage the wheel. Use only plastic or non-metallic scrapers to
remove the cradle adhesive strip residue.
NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be installed in the drop well of the wheel, 180 degrees from the
valve stem.
Clean the area where the sensor and cradle are to be installed.
3. NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be positioned with the hinge side of the sensor on the RH
side when viewed from the curb side (beauty side)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 7376
of the wheel.
NOTE: The sensor has raised markings indicating how to position the sensor.
Remove the adhesive tape liner from the cradle and position the sensor and cradle into the wheel
drop well 180 degrees from the valve stem.
4. Install the tapered end of the strap through the opening of the cradle on the hinge side of the
sensor. This will position the worm gear on the
locking clip side of the sensor.
5. CAUTION: Steel wheels have a "high spot" along their circumference. Make sure the strap is
positioned in the lowest spot possible for
correct sensor and cradle retention.
NOTE: Keep the strap parallel with the wheel flange while tightening the worm gear.
Position the worm gear 13-26 mm (0.5-1.0 inch) away from the sensor and tighten the worm gear.
^
Tighten to 3 Nm (27 inch lbs).
6. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel.
7. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheels: > 09-11-2 > Jun > 09 > Wheels/Tires - Popping/Snapping Noise At Low
Speeds
Wheels: Customer Interest Wheels/Tires - Popping/Snapping Noise At Low Speeds
TSB 09-11-2
06/15/09
POPPING/SNAPPING NOISE - FRONT OR REAR 18 INCH WHEELS - TURNING AT SLOW
SPEED BELOW 10 MPH (16 KM/H)
FORD: 2007-2008 Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
MERCURY: 2007-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 09-4-3 to update the vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Explorer, Sport Trac, and Mountaineer vehicles built prior to 1/28/2008
and 2007-2008 Edge and MKX vehicles built prior to 8/18/2008 and equipped with 18 inch wheels
may exhibit a noise coming from the front or rear wheel(s) while turning the steering wheel at
speeds lower than 10 MPH (16 Km/h). The noise may be coming from the chrome cladding that
attaches to the rim.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IF THE SOURCE OF NOISE IS NOT FROM THE WHEEL, FOLLOW NORMAL WORKSHOP
MANUAL PROCEDURES.
1. Verify the noise is coming from the wheel(s).
2. Replace the wheel(s) that have the noise with updated service parts. Refer to Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 204-04.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheels: > 09-11-2 > Jun > 09 > Wheels/Tires - Popping/Snapping Noise At Low
Speeds > Page 7385
3. Lubricate the remaining wheels at the outboard wheel flange, between the cladding and the
wheel inter[ace. Use Motorcraft(R) Silicone Spray
Lubricant with an extension nozzle. (Figures 1 and 2)
4. Clean any excess lubricant off the wheel with a soft cloth.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091102A 2007-2008 Explorer, 0.9 Hr.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge, MKX:
Replace One Wheel
and Lubricate Remaining Three Wheels. Includes Test Drive, Transfer Tire Pressure Monitor
Sensor (TPMS), And Balance Wheel Assembly (Do Not Use With 1007A, 1007A1)
091102B 2007-2008 Explorer, 1.1 Hrs.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge, MKX:
Replace Two
Wheels and Lubricate Remaining Two Wheels. Includes Test Drive, Transfer Tire Pressure Monitor
Sensor (TPMS), And Balance Wheel Assemblies (Do Not Use With 1007A, 1007A1)
091102C 2007-2008 Explorer, 1.4 Hrs.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge,
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheels: > 09-11-2 > Jun > 09 > Wheels/Tires - Popping/Snapping Noise At Low
Speeds > Page 7386
MKX: Replace Three Wheels and Lubricate Remaining Wheel. Includes Test Drive, Transfer Tire
Pressure Monitor Sensor (TPMS), Balance And Balance Wheel Assemblies (Do Not Use With
1007A, 1007A1)
091102D 2007-2008 Explorer, 1.6 Hrs.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge, MKX: Replace Four Wheels. Includes Test Drive,
Transfer Tire Pressure Monitor Sensor (TPMS), And Balance Wheel Assemblies (Do Not Use With
1007A, 1007A1)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
1007 68
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheels: > 07-23-4 > Nov > 07 > Wheels/Tires - Popping Noise From Wheels
When Turning
Wheels: Customer Interest Wheels/Tires - Popping Noise From Wheels When Turning
TSB 07-23-4
11/26/07
POPPING/SNAPPING NOISE - FRONT OR REAR 18 INCH WHEELS - TURNING AT SLOW
SPEEDS BELOW 10 MPH (16KM/H)
FORD: 2007 Edge 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer
MERCURY: 2007-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 07-19-6 to update the vehicle lines.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Explorer, Explorer Sport Trac and Mountaineer vehicles built prior to
8/17/2007 and 2007 Edge vehicles built prior to 8/24/2007 and equipped with 18" wheels may
exhibit noise coming from the front or rear wheel(s) while turning the steering wheel at speeds
lower than 10 MPH (16 Km/h). The noise may be coming from the chrome cladding that attaches to
the rim.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IF THE SOURCE OF NOISE IS NOT FROM THE WHEEL, FOLLOW NORMAL WORKSHOP
MANUAL PROCEDURES.
1. Verify the noise is coming from the wheel(s).
2. Replace wheel(s) with updated service parts for 18" Chrome (Bright) Clad Cast Aluminum wheel
and Satin Clad Cast Aluminum wheel(s). Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 204-04.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheels: > 07-23-4 > Nov > 07 > Wheels/Tires - Popping Noise From Wheels
When Turning > Page 7391
3. Lubricate the remaining wheels at the outboard wheel flange, between the cladding and the
wheel inter[ace. Use Motorcraft Silicone Spray Lubricant and spray lubricant with an extension
nozzle. (Figures 1 and 2)
NOTE
NEW WHEELS WILL NOT REQUIRE LUBRICATION.
4. Clean any excess lubricate off the wheel with a soft cloth.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072304A 2007-2008 Explorer, 0.9 Hr.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge: Replace One Wheel and Lubricate Remaining
Three Wheels. Includes Test Drive, Transfer Tire Pressure Monitor Sensor (TPMS), And Balance
Wheel Assembly (Do Not Use With 1007A, 1007A1)
072304B 2007-2008 Explorer, 1.1 Hrs.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge: Replace Two Wheels and Lubricate Remaining Two
Wheels. Includes Test Drive, Transfer TPMS, And Balance Wheel Assemblies (Do Not Use With
1007A, 1007A1)
072304C 2007-2008 Explorer, 1.4 Hrs.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge:
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheels: > 07-23-4 > Nov > 07 > Wheels/Tires - Popping Noise From Wheels
When Turning > Page 7392
Replace Three Wheels and Lubricate Remaining Wheel. Includes Test Drive, Transfer TPMS,
Balance And Balance Wheel Assemblies (Do Not Use With 1007A, 1007A1)
072304D 2007-2008 Explorer, 1.6 Hrs.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge: Replace Four Wheels. Includes Test Drive, Transfer
TPMS, And Balance Wheel Assemblies (Do Not Use With 1007A, 1007A1)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
1007 68
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 09-11-2 > Jun > 09 > Wheels/Tires - Popping/Snapping
Noise At Low Speeds
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Popping/Snapping Noise At Low Speeds
TSB 09-11-2
06/15/09
POPPING/SNAPPING NOISE - FRONT OR REAR 18 INCH WHEELS - TURNING AT SLOW
SPEED BELOW 10 MPH (16 KM/H)
FORD: 2007-2008 Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
MERCURY: 2007-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 09-4-3 to update the vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Explorer, Sport Trac, and Mountaineer vehicles built prior to 1/28/2008
and 2007-2008 Edge and MKX vehicles built prior to 8/18/2008 and equipped with 18 inch wheels
may exhibit a noise coming from the front or rear wheel(s) while turning the steering wheel at
speeds lower than 10 MPH (16 Km/h). The noise may be coming from the chrome cladding that
attaches to the rim.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IF THE SOURCE OF NOISE IS NOT FROM THE WHEEL, FOLLOW NORMAL WORKSHOP
MANUAL PROCEDURES.
1. Verify the noise is coming from the wheel(s).
2. Replace the wheel(s) that have the noise with updated service parts. Refer to Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 204-04.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 09-11-2 > Jun > 09 > Wheels/Tires - Popping/Snapping
Noise At Low Speeds > Page 7398
3. Lubricate the remaining wheels at the outboard wheel flange, between the cladding and the
wheel inter[ace. Use Motorcraft(R) Silicone Spray
Lubricant with an extension nozzle. (Figures 1 and 2)
4. Clean any excess lubricant off the wheel with a soft cloth.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091102A 2007-2008 Explorer, 0.9 Hr.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge, MKX:
Replace One Wheel
and Lubricate Remaining Three Wheels. Includes Test Drive, Transfer Tire Pressure Monitor
Sensor (TPMS), And Balance Wheel Assembly (Do Not Use With 1007A, 1007A1)
091102B 2007-2008 Explorer, 1.1 Hrs.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge, MKX:
Replace Two
Wheels and Lubricate Remaining Two Wheels. Includes Test Drive, Transfer Tire Pressure Monitor
Sensor (TPMS), And Balance Wheel Assemblies (Do Not Use With 1007A, 1007A1)
091102C 2007-2008 Explorer, 1.4 Hrs.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge,
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 09-11-2 > Jun > 09 > Wheels/Tires - Popping/Snapping
Noise At Low Speeds > Page 7399
MKX: Replace Three Wheels and Lubricate Remaining Wheel. Includes Test Drive, Transfer Tire
Pressure Monitor Sensor (TPMS), Balance And Balance Wheel Assemblies (Do Not Use With
1007A, 1007A1)
091102D 2007-2008 Explorer, 1.6 Hrs.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge, MKX: Replace Four Wheels. Includes Test Drive,
Transfer Tire Pressure Monitor Sensor (TPMS), And Balance Wheel Assemblies (Do Not Use With
1007A, 1007A1)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
1007 68
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 07-23-4 > Nov > 07 > Wheels/Tires - Popping Noise From
Wheels When Turning
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Popping Noise From Wheels When Turning
TSB 07-23-4
11/26/07
POPPING/SNAPPING NOISE - FRONT OR REAR 18 INCH WHEELS - TURNING AT SLOW
SPEEDS BELOW 10 MPH (16KM/H)
FORD: 2007 Edge 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer
MERCURY: 2007-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 07-19-6 to update the vehicle lines.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Explorer, Explorer Sport Trac and Mountaineer vehicles built prior to
8/17/2007 and 2007 Edge vehicles built prior to 8/24/2007 and equipped with 18" wheels may
exhibit noise coming from the front or rear wheel(s) while turning the steering wheel at speeds
lower than 10 MPH (16 Km/h). The noise may be coming from the chrome cladding that attaches to
the rim.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IF THE SOURCE OF NOISE IS NOT FROM THE WHEEL, FOLLOW NORMAL WORKSHOP
MANUAL PROCEDURES.
1. Verify the noise is coming from the wheel(s).
2. Replace wheel(s) with updated service parts for 18" Chrome (Bright) Clad Cast Aluminum wheel
and Satin Clad Cast Aluminum wheel(s). Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 204-04.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 07-23-4 > Nov > 07 > Wheels/Tires - Popping Noise From
Wheels When Turning > Page 7404
3. Lubricate the remaining wheels at the outboard wheel flange, between the cladding and the
wheel inter[ace. Use Motorcraft Silicone Spray Lubricant and spray lubricant with an extension
nozzle. (Figures 1 and 2)
NOTE
NEW WHEELS WILL NOT REQUIRE LUBRICATION.
4. Clean any excess lubricate off the wheel with a soft cloth.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072304A 2007-2008 Explorer, 0.9 Hr.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge: Replace One Wheel and Lubricate Remaining
Three Wheels. Includes Test Drive, Transfer Tire Pressure Monitor Sensor (TPMS), And Balance
Wheel Assembly (Do Not Use With 1007A, 1007A1)
072304B 2007-2008 Explorer, 1.1 Hrs.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge: Replace Two Wheels and Lubricate Remaining Two
Wheels. Includes Test Drive, Transfer TPMS, And Balance Wheel Assemblies (Do Not Use With
1007A, 1007A1)
072304C 2007-2008 Explorer, 1.4 Hrs.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge:
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 07-23-4 > Nov > 07 > Wheels/Tires - Popping Noise From
Wheels When Turning > Page 7405
Replace Three Wheels and Lubricate Remaining Wheel. Includes Test Drive, Transfer TPMS,
Balance And Balance Wheel Assemblies (Do Not Use With 1007A, 1007A1)
072304D 2007-2008 Explorer, 1.6 Hrs.
Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer, 2007 Edge: Replace Four Wheels. Includes Test Drive, Transfer
TPMS, And Balance Wheel Assemblies (Do Not Use With 1007A, 1007A1)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
1007 68
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front
Wheel Bearing and Wheel Hub
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 7410
Removal
NOTE: If removing the wheel hub, the wheel bearing must be replaced.
1. Remove the wheel knuckle. 2. Using the special tool, press the wheel hub from the wheel
bearing.
3. NOTE: This step may not be necessary if the inner wheel bearing race remains in the wheel
knuckle after removing the wheel hub.
Using the special tool, press the inner wheel bearing race from the wheel hub.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 7411
4. Remove the snap ring. 5. Using the special tool, press the outer wheel bearing race from the
wheel knuckle.
Installation
1. Using the special tool, press the wheel bearing into the wheel knuckle.
2. Install the snap ring. 3. Using the special tools, press the wheel hub into the wheel bearing.
4. Install the wheel knuckle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 7412
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear
Wheel Bearing and Wheel Hub
Special Tool(s)
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicles
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 7413
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicles
Removal
All vehicles
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the wheel and tire assembly.
2. CAUTION: Do not allow the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly to hang from the brake
hose or damage to the hose can occur.
Remove the 2 anchor plate bolts and position the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly aside. ^
Support the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly using mechanic's wire.
3. Remove the brake disc.
All wheel drive (AWD) vehicles 4. Remove and discard the halfshaft nut. 5. Using the special tool,
separate the halfshaft from the hub and bearing assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 7414
All vehicles 6. Remove the 4 bolts and the wheel bearing and wheel hub.
^ Discard the bolts.
Installation
All vehicles
1. Install the wheel bearing and new wheel hub bolts.
^ Tighten to 133 Nm (98 ft. lbs).
2. Position the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly and install the 2 bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs).
3. Install the brake disc.
AWD vehicles 4. Using a suitable installation tool, install the halfshaft into the wheel bearing and
wheel hub. 5. Install the halfshaft hub nut.
^ Tighten to 275 Nm (203 ft. lbs).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information
> Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
Front Wheel Hub Nut ...........................................................................................................................
.............................................. 350 Nm (258 ft. lbs).
Install a new front wheel hub nut.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Dust Cover, Wheel Hub >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Dust Cover: > 10-2-9 > Feb > 10 > Drivetrain Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area
Dust Cover: Customer Interest Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area
TSB 10-2-9
02/15/10
NOISE FROM REAR WHEEL HUB BEARING - BUILT ON OR BEFORE 12/4/2008
FORD: 2007-2009 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 09-26-5 to update the Parts List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Edge and MKX vehicles built on or before 12/4/2008 may exhibit a growl
or howl type noise coming from the left and/or right rear wheel area. This could be the result of a
faulty rear wheel hub bearing assembly.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. If Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics identify a faulty rear wheel hub bearing, it will be
necessary to replace the rear suspension trailing
arm/knuckle assembly along with a new rear wheel hub bearing assembly.
2. Refer to WSM, Section 204-02, for rear wheel hub bearing and trailing arm/knuckle replacement.
Only replace the rear suspension trailing
arm/knuckle assembly and rear bearing hub on the side with the concern. Failing to install a new
rear suspension trailing arm/knuckle assembly when installing a new rear bearing hub assembly
will result in premature bearing noise/wear.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100209A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 1.3 Hrs.
FWD: Replace ONE Rear Wheel Hub Bearing And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assembly
100209A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 1.5 Hrs.
AWD: Replace ONE Rear Wheel Hub Bearing And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assembly
100209B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 2.4 Hrs.
FWD: Replace BOTH Rear
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Dust Cover, Wheel Hub >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Dust Cover: > 10-2-9 > Feb > 10 > Drivetrain Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area > Page 7427
Wheel Hub Bearings And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assemblies
100209B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 2.8 Hrs.
AWD: Replace BOTH Rear Wheel Hub Bearings And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assemblies
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
1104 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Dust Cover, Wheel Hub >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Dust Cover: > 10-2-9 > Feb > 10
> Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area
Dust Cover: All Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area
TSB 10-2-9
02/15/10
NOISE FROM REAR WHEEL HUB BEARING - BUILT ON OR BEFORE 12/4/2008
FORD: 2007-2009 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKX
This article supersedes TSB 09-26-5 to update the Parts List.
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Edge and MKX vehicles built on or before 12/4/2008 may exhibit a growl
or howl type noise coming from the left and/or right rear wheel area. This could be the result of a
faulty rear wheel hub bearing assembly.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. If Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics identify a faulty rear wheel hub bearing, it will be
necessary to replace the rear suspension trailing
arm/knuckle assembly along with a new rear wheel hub bearing assembly.
2. Refer to WSM, Section 204-02, for rear wheel hub bearing and trailing arm/knuckle replacement.
Only replace the rear suspension trailing
arm/knuckle assembly and rear bearing hub on the side with the concern. Failing to install a new
rear suspension trailing arm/knuckle assembly when installing a new rear bearing hub assembly
will result in premature bearing noise/wear.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100209A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 1.3 Hrs.
FWD: Replace ONE Rear Wheel Hub Bearing And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assembly
100209A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 1.5 Hrs.
AWD: Replace ONE Rear Wheel Hub Bearing And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assembly
100209B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 2.4 Hrs.
FWD: Replace BOTH Rear
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Dust Cover, Wheel Hub >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Dust Cover: > 10-2-9 > Feb > 10
> Drivetrain - Growl/Howl From Rear Hub Area > Page 7433
Wheel Hub Bearings And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assemblies
100209B 2007-2009 Edge, MKX 2.8 Hrs.
AWD: Replace BOTH Rear Wheel Hub Bearings And Trailing Arm Knuckle Assemblies
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
1104 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Specifications
Wheel Fastener: Specifications
Wheel lug nuts
.............................................................................................................................................................
135 Nm (100 ft. lbs) in a star pattern
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair Front
Wheel Studs
Wheel Studs
Removal
1. Remove the wheel hub. 2. Using a press, remove the wheel stud from the wheel bearing and
hub assembly.
Installation
1. Position the new wheel stud in the wheel hub, aligning the serrations in the wheel hub flange
made by the original wheel stud. 2. Using a press, install a new wheel stud. 3. Install the wheel
hub.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 7439
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair Rear
Wheel Studs
Wheel Studs
Removal
1. Remove the wheel bearing and wheel hub. 2. Using a suitable press, remove the wheel stud
from the wheel hub.
^ Discard the wheel stud.
Installation
1. Position the new wheel stud in the wheel hub, aligning the serrations in the wheel hub flange
made by the original wheel stud. 2. Using a suitable press, install the wheel stud. 3. Install the
wheel bearing and wheel hub.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Temperature Blend Door Actuator, Driver
View 151-29 (Front HVAC)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Temperature Blend Door Actuator, Driver > Page 7446
View 151-29 (Front HVAC)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Temperature Blend Door Actuator, Driver > Page 7447
View 151-29 (Front HVAC)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Temperature Blend Door Actuator, Driver > Page 7448
View 151-29 (Front HVAC)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Mode Door Actuator
C2278
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Mode Door Actuator > Page 7451
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Diagrams Temperature Blend Door Actuator
C2091
C2092
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Mode Door Actuator > Page 7452
C2363
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door
MODE DOOR ACTUATOR - DEFROST/PANEL/FLOOR DOOR
Removal and Installation
NOTE:
- The defrost/panel/floor mode door actuator can be accessed from below the driver side of the
instrument panel.
- It is not required to install the new defrost/panel/floor mode door linkage parts included in the
defrost/panel/floor mode door actuator service part kit if only the mode door actuator requires
replacement and the linkage parts are not broken or binding.
Mode door actuator and linkage
1. Remove the 3 defrost/panel/floor mode door actuator screws. 2. Disconnect the
defrost/panel/floor mode door actuator electrical connector. 3. Remove the defrost/panel/floor
mode door actuator. 4. Manually operate, and inspect the defrost/panel/floor mode door linkage for
incorrect placement or damage.
Mode door actuator linkage only
5. Remove the mode door linkage.
1 Depress the tab and remove the panel door lever.
2 Remove the floor/defrost door intermediate lever screw and floor/defrost door intermediate lever.
3 Pull straight outward to remove the floor/defrost door lever.
Mode door actuator and linkage
6. NOTE: When installing the mode door actuator, make sure that the panel door lever and
floor/defrost intermediate lever are correctly aligned
with the mode door actuator cam.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 7455
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 7456
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair Mode Door Actuator - Air Inlet Door
MODE DOOR ACTUATOR - AIR INLET DOOR
Air Inlet Mode Door Actuator
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 7457
Air Inlet Mode Door Actuator Linkage
Removal and Installation
NOTE: It is not required to install the new air inlet door linkage parts included in the air inlet mode
door actuator service part kit if only the mode door actuator requires replacement and the linkage
parts are not broken or binding.
Air inlet mode door actuator and linkage
1. Disconnect the glove compartment damper from the glove compartment. 2. Remove the glove
compartment. 3. Remove the 3 air inlet mode door actuator screws. 4. Disconnect the air inlet
mode door actuator electrical connector. 5. Remove the air inlet mode door actuator. 6. Manually
operate and inspect the air inlet mode door and air inlet mode door linkage for incorrect placement
or damage.
Air inlet mode door linkage only
7. Remove the air inlet mode door intermediate lever screw. 8. Remove the air inlet mode door
intermediate lever.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 7458
9. Working through the air inlet duct grille opening, depress the clip and detach the air inlet mode
door lever from the air inlet mode door.
Air inlet mode door actuator and linkage
10. NOTE: The air inlet mode door must be fully seated in the correct position during installation. If
the air inlet mode door is not fully seated,
excessive noise will result when the climate control system is operated.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 7459
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair Temperature Blend Door Actuator - LH
TEMPERATURE BLEND DOOR ACTUATOR - LH
Removal and Installation
NOTE: It is not required to install the new LH temperature blend door linkage parts included in the
LH temperature blend door actuator service part kit if only the temperature blend door actuator
requires replacement and the linkage parts are not broken or binding.
LH temperature blend door actuator and linkage
1. Remove the 2 lower steering column opening cover bolts. 2. Detach the lower steering column
opening cover. 3. Disconnect the in-vehicle temperature sensor aspirator hose and electrical
connector. 4. Position the instrument panel wire harness away from the LH temperature blend door
actuator. 5. Remove the 3 LH temperature blend door actuator screws. 6. Disconnect the LH
temperature blend door actuator electrical connector. 7. Remove the LH temperature blend door
actuator. 8. Manually operate, and inspect the LH temperature blend door linkage for incorrect
placement, binding or damage.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 7460
LH temperature blend door linkage only
9. Detach the 2 retaining tabs and remove the LH temperature blend door linkage.
LH temperature blend door actuator and linkage
10. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 7461
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair Temperature Blend Door Actuator - RH, Dual-Zone
EATC
TEMPERATURE BLEND DOOR ACTUATOR - RH, DUAL-ZONE EATC
Removal and Installation
NOTE: It is not required to install the new RH temperature blend door linkage parts included in the
RH temperature blend door actuator service part kit if only the temperature blend door actuator
requires replacement and the linkage parts are not broken or binding.
RH temperature blend door actuator and linkage
1. Disconnect the glove compartment damper from the glove compartment. 2. Remove the glove
compartment. 3. Remove the RH lower instrument panel insulator. 4. Remove the RH lower floor
console trim panel. 5. Remove the 3 RH temperature blend door actuator screws. 6. Disconnect
the RH temperature blend door actuator electrical connector. 7. Remove the RH temperature blend
door actuator.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 7462
8. Manually operate, and inspect the RH temperature blend door linkage for incorrect placement,
binding or damage.
RH temperature blend door actuator linkage only
9. Detach the 2 retaining tabs and remove the RH temperature blend door linkage.
All vehicles
10. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest for Air Duct: > 09-21-6 > Nov > 09 > A/C - White Flakes Are Blowing From Dash Vents
Air Duct: Customer Interest A/C - White Flakes Are Blowing From Dash Vents
TSB 09-21-6
11/02/09
WHITE FLAKES COMING FROM A/C VENTS
FORD: 2005-2009 Focus 2008-2010 Crown Victoria 2000-2005 Expedition, F-150 2007-2009 Edge
2008-2010 Escape Hybrid, Escape
LINCOLN: 2008-2010 Town Car 2000-2005 Navigator 2007-2009 MKX
MERCURY:
2008-2010 Grand Marquis, Mariner Hybrid, Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-19-16 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some vehicles may experience white flakes coming from the A/C vents when the blower
motor is engaged. This may be caused by flux utilized in the manufacturing process of the
evaporator core.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Hazard and Risk Warnings for White Flakes
WARNING
MAY CAUSE EYE AND RESPIRATORY TRACT IRRITATION. PROLONGED REPEATED
EXPOSURE MAY CAUSE BONE DAMAGE (FLUOROSIS) AND HARM TO THE RESPIRATORY
SYSTEM (BASED ON ANIMAL DATA).
^ Avoid inhaling dust.
^ Avoid contact with eyes.
^ Store away from acids.
^ Wash thoroughly after handling.
^ Avoid release to the environment.
NOTE
THE USE OF DUST PROOF GOGGLES, CHEMICAL RESISTANT GLOVES (PVC) AND DUST
MASK IS RECOMMENDED.
Using compressed air (maximum inlet pressure) 100 PSI (689 kPa), clean the A/C ducts through
the registers and blow off the evaporator core through the blower motor opening.
NOTE
THE ENTIRE EVAPORATOR CORE SURFACE MUST BE DRY FOR BEST RESULTS.
NOTE
WHILE PERFORMING THIS PROCEDURE AND SELECTING DIFFERENT VENT MODES SUCH
AS FLOOR / PANEL AND FLOOR / DEFROST, IT MAY BE NECESSARY TO TEMPORARILY
START THE ENGINE TO ENABLE MODE DOOR MOVEMENT.
Clean A/C Ducts:
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest for Air Duct: > 09-21-6 > Nov > 09 > A/C - White Flakes Are Blowing From Dash Vents > Page 7471
1. Remove floor duct trim.
2. Using masking tape, connect one end of the vacuum cleaner hose to the floor duct on driver
side.
3. Tape closed all the other floor duct openings.
4. Obtain about two feet (61 cm) of rubber vacuum line large enough to fit the end of a small shop
air blowgun. Secure the hose to the end of the
blowgun using a worm clamp.
5. Close all instrument panel registers.
6. Set temperature setting to full cold.
7. Place mode in floor / panel.
8. Turn on vacuum cleaner.
9. Working with one register at a time insert the vacuum line down each duct and blow shop air
through each duct for 30 seconds. Be sure to close each
register before moving on to the next register.
10. Change mode to floor I defrost.
11. Blow down each defroster duct for 30 seconds.
12. Alternate mode door between floor and floor / defrost three (3) times, giving the door time to
move between each change.
13. Turn off vacuum cleaner.
Clean Evaporator Core:
1. Change mode to full floor.
2. Ensure temperature is full cold.
3. Remove blower motor per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412.
4. Turn on vacuum cleaner.
5. Reach into blower opening with vacuum line and proceed to blow shop air for a minimum of 5
minutes, utilizing a very slow sweeping action.
6. Blow the entire core face with an up and down motion, then repeat moving from side to side.
NOTE
ATTENTION TO THE BLOW-OFF OF THE EVAPORATOR CORE SURFACE WILL DETERMINE
EFFECTIVENESS OF REPAIR.
7. Install the blower motor per WSM, Section 412.
8. Open all registers.
9. Operate the A/C system in Max mode with the blower on the lowest setting. Monitor the
temperature with a thermometer until the lowest temp is
achieved. Switch to vent and monitor the temperature until ambient temperature is reached.
10. Repeat Step 9 three (3) additional times.
11. Switch the blower motor to high speed with the vent mode still selected. white flakes should not
come out of the vents. If no white flakes are present
continue to Step 12.
12. Disconnect vacuum cleaner and remove tape from floor duct.
13. Reassemble floor duct trim.
14. Blow powder off or vacuum dash board and vehicle interior as required.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest for Air Duct: > 09-21-6 > Nov > 09 > A/C - White Flakes Are Blowing From Dash Vents > Page 7472
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092106A 2004-2005 F-150, 1.2 Hrs.
2008-2010 Crown Victoria, Grand Marquis, Escape, Escape Hybrid, Mariner, Mariner Hybrid,
2005-2009 Focus, 2007-2009 Edge, MKX: Clean A/C Ducts And Evaporator Core (Do Not Use
With Any Other Labor Operations)
092106A 2000-2005 Expedition, 1.4 Hrs.
Navigator, 2008-2010 Town Car, 2000-2003 F-150: Clean A/C Ducts And Evaporator Core (Do Not
Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19860 49
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Duct: > 09-21-6 > Nov > 09 > A/C - White Flakes Are Blowing From Dash Vents
Air Duct: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - White Flakes Are Blowing From Dash Vents
TSB 09-21-6
11/02/09
WHITE FLAKES COMING FROM A/C VENTS
FORD: 2005-2009 Focus 2008-2010 Crown Victoria 2000-2005 Expedition, F-150 2007-2009 Edge
2008-2010 Escape Hybrid, Escape
LINCOLN: 2008-2010 Town Car 2000-2005 Navigator 2007-2009 MKX
MERCURY:
2008-2010 Grand Marquis, Mariner Hybrid, Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-19-16 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some vehicles may experience white flakes coming from the A/C vents when the blower
motor is engaged. This may be caused by flux utilized in the manufacturing process of the
evaporator core.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Hazard and Risk Warnings for White Flakes
WARNING
MAY CAUSE EYE AND RESPIRATORY TRACT IRRITATION. PROLONGED REPEATED
EXPOSURE MAY CAUSE BONE DAMAGE (FLUOROSIS) AND HARM TO THE RESPIRATORY
SYSTEM (BASED ON ANIMAL DATA).
^ Avoid inhaling dust.
^ Avoid contact with eyes.
^ Store away from acids.
^ Wash thoroughly after handling.
^ Avoid release to the environment.
NOTE
THE USE OF DUST PROOF GOGGLES, CHEMICAL RESISTANT GLOVES (PVC) AND DUST
MASK IS RECOMMENDED.
Using compressed air (maximum inlet pressure) 100 PSI (689 kPa), clean the A/C ducts through
the registers and blow off the evaporator core through the blower motor opening.
NOTE
THE ENTIRE EVAPORATOR CORE SURFACE MUST BE DRY FOR BEST RESULTS.
NOTE
WHILE PERFORMING THIS PROCEDURE AND SELECTING DIFFERENT VENT MODES SUCH
AS FLOOR / PANEL AND FLOOR / DEFROST, IT MAY BE NECESSARY TO TEMPORARILY
START THE ENGINE TO ENABLE MODE DOOR MOVEMENT.
Clean A/C Ducts:
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Duct: > 09-21-6 > Nov > 09 > A/C - White Flakes Are Blowing From Dash Vents >
Page 7478
1. Remove floor duct trim.
2. Using masking tape, connect one end of the vacuum cleaner hose to the floor duct on driver
side.
3. Tape closed all the other floor duct openings.
4. Obtain about two feet (61 cm) of rubber vacuum line large enough to fit the end of a small shop
air blowgun. Secure the hose to the end of the
blowgun using a worm clamp.
5. Close all instrument panel registers.
6. Set temperature setting to full cold.
7. Place mode in floor / panel.
8. Turn on vacuum cleaner.
9. Working with one register at a time insert the vacuum line down each duct and blow shop air
through each duct for 30 seconds. Be sure to close each
register before moving on to the next register.
10. Change mode to floor I defrost.
11. Blow down each defroster duct for 30 seconds.
12. Alternate mode door between floor and floor / defrost three (3) times, giving the door time to
move between each change.
13. Turn off vacuum cleaner.
Clean Evaporator Core:
1. Change mode to full floor.
2. Ensure temperature is full cold.
3. Remove blower motor per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412.
4. Turn on vacuum cleaner.
5. Reach into blower opening with vacuum line and proceed to blow shop air for a minimum of 5
minutes, utilizing a very slow sweeping action.
6. Blow the entire core face with an up and down motion, then repeat moving from side to side.
NOTE
ATTENTION TO THE BLOW-OFF OF THE EVAPORATOR CORE SURFACE WILL DETERMINE
EFFECTIVENESS OF REPAIR.
7. Install the blower motor per WSM, Section 412.
8. Open all registers.
9. Operate the A/C system in Max mode with the blower on the lowest setting. Monitor the
temperature with a thermometer until the lowest temp is
achieved. Switch to vent and monitor the temperature until ambient temperature is reached.
10. Repeat Step 9 three (3) additional times.
11. Switch the blower motor to high speed with the vent mode still selected. white flakes should not
come out of the vents. If no white flakes are present
continue to Step 12.
12. Disconnect vacuum cleaner and remove tape from floor duct.
13. Reassemble floor duct trim.
14. Blow powder off or vacuum dash board and vehicle interior as required.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Duct: > 09-21-6 > Nov > 09 > A/C - White Flakes Are Blowing From Dash Vents >
Page 7479
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092106A 2004-2005 F-150, 1.2 Hrs.
2008-2010 Crown Victoria, Grand Marquis, Escape, Escape Hybrid, Mariner, Mariner Hybrid,
2005-2009 Focus, 2007-2009 Edge, MKX: Clean A/C Ducts And Evaporator Core (Do Not Use
With Any Other Labor Operations)
092106A 2000-2005 Expedition, 1.4 Hrs.
Navigator, 2008-2010 Town Car, 2000-2003 F-150: Clean A/C Ducts And Evaporator Core (Do Not
Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19860 49
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air
Inlet Duct
Air Duct: Service and Repair Air Inlet Duct
AIR INLET DUCT
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the heater core and evaporator core housing. 2. Disconnect the air inlet mode door
actuator electrical connector. 3. Remove the cabin air filter cover and the cabin air filter (if
equipped) or air inlet screen (if equipped). 4. Remove the 5 fresh air inlet duct screws. 5. Detach
the 4 fresh air inlet duct clips and remove the fresh air inlet duct. 6. Remove the 7 air inlet duct
screws. 7. Remove the air inlet duct.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air
Inlet Duct > Page 7482
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air
Inlet Duct > Page 7483
Air Duct: Service and Repair Footwell Duct - Rear
FOOTWELL DUCT - REAR
Removal and Installation
LH rear footwell duct only
1. Remove the LH front seat. 2. Remove the floor console. 3. Remove the LH front door sill plate.
4. Remove the driver floor carpet pin-type retainers and position the carpet away from the LH rear
footwell duct. 5. Remove the 5 LH rear footwell duct pin-type retainers.
6. Remove the 7 floor console support bracket bolts.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air
Inlet Duct > Page 7484
7. NOTE: The floor console support bracket will have to be repositioned to remove the LH rear
footwell duct.
Remove the LH rear footwell duct.
RH rear footwell duct only
8. Remove the RH floor console side finish panel. 9. Remove the RH front seat.
10. Remove the RH front door sill plate. 11. Remove the passenger front floor carpet pin-type
retainers and position the carpet away from the RH rear footwell duct. 12. Remove the 5 RH rear
footwell duct pin-type retainers. 13. Remove the RH rear footwell duct.
Both rear footwell ducts
14. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Register: > 09-21-6 > Nov > 09 > A/C - White Flakes Are Blowing From Dash Vents
Air Register: Customer Interest A/C - White Flakes Are Blowing From Dash Vents
TSB 09-21-6
11/02/09
WHITE FLAKES COMING FROM A/C VENTS
FORD: 2005-2009 Focus 2008-2010 Crown Victoria 2000-2005 Expedition, F-150 2007-2009 Edge
2008-2010 Escape Hybrid, Escape
LINCOLN: 2008-2010 Town Car 2000-2005 Navigator 2007-2009 MKX
MERCURY:
2008-2010 Grand Marquis, Mariner Hybrid, Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-19-16 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some vehicles may experience white flakes coming from the A/C vents when the blower
motor is engaged. This may be caused by flux utilized in the manufacturing process of the
evaporator core.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Hazard and Risk Warnings for White Flakes
WARNING
MAY CAUSE EYE AND RESPIRATORY TRACT IRRITATION. PROLONGED REPEATED
EXPOSURE MAY CAUSE BONE DAMAGE (FLUOROSIS) AND HARM TO THE RESPIRATORY
SYSTEM (BASED ON ANIMAL DATA).
^ Avoid inhaling dust.
^ Avoid contact with eyes.
^ Store away from acids.
^ Wash thoroughly after handling.
^ Avoid release to the environment.
NOTE
THE USE OF DUST PROOF GOGGLES, CHEMICAL RESISTANT GLOVES (PVC) AND DUST
MASK IS RECOMMENDED.
Using compressed air (maximum inlet pressure) 100 PSI (689 kPa), clean the A/C ducts through
the registers and blow off the evaporator core through the blower motor opening.
NOTE
THE ENTIRE EVAPORATOR CORE SURFACE MUST BE DRY FOR BEST RESULTS.
NOTE
WHILE PERFORMING THIS PROCEDURE AND SELECTING DIFFERENT VENT MODES SUCH
AS FLOOR / PANEL AND FLOOR / DEFROST, IT MAY BE NECESSARY TO TEMPORARILY
START THE ENGINE TO ENABLE MODE DOOR MOVEMENT.
Clean A/C Ducts:
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Register: > 09-21-6 > Nov > 09 > A/C - White Flakes Are Blowing From Dash Vents >
Page 7493
1. Remove floor duct trim.
2. Using masking tape, connect one end of the vacuum cleaner hose to the floor duct on driver
side.
3. Tape closed all the other floor duct openings.
4. Obtain about two feet (61 cm) of rubber vacuum line large enough to fit the end of a small shop
air blowgun. Secure the hose to the end of the
blowgun using a worm clamp.
5. Close all instrument panel registers.
6. Set temperature setting to full cold.
7. Place mode in floor / panel.
8. Turn on vacuum cleaner.
9. Working with one register at a time insert the vacuum line down each duct and blow shop air
through each duct for 30 seconds. Be sure to close each
register before moving on to the next register.
10. Change mode to floor I defrost.
11. Blow down each defroster duct for 30 seconds.
12. Alternate mode door between floor and floor / defrost three (3) times, giving the door time to
move between each change.
13. Turn off vacuum cleaner.
Clean Evaporator Core:
1. Change mode to full floor.
2. Ensure temperature is full cold.
3. Remove blower motor per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412.
4. Turn on vacuum cleaner.
5. Reach into blower opening with vacuum line and proceed to blow shop air for a minimum of 5
minutes, utilizing a very slow sweeping action.
6. Blow the entire core face with an up and down motion, then repeat moving from side to side.
NOTE
ATTENTION TO THE BLOW-OFF OF THE EVAPORATOR CORE SURFACE WILL DETERMINE
EFFECTIVENESS OF REPAIR.
7. Install the blower motor per WSM, Section 412.
8. Open all registers.
9. Operate the A/C system in Max mode with the blower on the lowest setting. Monitor the
temperature with a thermometer until the lowest temp is
achieved. Switch to vent and monitor the temperature until ambient temperature is reached.
10. Repeat Step 9 three (3) additional times.
11. Switch the blower motor to high speed with the vent mode still selected. white flakes should not
come out of the vents. If no white flakes are present
continue to Step 12.
12. Disconnect vacuum cleaner and remove tape from floor duct.
13. Reassemble floor duct trim.
14. Blow powder off or vacuum dash board and vehicle interior as required.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Register: > 09-21-6 > Nov > 09 > A/C - White Flakes Are Blowing From Dash Vents >
Page 7494
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092106A 2004-2005 F-150, 1.2 Hrs.
2008-2010 Crown Victoria, Grand Marquis, Escape, Escape Hybrid, Mariner, Mariner Hybrid,
2005-2009 Focus, 2007-2009 Edge, MKX: Clean A/C Ducts And Evaporator Core (Do Not Use
With Any Other Labor Operations)
092106A 2000-2005 Expedition, 1.4 Hrs.
Navigator, 2008-2010 Town Car, 2000-2003 F-150: Clean A/C Ducts And Evaporator Core (Do Not
Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19860 49
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Register: > 09-21-6 > Nov > 09 > A/C - White Flakes Are Blowing From
Dash Vents
Air Register: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - White Flakes Are Blowing From Dash Vents
TSB 09-21-6
11/02/09
WHITE FLAKES COMING FROM A/C VENTS
FORD: 2005-2009 Focus 2008-2010 Crown Victoria 2000-2005 Expedition, F-150 2007-2009 Edge
2008-2010 Escape Hybrid, Escape
LINCOLN: 2008-2010 Town Car 2000-2005 Navigator 2007-2009 MKX
MERCURY:
2008-2010 Grand Marquis, Mariner Hybrid, Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-19-16 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some vehicles may experience white flakes coming from the A/C vents when the blower
motor is engaged. This may be caused by flux utilized in the manufacturing process of the
evaporator core.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Hazard and Risk Warnings for White Flakes
WARNING
MAY CAUSE EYE AND RESPIRATORY TRACT IRRITATION. PROLONGED REPEATED
EXPOSURE MAY CAUSE BONE DAMAGE (FLUOROSIS) AND HARM TO THE RESPIRATORY
SYSTEM (BASED ON ANIMAL DATA).
^ Avoid inhaling dust.
^ Avoid contact with eyes.
^ Store away from acids.
^ Wash thoroughly after handling.
^ Avoid release to the environment.
NOTE
THE USE OF DUST PROOF GOGGLES, CHEMICAL RESISTANT GLOVES (PVC) AND DUST
MASK IS RECOMMENDED.
Using compressed air (maximum inlet pressure) 100 PSI (689 kPa), clean the A/C ducts through
the registers and blow off the evaporator core through the blower motor opening.
NOTE
THE ENTIRE EVAPORATOR CORE SURFACE MUST BE DRY FOR BEST RESULTS.
NOTE
WHILE PERFORMING THIS PROCEDURE AND SELECTING DIFFERENT VENT MODES SUCH
AS FLOOR / PANEL AND FLOOR / DEFROST, IT MAY BE NECESSARY TO TEMPORARILY
START THE ENGINE TO ENABLE MODE DOOR MOVEMENT.
Clean A/C Ducts:
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Register: > 09-21-6 > Nov > 09 > A/C - White Flakes Are Blowing From
Dash Vents > Page 7500
1. Remove floor duct trim.
2. Using masking tape, connect one end of the vacuum cleaner hose to the floor duct on driver
side.
3. Tape closed all the other floor duct openings.
4. Obtain about two feet (61 cm) of rubber vacuum line large enough to fit the end of a small shop
air blowgun. Secure the hose to the end of the
blowgun using a worm clamp.
5. Close all instrument panel registers.
6. Set temperature setting to full cold.
7. Place mode in floor / panel.
8. Turn on vacuum cleaner.
9. Working with one register at a time insert the vacuum line down each duct and blow shop air
through each duct for 30 seconds. Be sure to close each
register before moving on to the next register.
10. Change mode to floor I defrost.
11. Blow down each defroster duct for 30 seconds.
12. Alternate mode door between floor and floor / defrost three (3) times, giving the door time to
move between each change.
13. Turn off vacuum cleaner.
Clean Evaporator Core:
1. Change mode to full floor.
2. Ensure temperature is full cold.
3. Remove blower motor per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412.
4. Turn on vacuum cleaner.
5. Reach into blower opening with vacuum line and proceed to blow shop air for a minimum of 5
minutes, utilizing a very slow sweeping action.
6. Blow the entire core face with an up and down motion, then repeat moving from side to side.
NOTE
ATTENTION TO THE BLOW-OFF OF THE EVAPORATOR CORE SURFACE WILL DETERMINE
EFFECTIVENESS OF REPAIR.
7. Install the blower motor per WSM, Section 412.
8. Open all registers.
9. Operate the A/C system in Max mode with the blower on the lowest setting. Monitor the
temperature with a thermometer until the lowest temp is
achieved. Switch to vent and monitor the temperature until ambient temperature is reached.
10. Repeat Step 9 three (3) additional times.
11. Switch the blower motor to high speed with the vent mode still selected. white flakes should not
come out of the vents. If no white flakes are present
continue to Step 12.
12. Disconnect vacuum cleaner and remove tape from floor duct.
13. Reassemble floor duct trim.
14. Blow powder off or vacuum dash board and vehicle interior as required.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Register: > 09-21-6 > Nov > 09 > A/C - White Flakes Are Blowing From
Dash Vents > Page 7501
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092106A 2004-2005 F-150, 1.2 Hrs.
2008-2010 Crown Victoria, Grand Marquis, Escape, Escape Hybrid, Mariner, Mariner Hybrid,
2005-2009 Focus, 2007-2009 Edge, MKX: Clean A/C Ducts And Evaporator Core (Do Not Use
With Any Other Labor Operations)
092106A 2000-2005 Expedition, 1.4 Hrs.
Navigator, 2008-2010 Town Car, 2000-2003 F-150: Clean A/C Ducts And Evaporator Core (Do Not
Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19860 49
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Register - Driver and Passenger Side
Air Register: Service and Repair Register - Driver and Passenger Side
REGISTER - DRIVER AND PASSENGER SIDE
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Passenger side register shown, driver side similar.
1. CAUTION: Do not pry on the outer register trim bezel. The clips on the outer register trim bezel
break if pried on to remove the
register.
Working through the register vein openings, insert a suitable hook shaped pick behind each of the
4 register clips while gently pulling the register rearward with the hook to disengage the clip.
2. Remove the driver or passenger side instrument panel register. 3. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Register - Driver and Passenger Side > Page 7504
Air Register: Service and Repair Register - Center
REGISTER - CENTER
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the center instrument panel finish panel. 2. Remove the 8 center register screws. 3.
Remove the center registers. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Service and Repair
AMBIENT AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front bumper cover. 2. Disconnect the ambient air temperature sensor electrical
connector and remove the ambient air temperature sensor. 3. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-8 (behind Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Blower Motor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7513
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7514
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7515
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7516
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7517
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7518
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7519
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7520
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7521
Blower Motor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7522
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7523
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7524
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7525
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7526
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7527
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7528
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7529
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7530
C288
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7531
Blower Motor: Service and Repair
BLOWER MOTOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH lower instrument panel insulator. 2. Disconnect the blower motor electrical
connector. 3. Remove the 3 blower motor screws. 4. Remove the blower motor. 5. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Page 7535
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Page 7536
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-8 (behind Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 7540
C2185
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 7541
Blower Motor Resistor: Description and Operation
BLOWER MOTOR RESISTOR
The blower motor switch varies the blower motor ground circuit resistance by adding or bypassing
series resistance in the blower motor resistor. Increased resistance will lower the blower motor
speed, and lowered resistance will increase blower motor speed. When the blower motor is in the
HI position, the blower motor resistor is bypassed.
The blower motor resistor is located on the heater core and evaporator core housing.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 7542
Blower Motor Resistor: Service and Repair
BLOWER MOTOR RESISTOR
Removal and Installation
1. For additional information, refer to Blower Motor Speed Control.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-8 (behind Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 7546
C271
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 7547
Blower Motor Switch: Description and Operation
BLOWER MOTOR SWITCH
The blower motor switch is mounted in the EMTC module and controls blower motor speed by
adding or bypassing resistors in the blower motor resistor in all modes except OFF. The blower
motor switch knob is removable and can be separately replaced.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Blower Motor Speed Control
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair Blower Motor Speed Control
BLOWER MOTOR SPEED CONTROL
Removal and Installation
1. Detach the glove compartment damper from the glove compartment. 2. Remove the glove
compartment. 3. Disconnect the blower motor speed control electrical connector. 4. Remove the 2
blower motor speed control screws. 5. Remove the blower motor speed control. 6. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Blower Motor Speed Control > Page 7550
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair Blower Motor Switch
BLOWER MOTOR SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the climate control module. 2. Pull to remove the blower motor switch knob.
3. Remove the blower motor switch nut.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Blower Motor Speed Control > Page 7551
4. Release the 2 retaining tabs with the index finger on each hand, while depressing the blower
motor switch shaft with the thumbs to remove the
blower motor switch.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Air Filter > Component Information > Locations
Cabin Air Filter: Locations
Air Inlet Duct
Cabin Air Filter
A cabin air filter is available as standard equipment on dual-zone EATC vehicles.EMTC vehicles
are not equipped from the factory with a cabin air filter, but are equipped with a screen in place of
the filter to prevent any large foreign material from entering the heater core and evaporator core
housing. The cabin air filter or screen can be accessed by removing the glove compartment and
removing the cabin air filter access cover. A cabin air filter can be installed as a dealer accessory
on vehicles not originally equipped with a filter, but only a screen or a filter should be used, never
both.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Air Filter > Component Information > Locations > Page
7555
Cabin Air Filter: Description and Operation
Air Distribution
There are 2 sources of air available to the air distribution system. Outside air
- Recirculated air
Recirculated air is always used when the climate control assembly is set to the MAX A/C mode on
vehicles equipped with Electronic Manual Temperature Control (EMTC) and can be selected in any
mode except DEFROST. Vehicles equipped with dual-zone Electronic Automatic Temperature
Control (EATC) use recirculated air only when the RECIRC function is selected in any mode other
than DEFROST, or when required by the HVAC module in the AUTOMATIC mode.
RECIRC is a timed function when selected while operating in FLOOR or FLOOR/DEFROST mode,
and will automatically default back to fresh air inlet in 5 minutes if operating with A/C ON at an
ambient temperature below (50°F). When operating with A/C OFF, the RECIRC function will always
default back to fresh air inlet in5minutes regardless of ambient temperature.
Air distribution within the vehicle is determined by the airftow mode selected, or by the dual-zone
RAYC system in the AUTOMATIC mode. The air distribution mode on vehicles equipped with
dual-zone ~ATC can be ovemdden by the driver if desired. Airflow mode control doors are used to
direct airflow within the heater core and evaporator core housing. Electric mode door actuators are
used to position these airaow mode doors.
Vehicles equipped with dual-zone EA.TQ use 2 separate temperature blend doors. This allows
individual temperature settings to be selected for the RH and LH air outlets. The airfow mode doors
are not partitioned for separate RH and LH airflow positions. Therefore, the airflow mode will
always remain similar for the RH and LH sides of the vehicle regardless of the temperatures
selected.
Air enters the passenger compartment from the following outlets: Instrument panel registers
- Floor duct outlets
- Windshield defroster
- Side window demisters
- Rear footwell duct
- Center console registers
Passenger compartment air is exhausted from the vehicle through open windows or body air vents.
Cabin Air Filter
A cabin air filter is available as standard equipment on dual-zone EATC vehicles.EMTC vehicles
are not equipped from the factory with a cabin air filter, but are equipped with a screen in place of
the filter to prevent any large foreign material from entering the heater core and evaporator core
housing. The cabin air filter or screen can be accessed by removing the glove compartment and
removing the cabin air filter access cover. A cabin air filter can be installed as a dealer accessory
on vehicles not originally equipped with a filter, but only a screen or a filter should be used, never
both.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Air Filter > Component Information > Locations > Page
7556
Cabin Air Filter: Service and Repair
Cabin Air Filter
A cabin air filter is available as standard equipment on dual-zone EATC vehicles.EMTC vehicles
are not equipped from the factory with a cabin air filter, but are equipped with a screen in place of
the filter to prevent any large foreign material from entering the heater core and evaporator core
housing. The cabin air filter or screen can be accessed by removing the glove compartment and
removing the cabin air filter access cover. A cabin air filter can be installed as a dealer accessory
on vehicles not originally equipped with a filter, but only a screen or a filter should be used, never
both.
Air Inlet Duct
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the heater core and evaporator core housing. For additional information, 2. Disconnect
the air inlet mode door actuator electrical connector. 3. Remove the cabin air filter cover and the
cabin air filter (if equipped) or air inlet screen (if equipped) 4. Remove the 5 fresh air inlet duct
screws. 5. Detach the 4 fresh air inlet duct clips and remove the fresh air inlet duct. 6. Remove the
7 air inlet duct screws. 7. Remove the air inlet duct. 8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component Information >
Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7560
C233
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7561
Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
IN-VEHICLE TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the 2 lower steering column opening cover bolts. 2. Detach the lower steering column
opening cover. 3. Disconnect the in-vehicle temperature sensor aspirator hose. 4. Disconnect the
in-vehicle temperature sensor electrical connector. 5. Release the 2 in-vehicle temperature sensor
clips and remove the in-vehicle temperature sensor.
6. NOTE: The in-vehicle temperature sensor hose and venturi assembly can be accessed from
below the driver side of the instrument panel.
Remove the in-vehicle temperature sensor hose and venturi assembly.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Diagrams
C100
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 7569
Compressor Clutch Relay: Description and Operation
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) CLUTCH RELAY (A/CCR)
NOTE: The PCM PIDs WAC and wide open throttle air conditioning cutoff fault (WACF) are used to
monitor the A/CCR output.
The A/CCR is wired normally open. There is no direct electrical connection between the A/C switch
or electronic automatic temperature control (EATC) module and the A/C clutch. The PCM receives
a signal indicating that A/C is requested. For some applications, this message is sent through the
communications network. When A/C is requested, the PCM checks other A/C related inputs that
are available, such as A/C pressure switch and A/C cycling switch. If these inputs indicate A/C
operation is OK, and the engine conditions are OK (coolant temperature, engine RPM, throttle
position), the PCM grounds the A/CCR output, closing the relay contacts and sending voltage to
the A/CCR.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 7570
Compressor Clutch Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 7571
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Condenser HVAC: Description and Operation
A/C CONDENSER
NOTE: The A/C condenser for this vehicle is produced from the factory with a receiver/drier
desiccant bag installed in the integrated receiver/drier. This receiver/drier desiccant bag may
become contaminated with moisture if the A/C condenser is not installed for an extended period of
time. Since it cannot be determined how much time has elapsed between production and
installation of the unit as a service part, the receiver/drier desiccant bag must be removed and
replaced with the separate receiver/drier desiccant bag, which is supplied together with the A/C
condenser service part kit.
The A/C condenser is an aluminum fin-and-tube design heat exchanger located in front of the
vehicle radiator. It cools compressed refrigerant gas by allowing air to pass over fins and tubes to
extract heat and by condensing gas to liquid refrigerant as it is cooled.
The receiver/drier is incorporated onto the LH side of the A/C condenser. The receiver/drier
desiccant bag is a separate component and can be separately removed and installed with the A/C
condenser removed from the vehicle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 7575
Condenser HVAC: Service and Repair
CONDENSER CORE
Removal and Installation
NOTE:
- The A/C condenser for this vehicle is produced from the factory with a receiver/drier desiccant
bag installed in the integrated receiver/drier. This receiver/drier desiccant bag may become
contaminated with moisture if the A/C condenser is not installed for an extended period of time.
Since it cannot be determined how much time has elapsed between production and installation of
the unit as a service part, the receiver/drier desiccant bag must be removed and replaced with the
separate receiver/drier desiccant bag, which is supplied together with the A/C condenser service
part kit.
- The O-ring seals used on this vehicle are not interchangeable with all similarly sized O-ring seals
used on other Ford products. Use only the O-ring
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 7576
seals specified for this vehicle in the Ford master parts catalog.
1. Recover the refrigerant. 2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL position it on a hoist. 3. Drain the
engine coolant. 4. Remove the front bumper cover. 5. Remove the cooling fan. 6. Release the
upper radiator hose clamp at the radiator and disconnect the hose. 7. Release the 2 radiator
bracket clips from the radiator support and position the radiator rearward. 8. Release the 2
condenser lines from the clips at the radiator. 9. Remove the condenser outlet and inlet fitting bolts
and disconnect the fittings.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
10. Remove the 2 condenser bolts.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
11. NOTE: The condenser core must be removed from above the vehicle.
Remove the condenser core.
12. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new O-ring seals lubricated in clean PAG oil.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
13. Fill the engine cooling system. 14. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions
Control Assembly: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7581
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7582
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7583
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7584
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7585
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7586
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7587
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7588
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7589
Control Assembly: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7590
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7591
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7592
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7593
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7594
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7595
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7596
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7597
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Control Components
Control Assembly: Description and Operation Control Components
CONTROL COMPONENTS
ELECTRONIC MANUAL TEMPERATURE CONTROL
The electronic manual temperature control (EMTC) components are used to select the following:
- Air inlet source (outside or recirculated)
- Blower motor speed
- Discharge air temperature (temperature blend)
- Discharge air location (defrost, panel, floor)
- A/C compressor operation
Control System Inputs
The EMTC system has 2 system control inputs.
EMTC Module (Climate Control Module) The EMTC module integrates the temperature control,
airflow mode selection, A/C request button, recirculated air request button and rear defog switch
into a single unit.
The temperature control selector setting determines air temperature. Movement of the temperature
display from COOL (blue) to WARM (red) causes a corresponding movement of the temperature
blend door and determines the discharge air temperature that the air distribution system will
maintain. The temperature control selector is an integral part of the EMTC module and cannot be
installed separately. The temperature selector knob is removable and can be separately replaced.
The airflow mode setting determines air discharge location. Movement of the airflow mode selector
causes a corresponding movement of the airflow mode doors and determines the air discharge
location. The airflow mode selector is an integral part of the EMTC module and cannot be installed
separately. The airflow mode selector knob is removable and can be separately replaced.
The A/C request button determines A/C compressor operation, except when the airflow mode
selector is in the OFF, MAX A/C or DEFROST mode. The A/C request button is an integral part of
the EMTC module and cannot be installed separately.
The recirculated air request button can select recirculated air in any mode except DEFROST, and
fresh air in any mode except MAX A/C or OFF. The recirculated air request button is an integral
part of the EMTC module and cannot be installed separately.
The rear defog button signals activation of the heated backlight. The rear defog button is an
integral part of the EMTC module and cannot be installed separately.
Control System Outputs
The EMTC system has 4 system outputs.
Temperature Blend Door Actuator The temperature blend door actuator moves the temperature
blend door on command from the EMTC module.
The temperature blend door actuator contains a reversible electric motor and a potentiometer. The
potentiometer circuit consists of a 5-volt reference signal connected to one end of a variable
resistor, and a signal ground connected to the other. A signal return circuit is connected to a
contact wiper, which is driven along the variable resistor by the actuator shaft. The signal returned
to the EMTC module from the contact wiper indicates the position of the temperature blend door.
The EMTC module drives the actuator motor in whichever direction is necessary to make the
actuator contact wiper voltage agree with the expected EMTC module contact wiper voltage value.
Airflow Mode Door Actuator The airflow mode door actuator uses a cam and lever assembly to
position the airflow mode doors on command from the EMTC module. The mode door actuator
contains a reversible electric motor and potentiometer. The potentiometer allows the EMTC module
to monitor the position of the airflow mode doors. The potentiometer circuit consists of a 5-volt
reference signal connected to one end of a variable resistor, and a signal ground connected to the
other. A signal return circuit is connected to a contact wiper, which is driven along the variable
resistor by the actuator shaft. The signal returned to the EMTC module from the contact wiper
indicates the position of the airflow mode doors.
Air Inlet Mode Door Actuator The air inlet mode door actuator moves the air inlet door between the
fresh and RECIRC positions on command from the EMTC module. The air inlet mode door actuator
is driven to, and will automatically stop at, the full RECIRC or full fresh air inlet position and does
not require a potentiometer circuit to monitor its position.
ELECTRONIC AUTOMATIC TEMPERATURE CONTROL
The dual-zone electronic automatic temperature control (EATC) module analyzes input from the
following major sources:
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Control Components > Page 7600
- Temperature, airflow mode, blower, A/C and RECIRC selection (made by the vehicle occupants)
- In-vehicle temperature sensor
- Ambient temperature sensor
- Solar radiation sensor
- Evaporator temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed
- Engine coolant temperature
Using these inputs, the dual-zone EATC module determines the correct conditions for the following
outputs:
- A/C compressor operation
- Blower speed
- Temperature blend door position
- Airflow mode door position
- Air inlet door position
Control System Inputs
The dual-zone EATC system has 4 control system inputs.
EATC Module (Climate Control Module) The dual-zone EATC module provides an interface for the
vehicle occupants to control the climate control system, or automatically controls the climate control
system in the AUTO mode. The dual-zone EATC module has a vacuum fluorescent display for
displaying set temperature, airflow direction, blower speed and diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs).
An on-board diagnostic (OBD) feature is incorporated to supply the technician with DTCs. These
DTCs help direct the technician to the inoperative component.
In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor The in-vehicle temperature sensor contains a thermistor, which
measures the in-vehicle air temperature and sends that reading to the dual-zone EATC module. An
aspirator hose is connected between the heater core and evaporator core housing and the
in-vehicle temperature sensor. The aspirator hose uses airflow through the heater core and
evaporator core housing to create a venturi-type suction to draw in-vehicle air through the
in-vehicle temperature sensor (across the thermistor).
Solar Radiation Sensor (Sunload Sensor) The solar radiation sensor supplies information to the
dual-zone EATC module indicating sunload.
Ambient Temperature Sensor The ambient temperature sensor signal is received by the dual-zone
EATC module and indicates the outside air temperature. The ambient temperature sensor is
located in front of the radiator on the radiator support bolster.
The ambient temperature sensor signal is not the sole factor considered by the dual-zone EATC
module for the outside air temperature display. Therefore, the ambient temperature PID monitored
with a scan tool may not exactly match the dual-zone EATC module display.
Control System Outputs
The EATC system has 4 control system outputs.
Blower Motor Speed Control The blower motor speed control controls the blower motor speed by
converting low power signals from the dual-zone EATC module to a high current, variable ground
feed for the blower motor. A delay function is used to provide a gradual increase or decrease in
blower motor speed under all conditions.
Temperature Blend Door Actuators The dual-zone EATC system uses 2 temperature blend door
actuators to control 2 separate temperature blend doors. The temperature blend doors
independently vary the LH side and RH side temperature settings, as desired. The temperature
blend door actuators each contain a reversible electric motor and a potentiometer. The
potentiometer circuit consists of a 5-volt reference signal connected to one end of a variable
resistor, and a signal ground connected to the other. A signal return circuit is connected to a
contact wiper, which is driven along the variable resistor by the actuator shaft. The signal returned
to the EATC module from the contact wiper indicates the position of the temperature blend door.
The EATC module drives the actuator motor in whichever direction is necessary to make the
actuator contact wiper voltage agree with the expected EATC module contact wiper voltage value.
Airflow Mode Door Actuator The airflow mode door actuator uses a cam and lever assembly to
position the airflow mode doors on command from the dual-zone EATC module. The mode door
actuator contains a reversible electric motor and potentiometer. The potentiometer allows the
dual-zone EATC module to monitor the position of the airflow mode doors. The potentiometer
circuit consists of a 5-volt reference signal connected to one end of a variable resistor, and a signal
ground connected to the other. A signal return circuit is connected to a contact wiper, which is
driven along the variable resistor by the actuator shaft. The signal returned to the dual-zone EATC
module from the contact wiper indicates the position of the airflow mode doors.
Air Inlet Mode Door Actuator The air inlet mode door actuator moves the air inlet door between the
fresh and RECIRC positions on command from the dual-zone EATC module.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Control Components > Page 7601
The air inlet mode door actuator is driven to, and will automatically stop at, the full RECIRC or full
fresh air inlet position and does not require a potentiometer circuit to monitor its position.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Control Components > Page 7602
Control Assembly: Description and Operation Heating and Ventilation
HEATING AND VENTILATION
The heating and ventilation system has the following features:
- Controls the temperature and, during A/C operation, reduces the relative humidity of the air inside
the vehicle.
- Delivers heated or cooled air to maintain the vehicle interior temperature and comfort level.
- Cooling or heating can be adjusted to maintain the desired temperature.
- Uses a reheat method to provide conditioned air to the passenger compartment.
- All airflow from the blower motor passes through the A/C evaporator core.
- Temperature blending is controlled by the temperature blend door(s), which regulate(s) the
amount of air that flows through and around the heater core, where it is then mixed and distributed.
Heater Core
The heater core consists of fins and tubes arranged to extract heat from the engine coolant and
transfer the heat to air passing through the heater core.
Blower Motor
The blower motor pulls air from the air inlet and forces it into the heater core and evaporator core
housing where it is mixed and distributed.
Heater Core and Evaporator Core Housing
The heater core and evaporator core housing directs airflow from the blower motor through the
evaporator core and heater core. All airflow from the blower motor passes through the evaporator
core. The airflow is then directed through or around the heater core by the temperature blend
door(s). Vehicles equipped with dual-zone electronic automatic temperature control (EATC) use a
partitioned heater core and evaporator core housing with 2 electric actuator-positioned temperature
blend doors. This allows for separate temperatures to be selected for the driver and passenger
sides of the passenger compartment. Manual systems use a single electric actuator-positioned
temperature blend door to direct airflow through or around the heater core.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Locations >
Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Locations >
Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module > Page 7607
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module
C228A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module > Page 7610
C228B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module > Page 7611
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams Manual Climate Control Module
C2357A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module > Page 7612
C2357B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 7613
Control Module HVAC: Service and Repair
CLIMATE CONTROL MODULE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the center instrument panel finish panel. 2. Remove the 4 climate control module
screws. 3. Remove the climate control module.
4. NOTE: Be sure the climate control module spacers are correctly positioned before installing the
climate control module.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Core: > 09-21-6 > Nov > 09 > A/C - White Flakes Are Blowing From Dash
Vents
Evaporator Core: Customer Interest A/C - White Flakes Are Blowing From Dash Vents
TSB 09-21-6
11/02/09
WHITE FLAKES COMING FROM A/C VENTS
FORD: 2005-2009 Focus 2008-2010 Crown Victoria 2000-2005 Expedition, F-150 2007-2009 Edge
2008-2010 Escape Hybrid, Escape
LINCOLN: 2008-2010 Town Car 2000-2005 Navigator 2007-2009 MKX
MERCURY:
2008-2010 Grand Marquis, Mariner Hybrid, Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-19-16 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some vehicles may experience white flakes coming from the A/C vents when the blower
motor is engaged. This may be caused by flux utilized in the manufacturing process of the
evaporator core.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Hazard and Risk Warnings for White Flakes
WARNING
MAY CAUSE EYE AND RESPIRATORY TRACT IRRITATION. PROLONGED REPEATED
EXPOSURE MAY CAUSE BONE DAMAGE (FLUOROSIS) AND HARM TO THE RESPIRATORY
SYSTEM (BASED ON ANIMAL DATA).
^ Avoid inhaling dust.
^ Avoid contact with eyes.
^ Store away from acids.
^ Wash thoroughly after handling.
^ Avoid release to the environment.
NOTE
THE USE OF DUST PROOF GOGGLES, CHEMICAL RESISTANT GLOVES (PVC) AND DUST
MASK IS RECOMMENDED.
Using compressed air (maximum inlet pressure) 100 PSI (689 kPa), clean the A/C ducts through
the registers and blow off the evaporator core through the blower motor opening.
NOTE
THE ENTIRE EVAPORATOR CORE SURFACE MUST BE DRY FOR BEST RESULTS.
NOTE
WHILE PERFORMING THIS PROCEDURE AND SELECTING DIFFERENT VENT MODES SUCH
AS FLOOR / PANEL AND FLOOR / DEFROST, IT MAY BE NECESSARY TO TEMPORARILY
START THE ENGINE TO ENABLE MODE DOOR MOVEMENT.
Clean A/C Ducts:
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Core: > 09-21-6 > Nov > 09 > A/C - White Flakes Are Blowing From Dash
Vents > Page 7622
1. Remove floor duct trim.
2. Using masking tape, connect one end of the vacuum cleaner hose to the floor duct on driver
side.
3. Tape closed all the other floor duct openings.
4. Obtain about two feet (61 cm) of rubber vacuum line large enough to fit the end of a small shop
air blowgun. Secure the hose to the end of the
blowgun using a worm clamp.
5. Close all instrument panel registers.
6. Set temperature setting to full cold.
7. Place mode in floor / panel.
8. Turn on vacuum cleaner.
9. Working with one register at a time insert the vacuum line down each duct and blow shop air
through each duct for 30 seconds. Be sure to close each
register before moving on to the next register.
10. Change mode to floor I defrost.
11. Blow down each defroster duct for 30 seconds.
12. Alternate mode door between floor and floor / defrost three (3) times, giving the door time to
move between each change.
13. Turn off vacuum cleaner.
Clean Evaporator Core:
1. Change mode to full floor.
2. Ensure temperature is full cold.
3. Remove blower motor per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412.
4. Turn on vacuum cleaner.
5. Reach into blower opening with vacuum line and proceed to blow shop air for a minimum of 5
minutes, utilizing a very slow sweeping action.
6. Blow the entire core face with an up and down motion, then repeat moving from side to side.
NOTE
ATTENTION TO THE BLOW-OFF OF THE EVAPORATOR CORE SURFACE WILL DETERMINE
EFFECTIVENESS OF REPAIR.
7. Install the blower motor per WSM, Section 412.
8. Open all registers.
9. Operate the A/C system in Max mode with the blower on the lowest setting. Monitor the
temperature with a thermometer until the lowest temp is
achieved. Switch to vent and monitor the temperature until ambient temperature is reached.
10. Repeat Step 9 three (3) additional times.
11. Switch the blower motor to high speed with the vent mode still selected. white flakes should not
come out of the vents. If no white flakes are present
continue to Step 12.
12. Disconnect vacuum cleaner and remove tape from floor duct.
13. Reassemble floor duct trim.
14. Blow powder off or vacuum dash board and vehicle interior as required.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Core: > 09-21-6 > Nov > 09 > A/C - White Flakes Are Blowing From Dash
Vents > Page 7623
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092106A 2004-2005 F-150, 1.2 Hrs.
2008-2010 Crown Victoria, Grand Marquis, Escape, Escape Hybrid, Mariner, Mariner Hybrid,
2005-2009 Focus, 2007-2009 Edge, MKX: Clean A/C Ducts And Evaporator Core (Do Not Use
With Any Other Labor Operations)
092106A 2000-2005 Expedition, 1.4 Hrs.
Navigator, 2008-2010 Town Car, 2000-2003 F-150: Clean A/C Ducts And Evaporator Core (Do Not
Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19860 49
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 09-21-6 > Nov > 09 > A/C - White Flakes Are Blowing
From Dash Vents
Evaporator Core: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - White Flakes Are Blowing From Dash Vents
TSB 09-21-6
11/02/09
WHITE FLAKES COMING FROM A/C VENTS
FORD: 2005-2009 Focus 2008-2010 Crown Victoria 2000-2005 Expedition, F-150 2007-2009 Edge
2008-2010 Escape Hybrid, Escape
LINCOLN: 2008-2010 Town Car 2000-2005 Navigator 2007-2009 MKX
MERCURY:
2008-2010 Grand Marquis, Mariner Hybrid, Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-19-16 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some vehicles may experience white flakes coming from the A/C vents when the blower
motor is engaged. This may be caused by flux utilized in the manufacturing process of the
evaporator core.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Hazard and Risk Warnings for White Flakes
WARNING
MAY CAUSE EYE AND RESPIRATORY TRACT IRRITATION. PROLONGED REPEATED
EXPOSURE MAY CAUSE BONE DAMAGE (FLUOROSIS) AND HARM TO THE RESPIRATORY
SYSTEM (BASED ON ANIMAL DATA).
^ Avoid inhaling dust.
^ Avoid contact with eyes.
^ Store away from acids.
^ Wash thoroughly after handling.
^ Avoid release to the environment.
NOTE
THE USE OF DUST PROOF GOGGLES, CHEMICAL RESISTANT GLOVES (PVC) AND DUST
MASK IS RECOMMENDED.
Using compressed air (maximum inlet pressure) 100 PSI (689 kPa), clean the A/C ducts through
the registers and blow off the evaporator core through the blower motor opening.
NOTE
THE ENTIRE EVAPORATOR CORE SURFACE MUST BE DRY FOR BEST RESULTS.
NOTE
WHILE PERFORMING THIS PROCEDURE AND SELECTING DIFFERENT VENT MODES SUCH
AS FLOOR / PANEL AND FLOOR / DEFROST, IT MAY BE NECESSARY TO TEMPORARILY
START THE ENGINE TO ENABLE MODE DOOR MOVEMENT.
Clean A/C Ducts:
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 09-21-6 > Nov > 09 > A/C - White Flakes Are Blowing
From Dash Vents > Page 7629
1. Remove floor duct trim.
2. Using masking tape, connect one end of the vacuum cleaner hose to the floor duct on driver
side.
3. Tape closed all the other floor duct openings.
4. Obtain about two feet (61 cm) of rubber vacuum line large enough to fit the end of a small shop
air blowgun. Secure the hose to the end of the
blowgun using a worm clamp.
5. Close all instrument panel registers.
6. Set temperature setting to full cold.
7. Place mode in floor / panel.
8. Turn on vacuum cleaner.
9. Working with one register at a time insert the vacuum line down each duct and blow shop air
through each duct for 30 seconds. Be sure to close each
register before moving on to the next register.
10. Change mode to floor I defrost.
11. Blow down each defroster duct for 30 seconds.
12. Alternate mode door between floor and floor / defrost three (3) times, giving the door time to
move between each change.
13. Turn off vacuum cleaner.
Clean Evaporator Core:
1. Change mode to full floor.
2. Ensure temperature is full cold.
3. Remove blower motor per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412.
4. Turn on vacuum cleaner.
5. Reach into blower opening with vacuum line and proceed to blow shop air for a minimum of 5
minutes, utilizing a very slow sweeping action.
6. Blow the entire core face with an up and down motion, then repeat moving from side to side.
NOTE
ATTENTION TO THE BLOW-OFF OF THE EVAPORATOR CORE SURFACE WILL DETERMINE
EFFECTIVENESS OF REPAIR.
7. Install the blower motor per WSM, Section 412.
8. Open all registers.
9. Operate the A/C system in Max mode with the blower on the lowest setting. Monitor the
temperature with a thermometer until the lowest temp is
achieved. Switch to vent and monitor the temperature until ambient temperature is reached.
10. Repeat Step 9 three (3) additional times.
11. Switch the blower motor to high speed with the vent mode still selected. white flakes should not
come out of the vents. If no white flakes are present
continue to Step 12.
12. Disconnect vacuum cleaner and remove tape from floor duct.
13. Reassemble floor duct trim.
14. Blow powder off or vacuum dash board and vehicle interior as required.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 09-21-6 > Nov > 09 > A/C - White Flakes Are Blowing
From Dash Vents > Page 7630
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092106A 2004-2005 F-150, 1.2 Hrs.
2008-2010 Crown Victoria, Grand Marquis, Escape, Escape Hybrid, Mariner, Mariner Hybrid,
2005-2009 Focus, 2007-2009 Edge, MKX: Clean A/C Ducts And Evaporator Core (Do Not Use
With Any Other Labor Operations)
092106A 2000-2005 Expedition, 1.4 Hrs.
Navigator, 2008-2010 Town Car, 2000-2003 F-150: Clean A/C Ducts And Evaporator Core (Do Not
Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19860 49
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 7631
Evaporator Core: Description and Operation
EVAPORATOR CORE
NOTE: Installation of a new receiver/drier desiccant bag is not required when repairing the air
conditioning system, except when there is physical evidence of contamination from a failed A/C
compressor or damage to the receiver/drier desiccant bag.
The evaporator core is an aluminum plate/fin type and is located in the heater core and evaporator
core housing. A mixture of liquid refrigerant and oil enters the bottom of the evaporator core
through the evaporator core inlet tube and continues out of the evaporator core through the
evaporator core outlet tube as a vapor. During A/C compressor operation, airflow from the blower
motor is cooled and dehumidified as it flows through the evaporator core fins.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-29 (Front HVAC)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7635
C296
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Evaporator Temperature Sensor
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Evaporator Temperature
Sensor
EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The evaporator temperature sensor contains a thermistor which receives a reference voltage from
the dual-zone EATC or EMTC module. The thermistor then varies the resistance to the reference
voltage based on the evaporator fin temperature. The resulting voltage is returned to the dual-zone
EATC or EMTC module where it is interpreted as an evaporator fin temperature reading.
The dual-zone EATC module or EMTC module maintains evaporator core temperature and
prevents icing of the evaporator core. It does this by switching off the A/C request signal to the
instrument cluster when the evaporator temperature sensor reading falls below acceptable levels,
and by switching on the A/C request when the evaporator temperature rises above acceptable
levels.
The evaporator temperature sensor electrical connector is located outside of the heater core and
evaporator core housing near the accelerator pedal, with the sensor pigtail leading into the housing
to the sensor probe which is inserted between the evaporator core fins.
The evaporator temperature sensor is not available as a separate component. To install a new
evaporator temperature sensor, a new heater core and evaporator core housing must be installed.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Evaporator Temperature Sensor > Page 7638
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning Evaporator
Temperature (ACET) Sensor
AIR CONDITIONING EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE (ACET) SENSOR
A/C Evaporator Temperature (ACET) Sensor Voltage And Resistance
The ACET sensor measures the evaporator air discharge temperature. The ACET sensor is a
thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of a
thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance increases as the
temperature decreases. The PCM sources a low current 5 volts on the ACET circuit. With SIG RTN
also connected to the ACET sensor, the varying resistance changes the voltage drop across the
sensor terminals. As A/C evaporator air temperature changes, the varying resistance of the ACET
sensor changes the voltage the PCM detects.
The ACET sensor is used to more accurately control A/C clutch cycling, improve defrost/demist
performance, and reduce A/C clutch cycling.
NOTE: These values can vary 15% due to sensor and VREF variations. Voltage values were
calculated for VREF equals 5.0 volts.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Expansion Valve: Description and Operation
THERMOSTATIC EXPANSION VALVE (TXV)
NOTE: Installation of a new receiver/drier desiccant bag is not required when repairing the air
conditioning system, except when there is physical evidence of contamination from a failed A/C
compressor or damage to the receiver/drier desiccant bag.
The thermostatic expansion valve (TXV) is located at the evaporator core inlet and outlet tubes at
the center rear of the engine compartment. The TXV provides a restriction to the flow of refrigerant
from the high-pressure side of the refrigerant system and separates the low-pressure and
high-pressure sides of the refrigerant system. Refrigerant entering and exiting the evaporator core
passes through the TXV through 2 separate flow paths. An internal temperature sensing bulb
senses the temperature of the refrigerant flowing out of the evaporator core and adjusts an internal
pin-type valve to meter the refrigerant flow into the evaporator core. The internal pin-type valve
decreases the amount of refrigerant entering the evaporator core at lower temperatures and
increases the amount of refrigerant entering the evaporator core at higher temperatures.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 7642
Expansion Valve: Service and Repair
THERMOSTATIC EXPANSION VALVE
Removal and Installation
NOTE:
- Installation of a new receiver/drier desiccant bag is not required when repairing the air
conditioning system except when there is physical evidence of system contamination from a failed
A/C compressor or damage to the receiver/drier desiccant bag.
- The O-ring seals used on this vehicle are not interchangeable with all similarly sized O-ring seals
used on other Ford products. Use only the O-ring seals specified for this vehicle in the Ford master
parts catalog.
1. Recover the refrigerant. 2. Remove the thermostatic expansion valve (TXV) fitting nut and
disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
3. Remove the 2 TXV bolts. 4. Remove the TXV.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new O-ring seals lubricated in clean PAG oil.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
6. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair
Heater Core: Service and Repair
HEATER CORE
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Page 7646
Removal and Installation
NOTE: If a heater core leak is suspected, the heater core must be pressure leak tested before it is
removed from the vehicle.
1. Remove the heater core and evaporator core housing. 2. Remove the 6 floor duct screws and
the floor duct. 3. Remove the heater core tube dash panel seal. 4. Remove the heater tube bracket
screw and the heater tube bracket. 5. Remove the 5 fresh air inlet duct screws and the fresh air
inlet duct. 6. Disconnect the wire harness from the plenum chamber. 7. Remove the 7 lower facing
plenum chamber screws. 8. Orient the heater core and evaporator core housing with the plenum
chamber upright. 9. Remove the upper facing plenum chamber screw.
10. Remove the 2 plenum chamber clips and remove the plenum chamber being careful not to
allow the evaporator core to become dislodged from the
installed position.
11. CAUTION: Do not handle the heater core by the inlet and/or outlet tube to remove. Handling
the heater core by the tubes may damage
the joints and lead to failure of the heater core.
Remove the heater core. 1
Grasp the heater core by the core-side of the heater tube connections and partially remove it from
the plenum chamber.
2 Grasp the heater core by the top of the core and remove it from the plenum chamber.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Page 7647
12. NOTE: It is not necessary to carry out this step if the evaporator core has not become
dislodged from the installed position during this procedure.
If the evaporator core has been moved at any point during heater core removal, remove the
evaporator core, verify that the drain seal is installed in the correct position and install the
evaporator core in the correct position.
13. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Compressor to Condenser Discharge Line
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Compressor to Condenser Discharge Line
COMPRESSOR TO CONDENSER DISCHARGE LINE
Removal and Installation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Compressor to Condenser Discharge Line > Page 7652
NOTE:
- The O-ring seals used on this vehicle are not interchangeable with all similarly sized O-ring seals
used on other Ford products. Use only the O-ring seals specified for this vehicle in the Ford master
parts catalog.
- Installation of a new receiver/drier desiccant bag is not required when repairing the A/C system
except when there is physical evidence of system contamination from a failed A/C compressor or
damage to the receiver/drier desiccant bag.
- The compressor-to-condenser discharge line consists of 2 separately serviceable lines. If only
one line is to be removed, only carry out the steps qualified for that line.
Both compressor-to-condenser discharge lines
1. Recover the refrigerant. 2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 3. Remove the
compressor-to-condenser discharge line fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
Condenser side compressor-to-condenser discharge line
4. Remove the front bumper cover. 5. Drain the engine coolant. 6. Release the upper radiator hose
clamp and disconnect the upper radiator hose from the radiator. 7. Remove the engine cooling fan.
8. Remove the compressor-to-condenser discharge line bracket bolt.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
9. Disconnect the A/C pressure transducer electrical connector.
10. Detach the 2 radiator brackets from the core support and position the radiator rearward. 11.
Remove the condenser inlet fitting bolt and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
12. Detach the compressor-to-condenser discharge line-to-radiator clip. 13. Remove the condenser
side compressor-to-condenser discharge line.
Compressor side compressor-to-condenser discharge line
14. Remove the drive belt from the A/C compressor pulley. 15. Disconnect the clutch field coil
electrical connector. 16. Remove the compressor-to-condenser discharge line bracket nut. 17.
Remove the A/C compressor discharge fitting bolt and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
18. Remove the compressor-to-condenser discharge line.
Both compressor-to-condenser discharge lines
19. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new O-ring seals lubricated in clean PAG oil.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
20. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Compressor to Condenser Discharge Line > Page 7653
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Condenser to Evaporator Line
CONDENSER TO EVAPORATOR LINE
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Compressor to Condenser Discharge Line > Page 7654
Removal and Installation
NOTE:
- The O-ring seals used on this vehicle are not interchangeable with all similarly sized O-ring seals
used on other Ford products. Use only the O-ring seals specified for this vehicle in the Ford master
parts catalog.
- Installation of a new receiver/drier desiccant bag is not required when repairing the A/C system
except when there is physical evidence of system contamination from a failed A/C compressor or
damage to the receiver/drier desiccant bag.
- The condenser-to-evaporator line consists of 2 separately serviceable lines. If only one line is to
be removed, only carry out the steps qualified for that line.
Both condenser-to-evaporator lines
1. Recover the refrigerant. 2. Disconnect the condenser-to-evaporator line spring lock coupling.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
Condenser-side condenser-to-evaporator line
3. Remove the front bumper cover. 4. Drain the engine coolant. 5. Release the upper radiator hose
clamp at the radiator and disconnect the hose. 6. Remove the engine cooling fan. 7. Remove the
condenser-to-evaporator line bracket bolt.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
8. Release the 2 radiator bracket clips from the radiator support and position the radiator rearward.
9. Remove the condenser outlet fitting bolt and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
10. Detach the condenser-to-evaporator line radiator clip.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Compressor to Condenser Discharge Line > Page 7655
11. Remove the condenser-side condenser-to-evaporator line.
Evaporator-side condenser-to-evaporator line
12. Remove evaporator outlet line.
13. Remove the 3 coolant reservoir bolts and position the coolant reservoir aside.
14. Remove the 2 power steering reservoir nuts and position the reservoir aside.
15. Detach the 2 wire harness retainers at the RH shock tower.
16. Remove the ground bolt at the RH shock tower.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Compressor to Condenser Discharge Line > Page 7656
17. Disconnect the RH front wheel speed sensor electrical connector. 18. Detach the 2
condenser-to-evaporator line clips. 19. Remove the evaporator-side condenser-to-evaporator line.
Both condenser-to-evaporator lines
20. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new O-ring seals lubricated in clean PAG oil.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
21. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Compressor to Condenser Discharge Line > Page 7657
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Evaporator Outlet Line
EVAPORATOR OUTLET LINE
Removal and Installation
NOTE:
- The O-ring seals used on this vehicle are not interchangeable with all similarly sized O-ring seals
used on other Ford products. Use only the O-ring seals specified for this vehicle in the Ford master
parts catalog.
- Installation of a new receiver/drier desiccant bag is not required when repairing the A/C system
except when there is physical evidence of system contamination from a failed A/C compressor or
damage to the receiver/drier desiccant bag.
1. Recover the refrigerant. 2. Remove the ground strap nut at the RH shock tower. 3. Remove the
evaporator outlet line bracket stud bolt.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
4. Disconnect the evaporator outlet line spring lock coupling.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
5. Remove the thermostatic expansion valve (TXV) fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
6. Remove the evaporator outlet line. 7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new O-ring seals lubricated in clean PAG oil.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Compressor to Condenser Discharge Line > Page 7658
8. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Housing Assembly HVAC: Service and Repair
HEATER CORE AND EVAPORATOR CORE HOUSING
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Page 7662
Removal and Installation
NOTE:
- Installation of a new receiver/drier desiccant bag is not required when repairing the air
conditioning system except when there is physical evidence of system contamination from a failed
A/C compressor or damage to the receiver/drier desiccant bag.
- The O-ring seals used on this vehicle are not interchangeable with all similarly sized O-ring seals
used on other Ford products. Use only the O-ring seals specified for this vehicle in the Ford master
parts catalog.
1. Recover the refrigerant. 2. Drain the engine coolant. 3. Remove the instrument panel. 4.
Remove the 3 driver side carpet pin-type retainers and position the driver side front carpet aside. 5.
Remove the 4 LH rear footwell duct pin-type retainers and the LH rear footwell duct. 6. Remove the
2 passenger front carpet pin-type retainers and position the passenger front carpet aside enough to
access the 2 front pin-type retainers
on the RH rear footwell duct.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Page 7663
7. Remove the 2 front pin-type retainers on the RH rear footwell duct and detach the RH rear
footwell duct from the heater core and evaporator core
housing.
8. Release the 2 heater hose clamps at the heater core and disconnect the heater hoses. 9.
Remove the thermostatic expansion valve (TXV) fitting nut and detach the A/C lines from the TXV.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
10. CAUTION: The retaining clips on the plastic evaporator drain tube elbow will break if the elbow
is removed from inside the vehicle. If
the evaporator drain tube elbow must be removed, the retaining clips must be detached from below
the vehicle. If the plastic evaporator drain tube elbow does not need to be removed, only detach
the evaporator drain tube from the elbow.
Disconnect the evaporator drain tube from the elbow at the floorpan.
11. Remove the 5 heater core and evaporator core housing nuts.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
12. Remove the heater core and evaporator core housing. 13. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
- Install new O-ring seals lubricated in clean PAG oil.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
14. Fill the engine coolant level. 15. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Receiver Dryer: Description and Operation
RECEIVER/DRIER
NOTE:
- The A/C condenser for this vehicle is produced from the factory with a receiver/drier desiccant
bag installed in the integrated receiver/drier. This receiver/drier desiccant bag may become
contaminated with moisture if the A/C condenser is not installed for an extended period of time.
Since it cannot be determined how much time has elapsed between production and installation of
the unit as a service part, the receiver/drier desiccant bag must be removed and replaced with the
separate receiver/drier desiccant bag, which is supplied together with the A/C condenser service
part kit.
- Installation of a new receiver/drier desiccant bag is not required when repairing the air
conditioning system, except when there is physical evidence of contamination from a failed A/C
compressor or damage to the receiver/drier desiccant bag.
The receiver/drier is integral to the A/C condenser. It stores high-pressure liquid refrigerant after it
leaves the condenser core. A receiver/drier desiccant bag installed inside the receiver/drier
removes any retained moisture from the refrigerant. The receiver/drier desiccant bag is a separate
component and can be separately removed and installed with the A/C condenser removed from the
vehicle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 7667
Receiver Dryer: Service and Repair
DESICCANT BAG
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Installation of a new receiver/drier desiccant bag is not required when repairing the air
conditioning system, except when there is physical evidence of contamination from a failed A/C
compressor or damage to the receiver/drier desiccant bag.
1. Remove the A/C condenser core. 2. Remove the receiver/drier plug.
- To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
3. Using a suitable tool. Grasp and remove the receiver/drier desiccant bag. 4. To install, reverse
the removal procedure.
- Lubricate the O-ring seal on the new receiver/drier plug with clean PAG oil.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Refrigerant: Capacity Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Refrigerant and Capacity
Capacity................................................................................................................................................
............................................................0.55 kg (19 oz)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 7672
Refrigerant: Fluid Type Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Refrigerant and Capacity
R-134a Refrigerant YN-19 (US); CYN-16-P or CYN-16-R
(Canada).........................................................................................................WSH-M17B19-A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Page
7673
Refrigerant: Description and Operation
REFRIGERANT SYSTEM DYE
A fluorescent refrigerant system dye "wafer" is added to the receiver/drier desiccant bag to assist in
refrigerant system leak diagnosis using a Rotunda approved ultraviolet blacklight. This fluorescent
dye "wafer" will dissolve after about 30 minutes of continued A/C operation. It is not necessary to
add additional dye to the refrigerant system before diagnosing leaks, even if a significant amount of
refrigerant has been removed from the system. Additional refrigerant system dye should only be
added if more than 50% of the refrigerant system lubricant capacity has been lost due to a fitting
separation, hose rupture, etc.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications
Refrigerant Oil: Capacity Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Refrigerant Lubricant and Capacity
Capacity................................................................................................................................................
...............................................................118 ml (4 oz)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications > Page 7678
Refrigerant Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Refrigerant Lubricant and Capacity
PAG Refrigerant Compressor Oil (R-134a Systems)
YN-12-D....................................................................................................................WSH-M1C231-B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7682
C1260
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component
Information > Description and Operation > A/C Pressure Transducer
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation A/C Pressure Transducer
A/C PRESSURE TRANSDUCER
The A/C pressure transducer monitors the compressor discharge pressure and communicates with
the PCM. The PCM will interrupt A/C compressor operation in the event that the A/C pressure
transducer indicates high system discharge pressures. It is also used to sense low charge
conditions. If the pressure is below a predetermined value for a given ambient temperature, the
PCM will not allow the clutch to engage. It is not necessary to recover the refrigerant before
removing the A/C pressure transducer.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component
Information > Description and Operation > A/C Pressure Transducer > Page 7685
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning (A/C) Cycling
Switch
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) CYCLING SWITCH
The A/C cycling switch may be wired to either the ACCS or ACPSW PCM input. When the A/C
cycling switch opens, the PCM turns off the A/C clutch. For information on the specific function of
the A/C cycling switch, refer to Heating and Air Conditioning, Climate Control System. Also, refer to
the applicable Vehicle/Diagrams for vehicle specific wiring.
If the ACCS signal is not received by the PCM, the PCM circuit will not allow the A/C to operate.
Some applications do not have a dedicated (separate) input to the PCM indicating that A/C is
requested. This information is received by the PCM through the communication link.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component
Information > Description and Operation > A/C Pressure Transducer > Page 7686
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning (A/C) High
Pressure Switch
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) HIGH PRESSURE SWITCH
The A/C high pressure switch is used for additional A/C system pressure control. The A/C high
pressure switch is either dual function for multiple speed, relay controlled electric fan applications,
or single function for all others.
For refrigerant containment control, the normally closed high pressure contacts open at a
predetermined A/C pressure. This results in the A/C turning off, preventing the A/C pressure from
rising to a level that would open the A/C high pressure relief valve.
For fan control, the normally open medium pressure contacts close at a predetermined A/C
pressure. This grounds the ACPSW circuit input to the PCM. The PCM then turns on the high
speed fan to help reduce the pressure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component
Information > Description and Operation > A/C Pressure Transducer > Page 7687
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning Pressure (ACP)
Transducer Sensor
AIR CONDITIONING PRESSURE (ACP) TRANSDUCER SENSOR
A/C Pressure Transducer Sensor Output Voltage
Typical ACP Transducer Sensor
The ACP transducer sensor is located in the high pressure (discharge) side of the A/C system. The
ACP transducer sensor provides a voltage signal to the PCM that is proportional to the A/C
pressure. The PCM uses this information for A/C clutch control, fan control and idle speed control.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7692
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7693
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7697
Compressor Clutch Relay: Description and Operation
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) CLUTCH RELAY (A/CCR)
NOTE: The PCM PIDs WAC and wide open throttle air conditioning cutoff fault (WACF) are used to
monitor the A/CCR output.
The A/CCR is wired normally open. There is no direct electrical connection between the A/C switch
or electronic automatic temperature control (EATC) module and the A/C clutch. The PCM receives
a signal indicating that A/C is requested. For some applications, this message is sent through the
communications network. When A/C is requested, the PCM checks other A/C related inputs that
are available, such as A/C pressure switch and A/C cycling switch. If these inputs indicate A/C
operation is OK, and the engine conditions are OK (coolant temperature, engine RPM, throttle
position), the PCM grounds the A/CCR output, closing the relay contacts and sending voltage to
the A/CCR.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7698
Compressor Clutch Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7699
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module > Page 7704
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module
C228A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module > Page 7707
C228B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module > Page 7708
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams Manual Climate Control Module
C2357A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module > Page 7709
C2357B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7710
Control Module HVAC: Service and Repair
CLIMATE CONTROL MODULE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the center instrument panel finish panel. 2. Remove the 4 climate control module
screws. 3. Remove the climate control module.
4. NOTE: Be sure the climate control module spacers are correctly positioned before installing the
climate control module.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Service and Repair
AMBIENT AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front bumper cover. 2. Disconnect the ambient air temperature sensor electrical
connector and remove the ambient air temperature sensor. 3. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-8 (behind Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7718
C271
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7719
Blower Motor Switch: Description and Operation
BLOWER MOTOR SWITCH
The blower motor switch is mounted in the EMTC module and controls blower motor speed by
adding or bypassing resistors in the blower motor resistor in all modes except OFF. The blower
motor switch knob is removable and can be separately replaced.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Blower Motor Speed Control
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair Blower Motor Speed Control
BLOWER MOTOR SPEED CONTROL
Removal and Installation
1. Detach the glove compartment damper from the glove compartment. 2. Remove the glove
compartment. 3. Disconnect the blower motor speed control electrical connector. 4. Remove the 2
blower motor speed control screws. 5. Remove the blower motor speed control. 6. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Blower Motor Speed Control > Page 7722
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair Blower Motor Switch
BLOWER MOTOR SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the climate control module. 2. Pull to remove the blower motor switch knob.
3. Remove the blower motor switch nut.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Blower Motor Speed Control > Page 7723
4. Release the 2 retaining tabs with the index finger on each hand, while depressing the blower
motor switch shaft with the thumbs to remove the
blower motor switch.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7727
C233
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7728
Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
IN-VEHICLE TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the 2 lower steering column opening cover bolts. 2. Detach the lower steering column
opening cover. 3. Disconnect the in-vehicle temperature sensor aspirator hose. 4. Disconnect the
in-vehicle temperature sensor electrical connector. 5. Release the 2 in-vehicle temperature sensor
clips and remove the in-vehicle temperature sensor.
6. NOTE: The in-vehicle temperature sensor hose and venturi assembly can be accessed from
below the driver side of the instrument panel.
Remove the in-vehicle temperature sensor hose and venturi assembly.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-29 (Front HVAC)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7732
C296
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Evaporator Temperature Sensor
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Evaporator Temperature
Sensor
EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The evaporator temperature sensor contains a thermistor which receives a reference voltage from
the dual-zone EATC or EMTC module. The thermistor then varies the resistance to the reference
voltage based on the evaporator fin temperature. The resulting voltage is returned to the dual-zone
EATC or EMTC module where it is interpreted as an evaporator fin temperature reading.
The dual-zone EATC module or EMTC module maintains evaporator core temperature and
prevents icing of the evaporator core. It does this by switching off the A/C request signal to the
instrument cluster when the evaporator temperature sensor reading falls below acceptable levels,
and by switching on the A/C request when the evaporator temperature rises above acceptable
levels.
The evaporator temperature sensor electrical connector is located outside of the heater core and
evaporator core housing near the accelerator pedal, with the sensor pigtail leading into the housing
to the sensor probe which is inserted between the evaporator core fins.
The evaporator temperature sensor is not available as a separate component. To install a new
evaporator temperature sensor, a new heater core and evaporator core housing must be installed.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Evaporator Temperature Sensor > Page 7735
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning Evaporator
Temperature (ACET) Sensor
AIR CONDITIONING EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE (ACET) SENSOR
A/C Evaporator Temperature (ACET) Sensor Voltage And Resistance
The ACET sensor measures the evaporator air discharge temperature. The ACET sensor is a
thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of a
thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance increases as the
temperature decreases. The PCM sources a low current 5 volts on the ACET circuit. With SIG RTN
also connected to the ACET sensor, the varying resistance changes the voltage drop across the
sensor terminals. As A/C evaporator air temperature changes, the varying resistance of the ACET
sensor changes the voltage the PCM detects.
The ACET sensor is used to more accurately control A/C clutch cycling, improve defrost/demist
performance, and reduce A/C clutch cycling.
NOTE: These values can vary 15% due to sensor and VREF variations. Voltage values were
calculated for VREF equals 5.0 volts.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 7739
C1260
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > A/C Pressure Transducer
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation A/C Pressure Transducer
A/C PRESSURE TRANSDUCER
The A/C pressure transducer monitors the compressor discharge pressure and communicates with
the PCM. The PCM will interrupt A/C compressor operation in the event that the A/C pressure
transducer indicates high system discharge pressures. It is also used to sense low charge
conditions. If the pressure is below a predetermined value for a given ambient temperature, the
PCM will not allow the clutch to engage. It is not necessary to recover the refrigerant before
removing the A/C pressure transducer.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > A/C Pressure Transducer > Page 7742
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning (A/C) Cycling
Switch
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) CYCLING SWITCH
The A/C cycling switch may be wired to either the ACCS or ACPSW PCM input. When the A/C
cycling switch opens, the PCM turns off the A/C clutch. For information on the specific function of
the A/C cycling switch, refer to Heating and Air Conditioning, Climate Control System. Also, refer to
the applicable Vehicle/Diagrams for vehicle specific wiring.
If the ACCS signal is not received by the PCM, the PCM circuit will not allow the A/C to operate.
Some applications do not have a dedicated (separate) input to the PCM indicating that A/C is
requested. This information is received by the PCM through the communication link.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > A/C Pressure Transducer > Page 7743
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning (A/C) High
Pressure Switch
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) HIGH PRESSURE SWITCH
The A/C high pressure switch is used for additional A/C system pressure control. The A/C high
pressure switch is either dual function for multiple speed, relay controlled electric fan applications,
or single function for all others.
For refrigerant containment control, the normally closed high pressure contacts open at a
predetermined A/C pressure. This results in the A/C turning off, preventing the A/C pressure from
rising to a level that would open the A/C high pressure relief valve.
For fan control, the normally open medium pressure contacts close at a predetermined A/C
pressure. This grounds the ACPSW circuit input to the PCM. The PCM then turns on the high
speed fan to help reduce the pressure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > A/C Pressure Transducer > Page 7744
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning Pressure (ACP)
Transducer Sensor
AIR CONDITIONING PRESSURE (ACP) TRANSDUCER SENSOR
A/C Pressure Transducer Sensor Output Voltage
Typical ACP Transducer Sensor
The ACP transducer sensor is located in the high pressure (discharge) side of the A/C system. The
ACP transducer sensor provides a voltage signal to the PCM that is proportional to the A/C
pressure. The PCM uses this information for A/C clutch control, fan control and idle speed control.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Service Port HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Service Port HVAC: Description and Operation
SERVICE GAUGE PORT VALVES
The high-pressure service gauge port valve is located on the compressor-to-condenser discharge
line.
The low-pressure service gauge port valve is located on the compressor suction line.
The fitting is an integral part of the refrigerant line or component.
- Special couplings are required for both the high-side and low-side service gauge ports.
- A very small amount of leakage will always be detectable around the Schrader-type valve with the
service gauge port valve cap removed, and is considered normal. A new Schrader-type valve core
can be installed if the seal leaks excessively.
- The service gauge port valve caps are used as primary seals in the refrigerant system to prevent
leakage through the Schrader-type valves from reaching the atmosphere. Always install and tighten
the A/C service gauge port valve caps to the correct torque after they are removed.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision > System Information >
Service and Repair > Inspection and Repair After A Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deployment
Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision: Service and Repair Inspection and Repair After
A Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deployment
Inspection and Repair After a Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deployment
WARNING: Remove restraint system diagnostic tools from the vehicle prior to road testing. If tools
are not removed, the supplemental restraint system (SRS) device may not deploy in a crash.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury or death in a crash and
possibly violate vehicle safety standards.
NOTE: After diagnosing or repairing a supplemental restraint system (SRS), the restraint system
diagnostic tools (if required) must be removed before operating the vehicle over the road.
NOTE: Deployable devices (such as air bag modules, pretensioners) may deploy alone or in
various combinations depending on the impact event.
NOTE: Always refer to the appropriate workshop manual procedures prior to carrying out vehicle
repairs affecting the SRS and safety belt system.
NOTE: The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the
customer.
All vehicles
1. NOTE: Refer to the correct removal and installation procedure for all SRS components being
installed.
When any deployable device or combination of devices are deployed and/or the restraints control
module (RCM) has the DTC B1231 (Event Threshold Exceeded) in memory, the repair of the
vehicle's SRS is to include the removal of all deployed devices and the installation of new
deployable devices, the removal and installation of new impact sensors, and the removal and
installation of a new RCM. DTCs must cleared from all required modules after repairs are carried
out.
Vehicles with occupant classification sensor (OCS) system
2. NOTE: After installation of new occupant classification sensor (OCS) system components carry
out the OCS System Reset procedure as
instructed in the workshop manual. Refer to the appropriate workshop manual for OCS system
removal and installation procedure.
When a vehicle has been involved in a collision and the occupant classification system module
(OCSM) has DTC B1231 stored in memory, the repair of the OCS system is to include the following
procedures for the specified system:
- For rail type OCS system, inspect the passenger side floorpan for damage and repair as
necessary. Install new OCS system rails.
- For weight sensor bolt type OCS system, inspect the passenger side floorpan for damage and
repair as necessary. Install a new seat track with OCS system weight sensor bolts. DTC must be
cleared from the OCSM before carrying out Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Reset.
Do not install a new OCSM unless DTC B1231 cannot be cleared.
- NOTE: Most bladder type OCSM do not store a DTC B1231 in memory after deployment. The
DTC B1231 is stored only by the RCM.
For bladder type OCS system, inspect for damage and repair as necessary. If installation of an
OCS system component is required, an OCS system service kit must be installed.
All vehicles
3. When any damage to the impact sensor mounting points or mounting hardware has occurred,
repair or install new mounting points and mounting
hardware as needed.
4. When the driver air bag module has deployed, a new clockspring must be installed.
5. New driver and/or front passenger safety belt systems (including retractors, buckles and height
adjusters) must be installed if the vehicle is
involved in a collision that results in deployment of the driver and/or front passenger safety belt
pretensioners. For additional information, refer to Safety Belt System.
6. Inspect the entire vehicle for damage, including the following components:
Steering column (deployable column if equipped) Instrument panel knee bolsters and mounting
points Instrument panel braces and brackets Instrument panel and mounting points Seats and seat
mounting points Safety belts, safety belt buckles and safety belt retractors.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision > System Information >
Service and Repair > Inspection and Repair After A Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deployment > Page 7753
SRS wiring, wiring harnesses and connectors
7. After carrying out the review and inspection of the entire vehicle for damage, repair or install new
components as needed.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision > System Information >
Service and Repair > Inspection and Repair After A Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deployment > Page 7754
Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision: Service and Repair Safety Belt Procedure After
A Collision
SAFETY BELT PROCEDURE AFTER A COLLISION
1. WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS] if
equipped, buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters
[if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and attaching hardware) should be inspected
after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be installed unless a qualified technician finds
the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly. Belt assemblies not in use during a
collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed if either damage or incorrect
operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase the risk of serious personal
injury in collisions.
NOTE: Safety belt assemblies should be periodically inspected to make sure they have not
become damaged and that they remain in correct operating condition, particularly if they have been
subjected to severe stress.
Before installing the new safety belt assembly, the safety belt attaching areas must be inspected
for damage and distortion. If the attaching points are damaged and distorted, the sheet metal must
be reworked back to its original shape and structural integrity.
Install the new safety belt(s) using the appropriate instructions. Carry out the Functional Test. See:
Seat Belt Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEPOWERING AND REPOWERING
Depowering Procedure
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Failure to follow this instruction may result in
air bag deployment, which may result in serious personal injury.
- Never probe the electrical connector on a side air curtain module. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in side air curtain module deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraints system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraints system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the smart power
distribution junction box (SPDJB), located in the LH lower kick panel, remove the lower kick panel
fuse cover and the
restraints control module (RCM) fuse 46 (7.5A) from the (SPDJB).
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30 seconds.
The air bag warning indicator will remain lit
continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or installing any new front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and
before servicing, installing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors,
such as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches. Failure to
follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
The front impact severity sensors are located on the radiator support under the front bumper cover.
The first row side impact sensors are located at or near the base of the B-pillars.
The second row side impact sensors are located on the C-pillars.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
Repowering Procedure
1. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 2. Install RCM fuse 46 (7.5A) to the SPDJB and install
the lower kick panel fuse cover.
3. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in front
of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal
injury.
Connect the battery ground cable.
4. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition switch from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the ignition switch back to ON
and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag
warning indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn OFF. If an air
bag SRS fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash at a 5 Hz rate (RCM not configured).
The air bag warning indicator might not light until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch
has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 7760
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator and any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) from the RCM and occupant classification
sensor (OCS) module using a scan tool.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 7761
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Deactivation and Reactivation
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEACTIVATION AND REACTIVATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Deactivation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of serious personal injury in
the event of an accidental deployment.
- Carry a live air bag module with the air bag and trim cover pointed away from your body. This will
reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live air bag module down with the trim cover face down. This will reduce the risk of
serious personal injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Failure to follow this instruction may result in
air bag deployment, which may result in personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the safety canopy module. Failure to follow this instruction may
result in safety canopy deployment, which may result in personal injury.
- The safety belt pretensioners are pyrotechnic devices. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in pretensioner or air bag deployment which may result in serious personal
injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraints system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraints system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All vehicles 1. Turn all vehicle accessories off. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the smart
power distribution junction box (SPDJB), located in the LH lower kick panel, remove the lower kick
panel fuse cover and the
restraints control module (RCM) fuse 46 (7.5A) from the SPDJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30 seconds.
The air bag warning indicator will remain lit
continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or installing any new front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and
before servicing, installing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors,
such as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensors are located on the radiator support under the front bumper cover.
The first row side impact sensors are located at or near the base of the B-pillars.
The second row side impact sensors are located on the C-pillars.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 7762
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
7. NOTE: Repeat this step for both locking pins.
Using a 3-mm Allen wrench or a suitable tool through the access hole on the backside of the
steering wheel, position the tool against the spring clip and push in, disengaging the clip from the
locking pin. With the spring clip disengaged from the locking pin, gently pull back on that side of the
driver air bag module to release it from the steering wheel.
8. CAUTION: Do not pull the driver air bag module electrical connectors out by the locking buttons.
Damage to the locking buttons may
occur.
Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking buttons on the driver air bag
module electrical connectors. With the locking buttons released, remove the electrical connectors
and the driver air bag module.
9. Open and lower the glove compartment door. Then unhook the glove compartment door from
the instrument panel (I/P).
- If equipped, detach the glove compartment door dampener.
Edge
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 7763
10. Remove the 2 passenger air bag module bolts from the cross vehicle beam bracket.
11. CAUTION: Do not handle the passenger air bag module by grabbing the edges of the
deployment doors. Damage to the air bag module
may occur.
Through the glove compartment opening, release the 4 LH side deployment door clips. Then
release the forward-most 5 clips and separate the deployment door and passenger air bag module
from the I/P.
12. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the RH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
13. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the RH locking button released, remove the RH electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 7764
14. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the LH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
15. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the LH locking button released, remove the LH electrical connector and remove the
passenger air bag module.
MKX
16. Pull straight out to release the 5 retaining clips and remove the RH I/P finish panel.
17. Remove the screw for the LH duct assembly bracket from the front of the I/P.
18. Through the glove compartment opening, remove the screw and the LH duct assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 7765
19. Through the glove compartment opening, remove the screw and the RH duct assembly.
20. Remove the 4 bolts and the passenger air bag module support bracket.
21. Remove the 3 nuts from the passenger air bag module.
22. CAUTION: Do not allow the passenger air bag module to hang from the wiring harness.
Damage to the wiring harness and connectors
may occur.
Lower the rear of the passenger air bag module off the 3 mounting studs. Move the passenger air
bag module rearward to release the 7 hooks from the I/P and rest the module on the cross vehicle
beam.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 7766
23. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the LH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
24. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the LH locking button released, remove the LH electrical connector from the passenger air
bag module.
25. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the RH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
26. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the RH locking button released, remove the RH electrical connector. Remove the passenger
air bag module from the glove compartment opening.
All vehicles
27. From under the rear of the front passenger seat, slide and disengage the passenger seat side
air bag module electrical connector locking clip, and
then release the tab and disconnect the passenger seat side air bag module electrical connector.
28. Remove the passenger side D-pillar trim panel.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 7767
29. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger safety canopy module electrical connector out by the
locking button. Damage to the locking button
may occur.
With the locking button released, remove the electrical connector from the passenger safety
canopy module.
30. Remove the driver side D-pillar trim panel.
31. CAUTION: Do not pull the driver safety canopy module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button
may occur.
With the locking button released, remove the electrical connector from the driver safety canopy
module.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 7768
32. From under the rear of the driver seat, detach the driver seat side air bag module electrical
connector from the seat cushion frame. Then slide and
disengage the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector locking clip, and then release
the tab and disconnect the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector.
33. Install RCM fuse 46 (7.5A) to the SPDJB. 34. Connect the battery ground cable.
Reactivation
All vehicles 1. Remove RCM fuse 46 (7.5A) from the SPDJB. 2. Disconnect the battery ground
cable and wait at least one minute.
3. Connect the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector and then slide and engage the
seat side air bag electrical connector locking clip.
Then attach the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector to the seat cushion frame.
4. CAUTION:
- Do not install the safety canopy module electrical connector by the locking button. Damage to the
locking button may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector locking button must be in the released position
when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector is unique and cannot be reversed when connected
to the safety canopy module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the safety canopy
module. Do not force the electrical connector into the safety canopy module. Damage to the
connector or component may occur.
With the locking button released, install the driver safety canopy module electrical connector fully
into the driver safety canopy module and seat the locking button.
5. Install the driver side D-pillar trim panel.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 7769
6. CAUTION:
- Do not install the safety canopy module electrical connector by the locking button. Damage to the
locking button may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector locking button must be in the released position
when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector is unique and cannot be reversed when connected
to the safety canopy module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the safety canopy
module. Do not force the electrical connector into the safety canopy module. Damage to the
connector or component may occur.
With the locking button released, install the passenger safety canopy module electrical connector
fully into the passenger safety canopy module and seat the locking button.
7. Install the passenger side D-pillar trim panel.
8. Connect the passenger seat side air bag module electrical connector and then slide and engage
the seat side air bag electrical connector locking
clip.
MKX
9. CAUTION:
- Do not install the passenger air bag module electrical connectors by the locking buttons. Damage
to the locking buttons may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connector locking buttons must be in the released
position when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the passenger air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in
the passenger air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the passenger air bag
module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 7770
Position the passenger air bag module on the cross vehicle beam. With the locking buttons
released, install the 2 passenger air bag module electrical connectors fully into the passenger air
bag module and seat the locking buttons.
10. NOTE: During the passenger air bag module installation, make sure all 7 of the hooks are fully
seated in the I/P.
Install the passenger air bag module 7 hooks into the I/P. Raise the rear of the passenger air bag
module onto the 3 mounting studs.
11. Install the 3 passenger air bag module nuts.
- Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
12. NOTE: To avoid a squeak or rattle condition, install the passenger air bag module bracket and
passenger air bag module bolts in this order.
Install the passenger air bag module support bracket and the 4 bolts. 1. Install the passenger air
bag module support bracket and 2 bolts to the cross vehicle beam.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
2. Install the inboard passenger air bag module support bracket-to-passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
3. Install the outboard passenger air bag module support bracket-to-passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 7771
13. Install the screw and the RH duct assembly.
14. Install the screw and the LH duct assembly.
15. Install the screw for the LH duct assembly bracket in the front of the I/P.
16. NOTE: Make sure the RH I/P finish panel 5 retaining clips are fully seated in the I/P.
Install the RH I/P finish panel.
Edge
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 7772
17. CAUTION:
- Do not install the passenger air bag module electrical connectors by the locking buttons. Damage
to the locking buttons may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connector locking buttons must be in the released
position when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the passenger air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in
the passenger air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the passenger air bag
module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
With the locking buttons released, install the 2 passenger air bag module electrical connectors fully
into the passenger air bag module and seat the locking buttons.
18. CAUTION: Do not handle the passenger air bag module by grabbing the edges of the
deployment doors. Damage to the air bag module
may occur.
NOTE: During air bag module installation, make sure all the deployment door clips are fully seated
in the I/P.
Install the passenger air bag module deployment door rear-most clips into the I/P first. Then install
the side deployment door clips working around to the forward-most clips seating each of them fully
into the I/P.
19. NOTE: To avoid a squeak or rattle condition, install the 2 passenger air bag module bolts in this
order.
Install the passenger air bag module 2 bolts. 1. Install the inboard passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
2. Install the outboard passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
All vehicles 20. Hook the glove compartment door to the I/P. Close the glove compartment door.
- If equipped, attach the glove compartment door dampener.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 7773
21. CAUTION:
- Do not install the driver air bag module electrical connectors by the locking buttons. Damage to
the locking buttons may occur.
- The driver air bag module electrical connector locking buttons must be in the released position
when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the passenger air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in
the passenger air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the passenger air bag
module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
With the locking buttons released, install the driver air bag module electrical connectors fully into
the driver air bag module and seat the locking buttons.
22. NOTE: Audible clicks will be heard when both wire clips are seated in the driver air bag module.
Align the driver air bag module locking pins to the steering wheel and, while pushing inward, seat
the 2 driver air bag module locking pins to the steering wheel wire clips. When the 2 locking pins are seated in place, there should be an even gap between the driver air
bag module trim cover and the steering wheel.
23. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 24. Install RCM fuse 46 (7.5A) to the SPDJB and
install the lower kick panel fuse cover.
25. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in
front of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected. Failure to follow this instructions may result in serious personal
injury.
Connect the battery ground cable.
26. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag warning
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag SRS
fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will either: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash at a 5 Hz rate (RCM not configured).
The air bag warning indicator may not illuminate until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator will need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Clear all continuous DTCs from the restraints control module using a scan tool.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Locations > Driver
Air Bag Module
View 151-10 (Steering Wheel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Locations > Driver
Air Bag Module > Page 7778
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Locations > Driver
Air Bag Module > Page 7779
Air Bag: Locations Side Air Bag Module
View 151-12 (Left Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Locations > Driver
Air Bag Module > Page 7780
View 151-13 (Right Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Locations > Driver
Air Bag Module > Page 7781
Air Bag: Locations Side Air Curtain Bag Module
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Locations > Driver
Air Bag Module > Page 7782
View 151-15 (Right Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Air Bag Module
Air Bag: Diagrams Passenger Air Bag Module
C256A
C256B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Air Bag Module > Page 7785
Air Bag: Diagrams Side Air Bag Module
C3321
C3329
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Air Bag Module > Page 7786
Air Bag: Diagrams Side Air Curtain Bag Module
C9018
C9019
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module
Air Bag: Service and Repair Driver Air Bag Module
DRIVER AIR BAG MODULE
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Carry a live air bag module with the air bag and trim cover pointed away from your body. This will
reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live air bag module down with the trim cover face down. This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards. Failure to follow this instruction may result in personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which may result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices. Failure to follow this
procedure may result in serious personal injury.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
1. Depower the system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 7789
2. NOTE: Repeat this step for both locking pins.
Using a 3-mm Allen wrench or a suitable tool through the access hole on the backside of the
steering wheel, position the tool against the spring clip and push in, disengaging the clip from the
locking pin. With the spring clip disengaged from the locking pin, gently pull back on that side of the
driver air bag module to release it from the steering wheel.
3. CAUTION: Do not pull the driver air bag module electrical connectors out by the locking buttons.
Damage to the locking buttons can
occur.
Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking buttons on the driver air bag
module electrical connectors. With the locking buttons released, remove the electrical connectors
and the driver air bag module.
Installation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 7790
1. CAUTION:
- Do not install the driver air bag module electrical connectors by the locking buttons. Damage to
the locking buttons can occur.
- The driver air bag module electrical connector locking buttons must be in the released position
when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The driver air bag module electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the
driver air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the driver air bag module.
Damage to the connector or component may occur.
With the locking buttons released, install the driver air bag module electrical connectors fully into
the driver air bag module and seat the locking buttons.
2. NOTE: Audible clicks will be heard when both wire clips are seated in the driver air bag module.
Align the driver air bag module locking pins to the steering wheel and, while pushing inward, seat
the 2 driver air bag module locking pins to the steering wheel wire clips. When the 2 locking pins are seated in place, there should be an even gap between the driver air
bag module trim cover and the steering wheel.
3. Repower the system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 7791
Air Bag: Service and Repair Passenger Air Bag Module
PASSENGER AIR BAG MODULE
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Carry a live air bag module with the air bag and deployment door pointed away from your body.
This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live air bag module down with the deployment door face down. This will reduce the
risk of injury in the event of an
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 7792
accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards. Failure to follow this instruction may result in personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which may result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
1. Depower the system. 2. Open and lower the glove compartment door.
- If equipped, detach the glove compartment door dampener.
3. Remove the 2 passenger air bag module bolts from the cross-car beam bracket.
4. CAUTION: Do not handle the passenger air bag module by grabbing the edges of the
deployment doors. Damage to the air bag module
may occur.
Through the glove compartment opening, release the LH side deployment door clips. Then release
the foreward-most clips and separate the deployment door and passenger air bag module from the
instrument panel (I/P).
5. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the RH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
6. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the RH locking button released, remove the RH electrical connector.
7. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the LH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
8. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the LH locking button released, remove the LH electrical connector and remove the
passenger air bag module.
Installation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 7793
1. CAUTION:
- Do not install the passenger air bag module electrical connectors by the locking buttons. Damage
to the locking buttons may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connector locking buttons must be in the released
position when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the passenger air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in
the passenger air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the passenger air bag
module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
NOTE: RH side shown, LH similar.
With the locking buttons released, install the 2 passenger air bag module electrical connectors fully
into the passenger air bag module and seat the locking buttons.
2. CAUTION: Do not handle the passenger air bag module by grabbing the edges of the
deployment doors. Damage to the air bag module
may occur.
NOTE: During passenger air bag module installation, make sure all the deployment door clips are
fully seated in the I/P.
Install the passenger air bag module deployment door rear-most clips into the I/P first. Then install
the side deployment door clips working around to the forward-most clips seating each of them fully
into the I/P.
3. NOTE: To avoid a squeak or rattle condition, install the 2 passenger air bag module bolts in this
order.
Install the passenger air bag module bolts. 1. Install the inboard passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
2. Install the outboard passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
4. Close the glove compartment door.
- If equipped, attach the glove compartment door dampener.
5. Repower the system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 7794
Air Bag: Service and Repair Safety Canopy Module
SAFETY CANOPY MODULE
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 7795
Part 2
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury from an accidental deployment, always carry or place a live
safety canopy module with the safety canopy and tear seam pointed away from your body. Failure
to do so may result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
- Anytime the safety canopy has deployed, the headliner, and all A-, B-, C- and D-pillar upper trim
panels and attaching hardware must be installed new along with any other damaged components
and hardware. Failure to do so may result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy
deployment.
- Vehicles equipped with safety canopy modules require a specific headliner. When installing a new
headliner on a vehicle equipped with safety canopy modules, make sure a headliner for safety
canopy modules is being used. The word AIRBAG will appear on the headliner
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 7796
where it meets each B-pillar trim panel. Failure to do so may result in personal injury in the event of
a safety canopy module deployment.
- Before installing a safety canopy module, inspect the roof line for any damage. If necessary, the
sheet metal must be reworked to its original condition and structural integrity. All damaged
fasteners must be installed new and any foreign material removed. Failure to do so may result in
personal injury in the event of a safety canopy deployment.
- Inspect the safety canopy before installation. If the safety canopy is damaged or the cover has
separated and the canopy material has been exposed, a new safety canopy module must be
installed. Do not attempt to repair the safety canopy module. Failure to follow these instructions
may result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
- To reduce the risk of injury, do not obstruct or place objects in the deployment path of the safety
canopy module. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury in the event of a
safety canopy module deployment.
- Never put any type of fastener or tie strap around any part of the safety canopy module or interior
trim panel. This will prevent the safety canopy module from deploying correctly. Failure to do so
may result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
- Never probe the electrical connector on a safety canopy module. Doing so may result in safety
canopy deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
- The safety canopy must be installed in the vehicle using new torque-prevailing type J-nuts
(W709759, 11 per side). The use of this J-nut is mandatory to reduce the risk of loss of fastener
effectiveness. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury in the event of a
safety canopy deployment.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indictor illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
1. Depower the system. 2. Remove the headliner.
3. CAUTION: Do not pull the safety canopy module electrical connector out by the locking button.
Damage to the locking button can occur.
Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the safety canopy
module electrical connector. With the locking button released, remove the electrical connector.
4. NOTE: Note the pin-type retainer on the safety canopy module front tether cord to the A-pillar
sheet metal for installation.
Remove the anchor bolt, then detach the pin-type retainer and the front tether cord anchor from the
A-pillar.
5. Remove the safety canopy module front tether cord routing pin-type retainer from the A-pillar
sheet metal. 6. Detach the 2 safety canopy module front tether cord A-pillar trim bracket routing
pin-type retainers from the A-pillar trim bracket. 7. Remove the safety canopy module A-pillar trim
bracket bolt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 7797
8. Remove the safety canopy module front door opening bolt.
9. NOTE: Note the position and the routing of the safety canopy module rear tether cord and
routing clip pin-type retainer for installation.
Detach the safety canopy module rear tether cord routing clip pin-type retainer from the upper
D-pillar sheet metal.
10. NOTE: Note the position of the safety canopy module rear tether anchor bracket hook and
pin-type retainer in the D-pillar sheet metal.
Remove the bolt, then detach the pin-type retainer and remove the safety canopy module rear
tether anchor bracket from the D-pillar sheet metal.
11. Remove the safety canopy module rear door opening bolt. 12. Remove the 2 safety canopy
module bolts near the C-pillar. 13. Remove the safety canopy module D-pillar bolt. 14. Remove the
2 safety canopy module rear bolts. 15. Remove the safety canopy module bolt near the B-pillar. 16.
Remove the safety canopy module B-pillar pin-type retainer.
17. Move the safety canopy module forward to release the rear bracket hook from the sheet metal
and remove the safety canopy module.
Installation
WARNING:
- Before installing a safety canopy module, inspect the roof line for any damage. If necessary, the
sheet metal must be reworked to its original condition and structural integrity. All new fasteners
must be installed if they are damaged and any foreign material removed. Failure to do so may
result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy deployment.
- Inspect the safety canopy before installation. If the safety canopy is damaged or the cover has
separated and the canopy material has been exposed, a new safety canopy module must be
installed. Do not attempt to repair the safety canopy module. Failure to follow these instructions
may result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
- Never put any type of fastener or tie strap around any part of the safety canopy module or interior
trim panel. This will prevent the safety canopy module from deploying correctly. Failure to do so
may result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
- The safety canopy must be installed in the vehicle using new torque-prevailing type J-nuts
(W709759, 11 per side). The use of this J-nut is mandatory to reduce the risk of loss of fastener
effectiveness. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury in the event of a
safety canopy deployment.
1. Remove the 4 front J-nuts and install new.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 7798
2. Remove the 7 rear J-nuts and install new.
3. Position the safety canopy module by moving it rearward, installing the rear bracket hook in the
sheet metal. 4. Install the safety canopy module B-pillar pin-type retainer. 5. Install the front tether
cord anchor pin-type retainer. 6. Install the safety canopy module front tether cord routing pin-type
retainer to the A-pillar sheet metal. 7. Attach the 2 safety canopy module front tether cord A-pillar
trim bracket routing pin-type retainers to the A-pillar trim bracket. 8. Install the safety canopy
module rear tether anchor bracket to the D-pillar sheet metal and attach the pin-type retainer. 9.
Attach the safety canopy module rear tether cord routing clip pin-type retainer to the upper D-pillar
sheet metal.
10. NOTE: Make sure all safety canopy module bolt holes line up with all J-nuts.
Install the safety canopy module D-pillar bolt. -
Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
11. Install the safety canopy module A-pillar trim bracket bolt.
- Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
12. Install the safety canopy module bolt near the B-pillar.
- Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
13. Install the 2 safety canopy module rear bolts.
- Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
14. Install the 2 safety canopy module bolts near the C-pillar.
- Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
15. Install the safety canopy module rear door opening bolt.
- Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
16. Install the safety canopy module rear tether cord anchor bracket bolt.
- Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
17. Install the safety canopy module front door opening bolt.
- Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
18. Install the safety canopy module front tether cord anchor bolt.
- Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 7799
19. CAUTION:
- Do not install the safety canopy module electrical connector by the locking button. Damage to the
locking button may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector locking button must be in the released position
when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector is unique and cannot be reversed when connected
to the safety canopy module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the safety canopy
module. Do not force the electrical connector into the safety canopy module. Damage to the
connector or component may occur.
With the locking button released, install the safety canopy module electrical connector fully into the
safety canopy module and seat the locking button.
20. Install the headliner. 21. Repower the system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations
Air Bag Control Module: Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7803
View 151-13 (Right Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7804
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams
C310A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7805
C310B (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7806
C310B (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7807
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair
RESTRAINTS CONTROL MODULE (RCM)
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- The restraints control module (RCM) orientation is critical for correct air bag supplemental
restraint system (SRS) operation. If a vehicle equipped with an SRS system has been involved in a
collision in which the center tunnel area has been damaged, inspect the mounting and bracket for
deformation. If damaged, a new RCM must be installed whether or not the air bags have deployed.
In addition, make sure the area of the RCM is restored to its original condition. Failure to follow this
procedure may result in serious personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices. Failure to follow this
procedure may result in serious
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7808
personal injury.
CAUTION:
- Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these charges, damage
may result.
- When installing a new restraints control module (RCM), it is necessary to carry out programmable
module installation (PMI). See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Information Bus/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- When installing a new restraints control module (RCM), always make sure the correct RCM is
being installed. If an incorrect RCM is installed, erroneous DTCs will result.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
1. If installing a new restraints control module (RCM), carry out the steps necessary to prepare for
programmable module installation (PMI). 2. Depower the system. 3. Remove the floor console.
4. Disconnect the selector lever cable from the ball stud located on the shifter and remove the
cable from the retaining clips. 5. Remove the 4 bolts (2 each side) from the inner floor console
support bracket. 6. Remove the bolts from the inner floor console bracket support-to-instrument
panel. 7. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the front inner floor console support bracket. 8.
Remove the inner floor console support bracket.
9. Press to release the locking tab and disconnect the small RCM electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7809
10. Disconnect the large RCM electrical connector.
1. Pinch the thumb tab and pivot the connector position assurance lever all the way back until it
stops. 2. Pull out and disconnect the RCM electrical connector.
11. Remove the 3 bolts and the RCM.
Installation
1. WARNING: The tightening torque of the air bag RCM retaining bolts is critical for correct system
operation. Failure to follow this
procedure may result in serious personal injury.
Install the restraints control module (RCM) and the 3 bolts. Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
2. Make sure the large RCM connector position assurance lever is in the full release position before
attempting to connect the connector.
3. CAUTION: Placing the large restraints control module (RCM) electrical wiring connector into the
RCM on an angle, may cause bad
electrical connections and damaged components.
Position the large RCM electrical connector into the RCM.
- CAUTION: Do not push the connector to the point where the lever pivots and seats itself. Light
pressure is needed to get the connector into position on the restraints control module (RCM),
before using the lever to fully seat the connector. Failure to follow these instructions may cause
component or connector damage.
With the large RCM electrical connector uniformly aligned to the RCM, lightly push in until a subtle
audible click is heard and slight resistance is felt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7810
4. Connect the large RCM electrical connector.
- Using the connector position assurance lever, pivot it toward the RCM, drawing the connector into
the RCM. Make sure the thumb tab is engaged to the retainer on the RCM and locked in place.
5. Connect the small RCM electrical connector. 6. Install the inner floor console support bracket. 7.
Install the 4 bolts (2 each side) to the inner floor console support bracket.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
8. Install the screws to the inner floor console bracket support-to-floor instrument panel.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
9. Install the selector lever cable in the selector lever housing.
10. NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable, make sure that the selector lever cable locking
tabs are locked in place and the cable end is
snapped onto the ball stud. Press the selector lever cable into the bracket and listen for the cable
to click in place. Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is locked into the bracket.
Also make sure that the selector lever cable end is correctly installed onto the ball stud. Pull back
on the selector lever cable end to make sure that the cable end is correctly installed.
Connect the selector lever cable end to the floor shifter.
11. Attach the electrical connectors to the front inner floor console support bracket. 12. Install the
floor console. 13. Repower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Do not prove out the SRS at
this time. 14. When installing a new RCM, carry out the steps necessary to complete
programmable module installation (PMI). 15. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition switch from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the ignition switch back to ON
and visually monitor the air bag indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag warning
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn OFF. If an air bag SRS
fault is present, the air bag indicator will: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash at a 5 Hz rate (RCM not configured).
The air bag warning indicator might not light until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch
has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault exists, a
chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning indicator and
any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7811
Clear all continuous diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) from the RCM and occupant classification
sensor (OCS) module using a scan tool.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Indicator > Component Information
> Service and Repair
Air Bag Deactivation Indicator: Service and Repair
PASSENGER AIR BAG DEACTIVATION (PAD) INDICATOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- The passenger air bag deactivation indicator is part of the hazard switch/traction control switch
assembly.
1. Depower the system. 2. Pull out to release the 8 retaining clips and detach the instrument panel
(I/P) center trim panel. 3. Disconnect the passenger air bag deactivation indicator electrical
connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Indicator > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Page 7815
4. Release the 4 locking tabs (2 upper and 2 lower) on the passenger air bag deactivation indicator
and remove it from the I/P center finish panel. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 6.
Repower the system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch > Component Information >
Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7819
C2355
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Diagrams
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Diagrams
C218A
C218B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7823
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Service and Repair
CLOCKSPRING
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices. Failure to follow this
instruction may result in serious personal injury.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7824
operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
1. Depower the system. 2. Tilt the steering wheel in the downward position and lock the tilt handle.
3. Remove the driver air bag module.
4. CAUTION: Vehicles with absolute steering angle sensor and/or adaptive headlamps, do not
allow the clockspring rotor to turn from the
straight-ahead position after the steering wheel is removed. Failure to follow this instruction may
result in component damage and/or system failure.
NOTE: Make sure the road wheels are in the straight-ahead position.
Remove the steering wheel.
5. Tape the clockspring rotor to the steering column shaft to prevent the clockspring rotor from
moving out of center. 6. Release the 2 tabs and position the upper steering column shroud upward.
7. Remove the 3 screws and the lower steering column shroud. 8. Disconnect the clockspring
electrical connector. 9. Remove the tape from the clockspring rotor to the steering column shaft. Do
not allow the clockspring rotor to move from center after tape is
removed.
10. CAUTION: Vehicles with absolute steering angle sensor and/or adaptive headlamps, do not
allow the clockspring rotor to turn from the
straight-ahead position after the steering wheel is removed. Failure to follow this instruction may
result in component damage and/or system failure.
NOTE: Vehicles with absolute steering angle sensor and/or adaptive headlamps, after the
clockspring has been removed make sure the arrow on the absolute steering angle sensor ring is
lined up with the arrow on the absolute steering angle sensor housing as shown.
Remove the 2 clockspring screws and remove the clockspring.
Installation
Vehicle repairs reusing the same clockspring
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7825
1. WARNING: Incorrect centralization may result in premature component failure. If in doubt when
centralizing the clockspring, repeat
the centralizing procedure. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
CAUTION: Make sure the road wheels are in the straight-ahead position. Failure to follow this
instruction may result in component damage and/or system failure.
if the vehicle's clockspring has rotated out of center, follow these steps to center the clockspring. 1.
Hold the clockspring outer housing stationary.
2. CAUTION: Overturning will destroy the clockspring. The internal ribbon wire acts as the stop and
can be broken from its internal
connection.
While turning the rotor counterclockwise, carefully feel for the ribbon wire to run out of length and
for a slight resistance. Stop turning at this point.
3. Turn the clockspring clockwise (approximately 2.25 turns) until the clockspring rotor wiring and
connector are in the 12 o'clock position.
Clockspring is now centered. Do not allow the rotor to turn from this position.
All vehicles
2. NOTE: Slight rotation of the absolute steering angle sensor ring is allowed to align the 2 arrows.
Make sure the sensor ring arrow is lined up with the absolute steering angle sensor housing arrow
as shown.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7826
3. CAUTION: If the clockspring is left unattended by the technician between centralizing the
clockspring and installing it to the
multi-function switch housing, the centralizing procedure must be repeated. Failure to follow this
instruction may result in component damage and/or system failure.
NOTE: Vehicles with absolute steering angle sensor and/or adaptive headlamps, slight rotation of the
clockspring rotor might be needed to seat the clockspring 3 locator pins into the absolute steering
angle sensor and or adaptive headlamps sensor ring. Very slight rotation is possible on a new
clockspring with the sealing key installed.
- Make sure the clockspring is fully seated into the multi-function switch housing before installing
the clockspring screws.
Install the clockspring and the 2 screws.
4. Connect the clockspring electrical connector. 5. Install the lower steering column shroud and the
3 screws. 6. Attach the upper steering column shroud to the lower steering column shroud.
7. CAUTION: If not installing a new clockspring, and the vehicle is left unattended by the technician
between the installation of the
clockspring to the multi-function switch housing and installing the steering wheel, the centralizing
procedure can be repeated at this time with the clockspring being installed in the multi-function
switch housing. Failure to follow this instruction may result in component damage and/or system
failure.
Install the steering wheel. If a new clockspring is being installed, and after the steering wheel installation, remove the
clockspring sealing key.
8. Install the driver air bag module. 9. Repower the system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Front Impact Sensor
Impact Sensor: Locations Front Impact Sensor
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Front Impact Sensor > Page 7831
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Front Impact Sensor > Page 7832
Impact Sensor: Locations Side Impact Sensor
View 151-12 (Left Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Front Impact Sensor > Page 7833
View 151-13 (Right Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Front Impact Sensor > Page 7834
View 151-15 (Right Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Front Impact Sensor > Page 7835
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Front Impact Sensor
Impact Sensor: Diagrams Front Impact Sensor
C1465
C1466
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Front Impact Sensor > Page 7838
Impact Sensor: Diagrams Side Impact Sensor
C3209
C3211
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Front Impact Sensor > Page 7839
C3248
C3249
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Front Impact Severity Sensor
FRONT IMPACT SEVERITY SENSOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting
bracket and wiring pigtail for deformation. Install and correctly position the sensor or any other
damaged SRS components whether or not the air bag is deployed. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in serious personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
1. Depower the system. 2. Remove the front bumper cover. 3. Disconnect the front impact severity
sensor electrical connector.
4. WARNING: The tightening torque of the front impact severity sensor retaining nuts is critical for
correct system operation. Failure to
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 7842
follow tightening instructions may result in serious personal injury.
NOTE: Make sure the hood latch bracket and front impact severity sensor mating surfaces are clean and
free of foreign material.
- Note position of the 2 locator tabs on sensor for installation.
Remove the bolt and the front impact severity sensor. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 6. Repower the system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 7843
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Side Impact Sensor - B-Pillar
SIDE IMPACT SENSOR - B-PILLAR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting
bracket and wiring pigtail for deformation. Install and correctly position the sensor or any other
damaged supplemental restraint system (SRS) components whether or not the air bag is deployed.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
1. Position the front seat forward.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 7844
2. Depower the system. 3. Remove the front door scuff plate.
- Pull up to release the 5 retaining clips.
4. Remove the rear door scuff plate.
- Pull up to release the 2 retaining clips.
5. Detach the 2 retainers and remove the lower B-Pillar trim panel. 6. Disconnect the side impact
sensor electrical connector.
7. WARNING: The tightening torque of the air bag side impact sensor retaining bolt is critical for
correct system operation. Failure to
follow tightening instruction may result in serious personal injury.
NOTE: Make sure the B-pillar and side impact sensor mating surfaces are clean and free of foreign
material.
- Note the position of the side impact sensor locating tabs for installation.
Remove the bolt and the side impact sensor. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 9. Repower the system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 7845
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Side Impact Sensor - C-Pillar
SIDE IMPACT SENSOR - C-PILLAR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting
bracket and wiring pigtail for deformation. Install and correctly position the sensor or any other
damaged supplemental restraint system (SRS) components whether or not the air bag is deployed.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a SRS fault.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
1. Fold down the rear seat backrest. 2. Depower the system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 7846
3. Position aside the quarter trim panel.
- Pull out on the quarter trim panel at the C-pillar to release the retaining clip to access the C-pillar
side impact sensor.
4. Disconnect the side impact sensor electrical connector.
5. WARNING: The tightening torque of the air bag side impact sensor retaining bolt is critical for
correct system operation. Failure to
follow tightening instructions may result in serious personal injury.
NOTE: Note the position of the 2 side impact sensor locating tabs for installation.
- Make sure the C-pillar and side impact sensor mating surfaces are clean and free of foreign
material.
Remove the bolt and the side impact sensor. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 7. Repower the system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Occupant Classification Module - Air Bag >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Occupant Classification Module - Air Bag >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7850
C3159
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Occupant Classification Module - Air Bag >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Module - Manual Seat Track
Seat Occupant Classification Module - Air Bag: Service and Repair Occupant Classification Module
- Manual Seat Track
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION MODULE - MANUAL SEAT TRACK
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
CAUTION: Use care when handling the seat and track assembly. Dropping the assembly or sitting
on a seat not secured in the vehicle may result in damaged components.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
1. Depower the system. 2. Disconnect the occupant classification sensor (OCS) module electrical
connector. 3. Remove the 2 screws and the OCS module. 4. To install, reverse the removal
procedure. 5. Install the passenger seat and repower the supplemental restraints system (SRS).
Do not prove out the SRS at this time. 6. Carry out the appropriate procedure after installation of an
OCS system component.
- If installing the original OCS system component, carry out the Zero Seat Weight Test and prove
out the SRS. See: Testing and
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Occupant Classification Module - Air Bag >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Module - Manual Seat Track > Page 7853
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics
- If installing a new OCS system component, carry out the System Reset procedure and prove out
the SRS. See: Service and Repair/Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Reset
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Occupant Classification Module - Air Bag >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Module - Manual Seat Track > Page 7854
Seat Occupant Classification Module - Air Bag: Service and Repair Occupant Classification Module
- Power Seat Track
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION MODULE - POWER SEAT TRACK
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
CAUTION: Use care when handling the seat and track assembly. Dropping the assembly or sitting
on a seat not secured in the vehicle may result in damaged components.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a restraints
control module (RCM) fault.
- The restraints control module (RCM) must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing
the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
1. Center and raise the front passenger seat to its highest position. 2. Depower the supplemental
restraint system (SRS). 3. Remove the front passenger seat. 4. Disconnect the occupant
classification sensor (OCS) module electrical connector. 5. Remove the 2 screws and the OCS
module. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 7. Install the front passenger seat. Do not
prove out the SRS at this time.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Occupant Classification Module - Air Bag >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Module - Manual Seat Track > Page 7855
8. Repower the supplemental restraints system (SRS). Do not prove out the SRS at this time. 9.
Carry out the appropriate procedure after installation of an OCS system component.
- If installing the original OCS system component, carry out the Zero Seat Weight Test. See:
Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics
- If installing a new OCS system component, carry out the System Reset procedure. See: Service
and Repair/Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Reset
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS)1
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS)1 > Page 7860
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS)1 > Page 7861
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS)1 > Page 7862
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) 1
C3324
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) 1 > Page 7865
C3325
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) 1 > Page 7866
C3330
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) 1 > Page 7867
C3331
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 7868
Seat Occupant Sensor: Description and Operation
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SENSOR (OCS) SYSTEM
The occupant classification sensor (OCS) system is standard equipment on all front passenger
seats. For diagnosing or servicing the OCS system, refer to Air Bag Systems.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track
Seat Occupant Sensor: Service and Repair Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SENSOR - MANUAL SEAT TRACK
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
CAUTION: Use care when handling the seat and track assembly. Dropping the assembly or sitting
on a seat not secured in the vehicle may result in damaged components.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
All occupant classification sensor (OCS) weight sensor bolt(s) 1. Position the seat to access all the
seat track-to-floor bolts and the safety belt anchor. 2. Depower the Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS). 3. Remove the front passenger seat. 4. Remove the manual seat track.
5. NOTE: After marking the seat track rails, do not change the position of the seat track.
Mark the position of both seat track rails.
Inboard OCS weight sensor bolt(s)
6. Remove the nut and the safety belt buckle pretensioner.
All OCS weight sensor bolt(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 7871
7. NOTE: Outboard front cross brace screws shown, inboard similar.
On the side with the affected OCS I-bolt(s), remove the 2 front cross brace screws.
8. On the side with the affected OCS weight sensor bolt(s), disengage the seat adjuster handle
spring and position it aside.
9. Separate the seat adjuster handle from the affected side of the seat track rail with the OCS
weight sensor bolt(s).
10. NOTE: Outboard rear cross brace screws shown, inboard similar.
On the side with the affected OCS weight sensor bolt(s), remove the 2 rear cross brace screws.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 7872
11. Remove and discard the 2 OCS weight sensor bolt nuts from the affected side of the seat track
rail with the OCS weight sensor bolt(s).
12. Remove the side plate with the OCS weight sensor bolt(s) from the seat track rail.
13. CAUTION: Do not overtighten the side plate with the occupant classification sensor (OCS)
weight sensor bolts to the bench or table.
Tighten only enough to compress the spring washer. Overtightening may damage the side plate or
OCS weight sensor bolts.
Using a suitable tool, clamp the side plate to a bench or table to compress the spring washer on
the affected OCS weight sensor bolt as shown.
14. NOTE: Note the position of the OCS weight sensor bolt, spring washer and retaining clip for
installation.
Remove and discard the retaining clip from the affected OCS weight sensor bolt.
15. Release the clamp and remove the OCS weight sensor bolt and spring washer from the side
plate. sensor bolt and spring washer from the side
plate.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 7873
Installation
All OCS weight sensor bolt(s)
1. CAUTION: Do not overtighten the side plate with the occupant classification sensor (OCS)
weight sensor bolts to the bench or table.
Tighten only enough to compress the spring washer. Overtightening may damage the side plate or
OCS weight sensor bolts.
Position the spring washer and OCS weight sensor bolt in the side plate. Then clamp the side plate
to a bench or table to compress the OCS weight sensor bolt spring washer.
2. NOTE: Make sure the occupant classification sensor (OCS) weight sensor bolt retaining clip is
seated fully in the OCS weight sensor bolt groove
underneath the OCS weight sensor O-ring seal.
Install the 2 new OCS weight sensor bolt retaining clips in the OCS weight sensor groove
underneath the O-ring seal.
3. Unclamp the side plate with the installed OCS weight sensor bolt from the bench or table.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 7874
4. NOTE: Slight rotational adjustment of the OCS weight sensors bolts may be necessary to install
the OCS weight sensor bolts and side plate to the
seat track rail.
Install the side plate and OCS weight sensor bolts to the seat track rail.
5. NOTE: When installing the side plate to the seat track rail, 2 new OCS weight sensor nuts must
be installed.
Install the 2 new OCS weight sensor bolt nuts to the seat track rail. Tighten to 33 Nm (24 lb-ft).
6. Install the seat adjuster handle to the seat track rail.
7. Engage the seat adjuster handle spring.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 7875
8. Install the 2 rear cross brace screws.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
9. Install the 2 front cross brace screws.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
Inboard OCS weight sensor bolt(s)
10. Install the nut and the safety belt buckle pretensioner.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
All OCS weight sensor bolt(s) 11. Install the manual seat track. 12. Install the passenger seat and
repower the supplemental restraints system (SRS). Do not prove out the SRS at this time. 13.
Carry out the appropriate procedure after installation of an OCS system component.
- If installing the original OCS system component, carry out the Zero Seat Weight Test and prove
out the SRS. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics
- If installing a new OCS system component, carry out the System Reset procedure and prove out
the SRS. See: Service and Repair/Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Reset
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 7876
Seat Occupant Sensor: Service and Repair Occupant Classification Sensor - Power Seat Track
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SENSOR - POWER SEAT TRACK
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 7877
Part 2
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
CAUTION: Use care when handling the seat and track assembly. Dropping the assembly or sitting
on a seat not secured in the vehicle may result in damaged components.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- If any occupant classification sensor (OCS) weight sensor bolt nuts are removed, new OCS
weight sensor bolt nuts must be installed.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
All occupant classification sensor (OCS) weight sensor bolt(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 7878
1. Position the seat to access all the seat track-to-floor bolts and the safety belt anchor. 2. Depower
the supplemental restraint system (SRS). 3. Remove the passenger front seat. 4. Remove the
power seat track.
5. NOTE:
- Inboard seat track rail shown, outboard similar.
- After marking the seat track rails, do not change the position of the seat track.
Mark the position of both seat track rails.
Inboard OCS weight sensor bolt(s) 6. Remove the nut and the safety belt buckle pretensioner.
Outboard OCS weight sensor bolt(s) 7. Remove the front retainer and the outboard seat track riser
cover shield. 8. Remove the 2 retainers and the OCS weight sensor bolt protection bracket.
All OCS weight sensor bolt(s) 9. On the side with the affected OCS weight sensor bolt(s), remove
the nut from the seat track front cross brace.
10. Remove and discard the 2 OCS weight sensor bolt nuts from the affected side of the seat track
rail with the OCS weight sensor(s).
11. NOTE: Outboard side shown, inboard similar.
Separate the front seat track motor cable from the affected seat track rail. Then remove the side
plate with the OCS weight sensor bolts from the seat track rail.
12. CAUTION: Do not overtighten the side plate with the OCS weight sensor bolts to the bench or
table. Tighten only enough to compress
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 7879
the spring washer. Overtightening may damage the side plate or OCS weight sensor bolts.
Using a suitable tool, clamp the side plate to a bench or table to compress the spring washer on
the affected OCS weight sensor bolt as shown.
13. NOTE: Note the position of the OCS weight sensor bolt, spring washer and retaining clip for
installation.
Remove and discard the retaining clip from the affected OCS weight sensor bolt.
14. Release the clamp and remove the OCS weight sensor bolt and spring washer from the side
plate.
Installation
All OCS weight sensor bolt(s)
1. CAUTION: Do not overtighten the side plate with the occupant classification sensor (OCS)
weight sensor bolts to the bench or table.
Tighten only enough to compress the spring washer. Overtightening may damage the side plate or
OCS weight sensor bolts.
Position the spring washer and OCS weight sensor bolt in the side plate. Then clamp the side plate
to a bench or table to compress the OCS weight sensor bolt spring washer.
2. NOTE: Make sure the OCS weight sensor bolt retaining clip is seated fully in the OCS weight
sensor bolt groove underneath the OCS weight
sensor O-ring seal.
Install the OCS weight sensor bolt retaining clip.
3. Remove the clamp and the side plate from the bench or table.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 7880
4. NOTE: Slight rotational adjustment of the front seat track motor cable and OCS weight sensor
bolts may be necessary to install the OCS weight
sensor bolts and side plate to the seat track rail.
Install the front seat track motor cable to the seat track rail. Then install the side plate with the OCS
weight sensor bolts to the seat track rail.
5. NOTE: When installing the side plate to the seat track rail, 2 new OCS weight sensor nuts must
be installed.
Install the 2 new OCS weight sensor bolt nuts to the seat track rail. Tighten to 33 Nm (24 lb-ft).
6. NOTE: Outboard side shown, inboard similar.
Install the nut to the seat track front cross brace. Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
Outboard OCS weight sensor bolt(s) 7. Install the 2 retainers and the OCS weight sensor bolt
protection bracket. 8. Install the front retainer and the outboard seat track riser cover shield.
Inboard OCS weight sensor bolt(s) 9. Install the nut and the safety belt buckle pretensioner.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
All OCS weight sensor bolt(s) 10. Install the power seat track. 11. Install the passenger seat and
repower the supplemental restraints system (SRS). Do not prove out the SRS at this time. 12.
Carry out the appropriate procedure after installation of an OCS system component.
- If installing the original OCS system component, carry out the Zero Seat Weight Test and prove
out the SRS. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics
- If installing a new OCS system component, carry out the System Reset procedure and prove out
the SRS. See: Service and Repair/Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Reset
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Position Sensor > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Seat Position Sensor: Service and Repair
SEAT POSITION SENSOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
All seats
1. Raise the driver seat and then position it to the middle of the track. 2. Depower the system. 3.
Remove the driver seat. 4. Disconnect the seat position sensor electrical connector.
Power seats
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Position Sensor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 7884
5. Detach the wire harness routing pin-type retainer from the seat position sensor bracket.
All seats
6. Push apart then inward to release the seat position sensor locking clip. 7. Slide the seat position
sensor rearward to release the 2 hooks from the bracket. Then remove the seat position sensor. 8.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. 9. Repower the system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Side Air Bag > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Side Air Bag: Description and Operation
SEAT SIDE AIR BAGS
The driver and passenger seat side air bags are attached to the seat backrest frame. If a seat side
air bag deployment has occurred or for more information, refer to Air Bag Systems.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Side Air Bag > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 7888
Side Air Bag: Service and Repair
SIDE AIR BAG MODULE
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Carry a live side air bag module with the air bag and tear seam pointed away from your body.
This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live side air bag module down on the cover tear seam. This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface may contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards. Failure to follow this instruction may result in personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which may result in serious personal injury.
- Side air bag modules with damaged covers must be installed new. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a side air bag deployment took place, a new side air bag module and bolts must be installed.
The side air bag module bracket on the seat back
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Side Air Bag > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 7889
frame should be inspected and installed new if necessary.
- When installing a new side air bag after deployment.
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
1. Position the affected seat and backrest fully up and forward. 2. Depower the system.
3. Release the seat backrest trim cover rear panel lower J-clip. Then, release the 2 seat backrest
trim cover rear panel side J-clips.
4. NOTE: The reinforcement board and seat backrest trim cover rear panel can be positioned aside
with the reinforcement board still inside the seat
backrest trim cover rear panel.
Detach the 2 pin-type retainers and position aside the seat backrest trim cover rear panel and
reinforcement board.
5. Through the rear of the seat remove and discard the 2 side air bag module bolts. Then, separate
the side air bag module from the seat backrest.
6. CAUTION: Do not pull the side air bag module electrical connector out by the locking button.
Damage to the locking button may occur.
Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the side air bag
module electrical connector. With the locking button released, remove the electrical connector and
the side air bag module.
Installation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Side Air Bag > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 7890
1. CAUTION:
- Do not install the side air bag module electrical connector by the locking button. Damage to the
locking button may occur.
- The side air bag module electrical connector locking button must be in the released position when
the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The side air bag module electrical connector is unique and cannot be reversed when connected
to the side air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the side air bag
module. Do not force the electrical connector into the side air bag module. Damage to the
connector or component may occur.
With the locking button released, install the side air bag module electrical connector fully into the
side air bag module and seat the locking button.
2. CAUTION: Make sure the side air bag module wiring harness is not pinched between the side air
bag module and the backrest frame.
Damage to wire harness may occur.
NOTE: When installing the side air bag module, new bolts must be installed.
Position the side air bag module in the seat backrest and install the 2 new bolts. Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
3. Position the seat backrest trim cover rear panel and attach the 2 pin-type retainers. 4. Attach the
2 seat backrest cover rear side J-clips. Then attach the seat backrest cover rear lower J-clip. 5.
Repower the system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations
Air Bag Control Module: Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7895
View 151-13 (Right Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7896
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams
C310A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7897
C310B (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7898
C310B (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7899
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair
RESTRAINTS CONTROL MODULE (RCM)
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- The restraints control module (RCM) orientation is critical for correct air bag supplemental
restraint system (SRS) operation. If a vehicle equipped with an SRS system has been involved in a
collision in which the center tunnel area has been damaged, inspect the mounting and bracket for
deformation. If damaged, a new RCM must be installed whether or not the air bags have deployed.
In addition, make sure the area of the RCM is restored to its original condition. Failure to follow this
procedure may result in serious personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices. Failure to follow this
procedure may result in serious
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7900
personal injury.
CAUTION:
- Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these charges, damage
may result.
- When installing a new restraints control module (RCM), it is necessary to carry out programmable
module installation (PMI). See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Information Bus/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- When installing a new restraints control module (RCM), always make sure the correct RCM is
being installed. If an incorrect RCM is installed, erroneous DTCs will result.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
1. If installing a new restraints control module (RCM), carry out the steps necessary to prepare for
programmable module installation (PMI). 2. Depower the system. 3. Remove the floor console.
4. Disconnect the selector lever cable from the ball stud located on the shifter and remove the
cable from the retaining clips. 5. Remove the 4 bolts (2 each side) from the inner floor console
support bracket. 6. Remove the bolts from the inner floor console bracket support-to-instrument
panel. 7. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the front inner floor console support bracket. 8.
Remove the inner floor console support bracket.
9. Press to release the locking tab and disconnect the small RCM electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7901
10. Disconnect the large RCM electrical connector.
1. Pinch the thumb tab and pivot the connector position assurance lever all the way back until it
stops. 2. Pull out and disconnect the RCM electrical connector.
11. Remove the 3 bolts and the RCM.
Installation
1. WARNING: The tightening torque of the air bag RCM retaining bolts is critical for correct system
operation. Failure to follow this
procedure may result in serious personal injury.
Install the restraints control module (RCM) and the 3 bolts. Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
2. Make sure the large RCM connector position assurance lever is in the full release position before
attempting to connect the connector.
3. CAUTION: Placing the large restraints control module (RCM) electrical wiring connector into the
RCM on an angle, may cause bad
electrical connections and damaged components.
Position the large RCM electrical connector into the RCM.
- CAUTION: Do not push the connector to the point where the lever pivots and seats itself. Light
pressure is needed to get the connector into position on the restraints control module (RCM),
before using the lever to fully seat the connector. Failure to follow these instructions may cause
component or connector damage.
With the large RCM electrical connector uniformly aligned to the RCM, lightly push in until a subtle
audible click is heard and slight resistance is felt.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7902
4. Connect the large RCM electrical connector.
- Using the connector position assurance lever, pivot it toward the RCM, drawing the connector into
the RCM. Make sure the thumb tab is engaged to the retainer on the RCM and locked in place.
5. Connect the small RCM electrical connector. 6. Install the inner floor console support bracket. 7.
Install the 4 bolts (2 each side) to the inner floor console support bracket.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
8. Install the screws to the inner floor console bracket support-to-floor instrument panel.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
9. Install the selector lever cable in the selector lever housing.
10. NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable, make sure that the selector lever cable locking
tabs are locked in place and the cable end is
snapped onto the ball stud. Press the selector lever cable into the bracket and listen for the cable
to click in place. Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is locked into the bracket.
Also make sure that the selector lever cable end is correctly installed onto the ball stud. Pull back
on the selector lever cable end to make sure that the cable end is correctly installed.
Connect the selector lever cable end to the floor shifter.
11. Attach the electrical connectors to the front inner floor console support bracket. 12. Install the
floor console. 13. Repower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Do not prove out the SRS at
this time. 14. When installing a new RCM, carry out the steps necessary to complete
programmable module installation (PMI). 15. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition switch from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the ignition switch back to ON
and visually monitor the air bag indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag warning
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn OFF. If an air bag SRS
fault is present, the air bag indicator will: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash at a 5 Hz rate (RCM not configured).
The air bag warning indicator might not light until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch
has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault exists, a
chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning indicator and
any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7903
Clear all continuous diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) from the RCM and occupant classification
sensor (OCS) module using a scan tool.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Classification
Module - Air Bag > Component Information > Locations
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Classification
Module - Air Bag > Component Information > Locations > Page 7907
C3159
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Classification
Module - Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Module - Manual Seat Track
Seat Occupant Classification Module - Air Bag: Service and Repair Occupant Classification Module
- Manual Seat Track
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION MODULE - MANUAL SEAT TRACK
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
CAUTION: Use care when handling the seat and track assembly. Dropping the assembly or sitting
on a seat not secured in the vehicle may result in damaged components.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
1. Depower the system. 2. Disconnect the occupant classification sensor (OCS) module electrical
connector. 3. Remove the 2 screws and the OCS module. 4. To install, reverse the removal
procedure. 5. Install the passenger seat and repower the supplemental restraints system (SRS).
Do not prove out the SRS at this time. 6. Carry out the appropriate procedure after installation of an
OCS system component.
- If installing the original OCS system component, carry out the Zero Seat Weight Test and prove
out the SRS. See: Air Bag Systems/Testing
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Classification
Module - Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Module - Manual Seat Track >
Page 7910
and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics
- If installing a new OCS system component, carry out the System Reset procedure and prove out
the SRS. See: Air Bag Systems/Service and Repair/Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System
Reset
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Classification
Module - Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Module - Manual Seat Track >
Page 7911
Seat Occupant Classification Module - Air Bag: Service and Repair Occupant Classification Module
- Power Seat Track
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION MODULE - POWER SEAT TRACK
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
CAUTION: Use care when handling the seat and track assembly. Dropping the assembly or sitting
on a seat not secured in the vehicle may result in damaged components.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a restraints
control module (RCM) fault.
- The restraints control module (RCM) must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing
the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
1. Center and raise the front passenger seat to its highest position. 2. Depower the supplemental
restraint system (SRS). 3. Remove the front passenger seat. 4. Disconnect the occupant
classification sensor (OCS) module electrical connector. 5. Remove the 2 screws and the OCS
module. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 7. Install the front passenger seat. Do not
prove out the SRS at this time.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Classification
Module - Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Module - Manual Seat Track >
Page 7912
8. Repower the supplemental restraints system (SRS). Do not prove out the SRS at this time. 9.
Carry out the appropriate procedure after installation of an OCS system component.
- If installing the original OCS system component, carry out the Zero Seat Weight Test. See: Air
Bag Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics
- If installing a new OCS system component, carry out the System Reset procedure. See: Air Bag
Systems/Service and Repair/Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Reset
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEPOWERING AND REPOWERING
Depowering Procedure
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Failure to follow this instruction may result in
air bag deployment, which may result in serious personal injury.
- Never probe the electrical connector on a side air curtain module. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in side air curtain module deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraints system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraints system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the smart power
distribution junction box (SPDJB), located in the LH lower kick panel, remove the lower kick panel
fuse cover and the
restraints control module (RCM) fuse 46 (7.5A) from the (SPDJB).
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30 seconds.
The air bag warning indicator will remain lit
continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or installing any new front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and
before servicing, installing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors,
such as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches. Failure to
follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
The front impact severity sensors are located on the radiator support under the front bumper cover.
The first row side impact sensors are located at or near the base of the B-pillars.
The second row side impact sensors are located on the C-pillars.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
Repowering Procedure
1. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 2. Install RCM fuse 46 (7.5A) to the SPDJB and install
the lower kick panel fuse cover.
3. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in front
of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal
injury.
Connect the battery ground cable.
4. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition switch from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the ignition switch back to ON
and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag
warning indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn OFF. If an air
bag SRS fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash at a 5 Hz rate (RCM not configured).
The air bag warning indicator might not light until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch
has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 7918
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator and any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) from the RCM and occupant classification
sensor (OCS) module using a scan tool.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 7919
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Deactivation and Reactivation
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEACTIVATION AND REACTIVATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Deactivation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of serious personal injury in
the event of an accidental deployment.
- Carry a live air bag module with the air bag and trim cover pointed away from your body. This will
reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live air bag module down with the trim cover face down. This will reduce the risk of
serious personal injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Failure to follow this instruction may result in
air bag deployment, which may result in personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the safety canopy module. Failure to follow this instruction may
result in safety canopy deployment, which may result in personal injury.
- The safety belt pretensioners are pyrotechnic devices. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in pretensioner or air bag deployment which may result in serious personal
injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraints system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraints system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All vehicles 1. Turn all vehicle accessories off. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the smart
power distribution junction box (SPDJB), located in the LH lower kick panel, remove the lower kick
panel fuse cover and the
restraints control module (RCM) fuse 46 (7.5A) from the SPDJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30 seconds.
The air bag warning indicator will remain lit
continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or installing any new front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and
before servicing, installing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors,
such as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensors are located on the radiator support under the front bumper cover.
The first row side impact sensors are located at or near the base of the B-pillars.
The second row side impact sensors are located on the C-pillars.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 7920
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
7. NOTE: Repeat this step for both locking pins.
Using a 3-mm Allen wrench or a suitable tool through the access hole on the backside of the
steering wheel, position the tool against the spring clip and push in, disengaging the clip from the
locking pin. With the spring clip disengaged from the locking pin, gently pull back on that side of the
driver air bag module to release it from the steering wheel.
8. CAUTION: Do not pull the driver air bag module electrical connectors out by the locking buttons.
Damage to the locking buttons may
occur.
Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking buttons on the driver air bag
module electrical connectors. With the locking buttons released, remove the electrical connectors
and the driver air bag module.
9. Open and lower the glove compartment door. Then unhook the glove compartment door from
the instrument panel (I/P).
- If equipped, detach the glove compartment door dampener.
Edge
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 7921
10. Remove the 2 passenger air bag module bolts from the cross vehicle beam bracket.
11. CAUTION: Do not handle the passenger air bag module by grabbing the edges of the
deployment doors. Damage to the air bag module
may occur.
Through the glove compartment opening, release the 4 LH side deployment door clips. Then
release the forward-most 5 clips and separate the deployment door and passenger air bag module
from the I/P.
12. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the RH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
13. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the RH locking button released, remove the RH electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 7922
14. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the LH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
15. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the LH locking button released, remove the LH electrical connector and remove the
passenger air bag module.
MKX
16. Pull straight out to release the 5 retaining clips and remove the RH I/P finish panel.
17. Remove the screw for the LH duct assembly bracket from the front of the I/P.
18. Through the glove compartment opening, remove the screw and the LH duct assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 7923
19. Through the glove compartment opening, remove the screw and the RH duct assembly.
20. Remove the 4 bolts and the passenger air bag module support bracket.
21. Remove the 3 nuts from the passenger air bag module.
22. CAUTION: Do not allow the passenger air bag module to hang from the wiring harness.
Damage to the wiring harness and connectors
may occur.
Lower the rear of the passenger air bag module off the 3 mounting studs. Move the passenger air
bag module rearward to release the 7 hooks from the I/P and rest the module on the cross vehicle
beam.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 7924
23. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the LH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
24. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the LH locking button released, remove the LH electrical connector from the passenger air
bag module.
25. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the RH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
26. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the RH locking button released, remove the RH electrical connector. Remove the passenger
air bag module from the glove compartment opening.
All vehicles
27. From under the rear of the front passenger seat, slide and disengage the passenger seat side
air bag module electrical connector locking clip, and
then release the tab and disconnect the passenger seat side air bag module electrical connector.
28. Remove the passenger side D-pillar trim panel.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 7925
29. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger safety canopy module electrical connector out by the
locking button. Damage to the locking button
may occur.
With the locking button released, remove the electrical connector from the passenger safety
canopy module.
30. Remove the driver side D-pillar trim panel.
31. CAUTION: Do not pull the driver safety canopy module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button
may occur.
With the locking button released, remove the electrical connector from the driver safety canopy
module.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 7926
32. From under the rear of the driver seat, detach the driver seat side air bag module electrical
connector from the seat cushion frame. Then slide and
disengage the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector locking clip, and then release
the tab and disconnect the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector.
33. Install RCM fuse 46 (7.5A) to the SPDJB. 34. Connect the battery ground cable.
Reactivation
All vehicles 1. Remove RCM fuse 46 (7.5A) from the SPDJB. 2. Disconnect the battery ground
cable and wait at least one minute.
3. Connect the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector and then slide and engage the
seat side air bag electrical connector locking clip.
Then attach the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector to the seat cushion frame.
4. CAUTION:
- Do not install the safety canopy module electrical connector by the locking button. Damage to the
locking button may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector locking button must be in the released position
when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector is unique and cannot be reversed when connected
to the safety canopy module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the safety canopy
module. Do not force the electrical connector into the safety canopy module. Damage to the
connector or component may occur.
With the locking button released, install the driver safety canopy module electrical connector fully
into the driver safety canopy module and seat the locking button.
5. Install the driver side D-pillar trim panel.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 7927
6. CAUTION:
- Do not install the safety canopy module electrical connector by the locking button. Damage to the
locking button may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector locking button must be in the released position
when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector is unique and cannot be reversed when connected
to the safety canopy module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the safety canopy
module. Do not force the electrical connector into the safety canopy module. Damage to the
connector or component may occur.
With the locking button released, install the passenger safety canopy module electrical connector
fully into the passenger safety canopy module and seat the locking button.
7. Install the passenger side D-pillar trim panel.
8. Connect the passenger seat side air bag module electrical connector and then slide and engage
the seat side air bag electrical connector locking
clip.
MKX
9. CAUTION:
- Do not install the passenger air bag module electrical connectors by the locking buttons. Damage
to the locking buttons may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connector locking buttons must be in the released
position when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the passenger air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in
the passenger air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the passenger air bag
module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 7928
Position the passenger air bag module on the cross vehicle beam. With the locking buttons
released, install the 2 passenger air bag module electrical connectors fully into the passenger air
bag module and seat the locking buttons.
10. NOTE: During the passenger air bag module installation, make sure all 7 of the hooks are fully
seated in the I/P.
Install the passenger air bag module 7 hooks into the I/P. Raise the rear of the passenger air bag
module onto the 3 mounting studs.
11. Install the 3 passenger air bag module nuts.
- Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
12. NOTE: To avoid a squeak or rattle condition, install the passenger air bag module bracket and
passenger air bag module bolts in this order.
Install the passenger air bag module support bracket and the 4 bolts. 1. Install the passenger air
bag module support bracket and 2 bolts to the cross vehicle beam.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
2. Install the inboard passenger air bag module support bracket-to-passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
3. Install the outboard passenger air bag module support bracket-to-passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 7929
13. Install the screw and the RH duct assembly.
14. Install the screw and the LH duct assembly.
15. Install the screw for the LH duct assembly bracket in the front of the I/P.
16. NOTE: Make sure the RH I/P finish panel 5 retaining clips are fully seated in the I/P.
Install the RH I/P finish panel.
Edge
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 7930
17. CAUTION:
- Do not install the passenger air bag module electrical connectors by the locking buttons. Damage
to the locking buttons may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connector locking buttons must be in the released
position when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the passenger air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in
the passenger air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the passenger air bag
module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
With the locking buttons released, install the 2 passenger air bag module electrical connectors fully
into the passenger air bag module and seat the locking buttons.
18. CAUTION: Do not handle the passenger air bag module by grabbing the edges of the
deployment doors. Damage to the air bag module
may occur.
NOTE: During air bag module installation, make sure all the deployment door clips are fully seated
in the I/P.
Install the passenger air bag module deployment door rear-most clips into the I/P first. Then install
the side deployment door clips working around to the forward-most clips seating each of them fully
into the I/P.
19. NOTE: To avoid a squeak or rattle condition, install the 2 passenger air bag module bolts in this
order.
Install the passenger air bag module 2 bolts. 1. Install the inboard passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
2. Install the outboard passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
All vehicles 20. Hook the glove compartment door to the I/P. Close the glove compartment door.
- If equipped, attach the glove compartment door dampener.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 7931
21. CAUTION:
- Do not install the driver air bag module electrical connectors by the locking buttons. Damage to
the locking buttons may occur.
- The driver air bag module electrical connector locking buttons must be in the released position
when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the passenger air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in
the passenger air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the passenger air bag
module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
With the locking buttons released, install the driver air bag module electrical connectors fully into
the driver air bag module and seat the locking buttons.
22. NOTE: Audible clicks will be heard when both wire clips are seated in the driver air bag module.
Align the driver air bag module locking pins to the steering wheel and, while pushing inward, seat
the 2 driver air bag module locking pins to the steering wheel wire clips. When the 2 locking pins are seated in place, there should be an even gap between the driver air
bag module trim cover and the steering wheel.
23. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 24. Install RCM fuse 46 (7.5A) to the SPDJB and
install the lower kick panel fuse cover.
25. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in
front of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected. Failure to follow this instructions may result in serious personal
injury.
Connect the battery ground cable.
26. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag warning
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag SRS
fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will either: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash at a 5 Hz rate (RCM not configured).
The air bag warning indicator may not illuminate until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator will need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Clear all continuous DTCs from the restraints control module using a scan tool.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Child Seat Tether Attachment: Description and Operation
Child Safety Seat Tether Anchors
WARNING: The child safety seat tether anchor/bolt MUST be securely tightened to specification.
Otherwise, the child safety seat may not be correctly secured and the child could be injured if the
vehicle is involved in a collision or stops suddenly.
If the child safety seat tether anchors were in use during a collision, inspect and install new anchors
as necessary. Return the vehicle structure to its original production configuration.
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH)
The lower anchors and tethers for children (LATCH) system is a standardized and uniform
attachment system for installing child safety seats in passenger vehicles. LATCH-equipped child
safety seats have 2 lower attachments that connect to the vehicle portion of the LATCH system.
The vehicle portion of the system consists of 2 attachment points (6-mm wires) welded to the 60
percent and the 40 percent rear seat backrest frame. The attachment points protrude from the
biteline between the seat cushion and seat backrest.
If a child safety seat was in use during a collision, inspect the vehicle portion of the system for
damage. If any of the attachment points (6-mm wires) are damaged, install a new seat backrest
frame. Refer to Seats.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Seat Belt: Description and Operation
SAFETY BELT EXTENSION ASSEMBLY
In certain cases, the safety belt may be too short even when it is fully extended. About 20 cm (8 in)
can be added to the belt length by using a safety belt extension. Safety belt extensions are
available at no cost from any Ford or Lincoln-Mercury dealer parts department. Safety belt
extensions are only available with black webbing.
Use only extensions manufactured by the same supplier as the safety belt. Manufacturer
identification is located at the end of the webbing on the label. Also, use the safety belt extension
only if the safety belt is too short for you when fully extended. Do not use an extension to change
the fit of the shoulder belt across the torso.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Seat Belt Buckle: Description and Operation
REAR SAFETY BELT BUCKLE
The 40 percent and or 60 percent rear safety belt buckles are serviced with the 40 percent and or
60 percent rear seat backrest frame assembly. The LH rear safety belt buckle is serviced with the
rear center safety belt retractor assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle and Pretensioner
Seat Belt Buckle: Service and Repair Safety Belt Buckle and Pretensioner
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE AND PRETENSIONER
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensors [BTS] if equipped, buckles,
shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and attaching
hardware) should be inspected after any collision. All new belt assemblies should be installed
unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly. Belt
assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed if
either damage or incorrect operation is noted.
The automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature of the safety belt retractor must be checked by a
qualified technician to verify that the ALR feature for a child safety seat is functioning correctly, in
addition to other checks for correct safety belt system function. A new belt and retractor assembly
must be installed if the safety belt assembly's ALR feature, or any other safety belt function, is not
operating correctly when inspected according to the functional inspection procedures. Failure to
install a new belt and retractor assembly could increase the risk of serious personal injury in
collisions.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle and Pretensioner > Page 7944
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in serious personal injury.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
All seats
1. Depower the SRS. 2. Position the seat all the way up and back.
3. NOTE: Note the position of the safety belt buckle pretensioner anti-rotation locator tab for
installation.
From the rear of the seat, remove the safety belt buckle pretensioner nut. Vehicles with a manual driver seat, remove the safety belt buckle pretensioner bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
4. Position the safety belt buckle pretensioner towards the front of the vehicle to access the
electrical connectors.
Seats with power
5. Remove the safety belt buckle pretensioner cover.
All seats
6. Remove the safety belt buckle pretensioner.
1. Disconnect the safety belt buckle pretensioner buckle switch electrical connector. 2. Disconnect
the safety belt buckle pretensioner electrical connector. 3. Cut the tie strap and remove the safety
belt buckle pretensioner.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedures. 8. Repower the SRS. 9. Check the active restraint
system for correct operation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle and Pretensioner > Page 7945
Seat Belt Buckle: Service and Repair Safety Belt Buckle - Rear
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE - REAR
1. The 40 percent and or 60 percent rear safety belt buckles are serviced with the 40 percent and
or 60 percent rear seat backrest frames
respectfully. The LH rear safety belt buckle is serviced with the rear center safety belt retractor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Passenger
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Passenger > Page 7950
View 151-18 (Driver Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Driver
C3065
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Driver > Page 7953
C3066
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Height Adjuster > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Seat Belt Height Adjuster: Service and Repair
SAFETY BELT SHOULDER HEIGHT ADJUSTER
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensors [BTS] if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after any collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted.
The automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature of the safety belt retractor must be checked by a
qualified technician to verify that the ALR feature for a child safety seat is functioning correctly, in
addition to other checks for correct safety belt system function. A new belt and retractor assembly
must be installed if the safety belt assembly's ALR feature, or any other safety belt function, is not
operating correctly when inspected according to the functional inspection procedures. Failure to
install a new belt and retractor assembly could increase the risk of serious personal injury in
collisions.
1. Remove the B-pillar trim panel. 2. Set the safety belt shoulder height adjuster to the lowest level.
3. Remove safety belt shoulder height adjuster bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
4. NOTE: The safety belt shoulder height adjuster must be oriented horizontally to allow the T-tab
through the sheet metal mounting hole.
Rotate and remove the height adjuster.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Height Adjuster > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 7957
6. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Seat Belt Reminder Lamp: Description and Operation
Safety Belt Warning Indicator and Chime
The warning indicator and chime are reminders to fasten the safety belt. The system operates as
follows: If the driver safety belt is not buckled before the ignition key is turned to the RUN or START
position, the indicator will illuminate for 1 to 2 minutes and the warning chime sounds for 4 to 8
seconds.
- If the safety belt is buckled while the indicator is on and the chime is sounding, the indicator and
warning chime turn off.
- If the safety belt is buckled before the key is turned to the ON position, neither the indicator nor
the chime will turn on.
Belt-Minder(R)
The Belt-Minder(R) feature is a supplemental warning to the safety belt warning function. This
feature provides an additional reminder that the driver's and/or front passenger's safety belt is
unbuckled by intermittently sounding a chime and illuminating the safety belt warning lamp in the
instrument cluster.
To activate or deactivate the Belt-Minder(R) feature, refer to Seat Belt Systems or the Owner's
Literature.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Seat Belt Retractor: Description and Operation
Dual Locking Mode Retractors
WARNING: After any vehicle collision, the safety belt system at all outboard seating positions
(except driver, which has no automatic locking retractor [ALR] feature) must be checked by a
qualified technician to verify that the ALR feature for child seats is still functioning correctly, in
addition to other checks for correct safety belt system function. A new belt and retractor assembly
must be installed if the safety belt assembly's ALR feature, or any other safety belt function, is not
operating correctly when checked according to the procedures. Failure to install a new belt and
retractor assembly could increase the risk of serious personal injury in collisions.
NOTE: When installing a new dual locking mode retractor, the retractor should be checked to make
sure it is not in the automatic locking retractor (ALR) mode after installation in the stowed position.
All outboard continuous-loop, 3-point retractor systems, except the driver position, are equipped
with the dual locking mode system.
The emergency locking retractor (ELR) mode will allow the occupant freedom of movement, locking
tight only on hard braking, hard cornering, or an impact of approximately 8 km/h (5 mph). The ELR
mode helps to reduce the forward movement of the driver and passengers. The ELR mode is
continuously in operation at all seating positions.
The ALR portion of this system does not allow the occupant freedom of movement. The ALR mode
is used when locking a child seat in an outboard seating position or when a tight belt fit is desired.
The ALR mode is disengaged when the webbing is free to move in or out of the retractor. The ALR
mode is automatically engaged when the webbing is fully extracted from the retractor and then
allowed to retract. As the webbing is retracted back onto the spool, an audible clicking sound is
made, indicating that the retractor is in ALR mode. The ALR mode is automatically disengaged
when most of the webbing is retracted back onto the spool.
The automatic locking mode must be used when installing a child safety seat in the front or rear
passenger seating positions where dual locking mode retractors are provided.
Energy Management Retractor
This vehicle has a safety belt system with an energy management feature at the front seating
positions to help further reduce the risk of injury in the event of a head-on collision.
The energy management retractor feature is designed to pay out webbing in a controlled manner.
This feature is designed to help reduce the belt force acting on an occupant's chest.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Front
Seat Belt Retractor: Service and Repair Safety Belt Retractor - Front
SAFETY BELT RETRACTOR - FRONT
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensors [BTS] if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after any collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Front > Page 7966
The automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature of the safety belt retractor must be checked by a
qualified technician to verify that the ALR feature for a child safety seat is functioning correctly, in
addition to other checks for correct safety belt system function. A new belt and retractor assembly
must be installed if the safety belt assembly's ALR feature, or any other safety belt function, is not
operating correctly when inspected according to the functional inspection procedures. Failure to
install a new belt and retractor assembly could increase the risk of serious personal injury in
collisions.
1. Position the front seat forward. 2. Remove the front door scuff plate.
- Pull up to release the 5 retaining clips.
3. Remove the rear door scuff plate.
- Pull up to release the 2 retaining clips.
4. Detach the 2 clips and remove the lower B-pillar trim panel.
5. NOTE: Inspect the front safety belt retractor D-ring cover for damage. If the front safety belt
retractor D-ring cover does not remain in place,
install a new cover.
Remove the front safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
6. Remove the bolt and the front safety belt retractor D-ring.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
7. Remove the front safety belt retractor anchor nut cover from the seat.
8. NOTE: Note the position of the front safety belt retractor anchor and the anti-rotation pin on the
seat for installation.
Remove the nut and the front safety belt retractor anchor. To install, tighten to 47 Nm (34 lb-ft).
9. NOTE: Note the position of the front safety belt retractor locator T-tab in the B-pillar sheet metal
for installation.
Remove the bolt and the front safety belt retractor. To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
10. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 11. Check the active restraint system for correct
operation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Front > Page 7967
Seat Belt Retractor: Service and Repair Safety Belt Retractor - Rear, Center
SAFETY BELT RETRACTOR - REAR, CENTER
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensors [BTS] if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after any collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted.
The automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature of the safety belt retractor must be checked by a
qualified technician to verify that the ALR feature for a child safety seat is functioning correctly, in
addition to other checks for correct safety belt system function. A new belt and retractor assembly
must be installed if the safety belt assembly's ALR feature, or any other safety belt function, is not
operating correctly when inspected according to the functional inspection procedures. Failure to
install a new belt and retractor assembly could increase the risk of serious personal injury in
collisions.
1. Remove the rear 60 percent seat backrest trim cover. 2. Remove the rear seat backrest foam
pad. 3. Remove the rear center safety belt retractor nut.
- To install, tighten to 50 Nm (37 lb-ft).
4. Detach the pin-type retainer on the rear center safety belt retractor sleeve from the seat backrest
frame. 5. Route the safety belt retractor anchor and belt buckle out of the rear seat backrest frame
and remove the rear center safety belt retractor. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 7.
Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Front > Page 7968
Seat Belt Retractor: Service and Repair Safety Belt Retractor - Rear
SAFETY BELT RETRACTOR - REAR
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensors [BTS] if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after any collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted.
The automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature of the safety belt retractor must be checked by a
qualified technician to verify that the ALR feature for a child safety seat is functioning correctly, in
addition to other checks for correct safety belt system function. A new belt and retractor assembly
must be installed if the safety belt assembly's ALR feature, or any other safety belt function, is not
operating correctly when inspected according to the functional inspection procedures. Failure to
install a new belt and retractor assembly could increase the risk of serious personal injury in
collisions.
NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
1. Release and slide the rear safety belt retractor anchor bolt cover up the belt, then remove the
rear safety belt retractor anchor bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Front > Page 7969
2. Position aside the quarter trim panel.
- Pull out on the quarter trim panel at the C-pillar to release the retaining clip to access the safety
belt retractor.
3. NOTE: Inspect the rear safety belt retractor D-ring cover for damage. If the rear safety belt
retractor D-ring cover does not remain in place, install
a new cover.
Remove the rear safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
4. Remove the bolt and rear safety belt retractor D-ring.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
5. Remove the bolt and rear safety belt retractor.
- Lift up to release the locator T-tab from the C-pillar sheet metal.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 7. Check the active restraint system for correct
operation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Diagrams > Safety Belt Buckle Pretensioner, Driver
C3201
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Diagrams > Safety Belt Buckle Pretensioner, Driver > Page 7974
C3202
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 7975
Seat Belt Tensioner: Description and Operation
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE PRETENSIONER
The safety belt buckle and pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device that removes excess webbing from
the safety belt when deployed. The pretensioner works in conjunction with the front air bag system.
When the front air bags deploy, the pretensioners deploy, causing the buckle to move downward,
removing excess webbing from the lap and shoulder safety belts.
If the vehicle is involved in a collision that results in deployment of the front air bags and safety belt
pretensioners, a new driver and passenger seat belt system (including safety belt buckle and
pretensioners, safety belt retractors, and height adjusters), must be installed.
For safety belt buckle pretensioner diagnostic information, refer to Air Bag Systems.
For safety belt buckle pretensioner disposal information, refer to Air Bag Systems.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 7976
Seat Belt Tensioner: Service and Repair
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE AND PRETENSIONER
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensors [BTS] if equipped, buckles,
shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and attaching
hardware) should be inspected after any collision. All new belt assemblies should be installed
unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly. Belt
assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed if
either damage or incorrect operation is noted.
The automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature of the safety belt retractor must be checked by a
qualified technician to verify that the ALR feature for a child safety seat is functioning correctly, in
addition to other checks for correct safety belt system function. A new belt and retractor assembly
must be installed if the safety belt assembly's ALR feature, or any other safety belt function, is not
operating correctly when inspected according to the functional inspection procedures. Failure to
install a new belt and retractor assembly could increase the risk of serious personal injury in
collisions.
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 7977
handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt retractor pretensioner. Never probe a
pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in pretensioner or air bag deployment and
could result in serious personal injury.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
All seats
1. Depower the SRS. 2. Position the seat all the way up and back.
3. NOTE: Note the position of the safety belt buckle pretensioner anti-rotation locator tab for
installation.
From the rear of the seat, remove the safety belt buckle pretensioner nut. Vehicles with a manual driver seat, remove the safety belt buckle pretensioner bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
4. Position the safety belt buckle pretensioner towards the front of the vehicle to access the
electrical connectors.
Seats with power
5. Remove the safety belt buckle pretensioner cover.
All seats
6. Remove the safety belt buckle pretensioner.
1. Disconnect the safety belt buckle pretensioner buckle switch electrical connector. 2. Disconnect
the safety belt buckle pretensioner electrical connector. 3. Cut the tie strap and remove the safety
belt buckle pretensioner.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedures. 8. Repower the SRS. 9. Check the active restraint
system for correct operation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch > Component Information >
Locations
View 151-18 (Driver Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7981
C356
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7986
C2355
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Front Impact Sensor
Impact Sensor: Locations Front Impact Sensor
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Front Impact Sensor > Page 7991
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Front Impact Sensor > Page 7992
Impact Sensor: Locations Side Impact Sensor
View 151-12 (Left Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Front Impact Sensor > Page 7993
View 151-13 (Right Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Front Impact Sensor > Page 7994
View 151-15 (Right Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Front Impact Sensor > Page 7995
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Front Impact Sensor
Impact Sensor: Diagrams Front Impact Sensor
C1465
C1466
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Front Impact Sensor > Page 7998
Impact Sensor: Diagrams Side Impact Sensor
C3209
C3211
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Front Impact Sensor > Page 7999
C3248
C3249
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Front Impact Severity Sensor
FRONT IMPACT SEVERITY SENSOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting
bracket and wiring pigtail for deformation. Install and correctly position the sensor or any other
damaged SRS components whether or not the air bag is deployed. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in serious personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
1. Depower the system. 2. Remove the front bumper cover. 3. Disconnect the front impact severity
sensor electrical connector.
4. WARNING: The tightening torque of the front impact severity sensor retaining nuts is critical for
correct system operation. Failure to
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8002
follow tightening instructions may result in serious personal injury.
NOTE: Make sure the hood latch bracket and front impact severity sensor mating surfaces are clean and
free of foreign material.
- Note position of the 2 locator tabs on sensor for installation.
Remove the bolt and the front impact severity sensor. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 6. Repower the system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8003
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Side Impact Sensor - B-Pillar
SIDE IMPACT SENSOR - B-PILLAR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting
bracket and wiring pigtail for deformation. Install and correctly position the sensor or any other
damaged supplemental restraint system (SRS) components whether or not the air bag is deployed.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
1. Position the front seat forward.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8004
2. Depower the system. 3. Remove the front door scuff plate.
- Pull up to release the 5 retaining clips.
4. Remove the rear door scuff plate.
- Pull up to release the 2 retaining clips.
5. Detach the 2 retainers and remove the lower B-Pillar trim panel. 6. Disconnect the side impact
sensor electrical connector.
7. WARNING: The tightening torque of the air bag side impact sensor retaining bolt is critical for
correct system operation. Failure to
follow tightening instruction may result in serious personal injury.
NOTE: Make sure the B-pillar and side impact sensor mating surfaces are clean and free of foreign
material.
- Note the position of the side impact sensor locating tabs for installation.
Remove the bolt and the side impact sensor. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 9. Repower the system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8005
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Side Impact Sensor - C-Pillar
SIDE IMPACT SENSOR - C-PILLAR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting
bracket and wiring pigtail for deformation. Install and correctly position the sensor or any other
damaged supplemental restraint system (SRS) components whether or not the air bag is deployed.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a SRS fault.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
1. Fold down the rear seat backrest. 2. Depower the system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8006
3. Position aside the quarter trim panel.
- Pull out on the quarter trim panel at the C-pillar to release the retaining clip to access the C-pillar
side impact sensor.
4. Disconnect the side impact sensor electrical connector.
5. WARNING: The tightening torque of the air bag side impact sensor retaining bolt is critical for
correct system operation. Failure to
follow tightening instructions may result in serious personal injury.
NOTE: Note the position of the 2 side impact sensor locating tabs for installation.
- Make sure the C-pillar and side impact sensor mating surfaces are clean and free of foreign
material.
Remove the bolt and the side impact sensor. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 7. Repower the system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Passenger
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Passenger > Page 8011
View 151-18 (Driver Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Driver
C3065
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Driver > Page 8014
C3066
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS)1
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS)1 > Page 8019
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS)1 > Page 8020
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS)1 > Page 8021
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) 1
C3324
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) 1 > Page 8024
C3325
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) 1 > Page 8025
C3330
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) 1 > Page 8026
C3331
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8027
Seat Occupant Sensor: Description and Operation
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SENSOR (OCS) SYSTEM
The occupant classification sensor (OCS) system is standard equipment on all front passenger
seats. For diagnosing or servicing the OCS system, refer to Air Bag Systems.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track
Seat Occupant Sensor: Service and Repair Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SENSOR - MANUAL SEAT TRACK
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
CAUTION: Use care when handling the seat and track assembly. Dropping the assembly or sitting
on a seat not secured in the vehicle may result in damaged components.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
All occupant classification sensor (OCS) weight sensor bolt(s) 1. Position the seat to access all the
seat track-to-floor bolts and the safety belt anchor. 2. Depower the Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS). 3. Remove the front passenger seat. 4. Remove the manual seat track.
5. NOTE: After marking the seat track rails, do not change the position of the seat track.
Mark the position of both seat track rails.
Inboard OCS weight sensor bolt(s)
6. Remove the nut and the safety belt buckle pretensioner.
All OCS weight sensor bolt(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 8030
7. NOTE: Outboard front cross brace screws shown, inboard similar.
On the side with the affected OCS I-bolt(s), remove the 2 front cross brace screws.
8. On the side with the affected OCS weight sensor bolt(s), disengage the seat adjuster handle
spring and position it aside.
9. Separate the seat adjuster handle from the affected side of the seat track rail with the OCS
weight sensor bolt(s).
10. NOTE: Outboard rear cross brace screws shown, inboard similar.
On the side with the affected OCS weight sensor bolt(s), remove the 2 rear cross brace screws.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 8031
11. Remove and discard the 2 OCS weight sensor bolt nuts from the affected side of the seat track
rail with the OCS weight sensor bolt(s).
12. Remove the side plate with the OCS weight sensor bolt(s) from the seat track rail.
13. CAUTION: Do not overtighten the side plate with the occupant classification sensor (OCS)
weight sensor bolts to the bench or table.
Tighten only enough to compress the spring washer. Overtightening may damage the side plate or
OCS weight sensor bolts.
Using a suitable tool, clamp the side plate to a bench or table to compress the spring washer on
the affected OCS weight sensor bolt as shown.
14. NOTE: Note the position of the OCS weight sensor bolt, spring washer and retaining clip for
installation.
Remove and discard the retaining clip from the affected OCS weight sensor bolt.
15. Release the clamp and remove the OCS weight sensor bolt and spring washer from the side
plate. sensor bolt and spring washer from the side
plate.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 8032
Installation
All OCS weight sensor bolt(s)
1. CAUTION: Do not overtighten the side plate with the occupant classification sensor (OCS)
weight sensor bolts to the bench or table.
Tighten only enough to compress the spring washer. Overtightening may damage the side plate or
OCS weight sensor bolts.
Position the spring washer and OCS weight sensor bolt in the side plate. Then clamp the side plate
to a bench or table to compress the OCS weight sensor bolt spring washer.
2. NOTE: Make sure the occupant classification sensor (OCS) weight sensor bolt retaining clip is
seated fully in the OCS weight sensor bolt groove
underneath the OCS weight sensor O-ring seal.
Install the 2 new OCS weight sensor bolt retaining clips in the OCS weight sensor groove
underneath the O-ring seal.
3. Unclamp the side plate with the installed OCS weight sensor bolt from the bench or table.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 8033
4. NOTE: Slight rotational adjustment of the OCS weight sensors bolts may be necessary to install
the OCS weight sensor bolts and side plate to the
seat track rail.
Install the side plate and OCS weight sensor bolts to the seat track rail.
5. NOTE: When installing the side plate to the seat track rail, 2 new OCS weight sensor nuts must
be installed.
Install the 2 new OCS weight sensor bolt nuts to the seat track rail. Tighten to 33 Nm (24 lb-ft).
6. Install the seat adjuster handle to the seat track rail.
7. Engage the seat adjuster handle spring.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 8034
8. Install the 2 rear cross brace screws.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
9. Install the 2 front cross brace screws.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
Inboard OCS weight sensor bolt(s)
10. Install the nut and the safety belt buckle pretensioner.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
All OCS weight sensor bolt(s) 11. Install the manual seat track. 12. Install the passenger seat and
repower the supplemental restraints system (SRS). Do not prove out the SRS at this time. 13.
Carry out the appropriate procedure after installation of an OCS system component.
- If installing the original OCS system component, carry out the Zero Seat Weight Test and prove
out the SRS. See: Air Bag Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics
- If installing a new OCS system component, carry out the System Reset procedure and prove out
the SRS. See: Air Bag Systems/Service and Repair/Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System
Reset
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 8035
Seat Occupant Sensor: Service and Repair Occupant Classification Sensor - Power Seat Track
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SENSOR - POWER SEAT TRACK
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 8036
Part 2
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
CAUTION: Use care when handling the seat and track assembly. Dropping the assembly or sitting
on a seat not secured in the vehicle may result in damaged components.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- If any occupant classification sensor (OCS) weight sensor bolt nuts are removed, new OCS
weight sensor bolt nuts must be installed.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
All occupant classification sensor (OCS) weight sensor bolt(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 8037
1. Position the seat to access all the seat track-to-floor bolts and the safety belt anchor. 2. Depower
the supplemental restraint system (SRS). 3. Remove the passenger front seat. 4. Remove the
power seat track.
5. NOTE:
- Inboard seat track rail shown, outboard similar.
- After marking the seat track rails, do not change the position of the seat track.
Mark the position of both seat track rails.
Inboard OCS weight sensor bolt(s) 6. Remove the nut and the safety belt buckle pretensioner.
Outboard OCS weight sensor bolt(s) 7. Remove the front retainer and the outboard seat track riser
cover shield. 8. Remove the 2 retainers and the OCS weight sensor bolt protection bracket.
All OCS weight sensor bolt(s) 9. On the side with the affected OCS weight sensor bolt(s), remove
the nut from the seat track front cross brace.
10. Remove and discard the 2 OCS weight sensor bolt nuts from the affected side of the seat track
rail with the OCS weight sensor(s).
11. NOTE: Outboard side shown, inboard similar.
Separate the front seat track motor cable from the affected seat track rail. Then remove the side
plate with the OCS weight sensor bolts from the seat track rail.
12. CAUTION: Do not overtighten the side plate with the OCS weight sensor bolts to the bench or
table. Tighten only enough to compress
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 8038
the spring washer. Overtightening may damage the side plate or OCS weight sensor bolts.
Using a suitable tool, clamp the side plate to a bench or table to compress the spring washer on
the affected OCS weight sensor bolt as shown.
13. NOTE: Note the position of the OCS weight sensor bolt, spring washer and retaining clip for
installation.
Remove and discard the retaining clip from the affected OCS weight sensor bolt.
14. Release the clamp and remove the OCS weight sensor bolt and spring washer from the side
plate.
Installation
All OCS weight sensor bolt(s)
1. CAUTION: Do not overtighten the side plate with the occupant classification sensor (OCS)
weight sensor bolts to the bench or table.
Tighten only enough to compress the spring washer. Overtightening may damage the side plate or
OCS weight sensor bolts.
Position the spring washer and OCS weight sensor bolt in the side plate. Then clamp the side plate
to a bench or table to compress the OCS weight sensor bolt spring washer.
2. NOTE: Make sure the OCS weight sensor bolt retaining clip is seated fully in the OCS weight
sensor bolt groove underneath the OCS weight
sensor O-ring seal.
Install the OCS weight sensor bolt retaining clip.
3. Remove the clamp and the side plate from the bench or table.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Occupant Classification Sensor - Manual Seat Track > Page 8039
4. NOTE: Slight rotational adjustment of the front seat track motor cable and OCS weight sensor
bolts may be necessary to install the OCS weight
sensor bolts and side plate to the seat track rail.
Install the front seat track motor cable to the seat track rail. Then install the side plate with the OCS
weight sensor bolts to the seat track rail.
5. NOTE: When installing the side plate to the seat track rail, 2 new OCS weight sensor nuts must
be installed.
Install the 2 new OCS weight sensor bolt nuts to the seat track rail. Tighten to 33 Nm (24 lb-ft).
6. NOTE: Outboard side shown, inboard similar.
Install the nut to the seat track front cross brace. Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
Outboard OCS weight sensor bolt(s) 7. Install the 2 retainers and the OCS weight sensor bolt
protection bracket. 8. Install the front retainer and the outboard seat track riser cover shield.
Inboard OCS weight sensor bolt(s) 9. Install the nut and the safety belt buckle pretensioner.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
All OCS weight sensor bolt(s) 10. Install the power seat track. 11. Install the passenger seat and
repower the supplemental restraints system (SRS). Do not prove out the SRS at this time. 12.
Carry out the appropriate procedure after installation of an OCS system component.
- If installing the original OCS system component, carry out the Zero Seat Weight Test and prove
out the SRS. See: Air Bag Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics
- If installing a new OCS system component, carry out the System Reset procedure and prove out
the SRS. See: Air Bag Systems/Service and Repair/Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System
Reset
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Seat Position Sensor: Service and Repair
SEAT POSITION SENSOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
All seats
1. Raise the driver seat and then position it to the middle of the track. 2. Depower the system. 3.
Remove the driver seat. 4. Disconnect the seat position sensor electrical connector.
Power seats
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8043
5. Detach the wire harness routing pin-type retainer from the seat position sensor bracket.
All seats
6. Push apart then inward to release the seat position sensor locking clip. 7. Slide the seat position
sensor rearward to release the 2 hooks from the bracket. Then remove the seat position sensor. 8.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. 9. Repower the system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-18 (Driver Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8047
C356
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8053
Accessory Delay Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8054
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna Control Module > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-8 (behind Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna Control Module > Component
Information > Locations > Page 8059
C2086
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Global Positioning System Antenna >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Global Positioning System Antenna: Service and Repair
GLOBAL POSITIONING SYSTEM (GPS) ANTENNA
Removal and Installation
MKX
1. Remove the instrument cluster.
All vehicles
2. Remove the audio unit.
3. NOTE: For vehicles without THX(R) audio, the vehicle will have an upper storage bin, rather
than an instrument panel speaker.
Remove the instrument panel speaker.
4. Release the clip and remove the GPS antenna. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Antenna Cable >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Antenna Cable - AM/FM
Antenna Cable: Service and Repair Antenna Cable - AM/FM
ANTENNA CABLE - AM/FM
Antenna Cable-to-antenna
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Antenna Cable >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Antenna Cable - AM/FM > Page 8068
Upper Antenna Cable-to-Lower Antenna Cable
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Not all steps need to be carried out if only the upper or lower antenna cable is being
removed.
1. Remove the audio unit. 2. Lower the glove compartment completely. 3. Remove the RH cowl
side trim panel. 4. Remove the RH A-pillar trim panel. 5. Remove the dome lamp. 6. Loosen the
AM/FM antenna base bolt and disconnect the antenna cable from the antenna.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
7. Remove the RH sun visor.
8. NOTE: Lower the headliner, as necessary.
Remove the AM/FM antenna cable bolt and the antenna cable. Disconnect the upper antenna cable from the lower antenna cable.
- To install, tighten the bolt to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Antenna Cable >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Antenna Cable - AM/FM > Page 8069
Antenna Cable: Service and Repair Antenna Cable - Satellite Radio
ANTENNA CABLE - SATELLITE RADIO
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the LH quarter trim panel. 2. Remove the D-pillar trim panel. 3. Remove the liftgate
scuff plate trim panel. 4. Disconnect the satellite radio antenna cable from the satellite radio
receiver. 5. Disconnect the satellite radio antenna cable from the satellite radio antenna, and
remove the cable. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm System Transmitter
> Component Information > Service and Repair
Alarm System Transmitter: Service and Repair
PASSIVE ANTI-THEFT SYSTEM (PATS) TRANSCEIVER
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the 3 screws and the lower steering column shroud. 2. Position the upper steering
column shroud aside. 3. Disconnect the electrical connector and remove the PATS transceiver.
4. NOTE: Replacement of the PATS transceiver does not require the PATS keys to be
programmed into the instrument cluster again.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm System
Transponder > Component Information > Diagrams
C252
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Hood Sensor/Switch (For
Alarm) > Component Information > Diagrams
C127
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Key-Pad > Component Information > Diagrams
C500
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Key-Pad > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8084
Keyless Entry Key-Pad: Testing and Inspection
KEYLESS ENTRY KEYPAD CODE PROGRAMMING
Programming a Personal Code and Keypad Association to Memory Seats and Mirrors (If Equipped)
NOTE:
- If the wrong code has been entered 7 times (35 consecutive button presses), the keypad will go
into an anti-scan mode. This mode disables the keypad for one minute and the keypad lamp will
flash. The anti-scan feature will turn off after one minute of keypad inactivity, after pressing the
UNLOCK control on the integrated keyhead transmitter (IKT), or after the ignition key has been
turned to the ON position.
- The factory set code cannot be associated with a memory setting.
1. Enter the permanent factory keyless entry keypad code. 2. Within 5 seconds, press the 1/2
button on the keypad. 3. Enter the new 5-digit keyless entry keypad code. Each number must be
entered within five seconds of each other.
4. To associate the entry code with a memory setting, enter a sixth digit to indicate which driver
should be set in a memory recalled by the personal
entry code: Pressing the 1/2 button recalls driver 1 settings
- Pressing the 3/4 button recalls driver 2 settings
- Pressing other keypad buttons or not pressing a keypad button as a sixth digit does not set a
driver and will not recall a memory setting
5. The doors will lock then unlock to confirm the new code is programmed.
Erasing the Personal Codes
NOTE: If the wrong code has been entered 7 times (35 consecutive button presses), the keypad
will go into an anti-scan mode. This mode disables the keypad for one minute and the keypad lamp
will flash. The anti-scan feature will turn off after one minute of keypad inactivity, after pressing the
UNLOCK control on the IKT, or after the ignition key has been turned to the ON position.
1. Enter the permanent factory keyless entry keypad code. 2. Within 5 seconds, press the 1/2
button on the keypad and release. 3. Within 5 seconds, press and hold the 1/2 button on the
keypad for 2 seconds. 4. All personal codes are now erased and only the permanent factory
keyless entry keypad code will work.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Key-Pad > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8085
Keyless Entry Key-Pad: Service and Repair
KEYLESS ENTRY KEYPAD
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the upper access plug. 2. Using a long, flat blade screwdriver, or suitable tool through
the upper access hole, release the rear keyless entry keypad retaining clip and position
the keyless entry keypad aside.
3. Remove the keyless entry keypad.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Testing and Inspection
AUTOLOCK AND HORN CHIRP PROGRAMMING
Programming the Autolock Feature Using the Door Lock Control Switch
NOTE:
- The autolock feature can be activated or deactivated independently of the auto-unlock feature.
- The autolock feature of the smart junction box (SJB) can also be configured ON or OFF with the
scan tool.
- When programming the autolock feature using the door lock control switch method the following
steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure will need to be repeated. If the
procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. NOTE: Prior to beginning, make sure the ignition key is in the OFF position and all vehicle doors
are closed.
Turn the ignition key from the OFF to the ON position.
2. Press the unlock button on the door lock control 3 times. 3. Turn the ignition key from the ON to
the OFF position. 4. Press the unlock button on the door lock control switch 3 times. 5. Turn the
ignition key to the ON position. The horn chirps once to indicate that programming mode is entered.
6. To enable/disable the autolock feature, press the unlock button on the door lock control switch
then the lock button. The horn chirps once if the
autolocks are disabled or twice (one short chirp followed by a long chirp) if the autolocks are
enabled.
7. Turn the ignition key to the OFF position. The horn chirps once to signal that the programming is
complete.
Programming the Autolock Feature Using the Keyless Entry Keypad
NOTE:
- The autolock feature can be activated or deactivated independently of the auto-unlock feature.
- The autolock feature of the SJB can also be configured ON or OFF with the scan tool.
1. Turn the ignition key to the OFF position and close all vehicle doors. 2. Enter the permanent
factory keyless entry keypad code. 3. Press and hold the 3/4 button on the keypad. While holding
the 3/4 button, press the 7/8 button. 4. Release the 7/8 button, then release the 3/4 button. The
horn chirps once if the autolocks are disabled or twice (one short chirp followed by a honk)
if the autolocks are enabled.
Programming the Autolock Feature Using the Instrument Cluster Message Center
NOTE:
- The autolock feature can be activated or deactivated independently of the auto-unlock feature.
- The autolock feature of the SJB can also be configured ON or OFF with the scan tool.
1. Turn the ignition key from the OFF to the ON position. 2. Press the SETUP button on the
message center switch until AUTOLOCK OFF is displayed. 3. Press the RESET button to select
ON or OFF. If the autolocks are enabled, the message center will have brackets around the display.
If the
autolocks are disabled, the message center will have brackets around the display.
Programming the Auto-Unlock Feature Using the Door Lock Control Switch
NOTE:
- The auto-unlock feature can be activated or deactivated independently of the autolock feature.
- The auto-unlock feature of the SJB can also be configured ON or OFF with the scan tool.
- When programming the auto-unlock feature using the door lock control switch method the
following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure will need to be repeated. If
the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. NOTE: Prior to beginning, make sure the ignition key is in the OFF position and all vehicle doors
are closed.
Turn the ignition key from the OFF to the ON position.
2. Press the unlock button on the door lock control 3 times. 3. Turn the ignition key from the ON to
the OFF position. 4. Press the unlock button on the door lock control switch 3 times. 5. Turn the
ignition key to the ON position. The horn chirps once to indicate that programming mode is entered.
6. To enable/disable the auto-unlock feature, press the lock button on the door lock control switch
then the unlock button. The horn chirps once if
auto-unlock is disabled or twice (one short chirp followed by a long chirp) if auto-unlock is enabled.
7. Turn the ignition key to the OFF position. The horn chirps once to signal that the programming is
complete.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8089
Programming the Auto-Unlock Feature Using the Keyless Entry Keypad
NOTE:
- The auto-unlock feature can be activated or deactivated independently of the autolock feature.
- The auto-unlock feature of the SJB can also be configured ON or OFF with the scan tool.
1. Turn the ignition key to the OFF position and close all vehicle doors. 2. Enter the permanent
factory keyless entry keypad code. 3. Press and hold the 3/4 button on the keypad. While holding
the 3/4 button, press and release the 7/8 button. While still holding the 3/4 button,
press and release the 7/8 button a second time.
4. Release the 3/4 button. The horn chirps once if auto-unlock is disabled or twice (one short chirp
followed by a honk) if auto-unlock is enabled.
Programming the Auto-Unlock Feature Using the Instrument Cluster Message Center
NOTE:
- The auto-unlock feature can be activated or deactivated independently of the autolock feature.
- The auto-unlock feature of the SJB can also be configured ON or OFF with the scan tool.
1. Turn the ignition key from the OFF to the ON position. 2. Press the SETUP button on the
message center switch until AUTOUNLOCK OFF is displayed. 3. Press the RESET button to select
ON or OFF. If auto-unlock is enabled, the message center will have brackets around the display. If
auto-unlock is disabled, the message center will have brackets around the display.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Remote Memory Activation
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Service and Repair Remote Memory Activation
REMOTE MEMORY ACTIVATION
1. Position the driver seat and mirrors to the desired position. 2. Press the set button on the driver
door panel. 3. Within 5 seconds press the 1 or 2 button on the driver door panel to associate with
the driver 1 or driver 2 position. 4. Press the set button again. 5. Within 5 seconds press a button
on the associated integrated keyhead transmitter (IKT). 6. Within 5 seconds press the 1 or 2 button
on the driver door panel to associate with the driver 1 or driver 2 position. 7. If a second memory
setting is desired, repeat the procedure with the second IKT.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Remote Memory Activation > Page 8092
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Service and Repair Remote Memory Deactivation
REMOTE MEMORY DEACTIVATION
1. Press the set button on the driver door panel. 2. Within 5 seconds press any button on the
integrated key that you wish to deactivate and then press the set button on the driver door panel. 3.
If a second memory setting is desired to be deactivated, repeat the procedure with the second
integrated key.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8097
C4014
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8098
Parking Assist Control Module: Service and Repair
PARKING AID MODULE
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to electrical charges. If exposed to these charges,
damage may result.
1. Remove the LH rear quarter trim panel. 2. Remove the 2 nuts and the parking aid module.
- Disconnect the parking aid module electrical connectors.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-16 (Rear End - Edge)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor, Outer Left
C4009
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor, Outer Left > Page 8104
C4011
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor, Outer Left > Page 8105
C4010
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor, Outer Left > Page 8106
C4012
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8107
Parking Assist Distance Sensor: Service and Repair
PARKING AID SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear bumper cover. 2. Disconnect the parking aid sensor(s) electrical connector(s).
3. Press the retaining tabs and remove the parking aid sensor(s). 4. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Warning Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams
C3268
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Locations > Page 8114
C253
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Locations > Page 8115
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Description and Operation
INFORMATION AND MESSAGE CENTER
The message center is a fixed format vacuum fluorescent display, integrated into the instrument
cluster. The message center functions are controlled by the message center switches. The
message center displays important vehicle information by constantly monitoring different vehicle
systems. The message center informs the driver of vehicle operations and notifies the driver of
potential vehicle problems by displaying a warning message pertaining to the system in which a
fault has been detected.
The message center provides the following features:
- Information displays
- Setup displays
- System check messages
- System warning messages
The message center information can be selected through a set of 3 buttons:
- INFO
- SETUP
- RESET
Message Center Configuration
The message center has the capability to configure items such as units (English or metric),
autolamp delay, to enable/disable a variety of options such as autolock, auto-unlock and easy
entry/easy exit (if equipped), or to carry out calibrations/settings on items such as the compass.
On configurable items such as autolock, auto-unlock or easy entry/easy exit the message center
indicates the appropriate selection (ON/OFF) by bracketing the selection. For example, if the driver
selects the autolock feature on, the message would display as follows: AUTOLOCK OFF. If the
driver selects the autolock off, the message would display as follows: AUTOLOCK AID ON .
Compass Display
The message center provides a compass display and uses directional information sent from a
compass module, located on the underside of the inside rear view mirror.
Information Displays
The information displays are non-timed modes. The selected mode remains on until the driver
presses a message center button to change the mode or it is overridden by another mode.
The information (INFO button) display modes are: Odometer
- Compass
- Trip odometer A or B
- Distance to empty (DTE)
- Average fuel economy
- Average speed
- Trip elapsed drive time 1 or 2
Setup Displays
The setup (SETUP button) displays are timed modes and terminate after a finite interval. The setup
display modes are: System check
- Units English/metric
- Autolamp delay in seconds (if equipped)
- Autolock on/off (if equipped)
- Auto-unlock on/off (if equipped)
- Power liftgate on/off (if equipped)
- Easy entry/easy exit seat on/off (if equipped)
- Reverse parking aid on/off (if equipped)
- Language
System Check
The system check provides a check of all the monitored systems on the vehicle. The system check
scrolls through each of the monitored systems and provides a visual indication to report out the
status of each system. The message center displays OK for approximately 2 seconds if the system
check does not detect a fault in the system and displays a warning message for approximately 2
seconds if the system check detects a fault in the system. Press the RESET button to scroll
through the system check messages.
The systems monitored during the system check are: Door ajar
- Engine temperature
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Locations > Page 8116
- TPMS
- Oil pressure
- Brake fluid level
- Washer fluid level
- Fuel level
- Distance to empty (DTE)
System Warning Messages
The system warning messages alert the operator to possible problems or malfunctions in the
vehicle operating systems. The message center displays the last selected feature if there are no
additional warning messages. Once a warning message has been displayed, the message must be
acknowledged to allow full functionality of the message center. Press the RESET to acknowledge
and clear the warning message. The warning messages are divided into 3 basic categories: Cannot be cleared until the condition is corrected.
- Reappears 10 minutes from pressing the RESET button.
- Reappears if the condition clears then reoccurs within the same ignition cycle ON-OFF cycle.
The warning messages that cannot be reset are: DRIVER DOOR AJAR
- PASSENGER DOOR AJAR
- REAR LEFT DOOR AJAR
- REAR RIGHT DOOR AJAR
- PARK BRAKE ENGAGED
- PLEASE CLOSE DOOR
- PRESS RESET TO CLEAR
The warning messages that reoccur after 10 minutes are: LOW FUEL LEVEL
- CHECK BRAKE SYSTEM
- LOW BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
The warning messages that display whenever the ignition switch is turned from the OFF position to
the ON position are: WASHER FLUID LEVEL LOW
- LIFTGATE AJAR
- LOW TIRE PRESSURE
- CHECK RPA (if equipped)
- CHECK COMPASS MODE (if equipped)
- COMPASS NO RESPONSE (if equipped)
- COMPASS DATA ERROR
- TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR FAULT
- TIRE PRESSURE SENSOR FAULT
- POWER LIFTGATE OFF
- PARK ASSIST OFF
Service Procedure Displays
The message center displays warning messages that indicate a system state during repair
procedures related to the tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS). The displayed warning
messages are as follows: TRAIN MODE: TRAIN xx TIRE
- TIRE TRAINING MODE COMPETE
- TIRE NOT TRAINED - REPAIR
The message center displays warning messages that indicate a system state during repair
procedures related to the compass display. The displayed warning messages are as follows: RESET FOR ZONE
- SETUP ZONE XX
- RESET FOR CAL
- CIRCLE SLOWLY TO CALIBRATE
- CALIBRATION COMPLETE
The message center displays the IKT KEY COULD NOT PROGRAM warning message to indicate
a problem programming the integrated key transmitter (IKT).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Inspection and Verification
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
1. Verify the customer concern.
Visual Inspection Chart
2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of mechanical or electrical damage. 3. If an obvious cause for
an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible) before proceeding to the
next step.
4. NOTE: Make sure to use the latest scan tool software release.
If the cause is not visually evident, connect the scan tool to the data link connector (DLC).
5. NOTE: The vehicle communication module (VCM) LED prove-out confirms power and ground
from the DLC are provided to the VCM.
If the scan tool does not communicate with the VCM: Check the VCM connection to the vehicle.
- Check the scan tool connection to the VCM.
- Refer to Information Bus (Module Communications Network), No Power To The Scan Tool, to
diagnose no communication with the scan tool.
6. If the scan tool does not communicate with the vehicle:
- Verify the ignition key is in the ON position.
- Verify the scan tool operation with a known good vehicle.
- Refer to Information Bus (Module Communications Network) to diagnose no response from the
PCM.
7. Carry out the network test:
- If the scan tool responds with no communication for one or more modules, refer to Information
Bus (Module Communications Network).
- If the network test passes, retrieve and record the continuous memory DTCs for the instrument
cluster.
8. Clear the continuous DTCs and carry out the self-test diagnostics for the instrument cluster. 9. If
the DTCs retrieved are related to the concern, go to the Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Charts.
For all other module DTCs, refer to Body
Control Systems (Multifunction Electronic Control Module). See: Diagnostic Trouble Code
Descriptions
10. If no DTCs related to the concern are retrieved, GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Principles of Operation
PRINCIPLES OF OPERATION
The message center is an integral part of the instrument cluster that receives and acts upon much
of the same information that is input and used to operate the instrument cluster gauges, indicators,
and warning indicators. The message center, located in the center of the instrument cluster is a
vacuum fluorescent 2-line display. The message center electronic functions use both hardwired,
and the controller area network (CAN) circuitry to transmit and receive information.
Whenever conditions are present that require a warning message, the message center replaces
the last selected display with the new warning display. Once the message is reset or cleared, the
message center returns to the last selected display. If multiple warnings are present, the message
center displays each warning for approximately 4 seconds. Warning messages are also generally
associated with other observable instrument cluster indications. For example, when the LH front
door is opened, the message center displays the message DRIVER DOOR AJAR along with the
door ajar warning indicator. This allows the message center to be a more informative supplement
to the instrument cluster gauges and indicators.
It is very important to understand:
- where the input (command) originates.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8119
- all the information (messages) necessary in order for a feature to operate.
- which module(s) receive(s) the input or command message.
- if the module that received the input (message) controls the output of the feature, or if it outputs a
message over the CAN to another module.
- which module controls the output of the feature.
Instrument Cluster Messages
NOTE: Whenever a message is suspected as missing, confirmed by a missing message DTC, it is
important to look for other symptoms that may also be present in the instrument cluster and
throughout the vehicle. Once a DTC is set in the instrument cluster it may be helpful to review the
complete message list available in Information Bus (Module Communications Network) to see what
other modules also rely on the same message and run the self-test for those modules. If the
message is missing from other modules, the same DTC may also be set in those modules.
Confirmation of missing messages common to multiple modules may indicate that the originating
module is the source of the concern or the communication network may be experiencing some
problems.
The instrument cluster uses input messages from other modules to control the gauges,
informational indicators, warning indicators and message center displays over the communication
networks. If a required message is missing or invalid for less than 5 seconds, the gauge or
indicator that requires the message remains at the last commanded state based upon the last
known good message. For example, if the message is missing the O/D off status for less than 5
seconds and the O/D off indicator was ON (O/D cancelled), the indicator remains in the ON state
until the next good message is received. If the message remains missing or invalid for greater than
5 seconds, the instrument cluster sets a U-code DTC and the output becomes a default action for
the indicator or gauge. Each indicator or gauge utilizes a different default strategy depending on
the nature of the indication. Refer Instrument Cluster for further descriptions of the default action
specific to each indicator or gauge. If the messaged input to the cluster returns at any time, the
normal function of the gauge or indicator resumes.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8120
B1209 / U2013
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8121
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Symptom Chart (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8122
Symptom Chart (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8123
Symptom Chart (Part 3)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8124
Symptom Chart (Part 4)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8125
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Pinpoint Tests
Test A: The Message Center Is Not Operating Correctly
PINPOINT TEST A: THE MESSAGE CENTER IS NOT OPERATING CORRECTLY
A1-A2
Normal Operation
The message center is located in the center of the instrument cluster between the tachometer and
the speedometer in the vacuum fluorescent display area. The message center is integral to the
instrument cluster and uses the same voltage supply as the instrument cluster. The RUN/START
voltage is supplied to the instrument cluster on circuit CBP29 (WH/VT) and the keep alive B+
voltage is received on circuit SBP26 (YE/RD). The instrument cluster ground is received through
circuit GD133 (BK). The message center functionality is controlled through the message center
switch, which is hardwired to the instrument cluster through input circuit CMC29 (GN/VT) and
return circuit RMC27 (WH/BN).
Possible Causes
- Message center switch
- Instrument cluster
Test B: The Message Center Switch Does Not Operate Correctly
PINPOINT TEST B: THE MESSAGE CENTER SWITCH DOES NOT OPERATE CORRECTLY
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8126
B1-B2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8127
B3-B5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8128
B6
Normal Operation
The message center is located in the center of the instrument cluster between the tachometer and
the speedometer in the vacuum fluorescent display area. The message center is integral to the
instrument cluster and uses the same voltage supply as the instrument cluster. The RUN/START
voltage is supplied to the instrument cluster on circuit CBP29 (WH/VT) and the keep alive B+
voltage is received on circuit SBP26 (YE/RD). The instrument cluster ground is received through
circuit GD133 (BK). The message center functionality is controlled through the message center
switch, which is hardwired to the instrument cluster through input circuit CMC29 (GN/VT) and
return circuit RMC27 (WH/BN).
DTC B1209 - is an on-demand DTC that sets if the instrument cluster detects any of the message
center switch buttons stuck during the self-test.
Possible Causes
- Circuitry
- Message center switch
- Instrument cluster
Test C: The Compass Is Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST C: THE COMPASS IS INOPERATIVE
C1-C2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8129
C2-C3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8130
C4-C5
Normal Operation
The compass sensor module receives voltage from the smart junction box (SJB) through circuit
CBP31 (BU/OG) and is grounded through circuit GD133 (BK). The compass sensor module
communicates the vehicle direction to the instrument cluster through the compass communication
data plus circuit VMC31 (YE/GN) and compass communication data minus circuit VMC30 (BU/GY).
DTC U2013 - is a continuous memory and on-demand DTC that sets if the instrument cluster is
missing the compass data from the compass module.
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuitry
- Compass module
- Instrument cluster
Test D: The Compass Is Inaccurate
PINPOINT TEST D: THE COMPASS IS INACCURATE
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8131
D1-D3
Normal Operation
The compass sensor module communicates the vehicle direction to the instrument cluster through
the compass communication data plus circuit VMC31 (YE/GN) and compass communication data
minus circuit VMC30 (BU/GY). The magnetic fields generated by the earths north and south poles
are divided into zones that differ from each other with respect to how the magnetic fields appear.
The magnetic north can change by up to 4 degrees between zones and become noticeable across
multiple zones. The compass zone must be set to the correct zone for the compass to read
accurately. Factors within the vehicle may affect the ability of the compass module to accurately
read the magnetic north. Calibrating the compass allows the compass module to compensate for
vehicle factors that influence the accuracy of the compass.
NOTE: Outside factors such as bridges, steel structures, tall buildings and power lines also affect
compass accuracy.
Possible Causes
- Vehicle magnetization
- Zone setting
- Calibration
- Compass module
Test E: The WASHER FLUID LEVEL LOW Warning Is Inoperative/Always On
PINPOINT TEST E: THE WASHER FLUID LEVEL LOW WARNING IS INOPERATIVE/ALWAYS
ON
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8132
E1-E4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8133
E4-E7
Normal Operation
The instrument cluster provides a reference voltage to the washer fluid switch through circuit
CMC20 (VT). The washer fluid switch is grounded through circuit GD123 (BK/GY). When the
washer fluid is low, the washer fluid switch closes to ground, pulling the reference voltage low.
When the instrument cluster detects the washer fluid input pulled low, it displays the WASHER
FLUID LOW warning.
Possible Causes
- Circuitry
- Washer fluid level switch
- Instrument cluster
Test F: The CHECK PARK ASSIST/PARK ASSIST OFF Warning Is Inoperative
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8134
PINPOINT TEST F: THE CHECK PARK ASSIST/PARK ASSIST OFF WARNING IS
INOPERATIVE
F1-F2
Normal Operation
The parking aid on/off status is sent from the parking aid module to the instrument cluster over the
medium speed controller area network (MS-CAN) communication bus lines. When the RESET
button is pressed, the instrument cluster sends a query to the parking aid module, requesting a
system status. The parking aid module responds to the instrument cluster with the status of the
system, either on or off. If the return status message is missing or corrupted, the instrument cluster
does not display the brackets around either the ON or OFF selection.
Possible Causes
- Communication network
- Parking aid system
Test G: The POWER LIFTGATE OFF Message Is Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST G: THE POWER LIFTGATE OFF MESSAGE IS INOPERATIVE
G1-G2
Normal Operation
The power liftgate on/off status is sent from the power liftgate module to the instrument cluster over
the medium speed controller area network (MS-CAN) communication bus lines. When the RESET
button is pressed, the instrument cluster sends a query to the power liftgate module, requesting a
system status. The power liftgate module responds to the instrument cluster with the status of the
system, either on or off. If the return
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8135
status message is missing or corrupted, the instrument cluster does not display the brackets
around either the ON or OFF selection.
Possible Causes
- Communication network
- Power liftgate system
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8136
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Service and Repair
MESSAGE CENTER SWITCH
Edge
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8137
MKX
Removal and Installation
MKX
1. NOTE: The transmission selector lever bezel is held in place by 4 tabs that are located in the
shifter assembly.
Remove the transmission selector lever bezel.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8138
2. Open the floor console compartment door and pull the floor console finish panel straight up to
release the retainer clips and remove the finish
panel.
3. Remove the 2 pin-type retainers and the storage compartment assembly.
All vehicles
4. Pull the instrument panel center finish panel straight out to release the retainer clips and remove
the instrument panel center finish panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
5. Press the 4 retaining tabs and remove the message center switch. 6. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8139
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Auxiliary Input / Output Jack,
Entertainment System > Component Information > Diagrams
C3312
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Auxiliary Input / Output Jack,
Entertainment System > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8144
Auxiliary Input / Output Jack: Service and Repair
AUDIO INPUT JACK
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the floor console finish panel.
2. Release the tabs and remove the audio input jack. 3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > DVD Player > Component
Information > Diagrams
C949
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > DVD Player > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 8148
DVD Player: Service and Repair
DIGITAL VERSATILE DISC (DVD) PLAYER
Removal
NOTE: Programmable module installation (PMI) only needs to be carried out if the DVD player is
being replaced.
1. Upload the DVD player configuration to the scan tool.
2. NOTE: Open the DVD player display.
Remove the 4 screws.
3. Remove the DVD player.
- Pull down on the sides of the DVD player to disengage the clips from the bracket.
- Using a suitable tool, push the rear most U-hook forward and release the U-hooks.
- Hang the DVD player on the J-hooks and disconnect the electrical connector.
- Remove the DVD player from the J-hooks.
Installation
1. Hang the DVD player on the J-hooks. 2. Connect the electrical connector. 3. Remove the DVD
player from the J-hooks.
4. NOTE: Tilt the DVD player, as necessary, to align it correctly.
Align the left side guide pin with the left side locating hole.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > DVD Player > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 8149
5. Lift up the right side of the DVD player and engage the U-hooks. 6. Install the 4 screws. 7. Push
on the left and right sides of the DVD player to engage the clips. 8. Download the DVD player
configuration from the scan tool.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Description and Operation
UNIVERSAL TRANSMITTER
The universal transmitter is an integral part of the LH sun visor and provides a convenient way to
substitute up to 3 hand-held transmitters with a single built-in device. The universal transmitter can
learn the radio frequency codes of most current transmitters. The universal transmitter:
- operates garage doors, gates and home/office lighting and security systems.
- learns and transmits the radio frequency of up to 3 hand-held transmitters from any of the
systems mentioned above.
- is powered by the vehicle battery and charging system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
NOTE: The universal transmitter system is only available as an option on the MKX. The feature is
not available on the Edge.
1. Verify the customer concern.
Visual Inspection Chart
2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of mechanical or electrical damage. 3. If an obvious cause for
an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible) before proceeding to the
next step. 4. If the cause is not visually evident, verify the symptom and GO to Symptom Chart.
See: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8155
Symptom Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8156
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Pinpoint Tests
PINPOINT TEST A: THE UNIVERSAL TRANSMITTER IS INOPERATIVE
A1
A2-A4
Normal Operation
The universal transmitter receives voltage on circuit CLN09 (YE/GN) and is grounded through
circuit GD133 (BK).
Possible Causes
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8157
- Circuitry
- Universal transmitter
- Receiver unit
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8158
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Universal Transmitter Programming
UNIVERSAL TRANSMITTER PROGRAMMING
WARNING: A garage door opening system that cannot stop or reverse itself after detecting an
object in its path does not meet current federal safety standards. To decrease the risk of serious
injury or death, do not use this universal transmitter with a door opening system that lacks stop and
reverse features as required by federal standards. This includes any garage door opening system
manufactured before April 1, 1982. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
1. Verify the hand-held transmitter is operative. 2. Prepare for programming the universal
transmitter by erasing all 3 channels by holding down the 2 outside buttons until the red indicator
begins to
flash (20-30 seconds). Release both buttons.
3. Select 1 of the 3 universal transmitter channels to be programmed by pressing the desired
button. 4. Hold the end of the hand-held transmitter 25-51 mm (1-2 in) from the front surface of the
universal transmitter so that the red indicator can still be
seen.
5. NOTE: For Canadian vehicles only, during programming, the hand-held transmitter may
automatically stop transmitting after 2 seconds, which
may not be long enough to program the universal transmitter. If programming this type of hand-held
transmitter, continue to hold the button on the universal transmitter while pressing the hand-held
transmitter button every 2 seconds.
Use both hands to press the hand-held transmitter button and the desired button on the universal
transmitter. Do not release either button.
6. Hold down both buttons until the red indicator on the universal transmitter flashes, first slowly
and then rapidly. Release both buttons when the
rapid flashing begins. The universal transmitter has successfully learned the new frequency signal
and can be used in place of the hand-held transmitter(s).
7. To operate, simply press the appropriate button on the universal transmitter. The red indicator is
on while the signal is being transmitted. 8. To program additional hand-held transmitters repeat
Steps 3-6.
Training a Garage Door Opener Equipped With "Rolling Codes"
1. Program the hand-held transmitter to the universal transmitter. 2. Train the garage door opener
receiver to recognize the universal transmitter.
1. Remove the cover panel from the garage door opener receiver. 2. Locate the training button on
the garage door opener receiver. Location and color of the button may vary by garage door opener
manufacturer.
Refer to the garage door opener instruction manual.
3. Press the training button on the garage door opener receiver for 1-2 seconds. 4. Press the
programmed universal transmitter button for as long as the universal transmitter red indicator
flashes (1-2 seconds). Release the
button and press the button to confirm that the universal transmitter is trained to the receiver.
5. The garage door opener should recognize the universal transmitter.
Erasing Channels
ERASING CHANNELS
1. NOTE: Individual channels cannot be erased, but can be reprogrammed using the procedures
for programming.
To erase all three programmed channels, hold down the two outside buttons until the red indicator
begins to flash (20-30 seconds). Release both buttons.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8159
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Global Positioning System > Global Positioning System
Antenna > Component Information > Service and Repair
Global Positioning System Antenna: Service and Repair
GLOBAL POSITIONING SYSTEM (GPS) ANTENNA
Removal and Installation
MKX
1. Remove the instrument cluster.
All vehicles
2. Remove the audio unit.
3. NOTE: For vehicles without THX(R) audio, the vehicle will have an upper storage bin, rather
than an instrument panel speaker.
Remove the instrument panel speaker.
4. Release the clip and remove the GPS antenna. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning
Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-18 (Driver Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8168
Memory Positioning Module: Diagrams
C3299A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8169
C3299B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8170
C3299C
C3299D
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Memory Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-21 (Driver Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Memory Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8174
C503
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Audio System - Pioneer Navigation Radio - Seek Inop
Navigation System: Technical Service Bulletins Audio System - Pioneer Navigation Radio - Seek
Inop
TSB 06-25-3
11/30/06
PIONEER NAVIGATION RADIO - SEEK FUNCTION INOPERATIVE - SERVICE TIP
FORD: 2006-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2007 Fusion, Mustang 2006-2007 Explorer 2007 Edge,
Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac, F-150
LINCOLN: 2006 Zephyr 2007 MKZ, Mark LT, MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2006-2007 Montego 2007 Milan 2006-2007 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some 2006-2007 vehicles equipped with a Pioneer Navigation Radio may appear to have a
defective seek function. It may be reported that the radio Seek function is inoperative, Seek will not
stop (keeps scrolling through stations) or the radio exhibits Poor FM reception. This may be due to
a misunderstanding of how the operation of the PTY (Program Type) feature functions. The PTY
feature filters out radio stations that do not fit a selected category of radio programming like: Top
40, Classical, and News. The result is a "continuous seek" condition if the feature is activated and
no stations are found under the selected category.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure to identify the PTY (Program Type) setting.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
To confirm the PTY (Program Type) setting use the following steps:
1. Under MEDIA, select the FM tab. (If you do not see an RDS and PTY button, push the SHOW
OPTIONS buttons).
2. Verify RDS and PTY are enabled by the buttons being illuminated. If the text, above the SET
PTY button says anything other than ALL, the unit is filtering for radio stations that transmit RDS
text and are categorized as the selected Program Type, like: Top 40, Classical, and News. (See
Figure 1)
3. To change the setting, either press the SET PTY button and select ALL. Or disable the PTY
feature by pushing the PTY button.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Audio System - Pioneer Navigation Radio - Seek Inop > Page 8179
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18806 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Navigation System: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8182
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8183
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8184
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8185
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8186
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8187
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8188
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8189
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8190
Navigation System: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8191
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8192
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8193
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8194
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8195
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8196
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8197
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8198
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8199
Navigation System: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
130-1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8200
130-2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8201
130-3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8202
130-5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8203
130-6
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8204
130-7
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8205
130-8
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8206
130-9
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8207
130-10
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8208
130-11
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8209
130-12
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8210
130-13
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8211
130-14
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8212
130-15
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8213
130-16
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier, Sound
System > Component Information > Diagrams > Subwoofer
C4208
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier, Sound
System > Component Information > Diagrams > Subwoofer > Page 8219
Amplifier: Diagrams THX Amplifier
C4348A
C4348B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier, Sound
System > Component Information > Diagrams > Subwoofer > Page 8220
C4348C
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier, Sound
System > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8221
Amplifier: Service and Repair
AUDIO AMPLIFIER - THX(R)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the subwoofer speaker. 2. Disconnect the THX(R) amplifier electrical connectors. 3.
Remove the 2 screws, the nut, and the THX(R) amplifier. 4. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Audio System - Pioneer Navigation Radio - Seek Inop
Radio/Stereo: Technical Service Bulletins Audio System - Pioneer Navigation Radio - Seek Inop
TSB 06-25-3
11/30/06
PIONEER NAVIGATION RADIO - SEEK FUNCTION INOPERATIVE - SERVICE TIP
FORD: 2006-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2007 Fusion, Mustang 2006-2007 Explorer 2007 Edge,
Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac, F-150
LINCOLN: 2006 Zephyr 2007 MKZ, Mark LT, MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2006-2007 Montego 2007 Milan 2006-2007 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some 2006-2007 vehicles equipped with a Pioneer Navigation Radio may appear to have a
defective seek function. It may be reported that the radio Seek function is inoperative, Seek will not
stop (keeps scrolling through stations) or the radio exhibits Poor FM reception. This may be due to
a misunderstanding of how the operation of the PTY (Program Type) feature functions. The PTY
feature filters out radio stations that do not fit a selected category of radio programming like: Top
40, Classical, and News. The result is a "continuous seek" condition if the feature is activated and
no stations are found under the selected category.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure to identify the PTY (Program Type) setting.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
To confirm the PTY (Program Type) setting use the following steps:
1. Under MEDIA, select the FM tab. (If you do not see an RDS and PTY button, push the SHOW
OPTIONS buttons).
2. Verify RDS and PTY are enabled by the buttons being illuminated. If the text, above the SET
PTY button says anything other than ALL, the unit is filtering for radio stations that transmit RDS
text and are categorized as the selected Program Type, like: Top 40, Classical, and News. (See
Figure 1)
3. To change the setting, either press the SET PTY button and select ALL. Or disable the PTY
feature by pushing the PTY button.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Audio System - Pioneer Navigation Radio - Seek Inop > Page 8226
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18806 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8227
C4344
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8228
Radio/Stereo: Service and Repair
SATELLITE RADIO RECEIVER
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the liftgate scuff plate trim panel. 2. Remove the 2 nuts and the satellite radio receiver.
- Disconnect the satellite radio antenna connector and the electrical connector.
- To install, tighten the nuts to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Remote Control,
Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Service and Repair
Remote Control: Service and Repair
STEERING WHEEL CONTROLS
Edge
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Remote Control,
Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8232
MKX
Removal and Installation
MKX
1. Remove the driver air bag module. 2. Remove the 4 screws and the steering wheel controls
bezel.
All vehicles
3. Remove the steering wheel controls by pulling the switch toward the rear of the vehicle.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Speaker
Speaker: Diagrams Speaker
C536
C570A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Speaker > Page 8237
C570B
C702
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Speaker > Page 8238
C612A
C612B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Speaker > Page 8239
C628
C802
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Speaker > Page 8240
Speaker: Diagrams Tweeter
C569
C613
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Speaker > Page 8241
C4337
C4338
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Speaker > Page 8242
C2359
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Speaker > Page 8243
C4212
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Door Speaker
Speaker: Service and Repair Door Speaker
DOOR SPEAKER
Front Or Rear Door
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Door Speaker > Page 8246
Front Door Tweeter
Removal and Installation
All speakers
1. Remove the door trim panel.
Front door tweeter speaker
2. Remove the 2 screws and the front door tweeter speaker from the door trim panel.
Front or rear door speaker
3. Remove the 4 screws and the door speaker.
- Disconnect the electrical connector(s).
All speakers
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Door Speaker > Page 8247
Speaker: Service and Repair Subwoofer Speaker
SUBWOOFER SPEAKER
Edge
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Door Speaker > Page 8248
MKX
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the quarter panel trim panel. 2. Remove the 3 bolts and the subwoofer speaker.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
- To install, tighten the bolts to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Door Speaker > Page 8249
Speaker: Service and Repair Instrument Panel Speaker
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the center instrument panel finish panel. 2. Remove the instrument panel speaker
cover. 3. Remove the 4 screws and the instrument panel speaker.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 8255
Accessory Delay Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 8256
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Antenna Control Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-8 (behind Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Antenna Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8260
C2086
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8264
C4014
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8265
Parking Assist Control Module: Service and Repair
PARKING AID MODULE
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to electrical charges. If exposed to these charges,
damage may result.
1. Remove the LH rear quarter trim panel. 2. Remove the 2 nuts and the parking aid module.
- Disconnect the parking aid module electrical connectors.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Diagrams
C127
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-16 (Rear End - Edge)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor, Outer Left
C4009
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor, Outer Left >
Page 8275
C4011
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor, Outer Left >
Page 8276
C4010
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor, Outer Left >
Page 8277
C4012
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8278
Parking Assist Distance Sensor: Service and Repair
PARKING AID SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear bumper cover. 2. Disconnect the parking aid sensor(s) electrical connector(s).
3. Press the retaining tabs and remove the parking aid sensor(s). 4. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Trailer Connector: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8284
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8285
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8286
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8287
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8288
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8289
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8290
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8291
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8292
Trailer Connector: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8293
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8294
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8295
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8296
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8297
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8298
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8299
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8300
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8301
C439
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8302
Trailer Connector: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
95-1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8303
95-2
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Trailer Lamps: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8308
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8309
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8310
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8311
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8312
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8313
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8314
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8315
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8316
Trailer Lamps: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8317
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8318
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8319
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8320
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8321
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8322
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8323
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8324
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8325
Trailer Lamps: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
95-1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8326
95-2
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Trailer Lamps: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
1. Verify the customer concern. 2. Verify the exterior lighting system of the vehicle is operating
correctly. If not, refer to the appropriate pinpoint test. 3. Visually inspect for obvious signs of
electrical damage.
VISUAL INSPECTION CHART
Electrical Battery junction box (BJB) fuse(s): 9 (20A) (trailer tow parking lamps)
- 24 (15A) (trailer tow LH stop/turn relay)
- 46 (15A) (trailer tow RH stop/turn relay)
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Trailer tow stop/turn relays
- Trailer tow parking lamp relay
- Trailer
4. If the concern is not visually evident, verify the symptom. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8329
Symptom Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8330
Trailer Lamps: Pinpoint Tests
Test X: The Trailer Lamps Are Inoperative - All
PINPOINT TEST X: THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE - ALL
X1
Normal Operation
The trailer tow connectors receive ground through circuit RAT08 (WH) for all of the trailer lamps.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Trailer
Test Y: The Individual Trailer Lamp Is Inoperative - Trailer Turn/Stoplamp
PINPOINT TEST Y: THE INDIVIDUAL TRAILER LAMP IS INOPERATIVE - TRAILER
TURN/STOPLAMP
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8331
Y1-Y2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8332
Y3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8333
Y4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8334
Y5-Y6
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8335
Y6 Continued
Normal Operation
The battery junction box (BJB) fuse 24 (15A) supplies voltage to the LH trailer tow stop/turn relay
and BJB fuse 46 (15A) supplies voltage to the RH trailer tow stop/turn relay. The trailer tow
stop/turn relay coils are grounded through circuit GD120 (BK/GN).
The trailer tow LH stop/turn relay coil receives voltage from circuit CLS18 (GY/BN) when the
vehicle LH rear stoplamp is illuminated. When the trailer tow LH stop/turn relay is energized,
voltage is routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT06 (YE).
The trailer tow RH stop/turn relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS19 (VT/OG) when the
vehicle RH rear stoplamp is illuminated. When the trailer tow RH stop/turn relay is energized,
voltage is routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT09 (GN).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Joint connector
- Trailer tow stop/turn relay
- BJB
- Trailer
Test Z: The Trailer Lamps Are Inoperative - Trailer Parking Lamps
PINPOINT TEST Z: THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE - TRAILER PARKING LAMPS
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8336
Z1-Z3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8337
Z3-Z4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8338
Z4 Continued
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8339
Z5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8340
Z6
Normal Operation
The trailer tow parking lamp relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) when the
vehicle parking lamps are illuminated. The trailer tow parking lamp relay coil is grounded through
circuit GD120 (BK/GN). The battery junction box (BJB) fuse 9 (20A) supplies voltage to the trailer
tow parking lamp relay switch side. When the trailer tow parking lamp relay is energized, the
voltage is routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT11 (BN).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Joint connector
- Trailer tow parking lamp relay
- BJB
- Trailer
Tests AA: The Trailer Lamps Are On Continuously
PINPOINT TEST AA: THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE ON CONTINUOUSLY
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8341
AA1-AA2
Normal Operation - Trailer Tow Turn/Stoplamp
The trailer tow LH stop/turn relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS18 (GY/BN) when the
vehicle LH rear stoplamp is illuminated. When the trailer tow LH stop/turn relay is energized,
voltage is routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT06 (YE).
The trailer tow RH stop/turn relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS19 (VT/OG) when the
vehicle RH rear stoplamp is illuminated. When the trailer tow RH stop/turn relay is energized,
voltage is routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT09 (GN).
Normal Operation - Trailer Tow Parking
The trailer tow parking lamp relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) when the
vehicle parking lamps are illuminated. When the trailer tow parking lamp relay is energized, voltage
is routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT11 (BN).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Trailer tow relay
- Trailer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8342
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay > Page 8347
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay > Page 8348
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay > Page 8351
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay > Page 8352
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Right Stop/Turn Lamp Relay
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay > Page 8353
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay > Page 8354
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Park Lamp Relay
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay > Page 8355
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions
Trailer Connector: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8360
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8361
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8362
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8363
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8364
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8365
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8366
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8367
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8368
Trailer Connector: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8369
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8370
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8371
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8372
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8373
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8374
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8375
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8376
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8377
C439
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8378
Trailer Connector: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
95-1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8379
95-2
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Driver Seat Module (DSM)
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Driver Seat Module (DSM)
DRIVER SEAT MODULE (DSM)
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Driver Seat Module (DSM) > Page 8387
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
NOTE: Prior to the replacement of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to the appropriate scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new module
after installation.
1. NOTE: This step is necessary only if the DSM is being replaced.
Upload the module configuration information from the DSM into the scan tool.
2. NOTE: If the driver seat can be moved to a high enough position, the DSM screws can be
removed without removing the driver seat.
If necessary, remove the driver seat.
3. Remove the 2 screws. 4. Disconnect the 4 electrical connectors and remove the DSM.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Driver Seat Module (DSM) > Page 8388
5. NOTE: Make sure to download the DSM configuration information from the scan tool into the
new DSM.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Driver Seat Module (DSM) > Page 8389
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Programmable Module Installation
PROGRAMMABLE MODULE INSTALLATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) Using the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) When the
Original Module is Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure be
carried out. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal
and installation procedures.
1. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle as normal. 2. From the Toolbox icon, select Module
Programming and press the check mark. 3. Select Programmable Module Installation. 4. Select the
module that is being replaced. 5. Follow the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the OFF
position, and press the check mark. 6. Install the new module and press the check mark. 7. Follow
the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the ON position, and press the check mark. 8.
The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration Complete. 9.
Test module for correct operation.
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) Using the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) When the
Original Module is NOT Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure be
carried out. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal
and installation procedures.
1. Install the new module. 2. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle as normal. 3. From the
Toolbox icon, select Module Programming and press the check mark. 4. Select Programmable
Module Installation. 5. Select the module that was replaced. 6. Follow the on-screen instructions,
turn the ignition key to the OFF position, and press the check mark. 7. Follow the on-screen
instructions, turn the ignition key to the ON position, and press the check mark. 8. If the data is not
available, the IDS displays a screen stating to contact the As-Built Data Center. Retrieve the data
from the technician service
publication website at this time and press the check mark.
9. Enter the module data and press the check mark.
10. The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration
Complete. 11. Test module for correct operation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair
Front Bumper Cover / Fascia: Service and Repair
BUMPER - EXPLODED VIEW, FRONT
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 8395
Part 2
BUMPER COVER - FRONT
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the 2 bolts from the top of the radiator grille.
3. Remove the 4 scrivets from the top of the radiator grille.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 8396
4. Remove the 3 lower pin-type retainers.
5. Remove the 6 fender splash shield screws (3 each side).
6. Remove the 4 lower screws (2 each side).
7. Disconnect the side marker lamp electrical connectors, if equipped.
8. Disconnect the fog lamp electrical connectors, if equipped.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 8397
9. Remove the front bumper cover.
- Pull the corner of the bumper cover from the bracket.
10. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Reinforcement > System
Information > Service and Repair > Bumper - Front
Front Bumper Reinforcement: Service and Repair Bumper - Front
BUMPER - EXPLODED VIEW, FRONT
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Reinforcement > System
Information > Service and Repair > Bumper - Front > Page 8402
Part 2
BUMPER - FRONT
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front bumper cover.
2. Remove the 6 front bumper bolts (3 each side).
- To install, tighten to 67 Nm (49 lb-ft).
3. Remove the 4 upper and lower bumper-to-radiator support bolts (2 each side).
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
4. Remove the front bumper. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Reinforcement > System
Information > Service and Repair > Bumper - Front > Page 8403
Front Bumper Reinforcement: Service and Repair Bumper - Front, Lower
BUMPER - EXPLODED VIEW, FRONT
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Reinforcement > System
Information > Service and Repair > Bumper - Front > Page 8404
Part 2
BUMPER - FRONT, LOWER
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front bumper cover.
2. Remove the 2 nuts from the power steering cooler pipe-to-lower front bumper.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
3. Remove the 6 bumper-to-radiator support nuts (3 each side) and remove the lower front bumper.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia > System Information
> Service and Repair
Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia: Service and Repair
BUMPER - EXPLODED VIEW, REAR
Rear Bumper Without Trailer Hitch (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia > System Information
> Service and Repair > Page 8409
Rear Bumper Without Trailer Hitch (Part 2)
Rear Bumper With Trailer Hitch (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia > System Information
> Service and Repair > Page 8410
Rear Bumper With Trailer Hitch (Part 2)
BUMPER COVER - REAR
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: MKX shown, Edge similar.
Remove the scrivets from the rear bumper cover.
2. Remove the 10 screws (5 each side) from the rear splash shield.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia > System Information
> Service and Repair > Page 8411
3. Remove the rear bumper cover-to-body brace screw.
4. Disconnect the trailer hitch and parking aid system wiring harness, if equipped.
5. Disconnect the retainers from the rear bumper cover-to-body brace.
6. Remove the rear bumper cover.
- Remove the bumper cover from the bumper cover bracket.
- Remove the bumper cover.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Reinforcement > System Information
> Service and Repair
Rear Bumper Reinforcement: Service and Repair
BUMPER - EXPLODED VIEW, REAR
Rear Bumper Without Trailer Hitch (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Reinforcement > System Information
> Service and Repair > Page 8415
Rear Bumper Without Trailer Hitch (Part 2)
Rear Bumper With Trailer Hitch (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Reinforcement > System Information
> Service and Repair > Page 8416
Rear Bumper With Trailer Hitch (Part 2)
BUMPER - REAR
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the rear bumper cover.
Edge only
2. Remove the 6 bumper mounting nuts (3 each side).
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-in).
MKX only
3. Remove the 2 underbody heat shields.
- Remove the 6 screws (3 each side).
- Remove the 2 pushpin retainers (1 each side).
- Disconnect the wiring harness from the heat shield.
4. Remove the 4 inside rear bumper bolts (2 each side) and the 2 nuts (1 each side)
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Reinforcement > System Information
> Service and Repair > Page 8417
5. Remove the 2 rear center bumper bolts.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
All vehicles
6. Remove the rear bumper. 7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Service and Repair
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair
COWL PANEL GRILLE
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Service and Repair >
Page 8422
Part 2
Removal and Installation
Upper and lower cowl grille panel
1. NOTE: The upper cowl panel grille must be removed before the lower cowl panel grille can be
removed.
Remove the LH and RH wiper pivot arms.
Upper cowl panel grille
2. Remove the RH cowl side outer panel. 3. Remove the LH cowl side outer panel. 4. Remove the
2 scrivets from the RH upper cowl panel grille. 5. Remove the 2 bolts from the RH upper cowl grille
panel and remove the RH upper cowl grille panel.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
6. Remove the 2 scrivets from the LH upper cowl grille panel. 7. Remove the 2 bolts from the LH
upper cowl grille panel and remove the LH upper cowl grille panel.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
Lower cowl panel grille
8. Remove the wiper arm and wiper pivot shaft assembly.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
- Remove the 2 bolts. To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
9. Remove the 2 bolts from the upper left lower cowl grille panel extension and remove the panel.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
10. Remove the 4 bolts from the upper right lower cowl panel extension and remove the panel.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
11. Disconnect the wiring harness from the retainer on the left front of the lower cowl grille panel.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Service and Repair >
Page 8423
12. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the powertrain control module (PCM). 13. Remove
the evaporative purge valve and bracket from the center of the lower cowl panel grille and set
aside. 14. Remove the 5 bolts and 3 nuts from inside the lower cowl grille panel.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
15. Remove the bolt from the lower cowl panel-to-front of dash
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
16. Remove the lower cowl grille panel and PCM from the vehicle.
Upper and lower cowl grille panel
17. CAUTION: Incorrect installation of the lower/upper cowl panel grille may cause damage to the
windshield. Make sure the cowl panel
grille clips are located under the windshield prior to installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. Transfer the components as necessary.
- Adjust the pivot arms.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Door Handle
Front Door Exterior Handle: Service and Repair Door Handle
EXTERIOR DOOR HANDLE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the plug from the rear of the door. 2. Loosen the exterior door handle reinforcement
screw and remove the exterior door handle bezel.
3. NOTE: Pull the exterior door handle strap outward and to the rear to release it from the exterior
door handle reinforcement.
Remove the exterior door handle strap.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Door Handle > Page 8432
Front Door Exterior Handle: Service and Repair Door Handle Reinforcement
DOOR HANDLE REINFORCEMENT
Exterior Front
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Door Handle > Page 8433
Exterior Rear
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the exterior door handle. 2. Remove the door trim panel. 3. Remove the door window
regulator and motor assembly. 4. If equipped, disconnect the upper lock cylinder actuating rod. 5.
Disconnect the lower exterior door handle reinforcement actuating rod.
6. NOTE: Front door shown, rear door similar.
Remove the exterior door handle reinforcement. 1. If equipped, disconnect the keyless entry
keypad wiring harness retainer. 2. Release the exterior door handle reinforcement locking clips
from the door window regulator and motor assembly. 3. Remove the exterior door handle
reinforcement.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Door Handle > Page 8434
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Interior Handle: Service and Repair
INTERIOR DOOR HANDLE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door trim panel.
2. NOTE: Front door shown, rear door similar.
Disconnect the interior door handle from the door window regulator and motor assembly.
3. NOTE: Front door shown, rear door similar.
Remove the interior door handle. Disconnect the interior door handle actuating cable from the interior door handle.
- Remove the interior door handle.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Latch: Service and Repair
DOOR LATCH
Front
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 8441
Rear
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door trim panel. 2. Remove the door window regulator and motor assembly. 3.
Disconnect the interior door handle actuating cable. 4. If equipped, disconnect the door lock
cylinder actuating rod. 5. Disconnect the door handle reinforcement actuating rod.
6. NOTE: Front door shown, rear door similar.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 8442
Release the door latch rear locking clip.
7. NOTE: Front door shown, rear door similar.
Release the door latch front locking clip. 1. Disconnect the door latch electrical connector. 2.
Release the door latch front locking clip.
8. Remove the door latch with the door lock actuating rod. 9. If necessary, disconnect the door lock
actuating rod.
10. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Lubricate the door latch to striker surfaces after installation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Panel: Service and Repair
DOOR TRIM PANEL-FRONT
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the front door handle bezel.
- Remove the screw cover.
- Remove the screw.
- Remove the front door handle bezel. Disconnect the electrical connectors, if equipped.
MKX only
2. Remove the screw cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 8446
All vehicles
3. Remove the screw. 4. Remove the 6 front door trim panel screws. 5. Disengage the bottom of
the door trim panel from the door.
- Pull outward to disengage the push nuts from the retainers.
6. Lift the top of the door trim panel edge upward and out of the beltline moulding. 7. Pull the lock
rod through the lock rod grommet. 8. Remove the front door trim panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Striker > System
Information > Adjustments
Front Door Striker: Adjustments
STRIKER ADJUSTMENT
NOTE: Before adjusting the door latch striker plate, verify that the door can be closed easily and
fits tightly.
1. Loosen the door latch striker bolts.
2. NOTE: A hammer and wood block may be necessary for large adjustments.
Reposition the door latch striker plate from side-to-side or up and down as necessary.
3. Tighten the door latch striker plate bolts.
- Tighten to 22 Nm (16 lb-ft).
4. Check the adjustment of the door.
- Repeat the procedure as necessary.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass >
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
GLASS, FRAMES AND MECHANISMS - EXPLODED VIEW, FRONT DOOR
DOOR GLASS TOP RUN - FRONT
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front door window glass.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass >
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8454
2. Remove the front door window glass inner weatherstrip.
3. Remove the front door glass top run. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Make sure the top run is fully seated before reinstalling the front door window glass.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Window Motor: Service and Repair
GLASS, FRAMES AND MECHANISMS - EXPLODED VIEW, FRONT DOOR
WINDOW REGULATOR AND MOTOR - FRONT DOOR
Removal and Installation
NOTE:
- LH shown, RH similar.
- For MKX only, the front window motor must be de-initialized, then initialized whenever the front
window motor is removed from the window regulator drum housing, a new window regulator is
installed, a new window glass is installed, a new top run is installed or for any operation in which
grease or lubricants are applied to the window regulator or glass run.
Window operating/not operating
1. Remove the front door speaker.
Window not operating
NOTE: Cutting the regulator cable should only be done if installing a new window regulator
assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8458
2. NOTE: Support window glass before cutting the window regulator cable.
Cut the window regulator cable.
Window operating
3. Reconnect the window control switch.
Window operating/not operating
4. Remove the access plugs and lower the window until the glass clamp bolts can be accessed
through the 2 access holes. Tape the glass in position.
5. NOTE: If the window regulator cable was cut previously, support the regulator before the glass
clamp bolts are loosened.
Loosen the glass clamp bolts. To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
6. Lower the window regulator downward until it reaches the stops at the bottom of the regulator
tracks.
7. If equipped, remove trim and disconnect the power mirror electrical connector.
- Remove the wiring harness pushpins from the door.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8459
8. Disconnect the electrical connector at the A-pillar.
9. Remove the 2 bolts from the electrical harness grommet to the door.
10. Using the speaker hole for access, release the clip on the harness from the inside to disconnect
the harness from the door. 11. Unclip the weatherstrip and feed through the wiring harness
between the weatherstrip and door.
12. Remove the 3 door latch screws.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
13. Remove the access plug from the latch side of door and remove the outside door handle
reinforcement screw. 14. Remove the outside door handle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8460
15. Remove the screw.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
16. If equipped, remove the keypad.
17. Remove the 10 door module bolts and remove the front door module, transfer parts as
necessary.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
18. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- MKX Only, if installing a new front window motor, it must be initialized. If installing the original
front window motor it must be de-initialized, then initialized.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair
GLASS, FRAMES AND MECHANISMS - EXPLODED VIEW, FRONT DOOR
WINDOW REGULATOR AND MOTOR - FRONT DOOR
Removal and Installation
NOTE:
- LH shown, RH similar.
- For MKX only, the front window motor must be de-initialized, then initialized whenever the front
window motor is removed from the window regulator drum housing, a new window regulator is
installed, a new window glass is installed, a new top run is installed or for any operation in which
grease or lubricants are applied to the window regulator or glass run.
Window operating/not operating
1. Remove the front door speaker.
Window not operating
NOTE: Cutting the regulator cable should only be done if installing a new window regulator
assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair > Page 8464
2. NOTE: Support window glass before cutting the window regulator cable.
Cut the window regulator cable.
Window operating
3. Reconnect the window control switch.
Window operating/not operating
4. Remove the access plugs and lower the window until the glass clamp bolts can be accessed
through the 2 access holes. Tape the glass in position.
5. NOTE: If the window regulator cable was cut previously, support the regulator before the glass
clamp bolts are loosened.
Loosen the glass clamp bolts. To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
6. Lower the window regulator downward until it reaches the stops at the bottom of the regulator
tracks.
7. If equipped, remove trim and disconnect the power mirror electrical connector.
- Remove the wiring harness pushpins from the door.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair > Page 8465
8. Disconnect the electrical connector at the A-pillar.
9. Remove the 2 bolts from the electrical harness grommet to the door.
10. Using the speaker hole for access, release the clip on the harness from the inside to disconnect
the harness from the door. 11. Unclip the weatherstrip and feed through the wiring harness
between the weatherstrip and door.
12. Remove the 3 door latch screws.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
13. Remove the access plug from the latch side of door and remove the outside door handle
reinforcement screw. 14. Remove the outside door handle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair > Page 8466
15. Remove the screw.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
16. If equipped, remove the keypad.
17. Remove the 10 door module bolts and remove the front door module, transfer parts as
necessary.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
18. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- MKX Only, if installing a new front window motor, it must be initialized. If installing the original
front window motor it must be de-initialized, then initialized.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Door Handle
Rear Door Exterior Handle: Service and Repair Door Handle
EXTERIOR DOOR HANDLE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the plug from the rear of the door. 2. Loosen the exterior door handle reinforcement
screw and remove the exterior door handle bezel.
3. NOTE: Pull the exterior door handle strap outward and to the rear to release it from the exterior
door handle reinforcement.
Remove the exterior door handle strap.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Door Handle > Page 8473
Rear Door Exterior Handle: Service and Repair Door Handle Reinforcement
DOOR HANDLE REINFORCEMENT
Exterior Front
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Door Handle > Page 8474
Exterior Rear
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the exterior door handle. 2. Remove the door trim panel. 3. Remove the door window
regulator and motor assembly. 4. If equipped, disconnect the upper lock cylinder actuating rod. 5.
Disconnect the lower exterior door handle reinforcement actuating rod.
6. NOTE: Front door shown, rear door similar.
Remove the exterior door handle reinforcement. 1. If equipped, disconnect the keyless entry
keypad wiring harness retainer. 2. Release the exterior door handle reinforcement locking clips
from the door window regulator and motor assembly. 3. Remove the exterior door handle
reinforcement.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Door Handle > Page 8475
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Interior Handle: Service and Repair
INTERIOR DOOR HANDLE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door trim panel.
2. NOTE: Front door shown, rear door similar.
Disconnect the interior door handle from the door window regulator and motor assembly.
3. NOTE: Front door shown, rear door similar.
Remove the interior door handle. Disconnect the interior door handle actuating cable from the interior door handle.
- Remove the interior door handle.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Latch: Service and Repair
DOOR LATCH
Front
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 8482
Rear
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door trim panel. 2. Remove the door window regulator and motor assembly. 3.
Disconnect the interior door handle actuating cable. 4. If equipped, disconnect the door lock
cylinder actuating rod. 5. Disconnect the door handle reinforcement actuating rod.
6. NOTE: Front door shown, rear door similar.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 8483
Release the door latch rear locking clip.
7. NOTE: Front door shown, rear door similar.
Release the door latch front locking clip. 1. Disconnect the door latch electrical connector. 2.
Release the door latch front locking clip.
8. Remove the door latch with the door lock actuating rod. 9. If necessary, disconnect the door lock
actuating rod.
10. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Lubricate the door latch to striker surfaces after installation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Panel: Service and Repair
DOOR TRIM PANEL - REAR
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the rear door handle bezel.
- Remove the screw cover.
- Remove the screw.
- Remove the rear door handle bezel. Disconnect the electrical connector, if equipped.
MKX only
2. Remove the screw cover.
All vehicles
3. Remove the screw.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 8487
4. Remove the 6 trim panel screws. 5. Disengage the bottom of the door trim panel from the door.
- Pull outward to disengage the push nuts from the retainers.
6. Lift the top of the door trim panel edge upward and out of the beltline moulding. 7. Pull the lock
rod through the lock rod grommet. 8. Remove the rear door trim panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Striker > System
Information > Adjustments
Rear Door Striker: Adjustments
STRIKER ADJUSTMENT
NOTE: Before adjusting the door latch striker plate, verify that the door can be closed easily and
fits tightly.
1. Loosen the door latch striker bolts.
2. NOTE: A hammer and wood block may be necessary for large adjustments.
Reposition the door latch striker plate from side-to-side or up and down as necessary.
3. Tighten the door latch striker plate bolts.
- Tighten to 22 Nm (16 lb-ft).
4. Check the adjustment of the door.
- Repeat the procedure as necessary.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Glass >
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
GLASS, FRAMES AND MECHANISMS - EXPLODED VIEW, REAR DOOR
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Glass >
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8495
Part 2
DOOR GLASS RUN AND BRACKET - REAR
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The bracket is removed with the rear door glass.
1. Remove the rear door glass. 2. Remove the rear door glass top run. 3. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Window Motor: Service and Repair
GLASS, FRAMES AND MECHANISMS - EXPLODED VIEW, REAR DOOR
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8499
Part 2
WINDOW REGULATOR AND MOTOR - REAR DOOR
Removal and Installation
NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Window operating/not operating
1. Remove the rear door speaker.
Window not operating
NOTE: Cutting the regulator cable should only be done if installing a new window regulator
assembly.
2. NOTE: Support window glass before cutting the window regulator cable.
Cut the window regulator cable.
Window operating
3. Reconnect the window control switch.
Window operating/not operating
4. Remove the access plug and lower the window until the glass clamp bolt can be accessed
through the access hole. Tape the glass in position.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8500
5. NOTE: If the window regulator cable was cut previously, support the regulator before the glass
clamp bolt is loosened.
Loosen the glass clamp bolt. To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
6. Lower the window regulator downward until it reaches the stops at the bottom of the regulator
tracks.
7. Disconnect the electrical connector at the B-pillar.
8. Remove the 2 bolts from the electrical harness grommet to the door. 9. Using the speaker hole
for access, release the clip on the harness from the inside to disconnect the harness from the door.
10. Unclip the weatherstrip and feed through the wiring harness between the weatherstrip and
door.
11. Remove the 3 door latch screws.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8501
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
12. Remove the access plug from the latch side of the door and remove the outside door handle
reinforcement screw. 13. Remove the outside door handle.
14. Remove the screw.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
15. If equipped, remove the door keypad.
16. Remove the 9 door module bolts and remove the rear door module, transfer parts as
necessary.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
17. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Regulator
> System Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair
GLASS, FRAMES AND MECHANISMS - EXPLODED VIEW, REAR DOOR
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Regulator
> System Information > Service and Repair > Page 8505
Part 2
WINDOW REGULATOR AND MOTOR - REAR DOOR
Removal and Installation
NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Window operating/not operating
1. Remove the rear door speaker.
Window not operating
NOTE: Cutting the regulator cable should only be done if installing a new window regulator
assembly.
2. NOTE: Support window glass before cutting the window regulator cable.
Cut the window regulator cable.
Window operating
3. Reconnect the window control switch.
Window operating/not operating
4. Remove the access plug and lower the window until the glass clamp bolt can be accessed
through the access hole. Tape the glass in position.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Regulator
> System Information > Service and Repair > Page 8506
5. NOTE: If the window regulator cable was cut previously, support the regulator before the glass
clamp bolt is loosened.
Loosen the glass clamp bolt. To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
6. Lower the window regulator downward until it reaches the stops at the bottom of the regulator
tracks.
7. Disconnect the electrical connector at the B-pillar.
8. Remove the 2 bolts from the electrical harness grommet to the door. 9. Using the speaker hole
for access, release the clip on the harness from the inside to disconnect the harness from the door.
10. Unclip the weatherstrip and feed through the wiring harness between the weatherstrip and
door.
11. Remove the 3 door latch screws.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Regulator
> System Information > Service and Repair > Page 8507
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
12. Remove the access plug from the latch side of the door and remove the outside door handle
reinforcement screw. 13. Remove the outside door handle.
14. Remove the screw.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
15. If equipped, remove the door keypad.
16. Remove the 9 door module bolts and remove the rear door module, transfer parts as
necessary.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
17. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Hood Latch: Description and Operation
HOOD LATCH
The hood latch components consist of the following:
- Hood latch release handle and cable
- Hood latch
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 8512
Hood Latch: Service and Repair
HOOD LATCH
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Mark the hood latch position prior to removal of the hood latch bolts.
Remove the 2 hood latch bolts and position the hood latch aside. To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
2. Disconnect the hood latch release cable and remove the hood latch.
3. NOTE: When the hood latch is installed, the latch adjustment must be checked to make sure the
latch is installed and aligned correctly.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. Lubricate the hood latch after installation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch Release > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Hood Latch Release: Service and Repair
HOOD LATCH RELEASE HANDLE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the hood latch. 2. Disconnect the hood latch release cable locator from the radiator
grille opening panel reinforcement. 3. Disconnect the hood latch release cable locator from the LH
inner fender.
4. NOTE: The hood latch release handle and cable assembly must be pulled through the dash
panel into the passenger compartment.
Remove the hood latch release handle and cable assembly. 1. Remove the hood latch release
handle screw. 2. Remove the hood latch release handle and cable assembly.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Switch / Sensor > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Diagrams
C127
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Liftgate Window Glass >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Liftgate Window Glass: Service and Repair
WINDOW GLASS - LIFTGATE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Material
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Liftgate Window Glass >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8524
Removal
WARNING: To prevent glass splinters from entering eyes or cutting hands, wear safety glasses
and heavy gloves when cutting glass from the vehicle. Failure to follow these instructions may
result in personal injury.
1. Remove the liftgate window wiper arm and motor. 2. Remove the liftgate spoiler. 3. Remove the
liftgate trim panel. 4. Disconnect the 2 liftgate window defrost electrical connectors.
5. NOTE: Lubricate the existing urethane adhesive with water to aid the special tool while cutting.
Using the special tool, place the flat side of the knife against the liftgate window glass. Start cutting
the adhesive away from the liftgate window glass at the top and work toward the corners.
6. Using the special tool, distance the liftgate window glass from the body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Liftgate Window Glass >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8525
7. Using the special tool, cut the remaining urethane adhesive and remove the liftgate window
glass.
8. Using a soft brush or vacuum, remove any dirt or foreign material from the pinch weld.
Installation
CAUTION: When installing urethane-installed glass parts, vehicle must not be driven until urethane
has cured. Adequate cure time is specified on the drive away chart for each urethane product as
temperatures and humidity vary. Inadequate or incorrect curing can adversely affect retention of
the windshield.
NOTE: For additional material guidelines, refer to the manufacturer's installation information.
1. Dry fit the liftgate window glass to the existing urethane adhesive bead on the body pinch weld.
2. For a uniform fit, use the 2 liftgate window glass alignment pins to align the liftgate window glass
in the opening. 3. Remove the liftgate window glass.
4. NOTE: Avoid scratching the pinch weld. For minor scratches or exposed metal on the pinch
weld, see the manufacturer's recommendations.
Using an appropriate tool, trim the urethane adhesive leaving a 1 mm (0.03 in) to 2 mm (0.07 in)
base of original equipment urethane on the pinch weld.
5. If installing the original liftgate window glass, remove the excess urethane adhesive. 6. Clean the
inside of the liftgate window glass surface with glass cleaner.
7. CAUTION: Be sure to use the same brand and cure-rate products for adhesive and primer. Do
not mix different brands of urethane and
primer.
NOTE: Sika uses the same black primer for the glass and pinch weld area.
If installing a new liftgate window glass, apply urethane glass primer according to the
manufacturer's instructions.
8. Cut the urethane adhesive applicator tip to specification.
9. NOTE: Use either a high ratio, electric or battery-operated caulk gun that will apply the urethane
with less effort and a continuous bead.
Apply urethane adhesive on top of the existing trimmed urethane adhesive bead on the pinch weld.
Make sure that all gaps in the urethane adhesive are smoothed into one continuous bead starting
and ending at the bottom of the liftgate window glass opening near the center.
10. NOTE: Before the urethane has set, partially lower the windows to prevent the glass from being
pushed out of position when a door is closed.
Install the liftgate window glass on the vehicle using the alignment pins.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Liftgate Window Glass >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8526
11. CAUTION: When installing urethane-installed glass parts, the vehicle must not be driven until
urethane has cured. Adequate cure time
is specified on the drive away chart for each urethane product as temperatures and humidity vary.
Inadequate or incorrect curing can adversely affect retention of the rear window glass.
After the urethane has cured, check the liftgate window glass seal for air or water leaks through the
urethane adhesive bead and add urethane adhesive as necessary.
12. Connect the 2 liftgate window defrost electrical connectors. 13. Install the liftgate trim panel. 14.
Install the liftgate spoiler. 15. Install the liftgate window wiper arm and motor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module: > 08-14-5 > Jul > 08 > Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC B117B
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Customer Interest Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC
B117B
TSB 08-14-5
07/21/08
POWER LIFT GATE INOPERATIVE - ALL FUNCTIONAL SWITCHES, REMOTE KEYLESS
ENTRY, WITH POWER LIFT GATE TRUNK MODULE DTC B117B
FORD: 2008 Taurus X 2007-2008 Edge, Expedition
Ford: 2009 Flex
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition, Navigator Edge, MKX, 2008 Taurus X and 2009 Flex may
exhibit an inoperative power lift gate from remote keyless entry, inside switches or the outside lift
gate handle with a power lift gate/trunk module (LTM) with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B117B
and PID UCH_OUT set to Active.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check power lift gate operation from all buttons.
2. If the power lift gate is inoperative, then check the LTM for DTC B117B and for PID UCH_Out
set to "Active".
NOTE
THE PID UCH_OUT IS SET TO "INACTIVE" OR ANY OTHER DTC ARE RETRIEVED, DO NOT
CONTINUE WITH THIS PROCEDURE, PERFORM NORMAL DIAGNOSTICS PER THE WORK
SHOP MANUAL SECTION 501-03.
3. If both the DTC B117B and the PID UCH_Out equal "Active" are present, then clear the LTM
memory and proceed to Step 4.
4. Reprogram the LTM module to the latest calibration using IDS release 55.13 Patch 28 and
higher or 56.1 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2008.7 DVD. Calibration
files may also be obtained at the website.
5. Initialize LTM per Work Shop Manual Section 501-03.
6. Check the operation of the power lift gate. Check for any DTCs. If lift gate operation passes from
all switches and there are NO DTCs in the LTM, return the vehicle to the customer.
7. If any DTCs are present after retesting or lift gate is inoperative, from any switches, perform
Work Shop Manual diagnosis per Section 501-03.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081405A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator, Edge, MKX, 2008 Taurus X, 2009 Flex: Reprogram The LTM, Includes Time To Check
DTCs And, Lift Gate Operation, Authorization Decal Not Required (Do Not Use With 12650D,
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module: > 08-14-5 > Jul > 08 > Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC B117B > Page 8535
12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Trunk / Liftgate
Control Module: > 08-14-5 > Jul > 08 > Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC B117B
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Power Liftgate
Inoperative/DTC B117B
TSB 08-14-5
07/21/08
POWER LIFT GATE INOPERATIVE - ALL FUNCTIONAL SWITCHES, REMOTE KEYLESS
ENTRY, WITH POWER LIFT GATE TRUNK MODULE DTC B117B
FORD: 2008 Taurus X 2007-2008 Edge, Expedition
Ford: 2009 Flex
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition, Navigator Edge, MKX, 2008 Taurus X and 2009 Flex may
exhibit an inoperative power lift gate from remote keyless entry, inside switches or the outside lift
gate handle with a power lift gate/trunk module (LTM) with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B117B
and PID UCH_OUT set to Active.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check power lift gate operation from all buttons.
2. If the power lift gate is inoperative, then check the LTM for DTC B117B and for PID UCH_Out
set to "Active".
NOTE
THE PID UCH_OUT IS SET TO "INACTIVE" OR ANY OTHER DTC ARE RETRIEVED, DO NOT
CONTINUE WITH THIS PROCEDURE, PERFORM NORMAL DIAGNOSTICS PER THE WORK
SHOP MANUAL SECTION 501-03.
3. If both the DTC B117B and the PID UCH_Out equal "Active" are present, then clear the LTM
memory and proceed to Step 4.
4. Reprogram the LTM module to the latest calibration using IDS release 55.13 Patch 28 and
higher or 56.1 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2008.7 DVD. Calibration
files may also be obtained at the website.
5. Initialize LTM per Work Shop Manual Section 501-03.
6. Check the operation of the power lift gate. Check for any DTCs. If lift gate operation passes from
all switches and there are NO DTCs in the LTM, return the vehicle to the customer.
7. If any DTCs are present after retesting or lift gate is inoperative, from any switches, perform
Work Shop Manual diagnosis per Section 501-03.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081405A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator, Edge, MKX, 2008 Taurus X, 2009 Flex: Reprogram The LTM, Includes Time To Check
DTCs And, Lift Gate Operation, Authorization Decal Not Required (Do Not Use With 12650D,
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Trunk / Liftgate
Control Module: > 08-14-5 > Jul > 08 > Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC B117B > Page 8541
12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8542
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8543
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Diagrams
C4174A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8544
C4174B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8545
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Service and Repair
POWER LIFTGATE MODULE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the power liftgate motor assembly.
2. Remove the power liftgate module.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors and remove the 3 bolts. To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Hazard
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Trunk / Liftgate Hazard Sensor: Service and Repair
PINCH STRIP SWITCH
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Left side shown, right side similar.
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel.
2. Disconnect the pinch strip electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Hazard
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8549
3. Remove the pinch strip.
- Remove the pin-type retainers.
- Remove the grommet and route the harness out of the vehicle.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Interior Trim
Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair
Trunk / Liftgate Interior Trim Panel: Service and Repair
LIFTGATE TRIM PANEL
Removal and Installation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Interior Trim
Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8553
1. Remove the power liftgate rod-to-liftgate cover and nut, if equipped
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
2. Remove the liftgate lower trim panel.
- Remove the 4 screws.
- Remove the liftgate lower trim panel.
3. Remove the liftgate upper trim panel. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Latch - Manual
Trunk / Liftgate Latch: Service and Repair Liftgate Latch - Manual
LIFTGATE LATCH - MANUAL
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel. 2. Disconnect the liftgate latch electrical connector. 3. Remove
the 3 liftgate latch screws.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
4. Remove the liftgate latch.
5. NOTE: Lubricate the liftgate latch after installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Latch - Manual > Page 8558
Trunk / Liftgate Latch: Service and Repair Liftgate Latch - Power
LIFTGATE LATCH - POWER
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel. 2. Remove the 2 liftgate release switch moulding bolts.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
3. Position the liftgate release switch molding aside. 4. Disconnect the liftgate latch electrical
connector. 5. Remove the 3 liftgate latch screws.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
6. Remove the liftgate latch.
7. NOTE: Lubricate the liftgate latch after installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Motor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Cinching Motor
C4188
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Motor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Cinching Motor > Page 8563
C4223
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Liftgate Motor
Trunk / Liftgate Motor: Service and Repair Power Liftgate Motor
POWER LIFTGATE MOTOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the power liftgate rod assembly. 2. Disconnect the power liftgate motor electrical
connectors. 3. Remove the power liftgate motor retaining bolts and remove the power liftgate motor
assembly.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
4. Position the back end of the rear quarter trim out enough to access the top power liftgate motor
retaining bolt. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Liftgate Motor > Page 8566
Trunk / Liftgate Motor: Service and Repair Power Liftgate Rod
POWER LIFTGATE ROD
Material
Material
Removal and Installation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Liftgate Motor > Page 8567
1. Remove the LH quarter trim panel access cover.
2. Unclip the power liftgate rod from the motor assembly.
- Squeeze the clip as shown to release and position the rod assembly upward.
3. Remove the cover and the power liftgate rod-to-liftgate retaining nut.
- To install, apply Threadlock 262 to the threads of the fastener and tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
4. Remove the 3 power liftgate rod mounting bracket nuts.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > License Lamps/Liftgate Release Switch
View 151-25 (Liftgate - Edge)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > License Lamps/Liftgate Release Switch > Page 8572
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > License Lamps/Liftgate Release Switch > Page 8573
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > License Lamps/Liftgate Release Switch
C4353
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > License Lamps/Liftgate Release Switch > Page 8576
C4333
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > License Lamps/Liftgate Release Switch > Page 8577
C4216
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > License Lamps/Liftgate Release Switch > Page 8578
C2269
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Release Switch - Manual
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Service and Repair Liftgate Release Switch - Manual
LIFTGATE RELEASE SWITCH - MANUAL
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel. 2. Disconnect the liftgate release switch electrical connector. 3.
Remove the 5 liftgate release switch moulding nuts.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
4. Depress the tabs and remove the liftgate release switch. 5. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Release Switch - Manual > Page 8581
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Service and Repair Liftgate Release Switch - Power
LIFTGATE RELEASE SWITCH - POWER
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel. 2. Disconnect the liftgate release switch electrical connector. 3.
Remove the 2 liftgate release switch moulding bolts.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
4. Depress the tabs and remove the liftgate release switch. 5. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information >
Service and Repair
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair
COWL PANEL GRILLE
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information >
Service and Repair > Page 8586
Part 2
Removal and Installation
Upper and lower cowl grille panel
1. NOTE: The upper cowl panel grille must be removed before the lower cowl panel grille can be
removed.
Remove the LH and RH wiper pivot arms.
Upper cowl panel grille
2. Remove the RH cowl side outer panel. 3. Remove the LH cowl side outer panel. 4. Remove the
2 scrivets from the RH upper cowl panel grille. 5. Remove the 2 bolts from the RH upper cowl grille
panel and remove the RH upper cowl grille panel.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
6. Remove the 2 scrivets from the LH upper cowl grille panel. 7. Remove the 2 bolts from the LH
upper cowl grille panel and remove the LH upper cowl grille panel.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
Lower cowl panel grille
8. Remove the wiper arm and wiper pivot shaft assembly.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
- Remove the 2 bolts. To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
9. Remove the 2 bolts from the upper left lower cowl grille panel extension and remove the panel.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
10. Remove the 4 bolts from the upper right lower cowl panel extension and remove the panel.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
11. Disconnect the wiring harness from the retainer on the left front of the lower cowl grille panel.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information >
Service and Repair > Page 8587
12. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the powertrain control module (PCM). 13. Remove
the evaporative purge valve and bracket from the center of the lower cowl panel grille and set
aside. 14. Remove the 5 bolts and 3 nuts from inside the lower cowl grille panel.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
15. Remove the bolt from the lower cowl panel-to-front of dash
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
16. Remove the lower cowl grille panel and PCM from the vehicle.
Upper and lower cowl grille panel
17. CAUTION: Incorrect installation of the lower/upper cowl panel grille may cause damage to the
windshield. Make sure the cowl panel
grille clips are located under the windshield prior to installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. Transfer the components as necessary.
- Adjust the pivot arms.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Fender > Front Fender > Front Fender Liner > System Information > Service
and Repair
Front Fender Liner: Service and Repair
FRONT END BODY PANELS - EXPLODED VIEW
FENDER SPLASH SHIELD
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the fender splash shield screws. 2. Remove the fender splash shield pin-type retainers.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Body / Frame Mount Bushing: Description and Operation
Frame Assembly
Front Subframe
The front subframe is bolted to the body and is used to: aid in structural support.
- aid in structural support.
- provide mounting surfaces for the front suspension control arms.
- provide the mounting surface for the steering gear.
- provide the mounting surface for the sway bar.
Rear Subframe
The rear subframe is bolted to the body and is used to: aid in structural support.
- provide mounting surfaces for the rear suspension control arms.
- provide a mounting point for the rear differential, if equipped.
- provide a mounting surface for the sway bar.
Underbody misalignment can affect front and rear wheel alignment, the operation of the
suspension parts and drivetrain operation. Window glass cracks, door and window opening
concerns and air or water leaks at the doors are often caused by incorrectly tightened bolts and
body misalignment.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Subframe > Front Subframe > System Information > Description and
Operation
Front Subframe: Description and Operation
FRAME ASSEMBLY
Front Subframe
The front subframe is bolted to the body and is used to: aid in structural support.
- provide mounting surfaces for the front suspension control arms.
- provide the mounting surface for the steering gear.
- provide the mounting surface for the sway bar.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Subframe > Front Subframe > System Information > Description and
Operation > Page 8601
Front Subframe: Service and Repair
Subframe - Front
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Subframe > Front Subframe > System Information > Description and
Operation > Page 8602
Subframe - Front (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Subframe > Front Subframe > System Information > Description and
Operation > Page 8603
Subframe - Front (Part 2)
CAUTION: Suspension and subframe fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance
of vital parts and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. A new part with the
same part number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement
part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during
reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. With a wax pencil, mark the relationship of the front subframe to the underbody at the mounting
locations.
2. Remove the RH splash shield.
3. Remove the 3 pushpin fasteners, the 7 screws and the front splash shield.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Subframe > Front Subframe > System Information > Description and
Operation > Page 8604
4. Remove the 3 RH subframe-to-lower bumper nuts.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
5. Remove the 3 LH subframe-to-lower bumper nuts and separate the lower bumper from the
subframe.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
6. Remove the 3 power steering tube bracket bolts from the RH side of the subframe and position
the power steering tube aside.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Subframe > Front Subframe > System Information > Description and
Operation > Page 8605
7. NOTE:
- Use the holding feature to prevent the ball stud from turning while removing or installing the
stabilizer bar link nut.
- RH side shown, LH side similar.
Remove the 2 stabilizer bar link-to-control arm nuts (1 each side) and separate the stabilizer bar
links from the lower control arms. Discard the nuts
- To install, tighten to 90 Nm (66 lb-ft).
8. NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
Remove the lower control arm-to-knuckle pinch bolts and separate the lower control arms from the
knuckles. Discard the bolts.
- To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
9. Loosen the Y-pipe clamp and disconnect the 2 exhaust hangers.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Subframe > Front Subframe > System Information > Description and
Operation > Page 8606
10. Remove the 4 nuts and the Y-pipe assembly.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
11. NOTE: The steering gear is not removed with the front subframe and must be positioned aside.
Position the steering gear aside using mechanic's wire.
Remove the 4 bolts and position the steering rack aside using a suitable length of mechanic's wire.
Discard the bolts.
- To install, tighten the steering gear bolts in the sequence shown. To install, tighten to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
12. Remove the 4 bolts and position the stabilizer bar aside using a suitable length of mechanic's
wire.
- Discard the bolts.
- To install, tighten to 63 Nm (46 lb-ft).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Subframe > Front Subframe > System Information > Description and
Operation > Page 8607
13. Remove the nuts and the roll restrictor heat shield.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
14. Remove the 3 bolts from the roll restrictor bracket.
- To install, tighten to 90 Nm (66 lb-ft).
15. Position the lift table under the subframe.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Subframe > Front Subframe > System Information > Description and
Operation > Page 8608
16. NOTE:
- Align the front subframe index marks to the body index marks made during removal.
- During installation, the subframe brackets are loosely installed with the support bracket bolts.
Tighten the rear subframe nuts prior to tightening the support bracket bolts.
Remove the 2 nuts, 4 bolts and the subframe support brackets. Discard the nuts and bolts.
- To install, tighten the nuts to 133 Nm (98 lb-ft).
- To install, tighten the bolts to 90 Nm (66 lb-ft).
17. Remove the 2 front subframe nuts.
- Discard the nuts.
- To install, tighten to 133 Nm (98 lb-ft).
18. Remove the 2 middle subframe nuts and remove the subframe.
- Discard the nuts.
- To install, tighten to 133 Nm (98 lb-ft).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Subframe > Front Subframe > System Information > Description and
Operation > Page 8609
19. Transfer the components as necessary. 20. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Subframe > Rear Subframe > System Information > Description and
Operation
Rear Subframe: Description and Operation
FRAME ASSEMBLY
Rear Subframe
The rear subframe is bolted to the body and is used to: aid in structural support.
- provide mounting surfaces for the rear suspension control arms.
- provide a mounting point for the rear differential, if equipped.
- provide a mounting surface for the sway bar.
Underbody misalignment can affect front and rear wheel alignment, the operation of the
suspension parts and drivetrain operation. Window glass cracks, door and window opening
concerns and air or water leaks at the doors are often caused by incorrectly tightened bolts and
body misalignment.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Subframe > Rear Subframe > System Information > Service and
Repair > Subframe - Rear
Rear Subframe: Service and Repair Subframe - Rear
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Subframe - Rear
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Subframe > Rear Subframe > System Information > Service and
Repair > Subframe - Rear > Page 8615
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Rear Subframe
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Subframe > Rear Subframe > System Information > Service and
Repair > Subframe - Rear > Page 8616
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Rear Subframe (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Subframe > Rear Subframe > System Information > Service and
Repair > Subframe - Rear > Page 8617
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Rear Subframe (Part 2)
CAUTION: Suspension and subframe fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance
of vital parts and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. A new part with the
same part number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement
part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during
reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the rear wheels. 2. If equipped, remove the bolts from the drive shaft-to-rear drive unit
flange.
- To install, tighten to 70 Nm (52 lb-ft).
3. With a wax pencil, mark the relationship of the rear subframe to the underbody at the mounting
locations.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Subframe > Rear Subframe > System Information > Service and
Repair > Subframe - Rear > Page 8618
4. Remove the muffler and tailpipe assembly. 5. Disconnect the LH and RH wheel speed sensor
connectors.
6. NOTE: All wheel drive (AWD) shown, front wheel drive (FWD) similar.
Remove the connector from the front of the subframe and position aside.
7. CAUTION: Do not allow the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly to hang from the brake
hose or damage to the hose may occur.
Remove the 4 bolts (2 each side) from the rear hub spindle-to-brake caliper. To install, tighten to 70 Nm (52 lb-ft).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Subframe > Rear Subframe > System Information > Service and
Repair > Subframe - Rear > Page 8619
8. Remove the 2 bolts (1 each side) from the brake hose bracket.
9. Position the brake calipers aside using mechanic's wire. It is not necessary to disconnect the
hydraulic brake lines.
10. Remove the 2 nuts (1 each side) from the parking brake cable bracket and upper stabilizer
shaft.
- Discard the nuts.
- To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
11. Remove the 4 bolts (2 each side) from the parking brake cable-to-backing plate.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Subframe > Rear Subframe > System Information > Service and
Repair > Subframe - Rear > Page 8620
- To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 lb-ft).
12. Remove the rear shock-to-trailing link lower nuts and flag bolts.
- Discard the nuts and flag bolts.
- To install, tighten to 80 Nm (59 lb-ft).
13. CAUTION:
- The rear subframe must be secured to the lifting table. The rear subframe may become unstable
and fall from the lifting table.
- Position a jackstand under the front of the vehicle to keep the vehicle from becoming unstable on
the hoist.
Position the lifting table under the rear subframe.
14. Remove the 4 front (2 each side) bushing brace-to-body bolts.
- Discard the bolts.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Subframe > Rear Subframe > System Information > Service and
Repair > Subframe - Rear > Page 8621
15. Remove the 2 front (1 each side) mounting nuts from the rear subframe.
- Discard the nuts.
- To install, tighten to 90 Nm (66 lb-ft).
16. NOTE: The bolts are 2 different sizes, note the location of the bolts to make sure of correct
installation.
Remove the 10 bolts (5 each side) from the trailing links-to-vehicle body. Discard the bolts.
- To install, tighten to 47 Nm (35 lb-ft).
17. NOTE: The rear springs are under pressure. The lifting table must be lowered slowly to relieve
the spring pressure.
Remove the 2 rear mounting nuts. Discard the nuts.
- To install, tighten to 90 Nm (66 lb-ft).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Subframe > Rear Subframe > System Information > Service and
Repair > Subframe - Rear > Page 8622
18. Remove the rear subframe. 19. Transfer the components as necessary. 20. To install, reverse
the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Subframe > Rear Subframe > System Information > Service and
Repair > Subframe - Rear > Page 8623
Rear Subframe: Service and Repair Subframe Bushings - Rear Differential, Rear
Subframe Bushings - Differential, Rear
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Subframe > Rear Subframe > System Information > Service and
Repair > Subframe - Rear > Page 8624
Removal
NOTE: There are 2 rear drive unit (RDU) bushings in the rear subframe, this procedure shows how
to remove one bushing. The procedure for the remaining RDU bushing is identical.
1. Remove the rear drive unit.
2. NOTE:
- Make sure the 204-617/2 is positioned with the larger opening toward the bushing to act as the
receiver cup.
- Make sure the arrow on the special tool is pointed toward the rear subframe when removing the
bushing.
Assemble the special tools to the rear subframe and press out the bushing.
Installation
NOTE: There are 2 RDU bushings in the subframe, this procedure shows how to install one
bushing. The procedure for the remaining RDU bushing is identical.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Subframe > Rear Subframe > System Information > Service and
Repair > Subframe - Rear > Page 8625
1. NOTE: Make sure the alignment marks on the special tool are aligned with the anti-rotation tabs
on the RDU bushing.
Install the RDU bushing into the special tool.
2. NOTE: Make sure the alignment marks are correctly aligned on both special tools and the
anti-rotation tabs are correctly seated in the special
tool.
Install the special tool onto the RDU bushing.
3. NOTE:
- Make sure the arrow on the special tool is visible on the bottom and facing away from the
subframe. The arrow must remain straight so that the bushings are correctly indexed into the
subframe.
- When installing the RDU bushing, 204-617/2 will fall away as the RDU bushing is installed into the
subframe. The special tool does not control the depth of the bushing, continue to tighten the nut
until the RDU bushing is fully seated into the subframe.
Install the RDU bushing into the subframe.
4. Install the RDU.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Grille > Component Information > Service and Repair
Grille: Service and Repair
RADIATOR GRILLE
Edge Radiator Grille
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Grille > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8629
MKX Radiator Grille
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front bumper cover. 2. Remove the isolator-to-bumper cover bolts. 3. Remove the
isolator-to-radiator grille reinforcement screws. 4. Remove the isolator.
- Release the isolator from the clips on the bumper cover.
5. Remove the radiator grille and radiator grille reinforcement.
- Release the radiator grille reinforcement from the clips on the bumper cover.
6. Remove the radiator grille-to-radiator grille reinforcement nuts and remove the radiator grille. 7.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Diagrams
C930
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Console - Floor
Console: Service and Repair Console - Floor
CONSOLE - FLOOR
Edge Floor Console
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Console - Floor > Page 8636
MKX Floor Console
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Position the gear shift lever to NEUTRAL.
2. NOTE: The seats must be in the full raised position to access the bolts.
Position the seats forward and remove the 2 rear bolts. To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
3. Remove the 2 console side panels.
4. NOTE: The seats must be in the full raised position to access the bolts.
Position the seats rearward and remove the 2 side panels and 2 center bolts. To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
5. Remove the console finish panel.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Console - Floor > Page 8637
MKX only
6. Remove the storage bin.
- Remove the 2 scrivets.
- Disconnect the power point electrical connector.
7. Remove the 2 console front side bolts.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
All vehicles
8. Remove the 2 console-to-instrument panel bolts.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
9. Disconnect the floor console electrical connector from the lower right front wiring harness.
10. Remove the floor console. 11. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Console - Floor > Page 8638
Console: Service and Repair Console - Overhead
CONSOLE - OVERHEAD
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the overhead console.
- Pull downward on the overhead console.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
2. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEPOWERING AND REPOWERING
Depowering Procedure
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Failure to follow this instruction may result in
air bag deployment, which may result in serious personal injury.
- Never probe the electrical connector on a side air curtain module. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in side air curtain module deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraints system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraints system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the smart power
distribution junction box (SPDJB), located in the LH lower kick panel, remove the lower kick panel
fuse cover and the
restraints control module (RCM) fuse 46 (7.5A) from the (SPDJB).
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30 seconds.
The air bag warning indicator will remain lit
continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or installing any new front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and
before servicing, installing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors,
such as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches. Failure to
follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
The front impact severity sensors are located on the radiator support under the front bumper cover.
The first row side impact sensors are located at or near the base of the B-pillars.
The second row side impact sensors are located on the C-pillars.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
Repowering Procedure
1. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 2. Install RCM fuse 46 (7.5A) to the SPDJB and install
the lower kick panel fuse cover.
3. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in front
of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal
injury.
Connect the battery ground cable.
4. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition switch from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the ignition switch back to ON
and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag
warning indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn OFF. If an air
bag SRS fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash at a 5 Hz rate (RCM not configured).
The air bag warning indicator might not light until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch
has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 8644
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator and any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) from the RCM and occupant classification
sensor (OCS) module using a scan tool.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 8645
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Deactivation and Reactivation
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEACTIVATION AND REACTIVATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Deactivation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of serious personal injury in
the event of an accidental deployment.
- Carry a live air bag module with the air bag and trim cover pointed away from your body. This will
reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live air bag module down with the trim cover face down. This will reduce the risk of
serious personal injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Failure to follow this instruction may result in
air bag deployment, which may result in personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the safety canopy module. Failure to follow this instruction may
result in safety canopy deployment, which may result in personal injury.
- The safety belt pretensioners are pyrotechnic devices. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in pretensioner or air bag deployment which may result in serious personal
injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraints system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraints system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All vehicles 1. Turn all vehicle accessories off. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the smart
power distribution junction box (SPDJB), located in the LH lower kick panel, remove the lower kick
panel fuse cover and the
restraints control module (RCM) fuse 46 (7.5A) from the SPDJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30 seconds.
The air bag warning indicator will remain lit
continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or installing any new front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and
before servicing, installing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors,
such as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensors are located on the radiator support under the front bumper cover.
The first row side impact sensors are located at or near the base of the B-pillars.
The second row side impact sensors are located on the C-pillars.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 8646
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
7. NOTE: Repeat this step for both locking pins.
Using a 3-mm Allen wrench or a suitable tool through the access hole on the backside of the
steering wheel, position the tool against the spring clip and push in, disengaging the clip from the
locking pin. With the spring clip disengaged from the locking pin, gently pull back on that side of the
driver air bag module to release it from the steering wheel.
8. CAUTION: Do not pull the driver air bag module electrical connectors out by the locking buttons.
Damage to the locking buttons may
occur.
Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking buttons on the driver air bag
module electrical connectors. With the locking buttons released, remove the electrical connectors
and the driver air bag module.
9. Open and lower the glove compartment door. Then unhook the glove compartment door from
the instrument panel (I/P).
- If equipped, detach the glove compartment door dampener.
Edge
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 8647
10. Remove the 2 passenger air bag module bolts from the cross vehicle beam bracket.
11. CAUTION: Do not handle the passenger air bag module by grabbing the edges of the
deployment doors. Damage to the air bag module
may occur.
Through the glove compartment opening, release the 4 LH side deployment door clips. Then
release the forward-most 5 clips and separate the deployment door and passenger air bag module
from the I/P.
12. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the RH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
13. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the RH locking button released, remove the RH electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 8648
14. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the LH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
15. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the LH locking button released, remove the LH electrical connector and remove the
passenger air bag module.
MKX
16. Pull straight out to release the 5 retaining clips and remove the RH I/P finish panel.
17. Remove the screw for the LH duct assembly bracket from the front of the I/P.
18. Through the glove compartment opening, remove the screw and the LH duct assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 8649
19. Through the glove compartment opening, remove the screw and the RH duct assembly.
20. Remove the 4 bolts and the passenger air bag module support bracket.
21. Remove the 3 nuts from the passenger air bag module.
22. CAUTION: Do not allow the passenger air bag module to hang from the wiring harness.
Damage to the wiring harness and connectors
may occur.
Lower the rear of the passenger air bag module off the 3 mounting studs. Move the passenger air
bag module rearward to release the 7 hooks from the I/P and rest the module on the cross vehicle
beam.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 8650
23. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the LH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
24. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the LH locking button released, remove the LH electrical connector from the passenger air
bag module.
25. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the RH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
26. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the RH locking button released, remove the RH electrical connector. Remove the passenger
air bag module from the glove compartment opening.
All vehicles
27. From under the rear of the front passenger seat, slide and disengage the passenger seat side
air bag module electrical connector locking clip, and
then release the tab and disconnect the passenger seat side air bag module electrical connector.
28. Remove the passenger side D-pillar trim panel.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 8651
29. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger safety canopy module electrical connector out by the
locking button. Damage to the locking button
may occur.
With the locking button released, remove the electrical connector from the passenger safety
canopy module.
30. Remove the driver side D-pillar trim panel.
31. CAUTION: Do not pull the driver safety canopy module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button
may occur.
With the locking button released, remove the electrical connector from the driver safety canopy
module.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 8652
32. From under the rear of the driver seat, detach the driver seat side air bag module electrical
connector from the seat cushion frame. Then slide and
disengage the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector locking clip, and then release
the tab and disconnect the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector.
33. Install RCM fuse 46 (7.5A) to the SPDJB. 34. Connect the battery ground cable.
Reactivation
All vehicles 1. Remove RCM fuse 46 (7.5A) from the SPDJB. 2. Disconnect the battery ground
cable and wait at least one minute.
3. Connect the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector and then slide and engage the
seat side air bag electrical connector locking clip.
Then attach the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector to the seat cushion frame.
4. CAUTION:
- Do not install the safety canopy module electrical connector by the locking button. Damage to the
locking button may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector locking button must be in the released position
when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector is unique and cannot be reversed when connected
to the safety canopy module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the safety canopy
module. Do not force the electrical connector into the safety canopy module. Damage to the
connector or component may occur.
With the locking button released, install the driver safety canopy module electrical connector fully
into the driver safety canopy module and seat the locking button.
5. Install the driver side D-pillar trim panel.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 8653
6. CAUTION:
- Do not install the safety canopy module electrical connector by the locking button. Damage to the
locking button may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector locking button must be in the released position
when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector is unique and cannot be reversed when connected
to the safety canopy module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the safety canopy
module. Do not force the electrical connector into the safety canopy module. Damage to the
connector or component may occur.
With the locking button released, install the passenger safety canopy module electrical connector
fully into the passenger safety canopy module and seat the locking button.
7. Install the passenger side D-pillar trim panel.
8. Connect the passenger seat side air bag module electrical connector and then slide and engage
the seat side air bag electrical connector locking
clip.
MKX
9. CAUTION:
- Do not install the passenger air bag module electrical connectors by the locking buttons. Damage
to the locking buttons may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connector locking buttons must be in the released
position when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the passenger air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in
the passenger air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the passenger air bag
module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 8654
Position the passenger air bag module on the cross vehicle beam. With the locking buttons
released, install the 2 passenger air bag module electrical connectors fully into the passenger air
bag module and seat the locking buttons.
10. NOTE: During the passenger air bag module installation, make sure all 7 of the hooks are fully
seated in the I/P.
Install the passenger air bag module 7 hooks into the I/P. Raise the rear of the passenger air bag
module onto the 3 mounting studs.
11. Install the 3 passenger air bag module nuts.
- Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
12. NOTE: To avoid a squeak or rattle condition, install the passenger air bag module bracket and
passenger air bag module bolts in this order.
Install the passenger air bag module support bracket and the 4 bolts. 1. Install the passenger air
bag module support bracket and 2 bolts to the cross vehicle beam.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
2. Install the inboard passenger air bag module support bracket-to-passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
3. Install the outboard passenger air bag module support bracket-to-passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 8655
13. Install the screw and the RH duct assembly.
14. Install the screw and the LH duct assembly.
15. Install the screw for the LH duct assembly bracket in the front of the I/P.
16. NOTE: Make sure the RH I/P finish panel 5 retaining clips are fully seated in the I/P.
Install the RH I/P finish panel.
Edge
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 8656
17. CAUTION:
- Do not install the passenger air bag module electrical connectors by the locking buttons. Damage
to the locking buttons may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connector locking buttons must be in the released
position when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the passenger air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in
the passenger air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the passenger air bag
module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
With the locking buttons released, install the 2 passenger air bag module electrical connectors fully
into the passenger air bag module and seat the locking buttons.
18. CAUTION: Do not handle the passenger air bag module by grabbing the edges of the
deployment doors. Damage to the air bag module
may occur.
NOTE: During air bag module installation, make sure all the deployment door clips are fully seated
in the I/P.
Install the passenger air bag module deployment door rear-most clips into the I/P first. Then install
the side deployment door clips working around to the forward-most clips seating each of them fully
into the I/P.
19. NOTE: To avoid a squeak or rattle condition, install the 2 passenger air bag module bolts in this
order.
Install the passenger air bag module 2 bolts. 1. Install the inboard passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
2. Install the outboard passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
All vehicles 20. Hook the glove compartment door to the I/P. Close the glove compartment door.
- If equipped, attach the glove compartment door dampener.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 8657
21. CAUTION:
- Do not install the driver air bag module electrical connectors by the locking buttons. Damage to
the locking buttons may occur.
- The driver air bag module electrical connector locking buttons must be in the released position
when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the passenger air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in
the passenger air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the passenger air bag
module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
With the locking buttons released, install the driver air bag module electrical connectors fully into
the driver air bag module and seat the locking buttons.
22. NOTE: Audible clicks will be heard when both wire clips are seated in the driver air bag module.
Align the driver air bag module locking pins to the steering wheel and, while pushing inward, seat
the 2 driver air bag module locking pins to the steering wheel wire clips. When the 2 locking pins are seated in place, there should be an even gap between the driver air
bag module trim cover and the steering wheel.
23. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 24. Install RCM fuse 46 (7.5A) to the SPDJB and
install the lower kick panel fuse cover.
25. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in
front of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected. Failure to follow this instructions may result in serious personal
injury.
Connect the battery ground cable.
26. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag warning
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag SRS
fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will either: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash at a 5 Hz rate (RCM not configured).
The air bag warning indicator may not illuminate until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator will need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Clear all continuous DTCs from the restraints control module using a scan tool.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Headliner: Service and Repair
HEADLINER
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 8661
Part 2
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Remove the digital versatile disc (DVD) player, if equipped. 3.
Remove the A-pillar trim panels. See: Trim Panel 4. Remove the B-pillar trim panels. 5. Remove
the C-pillar trim panels. 6. Remove the D-pillar trim panels. 7. Disconnect the electrical connectors
from the inside rear view mirror and compass, if equipped.
8. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the wiring harness on the LH A-pillar and remove the
harness from the A-pillar. 9. Remove the overhead console, if equipped.
10. Position the front and rear door weatherstrips aside. 11. Remove the sun visors.
- Remove the sun visor screws.
- Remove the sun visor. Disconnect the electrical connector, if equipped.
12. Disconnect the rear washer fluid hose connector on the RH A-pillar. 13. Remove the 2 garment
hangers.
- Remove the screw.
- Remove the garment hanger.
14. Position the liftgate weatherstrip aside.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 8662
15. Disconnect the rear washer fluid hose connector on the RH D-pillar. 16. Remove the headliner
rear pushpin.
17. Lower the headliner and disconnect the electrical connectors on the LH D-pillar.
18. CAUTION: To avoid bending or crimping the headliner, an assistant is required for this step.
Remove the headliner through the liftgate opening.
19. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel
Trim Panel: Service and Repair A-Pillar Trim Panel
INTERIOR TRIM - EXPLODED VIEW
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 8667
Part 2
A-PILLAR TRIM PANEL
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The A-pillar trim panel is held in place by a clip that is snapped to the back of the panel. A
new clip must be installed when installing the existing trim panel.
1. NOTE: The A-pillar trim panel is held in place by a tether that is snapped to the back of the
panel.
Remove the A-pillar trim panel and disconnect the tether.
2. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 8668
Trim Panel: Service and Repair B-Pillar Trim Panel
INTERIOR TRIM - EXPLODED VIEW
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 8669
Part 2
B-PILLAR TRIM PANEL
Removal and Installation
1. Position the front seats in the full forward position.
2. NOTE: Inspect the safety belt D-ring cover for damage. If the safety belt D-ring cover does not
remain in place, install a new cover.
Remove the safety belt D-ring cover and remove the safety belt bolt. To install, tighten to 54 Nm (40 lb-ft).
3. Remove the front door scuff plate trim panel. 4. Remove the rear door scuff plate trim panel. 5.
Remove the lower B-pillar trim panel. 6. Position the front and rear door weatherstrips aside.
7. Remove the upper B-pillar trim panel assist handle, if equipped.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 8670
- Remove the bolt covers.
- Remove the bolts. To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
8. Remove the B-pillar trim panel.
- Remove the screw cover.
- Remove the screw. To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 8671
Trim Panel: Service and Repair C-Pillar Trim Panel
INTERIOR TRIM - EXPLODED VIEW
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 8672
Part 2
C-PILLAR TRIM PANEL
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Inspect the safety belt D-ring cover for damage. If the safety belt D-ring cover does not
remain in place, install a new cover.
Remove the safety belt D-ring cover and remove the safety belt bolt. To install, tighten to 54 Nm (40 lb-ft).
2. Remove the screw cover. 3. Remove the screw.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
4. Position the quarter trim panel aside to allow C-pillar trim panel removal. 5. Remove the C-pillar
trim panel.
- Pull outward and downward to remove the panel.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 8673
Trim Panel: Service and Repair D-Pillar Trim Panel
INTERIOR TRIM - EXPLODED VIEW
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 8674
Part 2
D-PILLAR TRIM PANEL
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the quarter trim panel.
2. Remove the D-pillar trim panel.
- Disengage the trim panel from the retainers.
- Disconnect the speaker wire connector from the trim panel, if equipped.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 8675
Trim Panel: Service and Repair Quarter Trim Panel
INTERIOR TRIM - EXPLODED VIEW
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 8676
Part 2
QUARTER TRIM PANEL
Removal and Installation
LH side with power liftgate
1. Remove the cover and the switch from the LH quarter trim panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
2. Remove the power liftgate rod-to-liftgate cover and nut.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
All vehicles
3. Remove the rear cargo load area.
- Remove the foam blocks from the spare tire well.
4. NOTE: Inspect the safety belt lower anchor bolt cover for damage. If the safety belt lower anchor
bolt cover does not remain in place, install a
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 8677
new cover.
Remove the safety belt lower anchor bolt cover and remove the safety belt lower anchor bolt. To install, tighten to 54 Nm (40 lb-ft).
5. NOTE: Make sure the pushpin retainers are removed with the quarter trim panel.
Remove the RH or LH quarter trim panel. Disconnect the electrical connectors, if equipped.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Door Locks > Door Lock Cylinder > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Door Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
DOOR LOCK CYLINDER
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Individual lock cylinders are repaired by discarding the inoperative cylinder and building a
new lock cylinder using the appropriate lock repair package. The lock repair package includes a
detailed instruction sheet to build the new lock cylinder to the current key code of the vehicle.
1. Remove the exterior door handle. 2. Remove the door trim panel. 3. Remove the door window
regulator and motor assembly. 4. Disconnect the door lock cylinder actuating rod.
5. Using a suitable tool, release the retaining tab and remove the front door lock cylinder. 6. To
install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Key-Pad > Component Information >
Diagrams
C500
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Key-Pad > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 8687
Keyless Entry Key-Pad: Testing and Inspection
KEYLESS ENTRY KEYPAD CODE PROGRAMMING
Programming a Personal Code and Keypad Association to Memory Seats and Mirrors (If Equipped)
NOTE:
- If the wrong code has been entered 7 times (35 consecutive button presses), the keypad will go
into an anti-scan mode. This mode disables the keypad for one minute and the keypad lamp will
flash. The anti-scan feature will turn off after one minute of keypad inactivity, after pressing the
UNLOCK control on the integrated keyhead transmitter (IKT), or after the ignition key has been
turned to the ON position.
- The factory set code cannot be associated with a memory setting.
1. Enter the permanent factory keyless entry keypad code. 2. Within 5 seconds, press the 1/2
button on the keypad. 3. Enter the new 5-digit keyless entry keypad code. Each number must be
entered within five seconds of each other.
4. To associate the entry code with a memory setting, enter a sixth digit to indicate which driver
should be set in a memory recalled by the personal
entry code: Pressing the 1/2 button recalls driver 1 settings
- Pressing the 3/4 button recalls driver 2 settings
- Pressing other keypad buttons or not pressing a keypad button as a sixth digit does not set a
driver and will not recall a memory setting
5. The doors will lock then unlock to confirm the new code is programmed.
Erasing the Personal Codes
NOTE: If the wrong code has been entered 7 times (35 consecutive button presses), the keypad
will go into an anti-scan mode. This mode disables the keypad for one minute and the keypad lamp
will flash. The anti-scan feature will turn off after one minute of keypad inactivity, after pressing the
UNLOCK control on the IKT, or after the ignition key has been turned to the ON position.
1. Enter the permanent factory keyless entry keypad code. 2. Within 5 seconds, press the 1/2
button on the keypad and release. 3. Within 5 seconds, press and hold the 1/2 button on the
keypad for 2 seconds. 4. All personal codes are now erased and only the permanent factory
keyless entry keypad code will work.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Key-Pad > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 8688
Keyless Entry Key-Pad: Service and Repair
KEYLESS ENTRY KEYPAD
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the upper access plug. 2. Using a long, flat blade screwdriver, or suitable tool through
the upper access hole, release the rear keyless entry keypad retaining clip and position
the keyless entry keypad aside.
3. Remove the keyless entry keypad.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Testing and Inspection
AUTOLOCK AND HORN CHIRP PROGRAMMING
Programming the Autolock Feature Using the Door Lock Control Switch
NOTE:
- The autolock feature can be activated or deactivated independently of the auto-unlock feature.
- The autolock feature of the smart junction box (SJB) can also be configured ON or OFF with the
scan tool.
- When programming the autolock feature using the door lock control switch method the following
steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure will need to be repeated. If the
procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. NOTE: Prior to beginning, make sure the ignition key is in the OFF position and all vehicle doors
are closed.
Turn the ignition key from the OFF to the ON position.
2. Press the unlock button on the door lock control 3 times. 3. Turn the ignition key from the ON to
the OFF position. 4. Press the unlock button on the door lock control switch 3 times. 5. Turn the
ignition key to the ON position. The horn chirps once to indicate that programming mode is entered.
6. To enable/disable the autolock feature, press the unlock button on the door lock control switch
then the lock button. The horn chirps once if the
autolocks are disabled or twice (one short chirp followed by a long chirp) if the autolocks are
enabled.
7. Turn the ignition key to the OFF position. The horn chirps once to signal that the programming is
complete.
Programming the Autolock Feature Using the Keyless Entry Keypad
NOTE:
- The autolock feature can be activated or deactivated independently of the auto-unlock feature.
- The autolock feature of the SJB can also be configured ON or OFF with the scan tool.
1. Turn the ignition key to the OFF position and close all vehicle doors. 2. Enter the permanent
factory keyless entry keypad code. 3. Press and hold the 3/4 button on the keypad. While holding
the 3/4 button, press the 7/8 button. 4. Release the 7/8 button, then release the 3/4 button. The
horn chirps once if the autolocks are disabled or twice (one short chirp followed by a honk)
if the autolocks are enabled.
Programming the Autolock Feature Using the Instrument Cluster Message Center
NOTE:
- The autolock feature can be activated or deactivated independently of the auto-unlock feature.
- The autolock feature of the SJB can also be configured ON or OFF with the scan tool.
1. Turn the ignition key from the OFF to the ON position. 2. Press the SETUP button on the
message center switch until AUTOLOCK OFF is displayed. 3. Press the RESET button to select
ON or OFF. If the autolocks are enabled, the message center will have brackets around the display.
If the
autolocks are disabled, the message center will have brackets around the display.
Programming the Auto-Unlock Feature Using the Door Lock Control Switch
NOTE:
- The auto-unlock feature can be activated or deactivated independently of the autolock feature.
- The auto-unlock feature of the SJB can also be configured ON or OFF with the scan tool.
- When programming the auto-unlock feature using the door lock control switch method the
following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure will need to be repeated. If
the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. NOTE: Prior to beginning, make sure the ignition key is in the OFF position and all vehicle doors
are closed.
Turn the ignition key from the OFF to the ON position.
2. Press the unlock button on the door lock control 3 times. 3. Turn the ignition key from the ON to
the OFF position. 4. Press the unlock button on the door lock control switch 3 times. 5. Turn the
ignition key to the ON position. The horn chirps once to indicate that programming mode is entered.
6. To enable/disable the auto-unlock feature, press the lock button on the door lock control switch
then the unlock button. The horn chirps once if
auto-unlock is disabled or twice (one short chirp followed by a long chirp) if auto-unlock is enabled.
7. Turn the ignition key to the OFF position. The horn chirps once to signal that the programming is
complete.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > Page 8692
Programming the Auto-Unlock Feature Using the Keyless Entry Keypad
NOTE:
- The auto-unlock feature can be activated or deactivated independently of the autolock feature.
- The auto-unlock feature of the SJB can also be configured ON or OFF with the scan tool.
1. Turn the ignition key to the OFF position and close all vehicle doors. 2. Enter the permanent
factory keyless entry keypad code. 3. Press and hold the 3/4 button on the keypad. While holding
the 3/4 button, press and release the 7/8 button. While still holding the 3/4 button,
press and release the 7/8 button a second time.
4. Release the 3/4 button. The horn chirps once if auto-unlock is disabled or twice (one short chirp
followed by a honk) if auto-unlock is enabled.
Programming the Auto-Unlock Feature Using the Instrument Cluster Message Center
NOTE:
- The auto-unlock feature can be activated or deactivated independently of the autolock feature.
- The auto-unlock feature of the SJB can also be configured ON or OFF with the scan tool.
1. Turn the ignition key from the OFF to the ON position. 2. Press the SETUP button on the
message center switch until AUTOUNLOCK OFF is displayed. 3. Press the RESET button to select
ON or OFF. If auto-unlock is enabled, the message center will have brackets around the display. If
auto-unlock is disabled, the message center will have brackets around the display.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Remote Memory Activation
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Service and Repair Remote Memory Activation
REMOTE MEMORY ACTIVATION
1. Position the driver seat and mirrors to the desired position. 2. Press the set button on the driver
door panel. 3. Within 5 seconds press the 1 or 2 button on the driver door panel to associate with
the driver 1 or driver 2 position. 4. Press the set button again. 5. Within 5 seconds press a button
on the associated integrated keyhead transmitter (IKT). 6. Within 5 seconds press the 1 or 2 button
on the driver door panel to associate with the driver 1 or driver 2 position. 7. If a second memory
setting is desired, repeat the procedure with the second IKT.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Remote Memory Activation > Page 8695
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Service and Repair Remote Memory Deactivation
REMOTE MEMORY DEACTIVATION
1. Press the set button on the driver door panel. 2. Within 5 seconds press any button on the
integrated key that you wish to deactivate and then press the set button on the driver door panel. 3.
If a second memory setting is desired to be deactivated, repeat the procedure with the second
integrated key.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Right Rear
View 151-24 (Right Rear Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Right Rear > Page 8701
View 151-23 (Left Rear Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Right Rear > Page 8702
View 151-22 (Passenger Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Right Rear > Page 8703
View 151-21 (Driver Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Diagrams > Left Front
C525
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Diagrams > Left Front > Page 8706
C704
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Diagrams > Left Front > Page 8707
C603
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Diagrams > Left Front > Page 8708
C804
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Driver Side
View 151-21 (Driver Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Driver Side > Page 8713
View 151-22 (Passenger Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Driver Side
C505
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Driver Side > Page 8716
C605
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 8717
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 8718
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 8719
Power Door Lock Switch: Service and Repair
DOOR LOCK CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Open the cover, remove the screw and position the interior front door handle finish panel aside.
2. Disconnect the door lock control switch electrical connector. 3. Release the locking clips and
remove the door lock control switch. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Heated Mirror Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Heated Mirror Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page
8724
Heated Mirror Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Heated Mirror Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page
8725
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-18 (Driver Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8730
Memory Positioning Module: Diagrams
C3299A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8731
C3299B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8732
C3299C
C3299D
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Memory Switch > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-21 (Driver Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Memory Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 8736
C503
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Mirror Motor: Service and Repair
EXTERIOR MIRRORS - EXPLODED VIEW
EXTERIOR MIRROR MOTOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the exterior rear view mirror glass.
2. Remove the 3 exterior rear view mirror motor screws. 3. Disconnect the exterior rear view mirror
motor electrical connector. 4. Remove the exterior rear view mirror motor. 5. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-21 (Driver Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
8743
C527
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
8744
Power Mirror Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
8745
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
8746
Power Mirror Switch: Service and Repair
EXTERIOR MIRROR CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front door control switch bezel.
2. Remove the exterior mirror control switch.
- Depress the 2 locking tabs.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Application and ID
> Paint Codes
Paint: Application and ID Paint Codes
PAINT CODES
Vehicle Certification Label
Exterior Paint Code
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Application and ID
> Paint Codes > Page 8752
Exterior Paint
Exterior paint codes may be listed as a 2-part code. The first set of characters identify the primary
body color. The second set of characters (if applicable) identify the vehicle accent or 2-tone body
color. All colors are base coat/clear coat.
Exterior Color Codes G2 - Redfire - Ford Edge, Lincoln MKX
- G5 - Alloy Gray - Ford Edge, Lincoln MKX
- GW - Orange Crush - Ford Edge
- HJ - Pewter Metallic - Ford Edge, Lincoln MKX
- ND - Dune Pearl - Ford Edge, Lincoln MKX
- NH - Light Sage - Ford Edge, Lincoln MKX
- PG - Dark Amethyst - Ford Edge, Lincoln MKX
- PH - Creme Brulee - Ford Edge, Lincoln MKX
- PV - White Chocolate (tri-coat) - Lincoln MKX
- UA - Ebony - Ford Edge, Lincoln MKX
Interior Trim
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Application and ID
> Paint Codes > Page 8753
Interior Trim
Interior trim codes are listed as a 2-part code. The first character identifies the interior trim type.
The second character identifies the interior trim color.
Interior Trim Type 1 - Milliken cloth bucket seats, manual adjust - Ford Edge
- 2 - Milliken cloth bucket seats, power driver side - Ford Edge
- 3 - Fury leather bucket seats, power driver side - Ford Edge
- A - Soho leather bucket seats, power driver and passenger side - Lincoln MKX
- B - Soho perforated leather bucket seats, power driver and passenger side - Lincoln MKX
- C - Luxury perforated leather bucket seats - Lincoln MKX
Interior Trim Color C - Camel Tan - Ford Edge, Lincoln MKX
- G - Graystone - Lincoln MKX
- L - Medium Light Stone - Ford Edge
- W - Charcoal Black - Ford Edge, Lincoln MKX
Tape/Paint Stripe
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Application and ID
> Paint Codes > Page 8754
Tape/Paint Stripe
Tape and paint stripe codes do not apply
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Application and ID
> Paint Codes > Page 8755
Paint: Application and ID Paint Code Sticker Location
PAINT CODE STICKER LOCATION
Vehicle Certification (VC) Label Locator
The VC label is located on the left-hand door jamb.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Heated Mirror Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Heated Mirror Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 8760
Heated Mirror Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Heated Mirror Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 8761
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-18 (Driver Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8765
Memory Positioning Module: Diagrams
C3299A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8766
C3299B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8767
C3299C
C3299D
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Power Seat Control Module: Description and Operation
DRIVER SEAT MODULE - MEMORY SEAT
The power driver seat, power outside rear view mirrors and power adjustable pedals are controlled
by the driver seat module (DSM) only when the vehicle is equipped with the programmable/recall
memory option. The DSM is located on the driver seat track.
This system allows automatic positioning of the driver seat to 2 programmable positions.
- A power driver seat position can be stored at any time. The driver must move the seat to the
desired position using the driver seat switch assembly. The driver must then depress the memory
SET switch which activates the memory SET switch light emitting diode (LED). Within 5 seconds
(before the LED goes out), the driver must select a memory position. Memory 1 is selected by
depressing memory switch 1. Memory 2 is selected by depressing memory switch 2.
- If no memory switch input is received within the 5-second time limit, the operation is aborted and
the memory seat position switch (set switch) LED is turned OFF. This also occurs if one of the
following inputs is received during the 5-second programming limit: Driver seat control switch
- Memory seat position switch (set switch)
- Power adjustable pedal switch
A programmed seat position can only be recalled when the transmission selector is in PARK or
NEUTRAL with the ignition switch in the RUN position. A position may be programmed at any time.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 8774
Power Seat Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 8775
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module: > 08-14-5 > Jul > 08 > Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC B117B
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Customer Interest Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC
B117B
TSB 08-14-5
07/21/08
POWER LIFT GATE INOPERATIVE - ALL FUNCTIONAL SWITCHES, REMOTE KEYLESS
ENTRY, WITH POWER LIFT GATE TRUNK MODULE DTC B117B
FORD: 2008 Taurus X 2007-2008 Edge, Expedition
Ford: 2009 Flex
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition, Navigator Edge, MKX, 2008 Taurus X and 2009 Flex may
exhibit an inoperative power lift gate from remote keyless entry, inside switches or the outside lift
gate handle with a power lift gate/trunk module (LTM) with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B117B
and PID UCH_OUT set to Active.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check power lift gate operation from all buttons.
2. If the power lift gate is inoperative, then check the LTM for DTC B117B and for PID UCH_Out
set to "Active".
NOTE
THE PID UCH_OUT IS SET TO "INACTIVE" OR ANY OTHER DTC ARE RETRIEVED, DO NOT
CONTINUE WITH THIS PROCEDURE, PERFORM NORMAL DIAGNOSTICS PER THE WORK
SHOP MANUAL SECTION 501-03.
3. If both the DTC B117B and the PID UCH_Out equal "Active" are present, then clear the LTM
memory and proceed to Step 4.
4. Reprogram the LTM module to the latest calibration using IDS release 55.13 Patch 28 and
higher or 56.1 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2008.7 DVD. Calibration
files may also be obtained at the website.
5. Initialize LTM per Work Shop Manual Section 501-03.
6. Check the operation of the power lift gate. Check for any DTCs. If lift gate operation passes from
all switches and there are NO DTCs in the LTM, return the vehicle to the customer.
7. If any DTCs are present after retesting or lift gate is inoperative, from any switches, perform
Work Shop Manual diagnosis per Section 501-03.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081405A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator, Edge, MKX, 2008 Taurus X, 2009 Flex: Reprogram The LTM, Includes Time To Check
DTCs And, Lift Gate Operation, Authorization Decal Not Required (Do Not Use With 12650D,
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module: > 08-14-5 > Jul > 08 > Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC B117B > Page 8784
12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Trunk / Liftgate
Control Module: > 08-14-5 > Jul > 08 > Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC B117B
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Power Liftgate
Inoperative/DTC B117B
TSB 08-14-5
07/21/08
POWER LIFT GATE INOPERATIVE - ALL FUNCTIONAL SWITCHES, REMOTE KEYLESS
ENTRY, WITH POWER LIFT GATE TRUNK MODULE DTC B117B
FORD: 2008 Taurus X 2007-2008 Edge, Expedition
Ford: 2009 Flex
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition, Navigator Edge, MKX, 2008 Taurus X and 2009 Flex may
exhibit an inoperative power lift gate from remote keyless entry, inside switches or the outside lift
gate handle with a power lift gate/trunk module (LTM) with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B117B
and PID UCH_OUT set to Active.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check power lift gate operation from all buttons.
2. If the power lift gate is inoperative, then check the LTM for DTC B117B and for PID UCH_Out
set to "Active".
NOTE
THE PID UCH_OUT IS SET TO "INACTIVE" OR ANY OTHER DTC ARE RETRIEVED, DO NOT
CONTINUE WITH THIS PROCEDURE, PERFORM NORMAL DIAGNOSTICS PER THE WORK
SHOP MANUAL SECTION 501-03.
3. If both the DTC B117B and the PID UCH_Out equal "Active" are present, then clear the LTM
memory and proceed to Step 4.
4. Reprogram the LTM module to the latest calibration using IDS release 55.13 Patch 28 and
higher or 56.1 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2008.7 DVD. Calibration
files may also be obtained at the website.
5. Initialize LTM per Work Shop Manual Section 501-03.
6. Check the operation of the power lift gate. Check for any DTCs. If lift gate operation passes from
all switches and there are NO DTCs in the LTM, return the vehicle to the customer.
7. If any DTCs are present after retesting or lift gate is inoperative, from any switches, perform
Work Shop Manual diagnosis per Section 501-03.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081405A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator, Edge, MKX, 2008 Taurus X, 2009 Flex: Reprogram The LTM, Includes Time To Check
DTCs And, Lift Gate Operation, Authorization Decal Not Required (Do Not Use With 12650D,
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Trunk / Liftgate
Control Module: > 08-14-5 > Jul > 08 > Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC B117B > Page 8790
12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8791
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8792
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Diagrams
C4174A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8793
C4174B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8794
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Service and Repair
POWER LIFTGATE MODULE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the power liftgate motor assembly.
2. Remove the power liftgate module.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors and remove the 3 bolts. To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Heated Seat Module
Seat Heater Control Module: Locations Heated Seat Module
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Heated Seat Module > Page 8799
View 151-20 (Rear Seats)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Heated Seat Module > Page 8800
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Heated Seat Module > Page 8801
Seat Heater Control Module: Locations Climate Controlled Seat Backrest Module
View 151-18 (Driver Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Heated Seat Module > Page 8802
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Heated Seat Module > Page 8803
Seat Heater Control Module: Locations Climate Controlled Seat Cushion Module
View 151-18 (Driver Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Heated Seat Module > Page 8804
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Seat Module
Seat Heater Control Module: Diagrams Heated Seat Module
C329
C3162
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Seat Module > Page 8807
Seat Heater Control Module: Diagrams Climate Controlled Seat Module, Passenger Side
C3036A
C3036B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Seat Module > Page 8808
C3036C
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Seat Module > Page 8809
Seat Heater Control Module: Diagrams Climate Controlled Seat Backrest Module
C3322
C3326
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Seat Module > Page 8810
Seat Heater Control Module: Diagrams Climate Controlled Seat Cushion Module
C3327
C3328
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Climate Controlled Seat Module
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair Climate Controlled Seat Module
CLIMATE CONTROLLED SEAT MODULE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an airbag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- When installing a new climate control seat module (CCSM), it is necessary to carry out
programmable module installation (PMI).
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Before removing the climate control seat module (CCSM), carry out the appropriate steps in the
programmable module installation (PMI)
procedure.
2. Position the front passenger seat to access all the seat track-to-floor bolts and the safety belt
retractor belt anchor nut. 3. Depower the SRS. 4. Remove the front passenger seat. 5. Remove the
CCSM.
- Disconnect the 3 electrical connectors.
- Remove the 2 screws.
- Remove the CCSM.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 7. Install the front passenger seat and repower the
SRS. Do not prove out the SRS at this time. 8. Carry out the Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS)
System Zero Seat Weight Test and prove out the SRS. 9. Install the CCSM software data. Carry
out the appropriate steps in the PMI procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Climate Controlled Seat Module > Page 8813
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair Heated Seat Module
Front
HEATED SEAT MODULE - FRONT
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an airbag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Position the front passenger seat to access the heated seat module. 2. Depower the SRS. 3.
From under the front of the front passenger seat, remove the heated seat module.
- Vehicles with power seat track, remove the 2 screws and lower the bracket (if equipped).
- Disconnect the heated seat module electrical connector.
- Remove the screw and heated seat module.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 5. Repower the SRS. Do not prove out the SRS at this
time. 6. Carry out the Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Zero Seat Weight Test and
prove out the SRS.
Rear
HEATED SEAT MODULE - REAR SEAT
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the second row 60 percent seat front riser-to-floor nut and bolt.
- To install, tighten to 70 Nm (52 lb-ft).
2. Pivot the front of the 60 percent seat cushion upward. 3. Remove the screw, disconnect the
electrical connector and remove the heated seat module. 4. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Luggage Rack > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Luggage Rack: Service and Repair
ROOF RACK
Removal and Installation
NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Luggage Rack > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 8818
1. Remove the rear roof rack bolt cover.
- Lift upward on the rear of the bolt cover and then pull rearward.
2. Remove the front roof rack bolt cover.
- Lift upward on the front of the bolt cover and then pull forward.
3. Remove the 2 front roof rack bolts.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
4. Remove the 2 rear roof rack bolts.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Luggage Rack > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 8819
5. NOTE: The roof rack side rail has a tab located at the front of the ditch moulding and it is
installed under the windshield moulding. When
installing the roof rack side rail, start at the front of the vehicle and work toward the rear.
Remove the roof rack side rail. Start at the rear of the roof rack side rail working toward the front of the vehicle.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- The 4 roof rack bolts are installed in a specific order starting with the front bolt and working toward
the rear of the vehicle. The bolts must be installed in that order to make sure the roof rack side rail
is correctly aligned.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sun Shade >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Sun Shade: Service and Repair
ROOF OPENING PANEL - EXPLODED VIEW
Exterior Trim, Seals, Fixed Glass And End Caps
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sun Shade >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8824
Air Deflector Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sun Shade >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8825
Sliding Glass, Blinds And Primary Seal
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sun Shade >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8826
Idler Track And Mechanism
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sun Shade >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8827
Front And Rear Sunshade Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sun Shade >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8828
Rear Trim Ring Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sun Shade >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8829
Roof Opening Panel Motor(s) And Electrical
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sun Shade >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8830
Motor Block And Drive Tube Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sun Shade >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8831
Guide Tracks And Mechanisms
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sun Shade >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8832
Front Guide Track Mechanism
ROOF OPENING PANEL SHADE ASSEMBLY
Removal and Installation
Front and rear shade assembly
1. Move the glass to the fully CLOSED position. 2. Remove the headliner.
Front shade assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sun Shade >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8833
3. NOTE: The shade is under spring tension.
Depress the tabs and slide the guide bar (leading edge of shade) forward to release it from the
mechanism guide shoes and allow the shade to retract completely.
4. Remove the 2 front sunshade carrier outer screws.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
5. Remove the 2 front sunshade carrier center screws and the front sunshade assembly.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
Rear shade assembly
6. Open the rear shade to the half open position.
7. NOTE:
- Front guide shown, rear similar.
- The shade is under spring tension.
Depress the tabs and slide the guide bar (leading edge of shade) forward to release it from the
mechanism guide shoes and allow the shade to retract completely.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sun Shade >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8834
8. Remove the 2 rear sunshade carrier-to-housing screws and the rear sunshade assembly.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
Front and rear shade assembly
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Initialize the roof opening panel motor(s).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-28 (Roof - With Panoramic Vista Roof)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Locations > Page 8838
C920
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Motor - Shades
Sunroof / Moonroof Motor: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel Motor - Shades
ROOF OPENING PANEL MOTOR - SHADES
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: The roof opening panel shade motor contains ceramic magnets that may fail at any time
if cracked. Any roof opening panel shade motor that has been dropped onto a hard surface during
removal or installation should be replaced with a new motor.
1. Remove the headliner.
2. Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. NOTE: During installation, it may be necessary to rotate the motor clockwise or counterclockwise
for the gear teeth to set into the drive cable
correctly.
Remove the 3 motor screws and the motor assembly. To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Initialize the roof opening panel motor(s).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Motor - Shades > Page 8841
Sunroof / Moonroof Motor: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel Motor Block and Drive Tube
Assembly - Shades
ROOF OPENING PANEL MOTOR BLOCK AND DRIVE TUBE ASSEMBLY - SHADES
Removal
NOTE: There may be a special service replacement fastener available if a screw hole becomes
stripped during installation.
1. Remove the roof opening panel sliding glass. 2. Remove the front and rear shade assemblies. 3.
Remove the roof opening panel shade motor. 4. Remove the roof opening panel sliding glass
motor. 5. Manually move the sliding front glass mechanisms and shade mechanisms rearward.
6. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Remove the LH and RH rear drive tube bracket-to-housing screws.
7. NOTE: Make note of all the cable wrap locations, they must be reinstalled at the exact same
locations.
Cut cable wraps to the shade motor block and drive tube assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Motor - Shades > Page 8842
8. NOTE:
- LH shown, RH similar.
- Carefully mark the location of each guide track in 3 places before removing any fasteners. The
guide tracks must be installed in exactly the same position.
Remove the LH and RH rear 12 front guide track-to-housing screws.
9. NOTE:
- Carefully mark the location of each shade track in 3 places before removing any fasteners. The
shade tracks must be installed in exactly the same position.
- LH shown, RH similar.
Remove the LH and RH 6 rear shade track-to-housing screws.
10. CAUTION: Support the sliding glass motor block and drive tube assembly.
NOTE: Protect the vehicle interior from cable grease.
With the rear of the front guide tracks lowered, carefully pull the front shade guide feet out of the
rear of the front guide tracks to release the cable. Remove the shade tracks and the motor block
and tube assembly as one unit.
11. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Remove the LH and RH rear shade track-to-drive tube bracket screws and pull the motor block
tube out of the shade track.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Motor - Shades > Page 8843
12. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Remove the LH and RH rear shade track stop screws.
13. NOTE: If installing a new LH or RH rear shade track, use the cable supplied with the
replacement unit.
Pull the shade cables through the front of the shade track assemblies.
Installation
1. NOTE: If installing a new LH or RH rear shade track, use the cable supplied with the
replacement unit.
Feed the shade cables through the front of the shade track assemblies.
2. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Install the LH and RH rear shade track stop screws.
3. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Push the shade motor block tubes into the rear of the shade track assemblies and install the LH
and RH rear shade track-to-drive tube bracket screws. Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
4. NOTE:
- Protect the vehicle interior from cable grease.
- Make sure the front drive tubes are seated fully into the front guide tracks.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Motor - Shades > Page 8844
Holding the shade tracks and the motor block and tube assembly as one unit, insert the front shade
cables into the mechanisms. Move the mechanisms fully into the front guide tracks.
5. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Install the center rear shade track-to-housing screws but do not tighten at this time.
6. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Install the LH and RH 12 front guide track-to-housing screws. Align the track to the marks previously made. Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
7. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Install the remaining 4 rear shade track-to-housing screws. Align the track to the marks previously made. Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Motor - Shades > Page 8845
8. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Install the LH and RH rear drive tube bracket-to-housing screws. Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
9. NOTE:
- Be careful not to overtighten cable wraps during assembly to prevent crimping the cable sheath.
- The cable wraps must be reinstalled at the exact same locations.
Install new cable wraps to the shade motor block and drive tube assembly.
10. NOTE: Do not install the headliner at this time.
Install the front and rear shade assemblies but do not carry out the roof opening panel motor
initialization at this time. Shades.
11. Manually move the sliding front glass mechanisms forward until they are flush against the track
hard-stops.
12. NOTE: Do not install the headliner at this time.
Install the roof opening panel sliding glass motor but do not carry out the initialization at this time.
13. Carefully move the front and rear shades rearward to the fully OPEN position by pushing at the
edges closest to the tracks. 14. Install the roof opening panel shade motor but do not carry out the
initialization at this time. 15. With the roof opening sliding glass panel still removed, initialize the
roof opening panel motor(s).
16. NOTE:
- Press the glass open switch to move the mechanisms rearward to allow installation of the sliding
glass panel.
- It will be necessary to carry out the initialization procedure again after the glass panel is installed.
Install the roof opening panel sliding glass.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Motor - Shades > Page 8846
Sunroof / Moonroof Motor: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel Motor Block and Drive Tube
Assembly - Sliding Front Panel
ROOF OPENING PANEL MOTOR BLOCK AND DRIVE TUBE ASSEMBLY - SLIDING FRONT
PANEL
Removal
NOTE: There may be a special service replacement fastener available if a screw hole becomes
stripped during installation.
1. Remove the roof opening sliding glass panel. 2. Remove the front and rear shade assemblies. 3.
Remove the roof opening panel shade motor. 4. Remove the roof opening sliding glass panel
motor. 5. Manually move the sliding front glass mechanisms and shade mechanisms rearward.
6. NOTE: Make note of all the cable wrap locations, they must be reinstalled at the exact same
locations.
Cut cable wraps to the motor block and drive tube assembly and wiring harness.
7. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Remove the front drive tube bracket-to-guide track screws.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Motor - Shades > Page 8847
8. NOTE: Carefully mark the location of each guide track in 3 places before removing any
fasteners. The guide tracks must be installed in exactly
the same position.
LH shown, RH similar. Remove the LH and RH rear 12 front track-to-housing screws.
9. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Remove the LH and RH rear drive tube bracket-to-housing screws.
10. NOTE:
- Carefully mark the location of each shade track in 3 places before removing any fasteners. The
shade tracks must be installed in exactly the same position.
- LH shown, RH similar.
- Support the shade track and shade motor block and tube assembly.
Remove the LH and RH 6 rear shade track-to-housing screws.
11. NOTE: Protect the vehicle interior from cable grease.
Carefully pull the sliding glass front drive tube brackets out of the guide tracks.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Motor - Shades > Page 8848
12. NOTE:
- It is only necessary to pull the mechanisms halfway out of the guide tracks to disengage the
cables. If the mechanisms are completely removed from the track, they will need to be
reassembled first.
- LH shown, RH similar.
With the rear of the front guide tracks lowered, carefully pull the front sliding glass mechanisms
halfway out of the guide tracks to disconnect the drive cables and remove the motor block and tube
assembly.
Installation
1. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Insert the drive cables into the sliding glass mechanisms and insert the mechanisms completely
into the guide tracks.
2. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Install the center rear shade track-to-housing screws but do not tighten at this time.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Motor - Shades > Page 8849
3. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Install the LH and RH 12 front guide track-to-housing screws. Align the track to the marks previously made. Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
4. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Install the front drive tube bracket-to-guide track screws. Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
5. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Install the remaining 4 rear shade track-to-housing screws. Align the track to the marks previously made. Tighten all shade track-to-housing screws to 5 Nm
(44 lb-in).
6. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Motor - Shades > Page 8850
Install the LH and RH rear drive tube bracket-to-housing screws. Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
7. NOTE:
- Be careful not to overtighten cable wraps during assembly to prevent crimping the cable sheath.
- The cable wraps must be reinstalled at the exact same locations.
Install new cable wraps to the shade motor block and drive tube assembly.
8. NOTE: Do not install the headliner at this time.
Install the front and rear shade assemblies but do not carry out the roof opening panel motor
initialization at this time.
9. Manually move the sliding front glass mechanisms forward until they are flush against the track
hard-stops.
10. NOTE: Do not install the headliner at this time.
Install the roof opening panel sliding glass motor but do not carry out the initialization at this time.
11. Carefully move the front and rear shades rearward to the fully OPEN position by pushing at the
edges closest to the tracks. 12. Install the roof opening panel shade motor but do not carry out the
initialization at this time. 13. With the roof opening sliding glass panel still removed, initialize the
roof opening panel motor(s).
14. NOTE:
- Press the glass open switch to move the mechanisms rearward to allow installation of the sliding
glass panel.
- It will be necessary to carry out the initialization procedure again after the glass panel is installed.
Install the roof opening panel sliding glass.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Motor - Shades > Page 8851
Sunroof / Moonroof Motor: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel Motor - Sliding Front Panel
ROOF OPENING PANEL MOTOR - SLIDING FRONT PANEL
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: The roof opening panel sliding glass motor contains ceramic magnets that may fail at
any time if cracked. Any roof opening panel sliding glass motor that has been dropped onto a hard
surface during removal or installation should be replaced with a new motor.
1. Remove the headliner.
2. Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. NOTE: During installation, it may be necessary to rotate the motor clockwise or counterclockwise
for the gear teeth to set into the drive cable
correctly,
Remove the 3 motor screws and the motor assembly. To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Initialize the roof opening panel motor(s).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-28 (Roof - With Panoramic Vista Roof)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 8855
C912
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 8856
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Service and Repair
ROOF OPENING PANEL CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the overhead console. 2. Disengage the clips and remove the switch from the overhead
console. 3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Track:
> 07-25-4 > Dec > 07 > Body - Sunroof Slow Operation/Sticking/Binding
Sunroof / Moonroof Track: Customer Interest Body - Sunroof Slow Operation/Sticking/Binding
TSB 07-25-4
12/24/07
ROOF OPENING PANEL SLOW OR STICKING/BINDING OPERATION
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles equipped with a roof opening panel and built before
8/1/2007 may experience a roof opening panel operating slow or sticking. This may be caused by
the roof opening panel guide tracks being out of specification.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove roof opening panel guide track mechanism following Workshop Manual (WSM), Section
501-17.
2. Remove both ditch moldings and clip strips. (Figure 1)
3. Remove both side panel end caps. (Figure 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Track:
> 07-25-4 > Dec > 07 > Body - Sunroof Slow Operation/Sticking/Binding > Page 8865
4. Tape painted roof area next to panels to prevent damage to paint. (Figure 3)
5. Remove and discard both roof opening panel trims.
CAUTION
MAKE SURE THE CUTTING BLADES ARE CHANGED WHERE THE CUTTING DEPTH
CHANGES TO AVOID DAMAGE TO THE BODY OR GLASS.
NOTE
LUBRICATE THE URETHANE ADHESIVE WITH WATER TO AID THE SPECIAL TOOL WHEN
CUTTING THE URETHANE ADHESIVE.
a. Cut the urethane adhesive with a pneumatic knife and remove. (Figure 4)
6. Carefully mark the location of both idler tracks in 3 places before removing any fasteners. The
new idler tracks must be installed in exactly the same position. Left hand shown, right hand similar.
7. Remove the six (6) rear idler track-to-housing screws. (Figure 5) There is a special Replacement
Screw available if a screw hole becomes stripped
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Track:
> 07-25-4 > Dec > 07 > Body - Sunroof Slow Operation/Sticking/Binding > Page 8866
during installation. For additional information, WSM, Section 501-17.
8. Completely loosen the two (2) center rear idler track-to-housing screws. The screws will be
captured inside the track rail. In some cases it may be necessary to lift rails to completely remove
screws from roof threads to allow idler track removal. (Figure 6)
9. Slide idler track rearward to disengage the idler track from the front clip.
10. Remove the idler track.
11. Remove the two (2) center screws from the idler track and install back into the roof opening
module. Hand tighten the two (2) center screws.
12. Repeat Steps 6 through 10 for the opposite side idler track.
13. Trim urethane adhesive to 0.01" (0.5 mm) base of original equipment urethane along the roof
opening module surface.
14. Using a soft brush or vacuum, remove any dirt or foreign material from the roof opening module
surface.
15. Touch up scratches on roof opening module from cutting old panels off. Refer to WSM, Section
501-35 Restoring Corrosion Protection Following Repair.
16. Modify new idler tracks prior to installation. (Figure 7)
a. Locate the screw head access in the new idler tracks.
b. Measure and mark at the screw head access, 2 clearance slots on the inside edge of each new
idler track, 1/2" (13 mm) wide and 3/16" (5 mm) deep.
c. Cut slots using a small die grinder or equivalent. View shows after modification of a new idler
track. (Figure 7)
17. Install the new idler tracks.
a. Using slots, position new idler track into module.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Track:
> 07-25-4 > Dec > 07 > Body - Sunroof Slow Operation/Sticking/Binding > Page 8867
18. Loosen the two (2) center rear idler track-to-housing screws and slide new idler track into
proper position. Loosen screws only to allow idler track to slide, do not remove.
19. Install and tighten remaining six (6) rear idler track-to-housing screws to 35 lb-in (4 N.m).
20. Tighten the two (2) center rear idler track to housing screws to 35 lb-in (4 N.m).
21. Repeat Steps 16 through 19 for the opposite side idler track.
22. Install roof opening panel guide track mechanism following WSM, Section 501-17.
NOTE
DO NOT INSTALL ROOF OPENING PANEL TRIMS AT THIS TIME.
23. Test operation of roof opening panel and adjust as necessary.
CAUTION
WHEN INSTALLING URETHANE-INSTALLED PARTS, THE VEHICLE MUST NOT BE DRIVEN
UNTIL THE URETHANE HAS CURED. ADEQUATE CURE TIME IS SPECIFIED ON THE DRIVE
AWAY CHART FOR EACH URETHANE PRODUCT AS THE TEMPERATURES AND HUMIDITY
VARY. INADEQUATE OR INCORRECT CURING CAN ADVERSELY AFFECT THE RETENTION
OF THE TRIM PANEL .
NOTE
BE SURE TO USE THE SAME BRAND OF CURE-RATE PRODUCTS FOR THE ADHESIVE AND
PRIMER. DO NOT MIX DIFFERENT BRANDS OF URETHANE AND PRIMER. REFER TO WSM,
SECTION 501-17.
24. Cut the urethane adhesive applicator tip to the specification. (Figure 8)
NOTE
USE EITHER A HIGH-RATIO, ELECTRIC OR BATTERY-OPERATED CAULK GUN THAT WILL
APPLY THE URETHANE WITH LESS EFFORT AND A CONTINUOUS BEAD.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Track:
> 07-25-4 > Dec > 07 > Body - Sunroof Slow Operation/Sticking/Binding > Page 8868
25. Apply a smooth continuous bead of urethane adhesive on top of the existing trimmed urethane
adhesive bead. Make sure that all gaps in the urethane adhesive are smoothed into one
continuous bead. (Figure 9)
26. Insert the front of the trim panel into the front trim seal then rotate the rear of the side trim panel
down to engage. Apply the side trim panel assembly to the roof module. (Figure 10)
27. Install both side panel end caps.
28. Install the clip strip and ditch moldings.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072504A 2007 Edge AWD, FWD, 6.0 Hrs.
2007 MKX AWD, FWD: Replace Roof Opening Panel Idler Tracks, Includes Time to Cut Slots in
New Idler Tracks and Replace Roof Opening Panel Side Trim. Remove and Install ditch molding,
Headliner, Pillar and Quarter Trim Panels, Roof Opening Panel Glass, Shade and Motor, Adjust
Roof Panel Glass and Re-initialize Motor. (Do Not Use With 50282B, 51902A, 15790A, 04104A,
51916B, 31012A, 15790A, 14056D, 51916A, 50222A)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Track:
> 07-25-4 > Dec > 07 > Body - Sunroof Slow Operation/Sticking/Binding > Page 8869
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7851070 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof /
Moonroof Track: > 07-25-4 > Dec > 07 > Body - Sunroof Slow Operation/Sticking/Binding
Sunroof / Moonroof Track: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Sunroof Slow
Operation/Sticking/Binding
TSB 07-25-4
12/24/07
ROOF OPENING PANEL SLOW OR STICKING/BINDING OPERATION
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007 Edge and MKX vehicles equipped with a roof opening panel and built before
8/1/2007 may experience a roof opening panel operating slow or sticking. This may be caused by
the roof opening panel guide tracks being out of specification.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove roof opening panel guide track mechanism following Workshop Manual (WSM), Section
501-17.
2. Remove both ditch moldings and clip strips. (Figure 1)
3. Remove both side panel end caps. (Figure 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof /
Moonroof Track: > 07-25-4 > Dec > 07 > Body - Sunroof Slow Operation/Sticking/Binding > Page 8875
4. Tape painted roof area next to panels to prevent damage to paint. (Figure 3)
5. Remove and discard both roof opening panel trims.
CAUTION
MAKE SURE THE CUTTING BLADES ARE CHANGED WHERE THE CUTTING DEPTH
CHANGES TO AVOID DAMAGE TO THE BODY OR GLASS.
NOTE
LUBRICATE THE URETHANE ADHESIVE WITH WATER TO AID THE SPECIAL TOOL WHEN
CUTTING THE URETHANE ADHESIVE.
a. Cut the urethane adhesive with a pneumatic knife and remove. (Figure 4)
6. Carefully mark the location of both idler tracks in 3 places before removing any fasteners. The
new idler tracks must be installed in exactly the same position. Left hand shown, right hand similar.
7. Remove the six (6) rear idler track-to-housing screws. (Figure 5) There is a special Replacement
Screw available if a screw hole becomes stripped
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof /
Moonroof Track: > 07-25-4 > Dec > 07 > Body - Sunroof Slow Operation/Sticking/Binding > Page 8876
during installation. For additional information, WSM, Section 501-17.
8. Completely loosen the two (2) center rear idler track-to-housing screws. The screws will be
captured inside the track rail. In some cases it may be necessary to lift rails to completely remove
screws from roof threads to allow idler track removal. (Figure 6)
9. Slide idler track rearward to disengage the idler track from the front clip.
10. Remove the idler track.
11. Remove the two (2) center screws from the idler track and install back into the roof opening
module. Hand tighten the two (2) center screws.
12. Repeat Steps 6 through 10 for the opposite side idler track.
13. Trim urethane adhesive to 0.01" (0.5 mm) base of original equipment urethane along the roof
opening module surface.
14. Using a soft brush or vacuum, remove any dirt or foreign material from the roof opening module
surface.
15. Touch up scratches on roof opening module from cutting old panels off. Refer to WSM, Section
501-35 Restoring Corrosion Protection Following Repair.
16. Modify new idler tracks prior to installation. (Figure 7)
a. Locate the screw head access in the new idler tracks.
b. Measure and mark at the screw head access, 2 clearance slots on the inside edge of each new
idler track, 1/2" (13 mm) wide and 3/16" (5 mm) deep.
c. Cut slots using a small die grinder or equivalent. View shows after modification of a new idler
track. (Figure 7)
17. Install the new idler tracks.
a. Using slots, position new idler track into module.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof /
Moonroof Track: > 07-25-4 > Dec > 07 > Body - Sunroof Slow Operation/Sticking/Binding > Page 8877
18. Loosen the two (2) center rear idler track-to-housing screws and slide new idler track into
proper position. Loosen screws only to allow idler track to slide, do not remove.
19. Install and tighten remaining six (6) rear idler track-to-housing screws to 35 lb-in (4 N.m).
20. Tighten the two (2) center rear idler track to housing screws to 35 lb-in (4 N.m).
21. Repeat Steps 16 through 19 for the opposite side idler track.
22. Install roof opening panel guide track mechanism following WSM, Section 501-17.
NOTE
DO NOT INSTALL ROOF OPENING PANEL TRIMS AT THIS TIME.
23. Test operation of roof opening panel and adjust as necessary.
CAUTION
WHEN INSTALLING URETHANE-INSTALLED PARTS, THE VEHICLE MUST NOT BE DRIVEN
UNTIL THE URETHANE HAS CURED. ADEQUATE CURE TIME IS SPECIFIED ON THE DRIVE
AWAY CHART FOR EACH URETHANE PRODUCT AS THE TEMPERATURES AND HUMIDITY
VARY. INADEQUATE OR INCORRECT CURING CAN ADVERSELY AFFECT THE RETENTION
OF THE TRIM PANEL .
NOTE
BE SURE TO USE THE SAME BRAND OF CURE-RATE PRODUCTS FOR THE ADHESIVE AND
PRIMER. DO NOT MIX DIFFERENT BRANDS OF URETHANE AND PRIMER. REFER TO WSM,
SECTION 501-17.
24. Cut the urethane adhesive applicator tip to the specification. (Figure 8)
NOTE
USE EITHER A HIGH-RATIO, ELECTRIC OR BATTERY-OPERATED CAULK GUN THAT WILL
APPLY THE URETHANE WITH LESS EFFORT AND A CONTINUOUS BEAD.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof /
Moonroof Track: > 07-25-4 > Dec > 07 > Body - Sunroof Slow Operation/Sticking/Binding > Page 8878
25. Apply a smooth continuous bead of urethane adhesive on top of the existing trimmed urethane
adhesive bead. Make sure that all gaps in the urethane adhesive are smoothed into one
continuous bead. (Figure 9)
26. Insert the front of the trim panel into the front trim seal then rotate the rear of the side trim panel
down to engage. Apply the side trim panel assembly to the roof module. (Figure 10)
27. Install both side panel end caps.
28. Install the clip strip and ditch moldings.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072504A 2007 Edge AWD, FWD, 6.0 Hrs.
2007 MKX AWD, FWD: Replace Roof Opening Panel Idler Tracks, Includes Time to Cut Slots in
New Idler Tracks and Replace Roof Opening Panel Side Trim. Remove and Install ditch molding,
Headliner, Pillar and Quarter Trim Panels, Roof Opening Panel Glass, Shade and Motor, Adjust
Roof Panel Glass and Re-initialize Motor. (Do Not Use With 50282B, 51902A, 15790A, 04104A,
51916B, 31012A, 15790A, 14056D, 51916A, 50222A)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof /
Moonroof Track: > 07-25-4 > Dec > 07 > Body - Sunroof Slow Operation/Sticking/Binding > Page 8879
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7851070 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism
Sunroof / Moonroof Track: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism
ROOF OPENING PANEL - EXPLODED VIEW
Exterior Trim, Seals, Fixed Glass And End Caps
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8882
Air Deflector Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8883
Sliding Glass, Blinds And Primary Seal
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8884
Idler Track And Mechanism
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8885
Front And Rear Sunshade Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8886
Rear Trim Ring Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8887
Roof Opening Panel Motor(s) And Electrical
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8888
Motor Block And Drive Tube Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8889
Guide Tracks And Mechanisms
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8890
Front Guide Track Mechanism
ROOF OPENING PANEL SHADE TRACK AND MECHANISM
Removal and Installation
NOTE: This procedure is for the rear shade track only. To service the front shade track, refer to
Roof Opening Panel Guide Track and Mechanism.
1. The shade track and mechanisms are removed as an assembly with the shade motor block and
drive tube assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8891
Sunroof / Moonroof Track: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel Guide Track and Mechanism
ROOF OPENING PANEL - EXPLODED VIEW
Exterior Trim, Seals, Fixed Glass And End Caps
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8892
Air Deflector Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8893
Sliding Glass, Blinds And Primary Seal
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8894
Idler Track And Mechanism
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8895
Front And Rear Sunshade Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8896
Rear Trim Ring Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8897
Roof Opening Panel Motor(s) And Electrical
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8898
Motor Block And Drive Tube Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8899
Guide Tracks And Mechanisms
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8900
Front Guide Track Mechanism
ROOF OPENING PANEL GUIDE TRACK AND MECHANISM
Removal
NOTE: There may be a special service replacement fastener available if a screw hole becomes
stripped during installation.
1. Remove the roof opening panel blind. 2. Remove the roof opening panel sliding glass.
3. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8901
Remove the air deflector-to-track screw and air deflector arm capture plate on the affected track.
4. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Remove the air deflector catcher bracket outer screw on the affected track.
5. Remove the front shade assembly. 6. Remove the roof opening panel sliding glass motor. 7.
Move the sliding glass mechanism to the full forward position on the affected track.
8. Remove the front drive tube bracket-to-guide-track screw.
9. NOTE: Carefully mark the location of the guide track in 3 places before removing any fasteners.
The new guide track must be installed in exactly
the same position.
Remove the 8 front track-to-housing screws.
10. CAUTION: Protect the vehicle interior from grease when cable assembly is withdrawn from the
drive tube.
Drop the front of the guide track down while sliding the entire track and mechanism assembly
forward and down. The drive cable will slowly withdraw from the drive tube until the entire assembly
is free.
Installation
1. CAUTION: Protect the vehicle interior from grease when cable assembly is inserted into the
drive tube.
While holding the track and mechanism assembly, slowly insert the sliding glass drive cable into
the drive tube. Insert the shade cable into the
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8902
track and make sure the front drive tube bracket is fully seated into the track assembly.
2. Install the 8 front track-to-housing screws.
- Align the track to the marks previously made. Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. Install the front drive tube bracket-to-guide-track screw. Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
4. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Install the air deflector catcher bracket outer screw on the affected track. Tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
5. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Install the air deflector-to-track screw and air deflector arm capture plate on the affected track.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8903
- NOTE: If the nut plate(s) becomes stripped during installation, a new nut plate can be installed.
Tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
6. Attach the bottom of the concertina blind to the guide track in the most forward position.
7. NOTE: Do not install the headliner at this time.
Install the front shade assembly but do not carry out the roof opening panel motor initialization.
8. Re-time the roof opening panel.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8904
Sunroof / Moonroof Track: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel Idler Track Mechanism
ROOF OPENING PANEL - EXPLODED VIEW
Exterior Trim, Seals, Fixed Glass And End Caps
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8905
Air Deflector Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8906
Sliding Glass, Blinds And Primary Seal
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8907
Idler Track And Mechanism
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8908
Front And Rear Sunshade Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8909
Rear Trim Ring Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8910
Roof Opening Panel Motor(s) And Electrical
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8911
Motor Block And Drive Tube Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8912
Guide Tracks And Mechanisms
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8913
Front Guide Track Mechanism
ROOF OPENING PANEL IDLER TRACK MECHANISM
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the roof opening panel sliding glass. 2. Remove the roof opening panel side trim.
3. Carefully slide the idler link forward and out of the front of the track.
4. CAUTION: Make sure the idler mechanism guide shoes are compressed and aligned correctly
during installation. The guide shoes
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8914
cannot be serviced separately.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8915
Sunroof / Moonroof Track: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel Idler Track and Mechanism
ROOF OPENING PANEL - EXPLODED VIEW
Exterior Trim, Seals, Fixed Glass And End Caps
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8916
Air Deflector Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8917
Sliding Glass, Blinds And Primary Seal
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8918
Idler Track And Mechanism
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8919
Front And Rear Sunshade Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8920
Rear Trim Ring Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8921
Roof Opening Panel Motor(s) And Electrical
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8922
Motor Block And Drive Tube Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8923
Guide Tracks And Mechanisms
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8924
Front Guide Track Mechanism
ROOF OPENING PANEL IDLER TRACK AND MECHANISM
Removal and Installation
NOTE: There may be a special service replacement fastener available if a screw hole becomes
stripped during installation.
1. Remove the roof opening panel sliding glass. 2. Remove the roof opening panel side trim.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Shade Track and Mechanism >
Page 8925
3. CAUTION: Carefully mark the location of the idler track in 3 places before removing any
fasteners. The new idler track must be
installed in exactly the same position.
NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Remove the 6 rear idler track-to-housing screws. To install, tighten to 4 Nm (35 lb-in).
4. Completely loosen the 2 center rear idler track-to-housing screws.
- To install, tighten to 4 Nm (35 lb-in).
5. Slide track rearward to disengage front clip and remove assembly. 6. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Windguard > Component Information > Service and Repair
Sunroof / Moonroof Windguard: Service and Repair
ROOF OPENING PANEL - EXPLODED VIEW
Exterior Trim, Seals, Fixed Glass And End Caps
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Windguard > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8929
Air Deflector Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Windguard > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8930
Sliding Glass, Blinds And Primary Seal
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Windguard > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8931
Idler Track And Mechanism
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Windguard > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8932
Front And Rear Sunshade Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Windguard > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8933
Rear Trim Ring Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Windguard > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8934
Roof Opening Panel Motor(s) And Electrical
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Windguard > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8935
Motor Block And Drive Tube Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Windguard > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8936
Guide Tracks And Mechanisms
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Windguard > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8937
Front Guide Track Mechanism
AIR DEFLECTOR
Removal and Installation
NOTE: There may be a special service replacement fastener available if a screw hole becomes
stripped during installation.
1. Position the roof opening panel glass to the full OPEN position.
2. Remove the 2 air deflector-to-track screws and air deflector arm capture plate.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Windguard > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8938
- NOTE: If the nut plate(s) becomes stripped during installation, a new nut plate can be installed.
To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
3. Remove the 6 air deflector catcher bracket screws.
- To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
4. Remove the air deflector assembly. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel: > 07-16-11 > Aug > 07 > Body - Rattle/Squeak From Roof Opening Panel
Sunroof / Moonroof Interior Trim Panel: Customer Interest Body - Rattle/Squeak From Roof
Opening Panel
TSB 07-16-11
08/20/07
ROOF OPENING PANEL SQUEAK/RATTLE
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007 Ford Edge and Lincoln MKX vehicles equipped with a roof opening panel may
exhibit a rattle or squeak from the rear glass area. This may be caused by the delamination of the
rear trim ring hook and loop (Velcro) adhesive. Inspect the rear trim ring and if loose, determine if
the loop tape has delaminated from the plastic trim ring.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
If delamination of the hook and loop has occurred, use the following procedure to correct the
concern. If no delamination has occurred, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 100-04
diagnostics.
1. Remove rear trim ring per WSM, Section 501-17.
2. Inspect all loop tape locations for delamination. (Figure 1)
3. Remove all delaminated loop tape from module. (Figure 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel: > 07-16-11 > Aug > 07 > Body - Rattle/Squeak From Roof Opening Panel > Page 8947
4. Clean trim ring attachment surface with a Isopropyl Alcohol or Rubbing Alcohol (IPA) wipe
(Figure 3).
5. Allow surface to dry.
6. Apply Motorcraft(R) Instant Gel Adhesive to trim ring surface. (Figures 4 and 5)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel: > 07-16-11 > Aug > 07 > Body - Rattle/Squeak From Roof Opening Panel > Page 8948
Apply loop pad to trim ring. (Figure 6)
8. Allow adhesive to dry per Motorcraft® Instant Gel Adhesive recommendation.
9. Reinstall trim ring to vehicle per WSM, Section 501-17.
10. Clean roof opening panel glass with Motorcraft(R) Ultra Clear Spray Glass Cleaner or
equivalent.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071611A 2007 Edge/MKX With Roof 0.4 Hr.
Opening Panel: Reapply Loop And Pad To Trim Ring, Includes Time To Remove And Install Trim
Ring, Clean Glass
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7050036 24
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Sunroof / Moonroof Interior Trim Panel: > 07-16-11 > Aug > 07 > Body - Rattle/Squeak From Roof Opening Panel
Sunroof / Moonroof Interior Trim Panel: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Rattle/Squeak From
Roof Opening Panel
TSB 07-16-11
08/20/07
ROOF OPENING PANEL SQUEAK/RATTLE
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007 Ford Edge and Lincoln MKX vehicles equipped with a roof opening panel may
exhibit a rattle or squeak from the rear glass area. This may be caused by the delamination of the
rear trim ring hook and loop (Velcro) adhesive. Inspect the rear trim ring and if loose, determine if
the loop tape has delaminated from the plastic trim ring.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
If delamination of the hook and loop has occurred, use the following procedure to correct the
concern. If no delamination has occurred, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 100-04
diagnostics.
1. Remove rear trim ring per WSM, Section 501-17.
2. Inspect all loop tape locations for delamination. (Figure 1)
3. Remove all delaminated loop tape from module. (Figure 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Sunroof / Moonroof Interior Trim Panel: > 07-16-11 > Aug > 07 > Body - Rattle/Squeak From Roof Opening Panel > Page
8954
4. Clean trim ring attachment surface with a Isopropyl Alcohol or Rubbing Alcohol (IPA) wipe
(Figure 3).
5. Allow surface to dry.
6. Apply Motorcraft(R) Instant Gel Adhesive to trim ring surface. (Figures 4 and 5)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Sunroof / Moonroof Interior Trim Panel: > 07-16-11 > Aug > 07 > Body - Rattle/Squeak From Roof Opening Panel > Page
8955
Apply loop pad to trim ring. (Figure 6)
8. Allow adhesive to dry per Motorcraft® Instant Gel Adhesive recommendation.
9. Reinstall trim ring to vehicle per WSM, Section 501-17.
10. Clean roof opening panel glass with Motorcraft(R) Ultra Clear Spray Glass Cleaner or
equivalent.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071611A 2007 Edge/MKX With Roof 0.4 Hr.
Opening Panel: Reapply Loop And Pad To Trim Ring, Includes Time To Remove And Install Trim
Ring, Clean Glass
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7050036 24
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior
Sunroof / Moonroof Interior Trim Panel: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed
Glass, Interior
ROOF OPENING PANEL - EXPLODED VIEW
Exterior Trim, Seals, Fixed Glass And End Caps
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8958
Air Deflector Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8959
Sliding Glass, Blinds And Primary Seal
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8960
Idler Track And Mechanism
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8961
Front And Rear Sunshade Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8962
Rear Trim Ring Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8963
Roof Opening Panel Motor(s) And Electrical
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8964
Motor Block And Drive Tube Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8965
Guide Tracks And Mechanisms
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8966
Front Guide Track Mechanism
ROOF OPENING PANEL TRIM - FIXED GLASS, INTERIOR
Removal and Installation
1. Position the sunshade(s) to the fully OPEN position. 2. Carefully bend/pry the trim ring from its
hook-and-loop tape pads.
3. NOTE: A piece of paper may assist in keeping the hook-and-loop tape from sticking while
aligning the trim ring. Once the trim ring is in position
(front and rear locating pins lined up), remove the paper and press the trim firmly in place.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8967
Sunroof / Moonroof Interior Trim Panel: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel Trim - Front
ROOF OPENING PANEL - EXPLODED VIEW
Exterior Trim, Seals, Fixed Glass And End Caps
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8968
Air Deflector Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8969
Sliding Glass, Blinds And Primary Seal
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8970
Idler Track And Mechanism
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8971
Front And Rear Sunshade Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8972
Rear Trim Ring Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8973
Roof Opening Panel Motor(s) And Electrical
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8974
Motor Block And Drive Tube Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8975
Guide Tracks And Mechanisms
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8976
Front Guide Track Mechanism
ROOF OPENING PANEL TRIM - FRONT
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8977
Special Tool(s)
Material
Material
Removal
1. Position the roof opening sliding glass panel to the fully OPEN position. 2. Remove the antenna.
3. NOTE: A new roof opening panel front trim seal is supplied with the new front trim panel.
Remove the roof opening panel front trim seal.
4. CAUTION: Make sure the cutting blades are changed where the cutting depth changes to avoid
damage to the body, trim panels or
windshield moulding.
NOTE: Lubricate the urethane adhesive with water to aid the special tool when cutting the urethane
adhesive. Using the special tool, place the flat side of the knife against the roof module.
Refer to the adhesive path illustration and begin cutting at the center of the front trim panel and
work through towards the opposite corners.
5. Rotate the trim panel up and forward to clear the side trim panel. Cut off or bend the 2 steel
alignment tabs if necessary. 6. Remove the front trim panel assembly and discard.
Installation
CAUTION: When installing urethane-installed parts, the vehicle must not be driven until the
urethane has cured. Adequate cure time is specified on the drive away chart for each urethane
product as the temperatures and humidity vary. Inadequate or incorrect curing can adversely affect
the retention of the trim panel.
NOTE: For additional material guidelines, refer to the manufacturer's installation information.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8978
1. NOTE: Avoid scratching the painted surfaces. For minor scratches or exposed metal, see the
manufacturer's recommendations.
Using an appropriate tool, trim the urethane adhesive and pads leaving no more than 0.5 mm (0.01
in) base of original equipment urethane along the roof opening module surface.
2. NOTE: Make sure the water channel is free from any foreign material.
Using a soft brush or vacuum, remove any dirt or foreign material from the roof opening panel
module. Clean residual adhesive tape from the housing using a suitable cleaner.
3. CAUTION: Be sure to use the same brand of cure-rate products for the adhesive and primer. Do
not mix different brands of urethane
and primer.
Cut the urethane adhesive applicator tip to the specification.
4. NOTE: Use either a high-ratio, electric or battery-operated caulk gun that will apply the urethane
with less effort and a continuous bead.
Apply urethane adhesive on top of the existing trimmed urethane adhesive bead. Make sure that all
gaps in the urethane adhesive are smoothed into one continuous bead.
5. CAUTION: Make sure the windshield moulding does not get pinched under the front trim panel.
The windshield moulding should be
pulled over the top of the leading edge of the trim panel during installation.
NOTE: Position front trim panel to best overall appearance.
Apply the front trim panel assembly to the roof module. Work the trim panel down using only
vertical pressure.
6. Install the antenna.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8979
Sunroof / Moonroof Interior Trim Panel: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel Trim - Side
ROOF OPENING PANEL - EXPLODED VIEW
Exterior Trim, Seals, Fixed Glass And End Caps
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8980
Air Deflector Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8981
Sliding Glass, Blinds And Primary Seal
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8982
Idler Track And Mechanism
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8983
Front And Rear Sunshade Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8984
Rear Trim Ring Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8985
Roof Opening Panel Motor(s) And Electrical
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8986
Motor Block And Drive Tube Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8987
Guide Tracks And Mechanisms
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8988
Front Guide Track Mechanism
ROOF OPENING PANEL TRIM - SIDE
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8989
Special Tool(s)
Material
Material
Removal
1. Remove the ditch mouldings and clip strip. 2. Remove the end cap.
3. NOTE: If installing a new roof opening panel side trim panel, the trim panel seal is supplied with
the new trim panel.
Remove the roof opening panel side trim seal.
4. CAUTION: Make sure the cutting blades are changed where the cutting depth changes to avoid
damage to the body or glass panel seals.
NOTE: Lubricate the urethane adhesive with water to aid the special tool when cutting the urethane
adhesive. Using the special tool, place the flat side of the knife against the roof module.
- Distance the side trim panel from the roof module as needed.
- Position the sliding glass panel as required for necessary access.
Refer to the adhesive path illustration and begin cutting at the rear corner of the side trim panel and
work forward through all urethane and rubber net pads.
5. Rotate the rear of the side trim panel upward to unlatch from the front trim assembly. Remove
the side trim panel.
Installation
CAUTION: When installing urethane-installed parts, the vehicle must not be driven until the
urethane has cured. Adequate cure time is specified on the drive away chart for each urethane
product as the temperatures and humidity vary. Inadequate or incorrect curing can adversely affect
the retention of the trim panel.
NOTE: For additional material guidelines, refer to the manufacturer's installation information.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Trim - Fixed Glass,
Interior > Page 8990
1. NOTE: Avoid scratching the painted surfaces. For minor scratches or exposed metal, see the
manufacturer's recommendations.
Using an appropriate tool, trim the urethane adhesive leaving no more than 0.5 mm (0.01 in) base
of original equipment urethane along the roof opening module surface.
2. NOTE: Make sure the water channel is free from any foreign material.
Using a soft brush or vacuum, remove any dirt or foreign material from the roof opening panel
module.
3. CAUTION: Be sure to use the same brand of cure-rate products for the adhesive and primer. Do
not mix different brands of urethane
and primer. Refer to the Materials Chart in this procedure.
Cut the urethane adhesive applicator tip to the specification.
4. NOTE: Use either a high-ratio, electric or battery-operated caulk gun that will apply the urethane
with less effort and a continuous bead.
Apply urethane adhesive on top of the existing trimmed urethane adhesive bead. Make sure that all
gaps in the urethane adhesive are smoothed into one continuous bead.
5. NOTE: Position side trim panel to best overall appearance.
Insert the front of the trim panel into the front trim seal then rotate the rear of the side trim panel
down to engage. Apply the side trim panel assembly to the roof module.
6. Install the end cap. 7. Work the glass panel down using only vertical pressure. 8. Install the ditch
mouldings and clip strip.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Panel:
> 07-16-11 > Aug > 07 > Body - Rattle/Squeak From Roof Opening Panel
Sunroof / Moonroof Panel: Customer Interest Body - Rattle/Squeak From Roof Opening Panel
TSB 07-16-11
08/20/07
ROOF OPENING PANEL SQUEAK/RATTLE
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007 Ford Edge and Lincoln MKX vehicles equipped with a roof opening panel may
exhibit a rattle or squeak from the rear glass area. This may be caused by the delamination of the
rear trim ring hook and loop (Velcro) adhesive. Inspect the rear trim ring and if loose, determine if
the loop tape has delaminated from the plastic trim ring.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
If delamination of the hook and loop has occurred, use the following procedure to correct the
concern. If no delamination has occurred, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 100-04
diagnostics.
1. Remove rear trim ring per WSM, Section 501-17.
2. Inspect all loop tape locations for delamination. (Figure 1)
3. Remove all delaminated loop tape from module. (Figure 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Panel:
> 07-16-11 > Aug > 07 > Body - Rattle/Squeak From Roof Opening Panel > Page 8999
4. Clean trim ring attachment surface with a Isopropyl Alcohol or Rubbing Alcohol (IPA) wipe
(Figure 3).
5. Allow surface to dry.
6. Apply Motorcraft(R) Instant Gel Adhesive to trim ring surface. (Figures 4 and 5)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Panel:
> 07-16-11 > Aug > 07 > Body - Rattle/Squeak From Roof Opening Panel > Page 9000
Apply loop pad to trim ring. (Figure 6)
8. Allow adhesive to dry per Motorcraft® Instant Gel Adhesive recommendation.
9. Reinstall trim ring to vehicle per WSM, Section 501-17.
10. Clean roof opening panel glass with Motorcraft(R) Ultra Clear Spray Glass Cleaner or
equivalent.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071611A 2007 Edge/MKX With Roof 0.4 Hr.
Opening Panel: Reapply Loop And Pad To Trim Ring, Includes Time To Remove And Install Trim
Ring, Clean Glass
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7050036 24
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel: > 07-16-11 > Aug > 07 > Body - Rattle/Squeak From Roof Opening Panel
Sunroof / Moonroof Panel: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Rattle/Squeak From Roof
Opening Panel
TSB 07-16-11
08/20/07
ROOF OPENING PANEL SQUEAK/RATTLE
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007 Ford Edge and Lincoln MKX vehicles equipped with a roof opening panel may
exhibit a rattle or squeak from the rear glass area. This may be caused by the delamination of the
rear trim ring hook and loop (Velcro) adhesive. Inspect the rear trim ring and if loose, determine if
the loop tape has delaminated from the plastic trim ring.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
If delamination of the hook and loop has occurred, use the following procedure to correct the
concern. If no delamination has occurred, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 100-04
diagnostics.
1. Remove rear trim ring per WSM, Section 501-17.
2. Inspect all loop tape locations for delamination. (Figure 1)
3. Remove all delaminated loop tape from module. (Figure 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel: > 07-16-11 > Aug > 07 > Body - Rattle/Squeak From Roof Opening Panel > Page 9006
4. Clean trim ring attachment surface with a Isopropyl Alcohol or Rubbing Alcohol (IPA) wipe
(Figure 3).
5. Allow surface to dry.
6. Apply Motorcraft(R) Instant Gel Adhesive to trim ring surface. (Figures 4 and 5)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel: > 07-16-11 > Aug > 07 > Body - Rattle/Squeak From Roof Opening Panel > Page 9007
Apply loop pad to trim ring. (Figure 6)
8. Allow adhesive to dry per Motorcraft® Instant Gel Adhesive recommendation.
9. Reinstall trim ring to vehicle per WSM, Section 501-17.
10. Clean roof opening panel glass with Motorcraft(R) Ultra Clear Spray Glass Cleaner or
equivalent.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071611A 2007 Edge/MKX With Roof 0.4 Hr.
Opening Panel: Reapply Loop And Pad To Trim Ring, Includes Time To Remove And Install Trim
Ring, Clean Glass
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7050036 24
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding
Sunroof / Moonroof Panel: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding
ROOF OPENING PANEL - EXPLODED VIEW
Exterior Trim, Seals, Fixed Glass And End Caps
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9010
Air Deflector Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9011
Sliding Glass, Blinds And Primary Seal
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9012
Idler Track And Mechanism
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9013
Front And Rear Sunshade Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9014
Rear Trim Ring Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9015
Roof Opening Panel Motor(s) And Electrical
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9016
Motor Block And Drive Tube Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9017
Guide Tracks And Mechanisms
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9018
Front Guide Track Mechanism
ROOF OPENING PANEL GLASS - FRONT SLIDING
Removal and Installation
1. Open the roof opening panel to the VENT position. 2. Detach the top of the concertina blind from
the moving glass frame. 3. Reposition the sliding glass panel to any position rearward of VENT
position.
4. Remove the 4 roof opening panel glass front screws.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9019
5. Remove the 2 roof opening panel glass rear screws.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
6. CAUTION: It is possible for the idler mechanism to move freely once the glass panel is removed.
Do not move the idler rearward or it
may disengage from the idler track.
Carefully remove the roof opening panel glass.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Initialize the roof opening panel motor(s).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9020
Sunroof / Moonroof Panel: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel Glass - Rear Fixed
ROOF OPENING PANEL - EXPLODED VIEW
Exterior Trim, Seals, Fixed Glass And End Caps
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9021
Air Deflector Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9022
Sliding Glass, Blinds And Primary Seal
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9023
Idler Track And Mechanism
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9024
Front And Rear Sunshade Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9025
Rear Trim Ring Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9026
Roof Opening Panel Motor(s) And Electrical
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9027
Motor Block And Drive Tube Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9028
Guide Tracks And Mechanisms
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9029
Front Guide Track Mechanism
ROOF OPENING PANEL GLASS - REAR FIXED
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9030
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Material
Material
Removal
WARNING: To prevent glass splinters from entering the eyes or cutting the hands, wear safety
glasses and heavy gloves when cutting the glass from the vehicle. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Remove the roof opening panel sliding glass. 2. Remove the headliner. 3. Remove the rear fixed
glass interior trim ring.
4. CAUTION: Make sure the cutting blades are changed where the cutting depth changes to avoid
damage to the body and trim panels.
NOTE:
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9031
- Lubricate the urethane adhesive with water to aid the special tool when cutting the urethane
adhesive. Using the special tool, place the flat side of the knife against the rear glass.
- Using the special tool 164-R2459 (or equivalent), distance the roof opening panel fixed glass from
the roof module as needed.
Refer to the adhesive path illustration and cut as follows:
1. CAUTION: Use caution when cutting to prevent damage to the fixed glass front trim seal.
From the inside of the vehicle, start at the front and work towards the front corners.
2. CAUTION: Use caution when cutting to prevent damage to the side trim seals.
Continue working along the side and towards the rear corners.
3. Continue around the inside rear adhesive path.
4. CAUTION: Use caution when cutting along the side to prevent damage to the side trim seals.
From the inside of the vehicle, work along the side of the glass.
5. From the inside of the vehicle, work from the center towards the rear corners. 5. Remove the
fixed glass panel assembly.
6. NOTE: Make sure the water channel is free from any foreign material.
Using a soft brush or vacuum, remove any dirt or foreign material from the roof opening panel
module.
Installation
CAUTION: When installing urethane-installed glass parts, the vehicle must not be driven until the
urethane has cured. Adequate cure time is specified on the drive away chart for each urethane
product as the temperatures and humidity vary. Inadequate or incorrect curing can adversely affect
the retention of the glass panel.
NOTE: For additional material guidelines, refer to the manufacturer's installation information.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9032
1. NOTE: Avoid scratching the painted surfaces. For minor scratches or exposed metal, see the
manufacturer's recommendations.
Using an appropriate tool, trim the urethane adhesive leaving a 1-2 mm (0.04-0.08 in) base of
original equipment urethane along the roof opening module surface.
2. Clean the inside of the glass surface with glass cleaner.
3. CAUTION: Be sure to use the same brand of cure-rate products for the adhesive and primer. Do
not mix different brands of urethane
and primer. Refer to the Materials Chart in this procedure.
Cut the urethane adhesive applicator tip to the specification.
4. NOTE: Use either a high-ratio, electric or battery-operated caulk gun that will apply the urethane
with less effort and a continuous bead.
Apply urethane adhesive on top of the existing trimmed urethane adhesive bead. Make sure that all
gaps in the urethane adhesive are smoothed into one continuous bead.
5. CAUTION: When installing urethane-installed glass parts, the vehicle must not be driven until the
urethane has cured. Adequate cure
time is specified on the drive away chart for each urethane product as the temperatures and
humidity vary. Inadequate or incorrect curing can adversely affect the retention of the glass panel.
Apply the fixed glass panel assembly to the roof module. Work the glass panel down using only
vertical pressure.
6. Install the rear fixed glass interior trim ring. 7. Install the headliner. 8. Install the roof opening
panel sliding glass.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9033
Sunroof / Moonroof Panel: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel Blind
ROOF OPENING PANEL - EXPLODED VIEW
Exterior Trim, Seals, Fixed Glass And End Caps
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9034
Air Deflector Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9035
Sliding Glass, Blinds And Primary Seal
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9036
Idler Track And Mechanism
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9037
Front And Rear Sunshade Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9038
Rear Trim Ring Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9039
Roof Opening Panel Motor(s) And Electrical
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9040
Motor Block And Drive Tube Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9041
Guide Tracks And Mechanisms
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel Glass - Front Sliding > Page 9042
Front Guide Track Mechanism
ROOF OPENING PANEL BLIND
Removal and Installation
1. Open the roof opening panel to the VENT position. 2. Detach the top of the concertina blind from
the moving glass frame. 3. Open the roof opening panel to the fully OPEN position. 4. Detach the
bottom of the concertina blind from the guide track and remove the blind.
- To install, the blind should be attached to the guide track in the most forward position.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
ROOF OPENING PANEL - EXPLODED VIEW
Exterior Trim, Seals, Fixed Glass And End Caps
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9046
Air Deflector Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9047
Sliding Glass, Blinds And Primary Seal
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9048
Idler Track And Mechanism
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9049
Front And Rear Sunshade Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9050
Rear Trim Ring Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9051
Roof Opening Panel Motor(s) And Electrical
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9052
Motor Block And Drive Tube Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9053
Guide Tracks And Mechanisms
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9054
Front Guide Track Mechanism
ROOF OPENING PANEL SEAL - PRIMARY
Removal
1. Remove the roof opening panel sliding glass. 2. Carefully peel off the primary seal.
- Clean residual adhesive tape from the housing using a suitable cleaner.
Installation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9055
Primary Seal Alignment
1. NOTE:
- The primary seal seam is placed at the rear centerline.
- Make sure the primary seal lip is facing outward.
Install the primary seal. Refer to the primary seal alignment figure.
2. NOTE: When the roof opening sliding glass panel is in the VENT position, the roof opening panel
primary seal should contact the leading edge
of the sliding glass.
Install the roof opening panel sliding glass. Initialize the roof opening panel motor(s).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Wiring Harness > Component Information > Service and Repair
Sunroof / Moonroof Wiring Harness: Service and Repair
ROOF OPENING PANEL MOTOR WIRING HARNESS
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the headliner. 2. Disconnect the electrical connectors to the roof opening panel sliding
glass motor, shade motor and main harness.
3. NOTE: Make note of all the cable wrap locations attaching the harness to the drive tubes, they
must be reinstalled at the exact same locations.
Remove the cable wraps and the wiring harness.
4. NOTE: Be careful not to overtighten cable wraps during assembly to prevent crimping the cable
sheath.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-18 (Driver Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9064
Memory Positioning Module: Diagrams
C3299A
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9065
C3299B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9066
C3299C
C3299D
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Memory Switch > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-21 (Driver Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Memory Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9070
C503
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Control Module > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Power Seat Control Module: Description and Operation
DRIVER SEAT MODULE - MEMORY SEAT
The power driver seat, power outside rear view mirrors and power adjustable pedals are controlled
by the driver seat module (DSM) only when the vehicle is equipped with the programmable/recall
memory option. The DSM is located on the driver seat track.
This system allows automatic positioning of the driver seat to 2 programmable positions.
- A power driver seat position can be stored at any time. The driver must move the seat to the
desired position using the driver seat switch assembly. The driver must then depress the memory
SET switch which activates the memory SET switch light emitting diode (LED). Within 5 seconds
(before the LED goes out), the driver must select a memory position. Memory 1 is selected by
depressing memory switch 1. Memory 2 is selected by depressing memory switch 2.
- If no memory switch input is received within the 5-second time limit, the operation is aborted and
the memory seat position switch (set switch) LED is turned OFF. This also occurs if one of the
following inputs is received during the 5-second programming limit: Driver seat control switch
- Memory seat position switch (set switch)
- Power adjustable pedal switch
A programmed seat position can only be recalled when the transmission selector is in PARK or
NEUTRAL with the ignition switch in the RUN position. A position may be programmed at any time.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 9078
View 151-18 (Driver Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 9079
View 151-18 (Driver Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 9080
View 151-18 (Driver Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 9081
Power Seat Motor: Locations
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 9082
View 151-18 (Driver Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 9083
View 151-18 (Driver Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 9084
View 151-18 (Driver Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 9085
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 9086
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 9087
View 151-18 (Driver Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 9088
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 9089
View 151-18 (Driver Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 9090
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor
C332
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 9093
C3074
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 9094
C3075
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 9095
C363
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 9096
Power Seat Motor: Diagrams
C332
C3074
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 9097
C3075
C363
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 9098
C382
C362
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 9099
C338
C368
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 9100
C3215
C3216
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Recliner Motor
Power Seat Motor: Service and Repair Seat Recliner Motor
SEAT RECLINER MOTOR
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an airbag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All seats
1. If equipped with power lumbar, release the tension on the power lumbar cable before removing
the seat from the vehicle. 2. Position the seat to access all the seat track-to-floor bolts and the
safety belt retractor belt anchor nut. 3. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). 4.
Remove the front seat. 5. Remove the cushion side shield in the following sequence.
1. NOTE: Release the tension on the manual lumbar cable before removing the manual lumbar
handle.
If equipped with manual lumbar, release the 2 clips on the back of the manual lumbar handle then
pull and remove the manual lumbar handle.
2. Remove the cushion side shield screw(s). 3. Slide the cushion side shield up in the rear to
release the retainer. 4. Slide the cushion side shield forward to disengage the retainer. 5.
Disconnect the seat control switch electrical connector.
- Remove the cushion side shield.
6. Remove the recliner side shield in the following sequence.
1. Remove the recliner side shield screws. 2. Pull out and remove the recliner side shield.
7. Release the backrest trim cover J-clips.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Recliner Motor > Page 9103
8. NOTE: RH side shown, LH similar.
Release the LH and RH backrest trim cover tether from the backrest frame.
9. Pull out at the bottom and detach the 2 lower hard back panel pin-type retainers.
10. Slide the hard back panel out of the backrest trim cover. 11. Push the backrest foam pad away
from the backrest frame. 12. Remove the recliner motor in the following sequence.
1. Remove the clip from the torque shaft on the recliner motor side. 2. Slide the torque shaft out of
the recliner and recliner motor. 3. Remove the recliner motor bolt.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
4. Disconnect and remove the recliner motor.
13. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 14. Install the front seat and repower the SRS. If a
passenger seat has been serviced, do not prove out the SRS at this time.
Passenger seat only
15. Carry out the Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Zero Seat Weight Test and prove
out the SRS.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat Recliner Motor > Page 9104
Power Seat Motor: Service and Repair Power-Fold Seat Motor - Rear Seat
POWER-FOLD SEAT MOTOR - REAR SEAT
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the affected 40 percent or 60 percent seat. 2. Remove 2 screws and the outboard lower
side shield. 3. Remove the power fold motor in the following sequence.
1. Remove the 2 screws from the power fold motor. 2. Slide the cable housing out of the recliner. 3.
Turn the cable end so the tab aligns with the slot in the lever and separate the cable. 4. Remove
the power fold motor.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page
9108
Power Seat Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page
9109
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Left
Rear
Power Seat Solenoid: Locations Left Rear
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Left
Rear > Page 9114
View 151-20 (Rear Seats)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Left
Rear > Page 9115
View 151-15 (Right Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Solenoid > Component Information > Diagrams > Left
Rear
C3317
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Solenoid > Component Information > Diagrams > Left
Rear > Page 9118
C3334
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Locations > Power
Seat Release Switch, Rear
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Locations > Power
Seat Release Switch, Rear > Page 9123
Power Seat Switch: Locations Power Seat Switch
View 151-18 (Driver Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Locations > Power
Seat Release Switch, Rear > Page 9124
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Power
Seat Release Switch, Rear
C4351
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Power
Seat Release Switch, Rear > Page 9127
Power Seat Switch: Diagrams Power Seat Switch
C352
C3016
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Power
Seat Release Switch, Rear > Page 9128
C355
C3026
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat > Page 9131
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat > Page 9132
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, 8- or 10-Way Power Seats
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat > Page 9133
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Memory Set Switch
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Memory Set Switch
MEMORY SET SWITCH
Memory SET Switch Edge
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Memory Set Switch > Page 9136
Memory SET Switch, MKX
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the driver door trim panel.
Edge vehicles
2. Disconnect the electrical connector, release the 4 tabs and remove the memory SET switch
through the front of the door trim panel.
MK-vehicles
3. Disconnect the electrical connector, release the 4 tabs and remove the memory SET switch
through the back of the door trim panel.
All vehicles
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Memory Set Switch > Page 9137
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Seat Control Switch-Front
Seat Control Switch - Front
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
Warning: To reduce the risk of accidental deployment, do not use any memory saver devices.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
NOTE: The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the
customer.
ALL SEATS
1. If possible, position the seat all the way up and center the seat in the front door opening.
2. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to See: Interior Moulding /
Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Air Bag(s) Arming and
Disarming/Service and Repair
3. Separate the safety belt retractor belt anchor from the seat in the following sequence.
1. Carefully pull up and out to remove the safety belt retractor belt anchor nut cover from the
cushion side shield. 2. Remove the safety belt anchor nut. To install, tighten to 47 Nm (35 lb-ft). 3.
Separate the safety belt retractor belt anchor from the seat.
4. Remove the seat control switch in the following sequence.
1. Pull out and remove the seat control switch knob(s). 2. If equipped with manual recline, release
the clip and remove the manual recline handle. 3. If equipped with manual lumbar, pull and remove
the manual lumbar handle. 4. Remove the cushion side shield screw(s). 5. Slide the cushion side
shield up in the rear to release the retailer. 6. Slide the cushion side shield forward to disengage
the retainer. 7. Release the cushion side shield clips and separate the seat control switch. 8.
Disconnect the seat control switch electrical connector and remove the switch.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
6. Repower the SRS. If a passenger seat has been serviced, do not prove out the SRS at this time.
Refer to See: Interior Moulding /
Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair
PASSENGER SEAT
7. Carry out the Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Zero Seat Weight Test and prove
out the SRS. Refer to See: Relays and
Modules/Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems/Seat Occupant Classification Module - Air Bag
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement
Seat Back: Removal and Replacement
SEAT BACKREST - FRONT
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an airbag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All seats 1. Position the seat to access all the seat track-to-floor bolts and the safety belt retractor
belt anchor nut. 2. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). 3. Remove the front seat. 4.
Remove the cushion side shield in the following sequence.
1. If equipped with manual recline, release the clip and remove the manual recline handle. 2. If
equipped with manual height adjust, pull and remove the manual height adjust handle.
3. NOTE: Release the tension on the manual lumbar cable before removing the manual lumbar
handle.
If equipped with manual lumbar, release the 2 clips on the back of the manual lumbar handle then
pull and remove the manual lumbar handle.
4. Remove the cushion side shield screw(s). 5. If equipped with power seat track, slide the cushion
side shield up in the rear to release the retainer. 6. Slide the cushion side shield forward to
disengage the retainer.
- If equipped with manual seat tracks, remove the cushion side shield.
7. If equipped with power seat tracks, disconnect the seat control switch electrical connector.
- Remove the cushion side shield.
5. Remove the screws and the recliner side shield.
Seats with manual lumbar 6. Remove the manual lumbar cable from the manual lumbar adjuster in
the following sequence.
1. Remove the manual lumbar adjuster bracket screw. 2. Separate the manual lumbar adjuster
from the bracket. 3. Remove the manual lumbar cable from the manual lumbar adjuster.
Passenger seat with fold flat backrest
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9142
7. Separate the recliner cable casing and Z-fitting from the LH fold flat recliner.
8. Separate the recliner cable casing and Z-fitting from the RH fold flat recliner.
All seats 9. Disconnect the following electrical connectors, release any retainers and route out the
wire harness for following components:
- Side air bag module (if equipped).
- Power lumbar motor (if equipped).
- Power recline motor (if equipped).
- Thermal electric device (TED) (if equipped).
- Backrest heater mat (if equipped).
10. Remove the 4 recliner-to-seat track bolts and remove the backrest assembly.
- If equipped, route out the manual lumbar cable.
Installation
All seats 1. Position the backrest assembly to the seat track and install the 4 recliner-to-seat track
bolts.
- Route the manual lumbar cable (if equipped).
- Tighten to 50 Nm (37 lb-ft).
2. Route the wire harnesses, connect the electrical connectors and attach the retainers for the
following parts. For correct front passenger seat cushion
wire harness routing, refer to Seat Wire Harness Routing-Front Passenger Cushion. See:
Locations The side air bag module.
- The power lumbar motor (if equipped).
- The power recline motor (if equipped).
- The thermal electric device (TED) (if equipped).
- The backrest heater mat (if equipped).
Passenger seat with fold flat backrest
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9143
3. Install the Z-fitting to the RH fold flat recliner and attach the recliner cable casing.
4. Install the Z-fitting to the LH fold flat recliner and attach the recliner cable casing.
5. Adjust the fold flat recliner cable in the following sequence.
1. Release the fold flat recliner cable locking clip, allowing the cable to self-adjust. 2. Position the
backrest upright, locking the recliners in place. 3. Apply force to the backrest, verifying the recliners
are locked in place. 4. Lock the locking clip back in place.
Seats with manual lumbar 6. Install the manual lumbar adjuster in the following sequence.
1. Install the manual lumbar cable to the manual lumbar adjuster. 2. Position the manual lumbar
adjuster to the bracket. 3. Install the manual lumbar adjuster bracket screw.
All seats 7. Position the recliner side shield and install the screws. 8. Install the cushion side shield
in the following sequence.
1. Position the side shield to the seat and connect the seat control switch electrical connector (if
equipped). 2. Slide the cushion side shield rearward to engage the cushion side shield retainer to
the seat track bracket. 3. If equipped with power seat track, slide the cushion side shield down in
the rear to engage the retainer. 4. Install the cushion side shield screw(s). 5. Install the manual
lumbar handle (if equipped). 6. Install the manual height adjust handle (if equipped). 7. Position the
clip on the manual recline handle and install the manual recline handle (if equipped).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9144
9. Install the front seat and repower the SRS. If a passenger seat has been serviced, do not prove
out the SRS at this time.
Passenger seat 10. Carry out the Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Zero Seat Weight
Test and prove out the SRS.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9145
Seat Back: Overhaul
Seat Backrest - Front, Without Fold Flat
SEAT BACKREST - FRONT, WITHOUT FOLD FLAT
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9146
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9147
Part 2
Disassembly and Assembly
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Carry a live side air bag module with the air bag and tear seam pointed away from your body.
This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live side air bag module down on the cover tear seam. This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Side air bag modules with damaged covers must be replaced.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9148
All seats
1. Position the seat to access all the seat track-to-floor bolts and the safety belt retractor belt
anchor nut. 2. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). 3. Remove the front seat. 4.
Remove the front seat backrest.
5. Release the backrest trim cover J-clips.
6. NOTE: RH side shown, LH similar.
Release the LH and RH backrest trim cover tether from the backrest frame.
7. Pull out at the bottom and detach the 2 lower hard back panel pin-type retainers. 8. Slide the
hard back panel out of the backrest trim cover.
9. Remove the head restraint.
1. Using an appropriate tool, push in the hole, lift up on the head restraint and release one side of
the head restraint. 2. Push the release button and remove the head restraint.
10. CAUTION: Always install a new slave head restraint guide.
Pull out and remove the master and slave head restraint guides.
11. CAUTION: When installing, make sure the side air bag module wiring harness is not pinched
between the side air bag module and the
backrest frame.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9149
NOTE: When installing the side air bag module, new bolts must be installed.
Remove the side air bag module. 1. Remove the 2 side air bag module bolts.
- To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 lb-ft).
2. Remove the side air bag module with wire harness.
- Detach any side air bag module wire harness retainers.
12. CAUTION: Use care when separating the backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strips, or
the hook-and-loop strips can be torn
from the backrest foam pad.
NOTE: A new heater mat will come attached on a new foam pad.
Remove the backrest trim cover from the backrest foam pad in the following sequence. 1. Invert the
backrest trim cover in an inside out fashion to the wire in the backrest trim cover attached to the
clips in the backrest foam pad
- Separate the hook-and-loop strips.
2. Separate the backrest trim cover wire from the clips in the backrest foam pad.
- If equipped with climate controlled seat, on assembly make sure the climate control seat manifold
is in place before snapping the backrest trim cover wire back into the backrest foam pad clips.
3. Remove the backrest trim cover.
13. Separate the backrest frame from the backrest foam pad.
- If equipped with climate controlled seats, on assembly make sure there is no air gap between the
backrest thermal electric device (TED) and the backrest foam pad.
Seats with climate control
14. Remove the backrest climate control seat manifold from the backrest foam pad. 15. Separate
the wire harness pin-type retainer from the backrest frame, remove the screw, release the 3 clips
and remove the TED.
Seats with power lumbar
16. Remove the power lumbar assembly in the following sequence.
1. Disconnect the power lumbar motor. 2. Release the power lumbar assembly clip at the top of the
backrest frame. 3. Slide the lumbar wire frame up and out at the bottom of the backrest frame. 4.
Remove the power lumbar assembly.
Seats with manual lumbar
17. Release the manual lumbar hooks from the backrest frame, route out the manual lumbar cable
and remove the manual lumbar assembly.
Seats with power recline
18. CAUTION: The recliners are synchronized. Avoid rotating the recliner shaft until fully installed.
Remove the power recline motor in the following sequence. 1. Remove the clip from the torque
shaft on the power recline motor side. 2. Slide out and remove the torque shaft. 3. Remove the
power recline motor bolt.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
4. Disconnect and remove the power recline motor.
19. NOTE:
- Manual recliners are only serviced with the backrest frame. Do not remove the bolts retaining the
manual recliners to the backrest frame.
- To install a new power recliner, using the torque shaft, rotate both recliners to their front or rear
stop.
Remove the 4 bolts and the inboard and outboard power recliners. To install, tighten to 50 Nm (37 lb-ft).
All seats
20. To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure. 21. Install the front seat backrest. 22. Install
the front seat and repower the SRS. If a passenger seat has been serviced, do not prove out the
SRS at this time.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9150
Passenger seat
23. Carry out the Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Zero Seat Weight Test and prove
out the SRS.
Seat Backrest - Front, With Fold Flat
SEAT BACKREST - FRONT, WITH FOLD FLAT
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9151
Front Seat Backrest, Manual Recline With Fold Flat (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9152
Front Seat Backrest, Manual Recline With Fold Flat (Part 2)
Disassembly and Assembly
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Carry a live side air bag module with the air bag and tear seam pointed away from your body.
This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live side air bag module down on the cover tear seam. This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Side air bag modules with damaged covers must be replaced.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Only the front passenger seat can come equipped with optional fold-flat backrest.
All seats
1. Position the seat to access all the seat track-to-floor bolts and the safety belt retractor belt
anchor nut. 2. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). 3. Remove the front seat. 4.
Remove the front seat backrest. 5. Remove the LH and RH outer fold flat recliner covers.
- Pull to release the clips.
- Slide up to disengage the retainer and remove.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9153
6. Remove the 4 fold flat recliner-to-fold flat backrest frame bolts.
- To install, tighten to 50 Nm (37 lb-ft).
- If necessary, remove the fold flat recliner cable.
7. Release the backrest trim cover lower J-clip.
8. NOTE: RH side shown, LH similar.
Release the LH and RH backrest trim cover tether from the backrest frame.
9. Pull out at the bottom and detach the 2 lower hard back panel pin-type retainers.
10. Slide the hard back panel out of the backrest trim cover.
11. Remove the head restraint.
1. Using an appropriate tool, push in the hole, lift up on the head restraint and release one side of
the head restraint. 2. Push the release button and remove the head restraint.
12. CAUTION: Always install a new slave head restraint guide.
Pull out and remove the master and slave head restraint guides.
13. CAUTION: When installing, make sure the side air bag module wiring harness is not pinched
between the side air bag module and the
backrest frame.
NOTE: When installing the side air bag module, new bolts must be installed.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9154
Remove the side air bag module. Remove the 2 side air bag module bolts. To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 lb-ft).
- Remove the side air bag module with wire harness. Detach any side air bag module wire harness retainers.
14. CAUTION: Use care when separating the backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strips, or
the hook-and-loop strips can be torn
from the backrest foam pad.
NOTE: A new heater mat will come attached on a new foam pad.
Remove the backrest trim cover. Invert the backrest trim cover in an inside out fashion to the wire in the backrest trim cover attached
to the clips in the backrest foam pad. Separate the hook-and-loop strips.
- Separate the backrest trim cover wire from the clips in the backrest foam pad.
- If equipped, feed out the backrest heater mat wire harness from the opening in the side of the
backrest trim cover.
- Remove the backrest trim cover.
15. Separate the backrest frame from the backrest foam pad. 16. To assemble, reverse the
disassembly procedure. 17. Install the front seat backrest. 18. Install the front seat and repower the
SRS. If a passenger seat has been serviced, do not prove out the SRS at this time.
Passenger seat
19. Carry out the Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Zero Seat Weight Test and prove
out the SRS.
Seat Backrest - Rear, 60 Percent
SEAT BACKREST - REAR, 60 PERCENT
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9155
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9156
Part 2
Disassembly and Assembly
WARNING: Never remove the recliner-to-backrest frame bolts or the recliner-to-floor anchor
assembly bolts. If these bolts are removed, and a specially designed fixture is not used for
reassembly, the recliner will bind and the seat back can fail in a crash. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in serious personal injury to the vehicle occupant.
All seats
1. Remove the 60 percent seat. 2. Remove the 60 percent cushion.
3. NOTE: Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted prior to installation.
Remove the bolt and separate the safety belt retractor belt and buckle anchor from the riser. To install, tighten to 65 Nm (48 lb-ft).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9157
4. Remove the head restraint.
1. Push in the hole, lift up on the head restraint and release one side of the head restraint. 2. Push
the release button and remove the head restraint. 3. Remove the safety belt comfort guide.
5. CAUTION: Always install a new slave head restraint guide.
Pull out and remove the master and slave head restraint guides.
6. Remove the armrest bracket trim cover pin-type retainer and the armrest bracket trim cover.
- Cycle the armrest up and down to aid trim cover removal.
7. Remove the armrest bolt.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
8. Remove the armrest.
- With the armrest upright, tip the outboard side of the armrest to disengage the stop from the
backrest frame channel.
9. Remove the pin-type retainer in the armrest pocket, attaching the backrest trim cover to the
backrest.
10. Release the tabs and remove the child safety seat tether anchor bezel.
- Repeat for the other child safety seat tether anchor bezel.
11. Remove the safety belt bezel screw cover, the screw and the safety belt bezel.
- During assembly, make sure the safety belt bezel clips in place.
12. Release the backrest trim cover lower J-clip.
- Pull the heated seat electrical connector through the backrest trim cover opening (if equipped).
13. At the rear inboard side of the backrest, access the zipper tucked up behind the back panel and
unzip the zipper. 14. Remove the 2 pin-type retainers holding the backrest trim cover around each
of the 2 lower anchors and tethers for children (LATCH) and
attaching to the lower rear of the backrest frame.
15. Remove the pin-type retainer from inside the safety belt comfort guide pocket. 16. Pull back the
backrest trim cover over the armrest bracket and backrest frame latching wire for the armrest. 17.
Remove the screw at the top and the pin-type retainer at the bottom of the armrest filler panel. 18.
Lift the armrest filler panel over the armrest pivot bracket and slide out to the outboard side of the
seat.
- During assembly, make sure the armrest filler panel clips in place around the backrest trim cover
J-clip, at the inboard side.
19. Release the backrest trim cover J-clip from the backrest frame in the armrest pocket.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9158
20. From the back, invert the backrest trim cover up and over the backrest frame and remove the
backrest trim cover and backrest foam pad.
21. CAUTION: Use care when separating the backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strips, or
the hook-and-loop strips can be torn
from the backrest foam pad.
NOTE: If a new heater mat or foam pad with heat are needed, the parts will already be assembled
from the factory. There is no need to remove the heater mat from the foam pad.
Remove the backrest trim cover from the backrest foam pad in the following sequence. 1. Invert the
backrest trim cover in an inside out fashion to the wire in the backrest trim cover attached to the
clips in the backrest foam pad.
- Separate the hook-and-loop strips.
2. Separate the backrest trim cover wire from the clips in the backrest foam pad. 3. Remove the
backrest trim cover.
- Feed the safety belt retractor belt and safety belt buckle through the backrest trim cover and
backrest foam pad.
22. Remove the backrest foam pad. 23. Release the retainers and remove the back panel. 24.
Remove the safety belt retractor nut, pin-type retainer under the safety belt and the safety belt
retractor.
- To install, tighten to 50 Nm (37 lb-ft).
25. Remove 2 screws and the outboard upper side shield. 26. Remove 2 screws and the inboard
upper side shield. 27. Remove 2 screws and the outboard lower side shield. 28. Remove 2 screws
and the inboard lower side shield. 29. Separate the recliner cable casing at both ends from the
recliners. 30. Remove the recliner cable in the following sequence.
1. Turn the cable end so the tab aligns with the slot in the lever and separate the cable at one end.
2. Turn the cable end so the tab aligns with the slot in the lever and separate the cable at the other
end.
- Remove the recliner cable.
Seats with power fold
31. Remove the power fold motor in the following sequence.
1. Remove the 2 screws from the power fold motor. 2. Slide the cable casing out of the recliner. 3.
Turn the cable end so the tab aligns with the slot in the lever and separate the cable. 4. Remove
the power fold motor.
Seats with heat
32. Disconnect the electrical connector, remove the screw and the heated seat module.
All seats
33. To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
- Check the active restraint system for correct operation. Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
- Make sure the LATCH is accessible to the occupant.
Seat Backrest - Rear, 40 Percent
SEAT BACKREST - REAR, 40 PERCENT
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9159
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9160
Part 2
Disassembly and Assembly
WARNING: Never remove the recliner-to-backrest frame bolts or the recliner-to-floor anchor
assembly bolts. If these bolts are removed, and a specially designed fixture is not used for
reassembly, the recliner will bind and the seat back can fail in a crash. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in serious personal injury to the vehicle occupant.
All seats
1. Remove the 40 percent seat. 2. Remove the 40 percent cushion.
3. Remove the head restraint.
1. Push in the hole, lift up on the head restraint and release one side of the head restraint. 2. Push
the release button and remove the head restraint. 3. Remove the safety belt comfort guide.
4. CAUTION: Always install a new slave head restraint guide.
Pull out and remove the master and slave head restraint guides.
5. Release the tabs and remove the child safety seat tether anchor bezel. 6. Release the backrest
trim cover lower J-clip.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9161
- Pull the heated seat electrical connector through the backrest trim cover opening (if equipped).
7. At the rear inboard side of the backrest, access the zipper tucked up behind the back panel and
unzip the zipper. 8. Remove the pin-type retainer holding the backrest trim cover around the lower
anchors and tethers for children (LATCH) and attaching to the
lower rear of the backrest frame.
9. Remove the pin-type retainer from inside the safety belt comfort guide pocket.
10. CAUTION: Use care when separating the backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strips, or
the hook-and-loop strips can be torn
from the backrest foam pad.
Release the hook-and-loop strips and invert the backrest trim cover in an inside out fashion to the
wire in the backrest trim cover attached to the clips in the backrest foam pad.
11. Separate the backrest trim cover wire from the clips in the backrest foam pad and remove the
backrest trim cover. 12. Remove the backrest foam pad. 13. Release the retainers and remove the
back panel. 14. Remove 2 screws and the outboard upper side shield. 15. Remove 2 screws and
the inboard upper side shield. 16. Remove 2 screws and the outboard lower side shield. 17.
Remove 2 screws and the inboard lower side shield. 18. Separate the recliner cable casing at both
ends from the recliners. 19. Remove the recliner cable in the following sequence.
1. Turn the cable end so the tab aligns with the slot in the lever and separate the cable at one end.
2. Turn the cable end so the tab aligns with the slot in the lever and separate the cable at the other
end.
- Remove the recliner cable.
Seats with power fold
20. Remove the power fold motor in the following sequence.
1. Remove the 2 screws from the power fold motor. 2. Slide the cable casing out of the recliner. 3.
Turn the cable end so the tab aligns with the slot in the lever and separate the cable. 4. Remove
the power fold motor.
All seats
21. To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
- Make sure the LATCH is accessible to the occupant.
- Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover
Seat Cover: Service and Repair Seat Backrest Cover
Without Fold Flat
SEAT BACKREST COVER - FRONT, WITHOUT FOLD FLAT
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an airbag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Carry a live side air bag module with the air bag and tear seam pointed away from your body.
This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live side air bag module down on the cover tear seam. This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Side air bag modules with damaged covers must be replaced.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a side air bag deployment took place a new seat back trim cover and side air bag module must
be installed. The seat back frame should be installed new if necessary.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All seats
1. Position the seat to access all the seat track-to-floor bolts and the safety belt retractor belt
anchor nut. 2. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). 3. Remove the front seat.
4. Release the backrest trim cover J-clips.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover > Page 9166
5. NOTE: RH side shown, LH similar.
Release the LH and RH backrest trim cover tether from the backrest frame.
6. Pull out at the bottom and detach the 2 lower hard back panel pin-type retainers. 7. Slide the
hard back panel out of the backrest trim cover.
8. Remove the head restraint.
1. Using an appropriate tool, push in the hole, lift up on the head restraint and release one side of
the head restraint. 2. Push the release button and remove the head restraint.
9. CAUTION: Always install a new slave head restraint guide.
Pull out and remove the master and slave head restraint guides.
10. CAUTION: When installing, make sure the side air bag module wiring harness is not pinched
between the side air bag module and the
backrest frame.
NOTE: When installing the side air bag module, new bolts must be installed.
Through the rear of the seat, remove and discard the 2 side air bag module bolts. Then separate
the side air bag module from the seat backrest. To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 lb-ft).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover > Page 9167
11. CAUTION:
- Do not pull the side air bag module electrical connector out by the locking button. Damage to the
locking button can occur.
- Do not install the side air bag module electrical connector by the locking button. Damage to the
locking button can occur.
- The side air bag module electrical connector locking button must be in the released position when
the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The side air bag module electrical connector is unique and cannot be reversed when connected
to the side air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the side air bag
module. Do not force the electrical connector into the side air bag module.
Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the side air bag
module electrical connector. With the locking button released, remove the electrical connector and
the side air bag module.
12. CAUTION: Use care when separating the backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strips, or
the hook-and-loop strips can be torn
from the backrest foam pad.
NOTE: A new heater mat will come assembled on a new foam pad.
Remove the backrest trim cover from the backrest foam pad in the following sequence. 1. Invert the
backrest trim cover in an inside out fashion to the wire in the backrest trim cover attached to the
clips in the backrest foam pad.
- Separate the hook-and-loop strips.
2. Separate the backrest trim cover wire from the clips in the backrest foam pad.
- If equipped with climate controlled seat (CCS), on assembly make sure the CCS manifold is in
place before snapping the backrest trim cover wire back into the backrest foam pad clips.
3. Remove the backrest trim cover.
- When installing the backrest trim cover, tuck the hook-and-loop strips into the backrest foam pad
trenches last to get the best trim cover appearance.
13. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 14. Install the front seat and repower the SRS. If a
passenger seat has been serviced, do not prove out the SRS at this time.
Passenger seat
15. Carry out the Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Zero Seat Weight Test and prove
out the SRS.
With Fold Flat
SEAT BACKREST COVER - FRONT, WITH FOLD FLAT
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover > Page 9168
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an airbag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Carry a live side air bag module with the air bag and tear seam pointed away from your body.
This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live side air bag module down on the cover tear seam. This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Side air bag modules with damaged covers must be replaced.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Only the front passenger seat can come equipped with optional fold-flat backrest.
All seats
1. Position the seat to access all the seat track-to-floor bolts and the safety belt retractor belt
anchor nut. 2. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). 3. Remove the front seat. 4.
Remove the LH and RH outer fold flat recliner covers in the following sequence.
1. Pull to release the clips. 2. Slide up to disengage the retainer and remove.
Seats with heat
5. From under the seat, disconnect the backrest heater mat electrical connector, release any
pin-type retainers and route out the wire harness.
All seats
6. From under the seat, disconnect the side air bag electrical connector, release any pin-type
retainers and route out the wire harness. 7. Remove the 4 fold flat recliner-to-fold flat backrest
frame bolts and remove the backrest.
- To install, tighten to 50 Nm (37 lb-ft).
8. Release the backrest trim cover J-clips.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover > Page 9169
9. NOTE: RH side shown, LH similar.
Release the LH and RH backrest trim cover tether from the backrest frame.
10. Pull out at the bottom and detach the 2 hard back panel pin-type retainers from the backrest
frame. 11. Slide the hard back panel out of the backrest trim cover.
12. Remove the head restraint.
1. Using an appropriate tool, push in the hole, lift up on the head restraint and release one side of
the head restraint. 2. Push the release button and remove the head restraint.
13. CAUTION: Always install a new slave head restraint guide.
Pull out and remove the master and slave head restraint guides.
14. CAUTION: Use care when separating the backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strips, or
the hook-and-loop strips can be torn
from the backrest foam pad.
Separate the backrest trim cover-to-backrest foam pad hook-and-loop strips.
15. CAUTION: When installing, make sure the side air bag module wiring harness is not pinched
between the side air bag module and the
backrest frame.
NOTE: When installing the side air bag module, new bolts must be installed.
Through the rear of the seat, remove and discard the 2 side air bag module bolts. Then separate
the side air bag module from the seat backrest. To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 lb-ft).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover > Page 9170
16. CAUTION:
- Do not pull the side air bag module electrical connector out by the locking button. Damage to the
locking button can occur.
- Do not install the side air bag module electrical connector by the locking button. Damage to the
locking button can occur.
- The side air bag module electrical connector locking button must be in the released position when
the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The side air bag module electrical connector is unique and cannot be reversed when connected
to the side air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the side air bag
module. Do not force the electrical connector into the side air bag module.
Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the side air bag
module electrical connector. With the locking button released, remove the electrical connector and
the side air bag module.
17. CAUTION: Use care when separating the backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strips, or
the hook-and-loop strips can be torn
from the backrest foam pad.
NOTE: A new heater mat will come assembled on a new foam pad.
Remove the backrest trim cover in the following sequence. 1. Invert the backrest trim cover in an
inside out fashion to the wire in the backrest trim cover attached to the clips in the backrest foam
pad.
- Separate the hook-and-loop strips.
2. Separate the backrest trim cover wire from the clips in the backrest foam pad. 3. If equipped,
feed out the backrest heater mat and side air bag module wire harness from the opening in the side
of the backrest trim cover. 4. Remove the backrest trim cover.
18. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- For correct front passenger seat cushion wire harness routing at installation, refer to Seat Wire
Harness Routing-Front Passenger Cushion. See: Locations
19. Install the front seat and repower the SRS. If a passenger seat has been serviced, do not prove
out the SRS at this time.
Passenger seat only
20. Carry out the Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Zero Seat Weight Test and prove
out the SRS.
40 Percent
SEAT BACKREST COVER - REAR, 40 PERCENT
Removal and Installation
NOTE: A new heater mat will come assembled on a new foam pad.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover > Page 9171
1. Remove the 40 percent seat. 2. Remove the 40 percent cushion.
3. Remove the head restraint.
1. Push in the hole, lift up on the head restraint and release one side of the head restraint. 2. Push
the release button and remove the head restraint. 3. Remove the safety belt comfort guide.
4. CAUTION: Always install a new slave head restraint guide.
Pull out and remove the master and slave head restraint guides.
5. Release the tabs and remove the child safety seat tether anchor bezel. 6. Release the backrest
trim cover lower J-clip.
- Pull the heated seat electrical connector through the backrest trim cover opening (if equipped).
7. At the rear inboard side of the backrest, access the zipper tucked up behind the back panel and
unzip the zipper. 8. Remove the pin-type retainer holding the backrest trim cover around the lower
anchors and tethers for children (LATCH) and attaching to the
lower rear of the backrest frame.
9. Remove the pin-type retainer from inside the safety belt comfort guide pocket.
10. CAUTION: Use care when separating the backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strips, or
the hook-and-loop strips can be torn
from the backrest foam pad.
Release the hook-and-loop strips and invert the backrest trim cover in an inside out fashion to the
wire in the backrest trim cover attached to the clips in the backrest foam pad.
11. Separate the backrest trim cover wire from the clips in the backrest foam pad and remove the
backrest trim cover. 12. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
60 Percent
SEAT BACKREST COVER - REAR, 60 PERCENT
Removal and Installation
NOTE: A new heater mat will come assembled on a new foam pad.
1. Remove the 60 percent seat. 2. Remove the 60 percent cushion.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover > Page 9172
3. NOTE: Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted prior to installation.
Remove the bolt and separate the safety belt retractor belt and buckle anchor from the riser. To install, tighten to 65 Nm (48 lb-ft).
4. Remove the head restraint.
1. Push in the hole, lift up on the head restraint and release one side of the head restraint. 2. Push
the release button and remove the head restraint. 3. Remove the safety belt comfort guide.
5. CAUTION: Always install a new slave head restraint guide.
Pull out and remove the master and slave head restraint guides.
6. Remove the armrest bracket trim cover pin-type retainer and the armrest bracket trim cover.
1 Cycle the armrest up and down to aid trim cover removal.
7. Remove the armrest bolt.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
8. Remove the armrest.
- With the armrest upright, tip the outboard side of the armrest to disengage the stop from the
backrest frame channel.
9. Remove the pin-type retainer in the armrest pocket, attaching the backrest trim cover to the
backrest.
10. Release the tabs and remove the child safety seat tether anchor bezel.
- Repeat for the other child safety seat tether anchor bezel.
11. Remove the safety belt bezel screw cover, the screw and the safety belt bezel.
- During assembly, make sure the safety belt bezel clips in place.
12. Release the backrest trim cover lower J-clip.
- Pull the heated seat electrical connector through the backrest trim cover opening (if equipped).
13. At the rear inboard side of the backrest, access the zipper tucked up behind the back panel and
unzip the zipper. 14. Remove the 2 pin-type retainers holding the backrest trim cover around each
of the 2 lower anchors and tethers for children (LATCH) and
attaching to the lower rear of the backrest frame.
15. Remove the pin-type retainer from inside the safety belt comfort guide pocket. 16. Pull back the
backrest trim cover over the armrest bracket and backrest frame latching wire for the armrest.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover > Page 9173
17. Remove the screw at the top and the pin-type retainer at the bottom of the armrest filler panel.
18. Lift the armrest filler panel over the armrest pivot bracket and slide out to the outboard side of
the seat.
- During assembly, make sure the armrest filler panel clips in place around the backrest trim cover
J-clip, at the inboard side.
19. Release the backrest trim cover J-clip from the backrest frame in the armrest pocket. 20. From
the back, invert the backrest trim cover up and over the backrest frame and remove the backrest
trim cover and backrest foam pad.
21. CAUTION: Use care when separating the backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strips, or
the hook-and-loop strips can be torn
from the backrest foam pad.
Remove the backrest trim cover from the backrest foam pad in the following sequence.
1. Invert the backrest trim cover in an inside out fashion to the wire in the backrest trim cover
attached to the clips in the backrest foam pad.
- Separate the hook-and-loop strips.
2. Separate the backrest trim cover wire from the clips in the backrest foam pad. 3. Remove the
backrest trim cover.
- Feed the safety belt retractor belt and safety belt buckle through the backrest trim cover and
backrest foam pad.
22. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Check the active restraint system for correct operation. Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
- Make sure the LATCH is accessible to the occupant.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover > Page 9174
Seat Cover: Service and Repair Seat Cushion Cover
Front
SEAT CUSHION COVER - FRONT
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All seats
1. Position the seat to access all the seat track-to-floor bolts and the safety belt retractor belt
anchor nut. 2. Depower the SRS. 3. Remove the front seat. 4. Remove the front seat cushion. 5.
Release the cushion trim cover retainers from the cushion frame and remove the cushion trim
cover and cushion foam pad.
6. CAUTION: Use care when separating the cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strips, or
the hook-and-loop strips can be torn
from the cushion foam pad.
NOTE: A new heater mat will come assembled on a new foam pad.
Remove the cushion trim cover in the following sequence. 1. Separate the hook-and-loop strips. 2.
Separate the cushion trim cover wire retainer from the clips in the cushion foam pad.
- For vehicles with climate controlled seats (CCS), on assembly make sure the CCS manifold is in
place before snapping the cushion trim cover wire retainer back into the cushion foam pad.
3. Remove the cushion trim cover.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 8. Install the front seat cushion.
- For correct front passenger seat cushion wire harness routing, refer to Seat Wire Harness
Routing-Front Passenger Cushion. See: Locations
9. Install the front seat and repower the SRS. If a passenger seat has been serviced, do not prove
out the SRS at this time.
Passenger seat
10. Carry out the Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Zero Seat Weight Test and prove
out the SRS.
40 Percent
SEAT CUSHION COVER - REAR, 40 PERCENT
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover > Page 9175
Removal and Installation
NOTE: A new heater mat will come assembled on a new foam pad.
1. Remove the 40 percent seat. 2. Release all the cushion trim cover-to-cushion frame retainers
and remove the cushion foam pad and cushion trim cover.
3. CAUTION: Use care when separating the cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strips, or
the hook-and-loop strips can be torn
from the cushion foam pad.
Remove the cushion trim cover in the following sequence. 1. Feed the heater mat wire harness and
electrical connectors back through the cushion trim cover (if equipped). 2. Release the
hook-and-loop strips. 3. Separate the cushion trim cover wire retainer from the clips in the cushion
foam pad and remove the cushion trim cover.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
60 Percent
SEAT CUSHION COVER - REAR, 60 PERCENT
Removal and Installation
NOTE: A new heater mat will come assembled on a new foam pad.
1. Remove the 60 percent seat. 2. Release all the cushion trim cover-to-cushion frame retainers
and remove the cushion foam pad and cushion trim cover.
3. CAUTION: Use care when separating the cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strips, or
the hook-and-loop strips can be torn
from the cushion foam pad.
Remove the cushion trim cover in the following sequence. 1. Feed the heater mat wire harness and
electrical connectors back through the cushion trim cover (if equipped). 2. Release the
hook-and-loop strips. 3. Separate the cushion trim cover wire retainer from the clips in the cushion
foam pad and remove the cushion trim cover.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement
Seat Cushion: Removal and Replacement
Seat Cushion - Front
SEAT CUSHION - FRONT
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an airbag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All seats 1. Position the seat to access all the seat track-to-floor bolts and the safety belt retractor
belt anchor nut. 2. Depower the SRS. 3. Remove the front seat. 4. Release all wire harness and
connector retainers to the cushion frame.
Passenger seat with fold flat backrest 5. Separate the fold flat recliner cable holders from the
bottom of the cushion frame.
Seats with climate control 6. Disconnect the cushion thermal electric device (TED).
Passenger seat with manual track and heat 7. Disconnect the heated seat module electrical
connector and separate the pin-type retainers from the cushion frame.
Seats with heat 8. Disconnect the 2 heated seat electrical connectors and separate the pin-type
retainers from the cushion frame.
All seats 9. Remove the 4 cushion frame-to-seat track bolts and the cushion assembly.
Installation
Passenger seat with fold flat backrest
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9180
1. Make sure the fold flat recliner cable is routed correctly between the power seat track cross tube
and cushion frame.
All seats 2. Position the cushion assembly and install the 4 cushion frame-to-seat track bolts.
- With power seat track, make sure the cushion frame-to-seat track rear brackets are aligned
correctly with the tabs seated in the cushion frame (if equipped).
- Tighten to 23 Nm (17 lb-ft).
All passenger seats 3. For correct front passenger seat cushion wire harness routing, refer to Seat
Wire Harness Routing-Front Passenger Cushion. See: Locations
Passenger seat with fold flat backrest 4. Attach the 2 fold flat recliner cable holders to the bottom of
the cushion frame.
Seats with heat 5. Route the heated seat wire harness, connect the 2 heated seat electrical
connectors and attach the pin-type retainers to the cushion frame.
Passenger seat with manual track and heat 6. Connect the heated seat module electrical connector
and attach the pin-type retainers to the cushion frame.
Seats with climate control 7. Connect the cushion TED.
All seats 8. Attach any remaining wire harness and connector retainers to the cushion frame. 9.
Install the front seat and repower the SRS. If a passenger seat has been serviced, do not prove out
the SRS at this time.
Passenger seat 10. Carry out the Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Zero Seat Weight
Test and prove out the SRS.
Seat Cushion - Rear, 40 Percent
SEAT CUSHION - REAR, 40 PERCENT
Removal and Installation
All seats
1. Remove the 40 percent seat.
Seats equipped with heat
2. Disconnect the backrest heater mat electrical connector. Separate the 2 heated seat electrical
connectors from the backrest assembly.
All seats
3. Release the tab and remove the outboard cushion frame pivot bracket cover. 4. Release the tab
and remove the inboard cushion frame pivot bracket cover. 5. Remove the 2 cushion frame pivot
bracket bolts and the cushion assembly.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Seat Cushion - Rear, 60 Percent
SEAT CUSHION - REAR, 60 PERCENT
Removal and Installation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9181
All seats
1. Remove the 60 percent seat.
Seats equipped with heat
2. Disconnect the 2 heater mat electrical connectors. Separate the 2 heater mat electrical
connectors from the backrest assembly.
All seats
3. Release the tab and remove the outboard cushion frame pivot bracket cover. 4. Release the tab
and remove the inboard cushion frame pivot bracket cover. 5. Remove the 2 cushion frame pivot
bracket bolts and the cushion assembly.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9182
Seat Cushion: Overhaul
Seat Cushion - Front
SEAT CUSHION - FRONT
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9183
Seat Cushion With Power Seat Track (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9184
Seat Cushion With Power Seat Track (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9185
Driver Seat Cushion With Manual Seat Track (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9186
Driver Seat Cushion With Manual Seat Track (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9187
Passenger Seat Cushion With Manual Seat Track (Part 1)
Passenger Seat Cushion With Manual Seat Track (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9188
Passenger Power Seat Track (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9189
Passenger Power Seat Track (Part 2)
Disassembly and Assembly
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Never probe the connector on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9190
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Driver seat shown, passenger seat similar.
All seats
1. Position the seat to access all the seat track-to-floor bolts and the safety belt anchor. 2. Depower
the supplemental restraint system (SRS). 3. Remove the front seat. 4. Remove the front seat
cushion. 5. Release the cushion trim cover retainers from the cushion frame and remove the
cushion trim cover and cushion foam pad.
6. CAUTION: Use care when separating the cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strips, or
the hook-and-loop strips can be torn
from the cushion foam pad.
NOTE: A new heater mat will come assembled on a new foam pad.
Remove the cushion trim cover from the cushion foam pad in the following sequence. 1. Separate
the hook-and-loop strips. 2. Separate the cushion trim cover wire retainer from the clips in the
cushion foam pad.
- For vehicles with climate controlled seat, on assembly make sure the climate control seat
manifold is in place before snapping the cushion trim cover wire retainer back into the cushion
foam pad.
Seats with climate control
7. Remove the cushion climate control seat manifold from the cushion foam pad. 8. Remove the 3
cushion thermal electric device (TED)-to-cushion frame screws. 9. Remove the cushion
TED-to-climate control seat cushion adapter screw and remove the TED.
10. Release the clips and remove the cushion TED adapter from the cushion frame.
Heated seats
11. Remove the screw and the heated seat module.
All seats
12. Release the retainers from the cushion frame and remove the cushion support.
All seats
13. To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure. 14. Install the front seat cushion.
- For correct front passenger seat cushion wire harness routing, refer to Seat Wire Harness
Routing-Front Passenger Cushion. See: Locations
15. Install the front seat and repower the SRS. If a passenger seat has been serviced, do not prove
out the SRS at this time.
Passenger seat
16. Carry out the Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Zero Seat Weight Test and prove
out the SRS.
Seat Cushion - Rear, 40 Percent
SEAT CUSHION - REAR, 40 PERCENT
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9191
Disassembly and Assembly
1. Remove the 40 percent seat. 2. Remove the 40 percent seat cushion. 3. Remove the 2 kneeling
assembly-to-cushion frame bolts. Remove the kneeling assembly.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
4. Release all the cushion trim cover-to-cushion frame retainers and remove the cushion foam pad
and cushion trim cover.
5. CAUTION: Use care when separating the cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strips, or
the hook-and-loop strips can be torn
from the cushion foam pad.
Remove the cushion trim cover in the following sequence. 1. Feed the heater mat wire harness and
electrical connectors back through the cushion trim cover (if equipped). 2. Release the
hook-and-loop strips. 3. Separate the cushion trim cover wire retainer from the clips in the cushion
foam pad and remove the cushion trim cover.
6. To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
Seat Cushion - Rear, 60 Percent
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9192
SEAT CUSHION - REAR, 60 PERCENT
Disassembly and Assembly
1. Remove the 60 percent seat. 2. Remove the 60 percent seat cushion. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and
the kneeling assembly.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
4. Release all the cushion trim cover-to-cushion frame retainers and remove the cushion foam pad
and cushion trim cover.
5. CAUTION: Use care when separating the cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strips, or
the hook-and-loop strips can be torn
from the cushion foam pad.
Remove the cushion trim cover in the following sequence. 1. Feed the heater mat wire harness and
electrical connectors back through the cushion trim cover (if equipped). 2. Release the
hook-and-loop strips. 3. Separate the cushion trim cover wire retainer from the clips in the cushion
foam pad and remove the cushion trim cover.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 9193
6. To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Seat Heater: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9198
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9199
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9200
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9201
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9202
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9203
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9204
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9205
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9206
Seat Heater: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9207
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9208
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9209
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9210
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9211
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9212
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9213
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9214
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9215
Seat Heater: Connector Views
C3283
C3284
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9216
C3167
C3169
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9217
Seat Heater: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
119-1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9218
119-2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9219
119-5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9220
119-6
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9221
119-7
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9222
119-8
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9223
119-9
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Thermo-Electric Device
Seat Heater: Service and Repair Seat Backrest Thermo-Electric Device
SEAT BACKREST THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an airbag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Carry a live side air bag module with the air bag and tear seam pointed away from your body.
This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live side air bag module down on the cover tear seam. This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- The backrest thermo-electric device (TED) filter is detachable from the TED assembly housing
and can be replaced without TED removal.
All seats
1. Position the seat to access all the seat track-to-floor bolts and the safety belt retractor belt
anchor nut. 2. Depower the SRS. 3. Remove the front seat.
4. Release the backrest trim cover J-clips.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Thermo-Electric Device > Page 9226
5. NOTE: RH side shown, LH similar.
Release the LH and RH backrest trim cover tether from the backrest frame.
6. Pull out at the bottom and detach the 2 lower hard back panel pin-type retainers. 7. Slide the
hard back panel out of the backrest trim cover.
8. Remove the head restraint.
1. Using an appropriate tool, push in the hole, lift up on the head restraint and release one side of
the head restraint. 2. Push the release button and remove the head restraint.
9. CAUTION: Always install a new slave head restraint guide.
Pull out and remove the master and slave head restraint guides.
10. CAUTION: When installing, make sure the side air bag module wiring harness is not pinched
between the side air bag module and the
backrest frame.
NOTE: When installing the side air bag module, new bolts must be installed.
Through the rear of the seat remove and discard the 2 side air bag module bolts. Then separate
the side air bag module from the seat backrest. To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 lb-ft).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Thermo-Electric Device > Page 9227
11. CAUTION:
- Do not pull the side air bag module electrical connector out by the locking button. Damage to the
locking button can occur.
- Do not install the side air bag module electrical connector by the locking button. Damage to the
locking button can occur.
- The side air bag module electrical connector locking button must be in the released position when
the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The side air bag module electrical connector is unique and cannot be reversed when connected
to the side air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the side air bag
module. Do not force the electrical connector into the side air bag module. Using a small
screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the side air bag module electrical
connector. With the locking button released, remove the electrical connector and the side air bag
module.
Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the side air bag
module electrical connector. With the locking button released, remove the electrical connector and
the side air bag module.
12. Separate the backrest frame from the backrest foam pad. 13. Remove the screw, release the 3
clips, disconnect the electrical connector and remove the backrest thermal electric device (TED).
14. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 15. Install the front seat and repower the SRS. If a
passenger seat has been serviced, do not prove out the SRS at this time.
Passenger seat
16. Carry out the Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Zero Seat Weight Test and prove
out the SRS.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Thermo-Electric Device > Page 9228
Seat Heater: Service and Repair Seat Cushion Thermo-Electric Device
SEAT CUSHION THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an airbag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- The cushion thermo-electric device (TED) filter is detachable from the TED assembly housing
from underneath the seat cushion.
All seats
1. Position the seat to access all the seat track-to-floor bolts and the safety belt retractor belt
anchor nut. 2. Depower the SRS. 3. Remove the front seat. 4. Remove the front seat cushion. 5.
Release the cushion trim cover retainers from the cushion frame and remove the cushion trim
cover and cushion foam pad. 6. Remove the 3 cushion thermal electric device (TED)-to-cushion
frame screws. 7. Remove the cushion TED-to-climate control seat cushion adapter screw and
remove the TED. 8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- For correct front passenger seat cushion wire harness routing, refer to Seat Wire Harness
Routing-Front Passenger Cushion. See: Locations
9. Install the front seat cushion assembly.
10. Install the front seat and repower the SRS. If a passenger seat has been serviced, do not prove
out the SRS at this time.
Passenger seat
11. Carry out the Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Zero Seat Weight Test and prove
out the SRS.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Heated Seat Module
Seat Heater Control Module: Locations Heated Seat Module
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Heated Seat Module > Page 9233
View 151-20 (Rear Seats)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Heated Seat Module > Page 9234
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Heated Seat Module > Page 9235
Seat Heater Control Module: Locations Climate Controlled Seat Backrest Module
View 151-18 (Driver Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Heated Seat Module > Page 9236
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Heated Seat Module > Page 9237
Seat Heater Control Module: Locations Climate Controlled Seat Cushion Module
View 151-18 (Driver Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Heated Seat Module > Page 9238
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams >
Heated Seat Module
Seat Heater Control Module: Diagrams Heated Seat Module
C329
C3162
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams >
Heated Seat Module > Page 9241
Seat Heater Control Module: Diagrams Climate Controlled Seat Module, Passenger Side
C3036A
C3036B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams >
Heated Seat Module > Page 9242
C3036C
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams >
Heated Seat Module > Page 9243
Seat Heater Control Module: Diagrams Climate Controlled Seat Backrest Module
C3322
C3326
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams >
Heated Seat Module > Page 9244
Seat Heater Control Module: Diagrams Climate Controlled Seat Cushion Module
C3327
C3328
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Climate Controlled Seat Module
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair Climate Controlled Seat Module
CLIMATE CONTROLLED SEAT MODULE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an airbag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- When installing a new climate control seat module (CCSM), it is necessary to carry out
programmable module installation (PMI).
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Before removing the climate control seat module (CCSM), carry out the appropriate steps in the
programmable module installation (PMI)
procedure.
2. Position the front passenger seat to access all the seat track-to-floor bolts and the safety belt
retractor belt anchor nut. 3. Depower the SRS. 4. Remove the front passenger seat. 5. Remove the
CCSM.
- Disconnect the 3 electrical connectors.
- Remove the 2 screws.
- Remove the CCSM.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 7. Install the front passenger seat and repower the
SRS. Do not prove out the SRS at this time. 8. Carry out the Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS)
System Zero Seat Weight Test and prove out the SRS. 9. Install the CCSM software data. Carry
out the appropriate steps in the PMI procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Climate Controlled Seat Module > Page 9247
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair Heated Seat Module
Front
HEATED SEAT MODULE - FRONT
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an airbag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Position the front passenger seat to access the heated seat module. 2. Depower the SRS. 3.
From under the front of the front passenger seat, remove the heated seat module.
- Vehicles with power seat track, remove the 2 screws and lower the bracket (if equipped).
- Disconnect the heated seat module electrical connector.
- Remove the screw and heated seat module.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 5. Repower the SRS. Do not prove out the SRS at this
time. 6. Carry out the Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Zero Seat Weight Test and
prove out the SRS.
Rear
HEATED SEAT MODULE - REAR SEAT
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the second row 60 percent seat front riser-to-floor nut and bolt.
- To install, tighten to 70 Nm (52 lb-ft).
2. Pivot the front of the 60 percent seat cushion upward. 3. Remove the screw, disconnect the
electrical connector and remove the heated seat module. 4. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Locations > Left
Rear
View 151-23 (Left Rear Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Locations > Left
Rear > Page 9252
View 151-24 (Right Rear Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Left
Rear
C722
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Left
Rear > Page 9255
C822
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Seat Control Switch
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Seat Control Switch
Front
SEAT CONTROL SWITCH - FRONT
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an airbag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All seats
1. If possible, position the seat all the way up and center the seat in the front door opening. 2.
Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). 3. Remove the seat control switch in the
following sequence.
1. Remove the safety belt retractor belt anchor nut cover. 2. If equipped with manual recline,
release the clip and remove the manual recline handle. 3. If equipped with manual lumbar, pull and
remove the manual lumbar handle. 4. Remove the cushion side shield screw(s). 5. Slide the
cushion side shield up in the rear to release the retainer. 6. Slide the cushion side shield forward to
disengage the retainer. 7. Release the cushion side shield clips and separate the seat control
switch. 8. Disconnect the seat control switch electrical connector and remove the switch.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 5. Repower the SRS. If a passenger seat has been
serviced, do not prove out the SRS at this time.
Passenger seat
6. Carry out the Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Zero Seat Weight Test and prove
out the SRS.
Rear
SEAT CONTROL SWITCH - REAR SEAT
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Seat Control Switch > Page 9258
Seat Control Switch Without Power Liftgate
Seat Control Switch With Power Liftgate
Removal and Installation
Vehicles without power liftgate
1. Remove the quarter trim panel.
Vehicles with power liftgate
2. Pull out and remove the power liftgate strut cover in the quarter trim panel.
All vehicles
3. Remove the seat control switch.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
- Squeeze the tab at the top and bottom of the seat control switch and remove from the quarter trim
panel.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Seat Control Switch > Page 9259
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Heated Seat Switch - Rear Seat
HEATED SEAT SWITCH - REAR SEAT
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door handle bezel on the side of the affected switch in the following sequence.
1. Remove the rear door handle bezel screw cover. 2. Remove the rear door handle bezel screw.
3. Separate the rear door handle bezel from the door trim panel.
2. Disconnect the electrical connector, release the clips and remove the heated seat switch from
the back side of the rear door handle bezel. 3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair
Seat Track: Service and Repair
Seat Track
Special Tool(s)
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an airbag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- To install a new occupant classification module or an occupant classification sensor (OCS) weight
sensor bolt, refer to the appropriate procedure in Air Bag Systems.
All seats 1. Position the seat to access all the seat track-to-floor bolts and the safety belt retractor
belt anchor nut. 2. Depower the SRS. 3. Remove the front seat. 4. Remove the front seat backrest.
5. Separate the seat wire harness main feed electrical connector(s) from the seat track brackets. 6.
Disconnect the safety belt buckle pretensioner and safety belt buckle switch electrical connectors.
Separate any retainers holding the wire harness
or electrical connectors to the seat track and safety belt buckle and pretensioner.
7. Disconnect all the seat track motor electrical connectors and separate any retainers holding the
wire harness or electrical connectors to the seat
track (if equipped).
Driver seat 8. Disconnect the seat track position sensor and separate any retainers holding the wire
harness or electrical connectors to the seat track. 9. Disconnect the driver seat module (DSM)
electrical connectors and separate any retainers holding the wire harness to the seat track (if
equipped).
Passenger seat with manual seat track
10. NOTE: Rear inboard occupant classification sensor (OCS) weight sensor bolt protection
bracket shown, others similar.
Separate the wire harness from the OCS weight sensor bolt protection brackets, remove the 4
OCS weight sensor bolt protection bracket screws and remove the 4 OCS weight sensor bolt
protection brackets.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page
9263
Passenger seat with power seat track 11. Remove the cushion side shield in the following
sequence.
1. If equipped with manual recline, release the clip and remove the manual recline handle.
2. NOTE: Release the tension on the manual lumbar cable before removing the manual lumbar
handle.
If equipped with manual lumbar, release the 2 clips on the back of the manual lumbar handle then
pull and remove the manual lumbar handle.
3. Remove the cushion side shield screw(s). 4. Slide the cushion side shield up in the rear to
release the retainer. 5. Slide the cushion side shield forward to disengage the retainer. 6.
Disconnect the seat control switch electrical connector.
- Remove the cushion side shield.
12. Separate the wire harness from the outboard OCS weight sensor bolt protection bracket,
remove the 2 outboard OCS weight sensor bolt protection
bracket screws and remove the outboard OCS weight sensor bolt protection bracket.
13. Separate the wire harness from the inboard OCS weight sensor bolt protection bracket, remove
the inboard OCS weight sensor bolt protection
bracket screw and the inboard OCS weight sensor bolt protection bracket.
Passenger seat 14. Mark the 4 OCS weight sensor bolt electrical connectors so that they can be
reconnected in their same location at installation. 15. Disconnect the 4 OCS weight sensor bolt
electrical connectors and detach any wire harness retainers to the seat track. 16. Disconnect the
occupant classification module and detach any wire harness retainers to the seat track.
Passenger seat with power seat track 17. Disconnect the heated seat module electrical connector
and detach any wire harness retainers to the seat track (if equipped). 18. Disconnect the climate
control seat module (CCSM) electrical connectors and detach any wire harness retainers to the
seat track (if equipped).
All seats 19. Separate any retainers holding the seat wire harness or electrical connectors to the
seat track. 20. Remove the 4 seat track-to-cushion frame bolts and remove the seat track.
All passenger seats 21. To install a new occupant classification module or an OCS weight sensor
bolt, refer to the appropriate procedure in Air Bag Systems.
Installation
Power seat tracks 1. Position the cushion frame-to-seat track rear brackets to the power seat track
rear cross tube.
- Make sure the locator tabs of the cushion frame-to-seat track rear brackets are aligned correctly
to the cushion frame.
Passenger seat with fold flat backrest
2. Make sure the fold flat recliner cable is routed correctly between the power seat track cross tube
and cushion frame.
All seat tracks 3. Install the 4 cushion frame-to-seat track bolts.
- Tighten to 23 Nm (17 lb-ft).
All passenger seats 4. For correct front passenger seat cushion wire harness routing, refer to Seat
Wire Harness Routing-Front Passenger Cushion. See: Locations 5. Connect the 4 OCS weight
sensor bolt electrical connectors, as marked during removal and attach any retainers holding the
wire harness to the seat
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page
9264
track.
6. Connect the occupant classification module and attach any wire harness retainers to the seat
track.
Passenger seat with power seat track 7. Position the inboard OCS weight sensor bolt protection
bracket to the seat track, install the inboard OCS weight sensor bolt protection bracket
screw and attach the wire harness to the inboard OCS weight sensor bolt protection bracket. Tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
8. Position the outboard OCS weight sensor bolt protection bracket to the seat track, install the 2
outboard OCS weight sensor bolt protection bracket
screws and attach the wire harness to the outboard OCS weight sensor bolt protection bracket. Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
9. Install the cushion side shield in the following sequence.
1. Position the side shield to the seat and connect the seat control switch electrical connector. 2.
Slide the cushion side shield rearward to engage the cushion side shield retainer to the seat track
bracket. 3. Slide the cushion side shield down in the rear to engage the retainer. 4. Install the
cushion side shield screw(s). 5. Install the manual lumbar handle (if equipped). 6. Position the clip
on the manual recline handle and install the manual recline handle (if equipped).
10. Connect the heated seat module electrical connector and attach any retainers holding the wire
harness to the seat track (if equipped). 11. Connect the CCSM electrical connectors and attach any
retainers holding the wire harness to the seat track (if equipped).
Passenger seat with manual seat track
12. NOTE: Rear inboard OCS weight sensor bolt protection bracket shown, others similar.
Position each of the 4 OCS weight sensor bolt protection brackets, install the 4 OCS weight sensor
bolt protection bracket screws and attach the wire harness to the OCS weight sensor bolt
protection brackets. Tighten the front OCS weight sensor bolt protection brackets to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
- Tighten the rear OCS weight sensor bolt protection brackets to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
Driver seat 13. Connect the DSM electrical connectors and attach any retainers holding the wire
harness to the seat track (if equipped). 14. Connect the seat track position sensor and attach any
retainers holding the wire harness or electrical connectors to the seat track.
All seats 15. Connect all the seat track motor electrical connectors and attach any retainers holding
the wire harness or electrical connectors to the seat track (if
equipped).
16. Connect the safety belt buckle pretensioner and safety belt buckle switch electrical connectors.
Attach any retainers holding the wire harness or
electrical connectors to the seat track.
17. Attach the seat wire harness main feed in electrical connector(s) to the seat track brackets. 18.
Install the front seat backrest. 19. Install the front seat and repower the SRS. If a passenger seat
has been serviced, do not prove out the SRS at this time.
Passenger seat with existing seat track 20. Carry out the Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS)
System Zero Seat Weight Test and prove out the SRS.
Passenger seat with new seat track, OCS module or OCS weight sensor bolt 21. Carry out the
Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Reset and prove out the SRS.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Diagrams
C127
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Driver Side
View 151-21 (Driver Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Driver Side > Page 9274
View 151-22 (Passenger Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Side
C505
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Side > Page 9277
C605
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9278
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9279
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9280
Power Door Lock Switch: Service and Repair
DOOR LOCK CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Open the cover, remove the screw and position the interior front door handle finish panel aside.
2. Disconnect the door lock control switch electrical connector. 3. Release the locking clips and
remove the door lock control switch. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-21 (Driver Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9284
C527
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9285
Power Mirror Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9286
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9287
Power Mirror Switch: Service and Repair
EXTERIOR MIRROR CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front door control switch bezel.
2. Remove the exterior mirror control switch.
- Depress the 2 locking tabs.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Power Seat Release Switch, Rear
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Power Seat Release Switch, Rear > Page 9292
Power Seat Switch: Locations Power Seat Switch
View 151-18 (Driver Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Power Seat Release Switch, Rear > Page 9293
View 151-19 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Power Seat Release Switch, Rear
C4351
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Power Seat Release Switch, Rear > Page 9296
Power Seat Switch: Diagrams Power Seat Switch
C352
C3016
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Power Seat Release Switch, Rear > Page 9297
C355
C3026
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat > Page 9300
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat > Page 9301
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, 8- or 10-Way Power Seats
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat > Page 9302
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Memory Set Switch
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Memory Set Switch
MEMORY SET SWITCH
Memory SET Switch Edge
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Memory Set Switch > Page 9305
Memory SET Switch, MKX
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the driver door trim panel.
Edge vehicles
2. Disconnect the electrical connector, release the 4 tabs and remove the memory SET switch
through the front of the door trim panel.
MK-vehicles
3. Disconnect the electrical connector, release the 4 tabs and remove the memory SET switch
through the back of the door trim panel.
All vehicles
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Memory Set Switch > Page 9306
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Seat Control Switch-Front
Seat Control Switch - Front
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
Warning: To reduce the risk of accidental deployment, do not use any memory saver devices.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
NOTE: The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the
customer.
ALL SEATS
1. If possible, position the seat all the way up and center the seat in the front door opening.
2. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). Refer to See: Interior Moulding /
Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Air Bag(s) Arming and
Disarming/Service and Repair
3. Separate the safety belt retractor belt anchor from the seat in the following sequence.
1. Carefully pull up and out to remove the safety belt retractor belt anchor nut cover from the
cushion side shield. 2. Remove the safety belt anchor nut. To install, tighten to 47 Nm (35 lb-ft). 3.
Separate the safety belt retractor belt anchor from the seat.
4. Remove the seat control switch in the following sequence.
1. Pull out and remove the seat control switch knob(s). 2. If equipped with manual recline, release
the clip and remove the manual recline handle. 3. If equipped with manual lumbar, pull and remove
the manual lumbar handle. 4. Remove the cushion side shield screw(s). 5. Slide the cushion side
shield up in the rear to release the retailer. 6. Slide the cushion side shield forward to disengage
the retainer. 7. Release the cushion side shield clips and separate the seat control switch. 8.
Disconnect the seat control switch electrical connector and remove the switch.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
6. Repower the SRS. If a passenger seat has been serviced, do not prove out the SRS at this time.
Refer to See: Interior Moulding /
Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair
PASSENGER SEAT
7. Carry out the Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Zero Seat Weight Test and prove
out the SRS. Refer to See: Relays and
Modules/Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems/Seat Occupant Classification Module - Air Bag
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Hazard
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Trunk / Liftgate Hazard Sensor: Service and Repair
PINCH STRIP SWITCH
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Left side shown, right side similar.
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel.
2. Disconnect the pinch strip electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Hazard
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9310
3. Remove the pinch strip.
- Remove the pin-type retainers.
- Remove the grommet and route the harness out of the vehicle.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Left Rear
View 151-23 (Left Rear Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Left Rear > Page 9315
View 151-24 (Right Rear Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Left Rear
C722
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Left Rear > Page 9318
C822
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Seat Control Switch
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Seat Control Switch
Front
SEAT CONTROL SWITCH - FRONT
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an airbag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All seats
1. If possible, position the seat all the way up and center the seat in the front door opening. 2.
Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). 3. Remove the seat control switch in the
following sequence.
1. Remove the safety belt retractor belt anchor nut cover. 2. If equipped with manual recline,
release the clip and remove the manual recline handle. 3. If equipped with manual lumbar, pull and
remove the manual lumbar handle. 4. Remove the cushion side shield screw(s). 5. Slide the
cushion side shield up in the rear to release the retainer. 6. Slide the cushion side shield forward to
disengage the retainer. 7. Release the cushion side shield clips and separate the seat control
switch. 8. Disconnect the seat control switch electrical connector and remove the switch.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 5. Repower the SRS. If a passenger seat has been
serviced, do not prove out the SRS at this time.
Passenger seat
6. Carry out the Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Zero Seat Weight Test and prove
out the SRS.
Rear
SEAT CONTROL SWITCH - REAR SEAT
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Seat Control Switch > Page 9321
Seat Control Switch Without Power Liftgate
Seat Control Switch With Power Liftgate
Removal and Installation
Vehicles without power liftgate
1. Remove the quarter trim panel.
Vehicles with power liftgate
2. Pull out and remove the power liftgate strut cover in the quarter trim panel.
All vehicles
3. Remove the seat control switch.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
- Squeeze the tab at the top and bottom of the seat control switch and remove from the quarter trim
panel.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Seat Control Switch > Page 9322
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Heated Seat Switch - Rear Seat
HEATED SEAT SWITCH - REAR SEAT
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door handle bezel on the side of the affected switch in the following sequence.
1. Remove the rear door handle bezel screw cover. 2. Remove the rear door handle bezel screw.
3. Separate the rear door handle bezel from the door trim panel.
2. Disconnect the electrical connector, release the clips and remove the heated seat switch from
the back side of the rear door handle bezel. 3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Memory Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-21 (Driver Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Memory Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9326
C503
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-28 (Roof - With Panoramic Vista Roof)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9330
C912
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9331
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Service and Repair
ROOF OPENING PANEL CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the overhead console. 2. Disengage the clips and remove the switch from the overhead
console. 3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > License Lamps/Liftgate Release Switch
View 151-25 (Liftgate - Edge)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > License Lamps/Liftgate Release Switch > Page 9336
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > License Lamps/Liftgate Release Switch > Page 9337
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > License Lamps/Liftgate Release Switch
C4353
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > License Lamps/Liftgate Release Switch > Page 9340
C4333
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > License Lamps/Liftgate Release Switch > Page 9341
C4216
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > License Lamps/Liftgate Release Switch > Page 9342
C2269
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Release Switch - Manual
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Service and Repair Liftgate Release Switch - Manual
LIFTGATE RELEASE SWITCH - MANUAL
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel. 2. Disconnect the liftgate release switch electrical connector. 3.
Remove the 5 liftgate release switch moulding nuts.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
4. Depress the tabs and remove the liftgate release switch. 5. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Release Switch - Manual > Page 9345
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Service and Repair Liftgate Release Switch - Power
LIFTGATE RELEASE SWITCH - POWER
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel. 2. Disconnect the liftgate release switch electrical connector. 3.
Remove the 2 liftgate release switch moulding bolts.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
4. Depress the tabs and remove the liftgate release switch. 5. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sound Proofing / Insulation > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Sound Proofing / Insulation: Description and Operation
Sound Deadeners and Insulators
WARNING: Always refer to Material Safety Data Sheet (MSDS) when handling chemicals and wear
protective equipment as directed. Examples may include but are not limited to respirators and
chemically resistant gloves. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal
injury.
NOTICE:
- Mastic is made of a combustible material and should be removed prior to carrying out welding
procedures to the area. Heat zones from welding near the mastic can cause the mastic material to
burn.
- After repairs, corrosion protection must be restored to the are a AFTER the mastic material is
applied. Corrosion protection products may be wax based and loss of adhesion may occur.
NOTE:
- The following illustration serves as a reference to indicate mastic patch (butyl pad) locations.
Additional insulators and sound deadeners are used beyond those indicated in the illustration.
- To restore the vehicle to design intent, missing or damaged sound deadeners and insulators
should be replaced with the correct service replacement component.
Floor Pan Interior View
1. Whenever replacement of an existing mastic insulator is carried out, the surface must be
thoroughly cleaned to make sure correct adhesion will
occur. The surface should be 10°C (50°F) or greater before applying the mastic. The use of a heat
gun to warm the metal surface will aid in adhesion.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Spoilers, Flaps, and Air Dams > Spoiler > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Spoiler: > 09-6-3 > Apr > 09 > Body - Liftgate Spoiler Gasket Slippage
Spoiler: Customer Interest Body - Liftgate Spoiler Gasket Slippage
TSB 09-6-3
REAR LIFTGATE SPOILER - FOAM GASKET SLIDING OUT
FORD: 2007-2009 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Edge and MKX vehicles may experience the foam gasket sliding out from
under the rear lifigate spoiler. To repair this concern it will be necessary to replace the foam gasket.
ACTION Follow Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove the rear spoiler following Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 501-08.
2. Apply masking tape along the edge of the spoiler next the original foam gasket material to
protect the sur[ace finish of the spoiler from scratches.
3. Use 3MTM General Purpose Adhesive Cleaner to help soften the old foam gasket material
making it easier to remove with a wood or plastic putty knife.
NOTE
CARE MUST BE TAKEN NOT TO SCRAPE THROUGH THE MASKING TAPE DAMAGING THE
SPOILER SURFACE FINISH.
4. Once all the foam gasket material is clean from the sur[ace of the spoiler, proceed to remove
protective masking tape.
5. Remove all remaining glue residue on the surface of the spoiler, using 3M(TM) General Purpose
Adhesive Cleaner.
NOTE
TAKE CARE NOT TO DAMAGE THE SURFACE FINISH OF THE SPOILER.
6. Apply 3MTM Automotive Adhesion Promoter along the entire sur[ace where the gaskets will be
positioned. (Figure 1)
NOTE
TAKE CARE NOT TO ALLOW ANY 3M(TM) AUTOMOTIVE ADHESION PROMOTER TO COME
INTO CONTACT WITH THE PAINTED SURFACE. IF IT DOES, WIPE IT OFF IMMEDIATELY.
7. Allow 3MTM Automotive Adhesion Promoter to cure for a minimum of 60 seconds. If the
appearance or touch of the 3MTM Automotive Adhesion Promoter is still wet allow for additional
time to cure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Spoilers, Flaps, and Air Dams > Spoiler > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Spoiler: > 09-6-3 > Apr > 09 > Body - Liftgate Spoiler Gasket Slippage >
Page 9358
8. Apply foam strip along surface taking care that it is close to the rearward edge but not past it.
(Figure 2)
9. Apply even pressure along entire foam strip, starting at one end and proceeding to the opposite
end. Make sure to per[orm this action twice to ensure there is no air trapped between the gasket
and spoiler. (Figure 2)
10. Install spoiler following (WSM), Section 501-08.
Parts Block
NOTE
OBTAIN THE FOLLOWING PARTS LOCALLY
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
090603A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX: 0.8 Hr.
Replace Foam Gasket, Includes Time to Remove And Install Spoiler (Do Not Use With P49D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7044210 33
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Spoilers, Flaps, and Air Dams > Spoiler > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spoiler: > 09-6-3 > Apr > 09 > Body - Liftgate Spoiler
Gasket Slippage
Spoiler: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Liftgate Spoiler Gasket Slippage
TSB 09-6-3
REAR LIFTGATE SPOILER - FOAM GASKET SLIDING OUT
FORD: 2007-2009 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Edge and MKX vehicles may experience the foam gasket sliding out from
under the rear lifigate spoiler. To repair this concern it will be necessary to replace the foam gasket.
ACTION Follow Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove the rear spoiler following Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 501-08.
2. Apply masking tape along the edge of the spoiler next the original foam gasket material to
protect the sur[ace finish of the spoiler from scratches.
3. Use 3MTM General Purpose Adhesive Cleaner to help soften the old foam gasket material
making it easier to remove with a wood or plastic putty knife.
NOTE
CARE MUST BE TAKEN NOT TO SCRAPE THROUGH THE MASKING TAPE DAMAGING THE
SPOILER SURFACE FINISH.
4. Once all the foam gasket material is clean from the sur[ace of the spoiler, proceed to remove
protective masking tape.
5. Remove all remaining glue residue on the surface of the spoiler, using 3M(TM) General Purpose
Adhesive Cleaner.
NOTE
TAKE CARE NOT TO DAMAGE THE SURFACE FINISH OF THE SPOILER.
6. Apply 3MTM Automotive Adhesion Promoter along the entire sur[ace where the gaskets will be
positioned. (Figure 1)
NOTE
TAKE CARE NOT TO ALLOW ANY 3M(TM) AUTOMOTIVE ADHESION PROMOTER TO COME
INTO CONTACT WITH THE PAINTED SURFACE. IF IT DOES, WIPE IT OFF IMMEDIATELY.
7. Allow 3MTM Automotive Adhesion Promoter to cure for a minimum of 60 seconds. If the
appearance or touch of the 3MTM Automotive Adhesion Promoter is still wet allow for additional
time to cure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Spoilers, Flaps, and Air Dams > Spoiler > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spoiler: > 09-6-3 > Apr > 09 > Body - Liftgate Spoiler
Gasket Slippage > Page 9364
8. Apply foam strip along surface taking care that it is close to the rearward edge but not past it.
(Figure 2)
9. Apply even pressure along entire foam strip, starting at one end and proceeding to the opposite
end. Make sure to per[orm this action twice to ensure there is no air trapped between the gasket
and spoiler. (Figure 2)
10. Install spoiler following (WSM), Section 501-08.
Parts Block
NOTE
OBTAIN THE FOLLOWING PARTS LOCALLY
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
090603A 2007-2009 Edge, MKX: 0.8 Hr.
Replace Foam Gasket, Includes Time to Remove And Install Spoiler (Do Not Use With P49D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7044210 33
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Spoilers, Flaps, and Air Dams > Spoiler > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9365
Spoiler: Service and Repair
SPOILER
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel.
2. Disconnect the electrical connector and the rear windshield washer hose from the rear spoiler.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Spoilers, Flaps, and Air Dams > Spoiler > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9366
3. Remove the 4 rear spoiler nuts.
- Remove the 2 nut covers.
- Remove the 4 nuts.
4. Place a piece of tape on the liftgate to protect the paint.
5. NOTE: There are 4 pin type retainers on the bottom of the spoiler. When removing the spoiler it
is difficult to access the retainers to release them
from the liftgate. It may be necessary to pry upward on the rear spoiler to release it from the
retainers. Do not pry on the window.
Remove the rear spoiler. Place a pry bar between the liftgate and the spoiler.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Replace any retainers broken during removal.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Service and
Repair
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair
COWL PANEL GRILLE
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Service and
Repair > Page 9372
Part 2
Removal and Installation
Upper and lower cowl grille panel
1. NOTE: The upper cowl panel grille must be removed before the lower cowl panel grille can be
removed.
Remove the LH and RH wiper pivot arms.
Upper cowl panel grille
2. Remove the RH cowl side outer panel. 3. Remove the LH cowl side outer panel. 4. Remove the
2 scrivets from the RH upper cowl panel grille. 5. Remove the 2 bolts from the RH upper cowl grille
panel and remove the RH upper cowl grille panel.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
6. Remove the 2 scrivets from the LH upper cowl grille panel. 7. Remove the 2 bolts from the LH
upper cowl grille panel and remove the LH upper cowl grille panel.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
Lower cowl panel grille
8. Remove the wiper arm and wiper pivot shaft assembly.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
- Remove the 2 bolts. To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
9. Remove the 2 bolts from the upper left lower cowl grille panel extension and remove the panel.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
10. Remove the 4 bolts from the upper right lower cowl panel extension and remove the panel.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
11. Disconnect the wiring harness from the retainer on the left front of the lower cowl grille panel.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Service and
Repair > Page 9373
12. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the powertrain control module (PCM). 13. Remove
the evaporative purge valve and bracket from the center of the lower cowl panel grille and set
aside. 14. Remove the 5 bolts and 3 nuts from inside the lower cowl grille panel.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
15. Remove the bolt from the lower cowl panel-to-front of dash
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
16. Remove the lower cowl grille panel and PCM from the vehicle.
Upper and lower cowl grille panel
17. CAUTION: Incorrect installation of the lower/upper cowl panel grille may cause damage to the
windshield. Make sure the cowl panel
grille clips are located under the windshield prior to installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. Transfer the components as necessary.
- Adjust the pivot arms.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
GLASS, FRAMES AND MECHANISMS - EXPLODED VIEW, FRONT DOOR
DOOR GLASS TOP RUN - FRONT
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front door window glass.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 9378
2. Remove the front door window glass inner weatherstrip.
3. Remove the front door glass top run. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Make sure the top run is fully seated before reinstalling the front door window glass.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
GLASS, FRAMES AND MECHANISMS - EXPLODED VIEW, REAR DOOR
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 9382
Part 2
DOOR GLASS RUN AND BRACKET - REAR
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The bracket is removed with the rear door glass.
1. Remove the rear door glass. 2. Remove the rear door glass top run. 3. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
ROOF OPENING PANEL - EXPLODED VIEW
Exterior Trim, Seals, Fixed Glass And End Caps
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 9386
Air Deflector Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 9387
Sliding Glass, Blinds And Primary Seal
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 9388
Idler Track And Mechanism
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 9389
Front And Rear Sunshade Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 9390
Rear Trim Ring Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 9391
Roof Opening Panel Motor(s) And Electrical
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 9392
Motor Block And Drive Tube Assembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 9393
Guide Tracks And Mechanisms
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 9394
Front Guide Track Mechanism
ROOF OPENING PANEL SEAL - PRIMARY
Removal
1. Remove the roof opening panel sliding glass. 2. Carefully peel off the primary seal.
- Clean residual adhesive tape from the housing using a suitable cleaner.
Installation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 9395
Primary Seal Alignment
1. NOTE:
- The primary seal seam is placed at the rear centerline.
- Make sure the primary seal lip is facing outward.
Install the primary seal. Refer to the primary seal alignment figure.
2. NOTE: When the roof opening sliding glass panel is in the VENT position, the roof opening panel
primary seal should contact the leading edge
of the sliding glass.
Install the roof opening panel sliding glass. Initialize the roof opening panel motor(s).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Locations > Page
9400
C2064
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal to the
PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch > Page 9403
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Brake Pedal Switch (BPS) Brake
Deactivator Switch
BRAKE PEDAL SWITCH (BPS) BRAKE DEACTIVATOR SWITCH
The BPS, also called the brake deactivator switch, is for vehicle speed control deactivation. A
normally closed switch supplies battery positive voltage (B+) to the PCM when the brake pedal is
not applied. When the brake pedal is applied, the normally closed switch opens and power is
removed from the PCM.
On some applications the normally closed BPS, along with the normally open BPP switch, are used
for a brake rationality test within the PCM. The PCM misfire monitor profile learn function may be
disabled if a brake switch concern occurs. If one or both brake pedal inputs to the PCM is not
changing states when they were expected to, a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) is set by the PCM
strategy.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise Control > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION (CPP) SWITCH
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
The CPP switch is an input to the PCM indicating the clutch pedal position. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the CPP circuit. When the CPP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The CPP input to the PCM is used to detect a reduction in engine
load. The PCM uses the load information for mass air flow and fuel calculations.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair
SPEED CONTROL SWITCH
Edge
MKX
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page
9410
Removal and Installation
MKX
1. Remove the driver air bag module. 2. Remove the 4 screws and the steering wheel control
bezel.
All vehicles
3. Remove the speed control switch by pulling the switch toward the rear of the vehicle.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9415
C2064
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal to the
PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch > Page 9418
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Brake Pedal Switch (BPS) Brake
Deactivator Switch
BRAKE PEDAL SWITCH (BPS) BRAKE DEACTIVATOR SWITCH
The BPS, also called the brake deactivator switch, is for vehicle speed control deactivation. A
normally closed switch supplies battery positive voltage (B+) to the PCM when the brake pedal is
not applied. When the brake pedal is applied, the normally closed switch opens and power is
removed from the PCM.
On some applications the normally closed BPS, along with the normally open BPP switch, are used
for a brake rationality test within the PCM. The PCM misfire monitor profile learn function may be
disabled if a brake switch concern occurs. If one or both brake pedal inputs to the PCM is not
changing states when they were expected to, a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) is set by the PCM
strategy.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise Control >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION (CPP) SWITCH
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
The CPP switch is an input to the PCM indicating the clutch pedal position. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the CPP circuit. When the CPP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The CPP input to the PCM is used to detect a reduction in engine
load. The PCM uses the load information for mass air flow and fuel calculations.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair
SPEED CONTROL SWITCH
Edge
MKX
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 9425
Removal and Installation
MKX
1. Remove the driver air bag module. 2. Remove the 4 screws and the steering wheel control
bezel.
All vehicles
3. Remove the speed control switch by pulling the switch toward the rear of the vehicle.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Air Bag Deactivation Indicator > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Air Bag Deactivation Indicator: Service and Repair
PASSENGER AIR BAG DEACTIVATION (PAD) INDICATOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraint system (SRS) fault.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
- The supplemental restraint system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- The passenger air bag deactivation indicator is part of the hazard switch/traction control switch
assembly.
1. Depower the system. 2. Pull out to release the 8 retaining clips and detach the instrument panel
(I/P) center trim panel. 3. Disconnect the passenger air bag deactivation indicator electrical
connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Air Bag Deactivation Indicator > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 9430
4. Release the 4 locking tabs (2 upper and 2 lower) on the passenger air bag deactivation indicator
and remove it from the I/P center finish panel. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 6.
Repower the system.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams
C4186
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Cigarette Lighter: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9438
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9439
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9440
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9441
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9442
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9443
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9444
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9445
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9446
Cigarette Lighter: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9447
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9448
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9449
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9450
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9451
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9452
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9453
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9454
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9455
Cigarette Lighter: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
44-1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9456
44-3
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Diagrams
C909
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Vehicle Demagnetizing
Compass: Service and Repair Vehicle Demagnetizing
VEHICLE DEMAGNETIZING
CAUTION: During demagnetizing, the demagnetizer coil is pulled towards the vehicle. Place a cloth
over the vehicle roof to protect the vehicle surface if contact occurs. Make sure the cloth covers the
front third and the entire width of the roof.
NOTE:
- The demagnetizing process requires the use of a demagnetizing coil commonly used by television
repair technicians to demagnetize television tubes.
- To demagnetize, use a constant circular motion over the vehicle roof. Do not turn off the
demagnetizer while sweeping the vehicle roof to prevent remagnetizing ferrous materials contained
in the vehicle.
- During the demagnetizing process, make sure the phenolic surface of the tool (the side opposite
the handle) is closest to the vehicle surface.
1. Demagnetize the front third of the vehicle roof.
1 Turn on the demagnetizer at least 1 m (3 ft) away from the vehicle.
2 Holding the demagnetizer no more than 2.5 cm (1 in) from the vehicle roof and starting on the
passenger side, demagnetize the front third of the vehicle roof closest to the windshield using a
constant circular motion. Keep the circle radius within 30 cm (12 in) while sweeping across the
entire surface of the vehicle roof closest to the windshield. Continue the circular motion 4 times.
3 After the fourth pass and without stopping, move the demagnetizer at least 1 m (3 ft) away from
the vehicle.
4 Turn the demagnetizer off.
2. Carry out the Compass Zone Adjustment procedure. See: Compass Zone Adjustment 3. Carry
out the Compass Calibration Adjustment procedure. See: Compass Calibration
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Vehicle Demagnetizing > Page 9462
Compass: Service and Repair Compass Zone Adjustment
COMPASS ZONE ADJUSTMENT
1. Start the engine.
2. NOTE: The top of the message center must be blank. Do not select Trip, DTE, or AFE.
Press the message center switch INFO button repeatedly until the compass and the odometer are
displayed in the message center.
3. Determine which magnetic zone you are in for your geographic location. 4. Press and hold the
RESET button until RESET FOR ZONE is displayed in the message center. 5. Release the RESET
button and slowly press the RESET button down again. 6. Press the SETUP button repeatedly until
the correct zone setting for your geographic location is displayed. 7. Press and release the RESET
button to exit the zone setting mode and lock your individual zone.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Vehicle Demagnetizing > Page 9463
Compass: Service and Repair Compass Calibration
COMPASS CALIBRATION
1. NOTE: For optimum calibration, drive to an open, level location away from large metallic objects
or structures. Switch off all non-essential
electrical accessories (rear window defrost, heater, A/C, map lamps, wipers, etc.) and make sure
all doors are closed.
Start the vehicle.
2. Press the RESET button until RESET FOR CAL is displayed in the message center display.
3. NOTE: This will take up to 3 circles to complete calibration
Slowly drive the vehicle in a circle at no more than 5 km/h (3 mph) until CIRCLE SLOWLY TO
CALIBRATE changes to CALIBRATION COMPLETE in the message center.
4. The compass is now calibrated.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEPOWERING AND REPOWERING
Depowering Procedure
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Failure to follow this instruction may result in
air bag deployment, which may result in serious personal injury.
- Never probe the electrical connector on a side air curtain module. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in side air curtain module deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraints system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraints system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the smart power
distribution junction box (SPDJB), located in the LH lower kick panel, remove the lower kick panel
fuse cover and the
restraints control module (RCM) fuse 46 (7.5A) from the (SPDJB).
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30 seconds.
The air bag warning indicator will remain lit
continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or installing any new front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and
before servicing, installing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors,
such as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches. Failure to
follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
The front impact severity sensors are located on the radiator support under the front bumper cover.
The first row side impact sensors are located at or near the base of the B-pillars.
The second row side impact sensors are located on the C-pillars.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
Repowering Procedure
1. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 2. Install RCM fuse 46 (7.5A) to the SPDJB and install
the lower kick panel fuse cover.
3. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in front
of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal
injury.
Connect the battery ground cable.
4. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition switch from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the ignition switch back to ON
and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag
warning indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn OFF. If an air
bag SRS fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash at a 5 Hz rate (RCM not configured).
The air bag warning indicator might not light until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch
has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 9469
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator and any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) from the RCM and occupant classification
sensor (OCS) module using a scan tool.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 9470
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Deactivation and Reactivation
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEACTIVATION AND REACTIVATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Deactivation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of serious personal injury in
the event of an accidental deployment.
- Carry a live air bag module with the air bag and trim cover pointed away from your body. This will
reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live air bag module down with the trim cover face down. This will reduce the risk of
serious personal injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Failure to follow this instruction may result in
air bag deployment, which may result in personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the safety canopy module. Failure to follow this instruction may
result in safety canopy deployment, which may result in personal injury.
- The safety belt pretensioners are pyrotechnic devices. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in pretensioner or air bag deployment which may result in serious personal
injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraints system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraints system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All vehicles 1. Turn all vehicle accessories off. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the smart
power distribution junction box (SPDJB), located in the LH lower kick panel, remove the lower kick
panel fuse cover and the
restraints control module (RCM) fuse 46 (7.5A) from the SPDJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30 seconds.
The air bag warning indicator will remain lit
continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or installing any new front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and
before servicing, installing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors,
such as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensors are located on the radiator support under the front bumper cover.
The first row side impact sensors are located at or near the base of the B-pillars.
The second row side impact sensors are located on the C-pillars.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 9471
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
7. NOTE: Repeat this step for both locking pins.
Using a 3-mm Allen wrench or a suitable tool through the access hole on the backside of the
steering wheel, position the tool against the spring clip and push in, disengaging the clip from the
locking pin. With the spring clip disengaged from the locking pin, gently pull back on that side of the
driver air bag module to release it from the steering wheel.
8. CAUTION: Do not pull the driver air bag module electrical connectors out by the locking buttons.
Damage to the locking buttons may
occur.
Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking buttons on the driver air bag
module electrical connectors. With the locking buttons released, remove the electrical connectors
and the driver air bag module.
9. Open and lower the glove compartment door. Then unhook the glove compartment door from
the instrument panel (I/P).
- If equipped, detach the glove compartment door dampener.
Edge
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 9472
10. Remove the 2 passenger air bag module bolts from the cross vehicle beam bracket.
11. CAUTION: Do not handle the passenger air bag module by grabbing the edges of the
deployment doors. Damage to the air bag module
may occur.
Through the glove compartment opening, release the 4 LH side deployment door clips. Then
release the forward-most 5 clips and separate the deployment door and passenger air bag module
from the I/P.
12. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the RH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
13. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the RH locking button released, remove the RH electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 9473
14. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the LH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
15. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the LH locking button released, remove the LH electrical connector and remove the
passenger air bag module.
MKX
16. Pull straight out to release the 5 retaining clips and remove the RH I/P finish panel.
17. Remove the screw for the LH duct assembly bracket from the front of the I/P.
18. Through the glove compartment opening, remove the screw and the LH duct assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 9474
19. Through the glove compartment opening, remove the screw and the RH duct assembly.
20. Remove the 4 bolts and the passenger air bag module support bracket.
21. Remove the 3 nuts from the passenger air bag module.
22. CAUTION: Do not allow the passenger air bag module to hang from the wiring harness.
Damage to the wiring harness and connectors
may occur.
Lower the rear of the passenger air bag module off the 3 mounting studs. Move the passenger air
bag module rearward to release the 7 hooks from the I/P and rest the module on the cross vehicle
beam.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 9475
23. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the LH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
24. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the LH locking button released, remove the LH electrical connector from the passenger air
bag module.
25. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the RH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
26. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the RH locking button released, remove the RH electrical connector. Remove the passenger
air bag module from the glove compartment opening.
All vehicles
27. From under the rear of the front passenger seat, slide and disengage the passenger seat side
air bag module electrical connector locking clip, and
then release the tab and disconnect the passenger seat side air bag module electrical connector.
28. Remove the passenger side D-pillar trim panel.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 9476
29. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger safety canopy module electrical connector out by the
locking button. Damage to the locking button
may occur.
With the locking button released, remove the electrical connector from the passenger safety
canopy module.
30. Remove the driver side D-pillar trim panel.
31. CAUTION: Do not pull the driver safety canopy module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button
may occur.
With the locking button released, remove the electrical connector from the driver safety canopy
module.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 9477
32. From under the rear of the driver seat, detach the driver seat side air bag module electrical
connector from the seat cushion frame. Then slide and
disengage the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector locking clip, and then release
the tab and disconnect the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector.
33. Install RCM fuse 46 (7.5A) to the SPDJB. 34. Connect the battery ground cable.
Reactivation
All vehicles 1. Remove RCM fuse 46 (7.5A) from the SPDJB. 2. Disconnect the battery ground
cable and wait at least one minute.
3. Connect the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector and then slide and engage the
seat side air bag electrical connector locking clip.
Then attach the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector to the seat cushion frame.
4. CAUTION:
- Do not install the safety canopy module electrical connector by the locking button. Damage to the
locking button may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector locking button must be in the released position
when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector is unique and cannot be reversed when connected
to the safety canopy module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the safety canopy
module. Do not force the electrical connector into the safety canopy module. Damage to the
connector or component may occur.
With the locking button released, install the driver safety canopy module electrical connector fully
into the driver safety canopy module and seat the locking button.
5. Install the driver side D-pillar trim panel.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 9478
6. CAUTION:
- Do not install the safety canopy module electrical connector by the locking button. Damage to the
locking button may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector locking button must be in the released position
when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector is unique and cannot be reversed when connected
to the safety canopy module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the safety canopy
module. Do not force the electrical connector into the safety canopy module. Damage to the
connector or component may occur.
With the locking button released, install the passenger safety canopy module electrical connector
fully into the passenger safety canopy module and seat the locking button.
7. Install the passenger side D-pillar trim panel.
8. Connect the passenger seat side air bag module electrical connector and then slide and engage
the seat side air bag electrical connector locking
clip.
MKX
9. CAUTION:
- Do not install the passenger air bag module electrical connectors by the locking buttons. Damage
to the locking buttons may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connector locking buttons must be in the released
position when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the passenger air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in
the passenger air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the passenger air bag
module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 9479
Position the passenger air bag module on the cross vehicle beam. With the locking buttons
released, install the 2 passenger air bag module electrical connectors fully into the passenger air
bag module and seat the locking buttons.
10. NOTE: During the passenger air bag module installation, make sure all 7 of the hooks are fully
seated in the I/P.
Install the passenger air bag module 7 hooks into the I/P. Raise the rear of the passenger air bag
module onto the 3 mounting studs.
11. Install the 3 passenger air bag module nuts.
- Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
12. NOTE: To avoid a squeak or rattle condition, install the passenger air bag module bracket and
passenger air bag module bolts in this order.
Install the passenger air bag module support bracket and the 4 bolts. 1. Install the passenger air
bag module support bracket and 2 bolts to the cross vehicle beam.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
2. Install the inboard passenger air bag module support bracket-to-passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
3. Install the outboard passenger air bag module support bracket-to-passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 9480
13. Install the screw and the RH duct assembly.
14. Install the screw and the LH duct assembly.
15. Install the screw for the LH duct assembly bracket in the front of the I/P.
16. NOTE: Make sure the RH I/P finish panel 5 retaining clips are fully seated in the I/P.
Install the RH I/P finish panel.
Edge
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 9481
17. CAUTION:
- Do not install the passenger air bag module electrical connectors by the locking buttons. Damage
to the locking buttons may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connector locking buttons must be in the released
position when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the passenger air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in
the passenger air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the passenger air bag
module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
With the locking buttons released, install the 2 passenger air bag module electrical connectors fully
into the passenger air bag module and seat the locking buttons.
18. CAUTION: Do not handle the passenger air bag module by grabbing the edges of the
deployment doors. Damage to the air bag module
may occur.
NOTE: During air bag module installation, make sure all the deployment door clips are fully seated
in the I/P.
Install the passenger air bag module deployment door rear-most clips into the I/P first. Then install
the side deployment door clips working around to the forward-most clips seating each of them fully
into the I/P.
19. NOTE: To avoid a squeak or rattle condition, install the 2 passenger air bag module bolts in this
order.
Install the passenger air bag module 2 bolts. 1. Install the inboard passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
2. Install the outboard passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
All vehicles 20. Hook the glove compartment door to the I/P. Close the glove compartment door.
- If equipped, attach the glove compartment door dampener.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 9482
21. CAUTION:
- Do not install the driver air bag module electrical connectors by the locking buttons. Damage to
the locking buttons may occur.
- The driver air bag module electrical connector locking buttons must be in the released position
when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the passenger air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in
the passenger air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the passenger air bag
module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
With the locking buttons released, install the driver air bag module electrical connectors fully into
the driver air bag module and seat the locking buttons.
22. NOTE: Audible clicks will be heard when both wire clips are seated in the driver air bag module.
Align the driver air bag module locking pins to the steering wheel and, while pushing inward, seat
the 2 driver air bag module locking pins to the steering wheel wire clips. When the 2 locking pins are seated in place, there should be an even gap between the driver air
bag module trim cover and the steering wheel.
23. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 24. Install RCM fuse 46 (7.5A) to the SPDJB and
install the lower kick panel fuse cover.
25. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in
front of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected. Failure to follow this instructions may result in serious personal
injury.
Connect the battery ground cable.
26. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag warning
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag SRS
fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will either: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash at a 5 Hz rate (RCM not configured).
The air bag warning indicator may not illuminate until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator will need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Clear all continuous DTCs from the restraints control module using a scan tool.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair
INSTRUMENT PANEL DIMMER SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument panel side finish panel.
2. NOTE: The switch is removed by pushing from behind.
Release the tabs and remove the headlamp switch assembly. Disconnect the electrical connectors.
3. Release the 4 tabs and remove the instrument panel dimmer switch. 4. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Locations
View 151-25 (Liftgate - Edge)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 9489
C479
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9493
C253
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9494
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Description and Operation
INFORMATION AND MESSAGE CENTER
The message center is a fixed format vacuum fluorescent display, integrated into the instrument
cluster. The message center functions are controlled by the message center switches. The
message center displays important vehicle information by constantly monitoring different vehicle
systems. The message center informs the driver of vehicle operations and notifies the driver of
potential vehicle problems by displaying a warning message pertaining to the system in which a
fault has been detected.
The message center provides the following features:
- Information displays
- Setup displays
- System check messages
- System warning messages
The message center information can be selected through a set of 3 buttons:
- INFO
- SETUP
- RESET
Message Center Configuration
The message center has the capability to configure items such as units (English or metric),
autolamp delay, to enable/disable a variety of options such as autolock, auto-unlock and easy
entry/easy exit (if equipped), or to carry out calibrations/settings on items such as the compass.
On configurable items such as autolock, auto-unlock or easy entry/easy exit the message center
indicates the appropriate selection (ON/OFF) by bracketing the selection. For example, if the driver
selects the autolock feature on, the message would display as follows: AUTOLOCK OFF. If the
driver selects the autolock off, the message would display as follows: AUTOLOCK AID ON .
Compass Display
The message center provides a compass display and uses directional information sent from a
compass module, located on the underside of the inside rear view mirror.
Information Displays
The information displays are non-timed modes. The selected mode remains on until the driver
presses a message center button to change the mode or it is overridden by another mode.
The information (INFO button) display modes are: Odometer
- Compass
- Trip odometer A or B
- Distance to empty (DTE)
- Average fuel economy
- Average speed
- Trip elapsed drive time 1 or 2
Setup Displays
The setup (SETUP button) displays are timed modes and terminate after a finite interval. The setup
display modes are: System check
- Units English/metric
- Autolamp delay in seconds (if equipped)
- Autolock on/off (if equipped)
- Auto-unlock on/off (if equipped)
- Power liftgate on/off (if equipped)
- Easy entry/easy exit seat on/off (if equipped)
- Reverse parking aid on/off (if equipped)
- Language
System Check
The system check provides a check of all the monitored systems on the vehicle. The system check
scrolls through each of the monitored systems and provides a visual indication to report out the
status of each system. The message center displays OK for approximately 2 seconds if the system
check does not detect a fault in the system and displays a warning message for approximately 2
seconds if the system check detects a fault in the system. Press the RESET button to scroll
through the system check messages.
The systems monitored during the system check are: Door ajar
- Engine temperature
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9495
- TPMS
- Oil pressure
- Brake fluid level
- Washer fluid level
- Fuel level
- Distance to empty (DTE)
System Warning Messages
The system warning messages alert the operator to possible problems or malfunctions in the
vehicle operating systems. The message center displays the last selected feature if there are no
additional warning messages. Once a warning message has been displayed, the message must be
acknowledged to allow full functionality of the message center. Press the RESET to acknowledge
and clear the warning message. The warning messages are divided into 3 basic categories: Cannot be cleared until the condition is corrected.
- Reappears 10 minutes from pressing the RESET button.
- Reappears if the condition clears then reoccurs within the same ignition cycle ON-OFF cycle.
The warning messages that cannot be reset are: DRIVER DOOR AJAR
- PASSENGER DOOR AJAR
- REAR LEFT DOOR AJAR
- REAR RIGHT DOOR AJAR
- PARK BRAKE ENGAGED
- PLEASE CLOSE DOOR
- PRESS RESET TO CLEAR
The warning messages that reoccur after 10 minutes are: LOW FUEL LEVEL
- CHECK BRAKE SYSTEM
- LOW BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
The warning messages that display whenever the ignition switch is turned from the OFF position to
the ON position are: WASHER FLUID LEVEL LOW
- LIFTGATE AJAR
- LOW TIRE PRESSURE
- CHECK RPA (if equipped)
- CHECK COMPASS MODE (if equipped)
- COMPASS NO RESPONSE (if equipped)
- COMPASS DATA ERROR
- TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR FAULT
- TIRE PRESSURE SENSOR FAULT
- POWER LIFTGATE OFF
- PARK ASSIST OFF
Service Procedure Displays
The message center displays warning messages that indicate a system state during repair
procedures related to the tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS). The displayed warning
messages are as follows: TRAIN MODE: TRAIN xx TIRE
- TIRE TRAINING MODE COMPETE
- TIRE NOT TRAINED - REPAIR
The message center displays warning messages that indicate a system state during repair
procedures related to the compass display. The displayed warning messages are as follows: RESET FOR ZONE
- SETUP ZONE XX
- RESET FOR CAL
- CIRCLE SLOWLY TO CALIBRATE
- CALIBRATION COMPLETE
The message center displays the IKT KEY COULD NOT PROGRAM warning message to indicate
a problem programming the integrated key transmitter (IKT).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Inspection and Verification
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
1. Verify the customer concern.
Visual Inspection Chart
2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of mechanical or electrical damage. 3. If an obvious cause for
an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible) before proceeding to the
next step.
4. NOTE: Make sure to use the latest scan tool software release.
If the cause is not visually evident, connect the scan tool to the data link connector (DLC).
5. NOTE: The vehicle communication module (VCM) LED prove-out confirms power and ground
from the DLC are provided to the VCM.
If the scan tool does not communicate with the VCM: Check the VCM connection to the vehicle.
- Check the scan tool connection to the VCM.
- Refer to Information Bus (Module Communications Network), No Power To The Scan Tool, to
diagnose no communication with the scan tool.
6. If the scan tool does not communicate with the vehicle:
- Verify the ignition key is in the ON position.
- Verify the scan tool operation with a known good vehicle.
- Refer to Information Bus (Module Communications Network) to diagnose no response from the
PCM.
7. Carry out the network test:
- If the scan tool responds with no communication for one or more modules, refer to Information
Bus (Module Communications Network).
- If the network test passes, retrieve and record the continuous memory DTCs for the instrument
cluster.
8. Clear the continuous DTCs and carry out the self-test diagnostics for the instrument cluster. 9. If
the DTCs retrieved are related to the concern, go to the Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Charts.
For all other module DTCs, refer to Body
Control Systems (Multifunction Electronic Control Module). See: Diagnostic Trouble Code
Descriptions
10. If no DTCs related to the concern are retrieved, GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Principles of Operation
PRINCIPLES OF OPERATION
The message center is an integral part of the instrument cluster that receives and acts upon much
of the same information that is input and used to operate the instrument cluster gauges, indicators,
and warning indicators. The message center, located in the center of the instrument cluster is a
vacuum fluorescent 2-line display. The message center electronic functions use both hardwired,
and the controller area network (CAN) circuitry to transmit and receive information.
Whenever conditions are present that require a warning message, the message center replaces
the last selected display with the new warning display. Once the message is reset or cleared, the
message center returns to the last selected display. If multiple warnings are present, the message
center displays each warning for approximately 4 seconds. Warning messages are also generally
associated with other observable instrument cluster indications. For example, when the LH front
door is opened, the message center displays the message DRIVER DOOR AJAR along with the
door ajar warning indicator. This allows the message center to be a more informative supplement
to the instrument cluster gauges and indicators.
It is very important to understand:
- where the input (command) originates.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9498
- all the information (messages) necessary in order for a feature to operate.
- which module(s) receive(s) the input or command message.
- if the module that received the input (message) controls the output of the feature, or if it outputs a
message over the CAN to another module.
- which module controls the output of the feature.
Instrument Cluster Messages
NOTE: Whenever a message is suspected as missing, confirmed by a missing message DTC, it is
important to look for other symptoms that may also be present in the instrument cluster and
throughout the vehicle. Once a DTC is set in the instrument cluster it may be helpful to review the
complete message list available in Information Bus (Module Communications Network) to see what
other modules also rely on the same message and run the self-test for those modules. If the
message is missing from other modules, the same DTC may also be set in those modules.
Confirmation of missing messages common to multiple modules may indicate that the originating
module is the source of the concern or the communication network may be experiencing some
problems.
The instrument cluster uses input messages from other modules to control the gauges,
informational indicators, warning indicators and message center displays over the communication
networks. If a required message is missing or invalid for less than 5 seconds, the gauge or
indicator that requires the message remains at the last commanded state based upon the last
known good message. For example, if the message is missing the O/D off status for less than 5
seconds and the O/D off indicator was ON (O/D cancelled), the indicator remains in the ON state
until the next good message is received. If the message remains missing or invalid for greater than
5 seconds, the instrument cluster sets a U-code DTC and the output becomes a default action for
the indicator or gauge. Each indicator or gauge utilizes a different default strategy depending on
the nature of the indication. Refer Instrument Cluster for further descriptions of the default action
specific to each indicator or gauge. If the messaged input to the cluster returns at any time, the
normal function of the gauge or indicator resumes.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9499
B1209 / U2013
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9500
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Symptom Chart (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9501
Symptom Chart (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9502
Symptom Chart (Part 3)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9503
Symptom Chart (Part 4)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9504
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Pinpoint Tests
Test A: The Message Center Is Not Operating Correctly
PINPOINT TEST A: THE MESSAGE CENTER IS NOT OPERATING CORRECTLY
A1-A2
Normal Operation
The message center is located in the center of the instrument cluster between the tachometer and
the speedometer in the vacuum fluorescent display area. The message center is integral to the
instrument cluster and uses the same voltage supply as the instrument cluster. The RUN/START
voltage is supplied to the instrument cluster on circuit CBP29 (WH/VT) and the keep alive B+
voltage is received on circuit SBP26 (YE/RD). The instrument cluster ground is received through
circuit GD133 (BK). The message center functionality is controlled through the message center
switch, which is hardwired to the instrument cluster through input circuit CMC29 (GN/VT) and
return circuit RMC27 (WH/BN).
Possible Causes
- Message center switch
- Instrument cluster
Test B: The Message Center Switch Does Not Operate Correctly
PINPOINT TEST B: THE MESSAGE CENTER SWITCH DOES NOT OPERATE CORRECTLY
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9505
B1-B2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9506
B3-B5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9507
B6
Normal Operation
The message center is located in the center of the instrument cluster between the tachometer and
the speedometer in the vacuum fluorescent display area. The message center is integral to the
instrument cluster and uses the same voltage supply as the instrument cluster. The RUN/START
voltage is supplied to the instrument cluster on circuit CBP29 (WH/VT) and the keep alive B+
voltage is received on circuit SBP26 (YE/RD). The instrument cluster ground is received through
circuit GD133 (BK). The message center functionality is controlled through the message center
switch, which is hardwired to the instrument cluster through input circuit CMC29 (GN/VT) and
return circuit RMC27 (WH/BN).
DTC B1209 - is an on-demand DTC that sets if the instrument cluster detects any of the message
center switch buttons stuck during the self-test.
Possible Causes
- Circuitry
- Message center switch
- Instrument cluster
Test C: The Compass Is Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST C: THE COMPASS IS INOPERATIVE
C1-C2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9508
C2-C3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9509
C4-C5
Normal Operation
The compass sensor module receives voltage from the smart junction box (SJB) through circuit
CBP31 (BU/OG) and is grounded through circuit GD133 (BK). The compass sensor module
communicates the vehicle direction to the instrument cluster through the compass communication
data plus circuit VMC31 (YE/GN) and compass communication data minus circuit VMC30 (BU/GY).
DTC U2013 - is a continuous memory and on-demand DTC that sets if the instrument cluster is
missing the compass data from the compass module.
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuitry
- Compass module
- Instrument cluster
Test D: The Compass Is Inaccurate
PINPOINT TEST D: THE COMPASS IS INACCURATE
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9510
D1-D3
Normal Operation
The compass sensor module communicates the vehicle direction to the instrument cluster through
the compass communication data plus circuit VMC31 (YE/GN) and compass communication data
minus circuit VMC30 (BU/GY). The magnetic fields generated by the earths north and south poles
are divided into zones that differ from each other with respect to how the magnetic fields appear.
The magnetic north can change by up to 4 degrees between zones and become noticeable across
multiple zones. The compass zone must be set to the correct zone for the compass to read
accurately. Factors within the vehicle may affect the ability of the compass module to accurately
read the magnetic north. Calibrating the compass allows the compass module to compensate for
vehicle factors that influence the accuracy of the compass.
NOTE: Outside factors such as bridges, steel structures, tall buildings and power lines also affect
compass accuracy.
Possible Causes
- Vehicle magnetization
- Zone setting
- Calibration
- Compass module
Test E: The WASHER FLUID LEVEL LOW Warning Is Inoperative/Always On
PINPOINT TEST E: THE WASHER FLUID LEVEL LOW WARNING IS INOPERATIVE/ALWAYS
ON
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9511
E1-E4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9512
E4-E7
Normal Operation
The instrument cluster provides a reference voltage to the washer fluid switch through circuit
CMC20 (VT). The washer fluid switch is grounded through circuit GD123 (BK/GY). When the
washer fluid is low, the washer fluid switch closes to ground, pulling the reference voltage low.
When the instrument cluster detects the washer fluid input pulled low, it displays the WASHER
FLUID LOW warning.
Possible Causes
- Circuitry
- Washer fluid level switch
- Instrument cluster
Test F: The CHECK PARK ASSIST/PARK ASSIST OFF Warning Is Inoperative
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9513
PINPOINT TEST F: THE CHECK PARK ASSIST/PARK ASSIST OFF WARNING IS
INOPERATIVE
F1-F2
Normal Operation
The parking aid on/off status is sent from the parking aid module to the instrument cluster over the
medium speed controller area network (MS-CAN) communication bus lines. When the RESET
button is pressed, the instrument cluster sends a query to the parking aid module, requesting a
system status. The parking aid module responds to the instrument cluster with the status of the
system, either on or off. If the return status message is missing or corrupted, the instrument cluster
does not display the brackets around either the ON or OFF selection.
Possible Causes
- Communication network
- Parking aid system
Test G: The POWER LIFTGATE OFF Message Is Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST G: THE POWER LIFTGATE OFF MESSAGE IS INOPERATIVE
G1-G2
Normal Operation
The power liftgate on/off status is sent from the power liftgate module to the instrument cluster over
the medium speed controller area network (MS-CAN) communication bus lines. When the RESET
button is pressed, the instrument cluster sends a query to the power liftgate module, requesting a
system status. The power liftgate module responds to the instrument cluster with the status of the
system, either on or off. If the return
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9514
status message is missing or corrupted, the instrument cluster does not display the brackets
around either the ON or OFF selection.
Possible Causes
- Communication network
- Power liftgate system
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 9515
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Service and Repair
MESSAGE CENTER SWITCH
Edge
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 9516
MKX
Removal and Installation
MKX
1. NOTE: The transmission selector lever bezel is held in place by 4 tabs that are located in the
shifter assembly.
Remove the transmission selector lever bezel.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 9517
2. Open the floor console compartment door and pull the floor console finish panel straight up to
release the retainer clips and remove the finish
panel.
3. Remove the 2 pin-type retainers and the storage compartment assembly.
All vehicles
4. Pull the instrument panel center finish panel straight out to release the retainer clips and remove
the instrument panel center finish panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
5. Press the 4 retaining tabs and remove the message center switch. 6. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 9518
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Filler Cap Warning Indicator >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Filler Cap Warning Indicator: Description and Operation
CHECK FUEL CAP INDICATOR
The check fuel cap indicator is a communications network message sent by the PCM. The PCM
sends the message to illuminate the lamp when the strategy determines that there is a failure in the
vapor management system due to the fuel filler cap not being sealed correctly. This would be
detected by the inability to pull vacuum in the fuel tank, after a fueling event.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuel Gauge: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9526
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9527
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9528
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9529
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9530
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9531
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9532
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9533
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9534
Fuel Gauge: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9535
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9536
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9537
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9538
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9539
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9540
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9541
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9542
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-1-7 > Jan > 08 > Instruments Inaccurate Fuel Gauge
Fuel Gauge Sender: Customer Interest Instruments - Inaccurate Fuel Gauge
TSB 08-1-7
01/21/08
INACCURATE FUEL GAUGE INDICATOR - VEHICLE BUILT BEFORE 11/1/2007
FORD: 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Edge and MKX vehicles built before 11/1/2007, may experience an
inaccurate low fuel gauge indicator. This condition may be caused by a stuck float arm on the fuel
delivery module. The fuel delivery module float arm could get hung up on the fuel tank baffle plate.
This failure mode will only occur when the fuel tank is at or near empty fuel level. When the fuel
tank is refilled to a full level, the fuel gauge will continue to read a low fuel fill level. For all other fuel
gauge related concerns, refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 413-01.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. To make this repair it will be necessary to remove the fuel pump module from the fuel tank.
Follow WSM, Section 310-01.
2. Once the fuel delivery module is removed from the fuel tank, access the fuel tank baffle through
the fuel tank fuel delivery opening. (Figure 1)
3. Move the baffle plate with a wooden object or by hand towards the front of the vehicle to prevent
interference between the baffle and the float arm. The fuel tank baffle plate is a metal plate that is
easy to move by hand or using a tool with no consequent damage to the baffle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-1-7 > Jan > 08 > Instruments Inaccurate Fuel Gauge > Page 9551
4. The fuel delivery module float arm should have a clearance of 1 5/32" (29.63 mm) in the empty
tank position (bottom) and 13/16" (20.73 mm) in the full tank position (up). (Figure 2)
5. Install the fuel delivery module following WSM, Section 310-01.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
080107A 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.7 Hrs.
Reposition the Fuel Tank Baffle Plate. Includes Time to Remove Rear Seat and Fuel Delivery
Module. (Do Not Use With 9350E, 63100B,63100B, 9275A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9002 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-1-7 > Jan > 08 >
Instruments - Inaccurate Fuel Gauge
Fuel Gauge Sender: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Inaccurate Fuel Gauge
TSB 08-1-7
01/21/08
INACCURATE FUEL GAUGE INDICATOR - VEHICLE BUILT BEFORE 11/1/2007
FORD: 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Edge and MKX vehicles built before 11/1/2007, may experience an
inaccurate low fuel gauge indicator. This condition may be caused by a stuck float arm on the fuel
delivery module. The fuel delivery module float arm could get hung up on the fuel tank baffle plate.
This failure mode will only occur when the fuel tank is at or near empty fuel level. When the fuel
tank is refilled to a full level, the fuel gauge will continue to read a low fuel fill level. For all other fuel
gauge related concerns, refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 413-01.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. To make this repair it will be necessary to remove the fuel pump module from the fuel tank.
Follow WSM, Section 310-01.
2. Once the fuel delivery module is removed from the fuel tank, access the fuel tank baffle through
the fuel tank fuel delivery opening. (Figure 1)
3. Move the baffle plate with a wooden object or by hand towards the front of the vehicle to prevent
interference between the baffle and the float arm. The fuel tank baffle plate is a metal plate that is
easy to move by hand or using a tool with no consequent damage to the baffle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-1-7 > Jan > 08 >
Instruments - Inaccurate Fuel Gauge > Page 9557
4. The fuel delivery module float arm should have a clearance of 1 5/32" (29.63 mm) in the empty
tank position (bottom) and 13/16" (20.73 mm) in the full tank position (up). (Figure 2)
5. Install the fuel delivery module following WSM, Section 310-01.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
080107A 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.7 Hrs.
Reposition the Fuel Tank Baffle Plate. Includes Time to Remove Rear Seat and Fuel Delivery
Module. (Do Not Use With 9350E, 63100B,63100B, 9275A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9002 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9560
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Module
C463
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9563
C434
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 9564
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation
FUEL PUMP (FP) MODULE
Typical Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 9565
Typical Mechanical Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
The FP module is a device that contains the fuel pump and sender assembly. The fuel pump is
located inside the FP module reservoir and supplies fuel through the FP module manifold to the
engine and FP module jet pump. The jet pump continuously refills the reservoir with fuel, and a
check valve located in the manifold outlet maintains system pressure when the fuel pump is not
energized. A flapper valve located in the bottom of the reservoir allows fuel to enter the reservoir
and prime the fuel pump during the initial fill.
FUEL PUMP (FP) MODULE AND RESERVOIR
The FP module is mounted inside the fuel tank in a reservoir. The pump has a discharge check
valve that maintains the system pressure after the key has been turned off to minimize starting
concerns. The reservoir prevents fuel flow interruptions during extreme vehicle maneuvers with low
tank fill levels.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module
FUEL PUMP MODULE
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9568
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9569
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9570
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
repairing or disconnecting any of the fuel system components, the fuel system pressure must be
relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel causing personal injury or a fire hazard.
All vehicles
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9571
1. Release the fuel system pressure. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3. Release the fuel
tank filler cap and position aside.
4. Insert a suitable fuel drain tube into the fuel tank filler pipe until it reaches the fuel tank inlet
spout. 5. Attach the fuel storage tanker to the fuel drain tube and remove any residual fuel
remaining in the fuel tank filler pipe. 6. Remove the rear seat. 7. Position the carpet and/or any
insulation covering the fuel pump (FP) module access cover aside.
8. Remove the 4 screws and the FP module access cover.
9. Disconnect the FP module electrical connector.
10. Disconnect the fuel tank supply tube-to-FP module quick connect coupling.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9572
11. CAUTION: Place absorbent pads on the floor pan in the immediate area in case of fuel spills.
Carefully remove the fuel pump (FP)
module from the vehicle to avoid fuel spillage inside the vehicle.
Using the special tool, remove the FP module lock ring retainer.
All wheel drive (AWD) vehicles
12. CAUTION: The fuel pump (FP) module must be handled carefully to avoid damage to the FP
module and/or float arm.
Carefully lift the FP module out of the fuel tank enough to access and disconnect the fuel tank
crossover tube-to-FP module quick connect coupling.
All vehicles
13. CAUTION: The fuel pump (FP) module will have residual fuel remaining internally, drain into a
suitable container.
Completely remove the FP module from the fuel tank.
14. CAUTION:
- Inspect the mating surfaces of the fuel pump (FP) module flange and the fuel tank O-ring seal
contact surfaces. Do not polish or adjust the O-ring seal contact area of the fuel tank flange or the
fuel tank. Install a new FP module or fuel tank if the O-ring seal contact area is bent, scratched or
corroded.
- Make sure to install a new fuel pump (FP) module O-ring seal. Install a new lock ring if it is bent,
damaged or corroded.
NOTE: To install, apply clean engine oil to the O-ring seal.
Remove the FP module O-ring seal.
15. NOTE: Make sure the alignment tab on the fuel pump (FP) module and the fuel tank meet
before tightening the FP module lock ring.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9573
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Fuel Level Sensor
FUEL LEVEL SENSOR
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9574
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9575
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9576
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- This procedure involves fuel handling. Be prepared for spillage at all times and always observe
fuel handling precautions. Failure to follow these instructions can result in personal injury.
1. Release the fuel system pressure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9577
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3. Release the fuel tank filler cap and position aside.
4. Insert a suitable fuel drain tube into the fuel tank filler pipe until it reaches the fuel tank inlet
spout.
5. CAUTION: The fuel pump (FP) module and fuel level sensor will be below the fuel level in the
tank when the tank is full. Make sure to
drain 1/8 of the fuel capacity through the filler pipe prior to removing the fuel level sensor or fuel
spillage will occur.
Attach the fuel storage tanker to the fuel drain tube and remove any residual fuel remaining in the
fuel tank filler pipe.
6. Remove the rear seat. 7. Position the carpet and/or any insulation covering the fuel level sensor
access cover aside.
8. Remove the 4 screws and the fuel level sensor access cover.
9. Disconnect the fuel level sensor electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9578
10. CAUTION: Place absorbant pads in the general work area in case of fuel spillage.
Release the lock tab, rotate the fuel level sensor counterclockwise approximately 1/4 turn and lift
upward.
11. CAUTION:
- The fuel level sensor must be handled carefully to avoid damage to the float arm.
- Carefully remove the fuel level sensor from the fuel tank to avoid fuel spillage inside the vehicle.
Carefully lift and remove the fuel level sensor from the fuel tank.
12. CAUTION: Inspect the mating surfaces of the fuel level sensor flange and the fuel tank O-ring
seal contact surfaces. Do not polish or
adjust the O-ring seal contact area of the fuel tank flange or the fuel tank. Install a new fuel level
sensor or fuel tank if the O-ring seal contact area is bent, scratched or corroded.
NOTE: To install, apply clean engine oil to the O-ring seal.
- Upon installation, properly seat and press down firmly on the fuel level sensor, rotate it clockwise
until the lock arrow on the sensor aligns with the notch on the tank. Torque should not exceed 15
Nm (11 lb-ft).
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEPOWERING AND REPOWERING
Depowering Procedure
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Failure to follow this instruction may result in
air bag deployment, which may result in serious personal injury.
- Never probe the electrical connector on a side air curtain module. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in side air curtain module deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraints system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraints system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the smart power
distribution junction box (SPDJB), located in the LH lower kick panel, remove the lower kick panel
fuse cover and the
restraints control module (RCM) fuse 46 (7.5A) from the (SPDJB).
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30 seconds.
The air bag warning indicator will remain lit
continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or installing any new front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and
before servicing, installing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors,
such as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches. Failure to
follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
The front impact severity sensors are located on the radiator support under the front bumper cover.
The first row side impact sensors are located at or near the base of the B-pillars.
The second row side impact sensors are located on the C-pillars.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
Repowering Procedure
1. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 2. Install RCM fuse 46 (7.5A) to the SPDJB and install
the lower kick panel fuse cover.
3. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in front
of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal
injury.
Connect the battery ground cable.
4. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition switch from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the ignition switch back to ON
and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag
warning indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn OFF. If an air
bag SRS fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash at a 5 Hz rate (RCM not configured).
The air bag warning indicator might not light until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch
has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 9584
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator and any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) from the RCM and occupant classification
sensor (OCS) module using a scan tool.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 9585
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Deactivation and Reactivation
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEACTIVATION AND REACTIVATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Deactivation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of serious personal injury in
the event of an accidental deployment.
- Carry a live air bag module with the air bag and trim cover pointed away from your body. This will
reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live air bag module down with the trim cover face down. This will reduce the risk of
serious personal injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Failure to follow this instruction may result in
air bag deployment, which may result in personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the safety canopy module. Failure to follow this instruction may
result in safety canopy deployment, which may result in personal injury.
- The safety belt pretensioners are pyrotechnic devices. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in pretensioner or air bag deployment which may result in serious personal
injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a
supplemental restraints system (SRS) fault.
- The supplemental restraints system (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults before
releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All vehicles 1. Turn all vehicle accessories off. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the smart
power distribution junction box (SPDJB), located in the LH lower kick panel, remove the lower kick
panel fuse cover and the
restraints control module (RCM) fuse 46 (7.5A) from the SPDJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30 seconds.
The air bag warning indicator will remain lit
continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or installing any new front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and
before servicing, installing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors,
such as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensors are located on the radiator support under the front bumper cover.
The first row side impact sensors are located at or near the base of the B-pillars.
The second row side impact sensors are located on the C-pillars.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 9586
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
7. NOTE: Repeat this step for both locking pins.
Using a 3-mm Allen wrench or a suitable tool through the access hole on the backside of the
steering wheel, position the tool against the spring clip and push in, disengaging the clip from the
locking pin. With the spring clip disengaged from the locking pin, gently pull back on that side of the
driver air bag module to release it from the steering wheel.
8. CAUTION: Do not pull the driver air bag module electrical connectors out by the locking buttons.
Damage to the locking buttons may
occur.
Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking buttons on the driver air bag
module electrical connectors. With the locking buttons released, remove the electrical connectors
and the driver air bag module.
9. Open and lower the glove compartment door. Then unhook the glove compartment door from
the instrument panel (I/P).
- If equipped, detach the glove compartment door dampener.
Edge
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 9587
10. Remove the 2 passenger air bag module bolts from the cross vehicle beam bracket.
11. CAUTION: Do not handle the passenger air bag module by grabbing the edges of the
deployment doors. Damage to the air bag module
may occur.
Through the glove compartment opening, release the 4 LH side deployment door clips. Then
release the forward-most 5 clips and separate the deployment door and passenger air bag module
from the I/P.
12. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the RH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
13. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the RH locking button released, remove the RH electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 9588
14. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the LH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
15. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the LH locking button released, remove the LH electrical connector and remove the
passenger air bag module.
MKX
16. Pull straight out to release the 5 retaining clips and remove the RH I/P finish panel.
17. Remove the screw for the LH duct assembly bracket from the front of the I/P.
18. Through the glove compartment opening, remove the screw and the LH duct assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 9589
19. Through the glove compartment opening, remove the screw and the RH duct assembly.
20. Remove the 4 bolts and the passenger air bag module support bracket.
21. Remove the 3 nuts from the passenger air bag module.
22. CAUTION: Do not allow the passenger air bag module to hang from the wiring harness.
Damage to the wiring harness and connectors
may occur.
Lower the rear of the passenger air bag module off the 3 mounting studs. Move the passenger air
bag module rearward to release the 7 hooks from the I/P and rest the module on the cross vehicle
beam.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 9590
23. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the LH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
24. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the LH locking button released, remove the LH electrical connector from the passenger air
bag module.
25. Using a small screwdriver as shown, lift up and release the locking button on the RH passenger
air bag module electrical connector.
26. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger air bag module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button may
occur.
With the RH locking button released, remove the RH electrical connector. Remove the passenger
air bag module from the glove compartment opening.
All vehicles
27. From under the rear of the front passenger seat, slide and disengage the passenger seat side
air bag module electrical connector locking clip, and
then release the tab and disconnect the passenger seat side air bag module electrical connector.
28. Remove the passenger side D-pillar trim panel.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 9591
29. CAUTION: Do not pull the passenger safety canopy module electrical connector out by the
locking button. Damage to the locking button
may occur.
With the locking button released, remove the electrical connector from the passenger safety
canopy module.
30. Remove the driver side D-pillar trim panel.
31. CAUTION: Do not pull the driver safety canopy module electrical connector out by the locking
button. Damage to the locking button
may occur.
With the locking button released, remove the electrical connector from the driver safety canopy
module.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 9592
32. From under the rear of the driver seat, detach the driver seat side air bag module electrical
connector from the seat cushion frame. Then slide and
disengage the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector locking clip, and then release
the tab and disconnect the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector.
33. Install RCM fuse 46 (7.5A) to the SPDJB. 34. Connect the battery ground cable.
Reactivation
All vehicles 1. Remove RCM fuse 46 (7.5A) from the SPDJB. 2. Disconnect the battery ground
cable and wait at least one minute.
3. Connect the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector and then slide and engage the
seat side air bag electrical connector locking clip.
Then attach the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector to the seat cushion frame.
4. CAUTION:
- Do not install the safety canopy module electrical connector by the locking button. Damage to the
locking button may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector locking button must be in the released position
when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector is unique and cannot be reversed when connected
to the safety canopy module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the safety canopy
module. Do not force the electrical connector into the safety canopy module. Damage to the
connector or component may occur.
With the locking button released, install the driver safety canopy module electrical connector fully
into the driver safety canopy module and seat the locking button.
5. Install the driver side D-pillar trim panel.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 9593
6. CAUTION:
- Do not install the safety canopy module electrical connector by the locking button. Damage to the
locking button may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector locking button must be in the released position
when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The safety canopy module electrical connector is unique and cannot be reversed when connected
to the safety canopy module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the safety canopy
module. Do not force the electrical connector into the safety canopy module. Damage to the
connector or component may occur.
With the locking button released, install the passenger safety canopy module electrical connector
fully into the passenger safety canopy module and seat the locking button.
7. Install the passenger side D-pillar trim panel.
8. Connect the passenger seat side air bag module electrical connector and then slide and engage
the seat side air bag electrical connector locking
clip.
MKX
9. CAUTION:
- Do not install the passenger air bag module electrical connectors by the locking buttons. Damage
to the locking buttons may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connector locking buttons must be in the released
position when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the passenger air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in
the passenger air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the passenger air bag
module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 9594
Position the passenger air bag module on the cross vehicle beam. With the locking buttons
released, install the 2 passenger air bag module electrical connectors fully into the passenger air
bag module and seat the locking buttons.
10. NOTE: During the passenger air bag module installation, make sure all 7 of the hooks are fully
seated in the I/P.
Install the passenger air bag module 7 hooks into the I/P. Raise the rear of the passenger air bag
module onto the 3 mounting studs.
11. Install the 3 passenger air bag module nuts.
- Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
12. NOTE: To avoid a squeak or rattle condition, install the passenger air bag module bracket and
passenger air bag module bolts in this order.
Install the passenger air bag module support bracket and the 4 bolts. 1. Install the passenger air
bag module support bracket and 2 bolts to the cross vehicle beam.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
2. Install the inboard passenger air bag module support bracket-to-passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
3. Install the outboard passenger air bag module support bracket-to-passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 9595
13. Install the screw and the RH duct assembly.
14. Install the screw and the LH duct assembly.
15. Install the screw for the LH duct assembly bracket in the front of the I/P.
16. NOTE: Make sure the RH I/P finish panel 5 retaining clips are fully seated in the I/P.
Install the RH I/P finish panel.
Edge
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 9596
17. CAUTION:
- Do not install the passenger air bag module electrical connectors by the locking buttons. Damage
to the locking buttons may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connector locking buttons must be in the released
position when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the passenger air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in
the passenger air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the passenger air bag
module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
With the locking buttons released, install the 2 passenger air bag module electrical connectors fully
into the passenger air bag module and seat the locking buttons.
18. CAUTION: Do not handle the passenger air bag module by grabbing the edges of the
deployment doors. Damage to the air bag module
may occur.
NOTE: During air bag module installation, make sure all the deployment door clips are fully seated
in the I/P.
Install the passenger air bag module deployment door rear-most clips into the I/P first. Then install
the side deployment door clips working around to the forward-most clips seating each of them fully
into the I/P.
19. NOTE: To avoid a squeak or rattle condition, install the 2 passenger air bag module bolts in this
order.
Install the passenger air bag module 2 bolts. 1. Install the inboard passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
2. Install the outboard passenger air bag module bolt.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
All vehicles 20. Hook the glove compartment door to the I/P. Close the glove compartment door.
- If equipped, attach the glove compartment door dampener.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 9597
21. CAUTION:
- Do not install the driver air bag module electrical connectors by the locking buttons. Damage to
the locking buttons may occur.
- The driver air bag module electrical connector locking buttons must be in the released position
when the connector is being installed or connector damage may occur.
- The passenger air bag module electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the passenger air bag module. Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in
the passenger air bag module. Do not force the electrical connectors into the passenger air bag
module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
With the locking buttons released, install the driver air bag module electrical connectors fully into
the driver air bag module and seat the locking buttons.
22. NOTE: Audible clicks will be heard when both wire clips are seated in the driver air bag module.
Align the driver air bag module locking pins to the steering wheel and, while pushing inward, seat
the 2 driver air bag module locking pins to the steering wheel wire clips. When the 2 locking pins are seated in place, there should be an even gap between the driver air
bag module trim cover and the steering wheel.
23. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 24. Install RCM fuse 46 (7.5A) to the SPDJB and
install the lower kick panel fuse cover.
25. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in
front of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected. Failure to follow this instructions may result in serious personal
injury.
Connect the battery ground cable.
26. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag warning
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag SRS
fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will either: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash at a 5 Hz rate (RCM not configured).
The air bag warning indicator may not illuminate until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator will need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Clear all continuous DTCs from the restraints control module using a scan tool.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Tire Pressure Indicator > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection
Low Tire Pressure Indicator: Testing and Inspection
TPMS Indicator and Message Center Messages The TPMS indicator and vehicle message center
(if equipped) sometimes displays faults that cannot be resolved by the customer. Treat these
messages as TPMS faults that must be serviced.
TPMS Indicator Illuminates Continuously
NOTE: If the spare tire is in use, the damaged road tire must be repaired and installed on the
vehicle to restore complete TPMS functionality before carrying out any diagnosis.
1. The TPMS indicator remains on continuously for this condition:
^ Low Tire Pressure - The TPMS indicator is illuminated solid and the message center displays
LOW TIRE PRESSURE (if equipped). This is displayed when any of the tire pressures are low.
When this condition exists, the tire pressure must be adjusted to the recommended cold pressure
as indicated on the vehicle certification label.
2. NOTE: The TPMS sensors do not transmit when the vehicle is stationary. If the vehicle has been
stationary for more than 30 minutes, it will be
necessary to wake up the sensors so they will transmit the latest tire pressure information to the
SJB.
If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, perform this procedure to wake up the
TPMS sensors. 1
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
2 Adjust the air pressure in the LF tire (as necessary).
3 Activate the LF TPMS sensor, at least 2 times, using the tire pressure monitor activation tool.
4 Repeat Steps 2 and 3 for the remaining tires.
5 If the TPMS indicator remains illuminated after adjusting and activating each sensor, GO to
Symptom Chart. See: Tire Monitoring System/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic
Procedures
TPMS Indicator Flashes The TPMS indicator flashes for 70 seconds, then remains ON solid when
the ignition switch is turned to the ON position, for these conditions:
1. Tire Pressure Sensor Fault - If equipped, the message center will display TIRE SENSOR FAULT
when a tire pressure sensor is malfunctioning.
GO to Symptom Chart. See: Tire Monitoring System/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
2. No communication with the SJB (TPMS is integral to the SJB) - The TPMS indicator is
illuminated when the instrument cluster has received no
signals from the SJB for more than 5 seconds. If equipped, the message center displays TIRE
MONITOR FAULT. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Tire Monitoring System/Testing and
Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
3. Tire Pressure Monitor Fault - If equipped, the message center will display TIRE MONITOR
FAULT when the tire pressure monitoring system is
malfunctioning or communication with the instrument cluster has been lost. GO to Symptom Chart.
See: Tire Monitoring System/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator: Service and Repair
Ford provides no information related to a Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator for this vehicle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP (MIL)
CHECK ENGINE, SERVICE ENGINE SOON, Or ISO Standard Engine Symbol
The MIL notifies the driver that the powertrain control module (PCM) has detected an on board
diagnostic (OBD) emission-related component or system concern. When this occurs, an OBD
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) sets.
- The MIL is located in the instrument cluster and is labeled CHECK ENGINE, SERVICE ENGINE
SOON or the international standards organization (ISO) standard engine symbol.
- The MIL is illuminated during the instrument cluster prove out for approximately 4 seconds.
- The MIL remains illuminated after instrument cluster prove out if: an emission-related concern and DTC exists.
- the PCM does not send a control message to the instrument cluster (applications with the MIL
controlled through the communication link).
- the PCM is operating in the hardware limited operation strategy (HLOS).
- The MIL remains off during the instrument cluster prove out if an indicator or instrument cluster
concern is present.
- To turn off the MIL after a repair, a reset command from the scan tool must be sent, or 3
consecutive drive cycles must be completed without a concern.
- For all MIL concerns, go to Symptom Charts. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
- If the MIL flashes at a steady rate, a severe misfire condition may exist.
- If the MIL flashes erratically, the PCM can reset while cranking if the battery voltage is low.
- The MIL flashes after a period of time with the key in the RUN position (engine not running) if
DTC P1000 is set.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Change Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Oil Change Reminder Lamp: Service and Repair
Ford provides no information related to an Oil Change Reminder Lamp.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9613
C103
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9614
Oil Pressure Sender: Service and Repair
Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) Switch
Material
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove the cooling fan assembly. For additional information,
refer to Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories. 3. Disconnect the engine oil pressure
(EOP) switch electrical connector. 4. Remove the EOP switch.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Apply thread sealant with PTFE to the EOP switch threads prior to installation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Outside Temperature Display > Outside
Temperature Display Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Outside Temperature Display > Outside
Temperature Display Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 9619
C198
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Assist Warning Indicator >
Component Information > Diagrams
C3268
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Left Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9626
C2015
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9627
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Service and Repair
Parking Brake Warning Indicator Switch
Parking Brake Warning Indicator Switch
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the parking brake warning indicator switch electrical connector. 2. Remove the
parking brake warning indicator switch screw and the switch. 3. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Seat Belt Reminder Lamp: Description and Operation
Safety Belt Warning Indicator and Chime
The warning indicator and chime are reminders to fasten the safety belt. The system operates as
follows: If the driver safety belt is not buckled before the ignition key is turned to the RUN or START
position, the indicator will illuminate for 1 to 2 minutes and the warning chime sounds for 4 to 8
seconds.
- If the safety belt is buckled while the indicator is on and the chime is sounding, the indicator and
warning chime turn off.
- If the safety belt is buckled before the key is turned to the ON position, neither the indicator nor
the chime will turn on.
Belt-Minder(R)
The Belt-Minder(R) feature is a supplemental warning to the safety belt warning function. This
feature provides an additional reminder that the driver's and/or front passenger's safety belt is
unbuckled by intermittently sounding a chime and illuminating the safety belt warning lamp in the
instrument cluster.
To activate or deactivate the Belt-Minder(R) feature, refer to Seat Belt Systems or the Owner's
Literature.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair
INSTRUMENT PANEL DIMMER SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument panel side finish panel.
2. NOTE: The switch is removed by pushing from behind.
Release the tabs and remove the headlamp switch assembly. Disconnect the electrical connectors.
3. Release the 4 tabs and remove the instrument panel dimmer switch. 4. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-25 (Liftgate - Edge)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9638
C479
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: >
08-1-7 > Jan > 08 > Instruments - Inaccurate Fuel Gauge
Fuel Gauge Sender: Customer Interest Instruments - Inaccurate Fuel Gauge
TSB 08-1-7
01/21/08
INACCURATE FUEL GAUGE INDICATOR - VEHICLE BUILT BEFORE 11/1/2007
FORD: 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Edge and MKX vehicles built before 11/1/2007, may experience an
inaccurate low fuel gauge indicator. This condition may be caused by a stuck float arm on the fuel
delivery module. The fuel delivery module float arm could get hung up on the fuel tank baffle plate.
This failure mode will only occur when the fuel tank is at or near empty fuel level. When the fuel
tank is refilled to a full level, the fuel gauge will continue to read a low fuel fill level. For all other fuel
gauge related concerns, refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 413-01.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. To make this repair it will be necessary to remove the fuel pump module from the fuel tank.
Follow WSM, Section 310-01.
2. Once the fuel delivery module is removed from the fuel tank, access the fuel tank baffle through
the fuel tank fuel delivery opening. (Figure 1)
3. Move the baffle plate with a wooden object or by hand towards the front of the vehicle to prevent
interference between the baffle and the float arm. The fuel tank baffle plate is a metal plate that is
easy to move by hand or using a tool with no consequent damage to the baffle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: >
08-1-7 > Jan > 08 > Instruments - Inaccurate Fuel Gauge > Page 9647
4. The fuel delivery module float arm should have a clearance of 1 5/32" (29.63 mm) in the empty
tank position (bottom) and 13/16" (20.73 mm) in the full tank position (up). (Figure 2)
5. Install the fuel delivery module following WSM, Section 310-01.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
080107A 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.7 Hrs.
Reposition the Fuel Tank Baffle Plate. Includes Time to Remove Rear Seat and Fuel Delivery
Module. (Do Not Use With 9350E, 63100B,63100B, 9275A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9002 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge
Sender: > 08-1-7 > Jan > 08 > Instruments - Inaccurate Fuel Gauge
Fuel Gauge Sender: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Inaccurate Fuel Gauge
TSB 08-1-7
01/21/08
INACCURATE FUEL GAUGE INDICATOR - VEHICLE BUILT BEFORE 11/1/2007
FORD: 2007-2008 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Edge and MKX vehicles built before 11/1/2007, may experience an
inaccurate low fuel gauge indicator. This condition may be caused by a stuck float arm on the fuel
delivery module. The fuel delivery module float arm could get hung up on the fuel tank baffle plate.
This failure mode will only occur when the fuel tank is at or near empty fuel level. When the fuel
tank is refilled to a full level, the fuel gauge will continue to read a low fuel fill level. For all other fuel
gauge related concerns, refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 413-01.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. To make this repair it will be necessary to remove the fuel pump module from the fuel tank.
Follow WSM, Section 310-01.
2. Once the fuel delivery module is removed from the fuel tank, access the fuel tank baffle through
the fuel tank fuel delivery opening. (Figure 1)
3. Move the baffle plate with a wooden object or by hand towards the front of the vehicle to prevent
interference between the baffle and the float arm. The fuel tank baffle plate is a metal plate that is
easy to move by hand or using a tool with no consequent damage to the baffle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge
Sender: > 08-1-7 > Jan > 08 > Instruments - Inaccurate Fuel Gauge > Page 9653
4. The fuel delivery module float arm should have a clearance of 1 5/32" (29.63 mm) in the empty
tank position (bottom) and 13/16" (20.73 mm) in the full tank position (up). (Figure 2)
5. Install the fuel delivery module following WSM, Section 310-01.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
080107A 2007-2008 Edge/MKX: 1.7 Hrs.
Reposition the Fuel Tank Baffle Plate. Includes Time to Remove Rear Seat and Fuel Delivery
Module. (Do Not Use With 9350E, 63100B,63100B, 9275A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9002 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9656
View 151-14 (Left Rear)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Module
C463
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9659
C434
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9660
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation
FUEL PUMP (FP) MODULE
Typical Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9661
Typical Mechanical Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
The FP module is a device that contains the fuel pump and sender assembly. The fuel pump is
located inside the FP module reservoir and supplies fuel through the FP module manifold to the
engine and FP module jet pump. The jet pump continuously refills the reservoir with fuel, and a
check valve located in the manifold outlet maintains system pressure when the fuel pump is not
energized. A flapper valve located in the bottom of the reservoir allows fuel to enter the reservoir
and prime the fuel pump during the initial fill.
FUEL PUMP (FP) MODULE AND RESERVOIR
The FP module is mounted inside the fuel tank in a reservoir. The pump has a discharge check
valve that maintains the system pressure after the key has been turned off to minimize starting
concerns. The reservoir prevents fuel flow interruptions during extreme vehicle maneuvers with low
tank fill levels.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module
FUEL PUMP MODULE
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9664
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9665
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9666
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
repairing or disconnecting any of the fuel system components, the fuel system pressure must be
relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel causing personal injury or a fire hazard.
All vehicles
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9667
1. Release the fuel system pressure. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3. Release the fuel
tank filler cap and position aside.
4. Insert a suitable fuel drain tube into the fuel tank filler pipe until it reaches the fuel tank inlet
spout. 5. Attach the fuel storage tanker to the fuel drain tube and remove any residual fuel
remaining in the fuel tank filler pipe. 6. Remove the rear seat. 7. Position the carpet and/or any
insulation covering the fuel pump (FP) module access cover aside.
8. Remove the 4 screws and the FP module access cover.
9. Disconnect the FP module electrical connector.
10. Disconnect the fuel tank supply tube-to-FP module quick connect coupling.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9668
11. CAUTION: Place absorbent pads on the floor pan in the immediate area in case of fuel spills.
Carefully remove the fuel pump (FP)
module from the vehicle to avoid fuel spillage inside the vehicle.
Using the special tool, remove the FP module lock ring retainer.
All wheel drive (AWD) vehicles
12. CAUTION: The fuel pump (FP) module must be handled carefully to avoid damage to the FP
module and/or float arm.
Carefully lift the FP module out of the fuel tank enough to access and disconnect the fuel tank
crossover tube-to-FP module quick connect coupling.
All vehicles
13. CAUTION: The fuel pump (FP) module will have residual fuel remaining internally, drain into a
suitable container.
Completely remove the FP module from the fuel tank.
14. CAUTION:
- Inspect the mating surfaces of the fuel pump (FP) module flange and the fuel tank O-ring seal
contact surfaces. Do not polish or adjust the O-ring seal contact area of the fuel tank flange or the
fuel tank. Install a new FP module or fuel tank if the O-ring seal contact area is bent, scratched or
corroded.
- Make sure to install a new fuel pump (FP) module O-ring seal. Install a new lock ring if it is bent,
damaged or corroded.
NOTE: To install, apply clean engine oil to the O-ring seal.
Remove the FP module O-ring seal.
15. NOTE: Make sure the alignment tab on the fuel pump (FP) module and the fuel tank meet
before tightening the FP module lock ring.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9669
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Fuel Level Sensor
FUEL LEVEL SENSOR
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9670
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 1)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9671
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Vehicle (Part 2)
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9672
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- This procedure involves fuel handling. Be prepared for spillage at all times and always observe
fuel handling precautions. Failure to follow these instructions can result in personal injury.
1. Release the fuel system pressure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9673
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3. Release the fuel tank filler cap and position aside.
4. Insert a suitable fuel drain tube into the fuel tank filler pipe until it reaches the fuel tank inlet
spout.
5. CAUTION: The fuel pump (FP) module and fuel level sensor will be below the fuel level in the
tank when the tank is full. Make sure to
drain 1/8 of the fuel capacity through the filler pipe prior to removing the fuel level sensor or fuel
spillage will occur.
Attach the fuel storage tanker to the fuel drain tube and remove any residual fuel remaining in the
fuel tank filler pipe.
6. Remove the rear seat. 7. Position the carpet and/or any insulation covering the fuel level sensor
access cover aside.
8. Remove the 4 screws and the fuel level sensor access cover.
9. Disconnect the fuel level sensor electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pump Module > Page 9674
10. CAUTION: Place absorbant pads in the general work area in case of fuel spillage.
Release the lock tab, rotate the fuel level sensor counterclockwise approximately 1/4 turn and lift
upward.
11. CAUTION:
- The fuel level sensor must be handled carefully to avoid damage to the float arm.
- Carefully remove the fuel level sensor from the fuel tank to avoid fuel spillage inside the vehicle.
Carefully lift and remove the fuel level sensor from the fuel tank.
12. CAUTION: Inspect the mating surfaces of the fuel level sensor flange and the fuel tank O-ring
seal contact surfaces. Do not polish or
adjust the O-ring seal contact area of the fuel tank flange or the fuel tank. Install a new fuel level
sensor or fuel tank if the O-ring seal contact area is bent, scratched or corroded.
NOTE: To install, apply clean engine oil to the O-ring seal.
- Upon installation, properly seat and press down firmly on the fuel level sensor, rotate it clockwise
until the lock arrow on the sensor aligns with the notch on the tank. Torque should not exceed 15
Nm (11 lb-ft).
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Outside Temperature Display Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Outside Temperature Display Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 9678
C198
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Parking Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Left Front)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Parking Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9682
C2015
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Parking Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9683
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Service and Repair
Parking Brake Warning Indicator Switch
Parking Brake Warning Indicator Switch
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the parking brake warning indicator switch electrical connector. 2. Remove the
parking brake warning indicator switch screw and the switch. 3. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Low Tire Pressure
Indicator > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Low Tire Pressure Indicator: Testing and Inspection
TPMS Indicator and Message Center Messages The TPMS indicator and vehicle message center
(if equipped) sometimes displays faults that cannot be resolved by the customer. Treat these
messages as TPMS faults that must be serviced.
TPMS Indicator Illuminates Continuously
NOTE: If the spare tire is in use, the damaged road tire must be repaired and installed on the
vehicle to restore complete TPMS functionality before carrying out any diagnosis.
1. The TPMS indicator remains on continuously for this condition:
^ Low Tire Pressure - The TPMS indicator is illuminated solid and the message center displays
LOW TIRE PRESSURE (if equipped). This is displayed when any of the tire pressures are low.
When this condition exists, the tire pressure must be adjusted to the recommended cold pressure
as indicated on the vehicle certification label.
2. NOTE: The TPMS sensors do not transmit when the vehicle is stationary. If the vehicle has been
stationary for more than 30 minutes, it will be
necessary to wake up the sensors so they will transmit the latest tire pressure information to the
SJB.
If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, perform this procedure to wake up the
TPMS sensors. 1
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
2 Adjust the air pressure in the LF tire (as necessary).
3 Activate the LF TPMS sensor, at least 2 times, using the tire pressure monitor activation tool.
4 Repeat Steps 2 and 3 for the remaining tires.
5 If the TPMS indicator remains illuminated after adjusting and activating each sensor, GO to
Symptom Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
TPMS Indicator Flashes The TPMS indicator flashes for 70 seconds, then remains ON solid when
the ignition switch is turned to the ON position, for these conditions:
1. Tire Pressure Sensor Fault - If equipped, the message center will display TIRE SENSOR FAULT
when a tire pressure sensor is malfunctioning.
GO to Symptom Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
2. No communication with the SJB (TPMS is integral to the SJB) - The TPMS indicator is
illuminated when the instrument cluster has received no
signals from the SJB for more than 5 seconds. If equipped, the message center displays TIRE
MONITOR FAULT. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
3. Tire Pressure Monitor Fault - If equipped, the message center will display TIRE MONITOR
FAULT when the tire pressure monitoring system is
malfunctioning or communication with the instrument cluster has been lost. GO to Symptom Chart.
See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training
Special Tool(s)
NOTE: If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, the sensors will go into a "sleep
mode" to conserve battery power. It will be necessary to wake them up so they will transmit the
latest tire pressure information to the Smart Junction Box (SJB).
NOTE: The tire pressure sensor training procedure must be done on a single vehicle, in an area
without radio frequency noise and at least 1 m (3 ft) away from other vehicles equipped with a Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS).
Radio frequency noise is generated by electrical motors and appliance operation, cellular
telephones, remote transmitters, power inverters and portable entertainment equipment.
NOTE: If a sensor does not respond to the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool, attempt to
activate the same sensor with the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. If the sensor still does not
respond, move the vehicle to rotate the wheels at least one-fourth of a turn and attempt to activate
the same sensor again.
NOTE: The SJB has a 2-minute time limit between sensor responses. If the SJB does not
recognize any 1 of the 4 tire pressure sensors during this time limit, the horn will sound twice and
the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE NOT TRAINED REPEAT and the entire
procedure must be repeated.
NOTE: For vehicles with different front and rear tire pressures (such as the E-Series and certain
F-Series), the tire pressure sensors must be trained following a tire rotation. Failure to train the
sensors will cause the TPMS indicator to illuminate. For vehicles with the same tire pressure for
front and rear tires, tire rotation will not affect the system.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position, then press and release the brake pedal. 2. Cycle the
ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position. 3.
Press and release the brake pedal. 4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position. 5. Turn the
ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position.
- The horn will sound once and the TPMS indicator will flash if the training mode has been entered
successfully. If equipped, the message center will display TRAIN LF TIRE.
NOTE: It may take up to 6 seconds to activate a tire pressure sensor. During this time, the Tire
Pressure Monitor Activation Tool must remain in place 180 degrees from the valve stem.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 9691
6. Place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the LF tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees)
from the valve stem. Press and release the test
button on the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. The horn will sound briefly to indicate that the
tire pressure sensor has been recognized by the SJB.
7. Within 2 minutes of the horn sounding, place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the RF
tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees) from the
valve stem and press and release the test button to train the RF tire pressure sensor.
NOTE: Do not wait more than 2 minutes between training each sensor or the SJB will time out and
the entire procedure must be repeated.
8. Repeat Step 7 for the RR and LR tires.
The procedure is completed after the last tire has been trained. When the training procedure is
complete, the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE TRAINING COMPLETE. For vehicles
not equipped with a message center, successful completion of the training procedure will be
verified by turning the ignition switch to the OFF position without the horn sounding. If the horn
sounds twice when the switch is turned to the OFF position, the training procedure was not
successful.
9. Using the scan tool, locate the updated TPMS sensor identifiers trained to the SJB and
document them on the applicable warranty claim.
NOTE: This step is required to clear DTC C2780, cause the SJB to exit the manufacturing mode
and to make sure there are no other concerns with a newly programmed SJB.
10. If the sensors are being trained due to the installation of a new SJB, clear any DTCs and carry
out the SJB On-Demand Self Test.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Disassembly
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application.
When installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color
of the sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor can be removed and installed without removing the strap or the cradle.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
1. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Dismount the tire only as
instructed.
Remove the tire from the wheel.
2. CAUTION: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to
the sensor locking clip can occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the sensor locking clip.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 9694
3. CAUTION: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to
the sensor can occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver or similar tool, detach the sensor from the cradle.
4. Remove the sensor.
Assembly
1. CAUTION: Damage to the sensor can occur if excessive force is applied during sensor
installation.
NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the cradle. The sensor will make a "click" noise
when correctly seated.
Position the sensor into the cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end of the
cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. NOTE: The locking clip can only be fully seated when installed in the correct orientation. If the
sensor locking clip cannot be fully inserted, then
the sensor may not be fully seated on the cradle or the locking clip may be inserted backward.
Insert a new locking clip into the sensor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 9695
3. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel.
4. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 9696
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and
Cradle
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and Cradle
Material
Disassembly
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 9697
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application.
When installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color
of the sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor is available separately, the cradle and strap are available as a strap kit. There
are several different strap kits available based on wheel diameter but all strap kits share the same
base part number.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
1. Remove the tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor.
2. WARNING: The TPMS band is under tension. Always use safety goggles or a face shield and
gloves when removing the TPMS
band/strap. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
Remove a factory installed strap in this sequence: 1
Locate the strap buckle and secure the strap to the wheel using duct tape or a similar item, on both
sides of the buckle approximately 25 mm (0.98 inch) from the buckle.
2 Using a large screwdriver and a twisting motion, unbuckle the strap.
3 Discard the strap.
3. To remove a dealer installed strap, turn the worm gear screw until the strap is fully released from
the worm gear.
^ Discard the strap.
4. NOTE: To aid assembly, mark the location of the cradle prior to disassembly.
Using a screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the cradle by inserting the screwdriver under the cradle
and prying up.
Assembly
1. NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the new cradle. The sensor will make a "click"
noise when fully seated.
Position the sensor into the new cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end
of the cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. CAUTION: Metal scrapers can damage the wheel. Use only plastic or non-metallic scrapers to
remove the cradle adhesive strip residue.
NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be installed in the drop well of the wheel, 180 degrees from the
valve stem.
Clean the area where the sensor and cradle are to be installed.
3. NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be positioned with the hinge side of the sensor on the RH
side when viewed from the curb side (beauty side)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 9698
of the wheel.
NOTE: The sensor has raised markings indicating how to position the sensor.
Remove the adhesive tape liner from the cradle and position the sensor and cradle into the wheel
drop well 180 degrees from the valve stem.
4. Install the tapered end of the strap through the opening of the cradle on the hinge side of the
sensor. This will position the worm gear on the
locking clip side of the sensor.
5. CAUTION: Steel wheels have a "high spot" along their circumference. Make sure the strap is
positioned in the lowest spot possible for
correct sensor and cradle retention.
NOTE: Keep the strap parallel with the wheel flange while tightening the worm gear.
Position the worm gear 13-26 mm (0.5-1.0 inch) away from the sensor and tighten the worm gear.
^
Tighten to 3 Nm (27 inch lbs).
6. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel.
7. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL INDICATOR LAMP (TCIL)
The TCIL is an output signal from the PCM that controls the lamp on/off function depending on the
engagement or disengagement of overdrive.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-8 (behind Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 9706
Ambient Light Sensor: Diagrams
C286
C287
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 9707
Ambient Light Sensor: Service and Repair
LIGHT SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Using a suitable tool, remove the light sensor.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
2. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 9712
Backup Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 9713
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Brake Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9718
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9719
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9720
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9721
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9722
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9723
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9724
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9725
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9726
Brake Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9727
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9728
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9729
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9730
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9731
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9732
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9733
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9734
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9735
Brake Lamp: Connector Views
C415
C412
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9736
Brake Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
90-1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9737
90-2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9738
90-4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9739
90-5
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Brake Lamp: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
1. Verify the customer concern.
Visual Inspection Chart
2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of mechanical or electrical damage. 3. If an obvious cause for
an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible) before proceeding to the
next step.
NOTE: Make sure the headlamp switch is in the OFF position.
- Make sure the multifunction switch is in the LOW BEAM position.
4. NOTE: Make sure to use the latest scan tool software release.
If the cause is not visually evident, connect the scan tool to the data link connector (DLC).
5. NOTE: The vehicle communication module (VCM) LED prove-out confirms power and ground
from the DLC are provided to the VCM.
If the scan tool does not communicate with the VCM: Check the VCM connection to the vehicle.
- Check the scan tool connection to the VCM.
- Refer to Information Bus (Module Communications Network), No Power To The Scan Tool, to
diagnose no communication with the scan tool.
6. If the scan tool does not communicate with the vehicle:
- Verify the ignition key is in the ON position.
- Verify the scan tool operation with a known good vehicle.
- Refer to Information Bus (Module Communications Network) to diagnose no response from the
PCM.
7. Carry out the network test.
- If the scan tool responds with no communication for one or more modules, refer to Information
Bus (Module Communications Network).
- If the network test passes, retrieve and record the continuous memory DTCs.
8. Clear the continuous DTCs and carry out the self-test diagnostics for the SJB. 9. If the DTCs
retrieved are related to the concern, go to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Charts. For all other
DTCs, refer to Body Control Systems
(Multifunction Electronic Control Module). See: Diagnostic Trouble Code Descriptions
10. If no DTCs related to the concern are retrieved, GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9742
B1485-B2047
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9743
Symptom Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9744
Brake Lamp: Pinpoint Tests
Test H: All the Stoplamps Are Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST H: ALL THE STOPLAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE
H1
H1-H2
Normal Operation
The stoplamp switch is supplied voltage through circuit SBB71 (WH/RD) from the battery junction
box (BJB). When the brake pedal is applied, the stoplamp switch routes voltage to the smart
junction box (SJB) and the high mounted stoplamp through circuit CCB08 (VT/WH).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9745
- Stoplamp switch
Test I: One Or More Stoplamps Are Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST I: ONE OR MORE STOPLAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE
I1-I2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9746
I3-I6
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9747
I7-I9
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9748
I9-I10
Normal Operation
When the brake pedal is applied, the stoplamp switch routes voltage to the smart junction box
(SJB) and the high mounted stoplamp through circuit CCB08 (VT/WH). When the SJB detects the
brake pedal is applied, the SJB provides voltage to the LH and RH rear stoplamps through circuits
CLS18 (GY/BN) and CLS19 (VT/OG), respectively. If equipped with trailer tow, voltage is also
routed to the LH and RH trailer tow stop/turn relays. Ground for the LH and RH rear stoplamps is
provided through circuits GD149 (BK/GY) and GD151 (BK/GN), respectively. Ground for the high
mounted stoplamp is provided through circuit GD149 (BK/GY).
DTC B2044 Left Rear Stop Lamp Circuit Short to Ground - is a continuous and on-demand DTC
that sets when the SJB detects a short to ground on the LH rear stop/turn lamp voltage supply
circuit.
DTC B2045 Left Rear Stop Lamp Circuit Open - is an on-demand DTC that sets when the SJB
detects an open on the LH rear stop/turn lamp voltage supply circuit.
DTC B2046 Right Rear Stop Lamp Circuit Short to Ground - is a continuous and on-demand DTC
that sets when the SJB detects a short to ground on the RH rear stop/turn lamp voltage supply
circuit.
DTC B2047 Right Rear Stop Lamp Circuit Open - is an on-demand DTC that sets when the SJB
detects an open on the RH rear stop/turn lamp voltage supply circuit.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Trailer tow stop/turn relay (if equipped)
- High mounted stoplamp
- SJB
Test J: The Stoplamps Are On Continuously
PINPOINT TEST J: THE STOPLAMPS ARE ON CONTINUOUSLY
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9749
J1-J7
Normal Operation
When the brake pedal is applied, the stoplamp switch routes voltage to the smart junction box
(SJB) and the high mounted stoplamp and the PCM through circuit CCB08 (VT/WH). When the
SJB detects the brake pedal applied, the SJB provides voltage to the LH and RH rear stoplamps
through circuits CLS18 (GY/BN) and CLS19 (VT/OG), respectively. If equipped with trailer tow,
voltage is also supplied to the respective trailer tow stop/turn relay.
DTC B1485 Brake Pedal Input Short to Battery - is an on-demand DTC that sets when the SJB
detects a short to voltage from the stoplamp switch input circuit.
DTC B2045 Left Rear Stop Lamp Circuit Open - is an on-demand DTC that sets when the SJB
detects a short to voltage on the LH rear stop/turn lamp voltage supply circuit.
DTC B2047 Right Rear Stop Lamp Circuit Open - is an on-demand DTC that sets when the SJB
detects a short to voltage on the RH rear stop/turn lamp voltage supply circuit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9750
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Stoplamp switch
- PCM
- SJB
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page
9751
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest for Brake Light Switch: > 07-11-9 > Jun > 07 > Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging
Brake Light Switch: Customer Interest Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging
TSB 07-11-9
06/11/07
BRAKE DRAG
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some Edge/MKX vehicles may exhibit brake drag from the rear wheels or all wheels.
Customers may notice an odor and/or reduced powertrain performance. In some cases, the driver
may also note an integral vehicle dynamics (IVD) light after driving a given distance due to
pressure noted in the module without a change in brake on/off (BOO) state.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure to resolve brake drag concerns.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Raise the vehicle on a hoist, with engine running, and vehicle in park. Rotate all of the wheels by
hand to verify excessive force is necessary to turn wheels.
^ To resolve the brake drag concern from all wheels - Replacement of the BOO switch is
necessary.
^ To resolve the brake drag concern from the rear wheels only - Adjustment of the park brake
cables are necessary.
BOO Switch Replacement (All Brakes Drag) Removal
1. With the vehicle shut off and in park, remove the stop lamp switch by rotating the stop lamp
switch in the clockwise direction.
2. If the brake pedal moves up during the removal of the switch, the pedal was being inadvertently
held down by the stop lamp switch thus keeping the hydraulic circuits pressurized. Refer to
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 417-01.
3. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the switch and discard the switch.
Installation
NOTE
INSTALLATION OF THE NEW STOP LAMP SWITCH MUST BE DONE WITH THE BRAKE
PEDAL AT ITS NORMALLY INSTALLED AND RESTING POSITION. DO NOT PULL UP OR
PUSH DOWN ON THE BRAKE PEDAL DURING STOP LAMP SWITCH INSTALLATION. REFER
TO WSM, Section 417-01.
1. With the brake pedal at its rest position, insert the new stop lamp switch into the keyed hole on
the brake pedal and rotate the switch 45 degrees counter-clockwise to seat the switch. You may
hear a click sound during this step, this is normal.
2. Plug the wire harness connector to the new stop lamp switch.
3. Verify that the brake lamps are functioning properly and that the brakes are no longer dragging.
Park Cable Adjustment (Rear Brakes Drag)
Brake drag noted on rear wheels only likely caused by over adjusted park brake equalizer
adjustment (or all 3 cable lengths built at the minimum levels).
1. With vehicle on Hoist and shut off, verify rear brake pads are positioned properly per WSM,
Section 206-04: Rear Disc Brake.
2. With a fully released parking brake pedal, back off the adjustment until the wheels spin freely.
NOTE
DISTANCE BETWEEN THE NUT AND END OF THE STUD SHOULD BE 7/8" (22 mm)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest for Brake Light Switch: > 07-11-9 > Jun > 07 > Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging > Page 9760
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071109A 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.4 Hr.
Diagnose, Replace BOO Switch (Do Not Use With 13480A)
071109B 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.4 Hr.
Diagnose, Adjust Park Brake (Do Not Use With 2780B)
071109C 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.5 Hr.
Diagnose, Replace BOO Switch, And Adjust Park Brake (Do Not Use With 13480A, 2780B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
13480 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 07-11-9 > Jun > 07 > Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging
Brake Light Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging
TSB 07-11-9
06/11/07
BRAKE DRAG
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some Edge/MKX vehicles may exhibit brake drag from the rear wheels or all wheels.
Customers may notice an odor and/or reduced powertrain performance. In some cases, the driver
may also note an integral vehicle dynamics (IVD) light after driving a given distance due to
pressure noted in the module without a change in brake on/off (BOO) state.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure to resolve brake drag concerns.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Raise the vehicle on a hoist, with engine running, and vehicle in park. Rotate all of the wheels by
hand to verify excessive force is necessary to turn wheels.
^ To resolve the brake drag concern from all wheels - Replacement of the BOO switch is
necessary.
^ To resolve the brake drag concern from the rear wheels only - Adjustment of the park brake
cables are necessary.
BOO Switch Replacement (All Brakes Drag) Removal
1. With the vehicle shut off and in park, remove the stop lamp switch by rotating the stop lamp
switch in the clockwise direction.
2. If the brake pedal moves up during the removal of the switch, the pedal was being inadvertently
held down by the stop lamp switch thus keeping the hydraulic circuits pressurized. Refer to
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 417-01.
3. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the switch and discard the switch.
Installation
NOTE
INSTALLATION OF THE NEW STOP LAMP SWITCH MUST BE DONE WITH THE BRAKE
PEDAL AT ITS NORMALLY INSTALLED AND RESTING POSITION. DO NOT PULL UP OR
PUSH DOWN ON THE BRAKE PEDAL DURING STOP LAMP SWITCH INSTALLATION. REFER
TO WSM, Section 417-01.
1. With the brake pedal at its rest position, insert the new stop lamp switch into the keyed hole on
the brake pedal and rotate the switch 45 degrees counter-clockwise to seat the switch. You may
hear a click sound during this step, this is normal.
2. Plug the wire harness connector to the new stop lamp switch.
3. Verify that the brake lamps are functioning properly and that the brakes are no longer dragging.
Park Cable Adjustment (Rear Brakes Drag)
Brake drag noted on rear wheels only likely caused by over adjusted park brake equalizer
adjustment (or all 3 cable lengths built at the minimum levels).
1. With vehicle on Hoist and shut off, verify rear brake pads are positioned properly per WSM,
Section 206-04: Rear Disc Brake.
2. With a fully released parking brake pedal, back off the adjustment until the wheels spin freely.
NOTE
DISTANCE BETWEEN THE NUT AND END OF THE STUD SHOULD BE 7/8" (22 mm)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 07-11-9 > Jun > 07 > Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging >
Page 9766
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071109A 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.4 Hr.
Diagnose, Replace BOO Switch (Do Not Use With 13480A)
071109B 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.4 Hr.
Diagnose, Adjust Park Brake (Do Not Use With 2780B)
071109C 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.5 Hr.
Diagnose, Replace BOO Switch, And Adjust Park Brake (Do Not Use With 13480A, 2780B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
13480 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Page 9767
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Page 9768
C2064
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Page 9769
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal to the
PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Page 9770
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
STOPLAMP SWITCH
Removal
1. Disconnect the stoplamp switch electrical connector.
2. NOTE: The stoplamp switch will be difficult to remove if the switch plunger is not depressed. A
slight rearward force should be adequate to
depress the plunger.
With a light force (approximately 1-4 N [1-3 lb]), pull rearward on the brake pedal, rotate the
stoplamp switch 45 degrees clockwise and remove the stoplamp switch.
Installation
CAUTION: It is very important to not press, pull or touch the brake pedal assembly during the
installation of the stoplamp switch. Failure to follow these instructions may damage the stoplamp
switch.
1. Without movement to the brake pedal assembly, install the stoplamp switch and rotate 45
degrees counterclockwise. 2. Connect the stoplamp switch electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Cargo Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams
C926
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams
C904
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Courtesy Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9781
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9782
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9783
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9784
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9785
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9786
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9787
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9788
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9789
Courtesy Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9790
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9791
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9792
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9793
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9794
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9795
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9796
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9797
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9798
Courtesy Lamp: Connector Views
C4352
C923
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9799
C918
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9800
Courtesy Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
89-1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9801
89-2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9802
89-3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9803
89-4
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Courtesy Lamp: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Inspection and Verification
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
1. Verify the customer concern.
Visual Inspection Chart
2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of mechanical or electrical damage. 3. If an obvious cause for
an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible) before proceeding to the
next step.
4. NOTE: Make sure to use the latest scan tool release software.
If the cause is not visually evident, connect the scan tool to the data link connector (DLC).
5. NOTE: The vehicle communication module (VCM) LED prove-out confirms power and ground
from the DLC are provided to the VCM.
If the scan tool does not communicate with the VCM: Check the VCM connection to the vehicle.
- Check the scan tool connection to the VCM.
- Refer to Information Bus (Module Communications Network), No Power To The Scan Tool, to
diagnose no communication with the scan tool.
6. If the scan tool does not communicate with the vehicle:
- Verify the ignition key is in the ON position.
- Verify the scan tool operation with a known good vehicle.
- Refer to Information Bus (Module Communications Network) to diagnose no response from the
PCM.
7. Carry out the network test.
- If the scan tool responds with no communication with the SJB, refer to Information Bus (Module
Communications Network).
- If the network test passes, retrieve and record the continuous memory DTCs.
8. Clear the continuous DTCs and carry out the self-test diagnostics for the SJB. 9. If the DTCs
retrieved are related to the concern, go to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Charts. For all other
DTCs, refer to Body Control Systems
(Multifunction Electronic Control Module). See: Diagnostic Trouble Code Descriptions
10. If no DTCs related to the concern are retrieved, GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Principles of Operation
PRINCIPLES OF OPERATION
The smart junction box (SJB) supplies voltage to the interior lighting system. The interior lighting
system illuminates the courtesy lamps to enhance visibility of the interior while a vehicle door is
open or ajar, and the vehicle speed is less than 15 km/h (9 mph). The SJB controls all interior
lighting functions and timing by monitoring inputs from the door ajar switches and vehicle speed.
Interior Lighting Delay
The interior lighting delay feature provides temporary illumination of the courtesy lamps after the
doors are opened and then closed. The interior
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9806
lighting delay feature keeps the courtesy lamps on for a period of 25 seconds after all the doors are
closed. If during the 25 second delay time the SJB detects that the ignition has been turned out of
OFF, or if the vehicle is locked using the remote keyless entry (RKE) transmitter or the keypad, the
courtesy lamp illumination is discontinued.
Illuminated Entry
The illuminated entry requests the courtesy lamps to be illuminated (when the ignition is OFF) and
either the RKE transmitter UNLOCK button is pressed, or the vehicle is unlocked using the keypad.
The illuminated entry requests the courtesy lamps off after 25 seconds have elapsed, the ignition is
switched out of OFF, the RKE transmitter LOCK button is pressed, or the vehicle is locked using
the keypad or door lock cylinder.
Illuminated Exit
The illuminated exit requests the courtesy lamps to be illuminated for 25 seconds when all doors
are closed and the ignition key is removed from the ignition lock cylinder. The illuminated exit
requests the courtesy lamps to be deactivated when the ignition key is inserted into the ignition lock
cylinder, 25 seconds have elapsed or a door or liftgate is opened.
Theater Lighting
The theater lighting option ramps-up the courtesy lamps over 0.7 second when courtesy lamp
activation is requested. The theater lighting feature ramps-down the courtesy lamps over 1.7
seconds when interior lighting deactivation is requested by any feature other than the panic alarm
or battery saver.
Interior Lamp Arbitrator
The SJB chooses between the interior lighting, interior mode, interior lighting delay, illuminated
entry, illuminated exit and battery saver to determine which feature has precedence of activating
and deactivating the interior lamps.
The features are prioritized as follows: Perimeter alarm/panic alarm
- Demand lighting
- Battery saver
- Interior lighting
- Interior light delay
- Illuminated entry
- Illuminated exit
Battery Saver
The SJB provides automatic shut-off of the demand lamps (cargo lamp, vanity lamps, map lamps
and cargo lamp) and courtesy lamps after a time-out period in order to save battery voltage. A
timer in the SJB is started when the ignition is turned to the OFF position, and all the doors, the
liftgate and the liftgate glass are closed. When the time-out period for the lamps has elapsed, the
voltage is automatically shut off to the lamps by the SJB. While the SJB has voltage disabled, if the
ignition is turned to any position other than OFF, any door becomes ajar, or the UNLOCK button of
the RKE transmitter is pressed, a valid keypad code is entered, an unlock request from the cylinder
is received, or the dome lamp switch is turned on, the SJB restores voltage and starts the timer
again.
NOTE: Time out is 1 minute if the vehicle has less than 80 km (50 miles).
The battery saver time-outs are as follows: Courtesy lamps, if the dome lamp is on or the liftgate is open = 10 minutes
- Courtesy lamps, if the dome lamp is on or the liftgate is open = 10 minutes
- Demand lamps = 10 minutes
Field-Effect Transistor (FET) Protection
The SJB utilizes a FET protective circuit strategy for many of its outputs (for example, the
headlamp output circuit). Output loads (current level) are monitored for excessive current (typically
short circuits) and are shut down (turns off the voltage or ground provided by the module) when a
fault is detected. A continuous DTC is stored at that time for the fault. The circuit will then reset
after an ignition cycle or customer demand of the function (switching the component on, 30-minute
battery saver being energized). When an excessive circuit load occurs several times, the module
shuts down the output until a repair procedure is carried out. At the same time, the continuous DTC
that was stored on the first failure will not clear by a command to clear the continuous DTCs. The
module will not allow this code to be cleared or the circuit restored to normal until a successful
on-demand self-test proves that the fault has been repaired. After the on-demand self-test has
successfully completed (no on-demand DTCs present), the continuous DTC will have been cleared
and the circuit function will return.
Each circuit has 3 predefined levels of short circuit tolerance established in the module based on
each circuits capability. When the first or second level is reached, the continuous DTC associated
with the circuit sets along with DTC B106E. These DTCs may be cleared using the Clear DTC
Operation on the scan tool as long as the fault itself has been corrected. If any of the circuits are
shorted past the third level, then DTC B106F sets along with the associated continuous DTC. This
DTC cannot be cleared and a new module must be installed.
The SJB FET protected output circuits for the interior lighting system are for the puddle lamps and
courtesy lamp output circuits.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9807
Courtesy Lamp: Diagnostic Trouble Code Descriptions
B2A3A-B2077
B2718-B2721
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9808
Courtesy Lamp: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Symptom Chart (Part 1)
Symptom Chart (Part 2)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9809
Courtesy Lamp: Pinpoint Tests
Test A: The Courtesy Lamps Are Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST A: THE COURTESY LAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE
A1-A2
A2-A3
Normal Operation
Power is supplied to the courtesy lamps through the smart junction box (SJB) fuse 9 (15A), and
SJB fuse 25 (10A) for the demand lamps. When any door is opened, the ajar switch opens,
signaling the SJB. The SJB monitors the ajar circuits, and based on the ajar status, the SJB
supplies voltage to the courtesy lamps on circuit VLN33 (GY/VT). Ground is supplied through
circuit GD133 (BK) for the courtesy lamps, and circuit GD126 (BK/WH) for the cargo lamp.
DTC B2A35 - is an on-demand DTC that sets when the SJB detects an open from the interior
lighting circuit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9810
DTC B2A36 - is a continuous and on-demand DTC that sets when the SJB detects a short to
ground from the interior lighting circuit.
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuitry
- SJB
Test B: An Individual Courtesy Lamp Is Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST B: AN INDIVIDUAL COURTESY LAMP IS INOPERATIVE
B1
B1-B2
Normal Operation
The smart junction box (SJB) provides voltage to the courtesy lamps on circuit VLN33 (GY/VT).
The courtesy lamps are grounded through circuit GD133 (BK). The cargo lamp is also on the
courtesy lamp circuit. Circuit VLN33 (GY/VT) provides voltage to the cargo lamp, and the lamp is
grounded through circuit GD126 (BK/WH).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9811
Possible Causes
- Circuitry
- Interior lamp
Test C: The Courtesy Lamps Stay On Continuously
PINPOINT TEST C: THE COURTESY LAMPS STAY ON CONTINUOUSLY
C1-C3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9812
C3-C8
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9813
C8-C10
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9814
C10-C13
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9815
C13-C15
Normal Operation
When any door or the liftgate is opened, the ajar switch or the power liftgate module opens the
circuit to the smart junction box (SJB). The SJB monitors the ajar circuits, and based on the ajar
status, the SJB supplies voltage to the courtesy lamps on circuit VLN33 (GY/VT).
DTC B1320 - is an on-demand DTC that sets when the SJB detects an open from the LH front door
ajar circuit.
DTC B1328 - is an on-demand DTC that sets when the SJB detects an open from the RH front
door ajar circuit.
DTC B1336 - is an on-demand DTC that sets when the SJB detects an open from the RH rear door
ajar circuit.
DTC B1572 - is an on-demand DTC that sets when the SJB detects an open from the LH rear door
ajar circuit.
DTC B1688 - is an on-demand DTC that sets when the SJB detects a short to ground from the
dimmer switch circuit.
DTC B2077 - is an on-demand DTC that sets when the SJB detects an open from the liftgate ajar
circuit.
DTC B2A35 - is an on-demand DTC that sets when the SJB detects a short to voltage from the
courtesy lamp output circuit.
DTC B2718 - is a continuous and on-demand DTC that sets when the power liftgate module
detects a short to voltage from the liftgate ajar input circuit to the SJB.
DTC B2721 - is a continuous and on-demand DTC that sets when the power liftgate module
detects an open from the liftgate ajar input circuit to the SJB.
Possible Causes
- Circuitry
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9816
- Ajar switch
- Liftgate ajar switch
- Dimmer switch
- Power liftgate module
- SJB
Test D: The Courtesy Lamps Do Not Turn On With One Door Open
PINPOINT TEST D: THE COURTESY LAMPS DO NOT TURN ON WITH ONE DOOR OPEN
D1-D4
Normal Operation
When any door is opened, the ajar switch opens the circuit to the smart junction box (SJB). The
SJB monitors the ajar circuits, and based on the ajar status, the SJB supplies voltage to the
courtesy lamps on circuit VLN33 (GY/VT).
Possible Causes
- Circuitry
- Ajar switch
- SJB
Test E: The Demand Lamps Are Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST E: THE DEMAND LAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9817
E1-E3
Normal Operation
The smart junction box (SJB) supplies voltage to the demand lamps on circuit CLN09 (YE/GN).
The demand lamps are grounded through circuit GD133 (BK).
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuitry
- SJB
Test F: An Individual Demand Lamp Is Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST F: AN INDIVIDUAL DEMAND LAMP IS INOPERATIVE
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9818
F1-F2
Normal Operation
The smart junction box (SJB) supplies voltage to the demand lamps on circuit CLN09 (YE/GN).
The demand lamps are grounded through circuit GD133 (BK).
Possible Causes
- Circuitry
- Interior lamp
Test G: The Illuminated Entry Is Inoperative When Using The Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)
Transmitter
PINPOINT TEST G: THE ILLUMINATED ENTRY IS INOPERATIVE WHEN USING THE REMOTE
KEYLESS ENTRY (RKE) TRANSMITTER
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9819
G1-G2
Normal Operation
The illuminated entry provides interior lighting whenever the smart junction box (SJB) receives a
doors unlock request from the RKE transmitter. The SJB provides voltage on circuit VLN33
(GY/VT) for the courtesy lamps.
Possible Causes
- RKE system
- SJB
Test H: The Battery Saver Does Not Deactivate After Time-Out
PINPOINT TEST H: THE BATTERY SAVER DOES NOT DEACTIVATE AFTER TIME-OUT
H1-H2
Normal Operation
The smart junction box (SJB) provides a battery saver function. The battery saver function provides
automatic shutoff of the interior lamps (courtesy lamps and demand lamps) after a predetermined
time has elapsed in order to save battery power.
Possible Causes
- Circuitry
- SJB
Test I: The Puddle Lamp(s) Are Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST I: THE PUDDLE LAMP(S) ARE INOPERATIVE
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9820
I1-I3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9821
I4-I5
Normal Operation
The smart junction box (SJB) provides voltage to the puddle lamps through circuit CLN25 (VT). The
puddle lamps have separate ground circuits. The LH exterior mirror is grounded through circuit
GD133 (BK), and the RH exterior mirror is grounded through circuit GD140 (BK/GN).
DTC B2A39 - sets when the SJB detects an open on the puddle lamp output circuit.
DTC B2A3A - sets when the SJB detects a short to ground on the puddle lamp output circuit.
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuitry
- Exterior mirror
- SJB
Test J: The Puddle Lamps Stay On Continuously
PINPOINT TEST J: THE PUDDLE LAMPS STAY ON CONTINUOUSLY
J1-J2
Normal Operation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9822
The smart junction box (SJB) provides voltage to the puddle lamps through circuit CLN25 (VT). The
puddle lamps have separate ground circuits. The LH exterior mirror is grounded through circuit
GD133 (BK), and the RH exterior mirror is grounded through circuit GD140 (BK/GN).
DTC B2A39 - sets when the SJB detects a short to voltage on the puddle lamp output circuit.
Possible Causes
- Circuitry
- SJB
Test K: The Courtesy Lamps Are Inoperative From The Dimmer Control Switch
PINPOINT TEST K: THE COURTESY LAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE FROM THE DIMMER
CONTROL SWITCH
K1-K3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9823
K3-K4
Normal Operation
The smart junction box (SJB) monitors the dimmer switch status on circuit CLN28 (GN/BU) to
determine if the courtesy lamps are requested. Based on the dimmer switch status, the SJB
supplies voltage to the courtesy lamps through circuit VLN33 (GY/VT).
Possible Causes
- Circuitry
- Dimmer switch
- SJB
Test L: The Courtesy Lamps Do Not Turn On With The Liftgate Open
PINPOINT TEST L: THE COURTESY LAMPS DO NOT TURN ON WITH THE LIFTGATE OPEN
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9824
L1-L4
Normal Operation
When the liftgate is opened, the ajar switch (or power liftgate module, if equipped) opens the circuit
to the smart junction box (SJB). The SJB monitors the ajar circuit, and based on the ajar status, the
SJB supplies voltage to the courtesy lamps on circuit VLN33 (GY/VT).
DTC B2721 - sets when the power liftgate module detects a short to ground from the SJB, or
liftgate ajar circuit.
Possible Causes
- Circuitry
- Liftgate ajar switch
- Power liftgate module
- SJB
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page
9825
Courtesy Lamp: Service and Repair
PUDDLE LAMP
Removal and Installation
1. Release the tab to remove the puddle lamp from the mirror housing.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
2. NOTE: An audible click can be heard when the puddle lamp is fully seated.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page
9826
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Daytime Running Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9831
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9832
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9833
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9834
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9835
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9836
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9837
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9838
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9839
Daytime Running Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9840
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9841
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9842
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9843
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9844
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9845
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9846
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9847
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9848
Daytime Running Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
97-1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9849
97-2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9850
97-3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9851
97-5
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Inspection and Verification
Daytime Running Lamp: Testing and Inspection Inspection and Verification
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
1. Verify the customer concern by operating the daytime running lamps (DRL) following these
steps:
- Place the ignition switch in the RUN position.
- Place the headlamp switch in the OFF position.
- Place the transmission in any gear other than PARK (P).
- If the DRL does not operate, make sure the SJB is configured for DRL before proceeding to the
next step.
2. Carry out the continuous and on-demand self tests for the SJB.
- If any DTCs are retrieved related to the concern, refer to Body Control Systems (Multifunction
Electronic Control Module). If no DTCs are retrieved, go to the next step.
3. Verify the low beam operation.
- Place the headlamp switch in the HEADLAMPS ON position. If the low beams do not operate correctly, refer to Headlamps.
- If the low beams operate correctly and the DRL operation is incorrect, proceed to the next step.
4. Check the SJB inputs.
- Monitor the ignition switch, the headlamp switch input PIDs and the transmission gear status
PIDs. If the ignition switch PIDs do not agree with the ignition switch position, refer to Ignition Switch.
- If the transmission gear status PIDs do not agree with the gear selector lever position, refer to
Transmission Control Systems.
- If the headlamp switch PIDs do not agree with the headlamp switch position, refer to Headlamps.
- If the PIDs indicate correct ignition, headlamp switch and transmission gear status, install a new
SJB. Test the system for normal operation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Inspection and Verification > Page 9854
Daytime Running Lamp: Testing and Inspection Principles of Operation
PRINCIPLES OF OPERATION
NOTE: When installing a new smart junction box (SJB), it must be configured for this feature, if
originally equipped. Refer to Information Bus (Module Communications Network).
The SJB controls the DRL by using various inputs to determine whether or not the DRL should be
illuminated. These inputs include:
- Ignition switch position
- Headlamp switch position
- Headlamps on or off
- Transmission gear selection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Page 9855
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair
INSTRUMENT PANEL DIMMER SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument panel side finish panel.
2. NOTE: The switch is removed by pushing from behind.
Release the tabs and remove the headlamp switch assembly. Disconnect the electrical connectors.
3. Release the 4 tabs and remove the instrument panel dimmer switch. 4. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dome Lamp > Component Information > Service and Repair > Interior
Lamp - Front
Dome Lamp: Service and Repair Interior Lamp - Front
INTERIOR LAMP - FRONT
Removal and Installation
1. Pull the overhead console down and remove the console from the headliner retainer.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
2. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dome Lamp > Component Information > Service and Repair > Interior
Lamp - Front > Page 9863
Dome Lamp: Service and Repair Interior Lamp - Rear
INTERIOR LAMP - REAR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear interior lamp lens.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dome Lamp > Component Information > Service and Repair > Interior
Lamp - Front > Page 9864
2. Release the 2 retaining clips (through the access holes) and remove the rear interior lamp
assembly.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-25 (Liftgate - Edge)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9868
C479
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Bulb > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Fog/Driving Lamp Bulb: Service and Repair
FOG LAMP BULB
WARNING: The fog lamp bulb contains gas under pressure. The bulb may shatter if the glass
envelope is scratched or if the bulb is dropped. Handle the bulb carefully. Grasp the bulb only by its
base. Avoid touching the glass envelope. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal
injury.
NOTE:
- The fog lamp bulb should not be removed from the fog lamp until just before a new bulb is
installed. Removing the bulb for an extended period of time may affect fog lamp bulb performance.
Contaminants may enter the fog lamp where they can settle on the lens and reflector. Never turn
on the fog lamps with the bulb removed.
- Make sure the headlamp switch and the ignition switch are in the OFF position.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the 2 screws and position the fender splash shield aside. 3. Disconnect the electrical
connector and remove the fog lamp bulb. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Application and ID
Hazard Warning Flasher: Application and ID
The flasher function for this vehicle is provided by the Smart Junction Box (SJB).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9880
C2355
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Headlamp Bulb: Service and Repair
HEADLAMP BULB
Edge Low Beam
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 9885
Edge High Beam
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 9886
MKX Low Beam
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 9887
Removal and Installation
WARNING: The headlamp bulb contains gas under pressure. The bulb may shatter if the glass
envelope is scratched or if the bulb is dropped. Handle the bulb only by its base. Avoid touching the
glass envelope. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
NOTE:
- The headlamp bulb should not be removed from the headlamp until just before a new bulb is
installed. Removing the bulb for an extended period of time may affect headlamp bulb
performance. Contaminants may enter the headlamp where they can settle on the lens and
reflector. Never turn on the headlamps with the bulb removed from the headlamp.
- Make sure the headlamp switch and the ignition switch are in the OFF position.
MKX
1. Remove the headlamp bulb access cover.
All vehicles
2. NOTE: To remove, rotate the headlamp bulb approximately 1/8 turn counterclockwise.
Remove the headlamp bulb. Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Control Module > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Headlamp Control Module: Service and Repair
ADAPTIVE FRONT LIGHTING MODULE
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the 2 screws and position the fender splash shield aside. 3. Remove the 3 screws and
the adaptive front lighting module.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Illumination Dimmer Switch
View 151-8 (behind Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Illumination Dimmer Switch > Page 9895
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Multifunction Switch
C202
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Multifunction Switch > Page 9898
C2298
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion > Page 9901
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion > Page 9902
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Testing and Inspection Illumination Dimmer Switch
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion > Page 9903
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 9904
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Release the upper steering column shroud by pressing inward on the sides of the shroud
and lifting upwards.
Remove the upper steering column shroud.
2. Release the tilt lever, remove the 3 screws and then remove the lower steering column shroud.
3. Disconnect the multi-function switch electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 9905
4. Remove the 2 multi-function switch screws and remove the switch. 5. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 9909
C205
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 9910
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 9911
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 9912
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
HEADLAMP SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument panel side finish panel.
2. NOTE: The headlamp switch is removed by pushing from behind.
Release the tabs and remove the headlamp switch. Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Locations > Left
View 151-10 (Steering Wheel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Locations > Left > Page
9918
View 151-10 (Steering Wheel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Left
C2996
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Left > Page
9921
C2997
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
License Plate Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9926
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9927
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9928
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9929
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9930
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9931
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9932
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9933
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9934
License Plate Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9935
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9936
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9937
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9938
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9939
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9940
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9941
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9942
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9943
License Plate Lamp: Connector Views
C452
C462
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9944
License Plate Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
92-1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9945
92-2
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Marker Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9950
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9951
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9952
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9953
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9954
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9955
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9956
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9957
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9958
Marker Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9959
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9960
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9961
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9962
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9963
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9964
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9965
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9966
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9967
Marker Lamp: Connector Views
C151
C161
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9968
C4136
C4355
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9969
C4138
C4356
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9970
Marker Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
92-1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9971
92-2
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9972
Marker Lamp: Service and Repair
SIDE MARKER LAMP - FRONT
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the 2 screws and position the fender splash shield aside. 3. Release the tabs and
remove the side marker lamp.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Parking Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9977
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9978
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9979
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9980
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9981
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9982
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9983
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9984
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9985
Parking Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9986
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9987
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9988
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9989
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9990
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9991
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9992
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9993
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9994
Parking Lamp: Connector Views
C412
C415
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9995
C1023
C1043
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9996
Parking Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
92-1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9997
92-2
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Parking Lamp: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
1. Verify the customer concern.
Visual Inspection Chart
2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of mechanical or electrical damage. 3. If an obvious cause for
an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible) before proceeding to the
next step.
NOTE: Make sure the headlamp switch is in the OFF position.
- Make sure the multifunction switch is in the LOW BEAM position.
4. NOTE: Make sure to use the latest scan tool software release.
If the cause is not visually evident, connect the scan tool to the data link connector (DLC).
5. NOTE: The vehicle communication module (VCM) LED prove-out confirms power and ground
from the DLC are provided to the VCM.
If the scan tool does not communicate with the VCM: Check the VCM connection to the vehicle.
- Check the scan tool connection to the VCM.
- refer to Information Bus (Module Communications Network), No Power To The Scan Tool, to
diagnose no communication with the scan tool.
6. If the scan tool does not communicate with the vehicle:
- Verify the ignition key is in the ON position.
- Verify the scan tool operation with a known good vehicle.
- refer to Information Bus (Module Communications Network) to diagnose no response from the
PCM.
7. Carry out the network test.
- If the scan tool responds with no communication for one or more modules, refer to Information
Bus (Module Communications Network).
- If the network test passes, retrieve and record the continuous memory DTCs.
8. Clear the continuous DTCs and carry out the self-test diagnostics for the SJB. 9. If the DTCs
retrieved are related to the concern, go to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Charts. For all other
DTCs, refer to Body Control Systems
(Multifunction Electronic Control Module). See: Diagnostic Trouble Code Descriptions
10. If no DTCs related to the concern are retrieved, GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10000
B1578
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10001
Symptom Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10002
Parking Lamp: Pinpoint Tests
Test O: One Or More Parking, Rear Or License Plate Lamps Is Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST O: ONE OR MORE PARKING, REAR OR LICENSE PLATE LAMPS IS
INOPERATIVE
O1-O3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10003
O3-O4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10004
O4-O6
Normal Operation
When the headlamp switch is placed in the PARKING LAMPS ON position, the smart junction box
(SJB) provides a ground for the parking lamp relay coil (integrated into the SJB). When the parking
lamp relay is energized, voltage is routed through circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) to the rear and front
parking lamps. Ground is provided to the rear parking, liftgate and license plate lamps through
circuit GD149 (BK/GY) or circuit GD151 (BK/GN). Ground is provided to the front parking and side
marker lamps through circuit GD120 (BK/GN) or circuit GD123 (BK/GY).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10005
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Liftgate lamp
- Liftgate release handle
- Headlamp assembly
- SJB
Test P: The Parking, Rear Or License Plate Lamps Are On Continuously
PINPOINT TEST P: THE PARKING, REAR OR LICENSE PLATE LAMPS ARE ON
CONTINUOUSLY
P1-P4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10006
P5-P6
Normal Operation
The smart junction box (SJB) monitors the parking lamp request input from the headlamp switch
through circuit CLS34 (GY). The SJB provides a ground for the parking lamp relay coil (integrated
into the SJB) when a request for the parking lamps is received. When the parking lamp relay is
energized, voltage is routed through circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) to the rear and front parking lamps.
DTC B1578 Lamp Park Input Circuit Short to Ground - is an on-demand DTC that sets when the
SJB detects a short to ground in the parking lamps on input circuit.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Headlamp switch
- SJB
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page
10007
Parking Lamp: Service and Repair
PARKING LAMP BULB - FRONT
Edge
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page
10008
MKX
Removal and Installation
MKX
1. Remove the headlamp bulb access cover.
All vehicles
2. Remove the front parking lamp holder from the headlamp assembly.
- Remove the front parking lamp bulb.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page
10009
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10014
Backup Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10015
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Headlamp Control Module: Service and Repair
ADAPTIVE FRONT LIGHTING MODULE
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the 2 screws and position the fender splash shield aside. 3. Remove the 3 screws and
the adaptive front lighting module.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay > Page 10023
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay > Page 10024
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay > Page 10027
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay > Page 10028
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Right Stop/Turn Lamp Relay
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay > Page 10029
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay > Page 10030
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Park Lamp Relay
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay > Page 10031
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-8 (behind Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10036
Ambient Light Sensor: Diagrams
C286
C287
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10037
Ambient Light Sensor: Service and Repair
LIGHT SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Using a suitable tool, remove the light sensor.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
2. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Brake Light Switch: > 07-11-9 > Jun > 07 >
Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging
Brake Light Switch: Customer Interest Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging
TSB 07-11-9
06/11/07
BRAKE DRAG
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some Edge/MKX vehicles may exhibit brake drag from the rear wheels or all wheels.
Customers may notice an odor and/or reduced powertrain performance. In some cases, the driver
may also note an integral vehicle dynamics (IVD) light after driving a given distance due to
pressure noted in the module without a change in brake on/off (BOO) state.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure to resolve brake drag concerns.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Raise the vehicle on a hoist, with engine running, and vehicle in park. Rotate all of the wheels by
hand to verify excessive force is necessary to turn wheels.
^ To resolve the brake drag concern from all wheels - Replacement of the BOO switch is
necessary.
^ To resolve the brake drag concern from the rear wheels only - Adjustment of the park brake
cables are necessary.
BOO Switch Replacement (All Brakes Drag) Removal
1. With the vehicle shut off and in park, remove the stop lamp switch by rotating the stop lamp
switch in the clockwise direction.
2. If the brake pedal moves up during the removal of the switch, the pedal was being inadvertently
held down by the stop lamp switch thus keeping the hydraulic circuits pressurized. Refer to
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 417-01.
3. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the switch and discard the switch.
Installation
NOTE
INSTALLATION OF THE NEW STOP LAMP SWITCH MUST BE DONE WITH THE BRAKE
PEDAL AT ITS NORMALLY INSTALLED AND RESTING POSITION. DO NOT PULL UP OR
PUSH DOWN ON THE BRAKE PEDAL DURING STOP LAMP SWITCH INSTALLATION. REFER
TO WSM, Section 417-01.
1. With the brake pedal at its rest position, insert the new stop lamp switch into the keyed hole on
the brake pedal and rotate the switch 45 degrees counter-clockwise to seat the switch. You may
hear a click sound during this step, this is normal.
2. Plug the wire harness connector to the new stop lamp switch.
3. Verify that the brake lamps are functioning properly and that the brakes are no longer dragging.
Park Cable Adjustment (Rear Brakes Drag)
Brake drag noted on rear wheels only likely caused by over adjusted park brake equalizer
adjustment (or all 3 cable lengths built at the minimum levels).
1. With vehicle on Hoist and shut off, verify rear brake pads are positioned properly per WSM,
Section 206-04: Rear Disc Brake.
2. With a fully released parking brake pedal, back off the adjustment until the wheels spin freely.
NOTE
DISTANCE BETWEEN THE NUT AND END OF THE STUD SHOULD BE 7/8" (22 mm)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Brake Light Switch: > 07-11-9 > Jun > 07 >
Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging > Page 10046
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071109A 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.4 Hr.
Diagnose, Replace BOO Switch (Do Not Use With 13480A)
071109B 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.4 Hr.
Diagnose, Adjust Park Brake (Do Not Use With 2780B)
071109C 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.5 Hr.
Diagnose, Replace BOO Switch, And Adjust Park Brake (Do Not Use With 13480A, 2780B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
13480 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 07-11-9 >
Jun > 07 > Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging
Brake Light Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging
TSB 07-11-9
06/11/07
BRAKE DRAG
FORD: 2007 Edge
LINCOLN: 2007 MKX
ISSUE Some Edge/MKX vehicles may exhibit brake drag from the rear wheels or all wheels.
Customers may notice an odor and/or reduced powertrain performance. In some cases, the driver
may also note an integral vehicle dynamics (IVD) light after driving a given distance due to
pressure noted in the module without a change in brake on/off (BOO) state.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure to resolve brake drag concerns.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Raise the vehicle on a hoist, with engine running, and vehicle in park. Rotate all of the wheels by
hand to verify excessive force is necessary to turn wheels.
^ To resolve the brake drag concern from all wheels - Replacement of the BOO switch is
necessary.
^ To resolve the brake drag concern from the rear wheels only - Adjustment of the park brake
cables are necessary.
BOO Switch Replacement (All Brakes Drag) Removal
1. With the vehicle shut off and in park, remove the stop lamp switch by rotating the stop lamp
switch in the clockwise direction.
2. If the brake pedal moves up during the removal of the switch, the pedal was being inadvertently
held down by the stop lamp switch thus keeping the hydraulic circuits pressurized. Refer to
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 417-01.
3. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the switch and discard the switch.
Installation
NOTE
INSTALLATION OF THE NEW STOP LAMP SWITCH MUST BE DONE WITH THE BRAKE
PEDAL AT ITS NORMALLY INSTALLED AND RESTING POSITION. DO NOT PULL UP OR
PUSH DOWN ON THE BRAKE PEDAL DURING STOP LAMP SWITCH INSTALLATION. REFER
TO WSM, Section 417-01.
1. With the brake pedal at its rest position, insert the new stop lamp switch into the keyed hole on
the brake pedal and rotate the switch 45 degrees counter-clockwise to seat the switch. You may
hear a click sound during this step, this is normal.
2. Plug the wire harness connector to the new stop lamp switch.
3. Verify that the brake lamps are functioning properly and that the brakes are no longer dragging.
Park Cable Adjustment (Rear Brakes Drag)
Brake drag noted on rear wheels only likely caused by over adjusted park brake equalizer
adjustment (or all 3 cable lengths built at the minimum levels).
1. With vehicle on Hoist and shut off, verify rear brake pads are positioned properly per WSM,
Section 206-04: Rear Disc Brake.
2. With a fully released parking brake pedal, back off the adjustment until the wheels spin freely.
NOTE
DISTANCE BETWEEN THE NUT AND END OF THE STUD SHOULD BE 7/8" (22 mm)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 07-11-9 >
Jun > 07 > Brakes - IVD Lamp ON/Brakes Dragging > Page 10052
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071109A 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.4 Hr.
Diagnose, Replace BOO Switch (Do Not Use With 13480A)
071109B 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.4 Hr.
Diagnose, Adjust Park Brake (Do Not Use With 2780B)
071109C 2007 Edge/MKX: 0.5 Hr.
Diagnose, Replace BOO Switch, And Adjust Park Brake (Do Not Use With 13480A, 2780B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
13480 42
Disclaimer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10053
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10054
C2064
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10055
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal to the
PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10056
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
STOPLAMP SWITCH
Removal
1. Disconnect the stoplamp switch electrical connector.
2. NOTE: The stoplamp switch will be difficult to remove if the switch plunger is not depressed. A
slight rearward force should be adequate to
depress the plunger.
With a light force (approximately 1-4 N [1-3 lb]), pull rearward on the brake pedal, rotate the
stoplamp switch 45 degrees clockwise and remove the stoplamp switch.
Installation
CAUTION: It is very important to not press, pull or touch the brake pedal assembly during the
installation of the stoplamp switch. Failure to follow these instructions may damage the stoplamp
switch.
1. Without movement to the brake pedal assembly, install the stoplamp switch and rotate 45
degrees counterclockwise. 2. Connect the stoplamp switch electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-25 (Liftgate - Edge)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 10060
C479
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10064
C2355
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Illumination Dimmer Switch
View 151-8 (behind Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Illumination Dimmer Switch > Page 10069
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Multifunction Switch
C202
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Multifunction Switch > Page 10072
C2298
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion > Page 10075
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion > Page 10076
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Testing and Inspection Illumination Dimmer Switch
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Lamp Portion > Page 10077
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 10078
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Release the upper steering column shroud by pressing inward on the sides of the shroud
and lifting upwards.
Remove the upper steering column shroud.
2. Release the tilt lever, remove the 3 screws and then remove the lower steering column shroud.
3. Disconnect the multi-function switch electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 10079
4. Remove the 2 multi-function switch screws and remove the switch. 5. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10083
C205
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10084
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10085
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10086
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
HEADLAMP SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument panel side finish panel.
2. NOTE: The headlamp switch is removed by pushing from behind.
Release the tabs and remove the headlamp switch. Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Left
View 151-10 (Steering Wheel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Left > Page 10091
View 151-10 (Steering Wheel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Left
C2996
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Left > Page 10094
C2997
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10098
C202
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10099
Turn Signal Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10100
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10101
Turn Signal Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Release the upper steering column shroud by pressing inward on the sides of the shroud
and lifting upwards.
Remove the upper steering column shroud.
2. Release the tilt lever, remove the 3 screws and then remove the lower steering column shroud.
3. Disconnect the multi-function switch electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10102
4. Remove the 2 multi-function switch screws and remove the switch. 5. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Tail Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10107
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10108
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10109
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10110
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10111
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10112
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10113
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10114
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10115
Tail Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10116
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10117
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10118
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10119
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10120
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10121
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10122
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10123
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10124
Tail Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
92-1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10125
92-2
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Service and Repair > Rear Lamp
Assembly
Tail Lamp: Service and Repair Rear Lamp Assembly
REAR LAMP ASSEMBLY
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: The rear lamp assembly is held in place by snap-type retainers. The lamp should be
pulled straight and rearward to remove.
Remove the 2 screws and the rear lamp assembly. Disconnect the electrical connectors.
2. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- An audible click should be heard when the rear lamp assembly is fully seated to the quarter panel.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Service and Repair > Rear Lamp
Assembly > Page 10128
Tail Lamp: Service and Repair Rear Lamp Assembly - Liftgate
REAR LAMP ASSEMBLY - LIFTGATE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the luggage trim panel. 2. Disconnect the liftgate lamp electrical connector. 3. Remove
the 8 nuts and the liftgate lamp.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Trailer Lamps: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10133
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10134
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10135
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10136
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10137
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10138
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10139
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10140
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10141
Trailer Lamps: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10142
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10143
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10144
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10145
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10146
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10147
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10148
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10149
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10150
Trailer Lamps: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
95-1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 10151
95-2
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Trailer Lamps: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
1. Verify the customer concern. 2. Verify the exterior lighting system of the vehicle is operating
correctly. If not, refer to the appropriate pinpoint test. 3. Visually inspect for obvious signs of
electrical damage.
VISUAL INSPECTION CHART
Electrical Battery junction box (BJB) fuse(s): 9 (20A) (trailer tow parking lamps)
- 24 (15A) (trailer tow LH stop/turn relay)
- 46 (15A) (trailer tow RH stop/turn relay)
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Trailer tow stop/turn relays
- Trailer tow parking lamp relay
- Trailer
4. If the concern is not visually evident, verify the symptom. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10154
Symptom Chart
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10155
Trailer Lamps: Pinpoint Tests
Test X: The Trailer Lamps Are Inoperative - All
PINPOINT TEST X: THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE - ALL
X1
Normal Operation
The trailer tow connectors receive ground through circuit RAT08 (WH) for all of the trailer lamps.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Trailer
Test Y: The Individual Trailer Lamp Is Inoperative - Trailer Turn/Stoplamp
PINPOINT TEST Y: THE INDIVIDUAL TRAILER LAMP IS INOPERATIVE - TRAILER
TURN/STOPLAMP
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10156
Y1-Y2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10157
Y3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10158
Y4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10159
Y5-Y6
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10160
Y6 Continued
Normal Operation
The battery junction box (BJB) fuse 24 (15A) supplies voltage to the LH trailer tow stop/turn relay
and BJB fuse 46 (15A) supplies voltage to the RH trailer tow stop/turn relay. The trailer tow
stop/turn relay coils are grounded through circuit GD120 (BK/GN).
The trailer tow LH stop/turn relay coil receives voltage from circuit CLS18 (GY/BN) when the
vehicle LH rear stoplamp is illuminated. When the trailer tow LH stop/turn relay is energized,
voltage is routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT06 (YE).
The trailer tow RH stop/turn relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS19 (VT/OG) when the
vehicle RH rear stoplamp is illuminated. When the trailer tow RH stop/turn relay is energized,
voltage is routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT09 (GN).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Joint connector
- Trailer tow stop/turn relay
- BJB
- Trailer
Test Z: The Trailer Lamps Are Inoperative - Trailer Parking Lamps
PINPOINT TEST Z: THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE - TRAILER PARKING LAMPS
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10161
Z1-Z3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10162
Z3-Z4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10163
Z4 Continued
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10164
Z5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10165
Z6
Normal Operation
The trailer tow parking lamp relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) when the
vehicle parking lamps are illuminated. The trailer tow parking lamp relay coil is grounded through
circuit GD120 (BK/GN). The battery junction box (BJB) fuse 9 (20A) supplies voltage to the trailer
tow parking lamp relay switch side. When the trailer tow parking lamp relay is energized, the
voltage is routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT11 (BN).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Joint connector
- Trailer tow parking lamp relay
- BJB
- Trailer
Tests AA: The Trailer Lamps Are On Continuously
PINPOINT TEST AA: THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE ON CONTINUOUSLY
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10166
AA1-AA2
Normal Operation - Trailer Tow Turn/Stoplamp
The trailer tow LH stop/turn relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS18 (GY/BN) when the
vehicle LH rear stoplamp is illuminated. When the trailer tow LH stop/turn relay is energized,
voltage is routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT06 (YE).
The trailer tow RH stop/turn relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS19 (VT/OG) when the
vehicle RH rear stoplamp is illuminated. When the trailer tow RH stop/turn relay is energized,
voltage is routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT09 (GN).
Normal Operation - Trailer Tow Parking
The trailer tow parking lamp relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) when the
vehicle parking lamps are illuminated. When the trailer tow parking lamp relay is energized, voltage
is routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT11 (BN).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Trailer tow relay
- Trailer
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page
10167
Special Tool(s)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow
Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow
Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay > Page 10172
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow
Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay > Page 10173
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay > Page 10176
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay > Page 10177
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Right Stop/Turn Lamp Relay
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay > Page 10178
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay > Page 10179
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Park Lamp Relay
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Trailer Tow Left Stop/Turn Lamp Relay > Page 10180
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Flasher > Component Information > Application
and ID
Turn Signal Flasher: Application and ID
The flasher function for this vehicle is provided by the Smart Junction Box (SJB).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp
Turn Signal Lamp: Diagrams Park/Turn Lamp
C1023
C1043
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp > Page 10189
Turn Signal Lamp: Diagrams Park/Stop/Turn Lamp
C415
C412
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 10193
C202
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 10194
Turn Signal Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 10195
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 10196
Turn Signal Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Release the upper steering column shroud by pressing inward on the sides of the shroud
and lifting upwards.
Remove the upper steering column shroud.
2. Release the tilt lever, remove the 3 screws and then remove the lower steering column shroud.
3. Disconnect the multi-function switch electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 10197
4. Remove the 2 multi-function switch screws and remove the switch. 5. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Vanity Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Vanity Mirror Lamp,
Left
C907
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Vanity Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Vanity Mirror Lamp,
Left > Page 10202
C906
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Element Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Element Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 10208
Heated Glass Element Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Element Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 10209
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element Relay
> Component Information > Locations
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element Relay
> Component Information > Locations > Page 10214
Heated Glass Element Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element Relay
> Component Information > Locations > Page 10215
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Locations Window Adjust Switch
View 151-24 (Right Rear Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Window Adjust Switch > Page 10221
View 151-23 (Left Rear Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Window Adjust Switch > Page 10222
View 151-21 (Driver Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Window Adjust Switch > Page 10223
View 151-22 (Passenger Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Master Window Adjust Switch
C504A
C504B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 10226
C535A
C535B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 10227
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Window Adjust Switch
C701
C801
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 10228
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Power Window Switch, RH Side Front
C624
C648
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Master Window Adjust Switch
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 10231
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 10232
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Window Adjust Switches
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 10233
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 10234
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 10235
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 10236
Power Window Switch: Service and Repair
WINDOW CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
Edge only
1. Pull the switch bezel straight up to unclip it from the door trim panel.
MKX only
2. NOTE: LH front shown, all others similar.
Pull up on the front edge of the switch bezel and pull forward to unhook it from the door trim panel.
All vehicles
3. Disconnect the electrical connector(s). 4. Unclip the window control switch from the switch bezel.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Window Motor: Service and Repair
GLASS, FRAMES AND MECHANISMS - EXPLODED VIEW, FRONT DOOR
WINDOW REGULATOR AND MOTOR - FRONT DOOR
Removal and Installation
NOTE:
- LH shown, RH similar.
- For MKX only, the front window motor must be de-initialized, then initialized whenever the front
window motor is removed from the window regulator drum housing, a new window regulator is
installed, a new window glass is installed, a new top run is installed or for any operation in which
grease or lubricants are applied to the window regulator or glass run.
Window operating/not operating
1. Remove the front door speaker.
Window not operating
NOTE: Cutting the regulator cable should only be done if installing a new window regulator
assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 10242
2. NOTE: Support window glass before cutting the window regulator cable.
Cut the window regulator cable.
Window operating
3. Reconnect the window control switch.
Window operating/not operating
4. Remove the access plugs and lower the window until the glass clamp bolts can be accessed
through the 2 access holes. Tape the glass in position.
5. NOTE: If the window regulator cable was cut previously, support the regulator before the glass
clamp bolts are loosened.
Loosen the glass clamp bolts. To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
6. Lower the window regulator downward until it reaches the stops at the bottom of the regulator
tracks.
7. If equipped, remove trim and disconnect the power mirror electrical connector.
- Remove the wiring harness pushpins from the door.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 10243
8. Disconnect the electrical connector at the A-pillar.
9. Remove the 2 bolts from the electrical harness grommet to the door.
10. Using the speaker hole for access, release the clip on the harness from the inside to disconnect
the harness from the door. 11. Unclip the weatherstrip and feed through the wiring harness
between the weatherstrip and door.
12. Remove the 3 door latch screws.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
13. Remove the access plug from the latch side of door and remove the outside door handle
reinforcement screw. 14. Remove the outside door handle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 10244
15. Remove the screw.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
16. If equipped, remove the keypad.
17. Remove the 10 door module bolts and remove the front door module, transfer parts as
necessary.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
18. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- MKX Only, if installing a new front window motor, it must be initialized. If installing the original
front window motor it must be de-initialized, then initialized.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Rear Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Window Motor: Service and Repair
GLASS, FRAMES AND MECHANISMS - EXPLODED VIEW, REAR DOOR
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Rear Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 10248
Part 2
WINDOW REGULATOR AND MOTOR - REAR DOOR
Removal and Installation
NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Window operating/not operating
1. Remove the rear door speaker.
Window not operating
NOTE: Cutting the regulator cable should only be done if installing a new window regulator
assembly.
2. NOTE: Support window glass before cutting the window regulator cable.
Cut the window regulator cable.
Window operating
3. Reconnect the window control switch.
Window operating/not operating
4. Remove the access plug and lower the window until the glass clamp bolt can be accessed
through the access hole. Tape the glass in position.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Rear Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 10249
5. NOTE: If the window regulator cable was cut previously, support the regulator before the glass
clamp bolt is loosened.
Loosen the glass clamp bolt. To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
6. Lower the window regulator downward until it reaches the stops at the bottom of the regulator
tracks.
7. Disconnect the electrical connector at the B-pillar.
8. Remove the 2 bolts from the electrical harness grommet to the door. 9. Using the speaker hole
for access, release the clip on the harness from the inside to disconnect the harness from the door.
10. Unclip the weatherstrip and feed through the wiring harness between the weatherstrip and
door.
11. Remove the 3 door latch screws.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Rear Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 10250
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
12. Remove the access plug from the latch side of the door and remove the outside door handle
reinforcement screw. 13. Remove the outside door handle.
14. Remove the screw.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
15. If equipped, remove the door keypad.
16. Remove the 9 door module bolts and remove the rear door module, transfer parts as
necessary.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
17. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Locations Window Adjust Switch
View 151-24 (Right Rear Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Window Adjust Switch > Page 10255
View 151-23 (Left Rear Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Window Adjust Switch > Page 10256
View 151-21 (Driver Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Window Adjust Switch > Page 10257
View 151-22 (Passenger Door)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Master Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Master Window Adjust Switch
C504A
C504B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 10260
C535A
C535B
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 10261
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Window Adjust Switch
C701
C801
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 10262
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Power Window Switch, RH Side Front
C624
C648
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Master Window Adjust Switch
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 10265
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 10266
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Window Adjust Switches
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 10267
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 10268
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 10269
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 10270
Power Window Switch: Service and Repair
WINDOW CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
Edge only
1. Pull the switch bezel straight up to unclip it from the door trim panel.
MKX only
2. NOTE: LH front shown, all others similar.
Pull up on the front edge of the switch bezel and pull forward to unhook it from the door trim panel.
All vehicles
3. Disconnect the electrical connector(s). 4. Unclip the window control switch from the switch bezel.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > Front Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
GLASS, FRAMES AND MECHANISMS - EXPLODED VIEW, FRONT DOOR
DOOR GLASS TOP RUN - FRONT
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front door window glass.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > Front Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 10276
2. Remove the front door window glass inner weatherstrip.
3. Remove the front door glass top run. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Make sure the top run is fully seated before reinstalling the front door window glass.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Liftgate Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Liftgate Window Glass: Service and Repair
WINDOW GLASS - LIFTGATE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Material
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Liftgate Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 10280
Removal
WARNING: To prevent glass splinters from entering eyes or cutting hands, wear safety glasses
and heavy gloves when cutting glass from the vehicle. Failure to follow these instructions may
result in personal injury.
1. Remove the liftgate window wiper arm and motor. 2. Remove the liftgate spoiler. 3. Remove the
liftgate trim panel. 4. Disconnect the 2 liftgate window defrost electrical connectors.
5. NOTE: Lubricate the existing urethane adhesive with water to aid the special tool while cutting.
Using the special tool, place the flat side of the knife against the liftgate window glass. Start cutting
the adhesive away from the liftgate window glass at the top and work toward the corners.
6. Using the special tool, distance the liftgate window glass from the body.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Liftgate Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 10281
7. Using the special tool, cut the remaining urethane adhesive and remove the liftgate window
glass.
8. Using a soft brush or vacuum, remove any dirt or foreign material from the pinch weld.
Installation
CAUTION: When installing urethane-installed glass parts, vehicle must not be driven until urethane
has cured. Adequate cure time is specified on the drive away chart for each urethane product as
temperatures and humidity vary. Inadequate or incorrect curing can adversely affect retention of
the windshield.
NOTE: For additional material guidelines, refer to the manufacturer's installation information.
1. Dry fit the liftgate window glass to the existing urethane adhesive bead on the body pinch weld.
2. For a uniform fit, use the 2 liftgate window glass alignment pins to align the liftgate window glass
in the opening. 3. Remove the liftgate window glass.
4. NOTE: Avoid scratching the pinch weld. For minor scratches or exposed metal on the pinch
weld, see the manufacturer's recommendations.
Using an appropriate tool, trim the urethane adhesive leaving a 1 mm (0.03 in) to 2 mm (0.07 in)
base of original equipment urethane on the pinch weld.
5. If installing the original liftgate window glass, remove the excess urethane adhesive. 6. Clean the
inside of the liftgate window glass surface with glass cleaner.
7. CAUTION: Be sure to use the same brand and cure-rate products for adhesive and primer. Do
not mix different brands of urethane and
primer.
NOTE: Sika uses the same black primer for the glass and pinch weld area.
If installing a new liftgate window glass, apply urethane glass primer according to the
manufacturer's instructions.
8. Cut the urethane adhesive applicator tip to specification.
9. NOTE: Use either a high ratio, electric or battery-operated caulk gun that will apply the urethane
with less effort and a continuous bead.
Apply urethane adhesive on top of the existing trimmed urethane adhesive bead on the pinch weld.
Make sure that all gaps in the urethane adhesive are smoothed into one continuous bead starting
and ending at the bottom of the liftgate window glass opening near the center.
10. NOTE: Before the urethane has set, partially lower the windows to prevent the glass from being
pushed out of position when a door is closed.
Install the liftgate window glass on the vehicle using the alignment pins.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Liftgate Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 10282
11. CAUTION: When installing urethane-installed glass parts, the vehicle must not be driven until
urethane has cured. Adequate cure time
is specified on the drive away chart for each urethane product as temperatures and humidity vary.
Inadequate or incorrect curing can adversely affect retention of the rear window glass.
After the urethane has cured, check the liftgate window glass seal for air or water leaks through the
urethane adhesive bead and add urethane adhesive as necessary.
12. Connect the 2 liftgate window defrost electrical connectors. 13. Install the liftgate trim panel. 14.
Install the liftgate spoiler. 15. Install the liftgate window wiper arm and motor.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Quarter Window Glass: Service and Repair
WINDOW GLASS - REAR QUARTER
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Material
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 10286
Removal
WARNING: To prevent glass splinters from entering eyes or cutting hands, wear safety glasses
and heavy gloves when cutting glass from the vehicle. Failure to follow these instructions may
result in personal injury.
1. Remove the C-pillar, D-pillar and rear quarter trim panels.
2. NOTE: Lubricate the existing urethane adhesive with water to aid the special tool while cutting.
From inside the vehicle, using the special tool, cut the glass starting at the upper C-pillar and work
down, across the D-pillar, then across the bottom.
3. Remove the rear quarter window glass. 4. Using a soft brush or vacuum, remove any dirt or
foreign material from the pinch weld.
Installation
CAUTION: When installing urethane-installed glass parts, the vehicle must not be driven until
urethane has cured. Adequate cure time is specified on the drive away chart for each urethane
product as temperatures and humidity vary. Inadequate or incorrect curing can adversely affect
retention of the quarter window glass.
NOTE: For additional material guidelines, refer to the manufacturer's installation information.
1. Dry fit the rear quarter window glass to the existing urethane adhesive bead on the body pinch
weld. 2. For a uniform fit, use the 2 alignment pins on the rear quarter window glass to align the
rear quarter window glass in the opening. 3. Remove the rear quarter window glass.
4. NOTE: Avoid scratching the pinch weld. For minor scratches or exposed metal on the pinch
weld, see the manufacturer's recommendations.
Using an appropriate tool, trim the urethane adhesive leaving a 1 mm (0.03 in) to 2 mm (0.07 in)
base of original equipment urethane on the pinch weld.
5. If installing the original rear quarter window glass, remove the excess urethane adhesive.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 10287
6. Clean the inside of the rear quarter window glass surface with glass cleaner.
7. CAUTION: Be sure to use the same brand urethane and cure-rate products for adhesive and
primer. Do not mix different brands of
urethane and primer.
NOTE: Sika uses the same black primer for the glass and pinch weld area.
If installing a new rear quarter window glass, apply urethane glass primer according to the
manufacturer's instructions. Allow at least 6 minutes to dry.
8. Cut the urethane adhesive applicator tip to specification.
9. NOTE: Use either a high-ratio, electric or battery-operated caulk gun that will apply the urethane
with less effort and continuous bead.
Apply urethane adhesive on top of the existing trimmed urethane adhesive bead on the pinch weld.
Make sure that all gaps in the urethane are smoothed into one continuous bead starting and ending
at the bottom of the rear quarter window glass opening near the center.
10. CAUTION: When installing urethane-installed glass parts, the vehicle must not be driven until
urethane has cured. Adequate cure time
is specified on the drive away chart for each urethane product as temperatures and humidity vary.
Inadequate or incorrect curing can adversely affect retention of the quarter window glass.
NOTE: Before the urethane has set, partially lower the windows to prevent the glass from being
pushed out of position when a door is closed.
After the urethane has cured, check the rear quarter window glass seal for air or water leaks
through the urethane adhesive bead and add urethane adhesive as necessary.
11. Install the C-pillar, D-pillar and rear quarter trim panels.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Rear Door Window Glass > Rear Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
GLASS, FRAMES AND MECHANISMS - EXPLODED VIEW, REAR DOOR
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Rear Door Window Glass > Rear Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 10292
Part 2
DOOR GLASS RUN AND BRACKET - REAR
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The bracket is removed with the rear door glass.
1. Remove the rear door glass. 2. Remove the rear door glass top run. 3. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Front Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair
GLASS, FRAMES AND MECHANISMS - EXPLODED VIEW, FRONT DOOR
WINDOW REGULATOR AND MOTOR - FRONT DOOR
Removal and Installation
NOTE:
- LH shown, RH similar.
- For MKX only, the front window motor must be de-initialized, then initialized whenever the front
window motor is removed from the window regulator drum housing, a new window regulator is
installed, a new window glass is installed, a new top run is installed or for any operation in which
grease or lubricants are applied to the window regulator or glass run.
Window operating/not operating
1. Remove the front door speaker.
Window not operating
NOTE: Cutting the regulator cable should only be done if installing a new window regulator
assembly.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Front Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 10297
2. NOTE: Support window glass before cutting the window regulator cable.
Cut the window regulator cable.
Window operating
3. Reconnect the window control switch.
Window operating/not operating
4. Remove the access plugs and lower the window until the glass clamp bolts can be accessed
through the 2 access holes. Tape the glass in position.
5. NOTE: If the window regulator cable was cut previously, support the regulator before the glass
clamp bolts are loosened.
Loosen the glass clamp bolts. To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
6. Lower the window regulator downward until it reaches the stops at the bottom of the regulator
tracks.
7. If equipped, remove trim and disconnect the power mirror electrical connector.
- Remove the wiring harness pushpins from the door.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Front Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 10298
8. Disconnect the electrical connector at the A-pillar.
9. Remove the 2 bolts from the electrical harness grommet to the door.
10. Using the speaker hole for access, release the clip on the harness from the inside to disconnect
the harness from the door. 11. Unclip the weatherstrip and feed through the wiring harness
between the weatherstrip and door.
12. Remove the 3 door latch screws.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
13. Remove the access plug from the latch side of door and remove the outside door handle
reinforcement screw. 14. Remove the outside door handle.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Front Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 10299
15. Remove the screw.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
16. If equipped, remove the keypad.
17. Remove the 10 door module bolts and remove the front door module, transfer parts as
necessary.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
18. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- MKX Only, if installing a new front window motor, it must be initialized. If installing the original
front window motor it must be de-initialized, then initialized.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Rear Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair
GLASS, FRAMES AND MECHANISMS - EXPLODED VIEW, REAR DOOR
Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Rear Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 10303
Part 2
WINDOW REGULATOR AND MOTOR - REAR DOOR
Removal and Installation
NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Window operating/not operating
1. Remove the rear door speaker.
Window not operating
NOTE: Cutting the regulator cable should only be done if installing a new window regulator
assembly.
2. NOTE: Support window glass before cutting the window regulator cable.
Cut the window regulator cable.
Window operating
3. Reconnect the window control switch.
Window operating/not operating
4. Remove the access plug and lower the window until the glass clamp bolt can be accessed
through the access hole. Tape the glass in position.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Rear Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 10304
5. NOTE: If the window regulator cable was cut previously, support the regulator before the glass
clamp bolt is loosened.
Loosen the glass clamp bolt. To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
6. Lower the window regulator downward until it reaches the stops at the bottom of the regulator
tracks.
7. Disconnect the electrical connector at the B-pillar.
8. Remove the 2 bolts from the electrical harness grommet to the door. 9. Using the speaker hole
for access, release the clip on the harness from the inside to disconnect the harness from the door.
10. Unclip the weatherstrip and feed through the wiring harness between the weatherstrip and
door.
11. Remove the 3 door latch screws.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Rear Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 10305
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
12. Remove the access plug from the latch side of the door and remove the outside door handle
reinforcement screw. 13. Remove the outside door handle.
14. Remove the screw.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
15. If equipped, remove the door keypad.
16. Remove the 9 door module bolts and remove the rear door module, transfer parts as
necessary.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
17. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Windshield: Procedures
WINDSHIELD RESEAL
Material
1. Remove the cowl panel grille.
2. Position the LH and RH weatherstrips aside.
3. Remove the LH and RH A-pillar trim panels. 4. Remove the LH and RH sun visors. 5. If
equipped, remove the overhead console. 6. Lower the front portion of the headliner and block with
a suitable material. 7. Clean the interior and exterior of the windshield glass surface with glass
cleaner.
Material
8. Cut the urethane adhesive applicator tip to 6 mm (0.24 in).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
> Page 10310
9. NOTE:
- Use either a high-ratio, electric or battery-operated caulk gun that will apply the urethane with less
effort and a continuous bead.
- Make sure that all gaps in the urethane adhesive are smoothed into one continuous bead.
Apply urethane adhesive over top of the existing urethane adhesive. Apply the urethane to the top and sides of the windshield from the interior of the vehicle.
- Apply the urethane to the bottom of the windshield from the exterior of the vehicle.
10. CAUTION: The urethane adhesive must cure for a minimum of one hour before testing for air or
water leaks.
After the urethane has cured, check the windshield seal for air or water leaks through the urethane
bead and add urethane adhesive as necessary.
11. Position the front portion of the headliner. 12. If equipped, install the overhead console. 13.
Install the LH and RH sun visors.
14. Install the LH and RH A-pillar trim panels.
15. Install the LH and RH weatherstrips. 16. Install the cowl panel grille. 17. Clean the interior and
exterior windshield glass with glass cleaner.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
> Page 10311
Windshield: Removal and Replacement
WINDSHIELD GLASS
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Material
Material
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
> Page 10312
Removal
WARNING: To prevent glass splinters from entering eyes or cutting hands, wear safety glasses
and heavy gloves when cutting glass from the vehicle. Failure to follow these instructions may
result in personal injury.
1. Remove the A-pillar trim panels. 2. Remove the sun visors. 3. Remove the interior mirror. 4.
Partially lower the front portion of the headliner near the windshield header and block with suitable
material. 5. Remove the cowl panel grille.
6. NOTE:
- Lubricate the existing urethane adhesive with water to aid the special tool while cutting.
- Removing the windshield glass requires more than one technician.
Using the special tool, cut the urethane adhesive from the windshield glass starting at the top
center and working toward the bottom corners.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
> Page 10313
7. Using the special tool, distance the windshield glass from the body. 8. Using the Pneumatic
Knife with offset blade, cut the remaining urethane adhesive and remove the windshield glass. 9.
Using a soft brush or vacuum, remove any dirt or foreign material from the pinch weld.
Installation
CAUTION: When installing urethane-installed glass parts, the vehicle must not be driven until
urethane has cured. Adequate cure time is specified on the drive away chart for each urethane
product as temperatures and humidity vary. Inadequate or incorrect curing can adversely affect
retention of the windshield.
NOTE: For additional material guidelines, refer to the manufacturer's installation information.
1. Dry fit the windshield glass to the existing urethane adhesive bead on the body pinch weld. Align
the windshield glass in the opening for a uniform
fit.
2. For a uniform fit, use the 2 alignment pins on windshield glass to align the windshield glass in the
pin holes on the top pinch weld. 3. Use a non-permanent pencil to make alignment marks on the
windshield glass at the setting blocks and the body to aid in the installation alignment
of the windshield glass.
4. Remove the windshield glass.
5. NOTE: Avoid scratching the pinch weld. For minor scratches or exposed metal on the pinch
weld, see the manufacturer's recommendations.
Using an appropriate tool, trim the urethane adhesive leaving a 1-2 mm (0.04-0.08 in) base of
original equipment urethane on the pinchweld.
6. If installing the original windshield glass, remove the excess urethane adhesive. 7. Clean the
inside of the windshield glass surface with glass cleaner.
8. CAUTION: Be sure to use the same brand urethane and cure-rate products for adhesive and
primer. Do not mix different brands of
urethane and primer.
NOTE: Sika uses the same black primer for the glass and pinch weld area.
If installing a new windshield glass, apply urethane glass primer according to manufacturer's
instructions.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
> Page 10314
9. Cut the urethane adhesive applicator tip to specification.
10. NOTE: Use either a high-ratio, electric or battery-operated caulk gun that will apply the
urethane with less effort and a continuous bead.
Apply urethane adhesive on top of the existing trimmed urethane adhesive bead on the pinch weld.
Make sure that all gaps in the urethane adhesive are smoothed into one continuous bead starting
and ending at the bottom of the windshield near the center.
11. Install the windshield glass on the vehicle, aligning it with the markings made previously.
12. CAUTION: When installing urethane-installed glass parts, the vehicle must not be driven until
urethane has cured. Adequate cure time
is specified on the drive away chart for each urethane product as temperatures and humidity vary.
Inadequate or incorrect curing can adversely affect retention of the windshield.
After the urethane has cured, check the windshield glass seal for air or water leaks through the
urethane adhesive bead and add urethane adhesive as necessary.
13. Install the cowl panel grille. 14. Install the headliner. 15. Install the interior mirror. 16. Install the
sun visors. 17. Install the A-pillar trim panels.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Control Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 10320
C1552
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer
Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer
Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 10325
C138
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 10329
C202
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Front
Windshield Washer Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion Front
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Front >
Page 10332
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Front >
Page 10333
Windshield Washer Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion Rear
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Front >
Page 10334
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 10335
Windshield Washer Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Release the upper steering column shroud by pressing inward on the sides of the shroud
and lifting upwards.
Remove the upper steering column shroud.
2. Release the tilt lever, remove the 3 screws and then remove the lower steering column shroud.
3. Disconnect the multi-function switch electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 10336
4. Remove the 2 multi-function switch screws and remove the switch. 5. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 10340
C202
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Front
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Front
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Front > Page
10343
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Front > Page
10344
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Rear
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Front > Page
10345
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 10346
Wiper Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Release the upper steering column shroud by pressing inward on the sides of the shroud
and lifting upwards.
Remove the upper steering column shroud.
2. Release the tilt lever, remove the 3 screws and then remove the lower steering column shroud.
3. Disconnect the multi-function switch electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 10347
4. Remove the 2 multi-function switch screws and remove the switch. 5. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Edge (1 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Page 10351
C138
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Windshield Washer Hose: Service and Repair
WASHER HOSE REPAIR
1. Locate and verify the leaking washer hose.
2. Cut the hose cleanly and remove the damaged portion of the washer hose. 3. Install a
windshield washer hose adapter between the cut ends of the hose.
4. NOTE: In difficult cases, clamping may be required.
Install a segment of 6.4 mm (0.25 in) inside diameter black rubber hose over the ends of the
washer hose, and clamp both ends of the rubber hose using spring clamps.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Motor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 10358
C137
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Pump > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Windshield Washer Pump: Service and Repair
WASHER PUMP
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH front fender splash shield.
2. CAUTION: When replacing the washer pump, be careful not to damage the rubber grommet.
NOTE: To prevent spilling windshield washer fluid, drain the washer reservoir before washer pump
removal.
Remove the washer pump. 1. Disconnect the electrical connector. 2. Disconnect the hoses. 3.
Remove the washer pump.
3. CAUTION: Do not operate the washer pump prior to filling the washer reservoir. Failure to follow
these instructions may result in
premature pump failure.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. Fill the washer reservoir with windshield washer fluid.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Reservoir > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Windshield Washer Reservoir: Service and Repair
WASHER RESERVOIR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH front fender splash shield. 2. Disconnect the washer pump electrical connector.
3. NOTE: To prevent spilling windshield washer fluid, drain the washer reservoir before removal.
Disconnect the washer pump hoses.
4. Remove the bolt from the washer reservoir filler neck.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
5. Remove the washer reservoir nuts and the washer reservoir.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
6. CAUTION: Do not operate the washer pump prior to filling the washer reservoir. Failure to follow
these instructions may result in
premature pump failure.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. Fill the washer reservoir with windshield washer fluid.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Page 10368
C202
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Front
Windshield Washer Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion Front
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Front > Page 10371
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Front > Page 10372
Windshield Washer Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion Rear
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Front > Page 10373
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 10374
Windshield Washer Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Release the upper steering column shroud by pressing inward on the sides of the shroud
and lifting upwards.
Remove the upper steering column shroud.
2. Release the tilt lever, remove the 3 screws and then remove the lower steering column shroud.
3. Disconnect the multi-function switch electrical connector.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 10375
4. Remove the 2 multi-function switch screws and remove the switch. 5. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Adjustments > Wiper
Blade and Pivot Arm Adjustment - Windshield
Wiper Arm: Adjustments Wiper Blade and Pivot Arm Adjustment - Windshield
WIPER BLADE AND PIVOT ARM ADJUSTMENT - WINDSHIELD
1. Cycle and park the windshield wipers.
2. Verify that the RH and LH windshield wiper blades are located at the alignment marks on the
glass. 3. If necessary, remove the windshield wiper pivot arm nuts and the windshield wiper pivot
arms and reposition them to the correct locations.
- To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Adjustments > Wiper
Blade and Pivot Arm Adjustment - Windshield > Page 10380
Wiper Arm: Adjustments Wiper Blade and Pivot Arm Adjustment - Rear Window
WIPER BLADE AND PIVOT ARM ADJUSTMENT - REAR WINDOW
1. Cycle and park the rear window wiper.
2. Verify that the rear wiper blade is positioned at the first defroster line located on the rear window
glass. 3. If necessary, remove the rear wiper pivot arm nut and the rear wiper pivot arm and
reposition it to the correct location.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Mounting Arm and Pivot Shaft
Wiper Arm: Service and Repair Wiper Mounting Arm and Pivot Shaft
WIPER MOUNTING ARM AND PIVOT SHAFT
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the upper cowl panel grille. 2. Disconnect the windshield wiper motor electrical
connector. 3. Remove the 2 windshield wiper mounting arm and pivot shaft assembly bolts and the
windshield wiper mounting arm and pivot shaft assembly.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Mounting Arm and Pivot Shaft > Page 10383
Wiper Arm: Service and Repair Wiper Pivot Arm - Front
WIPER PIVOT ARM - FRONT
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front wiper pivot arm caps.
2. Remove the front wiper pivot arm retaining nuts and the front wiper pivot arms.
- To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- To adjust the windshield wiper pivot arms, refer to Wiper Blade and Pivot Arm Adjustment Windshield. See: Adjustments/Wiper Blade and Pivot Arm Adjustment - Windshield
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Mounting Arm and Pivot Shaft > Page 10384
Wiper Arm: Service and Repair Wiper Pivot Arm - Rear
WIPER PIVOT ARM - REAR
Removal and Installation
1. Open the rear wiper pivot arm nut cover.
2. Remove the nut and the rear wiper pivot arm.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- To adjust the rear wiper pivot arm, refer to Wiper Blade and Pivot Arm Adjustment - Rear
Window. See: Adjustments/Wiper Blade and Pivot Arm Adjustment - Rear Window
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Edge (2 Of 2))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Page 10388
C1552
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-25 (Liftgate - Edge)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Wiper Motor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10394
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
orientation.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10395
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10396
This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting several components at once (poor ground
connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices, connectors) between the ground point and
the component are shown. These ground connection details are shown here in order to keep the
individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10397
Symbols Part 1
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10398
Symbols Part 2
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10399
Symbols Part 3
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10400
Symbols Part 4
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10401
Symbols Part 5
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10402
Wiper Motor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10403
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10404
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10405
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10406
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10407
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 1/4" (6.35mm) of insulation from each wire end, taking
care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10408
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10409
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10410
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10411
C4218
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Motor - Windshield
Wiper Motor: Service and Repair Wiper Motor - Windshield
WIPER MOTOR - WINDSHIELD
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The windshield wiper motor is not serviceable separately. The windshield wiper motor and
the mounting arm and pivot shaft must be replaced together.
1. Remove the windshield wiper mounting arm and pivot shaft. 2. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Motor - Windshield > Page 10414
Wiper Motor: Service and Repair Wiper Motor - Rear Window
WIPER MOTOR - REAR WINDOW
Removal
1. Remove the rear wiper pivot arm. 2. Remove the liftgate interior trim panel. 3. Disconnect the
rear wiper motor electrical connector. 4. Remove the 3 rear wiper motor screws. 5. Remove the
rear wiper motor.
Installation
1. Position the rear wiper motor on the liftgate and install the 3 rear wiper motor screws.
- Tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
2. Connect the rear wiper motor electrical connector. 3. Install the liftgate interior trim panel. 4.
Install the rear wiper pivot arm.
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-9 (Dash Panel)
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
10418
C202
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Front
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Front
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Front > Page 10421
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Front > Page 10422
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Rear
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion - Front > Page 10423
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Page 10424
Wiper Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Release the upper steering column shroud by pressing inward on the sides of the shroud
and lifting upwards.
Remove the upper steering column shroud.
2. Release the tilt lever, remove the 3 screws and then remove the lower steering column shroud.
3. Disconnect the multi-function switch electrical connector.